Factory Workshop Manual
Make
Chevrolet
Model
Cavalier
Engine and year
Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994)
Please navigate through the PDF using the options
provided by OnlyManuals.com on the sidebar.
This manual was submitted by
Anonymous
Date
1st January 2018
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 >
Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
Relay Module: Customer Interest Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D
Date: December 08, 2010
Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle
Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion
(Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Attention:
This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body
electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the
point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal
surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011
model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
- An intermittent no crank/no start
- Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination
- Intermittent service lamp illumination
- Intermittent service message(s) being displayed
The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as
fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector.
This may be caused by any of the following conditions:
- Vibration
- Thermal cycling
- Poor connection/terminal retention
- Micro motion
- A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement
On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent
connections.
On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and
may cause a device to become inoperative.
Representative List of Control Modules and Components
The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected
by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or
component for every vehicle.
- Blower Control Module
- Body Control Module (BCM)
- Communication Interface Module (CIM)
- Cooling Fan Control Module
- Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
- Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM)
- Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module
- Engine Control Module (ECM)
- Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 >
Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 12
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 >
Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 13
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 >
Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 14
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec >
10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
Relay Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control
Modules
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D
Date: December 08, 2010
Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle
Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion
(Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Attention:
This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body
electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the
point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal
surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011
model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
- An intermittent no crank/no start
- Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination
- Intermittent service lamp illumination
- Intermittent service message(s) being displayed
The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as
fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector.
This may be caused by any of the following conditions:
- Vibration
- Thermal cycling
- Poor connection/terminal retention
- Micro motion
- A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement
On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent
connections.
On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and
may cause a device to become inoperative.
Representative List of Control Modules and Components
The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected
by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or
component for every vehicle.
- Blower Control Module
- Body Control Module (BCM)
- Communication Interface Module (CIM)
- Cooling Fan Control Module
- Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
- Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM)
- Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module
- Engine Control Module (ECM)
- Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec >
10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 20
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec >
10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 21
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec >
10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 22
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Relay Module: > 436103 >
May > 94 > Engine - Vibration at Idle or Clunk Noise at Launch
Engine Mount: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Vibration at Idle or Clunk Noise at Launch
Group Ref.: Engine
Bulletin No.: 436103
Date: May, 1994
SUBJECT: ENGINE VIBRATION AT IDLE OR CLUNK NOISE AT LAUNCH (REPLACE ENGINE
MOUNT)
MODELS: 1993-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER 1993-94 PONTIAC SUNBIRD
ENGINE APPLICATIONS: 2.0L (VIN H - RPO LE4) 2.2L (VIN 4 - RPO LN2) 3.1L (VIN T - RPO
LHO) WITH 3T40 (MD9) AND ISUZU 5-SPEED (MK7)
CONDITION: Some owners may experience engine vibration at idle or clunk noise at launch.
CAUSE: Right rear engine mount sagging.
CORRECTION:
Inspect right rear engine mount while in vehicle for less than 5 mm gap.
If gap checked in diagnosis is less than 5 mm, install the proper replacement engine mount as
follows:
All 2.2L (LN2) and 2.0L (LE4) use P/N 22637949. 3.1L (LHO with MD9 only) use P/N 22637950.
1. Install new engine mount and only tighten bolts finger tight to allow seating of engine.
2. Install engine mount bracket bolts only finger tight.
3. Loosen transaxle mount to transaxle mount bracket bolt and the two nuts holding the snubber
block on the mount itself.
4. Block wheels.
5. Set parking brake and start engine.
6. Shift from reverse to drive several times to seat the engine and transaxle assembly.
7. Turn ignition switch to "off" position.
8. Tighten transaxle mount to transaxle mount bracket bolt.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Relay Module: > 436103 >
May > 94 > Engine - Vibration at Idle or Clunk Noise at Launch > Page 28
9. Tighten engine mount bracket to body bolts.
10. Tighten engine mount to engine mount bracket nuts.
11. Center the snubber block on the transaxle mount (transaxle in "neutral"), then tighten the two
nuts holding the snubber block to mount.
Parts are expected to be available on May 2, 1994.
WARRANTY INFORMATION:
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation: J1510
Labor Time: 0.8 hr
Add: 0.2 hr (For inspection)
Add: 0.2 hr (To loosen/tighten transaxle mounts)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Relay Module: > 436103 >
May > 94 > Engine - Vibration at Idle or Clunk Noise at Launch > Page 34
9. Tighten engine mount bracket to body bolts.
10. Tighten engine mount to engine mount bracket nuts.
11. Center the snubber block on the transaxle mount (transaxle in "neutral"), then tighten the two
nuts holding the snubber block to mount.
Parts are expected to be available on May 2, 1994.
WARRANTY INFORMATION:
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation: J1510
Labor Time: 0.8 hr
Add: 0.2 hr (For inspection)
Add: 0.2 hr (To loosen/tighten transaxle mounts)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Convertible Top Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Rear Of Passenger Compartment (Convertible)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Convertible Top Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 39
Harness Connector Faces: Convertable Top Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module >
Component Information > Locations
Convenience Center
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Auto Door Lock Module/Enable Relay
Power Door Lock Control Module: Locations Auto Door Lock Module/Enable Relay
The Automatic Door Unlock Module is located at the left hand side of the Dash, near C100.
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
C100 (42 cavities) is located at the upper left hand side of Engine Compartment.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Auto Door Lock Module/Enable Relay > Page 47
Convenience Center
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 48
Harness Connector Faces: Door Unlock Module
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Relay >
Component Information > Locations
RH Front Door (Convertible)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 52
Harness Connector Faces: Automatic Door Lock Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Behind RH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 57
Behind RH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS Main
Relay > Component Information > Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS Main
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 62
Harness Connector Faces: Electronic Brake Control Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Solenoid Valve Relay > Component Information > Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Electronic Brake
Control Module: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 & C1286)
Electronic Brake Control Module: Customer Interest Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246
& C1286)
File In Section: 5 - Brakes
Bulletin No.: 73-50-26
Date: August, 1997
Subject: ABS Light On - DTC's 46 and 86 Set (Perform Diagnostic Procedure, Replace Center ABS
Motor Pinion)
Models: 1991-97 Buick Skylark 1992-97 Buick Regal 1994-97 Buick Century 1992-96 Chevrolet
Beretta, Corsica, Lumina APV 1992-97 Chevrolet Cavalier, Lumina, 1993-97 Chevrolet Camaro
1995-97 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 1997
Chevrolet Malibu, Venture
1993-97 Geo Prizm 1995-97 Geo Metro 1996-97 Geo Tracker 1991
Oldsmobile Calais
1992-96 Oldsmobile Cutlass Ciera 1992-97 Oldsmobile Achieva, Cutlass Supreme, Silhouette
1997
Oldsmobile Cutlass
1998 Oldsmobile Intrigue
1991-97 Pontiac Grand Am 1992-94 Pontiac Sunbird 1992-97 Pontiac Grand Prix, Trans Sport
1993-97 Pontiac Firebird, Trans Am 1995-97 Pontiac Sunfire
Condition
Some owners may comment that the ABS light is on with Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) 46
and 86 set (rear ABS channel will not move) as current or history. (DTC's 46 and 86 will be
displayed as C1246 and C1286 on 1997 and 1998 model year vehicles).
Cause
A condition exists where the ABS motor pack gear (pinion) will bind on the motor armature shaft
causing the motor not to move when commanded by the EBCM. This condition is aggravated by
light corrosion between the pinion and shaft. Therefore, it may occur more frequently when the
weather is hot and humid.
Important:
Other EBCM and ABS motor pack concerns can also cause this condition, but they are not as
common as the above cause.
Correction
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Electronic Brake
Control Module: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 & C1286) > Page 74
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Electronic Brake
Control Module: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 & C1286) > Page 75
Follow the included procedure (Attachments 1 and 2) for diagnosis. This condition may correct
itself before the owner is able to bring the vehicle in for service. Therefore, if DTC 46 is set in
history, and is not currently setting, the included procedure will instruct you to replace the center
ABS motor pinion. The new pinion has a Teflon insert which reduces friction between the pinion
and motor armature shaft.
Pinion Replacement
If the included procedure instructs you to replace the center ABS motor pinion, use P/N 18029776.
Please note that the new pinion is a direct replacement part which requires no modifications to the
motor shaft. Follow the pinion replacement procedure included with the new pinion. Complete
motor pack replacement is not required.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Labor Time
H2506 Use published labor
operation time.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Electronic
Brake Control Module: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 & C1286)
Electronic Brake Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 &
86 (C1246 & C1286)
File In Section: 5 - Brakes
Bulletin No.: 73-50-26
Date: August, 1997
Subject: ABS Light On - DTC's 46 and 86 Set (Perform Diagnostic Procedure, Replace Center ABS
Motor Pinion)
Models: 1991-97 Buick Skylark 1992-97 Buick Regal 1994-97 Buick Century 1992-96 Chevrolet
Beretta, Corsica, Lumina APV 1992-97 Chevrolet Cavalier, Lumina, 1993-97 Chevrolet Camaro
1995-97 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 1997
Chevrolet Malibu, Venture
1993-97 Geo Prizm 1995-97 Geo Metro 1996-97 Geo Tracker 1991
Oldsmobile Calais
1992-96 Oldsmobile Cutlass Ciera 1992-97 Oldsmobile Achieva, Cutlass Supreme, Silhouette
1997
Oldsmobile Cutlass
1998 Oldsmobile Intrigue
1991-97 Pontiac Grand Am 1992-94 Pontiac Sunbird 1992-97 Pontiac Grand Prix, Trans Sport
1993-97 Pontiac Firebird, Trans Am 1995-97 Pontiac Sunfire
Condition
Some owners may comment that the ABS light is on with Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) 46
and 86 set (rear ABS channel will not move) as current or history. (DTC's 46 and 86 will be
displayed as C1246 and C1286 on 1997 and 1998 model year vehicles).
Cause
A condition exists where the ABS motor pack gear (pinion) will bind on the motor armature shaft
causing the motor not to move when commanded by the EBCM. This condition is aggravated by
light corrosion between the pinion and shaft. Therefore, it may occur more frequently when the
weather is hot and humid.
Important:
Other EBCM and ABS motor pack concerns can also cause this condition, but they are not as
common as the above cause.
Correction
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Electronic
Brake Control Module: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 & C1286) > Page 81
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Electronic
Brake Control Module: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 & C1286) > Page 82
Follow the included procedure (Attachments 1 and 2) for diagnosis. This condition may correct
itself before the owner is able to bring the vehicle in for service. Therefore, if DTC 46 is set in
history, and is not currently setting, the included procedure will instruct you to replace the center
ABS motor pinion. The new pinion has a Teflon insert which reduces friction between the pinion
and motor armature shaft.
Pinion Replacement
If the included procedure instructs you to replace the center ABS motor pinion, use P/N 18029776.
Please note that the new pinion is a direct replacement part which requires no modifications to the
motor shaft. Follow the pinion replacement procedure included with the new pinion. Complete
motor pack replacement is not required.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Labor Time
H2506 Use published labor
operation time.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Antilock Brake Module
Electronic Brake Control Module: Locations Antilock Brake Module
Fig. 1 TYPICAL ABS Components
Refer to Fig. 1 for system component locations.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Antilock Brake Module > Page 85
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1
Electronic Brake Control Module: Diagrams C1
Harness Connector Faces: Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)- C1
Harness Connector Faces: Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)- C1 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 > Page 88
Electronic Brake Control Module: Diagrams C2
Harness Connector Faces: Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)- C2
Harness Connector Faces: Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)- C2 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 > Page 89
Electronic Brake Control Module: Diagrams C3
Harness Connector Faces: Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)- C3
Harness Connector Faces: Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)- C3 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 90
Electronic Brake Control Module: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The ABS system is controlled by a microprocessor based Electronic Brake Control Module
(EBCM). Inputs to the system include four wheel speed sensors, brakes, ignition switch and
unswitched battery voltage. Outputs include three bi-directional motor controls, three lamp controls,
two solenoid controls and the system enable relay. A serial data line, located in terminal 9 of the
Data Link Connector (DLC), is provided for service diagnostic tools and assembly plant testing.
The EBCM monitors the speed of each wheel. If any wheel begins to approach lock-up and the
brake switch is on, the EBCM controls the motors and solenoids to reduce brake pressure to the
wheel approaching lock-up. Once the wheel regains traction, brake pressure is increased until
wheel begins to approach lock-up. This cycle repeats until either vehicle comes to a stop, the brake
is released or no wheels approach lock-up. Additionally, the EBCM monitors itself, each input and
each output for proper operation. If any system fault is detected, the EBCM will store a DTC in
nonvolatile memory.
On a EBTCM, the ABS portion of the module operates the same as a EBCM. A EBTCM is used if
the vehicle is equipped with either the Enhanced Traction System (ETS) or Traction Control
System (TCS). The ETS or TCS portion of the EBTCM monitors wheel spin slip through the drive
wheels speed sensors. If the wheels begin to slip, the EBTCM determines the desired wheel torque
needed to minimize wheel slip. This information is sent to the PCM through the Serial data link. On
models equipped w/ETS, the PCM controls engine torque by ignition retard and transmission shifts.
On models equipped w/TCS, the PCM controls engine torque by ignition retard, transmission shifts
and applies brakes several times until the vehicle regains traction. Once the vehicle regains
traction, brake pressure is decreased and engine torque reduction is no longer requested. This
cycle repeats until traction control is no longer necessary.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 91
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
Fig. 800 EBCM Assembly Removal.
1. Disconnect EBCM electrical connectors, Fig.800. 2. Remove ECU to dash panel attaching
screws, then the ECU from dash panel. 3. Reverse procedure to install, noting the following:
a. Ensure plastic grommets, if equipped, are located properly. b. Bleed brake system as described
under Brake System Bleed. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Brake Bleeding
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Motor
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Component Locations
LH Front Of Engine Compartment
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Motor
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 97
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Motor
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 98
Harness Connector Faces: Coolant Fan Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan Motor
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 99
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Description and Operation
PURPOSE:
The electric Cooling Fan is used for engine and A/C condenser cooling and is controlled by the
ECM/PCM
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION:
Battery voltage to operate the cooling fan motor is supplied to a relay by the ECM/PCM completing
a ground. When the ECM/PCM grounds CKT 335 the relay is energized and the cooling fan is
turned ON."
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 105
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 106
Cruise Control Module: Diagrams
Harness Connector Faces: Cruise Control Module (Description)
Harness Connector Faces: Cruise Control Module
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 107
Cruise Control Module: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The module will interpret the position of the servo, the position of the control switches and the
output of the speed sensor. In response to these inputs, the module electrically signals the opening
or closing of the vent and vacuum solenoid valves in the servo.
The module is mounted on the dash support bracket at the right side of the steering column, but is
integral with the ECM on some models with certain engines.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 113
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 114
Harness Connector Faces: High Blower Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 119
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 120
Harness Connector Faces: A/C Compressor Control Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Multi-Function Chime (MFC) Module
Audible Warning Device Control Module: Locations Multi-Function Chime (MFC) Module
Convenience Center
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Multi-Function Chime (MFC) Module > Page 126
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Multi-Function Chime (MFC) Module > Page 127
Convenience Center
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Control Unit > Component Information > Locations
Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit: Locations
Daytime Running Lights (DRL) Module is located Behind LH side of I/P near C200
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Control Unit > Component Information > Locations > Page 132
Harness Connector Faces: Daytime Running Lights (DRL) Module
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Relay > Component Information > Locations
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Daytime Running Lights (DRL) Ignition Relay
Harness Connector Faces: Daytime Running Lights (DRL) Ignition Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Daytime Running Lights (DRL) Ignition Relay > Page 138
Harness Connector Faces: Daytime Running Light (DRL) Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Dome Light Switch <-->
[Dome Lamp Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams
Harness Connector Faces: Dome Light Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Convenience Center
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Lamp Dimmer Module
<--> [Lamp Control Module] > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Lamp Dimmer Module
<--> [Lamp Control Module] > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 149
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Lamp Dimmer Module
<--> [Lamp Control Module] > Component Information > Locations > Page 150
Harness Connector Faces: Lamp Dimmer Module
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory
Usage
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-06-04-054B
Date: November 18, 2010
Subject: Info - Non-GM Parts and Accessories (Aftermarket)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and update to the new U.S. Fixed
Operation Manager (FOM) and Canada Warranty Manager (WM) names. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 04-06-04-054A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
The recent rise and expansion of companies selling non-GM parts and accessories has made it
necessary to issue this reminder to dealers regarding GM's policy on the use and installation of
these aftermarket components.
When a dealer is performing a repair under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty, they are required to
use only genuine GM or GM-approved parts and accessories. This applies to all warranty repairs,
special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM. Parts and accessories advertised as being "the
same" as parts manufactured by GM, but not sold through GM, do not qualify for use in warranty
repairs, special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM.
During a warranty repair, if a GM original equipment part is not available through GM Customer
Care and Aftersales (GM CC&A;), ACDelco(R) distributors, other GM dealers or approved sources,
the dealer is to obtain comparable, non-GM parts and clearly indicate, in detail, on the repair order
the circumstances surrounding why non-GM parts were used. The dealer must give customers
written notice, prior to the sale or service, that such parts or accessories are not marketed or
warranted by General Motors.
It should also be noted that dealers modifying new vehicles and installing equipment, parts and
accessories obtained from sources not authorized by GM are responsible for complying with the
National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. Certain non-approved parts or assemblies, installed
by the dealer or its agent not authorized by GM, may result in a change to the vehicle's design
characteristics and may affect the vehicle's ability to conform to federal law. Dealers must fully
understand that non-GM approved parts may not have been validated, tested or certified for use.
This puts the dealer at risk for potential liability in the event of a part or vehicle failure. If a GM part
failure occurs as the result of the installation or use of a non-GM approved part, the warranty will
not be honored.
A good example of non-authorized modification of vehicles is the result of an ever increasing
supply of aftermarket devices available to the customer, which claim to increase the horsepower
and torque of the Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines. These include the addition of, but are not limited to
one or more of the following modifications:
- Propane injection
- Nitrous oxide injection
- Additional modules (black boxes) that connect to the vehicle wiring systems
- Revised engine calibrations downloaded for the engine control module
- Calibration modules which connect to the vehicle diagnostic connector
- Modification to the engine turbocharger waste gate
Although the installation of these devices, or modification of vehicle components, can increase
engine horsepower and torque, they may also negatively affect the engine emissions, reliability
and/or durability. In addition, other powertrain components, such as transmissions, universal joints,
drive shafts, and front/rear axle components, can be stressed beyond design safety limits by the
installation of these devices.
General Motors does not support or endorse the use of devices or modifications that, when
installed, increase the engine horsepower and torque. It is because of these unknown stresses,
and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a
policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining
warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a
non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is
subsequently removed. Refer to the latest version of Bulletin 09-06-04-026 (V8 Gas Engines) or
06-06-01-007 (Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines) for more information on dealer requirements for
calibration verification.
These same policies apply as they relate to the use of non-GM accessories. Damage or failure
from the use or installation of a non-GM accessory will not be covered under warranty. Failure
resulting from the alteration or modification of the vehicle, including the cutting, welding or
disconnecting of the vehicle's original equipment parts and components will void the warranty.
Additionally, dealers will NOT be reimbursed or compensated by GM in the event of any legal
inquiry at either the local, state or federal level that
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 157
results from the alteration or modification of a vehicle using non-GM approved parts or accessories.
Dealers should be especially cautious of accessory companies that claim the installation of their
product will not void the factory warranty. Many times these companies have even given direction
on how to quickly disassemble the accessory in an attempt to preclude the manufacturer from
finding out that is has been installed.
Any suspect repairs should be reviewed by the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), and in Canada
by the Warranty Manager (WM) for appropriate repair direction. If it is decided that a goodwill repair
is to be made on the vehicle, even with the installation of such non-GM approved components, the
customer is to be made aware of General Motors position on this issue and is to sign the
appropriate goodwill documentation required by General Motors.
It is imperative for dealers to understand that by installing such devices, they are jeopardizing not
only the warranty coverage, but also the performance and reliability of the customer's vehicle.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Specifications > PCM
Connector C1 (Black)
Engine Control Module: Specifications PCM Connector C1 (Black)
ECM Connector: C1
ECM Connector: C1 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Specifications > PCM
Connector C1 (Black) > Page 160
Engine Control Module: Specifications PCM Connector C2 (Black)
ECM Connector: C2
ECM Connector: C2 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Specifications > PCM
Connector C1 (Black) > Page 161
Engine Control Module: Specifications PCM Connector C3 (Green)
ECM Connector: C3
ECM Connector: C3 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations
Behind RH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 164
Behind RH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 (Black)
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C1 (Black)
ECM Connector: C1
ECM Connector: C1 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 (Black) >
Page 167
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C2 (Black)
ECM Connector: C2
ECM Connector: C2 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 (Black) >
Page 168
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C3 (Green)
ECM Connector: C3
ECM Connector: C3 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 169
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation
Computer Module
PURPOSE:
The Electronic Control Module or Powertrain Control Module (ECM/PCM) is the control center of
the fuel injection system. It constantly looks at the information from various sensors (inputs) and
controls the systems (outputs) that affect vehicle performance. The ECM/PCM also performs the
diagnostic function of the system. It can recognize operational problems, alert the driver through
the "SERVICE ENGINE SOON" or "MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP" light, and store a code or
codes which identify the problem areas to aid the technician in performing repairs.
OPERATION:
The computer is designed to process the various input information, and send the necessary
electrical response to control fuel delivery, spark control, and other emission control systems. The
computer can control these devices through the use of Quad Driver Modules (QDM). When the
ECM/PCM is commanding a device or a component "ON," the voltage potential of the output is
"LOW" or near zero volts. When the ECM/PCM is commanding a device or component "OFF," the
voltage potential of the circuit will be "HIGH," or near 12 volts. The primary function of the QDM is
to supply the ground for the component being controlled.
The input information has an interrelation between sensor output. If one of the input devices failed,
such as the oxygen sensor, this could affect more than one of the systems controlled by the
computer.
The computer has a learning ability which allows it to make corrections for minor variations in the
fuel system to improve driveability. If the battery is disconnected to clear trouble codes or for repair,
the learning process has to begin all over again, and a change may be noticed in the driving
performance of the vehicle. To reset the vehicles learning ability, make sure the engine is at
operating temperature and operate the vehicle at part throttle, moderate acceleration, and idle
conditions, until normal performance returns.
This vehicle is equipped with an ECM/PCM with two parts for service, a controller which is the
ECM/PCM itself and a memory calibration unit called a MEM-CAL, PROM, or EPROM.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Pinout Values and Diagnostic Parameters
Engine Control Module: Pinout Values and Diagnostic Parameters
ECM Connector: C1
ECM Connector: C1 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Pinout Values and Diagnostic Parameters > Page 172
ECM Connector: C2
ECM Connector: C2 (Description)
ECM Connector: C3
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Pinout Values and Diagnostic Parameters > Page 173
ECM Connector: C3 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Page 174
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair
ECM
Remove or Disconnect:
1. Negative battery cable.
2. Interior access panel.
3. Connectors from ECM/PCM.
3. ECM/PCM.
NOTICE: To prevent possible electrostatic discharge damage to the ECM/PCM, Do Not touch the
connector pins or soldered components on the
circuit board.
Install or Connect:
1. New ECM/PCM.
2. ECM connectors to ECM/PCM.
3. Negative battery cable.
4. interior access panel.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations
Fuel Pump Relay: Component Locations
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Right hand rear of the engine compartment, behind the right hand strut tower.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 180
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 181
Harness Connector Faces: Fuel Pump Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 182
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation
Relay Center
PURPOSE:
To relay power to the fuel pump.
OPERATION:
When the ignition key is first turned to the "ON" position, the ECM/PCM will energize the fuel pump
relay for two seconds. This increases fuel pressure for cranking. If the engine is not running within
two seconds, the ECM/PCM will shut "OFF" the relay and wait until the engine starts. As soon as
the engine is cranked, the ECM/PCM will energize the relay and power the fuel pump.
NOTE: The fuel pump relay may be bypassed by the oil pressure switch activating the fuel pump.
LOCATION:
Relay Center.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 183
Fuel Pump Relay: Service and Repair
The fuel pump relay is mounted in the engine compartment.
Fuel Pump Relay
NOTE: Other than checking for loose connections the only service on the fuel pump relay is
replacement.
PROCEDURE
1. Verify that the ignition switch is in the "OFF" position. 2. Disconnect the wiring harness plug. 3.
Remove the fuel pump relay. 4. Install the new fuel pump relay. 5. Connect the wiring harness plug
securely.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Manual
RH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Manual > Page 189
RH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 190
Harness Connector Faces: Electronic Ignition (EI) System
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 191
Ignition Control Module: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative battery cable.
2. Ignition Coils.
3. Module from assembly plate.
INSTALLATION
1. Module to assembly plate.
2. Ignition Coils.
3. Negative battery cable.
IDLE LEARN PROCEDURE: Any time the battery is disconnected, the programmed position of the
IAC valve pintle is lost, and replaced with a default value. To return the IAC valve pintle to the
correct position, perform the following procedure:
1. After restoring battery power, connect the Tech 1 "SCAN" tool.
2. Select "IAC SYSTEM," then select "IDLE LEARN" in the "MISC TEST" mode.
3. Proceed with idle learn as directed. ^
This procedure allows the ECM memory to be updated with the correct IAC valve pintle position, for
the vehicle, and provide a stable idle speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM) performs several system functions. These functions
include energy reserve, air bag deployment, malfunction detection, malfunction diagnosis, driver
notification, frontal crash detection and frontal crash recording.
OPERATION
The SDM contains a sensing device which converts vehicle velocity changes to an electrical signal.
The electrical signal generated is processed by the SDM and then compared to a value stored in
memory. When the generated signal exceeds the stored value, additional signals are compared to
signals stored in memory. When two of the generated signals exceed the stored values or when
one of the generated signals exceeds the stored value and the forward discriminating sensor
closes, the SDM will cause current to flow through the inflator modules deploying the air bags.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > C2
A-Center Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > C2 > Page 201
A-Center Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 202
Heated Glass Control Module: Diagrams
Harness Connector Faces: Heater-A/C And Rear Defogger Control Assembly- C1
Harness Connector Faces: Heater-A/C And Rear Defogger Control Assembly- C2
Harness Connector Faces: Heater-A/C And Rear Defogger Control Assembly- C3
Harness Connector Faces: Heater-A/C And Rear Defogger Control Assembly- C1 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 203
Harness Connector Faces: Heater-A/C And Rear Defogger Control Assembly- C2 (Description)
Harness Connector Faces: Heater-A/C And Rear Defogger Control Assembly- C3 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Convertible Top Switch
> Component Information > Locations
LH Front Of Door (Convertible)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Convertible Top Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 209
Harness Connector Faces: Convertable Top Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Door Lock Switch: > 438101B
> Sep > 95 > Interior - Lights Remain On/Battery Becomes Rundown
Power Door Lock Switch: Customer Interest Interior - Lights Remain On/Battery Becomes
Rundown
File In Section: 8 - Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 43-81-01B
Date: September, 1995
Subject: Battery Rundown/Interior Lights Remain On (Diagnostic Check/Replace Door Handle
Switch)
Models: 1992-94 Chevrolet Cavalier 1994
Chevrolet Corsica, Beretta
1992-94 Pontiac Sunbird
This bulletin is being revised to update the correction procedure and parts and warranty
information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 43-81-01A (Section 8 - Chassis/Body
Electrical).
Condition
Some owners may experience interior lights staying "ON" after all doors are closed and after the
Multi-Function Alarm Module's inadvertent lighting function has timed out, causing battery rundown.
In the Corsica/Beretta, the Multi-Function Alarm Module will automatically turn off the interior lights
after 20 minutes. The Cavalier and Sunbird's interior lights will continue to light indefinitely.
Cause
The LH and/or RH front door handle switch(es) may be providing a resistive path to ground which
may cause the Multi-Function Alarm Module to sense that the door(s) are falsely open.
Correction
Follow the diagnostic procedure as listed below. If a resistance other than the specified value
registers during testing, replace the malfunctioning door handle switch, (see P/N chart). Continue
through the entire test to check that both the RH and LH door handle switches are functioning
properly.
1. Disconnect the Multi-Function Alarm Module.
2. With the LH front door open, measure the resistance from:
Term "J" to Term "P" (J Car)
CONN C1, Term "H" to CONN C2, Term "E" (L Car)
Resistance should be between 0 - 0.5 Ohms.
3. With the LH front door closed, measure the resistance from:
Term "J" to Term "P" (J Car)
CONN C1, Term "H" to CONN C2, Term "E" (L Car)
Resistance should be > 30 Mega Ohms.
4. With the RH front door open, measure the resistance from:
Term "K" to Term "P" (J Car)
CONN C1, Term "G" to CONN C2, Term "E" (L Car)
Resistance should be between 0 - 0.5 Ohms.
5. With the RH front door closed, measure the resistance from:
Term "K" to Term "P" (J Car)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Door Lock Switch: > 438101B
> Sep > 95 > Interior - Lights Remain On/Battery Becomes Rundown > Page 218
CONN C1, Term "G" to CONN 02, Term "E" (L Car)
Resistance should be > 30 Mega Ohms.
Parts Information
All parts are found in Group 10.470 - LOCK ASM F/RH or LH
Important:
The door handle switches are part of the front side door lock assembly.
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Door Lock
Switch: > 438101B > Sep > 95 > Interior - Lights Remain On/Battery Becomes Rundown
Power Door Lock Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Lights Remain On/Battery
Becomes Rundown
File In Section: 8 - Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 43-81-01B
Date: September, 1995
Subject: Battery Rundown/Interior Lights Remain On (Diagnostic Check/Replace Door Handle
Switch)
Models: 1992-94 Chevrolet Cavalier 1994
Chevrolet Corsica, Beretta
1992-94 Pontiac Sunbird
This bulletin is being revised to update the correction procedure and parts and warranty
information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 43-81-01A (Section 8 - Chassis/Body
Electrical).
Condition
Some owners may experience interior lights staying "ON" after all doors are closed and after the
Multi-Function Alarm Module's inadvertent lighting function has timed out, causing battery rundown.
In the Corsica/Beretta, the Multi-Function Alarm Module will automatically turn off the interior lights
after 20 minutes. The Cavalier and Sunbird's interior lights will continue to light indefinitely.
Cause
The LH and/or RH front door handle switch(es) may be providing a resistive path to ground which
may cause the Multi-Function Alarm Module to sense that the door(s) are falsely open.
Correction
Follow the diagnostic procedure as listed below. If a resistance other than the specified value
registers during testing, replace the malfunctioning door handle switch, (see P/N chart). Continue
through the entire test to check that both the RH and LH door handle switches are functioning
properly.
1. Disconnect the Multi-Function Alarm Module.
2. With the LH front door open, measure the resistance from:
Term "J" to Term "P" (J Car)
CONN C1, Term "H" to CONN C2, Term "E" (L Car)
Resistance should be between 0 - 0.5 Ohms.
3. With the LH front door closed, measure the resistance from:
Term "J" to Term "P" (J Car)
CONN C1, Term "H" to CONN C2, Term "E" (L Car)
Resistance should be > 30 Mega Ohms.
4. With the RH front door open, measure the resistance from:
Term "K" to Term "P" (J Car)
CONN C1, Term "G" to CONN C2, Term "E" (L Car)
Resistance should be between 0 - 0.5 Ohms.
5. With the RH front door closed, measure the resistance from:
Term "K" to Term "P" (J Car)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Door Lock
Switch: > 438101B > Sep > 95 > Interior - Lights Remain On/Battery Becomes Rundown > Page 224
CONN C1, Term "G" to CONN 02, Term "E" (L Car)
Resistance should be > 30 Mega Ohms.
Parts Information
All parts are found in Group 10.470 - LOCK ASM F/RH or LH
Important:
The door handle switches are part of the front side door lock assembly.
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Door Lock Switch
Power Door Lock Switch: Locations Left Front Door Lock Switch
LH Front Of Door (Coupe)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Door Lock Switch > Page 227
LH Front Of Door (Convertible)
LH Front Door (Station Wagon Shown, Sedan Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Door Lock Switch > Page 228
Power Door Lock Switch: Locations Right Front Door Lock Switch
RH Front Of Door (Coupe)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Door Lock Switch > Page 229
RH Front Door (Convertible)
RH Front Door (Station Wagon Shown, Sedan Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Left Front Door Lock Switch > Page 230
LH Rear Door (Sedan And Station Wagon) (RH Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Door Lock Switch
Harness Connector Faces: LH Front Door Lock Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Door Lock Switch > Page 233
Harness Connector Faces: RH Front Door Lock Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Component Locations
Tailgate (Station Wagon)
Behind RH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 238
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Connector Locations
Behind RH Side Of I/P
Behind RH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 243
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
OPERATION
This sensor mounted on the master cylinder will activate the Brake Warning lamp if a low brake
fluid level is detected. The lamp will turn off once the fluid level is corrected.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
Brake Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
Fig. 3 Pressure Differential Valve & Brake Warning Lamp Switch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 247
Fig. 4 Dual Master Cylinder W/Built In Warning Lamp Switch.
DESCRIPTION
In Fig. 3, as pressure falls in one system, the other system's normal pressure forces the piston to
the inoperative side, contacting the switch terminal, causing the warning lamp on the instrument
panel to glow.
In Fig. 4 shows the switch mounted directly in the master cylinder assembly. Whenever there is a
specified differential pressure, the switch piston will activate the brake failure warning switch and
cause the brake warning lamp to glow.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Console
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Parking
Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 252
Console
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
63-50-15B > Mar > 98 > ABS Indicator Lamp On, DTC 21,22,32 or 33 Set
Wheel Speed Sensor: Customer Interest ABS Indicator Lamp On, DTC 21,22,32 or 33 Set
File In Section: 5 - Brakes
Bulletin No.: 63-50-15B
Date: March, 1998
Subject: ABS Indicator Lamp ON, DTC 21, 22, 32 or 33 Set (Install Front ABS Wheel Speed
Sensor Wiring Harness Connector Kit)
Models: 1992-97 Buick Skylark 1991-96 Chevrolet Beretta, Corsica 1992-97 Chevrolet Cavalier
1992-97 Oldsmobile Achieva 1992-94 Pontiac Sunbird 1995-97 Pontiac Sunfire 1992-97 Pontiac
Grand Am
This bulletin is being revised to update parts and applicable model information. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 63-50-15A - (Section 5 - Brakes)
Condition
Some owners may comment that the ABS indicator lamp is "ON". Also, malfunction DTC 21, 22, 32
or 33 could set.
Cause
The right front and left front ABS wheel speed sensor wiring harness could be damaged and result
in an open circuit. The wiring harness may be damaged approximately 4 inches (10 cm) back from
the harness connector to the wheel speed sensor. This allows moisture to enter the harness
causing corrosion and resulting in the open circuit.
Correction
A thorough inspection for corrosion and/or damage should be performed on suspect vehicles. It
may be necessary to move the protective conduit away in order to inspect the wiring properly. If a
failure occurs and damage is found, install the front ABS wheel speed sensor wiring harness
connector kit(s). The kit includes instructions, splices, and "pigtail" connector.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
63-50-15B > Mar > 98 > ABS Indicator Lamp On, DTC 21,22,32 or 33 Set > Page 261
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Description Labor Time
H2530 Right Side Use published
H2531 Left Side Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed
Sensor: > 63-50-15B > Mar > 98 > ABS Indicator Lamp On, DTC 21,22,32 or 33 Set
Wheel Speed Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS Indicator Lamp On, DTC 21,22,32 or 33
Set
File In Section: 5 - Brakes
Bulletin No.: 63-50-15B
Date: March, 1998
Subject: ABS Indicator Lamp ON, DTC 21, 22, 32 or 33 Set (Install Front ABS Wheel Speed
Sensor Wiring Harness Connector Kit)
Models: 1992-97 Buick Skylark 1991-96 Chevrolet Beretta, Corsica 1992-97 Chevrolet Cavalier
1992-97 Oldsmobile Achieva 1992-94 Pontiac Sunbird 1995-97 Pontiac Sunfire 1992-97 Pontiac
Grand Am
This bulletin is being revised to update parts and applicable model information. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 63-50-15A - (Section 5 - Brakes)
Condition
Some owners may comment that the ABS indicator lamp is "ON". Also, malfunction DTC 21, 22, 32
or 33 could set.
Cause
The right front and left front ABS wheel speed sensor wiring harness could be damaged and result
in an open circuit. The wiring harness may be damaged approximately 4 inches (10 cm) back from
the harness connector to the wheel speed sensor. This allows moisture to enter the harness
causing corrosion and resulting in the open circuit.
Correction
A thorough inspection for corrosion and/or damage should be performed on suspect vehicles. It
may be necessary to move the protective conduit away in order to inspect the wiring properly. If a
failure occurs and damage is found, install the front ABS wheel speed sensor wiring harness
connector kit(s). The kit includes instructions, splices, and "pigtail" connector.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed
Sensor: > 63-50-15B > Mar > 98 > ABS Indicator Lamp On, DTC 21,22,32 or 33 Set > Page 267
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Description Labor Time
H2530 Right Side Use published
H2531 Left Side Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Wheel Speed Sensor: Component Locations
LH Front Wheel (RH Similar)
LH Rear ABS Wheel Speed Sensor
LH Rear ABS Wheel Speed Sensor is located Rear of LH rear Wheel Hub
LH Rear Wheel (RH Similar)
Wheel Speed Sensors
These sensors located on the front steering knuckles and under the wheel bearing dust caps on
the rear wheels.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 270
Wheel Speed Sensor: Connector Locations
LH Front Wheel (RH Similar)
LH Rear Wheel (RH Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 271
Wheel Speed Sensor: Harness Locations
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
RH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 272
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
These sensors located on the front steering knuckles and under the wheel bearing dust caps on
the rear wheels, send a low voltage signal to the EBCM/EBTCM. This signal is produced by
rotating a toothed ring around the sensor pole piece, which produces a magnetic field that
increases and decreases in magnitude.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Front
Fig. 802 Front Wheel Speed Sensor Removal.
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect wheel sensor electrical connector, Fig. 802. 3. Remove
sensor attaching bolt, then the sensor from the mounting bracket. 4. Reverse procedure to install,
noting the following:
a. Ensure sensor is properly aligned and lays flat against bracket bosses, then torque attaching bolt
to 9 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel
Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 275
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Rear
Fig. 803 Rear Wheel Bearing & Speed Sensor Removal.
1. Raise and support vehicle, then remove rear wheel and tire assembly. 2. Remove rear brake
drum, then disconnect sensor electrical connector, Fig. 803. 3. Remove wheel bearing and sensor
attaching nuts and bolts, then bearing and sensor assembly. After bolts are removed, the rear
brake assembly
will be held in place by the hydraulic pipe. Use care not to bump or exert any force on the brake
assembly to prevent any damage to the hydraulic pipe.
4. Reverse procedure to install, noting the following:
a. Align bolt holes in wheel bearing and speed sensor assembly, drum brake assembly and rear
suspension bracket. b. When installing bolts, rotate axle flange to align large hole with each bolt
location, then install bolt while holding nut. c. Torque bolts to 37 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Coolant Level Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Resistance 177 ohms at 212 deg F
241 ohms at 194 deg F
332 ohms at 176 deg F
467 ohms at 158 deg F
667 ohms at 140 deg F
973 ohms at 122 deg F
1188 ohms at 113 deg F
1459 ohms at 104 deg F
1802 ohms at 95 deg F
2238 ohms at 86 deg F
2796 ohms at 77 deg F
3520 ohms at 68 deg F
4450 ohms at 59 deg F
5670 ohms at 50 deg F
7280 ohms at 41 deg F
9420 ohms at 32 deg F
12300 ohms at 23 deg F
16180 ohms at 14 deg F
21450 ohms at 5 deg F
28680 ohms at -4 deg F
52700 ohms at -22 deg F
100700 ohms at -40 deg F
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 284
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations
Rear Of Engine Compartment
LH rear of engine, on Coolant Outlet
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 287
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 288
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 289
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 290
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 291
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 292
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 293
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 294
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 295
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 296
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 297
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 298
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 299
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 300
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 301
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 302
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 303
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 304
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 305
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 306
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 307
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 308
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 309
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 310
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 311
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 312
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 313
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 314
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 315
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 316
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 317
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 318
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 319
Coolant Temperature Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 320
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
PURPOSE
The Engine Coolant Temperature sensor (ECT) is used to control:
^ Fuel delivery
^ Torque Converter Clutch (TCC)
^ Engine Spark Timing (EST)
^ Controlled Canister Purge (CCP)
^ Idle Air Control (IAC)
^ Cooling Fan
OPERATION:
The ECT is a thermistor that is located in the engine coolant flow. When the coolant temperature is
low, the sensor produces a high resistance. When the coolant temperature is high, the sensor
produces a low resistance.
The ECM sends a 5.0 volt signal to the ECT through a resistor in the computer and measures the
voltage. The voltage will be high or low depending on coolant temperature. With the ECT varying
its resistance, the ECM can sense engine coolant temperature by reading the varying voltage.
LOCATION:
Engine thermostat and coolant outlet.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 478101 > Apr > 94 > Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Temperature Sensor (Gauge): Customer Interest Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Group Ref.: Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 478101
Date: April, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: TEMPERATURE GAUGE FLUCTUATION
MODELS: 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND BERETTA 1993-94 BUICK
CENTURY 1993-94 OLDSMOBILE CUTLASS CIERA WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK S TRUCKS
WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
Some vehicles described above may exhibit a condition where temperature gauge readings
fluctuate in the normal range. These gauge fluctuations may be as much as 1/4 of the scale,
however, the indicator should never enter the red high temperature warning area of the gauge
under normal operating conditions.
Coolant temperature sensor location combined with the thermostat cycling characteristics
contribute to this sensitivity. The condition is considered a normal characteristic of this engine and
should not be cause for instrument panel cluster, gauge, indicator sender, or engine coolant
thermostat replacement or alteration.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins: > 478101 > Apr > 94 > Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Temperature Sensor (Gauge): All Technical Service Bulletins Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Group Ref.: Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 478101
Date: April, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: TEMPERATURE GAUGE FLUCTUATION
MODELS: 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND BERETTA 1993-94 BUICK
CENTURY 1993-94 OLDSMOBILE CUTLASS CIERA WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK S TRUCKS
WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
Some vehicles described above may exhibit a condition where temperature gauge readings
fluctuate in the normal range. These gauge fluctuations may be as much as 1/4 of the scale,
however, the indicator should never enter the red high temperature warning area of the gauge
under normal operating conditions.
Coolant temperature sensor location combined with the thermostat cycling characteristics
contribute to this sensitivity. The condition is considered a normal characteristic of this engine and
should not be cause for instrument panel cluster, gauge, indicator sender, or engine coolant
thermostat replacement or alteration.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Temperature Sensor (Gauge): > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability
Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Temperature Sensor (Gauge): > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability
Concerns/MIL ON > Page 339
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Other Service Bulletins for Temperature Sensor (Gauge): > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability
Concerns/MIL ON > Page 345
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page
346
Temperature Sensor (Gauge): Locations
Rear Of Engine Compartment
LH rear of engine, on Coolant Outlet
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Temperature Switch (Warning Indicator) > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Temperature Switch (Warning Indicator): Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
If the red light is not lit when the engine is being cranked, check for a burned out bulb, an open in
the light circuit, or a defective ignition switch.
If the red light is lit when the engine is running, check the wiring between light and switch for a
ground, temperature switch defective, or overheated cooling system. As a test circuit to check
whether the red bulb is functioning properly, a wire which is connected to the ground terminal of the
ignition switch is tapped into its circuit. When the ignition is in the start engine cranking position, the
ground terminal is grounded inside the switch and the red bulb will be lit. When the engine is
started and the ignition switch is in the on position, the test circuit is opened and the bulb is then
controlled by the temperature switch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Component Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 355
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Connector Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Locations > Page 356
Harness Connector Faces: Brake Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Description and Operation > Combination Cruise/Stop Light Switch
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Combination Cruise/Stop Light Switch
A separately mounted vacuum release valve is used with this combination switch. When the brake
pedal is depressed, the switch resets the cruise function to a non-cruise condition and illuminates
the brake lights. Two sets of electrical contacts are used in the switch: one to operate the stop
lights, and the other to operate the cruise release function.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Description and Operation > Combination Cruise/Stop Light Switch > Page 359
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Combination Vacuum Release
Valve/Converter Clutch Switch
The vacuum release valve provides an additional vent to atmosphere for the servo unit when the
brake pedal is held in the depressed position. The venting is spring actuated and occurs within the
free travel of the brake pedal arm.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 360
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Testing and Inspection
1. Turn ignition switch to On position. 2. Connect test light to ground. 3. Probe brown wire at brake
switch connector. Lamp should illuminate. 4. Check switch adjustment, with probe still at brown
wire, depressing brake pedal 1/8-1/2 inch. Light should go out. 5. If lamp did not illuminate in step
3, probe wire in adjacent connector cavity. If lamp illuminates, adjust or replace switch as
necessary. If light does
not illuminate, check wiring to switch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise
Control) > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 361
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Adjustments
The switch assembly and valve assembly cannot be adjusted until brake booster pushrod is
assembled to brake pedal assembly. Adjustment is as follows: 1. Depress brake pedal and switch
assembly and valve assembly into their proper retaining clips until fully seated. 2. On vehicles
equipped with ABS, release brake pedal and allow to come to rest. 3. On models less ABS, slowly
pull pedal back to its fully retracted position. The switch assembly and valve assembly will move
within their
retainers to their adjusted position.
4. The following brake pedal travel distances may be used to check for a properly adjusted cruise
control and stop lamp switch assembly and vacuum
release valve assembly. a. Cruise control switch contacts must open at 1/8- 1/2 inch pedal travel,
measured at centerline of brake pedal pad. Nominal actuation of stop
lamp contacts is 3/16 inch after cruise control contacts open.
b. Vacuum release valve assembly must open at 11/16-1 5/16 inches pedal travel, measured at
centerline of brake pedal pad.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 366
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 367
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
The clutch switch is used on vehicles equipped with manual transmission. When the clutch pedal is
depressed, the cruise function is disconnected and will remain so after the pedal is released.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise
Control > Component Information > Locations > Page 368
Clutch Switch: Adjustments
1. Ensure clutch release switch is fully seated in retainer. 2. Pull clutch pedal pad upward.
CAUTION: Do not exert an upward force on the clutch pedal of more than 20 lbs., or damage to
clutch master cylinder retaining ring may result.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair
Refer to multi-function switch replacement procedures.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Description and Operation
Vehicle Speed Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
On models with conventional instrument panels, a speedometer frame mounted optic head is used
to pick up light reflected by a speedometer cable mounted blade. The reflected light is produced by
a light emitting diode (LED). As the speedometer cable mounted blade enters the LED light beam,
the light is reflected into the optic head. From there, the light enters a photocell in the optic head
and produces a low power speed signal. This signal is sent to a buffer for amplification and
conditioning, then to the controller.
On models with electronic speedometers or electronic instrumentation, a transmission mounted
speed sensor is used. This sensor utilizes a permanent magnet (PM) to generate vehicle speed
information to the controller. Some models use a buffer amplifier to modify the sensor output.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel
Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch
Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump): Locations Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch
RH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel
Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch > Page 380
RH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel
Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch > Page 381
Fuel Pump / Oil Pressure Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel
Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Page 382
Harness Connector Faces: Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Locations
A-Center Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > IP Dimmer Control - Proper Setting
Dimmer Switch: Technical Service Bulletins IP Dimmer Control - Proper Setting
File In Section: 08 - Body and Accessories
Bulletin No.: 99-08-42-009
Date: November, 1999
INFORMATION
Subject: Proper Setting of I/P Dimmer Control to View PRNDL Display with Automatic Headlamp
Control
Models: 2000 and Prior All Passenger Cars and Trucks With Automatic Headlamp Control and
Electronic PRNDL Display
Under certain conditions, if the instrument panel dimmer control is turned relatively low, the PRNDL
will not be visible until the automatic headlamp control turns the headlamps off and the daytime
running lamps (DRL) are turned back on. Such a condition may be if the vehicle is first started in an
environment where the headlamp control turns on the headlamps and then the vehicle is driven out
into a brighter environment (for example, when a vehicle is backed out of a dark garage into the
bright sunlight).
This condition is normal and any repair attempt will not be successful. Demonstrate this condition
to the customer using the service lane and then turn the instrument panel dimmer control to a
higher setting. This will enable the driver to see the PRNDL display
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 395
Dimmer Switch: Locations
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Panel Dimmer Switch is located at LH side of I/P near LH front Speaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 396
Harness Connector Faces: Panel Dimmer Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 397
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair
1. Remove steering wheel as outlined under Steering Wheel. Refer to Steering and
Suspension/Steering.
2. Remove turn signal switch as outlined under Turn Signal Switch. Refer to Turn Signals.
3. Remove windshield wiper switch as outlined under Windshield Wiper Switch. Refer to Wiper and
Washer System.
4. Remove ignition switch to ignition switch housing attaching screws.
5. Depress ignition switch locking tab, then disconnect switch electrical connectors.
6. Reverse procedure to install, noting the following: a. Ensure lock cylinder shaft aligns with slotted
opening on ignition switch. b. Torque ignition switch attaching screws to 21 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Center Of Console (Sedan Shown, Station Wagon Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair
Modular Fuel Sender To Tank
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 404
Modular Fuel Sender Assembly
NOTE: Always replace fuel sender assembly O-ring when reinstalling fuel sender assembly.
Remove or Disconnect:
1. Negative battery cable.
2. Relieve system fuel pressure.
3. Drain fuel tank. Refer to "DRAINING FUEL TANK."
4. Fuel tank, Refer to "FUEL TANK REPLACEMENT."
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 405
5. While holding, the modular fuel sender assembly down, remove the snap ring from designated
slots located on the retainer.
IMPORTANT:
^ The modular fuel sender assembly may spring up from its position.
^ When removing the modular fuel sender assembly from the fuel tank, be aware that that the
reservoir bucket is full of fuel. It must be tipped slightly during removal to avoid damage to the float.
Discard fuel sender O-ring and replace with a new one.
^ Carefully discard the reservoir fuel into an approved container.
INSTALL OR CONNECT:
1. New O-ring on modular fuel sender to tank.
2. Align tab on front of sender with slot on front of retainer snap ring.
3. Slowly apply pressure to top of spring loaded sender until sender aligns flush with retainer on
tank.
4. Insert snap ring into designated slots.
IMPORTANT:
^ Be sure that the snap ring is fully seated within the tab slots.
5. Fuel tank. Refer to "FUEL TANK REPLACEMENT"
6. Lower vehicle.
7. Refill tank.
INSPECT:
^ Turn ignition to "ON" position for two seconds, then to "OFF" for ten seconds. Again turn to "ON"
position, and check for fuel leak's.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Key Reminder Switch
> Component Information > Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Console
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Parking Brake
Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 413
Console
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Temperature Switch
(Warning Indicator) > Component Information > Description and Operation
Temperature Switch (Warning Indicator): Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
If the red light is not lit when the engine is being cranked, check for a burned out bulb, an open in
the light circuit, or a defective ignition switch.
If the red light is lit when the engine is running, check the wiring between light and switch for a
ground, temperature switch defective, or overheated cooling system. As a test circuit to check
whether the red bulb is functioning properly, a wire which is connected to the ground terminal of the
ignition switch is tapped into its circuit. When the ignition is in the start engine cranking position, the
ground terminal is grounded inside the switch and the red bulb will be lit. When the engine is
started and the ignition switch is in the on position, the test circuit is opened and the bulb is then
controlled by the temperature switch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Backup Lamp Switch: Component Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 422
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 423
Backup Lamp Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Disconnect back-up lamp switch electrical connector.
3. Remove back-up lamp switch from top of transaxle case.
4. Reverse procedure to install. Prior to installation, apply sealant 1052080 or equivalent to switch
threads.
5. Torque back up lamp switch to 24 ft-lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Brake Light Switch: Component Locations
Insert stop lamp switch in retainer until switch body seats on retainer.
Pull brake pedal upward against internal pedal stop.
Switch will be moved in retainer providing proper adjustment.
Proper switch adjustment is achieved when no audible clicks are heard when the pedal is pulled
upward and the brake lights do not remin on without brake application.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 428
Brake Light Switch: Connector Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 429
Harness Connector Faces: Brake Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 430
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove drivers' side hash panel.
3. Disconnect switch electrical connector.
4. Remove switch from brake pedal support bracket.
5. Reverse procedure to install.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Center Of Console (Sedan Shown, Station Wagon Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Glove Box Lamp
Switch > Component Information > Locations
RH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Hazard Warning Switch: Component Locations
LH Side Of I/P
Turn/Hazard Headlight Switch Assembly is located Top of Steering Column, below Steering Wheel
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 441
LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 442
Hazard Warning Switch: Diagrams
Harness Connector Faces: Turn/Hazard-Headlight Switch Assembly- C1
Harness Connector Faces: Turn/Hazard-Headlight Switch Assembly- C2
Harness Connector Faces: Turn/Hazard-Headlight Switch Assembly- C1 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 443
Harness Connector Faces: Turn/Hazard-Headlight Switch Assembly- C2 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Headlamp Switch: Component Locations
LH Side Of I/P
Turn/Hazard Headlight Switch Assembly is located Top of Steering Column, below Steering Wheel
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 448
LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Headlamp Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 451
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 452
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 453
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 454
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 455
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 456
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 457
Headlamp Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 458
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 459
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 460
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 461
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 462
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 463
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 464
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 465
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 466
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 467
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 468
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 469
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 470
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 471
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 472
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 473
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 474
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 475
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 476
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 477
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 478
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 479
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 480
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 481
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 482
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 483
Headlamp Switch: Electrical Diagrams
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 1 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 484
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 2 Of 4)
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Wagon) (Part 4 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 485
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 1 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 486
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 2 Of 4)
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Sedan) (Part 4 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 487
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 1 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 488
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 2 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 489
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Coupe And Convertable) (Part 4 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 490
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 3 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 491
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 3 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 492
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Wagon) (Part 4 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 493
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 3 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 494
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 3 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 495
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Sedan) (Part 4 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 496
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 3 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 497
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 3 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 498
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Coupe And Convertable) (Part 4 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 499
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
The headlamp switch is part of the turn signal lever assembly and is not serviceable. The
headlamp switch, turn signal lever and cruise control switch must be replaced as an assembly.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Horn Switch: > NHTSA96I001000 > Jan > 96 > Recall
96I001000: Horn Assembly Defect
Horn Switch: Recalls Recall 96I001000: Horn Assembly Defect
This is not a safety recall in accordance with Federal Regulation 573. However, it is deemed a
safety improvement campaign by the agency. These vehicles were built with insufficient retention
of the horn pad. The horn pad can separate from the steering wheel falling between the steering
wheel spokes. The horn pad could become jammed between the steering wheel spokes and the
turn signal lever, resulting in damage to the turn signal lever, horn pad, and horn wiring. Dealers
will modify the horn pad retention clips, install horn pad retention brackets to the steering wheel,
reinstall the horn pad and assure that the hornpad is properly retained.
NOTE: General Motors has decided to conduct a safety improvement campaign to modify the horn
pad on these vehicles. Owners can contact Chevrolet at1-800-222-1020.
1993 CHEVROLET CAVALIER 1994 CHEVROLET CAVALIER
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Horn Switch: > NHTSA96I001000
> Jan > 96 > Recall 96I001000: Horn Assembly Defect
Horn Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 96I001000: Horn Assembly Defect
This is not a safety recall in accordance with Federal Regulation 573. However, it is deemed a
safety improvement campaign by the agency. These vehicles were built with insufficient retention
of the horn pad. The horn pad can separate from the steering wheel falling between the steering
wheel spokes. The horn pad could become jammed between the steering wheel spokes and the
turn signal lever, resulting in damage to the turn signal lever, horn pad, and horn wiring. Dealers
will modify the horn pad retention clips, install horn pad retention brackets to the steering wheel,
reinstall the horn pad and assure that the hornpad is properly retained.
NOTE: General Motors has decided to conduct a safety improvement campaign to modify the horn
pad on these vehicles. Owners can contact Chevrolet at1-800-222-1020.
1993 CHEVROLET CAVALIER 1994 CHEVROLET CAVALIER
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Turn Signal Switch: Component Locations
LH Side Of I/P
Turn/Hazard Headlight Switch Assembly is located Top of Steering Column, below Steering Wheel
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 517
LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 518
Turn Signal Switch: Service and Repair
WARNING:
On models equipped with Airbags, Refer to Air Bags (Supplemental Restraint Systems) Service
and Repair Disarming procedures before performing any repair. See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag
Systems/Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Remove steering wheel. Refer to Steering and Suspension /
Steering / Steering Wheel. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering
Wheel/Service and Repair
3. Remove lower steering column cover upper and lower attaching bolts, then remove lower
steering column cover. 4. Separate rose bud fastener, integral to wiring harness, from jacket
assembly. 5. Remove turn signal switch attaching screws, the depress locking tab and remove turn
signal switch electrical connectors. 6. Reverse procedure to install. Torque turn signal switch
attaching screws to 48 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Resistance 177 ohms at 212 deg F
241 ohms at 194 deg F
332 ohms at 176 deg F
467 ohms at 158 deg F
667 ohms at 140 deg F
973 ohms at 122 deg F
1188 ohms at 113 deg F
1459 ohms at 104 deg F
1802 ohms at 95 deg F
2238 ohms at 86 deg F
2796 ohms at 77 deg F
3520 ohms at 68 deg F
4450 ohms at 59 deg F
5670 ohms at 50 deg F
7280 ohms at 41 deg F
9420 ohms at 32 deg F
12300 ohms at 23 deg F
16180 ohms at 14 deg F
21450 ohms at 5 deg F
28680 ohms at -4 deg F
52700 ohms at -22 deg F
100700 ohms at -40 deg F
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 524
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations
Rear Of Engine Compartment
LH rear of engine, on Coolant Outlet
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 527
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 528
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 529
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 530
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 531
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 532
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 533
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 534
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 535
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 536
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 537
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 538
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 539
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 540
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 541
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 542
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 543
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 544
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 545
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 546
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 547
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 548
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 549
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 550
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 551
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 552
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 553
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 554
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 555
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 556
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 557
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 558
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 559
Coolant Temperature Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 560
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
PURPOSE
The Engine Coolant Temperature sensor (ECT) is used to control:
^ Fuel delivery
^ Torque Converter Clutch (TCC)
^ Engine Spark Timing (EST)
^ Controlled Canister Purge (CCP)
^ Idle Air Control (IAC)
^ Cooling Fan
OPERATION:
The ECT is a thermistor that is located in the engine coolant flow. When the coolant temperature is
low, the sensor produces a high resistance. When the coolant temperature is high, the sensor
produces a low resistance.
The ECM sends a 5.0 volt signal to the ECT through a resistor in the computer and measures the
voltage. The voltage will be high or low depending on coolant temperature. With the ECT varying
its resistance, the ECM can sense engine coolant temperature by reading the varying voltage.
LOCATION:
Engine thermostat and coolant outlet.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Crankshaft Position Sensor
RH rear of engine, on exhaust manifold
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
564
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Typical DIS Crankshaft Sensor
PURPOSE:
The crankshaft sensor provides a signal through the Direct Ignition (DI), which the ECM uses as
reference to calculate rpm and crankshaft position.
OPERATION:
This sensor protrudes into the block, within approximately .050" of the engine crankshaft reluctor.
The reluctor is a special wheel cast into the crankshaft with seven slots cast into it, six of which are
evenly spaced 60° apart. A seventh slot is spaced 10° from one of the other slots and serves to
generate a "sync pulse." As the reluctor rotates as part of the crankshaft, the slots change the
magnetic field of the sensor, creating an induced voltage pulse.
Based on the crank sensor pulses, the ignition module sends reference signals to the ECM which
are used to indicate crankshaft position and engine speed.
LOCATION:
This sensor is mounted remotely from the ignition module, right hand side of engine, at the end of
the crank shaft.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
565
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Remove or Disconnect
1. Sensor harness connector. 2. Sensor to block bolt. 3. Sensor from engine.
Inspect ^
Sensor O-ring for wear, cracks or leakage. Replace if necessary. Lube new O-ring with engine oil
before installing.
Install or Connect
1. Sensor into hole in block. 2. Sensor to block bolt.
^ Torque to 8 N.m (71 lb. in.).
3. Sensor harness connector.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Resistance 177 ohms at 212 deg F
241 ohms at 194 deg F
332 ohms at 176 deg F
467 ohms at 158 deg F
667 ohms at 140 deg F
973 ohms at 122 deg F
1188 ohms at 113 deg F
1459 ohms at 104 deg F
1802 ohms at 95 deg F
2238 ohms at 86 deg F
2796 ohms at 77 deg F
3520 ohms at 68 deg F
4450 ohms at 59 deg F
5670 ohms at 50 deg F
7280 ohms at 41 deg F
9420 ohms at 32 deg F
12300 ohms at 23 deg F
16180 ohms at 14 deg F
21450 ohms at 5 deg F
28680 ohms at -4 deg F
52700 ohms at -22 deg F
100700 ohms at -40 deg F
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications > Page 570
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Mechanical Specifications Torque Valve
Torque Valve
Induction Air Sensor 44 in.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 571
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Locations
Top Front Of Engine
(2.2L Shown, Others similar)
Intake Air Temperature Sensor is located LH front of Engine Compartment, on Air Cleaner.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 574
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 575
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 576
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 577
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 578
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 579
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 580
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 581
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 582
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 583
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 584
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 585
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 586
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 587
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 588
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 589
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 590
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 591
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 592
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 593
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 594
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 595
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 596
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 597
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 598
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 599
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 600
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 601
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 602
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 603
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 604
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 605
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 606
Intake Air Temperature Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
607
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Intake Air Temperature Sensor
PURPOSE:
The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor is a thermistor, a variable resistor which changes value
based on temperature, mounted in the air cleaner assembly. The IAT sensor input affects fuel
delivery and ignition timing controls in the ECM.
OPERATION:
The ECM supplies 5 volts to the IAT sensor and monitors the voltage on a signal line. The sensor
provides a path to ground through its thermistor. The voltage will be high when the intake air is cold
and low when the air is hot. By monitoring the voltage, the ECM calculates the intake air
temperature.
Low intake air temperature produces high resistance (100,000 ohms at -40°C/-40°F, while high
temperature causes low resistance (70 ohms at 130 °C/266°F). A failure in the IAT circuit should
set a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) 23/25.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Knock Sensor: Component Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
> Page 612
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 613
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE:
The knock sensor is used to detect engine detonation (ping). The ECM will retard the electronic
spark timing based on the signal received.
OPERATION:
The knock sensor detects abnormal vibration in the engine. Then, the knock sensor produces an
AC signal which increases with the severity of the knock. The ECM reads this signal and retards
the timing until the knock is stopped.
LOCATION:
Engine block near the cylinders.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 614
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-5
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 615
Knock Sensor Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Knock Sensor (KS) is used to detect engine detonation and the PCM will retard the ignition
control timing based on the signal being received. The circuitry, within the knock sensor, causes
the PCMs 5 volts to be pulled down so that under a no knock condition, CKT 496 would measure
about 2.5 volts. The knock sensor produces an AC signal, which rides on the 2.5 volts DC voltage.
The amplitude and frequency are dependent upon the knock level.
The EPROM used with this engine contains the functions which were part of remotely mounted
knock sensor modules used on other GM vehicles. The knock sensor portion of the EPROM then
sends a signal to other parts of the PCM which adjusts the spark timing to retard the spark and
reduce the detonation.
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. With engine idling, there should not be a knock signal present at the PCM, because detonation is
not likely under a no load condition.
2. Tapping on the engine lift bracket should simulate a knock signal to determine if the sensor is
capable of detecting detonation. If no knock is
detected, try tapping on engine block closer to sensor before replacing sensor.
3. If the engine has an internal problem which is creating a knock, the knock sensor may be
responding to the internal failure.
4. This test determines if the knock sensor is faulty or if the KS portion of the EPROM is faulty. If it
is determined that the EPROM is faulty, be sure
that it is properly installed and latched into place. If not properly installed, repair and retest.
Diagnostic Aids:
While observing knock signal on the Tech 1 scan tool, there should be an indication that knock is
present, when detonation can be heard. Detonation is most likely to occur under high engine load
conditions.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Electrical Specifications
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Idle 1-2 V
Wide Open Throttle 4.4.8 V
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Electrical Specifications > Page 620
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
MAP Sensor Screws 27 in.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 623
Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 626
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 627
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 628
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 629
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 630
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 631
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 632
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 633
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 634
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 635
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 636
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 637
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 638
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 639
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 640
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 641
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 642
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 643
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 644
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 645
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 646
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 647
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 648
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 649
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 650
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 651
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 652
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 653
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 654
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 655
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 656
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 657
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 658
Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 659
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
MAP Sensor
PURPOSE:
The Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor is a pressure sensitive variable resistor. It measures
the changes in the intake manifold pressure which result from engine load and speed changes, and
converts this to a voltage output. The computer uses this voltage output to control fuel delivery and
ignition timing.
The MAP sensor is also used to measure barometric pressure at start up and under certain
conditions, which allows the ECM to automatically adjust for different altitudes.
OPERATION:
The ECM supplies 5 volts to the MAP sensor and monitors the voltage on a signal line. The sensor
provides a path to ground through its variable resistor.
A closed throttle on engine coastdown will produce a relatively low MAP output, while a wide open
throttle will produce a high output. Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) is the opposite of what is
measured on a vacuum gauge. When manifold pressure is high, vacuum is low. A failure in the
MAP sensor circuit should set Diagnostic Trouble Code.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 660
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-1D
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 661
Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor measures the changes in the intake manifold
pressure which result from engine load (intake manifold vacuum) and RPM changes; and converts
these into a voltage output. The PCM sends a 5 volt reference voltage to the MAP sensor. As the
manifold pressure changed, the output voltage of the sensor also changes. By monitoring the
sensor output voltage, the PCM knows the manifold pressure. A lower pressure (low voltage)
output voltage will be about 1-2 volts at idle, while higher pressure (high voltage) output voltage will
be about 4-4.8 at Wide Open Throttle (WOT). The MAP sensor is also used, under certain
conditions, to measure barometric pressure, allowing the PCM to make adjustments for different
altitudes. The PCM used the MAP sensor to control fuel delivery and ignition timing
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
Note: Be sure to use the same diagnostic test equipment for all measurements.
1. When comparing Tech 1 scan tool readings to a known good vehicle, it is important to compare
vehicles that use a MAP sensor having the same
color insert or having the same "Hot Stamped" number.
2. Applying 34 kPa (10" Hg) vacuum to the MAP sensor should cause the voltage to change
Subtract second reading from the first. Voltage value
should be greater than 1.5 volts. Upon applying vacuum to the sensor, the change in voltage
should be instantaneous. A slow voltage change indicates a faulty sensor.
3. Check vacuum hose to sensor for leaking or restriction. Be sure that no other vacuum devices
are connected to the MAP hose.
Note: Make sure electrical connector remains securely fastened.
Diagnostic Aids:
Remove the MAP sensor from its bracket and gently twist sensor (by hand only) while observing
the MAP display on a scan tool. Make sure electrical connector remains securely fastened. This is
a good way to check for intermittent failures. Output fluctuations greater than .1 volt indicate a
faulty sensor.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Oxygen Sensors - Silica Contamination
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Oxygen Sensors - Silica Contamination
Model Year: 1981
Bulletin No: 81-I-37
File In Group: 60
Number: 11
Date: Feb. 81
Subject: Silica Contamination of Oxygen Sensors and Gelation of Oil.
Models Affected: All
Oxygen sensor performance can deteriorate if certain RTV silicone gasket materials are used.
Other RTV's when used with certain oils, may cause gelation of the oil. The degree of performance
severity depends on the type of RTV and application of the engine involved.
Therefore, when repairing engines where this item is involved, it is important to use either cork
composition gaskets or RTV silicone gasket material approved for such use. GMS (General Motors
Sealant) or equivalent material can be used. GMS is available through GMPD with the following
part numbers:
1052366 3 oz.
1052434 10.14 oz.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 666
Oxygen Sensor: Specifications
Oxygen Sensor 30 ft.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 667
Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Oxygen Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 670
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 671
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 672
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 673
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 674
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 675
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 676
Oxygen Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 677
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 678
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 679
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 680
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 681
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 682
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 683
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 684
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 685
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 686
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 687
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 688
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 689
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 690
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 691
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 692
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 693
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 694
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 695
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 696
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 697
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 698
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 699
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 700
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 701
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 702
Oxygen Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 703
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
Exhaust Oxygen Sensor (02)
PURPOSE:
The oxygen (O2) sensor measures the oxygen content of the exhaust. The ECM monitors the
sensor to maintain air/fuel mixture of 14.7 to 1.
OPERATION:
The oxygen sensor monitors atmospheric air versus exhaust gas oxygen content to produce a
voltage output. This voltage ranges from approximately 0.1 volt (high oxygen-lean mixture) to 0.9
volt (low oxygen-rich mixture). By monitoring the oxygen sensor output voltage, the computer can
determine the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas and adjust the air/fuel mixture accordingly, this
is known as "CLOSED LOOP" operation.
When the sensor is cold it is like an open circuit and produces no voltage below 600°F (315°C). An
open sensor circuit or cold sensor causes "OPEN LOOP" operation.
The heated oxygen sensor works in the same manner as the non-heated oxygen sensor. The
exception is that B+ is supplied to a heating unit that is part of the sensor itself. This heater
receives voltage from the generator charging circuit. The heater helps the ECM control the fuel
injection sooner for better fuel emissions. There are no malfunction Codes to detect if the heater
part of the sensor is working.
LOCATION:
Exhaust Manifold
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 704
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
VISUAL INSPECTION:
^ Connectors and wires
^ Housing and insulator for cracks/damage
^ Sensor tip for silicone contamination (white powdery coating)
PERFORMANCE TEST: Checks working range and response (speed).
1. Warm engine.
2. Install DVOM between sensor and ground (2 volt DC range).
3. Run engine at steady cruise speed (about 2500 rpm). Voltage should vary at least eight times in
ten seconds between 0.2 and 0.8 volts (normal range).
4. Drive sensor rich: The use of a properly adjusted propane flow meter (J-26911) is industry
standard. Voltage should increase to at least 0.8 volts within two to three seconds.
5. Drive sensor lean: Create a vacuum leak from a source that is not an ECM input or output.
Voltage should drop to at least 0.3 volts within two to three seconds.
NOTE: After each test the O2 sensor should return to normal operating range within two to three
seconds.
6. O2 Sensor should be replaced for failure to pass any of the tests above.
NOTE: A CEC system that is operating excessively rich or lean will drive the 02 sensor to its
maximum range. The rich or lean condition should be repaired first and not diagnosed as an 02
sensor failure.
7. Reconnect all hoses and electrical connectors. Clear all codes set and retrain idle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 705
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair
CAUTION: The Oxygen sensor uses a permanently attached pigtail and connector. This pigtail
should not be removed from the oxygen sensor. Damage or removal of the pigtail or connector
could affect proper operation of the oxygen sensor.
^ Take care when handling the oxygen sensor. The in-line electrical connector and louvered end
must be kept free of grease, dirt or other contaminants. Also, avoid using cleaning solvents of any
type. DO NOT drop or roughly handle the oxygen sensor.
^ The following procedure should be performed with engine temperature over 120°F otherwise the
oxygen sensor may be difficult to remove.
REMOVAL:
1. Remove negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect electrical connector. 3. Remove oxygen sensor.
NOTE: A special anti-seize compound is used on the oxygen sensor threads. The compound
consists of a liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite will burn away, but the glass beads will
remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New or service sensors will already have the
compound applied to the threads. If a sensor is removed from an engine, and, if for any reason it is
to be reinstalled, the threads must have anti-seize compound applied before reinstallation.
INSTALLATION:
1. Coat the threads of the oxygen sensor with anti-seize compound P/N 5613695, or equivalent if
necessary. 2. Install the sensor in the engine, and tighten to 41 Nm (30 ft lb). 3. Re-connect the
electrical connector. 4. Re-connect the negative battery cable. 5. Before starting engine, perform
IDLE LEARN PROCEDURE.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Center Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 710
Center Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 711
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation
Power Steering Pressure Switch
PURPOSE
To sense high pressure in the steering box and signal the ECM to adjust the idle speed
accordingly.
OPERATION
The Power Steering Pressure Switch (PSPS) opens during high pressure power steering
situations. When the power steering switch is open, power to the A/C relay is shut "OFF," resulting
in A/C compressor clutch disengagement. Also, a signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM uses this
signal to compensate for the additional engine load by moving the IAC valve.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 712
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-1E
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 713
Power Steering Pressure Switch Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Power Steering Pressure (PSP) switch is normally open to ground and CKT 495 will be near
the battery voltage.
Turning the steering wheel increases power steering oil pressure and its load on an idling engine.
The pressure switch will close before the load can cause an idle problem.
Closing the switch causes CKT 495 to read less than 1 volt. The PCM will increase the idle air rate
and disengage the A/C relay.
^ A pressure switch that will not close or an open CKT 495 or 450, may cause the engine to stop
when power steering loads are high.
^ A switch that will not open, or a CKT 495 shorted to ground, may affect idle quality and will cause
the A/C relay to be de-energized.
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. Different makes of scan tools may display the state of this switch in different ways. Refer to scan
tool operator's manual to determine how this
input is displayed.
2. Checks to determine if CKT 495 is shorted to ground.
3. This should simulate a closed switch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
At Closed Throttle < 0.9 V
At Wide Open Throttle 4.7 V
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications > Page 718
Throttle Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor 18 in.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
719
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 722
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 723
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 724
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 725
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 726
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 727
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 728
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 729
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 730
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 731
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 732
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 733
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 734
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 735
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 736
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 737
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 738
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 739
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 740
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 741
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 742
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 743
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 744
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 745
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 746
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 747
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 748
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 749
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 750
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 751
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 752
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 753
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 754
Throttle Position Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 755
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Throttle Position Sensor (TPS)
PURPOSE:
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) is a potentiometer that senses throttle angle and sends a signal
to the ECM. This input to the ECM is used to control the fuel system on acceleration and
deceleration.
OPERATION:
The TPS has three internal circuits. One to ground, a second from the ECM as a 5.0 volt reference
source and a third circuit is used by the ECM to measure the output voltage. As the throttle angle
changes (pressing down on accelerator pedal) the TPS voltage output varies from about .5 volt at
idle to about 4.9 volts at wide open throttle (WOT).
LOCATION:
Side of throttle body opposite of throttle lever.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 756
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
N/A: TPS is not adjustable on this engine.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 757
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Throttle Position Sensor
Typical Throttle Body Assembly
REMOVAL:
1. Disconnect the Throttle Position Sensor electrical connector.
2. Remove the Throttle Position Sensor mounting screws.
3. Remove the Throttle Position Sensor.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 758
NOTE: The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) is an electrical component and must not be soaked in
any liquid cleaner or solvent, damage may result.
INSTALLATION:
1. With the throttle valve closed, position the Throttle Position Sensor on the throttle shaft, then
align the screw holes.
2. Install the Throttle Position Sensor screws and tighten to 2.0 N-m (18 lb. in.).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Switch > Component Information > Locations
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 766
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 767
Harness Connector Faces: Park/Neutral Position Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 768
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Park/Neutral Switch (Auto. Trans)
PURPOSE:
The PARK/NEUTRAL (P/N) switch indicates to the computer when the transmission is in PARK or
NEUTRAL. This information is used by the ECM for Idle Air Control (IAC), Torque Converter Clutch
(TCC) and Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) operation.
OPERATION:
The P/N switch contacts are a part of the neutral switch and are closed to ground in park or neutral
and open in drive ranges and reverse. The ECM supplies ignition voltage through a current limiting
resistor to the switch and senses a closed circuit when voltage drops to less than 1 volt.
NOTE: DO NOT drive the vehicle with the PARK/NEUTRAL switch disconnected, since idle quality
may be affected.
LOCATION:
Top of transaxle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 769
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-1A
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 770
Park/Neutral Position Switch Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Park/Neutral Position (PNP) switch contacts shown are a part of the Park/Neutral position
switch and are closed to ground in park or neutral, and open in drive ranges.
The PCM supplies ignition voltage through a pull up resistor to CKT 434 and senses a closed
switch when the voltage on CKT 434 drops to less than one volt.
The PCM uses the PNP signal as one of the inputs to control:
^ Idle speed.
^ VSS diagnostics.
^ EGR.
If CKT 434 indicates PNP (grounded), while in drive range, the EGR would be inoperative, resulting
in possible detonation.
If CKT 434 indicates drive (open) a sag in the idle may occur when the gear selector is moved into
drive range.
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. Checks for a closed switch to ground in park position. Different makes of scan toots will display
the PNP switch differently. Refer to tool
operator's manual for type of display used for a specific tool.
2. Checks for an open switch in drive range.
3. Be sure Tech 1 scan tool indicates drive, even while wiggling shifter, to test for an intermittent or
misadjusted switch in drive range.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Component Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 775
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Connector Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 776
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
The Vehicle Speed Sensor is a gear-driven Permanent Magnet Generator housed in the vehicle's
transaxle. This sensor generates a sine wave output with a frequency proportional to vehicle
speed. The Engine Control Module (ECM) converts this signal to an output that is switched to
ground at a frequency of 4000 pulses per mile at the DK GRN (389) wire output. This output is
pulled up to 5 volts or greater by the components that use these speed signals as input.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Symptom Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 779
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Test A: Speedometer Is Inaccurate
1. Connect a Scan Tool to the DLC Connector. Drive the vehicle. Observe the Speedometer and
compare it to the vehicle speed shown on the Scan
Tool.
^ If both the Speedometer and Scan Tool display the same approximate speed, check for correct
tire size, ECM MEM-CAL and Vehicle Speed Sensor.
^ If the Scan Tool and Speedometer do not display the same approximate speed, replace or
exchange the Instrument Cluster (Refer to Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators).
ALTERNATE TEST
^ If the Kent Moore Tool J 38522 is available, do the following test.
2. Connect a Scan Tool to the DLC connector. Disconnect the Vehicle Speed Sensor connector.
Connect a lead between the J 38522 vehicle speed
generator's red output terminal and the Vehicle Speed Sensor connector terminal A (LT BLU).
Connect a lead between the J 38522 generator's black output and terminal B (DK GRN/WHT). Plug
the generator into the Cigar Lighter. Select 30 V P-P sine wave and set the frequency at 600hz.
Observe the Speedometer and compare to the vehicle speed shown on the Scan Tool.
^ If both the Speedometer and Scan Tool display the same approximate speed, check for correct
tire size, ECM MEM-CAL and Vehicle Speed Sensor.
^ If the Scan Tool and Speedometer do not display the same approximate speed, replace or
exchange the Instrument Cluster (Refer to Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators).
See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators
Test B: Speed Signal Test
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 780
Test C: Speed Out Put Test
Speed Signal Test
The Vehicle Speed Sensor is a gear-driven Permanent Magnet Generator housed in the vehicle's
transaxle. This sensor generates a sine wave output with a frequency proportional to vehicle
speed. The Engine Control Module (ECM) converts this signal to an output that is switched to
ground at a frequency of 4000 pulses per mile at the DK GRN (389) wire output. This output is
pulled up to 5 volts or greater by the components that use these speed signals as input.
System Diagnosis
^ If referred here from Cruise Control, do Test B. See: Diagnostic Tests/Test B: Speed Signal Test
^ Refer to Symptom Table for listed symptoms and refer Diagnostic Tests for Diagnostic
procedures. See: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures See: Diagnostic Tests
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations >
Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch
Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump): Locations Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch
RH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations >
Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch > Page 786
RH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations >
Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch > Page 787
Fuel Pump / Oil Pressure Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 788
Harness Connector Faces: Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
At Closed Throttle < 0.9 V
At Wide Open Throttle 4.7 V
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications > Page 793
Throttle Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor 18 in.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 794
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 797
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 798
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 799
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 800
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 801
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 802
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 803
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 804
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 805
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 806
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 807
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 808
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 809
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 810
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 811
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 812
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 813
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 814
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 815
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 816
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 817
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 818
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 819
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 820
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 821
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 822
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 823
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 824
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 825
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 826
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 827
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 828
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 829
Throttle Position Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 830
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Throttle Position Sensor (TPS)
PURPOSE:
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) is a potentiometer that senses throttle angle and sends a signal
to the ECM. This input to the ECM is used to control the fuel system on acceleration and
deceleration.
OPERATION:
The TPS has three internal circuits. One to ground, a second from the ECM as a 5.0 volt reference
source and a third circuit is used by the ECM to measure the output voltage. As the throttle angle
changes (pressing down on accelerator pedal) the TPS voltage output varies from about .5 volt at
idle to about 4.9 volts at wide open throttle (WOT).
LOCATION:
Side of throttle body opposite of throttle lever.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 831
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
N/A: TPS is not adjustable on this engine.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 832
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Throttle Position Sensor
Typical Throttle Body Assembly
REMOVAL:
1. Disconnect the Throttle Position Sensor electrical connector.
2. Remove the Throttle Position Sensor mounting screws.
3. Remove the Throttle Position Sensor.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 833
NOTE: The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) is an electrical component and must not be soaked in
any liquid cleaner or solvent, damage may result.
INSTALLATION:
1. With the throttle valve closed, position the Throttle Position Sensor on the throttle shaft, then
align the screw holes.
2. Install the Throttle Position Sensor screws and tighten to 2.0 N-m (18 lb. in.).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Switch > Component Information > Locations
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Crankshaft Position Sensor
RH rear of engine, on exhaust manifold
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 841
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Typical DIS Crankshaft Sensor
PURPOSE:
The crankshaft sensor provides a signal through the Direct Ignition (DI), which the ECM uses as
reference to calculate rpm and crankshaft position.
OPERATION:
This sensor protrudes into the block, within approximately .050" of the engine crankshaft reluctor.
The reluctor is a special wheel cast into the crankshaft with seven slots cast into it, six of which are
evenly spaced 60° apart. A seventh slot is spaced 10° from one of the other slots and serves to
generate a "sync pulse." As the reluctor rotates as part of the crankshaft, the slots change the
magnetic field of the sensor, creating an induced voltage pulse.
Based on the crank sensor pulses, the ignition module sends reference signals to the ECM which
are used to indicate crankshaft position and engine speed.
LOCATION:
This sensor is mounted remotely from the ignition module, right hand side of engine, at the end of
the crank shaft.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 842
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Remove or Disconnect
1. Sensor harness connector. 2. Sensor to block bolt. 3. Sensor from engine.
Inspect ^
Sensor O-ring for wear, cracks or leakage. Replace if necessary. Lube new O-ring with engine oil
before installing.
Install or Connect
1. Sensor into hole in block. 2. Sensor to block bolt.
^ Torque to 8 N.m (71 lb. in.).
3. Sensor harness connector.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Knock Sensor: Component Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 847
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 848
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE:
The knock sensor is used to detect engine detonation (ping). The ECM will retard the electronic
spark timing based on the signal received.
OPERATION:
The knock sensor detects abnormal vibration in the engine. Then, the knock sensor produces an
AC signal which increases with the severity of the knock. The ECM reads this signal and retards
the timing until the knock is stopped.
LOCATION:
Engine block near the cylinders.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 849
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-5
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 850
Knock Sensor Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Knock Sensor (KS) is used to detect engine detonation and the PCM will retard the ignition
control timing based on the signal being received. The circuitry, within the knock sensor, causes
the PCMs 5 volts to be pulled down so that under a no knock condition, CKT 496 would measure
about 2.5 volts. The knock sensor produces an AC signal, which rides on the 2.5 volts DC voltage.
The amplitude and frequency are dependent upon the knock level.
The EPROM used with this engine contains the functions which were part of remotely mounted
knock sensor modules used on other GM vehicles. The knock sensor portion of the EPROM then
sends a signal to other parts of the PCM which adjusts the spark timing to retard the spark and
reduce the detonation.
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. With engine idling, there should not be a knock signal present at the PCM, because detonation is
not likely under a no load condition.
2. Tapping on the engine lift bracket should simulate a knock signal to determine if the sensor is
capable of detecting detonation. If no knock is
detected, try tapping on engine block closer to sensor before replacing sensor.
3. If the engine has an internal problem which is creating a knock, the knock sensor may be
responding to the internal failure.
4. This test determines if the knock sensor is faulty or if the KS portion of the EPROM is faulty. If it
is determined that the EPROM is faulty, be sure
that it is properly installed and latched into place. If not properly installed, repair and retest.
Diagnostic Aids:
While observing knock signal on the Tech 1 scan tool, there should be an indication that knock is
present, when detonation can be heard. Detonation is most likely to occur under high engine load
conditions.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Discriminating
Sensors and Arming Sensors <--> [Impact Sensor] > Component Information > Description and Operation
Discriminating Sensors and Arming Sensors: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The discriminating and arming sensors are used by the SIR system to determine whether or not
certain frontal crashes require deployment of the air bags.
OPERATION
The sensor consists of a sensing element, normally open switch contacts and a diagnostic resistor.
The sensing element closes the switch contacts when the vehicle velocity changes are severe
enough to warrant air bag deployment.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Discriminating
Sensors and Arming Sensors <--> [Impact Sensor] > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 855
Discriminating Sensors and Arming Sensors: Service and Repair
WARNING: The diagnostic energy reserve module or sensing and diagnostic module
(DERM/SDM) can maintain enough voltage to cause air bag deployment for up to two minutes after
the ignition switch is turned off and the battery is disconnected. Servicing the SIR system during
this period may result in accidental deployment and personal injury.
1. Disarm system as described in Air Bag System Disarming & Arming. 2. Remove Connector
Position Assurance (CPA), then disconnect sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove sensor
attaching bolts, then the sensor from vehicle. 4. Reverse procedure to install, noting the following:
a. Install sensor with arrow pointed toward front of vehicle. b. After completing installation, rearm
system as described in Air Bag System Disarming & Arming. c. Turn ignition switch on and verify
that the AIR BAG or SIR warning lamp flashes seven to nine times and then turns off. If lamp does
not
respond as specified, refer to System Diagnosis.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle
Switch > Component Information > Locations
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Locations
Seat Belt Switch is located at the Part of LH front Seat Belt Buckle
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Passenger Presence System Information
Seat Occupant Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Passenger Presence System
Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-08-50-009F
Date: December 23, 2010
Subject: Information on Passenger Presence Sensing System (PPS or PSS) Concerns With
Custom Upholstery, Accessory Seat Heaters or Other Comfort Enhancing Devices
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Equipped with Passenger Presence Sensing
System
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 06-08-50-009E (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Concerns About Safety and Alterations to the Front Passenger Seat
Important ON A GM VEHICLE EQUIPPED WITH A PASSENGER SENSING SYSTEM, USE THE
SEAT COVERS AND OTHER SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT AS RELEASED BY GM FOR THAT
VEHICLE. DO NOT ALTER THE SEAT COVERS OR SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT. ANY
ALTERATIONS TO SEAT COVERS OR GM ACCESSORIES DEFEATS THE INTENDED DESIGN
OF THE SYSTEM. GM WILL NOT BE LIABLE FOR ANY PROBLEMS CAUSED BY USE OF
SUCH IMPROPER SEAT ALTERATIONS, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTY REPAIRS INCURRED.
The front passenger seat in many GM vehicles is equipped with a passenger sensing system that
will turn off the right front passenger's frontal airbag under certain conditions, such as when an
infant or child seat is present. In some vehicles, the passenger sensing system will also turn off the
right front passenger's seat mounted side impact airbag. For the system to function properly,
sensors are used in the seat to detect the presence of a properly-seated occupant. The passenger
sensing system may not operate properly if the original seat trim is replaced (1) by non-GM covers,
upholstery or trim, or (2) by GM covers, upholstery or trim designed for a different vehicle or (3) by
GM covers, upholstery or trim that has been altered by a trim shop, or (4) if any object, such as an
aftermarket seat heater or a comfort enhancing pad or device is installed under the seat fabric or
between the occupant and the seat fabric.
Aftermarket Seat Heaters, Custom Upholstery, and Comfort Enhancing Pads or Devices
Important ON A GM VEHICLE EQUIPPED WITH A PASSENGER SENSING SYSTEM, USE ONLY
SEAT COVERS AND OTHER SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT RELEASED AS GM
ACCESSORIES FOR THAT VEHICLE. DO NOT USE ANY OTHER TYPE OF SEAT COVERS OR
SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT, OR GM ACCESSORIES RELEASED FOR OTHER VEHICLE
APPLICATIONS. GM WILL NOT BE LIABLE FOR ANY PROBLEMS CAUSED BY USE OF SUCH
IMPROPER SEAT ACCESSORIES, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTY REPAIRS MADE
NECESSARY BY SUCH USE.
Many types of aftermarket accessories are available to customers, upfitting shops, and dealers.
Some of these devices sit on top of, or are Velcro(R) strapped to the seat while others such as seat
heaters are installed under the seat fabric. Additionally, seat covers made of leather or other
materials may have different padding thickness installed that could prevent the Passenger Sensing
System from functioning properly. Never alter the vehicle seats. Never add pads or other devices to
the seat cushion, as this may interfere with the operation of the Passenger Sensing System and
either prevent proper deployment of the passenger airbag or prevent proper suppression of the
passenger air bag.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 868
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 869
Clutch Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect clutch switch electrical connector.
2. Remove clutch bracket and switch attaching nuts, then remove switch.
3. Reverse procedure to install.
Torque switch attaching nuts to 53 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Neutral Safety Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 874
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 875
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 876
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 877
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 878
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 879
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 880
Neutral Safety Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 881
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 882
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 883
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 884
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 885
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 886
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 887
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 888
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 889
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 890
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 891
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 892
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 893
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 894
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 895
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 896
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 897
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 898
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 899
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 900
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 901
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 902
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 903
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 904
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 905
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 906
Neutral Safety Switch: Description and Operation
Fig. 6 Back-up Light/Neutral Start Switch Replacement
On vehicles equipped with automatic transmission, the neutral start and back-up light switches are
combined into one unit and must be replaced as an assembly.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 907
Neutral Safety Switch: Service and Repair
Fig. 6 Back-up Light/Neutral Start Switch Replacement
NOTE: On vehicles equipped with automatic transmission, the neutral start and back-up light
switches are combined into one unit and must be replaced as an assembly. 1. Disconnect battery
ground cable and shift linkage. 2. Disconnect electrical connector from switch. 3. Remove switch
mounting bolts, then switch assembly, Fig. 6. 4. If same switch is to be reinstalled, proceed as
follows:
a. Place shift shaft in Neutral position. b. Align flats of shift shaft with switch, then install switch. c.
Loosely install mounting bolts. d. Insert gauge pin, Fig. 6, in service adjustment hole and rotate
switch until pin drops in to a depth of 9 mm (9/64 inch). e. Torque mounting bolts to 18 ft. lbs.
5. If a new switch is to be installed, proceed as follows:
a. Place shift shaft in Neutral position. b. Align flats of shift shaft with switch, then install switch. c. If
bolt holes do not align with mounting boss on transaxle, verify shift shaft is in Neutral position, do
not rotate switch. Switch is pinned in
Neutral position. If switch has been rotated and the pin broken, use procedure outlined in step 4.
d. Torque mounting bolts to 18 ft. lbs.
6. Verify engine will only start in Park or Neutral positions.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Center Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations >
Page 914
Center Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 915
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation
Power Steering Pressure Switch
PURPOSE
To sense high pressure in the steering box and signal the ECM to adjust the idle speed
accordingly.
OPERATION
The Power Steering Pressure Switch (PSPS) opens during high pressure power steering
situations. When the power steering switch is open, power to the A/C relay is shut "OFF," resulting
in A/C compressor clutch disengagement. Also, a signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM uses this
signal to compensate for the additional engine load by moving the IAC valve.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 916
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-1E
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors and
Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 917
Power Steering Pressure Switch Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Power Steering Pressure (PSP) switch is normally open to ground and CKT 495 will be near
the battery voltage.
Turning the steering wheel increases power steering oil pressure and its load on an idling engine.
The pressure switch will close before the load can cause an idle problem.
Closing the switch causes CKT 495 to read less than 1 volt. The PCM will increase the idle air rate
and disengage the A/C relay.
^ A pressure switch that will not close or an open CKT 495 or 450, may cause the engine to stop
when power steering loads are high.
^ A switch that will not open, or a CKT 495 shorted to ground, may affect idle quality and will cause
the A/C relay to be de-energized.
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. Different makes of scan tools may display the state of this switch in different ways. Refer to scan
tool operator's manual to determine how this
input is displayed.
2. Checks to determine if CKT 495 is shorted to ground.
3. This should simulate a closed switch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Brake Switch - TCC: Component Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 924
Brake Switch - TCC: Connector Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations > Page 925
Harness Connector Faces: Brake Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Specifications
Pressure Switch ...................................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 8 Ft. Lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 933
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 934
Harness Connector Faces: Park/Neutral Position Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 935
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Park/Neutral Switch (Auto. Trans)
PURPOSE:
The PARK/NEUTRAL (P/N) switch indicates to the computer when the transmission is in PARK or
NEUTRAL. This information is used by the ECM for Idle Air Control (IAC), Torque Converter Clutch
(TCC) and Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) operation.
OPERATION:
The P/N switch contacts are a part of the neutral switch and are closed to ground in park or neutral
and open in drive ranges and reverse. The ECM supplies ignition voltage through a current limiting
resistor to the switch and senses a closed circuit when voltage drops to less than 1 volt.
NOTE: DO NOT drive the vehicle with the PARK/NEUTRAL switch disconnected, since idle quality
may be affected.
LOCATION:
Top of transaxle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 936
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-1A
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors
and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 937
Park/Neutral Position Switch Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Park/Neutral Position (PNP) switch contacts shown are a part of the Park/Neutral position
switch and are closed to ground in park or neutral, and open in drive ranges.
The PCM supplies ignition voltage through a pull up resistor to CKT 434 and senses a closed
switch when the voltage on CKT 434 drops to less than one volt.
The PCM uses the PNP signal as one of the inputs to control:
^ Idle speed.
^ VSS diagnostics.
^ EGR.
If CKT 434 indicates PNP (grounded), while in drive range, the EGR would be inoperative, resulting
in possible detonation.
If CKT 434 indicates drive (open) a sag in the idle may occur when the gear selector is moved into
drive range.
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. Checks for a closed switch to ground in park position. Different makes of scan toots will display
the PNP switch differently. Refer to tool
operator's manual for type of display used for a specific tool.
2. Checks for an open switch in drive range.
3. Be sure Tech 1 scan tool indicates drive, even while wiggling shifter, to test for an intermittent or
misadjusted switch in drive range.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Coupe
Center Of Console (Coupe)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Coupe > Page 943
Power Window Switch: Locations Station Wagon and Sedan
Center Of Console (Sedan Shown, Station Wagon Similar)
Center Of Console (Sedan Shown, Station Wagon Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 944
Power Window Switch: Diagrams
Harness Connector Faces: Console Window Switch- C1 (All Except Coupe)
Harness Connector Faces: Console Window Switch- C2 (All Except Coupe)
Harness Connector Faces: Console Window Switch- C1 (All Except Coupe) (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 945
Harness Connector Faces: Console Window Switch- C2 (All Except Coupe) (Description)
Harness Connector Faces: Console Window Switch (Coupe)
Harness Connector Faces: LH Rear Window Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 946
Harness Connector Faces: RH Rear Window Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 952
LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair
Fig. 13 Wiper Switch Removal
WARNING:
On models equipped with Airbags, Refer to Air Bags (Supplemental Restraint Systems) Service
and Repair Disarming procedures before performing any repair. See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag
Systems/Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Remove horn pad and steering wheel. Refer to Steering and
Suspension / Steering / Steering Wheel. See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Wheel/Service and Repair
3. Remove tilt lever from column, if equipped, Fig. 13. 4. Remove upper and lower steering column
covers. 5. Remove dampener assembly, then the headlight switch assembly. 6. Remove
windshield wiper switch assembly. 7. Reverse procedure to install.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest: > 333213 > Nov > 93 > Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull
Alignment: Customer Interest Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull
Group Ref.: Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 333213
Date: November, 1993
SUBJECT: VEHICLE MAY LEAD OR PULL (DIAGNOSE/SERVICE PROCEDURE)
MODELS: 1992-94 BUICK SKYLARK 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND
BERETTA 1992-94 OLDSMOBILE ACHIEVA 1992-94 PONTIAC SUNBIRD AND GRAND AM
CONDITION: Some owners may experience that the vehicle may lead or pull.
CORRECTION: DO NOT replace the steering gear to fix a lead or pull on 1993-94 vehicles as this
will not solve the problem. It may temporarily mask the problem due to the higher internal friction in
the new gear. However, the condition will resurface when the gear is worn in with mileage.
On 1992-94 vehicles, the following procedure should be followed for lead and pull conditions:
- Consult J/L/N lead/pull Corporate Bulletin # 073002. Previous divisional publication numbers
were:
Chevrolet 92-5O-3B
Pontiac 92-3-3
Oldsmobile 92-T-20
GM of Canada 92-3-110
- Consult J/L/N memory steer Corporate Bulletin # 233303R. Previous divisional publication
numbers were:
Chevrolet 93-171-3B
Buick 93-3-8
Pontiac 93-3-10
Oldsmobile 93-T-60
GM of Canada 93-3C-102
If the problem still exists, check system flows and pressures using gauge J 5176-D or J 25323-B.
System flow should be 1.9 gpm - 2.3 gpm, back pressure at or less than 100 psi with wheels
straight ahead and the engine at idle. If flows or pressures are out of specification, look for pinched
or crimped steering hoses and check for blockages by blowing air through the steering lines.
If problem still exists for 1992 V-6 vehicles only, evaluate vehicle for steering system induced
lead/pull by coasting with vehicle in neutral and engine off. Restart the vehicle. A steering induced
lead/pull will result in a significant, abrupt pull to the right. If this occurs, remove power steering
cooler lines from the steering system, (refer to Section 3B in the Service Manual). Use the following
hoses to connect directly from the steering gear to the pump reservoir inlet tube.
1. LHO engine (VIN T): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26038210
2. LG7 engine (VIN N): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26031205
If problem still persists on 1992 vehicles only, steering gear replacement can be attempted.
1993-94 vehicles have updated steering racks and should not require replacement for lead/pull
conditions. Also on 1993-94 vehicles, there are no cooler lines; therefore, the above by-pass hoses
do not apply. This is the latest information which should resolve any lead/pull conditions.
Parts are expected to be available on November 8, 1993.
WARRANTY INFORMATION: For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Number: T3385
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest: > 333213 > Nov > 93 > Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull > Page 965
Labor Time: 0.6 hr.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
Bulletin No.: 05-03-07-009C
Date: December 09, 2010
Subject: Wheel Alignment Specifications, Requirements and Recommendations for GM Vehicles
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being extensively revised to provide technicians and warranty
administrators with an all inclusive guide for wheel alignments. PLEASE FAMILIARIZE YOURSELF
WITH THESE UPDATES BEFORE PERFORMING YOUR NEXT GM WHEEL ALIGNMENT
SERVICE. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-07-009B (Section 03 - Suspension).
Purpose
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide retail, wholesale and fleet personnel with General Motors'
warranty service requirements and recommendations for customer concerns related to wheel
alignment. For your convenience, this bulletin updates and centralizes all of GM's Standard Wheel
Alignment Service Procedures, Policy Guidelines and bulletins on wheel alignment warranty
service.
Important PLEASE FAMILIARIZE YOURSELF WITH THESE UPDATES BEFORE PERFORMING
YOUR NEXT GM WHEEL ALIGNMENT SERVICE.
The following five (5) key steps are a summary of this bulletin and are REQUIRED in completing a
successful wheel alignment service.
1. Verify the vehicle is in an Original Equipment condition for curb weight, tires, wheels, suspension
and steering configurations. Vehicles
modified in any of these areas are not covered for wheel alignment warranty.
2. Review the customer concern relative to "Normal Operation" definitions. 3. Verify that vehicle is
within the "Mileage Policy" range. 4. Document wheel alignment warranty claims appropriately for
labor operations E2000 and E2020.
The following information must be documented or attached to the repair order:
- Customer concern in detail
- What corrected the customer concern?
- If a wheel alignment is performed:
- Consult SI for proper specifications.
- Document the "Before" AND "After" wheel alignment measurements/settings.
- Completed "Wheel Alignment Repair Order Questionnaire" (form attached to this bulletin)
5. Use the proper wheel alignment equipment (preferred with print-out capability), process and the
appropriate calibration maintenance schedules.
Important If it is determined that a wheel alignment is necessary under warranty, use the proper
labor code for the repair. E2000 for Steering Wheel Angle and/or Front Toe set or E2020 for Wheel
Alignment Check/Adjust includes Caster, Camber and Toe set (Wheel alignment labor time for
other component repairs is to be charged to the component that causes a wheel alignment
operation.).
The following flowchart is to help summarize the information detailed in this bulletin and should be
used whenever a wheel alignment is performed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 971
Verify Original Equipment Condition of the Vehicle
- Verify that Original Equipment Tires and Wheels or Official GM Accessory Tires and Wheels are
on the vehicle.
- Verify that aftermarket suspension "Lift" or "Lowering" Kits or other suspension alterations have
NOT been done to the vehicle.
- Check for accidental damage to the vehicle; for example, severe pothole or curb impacts, collision
damage that may have affected the wheel alignment of the vehicle; e.g., engine cradles,
suspension control arms, axles, wheels, wheel covers, tires may show evidence of damage/impact.
- Check to be sure vehicle has seen "Normal Use" rather than abuse; e.g., very aggressive driving
may show up by looking at the tires and condition of the vehicle.
- Check for other additional equipment items that may significantly affect vehicle mass such as
large tool boxes, campers, snow plow packages (without the snowplow RPO), etc., especially in
trucks and cutaway/incomplete vehicles. Significant additional mass can affect trim height and
wheel alignment of the vehicle and may necessitate a customer pay wheel alignment when placed
semi-permanently in the vehicle (Upfitter instructions are to realign the vehicle after placement of
these types of items. (This typically applies to trucks and incomplete vehicles that can be upfit with
equipment such as the above.)
Customer Concerns, "Normal Operation" Conditions and "Mileage Policy"
Possible Concerns
The following are typical conditions that may require wheel alignment warranty service:
1. Lead/Pull: defined as "at a constant highway speed on a typical straight road, the amount of
effort required at the steering wheel to maintain the
vehicle's straight heading."
Important Please evaluate for the condition with hands-on the steering wheel. Follow the "Vehicle
Leads/Pulls" diagnostic tree located in SI to determine the cause of a lead/pull concern. Lead/Pull
concerns can be due to road crown or road slope, tires, wheel alignment or even in rare
circumstances a steering gear issue. Lead/pull concerns due to road crown are considered
"Normal Operation" and are NOT a warrantable condition -- the customer should be advised that
this is "Normal Operation."
Important Some customers may comment on a "Lead/Pull" when they hold the steering wheel in a
level condition. If so, this is more likely a "steering wheel angle" concern because the customer is
"steering" the vehicle to obtain a "level" steering wheel.
2. Steering wheel angle to the left or right (counter-clockwise or clockwise, respectively): Defined
as the steering wheel angle (clocking)
deviation from "level" while maintaining a straight heading on a typical straight road.
3. Irregular or Premature tire wear: Slight to very slight "feathering" or "edge" wear on the
shoulders of tires is NOT considered unusual and
should even out with a tire rotation; if the customer is concerned about a "feathering" condition of
the tires, the customer could be advised to rotate the tires earlier than the next scheduled
mileage/maintenance interval (but no later than the next interval). Be sure to understand the
customer's driving habits as this will also heavily influence the tire wear performance; tire wear from
aggressive or abusive driving habits is NOT a warrantable condition.
Important Slight or mild feathering, cupping, edge or heel/toe wear of tire tread shoulders is
"normal" and can show up very early in a tire/vehicle service mileage; in fact, some new tires can
show evidence of feathering from the factory. These issues do NOT affect the overall performance
and tread life of the tire. Dealer personnel should always check the customer's maintenance
records to ensure that tire inflation pressure is being maintained to placard and that the tires are
being rotated (modified-X pattern) at the proper mileage intervals. Wheel alignments are NOT to be
performed for the types of "Normal" Tire Feathering shown in Figures 1-4 below.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 972
Figure 1: Full Tread View - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear on the Shoulder/Adjacent/Center
Ribs
Figure 2: Tire Shoulder View Example 1 - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear on the Shoulder
Figure 3: Tire Shoulder View Example 2 - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear
Figure 4: Detail Side View of Tire Shoulder Area - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear
Important When a wheel alignment is deemed necessary for tire wear, be sure to document on the
repair order, in as much detail as possible, the severity and type of tire wear (e.g., severe center
wear or severe inside or outside shoulder wear) and the position of the tire on the vehicle (RF, LF,
LR, RR). Please note the customer's concern with the wear such as, noise, appearance, wear life,
etc. A field product report with pictures of the tire wear condition is recommended. Refer to
Corporate Bulletin Number 02-00-89-002J and #07-00-89-036C.
4. Other repairs that affect wheel alignment; e.g., certain component replacement such as
suspension control arm replacement, engine cradle
adjustment/replace, steering gear replacement, steering tie rod replace, suspension strut/shock,
steering knuckle, etc. may require a wheel alignment.
Important If other components or repairs are identified as affecting the wheel alignment, policy calls
for the wheel alignment labor time to be charged to the replaced/repaired component's labor
operation time rather than the wheel alignment labor operations.
Important Vibration type customer concerns are generally NOT due to wheel alignment except in
the rare cases; e.g., extreme diagonal wear across the tread. In general, wheel alignments are
NOT to be performed as an investigation/correction for vibration concerns.
"Normal Operation" Conditions
Vehicle Lead/Pull Due to Road Crown or Slope:
As part of "Normal Operation," vehicles will follow side-to-side or left to right road crown or slope.
Be sure to verify from the customer the types of roads they are driving as they may not recognize
the influence of road crown on vehicle lead/pull and steering wheel angle. If a vehicle requires
significant steering effort to prevent it from "climbing" the road crown there may be an issue to be
looked into further.
Important
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 973
A wheel alignment will generally NOT correct vehicles that follow the road crown since this is within
"Normal Operation."
Mileage Policy
The following mileage policy applies for E2020 and E2000 labor operations: Note
Wheel Alignment is NOT covered under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty for Express and Savana
Cutaway vehicles as these vehicles require Upfitters to set the wheel alignment after completing
the vehicles.
- 0-800 km (0-500 mi): E2000/E2020 claims ONLY allowed with Call Center Authorization. Due to
the tie down during shipping, the vehicle's suspension requires some time to reach normal
operating position. For this reason, new vehicles are generally NOT to be aligned until they have
accumulated at least 800 km (500 mi). A field product report should accompany any claim within
this mileage range.
- 801-12,000 km (501-7,500 mi):
- If a vehicle came from the factory with incorrect alignment settings, any resulting off-angle
steering wheel, lead/pull characteristics or the rare occurrence of excessive tire wear would be
apparent early in the life of the vehicle. The following policy applies:
- Vehicles 100% Factory Set/Measured for Caster/Camber/Toe - Escalade/ESV/EXT,
Tahoe/Suburban, Yukon/XL/Denali, Silverado/Sierra, Express/Savana, Corvette and
Colorado/Canyon: E2000/E2020 Claims: Call Center Authorization Required
- All Vehicles NOT 100% Factory Set/Measured for Caster/Camber/Toe as noted above:
E2000/E2020 Claims: Dealer Service Manager Authorization Required
- 12,001 km and beyond (7,501 miles and beyond): During this period, customers are responsible
for the wheel alignment expense or dealers may provide on a case-by case basis a one-time
customer enthusiasm claim up to 16,000 km (10,000 mi). In the event that a defective component
required the use of the subject labor operations, the identified defective component labor operation
will include the appropriate labor time for a wheel alignment as an add condition to the component
repair.
Important Only one wheel alignment labor operation claim (E2000 or E2020) may be used per VIN.
Warranty Documentation Requirements
When a wheel alignment service has been deemed necessary, the following items will need to be
clearly documented on/with the repair order:
- Customer concern in detail
- What corrected the customer concern?
- If a wheel alignment is performed:
- Consult SI for proper specifications.
- Document the "Before" AND "After" wheel alignment measurements/settings.
- Completed "Wheel Alignment Repair Order Questionnaire" (form attached to this bulletin)
1. Document the customer concern in as much detail as possible on the repair order and in the
warranty administration system. Preferred examples:
- Steering wheel is off angle in the counterclockwise direction by approximately x degrees or
clocking position.
- Vehicle lead/pulls to the right at approximately x-y mph. Vehicle will climb the road crown. Severe,
Moderate or Slight.
- RF and LF tires are wearing on the outside shoulders with severe feathering.
Important In the event of a lead/pull or steering wheel angle concern, please note the direction of
lead/pull (left or right) or direction of steering wheel angle (clockwise or counterclockwise) on the
repair order and within the warranty claim verbatim.
Important In the event of a tire wear concern, please note the position on the vehicle and where the
wear is occurring on the tire; i.e., the RF tire is wearing on the inside shoulder.
2. Document the technician's findings on cause and correction of the issue. Examples:
- Reset LF toe from 0.45 degrees to 0.10 degrees and RF toe from -0.25 degrees to 0.10 degrees
to correct the steering wheel angle from 5 degrees counterclockwise to 0 degrees.
- Reset LF camber from 0.25 degrees to -0.05 degrees to correct the cross-camber condition of
+0.30 degrees to 0.00 degrees on the vehicle.
- Front Sum toe was found to be 0.50 degrees, reset to 0.20 degrees.
3. Print-out the "Before" and "After" wheel alignment measurements/settings and attach them to the
Repair Order or if print-out capability is not
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 974
available, measurements may also be clearly and legibly handwritten into the Wheel Alignment
Repair Order Questionnaire attached to this bulletin.
4. Attach the Wheel Alignment Repair Order Questionnaire below along with the print-out of
"Before" and "After" wheel alignment measurements to
the Repair Order and retain for use by GM.
Wheel Alignment Equipment and Process
Wheel alignments must be performed with a quality machine that will give accurate results when
performing checks. "External Reference" (image-based camera technology) is preferred. Please
refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 05-00-89-029B: General Motors Dealership Critical Equipment
Requirements and Recommendations.
Requirements:
- Computerized four wheel alignment system.
- Computer capable of printing before and after alignment reports.
- Computer capable of time and date stamp printout.
- Racking system must have jacking capability
- Racking system must be capable of level to 1.6 mm (1/16 in)
- Appropriate wheel stops and safety certification
- Built-in turn plates and slip plates
- Wheel clamps capable of attaching to 20" or larger wheels
- Racking capable of accepting any GM passenger car or light duty truck
- Operator properly trained and ASE-certified (U.S. only) in wheel alignment
Recommendations:
Racking should have front and rear jacking capability.
Equipment Maintenance and Calibration:
Alignment machines must be regularly calibrated in order to give correct information. Most
manufacturers recommend the following:
- Alignment machines with "internal reference" sensors should be checked (and calibrated, if
necessary) every six months.
- Alignment machines with "external reference" (image-based camera technology) should be
checked (and calibrated, if necessary) once a year.
- Racks must be kept level to within 1.6 mm (1/16 in).
- If any instrument that is part of the alignment machine is dropped or damaged in some way,
check the calibration immediately.
Check with the manufacturer of your specific equipment for their recommended service/calibration
schedule.
Wheel Alignment Process
When performing wheel alignment measurement and/or adjustment, the following steps should be
taken:
Preliminary Steps:
1. Verify that the vehicle has a full tank of fuel (compensate as necessary). 2. Inspect the wheels
and the tires for damage. 3. Inspect the tires for the proper inflation and irregular tire wear. 4.
Inspect the wheel bearings for excessive play. 5. Inspect all suspension and steering parts for
looseness, wear, or damage. 6. Inspect the steering wheel for excessive drag or poor return due to
stiff or rusted linkage or suspension components. 7. Inspect the vehicle trim height. 8. Compensate
for frame angle on targeted vehicles (refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications in SI).
Satisfactory vehicle operation may occur over a wide range of alignment angles. However, if the
wheel alignment angles are not within the range of specifications, adjust the wheel alignment to the
specifications. Refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications in SI. Give consideration to excess loads,
such as tool boxes, sample cases, etc. Follow the wheel alignment equipment manufacturer's
instructions.
Measure/Adjust:
Important Prior to making any adjustments to wheel alignment on a vehicle, technicians must verify
that the wheel alignment specifications loaded into their wheel alignment machine are up-to-date
by comparing these to the wheel alignment specifications for the appropriate model and model year
in SI. Using incorrect and/or outdated specifications may result in unnecessary adjustments,
irregular and/or premature tire wear and repeat customer concerns
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 975
Important When performing adjustments to vehicles requiring a 4-wheel alignment, set the rear
wheel alignment angles first in order to obtain proper front wheel alignment angles.
Perform the following steps in order to measure the front and rear alignment angles:
1. Install the alignment equipment according to the manufacturer's instructions. 2. Jounce the front
and the rear bumpers 3 times prior to checking the wheel alignment. 3. Measure the alignment
angles and record the readings.
If necessary, adjust the wheel alignment to vehicle specification and record the before and after
measurements. Refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications in SI.
Important Technicians must refer to SI for the correct wheel alignment specifications. SI is the only
source of GM wheel alignment specifications that is kept up-to-date throughout the year.
Test drive vehicle to ensure proper repair.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 976
Frame Angle Measurement (Express / Savana Only) ........
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 977
What corrected the customer concern and was the repair verified?
Please Explain: .............
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 333213 > Nov > 93 > Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull
Group Ref.: Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 333213
Date: November, 1993
SUBJECT: VEHICLE MAY LEAD OR PULL (DIAGNOSE/SERVICE PROCEDURE)
MODELS: 1992-94 BUICK SKYLARK 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND
BERETTA 1992-94 OLDSMOBILE ACHIEVA 1992-94 PONTIAC SUNBIRD AND GRAND AM
CONDITION: Some owners may experience that the vehicle may lead or pull.
CORRECTION: DO NOT replace the steering gear to fix a lead or pull on 1993-94 vehicles as this
will not solve the problem. It may temporarily mask the problem due to the higher internal friction in
the new gear. However, the condition will resurface when the gear is worn in with mileage.
On 1992-94 vehicles, the following procedure should be followed for lead and pull conditions:
- Consult J/L/N lead/pull Corporate Bulletin # 073002. Previous divisional publication numbers
were:
Chevrolet 92-5O-3B
Pontiac 92-3-3
Oldsmobile 92-T-20
GM of Canada 92-3-110
- Consult J/L/N memory steer Corporate Bulletin # 233303R. Previous divisional publication
numbers were:
Chevrolet 93-171-3B
Buick 93-3-8
Pontiac 93-3-10
Oldsmobile 93-T-60
GM of Canada 93-3C-102
If the problem still exists, check system flows and pressures using gauge J 5176-D or J 25323-B.
System flow should be 1.9 gpm - 2.3 gpm, back pressure at or less than 100 psi with wheels
straight ahead and the engine at idle. If flows or pressures are out of specification, look for pinched
or crimped steering hoses and check for blockages by blowing air through the steering lines.
If problem still exists for 1992 V-6 vehicles only, evaluate vehicle for steering system induced
lead/pull by coasting with vehicle in neutral and engine off. Restart the vehicle. A steering induced
lead/pull will result in a significant, abrupt pull to the right. If this occurs, remove power steering
cooler lines from the steering system, (refer to Section 3B in the Service Manual). Use the following
hoses to connect directly from the steering gear to the pump reservoir inlet tube.
1. LHO engine (VIN T): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26038210
2. LG7 engine (VIN N): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26031205
If problem still persists on 1992 vehicles only, steering gear replacement can be attempted.
1993-94 vehicles have updated steering racks and should not require replacement for lead/pull
conditions. Also on 1993-94 vehicles, there are no cooler lines; therefore, the above by-pass hoses
do not apply. This is the latest information which should resolve any lead/pull conditions.
Parts are expected to be available on November 8, 1993.
WARRANTY INFORMATION: For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Number: T3385
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 333213 > Nov > 93 > Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull > Page 982
Labor Time: 0.6 hr.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
Bulletin No.: 05-03-07-009C
Date: December 09, 2010
Subject: Wheel Alignment Specifications, Requirements and Recommendations for GM Vehicles
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being extensively revised to provide technicians and warranty
administrators with an all inclusive guide for wheel alignments. PLEASE FAMILIARIZE YOURSELF
WITH THESE UPDATES BEFORE PERFORMING YOUR NEXT GM WHEEL ALIGNMENT
SERVICE. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-07-009B (Section 03 - Suspension).
Purpose
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide retail, wholesale and fleet personnel with General Motors'
warranty service requirements and recommendations for customer concerns related to wheel
alignment. For your convenience, this bulletin updates and centralizes all of GM's Standard Wheel
Alignment Service Procedures, Policy Guidelines and bulletins on wheel alignment warranty
service.
Important PLEASE FAMILIARIZE YOURSELF WITH THESE UPDATES BEFORE PERFORMING
YOUR NEXT GM WHEEL ALIGNMENT SERVICE.
The following five (5) key steps are a summary of this bulletin and are REQUIRED in completing a
successful wheel alignment service.
1. Verify the vehicle is in an Original Equipment condition for curb weight, tires, wheels, suspension
and steering configurations. Vehicles
modified in any of these areas are not covered for wheel alignment warranty.
2. Review the customer concern relative to "Normal Operation" definitions. 3. Verify that vehicle is
within the "Mileage Policy" range. 4. Document wheel alignment warranty claims appropriately for
labor operations E2000 and E2020.
The following information must be documented or attached to the repair order:
- Customer concern in detail
- What corrected the customer concern?
- If a wheel alignment is performed:
- Consult SI for proper specifications.
- Document the "Before" AND "After" wheel alignment measurements/settings.
- Completed "Wheel Alignment Repair Order Questionnaire" (form attached to this bulletin)
5. Use the proper wheel alignment equipment (preferred with print-out capability), process and the
appropriate calibration maintenance schedules.
Important If it is determined that a wheel alignment is necessary under warranty, use the proper
labor code for the repair. E2000 for Steering Wheel Angle and/or Front Toe set or E2020 for Wheel
Alignment Check/Adjust includes Caster, Camber and Toe set (Wheel alignment labor time for
other component repairs is to be charged to the component that causes a wheel alignment
operation.).
The following flowchart is to help summarize the information detailed in this bulletin and should be
used whenever a wheel alignment is performed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications >
Page 988
Verify Original Equipment Condition of the Vehicle
- Verify that Original Equipment Tires and Wheels or Official GM Accessory Tires and Wheels are
on the vehicle.
- Verify that aftermarket suspension "Lift" or "Lowering" Kits or other suspension alterations have
NOT been done to the vehicle.
- Check for accidental damage to the vehicle; for example, severe pothole or curb impacts, collision
damage that may have affected the wheel alignment of the vehicle; e.g., engine cradles,
suspension control arms, axles, wheels, wheel covers, tires may show evidence of damage/impact.
- Check to be sure vehicle has seen "Normal Use" rather than abuse; e.g., very aggressive driving
may show up by looking at the tires and condition of the vehicle.
- Check for other additional equipment items that may significantly affect vehicle mass such as
large tool boxes, campers, snow plow packages (without the snowplow RPO), etc., especially in
trucks and cutaway/incomplete vehicles. Significant additional mass can affect trim height and
wheel alignment of the vehicle and may necessitate a customer pay wheel alignment when placed
semi-permanently in the vehicle (Upfitter instructions are to realign the vehicle after placement of
these types of items. (This typically applies to trucks and incomplete vehicles that can be upfit with
equipment such as the above.)
Customer Concerns, "Normal Operation" Conditions and "Mileage Policy"
Possible Concerns
The following are typical conditions that may require wheel alignment warranty service:
1. Lead/Pull: defined as "at a constant highway speed on a typical straight road, the amount of
effort required at the steering wheel to maintain the
vehicle's straight heading."
Important Please evaluate for the condition with hands-on the steering wheel. Follow the "Vehicle
Leads/Pulls" diagnostic tree located in SI to determine the cause of a lead/pull concern. Lead/Pull
concerns can be due to road crown or road slope, tires, wheel alignment or even in rare
circumstances a steering gear issue. Lead/pull concerns due to road crown are considered
"Normal Operation" and are NOT a warrantable condition -- the customer should be advised that
this is "Normal Operation."
Important Some customers may comment on a "Lead/Pull" when they hold the steering wheel in a
level condition. If so, this is more likely a "steering wheel angle" concern because the customer is
"steering" the vehicle to obtain a "level" steering wheel.
2. Steering wheel angle to the left or right (counter-clockwise or clockwise, respectively): Defined
as the steering wheel angle (clocking)
deviation from "level" while maintaining a straight heading on a typical straight road.
3. Irregular or Premature tire wear: Slight to very slight "feathering" or "edge" wear on the
shoulders of tires is NOT considered unusual and
should even out with a tire rotation; if the customer is concerned about a "feathering" condition of
the tires, the customer could be advised to rotate the tires earlier than the next scheduled
mileage/maintenance interval (but no later than the next interval). Be sure to understand the
customer's driving habits as this will also heavily influence the tire wear performance; tire wear from
aggressive or abusive driving habits is NOT a warrantable condition.
Important Slight or mild feathering, cupping, edge or heel/toe wear of tire tread shoulders is
"normal" and can show up very early in a tire/vehicle service mileage; in fact, some new tires can
show evidence of feathering from the factory. These issues do NOT affect the overall performance
and tread life of the tire. Dealer personnel should always check the customer's maintenance
records to ensure that tire inflation pressure is being maintained to placard and that the tires are
being rotated (modified-X pattern) at the proper mileage intervals. Wheel alignments are NOT to be
performed for the types of "Normal" Tire Feathering shown in Figures 1-4 below.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications >
Page 989
Figure 1: Full Tread View - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear on the Shoulder/Adjacent/Center
Ribs
Figure 2: Tire Shoulder View Example 1 - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear on the Shoulder
Figure 3: Tire Shoulder View Example 2 - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear
Figure 4: Detail Side View of Tire Shoulder Area - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear
Important When a wheel alignment is deemed necessary for tire wear, be sure to document on the
repair order, in as much detail as possible, the severity and type of tire wear (e.g., severe center
wear or severe inside or outside shoulder wear) and the position of the tire on the vehicle (RF, LF,
LR, RR). Please note the customer's concern with the wear such as, noise, appearance, wear life,
etc. A field product report with pictures of the tire wear condition is recommended. Refer to
Corporate Bulletin Number 02-00-89-002J and #07-00-89-036C.
4. Other repairs that affect wheel alignment; e.g., certain component replacement such as
suspension control arm replacement, engine cradle
adjustment/replace, steering gear replacement, steering tie rod replace, suspension strut/shock,
steering knuckle, etc. may require a wheel alignment.
Important If other components or repairs are identified as affecting the wheel alignment, policy calls
for the wheel alignment labor time to be charged to the replaced/repaired component's labor
operation time rather than the wheel alignment labor operations.
Important Vibration type customer concerns are generally NOT due to wheel alignment except in
the rare cases; e.g., extreme diagonal wear across the tread. In general, wheel alignments are
NOT to be performed as an investigation/correction for vibration concerns.
"Normal Operation" Conditions
Vehicle Lead/Pull Due to Road Crown or Slope:
As part of "Normal Operation," vehicles will follow side-to-side or left to right road crown or slope.
Be sure to verify from the customer the types of roads they are driving as they may not recognize
the influence of road crown on vehicle lead/pull and steering wheel angle. If a vehicle requires
significant steering effort to prevent it from "climbing" the road crown there may be an issue to be
looked into further.
Important
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications >
Page 990
A wheel alignment will generally NOT correct vehicles that follow the road crown since this is within
"Normal Operation."
Mileage Policy
The following mileage policy applies for E2020 and E2000 labor operations: Note
Wheel Alignment is NOT covered under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty for Express and Savana
Cutaway vehicles as these vehicles require Upfitters to set the wheel alignment after completing
the vehicles.
- 0-800 km (0-500 mi): E2000/E2020 claims ONLY allowed with Call Center Authorization. Due to
the tie down during shipping, the vehicle's suspension requires some time to reach normal
operating position. For this reason, new vehicles are generally NOT to be aligned until they have
accumulated at least 800 km (500 mi). A field product report should accompany any claim within
this mileage range.
- 801-12,000 km (501-7,500 mi):
- If a vehicle came from the factory with incorrect alignment settings, any resulting off-angle
steering wheel, lead/pull characteristics or the rare occurrence of excessive tire wear would be
apparent early in the life of the vehicle. The following policy applies:
- Vehicles 100% Factory Set/Measured for Caster/Camber/Toe - Escalade/ESV/EXT,
Tahoe/Suburban, Yukon/XL/Denali, Silverado/Sierra, Express/Savana, Corvette and
Colorado/Canyon: E2000/E2020 Claims: Call Center Authorization Required
- All Vehicles NOT 100% Factory Set/Measured for Caster/Camber/Toe as noted above:
E2000/E2020 Claims: Dealer Service Manager Authorization Required
- 12,001 km and beyond (7,501 miles and beyond): During this period, customers are responsible
for the wheel alignment expense or dealers may provide on a case-by case basis a one-time
customer enthusiasm claim up to 16,000 km (10,000 mi). In the event that a defective component
required the use of the subject labor operations, the identified defective component labor operation
will include the appropriate labor time for a wheel alignment as an add condition to the component
repair.
Important Only one wheel alignment labor operation claim (E2000 or E2020) may be used per VIN.
Warranty Documentation Requirements
When a wheel alignment service has been deemed necessary, the following items will need to be
clearly documented on/with the repair order:
- Customer concern in detail
- What corrected the customer concern?
- If a wheel alignment is performed:
- Consult SI for proper specifications.
- Document the "Before" AND "After" wheel alignment measurements/settings.
- Completed "Wheel Alignment Repair Order Questionnaire" (form attached to this bulletin)
1. Document the customer concern in as much detail as possible on the repair order and in the
warranty administration system. Preferred examples:
- Steering wheel is off angle in the counterclockwise direction by approximately x degrees or
clocking position.
- Vehicle lead/pulls to the right at approximately x-y mph. Vehicle will climb the road crown. Severe,
Moderate or Slight.
- RF and LF tires are wearing on the outside shoulders with severe feathering.
Important In the event of a lead/pull or steering wheel angle concern, please note the direction of
lead/pull (left or right) or direction of steering wheel angle (clockwise or counterclockwise) on the
repair order and within the warranty claim verbatim.
Important In the event of a tire wear concern, please note the position on the vehicle and where the
wear is occurring on the tire; i.e., the RF tire is wearing on the inside shoulder.
2. Document the technician's findings on cause and correction of the issue. Examples:
- Reset LF toe from 0.45 degrees to 0.10 degrees and RF toe from -0.25 degrees to 0.10 degrees
to correct the steering wheel angle from 5 degrees counterclockwise to 0 degrees.
- Reset LF camber from 0.25 degrees to -0.05 degrees to correct the cross-camber condition of
+0.30 degrees to 0.00 degrees on the vehicle.
- Front Sum toe was found to be 0.50 degrees, reset to 0.20 degrees.
3. Print-out the "Before" and "After" wheel alignment measurements/settings and attach them to the
Repair Order or if print-out capability is not
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications >
Page 991
available, measurements may also be clearly and legibly handwritten into the Wheel Alignment
Repair Order Questionnaire attached to this bulletin.
4. Attach the Wheel Alignment Repair Order Questionnaire below along with the print-out of
"Before" and "After" wheel alignment measurements to
the Repair Order and retain for use by GM.
Wheel Alignment Equipment and Process
Wheel alignments must be performed with a quality machine that will give accurate results when
performing checks. "External Reference" (image-based camera technology) is preferred. Please
refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 05-00-89-029B: General Motors Dealership Critical Equipment
Requirements and Recommendations.
Requirements:
- Computerized four wheel alignment system.
- Computer capable of printing before and after alignment reports.
- Computer capable of time and date stamp printout.
- Racking system must have jacking capability
- Racking system must be capable of level to 1.6 mm (1/16 in)
- Appropriate wheel stops and safety certification
- Built-in turn plates and slip plates
- Wheel clamps capable of attaching to 20" or larger wheels
- Racking capable of accepting any GM passenger car or light duty truck
- Operator properly trained and ASE-certified (U.S. only) in wheel alignment
Recommendations:
Racking should have front and rear jacking capability.
Equipment Maintenance and Calibration:
Alignment machines must be regularly calibrated in order to give correct information. Most
manufacturers recommend the following:
- Alignment machines with "internal reference" sensors should be checked (and calibrated, if
necessary) every six months.
- Alignment machines with "external reference" (image-based camera technology) should be
checked (and calibrated, if necessary) once a year.
- Racks must be kept level to within 1.6 mm (1/16 in).
- If any instrument that is part of the alignment machine is dropped or damaged in some way,
check the calibration immediately.
Check with the manufacturer of your specific equipment for their recommended service/calibration
schedule.
Wheel Alignment Process
When performing wheel alignment measurement and/or adjustment, the following steps should be
taken:
Preliminary Steps:
1. Verify that the vehicle has a full tank of fuel (compensate as necessary). 2. Inspect the wheels
and the tires for damage. 3. Inspect the tires for the proper inflation and irregular tire wear. 4.
Inspect the wheel bearings for excessive play. 5. Inspect all suspension and steering parts for
looseness, wear, or damage. 6. Inspect the steering wheel for excessive drag or poor return due to
stiff or rusted linkage or suspension components. 7. Inspect the vehicle trim height. 8. Compensate
for frame angle on targeted vehicles (refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications in SI).
Satisfactory vehicle operation may occur over a wide range of alignment angles. However, if the
wheel alignment angles are not within the range of specifications, adjust the wheel alignment to the
specifications. Refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications in SI. Give consideration to excess loads,
such as tool boxes, sample cases, etc. Follow the wheel alignment equipment manufacturer's
instructions.
Measure/Adjust:
Important Prior to making any adjustments to wheel alignment on a vehicle, technicians must verify
that the wheel alignment specifications loaded into their wheel alignment machine are up-to-date
by comparing these to the wheel alignment specifications for the appropriate model and model year
in SI. Using incorrect and/or outdated specifications may result in unnecessary adjustments,
irregular and/or premature tire wear and repeat customer concerns
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications >
Page 992
Important When performing adjustments to vehicles requiring a 4-wheel alignment, set the rear
wheel alignment angles first in order to obtain proper front wheel alignment angles.
Perform the following steps in order to measure the front and rear alignment angles:
1. Install the alignment equipment according to the manufacturer's instructions. 2. Jounce the front
and the rear bumpers 3 times prior to checking the wheel alignment. 3. Measure the alignment
angles and record the readings.
If necessary, adjust the wheel alignment to vehicle specification and record the before and after
measurements. Refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications in SI.
Important Technicians must refer to SI for the correct wheel alignment specifications. SI is the only
source of GM wheel alignment specifications that is kept up-to-date throughout the year.
Test drive vehicle to ensure proper repair.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications >
Page 993
Frame Angle Measurement (Express / Savana Only) ........
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications >
Page 994
What corrected the customer concern and was the repair verified?
Please Explain: .............
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 995
Alignment: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 333213 Date: 931101
Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull
Group Ref.: Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 333213
Date: November, 1993
SUBJECT: VEHICLE MAY LEAD OR PULL (DIAGNOSE/SERVICE PROCEDURE)
MODELS: 1992-94 BUICK SKYLARK 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND
BERETTA 1992-94 OLDSMOBILE ACHIEVA 1992-94 PONTIAC SUNBIRD AND GRAND AM
CONDITION: Some owners may experience that the vehicle may lead or pull.
CORRECTION: DO NOT replace the steering gear to fix a lead or pull on 1993-94 vehicles as this
will not solve the problem. It may temporarily mask the problem due to the higher internal friction in
the new gear. However, the condition will resurface when the gear is worn in with mileage.
On 1992-94 vehicles, the following procedure should be followed for lead and pull conditions:
- Consult J/L/N lead/pull Corporate Bulletin # 073002. Previous divisional publication numbers
were:
Chevrolet 92-5O-3B
Pontiac 92-3-3
Oldsmobile 92-T-20
GM of Canada 92-3-110
- Consult J/L/N memory steer Corporate Bulletin # 233303R. Previous divisional publication
numbers were:
Chevrolet 93-171-3B
Buick 93-3-8
Pontiac 93-3-10
Oldsmobile 93-T-60
GM of Canada 93-3C-102
If the problem still exists, check system flows and pressures using gauge J 5176-D or J 25323-B.
System flow should be 1.9 gpm - 2.3 gpm, back pressure at or less than 100 psi with wheels
straight ahead and the engine at idle. If flows or pressures are out of specification, look for pinched
or crimped steering hoses and check for blockages by blowing air through the steering lines.
If problem still exists for 1992 V-6 vehicles only, evaluate vehicle for steering system induced
lead/pull by coasting with vehicle in neutral and engine off. Restart the vehicle. A steering induced
lead/pull will result in a significant, abrupt pull to the right. If this occurs, remove power steering
cooler lines from the steering system, (refer to Section 3B in the Service Manual). Use the following
hoses to connect directly from the steering gear to the pump reservoir inlet tube.
1. LHO engine (VIN T): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26038210
2. LG7 engine (VIN N): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26031205
If problem still persists on 1992 vehicles only, steering gear replacement can be attempted.
1993-94 vehicles have updated steering racks and should not require replacement for lead/pull
conditions. Also on 1993-94 vehicles, there are no cooler lines; therefore, the above by-pass hoses
do not apply. This is the latest information which should resolve any lead/pull conditions.
Parts are expected to be available on November 8, 1993.
WARRANTY INFORMATION:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 996
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Number: T3385
Labor Time: 0.6 hr.
Technical Service Bulletin # 333213 Date: 931101
Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull
Group Ref.: Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 333213
Date: November, 1993
SUBJECT: VEHICLE MAY LEAD OR PULL (DIAGNOSE/SERVICE PROCEDURE)
MODELS: 1992-94 BUICK SKYLARK 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND
BERETTA 1992-94 OLDSMOBILE ACHIEVA 1992-94 PONTIAC SUNBIRD AND GRAND AM
CONDITION: Some owners may experience that the vehicle may lead or pull.
CORRECTION: DO NOT replace the steering gear to fix a lead or pull on 1993-94 vehicles as this
will not solve the problem. It may temporarily mask the problem due to the higher internal friction in
the new gear. However, the condition will resurface when the gear is worn in with mileage.
On 1992-94 vehicles, the following procedure should be followed for lead and pull conditions:
- Consult J/L/N lead/pull Corporate Bulletin # 073002. Previous divisional publication numbers
were:
Chevrolet 92-5O-3B
Pontiac 92-3-3
Oldsmobile 92-T-20
GM of Canada 92-3-110
- Consult J/L/N memory steer Corporate Bulletin # 233303R. Previous divisional publication
numbers were:
Chevrolet 93-171-3B
Buick 93-3-8
Pontiac 93-3-10
Oldsmobile 93-T-60
GM of Canada 93-3C-102
If the problem still exists, check system flows and pressures using gauge J 5176-D or J 25323-B.
System flow should be 1.9 gpm - 2.3 gpm, back pressure at or less than 100 psi with wheels
straight ahead and the engine at idle. If flows or pressures are out of specification, look for pinched
or crimped steering hoses and check for blockages by blowing air through the steering lines.
If problem still exists for 1992 V-6 vehicles only, evaluate vehicle for steering system induced
lead/pull by coasting with vehicle in neutral and engine off. Restart the vehicle. A steering induced
lead/pull will result in a significant, abrupt pull to the right. If this occurs, remove power steering
cooler lines from the steering system, (refer to Section 3B in the Service Manual). Use the following
hoses to connect directly from the steering gear to the pump reservoir inlet tube.
1. LHO engine (VIN T): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26038210
2. LG7 engine (VIN N): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26031205
If problem still persists on 1992 vehicles only, steering gear replacement can be attempted.
1993-94 vehicles have updated steering racks and should not require replacement for lead/pull
conditions. Also on 1993-94 vehicles, there are no cooler lines; therefore, the above by-pass hoses
do not apply. This is the latest information which should resolve any lead/pull conditions.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 997
Parts are expected to be available on November 8, 1993.
WARRANTY INFORMATION: For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Number: T3385
Labor Time: 0.6 hr.
Technical Service Bulletin # 333213 Date: 931101
Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull
Group Ref.: Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 333213
Date: November, 1993
SUBJECT: VEHICLE MAY LEAD OR PULL (DIAGNOSE/SERVICE PROCEDURE)
MODELS: 1992-94 BUICK SKYLARK 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND
BERETTA 1992-94 OLDSMOBILE ACHIEVA 1992-94 PONTIAC SUNBIRD AND GRAND AM
CONDITION: Some owners may experience that the vehicle may lead or pull.
CORRECTION: DO NOT replace the steering gear to fix a lead or pull on 1993-94 vehicles as this
will not solve the problem. It may temporarily mask the problem due to the higher internal friction in
the new gear. However, the condition will resurface when the gear is worn in with mileage.
On 1992-94 vehicles, the following procedure should be followed for lead and pull conditions:
- Consult J/L/N lead/pull Corporate Bulletin # 073002. Previous divisional publication numbers
were:
Chevrolet 92-5O-3B
Pontiac 92-3-3
Oldsmobile 92-T-20
GM of Canada 92-3-110
- Consult J/L/N memory steer Corporate Bulletin # 233303R. Previous divisional publication
numbers were:
Chevrolet 93-171-3B
Buick 93-3-8
Pontiac 93-3-10
Oldsmobile 93-T-60
GM of Canada 93-3C-102
If the problem still exists, check system flows and pressures using gauge J 5176-D or J 25323-B.
System flow should be 1.9 gpm - 2.3 gpm, back pressure at or less than 100 psi with wheels
straight ahead and the engine at idle. If flows or pressures are out of specification, look for pinched
or crimped steering hoses and check for blockages by blowing air through the steering lines.
If problem still exists for 1992 V-6 vehicles only, evaluate vehicle for steering system induced
lead/pull by coasting with vehicle in neutral and engine off. Restart the vehicle. A steering induced
lead/pull will result in a significant, abrupt pull to the right. If this occurs, remove power steering
cooler lines from the steering system, (refer to Section 3B in the Service Manual). Use the following
hoses to connect directly from the steering gear to the pump reservoir inlet tube.
1. LHO engine (VIN T): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26038210
2. LG7 engine (VIN N): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26031205
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 998
If problem still persists on 1992 vehicles only, steering gear replacement can be attempted.
1993-94 vehicles have updated steering racks and should not require replacement for lead/pull
conditions. Also on 1993-94 vehicles, there are no cooler lines; therefore, the above by-pass hoses
do not apply. This is the latest information which should resolve any lead/pull conditions.
Parts are expected to be available on November 8, 1993.
WARRANTY INFORMATION: For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Number: T3385
Labor Time: 0.6 hr.
Technical Service Bulletin # 333213 Date: 931101
Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull
Group Ref.: Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 333213
Date: November, 1993
SUBJECT: VEHICLE MAY LEAD OR PULL (DIAGNOSE/SERVICE PROCEDURE)
MODELS: 1992-94 BUICK SKYLARK 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND
BERETTA 1992-94 OLDSMOBILE ACHIEVA 1992-94 PONTIAC SUNBIRD AND GRAND AM
CONDITION: Some owners may experience that the vehicle may lead or pull.
CORRECTION: DO NOT replace the steering gear to fix a lead or pull on 1993-94 vehicles as this
will not solve the problem. It may temporarily mask the problem due to the higher internal friction in
the new gear. However, the condition will resurface when the gear is worn in with mileage.
On 1992-94 vehicles, the following procedure should be followed for lead and pull conditions:
- Consult J/L/N lead/pull Corporate Bulletin # 073002. Previous divisional publication numbers
were:
Chevrolet 92-5O-3B
Pontiac 92-3-3
Oldsmobile 92-T-20
GM of Canada 92-3-110
- Consult J/L/N memory steer Corporate Bulletin # 233303R. Previous divisional publication
numbers were:
Chevrolet 93-171-3B
Buick 93-3-8
Pontiac 93-3-10
Oldsmobile 93-T-60
GM of Canada 93-3C-102
If the problem still exists, check system flows and pressures using gauge J 5176-D or J 25323-B.
System flow should be 1.9 gpm - 2.3 gpm, back pressure at or less than 100 psi with wheels
straight ahead and the engine at idle. If flows or pressures are out of specification, look for pinched
or crimped steering hoses and check for blockages by blowing air through the steering lines.
If problem still exists for 1992 V-6 vehicles only, evaluate vehicle for steering system induced
lead/pull by coasting with vehicle in neutral and engine off. Restart the vehicle. A steering induced
lead/pull will result in a significant, abrupt pull to the right. If this occurs, remove power steering
cooler lines from the steering system, (refer to Section 3B in the Service Manual). Use the following
hoses to connect directly from the steering gear to the pump reservoir inlet tube.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 999
1. LHO engine (VIN T): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26038210
2. LG7 engine (VIN N): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26031205
If problem still persists on 1992 vehicles only, steering gear replacement can be attempted.
1993-94 vehicles have updated steering racks and should not require replacement for lead/pull
conditions. Also on 1993-94 vehicles, there are no cooler lines; therefore, the above by-pass hoses
do not apply. This is the latest information which should resolve any lead/pull conditions.
Parts are expected to be available on November 8, 1993.
WARRANTY INFORMATION: For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Number: T3385
Labor Time: 0.6 hr.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Vehicle Ride (Trim)
Height Specifications
Alignment: Specifications Vehicle Ride (Trim) Height Specifications
Model ...................................................................................................................................................
............................................ Cavalier Station Wagon Tire Size ...........................................................
................................................................................................................................................
185/75R x 14 Engine ...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................................. 2.2L Ride Height Measurements in
Inches [01]
Dimension Z ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 3.62 Dimension J ........................................................
.........................................................................................................................................................
9.53 Dimension K ................................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 9.65
[01] Maximum variation side to side & front to rear is 3/4 inch.
Model ...................................................................................................................................................
............................................ Cavalier Station Wagon Tire Size ...........................................................
................................................................................................................................................
195/70R x 14 Engine ...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................................. 2.2L Ride Height Measurements in
Inches [01]
Dimension Z ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 3.78 Dimension J ........................................................
.........................................................................................................................................................
9.53 Dimension K ................................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 9.65
[01] Maximum variation side to side & front to rear is 3/4 inch.
Model ...................................................................................................................................................
............................................ Cavalier Station Wagon Tire Size ...........................................................
................................................................................................................................................
195/70R x 14 Engine ...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................................. 3.1L Ride Height Measurements in
Inches [01]
Dimension Z ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 3.82 Dimension J ........................................................
.........................................................................................................................................................
9.53 Dimension K ................................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 9.65
[01] Maximum variation side to side & front to rear is 3/4 inch.
Model ...................................................................................................................................................
........................................... Cavalier Coupe & Sedan Tire Size ..........................................................
.................................................................................................................................................
185/75R x 14 Engine ...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................................. 2.2L Ride Height Measurements in
Inches [01]
Dimension Z ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 3.42 Dimension J ........................................................
.........................................................................................................................................................
9.26 Dimension K ................................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 9.13
[01] Maximum variation side to side & front to rear is 3/4 inch.
Model ...................................................................................................................................................
........................................... Cavalier Coupe & Sedan Tire Size ..........................................................
.................................................................................................................................................
195/70R x 14 Engine ...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................................... 2.2 Ride Height Measurements in
Inches [01]
Dimension Z ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 3.58 Dimension J ........................................................
.........................................................................................................................................................
9.26 Dimension K ................................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 9.13
[01] Maximum variation side to side & front to rear is 3/4 inch.
Model ...................................................................................................................................................
........................................... Cavalier Coupe & Sedan Tire Size ..........................................................
.................................................................................................................................................
195/70R x 14 Engine ...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................................. 3.1L Ride Height Measurements in
Inches [01]
Dimension Z ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 3.62 Dimension J ........................................................
.........................................................................................................................................................
9.26 Dimension K ................................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 9.13
[01] Maximum variation side to side & front to rear is 3/4 inch. Model ................................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. Cavalier Z24 Tire Size ......................................................................................................................
..................................................................................... 205/60R x 15 Engine .....................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................... 3.1L
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Vehicle Ride (Trim)
Height Specifications > Page 1002
Ride Height Measurements in Inches [01]
Dimension Z ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 3.58 Dimension J ........................................................
.........................................................................................................................................................
9.26 Dimension K ................................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 9.13
[01] Maximum variation side to side & front to rear is 3/4 inch.
Model ...................................................................................................................................................
............................................ Cavalier Station Wagon Tire Size ...........................................................
................................................................................................................................................
185/75R x 14 Engine ...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................................. 2.2L Ride Height Measurements in
Inches [01]
Dimension Z ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 9/32 Dimension J ........................................................
.........................................................................................................................................................
9.53 Dimension K ................................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 9.65
[01] Maximum variation side to side & front to rear is 3/4 inch.
Model ...................................................................................................................................................
............................................ Cavalier Station Wagon Tire Size ...........................................................
................................................................................................................................................
195/70R x 14 Engine ...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................................. 2.2L Ride Height Measurements in
Inches [01]
Dimension Z ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 7/16 Dimension J ........................................................
.........................................................................................................................................................
9.53 Dimension K ................................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 9.65
[01] Maximum variation side to side & front to rear is 3/4 inch.
Model ...................................................................................................................................................
............................................ Cavalier Station Wagon Tire Size ...........................................................
................................................................................................................................................
195/70R x 14 Engine ...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................................. 3.1L Ride Height Measurements in
Inches [01]
Dimension Z ........................................................................................................................................
...................................................................... 31/64 Dimension J ........................................................
.........................................................................................................................................................
9.53 Dimension K ................................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 9.65
[01] Maximum variation side to side & front to rear is 3/4 inch.
Model ...................................................................................................................................................
................................................. Cavalier Convertible Tire Size ...........................................................
................................................................................................................................................
185/75R x 14 Engine ...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................................... All Ride Height Measurements in
Inches [01]
Dimension Z ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 5/64 Dimension J ........................................................
.........................................................................................................................................................
9.26 Dimension K ................................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 9.13
[01] Maximum variation side to side & front to rear is 3/4 inch.
Model ...................................................................................................................................................
........................................... Cavalier Coupe & Sedan Tire Size ..........................................................
.................................................................................................................................................
195/70R x 14 Engine ...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................................... All Ride Height Measurements in
Inches [01]
Dimension Z ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 5/64 Dimension J ........................................................
.........................................................................................................................................................
9.26 Dimension K ................................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 9.13
[01] Maximum variation side to side & front to rear is 3/4 inch.
Model ...................................................................................................................................................
............................................................. Cavalier Z24 Tire Size ...........................................................
................................................................................................................................................
205/60R x 15 Engine ...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................................. 3.1L Ride Height Measurements in
Inches [01]
Dimension Z ........................................................................................................................................
...................................................................... 15/64 Dimension J ........................................................
.........................................................................................................................................................
9.26 Dimension K ................................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 9.13
[01] Maximum variation side to side & front to rear is 3/4 inch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Vehicle Ride (Trim)
Height Specifications > Page 1003
Alignment: Specifications Alignment Specifications
Front Alignment Specifications
CASTER ANGLE, DEGREES [1]
Desired ................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ +1.3 Limits ..................................................................
............................................................................................................................................ +0.3 to
+2.3
CAMBER ANGLE, DEGREES
Desired ................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................... -0.15 Limits ..................................................................
.......................................................................................................................................... -0.85 to +
0.5
TOTAL TOE, DEGREES .....................................................................................................................
....................................................................... +0.2
[1] Non-adjustable, for inspection purposes only.
Rear Alignment Specifications
Camber Angle, Degrees ......................................................................................................................
........................................................................... [01]
Limits ...................................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... - .85 to +.35 Desired .................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
-0.25
Thrust Angle, Degrees .........................................................................................................................
.......................................................................... [01]
Limits ...................................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... - .35 to +.35 Desired .................................................................
........................................................................................................................................................... 0
Total Toe, Degrees ..............................................................................................................................
........................................................................... [01]
Limits ...................................................................................................................................................
........................................................... -.06 to +.56 Desired .................................................................
...................................................................................................................................................... 0.25
[01] -- Non-adjustable, for inspection purposes only.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Ride/Trim Height
Measurement and Adjustment
Alignment: Service and Repair Ride/Trim Height Measurement and Adjustment
Fig. 3 Vehicle Ride Height Measurement Locations
Refer to Fig. 3, for ride height measurements and for specifications refer to Vehicle Ride Height
Specifications. When checking ride height measurements, fuel tank should be full, tires at should
be correct pressure, front seat should be rearward position, trunk should be empty except for spare
tire and jack and vehicle should be on level ground. If fuel tank is not full, add weight to trunk to
compensate for amount fuel vehicle is below the full level.
Prior to checking ride height, lift front bumper upward approximately 1.5 inches and gently release
(3 times), then check front ride height. Push front bumper downward approximately 1.5 inches and
gently release (3 times), then recheck front ride height. Average of both readings to determine
vehicle ride height. Check rear ride height in same manner, lifting and pushing rear bumper.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Ride/Trim Height
Measurement and Adjustment > Page 1006
Alignment: Service and Repair Front Wheel Alignment
Preliminary Inspection
CASTER ALIGNMENT CHECK
Caster is not adjustable. If caster angle is not within specifications, inspect for suspension support
misalignment or front suspension damage.
TOE ALIGNMENT CHECK
Toe setting is the only adjustment normally required. However, in special circumstances, such as
damage due to road hazard or collision, camber may be adjusted by modifying the strut assembly.
Front Caster Adjustment
Caster is not adjustable. If caster angle is not within specifications, inspect for suspension support
misalignment or front suspension damage.
Front Camber Adjustment
Fig. 1 Modifying Strut Bracket To Adjust Camber
Toe setting is the only adjustment normally required. However, in special circumstances, such as
damage due to road hazard or collision, camber may be adjusted by modifying the strut assembly.
1. Secure bottom of strut assembly in a suitable vise.
2. Enlarge bottom holes in outer flanges with a round file until holes in outer flanges match slots in
inner flanges, Fig. 1.
3. Connect strut to steering knuckle and install bolts finger tight.
4. Grasp top of tire firmly, then move tire inboard or outboard until correct camber reading is
obtained. Tighten retaining bolts enough to secure camber setting.
5. Remove wheel and tire and tighten strut to steering knuckle retaining bolts. On 1989-90 models,
Torque strut to steering knuckle retaining bolts to 135 ft. lbs. On 1991-92 models, Torque strut to
steering knuckle attaching bolt to 133 ft. lbs.
Front Toe Adjustment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Ride/Trim Height
Measurement and Adjustment > Page 1007
Fig. 2 Adjusting Toe
Toe-out is controlled by tie rod position. Adjustment is made by loosening the clamp bolts at the
steering knuckle end of the tie rods and rotating the rods to obtain proper toe setting, Fig. 2. After
correct toe setting is obtained, tighten clamp bolts. Torque clamp bolts to 41 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > Diagnostic
Connector - Fuel Pump > Component Information > Locations
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > Fuel Pressure
Test Port > Component Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Test Port: Service and Repair
Area around fuel pressure connection with GM X-30A or equivalent.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT:
1. Negative battery terminal.
2. Relieve fuel system pressure.
3. Fuel pressure connection and seal. Discard seal.
INSTALL OR CONNECT:
1. New seal on fuel pressure connection.
2. Fuel pressure connection in fuel rail. Tighten Fuel pressure connection assembly to 10.0 N-m
(88 lb. in.).
3. Tighten fuel filler cap.
4. Negative battery terminal.
5. Turn ignition switch to the "ON" position for two seconds, then turn to the "OFF" position for ten
seconds. Again turn to the "ON" position, and check for fuel leaks.
6. Perform the "Idle Learn Procedure." The ECM will need to relearn the IAC valve pintle position
following battery reconnect.
Air Plenum And Fuel Rail Removal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > Fuel Pressure
Test Port > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 1016
Fuel Pressure Connection
REMOVAL:
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Relieve the fuel system pressure, see FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELIEF:
3. Remove intake manifold plenum, see INTAKE MANIFOLD PLENUM.
4. Clean area around the fuel pressure connection with GM X-30A or equivalent.
5. Remove the fuel pressure connection and seal, discard the seal.
INSTALLATION:
1. Place a new seal on the fuel pressure connection assembly.
2. Screw the fuel pressure connection assembly into the fuel rail and tighten to 10.0 N-m (88 lb.
in.).
3. Check for fuel leaks: a.
Connect the negative battery cable.
b. With engine "OFF" and ignition "ON," check for fuel leaks.
c. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
4. Install the intake manifold plenum as per above procedure.
IDLE LEARN PROCEDURE: Any time the battery is disconnected, the programmed position of the
IAC valve pintle is lost, and replaced with a default value. To return the IAC valve pintle to the
correct position, perform the following procedure:
1. After restoring battery power, connect the Tech 1 "SCAN" tool.
2. Select "IAC SYSTEM," then select "IDLE LEARN" in the "MISC TEST" mode.
3. Proceed with idle learn as directed.
^ This procedure allows the ECM memory to be updated with the correct IAC valve pintle position,
for the vehicle, and provide a stable idle speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System
Information > Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
The idle speed is computer controlled and there is no provision for adjustment. If idle speed is
incorrect, refer to Computers and Control Systems / System Diagnosis.
MINIMUM IDLE SPEED
Transmission Gear Idle Speed IAC Counts Open/Closed Loop (2)
N/A N/A (1) 10-20 CL
(1) No idle speed specifications are provided for this vehicle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System
Information > Specifications > Page 1020
Idle Speed: Adjustments
The ECM controls idle speed and no adjustment should be attempted.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Filter Element: >
04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: Customer Interest Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Filter Element: >
04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 1030
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 1036
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure
Release > System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
WARNING: To reduce the risk of fire and personal injury, it is necessary to relieve the fuel system
pressure before servicing fuel system components.
After relieving system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing fuel lines
or connections. In order to reduce the chance of personal injury, cover fuel line fittings with a shop
towel before disconnecting, to catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved
container when disconnect is completed.
When servicing the fuel system use the following precautions:
a. Put a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the workshop.
b. Be sure shop is supplied with an adequate fire extinguisher.
c. Be sure to disconnect the negative battery cable before any service work is done.
d. Use a suitable container to catch any fuel that may leak from system during service.
e. Always relieve fuel system pressure before disconnecting any lines.
f. If the key must be turned "ON" while servicing fuel system, always disconnect or disable ignition,
to insure no sparks occur near fuel vapors.
PROCEDURE:
Tool required: J34730-1 Fuel Pressure Gauge or equivalent.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable, to avoid fuel pump turn "ON," if an accidental attempt is
made to start the engine.
2. Loosen the fuel filler cap to relieve tank vapor pressure.
3. Connect the fuel pressure gauge to the pressure connection. Wrap a shop towel around the
fitting while connecting the gauge to avoid spillage.
4. Install bleed hose into an approved container and open the valve to bleed the system pressure.
Fuel connections are now safe for servicing.
5. Drain any fuel remaining in the gauge into an approved container.
When repair to the fuel system has been completed, START the engine and check all connections
that were loosened for leaks.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order > Component
Information > Specifications > Ignition Firing Order
Firing Order: Specifications Ignition Firing Order
Firing Order .........................................................................................................................................
............................................................... 1-2-3-4-5-6
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing > Number One
Cylinder > Component Information > Locations > Number 1 Cylinder Location
Number One Cylinder: Locations Number 1 Cylinder Location
NUMBER ONE CYLINDER LOCATION
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing > Timing Marks
and Indicators > System Information > Locations
Timing Marks and Indicators: Locations
The ECM controls ignition timing therefore no provisions for adjustment are required. No timing
marks are provided on this engine.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug Wire <--> [Ignition
Cable] > Component Information > Specifications
Spark Plug Wire: Specifications
Spark Plug Wire Resistance Values:
0-15 inch cable ....................................................................................................................................
............................................... 3,000-10,000 ohms.
15-25 inch cable ..................................................................................................................................
............................................... 4,000-15,000 ohms.
25-35 inch cable ..................................................................................................................................
............................................... 6,000-20,000 ohms.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug Wire <--> [Ignition
Cable] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1056
Spark Plug Wire Routing
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug > Component
Information > Specifications
Spark Plug: Specifications
Spark Plug Gap ...................................................................................................................................
...................................................... .045 in. (1.14 mm)
NOTE: Check the gap specifications given on the Emissions Control Label. If the gap is different
from what is listed here, use the information on the label.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression Check > System
Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
The lowest reading cylinder should not be less than 70% of the highest and no cylinder reading
should be less than 689 kPa (100 psi). Perform compression test with engine at normal operating
temperature, spark plugs removed and throttle wide open.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Specifications > Valve Clearance Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications Valve Clearance Specifications
Vehicles are equipped with a non-adjustable rocker arm studs. If valve reconditioning is required,
the non-adjustable rocker arm stud must be replaced with an adjustable rocker arm stud and the
following procedure must be performed.
1. Remove rocker arm covers.
2. Crank engine until mark on torsional damper lines up with O mark on timing tab. The engine
should also be in the No. 1 firing position. This can be determined by placing fingers on No. 1
rocker arms as mark on damper approaches O mark.
3. If valves are not moving, engine is in No. 1 firing position. If valves move as the mark comes up
to the timing tab, engine is in No. 4 firing position and should be rotated one revolution to reach No.
1 position.
4. With engine in No. 1 firing position, adjust exhaust valves 1, 2 and 3 and intake valves 1, 5 and
6, as follows: a.
Back out adjusting nut until lash is felt at pushrod, then turn in adjusting nut until all lash is
removed.
b. When lash has been removed, turn adjusting nut in additional 1 1/2 turns to center lifter plunger.
5. Crank engine one revolution until timing tab O mark and torsional damper mark are again in
alignment.
6. With the engine in this, the No. 4 firing position. adjust exhaust valves 4, 5 and 6 and intake
valves 2, 3 and 4 as previously described.
7. Install rocker arm covers, then start engine and check timing and idle speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Specifications > Valve Clearance Specifications > Page 1067
Valve Clearance: Specifications Valve Arrangement
FRONT TO REAR
Right ....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................... E-I-E-I-I-E Left .........................................................................
......................................................................................................................................... E-I-I-E-I-E
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Specifications > Page 1068
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
Vehicles are equipped with a non-adjustable rocker arm studs. If valve reconditioning is required,
the non-adjustable rocker arm stud must be replaced with an adjustable rocker arm stud and the
following procedure must be performed.
1. Remove rocker arm covers.
2. Crank engine until mark on torsional damper lines up with O mark on timing tab. The engine
should also be in the No. 1 firing position. This can be determined by placing fingers on No. 1
rocker arms as mark on damper approaches O mark.
3. If valves are not moving, engine is in No. 1 firing position. If valves move as the mark comes up
to the timing tab, engine is in No. 4 firing position and should be rotated one revolution to reach No.
1 position.
4. With engine in No. 1 firing position, adjust exhaust valves 1, 2 and 3 and intake valves 1, 5 and
6, as follows: a.
Back out adjusting nut until lash is felt at pushrod, then turn in adjusting nut until all lash is
removed.
b. When lash has been removed, turn adjusting nut in additional 1 1/2 turns to center lifter plunger.
5. Crank engine one revolution until timing tab O mark and torsional damper mark are again in
alignment.
6. With the engine in this, the No. 4 firing position. adjust exhaust valves 4, 5 and 6 and intake
valves 2, 3 and 4 as previously described.
7. Install rocker arm covers, then start engine and check timing and idle speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine
- Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics
Drive Belt: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-06-01-008A
Date: July 27, 2009
Subject: Diagnosing Accessory Drive Belt / Serpentine Belt Noise and Availability and Use of
Kent-Moore EN-49228 Laser Alignment Tool - Drive Belt
Models:
2010 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 Vehicles 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add a model year and update the Tool Information.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 08-06-01-008 (Section 06 - Engine).
Background
Several aftermarket companies offer laser alignment tools for accessory drive systems that can be
very helpful in eliminating drive belt noise as a result of misaligned pulleys. Typically pricing ranges
from $160 - $200.
EN-49228 Laser Alignment Tool - Drive Belt
The GM Tool program has now made available a competitive, simple to use and time-saving laser
tool to assist in achieving precise alignment of the drive belt pulleys. This optional tool removes the
guesswork from proper pulley alignment and may serve to reduce comebacks from:
- Drive Belt Noise
- Accelerated Drive Belt Wear
- Drive Belt Slippage
Instructions
The instructions below are specific only to the truck Gen IV V-8 family of engines. These
instructions are only for illustrative purposes to show how the tool may be used. Universal
instructions are included in the box with the Laser Alignment Tool - Drive Belt.
Caution
- Do not look directly into the beam projected from the laser.
- Use caution when shining the laser on highly polished or reflective surfaces. Laser safety glasses
help reduce laser beam glare in many circumstances.
- Always use laser safety glasses when using the laser. Laser safety glasses are not designed to
protect eyes from direct laser exposure.
1. Observe and mark the serpentine belt orientation.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine
- Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics > Page 1073
2. Remove the serpentine belt from the accessory drive system.
3. Install the tool onto the power steering pulley. Position the legs of the tool into the outer grooves
of the pulley, farthest from the front of the
engine.
4. Install the retaining cord around the pulley and to the legs of the tool.
5. Put on the laser safety glasses provided with the tool. 6. Depress the switch on the rear of the
tool to activate the light beam. 7. Rotate the power steering pulley as required to project the light
beam onto the crankshaft balancer pulley grooves. 8. Inspect for proper power steering pulley
alignment.
- If the laser beam projects onto the second rib or raised area (1), the pulleys are aligned properly.
- If the laser beam projects more than one-quarter rib 0.9 mm (0.035 in) mis-alignment, adjust the
position of the power steering pulley as required.
- Refer to SI for Power Steering Pulley Removal and Installation procedures.
9. Install the serpentine belt to the accessory drive system in the original orientation.
10. Operate the vehicle and verify that the belt noise concern is no longer present.
Tool Information
Please visit the GM service tool website for pricing information or to place your order for this tool.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine
- Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics > Page 1074
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine
- Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics > Page 1075
Drive Belt: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Serpentine Drive Belt Wear Information
Bulletin No.: 04-06-01-013
Date: April 29, 2004
INFORMATION
Subject: Information on Serpentine Belt Wear
Models: 2004 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks 2003-2004 and Prior HUMMER H2
All current GM vehicles designed and manufactured in North America were assembled with
serpentine belts that are made with an EPDM material and should last the life of the vehicle. It is
extremely rare to observe any cracks in EPDM belts and it is not expected that they will require
maintenance before 10 years or 240,000 km (150,000 mi) of use.
Older style belts, which were manufactured with a chloroprene compound, may exhibit cracks
depending on age. However, the onset of cracking typically signals that the belt is only about
halfway through its usable life.
A good rule of thumb for chloroprene-based belts is that if cracks are observed 3 mm (1/8 in) apart,
ALL AROUND THE BELT, the belt may be reaching the end of its serviceable life and should be
considered a candidate for changing. Small cracks spaced at greater intervals should not be
considered as indicative that the belt needs changing.
Any belt that exhibits chunking should be replaced.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Specifications > Belt Tension
Specifications
Drive Belt: Specifications Belt Tension Specifications
Belt Tension [01] ..................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 50-70
[01] Belt tension is controlled automatically by the belt tensioner. If belt tensioner has to operate out
of its range to obtain adequate belt tension,
replace belt.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Specifications > Belt Tension
Specifications > Page 1078
Drive Belt: Specifications Engine Accessory Drive Belts
POWER STEERING
New lbs. ...............................................................................................................................................
..................................................................... 225-236
Used lbs. ..............................................................................................................................................
..................................................................... 112-124
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1079
Drive Belt: Adjustments
Belt tension is maintained by a spring-loaded tensioner. No adjustment
is necessary.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1080
Drive Belt: Service and Repair
Fig. 16 Serpentine Belt Routing
1. Remove belt guard.
2. Lift or rotate tensioner using a 1/2 inch breaker bar.
3. Remove serpentine drive belt.
4. Reverse procedure to install, routing belt as shown in Fig. 16.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: Customer Interest Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 1091
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine,
A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine,
A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 1097
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Crankcase Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair
Crankcase Filter: Service and Repair
The PCV system should be checked every 15,000 miles and also during regular engine tune-ups. If
the PCV system includes a breather filter, located in the air cleaner housing, this filter should be
replaced whenever the PCV valve or air cleaner is replaced. When a periodic inspection indicates
the PCV is not functioning properly, it should be serviced by replacement only.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Evaporative Canister Filter > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Evaporative Canister Filter: Service and Repair
NOTE: NOT ALL EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CONTROL CANISTERS HAVE A SERVICEABLE
FILTER.
At intervals recommended, usually every 24 months or 30,000 miles, the filter on an open bottom
canister should be replaced,
1. Remove all hoses from the top of the canister and mark. Remove the canister.
2. Remove the filter element by squeezing it out from under the lip surface at bottom of canister
and from under retainer bar, where used.
3. Squeeze the new element under retainer bar, where used, and position it evenly around the
entire bottom of the canister. Tuck the edges under the lip of canister.
4. Reinstall the canister to its original position on the vehicle, following normal service procedures.
5. Reconnect the hoses to the top of the canister, according to the labeling on top of canister.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > A/T - Transaxle Oil Filter Differences
Fluid Filter - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Transaxle Oil Filter Differences
GROUP REF.: Transmission
BULLETIN NO.: 477103
DATE: March, 1994
SUBJECT: TRANSAXLE OIL FILTER DIFFERENCES
MODELS: 1985-94 PASSENGER CARS AND U VANS WITH 4T60 OR 4T60-E TRANSAXLES
TRANSAXLE APPLICATIONS: HYDRA-MATIC 4T60 (RPO ME9) HYDRA-MATIC 4T60-E (RPO
M13)
TRANSAXLE MODELS: ALL
At the start of the 1993 model year, 4T6O transaxle oil filters were revised in appearance. This
revision made the 4T60 transaxle oil filter similar in appearance to the 4T60-E transaxle oil filter.
Current and previous design 4T6O transaxle oil filters can be used on any 4T6O transaxle. 4T60
and 4T60-E transaxle oil filters are NOT interchangeable. Refer to the current GMSPO catalog for
4T60 and 4T60-E transaxle oil filter part numbers.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure Release > System Information >
Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
WARNING: To reduce the risk of fire and personal injury, it is necessary to relieve the fuel system
pressure before servicing fuel system components.
After relieving system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing fuel lines
or connections. In order to reduce the chance of personal injury, cover fuel line fittings with a shop
towel before disconnecting, to catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved
container when disconnect is completed.
When servicing the fuel system use the following precautions:
a. Put a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the workshop.
b. Be sure shop is supplied with an adequate fire extinguisher.
c. Be sure to disconnect the negative battery cable before any service work is done.
d. Use a suitable container to catch any fuel that may leak from system during service.
e. Always relieve fuel system pressure before disconnecting any lines.
f. If the key must be turned "ON" while servicing fuel system, always disconnect or disable ignition,
to insure no sparks occur near fuel vapors.
PROCEDURE:
Tool required: J34730-1 Fuel Pressure Gauge or equivalent.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable, to avoid fuel pump turn "ON," if an accidental attempt is
made to start the engine.
2. Loosen the fuel filler cap to relieve tank vapor pressure.
3. Connect the fuel pressure gauge to the pressure connection. Wrap a shop towel around the
fitting while connecting the gauge to avoid spillage.
4. Install bleed hose into an approved container and open the valve to bleed the system pressure.
Fuel connections are now safe for servicing.
5. Drain any fuel remaining in the gauge into an approved container.
When repair to the fuel system has been completed, START the engine and check all connections
that were loosened for leaks.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine - Noise/Damage Oil Filter Application Importance
Oil Filter: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Noise/Damage Oil Filter Application Importance
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-016B
Date: July 27, 2009
Subject: Information on Internal Engine Noise or Damage After Oil Filter Replacement
Models:
2010 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3
2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being updated to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 07-06-01-016A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
Important Engine damage that is the result of an incorrect or improperly installed engine oil filter is
not a warrantable claim. The best way to avoid oil filter quality concerns is to purchase ACDelco(R)
oil filters directly from GMSPO.
Oil filter misapplication may cause abnormal engine noise or internal damage. Always utilize the
most recent parts information to ensure the correct part number filter is installed when replacing oil
filters. Do not rely on physical dimensions alone. Counterfeit copies of name brand parts have been
discovered in some aftermarket parts systems. Always ensure the parts you install are from a
trusted source. Improper oil filter installation may result in catastrophic engine damage.
Refer to the appropriate Service Information (SI) installation instructions when replacing any oil
filter and pay particular attention to procedures for proper cartridge filter element alignment. If the
diagnostics in SI (Engine Mechanical) lead to the oil filter as the cause of the internal engine noise
or damage, dealers should submit a field product report. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
02-00-89-002I (Information for Dealers on How to Submit a Field Product Report).
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine - Noise/Damage Oil Filter Application Importance > Page 1116
Oil Filter: Technical Service Bulletins Parts - OE and Aftermarket Oil Filters Revised
Group Ref.: Warranty Administration
Bulletin No.: 420502
Date: May, 1994
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
SUBJECT: AC ROCHESTER ENGINE OIL FILTER IDENTIFICATION
MODELS: 1994 PASSENGER CARS AND TRUCKS
ATTENTION: DEALER SERVICE MANAGER/WARRANTY ADMINISTRATOR
The purpose of this bulletin is to notify retail/wholesale service personnel of a running change to
the AC Rochester Original Equipment engine oil filters.
Due to an agreement to decrease the number of GMSPO part numbers, AC Rochester will phase
in a decision to make all Original Equipment engine oil filters blue; same color used on AC
aftermarket engine oil filters. This means that eventually the use of black Original Equipment
engine oil filters will be discontinued.
For the purpose of Warranty/Policy administration, the following will assist retail/wholesale service
personnel in identifying the difference between blue Original Equipment and aftermarket engine oil
filters:
^ AFTERMARKET FILTER: will continue to use "AC DURAGUARD OIL FILTER" label.
^ OE FILTER: will have a black bar code, Julian date code and the letters "OE" printed on the
dome of the filter. At this time, it is anticipated that all OE engine oil filters will be changed by May
1994.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 333213 > Nov > 93 > Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull
Power Steering Line/Hose: Customer Interest Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull
Group Ref.: Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 333213
Date: November, 1993
SUBJECT: VEHICLE MAY LEAD OR PULL (DIAGNOSE/SERVICE PROCEDURE)
MODELS: 1992-94 BUICK SKYLARK 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND
BERETTA 1992-94 OLDSMOBILE ACHIEVA 1992-94 PONTIAC SUNBIRD AND GRAND AM
CONDITION: Some owners may experience that the vehicle may lead or pull.
CORRECTION: DO NOT replace the steering gear to fix a lead or pull on 1993-94 vehicles as this
will not solve the problem. It may temporarily mask the problem due to the higher internal friction in
the new gear. However, the condition will resurface when the gear is worn in with mileage.
On 1992-94 vehicles, the following procedure should be followed for lead and pull conditions:
- Consult J/L/N lead/pull Corporate Bulletin # 073002. Previous divisional publication numbers
were:
Chevrolet 92-5O-3B
Pontiac 92-3-3
Oldsmobile 92-T-20
GM of Canada 92-3-110
- Consult J/L/N memory steer Corporate Bulletin # 233303R. Previous divisional publication
numbers were:
Chevrolet 93-171-3B
Buick 93-3-8
Pontiac 93-3-10
Oldsmobile 93-T-60
GM of Canada 93-3C-102
If the problem still exists, check system flows and pressures using gauge J 5176-D or J 25323-B.
System flow should be 1.9 gpm - 2.3 gpm, back pressure at or less than 100 psi with wheels
straight ahead and the engine at idle. If flows or pressures are out of specification, look for pinched
or crimped steering hoses and check for blockages by blowing air through the steering lines.
If problem still exists for 1992 V-6 vehicles only, evaluate vehicle for steering system induced
lead/pull by coasting with vehicle in neutral and engine off. Restart the vehicle. A steering induced
lead/pull will result in a significant, abrupt pull to the right. If this occurs, remove power steering
cooler lines from the steering system, (refer to Section 3B in the Service Manual). Use the following
hoses to connect directly from the steering gear to the pump reservoir inlet tube.
1. LHO engine (VIN T): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26038210
2. LG7 engine (VIN N): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26031205
If problem still persists on 1992 vehicles only, steering gear replacement can be attempted.
1993-94 vehicles have updated steering racks and should not require replacement for lead/pull
conditions. Also on 1993-94 vehicles, there are no cooler lines; therefore, the above by-pass hoses
do not apply. This is the latest information which should resolve any lead/pull conditions.
Parts are expected to be available on November 8, 1993.
WARRANTY INFORMATION: For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Number: T3385
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 333213 > Nov > 93 > Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull > Page 1126
Labor Time: 0.6 hr.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 333213 > Nov > 93 > Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull
Power Steering Line/Hose: All Technical Service Bulletins Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull
Group Ref.: Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 333213
Date: November, 1993
SUBJECT: VEHICLE MAY LEAD OR PULL (DIAGNOSE/SERVICE PROCEDURE)
MODELS: 1992-94 BUICK SKYLARK 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND
BERETTA 1992-94 OLDSMOBILE ACHIEVA 1992-94 PONTIAC SUNBIRD AND GRAND AM
CONDITION: Some owners may experience that the vehicle may lead or pull.
CORRECTION: DO NOT replace the steering gear to fix a lead or pull on 1993-94 vehicles as this
will not solve the problem. It may temporarily mask the problem due to the higher internal friction in
the new gear. However, the condition will resurface when the gear is worn in with mileage.
On 1992-94 vehicles, the following procedure should be followed for lead and pull conditions:
- Consult J/L/N lead/pull Corporate Bulletin # 073002. Previous divisional publication numbers
were:
Chevrolet 92-5O-3B
Pontiac 92-3-3
Oldsmobile 92-T-20
GM of Canada 92-3-110
- Consult J/L/N memory steer Corporate Bulletin # 233303R. Previous divisional publication
numbers were:
Chevrolet 93-171-3B
Buick 93-3-8
Pontiac 93-3-10
Oldsmobile 93-T-60
GM of Canada 93-3C-102
If the problem still exists, check system flows and pressures using gauge J 5176-D or J 25323-B.
System flow should be 1.9 gpm - 2.3 gpm, back pressure at or less than 100 psi with wheels
straight ahead and the engine at idle. If flows or pressures are out of specification, look for pinched
or crimped steering hoses and check for blockages by blowing air through the steering lines.
If problem still exists for 1992 V-6 vehicles only, evaluate vehicle for steering system induced
lead/pull by coasting with vehicle in neutral and engine off. Restart the vehicle. A steering induced
lead/pull will result in a significant, abrupt pull to the right. If this occurs, remove power steering
cooler lines from the steering system, (refer to Section 3B in the Service Manual). Use the following
hoses to connect directly from the steering gear to the pump reservoir inlet tube.
1. LHO engine (VIN T): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26038210
2. LG7 engine (VIN N): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26031205
If problem still persists on 1992 vehicles only, steering gear replacement can be attempted.
1993-94 vehicles have updated steering racks and should not require replacement for lead/pull
conditions. Also on 1993-94 vehicles, there are no cooler lines; therefore, the above by-pass hoses
do not apply. This is the latest information which should resolve any lead/pull conditions.
Parts are expected to be available on November 8, 1993.
WARRANTY INFORMATION: For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Number: T3385
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 333213 > Nov > 93 > Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull > Page
1132
Labor Time: 0.6 hr.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 07-06-01-023 > Dec > 07 > Engine - Oil
Leaks From Front Crankshaft Seal
Front Crankshaft Seal: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Oil Leaks From Front Crankshaft
Seal
Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-023
Date: December 05, 2007
TECHNICAL
Subject: 60 Degree V6 Engine Oil Leak at Crankshaft Front Oil Seal (Use New Crankshaft Front Oil
Seal Installer Tool EN-48869)
Models: 1986-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn)
with 2.8L, 3.1L, 3.4L, 3.5L or 3.9L 60 Degree V6 Engine
(VINs D, E, F, J, K, L, M, N, R, S, T, V, W, X, Z, 1, 3, 8, 9, W, R - RPOs LG6, LA1, LNJ, LG8, LL1
or LX9, L82, LL2, LB8, LHO, LG5, LB6, LE2 or LQ1, LH7, LC1, L44, LZ4, LZE, LZ9, LGD, LZ8,
LZG)
This bulletin does not apply to 2004-2007 Saturn VUE models with 3.5L DOHC V6 Engine (VIN 4 RPO L66) or 2005-2008 Cadillac CTS with 2.8L HFV6 Engine (VIN T - RPO LP1).
This bulletin only applies to 60 degree V6 engines. Some of the discontinued 60 degree V6 engine
VINs and RPOs may have carried over to other new model year engines and may no longer be a
60 degree V6 engine. So this bulletin may not apply. It is very important to verify that the
information shown is correct before using this bulletin.
If ALL the information from the vehicle (year, size, VIN Code, RPO) you're working on can be found
under the models listed above, then this bulletin applies to that engine. If one or more of the
vehicle's information can NOT be found under the models listed above, then this bulletin does NOT
apply.
Condition
Some customers may comment on external oil leakage.
Correction
Before replacement of the crankshaft front oil seal, be sure the PCV system is operating correctly.
Tools Required
TOOLS WERE SHIPPED TO YOUR DEALERSHIPS. IF YOU HAVE NOT RECEIVED THEM OR
THEY ARE LOST, PLEASE CALL GM SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS AT 1-800-GM-TOOLS.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 07-06-01-023 > Dec > 07 > Engine - Oil
Leaks From Front Crankshaft Seal > Page 1138
The EN-48869 has a unique design to allow the technician to easily install the front crankshaft seal
squarely to the correct depth and direction. Before proceeding with installation, review the
illustration to become familiar with the tool.
Removal Procedure
Remove the crankshaft balancer. Refer to Crankshaft Balancer Replacement in SI.
Use care not to damage the engine front cover or nick the crankshaft.
Remove the crankshaft front oil seal (1) using a suitable tool.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 07-06-01-023 > Dec > 07 > Engine - Oil
Leaks From Front Crankshaft Seal > Page 1139
Lubricate the inside of the crankshaft front oil seal (1) with clean engine oil. Then install the seal to
the installer body (2).
Align the oil seal and installer body (1) with the engine front cover and crankshaft.
Before installing the force screw, apply a small amount of the Extreme Pressure Lubricant J
23444-A, provided in the tool kit, to the force screw.
Install the drive nut (4) onto the threaded force screw shaft (5), washer (3), and bearing (2). Then
install to the installer body (1) and tighten the force screw to the crankshaft by hand.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 07-06-01-023 > Dec > 07 > Engine - Oil
Leaks From Front Crankshaft Seal > Page 1140
Using a wrench, turn the drive nut on the threaded force screw shaft (2), this will push the seal into
the engine front cover.
Continue to turn the drive nut (2) with the wrench until the installer body (1) is snug and flush
against the engine front cover.
Loosen and remove the drive nut from the threaded force screw shaft, washer, bearing, and
installer body. Verify that the seal has seated properly, flush against front cover flange (1).
Install the crankshaft balancer. Refer to Crankshaft Balancer Replacement in SI.
Inspect for proper fluid levels.
Inspect for leaks.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 07-06-01-023 > Dec > 07 > Engine - Oil
Leaks From Front Crankshaft Seal > Page 1141
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 07-06-01-023 > Dec > 07 > Engine - Oil
Leaks From Front Crankshaft Seal > Page 1147
The EN-48869 has a unique design to allow the technician to easily install the front crankshaft seal
squarely to the correct depth and direction. Before proceeding with installation, review the
illustration to become familiar with the tool.
Removal Procedure
Remove the crankshaft balancer. Refer to Crankshaft Balancer Replacement in SI.
Use care not to damage the engine front cover or nick the crankshaft.
Remove the crankshaft front oil seal (1) using a suitable tool.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 07-06-01-023 > Dec > 07 > Engine - Oil
Leaks From Front Crankshaft Seal > Page 1148
Lubricate the inside of the crankshaft front oil seal (1) with clean engine oil. Then install the seal to
the installer body (2).
Align the oil seal and installer body (1) with the engine front cover and crankshaft.
Before installing the force screw, apply a small amount of the Extreme Pressure Lubricant J
23444-A, provided in the tool kit, to the force screw.
Install the drive nut (4) onto the threaded force screw shaft (5), washer (3), and bearing (2). Then
install to the installer body (1) and tighten the force screw to the crankshaft by hand.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 07-06-01-023 > Dec > 07 > Engine - Oil
Leaks From Front Crankshaft Seal > Page 1149
Using a wrench, turn the drive nut on the threaded force screw shaft (2), this will push the seal into
the engine front cover.
Continue to turn the drive nut (2) with the wrench until the installer body (1) is snug and flush
against the engine front cover.
Loosen and remove the drive nut from the threaded force screw shaft, washer, bearing, and
installer body. Verify that the seal has seated properly, flush against front cover flange (1).
Install the crankshaft balancer. Refer to Crankshaft Balancer Replacement in SI.
Inspect for proper fluid levels.
Inspect for leaks.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 07-06-01-023 > Dec > 07 > Engine - Oil
Leaks From Front Crankshaft Seal > Page 1150
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Brake Fluid - Level & Filling Recommendations
Brake Fluid: Technical Service Bulletins Brake Fluid - Level & Filling Recommendations
File In Section: 05 - Brakes
Bulletin No.: 00-05-22-004
Date: May, 2000
INFORMATION
Subject: Brake Fluid Level and Filling Recommendations
Models: 2001 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
Many dealers and after-market repair shops advertise multi-point fluid "top-ups" in conjunction with
oil changes or regular maintenance packages. These offers often include adding brake fluid to the
master cylinder reservoir. There are only two reasons why the brake fluid level in the brake
reservoir might go down. The first is that the brake fluid level goes down an acceptable level during
normal brake lining wear. When the linings are replaced, the fluid will return to it's original level.
The second possible reason for a low fluid level is that fluid is leaking out of the brake system. If
fluid is leaking, the brake system requires repair and adding additional fluid will not correct the leak.
If the system was properly filled during delivery of the vehicle, no additional fluid should be required
under most circumstances between brake pad and/or shoe replacements. This information can be
reinforced with the customer by referring them to the Brake Fluid section of their vehicle's Owner's
Manual.
Guidelines
GM vehicles have incorporated a variety of brake fluid reservoir styles. The following guidelines are
restricted to the plastic bodied fluid reservoirs and do not affect the original service
recommendations for the older style metal bodied units.
You may encounter both black plastic and translucent style reservoirs. You may have reservoirs
with:
^ A MAX fill mark only
^ A MIN fill mark only
^ Both MAX and MIN marks
The translucent style reservoirs do not have to have the covers removed in order to view the fluid
level. It is a good practice not to remove the reservoir cover unless necessary to reduce the
possibility of contaminating the system. Use the following guidelines to assist in determining the
proper fluid level.
Important:
When adding brake fluid, use Delco Supreme II(R) Brake Fluid, GM P/N 12377967 or equivalent
brand bearing the DOT-3 rating only.
Important:
At no time should the fluid level be allowed to remain in an overfilled condition. Overfilling the brake
reservoir may put unnecessary stress on the seals and cover of the reservoir. Use the following
guidelines to properly maintain the fluid level. If the reservoir is overfilled, siphon out the additional
fluid to comply with the guidelines below.
Important:
If under any circumstance the brake fluid level is extremely low in the reservoir or the BRAKE
warning indicator is illuminated, the brake system should be checked for leaks and the system
repaired in addition to bringing the fluid level up to the recommended guidelines outlined below. A
leaking brake system will have reduced braking performance and will eventually not work at all.
Important:
Some vehicles have reservoirs that are very sensitive to brake fluid levels and may cause the
BRAKE indicator to flicker on turns as the fluid approaches the minimum required level. If you
encounter a vehicle with this concern, increase the fluid level staying within the guidelines outlined
below.
^ If the reservoir has a MAX level indicator, the reservoir should be returned to the MAX marking
only at the time new brake pads and/or shoes are installed. If the reservoir fluid level is at the
half-way point or above do not attempt to add additional brake fluid during routine fluid checks.
^ If the reservoir has both MAX and MIN indicators, the fluid level should be maintained above the
MIN indicator during routine fluid checks and returned to the MAX indication only after new brake
pads and/or shoes are installed.
^ For reservoirs with only a MIN indication, the fluid level should be maintained above the MIN
indicator during routine fluid checks. Return the
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Brake Fluid - Level & Filling Recommendations > Page 1156
reservoir fluid level to full only after installing new brake pads and/or shoes. A full reservoir is
indicated on translucent, snap cover reservoirs by a fluid level even with the top level of the view
window imprinted into the side of the reservoir. On screw top models in black or translucent plastic,
the full level is just below the bottom of the filler neck.
Parts Information
Part Number Description
12377967 Brake Fluid
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Page 1157
Brake Fluid: Specifications
Brake System DOT 3
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Clutch Fluid > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Clutch Fluid: Capacity Specifications
Fill the clutch master cylinder to the "Full" or "MAX" mark on the reservoir. Do not overfill.
Caution: Should accidental spillage occur, rinse the area thoroughly with water. Pay special
attention to any electrical wires, parts, harnesses, rubber or painted surfaces.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Clutch Fluid > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1162
Clutch Fluid: Fluid Type Specifications
Hydraulic Clutch Fluid
........................................................................................................................................ GM P/N
12345347 or DOT 3 Brake Fluid
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information
Bulletin No.: 00-06-02-006D
Date: August 15, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Engine Coolant Recycling and Warranty Information
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2007 and Prior
HUMMER Vehicles 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Attention:
Please address this bulletin to the Warranty Claims Administrator and the Service Manager.
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to adjust the title and Include Warranty Information. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 00-06-02-006C (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
Coolant Reimbursement Policy
General Motors supports the use of recycled engine coolant for warranty repairs/service, providing
a GM approved engine coolant recycling system is used. Recycled coolant will be reimbursed at
the GMSPO dealer price for new coolant plus the appropriate mark-up. When coolant replacement
is required during a warranty repair, it is crucial that only the relative amount of engine coolant
concentrate be charged, not the total diluted volume. In other words: if you are using two gallons of
pre-diluted (50:50) recycled engine coolant to service a vehicle, you may request reimbursement
for one gallon of GM Goodwrench engine coolant concentrate at the dealer price plus the
appropriate warranty parts handling allowance.
Licensed Approved DEX-COOL(R) Providers
Important:
USE OF NON-APPROVED VIRGIN OR RECYCLED DEX-COOL(R) OR DEVIATIONS IN THE
FORM OF ALTERNATE CHEMICALS OR ALTERATION OF EQUIPMENT, WILL VOID THE GM
ENDORSEMENT, MAY DEGRADE COOLANT SYSTEM INTEGRITY AND PLACE THE
COOLING SYSTEM WARRANTY UNDER JEOPARDY.
Shown in Table 1 are the only current licensed and approved providers of DEX-COOL(R). Products
that are advertised as "COMPATIBLE" or "RECOMMENDED" for use with DEX-COOL(R) have not
been tested or approved by General Motors. Non-approved coolants may degrade the
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information > Page 1167
coolant system integrity and will no longer be considered a 5 yr/150,000 mile (240,000 km) coolant.
Coolant Removal Services/Recycling
The tables include all coolant recycling processes currently approved by GM. Also included is a
primary phone number and demographic information. Used DEX-COOL(R) can be combined with
used conventional coolant (green) for recycling. Depending on the recycling service and/or
equipment, it is then designated as a conventional 2 yr/30,000 mile (50,000 km) coolant or
DEX-COOL(R) 5 yr/150,000 mile (240,000 km) coolant. Recycled coolants as designated in this
bulletin may be used during the vehicle(s) warranty period.
DEX-COOL(R) Recycling
The DEX-COOL(R) recycling service listed in Table 2 has been approved for recycling waste
engine coolants (DEX-COOL) or conventional) to DEX-COOL(R) with 5 yr/150,000 mile (240,000
km) usability. Recycling Fluid Technologies is the only licensed provider of Recycled
DEX-COOL(R) meeting GM6277M specifications and utilizes GM approved inhibitor packages.
This is currently a limited program being monitored by GM Service Operations which will be
expanded as demand increases.
Conventional (Green) Recycling
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information > Page 1168
Processes shown in the Table 3 are capable of recycling waste engine coolants (DEX-COOL(R) or
conventional) to a conventional (green) coolant. Recycling conventional coolant can be
accomplished at your facility by a technician using approved EQUIPMENT (listed by model number
in Table 3), or by an approved coolant recycling SERVICE which may recycle the coolant at your
facility or at an offsite operation. Refer to the table for GM approved coolant recyclers in either of
these two categories. Should you decide to recycle the coolant yourself, strict adherence to the
operating procedures is imperative. Use ONLY the inhibitor chemicals supplied by the respective
(GM approved) recycling equipment manufacturer.
Sealing Tablets
Cooling System Sealing Tablets (Seal Tabs) should not be used as a regular maintenance item
after servicing an engine cooling system. Discoloration of coolant can occur if too many seal tabs
have been inserted into the cooling system. This can occur if seal tabs are repeatedly used over
the service life of a vehicle. Where appropriate, seal tabs may be used if diagnostics fail to repair a
small leak in the cooling system. When a condition appears in which seal tabs may be
recommended, a specific bulletin will be released describing their proper usage.
Water Quality
The integrity of the coolant is dependent upon the quality of DEX-COOL(R) and water.
DEX-COOL(R) is a product that has enhanced protection capability as well as an extended service
interval. These enhanced properties may be jeopardized by combining DEX-COOL(R) with poor
quality water. If you suspect the water in your area of being poor quality, it is recommended you
use distilled or de-ionized water with DEX-COOL(R).
"Pink" DEX-COOL(R)
DEX-COOL(R) is orange in color to distinguish it from other coolants. Due to inconsistencies in the
mixing of the dyes used with DEX-COOL(R), some batches may appear pink after time. The color
shift from orange to pink does not affect the integrity of the coolant, and still maintains the 5
yr/150,000 mile (240,000 km) service interval.
Back Service
Only use DEX-COOL(R) if the vehicle was originally equipped with DEX-COOL(R).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information > Page 1169
Contamination
Mixing conventional green coolant with DEX-COOL(R) will degrade the service interval from 5
yrs./150,000 miles (240,000 km) to 2 yrs./30,000 miles (50,000 km) if left in the contaminated
condition. If contamination occurs, the cooling system must be flushed twice immediately and
re-filled with a 50/50 mixture of DEX-COOL(R) and clean water in order to preserve the enhanced
properties and extended service interval of DEX-COOL(R).
After 5 years/150,000 miles (240,000 km)
After 5 yrs/150,000 miles (240,000 km), the coolant should be changed, preferably using a coolant
exchanger. If the vehicle was originally equipped with DEX-COOL(R) and has not had problems
with contamination from non-DEX-COOL(R) coolants, then the service interval remains the same,
and the coolant does not need to be changed for another 5 yrs/150,000 miles (240,000 km)
Equipment (Coolant Exchangers)
The preferred method of performing coolant replacement is to use a coolant exchanger. A coolant
exchanger can replace virtually all of the old coolant with new coolant. Coolant exchangers can be
used to perform coolant replacement without spillage, and facilitate easy waste collection. They
can also be used to lower the coolant level in a vehicle to allow for less messy servicing of cooling
system components. It is recommended that you use a coolant exchanger with a vacuum feature
facilitates removing trapped air from the cooling system. This is a substantial time savings over
repeatedly thermo cycling the vehicle and topping-off the radiator. The vacuum feature also allows
venting of a hot system to relieve system pressure. Approved coolant exchangers are available
through the GMDE (General Motors Dealer Equipment) program.
For refilling a cooling system that has been partially or fully drained for repairs other than coolant
replacement, the Vac-N-Fill Coolant Refill Tool (GE-47716) is recommended to facilitate removal of
trapped air from the cooling system during refill.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information > Page 1170
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Coolant - Information on Back Service
File In Section: 6 - Engine
Bulletin No: 53-62-02
Date: November, 1995
Subject: DEX-COOL(TM) Engine Coolant - Information on Back service
Models: 1994-95 Passenger Cars and Trucks
A new extended-life engine coolant called DEX-COOL(TM) is currently being used in all General
Motors' vehicles (excluding Chevrolet Geo and Saturn). Refer to bulletin 53-62-01 for general
service information.
Backservice
DEX-COOL(TM) may be used in General Motors vehicles originally built with conventional (green)
coolant with the following considerations:
^ Vehicles eligible for back service are 1994 and 1995 models (excluding 1994 J Body with 4
cylinder engines).
^ The service interval for DEX-COOL(TM) introduced into an older model vehicle originally built
with "green" coolant will be 2 years/30,000 miles (50,000 Km) (not 5 years/100,000 miles (160,000
Km)).
^ All the "green" coolant must be removed from the cooling system by means of a system flush.
This may be accomplished with a water flushing device or a GMDE waterless coolant changer (use
a unit dedicated to "green" coolant, not DEX-COOL TM).
Important:
When using a GMDE waterless coolant changer, conduct the procedure twice, once with water,
and once with DEX-COOL(TM)
Backservice with DEX-COOL(TM) is advocated because of enhanced water pump seal durability
experienced with this coolant.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information > Page 1171
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Warranty - Recycled Engine Coolant Policy
Group Ref.: Warranty Administration Bulletin No.: 310504 Date: February, 1994
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
SUBJECT: RECYCLED ENGINE COOLANT POLICY
MODELS: 1994 AND PRIOR PASSENGER CARS AND TRUCKS
ATTENTION: WARRANTY CLAIMS ADMINISTRATOR AND SERVICE MANAGER
General Motors supports the use of recycled engine coolant for warranty repairs/service, providing
a GM approved engine coolant recycling system is used. For detailed information on GM approved
engine coolant recycling equipment guidelines refer to the following bulletins: Cadillac 93-1-18,
GMC Truck 93-6B-34, Chevrolet 93-73-6B, Pontiac 93-6-18, Oldsmobile 1-93-43, Buick 93-6B-1
(Corporate Number 236203).
Recycled coolant will be reimbursed at the GMSPO dealer price for new coolant plus the
appropriate mark-up. When coolant replacement is required during a warranty repair, it is crucial to
assure that only the relative amount of engine coolant concentrate be charged, not the total diluted
volume. In other words, if you are using two gallons of pre-diluted (50:50) recycled engine coolant
to service a vehicle, you may request reimbursement for one gallon of Goodwrench engine coolant
concentrate at the dealer price plus the appropriate warranty parts handling allowance.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information > Page 1172
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Coolant - Information on Propylene Glycol Usage
File In Section: 6 - Engine
Bulletin No.: 43-62-01B
Date: April, 1995
Subject: Propylene Glycol Engine Coolant
Models: 1994 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
This bulletin is being revised to reflect most current information on propylene glycol engine coolant.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 4362O1A (Group Reference 6 - Engine).
General Motors has been reviewing data supplied on the performance of propylene glycol engine
coolant in GM vehicles. It is our conclusion that propylene glycol engine coolant will perform
adequately under most vehicle operating conditions. As a result, propylene glycol engine coolant
(meeting performance specification GM 1825M) may be used in GM vehicles and will not affect the
warranty coverage.
Prior to adding propylene glycol engine coolant to the cooling system, all the existing (ethylene
glycol) coolant must be removed. This can be accomplished either by utilizing water-based coolant
flushing equipment or "waterless quick change" equipment available in the GMDE program. As with
any coolant change procedure, be sure to thoroughly purge the heater core and block as well as
the radiator before attempting to convert the system to propylene glycol coolant.
Freeze/Boil point levels are different for propylene glycol than for ethylene glycol engine coolant.
To accurately determine freeze/boil protection level, it is imperative that coolants not be mixed.
Removing all the used coolant as previously discussed resolves this concern. Freeze protection of
propylene glycol cannot be determined using a standard hydrometer. Rather, a refractometer or
test strip must be used.
Propylene glycol engine coolants may be recycled in the same manner as conventional ethylene
glycol coolant. No adverse effects will be encountered if these coolants are mixed prior to recycling,
however, the ratio of propylene glycol coolant to ethylene glycol coolant should be kept low to
minimize the effects on freeze point measurements.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 1173
Coolant: Specifications
Coolant Capacity, Qts. .........................................................................................................................
.............................................................................13.7 Radiator Cap Relief Pressure, Lbs. ................
..............................................................................................................................................................
........15 Thermo. Opening Temp. ° F ...................................................................................................
...........................................................................................195
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-037E
Date: April 07, 2011
Subject: Release of DEXRON(R)-VI Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF)
Models:
2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003-2008 HUMMER H2 2006-2008
HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saturn Relay 2005 and Prior Saturn L-Series 2005-2007 Saturn ION
2005-2008 Saturn VUE with 4T45-E 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X Except 2008 and Prior Chevrolet Aveo,
Equinox Except 2006 and Prior Chevrolet Epica Except 2007 and Prior Chevrolet Optra Except
2008 and Prior Pontiac Torrent, Vibe, Wave Except 2003-2005 Saturn ION with CVT or AF23 Only
Except 1991-2002 Saturn S-Series Except 2008 and Prior Saturn VUE with CVT, AF33 or 5AT
(MJ7/MJ8) Transmission Only Except 2008 Saturn Astra
Attention:
DEXRON(R)-VI Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF) is the only approved fluid for warranty repairs
for General Motors transmissions/transaxles requiring DEXRON(R)-III and/or prior DEXRON(R)
transmission fluids.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-037D (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
MANUAL TRANSMISSIONS / TRANSFER CASES and POWER STEERING
The content of this bulletin does not apply to manual transmissions or transfer cases. Any vehicle
that previously required DEXRON(R)-III for a manual transmission or transfer case should now use
P/N 88861800. This fluid is labeled Manual Transmission and Transfer Case Fluid. Some manual
transmissions and transfer cases require a different fluid. Appropriate references should be
checked when servicing any of these components.
Power Steering Systems should now use P/N 9985010 labeled Power Steering Fluid.
Consult the Parts Catalog, Owner's Manual, or Service Information (SI) for fluid recommendations.
Some of our customers and/or General Motors dealerships/Saturn Retailers may have some
concerns with DEXRON(R)-VI and DEXRON(R)-III Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF) and
transmission warranty claims. DEXRON(R)-VI is the only approved fluid for warranty repairs for
General Motors transmissions/transaxles requiring DEXRON(R)-III and/or prior DEXRON(R)
transmission fluids (except as noted above). Please remember that the clean oil reservoirs of the
J-45096 - Flushing and Flow Tester machine should be purged of DEXRON(R)-III and filled with
DEXRON(R)-VI for testing, flushing or filling General Motors transmissions/transaxles (except as
noted above).
DEXRON(R)-VI can be used in any proportion in past model vehicles equipped with an automatic
transmission/transaxle in place of DEXRON(R)-III (i.e. topping off the fluid in the event of a repair
or fluid change). DEXRON(R)-VI is also compatible with any former version of DEXRON(R) for use
in automatic transmissions/transaxles.
DEXRON(R)-VI ATF
General Motors Powertrain has upgraded to DEXRON(R)-VI ATF with the start of 2006 vehicle
production.
Current and prior automatic transmission models that had used DEXRON(R)-III must now only use
DEXRON(R)-VI.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 1178
All 2006 and future model transmissions that use DEXRON(R)-VI are to be serviced ONLY with
DEXRON(R)-VI fluid.
DEXRON(R)-VI is an improvement over DEXRON(R)-III in the following areas:
* These ATF change intervals remain the same as DEXRON(R)-III for the time being.
2006-2008 Transmission Fill and Cooler Flushing
Some new applications of the 6L80 six speed transmission will require the use of the J 45096 Flushing and Flow Tester to accomplish transmission fluid fill. The clean oil reservoir of the
machine should be purged of DEXRON(R)-III and filled with DEXRON(R)-VI.
Parts Information
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 1179
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Water Or Coolant Contamination Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-07-30-035B
Date: November 01, 2010
Subject: Information on Water or Ethylene Glycol in Transmission Fluid
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks with Automatic Transmission
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-07-30-035A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Water or ethylene glycol in automatic transmission fluid (ATF) is harmful to internal transmission
components and will have a negative effect on reliability and durability of these parts. Water or
ethylene glycol in ATF will also change the friction of the clutches, frequently resulting in shudder
during engagement or gear changes, especially during torque converter clutch engagement.
Indications of water in the ATF may include:
- ATF blowing out of the transmission vent tube.
- ATF may appear cloudy or, in cases of extreme contamination, have the appearance of a
strawberry milkshake.
- Visible water in the oil pan.
- A milky white substance inside the pan area.
- Spacer plate gaskets that appear to be glued to the valve body face or case.
- Spacer plate gaskets that appear to be swollen or wrinkled in areas where they are not
compressed.
- Rust on internal transmission iron/steel components.
If water in the ATF has been found and the source of the water entry has not been identified, or if a
leaking in-radiator transmission oil cooler is suspected (with no evidence of cross-contamination in
the coolant recovery reservoir), a simple and quick test kit is available that detects the presence of
ethylene glycol in ATF. The "Gly-Tek" test kit, available from the Nelco Company, should be
obtained and the ATF tested to make an accurate decision on the need for radiator replacement.
This can help to prevent customer comebacks if the in-radiator transmission oil cooler is leaking
and reduce repair expenses by avoiding radiator replacement if the cooler is not leaking. These
test kits can be obtained from:
Nelco Company
Test kits can be ordered by phone or through the website listed above. Orders are shipped
standard delivery time but can be shipped on a next day delivery basis for an extra charge. One
test kit will complete 10 individual fluid sample tests. For vehicles repaired under warranty, the cost
of the complete test kit plus shipping charges should be divided by 10 and submitted on the
warranty claim as a net item.
The transmission should be repaired or replaced based on the normal cost comparison procedure.
Important If water or coolant is found in the transmission, the following components MUST be
replaced.
- Replace all of the rubber-type seals.
- Replace all of the composition-faced clutch plates and/or bands.
- Replace all of the nylon parts.
- Replace the torque converter.
- Thoroughly clean and rebuild the transmission, using new gaskets and oil filter.
Important The following steps must be completed when repairing or replacing.
Flush and flow check the transmission oil cooler using J 45096. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
02-07-30-052F- Automatic Transmission Oil Cooler Flush and Flow Test Essential Tool J 45096
TransFlow.
- Thoroughly inspect the engine cooling system and hoses and clean/repair as necessary.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 1180
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 1181
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - DEXRON III Fluid Introduction
File In Section: 0 - General Information
Bulletin No.: 57-02-01
Date: March, 1995
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
Subject: Section 0 - General Information - DEXRON(R)-III Transmission Fluid Introduction
Models: 1995 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
General Motors has phased in a new automatic transmission fluid, DEXRON(R)-III, that does not
need replacing under normal service. DEXRON(R)-III is designed to help the transmission deliver
the best possible performance under all conditions. Refer to Figure 1.
The improvements in DEXRON(R)-III include better friction stability, more high temperature
oxidation stability and better material compatibility. DEXRON(R)-III has the same low temperature
fluidity as DEXRON(R)-IIE, for better transmission performance in cold weather.
DEXRON(R)-IIE and DEXRON(R)-III are fully compatible.
DEXRON(R)-III is fully compatible with any General Motors passenger vehicle or light truck with
automatic transmission and built since 1949.
Dealers should require their supplier to include the DEXRON(R)-III license number on all automatic
transmission fluid invoices.
Starting February 1, 1994 DEXRON(R)-III was phased into all North American assembly plants.
DEXRON(R)-III fluid is available from GMSPO (see fluid numbers below):
U.S.
1 Quart 12346143
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 1182
1 Gallon 12346144
55 Gallon 12346145
In Canada
1 Liter 10952622
4 Liter 10952623
200 Liter 10952624
The 1995 Automatic Transmission/Transaxle fluid change intervals are the following:
(1994 and prior should use the schedules as written in the Owner's Manual.)
If the vehicle is mainly driven under one or more of these conditions:
In heavy city traffic where the outside temperature regularly reaches 90°F (32°C) or higher.
In hilly or mountainous terrain.
When doing frequent trailer towing.
Uses such as found in taxi, police car or delivery service.
Change the fluid and filter every 50,000 miles (63,000 km).
If the vehicle is not used mainly under any of these conditions, the fluid and filter do not require
periodic changing for vehicles under 8,600 GVWR.
Vehicles over 8,600 GVWR change the fluid and filter every 50,000 miles (83,000 km) regardless
of driving conditions.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
CAPACITIES .......................................................................................................................................
................................................................ QUARTS
Pan Capacity .......................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 4.0 Total (Overhaul) Capacity Without Torque
Converter .............................................................................................................................................
................................................. 7.0 With Torque Converter ................................................................
................................................................................................................................... 9.0
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1185
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Fluid Type ............................................................................................................................................
................................................................ Dexron IIE
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1186
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair
NOTE: Use only Dexron IIE automatic transmission fluid
To check fluid, drive vehicle for at least 15 minutes to bring fluid to operating temperature (200°F).
With vehicle on a level surface and engine idling in Park and parking brake applied, the level on the
dipstick should be at the ``Full'' mark. To bring the fluid level from the ADD mark to the FULL mark
requires one pint of fluid. If vehicle cannot be driven sufficiently to bring fluid to operating
temperature, the level on the dipstick should be between the two dimples on the dipstick with fluid
temperature at 70°F. Note that the two dimples are located above the FULL mark. If additional fluid
is required, use only Dexron II automatic transmission fluid. An early change to a darker color from
the usual red color and or a strong odor that is usually associated with overheated fluid is normal
and should not be considered as a positive sign of required maintenance or unit failure. When
adding fluid, do not overfill, as foaming and loss of fluid through the vent may occur as the fluid
heats up. Also, if fluid level is too low, complete loss of drive may occur especially when cold,
which can cause transmission failure. Every 100,000 miles, the oil should be drained, the oil pan
removed, the screen cleaned and fresh fluid added. For vehicles subjected to more severe use
such as heavy city traffic especially in hot weather, prolonged periods of idling or towing, this
maintenance should be performed every 15,000 miles.
1. Raise and support vehicle, then position drain pan under oil pan.
2. Remove front and side oil pan attaching bolts, then loosen rear pan attaching bolts.
3. Carefully pry oil pan loose from transaxle case and allow fluid to drain.
4. Remove remaining attaching bolt, oil pan and gasket. Thoroughly clean pan before reinstalling.
5. Remove and discard screen and O-ring seal.
6. Install replacement screen and O-ring seal, locating screen against dipstick stop.
7. Install gasket on oil pan, then install pan and torque attaching bolts to 8 ft. lbs.
8. Lower vehicle and add approximately 4 qts. of fluid.
9. With selector in park, parking brake applied and engine at idle speed and operating temperature,
check fluid level and add fluid as necessary. Do
not race engine. Move shift lever through ranges, then back to ``Park'' position.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Fluid - M/T: Capacity Specifications
NVG-T550 5 Speed Manual Transaxle Fluid Capacity Approx. 2.0 liters 2.1 quarts
Isuzu 76mm 5 Speed Manual Transaxle Fluid Capacity Approx. 1.9 Liters 2.0 Quarts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1191
Fluid - M/T: Fluid Type Specifications
NVG-T550 5 Speed Manual Transaxle Fluid Type Synchromesh Transmission Fluid (GM Part No
12345349) or equivalent.
Isuzu 76mm 5 Speed Manual Transaxle Fluid Type Synchromesh Transmission Fluid (GM Part No
12345349) or equivalent.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > With
Isuzu 76mm 5 Speed Manual Transaxle
Fluid - M/T: Service and Repair With Isuzu 76mm 5 Speed Manual Transaxle
FLUID LEVEL
INSPECT
^ Fluid level only when the engine is "OFF", the vehicle is level and the transaxle is cold. To check
the fluid level, remove and read the fluid level indicator. If it indicates "Add" or below, use
synchromesh transaxle fluid GM P/N 12345349 or equivalent lubricant to fill transaxle to the "Full"
level.
IMPORTANT: The fluid level indicator must be fully seated during vehicle operation or leakage will
occur at the vent plug.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Fluid - M/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > With
Isuzu 76mm 5 Speed Manual Transaxle > Page 1194
Fluid - M/T: Service and Repair With NVG-T550 5 Speed Manual Transaxle
FLUID LEVEL
INSPECT
^ Fluid level only when the engine is "OFF", the vehicle is level and the transaxle is cold. To check
the fluid level, remove and read the fluid level indicator. If it indicates "Add" or below, use
synchromesh transaxle fluid GM P/N 12345349 or equivalent lubricant to fill transaxle to the "Full"
level.
IMPORTANT: The fluid level indicator must be fully seated during vehicle operation or leakage will
occur at the vent plug.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications
Engine Oil: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 11-00-90-001
Date: March 14, 2011
Subject: Global Information for GM dexos1(TM) and GM dexos2(TM) Engine Oil Specifications for
Spark Ignited and Diesel Engines, Available Licensed Brands, and Service Fill for Adding or
Complete Oil Change
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Excluding All Vehicles Equipped with
Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines
GM dexos 1(TM) Information Center Website
Refer to the following General Motors website for dexos 1(TM) information about the different
licensed brands that are currently available: http://www.gmdexos.com
GM dexos 1(TM) Engine Oil Trademark and Icons
The dexos(TM) specification and trademarks are exclusive to General Motors, LLC.
Only those oils displaying the dexos‹›(TM) trademark and icon on the front label meet the
demanding performance requirements and stringent quality standards set forth in the dexos‹›(TM)
specification.
Look on the front label for any of the logos shown above to identify an authorized, licensed dexos
1(TM) engine oil.
GM dexos 1(TM) Engine Oil Specification
Important General Motors dexos 1(TM) engine oil specification replaces the previous General
Motors specifications GM6094M, GM4718M and GM-LL-A-025 for most GM gasoline engines. The
oil specified for use in GM passenger cars and trucks, PRIOR to the 2011 model year remains
acceptable for those previous vehicles. However, dexos 1(TM) is backward compatible and can be
used in those older vehicles.
In North America, starting with the 2011 model year, GM introduced dexos 1(TM) certified engine
oil as a factory fill and service fill for gasoline engines. The reasons for the new engine oil
specification are as follows:
- To meet environmental goals such as increasing fuel efficiency and reducing engine emissions.
- To promote long engine life.
- To minimize the number of engine oil changes in order to help meet the goal of lessening the
industry's overall dependence on crude oil.
dexos 1(TM) is a GM-developed engine oil specification that has been designed to provide the
following benefits:
- Further improve fuel economy, to meet future corporate average fuel economy (CAFE)
requirements and fuel economy retention by allowing the oil to maintain its fuel economy benefits
throughout the life of the oil.
- More robust formulations for added engine protection and aeration performance.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications > Page 1199
- Support the GM Oil Life System, thereby minimizing the replacement of engine oil, before its life
has been depleted.
- Reduce the duplication of requirements for a large number of internal GM engine oil
specifications.
International Lubricants Standardization and Approval Committee (ILSAC)
GF-5 Standard
In addition to GM dexos 1(TM), a new International Lubricants Standardization and Approval
Committee (ILSAC) standard called GF-5, was introduced in October 2010.
- There will be a corresponding API category, called: SN Resource Conserving. The current GF-4
standard was put in place in 2004 and will become obsolete in October 2011. Similar to dexos
1(TM), the GF-5 standard will use a new fuel economy test, Sequence VID, which demands a
statistically significant increase in fuel economy versus the Sequence VIB test that was used for
GF-4.
- It is expected that all dexos 1(TM) approved oils will be capable of meeting the GF-5 standard.
However, not all GF-5 engine oils will be capable of meeting the dexos 1(TM) specification.
- Like dexos(TM), the new ILSAC GF-5 standard will call for more sophisticated additives. The API
will begin licensing marketers during October 2010, to produce and distribute GF-5 certified
products, which are expected to include SAE 0W-20, 0W-30, 5W-20, 5W-30 and 10W-30 oils.
Corporate Average Fuel Economy (CAFE) Requirements Effect on Fuel Economy
Since CAFE standards were first introduced in 1974, the fuel economy of cars has more than
doubled, while the fuel economy of light trucks has increased by more than 50 percent. Proposed
CAFE standards call for a continuation of increased fuel economy in new cars and trucks. To meet
these future requirements, all aspects of vehicle operation are being looked at more critically than
ever before.
New technology being introduced in GM vehicles designed to increase vehicle efficiency and fuel
economy include direct injection, cam phasing, turbocharging and active fuel management (AFM).
The demands of these new technologies on engine oil also are taken into consideration when
determining new oil specifications. AFM for example can help to achieve improved fuel economy.
However alternately deactivating and activating the cylinders by not allowing the intake and
exhaust valves to open contributes to additional stress on the engine oil.
Another industry trend for meeting tough fuel economy mandates has been a shift toward lower
viscosity oils.
dexos 1(TM) will eventually be offered in several viscosity grades in accordance with engine needs:
SAE 0W-20, 5W-20, 0W-30 and 5W-30.
Using the right viscosity grade oil is critical for proper engine performance. Always refer to the
Maintenance section of a vehicle Owner Manual for the proper viscosity grade for the engine being
serviced.
GM Oil Life System in Conjunction With dexos (TM) Supports Extended Oil Change Intervals
To help conserve oil while maintaining engine protection, many GM vehicles are equipped with the
GM Oil Life System. This system can provide oil change intervals that exceed the traditional 3,000
mile (4,830 km) recommendation.
The dexos (TM) specification, with its requirements for improved oil robustness, compliments the
GM Oil Life System by supporting extended oil change intervals over the lifetime of a vehicle.
If all GM customers with GM Oil Life System equipped vehicles would use the system as intended,
GM estimates that more than 100 million gallons of oil could be saved annually.
GM dexos 2(TM) Information Center Website
Refer to the following General Motors website for dexos 2(TM) information about the different
licensed brands that are currently available: http://www.gmdexos.com
GM dexos 2(TM) Engine Oil Trademark and Icons
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications > Page 1200
The dexos (TM) specification and trademarks are exclusive to General Motors, LLC.
Only those oils displaying the dexos (TM) trademark and icon on the front label meet the
demanding performance requirements and stringent quality standards set forth in the dexos
(TM)specification.
Look on the front label for any of the logos shown above to identify an authorized, licensed dexos
2(TM) engine oil.
GM dexos 2(TM) Engine Oil Specification
- dexos 2(TM) is approved and recommended by GM for use in Europe starting in model year 2010
vehicles, regardless of where the vehicle was manufactured.
- dexos 2(TM) is the recommended service fill oil for European gasoline engines.
Important The Duramax(TM) diesel engine is the exception and requires lubricants meeting
specification CJ-4.
- dexos 2(TM) is the recommended service fill oil for European light-duty diesel engines and
replaces GM-LL-B-025 and GM-LL-A-025.
- dexos 2(TM) protects diesel engines from harmful soot deposits and is designed with limits on
certain chemical components to prolong catalyst life and protect expensive emission reduction
systems. It is a robust oil, resisting degradation between oil changes and maintaining optimum
performance longer.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Engine Oil > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
Engine .................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................3.1L Coolant Capacity, Qts. ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.....13.7 Radiator Cap Relief Pressure, Lbs. ........................................................................................
..............................................................................................15 Thermo. Opening Temp. ° F..............
..............................................................................................................................................................
...................195 Fuel Tank Gals. .........................................................................................................
........................................................................................................15.2 Engine Oil Refill Qts. [02] ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
...................................4 Transaxle Oil
Manual Pts. ..........................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................4 Automatic Qts. ....................................................
...................................................................................................................................................[01]
[04]
[01] -- Approximate, make final check w/dipstick. [02] -- When changing engine oil filter additional
oil is required. [04] -- Oil pan only, 4 qts.; complete overhaul, 7 qts. dry, 9 qts.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Fluid: > 033206 > Mar > 94 > P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold
Power Steering Fluid: Customer Interest P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold
Group Ref.: Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 033206
Date: March 1994
SUBJECT: REDUCED POWER STEERING ASSIST AT LOW AMBIENT TEMPERATURES (NEW
POWER STEERING FLUID)
MODELS: 1994 AND PRIOR PASSENGER CARS AND LIGHT DUTY TRUCKS
Applications:
Appropriate for all passenger vehicles, but particularly beneficial in 1980 and later FWD Models
equipped with Power Rack and Pinion Steering.
CONDITION:
Comments of reduced power steering assist at low ambient temperatures (approximately 10°F and
lower) may be noted by some vehicle operators when turning the steering wheel in BOTH the right
and left direction during warm-up after cold start. All vehicles with power steering exhibit this
condition to varying degrees, but condition may be more noticeable with power rack and pinion
steering systems that typically have longer hoses and cooler lines.
Note:
This condition, which is related to power steering fluid viscosity, should not, however, be confused
with conditions having similar symptoms such as that described divisional Special Policy numbers
listed:
CAUSE:
In cold weather, power steering fluid thickens in the same manner as any other petroleum-based oil
or fluid. Upon cold starting, the fluid resists movement through the system and the driver senses
reduced power assist (sometimes referred to as "stiff steer"). As the vehicle operates and fluid
circulates through the power steering system, the fluid warms and thins to its normal operating
viscosity.
CORRECTION: Saginaw Division has developed a new Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid for
use in cold climates. Compared with conventional power steering fluid, this new fluid flows better at
low temperatures and resists the thickening which contributes to reduced power assist upon start
up.
RACK AND PINION STEERING SYSTEMS Reduced power assist upon cold weather starting may
be more noticeable in Power Rack and Pinion steering systems that may contain six or more feet of
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Fluid: > 033206 > Mar > 94 > P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold > Page
1211
pressure and return hose along with long cooler lines. Such long systems contain greater volumes
of fluid and vehicles so equipped tend to have longer periods of reduced power assist. The new
fluid performs particularly well with current designed Rack and Pinion steering systems and special
remanufactured Rack and Pinion Steering Assemblies.
PARTS INFORMATION:
Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid is available from GMSPO. Order as:
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
SERVICE PROCEDURE: The power steering fluid replacement procedure is a two-stage process:
first, flushing the old fluid from the system with new fluid; and second, bleeding the system to
remove any trapped air. The two sequences outline the steps in each procedure.
FLUSHING THE POWER STEERING SYSTEM 1.
Raise the front end of the vehicle off the ground until the wheels are free to turn.
2. Remove the fluid return line at the pump reservoir inlet connector.
3. Plug the inlet connector port on the pump reservoir.
4. Position the fluid return line toward a large container in order to catch the draining fluid.
5. While a second person fills the reservoir with new Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid, start
and run the engine at idle.
6. Turn the steering wheel from stop to stop.
NOTICE:
Do not hold the wheel against stops while flushing the system, Holding steering wheel against
wheel stops will cause high system pressure, overheating, and damage to the pump and/or gear.
7. Continue draining until all of the old fluid is cleared from the power steering system. Addition of
approximately 1 quart of new fluid will be required to flush system.
8. Unplug pump reservoir inlet and reconnect return line.
9. Turn engine off, and fill reservoir to the "Full Cold" mark.
10. Continue with following procedure "Bleeding the Power Steering System".
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Fluid: > 033206 > Mar > 94 > P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold > Page
1212
BLEEDING THE POWER STEERING SYSTEM After replacing the fluid or servicing the power
steering hydraulic system, you must bleed air from the system. Air in the system prevents an
accurate fluid level reading, causes pump cavitation noise and over time could damage the pump.
To bleed the power steering system proceed as follows:
1. Begin with the engine off, front wheels off the ground, and wheels turned all the way to the left.
2. Add Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid to the "FULL COLD" mark on the fluid level
indicator.
3. Bleed the system by turning the wheels from side to side without hitting stops.
Important:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Fluid: > 033206 > Mar > 94 > P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold > Page
1213
This may require turning the wheels from side to side twenty times. On systems with long return
lines or fluid coolers, turning steering wheel lock-to-lock forty times may be required. Keep the fluid
level at the "FULL COLD" mark. Fluid with air In it has a light tan appearance. This air must be
eliminated from the fluid before normal steering action can be obtained.
4. Start the engine. With the engine idling, recheck the fluid level. If necessary, add fluid to bring
the level to the "FULL COLD" mark.
5. Return the wheels to the center position. Lower front wheels to the ground. Continue running the
engine for two or three minutes.
6. Test the vehicle to be sure the steering functions normally and is free from noise.
Important:
Inspect for fluid leakage at connection points along the power steering system.
7. Recheck the fluid level as described in Steps 3 and 4 except that the fluid level should now be
up to the "FULL HOT" mark after the system has stabilized at its normal operating temperature.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 033206 > Mar > 94 > P/S - Reduced Assist When
Cold
Power Steering Fluid: All Technical Service Bulletins P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold
Group Ref.: Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 033206
Date: March 1994
SUBJECT: REDUCED POWER STEERING ASSIST AT LOW AMBIENT TEMPERATURES (NEW
POWER STEERING FLUID)
MODELS: 1994 AND PRIOR PASSENGER CARS AND LIGHT DUTY TRUCKS
Applications:
Appropriate for all passenger vehicles, but particularly beneficial in 1980 and later FWD Models
equipped with Power Rack and Pinion Steering.
CONDITION:
Comments of reduced power steering assist at low ambient temperatures (approximately 10°F and
lower) may be noted by some vehicle operators when turning the steering wheel in BOTH the right
and left direction during warm-up after cold start. All vehicles with power steering exhibit this
condition to varying degrees, but condition may be more noticeable with power rack and pinion
steering systems that typically have longer hoses and cooler lines.
Note:
This condition, which is related to power steering fluid viscosity, should not, however, be confused
with conditions having similar symptoms such as that described divisional Special Policy numbers
listed:
CAUSE:
In cold weather, power steering fluid thickens in the same manner as any other petroleum-based oil
or fluid. Upon cold starting, the fluid resists movement through the system and the driver senses
reduced power assist (sometimes referred to as "stiff steer"). As the vehicle operates and fluid
circulates through the power steering system, the fluid warms and thins to its normal operating
viscosity.
CORRECTION: Saginaw Division has developed a new Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid for
use in cold climates. Compared with conventional power steering fluid, this new fluid flows better at
low temperatures and resists the thickening which contributes to reduced power assist upon start
up.
RACK AND PINION STEERING SYSTEMS Reduced power assist upon cold weather starting may
be more noticeable in Power Rack and Pinion steering systems that may contain six or more feet of
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 033206 > Mar > 94 > P/S - Reduced Assist When
Cold > Page 1219
pressure and return hose along with long cooler lines. Such long systems contain greater volumes
of fluid and vehicles so equipped tend to have longer periods of reduced power assist. The new
fluid performs particularly well with current designed Rack and Pinion steering systems and special
remanufactured Rack and Pinion Steering Assemblies.
PARTS INFORMATION:
Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid is available from GMSPO. Order as:
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
SERVICE PROCEDURE: The power steering fluid replacement procedure is a two-stage process:
first, flushing the old fluid from the system with new fluid; and second, bleeding the system to
remove any trapped air. The two sequences outline the steps in each procedure.
FLUSHING THE POWER STEERING SYSTEM 1.
Raise the front end of the vehicle off the ground until the wheels are free to turn.
2. Remove the fluid return line at the pump reservoir inlet connector.
3. Plug the inlet connector port on the pump reservoir.
4. Position the fluid return line toward a large container in order to catch the draining fluid.
5. While a second person fills the reservoir with new Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid, start
and run the engine at idle.
6. Turn the steering wheel from stop to stop.
NOTICE:
Do not hold the wheel against stops while flushing the system, Holding steering wheel against
wheel stops will cause high system pressure, overheating, and damage to the pump and/or gear.
7. Continue draining until all of the old fluid is cleared from the power steering system. Addition of
approximately 1 quart of new fluid will be required to flush system.
8. Unplug pump reservoir inlet and reconnect return line.
9. Turn engine off, and fill reservoir to the "Full Cold" mark.
10. Continue with following procedure "Bleeding the Power Steering System".
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 033206 > Mar > 94 > P/S - Reduced Assist When
Cold > Page 1220
BLEEDING THE POWER STEERING SYSTEM After replacing the fluid or servicing the power
steering hydraulic system, you must bleed air from the system. Air in the system prevents an
accurate fluid level reading, causes pump cavitation noise and over time could damage the pump.
To bleed the power steering system proceed as follows:
1. Begin with the engine off, front wheels off the ground, and wheels turned all the way to the left.
2. Add Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid to the "FULL COLD" mark on the fluid level
indicator.
3. Bleed the system by turning the wheels from side to side without hitting stops.
Important:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Power Steering Fluid > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 033206 > Mar > 94 > P/S - Reduced Assist When
Cold > Page 1221
This may require turning the wheels from side to side twenty times. On systems with long return
lines or fluid coolers, turning steering wheel lock-to-lock forty times may be required. Keep the fluid
level at the "FULL COLD" mark. Fluid with air In it has a light tan appearance. This air must be
eliminated from the fluid before normal steering action can be obtained.
4. Start the engine. With the engine idling, recheck the fluid level. If necessary, add fluid to bring
the level to the "FULL COLD" mark.
5. Return the wheels to the center position. Lower front wheels to the ground. Continue running the
engine for two or three minutes.
6. Test the vehicle to be sure the steering functions normally and is free from noise.
Important:
Inspect for fluid leakage at connection points along the power steering system.
7. Recheck the fluid level as described in Steps 3 and 4 except that the fluid level should now be
up to the "FULL HOT" mark after the system has stabilized at its normal operating temperature.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling/Equipment
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling/Equipment
Bulletin No.: 08-01-38-001
Date: January 25, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Information On New GE-48800 CoolTech Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2008 and
Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
Attention:
This bulletin is being issued to announce the release of GM approved Air Conditioning (A/C)
Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging Equipment that meets the new Society of Automotive
Engineers (SAE) J2788 Refrigerant Recovery Standards. The ACR2000 (J-43600) cannot be
manufactured in its current state after December 2007 and will be superseded by GE-48800.
The new J2788 standard does not require that GM Dealers replace their ACR2000 units.
ACR2000's currently in use are very capable of servicing today's refrigerant systems when used
correctly and can continue to be used. Details regarding the new SAE J2788 standard are outlined
in GM Bulletin 07-01-38-004.
Effective February 1 2008, new A/C Refrigerant Recovery/Recharging equipment (P/N GE-48800)
will be released as a required replacement for the previously essential ACR2000 (J-43600). This
equipment is SAE J2788 compliant and meets GM requirements for A/C Refrigerant System
Repairs on all General Motors vehicles, including Hybrid systems with Polyolester (POE)
refrigerant oil. This equipment will not be shipped as an essential tool to GM Dealerships.
In addition, this equipment is Hybrid compliant and designed to prevent oil cross contamination
when servicing Hybrid vehicles with Electric A/C Compressors that use POE refrigerant oil.
The ACR2000 (J-43600) will need to be retrofitted with a J-43600-50 (Hose - ACR2000 Oil Flush
Loop) to be able to perform Hybrid A/C service work. All Hybrid dealers will receive the J-43600-50,
with installation instructions, as a component of the Hybrid essential tool package. Dealerships that
do not sell Hybrids, but may need to service Hybrids, can obtain J-43600-50 from SPX Kent Moore.
Refer to GM Bulletin 08-01-39-001 for the ACR2000 Hose Flush procedure.
The High Voltage (HV) electric A/C compressor used on Two Mode Hybrid vehicles uses a
Polyolester (POE) refrigerant oil instead of a Polyalkylene Glycol (PAG) synthetic refrigerant oil.
This is due to the better electrical resistance of the POE oil and its ability to provide HV isolation.
Failure to flush the hoses before adding refrigerant to a Hybrid vehicle with an electric A/C
compressor may result in an unacceptable amount of PAG oil entering the refrigerant system. It
may cause a Battery Energy Control Module Hybrid Battery Voltage System Isolation Lost
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC P1AE7) to be set. Additionally, the A/C system warranty will be
voided.
Warranty Submission Requirements
The Electronically Generated Repair Data (snapshot summary) and printer functions have been
eliminated from the GE-48800. The VGA display and temperature probes were eliminated to
reduce equipment costs. As a result, effective immediately the 18 digit "Snapshot/Charge
Summary" code is no longer required for Air Conditioning (A/C) refrigerant system repairs that are
submitted for warranty reimbursement. The charge summary data from before and after system
repairs will continue to required, but documented on the repair order only. Both high and low
pressures and the recovery and charge amounts should be noted during the repair and entered on
the repair order. If using ACR2000 (J-43600), the "Snapshot/Charge Summary" printouts should
continue to be attached to the shops copy of the repair order.
The labor codes that are affected by this requirement are D3000 through D4500.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 08-01-38-001 > Jan > 08 > A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling/Equipment
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling/Equipment
Bulletin No.: 08-01-38-001
Date: January 25, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Information On New GE-48800 CoolTech Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2008 and
Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
Attention:
This bulletin is being issued to announce the release of GM approved Air Conditioning (A/C)
Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging Equipment that meets the new Society of Automotive
Engineers (SAE) J2788 Refrigerant Recovery Standards. The ACR2000 (J-43600) cannot be
manufactured in its current state after December 2007 and will be superseded by GE-48800.
The new J2788 standard does not require that GM Dealers replace their ACR2000 units.
ACR2000's currently in use are very capable of servicing today's refrigerant systems when used
correctly and can continue to be used. Details regarding the new SAE J2788 standard are outlined
in GM Bulletin 07-01-38-004.
Effective February 1 2008, new A/C Refrigerant Recovery/Recharging equipment (P/N GE-48800)
will be released as a required replacement for the previously essential ACR2000 (J-43600). This
equipment is SAE J2788 compliant and meets GM requirements for A/C Refrigerant System
Repairs on all General Motors vehicles, including Hybrid systems with Polyolester (POE)
refrigerant oil. This equipment will not be shipped as an essential tool to GM Dealerships.
In addition, this equipment is Hybrid compliant and designed to prevent oil cross contamination
when servicing Hybrid vehicles with Electric A/C Compressors that use POE refrigerant oil.
The ACR2000 (J-43600) will need to be retrofitted with a J-43600-50 (Hose - ACR2000 Oil Flush
Loop) to be able to perform Hybrid A/C service work. All Hybrid dealers will receive the J-43600-50,
with installation instructions, as a component of the Hybrid essential tool package. Dealerships that
do not sell Hybrids, but may need to service Hybrids, can obtain J-43600-50 from SPX Kent Moore.
Refer to GM Bulletin 08-01-39-001 for the ACR2000 Hose Flush procedure.
The High Voltage (HV) electric A/C compressor used on Two Mode Hybrid vehicles uses a
Polyolester (POE) refrigerant oil instead of a Polyalkylene Glycol (PAG) synthetic refrigerant oil.
This is due to the better electrical resistance of the POE oil and its ability to provide HV isolation.
Failure to flush the hoses before adding refrigerant to a Hybrid vehicle with an electric A/C
compressor may result in an unacceptable amount of PAG oil entering the refrigerant system. It
may cause a Battery Energy Control Module Hybrid Battery Voltage System Isolation Lost
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC P1AE7) to be set. Additionally, the A/C system warranty will be
voided.
Warranty Submission Requirements
The Electronically Generated Repair Data (snapshot summary) and printer functions have been
eliminated from the GE-48800. The VGA display and temperature probes were eliminated to
reduce equipment costs. As a result, effective immediately the 18 digit "Snapshot/Charge
Summary" code is no longer required for Air Conditioning (A/C) refrigerant system repairs that are
submitted for warranty reimbursement. The charge summary data from before and after system
repairs will continue to required, but documented on the repair order only. Both high and low
pressures and the recovery and charge amounts should be noted during the repair and entered on
the repair order. If using ACR2000 (J-43600), the "Snapshot/Charge Summary" printouts should
continue to be attached to the shops copy of the repair order.
The labor codes that are affected by this requirement are D3000 through D4500.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 06-01-39-007 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Contaminated R134A Refrigerant
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Contaminated R134A Refrigerant
Bulletin No.: 06-01-39-007
Date: July 25, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Contaminated R134a Refrigerant Found on Market for Automotive Air-Conditioning
Systems
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2007 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2007 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Attention:
This bulletin should be directed to the Service Manager as well as the Parts Manager.
Commercially Available Contaminated R134a Refrigerant
Impurities have been found in new commercially available containers of R134a. High levels of
contaminates may cause decreased performance, and be detrimental to some air-conditioning
components. Accompanying these contaminates has been high levels of moisture.
Tip:
Excessive moisture may cause system concerns such as orifice tube freeze-up and reduced
performance.
Industry Reaction: New Industry Purity Standards
Due to the potential availability of these lower quality refrigerants, the Society of Automotive
Engineers (SAE), and the Air Conditioning and Refrigeration Industry (ARI) are in the process of
instituting reliable standards that will be carried on the labels of future R134a refrigerant containers.
This identifying symbol will be your assurance of a product that conforms to the minimum standard
for OEM Automotive Air-Conditioning use.
How Can You Protect Yourself Today?
It is recommended to use GM or ACDelco(R) sourced refrigerants for all A/C repair work. These
refrigerants meet General Motors own internal standards for quality and purity, insuring that your
completed repairs are as good as the way it left the factory.
Parts Information
The part numbers shown are available through GMSPO or ACDelco(R). The nearest ACDelco(R)
distributor in your area can be found by calling 1-800-223-3526 (U.S. Only).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 06-01-39-007 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Contaminated R134A Refrigerant > Page
1235
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-38-006A > May > 00 > A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge
Equipment
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
File In Section: 01 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 99-01-38-006A
Date: May, 2000
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
Subject: J-43600 ACR 2000 Essential Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
Models: 1993-2000 Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks with R-134a Refrigerant
This bulletin is being revised to change the effective date and to update the text. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 99-01-38-006 (Section 01 - HVAC).
Effective June 1, 2000, the use of J-43600 ACR 2000 will be required on all repairs that require A/C
system recovery and are reimbursable by GM. Additionally, GM highly recommends that J-43600
ACR 2000 be used on all GM cars and trucks for customer paid A/C repairs.
Important:
Also effective June 1, 2000, the "Add" time for all air conditioning recovery is revised to 0.5 hours
for front systems and 0.7 hours for front/rear dual systems (RPO C69 or C34). After June 1, 2000,
all air conditioning claims submitted with the 0.9 hours "Add" time will be rejected for "labor hours
excessive".
After the completion of repairs (charging), the ACR 2000 will prompt the user to perform a snapshot
of the air conditioning system operating data. The snapshot includes:
^ Maximum high side pressure.
^ Minimum low side pressure.
^ Duct outlet temperatures (2).
^ Refrigerant purity information.
This information is captured on a paper printout and in a warranty code.
For all GM paid repairs, the paper printout should be attached to the shop copy of the repair order.
The warranty code must be submitted in the warranty claim information in the comments field. The
code enables the reporting of valuable information about the repair to GM for product quality
improvement. Claims submitted without this information may be subject to review and subsequent
debit.
The required use of J-43600 ACR 2000 raises the question of the acceptable uses for any existing
recovery/recycle equipment that GM dealers are currently using. GM recognizes that many of the
previously essential ACR4's are reaching the end of their useful life. There are several alternatives
for existing equipment that may be considered:
^ Use the existing equipment as customer paid recovery only equipment. Example: Collision repair
area.
^ Use the existing equipment as a scavenger unit for contaminated A/C systems.
^ Sell the existing units to repair facilities outside the GM dealer network.
^ Discontinue the use of the existing units if the repair/maintenance costs exceed the value of the
equipment.
^ Donate the existing equipment to local technical schools.
^ Dedicate the ACR4 to A/C system flushing, using the J-42939 Flush Adapter.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-38-006A > May > 00 > A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge
Equipment > Page 1240
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a
Technical Service Bulletin # 431207E Date: 970101
A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a
File In Section: 1 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 43-12-07E
Date: January, 1997
INFORMATION
Subject: Guidelines for Retrofitting R-12 Vehicles to R-134a
Models: 1984-94 Passenger Cars and Trucks (See List Below)
This bulletin is being revised with the following changes:
1. Addition of all remaining GM vehicles, as listed.
2. Format rearranged for easier use.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 43-12-07D (Section 1 - HVAC).
Car/Truck Platform Coverage Starts:
1984 - A, B, D, E, F, J, K, P, Y Carlines
1985 - C, M, N, R, S Carlines
1986 - H Carline
1987 - L, V (Allante) Car lines; M/L, G, R/V, S/T, P Truck lines
1988 - T (LeMans), E (Reatta), W Car lines; C/k, MED. Duty Truck lines
1989 - Tracker
1990 - U Van
Vehicles Not Covered: T (Chevette and T1000), G RWD, C RWD, and X Car
If a vehicle is not covered in the list above, GM's recommendation is that the vehicle continue to be
serviced with R-12.
This bulletin outlines the detailed retrofit procedures, as well as providing background information
on many components and procedures. It is important to follow the bulletin, since each car and truck
line has unique parts and procedures. However, the basic procedure is simple, and will become
easier as you complete more retrofits.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1245
Retrofit Requirements
The customer should be reminded that there is NO requirement in the U.S. to retrofit any vehicle
produced with R-12. Vehicles built with R-12 can be serviced with R-12 as long as it is available
(except in certain Canadian Provinces). GM has taken steps to extend the supply of R-12 and
recommends that all R-12 vehicles continue to be serviced with R-12 as long as it is available.
Training Video
Before doing a retrofit the first time, it is recommended that you view the Certified Plus Training
Video, Program number 51010.15, "R-134a Retrofit for GM Cars and Trucks".
Table of Contents
A. Retrofit Procedure
1. Inspect Condition of Vehicle
2. Recover the R-12 (new method)
3. Install the service port conversion fittings
4. Install any additional parts needed
5. Evacuate and recharge with new PAG or V5 retrofit oil and R-134a
6. Install the retrofit label
Platform Details
Compressor Replacement Chart
B. General Information
1. Performance
2. Leakage
3. Desiccant
4. Improved Cooling Performance
5. PAG or V5 Oil Compatibility
6. Refrigerant Oil Level
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1246
C. Parts Information
D. Warranty Information
1. Vehicle Still in Warranty
2. Customer Paid' Retrofitting Costs
3. Labor Time Information
Notes on Retrofit
Important:
Before proceeding with any retrofit, make sure you have all component Parts required on hand to
perform a proper and complete repair with Minimal downtime.
R-12 Removal Prior to Retrofit
To prepare a system for retrofitting, the R-12 must be recovered and the system must be
completely evacuated. Evacuation is necessary to insure that small amounts of R-12 and air
remaining in the system are removed. This will prevent cross contamination of the two refrigerants,
which could lead to reduced A/C system reliability and performance.
It is very important that the specified times for waiting after recovery and evacuation not be
reduced. This time is required to sufficiently remove residual R-12 from the oil in the system.
A considerable amount of testing has determined that the following procedure is required to
achieve satisfactory results and conform to SAE J 1661:
1. Inspect Condition of Vehicle
Install the gauge set on the high and low side ports.
Use normal diagnostic procedures to find the cause of the vehicle's reported condition. One of
three conditions will exist with the refrigerant system:
a. System pressure correct, no leaks - proceed to Step 2 (Recovery). This would normally apply
when:
1. The system must be recovered/recharged for a repair to a system other than the A/C system, or
2. Where the A/C system condition did not involve leaks, but requires recovery/recharge to replace
a component.
b. Compressor not operating, but some charge. Leak test to find the leak, complete Step 2
(Recovery), then correct the leak before proceeding with Step 3 (Conversion port installation).
c. No charge in system - proceed with the Conversion port installation in Step 3. Use the ACR4 to
evacuate for 5 minutes. If the leak can be heard, repair the leak. If the leak cannot be heard,
charge with 1/2 pound of R-134a. Leak test with the J 39400 Leak Detector, recover the R-134a,
repair any additional leaks found, and proceed with the evacuation in Step 5.
2. Recover the R-12 from the System
Notice:
THIS PROCEDURE IS DIFFERENT THAN THE NORMAL (NON-RETROFIT) RECOVERY
PROCEDURE. R-12 will be recovered through the HIGH SIDE SERVICE PORT ONLY, WITH THE
ENGINE RUNNING. Recovery through the low side will not effectively remove the R-12 from the
accumulator, resulting in possible damage to the retrofitted system.
Important:
Vehicle must be above 50° F (10° C) to allow for complete recovery of the R-12. If it is not, either
allow it to warm up in the shop overnight, or increase the evacuation time in Step 5.a to 30 minutes.
a. Connect the recovery hose from the R-12 recovery cart (ACR3) to the middle port of the A/C
gauge set. Open the oil drain valve on the ACR3 cart long enough to drain the oil. Failure to do so
could cause excessive amounts of oil to build up in the separator, resulting in damage to the
recovery cart compressor.
b. Start the engine. Leave the hood up, and the windows open. On vehicles with manual A/C
controls, set the A/C controls to normal A/C mode, high blower, and temperature control to full cold.
On cars with automatic A/C controls, set the temperature to 75° F, "AUTO" mode, and manually
select high blower.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1247
Make sure the vehicle compressor is engaged. Turn the cart on and start the recovery cycle. OPEN
ONLY THE HIGH SIDE VALVE ON THE GAUGE SET. The vehicle system should eventually shut
the compressor off. If the low side pressure drops below 15 psi, and the compressor does not turn
off, turn it off now (go to "VENT" or "ECON" mode), but leave the engine running and the blower on
"high".
c. After the recovery cart shuts off the first time, wait 5 minutes. If the pressure on either the high or
the low side rises above 0 psi, restart the recovery process. After the second shutoff, wait 2
minutes. If the pressure again rises above 0 psi, restart, and after shutoff, again wait 2 minutes.
The process can be stopped when the pressure does not rise above 0 psi after 2 minutes. The
engine can be shut off at this time.
d. Remove the R-12 reclaim hose and the gauge set from the vehicle.
Any repairs needed should be done at this time. If any components other than the compressor are
replaced, they should be installed dry, and no extra oil should be added.
3. Install the Service Port Conversion Fittings
Important:
For GEO vehicles, skip to Step 4. Fitting installation is covered in that step. For vehicles that
require a HPCOS, see Step 4. Some of these vehicles use a specific combination fitting to mount
the HPCOS, which includes the high side service port fitting and the HPCOS port. The low side
fitting is installed as detailed below. See "Platform Details" for further information.
Important:
A new tool kit, P/N J 39500-250, has been released. This kit contains the following items:
^ J 39500-71 Oil Injection Bottle Conversion Kit (includes 3 12 oz bottles, an extender tube, caps,
and fittings)
^ J 39500-275 Tool kit, including the following: (See Figure 2)
- J 34611-A Double ended valve core remover
- J 25498-A High side adapter fitting
- J 38702 Deep valve core adapter fitting
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1248
- J 41265 Thread cleaning wire brush
- J 41266 Low side port thread restorer
- J 41267 High side port thread restorer
- J 39037 High side octagon socket
- J 41256 Low side octagon socket
New low profile, quick connect couplers, J 39500-20A (High side), and J 39500-24A (Low side),
have been released as essential tools, to attach to the ACR4 (see Figure 3). These are much
smaller couplers than the existing ones, and will allow attachment to the port fittings in much tighter
quarters.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1249
Select and install the proper R-134a fittings (shown in Figure 4) from the chart below, based on
how the ACR4 couplers will attach. Also, remember to check for proper hood clearance with the
conversion fittings. Try the straight fittings first. The two-piece high side fitting is used when the
existing fitting is screwed into the pipe fitting (some 1992, and nearly all 1993 models, use these
fittings). Use the 90° elbow if the straight fitting does not allow the ACR4 couplers to connect.
Fitting Type High Side Low Side
Straight 52467941 52467943
Straight Two-piece 52467324 N/A
90° Elbow 52469054 52469055
The fittings should be installed as follows:
a. Remove the caps from the R-12 fittings. Remove any dirt or grease from the port threads using
the thread cleaning wire brush, J 41265. Inspect the fittings for thread damage. If any damage is
found, use the port thread restorer (J 41266 low side, J 41267 high side) to repair the thread.
For the two-piece fitting, remove the existing R-12 fitting and discard it. Use tool J 38704A
(previously released, not part of the above kit) to remove the fitting. Make sure to hold the line
securely to prevent damage when removing the existing fitting. If the fitting cannot be removed
easily, use the saddle clamp valve listed below and seal the R-12 port and cap permanently.
b. Install the selected fitting onto the existing R-12 fitting. Leave the valve core in the straight
fittings, and remove the valve core when using the 90° fittings.
If the valve cores need to be removed at a later time, they can be removed with the straight
conversion fittings in place. On the low side straight fitting, use the J 34611-A tool to remove the
core pin in the conversion fitting, then remove the core valve from the original R-12 fitting. Always
recover the charge before valve core removal.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1250
Use the octagon sockets on the straight fittings (J 39037 high side, and J 41256 low side). Torque
the new fitting until it seats. The fitting should seat fully BEFORE reaching 11 N.m (8 lb ft). If 11
N.m (8 lb ft) of torque is reached and the fitting has not seated, it is probable that the threads have
been damaged. In this case, remove the fitting and use the thread restorer listed above. Reinstall
the fitting, adding one drop of a thread locking compound such as Loctite(R) 242.
The fittings (except the two-piece) have a thread locking compound applied to the threads. This
compound will set up enough to restrict removal of the fitting in about 15 minutes. The fittings can
now be used to evacuate the system (see Step 5).
An additional type of conversion port fitting has been developed. This fitting is called a saddle
clamp valve (see Figure 5). It can be clamped directly on a metal refrigerant line, and will be used if
the existing fitting is damaged or is inaccessible. A drop of a thread locking compound, such as
Loctite(R) 242, should be used on each bolt to prevent the threads from loosening.
The R134a saddle clamp valve part numbers are:
If an existing R-12 service port is not used, it must be rendered inoperative. Place several drops of
a thread locking compound, such as Loctite(R) 243, in the valve core, and onto the cap threads.
Secure the cap and let it set for 15 minutes.
4. Install Any Additional Parts Needed
See "Platform Details" after Step 6. If a vehicle is listed as a "Basic Retrofit", no additional parts are
required (except for compressors, see the Compressor Replacement Chart at the beginning of
Platform Details). If no parts are required, PROCEED TO STEP 5.
Compressors
Compressors do not need to be replaced as part of a normal retrofit, unless indicated in the
Compressor Replacement Chart. An R-12 compressor that is operating properly can, in most
cases, be left in the vehicle when it is retrofitted to R134a. However, if a compressor failure is the
reason the vehicle is in for service, and the vehicle will be retrofitted, OR if a vehicle has already
been retrofitted with R-134a and the compressor fails at some time in the future, new compressors
for use with R-134a are available. See the GMSPO Parts Catalog for specific part numbers. DO
NOT use a replacement R-12 compressor for any vehicle retrofitted to R-134a (unless it is the new
"oil-less" design). See "Compressor Availability" at the end of the Compressor Replacement Chart.
Accumulator /Dryer
If the vehicle is more than 5 years old, the Accumulator/Dryer (A/D) should be replaced to ensure
that moisture is removed from the system. See the instructions for proper A/D identification in
General Information.
High Pressure Cut-Off Switch (HPCOS)
Most trucks, and some 1984-93 B and D cars, require that a HPCOS be added to protect the
refrigerant system during long idles at high temperature. The HPCOS kit (P/N 15981985) contains
the switch, wire harness, heat sealing splice connectors, switch "0" ring, and installation
instructions. A saddle clamp adapter (P/N 15985307), or a special dual fitting, is mounted to the
high pressure line, and provides the port to mount the switch. A drop of a
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1251
thread locking compound, such as Loctite(R) 242, should be used on each bolt of the saddle clamp
to prevent the threads from loosening.
Some vehicles produced during the second half of the 1993 model year will already have a factory
installed HPCOS. Check the back of the compressor for this switch. If present, the above switch
will not have to be added.
5. Evacuate the System, and Recharge with PAG or V5 Retrofit Oil and R-134a
Newly designed low profile quick connect couplers for the ACR4, J 39500-20A and J 39500-24A,
have been released. These should be installed before proceeding with the evacuation. See Step 3,
and Figure 3.
a. Connect the R-134a cart (ACR4) to the system. Open the coupler valves on the hoses so that
the pressures can be read on the gauges. On the cart, open the HIGH SIDE VALVE ONLY. DO
NOT OPEN THE LOW SIDE VALVE! Program the cart for a 15 minute evacuation.
Important:
If the vehicle has been at outside temperatures of less than 50° F (10° C), or at high altitudes
(above 3000 ft), use a 30 minute evacuation to insure complete removal of the R-12.
If the vacuum pump will not start and a "H-P" reading is indicated on the ACR4 display, loosen the
fitting at the high side line connection to the ACR4 to relieve pressure in the line. Tighten the fitting
after pressure has been relieved. DO NOT USE THE RECOVERY MODE TO RELIEVE LINE
PRESSURE.
b. Start the evacuation. For a proper evacuation, the cart must pull down to 28-29 in. Hg. at sea
level (reduce by 1 in. for each 1000 ft above sea level). Check the low side gauge for proper
vacuum level, to make sure the new fittings are operating properly.
While the evacuation is being done, the Retrofit label can be filled out and installed (see Step 6).
Important:
If the compressor was replaced at the same time as this retrofit, and the new compressor was
shipped with the correct amount of PAG oil already in it, DO NOT add any additional oil to the
system! Go to Step D. If an "oil-less" compressor was installed, add oil in Step C.
A new retrofit oil for use with V5 compressor vehicles has been released. This oil will be used
ONLY for retrofitted vehicles in which the original V5 compressor is retained. IT WILL NOT BE
USED IF A COMPRESSOR IS REPLACED AT THE TIME OF THE RETROFIT. Failure to use this
oil may significantly shorten the useful life of the compressor.
Important:
If the V5 Retrofit oil is not available from GMSPO, the compressor MUST BE REPLACED!
To summarize the correct retrofit oil usage:
^ Compressor replaced during retrofit
- NO OIL ADDED if new compressor shipped with oil
- 8 oz. of PAG oil (9 oz of PAG oil with V5 compressor) added if compressor shipped without oil
("oil-less" design)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1252
^ PAG oil used for future service if needed (mark PAG on box on label, Figure 6).
^ HR6 or R4 original compressor RETAINED - add 8 oz FAG oil to system
^ V5 original compressor RETAINED - add 9 oz V5 Retrofit oil to system. If V5 Retrofit oil is not
available from GMSPO, REPLACE THE COMPRESSOR.
c. Based on the above chart, add oil if needed. Use the new oil bottle and the extended tube kit, J
39500-71. Fill the bottle with at least 10 oz of oil. Attach the new bottle to the back of the ACR4,
and open the oil fill valve. Allow the correct amount of oil to be drawn into the system. DO NOT
allow the oil level to drop below the end of the pickup tube. This will prevent any air from being
drawn into the system. If any oil was removed during the R-12 recovery evacuation steps, DO NOT
add additional oil to replace it.
d. Determine the correct amount of R-134a to use. Check the existing label of the vehicle for the
R-12 charge amount.
Use the formula {(R12 x .9) - .25 lb = R-134a} to determine the correct charge. This can also be
stated as: Take 90% of the R12 charge, and subtract 1/4 lb.
Follow the directions for the ACR4 cart to recharge the system. At the end of the process, "CPL"
will be displayed. Close the high side valve.
e. Start the vehicle, turn on the A/C system, and confirm that pressures are within normal operating
ranges, as shown in the 1994 Service Manual. The 1994 Service Manuals can be used as a
reference for diagnosis and specification of retrofitted systems.
On some vehicles with automatic A/C controls or low charge diagnostics, the A/C compressor may
not engage if any diagnostic codes were set during the retrofit. Check to see if any codes were set
in either the HVAC or Engine Control systems. If they were, clear the codes following the directions
in the Service Manual.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1253
f. TO INSURE AN ACCURATE CHARGE AMOUNT, IT IS IMPORTANT TO CLEAR THE ACR4 OF
ANY REMAINING REFRIGERANT. Close the high side coupler valve and remove the high side
hose from the vehicle. Then, open both the high and low side valves on the ACR4. After the
pressures on both gages are at low side pressure, close the low side coupler valve. See Step G
below, then remove the low side hose from the vehicle. Shut off the engine. Install the service port
caps on the new fittings. These serve as a seal and can prevent system leaks.
g. In the unlikely event that the low side fitting leaks when the coupler is removed, use the following
procedure:
1. Immediately reinstall the coupler on the fitting.
2. Find the valve core remover J 34611-A.
3. Remove the coupler.
4. Use the double-ended valve core remover to turn the valve core pin counter-clockwise until the
leak stops.
5. Install the cap.
If the leak was substantial or continued for an extended period of time, it is highly recommended to
evacuate and recharge the system to insure proper performance. If there is any question, the
system can be rechecked by repeating Step F.
h. Leak test any new port fittings, adapters, or valves that were installed, and any joints that were
opened or repaired during the retrofit process, using tool J 39400.
6. Install the Retrofit Label
The retrofit label (P/N 21030857, roll of 250) has been developed following SAF specifications to
insure a smooth transition from R-12 to R-134a, and to insure a professional approach to the
retrofit and a quality repair. Following the instructions in this bulletin will insure that the retrofit
meets the SAE standards.
Fill in the new label using a typewriter or a ball-point pen (see Figure 6). Select a location for the
label that will be easily visible. Some suggested areas are the radiator support panel, an area near
the existing R-12 charge label, or a flat surface near the high or low side service ports. The area
selected should be a clean, underhood, painted sheet metal surface, and should be degreased and
wiped down with a non-petroleum based cleaner. Do not install the label on a rubber surface. Apply
the label, then apply the clear overlay to the label.
Do not remove, cover, or render unreadable the existing R-12 charge label. DO cover the R-12
refrigerant charge amount on the existing label with an indelible, preferably black, marker.
Platform Details
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1254
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1255
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1256
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1257
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1258
FOR ALL VEHICLES EXCEPT GEO, see the "Compressor Replacement Chart" at the end of this
section. Compressor replacement requirements ARE NOT LISTED in the platform details (except
for application details), except as noted below for Y car and P and Medium Duty truck.
Compressor Replacement Chart
Important:
It is important to check the date code on the compressor. Any vehicle may have had a compressor
replaced either during or after the warranty period. The date code will determine whether or not the
compressor must be replaced.
Compressor Availability
A new compressor for use with R-134a systems will be shipped with the correct amount of PAG oil
installed (see "IMPORTANT" below). Do not add any additional oil in Step 5 of the retrofit
procedure if a compressor is to be replaced with a new R-134a compressor at the same time the
initial retrofit is
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1259
being done.
Important:
During 1996, "oil-less" compressors began to be serviced with NO added oil. New part numbers
will be issued, and both the box and the compressor will be clearly marked to indicate that no oil is
present. If you receive one of these newer compressors, simply add the normal amount of oil to the
system in Step 5 of the retrofit procedure (8 oz of PAG oil, or 9 oz of PAG oil with V5 compressor).
These "oil-less" compressors are compatible with EITHER R12 or R-134a.
Geo Models
Compressors DO NOT HAVE TO BE REPLACED as part of the retrofit. New compressors are
shipped with enough oil to accommodate the entire A/C system. Do not add additional PAG oil to
the system it the compressor is being replaced.
1985-88 Nova, 1989-93 Prizm (S)
1. Using the Service Manual, remove the following components in the order given:
a. Receiver/dryer.
b. Loosen evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe (to be reinstalled)
c. 1985-92 only: Loosen compressor to condenser (compressor discharge) pipe (to be reinstalled).
d. 1985-88 only: Service Valve & Extension Housing on compressor (to be installed).
e. Compressor (only if being replaced).
2. Using the Service Manual, install the following components in the order given. Be sure to use
new 0-rings whenever a refrigerant connection has been disconnected.
a. Compressor (if being replaced).
b. High and low side adapter fittings (see Step 3 of the retrofit procedure for detailed installation
instructions).
c. 1985-88 only: Service Valve & Extension Housing on compressor using new 0-rings. Six small
0-rings and one large 0-ring are required.
d. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe 0-ring.
e. 1985-92 Compressor to condenser (discharge) hose 0-ring.
f. Receiver/dryer and 0-rings.
R-134a amount: 85-92 - 650 grams (1.43 lb)
93 - 700 grams (1.54 lb) PAG oil amount: 100 cc (3.0 oz) Parts Required:
Receiver/dryer:
85-88 - 94855761
89-93 - 94855762
Adapter Fittings:
Low Side - 94855760
High Side - 94855759
0-Rings:
85-88 Compressor - Small 0-rings (6 required) - 94857336 - Large 0-ring - 94857337
85-93 Receiver/Dryer (2) - 94845949
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1260
85-93 Suction hose - 94855765
85-92 Discharge hose - 94845943
1985-88 Sprint, 1989-93 Metro (M)
1. Using the Service Manual, remove the following components in the order given:
a. Receiver/dryer.
b. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe.
c. Compressor to condenser (compressor discharge) pipe.
d. Joint service connector on compressor (to be reinstalled).
e. Compressor (only if being replaced).
2. Using the Service Manual, install the following components in the the order given. Be sure to use
new 0-rings whenever a refrigerant connection has been disconnected.
a. Compressor (if being replaced).
b. High and low side adapter fittings (see Step 3 of the retrofit procedure for detailed installation
instructions).
c. Joint service connector to compressor. Use new 0-rings. Six small 0-rings and one large 0-ring
are required.
d. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe, and new 0-ring.
e. Compressor to condenser (discharge) hose and new 0-ring.
f. Receiver/dryer and 0-ring.
R-134a amount: 500 grams (1.10 lb)
PAG oil amount: 100 cc (3.0 oz)
Parts Required:
Receiver/dryer:
85-86 - 91172081
87-88 - 91172079
89-93 - 96068480
Adapter Fittings:
Low Side - 91172092
85-88 - High Side - 91172094
89-93 - High Side - 52467941
0-Rings:
Compressor - Small 0-rings (6 required)
- 91172095
- Large 0-ring - 96068915
Receiver/Dryer (2) - 96068488
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1261
89-93 - Suction hose - 96068490
89-93 - Discharge hose - 96068489
Suction hose:
85-86 - 91172086
85-86 Dealer installed: 91172087
87-88 - 91172088
89-93 - w/turbo - 96069121 - w/o turbo
- 91172089
Discharge hose:
85-86 - 91172082
85-86 Dealer installed: 91172083
87-88 - 91172084
89-93 - 96069024
1989-93 Tracker
1. Using the Service Manual, remove the following components in the order given:
a. Receiver/dryer.
b. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe.
c. Compressor to condenser (compressor discharge) pipe.
d. Joint service connector on compressor (to be reinstalled).
e. Compressor (only if being replaced).
2. Using the Service Manual, install the following components in the order given. Be sure to use
new 0-rings whenever a refrigerant connection has been disconnected.
a. Compressor (if being replaced).
b. High and low side adapter fittings (see Step 3 of the Retrofit procedure for detailed installation
instructions).
c. Joint service connector to compressor. Use new 0-rings. Six small 0-rings and one large 0-ring
are required.
d. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe, and new 0-ring.
e. Compressor to condenser (discharge) hose and new 0-ring.
f. Receiver/dryer and 0-ring.
R-134a amount: 550 grams (1.21 lb)
PAG oil amount: 100 cc (3.0 oz)
Parts Required:
Receiver/dryer - 91172080
Adapter, Low Side - 91172092
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1262
Adapter, High Side - 91172093
0-Rings:
Compressor - Small (6) - 91172095 Large - 96068915
Receiver/dryer (2) - 96068488
Suction hose - 96068490
Discharge hose - 96068489
Suction hose - 91172091
Discharge hose - 91172085
1985-89 Spectrum and 1990-93 Storm (R)
1. Using the Service Manual, remove the following components in the order given:
a. Condenser (Storm) or radiator grille (Spectrum) (to be reinstalled).
b. Triple switch (Storm) or dual pressure switch (Spectrum) (to be reinstalled).
c. Receiver/dryer.
d. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe.
e. Check valve from high side service valve (discard).
f. Compressor (only if being replaced).
2. Using the Service Manual, install the following components in the order given. Be sure to use
new 0-rings whenever a refrigerant connection has been disconnected.
a. Compressor (if being replaced).
b. High side adapter fitting (see Step 3 of the retrofit procedure for detailed installation instructions).
Low Side - Part of suction hose
c. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe, and new 0-rings.
d. Receiver/dryer and 0-rings.
e. Triple switch or dual switch, and new 0-ring.
f. Condenser or radiator grille.
R-134a amount: 91 - 500 grams (1.10 lb)
92-93 - 600 grams (1.32 lb)
PAG oil amount: 150 cc (4.50 oz)
Parts Required:
Receiver/dryer:
85-89 - 97104795
90-91 - 97104797
92-93 - 97104798
Adapter, High Side:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1263
85-89 - 97104794
90-93 - 97104793
Adapter, Low Side: Part of Hose Asm.
0-rings:
Receiver/dryer 85-91 - 94154048
92-93 - 94461700
Switch/pipe - 94461902
Suction hose:
85-86: 1.5L - 97104799; 1.6L - 97104800
90-93: 1.6L - 97104801; 1.8L - 97104803
B. General Information
Several items affecting the performance and durability of the system should be considered:
1. Performance
When performed properly, the retrofit from R-12 to R-134a will have minimal effect on the system's
performance in most climatic conditions found in the United States and Canada.
2. Leakage
Experience has shown that most leakage in an A/C system is due to leaks at the joints, or through
a small leak in a hose, usually at the coupling. The R-134a molecules are smaller than R-12, and a
small leak may result in a faster loss of refrigerant with R-134a. Because of this, it is very important
to leak check all vehicles using the J 39400 leak detector, BEFORE the retrofit is performed, and
repair any leaks found.
"0" rings and hoses used in most GM vehicles are compatible with R-134a and do not need
replacement during a retrofit. "0" rings or hoses installed in previous repairs may have been of
non-compatible materials if GM parts were not used and will be more likely to deteriorate and leak
than the original equipment materials. All "0" rings and hoses available through GMSP0 are
compatible with R-134a. Remember that the normal policy is to replace the "0" rings whenever a
joint is opened for any reason.
3. Desiccant
You may have heard that the currently used desiccant in the accumulator is not compatible with
R-134a. Extensive testing has shown that it is, in fact, suitable for use with R-134a, once it has
been in service in an R-12 system. The accumulator in these models will not have to be changed
during the retrofit procedure, unless the vehicle is more than 5 years old. Vehicles more than 5
years old should have the A/D replaced to add new desiccant for proper system drying.
In the event that an accumulator/dryer (A/D) needs to be replaced on a retrofitted system in the
future, only A/D's with XH-7 desiccant should be used. The service parts for the 1993 vehicles
contain only XH-7 desiccant. The parts for the 1992 and older vehicles may contain either XH-5 or
XH-7. Parts containing XH-7 can be identified (see Figure 1) by 1) an "A" printed on the top of the
A/D; or 2) if there is a label on top of the A/D, there will be a square with an "A" inside; or 3) if there
is a time code and date printed on top of the A/D just under the "Harrison" logo, the A/D contains
XH-7. A/D's containing XH-5 can still be used on R-12 vehicles.
4. Improved Cooling Performance
There have been service bulletins issued in the past with information improving the cooling
performance of existing R-12 systems. These bulletins can also be used to improve the
performance of retrofitted vehicles in high ambient temperature climates.
5. PAG or V5 Oil Compatibility
Contrary to information published to date outside of General Motors, mineral oil and PAG or V5 oil
ARE chemically compatible. The mineral oil left in the system after reclaiming the R-12 can remain
in the system with no harmful effects. However, the mineral oil will not mix with the R-134a, and so
will not circulate and perform its lubricating function. Testing has shown that most of the mineral oil
will eventually collect in the
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1264
accumulator. The system will operate properly as long as refrigerant charge amounts are strictly
adhered to.
6. Refrigerant Charge Level
The retrofit R-134a charge level is more critical than with R-12 systems. Overcharging may push
the mineral oil out of the AID, and cause it to circulate as a liquid. This is more likely to result in
compressor damage. Undercharging may lead to loss of performance. It is very important to clear
the hoses during the charging operation, to insure that all the refrigerant is delivered to the vehicle
A/C system. This is covered in Step 6D of the Retrofit Procedure.
C. Parts Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1265
Important:
All of the following parts are NOT NEEDED for a normal retrofit. Follow the bulletin procedures to
determine which parts you need! Individual vehicle kits are not necessary, since most of the parts
are generic and only a few parts are needed for most vehicles.
GEO Parts are listed in "Platform Details."
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
D. Warranty Information
1. Vehicle Still Within the Original New Vehicle Limited Warranty Period
When GM models for the years listed in the bulletin require repairs to the refrigerant system and
the vehicles are still covered under the New
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 1266
Vehicle Limited Warranty, dealers are instructed to proceed as follows:
Important:
On vehicles equipped with A/C systems NOT produced by GM (i.e., rear A/C systems in van
conversions), consult the manufacturer of that A/C system for retrofit guidelines.
^ Offer the customer the option of repairing and recharging the system with R12, or retrofitting after
repair and recharging with R-134a at no additional charge.
^ Provide the owner with, and review the information contained in, the "Converting Your Auto Air
Conditioning System to Use the New Refrigerant" brochure. (Brochure, Form GM-0011, can be
ordered free of charge from GM Fulfillment HQ, Phone 1-800-269-5100).
^ Record the customer's choice on the repair order and, as with all properly completed repair
orders, ask the customer to sign on the appropriate line acknowledging the repairs requested.
^ Under no circumstances should the retrofit to R-134a be performed unless the customer has had
the option explained prior to repair. Once the vehicle has been retrofitted to R-134a, a significant
expenditure would be incurred to go back to R-12, in the event the customer has changed his/her
mind.
THIS OFFER APPLIES ONLY TO VEHICLES REQUIRING A/C REFRIGERANT SYSTEM
REPAIRS UNDER THE TERMS OF THE NEW VEHICLE LIMITED WARRANTY. It is not a special
policy, and any existing deductibles still apply. This is simply an option being offered to the
customer during the warranty period at this time. GM reserves the right to terminate this offer at
any time.
If the R-12 refrigerant system does not require discharging for a warranty repair, but the customer
requests a retrofit to R-134a, the retrofit WOULD BE PERFORMED AT THE CUSTOMER'S
EXPENSE, EVEN DURING THE WARRANTY PERIOD.
2. Customer Paid Retrofitting Costs
If the customer requests a retrofit to R-134a, for a specific vehicle whose retrofit parts and
procedures have been released in this bulletin, the customer would be expected to pay the costs to
retrofit under the following conditions:
^ The vehicle is no longer covered by the terms of the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
^ The vehicle is covered by warranty, but the repair covered under the warranty does not require
evacuating and recharging the refrigerant system.
3. Labor Time Information
For Vehicles Repaired Under Warranty: Use existing labor operations for correcting the original
condition. The quantity of R-134a used should be charged to the normal labor operation (not
D4500), just as if it were R-12.
Use D4500, 0.3 HR., to charge for parts and labor, for all of the following items:
^ Additional time for recovery of R-12 to meet SAE standards;
^ Install high and low side service port converter fittings;
^ Add PAG or V5 retrofit oil;
^ Complete label information and install.
Add 0.2 hours to D4500 for installation of the HPCOS.
Use T5321, 0.3 HR., for the Pontiac Bonneville hood seal installation.
ANY PARTS OR LABOR TIME OTHER THAN THOSE LISTED ABOVE SHOULD BE CHARGED
TO THE REGULAR LABOR OPERATION CORRESPONDING TO THE ORIGINAL CONDITION
THAT 1S BEING REPAIRED.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 631209 > May > 96 > A/C - R12 or R134a Service Recommendations
Technical Service Bulletin # 631209 Date: 960501
A/C - R12 or R134a Service Recommendations
File In Section: 1 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 63-12-09
Date: May, 1996
INFORMATION
Subject: Service Issues for Vehicles with R12 or R134a Air Conditioning Systems
Models: 1988-96 Passenger Cars and Trucks
R12 Service Recommendations
As you know, production of R12 refrigerant ceased on December 31, 1995. Although R12 will no
longer be manufactured, there is a reserve supply of R12 available. This reserve, along with strict
A/C repair service adherence to proper refrigerant recycling procedures, should assure continued
availability to meet consumers' needs.
R12 can and should continue to be used to service vehicles built with R12 A/C systems as long as
it is available. If R12 is no longer available or affordable, a system retrofit utilizing R134a is
recommended. R134a IS THE ONLY SUBSTITUTE REFRIGERANT RECOMMENDED BY GM
FOR USE IN GM VEHICLE A/C SYSTEMS, AND THEN ONLY AFTER FOLLOWING THE
PROPER RETROFIT PROCEDURES FOR THE SPECIFIC MODEL. All new vehicle
manufacturers have chosen R134a for retrofit. One of the key reasons is to protect both the service
industry and consumers from the high costs that would result from purchasing equipment
necessary to service multiple refrigerants. This position also reduces the threat of recycled
refrigerant contamination.
GM currently offers a simple, low cost R12 to R134a retrofit on many of its late model, front wheel
drive passenger cars. Dealers should discuss this capability with owners of these specific models,
listed in Retrofit Corporate Bulletin # 43-12-07D, whenever a repair to the A/C refrigerant system is
required. Early retrofit of these specific models will aid in prolonging availability of the R12 supply
and provide dealer service technicians the opportunity to become more familiar with the proper
procedures for performing a retrofit.
Remember - R12 and R134a refrigerant are not interchangeable! They cannot be mixed together.
In fact, despite the claims of some refrigerant manufacturers, no proposed R12 refrigerant
substitute can be added to, mixed with or used to "top off" an R12 system. Under provisions of law
covering the service of refrigerants, mixing dissimilar refrigerant products during service is
prohibited.
To Summarize GM R12 Service Policy
1. Service R12 vehicles with good quality new or recycled R12 as long as it is available.
2. Purchase R12 from a reliable supplier. GMSPO has a supply of high quality R12 available.
Dealers are requested to use only R12 supplied by GMSPO for warranty repairs. This high quality
refrigerant will insure system performance and avoid the possibility of introducing contaminated
material into the customer's A/C system.
3. Carefully test recovered R12 using the PureGuard monitor. On recovery equipment not
protected by the PureGuard, always test the recovery cylinder prior to recharging a vehicle A/C
system.
4. Discuss the R12 to R134a retrofit option with owners of GM vehicles listed in Retrofit Corporate
Bulletin # 43-12-07D. Provide owner with a copy of the pamphlet "Converting Your Auto Air
Conditioning System to Use the New Refrigerant".
5. Become familiar with retrofit procedures and exercise care in the handling of dissimilar
refrigerants to prevent contamination.
R134A Service Recommendations
When servicing a previously retrofitted vehicle, there is concern that if all of the R12 is not
completely removed prior to the retrofit procedure, it could contaminate your R134a equipment and
recovery tank when a subsequent A/C repair is performed. Although the number of retrofits being
performed today is minimal, the volume will increase as R12 prices rise.
GM Service Technology Group is in the process of field testing a new R134a refrigerant purity
tester similar to the PureGuard R12 refrigerant tester you now use. This new tool will mount to your
ACR4 R134a Recovery Recycle and Recharge cart and sample all R134a refrigerant prior to
recovery. It is expected that testing of this tool will be completed this year.
This new tool, the Pureguard 2, will also test vehicles and your recycle tank for air contamination,
which is threatening A/C system performance. High levels of air have been found in the recovery
tanks on a number of R12 and R134a recovery carts. Air contamination is caused by improper
recovery
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 631209 > May > 96 > A/C - R12 or R134a Service Recommendations >
Page 1271
procedures and short-cutting refrigerant recycling times. Use the following procedure for testing
and correcting air contamination in your A/C service equipment.
1. Make certain that the ACR4 equipment has not been used for at least 12 hours. It is
recommended that the equipment be left in an area where the temperature will remain constant
overnight to allow the temperature of the refrigerant in the tank to stabilize.
2. Record the surrounding air temperature next to the ACR4 refrigerant tank.
Important:
A major assumption is that the ambient air temperature next to the tank represents the refrigerant
temperature in the tank. Failure to take care in measuring the temperature could result in
unnecessary work.
3. Close both liquid (blue) and vapor (red) valves on the ACR4 tank.
4. Disconnect low side (blue) service hose from the back of the ACR4.
5. Slowly disconnect the tank vapor hose (red) from the back of the ACR4 and connect it to the low
side service port.
6. Open the vapor (red) valve on the tank and record the tank pressure on the low side gage.
7. Restore hoses to the original position.
8. Referring to the Table, find the ambient temperature measured in Step 2. Compare the pressure
reading from Step 6 to the "maximum allowable pressure". If the pressure reading from Step 6 is
less than the "maximum allowable pressure", no further action is necessary.
Important:
The closer the tank pressure is to the desired tank pressure, the better the A/C system will perform.
9. If the pressure reading from Step 6 exceeds the maximum allowable pressure from the Table,
open both tank valves and operate the ACR4 through 4 or 5 evacuation cycles. This will activate
the automatic air purge to lower the tank pressure.
Important:
Station should not be connected to vehicle.
10. Repeat the tank pressure checking procedure the next day to determine if the pressure has
been reduced to acceptable levels. If the tank pressure has been reduced but is not acceptable,
cycle with ACR4 through more evacuation cycles and recheck the next day. Continue process until
acceptable pressure is obtained. If the tank pressure is not reduced through the evacuation cycling,
then Kent-Moore should be contacted at 1-800-345-2233.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531205 > May > 95 > Contaminated R12 Refrigerant - Testing & Handling
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins Contaminated R12 Refrigerant - Testing & Handling
FILE IN SECTION: 1 - HVAC
BULLETIN NO.: 53-12-05
DATE: May, 1995
SUBJECT: Contaminated R12 Refrigerant Testing and Handling
MODELS: 1994 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks with R12 A/C Systems
The J 39851 "PureGuard" R12 refrigerant monitor was recently shipped to all GM dealers as an
essential tool to test R12 refrigerant. Dealers are strongly urged to install this protective device on
their ACR3 or other R12 recovery equipment immediately. The PureGuard is easily installed on any
recovery cart (20 minutes), requires no recovery cart modifications, is fully automatic (no training
required) and does not increase the time required to perform normal A/C service procedures.
Proper use of this tool can:
^ Prevent damage to your R12 recovery/recycling equipment.
^ Prevent contamination of previously recovered R12 in the recovery tank.
^ Prevent loss of your recovered R12 as contaminated refrigerant will activate automatic air purge
system.
^ Prevent the spread of contaminated R12 to other vehicles you service.
If your dealership has multiple R12 recovery stations which are not protected, use the PureGuard
to check the refrigerant in these recovery tanks for contamination at least once each week. Simply
connect the PureGuard blue service hose (that would normally be connected to the vehicle low
side service port) to the red or vapor side of any recovery cart tank and run the test. It is also
important to check a tank containing recovered/recycled material for purity before installation on
your charging equipment. Even new R12 refrigerant purchased from sources other than GM should
be tested for contamination prior to use.
Sources of Contaminated R12 Refrigerant
Since refrigerant testing has not been a standard practice in the mobile A/C repair industry, the
amount of R12 refrigerant contamination is unknown. As R12 prices rise and supplies are depleted,
it is anticipated that contaminated R12 refrigerant may become more prevalent from the following
as well as other sources:
^ The use of R12 refrigerant substitutes without installation of unique service fittings and proper
identification labeling.
^ Improper use of R12 substitutes, such as topping off R12 systems with R134a or other
refrigerants available to "do-it-yourselfers".
^ Poor quality or contaminated new or reprocessed R12 refrigerant.
R12 can and should continue to be used to service vehicles built with R12 as long as it is available.
Combining any refrigerant with R12 results in a refrigerant mixture which cannot be used in an A/C
system.
R134a is the only substitute refrigerant approved by GM and should only be used when the
appropriate retrofit service bulletin procedures are explicitly followed. Use of any other substitute
refrigerant requires the purchase of additional dedicated recovery, recycling (if applicable) and
charging equipment to service each substitute refrigerant used.
However, you should know that the Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) has listed several
products as acceptable replacements for R12 mobile A/C systems under the Significant New
Alternatives Policy (SNAP). Some of these products are: R134a, R401c (a DuPont refrigerant
blend) and FRIGC (another refrigerant blend). It is important to understand that the SNAP program
only considers the health, safety and environmental characteristics of a chemical. It does not test
for A/C system cooling performance or durability. That judgment is deferred to the vehicle
manufacturer. Use of any R12 refrigerant substitute without dedicated service equipment, unique
fittings, labels and refrigerant testing prior to recovery, could result in contamination of the R12
supply and the loss of the R12 recycling program.
What To Do When Contamination is Detected
Repeat the test to verify contaminated refrigerant is present. Clear the PureGuard following the
instructions listed on the face panel, then perform a second test to verify that the vehicle A/C
system contains contaminated or mixed refrigerant.
Contact the vehicle owner to advise that previous A/C system repairs were apparently performed
with an R12 refrigerant substitute. Suggest the owner
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531205 > May > 95 > Contaminated R12 Refrigerant - Testing & Handling >
Page 1276
contact or return to the previous repair facility. Explain that environmental regulations prohibit repair
facilities from discharging ozone depleting A/C refrigerants into the atmosphere. Explain that
recovery of this unknown refrigerant could damage your service equipment.
If the customer wishes to pursue repairs through your facility, it is recommended that the proper
A/C service equipment be purchased. General Motors recommends the Kent-Moore J 41428
"Scavenger", an air operated refrigerant recovery station, be used to remove unknown refrigerants.
The air operated feature reduces the hazard of recovering potentially flammable refrigerants.
Dealers should evaluate the need to purchase the equipment based on the number of
contaminated vehicles they encounter.
As an alternative to the initial purchase of a recovery only station, dealers should check locally for
A/C specialty shops which may have the equipment to service substitute or contaminated
refrigerants. They may be able to provide contaminated refrigerant recovery service to the dealer.
The GM Service Technology Group has tested a recovery procedure where a 15 or 30 pound DOT
approved refillable tank is fully evacuated then connected to a vehicle A/C system to recover the
charge. Testing has shown that even when the recovery tank is cooled down in dry ice, the
procedure does not guarantee the entire charge will be recovered. Since EPA regulations require
full recovery of ozone depleting substances, GM does not recommend this procedure.
Contaminated Refrigerant Disposal
Although A/C refrigerant testing and disposal have not been a service practice in the mobile A/C
industry, It has been common in the stationary A/C service industry for many years. Listed at the
end of this bulletin are companies that provide refrigerant disposal service for the stationary A/C
industry. Please be advised that GM has not independently evaluated these companies and is not
in any way endorsing or promoting the use of these companies. Each of these companies has
expressed an interest in providing refrigerant disposal service to GM dealers.
In working with the stationary A/C industry, these companies typically receive large volumes of
different refrigerants that have been mixed together. Unfortunately, because the volume of material
returned by the mobile A/C industry will be in much smaller quantities, the cost of handling will be
greater.
To arrange for return of the refrigerant, simply call the company nearest you using the phone
number listed below. The company will advise you on billing and shipping procedures. Disposal
cost will vary between $3.00 and $5.00 per pound plus freight and handling. Shipping charges will
vary by distance and location. In general, a 7 to 10 day turn-around time on the tank can be
expected. The tank can be shipped via common carrier. Documents that your refrigerant has been
properly disposed of will be sent to you with the return of your tank.
As an alternative, many dealerships already have contracts in place with a disposal company who
manages their hazardous wastes. In these cases, the disposal service may agree to handle
containers of mixed refrigerants. Initially, the local disposal companies may be surprised by this
inquiry. They may want to evaluate how much material will be collected before deciding whether to
provide this service.
As we move forward with the practice of testing R12 refrigerant, it will take time for all the questions
to be answered. STG will provide additional information as soon as it is available.
Understanding The PureGuard
The PureGuard is a highly sensitive instrument capable of detecting R12 with 3% or less
cross-contamination with other refrigerants. Any refrigerant mixture in excess of this amount poses
a threat to both your refrigerant supply and recovery equipment. The PureGuard uses a pass/fail
approach when monitoring the refrigerant and is precisely calibrated to cut power to the recovery
machine if it encounters R12 mixed with any substitute refrigerants. The PureGuard ignores the
presence of the air, dyes or oils in the refrigerant sampled.
At least 20 psi must be present in the vehicle's A/C system for the PureGuard to function.
Otherwise, refrigerant cannot be introduced to the PureGuard's test chamber. If a vehicle's A/C
system contains less than 20 psi, it is an indication that the vehicle's system is nearly depleted of
refrigerant.
Occasionally, erratic PureGuard operation or service code 002 display will be encountered when
A/C system pressure is exactly 20 psi. If this occurs, simply cycle the on/off switch to reset the
PureGuard. After the 30 second PureGuard warm-up cycle, proceed immediately with vehicle
recovery operation.
Feedback from the field has indicated PureGuard service code 002 will also be displayed if the oil
drain port is not sealed. Make sure the "0" ring seal in the cap is in place and that the cap is tight.
If the PureGuard fails to clear or if you experience any other problems operating the PureGuard,
contact Kent-Moore Technical Service at 1-800-345-2233. The unit should not be returned without
first contacting Kent-Moore to obtain return authorization.
Refrigerant Disposal Locations:
United States Refrigerant Reclamation Inc. 12420 North Green River Rd. Evansville, IN 47711
800-207-5931, FAX - 812-867-1463
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531205 > May > 95 > Contaminated R12 Refrigerant - Testing & Handling >
Page 1277
Omega Refrigerant Reclamation 5263 North Fourth St. Irwindale, CA 91706 310-698-0991, FAX 310-696-1908
Refrigerant Management Svcs of Georgia 216 F. Atlanta Hwy. Cumming, GA 30130 Ph/FAX 800-347-5872
Refrigerant Reclaim Inc. 122 Old Stage Coach Rd. Dumfries, VA 22026 800-238-5902, FAX 703-441-0393
Gartech Refrigerant Reclamation Ctr. 2002 Platinum Garland, TX 75042 214-272-4070, FAX 214-272-8548
National Refrigerants, Inc. 11401 Roosevelt Blvd. Philadelphia, PA 19154 215-698-6620, FAX 215-602-8205
CFC Reclamation 1321 Swift North Kansas City, MO 64116 816-471-2511
Full Cycle-Global 550 James Street Lakewood, NJ 08701 908-370-3400, FAX - 908-370-3088
Refrigerant Reclaim Svcs, Inc. dba Full Cycle-Global 121 S. Norwood Drive Ft. Worth, TX
76053-7807 817-282-0022, FAX - 800-831-6182
Full Cycle-Global 2055 Silber, Ste. 109 Houston, TX 77055 713-681-7370, FAX - 713-681-9947
Full Cycle-Global 343 South Airline Hwy. Gonzales, LA 70737 504-644-5303, FAX - 504-644-1809
Full Cycle-Global 2966 Wireton Blue Island, IL 60406 708-388-8551, FAX - 708-388-8550
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431215 > Nov > 94 > A/C - R134a Leak Detection With Tracer Dye
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - R134a Leak Detection With Tracer Dye
File In Section: 1 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 43-12-15
Date: November, 1994
Subject: R134a Leak Detection with Tracer Dye
Models: All 1993-95 Vehicles with OEM R134a Systems All R12 Vehicles Retrofitted to R134a
Systems
R134a refrigerant is uniquely different from R12 refrigerant and requires some changes in the
repair methods, tools and materials used in A/C service. Two important differences between R134a
and R12 which affect the technicians ability to locate refrigerant leaks are:
1. The R134a molecule is smaller than the R12 molecule and therefore will leak through smaller
openings. For the same size opening the smaller R134a molecule will leak out faster than the R12.
2. R134a refrigerant does not contain chlorine which the older R12 electronic leak detectors found
very easy to identify. Many of today's electronic leak detectors have difficulty locating small R134a
refrigerant leaks.
In order to insure the highest quality in A/C system service, the J 39400 electronic leak detector
was released as an essential tool for all GM dealers. This is the only refrigerant leak detector
approved by GM for service on R134a vehicles. If maintained properly (Reference Bulletin No.
431218) and used in accordance with Service Manual procedures, the J 39400 will provide the
most accurate and efficient method of locating R134a refrigerant leaks under most conditions.
If the technician cannot find the leak with the J 39400 and the system is known to have lost charge,
a new fluorescent leak tracer dye Kent-Moore* P/N J 41447, has been released that mixes with the
R134a PAG oil. This dye is detectable through the use of an ultraviolet (black) light and glows
yellow/green at the leak location (similar to using dye in engine leak detection). J 41447 IS THE
ONLY APPROVED DYE BY GENERAL MOTORS. Not all R134a dyes are compatible with GM's
PAG oil. Some dyes decrease the oil viscosity or chemically react with the oil. Use of alternate
products may affect system reliability and cause premature compressor failure.
Note:
THIS DYE IS NOT TO BE USED IN R-12 SYSTEMS.
Unlike mineral oil, the R134a PAG oil has special properties the technician should keep in mind.
1. PAG oil is water soluble and traces of PAG oil found at leaking joints are subject to "washing
out". Condensation on refrigerant lines or the evaporator core may wash the PAG oil and leak dye
off the line or off the core and out the condensate drain. This can make some leaks harder to find
using the dye detector. Fluorescence at the drain opening would indicate a core leak.
2. Use of the R134a tracer dye requires time. Depending upon the leak rate, it may take between
15 minutes and 7 days for the leak to become visible.
3. The dye, mixed with the PAG oil, is retained in the system and is detectable for 2+ years. Do not
double or triple charge the system with dye as this may cause reliability concerns. Use only the 1/4
oz. charge.
The dye has a refrigerant leak detection notice sticker included with the package. Complete the
sticker information and place near the charge label.
Dye Injection R-134a dye can be injected two ways:
1. With the A/C system charged, use the instructions provided with the new R134a leak dye
injection tool, J 41436.
2. With A/C system discharged, add dye into the newly replaced component assembly.
It is important to note that it is normal to find oil traces at the compressor shaft seal during
compressor operation, some oil will hydraulically seep past the shaft seal. This does not mean that
the shaft seal is defective or that the refrigerant has leaked. Refrigerant leaks at the shaft seal
should be verified with the electronic leak detector (J 39400) following the procedure detailed in the
Service Manual. If, however, the amount of oil is excessive, the shaft seal is suspect and should be
replaced. (For example, refrigerant oil has coated the clutch plate edge at gap between clutch and
pulley, or oil slinging has occurred-oil line shows on underside of hood, etc.).
Also, after working on A/C components with dye, it is important to wipe the joint and/or access
ports clean of any residual dye with GM solvent (GM
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431215 > Nov > 94 > A/C - R134a Leak Detection With Tracer Dye > Page
1282
P/N 1050436) to prevent false diagnosis at a later point.
* We believe this source and their equipment to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such equipment. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products or equipment from these firms or for any such items which may be
available from other sources.
Parts Information GM solvent, P/N 1050436, is currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431223 > Sep > 94 > A/C Refrigerant - Contamination
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C Refrigerant - Contamination
File In Section: 1 - HVAC Bulletin No.: 43-12-23 Date: September, 1994
Subject: Contaminated A/C Refrigerant
Models: 1994 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks with R12 Air Conditioning Systems
Government regulations limit the production of R12 refrigerant, commonly referred to as Freon,
during 1994/1995 and restrict manufacture of new R12 material effective January 1, 1996. As R12
prices rise and supplies are depleted, it is anticipated non-approved substitute refrigerants and/or
poor quality R12 material sold as new or reprocessed may become more prevalent.
The Mobile Air Conditioning Society (MACS) recently expressed concern over reports of the sale of
R12 refrigerant containing as high as 15% contamination by R22, a refrigerant commonly used in
stationary home systems but unsuitable for use in mobile units. GM dealers should be careful to
protect against contaminating their existing supplies of R12 or the A/C systems in customers'
vehicles they service by dealing with reputable suppliers. All R12 refrigerant purchased for
warranty repairs should be purchased through GM SPO to ensure GM quality standards are met.
The use of non-approved R12 refrigerant substitutes, some of which contain flammable materials,
has also been reported by MACS. These products are available to "do-it-yourselfers" who, in many
cases, believe they are harmless replacements for the small cans of R12 used so commonly in the
past. Once added to the A/C system, the vehicle can no longer be serviced using R12
recovery/recycling equipment without:
- Risking permanent damage to recovery/recycling equipment
- Contaminating the previously recovered R12 material in the recovery tank
- Spreading the contamination when the recovered material is used to charge other vehicles
or
- Possible loss of the recovered material if the contaminated level is high enough to activate the air
purge system
Contaminated refrigerant also impacts customer satisfaction through poor vehicle A/C performance
and loss of A/C system compressor/component durability. System or component failure resulting
from the use of refrigerant which does not meet GM specification is not covered by the "New
Vehicle Warranty".
Unfortunately, there is no simple method to identify if a "do-it-yourselfer" or repair shop has added
to or recharged a system with a non-approved refrigerant. The inability to protect against the
spread of contaminated refrigerant threatens the recycling program and the industry's desire to
maximize use of the remaining R12 supply.
Beginning in 1993, General Motors STG, Harrison Division, Research Labs and Kent-Moore
worked in conjunction with suppliers of various technologies to develop a tester to identify
contaminated refrigerant in vehicle A/C systems before recovery. During development of the
technology, several dealer service manager focus group studies were conducted to identify design
features to best suit dealership needs.
The discussions and surveys clearly indicated the desire for a dedicated instrument, permanently
mounted to the refrigerant recovery cart to ensure ALL vehicles are automatically tested prior to
recovering refrigerant. Testing ALL refrigerant for contamination prior to recovery is the ONLY
means to ensure customer satisfaction, protect recovery equipment and avoid unintentional venting
of refrigerant by your dealership.
General Motors has evaluated all available technology for this project and only the J 39851 R12
"Pureguard" meets General Motors' specifications. The J 39851 R12 Pureguard Refrigerant
Monitor has been classified as an essential tool and will be shipped by Kent-Moore to your
dealership beginning in September of 1994. The essential price of the R12 "Pureguard" is $561 (for
Canadian dealers the price is $800 Canadian). If your dealership has multiple R12 recovery
equipment, additional units may be ordered from Kent-Moore for $561 at 1-800-345-2233. Features
of the R12 "Pureguard" include:
- Universally mounts to R12 Recovery Equipment
- Automatically interrupts power to the Recovery Equipment when contaminated refrigerant is
identified
- Fully automatic design does not require technician action, training or interpretation
- LCD displays Pureguard functions
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431223 > Sep > 94 > A/C Refrigerant - Contamination > Page 1287
- Meets GM contamination sensitivity requirements
- Self calibrating
- Micro-processor controlled
- Audio alarm alerts technician
Other Refrigerant Identifiers are being advertised which may be available this A/C season.
However, ONLY the Kent-Moore J 39851 R12 "Pureguard" meets General Motors' current
specifications which ensure recovered refrigerant is compatible with General Motors vehicles and
General Motors approved recovery systems.
An R134a Pureguard Refrigerant Identifier is currently under development and is anticipated to be
available in early 1995. The contamination of R134a refrigerant is not expected to be a concern
until the program to retrofit R12 vehicles to R134a becomes more widely used.
Future bulletins will be issued to address the recovery and disposal of contaminated refrigerant.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 331226 > Jan > 94 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 Vehicles to R-134A
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Retrofitting R-12 Vehicles to R-134A
Group Ref.: HVAC
Bulletin No.: 331226
Date: January, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: RETROFITTING R-12 VEHICLES TO R-134a
MODELS: 1994 AND PRIOR YEARS, PASSENGER CARS AND TRUCKS WITH R-12 A/C
SYSTEMS
There has been a great deal of information presented by the media regarding the need to retrofit
vehicles produced with R-12, to a substitute refrigerant. This bulletin will outline GM's position and
future plans on this subject.
Most important, there is currently NO requirement to retrofit any R-12 vehicle. Vehicles built with
R-12 can be serviced with R-12, as long as the refrigerant is available. At some point in time, R-12
may become either too scarce or too expensive to economically justify service on some vehicles
with R-12. By that time, GM will provide you with instructions on retrofitting those vehicles from
R-12 to R-134a.
GM vehicle divisions, platforms, and component suppliers have been actively working on the
details of retrofitting R-12 vehicles. An enormous amount of work is required to determine how
hundreds of vehicle models can be satisfactorily retrofitted. Additional information will be provided
as it becomes available.
The following items contain important technical information that should answer many of the
questions, and correct some misconceptions reported in the media.
SUBSTITUTE REFRIGERANTS
R-134a is the only approved substitute refrigerant that GM recommends and it should only be used
if a complete retrofit procedure has been performed. None of the other refrigerants currently being
marketed as replacement or drop-in substitutes for R-12 are approved for use in GM vehicles.
R-12 and R-134a are not interchangeable. R-134a cannot be added to fill a low R-12 system. The
combination of the two materials can cause high system pressures, which could cause damage to
the system.
Retrofitting an R-12 vehicle to R-134a requires careful preparation to insure that neither the vehicle
nor the A/C service equipment has become contaminated.
RESIDUAL MINERAL OIL
The concern that mineral oil is chemically incompatible with R-134a and/or PAG lubricant has been
proven to be untrue. A normal charge of mineral oil left in the A/C system after a retrofit to R-134a
will not damage the system. Mineral oil, however, does not mix well with R-134a, and will not
provide adequate lubrication. Tests on both the orifice tube and TXV systems show that the mineral
oil parks in places such as the accumulator, and does not appreciably affect performance or
damage the system. The retrofit service bulletin will specify the correct oil to be used. It is important
that this oil recommendation be followed carefully.
RESIDUAL R-12
Residual R-12 left in a system, due to improper retrofit service procedures, may result in system
damage unless the residual R-12 is kept below the 2 percent limit specified by the Society of
Automotive Engineers' Specification J-1661. New service methods are being developed to
minimize the level of R-12 remaining in the A/C system after the retrofit procedure is completed.
Following these new procedures will be critical to insure that the above limits are met.
SYSTEM FLUSHING
R-11, a material commonly used as an A/C system flushing solvent, has been found to be
chemically incompatible with PAG lubricant. Technicians should be aware that residual R-11
remaining in an R-12 system will be very damaging if the vehicle is retrofitted to R-134a later in its
life. For many years GM has recommended the use of in-line filters as an alternative to system
flushing.
SYSTEM FLUSHING, USING EITHER R-11 OR ANY OTHER FLUSHING MATERIAL, IS NOT
APPROVED BY GM FOR ANY A/C SYSTEM.
DESICCANT PROTECTION
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 331226 > Jan > 94 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 Vehicles to R-134A > Page
1292
It has been reported that the desiccant (moisture absorption material) used in 1992 and older R-12
A/C systems is incompatible with R-134a and PAG oil. The older desiccant was designed
specifically for R-12 systems, but testing has shown that it is NOT necessary to replace the older
desiccant just because the vehicle is being retrofitted to R-134a. 1993 and newer GM vehicles use
desiccant designed to be compatible with both R-12 and R-134a systems.
The amount of desiccant used in most GM vehicles is designed to last for at least seven years. To
help maintain adequate protection for vehicles that must be retrofitted, it is recommended that the
accumulator/dryer, which contains the desiccant, be replaced if the vehicle is more than five years
old.
"O" RINGS
While continuing to service with R-12, be sure to use "O" rings and seal materials which are
compatible with R-134a and PAG oil. This practice will eliminate concern in case the vehicle
requires retrofitting later in its life. All "O" rings and seal materials available from GMSPO are
compatible with R-134a systems.
RETROFITTED SYSTEM PERFORMANCE
Currently, it appears that for most GM vehicles, the retrofit procedure will require minimal changes
to the existing system. Some vehicles may need additional parts and/or procedures to provide
acceptable performance and/or durability. Our testing has shown that vehicles that have undergone
recommended retrofit procedures will, in most climatic conditions, be minimally affected in terms of
A/C performance.
SERVICE POLICY
Basic service policy is as follows:
During Warranty - If an R-12 produced vehicle A/C system must be repaired or recharged under
warranty, repairs will be completed using R-12. If R-12 is unavailable or unaffordable, GM will notify
the dealer body and will pay for the warranty repair and the retrofit to R-134a.
NOTE:
It a customer requests that an in-warranty vehicle be converted to R-134a, and the R-12 system is
functioning properly, the customer will be expected to pay for the retrofit.
Out of Warranty - The cost of the conversion will be the responsibility of the customer.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 331228 > Dec > 93 > A/C - Refrigerant Production Change R12 to R134a
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Production Change R12 to R134a
Group Ref.: HVAC Bulletin No.: 331228 Date: December, 1993
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: REFRIGERANT CHANGE IN PRODUCTION VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIR
CONDITIONING (RPO C60)
MODELS: 1994 CHEVROLET CAVALIER 1994 PONTIAC SUNBIRD
Vehicles produced on and after January 3, 1994 equipped with air conditioning (RPO C60) will be
charged with R134a. This includes vehicles produced at both the Lordstown and Ramos assembly
plants. To identify this change, the vehicles charged with R134a will have the RPO code KR1 in
addition to RPO code C60. Also, an underhood sticker will indicate the use of R134a and proper
charge amount.
With the exception of the special tools needed to service R134a, service diagnostics and
procedures are generally the same as vehicles previously produced with R12. This information can
be located in Section 1B of the appropriate service manual.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 922501A > Aug > 92 > A/C - Use of Alternate Refrigerants In CFC 12
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Use of Alternate Refrigerants In CFC 12
Number: 92-250-1A
Section: 0A
Date: AUGUST 1992
Corporate Bulletin No.: 231205
ASE No.: A7
Subject: USE OF ALTERNATE REFRIGERANTS IN CFC 12 REFRIGERANT MOBILE AIR
CONDITIONERS
Model and Year: GALL MODEL YEARS - ALL PASSENGER CARS AND TRUCKS INCLUDING
GEO
A number of inquiries have been received concerning the use of "alternate refrigerants" as a
replacement for R-12 refrigerant in General Motors air conditioning systems.
Regardless of any advertised claims, there are currently no substitutes for refrigerant R-12
approved by General Motors. At the present time, only new or recycled R-12 is approved for use in
General Motors R-12 air conditioning systems.
Based on studies performed to date, the use of "alternate refrigerants" in General Motors R-12 air
conditioning systems may result in higher system pressures, higher leak rates or incompatibility
with drying and sealing materials. System performance and reliability may also be affected.
Service equipment manufacturers have indicated that cross-contaminating R-12 recovery/recycling
equipment with "alternate refrigerants" may damage the equipment. General Motors supports the
Society of Automotive Engineers recommended service procedures for recovery and recycling of
R-12. The use of known "alternate refrigerants" without proper service practices for identifying
vehicle systems containing these "alternate refrigerants" and dedicated recovery equipment to
service those vehicles will contaminate the recycled supply of R-12 refrigerant. Contamination of
the recycled R-12 refrigerant makes the refrigerant unusable for recharging air conditioning
systems and could jeopardize the recycling program.
At the present time, General Motors has not approved any "alternate refrigerant" for R-12 in R-12
air conditioning systems. Therefore, R-12 systems should continue to be serviced with new or
recycled R-12 only.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > Page 1301
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Contaminated R134A Refrigerant
Bulletin No.: 06-01-39-007
Date: July 25, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Contaminated R134a Refrigerant Found on Market for Automotive Air-Conditioning
Systems
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2007 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2007 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Attention:
This bulletin should be directed to the Service Manager as well as the Parts Manager.
Commercially Available Contaminated R134a Refrigerant
Impurities have been found in new commercially available containers of R134a. High levels of
contaminates may cause decreased performance, and be detrimental to some air-conditioning
components. Accompanying these contaminates has been high levels of moisture.
Tip:
Excessive moisture may cause system concerns such as orifice tube freeze-up and reduced
performance.
Industry Reaction: New Industry Purity Standards
Due to the potential availability of these lower quality refrigerants, the Society of Automotive
Engineers (SAE), and the Air Conditioning and Refrigeration Industry (ARI) are in the process of
instituting reliable standards that will be carried on the labels of future R134a refrigerant containers.
This identifying symbol will be your assurance of a product that conforms to the minimum standard
for OEM Automotive Air-Conditioning use.
How Can You Protect Yourself Today?
It is recommended to use GM or ACDelco(R) sourced refrigerants for all A/C repair work. These
refrigerants meet General Motors own internal standards for quality and purity, insuring that your
completed repairs are as good as the way it left the factory.
Parts Information
The part numbers shown are available through GMSPO or ACDelco(R). The nearest ACDelco(R)
distributor in your area can be found by calling 1-800-223-3526 (U.S. Only).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > Page 1302
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > Page 1303
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
File In Section: 01 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 99-01-38-006A
Date: May, 2000
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
Subject: J-43600 ACR 2000 Essential Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
Models: 1993-2000 Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks with R-134a Refrigerant
This bulletin is being revised to change the effective date and to update the text. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 99-01-38-006 (Section 01 - HVAC).
Effective June 1, 2000, the use of J-43600 ACR 2000 will be required on all repairs that require A/C
system recovery and are reimbursable by GM. Additionally, GM highly recommends that J-43600
ACR 2000 be used on all GM cars and trucks for customer paid A/C repairs.
Important:
Also effective June 1, 2000, the "Add" time for all air conditioning recovery is revised to 0.5 hours
for front systems and 0.7 hours for front/rear dual systems (RPO C69 or C34). After June 1, 2000,
all air conditioning claims submitted with the 0.9 hours "Add" time will be rejected for "labor hours
excessive".
After the completion of repairs (charging), the ACR 2000 will prompt the user to perform a snapshot
of the air conditioning system operating data. The snapshot includes:
^ Maximum high side pressure.
^ Minimum low side pressure.
^ Duct outlet temperatures (2).
^ Refrigerant purity information.
This information is captured on a paper printout and in a warranty code.
For all GM paid repairs, the paper printout should be attached to the shop copy of the repair order.
The warranty code must be submitted in the warranty claim information in the comments field. The
code enables the reporting of valuable information about the repair to GM for product quality
improvement. Claims submitted without this information may be subject to review and subsequent
debit.
The required use of J-43600 ACR 2000 raises the question of the acceptable uses for any existing
recovery/recycle equipment that GM dealers are currently using. GM recognizes that many of the
previously essential ACR4's are reaching the end of their useful life. There are several alternatives
for existing equipment that may be considered:
^ Use the existing equipment as customer paid recovery only equipment. Example: Collision repair
area.
^ Use the existing equipment as a scavenger unit for contaminated A/C systems.
^ Sell the existing units to repair facilities outside the GM dealer network.
^ Discontinue the use of the existing units if the repair/maintenance costs exceed the value of the
equipment.
^ Donate the existing equipment to local technical schools.
^ Dedicate the ACR4 to A/C system flushing, using the J-42939 Flush Adapter.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > Page 1304
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > Page 1305
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Production Change R12 to R134a
Group Ref.: HVAC Bulletin No.: 331228 Date: December, 1993
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: REFRIGERANT CHANGE IN PRODUCTION VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIR
CONDITIONING (RPO C60)
MODELS: 1994 CHEVROLET CAVALIER 1994 PONTIAC SUNBIRD
Vehicles produced on and after January 3, 1994 equipped with air conditioning (RPO C60) will be
charged with R134a. This includes vehicles produced at both the Lordstown and Ramos assembly
plants. To identify this change, the vehicles charged with R134a will have the RPO code KR1 in
addition to RPO code C60. Also, an underhood sticker will indicate the use of R134a and proper
charge amount.
With the exception of the special tools needed to service R134a, service diagnostics and
procedures are generally the same as vehicles previously produced with R12. This information can
be located in Section 1B of the appropriate service manual.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Page 1306
Refrigerant: Specifications
Refrigerant Capacity, Lbs. ...................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 1.5 Refrigerant Type .............................................
............................................................................................................................................................
R-134a Refrigeration Oil
Viscosity ..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ [02] Total System Capacity, Ounces ..........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
9 Compressor Oil Level .......................................................................................................................
........................................................................... [01]
Compressor Clutch Air Gap, Inch ........................................................................................................
................................................................... .015-.020
[01] Note that "Oil Level" cannot be checked. Refer to total capacity in ounces. [02] PAG
(Polyalkylene Glycol) synthetic refrigerant oil, GM part No. 12345923 or equivalent.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > A/C - New PAG Oil
Refrigerant Oil: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - New PAG Oil
Bulletin No.: 02-01-39-004B
Date: November 16, 2005
INFORMATION
Subject: New PAG Oil Released
Models: 2006 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2006 HUMMER
H2 2006 HUMMER H3 2005-2006 Saab 9-7X
Built With R-134a Refrigeration System
All Air Conditioning Compressor Types (Excluding R4 and A6 Type Compressors)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to change the PAG oil part number used for R4 and A6 compressors
with R-134a refrigerant systems. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-01-39-004A
(Section 01 - HVAC).
All General Motors vehicles built with R-134a refrigerant systems shall now be serviced with GM
Universal PAG Oil (excluding vehicles equipped with an R4 or A6 compressor).
R4 and A6 compressors with R-134a refrigerant systems shall use PAG OIL, GM P/N 12356151
(A/C Delco part number 15-118) (in Canada, use P/N 10953486).
Important:
The PAG oil referenced in this bulletin is formulated with specific additive packages that meet
General Motors specifications and use of another oil may void the A/C systems warranty.
Use this new PAG oil when servicing the A/C system on the vehicles listed above. Oil packaged in
an 8 oz tube should be installed using A/C Oil Injector, J 45037. Refer to the HVAC Section of
Service Information for detailed information on Oil Balancing and Capacities.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Refrigerant Oil: Capacity Specifications
Compressor Model [01] .......................................................................................................................
............................................................................ V-5 Oil Charge (FL. Oz.) When Replacing
Component
Compressor .........................................................................................................................................
............................................................................. [03]
Evaporator ...........................................................................................................................................
................................................................................. 3 Condenser ......................................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
........ 1 Accumulator .............................................................................................................................
......................................................................................... 3.5
[01] Variable displacement compressor. [03] Drain oil from old compressor and measure, then
drain new compressor. If more than one ounce is drained from old compressor, add same amount
to new compressor. If less than one ounce is drained from compressor, add two ounces.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 1313
Refrigerant Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
REFRIGERANT OIL TYPE
^ R-134a PAG (Polyalkaline Glycol) synthetic refrigerant oil (GM Part No. 12345923) or equivalent.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > With ABS
System
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair With ABS System
Manual Bleeding
1. Remove master cylinder reservoir cover, then fill reservoir as necessary. 2. Attach one end of a
clear plastic hose to rear bleeder valve of the brake control assembly, then put opposite end of the
hose into a clean container. 3. While depressing brake pedal, slowly open bleeder valve, until fluid
begins to flow. 4. Close valve and release brake pedal, then repeat procedure for front bleeder
valve. 5. Ensure master cylinder is full, then raise and support vehicle. 6. Bleed wheel cylinders
and calipers using the following sequence:
a. Right rear. b. Left rear. c. Right front. d. Left front.
7. Lower vehicle and check fluid level in reservoir, fill as necessary. 8. Turn on ignition and note
pedal travel and feel as follows:
a. If pedal feels firm and constant, start the engine and recheck pedal travel. If pedal still feels firm
and constant, continue procedure. b. If pedal feels soft or has excessive travel either initially or
after engine is started, repeat bleeding procedure.
9. Road test vehicle, make several normal stops from a moderate speed, then make one or two
ABS stops at approximately 50 mph.
10. Ensure pedal is still firm and constant.
Pressure Bleeding
NOTE: To prevent air, moisture and other contaminants from entering system, only diaphragm type
pressure bleeding equipment should be used.
1. Attach bleeder adapter tool No. J35589, or equivalent, to master cylinder reservoir, then the
adapter tool to the pressure bleeder. 2. Connect a clear plastic hose to the front bleeder valve on
the control assembly, then put opposite end of the hose into a clean container partially
filled with brake fluid.
3. Set pressure bleeder to 5-10 psi and wait for approximately 30 seconds to ensure there is no
leakage. 4. Set pressure bleed equipment to 30-35 psi. 5. Slowly open bleeder valve and allow fluid
to flow into container until no air bubbles are seen in fluid, then close the bleeder valve and torque
to
65 inch lbs.
6. Attach bleeder hose to rear bleeder valve of the control assembly and repeat preceding step. 7.
Position a cloth under hydraulic brake pipe connections. 8. Working from front of the control
assembly to the rear, slowly turn each pipe nut and check for air in escaping fluid. 9. When air flow
ceases, torque pipe nut to 13 ft. lbs.
10. Raise and support vehicle, then bleed wheel cylinders and calipers using the following
sequence:
a. Right rear. b. Left rear. c. Right front. d. Left front.
11. Lower vehicle and remove bleeder adapter tool from master cylinder. 12. Check fluid level in
reservoir, fill as necessary. 13. Turn ignition switch to On position and note pedal travel and feel as
follows:
a. If pedal feels firm and constant, start the engine and recheck pedal travel. If pedal still feels firm
and constant, continue procedure. b. If pedal feels soft or has excessive travel either initially or
after engine is started, repeat bleeding procedure.
14. Road test vehicle, make several normal stops from a moderate speed, then make one or two
ABS stops at approximately 50 mph. 15. Ensure pedal is still firm and constant.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > With ABS
System > Page 1318
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Without ABS System
Manual
Fig. 210 Brake System Manual Bleed.
NOTE: Pressure bleeding is recommended for all hydraulic systems. However, if a pressure
bleeder is unavailable, use the following procedure. Brake fluid damages painted surfaces.
Immediately clean any spilled fluid.
1. Remove vacuum reserve by pumping brakes several times with engine off. 2. Fill master cylinder
reservoir with clean brake fluid. Check fluid level often during bleeding procedure; do not let
reservoir fall below half full. 3. If necessary, bleed master cylinder as follows:
a. Disconnect master cylinder forward brake line connection until fluid flows from reservoir.
Reconnect and tighten brake line. b. Instruct an assistant to slowly depress brake pedal one time
and hold. c. Crack open front brake line connection again, purging air from cylinder. d. Retighten
connection and slowly release brake pedal. e. Wait 15 seconds, then repeat until all air is purged. f.
Bleed the rearward (nearest the cowl) brake line connection by repeating steps a through e.
4. Loosen, then slightly retighten bleeder valves at all four wheels. Repair any broken, stripped or
frozen valves at this time. 5. Proceed to appropriate wheel first and follow set sequence according
to Wheel Bleeding Sequence. 6. Place transparent tube over bleeder valve, then allow tube to
hang down into transparent container, Fig. 16. Ensure end of tube is submerged in
clean brake fluid.
7. Instruct an assistant to slowly depress brake pedal one time and hold. 8. Crack open bleeder
valve, purging air from cylinder. Retighten bleeder screw and slowly release pedal. 9. Wait 15
seconds, then repeat steps 7 and 8. Repeat these steps until all air is bled from system.
Pressure
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > With ABS
System > Page 1319
Fig. 21 Installing Pressure Bleeder Adapter
Fig. 210 Brake System Manual Bleed.
1. Loosen, then slightly retighten bleeder valves at all four wheels. Repair any broken, stripped or
frozen valves at this time. 2. Using a diaphragm type pressure bleeder, install suitable bleeder
adapter to master cylinder, Fig. 17. 3. Charge bleeder ball to 20-25 psi. 4. Connect pressure
bleeder line to adapter. 5. Open line valve on pressure bleeder, then depress bleed-off valve on
adapter until a small amount of brake fluid is released. 6. Raise and support vehicle. 7. Proceed to
appropriate wheel first and follow set sequence according to Wheel Bleeding Sequence. 8. Place
transparent tube over bleeder valve, then allow tube to hang down into transparent container, Fig.
16. Ensure end of tube is submerged in
clean brake fluid.
9. Open bleeder valve 1/2 to 3/4 turn and allow fluid to flow into container until all air is purged from
line.
Front Disc Brakes
NOTE: Pressure bleeding is recommended for all hydraulic disc brake systems.
The disc brake hydraulic system can be bled manually or with pressure bleeding equipment. On
vehicles with disc brakes the brake pedal will require more pumping and frequent checking of fluid
level in master cylinder during bleeding operation.
Never use brake fluid that has been drained from hydraulic system when bleeding the brakes. Be
sure the disc brake pistons are returned to their normal positions and that the shoe and lining
assemblies are properly seated. Before driving the vehicle, check brake operation to be sure that a
firm
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair > With ABS
System > Page 1320
pedal has been obtained.
Wheel Bleeding Sequence
Rear wheel drive models: if manual bleeding, RR-LR-RF-LF; if pressure bleeding, bleed front
brakes together and rear brakes together. Front wheel drive models: RR-LF-LR-RF
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Specifications
Circuit Breaker: Specifications
Fuse Block Details: Front View Of Fuse Block
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 1325
Fuse Block Details: Description
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Locations > DRL-In-Line Fuse
Circuit Breaker: Locations DRL-In-Line Fuse
DRL-In-Line Fuse is located LH rear of Engine Compartment, near EBCM
DRL-In-Line Fuse is located LH rear of Engine Compartment, near EBCM
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Locations > DRL-In-Line Fuse > Page 1328
Circuit Breaker: Locations Front View of Fuse Block
Fuse Block Details: Front View Of Fuse Block
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Locations > DRL-In-Line Fuse > Page 1329
Fuse Block Details: Description
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Locations > DRL-In-Line Fuse > Page 1330
Circuit Breaker: Locations Fuse Block
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Locations > DRL-In-Line Fuse > Page 1331
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Locations > DRL-In-Line Fuse > Page 1332
LH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Locations > DRL-In-Line Fuse > Page 1333
LH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Breaker: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1336
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1337
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1338
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1339
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1340
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1341
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1342
Circuit Breaker: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1343
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1344
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1345
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1346
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1347
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1348
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1349
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1350
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1351
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1352
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1353
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1354
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1355
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1356
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1357
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1358
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1359
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1360
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1361
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1362
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1363
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1364
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1365
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1366
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1367
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1368
Circuit Breaker: Electrical Diagrams
Fuse Block Details: WDO Circuit Breaker And HTR-A/C Fuse (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1369
Fuse Block Details: WDO Circuit Breaker And HTR-A/C Fuse (Part 2 Of 2)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1370
Fuse Block Details: RDO 1 Fuse, S/LP Fuse, And PWR ACC Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 1371
Circuit Breaker: Application and ID
Fuse Block Details: Front View Of Fuse Block
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Circuit Breaker > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 1372
Fuse Block Details: Description
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical - Aftermarket Fuse Warning
Fuse: Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Aftermarket Fuse Warning
Bulletin No.: 07-08-45-002
Date: September 05, 2007
ADVANCED SERVICE INFORMATION
Subject: Service Alert: Concerns With Aftermarket Fuses in GM Vehicles
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2008 and
Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2008 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Concerns with Harbor Freight Tools "Storehouse" Branded Blade Type Fuses
General Motors has become aware of a fuse recall by Harbor Freight Tools/Storehouse for a
variety of aftermarket fuses. In two cases, these fuses have not provided protection for the wiring
system of the vehicles they were customer installed in.
Upon testing the 15 amp version, it was found that the fuse still would not "open" when shorted
directly across the battery terminals.
How to Identify These Fuses
Packed in a 120 piece set, the fuse has a translucent, hard plastic, blue body with the amperage
stamped into the top. There are no white painted numbers on the fuse to indicate amperage. There
are no identifying marks on the fuse to tell who is making it. The fuses are known to be distributed
by Harbor Freight Tools but there may be other marketers, and packaging of this style of fuse. It
would be prudent to replace these fuses if found in a customers vehicle. Likewise, if wiring
overheating is found you should check the fuse panel for the presence of this style of fuse.
All GM dealers should use genuine GM fuses on the vehicles they service. You should also
encourage the use of GM fuses to your customers to assure they are getting the required electrical
system protection. GM has no knowledge of any concerns with other aftermarket fuses. If
additional information becomes available, this bulletin will be updated.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 1377
Fuse: Specifications
Fuse Block Details: Front View Of Fuse Block
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 1378
Fuse Block Details: Description
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Fuse Rating - Front View of Fuse Block
Fuse: Locations Fuse Rating - Front View of Fuse Block
Fuse Block Details: Front View Of Fuse Block
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Fuse Rating - Front View of Fuse Block > Page 1381
Fuse Block Details: Description
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Fuse Rating - Front View of Fuse Block > Page 1382
Fuse: Locations DRL-In-Line Fuse
DRL-In-Line Fuse is located LH rear of Engine Compartment, near EBCM
DRL-In-Line Fuse is located LH rear of Engine Compartment, near EBCM
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Fuse Rating - Front View of Fuse Block > Page 1383
Fuse: Locations Fuse Block
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Fuse Rating - Front View of Fuse Block > Page 1384
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Fuse Rating - Front View of Fuse Block > Page 1385
LH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Fuse Rating - Front View of Fuse Block > Page 1386
LH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1387
Fuse: Application and ID
Fuse Block Details: Front View Of Fuse Block
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse > Component Information > Locations >
Page 1388
Fuse Block Details: Description
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Fuse Block: Component Locations
The fuse panel is located on the left side of the instrument panel. To gain access to the panel, pivot
access door downward.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 1393
Fuse Block: Fuse and Fusible Link Locations
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 1394
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 1395
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuse Block: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1398
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1399
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1400
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1401
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1402
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1403
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1404
Fuse Block: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1405
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1406
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1407
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1408
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1409
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1410
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1411
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1412
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1413
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1414
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1415
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1416
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1417
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1418
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1419
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1420
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1421
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1422
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1423
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1424
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1425
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1426
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1427
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1428
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1429
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1430
Fuse Block: Electrical Diagrams
Fuse Block Details: Gages Fuse, F/P Fuse, Turn B/U Fuse And ECM Fuse (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1431
Fuse Block Details: Gages Fuse, F/P Fuse, Turn B/U Fuse And ECM Fuse (Part 2 Of 2)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1432
Fuse Block Details: WDO Circuit Breaker And HTR-A/C Fuse (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1433
Fuse Block Details: WDO Circuit Breaker And HTR-A/C Fuse (Part 2 Of 2)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1434
Fuse Block Details: Wiper Fuse, Cruise Fuse, RDO 2 Fuse And CIG LTR Fuse
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1435
Fuse Block Details: RDO 1 Fuse, S/LP Fuse, And PWR ACC Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1436
Fuse Block Details: CTSY Fuse (Coupe, Sedan And Station Wagon)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1437
Fuse Block Details: CTSY Fuse (Convertible)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 1438
Fuse Block: Application and ID
Fuse Block Details: Front View Of Fuse Block
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fuse Block > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 1439
Fuse Block Details: Description
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fusible Link > Component Information >
Locations > Fusible Link D
LH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fuses and Circuit Breakers > Fusible Link > Component Information >
Locations > Fusible Link D > Page 1444
LH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Coolant Level Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Coolant Level Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
This lamp will be illuminated when engine coolant level in the radiator drops below a predetermined
level. To turn lamp off, check cooling system, then add coolant to bring system to proper level.
OPERATION
Some vehicles use a buzzer or indicator lamp to convey a low coolant level condition. The buzzer
or lamp is activated by a sensor, located in the radiator, when the coolant level becomes one quart
low, or more.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Service and Repair
The check "engine lamp", "service engine soon" or "malfunction indiactor" lamp will be illuminated
when the ignition switch is placed in the "ON" position. When the engine is started, the lamp should
go "OFF." If the lamp remains "ON" for 10 seconds or constantly after the engine is started, the self
diagnosis system has detected a problem and has stored a code in the system Electronic Control
Module (ECM/PCM). After diagnosis and repair, the ECM/PCM memory can be cleared of codes
as follows:
Remove the ECM/PCM fuse or disconnect the battery ground cable for approximately 30 seconds,
with ignition switch in the "OFF" position. It should be noted, if battery ground cable is disconnected
to clear codes, components such as clocks, electronically tuned radios etc., will have to be reset.
On vehicles that are equipped as such, the ECM/PCM power feed is connected by a pigtail, in-line
fuse holder, at the positive battery terminal. To clear codes within the ECM/PCM system and
protect the components that need resetting, disconnect the in-line fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Service Reminder Indicators > Oil Level Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Oil Level Warning Indicator: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
This lamp illuminates to warn the driver that the engine oil level is low. When the ignition switch is
first moved to Run, the oil level indicator lights for about 1 1/2 seconds as a bulb check. The oil
level detection circuit has two internal timers. The first timer records the amount of time the ignition
has been Off. The second timer records the amount of time the ignition has been On before the
ignition was shut Off. The instrument cluster uses this information to determine if the engine has
been sitting long enough for the oil to have returned to the oil pan.
OPERATION
The oil level monitoring circuits will check the oil level switch under the following conditions:
1. Ignition has been turned Off for more than 30 minutes. 2. Ignition has been Off for at least three
minutes after ignition has been On for at least 12 minutes.
If the oil level is low (oil level switch open), the "Check Oil" indicator will be turned On for the
remainder of the ignition cycle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires
Tires: Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-03-10-020C
Date: April 27, 2010
Subject: Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 05-03-10-020B (Section 03 - Suspension).
GM's Position on the Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires
General Motors does not oppose the use of purified nitrogen as an inflation gas for tires. We expect
the theoretical benefits to be reduced in practical use due to the lack of an existing infrastructure to
continuously facilitate inflating tires with nearly pure nitrogen. Even occasional inflation with
compressed atmospheric air will negate many of the theoretical benefits. Given those theoretical
benefits, practical limitations, and the robust design of GM original equipment TPC tires, the
realized benefits to our customer of inflating their tires with purified nitrogen are expected to be
minimal.
The Promise of Nitrogen: Under Controlled Conditions
Recently, nitrogen gas (for use in inflating tires) has become available to the general consumer
through some retailers. The use of nitrogen gas to inflate tires is a technology used in automobile
racing. The following benefits under controlled conditions are attributed to nitrogen gas and its
unique properties:
- A reduction in the expected loss of Tire Pressure over time.
- A reduction in the variance of Tire Pressures with temperature changes due to reduction of water
vapor concentration.
- A reduction of long term rubber degradation due to a decrease in oxygen concentrations.
Important These are obtainable performance improvements when relatively pure nitrogen gas is
used to inflate tires under controlled conditions.
The Promise of Nitrogen: Real World Use
Nitrogen inflation can provide some benefit by reducing gas migration (pressure loss) at the
molecular level through the tire structure. NHTSA (National Highway Traffic Safety Administration)
has stated that the inflation pressure loss of tires can be up to 5% a month. Nitrogen molecules are
larger than oxygen molecules and, therefore, are less prone to "seeping" through the tire casing.
The actual obtainable benefits of nitrogen vary, based on the physical construction and the
materials used in the manufacturing of the tire being inflated.
Another potential benefit of nitrogen is the reduced oxidation of tire components. Research has
demonstrated that oxygen consumed in the oxidation process of the tire primarily comes from the
inflation media. Therefore, it is reasonable to assume that oxidation of tire components can be
reduced if the tire is inflated with pure nitrogen. However, only very small amounts of oxygen are
required to begin the normal oxidation process. Even slight contamination of the tire inflation gas
with compressed atmospheric air during normal inflation pressure maintenance, may negate the
benefits of using nitrogen.
GM Tire Quality, Technology and Focus of Importance
Since 1972, General Motors has designed tires under the TPC (Tire Performance Criteria)
specification system, which includes specific requirements that ensure robust tire performance
under normal usage. General Motors works with tire suppliers to design and manufacture original
equipment tires for GM vehicles. The GM TPC addresses required performance with respect to
both inflation pressure retention, and endurance properties for original equipment tires. The
inflation pressure retention requirements address availability of oxygen and oxidation concerns,
while endurance requirements ensure the mechanical structure of the tire has sufficient strength.
This combination has provided our customers with tires that maintain their structural integrity
throughout their useful treadlife under normal operating conditions.
Regardless of the inflation media for tires (atmospheric air or nitrogen), inflation pressure
maintenance of tires is critical for overall tire, and ultimately, vehicle performance. Maintaining the
correct inflation pressure allows the tire to perform as intended by the vehicle manufacturer in
many areas, including comfort, fuel economy, stopping distance, cornering, traction, treadwear,
and noise. Since the load carrying capability of a tire is related to inflation pressure, proper inflation
pressure maintenance is necessary for the tire to support the load imposed by the vehicle without
excessive structural
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires > Page 1460
degradation.
Important Regardless of the inflation media for tires (atmospheric air or nitrogen), inflation pressure
maintenance of tires is critical for overall tire, and ultimately, vehicle performance.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires > Page 1461
Tires: Technical Service Bulletins Tires/Wheels - Tire Puncture Repair Procedures
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-03-10-001F
Date: April 27, 2010
Subject: Tire Puncture Repair Procedures For All Cars and Light Duty Trucks
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-03-10-001E (Section 03 - Suspension).
This bulletin covers puncture repair procedures for passenger car and light duty truck radial tires in
the tread area only. The tire manufacturer must be contacted for its individual repair policy and
whether or not the speed rating is retained after repair.
Caution
- Tire changing can be dangerous and should be done by trained professionals using proper tools
and procedures. Always read and understand any manufacturer's warnings contained in their
customers literature or molded into the tire sidewall.
- Serious eye and ear injury may result from not wearing adequate eye and ear protection while
repairing tires.
- NEVER inflate beyond 275 kPa (40 pounds) pressure to seat beads.
Some run flat tires, such as the Goodyear Extended Mobility Tire (EMT) used on the Corvette, may
require more than 275 kPa (40 psi) to seat the bead. In such a case, a tire safety cage must be
used. Consult the tire manufacturer for its individual repair policy.
- NEVER stand, lean or reach over the assembly during inflation.
Repairable area on a radial tire.
Important
- NEVER repair tires worn to the tread indicators 1.59 mm (2/32") remaining depth).
- NEVER repair tires with a tread puncture larger than 6.35 mm (1/4").
- NEVER substitute an inner tube for a permissible or non-permissible repair.
- NEVER perform an outside-in tire repair (plug only, on the wheel).
- Every tire must be removed from the wheel for proper inspection and repair.
- Regardless of the type of repair used, the repair must seal the inner liner and fill the injury.
- Consult with repair material supplier/manufacturer for repair unit application procedures and
repair tools/repair material recommendations.
Three basic steps for tire puncture repair:
1. Remove the tire from the wheel for inspection and repair.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires > Page 1462
2. Fill the injury (puncture) to keep moisture out. 3. Seal the inner liner with a repair unit to prevent
air loss.
External Inspection
1. Prior to demounting, inspect the tire surface, the valve and the wheel for the source of the leak
by using a water and soap solution. Mark the
injured area and totally deflate the tire by removing the valve core.
2. Demount the tire from the wheel and place the tire on a well-lighted spreader.
Internal Inspection
1. Spread the beads and mark the puncture with a tire crayon. 2. Inspect the inner tire for any signs
of internal damage. 3. Remove the puncturing object, noting the direction of the penetration. 4.
Probe the injury with a blunt awl in order to determine the extent and direction of the injury. 5.
Remove any loose foreign material from the injury. 6. Punctures exceeding 6.35 mm (1/4") should
not be repaired.
Cleaning
1. Clean the area around the puncture thoroughly with a proper liner cleaner, clean cloth and a
scraper. This step serves to remove dirt and mold
lubricants to insure proper adhesion and non-contamination of the buffing tool.
2. Refer to information on the product or manufacturer's Material Safety Data Sheet and follow
guidelines for handling and disposal.
Clean the Injury Channel
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires > Page 1463
1. Use a proper hand reamer, carbide cutter or drill bit to ream the puncture channel from the inside
of the tire in order to clean the injury. 2. Remove steel wires protruding above the liner surface to
prevent damage to the repair unit. 3. Consult your repair material supplier for recommended
reaming tool(s).
Fill the Injury
1. It is necessary to fill the injury channel to provide back up for the repair unit and to prevent
moisture from entering the tire fabric and steel wires. 2. (For combination repair/plug units skip this
step.) Cement the injured channel and fill the injury from the inside of the tire with the repair plug
per
repair material manufacturer's recommendations. Without stretching the plug, cut the plug off just
above the inside tire surface.
3. Consult your repair material supplier for proper repair material selection.
Repair Unit Selection
Important Do not install the repair unit in this step.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires > Page 1464
1. Center the repair unit over the injury as a reference and outline an area larger than the unit so
that buffing will not remove the crayon marks. 2. Remove the repair unit. 3. DO NOT overlap
previous or multiple repair units. 4. Consult your repair material supplier for proper repair unit
selection.
Buffing
1. To prevent contamination and preserve the outline, buff within the marked area thoroughly and
evenly with a low speed buffing tool using a fine
wire brush or gritted rasp.
2. Buff to a smooth velvet surface (RMA #1 or #2 buffed texture). 3. Use caution not to gouge the
inner liner or expose casing fabric. 4. Remove any buffing dust with a vacuum cleaner. 5. Consult
your repair material supplier for a proper buffing tool.
Cementing
Apply chemical cement according to the repair material manufacturer's procedures.
Repair Unit Application
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires > Page 1465
1. The tire must be in the relaxed position when the repair unit is installed (Do not spread the beads
excessively).
Two-Piece Plug and Repair Units
1. If applicable, install the repair unit so that the alignment is correct. 2. Center the repair unit over
the injury and stitch down thoroughly with the stitching tool, working from the center out.
3. Being careful not to stretch the plug material, cut the plug flush with the outer tread.
Combination Repair/Plug Units
1. Pull the plug through the injury until the repair just reaches the liner. Stitch down thoroughly. 2.
Follow the repair material manufacturer's recommendations for further installation instructions.
2. Consult your repair material supplier for the proper stitching tool.
Safety Cage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires > Page 1466
Some run flat tires, such as the Goodyear Extended Mobility Tire (EMT) used on the Corvette, may
require more than 275 kPa (40 psi) to seat the bead. In such a case, a tire safety cage must be
used. Consult the tire manufacturer for its individual repair policy.
Final Inspection
1. After remounting and inflating the tire, check both beads, the repair and the valve with a water
and soap solution in order to detect leaks. 2. If the tire continues to lose air, the tire must be
demounted and reinspected. 3. Balance the tire and wheel assembly. Refer to Tire and Wheel
Assembly Balancing - OFF Vehicle.
For additional tire puncture repair information, contact:
Rubber Manufacturers Association (RMA)
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires > Page 1467
Tires: Technical Service Bulletins Tires - Correct Inflation Pressure Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-00-90-002J
Date: January 28, 2009
Subject: Information on Proper Tire Pressure
Models: 2010 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2009 and
Prior HUMMER H2, H3, H3T 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years and clarify additional information. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 00-00-90-002I (Section 00 - General Information).
Important:
^ Adjustment of tire pressure for a customer with a Low Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) light on and
no codes in the TPM system is NOT a warrantable repair. Claims to simply adjust the tire pressure
will be rejected.
^ ALL tires (including the spare tire) MUST be set to the recommended inflation pressure stated on
the vehicle's tire placard (on driver's door) during the PRE-DELIVERY INSPECTION (PDI).
Recommended inflation pressure is not the pressure printed on tire sidewall.
^ Tires may be over-inflated from the assembly plant due to the mounting process.
^ Generally a 5.6°C (10°F) temperature change will result in (is equivalent to) a 6.9 kPa (1 psi) tire
pressure change.
^ 2008-2009 HUMMER H2 Only - The H2 comes standard with Light Truck "D" Load Range tires
with a recommended cold inflation pressure of 289 kPa (42 psi). These tires will alert the driver to a
low pressure situation at roughly 262 kPa (38 psi) due to a requirement in FMVSS 138 which
specifies a Minimum Activation Pressure for each tire type. This creates a relatively narrow window
of "usable" pressure values and the warning will be more sensitive to outside temperature changes
during the colder months. As with other cold temperature/tire pressure issues, there is nothing
wrong with the system itself. If a vehicle is brought in with this concern, check for tire damage and
set all tires to the Recommended Cold Inflation Pressure shown on the vehicle placard.
Accurate tire pressures ensure the safe handling and appropriate ride characteristics of GM cars
and trucks. It is critical that the tire pressure be adjusted to the specifications on the vehicle¡C■s
tire placard during PDI.
Ride, handling and road noise concerns may be caused by improperly adjusted tire pressure.
The first step in the diagnosis of these concerns is to verify that the tires are inflated to the correct
pressures. The recommended tire inflation pressure is listed on the vehicle¡C■s tire placard. The
tire placard is located on the driver¡C■s side front or rear door edge, center pillar, or the rear
compartment lid.
Tip
^ Generally a 5.6°C (10°F) temperature increase will result in (is equivalent to) a 6.9 kPa (1 psi) tire
pressure increase.
^ The definition of a "cold" tire is one that has been sitting for at least 3 hours, or driven no more
than 1.6 km (1 mi).
^ On extremely cold days, if the vehicle has been indoors, it may be necessary to compensate for
the low external temperature by adding additional air to the tire during PDI.
^ During cold weather, the Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) indicator light (a yellow horseshoe with an
exclamation point) may illuminate. If this indicator turns off after the tires warm up (reach operating
temperature), the tire pressure should be reset to placard pressure at the cold temperature.
^ The TPM system will work correctly with nitrogen in tires.
^ The TPM system is compatible with the GM Vehicle Care Tire Sealant but may not be with other
commercially available sealants.
Important:
^ Do not use the tire pressure indicated on the tire itself as a guide.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires > Page 1468
^ Always inspect and adjust the pressure when the tires are cold.
^ Vehicles that have different pressures for the front and the rear need to be adjusted after tire
rotation.
Improper tire inflation may result in any or all of the following conditions:
^ Premature tire wear
^ Harsh ride
^ Excessive road noise
^ Poor handling
^ Reduced fuel economy
^ Low Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) Light ON
^ Low Tire Pressure Message on the Drivers Information Center (DIC)
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires > Page 1469
Tires: Technical Service Bulletins Tires - Speed Rated Information
Group Ref.: 3 - Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 433502
Date: July, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: SPEED RATED TIRES
MODELS: 1995 AND PRIOR YEAR PASSENGER CARS AND LIGHT DUTY TRUCKS
All original equipment passenger car and light duty truck tires used by General Motors have a
speed rating symbol molded on their sidewall. This speed symbol, along with the tire's load index,
make up the service description that follows the tire's size. The original equipment tire size, speed
rating, and recommended inflation pressure are listed on the tire placard usually located on the
driver's door edge. WHEN REPLACING TIRES, NEVER INSTALL A TIRE THAT IS A SMALLER
SIZE OR LESSER SPEED RATING THAN THAT USED AS ORIGINAL EQUIPMENT. As in the
past, it is recommended that replacement tires have a TPC (Tire Performance Criteria) number on
the sidewall that is identical to that on the original tires.
Common speed rating on tires used by General Motors are as follows: (see illustration)
IMPORTANT:
Most base all season tires and touring tires used by GM are S rated. Performance tires will usually
have a higher speed rating. High performance tires are usually Z rated. Z rated tires carry the Z
symbol within the tire size, rather than after the size in the service description. These speeds apply
only at the tire's full pressure. An underinflated tire will not meet its speed rating capability.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires > Page 1470
Tires: Technical Service Bulletins Tires - Manufacturers' Assistance
Group Ref.: Steering/ Suspension Bulletin No.: 323501 Date: December, 1993
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: TIRE MANUFACTURERS' CONTACTS FOR ASSISTANCE
MODELS: 1991-94 PASSENGER CARS AND TRUCKS
General Tire has established a "Tire Fix" Department to assist you with anything from a tire
adjustment to the location of the nearest General Tire dealer. "Tire Fix" representatives are
available Monday through Friday from 8:00 A.M. to 6:00 P.M. Eastern Time at 1-800-847-3349.
A General Tire Brochure is provided for review with all appropriate dealer personnel. A single
contact point at General Tire can assist you with most aspects of their product to satisfy your
customers' needs.
Other tire manufacturers can be contacted for assistance at the Toll Free Numbers listed in
illustration:
Please retain this information for future reference.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV)
Wheels: Customer Interest Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV)
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-03-10-006F
Date: May 04, 2010
Subject: Information on Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009
and Prior Saab 9-7X 2000-2005 Saturn L Series 2003-2007 Saturn ION
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to considerably expand the available information on
Radial Force Variation (RFV) and should be reviewed in whole. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-03-10-006E (Section 03 - Suspension).
Important
- Before measuring tires on equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700, the vehicle MUST be driven
a minimum of 16 km (10 mi) to ensure removal of any flat-spotting. Refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 03-03-10-007E - Tire/Wheel Characteristics of GM Original Equipment Tires.
- Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 MUST be calibrated prior to measuring tire/wheel
assemblies for each vehicle.
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide guidance to GM dealers when using tire force variation
measurement equipment, such as the Hunter GSP9700. This type of equipment can be a valuable
tool in diagnosing vehicle ride concerns. The most common ride concern involving tire radial force
variation is highway speed shake on smooth roads.
Tire related smooth road highway speed shake can be caused by three conditions: imbalance, out
of round and tire force variation. These three conditions are not necessarily related. All three
conditions must be addressed.
Imbalance is normally addressed first, because it is the simpler of the three to correct. Off-vehicle,
two plane dynamic wheel balancers are readily available and can accurately correct any
imbalance. Balancer calibration and maintenance, proper attachment of the wheel to the balancer,
and proper balance weights, are all factors required for a quality balance. However, a perfectly
balanced tire/wheel assembly can still be "oval shaped" and cause a vibration.
Before balancing, perform the following procedures.
Tire and Wheel Diagnosis
1. Set the tire pressure to the placard values. 2. With the vehicle raised, ensure the wheels are
centered on the hub by loosening all wheel nuts and hand-tightening all nuts first by hand while
shaking the wheel, then torque to specifications using a torque wrench, NOT a torque stick.
3. Visually inspect the tires and the wheels. Inspect for evidence of the following conditions and
correct as necessary:
- Missing balance weights
- Bent rim flange
- Irregular tire wear
- Incomplete bead seating
- Tire irregularities (including pressure settings)
- Mud/ice build-up in wheel
- Stones in the tire tread
- Remove any aftermarket wheels and/or tires and restore vehicle to original condition prior to
diagnosing a smooth road shake condition.
4. Road test the vehicle using the Electronic Vibration Analyzer (EVA) essential tool. Drive for a
sufficient distance on a known, smooth road
surface to duplicate the condition. Determine if the vehicle is sensitive to brake apply. If the brakes
are applied lightly and the pulsation felt in the steering wheel increases, refer to the Brakes section
of the service manual that deals with brake-induced pulsation. If you can start to hear the vibration
as a low boom noise (in addition to feeling it), but cannot see it, the vehicle likely has a first order
(one pulse per propshaft revolution) driveline vibration. Driveline first order vibrations are high
enough in frequency that most humans can start to hear them at highway speeds, but are too high
to be able to be easily seen. These issues can be caused by driveline imbalance or misalignment.
If the vehicle exhibits this low boom and the booming pulses in-and-out on a regular basis (like a
throbbing), chances are good that the vehicle could have driveline vibration. This type
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV) > Page 1479
of vibration is normally felt more in the "seat of the pants" than the steering wheel.
5. Next, record the Hertz (Hz) reading as displayed by the EVA onto the tire data worksheet found
at the end of this bulletin. This should be done
after a tire break-in period of at least 16 km (10 mi) at 72 km/h (45 mph) or greater, in order to
eliminate any possible tire flat-spotting. This reading confirms what the vehicle vibration frequency
is prior to vehicle service and documents the amount of improvement occurring as the result of the
various steps taken to repair. Completing the Steering Wheel Shake Worksheet below is required.
A copy of the completed worksheet must be saved with the R.O. and a copy included with any
parts returned to the Warranty Parts Center for analysis. A reading of 35 to 50 Hz typically
indicates a first order propshaft vibration. If this is the situation, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
08-07-30-044D. Generally, a reading between 10 and 20 Hz indicates a tire/wheel vibration and if
this is the reading obtained, continue using this bulletin. If the tire 1st order vibration goes away
and stays away during this evaluation, the cause is likely tire flat-spotting. Tire flat-spotting vibration
may come and go at any speed over 72 km/h (45 mph) during the first 10 minutes of operation, if
vibration continues after 10 minutes of driving at speeds greater than 72 km/h (45 mph), tire
flat-spotting can be ruled out as the cause for vibration.
6. If flat-spotting is the cause, provide the explanation that this has occurred due to the vehicle
being parked for long periods of time and that the
nature of the tire is to take a set. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 03-03-10-007E: Information
on Tire/Wheel Characteristics (Vibration, Balance, Shake, Flat Spotting) of GM Original Equipment
Tires.
7. If the road test indicates a shake/vibration exists, check the imbalance of each tire/wheel
assembly on a known, calibrated, off-car dynamic
balancer.Make sure the mounting surface of the wheel and the surface of the balancer are
absolutely clean and free of debris. Be sure to chose the proper cone/collet for the wheel, and
always use the pilot bore for centering. Never center the wheel using the hub-cap bore since it is
not a precision machined surface. If any assembly calls for more than 1/4 ounce on either rim
flange, remove all balance weights and rebalance to as close to zero as possible. If you can see
the vibration (along with feeling it) in the steering wheel (driving straight without your hands on the
wheel), it is very likely to be a tire/wheel first order (one pulse per revolution) disturbance. First
order disturbances can be caused by imbalance as well as non-uniformities in tires, wheels or
hubs. This first order frequency is too low for a human to hear, but if the amplitude is high enough,
it can be seen.
If a vibration or shake still exists after balancing, any out of round conditions, of the wheel, and
force variation conditions of the tire, must be addressed. Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700
can address both (it is also a wheel balancer).
Tire radial force vibration (RFV) can be defined as the amount of stiffness variation the tire will
produce in one revolution under a constant load. Radial force variation is what the vehicle feels
because the load (weight) of the vehicle is always on the tires. Although free runout of tires (not
under load) is not always a good indicator of a smooth ride, it is critical that total tire/wheel
assembly runout be within specification.
Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 loads the tire, similar to on the vehicle, and measures
radial force variation of the tire/wheel assembly. Note that the wheel is affecting the tire's RFV
measurement at this point. To isolate the wheel, its runout must be measured. This can be easily
done on the Hunter, without the need to set up dial indicators. If the wheel meets the runout
specification, the tire's RFV can then be addressed.
After measuring the tire/wheel assembly under load, and the wheel alone, the machine then
calculates (predicts) the radial force variation of the tire. However, because this is a prediction that
can include mounting inaccuracies, and the load wheel is much smaller in diameter than used in
tire production, this type of service equipment should NOT be used to audit new tires. Rather, it
should be used as a service diagnostic tool to minimize radial force variation of the tire/wheel
assembly.
Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 does an excellent job of measuring wheel runout, and of
finding the low point of the wheel (for runout) and the high point of the tire (for radial force
variation). This allows the tire to be matched mounted to the wheel for lowest tire/wheel assembly
force variation.
The machine will simplify this process into easy steps. The following assembly radial force variation
numbers should be used as a guide:
When measuring RFV and match mounting tires perform the following steps.
Measuring Wheel Runout and Assembly Radial Force Variation
Important The completed worksheet at the end of this bulletin must be attached to the hard copy of
the repair order.
- Measure radial force variation and radial runout.
- If a road force/balancing machine is used, record the radial force variation (RFV) on the
worksheet at the end of this bulletin. It may be of benefit to have the lowest RFV assembly to the
front left corner. If the machine is not available and the EVA data suggests there is an issue, swap
the tire and wheel assemblies from the front to the back. Re-check on the EVA and if the problem
still exists, test another vehicle to find tires that do not exhibit the same frequency and swap those
tires onto the subject vehicle.
- If a runout/balancing machine is used, record the radial runout of the tire/wheel assemblies on the
worksheet at the end of this bulletin. If one or more of the tire/wheel assemblies are more than.040
in (1.02 mm), match mount the tire to the wheel to get below.040 in (1.02 mm). For sensitive
customers, readings of 0.030 inch (0.76 mm) or less are preferable, it may also be of benefit to
have the lowest runout assembly to the front left corner. If the machine is not available and the
EVA data suggests there is an issue, swap the tire and wheel assemblies from the front to the
back. Re-check on the EVA and if the problem still exists, test another vehicle to find tires that do
not exhibit the same frequency and swap those tires
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV) > Page 1480
onto the subject vehicle.
- After match mounting, the tire/wheel assembly must be rebalanced.
If match mounting tires to in-spec wheels produces assembly values higher than these, tire
replacement may be necessary. Replacing tires at lower values will probably mean good tires are
being condemned. Because tires can sometimes become temporarily flat-spotted, which will affect
force variation, it is important that the vehicle be driven at least 16 km (10 mi) prior to measuring.
Tire pressure must also be adjusted to the usage pressure on the vehicle's tire placard prior to
measuring.
Most GM vehicles will tolerate radial force variation up to these levels. However, some vehicles are
more sensitive, and may require lower levels. Also, there are other tire parameters that equipment
such as the Hunter GSP9700 cannot measure that may be a factor. In such cases, TAC should be
contacted for further instructions.
Important
- When mounting a GM wheel to a wheel balancer/force variation machine, always use the wheel's
center pilot hole. This is the primary centering mechanism on all GM wheels; the bolt holes are
secondary. Usually a back cone method to the machine should be used. For added accuracy and
repeatability, a flange plate should be used to clamp the wheel onto the cone and machine. This
system is offered by all balancer manufacturers in GM's dealer program.
- Any type of service equipment that removes tread rubber by grinding, buffing or truing is NOT
recommended, and may void the tire warranty. However, tires may have been ground by the tire
company as part of their tire manufacturing process. This is a legitimate procedure.
Steering Wheel Shake Worksheet
When diagnosing vibration concerns, use the following worksheet in conjunction with the
appropriate Vibration Analysis-Road testing procedure in the Vibration Correction sub-section in SI.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV) > Page 1481
Refer to the appropriate section of SI for specifications and repair procedures that are related to the
vibration concern.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-03-10-003F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels
Wheels: Customer Interest Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 05-03-10-003F
Date: April 27, 2010
Subject: Low Tire Pressure, Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels (Repair with Adhesive Sealant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X with Cast Aluminum Wheels
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years and the bulletin reference
information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-10-003E (Section 03 - Suspension).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a low tire pressure condition.
Diagnosis of the low tire pressure condition indicates an air leak through the cast aluminum wheel.
Cause
Porosity in the cast aluminum wheel may be the cause.
Notice
This bulletin specifically addresses issues related to the wheel casting that may result in an air
leak. For issues related to corrosion of the wheel in service, please refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-03-10-006C - Tire Slowly Goes Flat, Tire Air Loss, Low Tire Pressure Warning Light
Illuminated, Aluminum Wheel Bead Seat Corrosion (Clean and Resurface Wheel Bead Seat).
Correction
1. Remove the tire and wheel assembly from the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate service
procedure in SI. 2. Locate the leaking area by inflating the tire to 276 kPa (40 psi) and dipping the
tire/wheel assembly in a water bath, or use a spray bottle with soap
and water to locate the specific leak location.
Important
- If the porosity leak is located in the bead area of the aluminum rim (where the tire meets the rim),
the wheel should be replaced.
- If two or more leaks are located on one wheel, the wheel should be replaced.
3. If air bubbles are observed, mark the location.
- If the leak location is on the tire/rubber area, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 04-03-10-001F Tire Puncture Repair Procedures for All Cars and Light Duty Trucks.
- If the leak is located on the aluminum wheel area, continue with the next step.
4. Inscribe a mark on the tire at the valve stem in order to indicate the orientation of the tire to the
wheel. 5. Dismount the tire from the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 6. Remove
the tire pressure sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor removal procedure in SI. 7. Scuff the
INSIDE rim surface at the leak area with #80 grit paper and clean the area with general purpose
cleaner, such as 3M(R) General Purpose
Adhesive Cleaner, P/N 08984, or equivalent.
8. Apply a 3 mm (0.12 in) thick layer of Silicone - Adhesive/Sealant, P/N 12378478 (in Canada, use
88900041), or equivalent, to the leak area. 9. Allow for the adhesive/sealant to dry.
Notice Caution must be used when mounting the tire so as not to damage the sealer. Damaging
the repair area may result in an air leak.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-03-10-003F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels >
Page 1486
10. Align the inscribed mark on the tire with the valve stem on the wheel. 11. Reinstall the Tire
Pressure Sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor installation procedure in SI. 12. Mount the tire on
the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 13. Pressurize the tire to 276 kPa (40 psi) and
inspect for leaks. 14. Adjust tire pressure to meet the placard specification. 15. Balance the
tire/wheel assembly. Refer to Tire and Wheel Assembly Balancing - Off-Vehicle. 16. Install the tire
and wheel assembly onto the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate service procedure in SI.
Parts Information
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
Important The Silicone - Adhesive/Sealant comes in a case quantity of six. ONLY charge warranty
one tube of adhesive/sealant per wheel repair.
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
One leak repair per wheel.
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Staining/Pitting/Corrosion
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-03-10-002F
Date: April 21, 2011
Subject: Chemical Staining, Pitting, Corrosion and/or Spotted Appearance of Chromed Aluminum
Wheels
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years, suggest additional restorative
products and add additional corrosion information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
00-03-10-002E (Section 03 - Suspension). Important You may give a copy of this bulletin to the
customer.
What is Chemical Staining of Chrome Wheels? Figure 1
Chemical staining in most cases results from acid based cleaners (refer to Figure 1 for an
example). These stains are frequently milky, black, or greenish in appearance. They result from
using cleaning solutions that contain acids on chrome wheels. Soap and water is usually sufficient
to clean wheels.
If the customer insists on using a wheel cleaner they should only use one that specifically states
that it is safe for chromed wheels and does not contain anything in the following list. (Dealers
should also survey any products they use during prep or normal cleaning of stock units for these
chemicals.)
- Ammonium Bifluoride (fluoride source for dissolution of chrome)
- Hydrofluoric Acid (directly dissolves chrome)
- Hydrochloric Acid (directly dissolves chrome)
- Sodium Dodecylbenzenesulfonic Acid
- Sulfamic Acid
- Phosphoric Acid
- Hydroxyacetic Acid
Notice
Many wheel cleaner instructions advise to take care to avoid contact with painted surfaces. Most
customers think of painted surfaces as the fenders, quarter panels and other exterior sheet metal.
Many vehicles have painted brake calipers. Acidic wheel cleaners may craze, crack, or discolor the
paint on the brake calipers. Damage from wheel cleaners is not covered under the vehicle new car
warranty. Soap and water applied with a soft brush is usually all that is required to clean the
calipers.
Whenever any wheel cleaner is used, it must be THOROUGHLY rinsed off of the wheel with clean,
clear water. Special care must be taken to rinse under the hub cap, balance weights, wheel nuts,
lug nut caps, between the wheel cladding and off the back side of the wheel. Wheels returned to
the Warranty Parts Center (WPC) that exhibit damage from wheel cleaners most often have the
damage around and under the wheel weight where the cleaner was incompletely flushed away.
Notice
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 1492
Do not use cleaning solutions that contain hydrofluoric, oxalic and most other acids on chrome
wheels (or any wheels).
If the customer is unsure of the chemical make-up of a particular wheel cleaner, it should be
avoided.
For wheels showing signs of milky staining from acidic cleaners, refer to Customer Assistance and
Instructions below.
Warranty of Stained Chrome Wheels
Stained wheels are not warrantable. Most acid based cleaners will permanently stain chrome
wheels. Follow-up with dealers has confirmed that such cleaners were used on wheels that were
returned to the Warranty Parts Center (WPC). Any stained wheels received by the WPC will be
charged back to the dealership. To assist the customer, refer to Customer Assistance and
Instructions below.
Pitting or Spotted Appearance of Chrome Wheels Figure 2
A second type or staining or finish disturbance may result from road chemicals, such as calcium
chloride used for dust control of unpaved roads. The staining will look like small pitting (refer to
Figure 2). This staining will usually be on the leading edges of each wheel spoke, but may be
uniformly distributed. If a vehicle must be operated under such conditions, the chrome wheels
should be washed with mild soap and water and thoroughly rinsed as soon as conveniently
possible.
Important Road chemicals, such as calcium chloride used for dust control of unpaved roads, can
also stain chrome wheels. The staining will look like small pitting. This staining will usually be on
the leading edges of each wheel spoke. This is explained by the vehicle traveling in the forward
direction while being splashed by the road chemical. If a vehicle must be operated under such
conditions, the chrome wheels should be washed with mild soap and water and thoroughly rinsed
as soon as conveniently possible.
Warranty of Pitted or Spotted Chrome Wheels
Wheels returned with pitting or spotting as a result of road chemicals may be replaced one time.
Damage resulting from contact with these applied road chemicals is corrosive to the wheels finish
and may cause damage if the wheels are not kept clean.
Important Notify the customer that this is a one time replacement. Please stress to the customer
the vital importance of keeping the wheels clean if they are operating the vehicle in an area that
applies calcium chloride or other dust controlling chemicals! "GM of Canada" dealers require prior
approval by the District Manager - Customer Care and Service Process (DM-CCSP).
"Stardust" Corrosion of Chrome Wheels Figure 3
A third type of finish disturbance results from prolonged exposure to brake dust and resultant
penetration of brake dust through the chrome. As brakes are applied hot particles of brake material
are thrown off and tend to be forced through the leading edge of the wheel spoke windows by
airflow. These
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 1493
hot particles embed themselves in the chrome layer and create a small pit. If the material is allowed
to sit on the wheel while it is exposed to moisture or salt, it will corrode the wheel beneath the
chrome leaving a pit or small blister in the chrome.
Heavy brake dust build-up should be removed from wheels by using GM Chrome Cleaner and
Polish, P/N 1050173 (in Canada use 10953013). For moderate cleaning, light brake dust build-up
or water spots use GM Swirl Remover Polish, P/N 12377965 (in Canada, use Meguiars
Plast-X(TM) Clear Plastic Cleaner and Polish #G12310C**). After cleaning, the wheel should be
waxed using GM Cleaner Wax, P/N 12377966 (in Canada, use Meguiars Cleaner Wax
#M0616C**), which will help protect the wheel from brake dust and reduce adhesion of any brake
dust that gets on the wheel surface. For general maintenance cleaning, PEEK Metal Polish† may
be used. It will clean and shine the chrome and leave behind a wax coating that may help protect
the finish.
Warranty of Stardust Corroded Chrome Wheels
Wheels returned with pitting or spotting as a result of neglect and brake dust build-up may be
replaced one time.
Important Notify the customer that this is a one time replacement. Please stress to the customer
the vital importance of keeping the wheels clean and free of prolonged exposure to brake dust
build-up. "GM of Canada" dealers require prior approval by the District Manager - Customer Care
and Service Process (DM-CCSP).
Customer Assistance and Instructions
GM has looked for ways customers may improve the appearance of wheels damaged by acidic
cleaners. The following product and procedure has been found to dramatically improve the
appearance of stained wheels. For wheels that have milky stains caused by acidic cleaners try the
following:
Notice
THE 3M CHROME AND METAL POLISH REQUIRED FOR THIS PROCEDURE IS AN
EXTREMELY AGGRESSIVE POLISH/CLEANER. THE WHEELS MUST BE CLEANED BEFORE
APPLICATION TO AVOID SCRATCHING THE WHEEL SURFACE. THIS PRODUCT WILL
REDUCE THE THICKNESS OF THE CHROME PLATING ON THE WHEEL AND IF USED
INCORRECTLY OR EXCESSIVELY MAY REMOVE THE CHROME PLATING ALL TOGETHER,
EXPOSING A LESS BRIGHT AND BRASSY COLORED SUB-LAYER. FOLLOW INSTRUCTIONS
EXACTLY.
1. Wash the wheels with vigorously with soap and water. This step will clean and may reduce
wheel staining. Flood all areas of the wheel with water
to rinse.
2. Dry the wheels completely.
Notice Begin with a small section of the wheel and with light pressure buff off polish and examine
results. ONLY apply and rub with sufficient force and time to remove enough staining that you are
satisfied with the results. Some wheels may be stained to the extent that you may only achieve a
50% improvement while others may be able to be restored to the original lustre. IN ALL CASES,
only apply until the results are satisfactory.
3. Apply 3M Chrome and Metal Polish #39527* with a clean terry cloth towel. As you apply the
polish, the staining will be diminished. 4. When dry, buff off the polish with a clean portion of the
towel. 5. Repeat application of the 3M Chrome and Metal Polish until satisfied with the results. If
continued applications fail to improve the appearance
further discontinue use.
This procedure will improve the appearance of the wheels and may, with repeated applications,
restore the finish dramatically. For wheels that exhibit spotting from road chemicals the above
procedure may marginally improve the condition but will not restore the finish or remove the pitting.
In this type of staining the wheel finish has actually been removed in spots and no manner of
cleaning will restore the finish.
†*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or
assume any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may
be available from other sources.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 1494
*This product is currently available from 3M. To obtain information for your local retail location
please call 3M at 1-888-364-3577.
**This product is currently available from Meguiars (Canada). To obtain information for your local
retail location please call Meguiars at 1-800-347-5700 or at www.meguiarscanada.com.
^ This product is currently available from Tri-Peek International. To obtain information for your local
retail location please call Tri-Peek at
1-877-615-4272 or at www.tripeek.com.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 99-08-51-007E > Mar > 11 > Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum
Wheels
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum Wheels
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 99-08-51-007E
Date: March 17, 2011
Subject: Refinishing Aluminum Wheels
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add additional model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 99-08-51-007D (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
This bulletin updates General Motor's position on refinishing aluminum wheels. GM does not
endorse any repairs that involve welding, bending, straightening or re-machining. Only cosmetic
refinishing of the wheel's coatings, using recommended procedures, is allowed.
Evaluating Damage
In evaluating damage, it is the GM Dealer's responsibility to inspect the wheel for corrosion,
scrapes, gouges, etc. The Dealer must insure that such damage is not deeper than what can be
sanded or polished off. The wheel must be inspected for cracks. If cracks are found, discard the
wheel. Any wheels with bent rim flanges must not be repaired or refinished. Wheels that have been
refinished by an outside company must be returned to the same vehicle. The Dealer must record
the wheel ID stamp or the cast date on the wheel in order to assure this requirement. Refer to
Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company later in this bulletin.
Aluminum Wheel Refinishing Recommendations
- Chrome-plated aluminum wheels Re-plating these wheels is not recommended.
- Polished aluminum wheels These wheels have a polyester or acrylic clearcoat on them. If the
clearcoat is damaged, refinishing is possible. However, the required refinishing process cannot be
performed in the dealer environment. Refer to Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company later
in this bulletin.
- Painted aluminum wheels These wheels are painted using a primer, color coat, and clearcoat
procedure. If the paint is damaged, refinishing is possible. As with polished wheels, all original
coatings must be removed first. Media blasting is recommended. Refer to GM Aluminum
Refinishing Bulletin #53-17-03A for the re-painting of this type of wheel.
- Bright, machined aluminum wheels These wheels have a polyester or acrylic clearcoat on them.
In some cases, the recessed "pocket" areas of the wheel may be painted. Surface refinishing is
possible. The wheel must be totally stripped by media blasting or other suitable means. The wheel
should be resurfaced by using a sanding process rather than a machining process. This allows the
least amount of material to be removed.
Important Do not use any re-machining process that removes aluminum. This could affect the
dimensions and function of the wheel.
Painting is an option to re-clearcoating polished and bright machined aluminum wheels. Paint will
better mask any surface imperfections and is somewhat more durable than clearcoat alone. GM
recommends using Corsican SILVER WAEQ9283 for a fine "aluminum-like" look or Sparkle
SILVER WA9967 for a very bright look. As an option, the body color may also be used. When using
any of the painting options, it is recommended that all four wheels be refinished in order to maintain
color uniformity. Refer to GM Aluminum Refinishing Bulletin #53-17-03A for specific procedures
and product recommendations.
Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company
Important Some outside companies are offering wheel refinishing services. Such refinished wheels
will be permanently marked by the refinisher and are warranted by the refinisher. Any process that
re-machines or otherwise re-manufactures the wheel should not be used.
A refinisher's responsibility includes inspecting for cracks using the Zyglo system or the equivalent.
Any cracked wheels must not be refinished. No welding, hammering or reforming of any kind is
allowed. The wheel ID must be recorded and follow the wheel throughout the process in order to
assure that the same wheel is returned. A plastic media blast may be used for clean up of the
wheel. Hand and/or lathe sanding of the machined surface and the wheel window is allowed.
Material removal, though, must be kept to a minimum. Re-machining of the wheel is not allowed.
Paint and/or clear coat must not be present on the following surfaces: the nut chamfers, the wheel
mounting surfaces and the wheel pilot hole. The refinisher must permanently ID stamp the wheel
and warrant the painted/clearcoated surfaces for a minimum of one year or the remainder of the
new vehicle warranty, whichever is
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 99-08-51-007E > Mar > 11 > Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum
Wheels > Page 1499
longer.
Important Whenever a wheel is refinished, the mounting surface and the wheel nut contact
surfaces must not be painted or clearcoated. Coating these surfaces could affect the wheel nut
torque.
When re-mounting a tire on an aluminum wheel, coated balance weights must be used in order to
reduce the chance of future cosmetic damage.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing
Procedures/Precautions
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Changing Procedures/Precautions
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-03-10-010A
Date: June 09, 2010
Subject: Information on Proper Wheel Changing Procedures and Cautions
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER Models 2005-2009 Saab
9-7X 2005-2009 Saturn Vehicles
Attention:
Complete wheel changing instructions for each vehicle line can be found under Tire and Wheel
Removal and Installation in Service Information (SI). This bulletin is intended to quickly review and
reinforce simple but vital procedures to reduce the possibility of achieving low torque during wheel
installation. Always refer to SI for wheel lug nut torque specifications and complete jacking
instructions for safe wheel changing.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include the 2011 model year and update the available
special tool list. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-03-10-010 (Section 03 Suspension).
Frequency of Wheel Changes - Marketplace Driven
Just a few years ago, the increasing longevity of tires along with greater resistance to punctures
had greatly reduced the number of times wheels were removed to basically required tire rotation
intervals. Today with the booming business in accessory wheels/special application tires (such as
winter tires), consumers are having tire/wheel assemblies removed - replaced - or installed more
than ever. With this increased activity, it opens up more of a chance for error on the part of the
technician. This bulletin will review a few of the common concerns and mistakes to make yourself
aware of.
Proper Servicing Starts With the Right Tools
The following tools have been made available to assist in proper wheel and tire removal and
installation.
- J 41013 Rotor Resurfacing Kit (or equivalent)
- J 42450-A Wheel Hub Resurfacing Kit (or equivalent)
Corroded Surfaces
One area of concern is corrosion on the mating surfaces of the wheel to the hub on the vehicle.
Excessive corrosion, dirt, rust or debris built up on these surfaces can mimic a properly tightened
wheel in the service stall. Once the vehicle is driven, the debris may loosen, grind up or be washed
away from water splash. This action may result in clearance at the mating surface of the wheel and
an under-torqued condition.
Caution
Before installing a wheel, remove any buildup on the wheel mounting surface and brake drum or
brake disc mounting surface. Installing wheels with poor metal-to-metal contact at the mounting
surfaces can cause wheel nuts to loosen. This may cause a wheel to come off when the vehicle is
moving, possibly resulting in a loss of control or personal injury.
Whenever you remove the tire/wheel assemblies, you must inspect the mating surfaces. If
corrosion is found, you should remove the debris with a die grinder equipped with a fine sanding
pad, wire brush or cleaning disc. Just remove enough material to assure a clean, smooth mating
surface.
The J 41013 (or equivalent) can be used to clean the following surfaces:
- The hub mounting surface
- The brake rotor mounting surface
- The wheel mounting surface
Use the J 42450-A (or equivalent) to clean around the base of the studs and the hub.
Lubricants, Grease and Fluids
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing
Procedures/Precautions > Page 1504
Some customers may use penetrating oils, grease or other lubricants on wheel studs to aid in
removal or installation. Always use a suitable cleaner/solvent to remove these lubricants prior to
installing the wheel and tire assemblies. Lubricants left on the wheel studs may cause improper
readings of wheel nut torque. Always install wheels to clean, dry wheel studs ONLY.
Notice
Lubricants left on the wheel studs or vertical mounting surfaces between the wheel and the rotor or
drum may cause the wheel to work itself loose after the vehicle is driven. Always install wheels to
clean, dry wheel studs and surfaces ONLY. Beginning with 2011 model year vehicles, put a light
coating of grease, GM P/N 1051344 (in Canada, P/N 9930370), on the inner surface of the wheel
pilot hole to prevent wheel seizure to the axle or bearing hub.
Wheel Stud and Lug Nut Damage
Always inspect the wheel studs and lug nuts for signs of damage from crossthreading or abuse.
You should never have to force wheel nuts down the stud. Lug nuts that are damaged may not
retain properly, yet give the impression of fully tightening. Always inspect and replace any
component suspected of damage.
Tip
Always start wheel nuts by hand! Be certain that all wheel nut threads have been engaged
BEFORE tightening the nut.
Important If the vehicle has directional tread tires, verify the directional arrow on the outboard side
of the tire is pointing in the direction of forward rotation.
Wheel Nut Tightening and Torque
Improper wheel nut tightening can lead to brake pulsation and rotor damage. In order to avoid
additional brake repairs, evenly tighten the wheel nuts to the proper torque specification as shown
for each vehicle in SI. Always observe the proper wheel nut tightening sequence as shown below in
order to avoid trapping the wheel on the wheel stud threads or clamping the wheel slightly off
center resulting in vibration.
The Most Important Service You Provide
While the above information is well known, and wheel removal so common, technicians run the risk
of becoming complacent on this very important
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing
Procedures/Precautions > Page 1505
service operation. A simple distraction or time constraint that rushes the job may result in personal
injury if the greatest of care is not exercised. Make it a habit to double check your work and to
always side with caution when installing wheels.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force
Variation (RFV)
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV)
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-03-10-006F
Date: May 04, 2010
Subject: Information on Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009
and Prior Saab 9-7X 2000-2005 Saturn L Series 2003-2007 Saturn ION
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to considerably expand the available information on
Radial Force Variation (RFV) and should be reviewed in whole. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-03-10-006E (Section 03 - Suspension).
Important
- Before measuring tires on equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700, the vehicle MUST be driven
a minimum of 16 km (10 mi) to ensure removal of any flat-spotting. Refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 03-03-10-007E - Tire/Wheel Characteristics of GM Original Equipment Tires.
- Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 MUST be calibrated prior to measuring tire/wheel
assemblies for each vehicle.
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide guidance to GM dealers when using tire force variation
measurement equipment, such as the Hunter GSP9700. This type of equipment can be a valuable
tool in diagnosing vehicle ride concerns. The most common ride concern involving tire radial force
variation is highway speed shake on smooth roads.
Tire related smooth road highway speed shake can be caused by three conditions: imbalance, out
of round and tire force variation. These three conditions are not necessarily related. All three
conditions must be addressed.
Imbalance is normally addressed first, because it is the simpler of the three to correct. Off-vehicle,
two plane dynamic wheel balancers are readily available and can accurately correct any
imbalance. Balancer calibration and maintenance, proper attachment of the wheel to the balancer,
and proper balance weights, are all factors required for a quality balance. However, a perfectly
balanced tire/wheel assembly can still be "oval shaped" and cause a vibration.
Before balancing, perform the following procedures.
Tire and Wheel Diagnosis
1. Set the tire pressure to the placard values. 2. With the vehicle raised, ensure the wheels are
centered on the hub by loosening all wheel nuts and hand-tightening all nuts first by hand while
shaking the wheel, then torque to specifications using a torque wrench, NOT a torque stick.
3. Visually inspect the tires and the wheels. Inspect for evidence of the following conditions and
correct as necessary:
- Missing balance weights
- Bent rim flange
- Irregular tire wear
- Incomplete bead seating
- Tire irregularities (including pressure settings)
- Mud/ice build-up in wheel
- Stones in the tire tread
- Remove any aftermarket wheels and/or tires and restore vehicle to original condition prior to
diagnosing a smooth road shake condition.
4. Road test the vehicle using the Electronic Vibration Analyzer (EVA) essential tool. Drive for a
sufficient distance on a known, smooth road
surface to duplicate the condition. Determine if the vehicle is sensitive to brake apply. If the brakes
are applied lightly and the pulsation felt in the steering wheel increases, refer to the Brakes section
of the service manual that deals with brake-induced pulsation. If you can start to hear the vibration
as a low boom noise (in addition to feeling it), but cannot see it, the vehicle likely has a first order
(one pulse per propshaft revolution) driveline vibration. Driveline first order vibrations are high
enough in frequency that most humans can start to hear them at highway speeds, but are too high
to be able to be easily seen. These issues can be caused by driveline imbalance or misalignment.
If the vehicle exhibits this low boom and the booming pulses in-and-out on a regular basis (like a
throbbing), chances are good that the vehicle could have driveline vibration. This type
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force
Variation (RFV) > Page 1510
of vibration is normally felt more in the "seat of the pants" than the steering wheel.
5. Next, record the Hertz (Hz) reading as displayed by the EVA onto the tire data worksheet found
at the end of this bulletin. This should be done
after a tire break-in period of at least 16 km (10 mi) at 72 km/h (45 mph) or greater, in order to
eliminate any possible tire flat-spotting. This reading confirms what the vehicle vibration frequency
is prior to vehicle service and documents the amount of improvement occurring as the result of the
various steps taken to repair. Completing the Steering Wheel Shake Worksheet below is required.
A copy of the completed worksheet must be saved with the R.O. and a copy included with any
parts returned to the Warranty Parts Center for analysis. A reading of 35 to 50 Hz typically
indicates a first order propshaft vibration. If this is the situation, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
08-07-30-044D. Generally, a reading between 10 and 20 Hz indicates a tire/wheel vibration and if
this is the reading obtained, continue using this bulletin. If the tire 1st order vibration goes away
and stays away during this evaluation, the cause is likely tire flat-spotting. Tire flat-spotting vibration
may come and go at any speed over 72 km/h (45 mph) during the first 10 minutes of operation, if
vibration continues after 10 minutes of driving at speeds greater than 72 km/h (45 mph), tire
flat-spotting can be ruled out as the cause for vibration.
6. If flat-spotting is the cause, provide the explanation that this has occurred due to the vehicle
being parked for long periods of time and that the
nature of the tire is to take a set. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 03-03-10-007E: Information
on Tire/Wheel Characteristics (Vibration, Balance, Shake, Flat Spotting) of GM Original Equipment
Tires.
7. If the road test indicates a shake/vibration exists, check the imbalance of each tire/wheel
assembly on a known, calibrated, off-car dynamic
balancer.Make sure the mounting surface of the wheel and the surface of the balancer are
absolutely clean and free of debris. Be sure to chose the proper cone/collet for the wheel, and
always use the pilot bore for centering. Never center the wheel using the hub-cap bore since it is
not a precision machined surface. If any assembly calls for more than 1/4 ounce on either rim
flange, remove all balance weights and rebalance to as close to zero as possible. If you can see
the vibration (along with feeling it) in the steering wheel (driving straight without your hands on the
wheel), it is very likely to be a tire/wheel first order (one pulse per revolution) disturbance. First
order disturbances can be caused by imbalance as well as non-uniformities in tires, wheels or
hubs. This first order frequency is too low for a human to hear, but if the amplitude is high enough,
it can be seen.
If a vibration or shake still exists after balancing, any out of round conditions, of the wheel, and
force variation conditions of the tire, must be addressed. Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700
can address both (it is also a wheel balancer).
Tire radial force vibration (RFV) can be defined as the amount of stiffness variation the tire will
produce in one revolution under a constant load. Radial force variation is what the vehicle feels
because the load (weight) of the vehicle is always on the tires. Although free runout of tires (not
under load) is not always a good indicator of a smooth ride, it is critical that total tire/wheel
assembly runout be within specification.
Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 loads the tire, similar to on the vehicle, and measures
radial force variation of the tire/wheel assembly. Note that the wheel is affecting the tire's RFV
measurement at this point. To isolate the wheel, its runout must be measured. This can be easily
done on the Hunter, without the need to set up dial indicators. If the wheel meets the runout
specification, the tire's RFV can then be addressed.
After measuring the tire/wheel assembly under load, and the wheel alone, the machine then
calculates (predicts) the radial force variation of the tire. However, because this is a prediction that
can include mounting inaccuracies, and the load wheel is much smaller in diameter than used in
tire production, this type of service equipment should NOT be used to audit new tires. Rather, it
should be used as a service diagnostic tool to minimize radial force variation of the tire/wheel
assembly.
Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 does an excellent job of measuring wheel runout, and of
finding the low point of the wheel (for runout) and the high point of the tire (for radial force
variation). This allows the tire to be matched mounted to the wheel for lowest tire/wheel assembly
force variation.
The machine will simplify this process into easy steps. The following assembly radial force variation
numbers should be used as a guide:
When measuring RFV and match mounting tires perform the following steps.
Measuring Wheel Runout and Assembly Radial Force Variation
Important The completed worksheet at the end of this bulletin must be attached to the hard copy of
the repair order.
- Measure radial force variation and radial runout.
- If a road force/balancing machine is used, record the radial force variation (RFV) on the
worksheet at the end of this bulletin. It may be of benefit to have the lowest RFV assembly to the
front left corner. If the machine is not available and the EVA data suggests there is an issue, swap
the tire and wheel assemblies from the front to the back. Re-check on the EVA and if the problem
still exists, test another vehicle to find tires that do not exhibit the same frequency and swap those
tires onto the subject vehicle.
- If a runout/balancing machine is used, record the radial runout of the tire/wheel assemblies on the
worksheet at the end of this bulletin. If one or more of the tire/wheel assemblies are more than.040
in (1.02 mm), match mount the tire to the wheel to get below.040 in (1.02 mm). For sensitive
customers, readings of 0.030 inch (0.76 mm) or less are preferable, it may also be of benefit to
have the lowest runout assembly to the front left corner. If the machine is not available and the
EVA data suggests there is an issue, swap the tire and wheel assemblies from the front to the
back. Re-check on the EVA and if the problem still exists, test another vehicle to find tires that do
not exhibit the same frequency and swap those tires
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force
Variation (RFV) > Page 1511
onto the subject vehicle.
- After match mounting, the tire/wheel assembly must be rebalanced.
If match mounting tires to in-spec wheels produces assembly values higher than these, tire
replacement may be necessary. Replacing tires at lower values will probably mean good tires are
being condemned. Because tires can sometimes become temporarily flat-spotted, which will affect
force variation, it is important that the vehicle be driven at least 16 km (10 mi) prior to measuring.
Tire pressure must also be adjusted to the usage pressure on the vehicle's tire placard prior to
measuring.
Most GM vehicles will tolerate radial force variation up to these levels. However, some vehicles are
more sensitive, and may require lower levels. Also, there are other tire parameters that equipment
such as the Hunter GSP9700 cannot measure that may be a factor. In such cases, TAC should be
contacted for further instructions.
Important
- When mounting a GM wheel to a wheel balancer/force variation machine, always use the wheel's
center pilot hole. This is the primary centering mechanism on all GM wheels; the bolt holes are
secondary. Usually a back cone method to the machine should be used. For added accuracy and
repeatability, a flange plate should be used to clamp the wheel onto the cone and machine. This
system is offered by all balancer manufacturers in GM's dealer program.
- Any type of service equipment that removes tread rubber by grinding, buffing or truing is NOT
recommended, and may void the tire warranty. However, tires may have been ground by the tire
company as part of their tire manufacturing process. This is a legitimate procedure.
Steering Wheel Shake Worksheet
When diagnosing vibration concerns, use the following worksheet in conjunction with the
appropriate Vibration Analysis-Road testing procedure in the Vibration Correction sub-section in SI.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force
Variation (RFV) > Page 1512
Refer to the appropriate section of SI for specifications and repair procedures that are related to the
vibration concern.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 05-03-10-003F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast
Aluminum Wheels
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 05-03-10-003F
Date: April 27, 2010
Subject: Low Tire Pressure, Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels (Repair with Adhesive Sealant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X with Cast Aluminum Wheels
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years and the bulletin reference
information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-10-003E (Section 03 - Suspension).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a low tire pressure condition.
Diagnosis of the low tire pressure condition indicates an air leak through the cast aluminum wheel.
Cause
Porosity in the cast aluminum wheel may be the cause.
Notice
This bulletin specifically addresses issues related to the wheel casting that may result in an air
leak. For issues related to corrosion of the wheel in service, please refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-03-10-006C - Tire Slowly Goes Flat, Tire Air Loss, Low Tire Pressure Warning Light
Illuminated, Aluminum Wheel Bead Seat Corrosion (Clean and Resurface Wheel Bead Seat).
Correction
1. Remove the tire and wheel assembly from the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate service
procedure in SI. 2. Locate the leaking area by inflating the tire to 276 kPa (40 psi) and dipping the
tire/wheel assembly in a water bath, or use a spray bottle with soap
and water to locate the specific leak location.
Important
- If the porosity leak is located in the bead area of the aluminum rim (where the tire meets the rim),
the wheel should be replaced.
- If two or more leaks are located on one wheel, the wheel should be replaced.
3. If air bubbles are observed, mark the location.
- If the leak location is on the tire/rubber area, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 04-03-10-001F Tire Puncture Repair Procedures for All Cars and Light Duty Trucks.
- If the leak is located on the aluminum wheel area, continue with the next step.
4. Inscribe a mark on the tire at the valve stem in order to indicate the orientation of the tire to the
wheel. 5. Dismount the tire from the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 6. Remove
the tire pressure sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor removal procedure in SI. 7. Scuff the
INSIDE rim surface at the leak area with #80 grit paper and clean the area with general purpose
cleaner, such as 3M(R) General Purpose
Adhesive Cleaner, P/N 08984, or equivalent.
8. Apply a 3 mm (0.12 in) thick layer of Silicone - Adhesive/Sealant, P/N 12378478 (in Canada, use
88900041), or equivalent, to the leak area. 9. Allow for the adhesive/sealant to dry.
Notice Caution must be used when mounting the tire so as not to damage the sealer. Damaging
the repair area may result in an air leak.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 05-03-10-003F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast
Aluminum Wheels > Page 1517
10. Align the inscribed mark on the tire with the valve stem on the wheel. 11. Reinstall the Tire
Pressure Sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor installation procedure in SI. 12. Mount the tire on
the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 13. Pressurize the tire to 276 kPa (40 psi) and
inspect for leaks. 14. Adjust tire pressure to meet the placard specification. 15. Balance the
tire/wheel assembly. Refer to Tire and Wheel Assembly Balancing - Off-Vehicle. 16. Install the tire
and wheel assembly onto the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate service procedure in SI.
Parts Information
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
Important The Silicone - Adhesive/Sealant comes in a case quantity of six. ONLY charge warranty
one tube of adhesive/sealant per wheel repair.
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
One leak repair per wheel.
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 04-03-10-012B > Feb > 08 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel Brake Dust
Accumulation/Pitting
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Brake Dust Accumulation/Pitting
Bulletin No.: 04-03-10-012B
Date: February 01, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Pitting and Brake Dust on Chrome wheels
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2008 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
04-03-10-012A (Section 03 - Suspension).
Analysis of Returned Wheels
Chrome wheels returned under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty for pitting concerns have
recently been evaluated. This condition is usually most severe in the vent (or window) area of the
front wheels. This "pitting" may actually be brake dust that has been allowed to accumulate on the
wheel. The longer this accumulation builds up, the more difficult it is to remove.
Cleaning the Wheels
In all cases, the returned wheels could be cleaned to their original condition using GM Vehicle Care
Cleaner Wax, P/N 12377966 (in Canada, P/N 10952905). When using this product, you should
confine your treatment to the areas of the wheel that show evidence of the brake dust build-up.
This product is only for use on chromed steel or chromed aluminum wheels.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Wheel replacement for this condition is NOT applicable under the terms of the New Vehicle Limited
Warranty.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 99-03-10-102 > Jun > 99 > Warranty - OE Chrome Plated
Aluminum Wheel ID
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Warranty - OE Chrome Plated Aluminum Wheel ID
File In Section: 03 - Suspension
Bulletin No.: 99-03-10-102
Date: June, 1999
INFORMATION
Subject: Original Equipment Chrome Plated Aluminum Wheel Identification
Models: 1999 and Prior Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
Chrome plated aluminum wheels have been returned to the Warranty Parts Center that are not the
original equipment (OE) components.
Original equipment chrome plated aluminum wheels can be identified by either a balance weight
clip retention groove (1) or a step (2) that is machined around both of the wheel's rim flanges. The
rim flanges (3) of painted original equipment aluminum wheels do not have a groove or a step.
Chrome plated aluminum wheels that do not have the wheel rim flange groove or step are
aftermarket chrome plated components and are NOT warrantable. Any aftermarket chrome wheels
received by the Warranty Parts Center will be charged back to the dealership.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 72-05-05 > Aug > 97 > Warranty - Guidelines for Using E0420
Wheel Replace
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Warranty - Guidelines for Using E0420 Wheel Replace
File In Section: Warranty Administration
Bulletin No.: 72-05-05
Date: August, 1997
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
Subject: Guidelines for Using EO42O Wheel Replace
Models: 1989-98 Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide service personnel with guidelines for using the above
subject labor operation.
Effective with repair orders dated on or after September 1, 1997, dealers are to be guided by the
following:
^ Aluminum Wheels (including chrome plated) with Porosity - Wheels that exhibit porosity should
be repaired as described in the vehicle service manual. Wheels should not be replaced without
wholesale approval.
^ Aluminum Wheels (except chrome plated) with a "Finish Defect" - Wheels that exhibit a defect in
the finish, (i.e., discoloration or surface degradation) should be refinished as described in the
Corporate Service Bulletin Number 53-17-03A released in May, 1996.
^ Chrome Wheels - Wheels that are chromed and found to have a finish defect can only be
replaced.
^ Aluminum and chrome wheels replaced under warranty will be subject to random part review and
inspection. Those wheels inspected and found not to be defective and/or should have been
repaired, will be subject to charge back.
Wheels damaged by normal wear, road hazards, car wash brushes, or other physical or chemical
damage are not eligible for warranty coverage.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 531703A > May > 96 > Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing
Technical Service Bulletin # 531703A Date: 960501
Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing
File In Section: 10 - Body
Bulletin No.: 53-17-03A
Date: May, 1996
INFORMATION
Subject: Aluminum Wheel Refinishing
Models: 1991-96 Passenger Cars and Trucks
This bulletin is being revised to delete the 1990 model year and add the 1996 model year. Please
discard Corporate Bulletin Number 53-17-03 (Section 10 - Body).
This bulletin supersedes and cancels all previous service bulletins concerning the refinishing of
aluminum wheels. The purpose of this service bulletin is to assist dealerships in repairing the
discoloration or surface degradation that has occurred on styled aluminum wheels.
This bulletin provides NEW PROCEDURES AND SPECIFIC MATERIALS for the refinishing of
painted aluminum wheels or aluminum wheels with discoloration or surface degradation.
Important:
THE RE-MACHINING OF ALUMINUM WHEELS IS NOT RECOMMENDED. THE RE-CLEAR
COATING OF ALUMINUM WHEELS IS NO LONGER RECOMMENDED DUE TO CONCERNS OF
REPAIR DURABILITY
The new procedure requires the wheel surface be plastic media blasted to remove old paint or
clear coat. CHEMICAL STRIPPERS ARE NOT RECOMMENDED.
Material Required
System 1: DuPont Products
3939-S Cleaning Solvent 615/616 Etching Primer URO 5000 Primer Surfacer IMRON 6000
Basecoat 3440-S IMRON Clear
System 2: PPG Products
DX533 Aluminum Cleaner DX503 Aluminum Conditioner DP Epoxy Primer Deltron Basecoat
(DBC) Concept 2001 Clear Acrylic Urethane
System 3: Spies Hecker
Permahyd Silicone Remover 7090 Permahyd 1:1 Primer 4070 Permahyd 2:1 Surfacer 5080
Permahyd Base Coat Series 280/285 Permahyd H.S. Clearcoat 8060
Color Selection
If the wheels being painted were previously clearcoated aluminum, we would recommend using
Corsican SILVER WAEQ9283 for a fine "aluminum-like" look or Sparkle SILVER WA9967 for a
very bright look. As an option to the customer, you may also use body color. For color
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 531703A > May > 96 > Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing > Page
1534
selection and verification, refer to your paint manufacturer's color book. On wheels that were
previous clearcoated aluminum it is recommended that all four wheels and their center caps be
refinished to maintain color uniformity.
Important:
THE PRODUCTS LISTED MUST BE USED AS A SYSTEM. DO NOT MIX OTHER
MANUFACTURERS' PRODUCT LINES WITH THE REQUIRED MATERIALS. PRODUCTS
LISTED IN THIS BULLETIN HAVE SHOWN THE REQUIRED REPAIR DURABILITY, AND
CURRENTLY ARE THE ONLY PAINT SYSTEMS THAT MEET GM SPECIFICATION
4350M-A336.
Procedures
1. Remove wheels from vehicle. Tires may remain mounted on wheels.
2. Remove balance weights and mark their location on tire.
3. Wipe excess grease, etc. from wheels with wax and grease remover.
4. Have wheels plastic media blasted to remove clearcoat. FOR FURTHER INFORMATION ON
MEDIA BLASTING IN YOUR AREA, CALL US TECHNOLOGIES INC., CONTACT DAVE
ROSENBURG AT 1-800-634-9185.
Caution:
IT IS MANDATORY THAT ADEQUATE RESPIRATORY PROTECTION BE WORN. EXAMPLES
OF SUCH PROTECTION ARE: AIR LINE RESPIRATORS WITH FULL HOOD OR HALF MASK. IF
NOT AVAILABLE, USE A VAPOR/PARTICULATE RESPIRATOR THAT RESPIRATOR
MANUFACTURER RECOMMENDS AS EFFECTIVE FOR ISOCYANATE VAPOR AND MISTS
(UNLESS LOCAL REGULATIONS PREVAIL).
5. Painting Process
a. Refer to Attachments 1-3 for each System's individual formula and process.
b. After following the specific System's individual formula and process, follow these steps:
6. Unmask wheels.
7. Clean all wheel mounting surface of any corrosion, overspray, or dirt.
8. Install new coated balance weights, at marked locations.
9. Replace wheels on vehicle.
10. USE A TORQUE STICK ON AN IMPACT WRENCH, OR A TORQUE WRENCH TO
CONSISTENTLY AND UNIFORMLY FASTEN THE WHEEL TO THE SPECIFIED TORQUE FOR
THE VEHICLE. THE STAR PATTERN MUST BE FOLLOWED.
Important:
TORQUE STICKS MUST BE USED ANY TIME AN IMPACT WRENCH IS USED TO TIGHTEN
WHEEL NUTS.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use as shown.
Attachment 1 - DuPont Products
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 531703A > May > 96 > Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing > Page
1535
Painting Process
System: Dupont Products
Paint Color Information: Corsican Silver WA EQ9283 Dupont # C9143, Sparkle Silver WA9967
Dupont # C9339
1. Wipe wheel with cleaning solvent: 3939-S, 3949-S or 3900-S.
2. Mask off tires.
Important:
3. Mask off all wheel mounting surfaces and wheel mount surfaces.
4. Apply two coats of 615/616-S etching primer to wheel allowing 10 minutes flash between coats.
Allow to dry for 30 minutes before applying primer coat.
5. Apply URO 5000 primer 1220/193-S + accelerator 389-S using two coats at 65-70 PSI at the
gun. Allow 12-15 minutes between coats. Force bake 30 minutes at 140°F (60°C).
6. Scuff sand using green Scotch-Brite pad.
7. Solvent wipe before top coating.
8. Apply IMRON 6000 base coat to wheel. 2-3 coats to hiding at 60-70 PSI allowing to flash
between coats. Base coat needs to dry 20-30 minutes before clearcoat is applied.
9. Apply 3440-S clearcoat to wheel using two coats at 60-70 PSI. Flash 10-15 minutes between
coats. 389-S can be used in basecoat and clearcoat to give faster set up times.
10. Allow overnight dry before reassemble. Can be baked for 30 minutes at 140°F (60°C).
Attachment 2 - PPG Products
Painting Process: PPG System
Paint Color Information: Corsican Silver WAEQ9283; PPG # DBC-3531, Sparkle Silver WA9967;
PPG # 35367
1. Wash entire wheel with aluminum cleaner DX533, mix 1:3 with water. Allow to react 2-3 minutes
and rinse thoroughly.
2. Wash entire wheel with aluminum conditioner DX5O3 straight from the container. Allow to react
2-3 minutes until pale gold or tan color develops. Rinse thoroughly and dry.
3. Mask off tires.
Important:
4. Mask off all wheel nut mounting surfaces and wheel mounting surfaces.
5. Apply 1-2 coats of DP Primer and allow to flash for 15-20 minutes.
6. Apply 2-3 coats of Deltron Basecoat (DBC) and allow to flash 20 minutes after the final coat.
7. Apply two (2) wet coats of Concept 2001 Acrylic urethane.
8. Flash 20 minutes and bake 140°F (60°C) for 30 minutes.
For more information contact your PPG Jobber.
Attachment 3 - Spies Hecker
Painting Process: Spies Hecker System
Paint Color Information: Corsican Silver AWEQ9283; SH-72913, Sparkle Silver WA9967;
SH-71912
1. Clean with Permahyd Silicone Remover 7090.
2. Mask off tires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 531703A > May > 96 > Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing > Page
1536
Important:
3. Mask off all wheel nut mounting surfaces and wheel mounting surfaces.
4. Apply 1-1/2 coats of Permahyd 1:1 Primer 4070. Mix 1:1 with Permahyd Hardener 3070 as per
TDS.
5. Allow to flash for 30 minutes.
6. Apply two (2) coats of Permahyd 2:1 Surfacer 5080. Mix 2:1 with Permahyd Hardener 3071 as
per TDS.
7. Bake for 60 minutes at 140°F (60°C) or allow to flash for 3 hours at 68°F (20°C).
8. Apply Permahyd Base Coat Series 280/285 as per TDS.
9. Allow to flash 10 to 15 minutes.
10. Apply 1 to 2 coats of Permacron High Solid Clear Coat 8060 as per TDS.
11. Allow to flash 10 minutes. Then bake at 140°F (60°C) for 40 minutes.
For more information, contact your SPIES HECKER Jobber.
We believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such products. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products or equipment from these firms or for any such items which may be
available from other sources.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Staining/Pitting/Corrosion
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-03-10-002F
Date: April 21, 2011
Subject: Chemical Staining, Pitting, Corrosion and/or Spotted Appearance of Chromed Aluminum
Wheels
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years, suggest additional restorative
products and add additional corrosion information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
00-03-10-002E (Section 03 - Suspension). Important You may give a copy of this bulletin to the
customer.
What is Chemical Staining of Chrome Wheels? Figure 1
Chemical staining in most cases results from acid based cleaners (refer to Figure 1 for an
example). These stains are frequently milky, black, or greenish in appearance. They result from
using cleaning solutions that contain acids on chrome wheels. Soap and water is usually sufficient
to clean wheels.
If the customer insists on using a wheel cleaner they should only use one that specifically states
that it is safe for chromed wheels and does not contain anything in the following list. (Dealers
should also survey any products they use during prep or normal cleaning of stock units for these
chemicals.)
- Ammonium Bifluoride (fluoride source for dissolution of chrome)
- Hydrofluoric Acid (directly dissolves chrome)
- Hydrochloric Acid (directly dissolves chrome)
- Sodium Dodecylbenzenesulfonic Acid
- Sulfamic Acid
- Phosphoric Acid
- Hydroxyacetic Acid
Notice
Many wheel cleaner instructions advise to take care to avoid contact with painted surfaces. Most
customers think of painted surfaces as the fenders, quarter panels and other exterior sheet metal.
Many vehicles have painted brake calipers. Acidic wheel cleaners may craze, crack, or discolor the
paint on the brake calipers. Damage from wheel cleaners is not covered under the vehicle new car
warranty. Soap and water applied with a soft brush is usually all that is required to clean the
calipers.
Whenever any wheel cleaner is used, it must be THOROUGHLY rinsed off of the wheel with clean,
clear water. Special care must be taken to rinse under the hub cap, balance weights, wheel nuts,
lug nut caps, between the wheel cladding and off the back side of the wheel. Wheels returned to
the Warranty Parts Center (WPC) that exhibit damage from wheel cleaners most often have the
damage around and under the wheel weight where the cleaner was incompletely flushed away.
Notice
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 1542
Do not use cleaning solutions that contain hydrofluoric, oxalic and most other acids on chrome
wheels (or any wheels).
If the customer is unsure of the chemical make-up of a particular wheel cleaner, it should be
avoided.
For wheels showing signs of milky staining from acidic cleaners, refer to Customer Assistance and
Instructions below.
Warranty of Stained Chrome Wheels
Stained wheels are not warrantable. Most acid based cleaners will permanently stain chrome
wheels. Follow-up with dealers has confirmed that such cleaners were used on wheels that were
returned to the Warranty Parts Center (WPC). Any stained wheels received by the WPC will be
charged back to the dealership. To assist the customer, refer to Customer Assistance and
Instructions below.
Pitting or Spotted Appearance of Chrome Wheels Figure 2
A second type or staining or finish disturbance may result from road chemicals, such as calcium
chloride used for dust control of unpaved roads. The staining will look like small pitting (refer to
Figure 2). This staining will usually be on the leading edges of each wheel spoke, but may be
uniformly distributed. If a vehicle must be operated under such conditions, the chrome wheels
should be washed with mild soap and water and thoroughly rinsed as soon as conveniently
possible.
Important Road chemicals, such as calcium chloride used for dust control of unpaved roads, can
also stain chrome wheels. The staining will look like small pitting. This staining will usually be on
the leading edges of each wheel spoke. This is explained by the vehicle traveling in the forward
direction while being splashed by the road chemical. If a vehicle must be operated under such
conditions, the chrome wheels should be washed with mild soap and water and thoroughly rinsed
as soon as conveniently possible.
Warranty of Pitted or Spotted Chrome Wheels
Wheels returned with pitting or spotting as a result of road chemicals may be replaced one time.
Damage resulting from contact with these applied road chemicals is corrosive to the wheels finish
and may cause damage if the wheels are not kept clean.
Important Notify the customer that this is a one time replacement. Please stress to the customer
the vital importance of keeping the wheels clean if they are operating the vehicle in an area that
applies calcium chloride or other dust controlling chemicals! "GM of Canada" dealers require prior
approval by the District Manager - Customer Care and Service Process (DM-CCSP).
"Stardust" Corrosion of Chrome Wheels Figure 3
A third type of finish disturbance results from prolonged exposure to brake dust and resultant
penetration of brake dust through the chrome. As brakes are applied hot particles of brake material
are thrown off and tend to be forced through the leading edge of the wheel spoke windows by
airflow. These
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 1543
hot particles embed themselves in the chrome layer and create a small pit. If the material is allowed
to sit on the wheel while it is exposed to moisture or salt, it will corrode the wheel beneath the
chrome leaving a pit or small blister in the chrome.
Heavy brake dust build-up should be removed from wheels by using GM Chrome Cleaner and
Polish, P/N 1050173 (in Canada use 10953013). For moderate cleaning, light brake dust build-up
or water spots use GM Swirl Remover Polish, P/N 12377965 (in Canada, use Meguiars
Plast-X(TM) Clear Plastic Cleaner and Polish #G12310C**). After cleaning, the wheel should be
waxed using GM Cleaner Wax, P/N 12377966 (in Canada, use Meguiars Cleaner Wax
#M0616C**), which will help protect the wheel from brake dust and reduce adhesion of any brake
dust that gets on the wheel surface. For general maintenance cleaning, PEEK Metal Polish† may
be used. It will clean and shine the chrome and leave behind a wax coating that may help protect
the finish.
Warranty of Stardust Corroded Chrome Wheels
Wheels returned with pitting or spotting as a result of neglect and brake dust build-up may be
replaced one time.
Important Notify the customer that this is a one time replacement. Please stress to the customer
the vital importance of keeping the wheels clean and free of prolonged exposure to brake dust
build-up. "GM of Canada" dealers require prior approval by the District Manager - Customer Care
and Service Process (DM-CCSP).
Customer Assistance and Instructions
GM has looked for ways customers may improve the appearance of wheels damaged by acidic
cleaners. The following product and procedure has been found to dramatically improve the
appearance of stained wheels. For wheels that have milky stains caused by acidic cleaners try the
following:
Notice
THE 3M CHROME AND METAL POLISH REQUIRED FOR THIS PROCEDURE IS AN
EXTREMELY AGGRESSIVE POLISH/CLEANER. THE WHEELS MUST BE CLEANED BEFORE
APPLICATION TO AVOID SCRATCHING THE WHEEL SURFACE. THIS PRODUCT WILL
REDUCE THE THICKNESS OF THE CHROME PLATING ON THE WHEEL AND IF USED
INCORRECTLY OR EXCESSIVELY MAY REMOVE THE CHROME PLATING ALL TOGETHER,
EXPOSING A LESS BRIGHT AND BRASSY COLORED SUB-LAYER. FOLLOW INSTRUCTIONS
EXACTLY.
1. Wash the wheels with vigorously with soap and water. This step will clean and may reduce
wheel staining. Flood all areas of the wheel with water
to rinse.
2. Dry the wheels completely.
Notice Begin with a small section of the wheel and with light pressure buff off polish and examine
results. ONLY apply and rub with sufficient force and time to remove enough staining that you are
satisfied with the results. Some wheels may be stained to the extent that you may only achieve a
50% improvement while others may be able to be restored to the original lustre. IN ALL CASES,
only apply until the results are satisfactory.
3. Apply 3M Chrome and Metal Polish #39527* with a clean terry cloth towel. As you apply the
polish, the staining will be diminished. 4. When dry, buff off the polish with a clean portion of the
towel. 5. Repeat application of the 3M Chrome and Metal Polish until satisfied with the results. If
continued applications fail to improve the appearance
further discontinue use.
This procedure will improve the appearance of the wheels and may, with repeated applications,
restore the finish dramatically. For wheels that exhibit spotting from road chemicals the above
procedure may marginally improve the condition but will not restore the finish or remove the pitting.
In this type of staining the wheel finish has actually been removed in spots and no manner of
cleaning will restore the finish.
†*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or
assume any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may
be available from other sources.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 1544
*This product is currently available from 3M. To obtain information for your local retail location
please call 3M at 1-888-364-3577.
**This product is currently available from Meguiars (Canada). To obtain information for your local
retail location please call Meguiars at 1-800-347-5700 or at www.meguiarscanada.com.
^ This product is currently available from Tri-Peek International. To obtain information for your local
retail location please call Tri-Peek at
1-877-615-4272 or at www.tripeek.com.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 99-08-51-007E > Mar > 11 > Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum
Wheels
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum Wheels
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 99-08-51-007E
Date: March 17, 2011
Subject: Refinishing Aluminum Wheels
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add additional model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 99-08-51-007D (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
This bulletin updates General Motor's position on refinishing aluminum wheels. GM does not
endorse any repairs that involve welding, bending, straightening or re-machining. Only cosmetic
refinishing of the wheel's coatings, using recommended procedures, is allowed.
Evaluating Damage
In evaluating damage, it is the GM Dealer's responsibility to inspect the wheel for corrosion,
scrapes, gouges, etc. The Dealer must insure that such damage is not deeper than what can be
sanded or polished off. The wheel must be inspected for cracks. If cracks are found, discard the
wheel. Any wheels with bent rim flanges must not be repaired or refinished. Wheels that have been
refinished by an outside company must be returned to the same vehicle. The Dealer must record
the wheel ID stamp or the cast date on the wheel in order to assure this requirement. Refer to
Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company later in this bulletin.
Aluminum Wheel Refinishing Recommendations
- Chrome-plated aluminum wheels Re-plating these wheels is not recommended.
- Polished aluminum wheels These wheels have a polyester or acrylic clearcoat on them. If the
clearcoat is damaged, refinishing is possible. However, the required refinishing process cannot be
performed in the dealer environment. Refer to Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company later
in this bulletin.
- Painted aluminum wheels These wheels are painted using a primer, color coat, and clearcoat
procedure. If the paint is damaged, refinishing is possible. As with polished wheels, all original
coatings must be removed first. Media blasting is recommended. Refer to GM Aluminum
Refinishing Bulletin #53-17-03A for the re-painting of this type of wheel.
- Bright, machined aluminum wheels These wheels have a polyester or acrylic clearcoat on them.
In some cases, the recessed "pocket" areas of the wheel may be painted. Surface refinishing is
possible. The wheel must be totally stripped by media blasting or other suitable means. The wheel
should be resurfaced by using a sanding process rather than a machining process. This allows the
least amount of material to be removed.
Important Do not use any re-machining process that removes aluminum. This could affect the
dimensions and function of the wheel.
Painting is an option to re-clearcoating polished and bright machined aluminum wheels. Paint will
better mask any surface imperfections and is somewhat more durable than clearcoat alone. GM
recommends using Corsican SILVER WAEQ9283 for a fine "aluminum-like" look or Sparkle
SILVER WA9967 for a very bright look. As an option, the body color may also be used. When using
any of the painting options, it is recommended that all four wheels be refinished in order to maintain
color uniformity. Refer to GM Aluminum Refinishing Bulletin #53-17-03A for specific procedures
and product recommendations.
Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company
Important Some outside companies are offering wheel refinishing services. Such refinished wheels
will be permanently marked by the refinisher and are warranted by the refinisher. Any process that
re-machines or otherwise re-manufactures the wheel should not be used.
A refinisher's responsibility includes inspecting for cracks using the Zyglo system or the equivalent.
Any cracked wheels must not be refinished. No welding, hammering or reforming of any kind is
allowed. The wheel ID must be recorded and follow the wheel throughout the process in order to
assure that the same wheel is returned. A plastic media blast may be used for clean up of the
wheel. Hand and/or lathe sanding of the machined surface and the wheel window is allowed.
Material removal, though, must be kept to a minimum. Re-machining of the wheel is not allowed.
Paint and/or clear coat must not be present on the following surfaces: the nut chamfers, the wheel
mounting surfaces and the wheel pilot hole. The refinisher must permanently ID stamp the wheel
and warrant the painted/clearcoated surfaces for a minimum of one year or the remainder of the
new vehicle warranty, whichever is
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 99-08-51-007E > Mar > 11 > Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum
Wheels > Page 1549
longer.
Important Whenever a wheel is refinished, the mounting surface and the wheel nut contact
surfaces must not be painted or clearcoated. Coating these surfaces could affect the wheel nut
torque.
When re-mounting a tire on an aluminum wheel, coated balance weights must be used in order to
reduce the chance of future cosmetic damage.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing
Procedures/Precautions
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Changing Procedures/Precautions
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-03-10-010A
Date: June 09, 2010
Subject: Information on Proper Wheel Changing Procedures and Cautions
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER Models 2005-2009 Saab
9-7X 2005-2009 Saturn Vehicles
Attention:
Complete wheel changing instructions for each vehicle line can be found under Tire and Wheel
Removal and Installation in Service Information (SI). This bulletin is intended to quickly review and
reinforce simple but vital procedures to reduce the possibility of achieving low torque during wheel
installation. Always refer to SI for wheel lug nut torque specifications and complete jacking
instructions for safe wheel changing.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include the 2011 model year and update the available
special tool list. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-03-10-010 (Section 03 Suspension).
Frequency of Wheel Changes - Marketplace Driven
Just a few years ago, the increasing longevity of tires along with greater resistance to punctures
had greatly reduced the number of times wheels were removed to basically required tire rotation
intervals. Today with the booming business in accessory wheels/special application tires (such as
winter tires), consumers are having tire/wheel assemblies removed - replaced - or installed more
than ever. With this increased activity, it opens up more of a chance for error on the part of the
technician. This bulletin will review a few of the common concerns and mistakes to make yourself
aware of.
Proper Servicing Starts With the Right Tools
The following tools have been made available to assist in proper wheel and tire removal and
installation.
- J 41013 Rotor Resurfacing Kit (or equivalent)
- J 42450-A Wheel Hub Resurfacing Kit (or equivalent)
Corroded Surfaces
One area of concern is corrosion on the mating surfaces of the wheel to the hub on the vehicle.
Excessive corrosion, dirt, rust or debris built up on these surfaces can mimic a properly tightened
wheel in the service stall. Once the vehicle is driven, the debris may loosen, grind up or be washed
away from water splash. This action may result in clearance at the mating surface of the wheel and
an under-torqued condition.
Caution
Before installing a wheel, remove any buildup on the wheel mounting surface and brake drum or
brake disc mounting surface. Installing wheels with poor metal-to-metal contact at the mounting
surfaces can cause wheel nuts to loosen. This may cause a wheel to come off when the vehicle is
moving, possibly resulting in a loss of control or personal injury.
Whenever you remove the tire/wheel assemblies, you must inspect the mating surfaces. If
corrosion is found, you should remove the debris with a die grinder equipped with a fine sanding
pad, wire brush or cleaning disc. Just remove enough material to assure a clean, smooth mating
surface.
The J 41013 (or equivalent) can be used to clean the following surfaces:
- The hub mounting surface
- The brake rotor mounting surface
- The wheel mounting surface
Use the J 42450-A (or equivalent) to clean around the base of the studs and the hub.
Lubricants, Grease and Fluids
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing
Procedures/Precautions > Page 1554
Some customers may use penetrating oils, grease or other lubricants on wheel studs to aid in
removal or installation. Always use a suitable cleaner/solvent to remove these lubricants prior to
installing the wheel and tire assemblies. Lubricants left on the wheel studs may cause improper
readings of wheel nut torque. Always install wheels to clean, dry wheel studs ONLY.
Notice
Lubricants left on the wheel studs or vertical mounting surfaces between the wheel and the rotor or
drum may cause the wheel to work itself loose after the vehicle is driven. Always install wheels to
clean, dry wheel studs and surfaces ONLY. Beginning with 2011 model year vehicles, put a light
coating of grease, GM P/N 1051344 (in Canada, P/N 9930370), on the inner surface of the wheel
pilot hole to prevent wheel seizure to the axle or bearing hub.
Wheel Stud and Lug Nut Damage
Always inspect the wheel studs and lug nuts for signs of damage from crossthreading or abuse.
You should never have to force wheel nuts down the stud. Lug nuts that are damaged may not
retain properly, yet give the impression of fully tightening. Always inspect and replace any
component suspected of damage.
Tip
Always start wheel nuts by hand! Be certain that all wheel nut threads have been engaged
BEFORE tightening the nut.
Important If the vehicle has directional tread tires, verify the directional arrow on the outboard side
of the tire is pointing in the direction of forward rotation.
Wheel Nut Tightening and Torque
Improper wheel nut tightening can lead to brake pulsation and rotor damage. In order to avoid
additional brake repairs, evenly tighten the wheel nuts to the proper torque specification as shown
for each vehicle in SI. Always observe the proper wheel nut tightening sequence as shown below in
order to avoid trapping the wheel on the wheel stud threads or clamping the wheel slightly off
center resulting in vibration.
The Most Important Service You Provide
While the above information is well known, and wheel removal so common, technicians run the risk
of becoming complacent on this very important
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing
Procedures/Precautions > Page 1555
service operation. A simple distraction or time constraint that rushes the job may result in personal
injury if the greatest of care is not exercised. Make it a habit to double check your work and to
always side with caution when installing wheels.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 04-03-10-012B > Feb > 08 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel Brake Dust
Accumulation/Pitting
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Brake Dust Accumulation/Pitting
Bulletin No.: 04-03-10-012B
Date: February 01, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Pitting and Brake Dust on Chrome wheels
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2008 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
04-03-10-012A (Section 03 - Suspension).
Analysis of Returned Wheels
Chrome wheels returned under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty for pitting concerns have
recently been evaluated. This condition is usually most severe in the vent (or window) area of the
front wheels. This "pitting" may actually be brake dust that has been allowed to accumulate on the
wheel. The longer this accumulation builds up, the more difficult it is to remove.
Cleaning the Wheels
In all cases, the returned wheels could be cleaned to their original condition using GM Vehicle Care
Cleaner Wax, P/N 12377966 (in Canada, P/N 10952905). When using this product, you should
confine your treatment to the areas of the wheel that show evidence of the brake dust build-up.
This product is only for use on chromed steel or chromed aluminum wheels.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Wheel replacement for this condition is NOT applicable under the terms of the New Vehicle Limited
Warranty.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 99-03-10-102 > Jun > 99 > Warranty - OE Chrome Plated Aluminum
Wheel ID
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Warranty - OE Chrome Plated Aluminum Wheel ID
File In Section: 03 - Suspension
Bulletin No.: 99-03-10-102
Date: June, 1999
INFORMATION
Subject: Original Equipment Chrome Plated Aluminum Wheel Identification
Models: 1999 and Prior Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
Chrome plated aluminum wheels have been returned to the Warranty Parts Center that are not the
original equipment (OE) components.
Original equipment chrome plated aluminum wheels can be identified by either a balance weight
clip retention groove (1) or a step (2) that is machined around both of the wheel's rim flanges. The
rim flanges (3) of painted original equipment aluminum wheels do not have a groove or a step.
Chrome plated aluminum wheels that do not have the wheel rim flange groove or step are
aftermarket chrome plated components and are NOT warrantable. Any aftermarket chrome wheels
received by the Warranty Parts Center will be charged back to the dealership.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 72-05-05 > Aug > 97 > Warranty - Guidelines for Using E0420 Wheel
Replace
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Warranty - Guidelines for Using E0420 Wheel Replace
File In Section: Warranty Administration
Bulletin No.: 72-05-05
Date: August, 1997
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
Subject: Guidelines for Using EO42O Wheel Replace
Models: 1989-98 Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide service personnel with guidelines for using the above
subject labor operation.
Effective with repair orders dated on or after September 1, 1997, dealers are to be guided by the
following:
^ Aluminum Wheels (including chrome plated) with Porosity - Wheels that exhibit porosity should
be repaired as described in the vehicle service manual. Wheels should not be replaced without
wholesale approval.
^ Aluminum Wheels (except chrome plated) with a "Finish Defect" - Wheels that exhibit a defect in
the finish, (i.e., discoloration or surface degradation) should be refinished as described in the
Corporate Service Bulletin Number 53-17-03A released in May, 1996.
^ Chrome Wheels - Wheels that are chromed and found to have a finish defect can only be
replaced.
^ Aluminum and chrome wheels replaced under warranty will be subject to random part review and
inspection. Those wheels inspected and found not to be defective and/or should have been
repaired, will be subject to charge back.
Wheels damaged by normal wear, road hazards, car wash brushes, or other physical or chemical
damage are not eligible for warranty coverage.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 531703A > May > 96 > Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing
Technical Service Bulletin # 531703A Date: 960501
Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing
File In Section: 10 - Body
Bulletin No.: 53-17-03A
Date: May, 1996
INFORMATION
Subject: Aluminum Wheel Refinishing
Models: 1991-96 Passenger Cars and Trucks
This bulletin is being revised to delete the 1990 model year and add the 1996 model year. Please
discard Corporate Bulletin Number 53-17-03 (Section 10 - Body).
This bulletin supersedes and cancels all previous service bulletins concerning the refinishing of
aluminum wheels. The purpose of this service bulletin is to assist dealerships in repairing the
discoloration or surface degradation that has occurred on styled aluminum wheels.
This bulletin provides NEW PROCEDURES AND SPECIFIC MATERIALS for the refinishing of
painted aluminum wheels or aluminum wheels with discoloration or surface degradation.
Important:
THE RE-MACHINING OF ALUMINUM WHEELS IS NOT RECOMMENDED. THE RE-CLEAR
COATING OF ALUMINUM WHEELS IS NO LONGER RECOMMENDED DUE TO CONCERNS OF
REPAIR DURABILITY
The new procedure requires the wheel surface be plastic media blasted to remove old paint or
clear coat. CHEMICAL STRIPPERS ARE NOT RECOMMENDED.
Material Required
System 1: DuPont Products
3939-S Cleaning Solvent 615/616 Etching Primer URO 5000 Primer Surfacer IMRON 6000
Basecoat 3440-S IMRON Clear
System 2: PPG Products
DX533 Aluminum Cleaner DX503 Aluminum Conditioner DP Epoxy Primer Deltron Basecoat
(DBC) Concept 2001 Clear Acrylic Urethane
System 3: Spies Hecker
Permahyd Silicone Remover 7090 Permahyd 1:1 Primer 4070 Permahyd 2:1 Surfacer 5080
Permahyd Base Coat Series 280/285 Permahyd H.S. Clearcoat 8060
Color Selection
If the wheels being painted were previously clearcoated aluminum, we would recommend using
Corsican SILVER WAEQ9283 for a fine "aluminum-like" look or Sparkle SILVER WA9967 for a
very bright look. As an option to the customer, you may also use body color. For color
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 531703A > May > 96 > Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing > Page 1572
selection and verification, refer to your paint manufacturer's color book. On wheels that were
previous clearcoated aluminum it is recommended that all four wheels and their center caps be
refinished to maintain color uniformity.
Important:
THE PRODUCTS LISTED MUST BE USED AS A SYSTEM. DO NOT MIX OTHER
MANUFACTURERS' PRODUCT LINES WITH THE REQUIRED MATERIALS. PRODUCTS
LISTED IN THIS BULLETIN HAVE SHOWN THE REQUIRED REPAIR DURABILITY, AND
CURRENTLY ARE THE ONLY PAINT SYSTEMS THAT MEET GM SPECIFICATION
4350M-A336.
Procedures
1. Remove wheels from vehicle. Tires may remain mounted on wheels.
2. Remove balance weights and mark their location on tire.
3. Wipe excess grease, etc. from wheels with wax and grease remover.
4. Have wheels plastic media blasted to remove clearcoat. FOR FURTHER INFORMATION ON
MEDIA BLASTING IN YOUR AREA, CALL US TECHNOLOGIES INC., CONTACT DAVE
ROSENBURG AT 1-800-634-9185.
Caution:
IT IS MANDATORY THAT ADEQUATE RESPIRATORY PROTECTION BE WORN. EXAMPLES
OF SUCH PROTECTION ARE: AIR LINE RESPIRATORS WITH FULL HOOD OR HALF MASK. IF
NOT AVAILABLE, USE A VAPOR/PARTICULATE RESPIRATOR THAT RESPIRATOR
MANUFACTURER RECOMMENDS AS EFFECTIVE FOR ISOCYANATE VAPOR AND MISTS
(UNLESS LOCAL REGULATIONS PREVAIL).
5. Painting Process
a. Refer to Attachments 1-3 for each System's individual formula and process.
b. After following the specific System's individual formula and process, follow these steps:
6. Unmask wheels.
7. Clean all wheel mounting surface of any corrosion, overspray, or dirt.
8. Install new coated balance weights, at marked locations.
9. Replace wheels on vehicle.
10. USE A TORQUE STICK ON AN IMPACT WRENCH, OR A TORQUE WRENCH TO
CONSISTENTLY AND UNIFORMLY FASTEN THE WHEEL TO THE SPECIFIED TORQUE FOR
THE VEHICLE. THE STAR PATTERN MUST BE FOLLOWED.
Important:
TORQUE STICKS MUST BE USED ANY TIME AN IMPACT WRENCH IS USED TO TIGHTEN
WHEEL NUTS.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use as shown.
Attachment 1 - DuPont Products
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 531703A > May > 96 > Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing > Page 1573
Painting Process
System: Dupont Products
Paint Color Information: Corsican Silver WA EQ9283 Dupont # C9143, Sparkle Silver WA9967
Dupont # C9339
1. Wipe wheel with cleaning solvent: 3939-S, 3949-S or 3900-S.
2. Mask off tires.
Important:
3. Mask off all wheel mounting surfaces and wheel mount surfaces.
4. Apply two coats of 615/616-S etching primer to wheel allowing 10 minutes flash between coats.
Allow to dry for 30 minutes before applying primer coat.
5. Apply URO 5000 primer 1220/193-S + accelerator 389-S using two coats at 65-70 PSI at the
gun. Allow 12-15 minutes between coats. Force bake 30 minutes at 140°F (60°C).
6. Scuff sand using green Scotch-Brite pad.
7. Solvent wipe before top coating.
8. Apply IMRON 6000 base coat to wheel. 2-3 coats to hiding at 60-70 PSI allowing to flash
between coats. Base coat needs to dry 20-30 minutes before clearcoat is applied.
9. Apply 3440-S clearcoat to wheel using two coats at 60-70 PSI. Flash 10-15 minutes between
coats. 389-S can be used in basecoat and clearcoat to give faster set up times.
10. Allow overnight dry before reassemble. Can be baked for 30 minutes at 140°F (60°C).
Attachment 2 - PPG Products
Painting Process: PPG System
Paint Color Information: Corsican Silver WAEQ9283; PPG # DBC-3531, Sparkle Silver WA9967;
PPG # 35367
1. Wash entire wheel with aluminum cleaner DX533, mix 1:3 with water. Allow to react 2-3 minutes
and rinse thoroughly.
2. Wash entire wheel with aluminum conditioner DX5O3 straight from the container. Allow to react
2-3 minutes until pale gold or tan color develops. Rinse thoroughly and dry.
3. Mask off tires.
Important:
4. Mask off all wheel nut mounting surfaces and wheel mounting surfaces.
5. Apply 1-2 coats of DP Primer and allow to flash for 15-20 minutes.
6. Apply 2-3 coats of Deltron Basecoat (DBC) and allow to flash 20 minutes after the final coat.
7. Apply two (2) wet coats of Concept 2001 Acrylic urethane.
8. Flash 20 minutes and bake 140°F (60°C) for 30 minutes.
For more information contact your PPG Jobber.
Attachment 3 - Spies Hecker
Painting Process: Spies Hecker System
Paint Color Information: Corsican Silver AWEQ9283; SH-72913, Sparkle Silver WA9967;
SH-71912
1. Clean with Permahyd Silicone Remover 7090.
2. Mask off tires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 531703A > May > 96 > Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing > Page 1574
Important:
3. Mask off all wheel nut mounting surfaces and wheel mounting surfaces.
4. Apply 1-1/2 coats of Permahyd 1:1 Primer 4070. Mix 1:1 with Permahyd Hardener 3070 as per
TDS.
5. Allow to flash for 30 minutes.
6. Apply two (2) coats of Permahyd 2:1 Surfacer 5080. Mix 2:1 with Permahyd Hardener 3071 as
per TDS.
7. Bake for 60 minutes at 140°F (60°C) or allow to flash for 3 hours at 68°F (20°C).
8. Apply Permahyd Base Coat Series 280/285 as per TDS.
9. Allow to flash 10 to 15 minutes.
10. Apply 1 to 2 coats of Permacron High Solid Clear Coat 8060 as per TDS.
11. Allow to flash 10 minutes. Then bake at 140°F (60°C) for 40 minutes.
For more information, contact your SPIES HECKER Jobber.
We believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such products. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products or equipment from these firms or for any such items which may be
available from other sources.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Specifications
Front Suspension
Hub and Bearing Assembly to Steering Knuckle Bolts
........................................................................................................................ 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Wheel Bearing Removal and Installation
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front Wheel Bearing Removal and Installation
FRONT WHEEL BEARINGS AND/OR HUB
Fig. 2 Modified Outer Seal Protector
Fig. 3 Removing And Installing Shaft Nut
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Remove tire and wheel assembly, then install modified outer seal
protector No. J 34754 or equivalent, Fig. 2. 3. Insert a drift punch through the rotor, Fig. 3 , then
remove axle shaft nut and washer. 4. Remove ball joint, then using tool No. J-28733-A, or
equivalent, disengage axle from hub and bearing assembly. 5. On all models, move axle shaft
inward, then remove caliper attaching bolts and support caliper. 6. Remove brake rotor, then hub
and bearing assembly attaching bolts. 7. Remove hub and bearing assembly.
INSTALLATION
1. Install hub and bearing assembly, tighten attaching bolts to specification. 2. Install hub and
bearing seal, then the brake rotor. 3. Install caliper, tighten attaching bolts to specification. 4. Move
axle shaft outward, then insert drift punch through rotor, Fig. 3. 5. Install washer and new shaft nut,
tighten shaft nut to specification. 6. Install ball joint, then remove drift punch and seal protector. 7.
Install tire and wheel assembly, then lower vehicle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information > Service and
Repair > Front Wheel Bearing Removal and Installation > Page 1580
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear
REAR HUB AND/OR BEARINGS
1. Raise and support vehicle, then remove wheel and tire assembly and brake drum.
CAUTION: Do not hammer brake drum since damage to bearing may result.
2. Remove four hub/bearing assembly to rear axle attaching bolts, then the hub/bearing assembly
from axle.
NOTE: The upper rear hub attaching bolt may not clear brake shoe when removing hub and
bearing assembly. Partially remove hub and bearing assembly prior to removing this bolt.
3. Reverse procedure to install. Torque hub attaching bolts to specification.
CAUTION: Use care not to drop hub/bearing assembly since damage to bearing may result.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information >
Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
Component ..........................................................................................................................................
....................................................... Torque/Ft. Lbs.
Axle Nut ...............................................................................................................................................
............................................................................ 184
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Fastener: > 01-03-10-009A > Jul > 04 > Wheels - Plastic Wheel Nut Covers
Loose/Missing
Wheel Fastener: Customer Interest Wheels - Plastic Wheel Nut Covers Loose/Missing
Bulletin No.: 01-03-10-009A
Date: July 27, 2004
TECHNICAL
Subject: Plastic Wheel Nut Covers Missing and/or Loose (Replace Missing Covers and Add
Sealant to All Covers)
Models: 2005 and All Prior Passenger Cars (Except All Cadillac Models and Pontiac GTO)
with Plastic Wheel Nut Covers
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add additional models years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 01-03-10-009.
Condition
Some customers may comment that the plastic wheel nut covers are missing and/or loose.
Correction
Important:
^ DO NOT USE a silicone-based adhesive.
^ Do not apply the *permatex(R) around the threads in a circular pattern.
^ Apply a single bead across the threads approximately 10 mm (0.4 in) in length, 5 mm (0.2 in) in
height and 5 mm (0.2 in) in width.
Replace any missing plastic wheel nut covers with the appropriate covers and apply Permatex(R) #
2 Form A Gasket Sealant(R) to the threads of all the plastic wheel nut covers. Tighten finger tight
plus a 1/4 turn with a hand wrench.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such material.
General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any responsibility for the
products from this firm or for any other such items which may be available from other sources.
Permatex(R) # 2 Form A Gasket Sealant(R) part numbers (available at your local parts supplier)
^ P/N 80009 (2A/2AR) - 44 ml (1.5 oz) tube boxed
^ P/N 80015 (2AR) - 44 ml (1.5 oz) tube carded
^ P/N 80010 (2B/2BR) - 89 ml (3 oz) tube boxed
^ P/N 80016 (2BR) - 89 ml (3 oz) tube carded
^ P/N 80011 (2C) - 325 ml (11 oz) tube boxed
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Wheel Fastener: > 01-03-10-009A > Jul > 04 > Wheels - Plastic Wheel Nut Covers
Loose/Missing > Page 1593
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Fastener: > 01-03-10-009A > Jul > 04 > Wheels - Plastic Wheel
Nut Covers Loose/Missing
Wheel Fastener: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Plastic Wheel Nut Covers Loose/Missing
Bulletin No.: 01-03-10-009A
Date: July 27, 2004
TECHNICAL
Subject: Plastic Wheel Nut Covers Missing and/or Loose (Replace Missing Covers and Add
Sealant to All Covers)
Models: 2005 and All Prior Passenger Cars (Except All Cadillac Models and Pontiac GTO)
with Plastic Wheel Nut Covers
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add additional models years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 01-03-10-009.
Condition
Some customers may comment that the plastic wheel nut covers are missing and/or loose.
Correction
Important:
^ DO NOT USE a silicone-based adhesive.
^ Do not apply the *permatex(R) around the threads in a circular pattern.
^ Apply a single bead across the threads approximately 10 mm (0.4 in) in length, 5 mm (0.2 in) in
height and 5 mm (0.2 in) in width.
Replace any missing plastic wheel nut covers with the appropriate covers and apply Permatex(R) #
2 Form A Gasket Sealant(R) to the threads of all the plastic wheel nut covers. Tighten finger tight
plus a 1/4 turn with a hand wrench.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such material.
General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any responsibility for the
products from this firm or for any other such items which may be available from other sources.
Permatex(R) # 2 Form A Gasket Sealant(R) part numbers (available at your local parts supplier)
^ P/N 80009 (2A/2AR) - 44 ml (1.5 oz) tube boxed
^ P/N 80015 (2AR) - 44 ml (1.5 oz) tube carded
^ P/N 80010 (2B/2BR) - 89 ml (3 oz) tube boxed
^ P/N 80016 (2BR) - 89 ml (3 oz) tube carded
^ P/N 80011 (2C) - 325 ml (11 oz) tube boxed
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wheel Fastener: > 01-03-10-009A > Jul > 04 > Wheels - Plastic Wheel
Nut Covers Loose/Missing > Page 1599
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Specifications > Front Suspension
Wheel Fastener: Specifications Front Suspension
FRONT SUSPENSION
Component ..........................................................................................................................................
....................................................... Torque/Ft. Lbs.
Ball Joint To Knuckle ...........................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 41-50 Caliper Bolts .....................................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
... 38 Control Arm Pivot Bolt ................................................................................................................
...................................................................................... 61 Hub & Bearing Assembly .........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
........... 70 Hub Nut ..............................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................. 185 Inner Tie Rod End Bolts ................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...................... 65 Power Coupling To Steering Column ......................................................................
.......................................................................................................... 30 Power Coupling To Stub
Shaft ....................................................................................................................................................
....................................... 30 Power Rack & Pinion Mounts .................................................................
........................................................................................................................... 22 Power Steering
Return Lines ........................................................................................................................................
...................................................... 19 Stabilizer Shaft To Control Arm ...............................................
......................................................................................................................................... 13 Stabilizer
To Support Assembly ..........................................................................................................................
............................................................... 16 Steering Knuckle To Strut Assembly ..............................
................................................................................................................................................. 133
Strut Assembly To Body ......................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 18 Strut Cartridge Retaining Nut ..........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
..... 65 Suspension Support Assembly .................................................................................................
........................................................................................ [01]
Tie Rod Pinch Bolts .............................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 41 Tie Rod To Steering Knuckle ...........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
... 37 Tie Rod To Strut .........................................................................................................................
....................................................................................... 37 Wheel Lug Nuts ......................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
........... 100
[01] -- Torque suspension support assembly center bolts to 66 ft. lbs.; then front bolts to 65 ft. lbs.;
then rear bolts to 65 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information >
Specifications > Front Suspension > Page 1602
Wheel Fastener: Specifications Rear Suspension
REAR SUSPENSION
Component ..........................................................................................................................................
....................................................... Torque/Ft. Lbs.
Axle To Body Bracket ..........................................................................................................................
............................................................................. 68 Brake Line Bracket To Axle ..............................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. 11 Brake Line Bracket To Frame ......................................................................................................
........................................................................................ 8 Hub & Bearing Assembly .........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
........... 37 Shock Absorber Bolt At Axle ..............................................................................................
.............................................................................................. 35 Shock Absorber Mount To Body ......
..............................................................................................................................................................
................... 13 Shock Absorber To Mount ..........................................................................................
....................................................................................................... 21 Stabilizer Shaft Clamp Bolts At
Axle ......................................................................................................................................................
........................... 13 Stabilizer Shaft Clamp Nuts ................................................................................
............................................................................................................... 16 Wheel Lug Nuts ..............
..............................................................................................................................................................
................................... 100
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Compression Check > System Information >
Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
The lowest reading cylinder should not be less than 70% of the highest and no cylinder reading
should be less than 689 kPa (100 psi). Perform compression test with engine at normal operating
temperature, spark plugs removed and throttle wide open.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Specifications > Camshaft Journal & Lifter Specs
Camshaft: Specifications Camshaft Journal & Lifter Specs
Engine Liter/VIN ..................................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 3.1L/T
All Measurements Given In Inches Unless Otherwise Specified
Camshaft Journal Diameter .................................................................................................................
............................................................................ [03] Camshaft Bearing Clearance ..........................
.................................................................................................................................................
0.0010-0.0040
[03] Journals 1 & 4, 2.009-2.011 inches] journals 2 & 3, 1.999-2.001 inches.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Specifications > Camshaft Journal & Lifter Specs > Page 1613
Camshaft: Specifications Camshaft Lift Specs
Intake ...................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 0.2626
Exhaust ................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 0.2732
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Camshaft,
Engine > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1614
Camshaft: Service and Repair
1. Remove engine from vehicle. Refer to Engine / Service and Repair. See: Service and Repair
2. Remove valve lifters. Refer to Lifter, Valve / Service and Repair. See: Lifter / Lash
Adjuster/Service and Repair
3. Remove crankcase front cover. Refer to Timing Components / Timing Cover / Service and
Repair. See: Timing Components/Timing Cover/Service and Repair
4. Remove fuel pump and pushrod, then the timing chain and sprocket. Refer to Timing
Components / Timing Chain / Service and Repair. See: Timing Components/Timing Chain/Service
and Repair
5. Remove camshaft. Use caution not to damage bearings during camshaft removal.
6. Reverse procedure to install. Coat camshaft lobes with GM EOS 1052367 or other suitable
lubricant before installation.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Lifter / Lash
Adjuster, Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair
Lifter / Lash Adjuster: Service and Repair
1. Remove intake manifold. Refer to Intake Manifold.
2. Remove valve mechanism, then the valve lifters.
3. Install valve lifters. When installing new lifters, coat foot of valve lifters with Molykote or
equivalent, ensuring lifter foot is convex.
4. Install intake manifold. Refer to Intake Manifold.
5. Install and adjust valve mechanism.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Camshaft, Lifters and Push Rods > Rocker Arm
Assembly > Component Information > Adjustments
Rocker Arm Assembly: Adjustments
Vehicles are equipped with a non-adjustable rocker arm studs. If valve reconditioning is required,
the non-adjustable rocker arm stud must be replaced with an adjustable rocker arm stud and the
following procedure must be performed.
1. Remove rocker arm covers.
2. Crank engine until mark on torsional damper lines up with O mark on timing tab. The engine
should also be in the No. 1 firing position. This can be determined by placing fingers on No. 1
rocker arms as mark on damper approaches O mark.
3. If valves are not moving, engine is in No. 1 firing position. If valves move as the mark comes up
to the timing tab, engine is in No. 4 firing position and should be rotated one revolution to reach No.
1 position.
4. With engine in No. 1 firing position, adjust exhaust valves 1, 2 and 3 and intake valves 1, 5 and
6, as follows: a.
Back out adjusting nut until lash is felt at pushrod, then turn in adjusting nut until all lash is
removed.
b. When lash has been removed, turn adjusting nut in additional 1 1/2 turns to center lifter plunger.
5. Crank engine one revolution until timing tab O mark and torsional damper mark are again in
alignment.
6. With the engine in this, the No. 4 firing position. adjust exhaust valves 4, 5 and 6 and intake
valves 2, 3 and 4 as previously described.
7. Install rocker arm covers, then start engine and check timing and idle speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod
Bearing > Component Information > Service and Repair
Connecting Rod Bearing: Service and Repair
Main and rod bearing are available in standard sizes and undersizes.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Connecting Rod,
Engine > Component Information > Specifications
Connecting Rod: Specifications
Torque Specification 39 ft.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft Main
Bearing > Component Information > Service and Repair
Crankshaft Main Bearing: Service and Repair
Main and rod bearing are available in standard sizes and undersizes.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Main Bearing Torque Specifications
Crankshaft: Specifications Main Bearing Cap
Main Bearing Cap
Torque Specification 63-83 ft.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Crankshaft, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications > Main Bearing Torque Specifications > Page 1635
Crankshaft: Specifications Crankshaft Dimensions
Engine Liter/VIN ..................................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 3.1L/T
All Measurements Given In Inches Unless Otherwise Specified
Crankshaft
Standard Journal Diameter
Main Bearing .......................................................................................................................................
................................................. 2.6473-2.6483 Crank Pin ...................................................................
........................................................................................................................... 1.9983-1.9994
Out of Round All [01] ...........................................................................................................................
................................................................ 0.0002 Taper All [01] ..........................................................
.............................................................................................................................................. 0.0002
Bearing Clearance
Main Bearings ......................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 0.0012-0.0030 Connecting Rod Bearings .....................................
.................................................................................................................................... 0.0011-0.0037
Thrust Bearing Clearance ....................................................................................................................
.................................................... 0.0012-0.0030
Connecting Rod Side Clearance .........................................................................................................
............................................................ 0.0071-0.0173
[01] Maximum.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Specifications
Piston: Specifications
Engine Liter/VIN ..................................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 3.1L/T
All Measurements Given In Inches Unless Otherwise Specified
Piston Diameter (Std.) .........................................................................................................................
............................................................ 3.5026-3.5037 Piston Clearance ............................................
.................................................................................................................................................
0.0009-0.0027 Piston Pin Diameter [01] ..............................................................................................
................................................................................... 0.9052-0.9054 Piston Pin To Piston Clearance
..............................................................................................................................................................
......... 0.0004-0.0010 Piston Ring End Gap [02]
Comp. ..................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................... [16] Oil .........................................................................
.................................................................................................................................................... 0.008
Piston Ring Side Clearance
Comp. ..................................................................................................................................................
....................................................... 0.0016-0.0035 Oil ........................................................................
.......................................................................................................................................
0.0020-0.0080
[01] Pistons & pins are matched set & should be replaced as an assembly. [02] Maximum. [16] Top
ring, 0.010 inch] 2nd ring, 0.028 inch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Oversize Availability
Piston: Service and Repair Oversize Availability
Pistons and rings are available in standard and oversize. Piston pins are available in standard size
only.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Oversize Availability > Page 1641
Piston: Service and Repair Piston Measurements and Replacement
Fig. 7 Piston & Rod Assembly
There is a machined hole or cast notch in the top of all pistons. The piston assemblies should
always be installed with the hole or notch toward front of engine, Fig. 7.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Pin, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Piston Pin: Service and Repair
Fig. 7 Piston & Rod Assembly
There is a machined hole or cast notch in the top of all pistons. The piston assemblies should
always be installed with the hole or notch toward front of engine, Fig. 7.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Block Assembly > Piston Ring, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Piston Ring: Service and Repair
Pistons and rings are available in standard and oversize. Piston pins are available in standard size
only.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications > Valve Clearance Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications Valve Clearance Specifications
Vehicles are equipped with a non-adjustable rocker arm studs. If valve reconditioning is required,
the non-adjustable rocker arm stud must be replaced with an adjustable rocker arm stud and the
following procedure must be performed.
1. Remove rocker arm covers.
2. Crank engine until mark on torsional damper lines up with O mark on timing tab. The engine
should also be in the No. 1 firing position. This can be determined by placing fingers on No. 1
rocker arms as mark on damper approaches O mark.
3. If valves are not moving, engine is in No. 1 firing position. If valves move as the mark comes up
to the timing tab, engine is in No. 4 firing position and should be rotated one revolution to reach No.
1 position.
4. With engine in No. 1 firing position, adjust exhaust valves 1, 2 and 3 and intake valves 1, 5 and
6, as follows: a.
Back out adjusting nut until lash is felt at pushrod, then turn in adjusting nut until all lash is
removed.
b. When lash has been removed, turn adjusting nut in additional 1 1/2 turns to center lifter plunger.
5. Crank engine one revolution until timing tab O mark and torsional damper mark are again in
alignment.
6. With the engine in this, the No. 4 firing position. adjust exhaust valves 4, 5 and 6 and intake
valves 2, 3 and 4 as previously described.
7. Install rocker arm covers, then start engine and check timing and idle speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications > Valve Clearance Specifications > Page 1653
Valve Clearance: Specifications Valve Arrangement
FRONT TO REAR
Right ....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................... E-I-E-I-I-E Left .........................................................................
......................................................................................................................................... E-I-I-E-I-E
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications > Page 1654
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
Vehicles are equipped with a non-adjustable rocker arm studs. If valve reconditioning is required,
the non-adjustable rocker arm stud must be replaced with an adjustable rocker arm stud and the
following procedure must be performed.
1. Remove rocker arm covers.
2. Crank engine until mark on torsional damper lines up with O mark on timing tab. The engine
should also be in the No. 1 firing position. This can be determined by placing fingers on No. 1
rocker arms as mark on damper approaches O mark.
3. If valves are not moving, engine is in No. 1 firing position. If valves move as the mark comes up
to the timing tab, engine is in No. 4 firing position and should be rotated one revolution to reach No.
1 position.
4. With engine in No. 1 firing position, adjust exhaust valves 1, 2 and 3 and intake valves 1, 5 and
6, as follows: a.
Back out adjusting nut until lash is felt at pushrod, then turn in adjusting nut until all lash is
removed.
b. When lash has been removed, turn adjusting nut in additional 1 1/2 turns to center lifter plunger.
5. Crank engine one revolution until timing tab O mark and torsional damper mark are again in
alignment.
6. With the engine in this, the No. 4 firing position. adjust exhaust valves 4, 5 and 6 and intake
valves 2, 3 and 4 as previously described.
7. Install rocker arm covers, then start engine and check timing and idle speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Fuel Pressure Release
> System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
WARNING: To reduce the risk of fire and personal injury, it is necessary to relieve the fuel system
pressure before servicing fuel system components.
After relieving system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing fuel lines
or connections. In order to reduce the chance of personal injury, cover fuel line fittings with a shop
towel before disconnecting, to catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved
container when disconnect is completed.
When servicing the fuel system use the following precautions:
a. Put a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the workshop.
b. Be sure shop is supplied with an adequate fire extinguisher.
c. Be sure to disconnect the negative battery cable before any service work is done.
d. Use a suitable container to catch any fuel that may leak from system during service.
e. Always relieve fuel system pressure before disconnecting any lines.
f. If the key must be turned "ON" while servicing fuel system, always disconnect or disable ignition,
to insure no sparks occur near fuel vapors.
PROCEDURE:
Tool required: J34730-1 Fuel Pressure Gauge or equivalent.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable, to avoid fuel pump turn "ON," if an accidental attempt is
made to start the engine.
2. Loosen the fuel filler cap to relieve tank vapor pressure.
3. Connect the fuel pressure gauge to the pressure connection. Wrap a shop towel around the
fitting while connecting the gauge to avoid spillage.
4. Install bleed hose into an approved container and open the valve to bleed the system pressure.
Fuel connections are now safe for servicing.
5. Drain any fuel remaining in the gauge into an approved container.
When repair to the fuel system has been completed, START the engine and check all connections
that were loosened for leaks.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Rocker Arm Assembly
> Component Information > Adjustments
Rocker Arm Assembly: Adjustments
Vehicles are equipped with a non-adjustable rocker arm studs. If valve reconditioning is required,
the non-adjustable rocker arm stud must be replaced with an adjustable rocker arm stud and the
following procedure must be performed.
1. Remove rocker arm covers.
2. Crank engine until mark on torsional damper lines up with O mark on timing tab. The engine
should also be in the No. 1 firing position. This can be determined by placing fingers on No. 1
rocker arms as mark on damper approaches O mark.
3. If valves are not moving, engine is in No. 1 firing position. If valves move as the mark comes up
to the timing tab, engine is in No. 4 firing position and should be rotated one revolution to reach No.
1 position.
4. With engine in No. 1 firing position, adjust exhaust valves 1, 2 and 3 and intake valves 1, 5 and
6, as follows: a.
Back out adjusting nut until lash is felt at pushrod, then turn in adjusting nut until all lash is
removed.
b. When lash has been removed, turn adjusting nut in additional 1 1/2 turns to center lifter plunger.
5. Crank engine one revolution until timing tab O mark and torsional damper mark are again in
alignment.
6. With the engine in this, the No. 4 firing position. adjust exhaust valves 4, 5 and 6 and intake
valves 2, 3 and 4 as previously described.
7. Install rocker arm covers, then start engine and check timing and idle speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Cover >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Valve Cover: Service and Repair
LEFT SIDE
1. Disconnect battery ground cable and drain cooling system.
2. Loosen bypass tube at intake, then remove rocker arm cover to air inlet attaching tube.
3. Remove rocker arm cover attaching bolts, then remove rocker arm cover.
4. Reverse procedure to install. Torque rocker arm cover attaching bolts to specifications.
RIGHT SIDE
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove brake booster vacuum line at bracket, then remove cable bracket at plenum.
3. Remove vacuum line bracket at cable bracket, then remove lines at alternator bracket stud.
4. Remove rear alternator attaching brace, then remove serpentine belt.
5. Remove alternator attaching bolts and position alternator aside.
6. Remove PCV valve, then remove rocker arm cover attaching bolts.
7. Remove spark plug wires, then remove rocker arm cover assembly.
8. Reverse procedure to install. Torque attaching bolts to specifications.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Guide >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Valve Guide: Service and Repair
Valve guides are an integral part of the cylinder head and are not removable. If valve stem
clearance becomes excessive, the valve guide should be reamed to the next oversize and the
appropriate oversize valves installed. Valves are available in .003, .015 and .030 inch over sizes.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Specifications
Valve Spring: Specifications
Engine Liter/VIN ..................................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 3.1L/T
All Measurements Given In Inches Unless Otherwise Specified
Free Length .........................................................................................................................................
............................................................................ 1.91 Installed Height ...............................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
1.693 Seated Pressure Pounds @ Inches ..........................................................................................
............................................................................. 90 @ 1.701 Comp. Pressure Pounds @ Inches ...
..............................................................................................................................................................
.... 215 @ 1.291
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Valve Spring & Valve Stem Oil Seal Replace
Valve Spring: Service and Repair Valve Spring & Valve Stem Oil Seal Replace
Fig. 9 Valves, Valve Seals & Valve Springs
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery ground cable, then remove rocker cover.
2. With engine cold, remove spark plug and clean debris from plug recess.
3. Remove rocker arm and pushrod on cylinders to be serviced.
4. Install air line adapter tool No. J 23590 or equivalent in spark plug thread and apply compressed
air to hold valves in place.
5. With valve spring compressor tool compress valve spring and remove valve lock and cap, Fig. 9.
6. Remove spring, valve stem oil seal and shim.
INSTALLATION
1. Install shim if required, then new valve stem oil seal.
2. Set valve spring and cap in place.
3. Using valve spring compressor tool compress valve spring.
4. Install valve locks and release compressor. Make sure locks seat properly in the upper groove of
the valve stem. Grease may be used to hold the locks in place while releasing the compressor tool.
5. Install spark plug, pushrods, rocker arms and rocker cover.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve Spring >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Valve Spring & Valve Stem Oil Seal Replace > Page 1672
Valve Spring: Service and Repair Valve Stem Oil Seal and Valve Spring Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Remove rocker arm cover, then the spark plug, rocker arm and pushrod on cylinder(s) being
serviced.
2. Install air line adapter tool No. J-22794 or equivalent to spark plug port and apply compressed
air to hold valves in place.
3. Using valve spring compressor tool No. J-26513-A or equivalent to compress valve spring,
remove valve locks, valve caps, oil seal and valve spring and damper.
4. Remove valve stem oil seal.
INSTALLATION
1. Set valve spring and damper around valve guide boss.
2. Install a valve stem seal over the valve stem and valve guide base-inlet only.
3. Drop an oil seal and valve rotator over the exhaust, and a valve spring cap over the valve spring.
4. Compress spring using valve spring compressor tool No. J-26513-A or equivalent, install oil seal
in lower groove of stem, ensuring seal is flat and not twisted.
5. Install valve locks and release compressor tool, ensuring locks seat properly in upper groove of
valve stem. Use suitable grease as necessary to hold locks in place while releasing compressor
tool.
6. Using tool J-23994 or equivalent, apply vacuum to valve cap to ensure no air leaks past seal.
7. Install spark plug, torquing to specifications.
8. Install and adjust valve mechanism.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust
> Component Information > Specifications > Valve Specifications
Valve: Specifications Valve Specifications
Engine Liter/VIN ..................................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 3.1L/T
All Measurements Given In Inches Unless Otherwise Specified
Stem Diameter
Valve Stem Installed Height ................................................................................................................
............................................................................ 1.71 Valve Lash
Intake ...................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................... [13] Exhaust .................................................................
...................................................................................................................................................... [13]
Face Angle ..........................................................................................................................................
......................................................................... 45deg. Margin [01] .....................................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. [14]
[01] Minimum. [13] Zero lash plus 1 1/2 turns. [14] Intake, .083 inch] Exhaust, .106 inch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Cylinder Head Assembly > Valve, Intake/Exhaust
> Component Information > Specifications > Valve Specifications > Page 1677
Valve: Specifications Valve Arrangement
FRONT TO REAR Right.......................................................................................................................
.................................................................................................E-I-E-I-I-E Left.....................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................E-I-I-E-I-E
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics
Drive Belt: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-06-01-008A
Date: July 27, 2009
Subject: Diagnosing Accessory Drive Belt / Serpentine Belt Noise and Availability and Use of
Kent-Moore EN-49228 Laser Alignment Tool - Drive Belt
Models:
2010 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 Vehicles 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add a model year and update the Tool Information.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 08-06-01-008 (Section 06 - Engine).
Background
Several aftermarket companies offer laser alignment tools for accessory drive systems that can be
very helpful in eliminating drive belt noise as a result of misaligned pulleys. Typically pricing ranges
from $160 - $200.
EN-49228 Laser Alignment Tool - Drive Belt
The GM Tool program has now made available a competitive, simple to use and time-saving laser
tool to assist in achieving precise alignment of the drive belt pulleys. This optional tool removes the
guesswork from proper pulley alignment and may serve to reduce comebacks from:
- Drive Belt Noise
- Accelerated Drive Belt Wear
- Drive Belt Slippage
Instructions
The instructions below are specific only to the truck Gen IV V-8 family of engines. These
instructions are only for illustrative purposes to show how the tool may be used. Universal
instructions are included in the box with the Laser Alignment Tool - Drive Belt.
Caution
- Do not look directly into the beam projected from the laser.
- Use caution when shining the laser on highly polished or reflective surfaces. Laser safety glasses
help reduce laser beam glare in many circumstances.
- Always use laser safety glasses when using the laser. Laser safety glasses are not designed to
protect eyes from direct laser exposure.
1. Observe and mark the serpentine belt orientation.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics > Page
1683
2. Remove the serpentine belt from the accessory drive system.
3. Install the tool onto the power steering pulley. Position the legs of the tool into the outer grooves
of the pulley, farthest from the front of the
engine.
4. Install the retaining cord around the pulley and to the legs of the tool.
5. Put on the laser safety glasses provided with the tool. 6. Depress the switch on the rear of the
tool to activate the light beam. 7. Rotate the power steering pulley as required to project the light
beam onto the crankshaft balancer pulley grooves. 8. Inspect for proper power steering pulley
alignment.
- If the laser beam projects onto the second rib or raised area (1), the pulleys are aligned properly.
- If the laser beam projects more than one-quarter rib 0.9 mm (0.035 in) mis-alignment, adjust the
position of the power steering pulley as required.
- Refer to SI for Power Steering Pulley Removal and Installation procedures.
9. Install the serpentine belt to the accessory drive system in the original orientation.
10. Operate the vehicle and verify that the belt noise concern is no longer present.
Tool Information
Please visit the GM service tool website for pricing information or to place your order for this tool.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics > Page
1684
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Drive Belt Misalignment Diagnostics > Page
1685
Drive Belt: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Serpentine Drive Belt Wear Information
Bulletin No.: 04-06-01-013
Date: April 29, 2004
INFORMATION
Subject: Information on Serpentine Belt Wear
Models: 2004 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks 2003-2004 and Prior HUMMER H2
All current GM vehicles designed and manufactured in North America were assembled with
serpentine belts that are made with an EPDM material and should last the life of the vehicle. It is
extremely rare to observe any cracks in EPDM belts and it is not expected that they will require
maintenance before 10 years or 240,000 km (150,000 mi) of use.
Older style belts, which were manufactured with a chloroprene compound, may exhibit cracks
depending on age. However, the onset of cracking typically signals that the belt is only about
halfway through its usable life.
A good rule of thumb for chloroprene-based belts is that if cracks are observed 3 mm (1/8 in) apart,
ALL AROUND THE BELT, the belt may be reaching the end of its serviceable life and should be
considered a candidate for changing. Small cracks spaced at greater intervals should not be
considered as indicative that the belt needs changing.
Any belt that exhibits chunking should be replaced.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Specifications > Belt Tension Specifications
Drive Belt: Specifications Belt Tension Specifications
Belt Tension [01] ..................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 50-70
[01] Belt tension is controlled automatically by the belt tensioner. If belt tensioner has to operate out
of its range to obtain adequate belt tension,
replace belt.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Specifications > Belt Tension Specifications > Page 1688
Drive Belt: Specifications Engine Accessory Drive Belts
POWER STEERING
New lbs. ...............................................................................................................................................
..................................................................... 225-236
Used lbs. ..............................................................................................................................................
..................................................................... 112-124
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1689
Drive Belt: Adjustments
Belt tension is maintained by a spring-loaded tensioner. No adjustment
is necessary.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1690
Drive Belt: Service and Repair
Fig. 16 Serpentine Belt Routing
1. Remove belt guard.
2. Lift or rotate tensioner using a 1/2 inch breaker bar.
3. Remove serpentine drive belt.
4. Reverse procedure to install, routing belt as shown in Fig. 16.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Drive Belt Tensioner > Component Information > Service and Repair
Drive Belt Tensioner: Service and Repair
1. Remove serpentine belt. Refer to Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories / Drive Belt.
See: Drive Belt/Service and Repair
2. Raise and support vehicle.
3. Remove inner splash shield, tensioner bolt and tensioner.
4. Reverse procedure to install, Torquing tensioner bolt to 35 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Engine Mount: > 436103 >
May > 94 > Engine - Vibration at Idle or Clunk Noise at Launch
Engine Mount: Customer Interest Engine - Vibration at Idle or Clunk Noise at Launch
Group Ref.: Engine
Bulletin No.: 436103
Date: May, 1994
SUBJECT: ENGINE VIBRATION AT IDLE OR CLUNK NOISE AT LAUNCH (REPLACE ENGINE
MOUNT)
MODELS: 1993-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER 1993-94 PONTIAC SUNBIRD
ENGINE APPLICATIONS: 2.0L (VIN H - RPO LE4) 2.2L (VIN 4 - RPO LN2) 3.1L (VIN T - RPO
LHO) WITH 3T40 (MD9) AND ISUZU 5-SPEED (MK7)
CONDITION: Some owners may experience engine vibration at idle or clunk noise at launch.
CAUSE: Right rear engine mount sagging.
CORRECTION:
Inspect right rear engine mount while in vehicle for less than 5 mm gap.
If gap checked in diagnosis is less than 5 mm, install the proper replacement engine mount as
follows:
All 2.2L (LN2) and 2.0L (LE4) use P/N 22637949. 3.1L (LHO with MD9 only) use P/N 22637950.
1. Install new engine mount and only tighten bolts finger tight to allow seating of engine.
2. Install engine mount bracket bolts only finger tight.
3. Loosen transaxle mount to transaxle mount bracket bolt and the two nuts holding the snubber
block on the mount itself.
4. Block wheels.
5. Set parking brake and start engine.
6. Shift from reverse to drive several times to seat the engine and transaxle assembly.
7. Turn ignition switch to "off" position.
8. Tighten transaxle mount to transaxle mount bracket bolt.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Engine Mount: > 436103 >
May > 94 > Engine - Vibration at Idle or Clunk Noise at Launch > Page 1702
9. Tighten engine mount bracket to body bolts.
10. Tighten engine mount to engine mount bracket nuts.
11. Center the snubber block on the transaxle mount (transaxle in "neutral"), then tighten the two
nuts holding the snubber block to mount.
Parts are expected to be available on May 2, 1994.
WARRANTY INFORMATION:
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation: J1510
Labor Time: 0.8 hr
Add: 0.2 hr (For inspection)
Add: 0.2 hr (To loosen/tighten transaxle mounts)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Mount: >
436103 > May > 94 > Engine - Vibration at Idle or Clunk Noise at Launch
Engine Mount: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Vibration at Idle or Clunk Noise at Launch
Group Ref.: Engine
Bulletin No.: 436103
Date: May, 1994
SUBJECT: ENGINE VIBRATION AT IDLE OR CLUNK NOISE AT LAUNCH (REPLACE ENGINE
MOUNT)
MODELS: 1993-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER 1993-94 PONTIAC SUNBIRD
ENGINE APPLICATIONS: 2.0L (VIN H - RPO LE4) 2.2L (VIN 4 - RPO LN2) 3.1L (VIN T - RPO
LHO) WITH 3T40 (MD9) AND ISUZU 5-SPEED (MK7)
CONDITION: Some owners may experience engine vibration at idle or clunk noise at launch.
CAUSE: Right rear engine mount sagging.
CORRECTION:
Inspect right rear engine mount while in vehicle for less than 5 mm gap.
If gap checked in diagnosis is less than 5 mm, install the proper replacement engine mount as
follows:
All 2.2L (LN2) and 2.0L (LE4) use P/N 22637949. 3.1L (LHO with MD9 only) use P/N 22637950.
1. Install new engine mount and only tighten bolts finger tight to allow seating of engine.
2. Install engine mount bracket bolts only finger tight.
3. Loosen transaxle mount to transaxle mount bracket bolt and the two nuts holding the snubber
block on the mount itself.
4. Block wheels.
5. Set parking brake and start engine.
6. Shift from reverse to drive several times to seat the engine and transaxle assembly.
7. Turn ignition switch to "off" position.
8. Tighten transaxle mount to transaxle mount bracket bolt.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Engine Mount: >
436103 > May > 94 > Engine - Vibration at Idle or Clunk Noise at Launch > Page 1708
9. Tighten engine mount bracket to body bolts.
10. Tighten engine mount to engine mount bracket nuts.
11. Center the snubber block on the transaxle mount (transaxle in "neutral"), then tighten the two
nuts holding the snubber block to mount.
Parts are expected to be available on May 2, 1994.
WARRANTY INFORMATION:
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation: J1510
Labor Time: 0.8 hr
Add: 0.2 hr (For inspection)
Add: 0.2 hr (To loosen/tighten transaxle mounts)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1709
Engine Mount: Service and Repair
Fig. 1 Front Engine Mount
Fig. 2 Rear Engine Mount
FRONT MOUNT
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove engine mount nuts, then raise and support vehicle.
3. Support engine with suitable jack.
4. Remove inner fender shield.
5. Remove and discard engine mount bolts, Fig. 1.
6. Remove engine mount from vehicle.
7. Reverse procedure to install, using new engine mount bolts. Remove alignment bolt. Refer to
Fig. 1, for tightening specifications. If excessive force is required to remove alignment bolt, loosen
transaxle adjusting bolts to align power train components.
REAR MOUNT
1. Disconnect battery ground cable, then raise and support vehicle.
2. Support engine with suitable jack.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories >
Engine Mount > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1710
3. Remove motor mount nuts and attaching bolts, Fig. 2.
4. Reverse procedure to install. Refer to Fig. 2, for tightening specifications.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil Pressure >
Component Information > Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure: Specifications Vin T, Oil Pressure
Vin T, Oil Pressure
Normal Oil Pressure 50-65 psi
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications
Engine Oil: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 11-00-90-001
Date: March 14, 2011
Subject: Global Information for GM dexos1(TM) and GM dexos2(TM) Engine Oil Specifications for
Spark Ignited and Diesel Engines, Available Licensed Brands, and Service Fill for Adding or
Complete Oil Change
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Excluding All Vehicles Equipped with
Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines
GM dexos 1(TM) Information Center Website
Refer to the following General Motors website for dexos 1(TM) information about the different
licensed brands that are currently available: http://www.gmdexos.com
GM dexos 1(TM) Engine Oil Trademark and Icons
The dexos(TM) specification and trademarks are exclusive to General Motors, LLC.
Only those oils displaying the dexos‹›(TM) trademark and icon on the front label meet the
demanding performance requirements and stringent quality standards set forth in the dexos‹›(TM)
specification.
Look on the front label for any of the logos shown above to identify an authorized, licensed dexos
1(TM) engine oil.
GM dexos 1(TM) Engine Oil Specification
Important General Motors dexos 1(TM) engine oil specification replaces the previous General
Motors specifications GM6094M, GM4718M and GM-LL-A-025 for most GM gasoline engines. The
oil specified for use in GM passenger cars and trucks, PRIOR to the 2011 model year remains
acceptable for those previous vehicles. However, dexos 1(TM) is backward compatible and can be
used in those older vehicles.
In North America, starting with the 2011 model year, GM introduced dexos 1(TM) certified engine
oil as a factory fill and service fill for gasoline engines. The reasons for the new engine oil
specification are as follows:
- To meet environmental goals such as increasing fuel efficiency and reducing engine emissions.
- To promote long engine life.
- To minimize the number of engine oil changes in order to help meet the goal of lessening the
industry's overall dependence on crude oil.
dexos 1(TM) is a GM-developed engine oil specification that has been designed to provide the
following benefits:
- Further improve fuel economy, to meet future corporate average fuel economy (CAFE)
requirements and fuel economy retention by allowing the oil to maintain its fuel economy benefits
throughout the life of the oil.
- More robust formulations for added engine protection and aeration performance.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications > Page 1719
- Support the GM Oil Life System, thereby minimizing the replacement of engine oil, before its life
has been depleted.
- Reduce the duplication of requirements for a large number of internal GM engine oil
specifications.
International Lubricants Standardization and Approval Committee (ILSAC)
GF-5 Standard
In addition to GM dexos 1(TM), a new International Lubricants Standardization and Approval
Committee (ILSAC) standard called GF-5, was introduced in October 2010.
- There will be a corresponding API category, called: SN Resource Conserving. The current GF-4
standard was put in place in 2004 and will become obsolete in October 2011. Similar to dexos
1(TM), the GF-5 standard will use a new fuel economy test, Sequence VID, which demands a
statistically significant increase in fuel economy versus the Sequence VIB test that was used for
GF-4.
- It is expected that all dexos 1(TM) approved oils will be capable of meeting the GF-5 standard.
However, not all GF-5 engine oils will be capable of meeting the dexos 1(TM) specification.
- Like dexos(TM), the new ILSAC GF-5 standard will call for more sophisticated additives. The API
will begin licensing marketers during October 2010, to produce and distribute GF-5 certified
products, which are expected to include SAE 0W-20, 0W-30, 5W-20, 5W-30 and 10W-30 oils.
Corporate Average Fuel Economy (CAFE) Requirements Effect on Fuel Economy
Since CAFE standards were first introduced in 1974, the fuel economy of cars has more than
doubled, while the fuel economy of light trucks has increased by more than 50 percent. Proposed
CAFE standards call for a continuation of increased fuel economy in new cars and trucks. To meet
these future requirements, all aspects of vehicle operation are being looked at more critically than
ever before.
New technology being introduced in GM vehicles designed to increase vehicle efficiency and fuel
economy include direct injection, cam phasing, turbocharging and active fuel management (AFM).
The demands of these new technologies on engine oil also are taken into consideration when
determining new oil specifications. AFM for example can help to achieve improved fuel economy.
However alternately deactivating and activating the cylinders by not allowing the intake and
exhaust valves to open contributes to additional stress on the engine oil.
Another industry trend for meeting tough fuel economy mandates has been a shift toward lower
viscosity oils.
dexos 1(TM) will eventually be offered in several viscosity grades in accordance with engine needs:
SAE 0W-20, 5W-20, 0W-30 and 5W-30.
Using the right viscosity grade oil is critical for proper engine performance. Always refer to the
Maintenance section of a vehicle Owner Manual for the proper viscosity grade for the engine being
serviced.
GM Oil Life System in Conjunction With dexos (TM) Supports Extended Oil Change Intervals
To help conserve oil while maintaining engine protection, many GM vehicles are equipped with the
GM Oil Life System. This system can provide oil change intervals that exceed the traditional 3,000
mile (4,830 km) recommendation.
The dexos (TM) specification, with its requirements for improved oil robustness, compliments the
GM Oil Life System by supporting extended oil change intervals over the lifetime of a vehicle.
If all GM customers with GM Oil Life System equipped vehicles would use the system as intended,
GM estimates that more than 100 million gallons of oil could be saved annually.
GM dexos 2(TM) Information Center Website
Refer to the following General Motors website for dexos 2(TM) information about the different
licensed brands that are currently available: http://www.gmdexos.com
GM dexos 2(TM) Engine Oil Trademark and Icons
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - GM dexos 1 and dexos 2(R) Oil Specifications > Page 1720
The dexos (TM) specification and trademarks are exclusive to General Motors, LLC.
Only those oils displaying the dexos (TM) trademark and icon on the front label meet the
demanding performance requirements and stringent quality standards set forth in the dexos
(TM)specification.
Look on the front label for any of the logos shown above to identify an authorized, licensed dexos
2(TM) engine oil.
GM dexos 2(TM) Engine Oil Specification
- dexos 2(TM) is approved and recommended by GM for use in Europe starting in model year 2010
vehicles, regardless of where the vehicle was manufactured.
- dexos 2(TM) is the recommended service fill oil for European gasoline engines.
Important The Duramax(TM) diesel engine is the exception and requires lubricants meeting
specification CJ-4.
- dexos 2(TM) is the recommended service fill oil for European light-duty diesel engines and
replaces GM-LL-B-025 and GM-LL-A-025.
- dexos 2(TM) protects diesel engines from harmful soot deposits and is designed with limits on
certain chemical components to prolong catalyst life and protect expensive emission reduction
systems. It is a robust oil, resisting degradation between oil changes and maintaining optimum
performance longer.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Engine Oil > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Engine Oil: Capacity Specifications
Engine .................................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................3.1L Coolant Capacity, Qts. ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.....13.7 Radiator Cap Relief Pressure, Lbs. ........................................................................................
..............................................................................................15 Thermo. Opening Temp. ° F..............
..............................................................................................................................................................
...................195 Fuel Tank Gals. .........................................................................................................
........................................................................................................15.2 Engine Oil Refill Qts. [02] ....
..............................................................................................................................................................
...................................4 Transaxle Oil
Manual Pts. ..........................................................................................................................................
..............................................................................4 Automatic Qts. ....................................................
...................................................................................................................................................[01]
[04]
[01] -- Approximate, make final check w/dipstick. [02] -- When changing engine oil filter additional
oil is required. [04] -- Oil pan only, 4 qts.; complete overhaul, 7 qts. dry, 9 qts.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Noise/Damage Oil Filter Application Importance
Oil Filter: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Noise/Damage Oil Filter Application Importance
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-016B
Date: July 27, 2009
Subject: Information on Internal Engine Noise or Damage After Oil Filter Replacement
Models:
2010 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3
2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being updated to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 07-06-01-016A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
Important Engine damage that is the result of an incorrect or improperly installed engine oil filter is
not a warrantable claim. The best way to avoid oil filter quality concerns is to purchase ACDelco(R)
oil filters directly from GMSPO.
Oil filter misapplication may cause abnormal engine noise or internal damage. Always utilize the
most recent parts information to ensure the correct part number filter is installed when replacing oil
filters. Do not rely on physical dimensions alone. Counterfeit copies of name brand parts have been
discovered in some aftermarket parts systems. Always ensure the parts you install are from a
trusted source. Improper oil filter installation may result in catastrophic engine damage.
Refer to the appropriate Service Information (SI) installation instructions when replacing any oil
filter and pay particular attention to procedures for proper cartridge filter element alignment. If the
diagnostics in SI (Engine Mechanical) lead to the oil filter as the cause of the internal engine noise
or damage, dealers should submit a field product report. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
02-00-89-002I (Information for Dealers on How to Submit a Field Product Report).
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Filter, Engine >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Noise/Damage Oil Filter Application Importance > Page
1727
Oil Filter: Technical Service Bulletins Parts - OE and Aftermarket Oil Filters Revised
Group Ref.: Warranty Administration
Bulletin No.: 420502
Date: May, 1994
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
SUBJECT: AC ROCHESTER ENGINE OIL FILTER IDENTIFICATION
MODELS: 1994 PASSENGER CARS AND TRUCKS
ATTENTION: DEALER SERVICE MANAGER/WARRANTY ADMINISTRATOR
The purpose of this bulletin is to notify retail/wholesale service personnel of a running change to
the AC Rochester Original Equipment engine oil filters.
Due to an agreement to decrease the number of GMSPO part numbers, AC Rochester will phase
in a decision to make all Original Equipment engine oil filters blue; same color used on AC
aftermarket engine oil filters. This means that eventually the use of black Original Equipment
engine oil filters will be discontinued.
For the purpose of Warranty/Policy administration, the following will assist retail/wholesale service
personnel in identifying the difference between blue Original Equipment and aftermarket engine oil
filters:
^ AFTERMARKET FILTER: will continue to use "AC DURAGUARD OIL FILTER" label.
^ OE FILTER: will have a black bar code, Julian date code and the letters "OE" printed on the
dome of the filter. At this time, it is anticipated that all OE engine oil filters will be changed by May
1994.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Level Warning Indicator >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Level Warning Indicator: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
This lamp illuminates to warn the driver that the engine oil level is low. When the ignition switch is
first moved to Run, the oil level indicator lights for about 1 1/2 seconds as a bulb check. The oil
level detection circuit has two internal timers. The first timer records the amount of time the ignition
has been Off. The second timer records the amount of time the ignition has been On before the
ignition was shut Off. The instrument cluster uses this information to determine if the engine has
been sitting long enough for the oil to have returned to the oil pan.
OPERATION
The oil level monitoring circuits will check the oil level switch under the following conditions:
1. Ignition has been turned Off for more than 30 minutes. 2. Ignition has been Off for at least three
minutes after ignition has been On for at least 12 minutes.
If the oil level is low (oil level switch open), the "Check Oil" indicator will be turned On for the
remainder of the ignition cycle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pan, Engine >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Oil Pan: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove serpentine belt and belt tensioner.
3. Raise and support vehicle, then drain engine oil.
4. Remove starter assembly, then remove outer plastic flywheel and starter shield.
5. Remove inner metal flywheel shield.
6. Remove engine to frame mount attaching nuts. Refer to Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and
Accessories / Engine Mount. See: Drive Belts, Mounts, Brackets and Accessories/Engine
Mount/Service and Repair
7. Lower vehicle and support engine using tool No. J 28467-A or equivalent.
8. Raise and support vehicle, then remove inner fender splash shield.
9. Remove oil pan attaching nuts and bolts, then remove oil pan.
10. Reverse procedure to install. Torque attaching nuts and bolts to specifications.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Gauge >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Pressure Gauge: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
This oil pressure indicating system incorporates an instrument voltage regulator, electrical oil
pressure gauge and a sending unit which are connected in series. The sending unit consists of a
diaphragm, contact and a variable resistor.
OPERATION
As oil pressure increases or decreases, the diaphragm actuated the contact on the variable
resistor, in turn controlling current flow through the gauge. When oil pressure is low, the resistance
of the variable resistor is high, restricting current flow to the gauge, in turn indicating low oil
pressure. As oil pressure increases, the resistance of the variable resistor is lowered, permitting an
increased current flow to the gauge, resulting in an increased gauge reading.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Gauge >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1737
Oil Pressure Gauge: Service and Repair
Disconnect the oil pressure gauge lead from the sending unit, connect a 12 volt test lamp between
the gauge lead and the ground and turn ignition on. If test lamp flashes, the instrument voltage
regulator is functioning properly and the gauge circuit is not broken. If the test lamp remains lit, the
instrument voltage regulator is defective and must be replaced. If the test lamp does not light,
check the instrument voltage regulator for proper ground or an open circuit. Also, check for an open
in the instrument voltage regulator to oil pressure gauge wire or in the gauge itself. If test lamp
flashes and gauge is not accurate, the gauge may be out of calibration, requiring replacement.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Switch (For
Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch
Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump): Locations Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch
RH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Switch (For
Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch > Page 1742
RH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Switch (For
Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch > Page 1743
Fuel Pump / Oil Pressure Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pressure Switch (For
Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Page 1744
Harness Connector Faces: Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Pump, Engine > Engine
Oil Pressure > Component Information > Specifications
Engine Oil Pressure: Specifications Vin T, Oil Pressure
Vin T, Oil Pressure
Normal Oil Pressure 50-65 psi
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Engine Lubrication > Oil Temperature Gauge >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Oil Temperature Gauge: Testing and Inspection
Check for a defective wire inside the insulation which could cause system malfunction but prove
"GOOD" in a continuity/voltage check with the system disconnected. These circuits may be
intermittent or resistive when loaded, and if possible, should be checked by monitoring for a voltage
drop with the system operational.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Intake Manifold Inspection/Replacement
Intake Manifold: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Intake Manifold Inspection/Replacement
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-06-01-026C
Date: February 03, 2010
Subject: Intake Manifold Inspection/Replacement After Severe Internal Engine Damage
Models:
2010 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3
2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include additional model years. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 00-06-01-026B (Section 06 - Engine).
When replacing an engine due to internal damage, extreme care should be taken when transferring
the intake manifold to the new Goodwrench service engine long block. Internal damage may result
in the potential discharge of internal engine component debris in the intake manifold via broken
pistons and/or bent, broken, or missing intake valves. After removing the intake manifold from the
engine, the technician should carefully inspect all of the cylinder head intake ports to see if the
valve heads are still present and not bent. Usually when the valve heads are missing or sufficiently
bent, internal engine component debris will be present to varying degrees in the intake port of the
cylinder head. If this debris is present in any of the cylinder head intake ports, the intake manifold
should be replaced. This replacement is required due to the complex inlet runner and plenum
configuration of most of the intake manifolds, making thorough and complete component cleaning
difficult and nearly impossible to verify complete removal of debris. Re-installation of an intake
manifold removed from an engine with deposits of internal engine component debris may result in
the ingestion of any remaining debris into the new Goodwrench service engine. This may cause
damage or potential failure of the new service engine.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications > Upper Intake Manifold Torque and Sequence
Intake Manifold: Specifications Upper Intake Manifold Torque and Sequence
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 1758
Intake Manifold: Service and Repair
Figure 1. Intake Manifold Installation
Remove or Disconnect
1. Negative battery cable. 2. Battery. 3. Air cleaner assembly. 4. Sernentine belt. 5. Exbaust
crosanver pipe. 6. EGR transfer tube from exhaust manifold. 7. Drain and recover cooling system.
8. Radiator surge tank. 9. Brake vacuum pipe at plenum.
10. Throttle cable and vacuum line bracket at plenum. 11. Power steering lines at generator
bracket. 12. Rear generator brare. 13. Generator. 14. Secondary ignition wires from spark plugs
and unroute. 15. Rear valve cover. 16. Disconnect and unroute electrical connections.
^ T.P. sensor.
^ I.A.C.
^ E.G.R.
^ Engine Coolant Temperature (E.C.T.) Sensor.
^ Injector wiring harness connector.
17. PCV hose and any other vacuum lines. 18. Cables at throttle body. 19. Throttle body heater
hoses.
Important: Relieve fuel pressure.
20. Plenum. 21. Fuel lines from fuel rail. 22. Fuel lines at bracket. 23. Power steering mounting
belts (support pump aside leaving fluid lines attached). 24. Coolant bleed pipe from thermostat
housitsg. 25. Heater pipe from cylinder heads, thermostat housing and coolant pump.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 1759
26. Upper radiator hose at thermostat housing. 27. Thermostat housing. 28. Remove valve cover.
29. Intake manifold.
Important: Retain washers in same orientation on 4 center bolts.
30. Loosen rocker arms. 31. Pushrods.
^ Intake and exhaust pushrods are different lengths with the exhaust pushrod being the longer of
the two. Intake pushrods are marked orange; and are 6 inches long; exhaust pushrods are marked
blue and are 6-3/8 inches long.
32. Intake gasket.
Inspect
^ Flatnest of inlet flanges.
Clean
^ Gasket material from mating surfaces.
^ Excess RTV sealant from front and rear ridges of cylinder.
^ Block.
^ Sealing surfaces with degreaser.
Install or Connect
Figure 1. Intake Manifold Installation
1. Place a 2-3 mm head of GM RTV sealer P/N 1052917 or equivalent on each ridge where the
front and rear of the intake manifold Coutact the
block.
2. Intake manifold gasket. 3. Pushrods.
^ Intake pnshrods are marked orange and are 6 inches long.
^ Exhaust puabrods are marked blue and are 6 3/8 inches long.
^ Make sure pushrods seat in lifter.
4. Rocker arm nuts.
Tighten
^ Rocker arm nuts to 25 Nm (18 lbs. ft.).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Intake Manifold > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 1760
5. Intake manifold.
Tighten
^ Intake manifold bolts in proper sequence.
6. Front valve cover. 7. Heater pipe to manifold. 8. Thermostat housing. 9. Upper radiator hose to
thermostat housing.
10. Heater pipe to the cylinder heads, water pump and coolant pump. 11. Coolant bleed pipe on
the thermostat housing. 12. Power steering pump. 13. Fuel lines. 14. Fuel lines at bracket. 15.
Plenum. 16. Throttle body heater hoses. 17. Cables to throttle body. 18. PCV hose and any other
vacuum lines. 19. Route and connect electrical connections.
^ T.P. sensor.
^ I.A.C.
^ E.G.R.
^ Engine Coolant Temperature (E.C.T.) Sensor.
^ Injector wiring harness connector,
20. Rear valve cover. 21. Route and connect all secondary ignition wires. 22. Generator. 23.
Generator brace. 24. Power steering line to generator bracket. 25. Trottle cable and vacuum line
bracket to the plenum. 26. Brake vacuum pipe to plenum. 27. Radiator surge tank. 28. EGR
transfer tube to the exhaust manifold. 29. Exhaust crossover to exhaust manifolds. 30. Serpentine
belt. 31. Air cleaner assembly. 32. Battery. 33. Negative battery cable. 34. Fill coolilig system. 35.
Refer to "Idle Learn Procedure".
Inspect
^ Proper fluid levels.
^ Leaks.
^ Completion of repairs
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Level
Warning Indicator > Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Level Warning Indicator: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
This lamp illuminates to warn the driver that the engine oil level is low. When the ignition switch is
first moved to Run, the oil level indicator lights for about 1 1/2 seconds as a bulb check. The oil
level detection circuit has two internal timers. The first timer records the amount of time the ignition
has been Off. The second timer records the amount of time the ignition has been On before the
ignition was shut Off. The instrument cluster uses this information to determine if the engine has
been sitting long enough for the oil to have returned to the oil pan.
OPERATION
The oil level monitoring circuits will check the oil level switch under the following conditions:
1. Ignition has been turned Off for more than 30 minutes. 2. Ignition has been Off for at least three
minutes after ignition has been On for at least 12 minutes.
If the oil level is low (oil level switch open), the "Check Oil" indicator will be turned On for the
remainder of the ignition cycle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Gauge > Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Pressure Gauge: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
This oil pressure indicating system incorporates an instrument voltage regulator, electrical oil
pressure gauge and a sending unit which are connected in series. The sending unit consists of a
diaphragm, contact and a variable resistor.
OPERATION
As oil pressure increases or decreases, the diaphragm actuated the contact on the variable
resistor, in turn controlling current flow through the gauge. When oil pressure is low, the resistance
of the variable resistor is high, restricting current flow to the gauge, in turn indicating low oil
pressure. As oil pressure increases, the resistance of the variable resistor is lowered, permitting an
increased current flow to the gauge, resulting in an increased gauge reading.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Pressure
Gauge > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1768
Oil Pressure Gauge: Service and Repair
Disconnect the oil pressure gauge lead from the sending unit, connect a 12 volt test lamp between
the gauge lead and the ground and turn ignition on. If test lamp flashes, the instrument voltage
regulator is functioning properly and the gauge circuit is not broken. If the test lamp remains lit, the
instrument voltage regulator is defective and must be replaced. If the test lamp does not light,
check the instrument voltage regulator for proper ground or an open circuit. Also, check for an open
in the instrument voltage regulator to oil pressure gauge wire or in the gauge itself. If test lamp
flashes and gauge is not accurate, the gauge may be out of calibration, requiring replacement.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Lamps and Indicators - Engine > Oil Temperature
Gauge > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Oil Temperature Gauge: Testing and Inspection
Check for a defective wire inside the insulation which could cause system malfunction but prove
"GOOD" in a continuity/voltage check with the system disconnected. These circuits may be
intermittent or resistive when loaded, and if possible, should be checked by monitoring for a voltage
drop with the system operational.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal:
> 05-06-01-019F > Oct > 07 > Engine - Oil Leaks from Crankshaft Rear Main Seal
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: Customer Interest Engine - Oil Leaks from Crankshaft Rear Main
Seal
Bulletin No.: 05-06-01-019F
Date: October 02, 2007
TECHNICAL
Subject: Engine Oil Leak at Crankshaft Rear Main Oil Seal (Install Revised Crankshaft Rear Main
Oil Seal Using Revised Rear Main Seal Installer and Remover Tools)
Models: 1986-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn)
with 2.8L, 3.1L, 3.4L, 3.5L, 3.9L 60 Degree V6 Engine (VINs D, E, F, J, K, L, M, N, R, S, T, V, W,
X, Z, 1, 3, 8, 9, W, R - RPOs LG6, LA1, LNJ, LG8, LL1 or LX9, L82, LL2, LB8, LHO, LG5, LB6, LE2
or LQ1, LH7, LC1, L44, LZ4, LZE, LZ9, LGD, LZ8, LZG)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add an Important statement on proper seal installation. Please
discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-06-01-019E (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
This bulletin only applies to 60 degree V6 engines. Some of the discontinued 60 degree V6 engine
VINs and RPOs may have carried over to other new model year engines and may no longer be a
60 degree V6 engine. So this bulletin may not apply. It is very important to verify that the following
information is correct before using this bulletin:
Year of vehicle (e.g. N = 1992)
V6 Engine Liter size (e.g. 3.4L)
VIN CODE (e.g. X)
RPO (e.g. LQ1)
If ALL the information from the vehicle (year, size, VIN Code, RPO) you're working on can be found
under the models listed above, then this bulletin applies to that engine. If one or more of the
vehicle's information can NOT be found under the models listed above, then this bulletin does NOT
apply.
This bulletin does not apply to 2004-2007 Saturn VUE models with 3.5L DOHC V6 Engine (VIN 4 RPO L66) or 2005-2008 Cadillac CTS with 2.8L HFV6 Engine (VIN T - RPO LP1).
Condition
Some customers may comment on external oil leakage.
Correction
Before replacement of the new design crankshaft rear main oil seal, be sure the PCV system is
operating correctly. The new seal described below comes with a protective nylon sleeve already
installed in the seal. This sleeve assures that the seal is installed in the correct direction and also
protects the seal from getting damaged during installation. Do not remove the protective sleeve
from the seal; if removed, the installation tool (EN48108) will not work.
A new design crankshaft rear main oil seal and installation tool (EN-48108) has been released.
This seal incorporates features that improve high mileage durability. Replace the crankshaft rear
main oil seal with the new design rear main oil seal, P/N 12592195, using the following service
procedures.
Tools Required
TOOLS WERE SHIPPED TO YOUR DEALERSHIPS. IF YOU HAVE NOT RECEIVED THEM OR
THEY ARE LOST, PLEASE CALL GM SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS AT 1-800-GM-TOOLS.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal:
> 05-06-01-019F > Oct > 07 > Engine - Oil Leaks from Crankshaft Rear Main Seal > Page 1781
EN-48108 Rear Main Oil Seal Installation Tool
This tool has a unique design to allow the technician to easily install the rear main seal squarely to
the correct depth and direction. Before proceeding with installation, review the above illustration to
become familiar with the components shown in the illustration.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal:
> 05-06-01-019F > Oct > 07 > Engine - Oil Leaks from Crankshaft Rear Main Seal > Page 1782
EN-48672 rear Main Oil Seal Remover Tool
This tool has a unique design to allow the technician to easily remove the rear main seal without
nicking the crankshaft sealing surface when removing the seal. Before proceeding with removal,
review the above illustration to become familiar with the following components:
Removal Plate
Threaded Adjustment Pins and Jam Nuts
Force Screw
# 2 Self Drill Screws 38 mm (1.5 in) long 8 needed
Extreme Pressure Lubricant
Removal Procedure
Remove the transmission. Refer to Transmission Replacement in SI or the appropriate Service
Manual.
Remove the engine flywheel. Refer to Engine Flywheel Replacement in SI or the appropriate
Service Manual.
Install the removal plate (2) and both threaded adjustment pins and jam nuts (1) into the back of
the crankshaft flange and secure the plate with adjustment pins and jam nuts.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal:
> 05-06-01-019F > Oct > 07 > Engine - Oil Leaks from Crankshaft Rear Main Seal > Page 1783
Install # 2 Self Drill Screws 38 mm (1.5 in) long, eight needed, (1) and tighten down flush to the
plate.
Before installing the force screw, apply a small amount of the Extreme Pressure Lubricant J
23444-A, provided in the tool kit.
Install the force screw (1) and back off both jam nuts (2) and continue to turn the force screw (1)
into the removal plate to remove the seal from the crankshaft.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal:
> 05-06-01-019F > Oct > 07 > Engine - Oil Leaks from Crankshaft Rear Main Seal > Page 1784
Once the seal is removed from the crankshaft, remove and save all eight screws and discard the
old seal.
Clean the crankshaft sealing surface with a clean, lint free towel. Inspect the lead-in edge of the
crankshaft for burrs or sharp edges that could damage the rear main oil seal. Remove any burrs or
sharp edges with crocus cloth or equivalent before proceeding.
Installation Procedure
Do not remove the protective nylon sleeve from the new rear main seal prior to installation. The
EN-48108 is designed to install the rear main seal with the protective sleeve in place. Never apply
or use any oil, lubricants or sealing compounds on the crankshaft rear main oil seal.
Align the mandrel dowel pin (EN-48108) to the dowel pin hole in the crankshaft. Refer to the above
illustration.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal:
> 05-06-01-019F > Oct > 07 > Engine - Oil Leaks from Crankshaft Rear Main Seal > Page 1785
Using a large flat-bladed screwdriver, tighten the two mandrel screws to the crankshaft. Ensure that
the mandrel is snug to the crankshaft hub. Refer to the above illustration.
Different types (styles) of rear main seals were used in production in different model years, engines
and manufacturing facilities. As a result, the NEW style rear main seal that you will be installing
may have a different appearance or shape than the one removed. Regardless of what type of seal
was removed and what side was facing outside the engine, the new seal must be installed as
described. Upon close inspection of the outer lip on the new seal, the words this side out" will be
seen. This side of the seal must be facing OUTSIDE the engine when correctly installed. While this
may seem backwards, it is correct. In addition, the protective nylon (plastic) sleeve that the seal is
mounted on in the package was designed so that the seal can only be installed in the proper
direction when using the installation tool described in the following steps.
Install the rear main seal (1), with the protective nylon sleeve attached (2), onto the mandrel. The
seal, if properly installed, will center on a step that protrudes from the center of the mandrel. As an
error proof, seal will fit only one way onto the mandrel. Refer to the above illustration.
Before installing the outer drive drum, bearing, washer and the drive nut onto the threaded shaft,
apply a small amount of the Extreme Pressure Lubricant J 23444-A, provided in the tool kit.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal:
> 05-06-01-019F > Oct > 07 > Engine - Oil Leaks from Crankshaft Rear Main Seal > Page 1786
Install the outer drive drum onto the mandrel (EN-481 08). Install the bearing, washer and the drive
nut onto the threaded shaft. Refer to the above illustration.
Using a wrench, turn the drive nut on the mandrel (EN-48108), which will push the seal into the
engine block bore. Turn the wrench until the drive drum is snug and flush against the engine block.
Refer to the above illustration.
Loosen and remove the drive nut, washer, bearing and drive drum. Discard the protective nylon
sleeve.
Verify that the seal has seated properly.
Use a flat-bladed screwdriver to remove the two attachment screws from the mandrel and remove
the mandrel from the crankshaft hub. Refer to the above illustration.
Install the engine flywheel. Refer to Engine Flywheel Replacement in SI or the appropriate Service
Manual.
Install the transmission. Refer to Transmission Replacement in SI or the appropriate Service
Manual.
Inspect for proper fluid levels.
Inspect for leaks.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal:
> 05-06-01-019F > Oct > 07 > Engine - Oil Leaks from Crankshaft Rear Main Seal > Page 1787
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal:
> 87-60-02A > Jul > 98 > Engine - Oil Odors
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: Customer Interest Engine - Oil Odors
File In Section: 6 - Engine
Bulletin No.: 87-60-02A
Date: July, 1998
Subject: Engine Oil Odor (Replace Rear Main Bearing Seal)
Models: 1990-96 Buick Regal 1994-97 Buick Skylark 1994-98 Buick Century 1990-94 Chevrolet
Cavalier 1990-95 Chevrolet Camaro 1990-96 Chevrolet Beretta, Corsica, APV 1990-98 Chevrolet
Lumina 1995-98 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 1997-98 Chevrolet Malibu, Venture 1990-97 Oldsmobile
Cutlass Supreme 1990-98 Oldsmobile Silhouette 1994-96 Oldsmobile Cutlass Ciera 1994-97
Oldsmobile Achieva 1997-98 Oldsmobile Cutlass 1990-94 Pontiac Sunbird 1990-95 Pontiac
Firebird 1990-98 Pontiac Grand Prix, Trans Sport 1994-98 Pontiac Grand Am with 3.1L, 3100,
3.4L, 3400 Engines (VINs T, D, X, M, E, S - RPOs LH0, LG6, L01, L82, LA1, L32)
This bulletin is being revised to correct the model usage and part number. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 87-60-02 (Section 6 - Engine).
Condition
Some of the above listed V6 engines may, on a very infrequent basis, have an oil odor condition
that is generally encountered after the engine's oil has been changed. Typically the odor lasts
approximately 1000 miles after the change of oil and then does not reappear until the next change
of oil.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a reaction taking place between the engine oil additive package
and the grease used on the engine's crankshaft rear main oil seal.
Correction
Verify that the engine does not have any external oil leaks. This can be accomplished by using the
methods outlined in the appropriate Service Manual.
If normal diagnostics are unable to establish the source of the oil odor, replace the crankshaft rear
main oil seal. Before installing the seal, remove the grease from the seal and lightly coat the lip
area of the seal with clean engine oil.
Parts Information
P/N Description Qty
14085829 Crankshaft, rear main bearing seal 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal:
> 87-60-02A > Jul > 98 > Engine - Oil Odors > Page 1792
Labor Operation Description Labor Time
J1120 Seal, Crankshaft Use published labor operation time
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal: > 05-06-01-019F > Oct > 07 > Engine - Oil Leaks from Crankshaft Rear Main Seal
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Oil Leaks from Crankshaft
Rear Main Seal
Bulletin No.: 05-06-01-019F
Date: October 02, 2007
TECHNICAL
Subject: Engine Oil Leak at Crankshaft Rear Main Oil Seal (Install Revised Crankshaft Rear Main
Oil Seal Using Revised Rear Main Seal Installer and Remover Tools)
Models: 1986-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn)
with 2.8L, 3.1L, 3.4L, 3.5L, 3.9L 60 Degree V6 Engine (VINs D, E, F, J, K, L, M, N, R, S, T, V, W,
X, Z, 1, 3, 8, 9, W, R - RPOs LG6, LA1, LNJ, LG8, LL1 or LX9, L82, LL2, LB8, LHO, LG5, LB6, LE2
or LQ1, LH7, LC1, L44, LZ4, LZE, LZ9, LGD, LZ8, LZG)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add an Important statement on proper seal installation. Please
discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-06-01-019E (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
This bulletin only applies to 60 degree V6 engines. Some of the discontinued 60 degree V6 engine
VINs and RPOs may have carried over to other new model year engines and may no longer be a
60 degree V6 engine. So this bulletin may not apply. It is very important to verify that the following
information is correct before using this bulletin:
Year of vehicle (e.g. N = 1992)
V6 Engine Liter size (e.g. 3.4L)
VIN CODE (e.g. X)
RPO (e.g. LQ1)
If ALL the information from the vehicle (year, size, VIN Code, RPO) you're working on can be found
under the models listed above, then this bulletin applies to that engine. If one or more of the
vehicle's information can NOT be found under the models listed above, then this bulletin does NOT
apply.
This bulletin does not apply to 2004-2007 Saturn VUE models with 3.5L DOHC V6 Engine (VIN 4 RPO L66) or 2005-2008 Cadillac CTS with 2.8L HFV6 Engine (VIN T - RPO LP1).
Condition
Some customers may comment on external oil leakage.
Correction
Before replacement of the new design crankshaft rear main oil seal, be sure the PCV system is
operating correctly. The new seal described below comes with a protective nylon sleeve already
installed in the seal. This sleeve assures that the seal is installed in the correct direction and also
protects the seal from getting damaged during installation. Do not remove the protective sleeve
from the seal; if removed, the installation tool (EN48108) will not work.
A new design crankshaft rear main oil seal and installation tool (EN-48108) has been released.
This seal incorporates features that improve high mileage durability. Replace the crankshaft rear
main oil seal with the new design rear main oil seal, P/N 12592195, using the following service
procedures.
Tools Required
TOOLS WERE SHIPPED TO YOUR DEALERSHIPS. IF YOU HAVE NOT RECEIVED THEM OR
THEY ARE LOST, PLEASE CALL GM SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS AT 1-800-GM-TOOLS.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal: > 05-06-01-019F > Oct > 07 > Engine - Oil Leaks from Crankshaft Rear Main Seal > Page 1798
EN-48108 Rear Main Oil Seal Installation Tool
This tool has a unique design to allow the technician to easily install the rear main seal squarely to
the correct depth and direction. Before proceeding with installation, review the above illustration to
become familiar with the components shown in the illustration.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal: > 05-06-01-019F > Oct > 07 > Engine - Oil Leaks from Crankshaft Rear Main Seal > Page 1799
EN-48672 rear Main Oil Seal Remover Tool
This tool has a unique design to allow the technician to easily remove the rear main seal without
nicking the crankshaft sealing surface when removing the seal. Before proceeding with removal,
review the above illustration to become familiar with the following components:
Removal Plate
Threaded Adjustment Pins and Jam Nuts
Force Screw
# 2 Self Drill Screws 38 mm (1.5 in) long 8 needed
Extreme Pressure Lubricant
Removal Procedure
Remove the transmission. Refer to Transmission Replacement in SI or the appropriate Service
Manual.
Remove the engine flywheel. Refer to Engine Flywheel Replacement in SI or the appropriate
Service Manual.
Install the removal plate (2) and both threaded adjustment pins and jam nuts (1) into the back of
the crankshaft flange and secure the plate with adjustment pins and jam nuts.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal: > 05-06-01-019F > Oct > 07 > Engine - Oil Leaks from Crankshaft Rear Main Seal > Page 1800
Install # 2 Self Drill Screws 38 mm (1.5 in) long, eight needed, (1) and tighten down flush to the
plate.
Before installing the force screw, apply a small amount of the Extreme Pressure Lubricant J
23444-A, provided in the tool kit.
Install the force screw (1) and back off both jam nuts (2) and continue to turn the force screw (1)
into the removal plate to remove the seal from the crankshaft.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal: > 05-06-01-019F > Oct > 07 > Engine - Oil Leaks from Crankshaft Rear Main Seal > Page 1801
Once the seal is removed from the crankshaft, remove and save all eight screws and discard the
old seal.
Clean the crankshaft sealing surface with a clean, lint free towel. Inspect the lead-in edge of the
crankshaft for burrs or sharp edges that could damage the rear main oil seal. Remove any burrs or
sharp edges with crocus cloth or equivalent before proceeding.
Installation Procedure
Do not remove the protective nylon sleeve from the new rear main seal prior to installation. The
EN-48108 is designed to install the rear main seal with the protective sleeve in place. Never apply
or use any oil, lubricants or sealing compounds on the crankshaft rear main oil seal.
Align the mandrel dowel pin (EN-48108) to the dowel pin hole in the crankshaft. Refer to the above
illustration.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal: > 05-06-01-019F > Oct > 07 > Engine - Oil Leaks from Crankshaft Rear Main Seal > Page 1802
Using a large flat-bladed screwdriver, tighten the two mandrel screws to the crankshaft. Ensure that
the mandrel is snug to the crankshaft hub. Refer to the above illustration.
Different types (styles) of rear main seals were used in production in different model years, engines
and manufacturing facilities. As a result, the NEW style rear main seal that you will be installing
may have a different appearance or shape than the one removed. Regardless of what type of seal
was removed and what side was facing outside the engine, the new seal must be installed as
described. Upon close inspection of the outer lip on the new seal, the words this side out" will be
seen. This side of the seal must be facing OUTSIDE the engine when correctly installed. While this
may seem backwards, it is correct. In addition, the protective nylon (plastic) sleeve that the seal is
mounted on in the package was designed so that the seal can only be installed in the proper
direction when using the installation tool described in the following steps.
Install the rear main seal (1), with the protective nylon sleeve attached (2), onto the mandrel. The
seal, if properly installed, will center on a step that protrudes from the center of the mandrel. As an
error proof, seal will fit only one way onto the mandrel. Refer to the above illustration.
Before installing the outer drive drum, bearing, washer and the drive nut onto the threaded shaft,
apply a small amount of the Extreme Pressure Lubricant J 23444-A, provided in the tool kit.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal: > 05-06-01-019F > Oct > 07 > Engine - Oil Leaks from Crankshaft Rear Main Seal > Page 1803
Install the outer drive drum onto the mandrel (EN-481 08). Install the bearing, washer and the drive
nut onto the threaded shaft. Refer to the above illustration.
Using a wrench, turn the drive nut on the mandrel (EN-48108), which will push the seal into the
engine block bore. Turn the wrench until the drive drum is snug and flush against the engine block.
Refer to the above illustration.
Loosen and remove the drive nut, washer, bearing and drive drum. Discard the protective nylon
sleeve.
Verify that the seal has seated properly.
Use a flat-bladed screwdriver to remove the two attachment screws from the mandrel and remove
the mandrel from the crankshaft hub. Refer to the above illustration.
Install the engine flywheel. Refer to Engine Flywheel Replacement in SI or the appropriate Service
Manual.
Install the transmission. Refer to Transmission Replacement in SI or the appropriate Service
Manual.
Inspect for proper fluid levels.
Inspect for leaks.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal: > 05-06-01-019F > Oct > 07 > Engine - Oil Leaks from Crankshaft Rear Main Seal > Page 1804
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal: > 87-60-02A > Jul > 98 > Engine - Oil Odors
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Oil Odors
File In Section: 6 - Engine
Bulletin No.: 87-60-02A
Date: July, 1998
Subject: Engine Oil Odor (Replace Rear Main Bearing Seal)
Models: 1990-96 Buick Regal 1994-97 Buick Skylark 1994-98 Buick Century 1990-94 Chevrolet
Cavalier 1990-95 Chevrolet Camaro 1990-96 Chevrolet Beretta, Corsica, APV 1990-98 Chevrolet
Lumina 1995-98 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 1997-98 Chevrolet Malibu, Venture 1990-97 Oldsmobile
Cutlass Supreme 1990-98 Oldsmobile Silhouette 1994-96 Oldsmobile Cutlass Ciera 1994-97
Oldsmobile Achieva 1997-98 Oldsmobile Cutlass 1990-94 Pontiac Sunbird 1990-95 Pontiac
Firebird 1990-98 Pontiac Grand Prix, Trans Sport 1994-98 Pontiac Grand Am with 3.1L, 3100,
3.4L, 3400 Engines (VINs T, D, X, M, E, S - RPOs LH0, LG6, L01, L82, LA1, L32)
This bulletin is being revised to correct the model usage and part number. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 87-60-02 (Section 6 - Engine).
Condition
Some of the above listed V6 engines may, on a very infrequent basis, have an oil odor condition
that is generally encountered after the engine's oil has been changed. Typically the odor lasts
approximately 1000 miles after the change of oil and then does not reappear until the next change
of oil.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a reaction taking place between the engine oil additive package
and the grease used on the engine's crankshaft rear main oil seal.
Correction
Verify that the engine does not have any external oil leaks. This can be accomplished by using the
methods outlined in the appropriate Service Manual.
If normal diagnostics are unable to establish the source of the oil odor, replace the crankshaft rear
main oil seal. Before installing the seal, remove the grease from the seal and lightly coat the lip
area of the seal with clean engine oil.
Parts Information
P/N Description Qty
14085829 Crankshaft, rear main bearing seal 1
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal: > 87-60-02A > Jul > 98 > Engine - Oil Odors > Page 1809
Labor Operation Description Labor Time
J1120 Seal, Crankshaft Use published labor operation time
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Crankshaft Main
Bearing Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1810
Crankshaft Main Bearing Seal: Service and Repair
Fig. 8 Removing Oil Seal
Fig. 9 Installing Oil Seal
1. Support engine using tool No. J 28467-A or equivalent, then remove transaxle assembly.
2. Remove flywheel assembly.
3. Remove oil seal as shown in Fig. 8. Use caution not to damage crankshaft surface with removal
tool.
4. Check inside diameter of bore and crankshaft for nicks or burrs. Repair as required.
5. Apply oil to inside diameter of new seal, then install seal on mandrel of tool No. J-34686 until
back of seal bottoms squarely against collar of tool, Fig. 9.
6. Align dowel pin of tool with dowel pin of crankshaft, then attach tool to crankshaft. Torque
attaching screws to 45 inch lbs.
7. Turn ``T'' handle of tool so collar pushes seal into bore. Ensure seal is properly seated.
8. Loosen ``T'' handle of tool until it comes to a stop, then remove tool attaching screws. Ensure
seal is seated squarely in bore.
9. Install flywheel and transaxle assembly.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft
Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Crankshaft Seal: > 07-06-01-023
> Dec > 07 > Engine - Oil Leaks From Front Crankshaft Seal
Front Crankshaft Seal: Customer Interest Engine - Oil Leaks From Front Crankshaft Seal
Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-023
Date: December 05, 2007
TECHNICAL
Subject: 60 Degree V6 Engine Oil Leak at Crankshaft Front Oil Seal (Use New Crankshaft Front Oil
Seal Installer Tool EN-48869)
Models: 1986-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn)
with 2.8L, 3.1L, 3.4L, 3.5L or 3.9L 60 Degree V6 Engine
(VINs D, E, F, J, K, L, M, N, R, S, T, V, W, X, Z, 1, 3, 8, 9, W, R - RPOs LG6, LA1, LNJ, LG8, LL1
or LX9, L82, LL2, LB8, LHO, LG5, LB6, LE2 or LQ1, LH7, LC1, L44, LZ4, LZE, LZ9, LGD, LZ8,
LZG)
This bulletin does not apply to 2004-2007 Saturn VUE models with 3.5L DOHC V6 Engine (VIN 4 RPO L66) or 2005-2008 Cadillac CTS with 2.8L HFV6 Engine (VIN T - RPO LP1).
This bulletin only applies to 60 degree V6 engines. Some of the discontinued 60 degree V6 engine
VINs and RPOs may have carried over to other new model year engines and may no longer be a
60 degree V6 engine. So this bulletin may not apply. It is very important to verify that the
information shown is correct before using this bulletin.
If ALL the information from the vehicle (year, size, VIN Code, RPO) you're working on can be found
under the models listed above, then this bulletin applies to that engine. If one or more of the
vehicle's information can NOT be found under the models listed above, then this bulletin does NOT
apply.
Condition
Some customers may comment on external oil leakage.
Correction
Before replacement of the crankshaft front oil seal, be sure the PCV system is operating correctly.
Tools Required
TOOLS WERE SHIPPED TO YOUR DEALERSHIPS. IF YOU HAVE NOT RECEIVED THEM OR
THEY ARE LOST, PLEASE CALL GM SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS AT 1-800-GM-TOOLS.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft
Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Crankshaft Seal: > 07-06-01-023
> Dec > 07 > Engine - Oil Leaks From Front Crankshaft Seal > Page 1819
The EN-48869 has a unique design to allow the technician to easily install the front crankshaft seal
squarely to the correct depth and direction. Before proceeding with installation, review the
illustration to become familiar with the tool.
Removal Procedure
Remove the crankshaft balancer. Refer to Crankshaft Balancer Replacement in SI.
Use care not to damage the engine front cover or nick the crankshaft.
Remove the crankshaft front oil seal (1) using a suitable tool.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft
Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Crankshaft Seal: > 07-06-01-023
> Dec > 07 > Engine - Oil Leaks From Front Crankshaft Seal > Page 1820
Lubricate the inside of the crankshaft front oil seal (1) with clean engine oil. Then install the seal to
the installer body (2).
Align the oil seal and installer body (1) with the engine front cover and crankshaft.
Before installing the force screw, apply a small amount of the Extreme Pressure Lubricant J
23444-A, provided in the tool kit, to the force screw.
Install the drive nut (4) onto the threaded force screw shaft (5), washer (3), and bearing (2). Then
install to the installer body (1) and tighten the force screw to the crankshaft by hand.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft
Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Crankshaft Seal: > 07-06-01-023
> Dec > 07 > Engine - Oil Leaks From Front Crankshaft Seal > Page 1821
Using a wrench, turn the drive nut on the threaded force screw shaft (2), this will push the seal into
the engine front cover.
Continue to turn the drive nut (2) with the wrench until the installer body (1) is snug and flush
against the engine front cover.
Loosen and remove the drive nut from the threaded force screw shaft, washer, bearing, and
installer body. Verify that the seal has seated properly, flush against front cover flange (1).
Install the crankshaft balancer. Refer to Crankshaft Balancer Replacement in SI.
Inspect for proper fluid levels.
Inspect for leaks.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft
Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Front Crankshaft Seal: > 07-06-01-023
> Dec > 07 > Engine - Oil Leaks From Front Crankshaft Seal > Page 1822
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft
Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Crankshaft Seal: >
07-06-01-023 > Dec > 07 > Engine - Oil Leaks From Front Crankshaft Seal
Front Crankshaft Seal: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Oil Leaks From Front Crankshaft
Seal
Bulletin No.: 07-06-01-023
Date: December 05, 2007
TECHNICAL
Subject: 60 Degree V6 Engine Oil Leak at Crankshaft Front Oil Seal (Use New Crankshaft Front Oil
Seal Installer Tool EN-48869)
Models: 1986-2008 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn)
with 2.8L, 3.1L, 3.4L, 3.5L or 3.9L 60 Degree V6 Engine
(VINs D, E, F, J, K, L, M, N, R, S, T, V, W, X, Z, 1, 3, 8, 9, W, R - RPOs LG6, LA1, LNJ, LG8, LL1
or LX9, L82, LL2, LB8, LHO, LG5, LB6, LE2 or LQ1, LH7, LC1, L44, LZ4, LZE, LZ9, LGD, LZ8,
LZG)
This bulletin does not apply to 2004-2007 Saturn VUE models with 3.5L DOHC V6 Engine (VIN 4 RPO L66) or 2005-2008 Cadillac CTS with 2.8L HFV6 Engine (VIN T - RPO LP1).
This bulletin only applies to 60 degree V6 engines. Some of the discontinued 60 degree V6 engine
VINs and RPOs may have carried over to other new model year engines and may no longer be a
60 degree V6 engine. So this bulletin may not apply. It is very important to verify that the
information shown is correct before using this bulletin.
If ALL the information from the vehicle (year, size, VIN Code, RPO) you're working on can be found
under the models listed above, then this bulletin applies to that engine. If one or more of the
vehicle's information can NOT be found under the models listed above, then this bulletin does NOT
apply.
Condition
Some customers may comment on external oil leakage.
Correction
Before replacement of the crankshaft front oil seal, be sure the PCV system is operating correctly.
Tools Required
TOOLS WERE SHIPPED TO YOUR DEALERSHIPS. IF YOU HAVE NOT RECEIVED THEM OR
THEY ARE LOST, PLEASE CALL GM SPECIAL SERVICE TOOLS AT 1-800-GM-TOOLS.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft
Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Crankshaft Seal: >
07-06-01-023 > Dec > 07 > Engine - Oil Leaks From Front Crankshaft Seal > Page 1828
The EN-48869 has a unique design to allow the technician to easily install the front crankshaft seal
squarely to the correct depth and direction. Before proceeding with installation, review the
illustration to become familiar with the tool.
Removal Procedure
Remove the crankshaft balancer. Refer to Crankshaft Balancer Replacement in SI.
Use care not to damage the engine front cover or nick the crankshaft.
Remove the crankshaft front oil seal (1) using a suitable tool.
Installation Procedure
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft
Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Crankshaft Seal: >
07-06-01-023 > Dec > 07 > Engine - Oil Leaks From Front Crankshaft Seal > Page 1829
Lubricate the inside of the crankshaft front oil seal (1) with clean engine oil. Then install the seal to
the installer body (2).
Align the oil seal and installer body (1) with the engine front cover and crankshaft.
Before installing the force screw, apply a small amount of the Extreme Pressure Lubricant J
23444-A, provided in the tool kit, to the force screw.
Install the drive nut (4) onto the threaded force screw shaft (5), washer (3), and bearing (2). Then
install to the installer body (1) and tighten the force screw to the crankshaft by hand.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft
Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Crankshaft Seal: >
07-06-01-023 > Dec > 07 > Engine - Oil Leaks From Front Crankshaft Seal > Page 1830
Using a wrench, turn the drive nut on the threaded force screw shaft (2), this will push the seal into
the engine front cover.
Continue to turn the drive nut (2) with the wrench until the installer body (1) is snug and flush
against the engine front cover.
Loosen and remove the drive nut from the threaded force screw shaft, washer, bearing, and
installer body. Verify that the seal has seated properly, flush against front cover flange (1).
Install the crankshaft balancer. Refer to Crankshaft Balancer Replacement in SI.
Inspect for proper fluid levels.
Inspect for leaks.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft
Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Front Crankshaft Seal: >
07-06-01-023 > Dec > 07 > Engine - Oil Leaks From Front Crankshaft Seal > Page 1831
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Front Crankshaft
Seal > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1832
Front Crankshaft Seal: Service and Repair
1. Remove front wheel and tire assemblies.
2. Remove inner splash shield and torsional damper, then pry seal from cover using a suitable
screwdriver. Use caution not to damage crankshaft surface during seal removal.
3. Install new seal using tool No. J 35468 or equivalent, so open end faces toward inside of cover,
then drive seal into position using suitable tool.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Seals and Gaskets, Engine > Valve Guide Seal >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Valve Guide Seal: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove rocker arm cover, then the spark plug, rocker arm and pushrod on cylinder(s) being
serviced.
2. Install air line adapter tool No. J-22794 or equivalent to spark plug port and apply compressed
air to hold valves in place.
3. Using valve spring compressor tool No. J-26513-A or equivalent to compress valve spring,
remove valve locks, valve caps, oil seal and valve spring and damper.
4. Remove valve stem oil seal.
INSTALLATION
1. Set valve spring and damper around valve guide boss.
2. Install a valve stem seal over the valve stem and valve guide base-inlet only.
3. Drop an oil seal and valve rotator over the exhaust, and a valve spring cap over the valve spring.
4. Compress spring using valve spring compressor tool No. J-26513-A or equivalent, install oil seal
in lower groove of stem, ensuring seal is flat and not twisted.
5. Install valve locks and release compressor tool, ensuring locks seat properly in upper groove of
valve stem. Use suitable grease as necessary to hold locks in place while releasing compressor
tool.
6. Using tool J-23994 or equivalent, apply vacuum to valve cap to ensure no air leaks past seal.
7. Install spark plug, torquing to specifications.
8. Install and adjust valve mechanism.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch
Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump): Locations Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch
RH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch > Page
1841
RH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch > Page
1842
Fuel Pump / Oil Pressure Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure
Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Page 1843
Harness Connector Faces: Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Interference Engine
Timing Chain: Service and Repair Interference Engine
The OE manufacture does not specify if this engine is an interference engine or not.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Chain > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Interference Engine > Page 1849
Timing Chain: Service and Repair Timing Chain and Sprocket
Fig. 6 Valve Timing Marks
1. Remove crankcase front cover, refer to Timing Cover / Service and Repair. See: Timing
Cover/Service and Repair 2. Place No. 1 cylinder at TDC and align timing marks on crankshaft and
camshaft sprockets, Fig. 6. 3. Remove camshaft sprocket attaching bolts. Tap lower edge of
sprocket with plastic mallet and remove sprocket and timing chain. 4. Align timing marks, Fig. 6,
and install timing chain on sprockets. 5. Align dowel on camshaft with dowel hole on camshaft
sprocket, then install sprocket to camshaft, using attaching bolts to to draw sprocket fully to
camshaft. Torque attaching bolts to specification.
6. Lubricate timing chain with engine oil, then install front cover.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Timing Components > Timing Cover > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Timing Cover: Service and Repair
Fig. 5 Installing Front Cover
1. Disconnect battery ground cable and drain cooling system.
2. Remove serpentine belt and tensioner.
3. Disconnect alternator and position aside.
4. Disconnect power steering pump and position aside.
5. Raise and support vehicle, then remove inner splash shield.
6. Remove flywheel cover attaching bolts at transaxle, then remove flywheel cover.
7. Remove harmonic balancer with pulling tool No. J 24420-B or equivalent.
8. Remove starter assembly.
9. Remove serpentine belt idler pulley.
10. Remove oil pan. Refer to Engine Lubrication / Oil Pan, Engine / Service and Repair. See:
Engine Lubrication/Oil Pan/Service and Repair
11. Remove front cover lower attaching bolts.
12. Lower vehicle, then remove water pump attaching radiator hose.
13. Remove heater hose at cooling system fill pipe, then remove bypass and overflow hoses.
14. Remove water pump pulley, the remove spark plug wire shield at water pump.
15. Remove canister purge hose.
16. Remove upper front cover attaching bolts, then remove front cover, Fig. 5.
17. Reverse to install. Torque all attaching nuts, bolts or screws to specifications.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > Diagnostic Connector - Fuel Pump > Component Information > Locations
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > Fuel Pressure Test Port > Component Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Test Port: Service and Repair
Area around fuel pressure connection with GM X-30A or equivalent.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT:
1. Negative battery terminal.
2. Relieve fuel system pressure.
3. Fuel pressure connection and seal. Discard seal.
INSTALL OR CONNECT:
1. New seal on fuel pressure connection.
2. Fuel pressure connection in fuel rail. Tighten Fuel pressure connection assembly to 10.0 N-m
(88 lb. in.).
3. Tighten fuel filler cap.
4. Negative battery terminal.
5. Turn ignition switch to the "ON" position for two seconds, then turn to the "OFF" position for ten
seconds. Again turn to the "ON" position, and check for fuel leaks.
6. Perform the "Idle Learn Procedure." The ECM will need to relearn the IAC valve pintle position
following battery reconnect.
Air Plenum And Fuel Rail Removal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Pressure > Fuel Pressure Test Port > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 1861
Fuel Pressure Connection
REMOVAL:
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Relieve the fuel system pressure, see FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELIEF:
3. Remove intake manifold plenum, see INTAKE MANIFOLD PLENUM.
4. Clean area around the fuel pressure connection with GM X-30A or equivalent.
5. Remove the fuel pressure connection and seal, discard the seal.
INSTALLATION:
1. Place a new seal on the fuel pressure connection assembly.
2. Screw the fuel pressure connection assembly into the fuel rail and tighten to 10.0 N-m (88 lb.
in.).
3. Check for fuel leaks: a.
Connect the negative battery cable.
b. With engine "OFF" and ignition "ON," check for fuel leaks.
c. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
4. Install the intake manifold plenum as per above procedure.
IDLE LEARN PROCEDURE: Any time the battery is disconnected, the programmed position of the
IAC valve pintle is lost, and replaced with a default value. To return the IAC valve pintle to the
correct position, perform the following procedure:
1. After restoring battery power, connect the Tech 1 "SCAN" tool.
2. Select "IAC SYSTEM," then select "IDLE LEARN" in the "MISC TEST" mode.
3. Proceed with idle learn as directed.
^ This procedure allows the ECM memory to be updated with the correct IAC valve pintle position,
for the vehicle, and provide a stable idle speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle
Speed > System Information > Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
The idle speed is computer controlled and there is no provision for adjustment. If idle speed is
incorrect, refer to Computers and Control Systems / System Diagnosis.
MINIMUM IDLE SPEED
Transmission Gear Idle Speed IAC Counts Open/Closed Loop (2)
N/A N/A (1) 10-20 CL
(1) No idle speed specifications are provided for this vehicle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle
Speed > System Information > Specifications > Page 1865
Idle Speed: Adjustments
The ECM controls idle speed and no adjustment should be attempted.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air
Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: Customer Interest Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air
Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 1875
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Air Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air
Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Air Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page
1881
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel
Filter > Fuel Pressure Release > System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
WARNING: To reduce the risk of fire and personal injury, it is necessary to relieve the fuel system
pressure before servicing fuel system components.
After relieving system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing fuel lines
or connections. In order to reduce the chance of personal injury, cover fuel line fittings with a shop
towel before disconnecting, to catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved
container when disconnect is completed.
When servicing the fuel system use the following precautions:
a. Put a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the workshop.
b. Be sure shop is supplied with an adequate fire extinguisher.
c. Be sure to disconnect the negative battery cable before any service work is done.
d. Use a suitable container to catch any fuel that may leak from system during service.
e. Always relieve fuel system pressure before disconnecting any lines.
f. If the key must be turned "ON" while servicing fuel system, always disconnect or disable ignition,
to insure no sparks occur near fuel vapors.
PROCEDURE:
Tool required: J34730-1 Fuel Pressure Gauge or equivalent.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable, to avoid fuel pump turn "ON," if an accidental attempt is
made to start the engine.
2. Loosen the fuel filler cap to relieve tank vapor pressure.
3. Connect the fuel pressure gauge to the pressure connection. Wrap a shop towel around the
fitting while connecting the gauge to avoid spillage.
4. Install bleed hose into an approved container and open the valve to bleed the system pressure.
Fuel connections are now safe for servicing.
5. Drain any fuel remaining in the gauge into an approved container.
When repair to the fuel system has been completed, START the engine and check all connections
that were loosened for leaks.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing
Order > Component Information > Specifications > Ignition Firing Order
Firing Order: Specifications Ignition Firing Order
Firing Order .........................................................................................................................................
............................................................... 1-2-3-4-5-6
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Ignition Timing > Number One Cylinder > Component Information > Locations > Number 1 Cylinder Location
Number One Cylinder: Locations Number 1 Cylinder Location
NUMBER ONE CYLINDER LOCATION
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Ignition Timing > Timing Marks and Indicators > System Information > Locations
Timing Marks and Indicators: Locations
The ECM controls ignition timing therefore no provisions for adjustment are required. No timing
marks are provided on this engine.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug Wire <--> [Ignition Cable] > Component Information > Specifications
Spark Plug Wire: Specifications
Spark Plug Wire Resistance Values:
0-15 inch cable ....................................................................................................................................
............................................... 3,000-10,000 ohms.
15-25 inch cable ..................................................................................................................................
............................................... 4,000-15,000 ohms.
25-35 inch cable ..................................................................................................................................
............................................... 6,000-20,000 ohms.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark
Plug Wire <--> [Ignition Cable] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1901
Spark Plug Wire Routing
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Spark Plug > Component Information > Specifications
Spark Plug: Specifications
Spark Plug Gap ...................................................................................................................................
...................................................... .045 in. (1.14 mm)
NOTE: Check the gap specifications given on the Emissions Control Label. If the gap is different
from what is listed here, use the information on the label.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks >
Compression Check > System Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
The lowest reading cylinder should not be less than 70% of the highest and no cylinder reading
should be less than 689 kPa (100 psi). Perform compression test with engine at normal operating
temperature, spark plugs removed and throttle wide open.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve
Clearance > System Information > Specifications > Valve Clearance Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications Valve Clearance Specifications
Vehicles are equipped with a non-adjustable rocker arm studs. If valve reconditioning is required,
the non-adjustable rocker arm stud must be replaced with an adjustable rocker arm stud and the
following procedure must be performed.
1. Remove rocker arm covers.
2. Crank engine until mark on torsional damper lines up with O mark on timing tab. The engine
should also be in the No. 1 firing position. This can be determined by placing fingers on No. 1
rocker arms as mark on damper approaches O mark.
3. If valves are not moving, engine is in No. 1 firing position. If valves move as the mark comes up
to the timing tab, engine is in No. 4 firing position and should be rotated one revolution to reach No.
1 position.
4. With engine in No. 1 firing position, adjust exhaust valves 1, 2 and 3 and intake valves 1, 5 and
6, as follows: a.
Back out adjusting nut until lash is felt at pushrod, then turn in adjusting nut until all lash is
removed.
b. When lash has been removed, turn adjusting nut in additional 1 1/2 turns to center lifter plunger.
5. Crank engine one revolution until timing tab O mark and torsional damper mark are again in
alignment.
6. With the engine in this, the No. 4 firing position. adjust exhaust valves 4, 5 and 6 and intake
valves 2, 3 and 4 as previously described.
7. Install rocker arm covers, then start engine and check timing and idle speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve
Clearance > System Information > Specifications > Valve Clearance Specifications > Page 1912
Valve Clearance: Specifications Valve Arrangement
FRONT TO REAR
Right ....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................... E-I-E-I-I-E Left .........................................................................
......................................................................................................................................... E-I-I-E-I-E
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve
Clearance > System Information > Specifications > Page 1913
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
Vehicles are equipped with a non-adjustable rocker arm studs. If valve reconditioning is required,
the non-adjustable rocker arm stud must be replaced with an adjustable rocker arm stud and the
following procedure must be performed.
1. Remove rocker arm covers.
2. Crank engine until mark on torsional damper lines up with O mark on timing tab. The engine
should also be in the No. 1 firing position. This can be determined by placing fingers on No. 1
rocker arms as mark on damper approaches O mark.
3. If valves are not moving, engine is in No. 1 firing position. If valves move as the mark comes up
to the timing tab, engine is in No. 4 firing position and should be rotated one revolution to reach No.
1 position.
4. With engine in No. 1 firing position, adjust exhaust valves 1, 2 and 3 and intake valves 1, 5 and
6, as follows: a.
Back out adjusting nut until lash is felt at pushrod, then turn in adjusting nut until all lash is
removed.
b. When lash has been removed, turn adjusting nut in additional 1 1/2 turns to center lifter plunger.
5. Crank engine one revolution until timing tab O mark and torsional damper mark are again in
alignment.
6. With the engine in this, the No. 4 firing position. adjust exhaust valves 4, 5 and 6 and intake
valves 2, 3 and 4 as previously described.
7. Install rocker arm covers, then start engine and check timing and idle speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Engine > Water Pump > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Water Pump: Service and Repair
Fig. 15 Water Pump Mounting
1. Disconnect battery ground cable, then drain cooling system.
2. Disconnect serpentine belt at the water pump pulley.
3. Remove water pump pulley, then the water pump, Fig. 15.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information
Bulletin No.: 00-06-02-006D
Date: August 15, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Engine Coolant Recycling and Warranty Information
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2007 and Prior
HUMMER Vehicles 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Attention:
Please address this bulletin to the Warranty Claims Administrator and the Service Manager.
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to adjust the title and Include Warranty Information. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 00-06-02-006C (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
Coolant Reimbursement Policy
General Motors supports the use of recycled engine coolant for warranty repairs/service, providing
a GM approved engine coolant recycling system is used. Recycled coolant will be reimbursed at
the GMSPO dealer price for new coolant plus the appropriate mark-up. When coolant replacement
is required during a warranty repair, it is crucial that only the relative amount of engine coolant
concentrate be charged, not the total diluted volume. In other words: if you are using two gallons of
pre-diluted (50:50) recycled engine coolant to service a vehicle, you may request reimbursement
for one gallon of GM Goodwrench engine coolant concentrate at the dealer price plus the
appropriate warranty parts handling allowance.
Licensed Approved DEX-COOL(R) Providers
Important:
USE OF NON-APPROVED VIRGIN OR RECYCLED DEX-COOL(R) OR DEVIATIONS IN THE
FORM OF ALTERNATE CHEMICALS OR ALTERATION OF EQUIPMENT, WILL VOID THE GM
ENDORSEMENT, MAY DEGRADE COOLANT SYSTEM INTEGRITY AND PLACE THE
COOLING SYSTEM WARRANTY UNDER JEOPARDY.
Shown in Table 1 are the only current licensed and approved providers of DEX-COOL(R). Products
that are advertised as "COMPATIBLE" or "RECOMMENDED" for use with DEX-COOL(R) have not
been tested or approved by General Motors. Non-approved coolants may degrade the
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information > Page 1922
coolant system integrity and will no longer be considered a 5 yr/150,000 mile (240,000 km) coolant.
Coolant Removal Services/Recycling
The tables include all coolant recycling processes currently approved by GM. Also included is a
primary phone number and demographic information. Used DEX-COOL(R) can be combined with
used conventional coolant (green) for recycling. Depending on the recycling service and/or
equipment, it is then designated as a conventional 2 yr/30,000 mile (50,000 km) coolant or
DEX-COOL(R) 5 yr/150,000 mile (240,000 km) coolant. Recycled coolants as designated in this
bulletin may be used during the vehicle(s) warranty period.
DEX-COOL(R) Recycling
The DEX-COOL(R) recycling service listed in Table 2 has been approved for recycling waste
engine coolants (DEX-COOL) or conventional) to DEX-COOL(R) with 5 yr/150,000 mile (240,000
km) usability. Recycling Fluid Technologies is the only licensed provider of Recycled
DEX-COOL(R) meeting GM6277M specifications and utilizes GM approved inhibitor packages.
This is currently a limited program being monitored by GM Service Operations which will be
expanded as demand increases.
Conventional (Green) Recycling
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information > Page 1923
Processes shown in the Table 3 are capable of recycling waste engine coolants (DEX-COOL(R) or
conventional) to a conventional (green) coolant. Recycling conventional coolant can be
accomplished at your facility by a technician using approved EQUIPMENT (listed by model number
in Table 3), or by an approved coolant recycling SERVICE which may recycle the coolant at your
facility or at an offsite operation. Refer to the table for GM approved coolant recyclers in either of
these two categories. Should you decide to recycle the coolant yourself, strict adherence to the
operating procedures is imperative. Use ONLY the inhibitor chemicals supplied by the respective
(GM approved) recycling equipment manufacturer.
Sealing Tablets
Cooling System Sealing Tablets (Seal Tabs) should not be used as a regular maintenance item
after servicing an engine cooling system. Discoloration of coolant can occur if too many seal tabs
have been inserted into the cooling system. This can occur if seal tabs are repeatedly used over
the service life of a vehicle. Where appropriate, seal tabs may be used if diagnostics fail to repair a
small leak in the cooling system. When a condition appears in which seal tabs may be
recommended, a specific bulletin will be released describing their proper usage.
Water Quality
The integrity of the coolant is dependent upon the quality of DEX-COOL(R) and water.
DEX-COOL(R) is a product that has enhanced protection capability as well as an extended service
interval. These enhanced properties may be jeopardized by combining DEX-COOL(R) with poor
quality water. If you suspect the water in your area of being poor quality, it is recommended you
use distilled or de-ionized water with DEX-COOL(R).
"Pink" DEX-COOL(R)
DEX-COOL(R) is orange in color to distinguish it from other coolants. Due to inconsistencies in the
mixing of the dyes used with DEX-COOL(R), some batches may appear pink after time. The color
shift from orange to pink does not affect the integrity of the coolant, and still maintains the 5
yr/150,000 mile (240,000 km) service interval.
Back Service
Only use DEX-COOL(R) if the vehicle was originally equipped with DEX-COOL(R).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information > Page 1924
Contamination
Mixing conventional green coolant with DEX-COOL(R) will degrade the service interval from 5
yrs./150,000 miles (240,000 km) to 2 yrs./30,000 miles (50,000 km) if left in the contaminated
condition. If contamination occurs, the cooling system must be flushed twice immediately and
re-filled with a 50/50 mixture of DEX-COOL(R) and clean water in order to preserve the enhanced
properties and extended service interval of DEX-COOL(R).
After 5 years/150,000 miles (240,000 km)
After 5 yrs/150,000 miles (240,000 km), the coolant should be changed, preferably using a coolant
exchanger. If the vehicle was originally equipped with DEX-COOL(R) and has not had problems
with contamination from non-DEX-COOL(R) coolants, then the service interval remains the same,
and the coolant does not need to be changed for another 5 yrs/150,000 miles (240,000 km)
Equipment (Coolant Exchangers)
The preferred method of performing coolant replacement is to use a coolant exchanger. A coolant
exchanger can replace virtually all of the old coolant with new coolant. Coolant exchangers can be
used to perform coolant replacement without spillage, and facilitate easy waste collection. They
can also be used to lower the coolant level in a vehicle to allow for less messy servicing of cooling
system components. It is recommended that you use a coolant exchanger with a vacuum feature
facilitates removing trapped air from the cooling system. This is a substantial time savings over
repeatedly thermo cycling the vehicle and topping-off the radiator. The vacuum feature also allows
venting of a hot system to relieve system pressure. Approved coolant exchangers are available
through the GMDE (General Motors Dealer Equipment) program.
For refilling a cooling system that has been partially or fully drained for repairs other than coolant
replacement, the Vac-N-Fill Coolant Refill Tool (GE-47716) is recommended to facilitate removal of
trapped air from the cooling system during refill.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information > Page 1925
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Coolant - Information on Back Service
File In Section: 6 - Engine
Bulletin No: 53-62-02
Date: November, 1995
Subject: DEX-COOL(TM) Engine Coolant - Information on Back service
Models: 1994-95 Passenger Cars and Trucks
A new extended-life engine coolant called DEX-COOL(TM) is currently being used in all General
Motors' vehicles (excluding Chevrolet Geo and Saturn). Refer to bulletin 53-62-01 for general
service information.
Backservice
DEX-COOL(TM) may be used in General Motors vehicles originally built with conventional (green)
coolant with the following considerations:
^ Vehicles eligible for back service are 1994 and 1995 models (excluding 1994 J Body with 4
cylinder engines).
^ The service interval for DEX-COOL(TM) introduced into an older model vehicle originally built
with "green" coolant will be 2 years/30,000 miles (50,000 Km) (not 5 years/100,000 miles (160,000
Km)).
^ All the "green" coolant must be removed from the cooling system by means of a system flush.
This may be accomplished with a water flushing device or a GMDE waterless coolant changer (use
a unit dedicated to "green" coolant, not DEX-COOL TM).
Important:
When using a GMDE waterless coolant changer, conduct the procedure twice, once with water,
and once with DEX-COOL(TM)
Backservice with DEX-COOL(TM) is advocated because of enhanced water pump seal durability
experienced with this coolant.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information > Page 1926
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Warranty - Recycled Engine Coolant Policy
Group Ref.: Warranty Administration Bulletin No.: 310504 Date: February, 1994
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
SUBJECT: RECYCLED ENGINE COOLANT POLICY
MODELS: 1994 AND PRIOR PASSENGER CARS AND TRUCKS
ATTENTION: WARRANTY CLAIMS ADMINISTRATOR AND SERVICE MANAGER
General Motors supports the use of recycled engine coolant for warranty repairs/service, providing
a GM approved engine coolant recycling system is used. For detailed information on GM approved
engine coolant recycling equipment guidelines refer to the following bulletins: Cadillac 93-1-18,
GMC Truck 93-6B-34, Chevrolet 93-73-6B, Pontiac 93-6-18, Oldsmobile 1-93-43, Buick 93-6B-1
(Corporate Number 236203).
Recycled coolant will be reimbursed at the GMSPO dealer price for new coolant plus the
appropriate mark-up. When coolant replacement is required during a warranty repair, it is crucial to
assure that only the relative amount of engine coolant concentrate be charged, not the total diluted
volume. In other words, if you are using two gallons of pre-diluted (50:50) recycled engine coolant
to service a vehicle, you may request reimbursement for one gallon of Goodwrench engine coolant
concentrate at the dealer price plus the appropriate warranty parts handling allowance.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System - Coolant Recycling Information > Page 1927
Coolant: Technical Service Bulletins Coolant - Information on Propylene Glycol Usage
File In Section: 6 - Engine
Bulletin No.: 43-62-01B
Date: April, 1995
Subject: Propylene Glycol Engine Coolant
Models: 1994 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
This bulletin is being revised to reflect most current information on propylene glycol engine coolant.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 4362O1A (Group Reference 6 - Engine).
General Motors has been reviewing data supplied on the performance of propylene glycol engine
coolant in GM vehicles. It is our conclusion that propylene glycol engine coolant will perform
adequately under most vehicle operating conditions. As a result, propylene glycol engine coolant
(meeting performance specification GM 1825M) may be used in GM vehicles and will not affect the
warranty coverage.
Prior to adding propylene glycol engine coolant to the cooling system, all the existing (ethylene
glycol) coolant must be removed. This can be accomplished either by utilizing water-based coolant
flushing equipment or "waterless quick change" equipment available in the GMDE program. As with
any coolant change procedure, be sure to thoroughly purge the heater core and block as well as
the radiator before attempting to convert the system to propylene glycol coolant.
Freeze/Boil point levels are different for propylene glycol than for ethylene glycol engine coolant.
To accurately determine freeze/boil protection level, it is imperative that coolants not be mixed.
Removing all the used coolant as previously discussed resolves this concern. Freeze protection of
propylene glycol cannot be determined using a standard hydrometer. Rather, a refractometer or
test strip must be used.
Propylene glycol engine coolants may be recycled in the same manner as conventional ethylene
glycol coolant. No adverse effects will be encountered if these coolants are mixed prior to recycling,
however, the ratio of propylene glycol coolant to ethylene glycol coolant should be kept low to
minimize the effects on freeze point measurements.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1928
Coolant: Specifications
Coolant Capacity, Qts. .........................................................................................................................
.............................................................................13.7 Radiator Cap Relief Pressure, Lbs. ................
..............................................................................................................................................................
........15 Thermo. Opening Temp. ° F ...................................................................................................
...........................................................................................195
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Level Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Coolant Level Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
This lamp will be illuminated when engine coolant level in the radiator drops below a predetermined
level. To turn lamp off, check cooling system, then add coolant to bring system to proper level.
OPERATION
Some vehicles use a buzzer or indicator lamp to convey a low coolant level condition. The buzzer
or lamp is activated by a sensor, located in the radiator, when the coolant level becomes one quart
low, or more.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Level Sensor > Component
Information > Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Coolant Reservoir > Component
Information > Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Locations
RH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1944
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1945
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1946
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1947
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1948
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1949
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1950
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1951
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1952
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1953
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1954
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1955
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1956
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1957
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1958
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1959
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1960
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1961
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1962
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1963
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1964
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1965
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1966
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1967
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1968
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1969
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1970
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1971
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1972
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1973
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1974
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1975
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1976
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Electrical Diagrams
Cooling System
Fig. 37 Cooling Fan Wiring Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1977
Coolant Fan
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1978
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The cooling fan is controlled by the PCM through the fan relay by inputs received from the engine
coolant temperature sensor, intake air temperature sensors, A/C control switch, A/C pressure
switch and the vehicle speed sensor. When the PCM grounds circuit 335 the cooling fan begins
operation. If engine coolant temperature is in excess of 228°F or when A/C is requested and the
A/C pressure is above 200 psi, then the cooling fan will run. When vehicle speed is above 70 MPH
the PCM opens the ground circuit to the fan and discontinues fan operation. If A/C head pressure
or coolant temperature becomes excessive or diagnostic trouble codes (DTC 14 or 15) are set, the
PCM will begin fan operation regardless of vehicle speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1979
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Remove air cleaner duct, then air cleaner assembly. 3. Mark
latch position for reassembly, then remove primary hood latch. 4. Drain engine coolant to a level
below radiator inlet hose, then disconnect radiator inlet hose at radiator and position aside. 5. On
models with automatic transmission, disconnect transaxle cooler lines and position aside. 6. On all
models, disconnect wiring harness connector at cooling fan, then remove fan assembly from
radiator support. 7. Reverse procedure to install.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Component Locations
LH Front Of Engine Compartment
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 1984
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 1985
Harness Connector Faces: Coolant Fan Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Radiator Cooling
Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 1986
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Description and Operation
PURPOSE:
The electric Cooling Fan is used for engine and A/C condenser cooling and is controlled by the
ECM/PCM
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION:
Battery voltage to operate the cooling fan motor is supplied to a relay by the ECM/PCM completing
a ground. When the ECM/PCM grounds CKT 335 the relay is energized and the cooling fan is
turned ON."
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fan Clutch: Description and Operation
Fig. 1 Typical Variable Speed Cooling Fan
Fig. 2 Variable Speed Fan W/Flat Bi-Metal Thermostatic Spring
Fig. 3 Variable-Speed Fan W/Coiled Bi-Metal Thermostatic Spring
The fan drive clutch, Fig. 1 , is a fluid coupling containing silicone oil. Fan speed is regulated by the
torque carrying capacity of the silicone oil. The more silicone oil in the coupling, the greater the fan
speed; the less silicone oil, the slower the fan speed.
Two types of fan drive clutches are in use. On one, Fig.2 , a bi-metallic strip and control piston on
the front of the fluid coupling regulates the amount of silicone oil entering the coupling. The
bi-metallic strip flexes outward with an increase in surrounding temperature and allows a piston to
move outward. The piston opens a valve regulating the flow of silicone oil into the coupling from a
reserve chamber. The silicone oil is returned to the reserve chamber through a bleed hole when
the valve is closed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1990
On the other type of fan drive clutch, Fig. 3 , a heat-sensitive, bi-metal spring connected to an
opening plate brings about a similar result. Both units cause the fan speed to increase with a rise in
temperature and to decrease as the temperature goes down.
In some cases a Flex-Fan is used instead of a Fan Drive Clutch. Flexible blades vary the volume of
air being drawn through the radiator, automatically increasing the pitch at low engine speeds.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1991
Fan Clutch: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 4 Bi-Metal Spring Disengagement
Do not operate the engine until the fan has been checked for possible cracks and separations.
Run the engine at a fast idle speed (1000 RPM) until normal operating temperature is reached.
This process can be expedited by blocking off the front of the radiator with a suitable piece of
cardboard. Regardless of temperature, the unit must be operated for at least five minutes before
being tested.
Stop the engine and, using a glove or a cloth, immediately check the effort required to turn the fan.
If considerable effort is required, it can be assumed that the coupling is operating satisfactorily. If
very little effort is required to turn the fan, it is an indication that the coupling is not operating
properly and should be replaced.
If the clutch fan is the coiled bi-metal spring type, it may be tested while the vehicle is being driven.
To check, disconnect the bi-metal spring, Fig. 4 , and rotate the spring 90° counterclockwise. This
disables the temperature controlled free wheeling feature and the clutch performs like a
conventional fan. If this cures the overheating condition, replace the fan clutch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator Cooling Fan > Fan Clutch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 1992
Fan Clutch: Service and Repair
Fig. 1 Typical Variable Speed Cooling Fan
To prevent silicone fluid from draining into fan drive bearing, do not store or place drive unit on
bench with rear of shaft pointing downward.
The removal procedure for either type of fan clutch assembly is similar for all vehicles. The unit
must be unfastened from the water pump, then it may be lifted from the vehicle.
The type of unit shown in Fig. 2 may be partially disassembled for inspection and cleaning as
follows:
1. Remove capscrews holding assembly together and separate fan from drive clutch. 2. Remove
metal strip on front of fan clutch by pushing one end toward fan clutch body to clear retaining
bracket. 3. Push strip aside until its opposite end springs out of place, then remove small control
piston. 4. Inspect piston for free movement in coupling device. If piston sticks, clean it with emery
cloth. If bi-metal strip is damaged, replace entire unit.
These strips are not interchangeable.
5. When reassembling, install control piston so that projection on end will contact metal strip, then
install metal strip. 6. After reassembly, clean clutch drive with a solvent soaked cloth. Avoid dipping
clutch assembly in any type of liquid. 7. Install assembly in vehicle.
The coil spring type of fan clutch cannot be disassembled, serviced or repaired. If it does not
function properly, it must be replaced with a new unit.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Resistance 177 ohms at 212 deg F
241 ohms at 194 deg F
332 ohms at 176 deg F
467 ohms at 158 deg F
667 ohms at 140 deg F
973 ohms at 122 deg F
1188 ohms at 113 deg F
1459 ohms at 104 deg F
1802 ohms at 95 deg F
2238 ohms at 86 deg F
2796 ohms at 77 deg F
3520 ohms at 68 deg F
4450 ohms at 59 deg F
5670 ohms at 50 deg F
7280 ohms at 41 deg F
9420 ohms at 32 deg F
12300 ohms at 23 deg F
16180 ohms at 14 deg F
21450 ohms at 5 deg F
28680 ohms at -4 deg F
52700 ohms at -22 deg F
100700 ohms at -40 deg F
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications > Page
1997
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations
Rear Of Engine Compartment
LH rear of engine, on Coolant Outlet
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2000
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2001
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2002
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2003
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2004
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2005
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2006
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2007
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2008
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2009
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2010
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2011
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2012
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2013
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2014
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2015
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2016
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2017
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2018
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2019
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2020
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2021
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2022
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2023
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2024
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2025
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2026
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2027
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2028
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2029
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2030
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2031
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2032
Coolant Temperature Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2033
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
PURPOSE
The Engine Coolant Temperature sensor (ECT) is used to control:
^ Fuel delivery
^ Torque Converter Clutch (TCC)
^ Engine Spark Timing (EST)
^ Controlled Canister Purge (CCP)
^ Idle Air Control (IAC)
^ Cooling Fan
OPERATION:
The ECT is a thermistor that is located in the engine coolant flow. When the coolant temperature is
low, the sensor produces a high resistance. When the coolant temperature is high, the sensor
produces a low resistance.
The ECM sends a 5.0 volt signal to the ECT through a resistor in the computer and measures the
voltage. The voltage will be high or low depending on coolant temperature. With the ECT varying
its resistance, the ECM can sense engine coolant temperature by reading the varying voltage.
LOCATION:
Engine thermostat and coolant outlet.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest
for Temperature Sensor (Gauge): > 478101 > Apr > 94 > Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Temperature Sensor (Gauge): Customer Interest Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Group Ref.: Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 478101
Date: April, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: TEMPERATURE GAUGE FLUCTUATION
MODELS: 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND BERETTA 1993-94 BUICK
CENTURY 1993-94 OLDSMOBILE CUTLASS CIERA WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK S TRUCKS
WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
Some vehicles described above may exhibit a condition where temperature gauge readings
fluctuate in the normal range. These gauge fluctuations may be as much as 1/4 of the scale,
however, the indicator should never enter the red high temperature warning area of the gauge
under normal operating conditions.
Coolant temperature sensor location combined with the thermostat cycling characteristics
contribute to this sensitivity. The condition is considered a normal characteristic of this engine and
should not be cause for instrument panel cluster, gauge, indicator sender, or engine coolant
thermostat replacement or alteration.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical
Service Bulletins for Temperature Sensor (Gauge): > 478101 > Apr > 94 > Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Temperature Sensor (Gauge): All Technical Service Bulletins Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Group Ref.: Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 478101
Date: April, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: TEMPERATURE GAUGE FLUCTUATION
MODELS: 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND BERETTA 1993-94 BUICK
CENTURY 1993-94 OLDSMOBILE CUTLASS CIERA WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK S TRUCKS
WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
Some vehicles described above may exhibit a condition where temperature gauge readings
fluctuate in the normal range. These gauge fluctuations may be as much as 1/4 of the scale,
however, the indicator should never enter the red high temperature warning area of the gauge
under normal operating conditions.
Coolant temperature sensor location combined with the thermostat cycling characteristics
contribute to this sensitivity. The condition is considered a normal characteristic of this engine and
should not be cause for instrument panel cluster, gauge, indicator sender, or engine coolant
thermostat replacement or alteration.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2047
Temperature Sensor (Gauge): Locations
Rear Of Engine Compartment
LH rear of engine, on Coolant Outlet
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Engine - Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch > Temperature Switch (Warning Indicator) > Component Information > Description and Operation
Temperature Switch (Warning Indicator): Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
If the red light is not lit when the engine is being cranked, check for a burned out bulb, an open in
the light circuit, or a defective ignition switch.
If the red light is lit when the engine is running, check the wiring between light and switch for a
ground, temperature switch defective, or overheated cooling system. As a test circuit to check
whether the red bulb is functioning properly, a wire which is connected to the ground terminal of the
ignition switch is tapped into its circuit. When the ignition is in the start engine cranking position, the
ground terminal is grounded inside the switch and the red bulb will be lit. When the engine is
started and the ignition switch is in the on position, the test circuit is opened and the bulb is then
controlled by the temperature switch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators
Heater Core: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-06-02-001A
Date: July 16, 2008
Subject: Information On Aluminum Heater Core and/or Radiator Replacement
Models: 2005 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2005
HUMMER H2
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to update the Warranty Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 05-06-02-001 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
Important:
2004-05 Chevrolet Aveo (Pontiac Wave, Canada Only) does not use DEX-COOL(R). Refer to the
flushing procedure explained later in this bulletin.
The following information should be utilized when servicing aluminum heater core and/or radiators
on repeat visits. A replacement may be necessary because erosion, corrosion, or insufficient
inhibitor levels may cause damage to the heater core, radiator or water pump. A coolant check
should be performed whenever a heater core, radiator, or water pump is replaced. The following
procedures/ inspections should be done to verify proper coolant effectiveness.
Caution:
To avoid being burned, do not remove the radiator cap or surge tank cap while the engine is hot.
The cooling system will release scalding fluid and steam under pressure if the radiator cap or surge
tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot.
Important:
If the vehicle's coolant is low, drained out, or the customer has repeatedly added coolant or water
to the system, then the system should be completely flushed using the procedure explained later in
this bulletin.
Technician Diagnosis
^ Verify coolant concentration. A 50% coolant/water solution ensures proper freeze and corrosion
protection. Inhibitor levels cannot be easily measured in the field, but can be indirectly done by the
measurement of coolant concentration. This must be done by using a Refractometer J 23688
(Fahrenheit scale) or J 26568 (centigrade scale), or equivalent, coolant tester. The Refractometer
uses a minimal amount of coolant that can be taken from the coolant recovery reservoir, radiator or
the engine block. Inexpensive gravity float testers (floating balls) will not completely analyze the
coolant concentration fully and should not be used. The concentration levels should be between
50% and 65% coolant concentrate. This mixture will have a freeze point protection of -34 degrees
Fahrenheit (-37 degrees Celsius). If the concentration is below 50%, the cooling system must be
flushed.
^ Inspect the coolant flow restrictor if the vehicle is equipped with one. Refer to Service Information
(SI) and/or the appropriate Service Manual for component location and condition for operation.
^ Verify that no electrolysis is present in the cooling system. This electrolysis test can be performed
before or after the system has been repaired. Use a digital voltmeter set to 12 volts. Attach one test
lead to the negative battery post and insert the other test lead into the radiator coolant, making sure
the lead does not touch the filler neck or core. Any voltage reading over 0.3 volts indicates that
stray current is finding its way into the coolant. Electrolysis is often an intermittent condition that
occurs when a device or accessory that is mounted to the radiator is energized. This type of current
could be caused from a poorly grounded cooling fan or some other accessory and can be verified
by watching the volt meter and turning on and off various accessories or engage the starter motor.
Before using one of the following flush procedures, the coolant recovery reservoir must be
removed, drained, cleaned and reinstalled before refilling the system.
Notice:
^ Using coolant other than DEX‐COOL(R) may cause premature engine, heater core or
radiator corrosion. In addition, the engine coolant may require changing sooner, at 30,000 miles
(50,000 km) or 24 months, whichever occurs first. Any repairs would not be covered by your
warranty. Always use DEX‐COOL(R) (silicate free) coolant in your vehicle.
^ If you use an improper coolant mixture, your engine could overheat and be badly damaged. The
repair cost would not be covered by your warranty. Too much water in the mixture can freeze and
crack the engine, radiator, heater core and other parts.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators > Page 2055
Flushing Procedures using DEX-COOL(R)
Important:
The following procedure recommends refilling the system with DEX-COOL(R), P/N 12346290 (in
Canada, use P/N 10953464), GM specification 6277M. This coolant is orange in color and has a
service interval of 5 years or 240,000 km (150,000 mi). However, when used on vehicles built prior
to the introduction of DEX-COOL(R), maintenance intervals will remain the same as specified in the
Owner's Manual.
^ If available, use the approved cooling system flush and fill machine (available through the GM
Dealer Equipment Program) following the manufacturer's operating instructions.
^ If approved cooling system flush and fill machine is not available, drain the coolant and dispose of
properly following the draining procedures in the appropriate Service Manual. Refill the system
using clear, drinkable water and run the vehicle until the thermostat opens. Repeat and run the
vehicle three (3) times to totally remove the old coolant or until the drained coolant is almost clear.
Once the system is completely flushed, refill the cooling system to a 50%-60% concentration with
DEX‐COOL(R), P/N 12346290 (in Canada, use P/N 10953464), GM specification 6277M,
following the refill procedures in the appropriate Service Manual.
If a Service Manual is not available, fill half the capacity of the system with 100% DEX-COOL(R),
P/N 12346290 (in Canada, use P/N 10953464), GM specification 6277M. Then slowly add clear,
drinkable water (preferably distilled) to the system until the level of the coolant mixture has reached
the base of the radiator neck. Wait two (2) minutes and reverify the coolant level. If necessary, add
clean water to restore the coolant to the appropriate level.
Once the system is refilled, reverify the coolant concentration using a Refractometer J 23688
(Fahrenheit scale) or J 26568 (centigrade scale) coolant tester, or equivalent. The concentration
levels should be between 50% and 65%.
Flushing Procedures using Conventional Silicated (Green Colored) Coolant
Important:
2004-2005 Chevrolet Aveo (Pontiac Wave, Canada Only) does not use DEX‐COOL(R).
The Aveo and Wave are filled with conventional, silicated engine coolant that is blue in color.
Silicated coolants are typically green in color and are required to be drained, flushed and refilled
every 30,000 miles (48,000 km). The Aveo and Wave are to be serviced with conventional, silicated
coolant. Use P/N 12378560 (1 gal) (in Canada, use P/N 88862159 (1 L). Refer to the Owner's
Manual or Service Information (SI) for further information on OEM coolant.
Important:
Do not mix the OEM orange colored DEX-COOL(R) coolant with green colored coolant when
adding coolant to the system or when servicing the vehicle's cooling system. Mixing the orange and
green colored coolants will produce a brown coolant which may be a customer dissatisfier and will
not extend the service interval to that of DEX-COOL(R). Conventional silicated coolants offered by
GM Service and Parts Operations are green in color.
^ If available, use the approved cooling system flush and fill machine (available through the GM
Dealer Equipment Program) following the manufacturer's operating instructions.
^ If approved cooling systems flush and fill machine is not available, drain coolant and dispose of
properly following the draining procedures in appropriate Service Manual. Refill the system using
clear, drinkable water and run vehicle until thermostat opens. Repeat and run vehicle three (3)
times to totally remove old coolant or until drained coolant is almost clear. Once the system is
completely flushed, refill the cooling system to a 50%-60% concentration with a good quality
ethylene glycol base engine coolant, P/N 12378560, 1 gal (in Canada, use P/N 88862159 1 L),
conforming to GM specification 1825M, or recycled coolant conforming to GM specification 1825M,
following the refill procedures in the appropriate Service Manual.
If a Service Manual is not available, fill half the capacity of the system with 100% good quality
ethylene glycol base (green colored) engine coolant, P/N 12378560 1 gal., (in Canada, use P/N
88862159 1 L) conforming to GM specification 1825M. Then slowly add clear, drinkable water
(preferably distilled) to system until the level of the coolant mixture has reached the base of the
radiator neck. Wait two (2) minutes and recheck coolant level. If necessary, add clean water to
restore coolant to the appropriate level.
Once the system is refilled, recheck the coolant concentration using a Refractometer J 23688
(Fahrenheit scale) or J 26568 (centigrade scale) coolant tester, or equivalent. Concentration levels
should be between 50% and 65%.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators > Page 2056
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > With Air Conditioning
Heater Core: Service and Repair With Air Conditioning
Heater/Evaporator Module
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Negative battery cable and drain cooling system. 2. Raise vehicle and remove drain tube from
heater-A/C module. 3. Heater hoses from heater core and lower vehicle. 4. Right and left sound
insulators and steering column opening filler. 5. Floor air outlet duct and heater core cover.
CAUTION: To avoid breaking the drain tube, carefully pull the heater core cover straight rearward
when removing.
6. Heater core mounting clamps and remove heater core.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Heater core and heater core mounting clamps. 2. Heater core cover and floor air outlet duct.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > With Air Conditioning > Page 2059
3. Right and left sound insulators and steering column opening filler. 4. Raise vehicle and connect
heater hoses to heater core. 5. Drain tube to heater case and lower vehicle. 6. Negative battery
cable and fill cooling system. 7. Check for leaks.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > With Air Conditioning > Page 2060
Heater Core: Service and Repair Without Air Conditioning
Heater Module
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Negative battery cable and drain cooling system. 2. Raise vehicle and remove drain tube from
heater case. 3. Heater hoses from heater core and lower vehicle. 4. Right and left sound insulators
and steering column opening filler. 5. Floor air outlet duct and heater core cover. 6. Heater core
mounting clamps and remove heater core.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Heater core and heater core mounting clamps.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Heater Core > Component Information >
Service and Repair > With Air Conditioning > Page 2061
2. Heater core cover and floor air outlet duct. 3. Right and left sound insulators and steering column
opening filler. 4. Raise vehicle and connect heater hoses to heater core. 5. Drain tube to heater
case and lower vehicle. 6. Negative battery cable and fill cooling system. 7. Check for leaks.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Coolant Level Indicator Lamp > Component Information > Description and Operation
Coolant Level Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
This lamp will be illuminated when engine coolant level in the radiator drops below a predetermined
level. To turn lamp off, check cooling system, then add coolant to bring system to proper level.
OPERATION
Some vehicles use a buzzer or indicator lamp to convey a low coolant level condition. The buzzer
or lamp is activated by a sensor, located in the radiator, when the coolant level becomes one quart
low, or more.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Temperature Gauge: >
478101 > Apr > 94 > Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Temperature Gauge: Customer Interest Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Group Ref.: Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 478101
Date: April, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: TEMPERATURE GAUGE FLUCTUATION
MODELS: 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND BERETTA 1993-94 BUICK
CENTURY 1993-94 OLDSMOBILE CUTLASS CIERA WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK S TRUCKS
WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
Some vehicles described above may exhibit a condition where temperature gauge readings
fluctuate in the normal range. These gauge fluctuations may be as much as 1/4 of the scale,
however, the indicator should never enter the red high temperature warning area of the gauge
under normal operating conditions.
Coolant temperature sensor location combined with the thermostat cycling characteristics
contribute to this sensitivity. The condition is considered a normal characteristic of this engine and
should not be cause for instrument panel cluster, gauge, indicator sender, or engine coolant
thermostat replacement or alteration.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Temperature Gauge: > 478101 > Apr > 94 > Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Temperature Gauge: All Technical Service Bulletins Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Group Ref.: Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 478101
Date: April, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: TEMPERATURE GAUGE FLUCTUATION
MODELS: 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND BERETTA 1993-94 BUICK
CENTURY 1993-94 OLDSMOBILE CUTLASS CIERA WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK S TRUCKS
WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
Some vehicles described above may exhibit a condition where temperature gauge readings
fluctuate in the normal range. These gauge fluctuations may be as much as 1/4 of the scale,
however, the indicator should never enter the red high temperature warning area of the gauge
under normal operating conditions.
Coolant temperature sensor location combined with the thermostat cycling characteristics
contribute to this sensitivity. The condition is considered a normal characteristic of this engine and
should not be cause for instrument panel cluster, gauge, indicator sender, or engine coolant
thermostat replacement or alteration.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Gauge > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2079
Temperature Gauge: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
This temperature indicating system consists of a sending unit, located on the cylinder head,
electrical temperature gauge and an instrument voltage regulator.
OPERATION
As engine temperature increases or decreases, the resistance of the sending unit changes, in turn
controlling current flow through the gauge. When engine temperature is low sending unit resistance
is high, current flow through the gauge is restricted, and the gauge pointer remains against the stop
or moves very little. As engine temperature increases sending unit resistance decreases and
current flow through the gauge increases, resulting in increased pointer movement.
Troubleshooting for the electrical temperature indicating system is the same as for the electrical oil
pressure indicating system.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator, Engine Cooling > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest for Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator: > 478101 > Apr > 94 > Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator: Customer Interest Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Group Ref.: Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 478101
Date: April, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: TEMPERATURE GAUGE FLUCTUATION
MODELS: 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND BERETTA 1993-94 BUICK
CENTURY 1993-94 OLDSMOBILE CUTLASS CIERA WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK S TRUCKS
WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
Some vehicles described above may exhibit a condition where temperature gauge readings
fluctuate in the normal range. These gauge fluctuations may be as much as 1/4 of the scale,
however, the indicator should never enter the red high temperature warning area of the gauge
under normal operating conditions.
Coolant temperature sensor location combined with the thermostat cycling characteristics
contribute to this sensitivity. The condition is considered a normal characteristic of this engine and
should not be cause for instrument panel cluster, gauge, indicator sender, or engine coolant
thermostat replacement or alteration.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator, Engine Cooling > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins for Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator: > 478101 > Apr > 94 > Temperature Gauge Fluctuation
Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator: All Technical Service Bulletins Temperature Gauge Fluctuation
Group Ref.: Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 478101
Date: April, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: TEMPERATURE GAUGE FLUCTUATION
MODELS: 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND BERETTA 1993-94 BUICK
CENTURY 1993-94 OLDSMOBILE CUTLASS CIERA WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK S TRUCKS
WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
Some vehicles described above may exhibit a condition where temperature gauge readings
fluctuate in the normal range. These gauge fluctuations may be as much as 1/4 of the scale,
however, the indicator should never enter the red high temperature warning area of the gauge
under normal operating conditions.
Coolant temperature sensor location combined with the thermostat cycling characteristics
contribute to this sensitivity. The condition is considered a normal characteristic of this engine and
should not be cause for instrument panel cluster, gauge, indicator sender, or engine coolant
thermostat replacement or alteration.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Lamps and Indicators - Cooling System >
Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator, Engine Cooling > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2093
Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
If the red light is not lit when the engine is being cranked, check for a burned out bulb, an open in
the light circuit, or a defective ignition switch.
If the red light is lit when the engine is running, check the wiring between light and switch for a
ground, temperature switch defective, or overheated cooling system. As a test circuit to check
whether the red bulb is functioning properly, a wire which is connected to the ground terminal of the
ignition switch is tapped into its circuit. When the ignition is in the start engine cranking position, the
ground terminal is grounded inside the switch and the red bulb will be lit. When the engine is
started and the ignition switch is in the on position, the test circuit is opened and the bulb is then
controlled by the temperature switch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators
Radiator: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-06-02-001A
Date: July 16, 2008
Subject: Information On Aluminum Heater Core and/or Radiator Replacement
Models: 2005 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2005
HUMMER H2
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to update the Warranty Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 05-06-02-001 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
Important:
2004-05 Chevrolet Aveo (Pontiac Wave, Canada Only) does not use DEX-COOL(R). Refer to the
flushing procedure explained later in this bulletin.
The following information should be utilized when servicing aluminum heater core and/or radiators
on repeat visits. A replacement may be necessary because erosion, corrosion, or insufficient
inhibitor levels may cause damage to the heater core, radiator or water pump. A coolant check
should be performed whenever a heater core, radiator, or water pump is replaced. The following
procedures/ inspections should be done to verify proper coolant effectiveness.
Caution:
To avoid being burned, do not remove the radiator cap or surge tank cap while the engine is hot.
The cooling system will release scalding fluid and steam under pressure if the radiator cap or surge
tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot.
Important:
If the vehicle's coolant is low, drained out, or the customer has repeatedly added coolant or water
to the system, then the system should be completely flushed using the procedure explained later in
this bulletin.
Technician Diagnosis
^ Verify coolant concentration. A 50% coolant/water solution ensures proper freeze and corrosion
protection. Inhibitor levels cannot be easily measured in the field, but can be indirectly done by the
measurement of coolant concentration. This must be done by using a Refractometer J 23688
(Fahrenheit scale) or J 26568 (centigrade scale), or equivalent, coolant tester. The Refractometer
uses a minimal amount of coolant that can be taken from the coolant recovery reservoir, radiator or
the engine block. Inexpensive gravity float testers (floating balls) will not completely analyze the
coolant concentration fully and should not be used. The concentration levels should be between
50% and 65% coolant concentrate. This mixture will have a freeze point protection of -34 degrees
Fahrenheit (-37 degrees Celsius). If the concentration is below 50%, the cooling system must be
flushed.
^ Inspect the coolant flow restrictor if the vehicle is equipped with one. Refer to Service Information
(SI) and/or the appropriate Service Manual for component location and condition for operation.
^ Verify that no electrolysis is present in the cooling system. This electrolysis test can be performed
before or after the system has been repaired. Use a digital voltmeter set to 12 volts. Attach one test
lead to the negative battery post and insert the other test lead into the radiator coolant, making sure
the lead does not touch the filler neck or core. Any voltage reading over 0.3 volts indicates that
stray current is finding its way into the coolant. Electrolysis is often an intermittent condition that
occurs when a device or accessory that is mounted to the radiator is energized. This type of current
could be caused from a poorly grounded cooling fan or some other accessory and can be verified
by watching the volt meter and turning on and off various accessories or engage the starter motor.
Before using one of the following flush procedures, the coolant recovery reservoir must be
removed, drained, cleaned and reinstalled before refilling the system.
Notice:
^ Using coolant other than DEX‐COOL(R) may cause premature engine, heater core or
radiator corrosion. In addition, the engine coolant may require changing sooner, at 30,000 miles
(50,000 km) or 24 months, whichever occurs first. Any repairs would not be covered by your
warranty. Always use DEX‐COOL(R) (silicate free) coolant in your vehicle.
^ If you use an improper coolant mixture, your engine could overheat and be badly damaged. The
repair cost would not be covered by your warranty. Too much water in the mixture can freeze and
crack the engine, radiator, heater core and other parts.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators > Page 2098
Flushing Procedures using DEX-COOL(R)
Important:
The following procedure recommends refilling the system with DEX-COOL(R), P/N 12346290 (in
Canada, use P/N 10953464), GM specification 6277M. This coolant is orange in color and has a
service interval of 5 years or 240,000 km (150,000 mi). However, when used on vehicles built prior
to the introduction of DEX-COOL(R), maintenance intervals will remain the same as specified in the
Owner's Manual.
^ If available, use the approved cooling system flush and fill machine (available through the GM
Dealer Equipment Program) following the manufacturer's operating instructions.
^ If approved cooling system flush and fill machine is not available, drain the coolant and dispose of
properly following the draining procedures in the appropriate Service Manual. Refill the system
using clear, drinkable water and run the vehicle until the thermostat opens. Repeat and run the
vehicle three (3) times to totally remove the old coolant or until the drained coolant is almost clear.
Once the system is completely flushed, refill the cooling system to a 50%-60% concentration with
DEX‐COOL(R), P/N 12346290 (in Canada, use P/N 10953464), GM specification 6277M,
following the refill procedures in the appropriate Service Manual.
If a Service Manual is not available, fill half the capacity of the system with 100% DEX-COOL(R),
P/N 12346290 (in Canada, use P/N 10953464), GM specification 6277M. Then slowly add clear,
drinkable water (preferably distilled) to the system until the level of the coolant mixture has reached
the base of the radiator neck. Wait two (2) minutes and reverify the coolant level. If necessary, add
clean water to restore the coolant to the appropriate level.
Once the system is refilled, reverify the coolant concentration using a Refractometer J 23688
(Fahrenheit scale) or J 26568 (centigrade scale) coolant tester, or equivalent. The concentration
levels should be between 50% and 65%.
Flushing Procedures using Conventional Silicated (Green Colored) Coolant
Important:
2004-2005 Chevrolet Aveo (Pontiac Wave, Canada Only) does not use DEX‐COOL(R).
The Aveo and Wave are filled with conventional, silicated engine coolant that is blue in color.
Silicated coolants are typically green in color and are required to be drained, flushed and refilled
every 30,000 miles (48,000 km). The Aveo and Wave are to be serviced with conventional, silicated
coolant. Use P/N 12378560 (1 gal) (in Canada, use P/N 88862159 (1 L). Refer to the Owner's
Manual or Service Information (SI) for further information on OEM coolant.
Important:
Do not mix the OEM orange colored DEX-COOL(R) coolant with green colored coolant when
adding coolant to the system or when servicing the vehicle's cooling system. Mixing the orange and
green colored coolants will produce a brown coolant which may be a customer dissatisfier and will
not extend the service interval to that of DEX-COOL(R). Conventional silicated coolants offered by
GM Service and Parts Operations are green in color.
^ If available, use the approved cooling system flush and fill machine (available through the GM
Dealer Equipment Program) following the manufacturer's operating instructions.
^ If approved cooling systems flush and fill machine is not available, drain coolant and dispose of
properly following the draining procedures in appropriate Service Manual. Refill the system using
clear, drinkable water and run vehicle until thermostat opens. Repeat and run vehicle three (3)
times to totally remove old coolant or until drained coolant is almost clear. Once the system is
completely flushed, refill the cooling system to a 50%-60% concentration with a good quality
ethylene glycol base engine coolant, P/N 12378560, 1 gal (in Canada, use P/N 88862159 1 L),
conforming to GM specification 1825M, or recycled coolant conforming to GM specification 1825M,
following the refill procedures in the appropriate Service Manual.
If a Service Manual is not available, fill half the capacity of the system with 100% good quality
ethylene glycol base (green colored) engine coolant, P/N 12378560 1 gal., (in Canada, use P/N
88862159 1 L) conforming to GM specification 1825M. Then slowly add clear, drinkable water
(preferably distilled) to system until the level of the coolant mixture has reached the base of the
radiator neck. Wait two (2) minutes and recheck coolant level. If necessary, add clean water to
restore coolant to the appropriate level.
Once the system is refilled, recheck the coolant concentration using a Refractometer J 23688
(Fahrenheit scale) or J 26568 (centigrade scale) coolant tester, or equivalent. Concentration levels
should be between 50% and 65%.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators > Page 2099
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators > Page 2100
Radiator: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling - Radiator Repair/Replacement Guidelines
File In Section: 06 - Engine/Propulsion System
Bulletin No.: 99-06-02-017
Date: October, 1999
INFORMATION
Subject: Radiator Repair/Replacement Guidelines
Models: 2000 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
If repair of an aluminum/plastic radiator is required, it is recommended that the following guidelines
be followed:
For Vehicles Under Warranty
For aluminum/plastic radiators that have damage to the face of the core including bent fins,
punctures, cuts, leaking tubes or header tubes, the aluminum radiator core section should be
replaced with a new one. In these cases, if both of the plastic tanks are not damaged, they can be
reused with the new core. If one or both of the plastic tanks are damaged along with the core, it is
recommended that a complete new radiator assembly be installed.
Warranty repairs for leaks at the tank to header (gasket leaks), broken/cracked plastic tanks, cross
threaded or leaking oil coolers should be repaired without replacing the complete radiator. This
type of repair should be handled by the radiator repair facility in your area.
Many of these radiator repair facilities are members of the National Automotive Radiator Service
Association (NARSA) who follow industry and General Motors guidelines when repairing radiators.
These facilities have the special tools, tanks and pressurizing equipment needed to properly test
the repaired radiator prior to returning it to the dealership. Many of these facilities receive the repair
components directly from General Motors.
The sublet expense for a new radiator or the repair of the radiator under warranty should be
handled following normal procedures.
For Vehicles No Longer Under Warranty
The GM released epoxy repair kit referenced in previous publications is no longer available.
Repairs to the radiator, rather than replacement, is strictly at the owner's discretion.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2101
Radiator: Specifications
Coolant Capacity, Qts. .........................................................................................................................
.............................................................................13.7 Radiator Cap Relief Pressure, Lbs. ................
..............................................................................................................................................................
........15 Thermo. Opening Temp. ° F ...................................................................................................
...........................................................................................195
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Radiator > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2102
Radiator: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable, then discharge and recover air conditioning refrigerant. 2.
Drain and recover engine coolant. 3. Remove hood latch from mounting plate, then both headlight
assemblies. 4. Remove radiator mounts, then raise and support vehicle. 5. Disconnect forward SIR
sensor harness, then remove cooling fan assembly. 6. Disconnect radiator hoses, then
transmission oil cooler lines from radiator. 7. Lower vehicle, then remove hood latch support and
forward sensor with wiring harness. 8. Disconnect compressor and accumulator hoses from
condenser, discarding O-rings. 9. Disconnect coolant overflow line, then remove radiator.
10. Reverse procedure to install, installing new air conditioning O-rings.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Component Locations
LH Front Of Engine Compartment
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2108
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 2109
Harness Connector Faces: Coolant Fan Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Relays and Modules - Cooling System >
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 2110
Radiator Cooling Fan Motor Relay: Description and Operation
PURPOSE:
The electric Cooling Fan is used for engine and A/C condenser cooling and is controlled by the
ECM/PCM
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION:
Battery voltage to operate the cooling fan motor is supplied to a relay by the ECM/PCM completing
a ground. When the ECM/PCM grounds CKT 335 the relay is energized and the cooling fan is
turned ON."
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Coolant Level Sensor > Component Information > Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Resistance 177 ohms at 212 deg F
241 ohms at 194 deg F
332 ohms at 176 deg F
467 ohms at 158 deg F
667 ohms at 140 deg F
973 ohms at 122 deg F
1188 ohms at 113 deg F
1459 ohms at 104 deg F
1802 ohms at 95 deg F
2238 ohms at 86 deg F
2796 ohms at 77 deg F
3520 ohms at 68 deg F
4450 ohms at 59 deg F
5670 ohms at 50 deg F
7280 ohms at 41 deg F
9420 ohms at 32 deg F
12300 ohms at 23 deg F
16180 ohms at 14 deg F
21450 ohms at 5 deg F
28680 ohms at -4 deg F
52700 ohms at -22 deg F
100700 ohms at -40 deg F
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2119
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations
Rear Of Engine Compartment
LH rear of engine, on Coolant Outlet
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2122
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2123
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2124
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2125
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2126
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2127
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2128
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2129
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2130
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2131
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2132
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2133
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2134
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2135
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2136
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2137
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2138
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2139
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2140
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2141
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2142
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2143
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2144
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2145
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2146
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2147
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2148
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2149
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2150
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2151
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2152
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2153
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2154
Coolant Temperature Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 2155
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
PURPOSE
The Engine Coolant Temperature sensor (ECT) is used to control:
^ Fuel delivery
^ Torque Converter Clutch (TCC)
^ Engine Spark Timing (EST)
^ Controlled Canister Purge (CCP)
^ Idle Air Control (IAC)
^ Cooling Fan
OPERATION:
The ECT is a thermistor that is located in the engine coolant flow. When the coolant temperature is
low, the sensor produces a high resistance. When the coolant temperature is high, the sensor
produces a low resistance.
The ECM sends a 5.0 volt signal to the ECT through a resistor in the computer and measures the
voltage. The voltage will be high or low depending on coolant temperature. With the ECT varying
its resistance, the ECM can sense engine coolant temperature by reading the varying voltage.
LOCATION:
Engine thermostat and coolant outlet.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Temperature Sensor (Gauge): > 478101 > Apr > 94 > Temperature Gauge Fluctuation
Temperature Sensor (Gauge): Customer Interest Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Group Ref.: Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 478101
Date: April, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: TEMPERATURE GAUGE FLUCTUATION
MODELS: 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND BERETTA 1993-94 BUICK
CENTURY 1993-94 OLDSMOBILE CUTLASS CIERA WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK S TRUCKS
WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
Some vehicles described above may exhibit a condition where temperature gauge readings
fluctuate in the normal range. These gauge fluctuations may be as much as 1/4 of the scale,
however, the indicator should never enter the red high temperature warning area of the gauge
under normal operating conditions.
Coolant temperature sensor location combined with the thermostat cycling characteristics
contribute to this sensitivity. The condition is considered a normal characteristic of this engine and
should not be cause for instrument panel cluster, gauge, indicator sender, or engine coolant
thermostat replacement or alteration.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Temperature Sensor (Gauge): > 478101 > Apr > 94 > Temperature
Gauge - Fluctuation
Temperature Sensor (Gauge): All Technical Service Bulletins Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Group Ref.: Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 478101
Date: April, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: TEMPERATURE GAUGE FLUCTUATION
MODELS: 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND BERETTA 1993-94 BUICK
CENTURY 1993-94 OLDSMOBILE CUTLASS CIERA WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK S TRUCKS
WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
Some vehicles described above may exhibit a condition where temperature gauge readings
fluctuate in the normal range. These gauge fluctuations may be as much as 1/4 of the scale,
however, the indicator should never enter the red high temperature warning area of the gauge
under normal operating conditions.
Coolant temperature sensor location combined with the thermostat cycling characteristics
contribute to this sensitivity. The condition is considered a normal characteristic of this engine and
should not be cause for instrument panel cluster, gauge, indicator sender, or engine coolant
thermostat replacement or alteration.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 2169
Temperature Sensor (Gauge): Locations
Rear Of Engine Compartment
LH rear of engine, on Coolant Outlet
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System
> Engine - Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch > Temperature Switch (Warning Indicator) > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Temperature Switch (Warning Indicator): Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
If the red light is not lit when the engine is being cranked, check for a burned out bulb, an open in
the light circuit, or a defective ignition switch.
If the red light is lit when the engine is running, check the wiring between light and switch for a
ground, temperature switch defective, or overheated cooling system. As a test circuit to check
whether the red bulb is functioning properly, a wire which is connected to the ground terminal of the
ignition switch is tapped into its circuit. When the ignition is in the start engine cranking position, the
ground terminal is grounded inside the switch and the red bulb will be lit. When the engine is
started and the ignition switch is in the on position, the test circuit is opened and the bulb is then
controlled by the temperature switch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Temperature Gauge: > 478101 > Apr > 94 > Temperature
Gauge - Fluctuation
Temperature Gauge: Customer Interest Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Group Ref.: Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 478101
Date: April, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: TEMPERATURE GAUGE FLUCTUATION
MODELS: 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND BERETTA 1993-94 BUICK
CENTURY 1993-94 OLDSMOBILE CUTLASS CIERA WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK S TRUCKS
WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
Some vehicles described above may exhibit a condition where temperature gauge readings
fluctuate in the normal range. These gauge fluctuations may be as much as 1/4 of the scale,
however, the indicator should never enter the red high temperature warning area of the gauge
under normal operating conditions.
Coolant temperature sensor location combined with the thermostat cycling characteristics
contribute to this sensitivity. The condition is considered a normal characteristic of this engine and
should not be cause for instrument panel cluster, gauge, indicator sender, or engine coolant
thermostat replacement or alteration.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Temperature Gauge: > 478101 > Apr > 94 >
Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Temperature Gauge: All Technical Service Bulletins Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Group Ref.: Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 478101
Date: April, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: TEMPERATURE GAUGE FLUCTUATION
MODELS: 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND BERETTA 1993-94 BUICK
CENTURY 1993-94 OLDSMOBILE CUTLASS CIERA WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK S TRUCKS
WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
Some vehicles described above may exhibit a condition where temperature gauge readings
fluctuate in the normal range. These gauge fluctuations may be as much as 1/4 of the scale,
however, the indicator should never enter the red high temperature warning area of the gauge
under normal operating conditions.
Coolant temperature sensor location combined with the thermostat cycling characteristics
contribute to this sensitivity. The condition is considered a normal characteristic of this engine and
should not be cause for instrument panel cluster, gauge, indicator sender, or engine coolant
thermostat replacement or alteration.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2186
Temperature Gauge: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
This temperature indicating system consists of a sending unit, located on the cylinder head,
electrical temperature gauge and an instrument voltage regulator.
OPERATION
As engine temperature increases or decreases, the resistance of the sending unit changes, in turn
controlling current flow through the gauge. When engine temperature is low sending unit resistance
is high, current flow through the gauge is restricted, and the gauge pointer remains against the stop
or moves very little. As engine temperature increases sending unit resistance decreases and
current flow through the gauge increases, resulting in increased pointer movement.
Troubleshooting for the electrical temperature indicating system is the same as for the electrical oil
pressure indicating system.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator,
Engine Cooling > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Temperature Warning
Lamp/Indicator: > 478101 > Apr > 94 > Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator: Customer Interest Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Group Ref.: Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 478101
Date: April, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: TEMPERATURE GAUGE FLUCTUATION
MODELS: 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND BERETTA 1993-94 BUICK
CENTURY 1993-94 OLDSMOBILE CUTLASS CIERA WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK S TRUCKS
WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
Some vehicles described above may exhibit a condition where temperature gauge readings
fluctuate in the normal range. These gauge fluctuations may be as much as 1/4 of the scale,
however, the indicator should never enter the red high temperature warning area of the gauge
under normal operating conditions.
Coolant temperature sensor location combined with the thermostat cycling characteristics
contribute to this sensitivity. The condition is considered a normal characteristic of this engine and
should not be cause for instrument panel cluster, gauge, indicator sender, or engine coolant
thermostat replacement or alteration.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator,
Engine Cooling > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Temperature
Warning Lamp/Indicator: > 478101 > Apr > 94 > Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator: All Technical Service Bulletins Temperature Gauge Fluctuation
Group Ref.: Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 478101
Date: April, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: TEMPERATURE GAUGE FLUCTUATION
MODELS: 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND BERETTA 1993-94 BUICK
CENTURY 1993-94 OLDSMOBILE CUTLASS CIERA WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK S TRUCKS
WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
Some vehicles described above may exhibit a condition where temperature gauge readings
fluctuate in the normal range. These gauge fluctuations may be as much as 1/4 of the scale,
however, the indicator should never enter the red high temperature warning area of the gauge
under normal operating conditions.
Coolant temperature sensor location combined with the thermostat cycling characteristics
contribute to this sensitivity. The condition is considered a normal characteristic of this engine and
should not be cause for instrument panel cluster, gauge, indicator sender, or engine coolant
thermostat replacement or alteration.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator,
Engine Cooling > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2200
Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
If the red light is not lit when the engine is being cranked, check for a burned out bulb, an open in
the light circuit, or a defective ignition switch.
If the red light is lit when the engine is running, check the wiring between light and switch for a
ground, temperature switch defective, or overheated cooling system. As a test circuit to check
whether the red bulb is functioning properly, a wire which is connected to the ground terminal of the
ignition switch is tapped into its circuit. When the ignition is in the start engine cranking position, the
ground terminal is grounded inside the switch and the red bulb will be lit. When the engine is
started and the ignition switch is in the on position, the test circuit is opened and the bulb is then
controlled by the temperature switch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling >
Component Information > Specifications
Thermostat: Specifications
Coolant Capacity, Qts. .........................................................................................................................
.............................................................................13.7 Radiator Cap Relief Pressure, Lbs. ................
..............................................................................................................................................................
........15 Thermo. Opening Temp. ° F ...................................................................................................
...........................................................................................195
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2204
Thermostat: Testing and Inspection
Fig. 1 Thermostat.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Thermostat, Engine Cooling >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 2205
Thermostat: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect negative battery cable.
2. Drain coolant and remove air cleaner assembly.
3. Remove coolant outlet to inlet manifold attaching bolt and nut, coolant outlet and thermostat.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Cooling System > Water Pump > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Water Pump: Service and Repair
Fig. 15 Water Pump Mounting
1. Disconnect battery ground cable, then drain cooling system.
2. Disconnect serpentine belt at the water pump pulley.
3. Remove water pump pulley, then the water pump, Fig. 15.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Locations
Catalytic Converter: Locations
Exhaust System
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2213
Converter Attachment (w/Flange And Clamp)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2214
Catalytic Converter: Description and Operation
Converter Types
CAUTION: Prolonged operation with a misfiring or flooded engine may cause the converter to
overheat. This could cause damage either to the catalyst itself or the operating vehicle and
possible personal injury.
NOTE: When jacking or lifting vehicle from frame side rails, be certain lift pads DO NOT contact
catalytic converter otherwise damage to converter may result.
PURPOSE:
The Catalytic Converter (CAT) is an emission control device added to the exhaust system to
effectively reduce the levels of carbon monoxide, hydrocarbons, and in some cases oxides of
nitrogen, exiting the tailpipe.
OPERATION:
The CAT allows for a faster chemical reaction to take place and although it enters into the chemical
reaction, it remains unchanged, ready to repeat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2215
the process. This device sometimes requires the use of heat shields, due to its high operating
temperatures. The heat shields are necessary to protect chassis components, passenger
compartment, and other areas from heat related damage.
CONSTRUCTION:
General Motors uses four different converter designs in conjunction with two types of catalysts. The
four converter designs are:
1. Single bed monolith
2. Dual bed monolith
3. Single bed pellet
4. Dual bed pellet
The two types of catalysts used are an Oxidation catalyst and a Three-Way (Oxidation/Reduction)
catalyst. The Oxidation catalyst is coated with a material containing platinum and palladium which
lowers levels of carbon monoxide and hydrocarbons. The Three-Way (Oxidation/Reduction)
catalyst is coated with platinum and rhodium which lowers levels of oxides of nitrogen (NOx), as
well as carbon monoxide and hydrocarbons. All dual bed converters, whether monolith or pellet
type, contain both oxidation and three-way catalysts.
A small diameter fuel tank filler neck is used on catalytic converter equipped vehicles to prevent the
use of leaded fuel pump nozzles. Since the use of leaded fuels, or fuel additives containing lead,
contaminates the catalysts, rendering the catalyst ineffective, the use of unleaded fuels is
mandatory on catalytic converter equipped vehicles.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2216
Catalytic Converter: Testing and Inspection
RESTRICTED EXHAUST TEST
Proper diagnosis for a restricted exhaust system is essential before any components are replaced.
The following procedure(s) may be used for diagnosis:
Exhaust System Test at Oxygen Sensor
CHECK AT 02 SENSOR:
1. Carefully remove O2 sensor.
2. Install Exhaust Backpressure Tester in place of 02 sensor.
3. After completing the diagnosis described below, be sure to coat threads of 02 sensor with
anti-seize compound prior to re-installation.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. With the engine idling at normal operating temperature, transaxle in park or neutral, observe the
exhaust system backpressure reading on the gauge. The reading should not exceed .5 psi or 3.4
kPa. Increase engine speed to 3000 rpm and observe gauge. The reading should not exceed .75
psi or 5 kPa.
2. If the backpressure exceeds the given specifications, a restricted exhaust system is indicated.
3. Inspect the entire exhaust system for a collapsed pipe, heat distress, or possible internal muffler
failure.
4. If there are no obvious reasons for the excessive backpressure, a restricted catalytic converter
should be suspected, and replaced.
THERMAL TEST
Use a pyrometer to measure the temperature difference between the inlet and outlet. A warm and
properly working catalytic converter will show about 100 degrees hotter at the outlet. NOTE: A fuel
system that is running rich will not produce a catalyst and will indicate little or no temperature
variation.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component
Information > Specifications
Exhaust Manifold: Specifications
Component ..........................................................................................................................................
....................................................... Torque/Ft. Lbs.
Camshaft Rear Cover ..........................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 6-9 Camshaft Sprocket .........................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...... 21 Connecting Rod Nut ................................................................................................................
........................................................................................... 39 Crankshaft Balancer ...........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................. 76 Cylinder Head ..............................................................................................................
.................................................................................................... [03]
Distributor hold-down ...........................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 20-31 Drive Belt Tensioner Bolt ..................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. 35 Engine Mount Bracket To Body Lower Bolt .................................................................................
.................................................................................... 74 Exhaust Crossover To Right Manifold .......
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......... 18 Exhaust Manifold .................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................. 18 Front Cover ......................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
................. [01]
Front Engine Mount Bracket Body Upper Bolt .....................................................................................
............................................................................ 74 Front Engine Mount To Bracket Bolt .................
..............................................................................................................................................................
. 50 Front Engine Mount To Bracket Bolt (Bottom) ..............................................................................
................................................................................... 61 Front Engine Mount To Frame Bolt (Top) ...
..............................................................................................................................................................
........ 54 Heat Shield ............................................................................................................................
............................................................................................... 7 Intake Manifold .................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.............. 13-25 Main Bearing Cap .......................................................................................................
.................................................................................................. 63-83 Negative Battery Cable ..........
..............................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 11 Oil Level Indicator Nut .....................................................................................
................................................................................................................. 18 Oil Pan ..........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................... [02]
Oil Pump Drive ....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 25 Oil Pump To Rear Bearing Cap .......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.... 30 Rear Engine Bracket To Body Bolt ............................................................................................
........................................................................................ 45 Rear Engine Mount To Engine Bolt .......
..............................................................................................................................................................
.............. 40 Rocker Arm Covers .........................................................................................................
..................................................................................................... 7 Rocker Arm Nuts ........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
......................... 18 Spark Plugs ..........................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................. 18 Thermostat Housing ........
..............................................................................................................................................................
................................ 15-23 Timing Chain Dampener ..........................................................................
.......................................................................................................................... 15 Torsional
Dampener ............................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 67-85 Water Pump Pulley To Pump Bolts .................................
.................................................................................................................................................. 15
Water Pump To Block ..........................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 18 Water Pump To Front Cover Bolts ..................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...... 7
[01] -- 8 mm bolts, 20 ft. lbs.; 10 mm bolts, 28 ft. lbs. [02] -- 6 mm bolts, 71 inch lbs.; 8 mm bolts, 18
ft. lbs. [03] -- Refer to Cylinder Head Assembly, Replace for tightening sequence & specification.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Manifold > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2220
Exhaust Manifold: Service and Repair
LEFT SIDE
1. Disconnect battery ground cable and remove air cleaner and inlet hose.
2. Drain cooling system, then remove coolant bypass pipe.
3. Disconnect crossover pipe at manifold, then remove manifold attaching bolts and the manifold.
4. Reverse procedure to install.
RIGHT SIDE
1. Disconnect battery ground cable and remove air cleaner.
2. Raise and support vehicle, then remove heat shield.
3. Remove exhaust pipe at crossover, then lower the vehicle.
4. Disconnect oxygen sensor electrical connector.
5. Remove exhaust manifold attaching bolts, then remove manifold.
6. Reverse procedure to install, torque attaching nuts, bolts and screws to specifications.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe > Component Information
> Specifications
Exhaust Pipe: Specifications
Component ..........................................................................................................................................
......................................................... Torque/Ft. Lbs.
Camshaft Rear Cover ..........................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 6-9 Camshaft Sprocket .........................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...... 21 Connecting Rod Nut ................................................................................................................
........................................................................................... 39 Crankshaft Balancer ...........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................. 76 Cylinder Head ..............................................................................................................
.................................................................................................... [03]
Distributor hold-down ...........................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 20-31 Drive Belt Tensioner Bolt ..................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. 35 Engine Mount Bracket To Body Lower Bolt .................................................................................
.................................................................................... 74 Exhaust Crossover To Right Manifold .......
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......... 18 Exhaust Manifold .................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................. 18 Front Cover ......................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
................. [01]
Front Engine Mount Bracket Body Upper Bolt .....................................................................................
............................................................................ 74 Front Engine Mount To Bracket Bolt .................
..............................................................................................................................................................
. 50 Front Engine Mount To Bracket Bolt (Bottom) ..............................................................................
................................................................................... 61 Front Engine Mount To Frame Bolt (Top) ...
..............................................................................................................................................................
........ 54 Heat Shield ............................................................................................................................
............................................................................................... 7 Intake Manifold .................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.............. 13-25 Main Bearing Cap .......................................................................................................
.................................................................................................. 63-83 Negative Battery Cable ..........
..............................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 11 Oil Level Indicator Nut .....................................................................................
................................................................................................................. 18 Oil Pan ..........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................... [02]
Oil Pump Drive ....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 25 Oil Pump To Rear Bearing Cap .......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.... 30 Rear Engine Bracket To Body Bolt ............................................................................................
........................................................................................ 45 Rear Engine Mount To Engine Bolt .......
..............................................................................................................................................................
.............. 40 Rocker Arm Covers .........................................................................................................
..................................................................................................... 7 Rocker Arm Nuts ........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
......................... 18 Spark Plugs ..........................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................. 18 Thermostat Housing ........
..............................................................................................................................................................
................................ 15-23 Timing Chain Dampener ..........................................................................
.......................................................................................................................... 15 Torsional
Dampener ............................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 67-85 Water Pump Pulley To Pump Bolts .................................
.................................................................................................................................................. 15
Water Pump To Block ..........................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 18 Water Pump To Front Cover Bolts ..................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...... 7
[01] -- 8 mm bolts, 20 ft. lbs.; 10 mm bolts, 28 ft. lbs. [02] -- 6 mm bolts, 71 inch lbs.; 8 mm bolts, 18
ft. lbs. [03] -- Refer to Cylinder Head Assembly, Replace for tightening sequence & specification.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Exhaust Pipe/Muffler Hanger >
Component Information > Specifications
Exhaust Pipe/Muffler Hanger: Specifications
Component ..........................................................................................................................................
......................................................... Torque/Ft. Lbs.
Camshaft Rear Cover ..........................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 6-9 Camshaft Sprocket .........................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...... 21 Connecting Rod Nut ................................................................................................................
........................................................................................... 39 Crankshaft Balancer ...........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................. 76 Cylinder Head ..............................................................................................................
.................................................................................................... [03]
Distributor hold-down ...........................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 20-31 Drive Belt Tensioner Bolt ..................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. 35 Engine Mount Bracket To Body Lower Bolt .................................................................................
.................................................................................... 74 Exhaust Crossover To Right Manifold .......
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......... 18 Exhaust Manifold .................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................. 18 Front Cover ......................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
................. [01]
Front Engine Mount Bracket Body Upper Bolt .....................................................................................
............................................................................ 74 Front Engine Mount To Bracket Bolt .................
..............................................................................................................................................................
. 50 Front Engine Mount To Bracket Bolt (Bottom) ..............................................................................
................................................................................... 61 Front Engine Mount To Frame Bolt (Top) ...
..............................................................................................................................................................
........ 54 Heat Shield ............................................................................................................................
............................................................................................... 7 Intake Manifold .................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.............. 13-25 Main Bearing Cap .......................................................................................................
.................................................................................................. 63-83 Negative Battery Cable ..........
..............................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 11 Oil Level Indicator Nut .....................................................................................
................................................................................................................. 18 Oil Pan ..........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................... [02]
Oil Pump Drive ....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 25 Oil Pump To Rear Bearing Cap .......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.... 30 Rear Engine Bracket To Body Bolt ............................................................................................
........................................................................................ 45 Rear Engine Mount To Engine Bolt .......
..............................................................................................................................................................
.............. 40 Rocker Arm Covers .........................................................................................................
..................................................................................................... 7 Rocker Arm Nuts ........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
......................... 18 Spark Plugs ..........................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................. 18 Thermostat Housing ........
..............................................................................................................................................................
................................ 15-23 Timing Chain Dampener ..........................................................................
.......................................................................................................................... 15 Torsional
Dampener ............................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 67-85 Water Pump Pulley To Pump Bolts .................................
.................................................................................................................................................. 15
Water Pump To Block ..........................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 18 Water Pump To Front Cover Bolts ..................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...... 7
[01] -- 8 mm bolts, 20 ft. lbs.; 10 mm bolts, 28 ft. lbs. [02] -- 6 mm bolts, 71 inch lbs.; 8 mm bolts, 18
ft. lbs. [03] -- Refer to Cylinder Head Assembly, Replace for tightening sequence & specification.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Heat Shield, Exhaust > Component
Information > Specifications
Heat Shield: Specifications
Component ..........................................................................................................................................
......................................................... Torque/Ft. Lbs.
Camshaft Rear Cover ..........................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 6-9 Camshaft Sprocket .........................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...... 21 Connecting Rod Nut ................................................................................................................
........................................................................................... 39 Crankshaft Balancer ...........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.................. 76 Cylinder Head ..............................................................................................................
.................................................................................................... [03]
Distributor hold-down ...........................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 20-31 Drive Belt Tensioner Bolt ..................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. 35 Engine Mount Bracket To Body Lower Bolt .................................................................................
.................................................................................... 74 Exhaust Crossover To Right Manifold .......
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......... 18 Exhaust Manifold .................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................. 18 Front Cover ......................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
................. [01]
Front Engine Mount Bracket Body Upper Bolt .....................................................................................
............................................................................ 74 Front Engine Mount To Bracket Bolt .................
..............................................................................................................................................................
. 50 Front Engine Mount To Bracket Bolt (Bottom) ..............................................................................
................................................................................... 61 Front Engine Mount To Frame Bolt (Top) ...
..............................................................................................................................................................
........ 54 Heat Shield ............................................................................................................................
............................................................................................... 7 Intake Manifold .................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.............. 13-25 Main Bearing Cap .......................................................................................................
.................................................................................................. 63-83 Negative Battery Cable ..........
..............................................................................................................................................................
.............................. 11 Oil Level Indicator Nut .....................................................................................
................................................................................................................. 18 Oil Pan ..........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
..................................... [02]
Oil Pump Drive ....................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 25 Oil Pump To Rear Bearing Cap .......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.... 30 Rear Engine Bracket To Body Bolt ............................................................................................
........................................................................................ 45 Rear Engine Mount To Engine Bolt .......
..............................................................................................................................................................
.............. 40 Rocker Arm Covers .........................................................................................................
..................................................................................................... 7 Rocker Arm Nuts ........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
......................... 18 Spark Plugs ..........................................................................................................
.............................................................................................................. 18 Thermostat Housing ........
..............................................................................................................................................................
................................ 15-23 Timing Chain Dampener ..........................................................................
.......................................................................................................................... 15 Torsional
Dampener ............................................................................................................................................
......................................................... 67-85 Water Pump Pulley To Pump Bolts .................................
.................................................................................................................................................. 15
Water Pump To Block ..........................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 18 Water Pump To Front Cover Bolts ..................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...... 7
[01] -- 8 mm bolts, 20 ft. lbs.; 10 mm bolts, 28 ft. lbs. [02] -- 6 mm bolts, 71 inch lbs.; 8 mm bolts, 18
ft. lbs. [03] -- Refer to Cylinder Head Assembly, Replace for tightening sequence & specification.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Muffler: > 33-17-01A > Dec > 97 > Exhaust System - Paint Peeling from
Painted Muffler
Muffler: Customer Interest Exhaust System - Paint Peeling from Painted Muffler
File In Section: 10 - Body
Bulletin No.: 33-17-01A
Date: December, 1997
Subject: Paint Peeling from Muffler (New Repair Paint Available)
Models: 1993-98 Passenger Cars with Painted Mufflers
This bulletin is being revised to add additional model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 33-17-01 (Section 10 - Body).
Condition
Some owners may experience paint peeling from the muffler.
Correction
Clean and repaint the affected area using the following procedure and product.
Important:
DO NOT REPLACE COMPONENTS TO REPAIR THIS CONDITION.
The exhaust system must be cold to begin this procedure.
Material Required: * Wabash Products # KB-318-HHHS, available in pints or quarts as ready to
spray material (no mixing required). Call Wabash Products, 1-800-326-7269 or 812-232-6097 for
pricing and shipping information.
Procedure
On a cold exhaust system:
1. Raise vehicle on hoist.
2. While supporting exhaust with a transmission jack, remove the rear exhaust system hangers and
lower the exhaust.
3. Clean the affected area with a wax and grease remover, lacquer thinner or other suitable
solvent.
4. Wire brush the affected area to remove flaking paint and blow off with air.
5. Sand the affected area with # 80 to 150 grit sandpaper to remove rust, dirt or other
contaminants.
6. Clean the affected area with a wax and grease remover, lacquer thinner or other suitable
solvent.
7. Tape off the rear lower body panels and exhaust pipes forward of mufflers to protect from
overspray.
8. Apply paint to affected area in several (6 to 8) thin coats (to prevent sags and runs) obtaining
approximately 1 mil paint coverage.
9. Raise exhaust system with jack, reinstall exhaust hangers, lower vehicle and remove from hoist.
^ Allow 30 minutes drying time.
10. In a well ventilated area, start engine and allow to idle for up to 30 minutes until paint is cured
and dry.
Important:
Some "smoking" will occur while curing the paint with the engine running.
The paint can be heated and cured while driving, but be careful not to get the exhaust system wet
during the first 30 minutes.
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Muffler: > 33-17-01A > Dec > 97 > Exhaust System - Paint Peeling from
Painted Muffler > Page 2238
Labor Material
Operation Labor Time Allowance
A6150 0.6 hr - Single Exhaust GC
Add 0.2 hr - Dual Exhaust GC
Important:
While the above procedure and materials are correct for vehicles from 1993 to 1998, the Labor
Operation and Time Allowance only pertains to vehicles in the Warranty period.
* We believe this source and their equipment to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such equipment. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products or equipment from these firms or for any such items which may be
available from other sources.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Muffler: > 33-17-01A > Dec > 97 > Exhaust System - Paint
Peeling from Painted Muffler
Muffler: All Technical Service Bulletins Exhaust System - Paint Peeling from Painted Muffler
File In Section: 10 - Body
Bulletin No.: 33-17-01A
Date: December, 1997
Subject: Paint Peeling from Muffler (New Repair Paint Available)
Models: 1993-98 Passenger Cars with Painted Mufflers
This bulletin is being revised to add additional model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 33-17-01 (Section 10 - Body).
Condition
Some owners may experience paint peeling from the muffler.
Correction
Clean and repaint the affected area using the following procedure and product.
Important:
DO NOT REPLACE COMPONENTS TO REPAIR THIS CONDITION.
The exhaust system must be cold to begin this procedure.
Material Required: * Wabash Products # KB-318-HHHS, available in pints or quarts as ready to
spray material (no mixing required). Call Wabash Products, 1-800-326-7269 or 812-232-6097 for
pricing and shipping information.
Procedure
On a cold exhaust system:
1. Raise vehicle on hoist.
2. While supporting exhaust with a transmission jack, remove the rear exhaust system hangers and
lower the exhaust.
3. Clean the affected area with a wax and grease remover, lacquer thinner or other suitable
solvent.
4. Wire brush the affected area to remove flaking paint and blow off with air.
5. Sand the affected area with # 80 to 150 grit sandpaper to remove rust, dirt or other
contaminants.
6. Clean the affected area with a wax and grease remover, lacquer thinner or other suitable
solvent.
7. Tape off the rear lower body panels and exhaust pipes forward of mufflers to protect from
overspray.
8. Apply paint to affected area in several (6 to 8) thin coats (to prevent sags and runs) obtaining
approximately 1 mil paint coverage.
9. Raise exhaust system with jack, reinstall exhaust hangers, lower vehicle and remove from hoist.
^ Allow 30 minutes drying time.
10. In a well ventilated area, start engine and allow to idle for up to 30 minutes until paint is cured
and dry.
Important:
Some "smoking" will occur while curing the paint with the engine running.
The paint can be heated and cured while driving, but be careful not to get the exhaust system wet
during the first 30 minutes.
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Engine, Cooling and Exhaust > Exhaust System > Muffler > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Muffler: > 33-17-01A > Dec > 97 > Exhaust System - Paint
Peeling from Painted Muffler > Page 2244
Labor Material
Operation Labor Time Allowance
A6150 0.6 hr - Single Exhaust GC
Add 0.2 hr - Dual Exhaust GC
Important:
While the above procedure and materials are correct for vehicles from 1993 to 1998, the Labor
Operation and Time Allowance only pertains to vehicles in the Warranty period.
* We believe this source and their equipment to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such equipment. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products or equipment from these firms or for any such items which may be
available from other sources.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory
Usage
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-06-04-054B
Date: November 18, 2010
Subject: Info - Non-GM Parts and Accessories (Aftermarket)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and update to the new U.S. Fixed
Operation Manager (FOM) and Canada Warranty Manager (WM) names. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 04-06-04-054A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
The recent rise and expansion of companies selling non-GM parts and accessories has made it
necessary to issue this reminder to dealers regarding GM's policy on the use and installation of
these aftermarket components.
When a dealer is performing a repair under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty, they are required to
use only genuine GM or GM-approved parts and accessories. This applies to all warranty repairs,
special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM. Parts and accessories advertised as being "the
same" as parts manufactured by GM, but not sold through GM, do not qualify for use in warranty
repairs, special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM.
During a warranty repair, if a GM original equipment part is not available through GM Customer
Care and Aftersales (GM CC&A;), ACDelco(R) distributors, other GM dealers or approved sources,
the dealer is to obtain comparable, non-GM parts and clearly indicate, in detail, on the repair order
the circumstances surrounding why non-GM parts were used. The dealer must give customers
written notice, prior to the sale or service, that such parts or accessories are not marketed or
warranted by General Motors.
It should also be noted that dealers modifying new vehicles and installing equipment, parts and
accessories obtained from sources not authorized by GM are responsible for complying with the
National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. Certain non-approved parts or assemblies, installed
by the dealer or its agent not authorized by GM, may result in a change to the vehicle's design
characteristics and may affect the vehicle's ability to conform to federal law. Dealers must fully
understand that non-GM approved parts may not have been validated, tested or certified for use.
This puts the dealer at risk for potential liability in the event of a part or vehicle failure. If a GM part
failure occurs as the result of the installation or use of a non-GM approved part, the warranty will
not be honored.
A good example of non-authorized modification of vehicles is the result of an ever increasing
supply of aftermarket devices available to the customer, which claim to increase the horsepower
and torque of the Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines. These include the addition of, but are not limited to
one or more of the following modifications:
- Propane injection
- Nitrous oxide injection
- Additional modules (black boxes) that connect to the vehicle wiring systems
- Revised engine calibrations downloaded for the engine control module
- Calibration modules which connect to the vehicle diagnostic connector
- Modification to the engine turbocharger waste gate
Although the installation of these devices, or modification of vehicle components, can increase
engine horsepower and torque, they may also negatively affect the engine emissions, reliability
and/or durability. In addition, other powertrain components, such as transmissions, universal joints,
drive shafts, and front/rear axle components, can be stressed beyond design safety limits by the
installation of these devices.
General Motors does not support or endorse the use of devices or modifications that, when
installed, increase the engine horsepower and torque. It is because of these unknown stresses,
and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a
policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining
warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a
non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is
subsequently removed. Refer to the latest version of Bulletin 09-06-04-026 (V8 Gas Engines) or
06-06-01-007 (Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines) for more information on dealer requirements for
calibration verification.
These same policies apply as they relate to the use of non-GM accessories. Damage or failure
from the use or installation of a non-GM accessory will not be covered under warranty. Failure
resulting from the alteration or modification of the vehicle, including the cutting, welding or
disconnecting of the vehicle's original equipment parts and components will void the warranty.
Additionally, dealers will NOT be reimbursed or compensated by GM in the event of any legal
inquiry at either the local, state or federal level that
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 2252
results from the alteration or modification of a vehicle using non-GM approved parts or accessories.
Dealers should be especially cautious of accessory companies that claim the installation of their
product will not void the factory warranty. Many times these companies have even given direction
on how to quickly disassemble the accessory in an attempt to preclude the manufacturer from
finding out that is has been installed.
Any suspect repairs should be reviewed by the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), and in Canada
by the Warranty Manager (WM) for appropriate repair direction. If it is decided that a goodwill repair
is to be made on the vehicle, even with the installation of such non-GM approved components, the
customer is to be made aware of General Motors position on this issue and is to sign the
appropriate goodwill documentation required by General Motors.
It is imperative for dealers to understand that by installing such devices, they are jeopardizing not
only the warranty coverage, but also the performance and reliability of the customer's vehicle.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Specifications > PCM
Connector C1 (Black)
Engine Control Module: Specifications PCM Connector C1 (Black)
ECM Connector: C1
ECM Connector: C1 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Specifications > PCM
Connector C1 (Black) > Page 2255
Engine Control Module: Specifications PCM Connector C2 (Black)
ECM Connector: C2
ECM Connector: C2 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Specifications > PCM
Connector C1 (Black) > Page 2256
Engine Control Module: Specifications PCM Connector C3 (Green)
ECM Connector: C3
ECM Connector: C3 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations
Behind RH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 2259
Behind RH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 (Black)
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C1 (Black)
ECM Connector: C1
ECM Connector: C1 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 (Black) >
Page 2262
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C2 (Black)
ECM Connector: C2
ECM Connector: C2 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 (Black) >
Page 2263
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C3 (Green)
ECM Connector: C3
ECM Connector: C3 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2264
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation
Computer Module
PURPOSE:
The Electronic Control Module or Powertrain Control Module (ECM/PCM) is the control center of
the fuel injection system. It constantly looks at the information from various sensors (inputs) and
controls the systems (outputs) that affect vehicle performance. The ECM/PCM also performs the
diagnostic function of the system. It can recognize operational problems, alert the driver through
the "SERVICE ENGINE SOON" or "MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP" light, and store a code or
codes which identify the problem areas to aid the technician in performing repairs.
OPERATION:
The computer is designed to process the various input information, and send the necessary
electrical response to control fuel delivery, spark control, and other emission control systems. The
computer can control these devices through the use of Quad Driver Modules (QDM). When the
ECM/PCM is commanding a device or a component "ON," the voltage potential of the output is
"LOW" or near zero volts. When the ECM/PCM is commanding a device or component "OFF," the
voltage potential of the circuit will be "HIGH," or near 12 volts. The primary function of the QDM is
to supply the ground for the component being controlled.
The input information has an interrelation between sensor output. If one of the input devices failed,
such as the oxygen sensor, this could affect more than one of the systems controlled by the
computer.
The computer has a learning ability which allows it to make corrections for minor variations in the
fuel system to improve driveability. If the battery is disconnected to clear trouble codes or for repair,
the learning process has to begin all over again, and a change may be noticed in the driving
performance of the vehicle. To reset the vehicles learning ability, make sure the engine is at
operating temperature and operate the vehicle at part throttle, moderate acceleration, and idle
conditions, until normal performance returns.
This vehicle is equipped with an ECM/PCM with two parts for service, a controller which is the
ECM/PCM itself and a memory calibration unit called a MEM-CAL, PROM, or EPROM.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Pinout Values and Diagnostic Parameters
Engine Control Module: Pinout Values and Diagnostic Parameters
ECM Connector: C1
ECM Connector: C1 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Pinout Values and Diagnostic Parameters > Page 2267
ECM Connector: C2
ECM Connector: C2 (Description)
ECM Connector: C3
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Pinout Values and Diagnostic Parameters > Page 2268
ECM Connector: C3 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Page 2269
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair
ECM
Remove or Disconnect:
1. Negative battery cable.
2. Interior access panel.
3. Connectors from ECM/PCM.
3. ECM/PCM.
NOTICE: To prevent possible electrostatic discharge damage to the ECM/PCM, Do Not touch the
connector pins or soldered components on the
circuit board.
Install or Connect:
1. New ECM/PCM.
2. ECM connectors to ECM/PCM.
3. Negative battery cable.
4. interior access panel.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations
Fuel Pump Relay: Component Locations
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Right hand rear of the engine compartment, behind the right hand strut tower.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 2275
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 2276
Harness Connector Faces: Fuel Pump Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 2277
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation
Relay Center
PURPOSE:
To relay power to the fuel pump.
OPERATION:
When the ignition key is first turned to the "ON" position, the ECM/PCM will energize the fuel pump
relay for two seconds. This increases fuel pressure for cranking. If the engine is not running within
two seconds, the ECM/PCM will shut "OFF" the relay and wait until the engine starts. As soon as
the engine is cranked, the ECM/PCM will energize the relay and power the fuel pump.
NOTE: The fuel pump relay may be bypassed by the oil pressure switch activating the fuel pump.
LOCATION:
Relay Center.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 2278
Fuel Pump Relay: Service and Repair
The fuel pump relay is mounted in the engine compartment.
Fuel Pump Relay
NOTE: Other than checking for loose connections the only service on the fuel pump relay is
replacement.
PROCEDURE
1. Verify that the ignition switch is in the "OFF" position. 2. Disconnect the wiring harness plug. 3.
Remove the fuel pump relay. 4. Install the new fuel pump relay. 5. Connect the wiring harness plug
securely.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Manual
RH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Manual > Page 2284
RH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 2285
Harness Connector Faces: Electronic Ignition (EI) System
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and
Modules - Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 2286
Ignition Control Module: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative battery cable.
2. Ignition Coils.
3. Module from assembly plate.
INSTALLATION
1. Module to assembly plate.
2. Ignition Coils.
3. Negative battery cable.
IDLE LEARN PROCEDURE: Any time the battery is disconnected, the programmed position of the
IAC valve pintle is lost, and replaced with a default value. To return the IAC valve pintle to the
correct position, perform the following procedure:
1. After restoring battery power, connect the Tech 1 "SCAN" tool.
2. Select "IAC SYSTEM," then select "IDLE LEARN" in the "MISC TEST" mode.
3. Proceed with idle learn as directed. ^
This procedure allows the ECM memory to be updated with the correct IAC valve pintle position, for
the vehicle, and provide a stable idle speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Resistance 177 ohms at 212 deg F
241 ohms at 194 deg F
332 ohms at 176 deg F
467 ohms at 158 deg F
667 ohms at 140 deg F
973 ohms at 122 deg F
1188 ohms at 113 deg F
1459 ohms at 104 deg F
1802 ohms at 95 deg F
2238 ohms at 86 deg F
2796 ohms at 77 deg F
3520 ohms at 68 deg F
4450 ohms at 59 deg F
5670 ohms at 50 deg F
7280 ohms at 41 deg F
9420 ohms at 32 deg F
12300 ohms at 23 deg F
16180 ohms at 14 deg F
21450 ohms at 5 deg F
28680 ohms at -4 deg F
52700 ohms at -22 deg F
100700 ohms at -40 deg F
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 2292
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations
Rear Of Engine Compartment
LH rear of engine, on Coolant Outlet
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2295
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2296
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2297
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2298
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2299
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2300
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2301
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2302
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2303
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2304
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2305
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2306
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2307
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2308
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2309
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2310
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2311
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2312
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2313
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2314
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2315
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2316
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2317
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2318
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2319
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2320
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2321
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2322
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2323
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2324
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2325
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2326
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2327
Coolant Temperature Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 2328
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
PURPOSE
The Engine Coolant Temperature sensor (ECT) is used to control:
^ Fuel delivery
^ Torque Converter Clutch (TCC)
^ Engine Spark Timing (EST)
^ Controlled Canister Purge (CCP)
^ Idle Air Control (IAC)
^ Cooling Fan
OPERATION:
The ECT is a thermistor that is located in the engine coolant flow. When the coolant temperature is
low, the sensor produces a high resistance. When the coolant temperature is high, the sensor
produces a low resistance.
The ECM sends a 5.0 volt signal to the ECT through a resistor in the computer and measures the
voltage. The voltage will be high or low depending on coolant temperature. With the ECT varying
its resistance, the ECM can sense engine coolant temperature by reading the varying voltage.
LOCATION:
Engine thermostat and coolant outlet.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Crankshaft Position Sensor
RH rear of engine, on exhaust manifold
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2332
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Typical DIS Crankshaft Sensor
PURPOSE:
The crankshaft sensor provides a signal through the Direct Ignition (DI), which the ECM uses as
reference to calculate rpm and crankshaft position.
OPERATION:
This sensor protrudes into the block, within approximately .050" of the engine crankshaft reluctor.
The reluctor is a special wheel cast into the crankshaft with seven slots cast into it, six of which are
evenly spaced 60° apart. A seventh slot is spaced 10° from one of the other slots and serves to
generate a "sync pulse." As the reluctor rotates as part of the crankshaft, the slots change the
magnetic field of the sensor, creating an induced voltage pulse.
Based on the crank sensor pulses, the ignition module sends reference signals to the ECM which
are used to indicate crankshaft position and engine speed.
LOCATION:
This sensor is mounted remotely from the ignition module, right hand side of engine, at the end of
the crank shaft.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
2333
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Remove or Disconnect
1. Sensor harness connector. 2. Sensor to block bolt. 3. Sensor from engine.
Inspect ^
Sensor O-ring for wear, cracks or leakage. Replace if necessary. Lube new O-ring with engine oil
before installing.
Install or Connect
1. Sensor into hole in block. 2. Sensor to block bolt.
^ Torque to 8 N.m (71 lb. in.).
3. Sensor harness connector.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Resistance 177 ohms at 212 deg F
241 ohms at 194 deg F
332 ohms at 176 deg F
467 ohms at 158 deg F
667 ohms at 140 deg F
973 ohms at 122 deg F
1188 ohms at 113 deg F
1459 ohms at 104 deg F
1802 ohms at 95 deg F
2238 ohms at 86 deg F
2796 ohms at 77 deg F
3520 ohms at 68 deg F
4450 ohms at 59 deg F
5670 ohms at 50 deg F
7280 ohms at 41 deg F
9420 ohms at 32 deg F
12300 ohms at 23 deg F
16180 ohms at 14 deg F
21450 ohms at 5 deg F
28680 ohms at -4 deg F
52700 ohms at -22 deg F
100700 ohms at -40 deg F
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications > Page 2338
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Mechanical Specifications Torque Valve
Torque Valve
Induction Air Sensor 44 in.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 2339
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Locations
Top Front Of Engine
(2.2L Shown, Others similar)
Intake Air Temperature Sensor is located LH front of Engine Compartment, on Air Cleaner.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2342
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2343
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2344
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2345
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2346
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2347
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2348
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2349
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2350
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2351
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2352
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2353
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2354
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2355
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2356
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2357
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2358
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2359
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2360
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2361
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2362
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2363
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2364
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2365
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2366
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2367
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2368
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2369
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2370
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2371
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2372
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2373
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2374
Intake Air Temperature Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
2375
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Intake Air Temperature Sensor
PURPOSE:
The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor is a thermistor, a variable resistor which changes value
based on temperature, mounted in the air cleaner assembly. The IAT sensor input affects fuel
delivery and ignition timing controls in the ECM.
OPERATION:
The ECM supplies 5 volts to the IAT sensor and monitors the voltage on a signal line. The sensor
provides a path to ground through its thermistor. The voltage will be high when the intake air is cold
and low when the air is hot. By monitoring the voltage, the ECM calculates the intake air
temperature.
Low intake air temperature produces high resistance (100,000 ohms at -40°C/-40°F, while high
temperature causes low resistance (70 ohms at 130 °C/266°F). A failure in the IAT circuit should
set a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) 23/25.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Knock Sensor: Component Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
> Page 2380
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2381
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE:
The knock sensor is used to detect engine detonation (ping). The ECM will retard the electronic
spark timing based on the signal received.
OPERATION:
The knock sensor detects abnormal vibration in the engine. Then, the knock sensor produces an
AC signal which increases with the severity of the knock. The ECM reads this signal and retards
the timing until the knock is stopped.
LOCATION:
Engine block near the cylinders.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2382
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-5
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2383
Knock Sensor Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Knock Sensor (KS) is used to detect engine detonation and the PCM will retard the ignition
control timing based on the signal being received. The circuitry, within the knock sensor, causes
the PCMs 5 volts to be pulled down so that under a no knock condition, CKT 496 would measure
about 2.5 volts. The knock sensor produces an AC signal, which rides on the 2.5 volts DC voltage.
The amplitude and frequency are dependent upon the knock level.
The EPROM used with this engine contains the functions which were part of remotely mounted
knock sensor modules used on other GM vehicles. The knock sensor portion of the EPROM then
sends a signal to other parts of the PCM which adjusts the spark timing to retard the spark and
reduce the detonation.
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. With engine idling, there should not be a knock signal present at the PCM, because detonation is
not likely under a no load condition.
2. Tapping on the engine lift bracket should simulate a knock signal to determine if the sensor is
capable of detecting detonation. If no knock is
detected, try tapping on engine block closer to sensor before replacing sensor.
3. If the engine has an internal problem which is creating a knock, the knock sensor may be
responding to the internal failure.
4. This test determines if the knock sensor is faulty or if the KS portion of the EPROM is faulty. If it
is determined that the EPROM is faulty, be sure
that it is properly installed and latched into place. If not properly installed, repair and retest.
Diagnostic Aids:
While observing knock signal on the Tech 1 scan tool, there should be an indication that knock is
present, when detonation can be heard. Detonation is most likely to occur under high engine load
conditions.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Electrical Specifications
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Idle 1-2 V
Wide Open Throttle 4.4.8 V
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Electrical Specifications > Page 2388
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
MAP Sensor Screws 27 in.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 2391
Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2394
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2395
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2396
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2397
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2398
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2399
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2400
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2401
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2402
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2403
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2404
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2405
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2406
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2407
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2408
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2409
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2410
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2411
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2412
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2413
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2414
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2415
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2416
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2417
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2418
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2419
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2420
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2421
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2422
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2423
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2424
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2425
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2426
Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 2427
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
MAP Sensor
PURPOSE:
The Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor is a pressure sensitive variable resistor. It measures
the changes in the intake manifold pressure which result from engine load and speed changes, and
converts this to a voltage output. The computer uses this voltage output to control fuel delivery and
ignition timing.
The MAP sensor is also used to measure barometric pressure at start up and under certain
conditions, which allows the ECM to automatically adjust for different altitudes.
OPERATION:
The ECM supplies 5 volts to the MAP sensor and monitors the voltage on a signal line. The sensor
provides a path to ground through its variable resistor.
A closed throttle on engine coastdown will produce a relatively low MAP output, while a wide open
throttle will produce a high output. Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) is the opposite of what is
measured on a vacuum gauge. When manifold pressure is high, vacuum is low. A failure in the
MAP sensor circuit should set Diagnostic Trouble Code.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 2428
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-1D
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 2429
Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor measures the changes in the intake manifold
pressure which result from engine load (intake manifold vacuum) and RPM changes; and converts
these into a voltage output. The PCM sends a 5 volt reference voltage to the MAP sensor. As the
manifold pressure changed, the output voltage of the sensor also changes. By monitoring the
sensor output voltage, the PCM knows the manifold pressure. A lower pressure (low voltage)
output voltage will be about 1-2 volts at idle, while higher pressure (high voltage) output voltage will
be about 4-4.8 at Wide Open Throttle (WOT). The MAP sensor is also used, under certain
conditions, to measure barometric pressure, allowing the PCM to make adjustments for different
altitudes. The PCM used the MAP sensor to control fuel delivery and ignition timing
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
Note: Be sure to use the same diagnostic test equipment for all measurements.
1. When comparing Tech 1 scan tool readings to a known good vehicle, it is important to compare
vehicles that use a MAP sensor having the same
color insert or having the same "Hot Stamped" number.
2. Applying 34 kPa (10" Hg) vacuum to the MAP sensor should cause the voltage to change
Subtract second reading from the first. Voltage value
should be greater than 1.5 volts. Upon applying vacuum to the sensor, the change in voltage
should be instantaneous. A slow voltage change indicates a faulty sensor.
3. Check vacuum hose to sensor for leaking or restriction. Be sure that no other vacuum devices
are connected to the MAP hose.
Note: Make sure electrical connector remains securely fastened.
Diagnostic Aids:
Remove the MAP sensor from its bracket and gently twist sensor (by hand only) while observing
the MAP display on a scan tool. Make sure electrical connector remains securely fastened. This is
a good way to check for intermittent failures. Output fluctuations greater than .1 volt indicate a
faulty sensor.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Oxygen Sensors - Silica Contamination
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Oxygen Sensors - Silica Contamination
Model Year: 1981
Bulletin No: 81-I-37
File In Group: 60
Number: 11
Date: Feb. 81
Subject: Silica Contamination of Oxygen Sensors and Gelation of Oil.
Models Affected: All
Oxygen sensor performance can deteriorate if certain RTV silicone gasket materials are used.
Other RTV's when used with certain oils, may cause gelation of the oil. The degree of performance
severity depends on the type of RTV and application of the engine involved.
Therefore, when repairing engines where this item is involved, it is important to use either cork
composition gaskets or RTV silicone gasket material approved for such use. GMS (General Motors
Sealant) or equivalent material can be used. GMS is available through GMPD with the following
part numbers:
1052366 3 oz.
1052434 10.14 oz.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 2434
Oxygen Sensor: Specifications
Oxygen Sensor 30 ft.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Page 2435
Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Oxygen Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2438
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2439
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2440
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2441
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2442
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2443
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2444
Oxygen Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2445
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2446
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2447
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2448
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2449
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2450
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2451
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2452
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2453
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2454
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2455
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2456
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2457
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2458
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2459
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2460
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2461
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2462
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2463
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2464
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2465
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2466
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2467
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2468
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2469
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 2470
Oxygen Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2471
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
Exhaust Oxygen Sensor (02)
PURPOSE:
The oxygen (O2) sensor measures the oxygen content of the exhaust. The ECM monitors the
sensor to maintain air/fuel mixture of 14.7 to 1.
OPERATION:
The oxygen sensor monitors atmospheric air versus exhaust gas oxygen content to produce a
voltage output. This voltage ranges from approximately 0.1 volt (high oxygen-lean mixture) to 0.9
volt (low oxygen-rich mixture). By monitoring the oxygen sensor output voltage, the computer can
determine the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas and adjust the air/fuel mixture accordingly, this
is known as "CLOSED LOOP" operation.
When the sensor is cold it is like an open circuit and produces no voltage below 600°F (315°C). An
open sensor circuit or cold sensor causes "OPEN LOOP" operation.
The heated oxygen sensor works in the same manner as the non-heated oxygen sensor. The
exception is that B+ is supplied to a heating unit that is part of the sensor itself. This heater
receives voltage from the generator charging circuit. The heater helps the ECM control the fuel
injection sooner for better fuel emissions. There are no malfunction Codes to detect if the heater
part of the sensor is working.
LOCATION:
Exhaust Manifold
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2472
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
VISUAL INSPECTION:
^ Connectors and wires
^ Housing and insulator for cracks/damage
^ Sensor tip for silicone contamination (white powdery coating)
PERFORMANCE TEST: Checks working range and response (speed).
1. Warm engine.
2. Install DVOM between sensor and ground (2 volt DC range).
3. Run engine at steady cruise speed (about 2500 rpm). Voltage should vary at least eight times in
ten seconds between 0.2 and 0.8 volts (normal range).
4. Drive sensor rich: The use of a properly adjusted propane flow meter (J-26911) is industry
standard. Voltage should increase to at least 0.8 volts within two to three seconds.
5. Drive sensor lean: Create a vacuum leak from a source that is not an ECM input or output.
Voltage should drop to at least 0.3 volts within two to three seconds.
NOTE: After each test the O2 sensor should return to normal operating range within two to three
seconds.
6. O2 Sensor should be replaced for failure to pass any of the tests above.
NOTE: A CEC system that is operating excessively rich or lean will drive the 02 sensor to its
maximum range. The rich or lean condition should be repaired first and not diagnosed as an 02
sensor failure.
7. Reconnect all hoses and electrical connectors. Clear all codes set and retrain idle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2473
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair
CAUTION: The Oxygen sensor uses a permanently attached pigtail and connector. This pigtail
should not be removed from the oxygen sensor. Damage or removal of the pigtail or connector
could affect proper operation of the oxygen sensor.
^ Take care when handling the oxygen sensor. The in-line electrical connector and louvered end
must be kept free of grease, dirt or other contaminants. Also, avoid using cleaning solvents of any
type. DO NOT drop or roughly handle the oxygen sensor.
^ The following procedure should be performed with engine temperature over 120°F otherwise the
oxygen sensor may be difficult to remove.
REMOVAL:
1. Remove negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect electrical connector. 3. Remove oxygen sensor.
NOTE: A special anti-seize compound is used on the oxygen sensor threads. The compound
consists of a liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite will burn away, but the glass beads will
remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New or service sensors will already have the
compound applied to the threads. If a sensor is removed from an engine, and, if for any reason it is
to be reinstalled, the threads must have anti-seize compound applied before reinstallation.
INSTALLATION:
1. Coat the threads of the oxygen sensor with anti-seize compound P/N 5613695, or equivalent if
necessary. 2. Install the sensor in the engine, and tighten to 41 Nm (30 ft lb). 3. Re-connect the
electrical connector. 4. Re-connect the negative battery cable. 5. Before starting engine, perform
IDLE LEARN PROCEDURE.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Center Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 2478
Center Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2479
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation
Power Steering Pressure Switch
PURPOSE
To sense high pressure in the steering box and signal the ECM to adjust the idle speed
accordingly.
OPERATION
The Power Steering Pressure Switch (PSPS) opens during high pressure power steering
situations. When the power steering switch is open, power to the A/C relay is shut "OFF," resulting
in A/C compressor clutch disengagement. Also, a signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM uses this
signal to compensate for the additional engine load by moving the IAC valve.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2480
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-1E
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2481
Power Steering Pressure Switch Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Power Steering Pressure (PSP) switch is normally open to ground and CKT 495 will be near
the battery voltage.
Turning the steering wheel increases power steering oil pressure and its load on an idling engine.
The pressure switch will close before the load can cause an idle problem.
Closing the switch causes CKT 495 to read less than 1 volt. The PCM will increase the idle air rate
and disengage the A/C relay.
^ A pressure switch that will not close or an open CKT 495 or 450, may cause the engine to stop
when power steering loads are high.
^ A switch that will not open, or a CKT 495 shorted to ground, may affect idle quality and will cause
the A/C relay to be de-energized.
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. Different makes of scan tools may display the state of this switch in different ways. Refer to scan
tool operator's manual to determine how this
input is displayed.
2. Checks to determine if CKT 495 is shorted to ground.
3. This should simulate a closed switch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
At Closed Throttle < 0.9 V
At Wide Open Throttle 4.7 V
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications > Page 2486
Throttle Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor 18 in.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2487
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2490
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2491
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2492
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2493
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2494
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2495
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2496
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2497
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2498
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2499
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2500
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2501
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2502
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2503
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2504
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2505
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2506
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2507
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2508
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2509
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2510
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2511
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2512
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2513
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2514
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2515
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2516
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2517
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2518
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2519
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2520
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2521
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2522
Throttle Position Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2523
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Throttle Position Sensor (TPS)
PURPOSE:
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) is a potentiometer that senses throttle angle and sends a signal
to the ECM. This input to the ECM is used to control the fuel system on acceleration and
deceleration.
OPERATION:
The TPS has three internal circuits. One to ground, a second from the ECM as a 5.0 volt reference
source and a third circuit is used by the ECM to measure the output voltage. As the throttle angle
changes (pressing down on accelerator pedal) the TPS voltage output varies from about .5 volt at
idle to about 4.9 volts at wide open throttle (WOT).
LOCATION:
Side of throttle body opposite of throttle lever.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2524
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
N/A: TPS is not adjustable on this engine.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2525
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Throttle Position Sensor
Typical Throttle Body Assembly
REMOVAL:
1. Disconnect the Throttle Position Sensor electrical connector.
2. Remove the Throttle Position Sensor mounting screws.
3. Remove the Throttle Position Sensor.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2526
NOTE: The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) is an electrical component and must not be soaked in
any liquid cleaner or solvent, damage may result.
INSTALLATION:
1. With the throttle valve closed, position the Throttle Position Sensor on the throttle shaft, then
align the screw holes.
2. Install the Throttle Position Sensor screws and tighten to 2.0 N-m (18 lb. in.).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Switch > Component Information > Locations
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 2534
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 2535
Harness Connector Faces: Park/Neutral Position Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 2536
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Park/Neutral Switch (Auto. Trans)
PURPOSE:
The PARK/NEUTRAL (P/N) switch indicates to the computer when the transmission is in PARK or
NEUTRAL. This information is used by the ECM for Idle Air Control (IAC), Torque Converter Clutch
(TCC) and Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) operation.
OPERATION:
The P/N switch contacts are a part of the neutral switch and are closed to ground in park or neutral
and open in drive ranges and reverse. The ECM supplies ignition voltage through a current limiting
resistor to the switch and senses a closed circuit when voltage drops to less than 1 volt.
NOTE: DO NOT drive the vehicle with the PARK/NEUTRAL switch disconnected, since idle quality
may be affected.
LOCATION:
Top of transaxle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 2537
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-1A
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 2538
Park/Neutral Position Switch Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Park/Neutral Position (PNP) switch contacts shown are a part of the Park/Neutral position
switch and are closed to ground in park or neutral, and open in drive ranges.
The PCM supplies ignition voltage through a pull up resistor to CKT 434 and senses a closed
switch when the voltage on CKT 434 drops to less than one volt.
The PCM uses the PNP signal as one of the inputs to control:
^ Idle speed.
^ VSS diagnostics.
^ EGR.
If CKT 434 indicates PNP (grounded), while in drive range, the EGR would be inoperative, resulting
in possible detonation.
If CKT 434 indicates drive (open) a sag in the idle may occur when the gear selector is moved into
drive range.
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. Checks for a closed switch to ground in park position. Different makes of scan toots will display
the PNP switch differently. Refer to tool
operator's manual for type of display used for a specific tool.
2. Checks for an open switch in drive range.
3. Be sure Tech 1 scan tool indicates drive, even while wiggling shifter, to test for an intermittent or
misadjusted switch in drive range.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Component Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 2543
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Connector Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2544
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
The Vehicle Speed Sensor is a gear-driven Permanent Magnet Generator housed in the vehicle's
transaxle. This sensor generates a sine wave output with a frequency proportional to vehicle
speed. The Engine Control Module (ECM) converts this signal to an output that is switched to
ground at a frequency of 4000 pulses per mile at the DK GRN (389) wire output. This output is
pulled up to 5 volts or greater by the components that use these speed signals as input.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Symptom Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2547
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Test A: Speedometer Is Inaccurate
1. Connect a Scan Tool to the DLC Connector. Drive the vehicle. Observe the Speedometer and
compare it to the vehicle speed shown on the Scan
Tool.
^ If both the Speedometer and Scan Tool display the same approximate speed, check for correct
tire size, ECM MEM-CAL and Vehicle Speed Sensor.
^ If the Scan Tool and Speedometer do not display the same approximate speed, replace or
exchange the Instrument Cluster (Refer to Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators).
ALTERNATE TEST
^ If the Kent Moore Tool J 38522 is available, do the following test.
2. Connect a Scan Tool to the DLC connector. Disconnect the Vehicle Speed Sensor connector.
Connect a lead between the J 38522 vehicle speed
generator's red output terminal and the Vehicle Speed Sensor connector terminal A (LT BLU).
Connect a lead between the J 38522 generator's black output and terminal B (DK GRN/WHT). Plug
the generator into the Cigar Lighter. Select 30 V P-P sine wave and set the frequency at 600hz.
Observe the Speedometer and compare to the vehicle speed shown on the Scan Tool.
^ If both the Speedometer and Scan Tool display the same approximate speed, check for correct
tire size, ECM MEM-CAL and Vehicle Speed Sensor.
^ If the Scan Tool and Speedometer do not display the same approximate speed, replace or
exchange the Instrument Cluster (Refer to Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators).
See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators
Test B: Speed Signal Test
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection >
Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 2548
Test C: Speed Out Put Test
Speed Signal Test
The Vehicle Speed Sensor is a gear-driven Permanent Magnet Generator housed in the vehicle's
transaxle. This sensor generates a sine wave output with a frequency proportional to vehicle
speed. The Engine Control Module (ECM) converts this signal to an output that is switched to
ground at a frequency of 4000 pulses per mile at the DK GRN (389) wire output. This output is
pulled up to 5 volts or greater by the components that use these speed signals as input.
System Diagnosis
^ If referred here from Cruise Control, do Test B. See: Diagnostic Tests/Test B: Speed Signal Test
^ Refer to Symptom Table for listed symptoms and refer Diagnostic Tests for Diagnostic
procedures. See: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures See: Diagnostic Tests
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations >
Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch
Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump): Locations Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch
RH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations >
Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch > Page 2554
RH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations >
Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch > Page 2555
Fuel Pump / Oil Pressure Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 2556
Harness Connector Faces: Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
At Closed Throttle < 0.9 V
At Wide Open Throttle 4.7 V
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications > Page 2561
Throttle Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor 18 in.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
2562
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2565
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2566
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2567
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2568
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2569
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2570
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2571
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2572
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2573
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2574
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2575
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2576
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2577
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2578
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2579
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2580
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2581
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2582
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2583
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2584
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2585
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2586
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2587
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2588
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2589
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2590
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2591
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2592
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2593
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2594
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2595
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2596
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 2597
Throttle Position Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2598
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Throttle Position Sensor (TPS)
PURPOSE:
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) is a potentiometer that senses throttle angle and sends a signal
to the ECM. This input to the ECM is used to control the fuel system on acceleration and
deceleration.
OPERATION:
The TPS has three internal circuits. One to ground, a second from the ECM as a 5.0 volt reference
source and a third circuit is used by the ECM to measure the output voltage. As the throttle angle
changes (pressing down on accelerator pedal) the TPS voltage output varies from about .5 volt at
idle to about 4.9 volts at wide open throttle (WOT).
LOCATION:
Side of throttle body opposite of throttle lever.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2599
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
N/A: TPS is not adjustable on this engine.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2600
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Throttle Position Sensor
Typical Throttle Body Assembly
REMOVAL:
1. Disconnect the Throttle Position Sensor electrical connector.
2. Remove the Throttle Position Sensor mounting screws.
3. Remove the Throttle Position Sensor.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2601
NOTE: The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) is an electrical component and must not be soaked in
any liquid cleaner or solvent, damage may result.
INSTALLATION:
1. With the throttle valve closed, position the Throttle Position Sensor on the throttle shaft, then
align the screw holes.
2. Install the Throttle Position Sensor screws and tighten to 2.0 N-m (18 lb. in.).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Switch > Component Information > Locations
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Crankshaft Position Sensor
RH rear of engine, on exhaust manifold
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2609
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Typical DIS Crankshaft Sensor
PURPOSE:
The crankshaft sensor provides a signal through the Direct Ignition (DI), which the ECM uses as
reference to calculate rpm and crankshaft position.
OPERATION:
This sensor protrudes into the block, within approximately .050" of the engine crankshaft reluctor.
The reluctor is a special wheel cast into the crankshaft with seven slots cast into it, six of which are
evenly spaced 60° apart. A seventh slot is spaced 10° from one of the other slots and serves to
generate a "sync pulse." As the reluctor rotates as part of the crankshaft, the slots change the
magnetic field of the sensor, creating an induced voltage pulse.
Based on the crank sensor pulses, the ignition module sends reference signals to the ECM which
are used to indicate crankshaft position and engine speed.
LOCATION:
This sensor is mounted remotely from the ignition module, right hand side of engine, at the end of
the crank shaft.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2610
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Remove or Disconnect
1. Sensor harness connector. 2. Sensor to block bolt. 3. Sensor from engine.
Inspect ^
Sensor O-ring for wear, cracks or leakage. Replace if necessary. Lube new O-ring with engine oil
before installing.
Install or Connect
1. Sensor into hole in block. 2. Sensor to block bolt.
^ Torque to 8 N.m (71 lb. in.).
3. Sensor harness connector.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Knock Sensor: Component Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2615
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2616
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE:
The knock sensor is used to detect engine detonation (ping). The ECM will retard the electronic
spark timing based on the signal received.
OPERATION:
The knock sensor detects abnormal vibration in the engine. Then, the knock sensor produces an
AC signal which increases with the severity of the knock. The ECM reads this signal and retards
the timing until the knock is stopped.
LOCATION:
Engine block near the cylinders.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2617
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-5
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 2618
Knock Sensor Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Knock Sensor (KS) is used to detect engine detonation and the PCM will retard the ignition
control timing based on the signal being received. The circuitry, within the knock sensor, causes
the PCMs 5 volts to be pulled down so that under a no knock condition, CKT 496 would measure
about 2.5 volts. The knock sensor produces an AC signal, which rides on the 2.5 volts DC voltage.
The amplitude and frequency are dependent upon the knock level.
The EPROM used with this engine contains the functions which were part of remotely mounted
knock sensor modules used on other GM vehicles. The knock sensor portion of the EPROM then
sends a signal to other parts of the PCM which adjusts the spark timing to retard the spark and
reduce the detonation.
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. With engine idling, there should not be a knock signal present at the PCM, because detonation is
not likely under a no load condition.
2. Tapping on the engine lift bracket should simulate a knock signal to determine if the sensor is
capable of detecting detonation. If no knock is
detected, try tapping on engine block closer to sensor before replacing sensor.
3. If the engine has an internal problem which is creating a knock, the knock sensor may be
responding to the internal failure.
4. This test determines if the knock sensor is faulty or if the KS portion of the EPROM is faulty. If it
is determined that the EPROM is faulty, be sure
that it is properly installed and latched into place. If not properly installed, repair and retest.
Diagnostic Aids:
While observing knock signal on the Tech 1 scan tool, there should be an indication that knock is
present, when detonation can be heard. Detonation is most likely to occur under high engine load
conditions.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
Diagnostic Connector - Fuel Pump > Component Information > Locations
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
Fuel Pressure Test Port > Component Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Test Port: Service and Repair
Area around fuel pressure connection with GM X-30A or equivalent.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT:
1. Negative battery terminal.
2. Relieve fuel system pressure.
3. Fuel pressure connection and seal. Discard seal.
INSTALL OR CONNECT:
1. New seal on fuel pressure connection.
2. Fuel pressure connection in fuel rail. Tighten Fuel pressure connection assembly to 10.0 N-m
(88 lb. in.).
3. Tighten fuel filler cap.
4. Negative battery terminal.
5. Turn ignition switch to the "ON" position for two seconds, then turn to the "OFF" position for ten
seconds. Again turn to the "ON" position, and check for fuel leaks.
6. Perform the "Idle Learn Procedure." The ECM will need to relearn the IAC valve pintle position
following battery reconnect.
Air Plenum And Fuel Rail Removal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure >
Fuel Pressure Test Port > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 2627
Fuel Pressure Connection
REMOVAL:
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Relieve the fuel system pressure, see FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELIEF:
3. Remove intake manifold plenum, see INTAKE MANIFOLD PLENUM.
4. Clean area around the fuel pressure connection with GM X-30A or equivalent.
5. Remove the fuel pressure connection and seal, discard the seal.
INSTALLATION:
1. Place a new seal on the fuel pressure connection assembly.
2. Screw the fuel pressure connection assembly into the fuel rail and tighten to 10.0 N-m (88 lb.
in.).
3. Check for fuel leaks: a.
Connect the negative battery cable.
b. With engine "OFF" and ignition "ON," check for fuel leaks.
c. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
4. Install the intake manifold plenum as per above procedure.
IDLE LEARN PROCEDURE: Any time the battery is disconnected, the programmed position of the
IAC valve pintle is lost, and replaced with a default value. To return the IAC valve pintle to the
correct position, perform the following procedure:
1. After restoring battery power, connect the Tech 1 "SCAN" tool.
2. Select "IAC SYSTEM," then select "IDLE LEARN" in the "MISC TEST" mode.
3. Proceed with idle learn as directed.
^ This procedure allows the ECM memory to be updated with the correct IAC valve pintle position,
for the vehicle, and provide a stable idle speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed >
System Information > Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
The idle speed is computer controlled and there is no provision for adjustment. If idle speed is
incorrect, refer to Computers and Control Systems / System Diagnosis.
MINIMUM IDLE SPEED
Transmission Gear Idle Speed IAC Counts Open/Closed Loop (2)
N/A N/A (1) 10-20 CL
(1) No idle speed specifications are provided for this vehicle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed >
System Information > Specifications > Page 2631
Idle Speed: Adjustments
The ECM controls idle speed and no adjustment should be attempted.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner
Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Filter
Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: Customer Interest Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner
Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Filter
Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 2641
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner
Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air
Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner
Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air
Filter Element: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 2647
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Fuel
Pressure Release > System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
WARNING: To reduce the risk of fire and personal injury, it is necessary to relieve the fuel system
pressure before servicing fuel system components.
After relieving system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing fuel lines
or connections. In order to reduce the chance of personal injury, cover fuel line fittings with a shop
towel before disconnecting, to catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved
container when disconnect is completed.
When servicing the fuel system use the following precautions:
a. Put a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the workshop.
b. Be sure shop is supplied with an adequate fire extinguisher.
c. Be sure to disconnect the negative battery cable before any service work is done.
d. Use a suitable container to catch any fuel that may leak from system during service.
e. Always relieve fuel system pressure before disconnecting any lines.
f. If the key must be turned "ON" while servicing fuel system, always disconnect or disable ignition,
to insure no sparks occur near fuel vapors.
PROCEDURE:
Tool required: J34730-1 Fuel Pressure Gauge or equivalent.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable, to avoid fuel pump turn "ON," if an accidental attempt is
made to start the engine.
2. Loosen the fuel filler cap to relieve tank vapor pressure.
3. Connect the fuel pressure gauge to the pressure connection. Wrap a shop towel around the
fitting while connecting the gauge to avoid spillage.
4. Install bleed hose into an approved container and open the valve to bleed the system pressure.
Fuel connections are now safe for servicing.
5. Drain any fuel remaining in the gauge into an approved container.
When repair to the fuel system has been completed, START the engine and check all connections
that were loosened for leaks.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order >
Component Information > Specifications > Ignition Firing Order
Firing Order: Specifications Ignition Firing Order
Firing Order .........................................................................................................................................
............................................................... 1-2-3-4-5-6
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing >
Number One Cylinder > Component Information > Locations > Number 1 Cylinder Location
Number One Cylinder: Locations Number 1 Cylinder Location
NUMBER ONE CYLINDER LOCATION
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing >
Timing Marks and Indicators > System Information > Locations
Timing Marks and Indicators: Locations
The ECM controls ignition timing therefore no provisions for adjustment are required. No timing
marks are provided on this engine.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug Wire
<--> [Ignition Cable] > Component Information > Specifications
Spark Plug Wire: Specifications
Spark Plug Wire Resistance Values:
0-15 inch cable ....................................................................................................................................
............................................... 3,000-10,000 ohms.
15-25 inch cable ..................................................................................................................................
............................................... 4,000-15,000 ohms.
25-35 inch cable ..................................................................................................................................
............................................... 6,000-20,000 ohms.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug Wire
<--> [Ignition Cable] > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2667
Spark Plug Wire Routing
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Spark Plug >
Component Information > Specifications
Spark Plug: Specifications
Spark Plug Gap ...................................................................................................................................
...................................................... .045 in. (1.14 mm)
NOTE: Check the gap specifications given on the Emissions Control Label. If the gap is different
from what is listed here, use the information on the label.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Compression
Check > System Information > Specifications
Compression Check: Specifications
The lowest reading cylinder should not be less than 70% of the highest and no cylinder reading
should be less than 689 kPa (100 psi). Perform compression test with engine at normal operating
temperature, spark plugs removed and throttle wide open.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications > Valve Clearance Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications Valve Clearance Specifications
Vehicles are equipped with a non-adjustable rocker arm studs. If valve reconditioning is required,
the non-adjustable rocker arm stud must be replaced with an adjustable rocker arm stud and the
following procedure must be performed.
1. Remove rocker arm covers.
2. Crank engine until mark on torsional damper lines up with O mark on timing tab. The engine
should also be in the No. 1 firing position. This can be determined by placing fingers on No. 1
rocker arms as mark on damper approaches O mark.
3. If valves are not moving, engine is in No. 1 firing position. If valves move as the mark comes up
to the timing tab, engine is in No. 4 firing position and should be rotated one revolution to reach No.
1 position.
4. With engine in No. 1 firing position, adjust exhaust valves 1, 2 and 3 and intake valves 1, 5 and
6, as follows: a.
Back out adjusting nut until lash is felt at pushrod, then turn in adjusting nut until all lash is
removed.
b. When lash has been removed, turn adjusting nut in additional 1 1/2 turns to center lifter plunger.
5. Crank engine one revolution until timing tab O mark and torsional damper mark are again in
alignment.
6. With the engine in this, the No. 4 firing position. adjust exhaust valves 4, 5 and 6 and intake
valves 2, 3 and 4 as previously described.
7. Install rocker arm covers, then start engine and check timing and idle speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications > Valve Clearance Specifications > Page 2678
Valve Clearance: Specifications Valve Arrangement
FRONT TO REAR
Right ....................................................................................................................................................
........................................................... E-I-E-I-I-E Left .........................................................................
......................................................................................................................................... E-I-I-E-I-E
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance >
System Information > Specifications > Page 2679
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
Vehicles are equipped with a non-adjustable rocker arm studs. If valve reconditioning is required,
the non-adjustable rocker arm stud must be replaced with an adjustable rocker arm stud and the
following procedure must be performed.
1. Remove rocker arm covers.
2. Crank engine until mark on torsional damper lines up with O mark on timing tab. The engine
should also be in the No. 1 firing position. This can be determined by placing fingers on No. 1
rocker arms as mark on damper approaches O mark.
3. If valves are not moving, engine is in No. 1 firing position. If valves move as the mark comes up
to the timing tab, engine is in No. 4 firing position and should be rotated one revolution to reach No.
1 position.
4. With engine in No. 1 firing position, adjust exhaust valves 1, 2 and 3 and intake valves 1, 5 and
6, as follows: a.
Back out adjusting nut until lash is felt at pushrod, then turn in adjusting nut until all lash is
removed.
b. When lash has been removed, turn adjusting nut in additional 1 1/2 turns to center lifter plunger.
5. Crank engine one revolution until timing tab O mark and torsional damper mark are again in
alignment.
6. With the engine in this, the No. 4 firing position. adjust exhaust valves 4, 5 and 6 and intake
valves 2, 3 and 4 as previously described.
7. Install rocker arm covers, then start engine and check timing and idle speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > A/C Signal > Component
Information > Description and Operation
A/C Signal: Description and Operation
PURPOSE:
This signal indicates that the A/C control switch is turned "ON" and the pressure switch is closed.
OPERATION:
The ECM uses this signal to adjust the idle speed, and on some models engages the A/C
compressor clutch. If this signal is not available to the ECM, the engine idle may be rough when the
A/C compressor cycles. In some cases the A/C compressor will be inoperative.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Resistance 177 ohms at 212 deg F
241 ohms at 194 deg F
332 ohms at 176 deg F
467 ohms at 158 deg F
667 ohms at 140 deg F
973 ohms at 122 deg F
1188 ohms at 113 deg F
1459 ohms at 104 deg F
1802 ohms at 95 deg F
2238 ohms at 86 deg F
2796 ohms at 77 deg F
3520 ohms at 68 deg F
4450 ohms at 59 deg F
5670 ohms at 50 deg F
7280 ohms at 41 deg F
9420 ohms at 32 deg F
12300 ohms at 23 deg F
16180 ohms at 14 deg F
21450 ohms at 5 deg F
28680 ohms at -4 deg F
52700 ohms at -22 deg F
100700 ohms at -40 deg F
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 2688
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Mechanical Specifications Torque Valve
Torque Valve
Induction Air Sensor 44 in.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2689
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Locations
Top Front Of Engine
(2.2L Shown, Others similar)
Intake Air Temperature Sensor is located LH front of Engine Compartment, on Air Cleaner.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2692
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2693
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2694
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2695
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2696
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2697
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2698
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2699
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2700
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2701
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2702
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2703
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2704
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2705
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2706
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2707
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2708
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2709
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2710
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2711
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2712
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2713
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2714
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2715
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2716
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2717
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2718
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2719
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2720
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2721
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2722
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2723
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2724
Intake Air Temperature Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2725
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Intake Air Temperature Sensor
PURPOSE:
The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor is a thermistor, a variable resistor which changes value
based on temperature, mounted in the air cleaner assembly. The IAT sensor input affects fuel
delivery and ignition timing controls in the ECM.
OPERATION:
The ECM supplies 5 volts to the IAT sensor and monitors the voltage on a signal line. The sensor
provides a path to ground through its thermistor. The voltage will be high when the intake air is cold
and low when the air is hot. By monitoring the voltage, the ECM calculates the intake air
temperature.
Low intake air temperature produces high resistance (100,000 ohms at -40°C/-40°F, while high
temperature causes low resistance (70 ohms at 130 °C/266°F). A failure in the IAT circuit should
set a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) 23/25.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Resistance 177 ohms at 212 deg F
241 ohms at 194 deg F
332 ohms at 176 deg F
467 ohms at 158 deg F
667 ohms at 140 deg F
973 ohms at 122 deg F
1188 ohms at 113 deg F
1459 ohms at 104 deg F
1802 ohms at 95 deg F
2238 ohms at 86 deg F
2796 ohms at 77 deg F
3520 ohms at 68 deg F
4450 ohms at 59 deg F
5670 ohms at 50 deg F
7280 ohms at 41 deg F
9420 ohms at 32 deg F
12300 ohms at 23 deg F
16180 ohms at 14 deg F
21450 ohms at 5 deg F
28680 ohms at -4 deg F
52700 ohms at -22 deg F
100700 ohms at -40 deg F
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2729
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations
Rear Of Engine Compartment
LH rear of engine, on Coolant Outlet
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2732
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2733
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2734
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2735
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2736
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2737
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2738
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2739
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2740
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2741
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2742
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2743
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2744
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2745
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2746
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2747
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2748
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2749
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2750
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2751
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2752
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2753
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2754
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2755
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2756
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2757
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2758
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2759
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2760
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2761
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2762
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2763
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2764
Coolant Temperature Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature
Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2765
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
PURPOSE
The Engine Coolant Temperature sensor (ECT) is used to control:
^ Fuel delivery
^ Torque Converter Clutch (TCC)
^ Engine Spark Timing (EST)
^ Controlled Canister Purge (CCP)
^ Idle Air Control (IAC)
^ Cooling Fan
OPERATION:
The ECT is a thermistor that is located in the engine coolant flow. When the coolant temperature is
low, the sensor produces a high resistance. When the coolant temperature is high, the sensor
produces a low resistance.
The ECM sends a 5.0 volt signal to the ECT through a resistor in the computer and measures the
voltage. The voltage will be high or low depending on coolant temperature. With the ECT varying
its resistance, the ECM can sense engine coolant temperature by reading the varying voltage.
LOCATION:
Engine thermostat and coolant outlet.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Crankshaft Position Sensor
RH rear of engine, on exhaust manifold
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2769
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Typical DIS Crankshaft Sensor
PURPOSE:
The crankshaft sensor provides a signal through the Direct Ignition (DI), which the ECM uses as
reference to calculate rpm and crankshaft position.
OPERATION:
This sensor protrudes into the block, within approximately .050" of the engine crankshaft reluctor.
The reluctor is a special wheel cast into the crankshaft with seven slots cast into it, six of which are
evenly spaced 60° apart. A seventh slot is spaced 10° from one of the other slots and serves to
generate a "sync pulse." As the reluctor rotates as part of the crankshaft, the slots change the
magnetic field of the sensor, creating an induced voltage pulse.
Based on the crank sensor pulses, the ignition module sends reference signals to the ECM which
are used to indicate crankshaft position and engine speed.
LOCATION:
This sensor is mounted remotely from the ignition module, right hand side of engine, at the end of
the crank shaft.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2770
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Remove or Disconnect
1. Sensor harness connector. 2. Sensor to block bolt. 3. Sensor from engine.
Inspect ^
Sensor O-ring for wear, cracks or leakage. Replace if necessary. Lube new O-ring with engine oil
before installing.
Install or Connect
1. Sensor into hole in block. 2. Sensor to block bolt.
^ Torque to 8 N.m (71 lb. in.).
3. Sensor harness connector.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Locations
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Data Link Connector >
Component Information > Locations > Page 2774
Data Link Connector: Diagrams
Harness Connector Faces: Data Link Connector (DLC)
Harness Connector Faces: Data Link Connector (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory
Usage
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-06-04-054B
Date: November 18, 2010
Subject: Info - Non-GM Parts and Accessories (Aftermarket)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and update to the new U.S. Fixed
Operation Manager (FOM) and Canada Warranty Manager (WM) names. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 04-06-04-054A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
The recent rise and expansion of companies selling non-GM parts and accessories has made it
necessary to issue this reminder to dealers regarding GM's policy on the use and installation of
these aftermarket components.
When a dealer is performing a repair under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty, they are required to
use only genuine GM or GM-approved parts and accessories. This applies to all warranty repairs,
special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM. Parts and accessories advertised as being "the
same" as parts manufactured by GM, but not sold through GM, do not qualify for use in warranty
repairs, special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM.
During a warranty repair, if a GM original equipment part is not available through GM Customer
Care and Aftersales (GM CC&A;), ACDelco(R) distributors, other GM dealers or approved sources,
the dealer is to obtain comparable, non-GM parts and clearly indicate, in detail, on the repair order
the circumstances surrounding why non-GM parts were used. The dealer must give customers
written notice, prior to the sale or service, that such parts or accessories are not marketed or
warranted by General Motors.
It should also be noted that dealers modifying new vehicles and installing equipment, parts and
accessories obtained from sources not authorized by GM are responsible for complying with the
National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. Certain non-approved parts or assemblies, installed
by the dealer or its agent not authorized by GM, may result in a change to the vehicle's design
characteristics and may affect the vehicle's ability to conform to federal law. Dealers must fully
understand that non-GM approved parts may not have been validated, tested or certified for use.
This puts the dealer at risk for potential liability in the event of a part or vehicle failure. If a GM part
failure occurs as the result of the installation or use of a non-GM approved part, the warranty will
not be honored.
A good example of non-authorized modification of vehicles is the result of an ever increasing
supply of aftermarket devices available to the customer, which claim to increase the horsepower
and torque of the Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines. These include the addition of, but are not limited to
one or more of the following modifications:
- Propane injection
- Nitrous oxide injection
- Additional modules (black boxes) that connect to the vehicle wiring systems
- Revised engine calibrations downloaded for the engine control module
- Calibration modules which connect to the vehicle diagnostic connector
- Modification to the engine turbocharger waste gate
Although the installation of these devices, or modification of vehicle components, can increase
engine horsepower and torque, they may also negatively affect the engine emissions, reliability
and/or durability. In addition, other powertrain components, such as transmissions, universal joints,
drive shafts, and front/rear axle components, can be stressed beyond design safety limits by the
installation of these devices.
General Motors does not support or endorse the use of devices or modifications that, when
installed, increase the engine horsepower and torque. It is because of these unknown stresses,
and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a
policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining
warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a
non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is
subsequently removed. Refer to the latest version of Bulletin 09-06-04-026 (V8 Gas Engines) or
06-06-01-007 (Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines) for more information on dealer requirements for
calibration verification.
These same policies apply as they relate to the use of non-GM accessories. Damage or failure
from the use or installation of a non-GM accessory will not be covered under warranty. Failure
resulting from the alteration or modification of the vehicle, including the cutting, welding or
disconnecting of the vehicle's original equipment parts and components will void the warranty.
Additionally, dealers will NOT be reimbursed or compensated by GM in the event of any legal
inquiry at either the local, state or federal level that
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 2779
results from the alteration or modification of a vehicle using non-GM approved parts or accessories.
Dealers should be especially cautious of accessory companies that claim the installation of their
product will not void the factory warranty. Many times these companies have even given direction
on how to quickly disassemble the accessory in an attempt to preclude the manufacturer from
finding out that is has been installed.
Any suspect repairs should be reviewed by the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), and in Canada
by the Warranty Manager (WM) for appropriate repair direction. If it is decided that a goodwill repair
is to be made on the vehicle, even with the installation of such non-GM approved components, the
customer is to be made aware of General Motors position on this issue and is to sign the
appropriate goodwill documentation required by General Motors.
It is imperative for dealers to understand that by installing such devices, they are jeopardizing not
only the warranty coverage, but also the performance and reliability of the customer's vehicle.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Specifications > PCM Connector C1 (Black)
Engine Control Module: Specifications PCM Connector C1 (Black)
ECM Connector: C1
ECM Connector: C1 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Specifications > PCM Connector C1 (Black) > Page 2782
Engine Control Module: Specifications PCM Connector C2 (Black)
ECM Connector: C2
ECM Connector: C2 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Specifications > PCM Connector C1 (Black) > Page 2783
Engine Control Module: Specifications PCM Connector C3 (Green)
ECM Connector: C3
ECM Connector: C3 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Behind RH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2786
Behind RH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > C1 (Black)
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C1 (Black)
ECM Connector: C1
ECM Connector: C1 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > C1 (Black) > Page 2789
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C2 (Black)
ECM Connector: C2
ECM Connector: C2 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > C1 (Black) > Page 2790
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C3 (Green)
ECM Connector: C3
ECM Connector: C3 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2791
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation
Computer Module
PURPOSE:
The Electronic Control Module or Powertrain Control Module (ECM/PCM) is the control center of
the fuel injection system. It constantly looks at the information from various sensors (inputs) and
controls the systems (outputs) that affect vehicle performance. The ECM/PCM also performs the
diagnostic function of the system. It can recognize operational problems, alert the driver through
the "SERVICE ENGINE SOON" or "MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP" light, and store a code or
codes which identify the problem areas to aid the technician in performing repairs.
OPERATION:
The computer is designed to process the various input information, and send the necessary
electrical response to control fuel delivery, spark control, and other emission control systems. The
computer can control these devices through the use of Quad Driver Modules (QDM). When the
ECM/PCM is commanding a device or a component "ON," the voltage potential of the output is
"LOW" or near zero volts. When the ECM/PCM is commanding a device or component "OFF," the
voltage potential of the circuit will be "HIGH," or near 12 volts. The primary function of the QDM is
to supply the ground for the component being controlled.
The input information has an interrelation between sensor output. If one of the input devices failed,
such as the oxygen sensor, this could affect more than one of the systems controlled by the
computer.
The computer has a learning ability which allows it to make corrections for minor variations in the
fuel system to improve driveability. If the battery is disconnected to clear trouble codes or for repair,
the learning process has to begin all over again, and a change may be noticed in the driving
performance of the vehicle. To reset the vehicles learning ability, make sure the engine is at
operating temperature and operate the vehicle at part throttle, moderate acceleration, and idle
conditions, until normal performance returns.
This vehicle is equipped with an ECM/PCM with two parts for service, a controller which is the
ECM/PCM itself and a memory calibration unit called a MEM-CAL, PROM, or EPROM.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Pinout Values and Diagnostic Parameters
Engine Control Module: Pinout Values and Diagnostic Parameters
ECM Connector: C1
ECM Connector: C1 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Pinout Values and Diagnostic Parameters > Page 2794
ECM Connector: C2
ECM Connector: C2 (Description)
ECM Connector: C3
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Pinout Values and Diagnostic Parameters > Page 2795
ECM Connector: C3 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2796
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair
ECM
Remove or Disconnect:
1. Negative battery cable.
2. Interior access panel.
3. Connectors from ECM/PCM.
3. ECM/PCM.
NOTICE: To prevent possible electrostatic discharge damage to the ECM/PCM, Do Not touch the
connector pins or soldered components on the
circuit board.
Install or Connect:
1. New ECM/PCM.
2. ECM connectors to ECM/PCM.
3. Negative battery cable.
4. interior access panel.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Specifications
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Specifications Actuator Tightening Torque
Actuator Tightening Torque
Idle Air Control Valve 27 in.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2800
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2801
Harness Connector Faces: Idle Air Control Valve
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Specifications > Page 2802
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Description and Operation
Idle Air Control Valve Assembly (IAC)
PURPOSE:
To control the engine idle speed and prevent stalling due to changes in engine load.
OPERATION:
The IAC valve controls the amount of air bypassed around the throttle plate. If more air is
bypassed, idle speed will increase, and if less air is bypassed, the idle speed will decrease. The
IAC valve accomplishes this by moving a conical shaped pintle in to decrease bypassed air and out
to increase bypassed air. This can be seen as counts as displayed on a "SCAN" tool. Inward
Movement of the pintle = Decreased RPM =Lower Counts. Outward Movement of the pintle =
Increased RPM = Higher Counts. The ECM uses sensor and switch inputs to control the position of
the IAC pintle. If the pintle is stuck open, the idle speed will remain high. If the pintle is stuck
closed, the idle speed will be too low, and stalling may occur. If the pintle is stuck partially open, the
idle speed will be higher than normal, and there will be no response to changes in engine load such
as A/C ("ON") or transmission in ("Drive").
LOCATION:
Throttle body.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Chart C-2B, Idle Air Control (IAC) Valve Check
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Testing and Inspection Chart C-2B, Idle Air Control (IAC)
Valve Check
Chart C-2B Idle Air Control (IAC) Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Chart C-2B, Idle Air Control (IAC) Valve Check > Page
2805
Idle Air Control Circuit
Circuit Description:
The PCM controls engine idle speed with the Idle Air Control (IAC) valve. To increase idle speed,
the PCM retracts the IAC valve pintle away from its seat, allowing more air to bypass the throttle
bore. To decrease idle speed, it extends the IAC valve pintle towards its seat, reducing bypass air
flow. A Tech 1 scan tool will display the PCM commands to the IAC valve in counts. Higher counts
indicate more air bypass (higher idle). Lower counts indicate less air is allowed to bypass (lower
idle).
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. The Tech 1 RPM control mode is used to extend and retract the IAC valve. The valve should
move smoothly within the specified range. If the idle
speed is commanded (IAC extended) too low (below 700 RPM), the engine may stall. This may be
normal and would not indicate a problem. Retracting the IAC beyond its controlled range (above
1500 RPM) will cause a delay before the RPMs start dropping. This too is normal.
2. This test uses the Tech 1 to command the IAC controlled idle speed. The PCM issues
commands to obtain commanded idle speed. The node lights
each should flash red and green to indicate a good circuit as the PCM issues commands. While the
sequence of color is not important if either light is "OFF" or does not flash red and green, check the
circuits for faults, beginning with poor terminal contacts.
Diagnostic Aids:
A slow, unstable or fast idle may be caused by a non-IAC system problem that cannot be
overcome by the IAC valve. Out of control range IAC scan tool counts will be above 60 if idle is too
low and zero counts if idle is too high. The following checks should be made to repair a non-IAC
system problem:
^ Vacuum leak (high idle). If idle is too high, stop the engine. Fully extend (low) IAC with Tech 1
scan tool. Start engine. If idle speed is above 800 RPM, locate and correct vacuum leak including
crankcase ventilation system. Also check for binding of throttle blade or linkage.
^ System too lean (high air/fuel ratio). The idle speed may be too high or too low. Engine speed
may vary tip and down and disconnecting the IAC valve does not help. DTC 44 may be set. Scan
O2S voltage will be less than 300 mV (.3 volt). Check for low regulated fuel pressure, water in the
fuel or a restricted injector.
^ System too rich (low air/fuel ratio). The idle speed will be too low. Scan tool IAC counts will
usually be above 80. System is obviously rich and may exhibit black smoke in exhaust.
Scan tool 02S voltage will be fixed above 800 mV (.8 volt).
Check for high fuel pressure, leaking or sticking injector. Silicone contaminated Oxygen Sensors
(O2S) scan voltage will be slow to respond.
^ Throttle body. Remove IAC valve and inspect bore for foreign material.
^ IAC valve electrical connections. IAC valve connections should be carefully checked for proper
contact.
^ Crankcase ventilation valve. An incorrect or faulty crankcase ventilation valve may result in an
incorrect idle speed.
^ Refer to "Rough, Unstable or Incorrect Idle, Stalling" in "Diagnosis By Symptom."
^ If intermittent poor driveability or idle symptoms are resolved by disconnecting the IAC, carefully
recheck connections, valve terminal resistance or replace IAC. A rapid change of IAC counts are
an indication of a loose connection or connector.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Chart C-2B, Idle Air Control (IAC) Valve Check > Page
2806
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Testing and Inspection Idle Air Control (IAC) Reset
Procedure
IMPORTANT: If installing a new IAC valve, be sure to replace with an identical part. IAC valve
pintle shape and diameter are designed for the specific application.
Measure the distance between tip of IAC valve pintle and mounting flange. If greater than 28 mm,
use ringer pressure to slowly retract the pintle. The force required to retract the pintle of a new
valve will not cause damage to the valve.
Reset IAC valve pintle position:
a. Turn ignition "ON" for five seconds.
b. Turn ignition "OFF" for ten seconds.
c. Start engine, check for proper idle operation.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Service and Repair > Idle Air Control (IAC) Reset Procedure
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Service and Repair Idle Air Control (IAC) Reset
Procedure
IMPORTANT: If installing a new IAC valve, be sure to replace with an identical part. IAC valve
pintle shape and diameter are designed for the specific application.
Measure the distance between tip of IAC valve pintle and mounting flange. If greater than 28 mm,
use ringer pressure to slowly retract the pintle. The force required to retract the pintle of a new
valve will not cause damage to the valve.
Reset IAC valve pintle position:
a. Turn ignition "ON" for five seconds.
b. Turn ignition "OFF" for ten seconds.
c. Start engine, check for proper idle operation.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Service and Repair > Idle Air Control (IAC) Reset Procedure > Page 2809
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Service and Repair Idle Air Control (IAC) Valve
Replacement
Throttle Body Assembly
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Service and Repair > Idle Air Control (IAC) Reset Procedure > Page 2810
IAC Valve
REMOVAL:
1. Disconnect the idle air control (IAC) valve electrical connector.
2. Remove the IAC valve attaching screws.
3. Remove the IAC valve assembly.
4. Clean the IAC valve O-ring sealing surface, pintle valve, seat and air passage. ^
Use carburetor cleaner and a parts cleaning brush to remove carbon deposits. DO NOT use a
cleaner that contains Methyl Ethyl Ketone. It is an extremely strong solvent, and not necessary for
this type of deposit.
^ Shiny spots on the pintle or seat are normal, and do not indicate misalignment or a bent pintle
shaft.
^ If the air passage has heavy deposits, remove the throttle body for complete cleaning.
^ Inspect the IAC valve O-ring for cuts, cracks or distortion. Replace if damaged.
NOTE: If installing a new IAC valve, be sure to replace with an identical part. IAC valve pintle
shape and diameter are designed for specific application.
INSTALLATION:
1. If installing a new IAC valve, measure the distance between the tip of the pintle and the
mounting flange. ^
If greater than 28 mm, use finger pressure to slowly retract the pintle. The force required to retract
the pintle of a new valve will not cause damage to the valve.
2. Lubricate the IAC valve O-ring with clean engine oil.
3. Install the IAC valve assembly.
4. Install the IAC valve attaching screws, and tighten to 3.4 Nm (30 in lb).
5. Connect the IAC valve electrical connector.
6. START the engine and allow it to reach operating temperature.
IDLE LEARN PROCEDURE: Any time the battery is disconnected, the programmed position of the
IAC valve pintle is lost, and replaced with a default value. To return the IAC valve pintle to the
correct position, perform the following procedure:
1. After restoring battery power, connect the Tech 1 "SCAN" tool.
2. Select "IAC SYSTEM," then select "IDLE LEARN" in the "MISC TEST" mode.
3. Proceed with idle learn as directed.
^ This procedure allows the ECM memory to be updated with the correct IAC valve pintle position,
for the vehicle, and provide a stable idle speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Service and Repair > Idle Air Control (IAC) Reset Procedure > Page 2811
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Service and Repair Idle Air/Vacuum Signal Housing
Throttle Body Assembly
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT:
1. Negative battery terminal.
2. Vacuum harness connector.
3. IAC valve electrical connector.
4. Idle Air Control (IAC) valve.
5. Idle air/vacuum signal housing screws.
6. Idle air/vacuum signal housing assembly and gasket. Discard gasket.
7. Clean gasket mounting surfaces to ensure a good seal.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator
- Electronic > Component Information > Service and Repair > Idle Air Control (IAC) Reset Procedure > Page 2812
NOTE: Use care in cleaning old gasket material from machined aluminum surfaces. Sharp tools
may damage sealing surfaces.
INSTALL OR CONNECT:
1. New idle air/vacuum signal assembly gasket.
2. Idle air/vacuum signal housing assembly.
3. Idle air/vacuum signal housing screws. Tighten idle air/vacuum signal housing screws (starting in
center and moving outward) to 3.4 N-m (30 lb. in.).
4. Measure Distance between tip of IAC valve pintle and mounting flange. If greater than 28 mm, use ringer pressure to slowly retract the pintle. The force required to retract
the pintle of a new valve will not cause damage to the valve.
5. Lubricate IAC valve O-ring with clean engine, oil.
6. IAC valve assembly.
7. Attaching screws. Tighten IAC valve attaching screws to 3.0 N-m (27 lb. in.).
8. IAC valve electrical connector.
9. Vacuum harness connector.
10. Negative battery terminal.
11. Perform the "Idle Learn Procedure." The ECM will need to relearn the IAC valve pintle position
following battery reconnect.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Serial Data <--> [Information
Bus] > Component Information > Testing and Inspection
Serial Data: Testing and Inspection
Serial Data Line Diagnosis (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Serial Data <--> [Information
Bus] > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2816
Serial Data Line Diagnosis (Part 2 Of 2)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
Knock Sensor: Component Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2821
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2822
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE:
The knock sensor is used to detect engine detonation (ping). The ECM will retard the electronic
spark timing based on the signal received.
OPERATION:
The knock sensor detects abnormal vibration in the engine. Then, the knock sensor produces an
AC signal which increases with the severity of the knock. The ECM reads this signal and retards
the timing until the knock is stopped.
LOCATION:
Engine block near the cylinders.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2823
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-5
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 2824
Knock Sensor Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Knock Sensor (KS) is used to detect engine detonation and the PCM will retard the ignition
control timing based on the signal being received. The circuitry, within the knock sensor, causes
the PCMs 5 volts to be pulled down so that under a no knock condition, CKT 496 would measure
about 2.5 volts. The knock sensor produces an AC signal, which rides on the 2.5 volts DC voltage.
The amplitude and frequency are dependent upon the knock level.
The EPROM used with this engine contains the functions which were part of remotely mounted
knock sensor modules used on other GM vehicles. The knock sensor portion of the EPROM then
sends a signal to other parts of the PCM which adjusts the spark timing to retard the spark and
reduce the detonation.
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. With engine idling, there should not be a knock signal present at the PCM, because detonation is
not likely under a no load condition.
2. Tapping on the engine lift bracket should simulate a knock signal to determine if the sensor is
capable of detecting detonation. If no knock is
detected, try tapping on engine block closer to sensor before replacing sensor.
3. If the engine has an internal problem which is creating a knock, the knock sensor may be
responding to the internal failure.
4. This test determines if the knock sensor is faulty or if the KS portion of the EPROM is faulty. If it
is determined that the EPROM is faulty, be sure
that it is properly installed and latched into place. If not properly installed, repair and retest.
Diagnostic Aids:
While observing knock signal on the Tech 1 scan tool, there should be an indication that knock is
present, when detonation can be heard. Detonation is most likely to occur under high engine load
conditions.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Service and Repair
The check "engine lamp", "service engine soon" or "malfunction indiactor" lamp will be illuminated
when the ignition switch is placed in the "ON" position. When the engine is started, the lamp should
go "OFF." If the lamp remains "ON" for 10 seconds or constantly after the engine is started, the self
diagnosis system has detected a problem and has stored a code in the system Electronic Control
Module (ECM/PCM). After diagnosis and repair, the ECM/PCM memory can be cleared of codes
as follows:
Remove the ECM/PCM fuse or disconnect the battery ground cable for approximately 30 seconds,
with ignition switch in the "OFF" position. It should be noted, if battery ground cable is disconnected
to clear codes, components such as clocks, electronically tuned radios etc., will have to be reset.
On vehicles that are equipped as such, the ECM/PCM power feed is connected by a pigtail, in-line
fuse holder, at the positive battery terminal. To clear codes within the ECM/PCM system and
protect the components that need resetting, disconnect the in-line fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Idle 1-2 V
Wide Open Throttle 4.4.8 V
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 2832
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
MAP Sensor Screws 27 in.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2835
Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2838
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2839
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2840
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2841
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2842
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2843
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2844
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2845
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2846
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2847
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2848
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2849
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2850
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2851
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2852
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2853
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2854
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2855
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2856
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2857
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2858
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2859
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2860
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2861
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2862
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2863
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2864
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2865
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2866
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2867
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2868
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2869
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2870
Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2871
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
MAP Sensor
PURPOSE:
The Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor is a pressure sensitive variable resistor. It measures
the changes in the intake manifold pressure which result from engine load and speed changes, and
converts this to a voltage output. The computer uses this voltage output to control fuel delivery and
ignition timing.
The MAP sensor is also used to measure barometric pressure at start up and under certain
conditions, which allows the ECM to automatically adjust for different altitudes.
OPERATION:
The ECM supplies 5 volts to the MAP sensor and monitors the voltage on a signal line. The sensor
provides a path to ground through its variable resistor.
A closed throttle on engine coastdown will produce a relatively low MAP output, while a wide open
throttle will produce a high output. Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) is the opposite of what is
measured on a vacuum gauge. When manifold pressure is high, vacuum is low. A failure in the
MAP sensor circuit should set Diagnostic Trouble Code.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2872
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-1D
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2873
Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor measures the changes in the intake manifold
pressure which result from engine load (intake manifold vacuum) and RPM changes; and converts
these into a voltage output. The PCM sends a 5 volt reference voltage to the MAP sensor. As the
manifold pressure changed, the output voltage of the sensor also changes. By monitoring the
sensor output voltage, the PCM knows the manifold pressure. A lower pressure (low voltage)
output voltage will be about 1-2 volts at idle, while higher pressure (high voltage) output voltage will
be about 4-4.8 at Wide Open Throttle (WOT). The MAP sensor is also used, under certain
conditions, to measure barometric pressure, allowing the PCM to make adjustments for different
altitudes. The PCM used the MAP sensor to control fuel delivery and ignition timing
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
Note: Be sure to use the same diagnostic test equipment for all measurements.
1. When comparing Tech 1 scan tool readings to a known good vehicle, it is important to compare
vehicles that use a MAP sensor having the same
color insert or having the same "Hot Stamped" number.
2. Applying 34 kPa (10" Hg) vacuum to the MAP sensor should cause the voltage to change
Subtract second reading from the first. Voltage value
should be greater than 1.5 volts. Upon applying vacuum to the sensor, the change in voltage
should be instantaneous. A slow voltage change indicates a faulty sensor.
3. Check vacuum hose to sensor for leaking or restriction. Be sure that no other vacuum devices
are connected to the MAP hose.
Note: Make sure electrical connector remains securely fastened.
Diagnostic Aids:
Remove the MAP sensor from its bracket and gently twist sensor (by hand only) while observing
the MAP display on a scan tool. Make sure electrical connector remains securely fastened. This is
a good way to check for intermittent failures. Output fluctuations greater than .1 volt indicate a
faulty sensor.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Memory Calibration Unit >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > PROM/MEMCAL - Identification Marks
Memory Calibration Unit: Technical Service Bulletins PROM/MEMCAL - Identification Marks
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 44-65-01
Date: October, 1994
Subject: New PROM/MEMCAL Identification Markings
Models: 1995 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
Note:
For the purposes of this document, the terms PROM and MEMCAL will be used interchangeably.
To simplify identification of service PROMs. a new external marking format will be implemented.
Parts manufactured after Sept. 1994 will feature these new markings. This change will place the full
8-digit service part number on the PROM, in place of the old 4-digit "EXTERNAL ID" number. In the
past, parts and service personnel could not identify a PROM without using a cross-reference table
that matched external IDs and service numbers. In the future, the cross-reference table will not be
required for PROMs; parts will be ordered directly from the number appearing on the PROM.
However, the label will retain the broadcast code alpha characters to allow continued use of
cross-reference charts, if so desired.
Old Marking Format:
New Marking Format:
^ Ordering the above PROM from the old marking format would require using a cross-reference
chart to determine a service part number, based on the BROAD CAST CODE and EXTERNAL ID
NUMBERS.
^ To order from the new format, simply combine the 2nd and 3rd lines to form an 8-digit part
number that can be directly ordered from SPO (number 16134624 in the above example).
As these changes are phased into the parts inventory, it should be noted that dealers will continue
to see parts with both formats for some time in the future. This is because:
^ Millions of vehicles have already been built with the old format.
^ SPO has existing stock of MEMCALs and PROMs with the old format.
^ PROMS with 7-digit part numbers (representing less than 10% of current part numbers) will
continue to use the old format. The 7-digit part numbers are easily identified because they always
begin with "122xxxx".
Due to manufacturing processes, more than one 8-digit part number may appear on a MEMCAL. In
this event, service personnel should use the label on the exterior cover of the MEMCAL assembly.
To avoid confusion, only the service label will include the BROAD CAST CODE, consisting of letter
characters (I.E., ARCL).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Memory Calibration Unit >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > PROM/MEMCAL - Identification Marks > Page 2878
CHANGES TO MEMCAL/PROM LABELING FORMATS
^ MEMCALs may use either INK-JET or ADHESIVE labels, as shown.
^ PROMs will always use ADHESIVE labels with the same format as shown for MEMCALs. These
changes will become effective on parts manufactured after 10/94.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Quad Driver <--> [Output
Driver] > Component Information > Locations
Quad Driver: Locations
Quad/Output drivers are hard wired onto the ECM/PCM/VCM.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Quad Driver <--> [Output
Driver] > Component Information > Locations > Page 2882
Quad Driver: Description and Operation
Quad/Output Driver Module
The Control Module in this vehicle controls most components with electronic switches which
complete a ground circuit when turned on.
When the switches are arranged in groups of 4, they can independently control up to 4 outputs and
are called Quad Drivers.
When the switches are arranged in groups of 7, they can independently control up to 7 outputs and
are called Output Drivers.
Not all outputs are always used.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Quad Driver <--> [Output
Driver] > Component Information > Locations > Page 2883
Quad Driver: Testing and Inspection
Little or no quad driver testing was supplied by the manufacturer. The engine module decides when
to turn each switch of the driver "ON".
Even though some models will set codes, in the end, if you want to check the driver itself, you'll
need:
1. To use a scantool to command the suspected driver switch to energize (ground) the circuit, while
checking with a test light, 2. To operate the vehicle in a way that should cause the suspected
portion of the driver to switch "ON".
On the up side, since the early 90's, most driver load circuits utilized circuit breakers. This
protected most drivers and engine models from burning up when the circuit was overloaded.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Quad Driver <--> [Output
Driver] > Component Information > Locations > Page 2884
Quad Driver: Service and Repair
Quad/Output drivers are hard wired onto the ECM/PCM/VCM, and can't be serviced separately.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Oxygen Sensors - Silica Contamination
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Oxygen Sensors - Silica Contamination
Model Year: 1981
Bulletin No: 81-I-37
File In Group: 60
Number: 11
Date: Feb. 81
Subject: Silica Contamination of Oxygen Sensors and Gelation of Oil.
Models Affected: All
Oxygen sensor performance can deteriorate if certain RTV silicone gasket materials are used.
Other RTV's when used with certain oils, may cause gelation of the oil. The degree of performance
severity depends on the type of RTV and application of the engine involved.
Therefore, when repairing engines where this item is involved, it is important to use either cork
composition gaskets or RTV silicone gasket material approved for such use. GMS (General Motors
Sealant) or equivalent material can be used. GMS is available through GMPD with the following
part numbers:
1052366 3 oz.
1052434 10.14 oz.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2889
Oxygen Sensor: Specifications
Oxygen Sensor 30 ft.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 2890
Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Oxygen Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2893
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2894
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2895
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2896
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2897
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2898
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2899
Oxygen Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2900
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2901
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2902
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2903
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2904
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2905
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2906
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2907
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2908
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2909
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2910
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2911
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2912
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2913
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2914
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2915
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2916
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2917
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2918
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2919
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2920
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2921
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2922
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2923
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2924
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2925
Oxygen Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2926
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
Exhaust Oxygen Sensor (02)
PURPOSE:
The oxygen (O2) sensor measures the oxygen content of the exhaust. The ECM monitors the
sensor to maintain air/fuel mixture of 14.7 to 1.
OPERATION:
The oxygen sensor monitors atmospheric air versus exhaust gas oxygen content to produce a
voltage output. This voltage ranges from approximately 0.1 volt (high oxygen-lean mixture) to 0.9
volt (low oxygen-rich mixture). By monitoring the oxygen sensor output voltage, the computer can
determine the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas and adjust the air/fuel mixture accordingly, this
is known as "CLOSED LOOP" operation.
When the sensor is cold it is like an open circuit and produces no voltage below 600°F (315°C). An
open sensor circuit or cold sensor causes "OPEN LOOP" operation.
The heated oxygen sensor works in the same manner as the non-heated oxygen sensor. The
exception is that B+ is supplied to a heating unit that is part of the sensor itself. This heater
receives voltage from the generator charging circuit. The heater helps the ECM control the fuel
injection sooner for better fuel emissions. There are no malfunction Codes to detect if the heater
part of the sensor is working.
LOCATION:
Exhaust Manifold
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2927
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
VISUAL INSPECTION:
^ Connectors and wires
^ Housing and insulator for cracks/damage
^ Sensor tip for silicone contamination (white powdery coating)
PERFORMANCE TEST: Checks working range and response (speed).
1. Warm engine.
2. Install DVOM between sensor and ground (2 volt DC range).
3. Run engine at steady cruise speed (about 2500 rpm). Voltage should vary at least eight times in
ten seconds between 0.2 and 0.8 volts (normal range).
4. Drive sensor rich: The use of a properly adjusted propane flow meter (J-26911) is industry
standard. Voltage should increase to at least 0.8 volts within two to three seconds.
5. Drive sensor lean: Create a vacuum leak from a source that is not an ECM input or output.
Voltage should drop to at least 0.3 volts within two to three seconds.
NOTE: After each test the O2 sensor should return to normal operating range within two to three
seconds.
6. O2 Sensor should be replaced for failure to pass any of the tests above.
NOTE: A CEC system that is operating excessively rich or lean will drive the 02 sensor to its
maximum range. The rich or lean condition should be repaired first and not diagnosed as an 02
sensor failure.
7. Reconnect all hoses and electrical connectors. Clear all codes set and retrain idle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2928
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair
CAUTION: The Oxygen sensor uses a permanently attached pigtail and connector. This pigtail
should not be removed from the oxygen sensor. Damage or removal of the pigtail or connector
could affect proper operation of the oxygen sensor.
^ Take care when handling the oxygen sensor. The in-line electrical connector and louvered end
must be kept free of grease, dirt or other contaminants. Also, avoid using cleaning solvents of any
type. DO NOT drop or roughly handle the oxygen sensor.
^ The following procedure should be performed with engine temperature over 120°F otherwise the
oxygen sensor may be difficult to remove.
REMOVAL:
1. Remove negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect electrical connector. 3. Remove oxygen sensor.
NOTE: A special anti-seize compound is used on the oxygen sensor threads. The compound
consists of a liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite will burn away, but the glass beads will
remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New or service sensors will already have the
compound applied to the threads. If a sensor is removed from an engine, and, if for any reason it is
to be reinstalled, the threads must have anti-seize compound applied before reinstallation.
INSTALLATION:
1. Coat the threads of the oxygen sensor with anti-seize compound P/N 5613695, or equivalent if
necessary. 2. Install the sensor in the engine, and tighten to 41 Nm (30 ft lb). 3. Re-connect the
electrical connector. 4. Re-connect the negative battery cable. 5. Before starting engine, perform
IDLE LEARN PROCEDURE.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Center Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 2933
Center Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2934
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation
Power Steering Pressure Switch
PURPOSE
To sense high pressure in the steering box and signal the ECM to adjust the idle speed
accordingly.
OPERATION
The Power Steering Pressure Switch (PSPS) opens during high pressure power steering
situations. When the power steering switch is open, power to the A/C relay is shut "OFF," resulting
in A/C compressor clutch disengagement. Also, a signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM uses this
signal to compensate for the additional engine load by moving the IAC valve.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2935
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-1E
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 2936
Power Steering Pressure Switch Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Power Steering Pressure (PSP) switch is normally open to ground and CKT 495 will be near
the battery voltage.
Turning the steering wheel increases power steering oil pressure and its load on an idling engine.
The pressure switch will close before the load can cause an idle problem.
Closing the switch causes CKT 495 to read less than 1 volt. The PCM will increase the idle air rate
and disengage the A/C relay.
^ A pressure switch that will not close or an open CKT 495 or 450, may cause the engine to stop
when power steering loads are high.
^ A switch that will not open, or a CKT 495 shorted to ground, may affect idle quality and will cause
the A/C relay to be de-energized.
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. Different makes of scan tools may display the state of this switch in different ways. Refer to scan
tool operator's manual to determine how this
input is displayed.
2. Checks to determine if CKT 495 is shorted to ground.
3. This should simulate a closed switch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine
Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage
Engine Control Module: Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Aftermarket Accessory
Usage
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-06-04-054B
Date: November 18, 2010
Subject: Info - Non-GM Parts and Accessories (Aftermarket)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and update to the new U.S. Fixed
Operation Manager (FOM) and Canada Warranty Manager (WM) names. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 04-06-04-054A (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
The recent rise and expansion of companies selling non-GM parts and accessories has made it
necessary to issue this reminder to dealers regarding GM's policy on the use and installation of
these aftermarket components.
When a dealer is performing a repair under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty, they are required to
use only genuine GM or GM-approved parts and accessories. This applies to all warranty repairs,
special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM. Parts and accessories advertised as being "the
same" as parts manufactured by GM, but not sold through GM, do not qualify for use in warranty
repairs, special policy repairs or any repairs paid for by GM.
During a warranty repair, if a GM original equipment part is not available through GM Customer
Care and Aftersales (GM CC&A;), ACDelco(R) distributors, other GM dealers or approved sources,
the dealer is to obtain comparable, non-GM parts and clearly indicate, in detail, on the repair order
the circumstances surrounding why non-GM parts were used. The dealer must give customers
written notice, prior to the sale or service, that such parts or accessories are not marketed or
warranted by General Motors.
It should also be noted that dealers modifying new vehicles and installing equipment, parts and
accessories obtained from sources not authorized by GM are responsible for complying with the
National Traffic and Motor Vehicle Safety Act. Certain non-approved parts or assemblies, installed
by the dealer or its agent not authorized by GM, may result in a change to the vehicle's design
characteristics and may affect the vehicle's ability to conform to federal law. Dealers must fully
understand that non-GM approved parts may not have been validated, tested or certified for use.
This puts the dealer at risk for potential liability in the event of a part or vehicle failure. If a GM part
failure occurs as the result of the installation or use of a non-GM approved part, the warranty will
not be honored.
A good example of non-authorized modification of vehicles is the result of an ever increasing
supply of aftermarket devices available to the customer, which claim to increase the horsepower
and torque of the Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines. These include the addition of, but are not limited to
one or more of the following modifications:
- Propane injection
- Nitrous oxide injection
- Additional modules (black boxes) that connect to the vehicle wiring systems
- Revised engine calibrations downloaded for the engine control module
- Calibration modules which connect to the vehicle diagnostic connector
- Modification to the engine turbocharger waste gate
Although the installation of these devices, or modification of vehicle components, can increase
engine horsepower and torque, they may also negatively affect the engine emissions, reliability
and/or durability. In addition, other powertrain components, such as transmissions, universal joints,
drive shafts, and front/rear axle components, can be stressed beyond design safety limits by the
installation of these devices.
General Motors does not support or endorse the use of devices or modifications that, when
installed, increase the engine horsepower and torque. It is because of these unknown stresses,
and the potential to alter reliability, durability and emissions performance, that GM has adopted a
policy that prevents any UNAUTHORIZED dealer warranty claim submissions to any remaining
warranty coverage, to the powertrain and driveline components whenever the presence of a
non-GM (aftermarket) calibration is confirmed - even if the non-GM control module calibration is
subsequently removed. Refer to the latest version of Bulletin 09-06-04-026 (V8 Gas Engines) or
06-06-01-007 (Duramax(TM) Diesel Engines) for more information on dealer requirements for
calibration verification.
These same policies apply as they relate to the use of non-GM accessories. Damage or failure
from the use or installation of a non-GM accessory will not be covered under warranty. Failure
resulting from the alteration or modification of the vehicle, including the cutting, welding or
disconnecting of the vehicle's original equipment parts and components will void the warranty.
Additionally, dealers will NOT be reimbursed or compensated by GM in the event of any legal
inquiry at either the local, state or federal level that
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine
Controls - Aftermarket Accessory Usage > Page 2942
results from the alteration or modification of a vehicle using non-GM approved parts or accessories.
Dealers should be especially cautious of accessory companies that claim the installation of their
product will not void the factory warranty. Many times these companies have even given direction
on how to quickly disassemble the accessory in an attempt to preclude the manufacturer from
finding out that is has been installed.
Any suspect repairs should be reviewed by the Fixed Operations Manager (FOM), and in Canada
by the Warranty Manager (WM) for appropriate repair direction. If it is decided that a goodwill repair
is to be made on the vehicle, even with the installation of such non-GM approved components, the
customer is to be made aware of General Motors position on this issue and is to sign the
appropriate goodwill documentation required by General Motors.
It is imperative for dealers to understand that by installing such devices, they are jeopardizing not
only the warranty coverage, but also the performance and reliability of the customer's vehicle.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Specifications > PCM Connector C1
(Black)
Engine Control Module: Specifications PCM Connector C1 (Black)
ECM Connector: C1
ECM Connector: C1 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Specifications > PCM Connector C1
(Black) > Page 2945
Engine Control Module: Specifications PCM Connector C2 (Black)
ECM Connector: C2
ECM Connector: C2 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Specifications > PCM Connector C1
(Black) > Page 2946
Engine Control Module: Specifications PCM Connector C3 (Green)
ECM Connector: C3
ECM Connector: C3 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Behind RH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations >
Page 2949
Behind RH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 (Black)
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C1 (Black)
ECM Connector: C1
ECM Connector: C1 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 (Black) > Page 2952
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C2 (Black)
ECM Connector: C2
ECM Connector: C2 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 (Black) > Page 2953
Engine Control Module: Diagrams C3 (Green)
ECM Connector: C3
ECM Connector: C3 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 2954
Engine Control Module: Description and Operation
Computer Module
PURPOSE:
The Electronic Control Module or Powertrain Control Module (ECM/PCM) is the control center of
the fuel injection system. It constantly looks at the information from various sensors (inputs) and
controls the systems (outputs) that affect vehicle performance. The ECM/PCM also performs the
diagnostic function of the system. It can recognize operational problems, alert the driver through
the "SERVICE ENGINE SOON" or "MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LAMP" light, and store a code or
codes which identify the problem areas to aid the technician in performing repairs.
OPERATION:
The computer is designed to process the various input information, and send the necessary
electrical response to control fuel delivery, spark control, and other emission control systems. The
computer can control these devices through the use of Quad Driver Modules (QDM). When the
ECM/PCM is commanding a device or a component "ON," the voltage potential of the output is
"LOW" or near zero volts. When the ECM/PCM is commanding a device or component "OFF," the
voltage potential of the circuit will be "HIGH," or near 12 volts. The primary function of the QDM is
to supply the ground for the component being controlled.
The input information has an interrelation between sensor output. If one of the input devices failed,
such as the oxygen sensor, this could affect more than one of the systems controlled by the
computer.
The computer has a learning ability which allows it to make corrections for minor variations in the
fuel system to improve driveability. If the battery is disconnected to clear trouble codes or for repair,
the learning process has to begin all over again, and a change may be noticed in the driving
performance of the vehicle. To reset the vehicles learning ability, make sure the engine is at
operating temperature and operate the vehicle at part throttle, moderate acceleration, and idle
conditions, until normal performance returns.
This vehicle is equipped with an ECM/PCM with two parts for service, a controller which is the
ECM/PCM itself and a memory calibration unit called a MEM-CAL, PROM, or EPROM.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Pinout
Values and Diagnostic Parameters
Engine Control Module: Pinout Values and Diagnostic Parameters
ECM Connector: C1
ECM Connector: C1 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Pinout
Values and Diagnostic Parameters > Page 2957
ECM Connector: C2
ECM Connector: C2 (Description)
ECM Connector: C3
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Pinout
Values and Diagnostic Parameters > Page 2958
ECM Connector: C3 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Engine Control Module > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 2959
Engine Control Module: Service and Repair
ECM
Remove or Disconnect:
1. Negative battery cable.
2. Interior access panel.
3. Connectors from ECM/PCM.
3. ECM/PCM.
NOTICE: To prevent possible electrostatic discharge damage to the ECM/PCM, Do Not touch the
connector pins or soldered components on the
circuit board.
Install or Connect:
1. New ECM/PCM.
2. ECM connectors to ECM/PCM.
3. Negative battery cable.
4. interior access panel.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Resistance 177 ohms at 212 deg F
241 ohms at 194 deg F
332 ohms at 176 deg F
467 ohms at 158 deg F
667 ohms at 140 deg F
973 ohms at 122 deg F
1188 ohms at 113 deg F
1459 ohms at 104 deg F
1802 ohms at 95 deg F
2238 ohms at 86 deg F
2796 ohms at 77 deg F
3520 ohms at 68 deg F
4450 ohms at 59 deg F
5670 ohms at 50 deg F
7280 ohms at 41 deg F
9420 ohms at 32 deg F
12300 ohms at 23 deg F
16180 ohms at 14 deg F
21450 ohms at 5 deg F
28680 ohms at -4 deg F
52700 ohms at -22 deg F
100700 ohms at -40 deg F
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 2964
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations
Rear Of Engine Compartment
LH rear of engine, on Coolant Outlet
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2967
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2968
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2969
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2970
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2971
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2972
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2973
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2974
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2975
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2976
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2977
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2978
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2979
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2980
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2981
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2982
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2983
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2984
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2985
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2986
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2987
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2988
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2989
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2990
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2991
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2992
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2993
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2994
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2995
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2996
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2997
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2998
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 2999
Coolant Temperature Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 3000
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
PURPOSE
The Engine Coolant Temperature sensor (ECT) is used to control:
^ Fuel delivery
^ Torque Converter Clutch (TCC)
^ Engine Spark Timing (EST)
^ Controlled Canister Purge (CCP)
^ Idle Air Control (IAC)
^ Cooling Fan
OPERATION:
The ECT is a thermistor that is located in the engine coolant flow. When the coolant temperature is
low, the sensor produces a high resistance. When the coolant temperature is high, the sensor
produces a low resistance.
The ECM sends a 5.0 volt signal to the ECT through a resistor in the computer and measures the
voltage. The voltage will be high or low depending on coolant temperature. With the ECT varying
its resistance, the ECM can sense engine coolant temperature by reading the varying voltage.
LOCATION:
Engine thermostat and coolant outlet.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Crankshaft Position Sensor
RH rear of engine, on exhaust manifold
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3004
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Typical DIS Crankshaft Sensor
PURPOSE:
The crankshaft sensor provides a signal through the Direct Ignition (DI), which the ECM uses as
reference to calculate rpm and crankshaft position.
OPERATION:
This sensor protrudes into the block, within approximately .050" of the engine crankshaft reluctor.
The reluctor is a special wheel cast into the crankshaft with seven slots cast into it, six of which are
evenly spaced 60° apart. A seventh slot is spaced 10° from one of the other slots and serves to
generate a "sync pulse." As the reluctor rotates as part of the crankshaft, the slots change the
magnetic field of the sensor, creating an induced voltage pulse.
Based on the crank sensor pulses, the ignition module sends reference signals to the ECM which
are used to indicate crankshaft position and engine speed.
LOCATION:
This sensor is mounted remotely from the ignition module, right hand side of engine, at the end of
the crank shaft.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3005
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Remove or Disconnect
1. Sensor harness connector. 2. Sensor to block bolt. 3. Sensor from engine.
Inspect ^
Sensor O-ring for wear, cracks or leakage. Replace if necessary. Lube new O-ring with engine oil
before installing.
Install or Connect
1. Sensor into hole in block. 2. Sensor to block bolt.
^ Torque to 8 N.m (71 lb. in.).
3. Sensor harness connector.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Resistance 177 ohms at 212 deg F
241 ohms at 194 deg F
332 ohms at 176 deg F
467 ohms at 158 deg F
667 ohms at 140 deg F
973 ohms at 122 deg F
1188 ohms at 113 deg F
1459 ohms at 104 deg F
1802 ohms at 95 deg F
2238 ohms at 86 deg F
2796 ohms at 77 deg F
3520 ohms at 68 deg F
4450 ohms at 59 deg F
5670 ohms at 50 deg F
7280 ohms at 41 deg F
9420 ohms at 32 deg F
12300 ohms at 23 deg F
16180 ohms at 14 deg F
21450 ohms at 5 deg F
28680 ohms at -4 deg F
52700 ohms at -22 deg F
100700 ohms at -40 deg F
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications > Page 3010
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Mechanical Specifications Torque Valve
Torque Valve
Induction Air Sensor 44 in.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3011
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Locations
Top Front Of Engine
(2.2L Shown, Others similar)
Intake Air Temperature Sensor is located LH front of Engine Compartment, on Air Cleaner.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3014
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3015
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3016
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3017
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3018
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3019
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3020
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3021
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3022
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3023
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3024
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3025
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3026
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3027
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3028
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3029
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3030
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3031
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3032
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3033
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3034
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3035
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3036
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3037
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3038
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3039
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3040
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3041
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3042
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3043
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3044
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3045
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3046
Intake Air Temperature Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3047
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Intake Air Temperature Sensor
PURPOSE:
The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor is a thermistor, a variable resistor which changes value
based on temperature, mounted in the air cleaner assembly. The IAT sensor input affects fuel
delivery and ignition timing controls in the ECM.
OPERATION:
The ECM supplies 5 volts to the IAT sensor and monitors the voltage on a signal line. The sensor
provides a path to ground through its thermistor. The voltage will be high when the intake air is cold
and low when the air is hot. By monitoring the voltage, the ECM calculates the intake air
temperature.
Low intake air temperature produces high resistance (100,000 ohms at -40°C/-40°F, while high
temperature causes low resistance (70 ohms at 130 °C/266°F). A failure in the IAT circuit should
set a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) 23/25.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Knock Sensor: Component Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
3052
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3053
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE:
The knock sensor is used to detect engine detonation (ping). The ECM will retard the electronic
spark timing based on the signal received.
OPERATION:
The knock sensor detects abnormal vibration in the engine. Then, the knock sensor produces an
AC signal which increases with the severity of the knock. The ECM reads this signal and retards
the timing until the knock is stopped.
LOCATION:
Engine block near the cylinders.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3054
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-5
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3055
Knock Sensor Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Knock Sensor (KS) is used to detect engine detonation and the PCM will retard the ignition
control timing based on the signal being received. The circuitry, within the knock sensor, causes
the PCMs 5 volts to be pulled down so that under a no knock condition, CKT 496 would measure
about 2.5 volts. The knock sensor produces an AC signal, which rides on the 2.5 volts DC voltage.
The amplitude and frequency are dependent upon the knock level.
The EPROM used with this engine contains the functions which were part of remotely mounted
knock sensor modules used on other GM vehicles. The knock sensor portion of the EPROM then
sends a signal to other parts of the PCM which adjusts the spark timing to retard the spark and
reduce the detonation.
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. With engine idling, there should not be a knock signal present at the PCM, because detonation is
not likely under a no load condition.
2. Tapping on the engine lift bracket should simulate a knock signal to determine if the sensor is
capable of detecting detonation. If no knock is
detected, try tapping on engine block closer to sensor before replacing sensor.
3. If the engine has an internal problem which is creating a knock, the knock sensor may be
responding to the internal failure.
4. This test determines if the knock sensor is faulty or if the KS portion of the EPROM is faulty. If it
is determined that the EPROM is faulty, be sure
that it is properly installed and latched into place. If not properly installed, repair and retest.
Diagnostic Aids:
While observing knock signal on the Tech 1 scan tool, there should be an indication that knock is
present, when detonation can be heard. Detonation is most likely to occur under high engine load
conditions.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Electrical Specifications
Idle 1-2 V
Wide Open Throttle 4.4.8 V
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Electrical Specifications > Page 3060
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
MAP Sensor Screws 27 in.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations
Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 3063
Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3066
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3067
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3068
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3069
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3070
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3071
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3072
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3073
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3074
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3075
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3076
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3077
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3078
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3079
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3080
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3081
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3082
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3083
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3084
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3085
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3086
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3087
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3088
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3089
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3090
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3091
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3092
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3093
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3094
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3095
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3096
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3097
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 3098
Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3099
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
MAP Sensor
PURPOSE:
The Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor is a pressure sensitive variable resistor. It measures
the changes in the intake manifold pressure which result from engine load and speed changes, and
converts this to a voltage output. The computer uses this voltage output to control fuel delivery and
ignition timing.
The MAP sensor is also used to measure barometric pressure at start up and under certain
conditions, which allows the ECM to automatically adjust for different altitudes.
OPERATION:
The ECM supplies 5 volts to the MAP sensor and monitors the voltage on a signal line. The sensor
provides a path to ground through its variable resistor.
A closed throttle on engine coastdown will produce a relatively low MAP output, while a wide open
throttle will produce a high output. Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) is the opposite of what is
measured on a vacuum gauge. When manifold pressure is high, vacuum is low. A failure in the
MAP sensor circuit should set Diagnostic Trouble Code.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3100
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-1D
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3101
Manifold Absolute Pressure Sensor Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor measures the changes in the intake manifold
pressure which result from engine load (intake manifold vacuum) and RPM changes; and converts
these into a voltage output. The PCM sends a 5 volt reference voltage to the MAP sensor. As the
manifold pressure changed, the output voltage of the sensor also changes. By monitoring the
sensor output voltage, the PCM knows the manifold pressure. A lower pressure (low voltage)
output voltage will be about 1-2 volts at idle, while higher pressure (high voltage) output voltage will
be about 4-4.8 at Wide Open Throttle (WOT). The MAP sensor is also used, under certain
conditions, to measure barometric pressure, allowing the PCM to make adjustments for different
altitudes. The PCM used the MAP sensor to control fuel delivery and ignition timing
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
Note: Be sure to use the same diagnostic test equipment for all measurements.
1. When comparing Tech 1 scan tool readings to a known good vehicle, it is important to compare
vehicles that use a MAP sensor having the same
color insert or having the same "Hot Stamped" number.
2. Applying 34 kPa (10" Hg) vacuum to the MAP sensor should cause the voltage to change
Subtract second reading from the first. Voltage value
should be greater than 1.5 volts. Upon applying vacuum to the sensor, the change in voltage
should be instantaneous. A slow voltage change indicates a faulty sensor.
3. Check vacuum hose to sensor for leaking or restriction. Be sure that no other vacuum devices
are connected to the MAP hose.
Note: Make sure electrical connector remains securely fastened.
Diagnostic Aids:
Remove the MAP sensor from its bracket and gently twist sensor (by hand only) while observing
the MAP display on a scan tool. Make sure electrical connector remains securely fastened. This is
a good way to check for intermittent failures. Output fluctuations greater than .1 volt indicate a
faulty sensor.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Oxygen
Sensors - Silica Contamination
Oxygen Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Oxygen Sensors - Silica Contamination
Model Year: 1981
Bulletin No: 81-I-37
File In Group: 60
Number: 11
Date: Feb. 81
Subject: Silica Contamination of Oxygen Sensors and Gelation of Oil.
Models Affected: All
Oxygen sensor performance can deteriorate if certain RTV silicone gasket materials are used.
Other RTV's when used with certain oils, may cause gelation of the oil. The degree of performance
severity depends on the type of RTV and application of the engine involved.
Therefore, when repairing engines where this item is involved, it is important to use either cork
composition gaskets or RTV silicone gasket material approved for such use. GMS (General Motors
Sealant) or equivalent material can be used. GMS is available through GMPD with the following
part numbers:
1052366 3 oz.
1052434 10.14 oz.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3106
Oxygen Sensor: Specifications
Oxygen Sensor 30 ft.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3107
Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Oxygen Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3110
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3111
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3112
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3113
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3114
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3115
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3116
Oxygen Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3117
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3118
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3119
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3120
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3121
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3122
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3123
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3124
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3125
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3126
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3127
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3128
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3129
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3130
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3131
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3132
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3133
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3134
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3135
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3136
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3137
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3138
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3139
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3140
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3141
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3142
Oxygen Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3143
Oxygen Sensor: Description and Operation
Exhaust Oxygen Sensor (02)
PURPOSE:
The oxygen (O2) sensor measures the oxygen content of the exhaust. The ECM monitors the
sensor to maintain air/fuel mixture of 14.7 to 1.
OPERATION:
The oxygen sensor monitors atmospheric air versus exhaust gas oxygen content to produce a
voltage output. This voltage ranges from approximately 0.1 volt (high oxygen-lean mixture) to 0.9
volt (low oxygen-rich mixture). By monitoring the oxygen sensor output voltage, the computer can
determine the amount of oxygen in the exhaust gas and adjust the air/fuel mixture accordingly, this
is known as "CLOSED LOOP" operation.
When the sensor is cold it is like an open circuit and produces no voltage below 600°F (315°C). An
open sensor circuit or cold sensor causes "OPEN LOOP" operation.
The heated oxygen sensor works in the same manner as the non-heated oxygen sensor. The
exception is that B+ is supplied to a heating unit that is part of the sensor itself. This heater
receives voltage from the generator charging circuit. The heater helps the ECM control the fuel
injection sooner for better fuel emissions. There are no malfunction Codes to detect if the heater
part of the sensor is working.
LOCATION:
Exhaust Manifold
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3144
Oxygen Sensor: Testing and Inspection
VISUAL INSPECTION:
^ Connectors and wires
^ Housing and insulator for cracks/damage
^ Sensor tip for silicone contamination (white powdery coating)
PERFORMANCE TEST: Checks working range and response (speed).
1. Warm engine.
2. Install DVOM between sensor and ground (2 volt DC range).
3. Run engine at steady cruise speed (about 2500 rpm). Voltage should vary at least eight times in
ten seconds between 0.2 and 0.8 volts (normal range).
4. Drive sensor rich: The use of a properly adjusted propane flow meter (J-26911) is industry
standard. Voltage should increase to at least 0.8 volts within two to three seconds.
5. Drive sensor lean: Create a vacuum leak from a source that is not an ECM input or output.
Voltage should drop to at least 0.3 volts within two to three seconds.
NOTE: After each test the O2 sensor should return to normal operating range within two to three
seconds.
6. O2 Sensor should be replaced for failure to pass any of the tests above.
NOTE: A CEC system that is operating excessively rich or lean will drive the 02 sensor to its
maximum range. The rich or lean condition should be repaired first and not diagnosed as an 02
sensor failure.
7. Reconnect all hoses and electrical connectors. Clear all codes set and retrain idle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Oxygen Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3145
Oxygen Sensor: Service and Repair
CAUTION: The Oxygen sensor uses a permanently attached pigtail and connector. This pigtail
should not be removed from the oxygen sensor. Damage or removal of the pigtail or connector
could affect proper operation of the oxygen sensor.
^ Take care when handling the oxygen sensor. The in-line electrical connector and louvered end
must be kept free of grease, dirt or other contaminants. Also, avoid using cleaning solvents of any
type. DO NOT drop or roughly handle the oxygen sensor.
^ The following procedure should be performed with engine temperature over 120°F otherwise the
oxygen sensor may be difficult to remove.
REMOVAL:
1. Remove negative battery cable. 2. Disconnect electrical connector. 3. Remove oxygen sensor.
NOTE: A special anti-seize compound is used on the oxygen sensor threads. The compound
consists of a liquid graphite and glass beads. The graphite will burn away, but the glass beads will
remain, making the sensor easier to remove. New or service sensors will already have the
compound applied to the threads. If a sensor is removed from an engine, and, if for any reason it is
to be reinstalled, the threads must have anti-seize compound applied before reinstallation.
INSTALLATION:
1. Coat the threads of the oxygen sensor with anti-seize compound P/N 5613695, or equivalent if
necessary. 2. Install the sensor in the engine, and tighten to 41 Nm (30 ft lb). 3. Re-connect the
electrical connector. 4. Re-connect the negative battery cable. 5. Before starting engine, perform
IDLE LEARN PROCEDURE.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations
Center Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 3150
Center Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3151
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation
Power Steering Pressure Switch
PURPOSE
To sense high pressure in the steering box and signal the ECM to adjust the idle speed
accordingly.
OPERATION
The Power Steering Pressure Switch (PSPS) opens during high pressure power steering
situations. When the power steering switch is open, power to the A/C relay is shut "OFF," resulting
in A/C compressor clutch disengagement. Also, a signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM uses this
signal to compensate for the additional engine load by moving the IAC valve.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3152
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-1E
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 3153
Power Steering Pressure Switch Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Power Steering Pressure (PSP) switch is normally open to ground and CKT 495 will be near
the battery voltage.
Turning the steering wheel increases power steering oil pressure and its load on an idling engine.
The pressure switch will close before the load can cause an idle problem.
Closing the switch causes CKT 495 to read less than 1 volt. The PCM will increase the idle air rate
and disengage the A/C relay.
^ A pressure switch that will not close or an open CKT 495 or 450, may cause the engine to stop
when power steering loads are high.
^ A switch that will not open, or a CKT 495 shorted to ground, may affect idle quality and will cause
the A/C relay to be de-energized.
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. Different makes of scan tools may display the state of this switch in different ways. Refer to scan
tool operator's manual to determine how this
input is displayed.
2. Checks to determine if CKT 495 is shorted to ground.
3. This should simulate a closed switch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
At Closed Throttle < 0.9 V
At Wide Open Throttle 4.7 V
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical
Specifications > Page 3158
Throttle Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor 18 in.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3159
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3162
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3163
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3164
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3165
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3166
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3167
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3168
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3169
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3170
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3171
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3172
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3173
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3174
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3175
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3176
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3177
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3178
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3179
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3180
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3181
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3182
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3183
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3184
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3185
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3186
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3187
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3188
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3189
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3190
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3191
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3192
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3193
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information
and Instructions > Page 3194
Throttle Position Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3195
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Throttle Position Sensor (TPS)
PURPOSE:
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) is a potentiometer that senses throttle angle and sends a signal
to the ECM. This input to the ECM is used to control the fuel system on acceleration and
deceleration.
OPERATION:
The TPS has three internal circuits. One to ground, a second from the ECM as a 5.0 volt reference
source and a third circuit is used by the ECM to measure the output voltage. As the throttle angle
changes (pressing down on accelerator pedal) the TPS voltage output varies from about .5 volt at
idle to about 4.9 volts at wide open throttle (WOT).
LOCATION:
Side of throttle body opposite of throttle lever.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3196
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
N/A: TPS is not adjustable on this engine.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3197
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Throttle Position Sensor
Typical Throttle Body Assembly
REMOVAL:
1. Disconnect the Throttle Position Sensor electrical connector.
2. Remove the Throttle Position Sensor mounting screws.
3. Remove the Throttle Position Sensor.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3198
NOTE: The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) is an electrical component and must not be soaked in
any liquid cleaner or solvent, damage may result.
INSTALLATION:
1. With the throttle valve closed, position the Throttle Position Sensor on the throttle shaft, then
align the screw holes.
2. Install the Throttle Position Sensor screws and tighten to 2.0 N-m (18 lb. in.).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Switch > Component Information > Locations
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 3206
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page
3207
Harness Connector Faces: Park/Neutral Position Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page
3208
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Park/Neutral Switch (Auto. Trans)
PURPOSE:
The PARK/NEUTRAL (P/N) switch indicates to the computer when the transmission is in PARK or
NEUTRAL. This information is used by the ECM for Idle Air Control (IAC), Torque Converter Clutch
(TCC) and Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) operation.
OPERATION:
The P/N switch contacts are a part of the neutral switch and are closed to ground in park or neutral
and open in drive ranges and reverse. The ECM supplies ignition voltage through a current limiting
resistor to the switch and senses a closed circuit when voltage drops to less than 1 volt.
NOTE: DO NOT drive the vehicle with the PARK/NEUTRAL switch disconnected, since idle quality
may be affected.
LOCATION:
Top of transaxle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page
3209
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-1A
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page
3210
Park/Neutral Position Switch Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Park/Neutral Position (PNP) switch contacts shown are a part of the Park/Neutral position
switch and are closed to ground in park or neutral, and open in drive ranges.
The PCM supplies ignition voltage through a pull up resistor to CKT 434 and senses a closed
switch when the voltage on CKT 434 drops to less than one volt.
The PCM uses the PNP signal as one of the inputs to control:
^ Idle speed.
^ VSS diagnostics.
^ EGR.
If CKT 434 indicates PNP (grounded), while in drive range, the EGR would be inoperative, resulting
in possible detonation.
If CKT 434 indicates drive (open) a sag in the idle may occur when the gear selector is moved into
drive range.
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. Checks for a closed switch to ground in park position. Different makes of scan toots will display
the PNP switch differently. Refer to tool
operator's manual for type of display used for a specific tool.
2. Checks for an open switch in drive range.
3. Be sure Tech 1 scan tool indicates drive, even while wiggling shifter, to test for an intermittent or
misadjusted switch in drive range.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Component Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations >
Page 3215
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Connector Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3216
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
The Vehicle Speed Sensor is a gear-driven Permanent Magnet Generator housed in the vehicle's
transaxle. This sensor generates a sine wave output with a frequency proportional to vehicle
speed. The Engine Control Module (ECM) converts this signal to an output that is switched to
ground at a frequency of 4000 pulses per mile at the DK GRN (389) wire output. This output is
pulled up to 5 volts or greater by the components that use these speed signals as input.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures
Symptom Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 3219
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Test A: Speedometer Is Inaccurate
1. Connect a Scan Tool to the DLC Connector. Drive the vehicle. Observe the Speedometer and
compare it to the vehicle speed shown on the Scan
Tool.
^ If both the Speedometer and Scan Tool display the same approximate speed, check for correct
tire size, ECM MEM-CAL and Vehicle Speed Sensor.
^ If the Scan Tool and Speedometer do not display the same approximate speed, replace or
exchange the Instrument Cluster (Refer to Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators).
ALTERNATE TEST
^ If the Kent Moore Tool J 38522 is available, do the following test.
2. Connect a Scan Tool to the DLC connector. Disconnect the Vehicle Speed Sensor connector.
Connect a lead between the J 38522 vehicle speed
generator's red output terminal and the Vehicle Speed Sensor connector terminal A (LT BLU).
Connect a lead between the J 38522 generator's black output and terminal B (DK GRN/WHT). Plug
the generator into the Cigar Lighter. Select 30 V P-P sine wave and set the frequency at 600hz.
Observe the Speedometer and compare to the vehicle speed shown on the Scan Tool.
^ If both the Speedometer and Scan Tool display the same approximate speed, check for correct
tire size, ECM MEM-CAL and Vehicle Speed Sensor.
^ If the Scan Tool and Speedometer do not display the same approximate speed, replace or
exchange the Instrument Cluster (Refer to Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators).
See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators
Test B: Speed Signal Test
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom
Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 3220
Test C: Speed Out Put Test
Speed Signal Test
The Vehicle Speed Sensor is a gear-driven Permanent Magnet Generator housed in the vehicle's
transaxle. This sensor generates a sine wave output with a frequency proportional to vehicle
speed. The Engine Control Module (ECM) converts this signal to an output that is switched to
ground at a frequency of 4000 pulses per mile at the DK GRN (389) wire output. This output is
pulled up to 5 volts or greater by the components that use these speed signals as input.
System Diagnosis
^ If referred here from Cruise Control, do Test B. See: Diagnostic Tests/Test B: Speed Signal Test
^ Refer to Symptom Table for listed symptoms and refer Diagnostic Tests for Diagnostic
procedures. See: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures See: Diagnostic Tests
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
At Closed Throttle < 0.9 V
At Wide Open Throttle 4.7 V
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 3225
Throttle Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor 18 in.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3226
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3229
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3230
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3231
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3232
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3233
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3234
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3235
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3236
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3237
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3238
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3239
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3240
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3241
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3242
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3243
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3244
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3245
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3246
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3247
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3248
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3249
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3250
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3251
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3252
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3253
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3254
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3255
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3256
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3257
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3258
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3259
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3260
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3261
Throttle Position Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3262
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Throttle Position Sensor (TPS)
PURPOSE:
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) is a potentiometer that senses throttle angle and sends a signal
to the ECM. This input to the ECM is used to control the fuel system on acceleration and
deceleration.
OPERATION:
The TPS has three internal circuits. One to ground, a second from the ECM as a 5.0 volt reference
source and a third circuit is used by the ECM to measure the output voltage. As the throttle angle
changes (pressing down on accelerator pedal) the TPS voltage output varies from about .5 volt at
idle to about 4.9 volts at wide open throttle (WOT).
LOCATION:
Side of throttle body opposite of throttle lever.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3263
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
N/A: TPS is not adjustable on this engine.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3264
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Throttle Position Sensor
Typical Throttle Body Assembly
REMOVAL:
1. Disconnect the Throttle Position Sensor electrical connector.
2. Remove the Throttle Position Sensor mounting screws.
3. Remove the Throttle Position Sensor.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3265
NOTE: The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) is an electrical component and must not be soaked in
any liquid cleaner or solvent, damage may result.
INSTALLATION:
1. With the throttle valve closed, position the Throttle Position Sensor on the throttle shaft, then
align the screw holes.
2. Install the Throttle Position Sensor screws and tighten to 2.0 N-m (18 lb. in.).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Switch >
Component Information > Locations
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3273
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3274
Harness Connector Faces: Park/Neutral Position Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3275
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Park/Neutral Switch (Auto. Trans)
PURPOSE:
The PARK/NEUTRAL (P/N) switch indicates to the computer when the transmission is in PARK or
NEUTRAL. This information is used by the ECM for Idle Air Control (IAC), Torque Converter Clutch
(TCC) and Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) operation.
OPERATION:
The P/N switch contacts are a part of the neutral switch and are closed to ground in park or neutral
and open in drive ranges and reverse. The ECM supplies ignition voltage through a current limiting
resistor to the switch and senses a closed circuit when voltage drops to less than 1 volt.
NOTE: DO NOT drive the vehicle with the PARK/NEUTRAL switch disconnected, since idle quality
may be affected.
LOCATION:
Top of transaxle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3276
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-1A
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3277
Park/Neutral Position Switch Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Park/Neutral Position (PNP) switch contacts shown are a part of the Park/Neutral position
switch and are closed to ground in park or neutral, and open in drive ranges.
The PCM supplies ignition voltage through a pull up resistor to CKT 434 and senses a closed
switch when the voltage on CKT 434 drops to less than one volt.
The PCM uses the PNP signal as one of the inputs to control:
^ Idle speed.
^ VSS diagnostics.
^ EGR.
If CKT 434 indicates PNP (grounded), while in drive range, the EGR would be inoperative, resulting
in possible detonation.
If CKT 434 indicates drive (open) a sag in the idle may occur when the gear selector is moved into
drive range.
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. Checks for a closed switch to ground in park position. Different makes of scan toots will display
the PNP switch differently. Refer to tool
operator's manual for type of display used for a specific tool.
2. Checks for an open switch in drive range.
3. Be sure Tech 1 scan tool indicates drive, even while wiggling shifter, to test for an intermittent or
misadjusted switch in drive range.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Component Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3282
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Connector Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3283
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
The Vehicle Speed Sensor is a gear-driven Permanent Magnet Generator housed in the vehicle's
transaxle. This sensor generates a sine wave output with a frequency proportional to vehicle
speed. The Engine Control Module (ECM) converts this signal to an output that is switched to
ground at a frequency of 4000 pulses per mile at the DK GRN (389) wire output. This output is
pulled up to 5 volts or greater by the components that use these speed signals as input.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Symptom Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 3286
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Test A: Speedometer Is Inaccurate
1. Connect a Scan Tool to the DLC Connector. Drive the vehicle. Observe the Speedometer and
compare it to the vehicle speed shown on the Scan
Tool.
^ If both the Speedometer and Scan Tool display the same approximate speed, check for correct
tire size, ECM MEM-CAL and Vehicle Speed Sensor.
^ If the Scan Tool and Speedometer do not display the same approximate speed, replace or
exchange the Instrument Cluster (Refer to Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators).
ALTERNATE TEST
^ If the Kent Moore Tool J 38522 is available, do the following test.
2. Connect a Scan Tool to the DLC connector. Disconnect the Vehicle Speed Sensor connector.
Connect a lead between the J 38522 vehicle speed
generator's red output terminal and the Vehicle Speed Sensor connector terminal A (LT BLU).
Connect a lead between the J 38522 generator's black output and terminal B (DK GRN/WHT). Plug
the generator into the Cigar Lighter. Select 30 V P-P sine wave and set the frequency at 600hz.
Observe the Speedometer and compare to the vehicle speed shown on the Scan Tool.
^ If both the Speedometer and Scan Tool display the same approximate speed, check for correct
tire size, ECM MEM-CAL and Vehicle Speed Sensor.
^ If the Scan Tool and Speedometer do not display the same approximate speed, replace or
exchange the Instrument Cluster (Refer to Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators).
See: Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators
Test B: Speed Signal Test
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 3287
Test C: Speed Out Put Test
Speed Signal Test
The Vehicle Speed Sensor is a gear-driven Permanent Magnet Generator housed in the vehicle's
transaxle. This sensor generates a sine wave output with a frequency proportional to vehicle
speed. The Engine Control Module (ECM) converts this signal to an output that is switched to
ground at a frequency of 4000 pulses per mile at the DK GRN (389) wire output. This output is
pulled up to 5 volts or greater by the components that use these speed signals as input.
System Diagnosis
^ If referred here from Cruise Control, do Test B. See: Diagnostic Tests/Test B: Speed Signal Test
^ Refer to Symptom Table for listed symptoms and refer Diagnostic Tests for Diagnostic
procedures. See: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures See: Diagnostic Tests
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Locations
Catalytic Converter: Locations
Exhaust System
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3292
Converter Attachment (w/Flange And Clamp)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3293
Catalytic Converter: Description and Operation
Converter Types
CAUTION: Prolonged operation with a misfiring or flooded engine may cause the converter to
overheat. This could cause damage either to the catalyst itself or the operating vehicle and
possible personal injury.
NOTE: When jacking or lifting vehicle from frame side rails, be certain lift pads DO NOT contact
catalytic converter otherwise damage to converter may result.
PURPOSE:
The Catalytic Converter (CAT) is an emission control device added to the exhaust system to
effectively reduce the levels of carbon monoxide, hydrocarbons, and in some cases oxides of
nitrogen, exiting the tailpipe.
OPERATION:
The CAT allows for a faster chemical reaction to take place and although it enters into the chemical
reaction, it remains unchanged, ready to repeat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3294
the process. This device sometimes requires the use of heat shields, due to its high operating
temperatures. The heat shields are necessary to protect chassis components, passenger
compartment, and other areas from heat related damage.
CONSTRUCTION:
General Motors uses four different converter designs in conjunction with two types of catalysts. The
four converter designs are:
1. Single bed monolith
2. Dual bed monolith
3. Single bed pellet
4. Dual bed pellet
The two types of catalysts used are an Oxidation catalyst and a Three-Way (Oxidation/Reduction)
catalyst. The Oxidation catalyst is coated with a material containing platinum and palladium which
lowers levels of carbon monoxide and hydrocarbons. The Three-Way (Oxidation/Reduction)
catalyst is coated with platinum and rhodium which lowers levels of oxides of nitrogen (NOx), as
well as carbon monoxide and hydrocarbons. All dual bed converters, whether monolith or pellet
type, contain both oxidation and three-way catalysts.
A small diameter fuel tank filler neck is used on catalytic converter equipped vehicles to prevent the
use of leaded fuel pump nozzles. Since the use of leaded fuels, or fuel additives containing lead,
contaminates the catalysts, rendering the catalyst ineffective, the use of unleaded fuels is
mandatory on catalytic converter equipped vehicles.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Catalytic Converter > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3295
Catalytic Converter: Testing and Inspection
RESTRICTED EXHAUST TEST
Proper diagnosis for a restricted exhaust system is essential before any components are replaced.
The following procedure(s) may be used for diagnosis:
Exhaust System Test at Oxygen Sensor
CHECK AT 02 SENSOR:
1. Carefully remove O2 sensor.
2. Install Exhaust Backpressure Tester in place of 02 sensor.
3. After completing the diagnosis described below, be sure to coat threads of 02 sensor with
anti-seize compound prior to re-installation.
DIAGNOSIS:
1. With the engine idling at normal operating temperature, transaxle in park or neutral, observe the
exhaust system backpressure reading on the gauge. The reading should not exceed .5 psi or 3.4
kPa. Increase engine speed to 3000 rpm and observe gauge. The reading should not exceed .75
psi or 5 kPa.
2. If the backpressure exceeds the given specifications, a restricted exhaust system is indicated.
3. Inspect the entire exhaust system for a collapsed pipe, heat distress, or possible internal muffler
failure.
4. If there are no obvious reasons for the excessive backpressure, a restricted catalytic converter
should be suspected, and replaced.
THERMAL TEST
Use a pyrometer to measure the temperature difference between the inlet and outlet. A warm and
properly working catalytic converter will show about 100 degrees hotter at the outlet. NOTE: A fuel
system that is running rich will not produce a catalyst and will indicate little or no temperature
variation.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Canister Purge Control Valve: Component Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Control Valve > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3301
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Locations
RH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 3305
Canister Purge Solenoid: Description and Operation
Canister Purge Solenoid Normally Closed
PURPOSE:
The Canister Purge Solenoid is controlled by the ECM/PCM and allows manifold and/or ported
vacuum to purge the fuel evaporative cannister when energized.
OPERATION:
The ECM/PCM operates a Pulse Width Modulated (PWM) solenoid to control vacuum to purge the
canister. Under cold engine or idle conditions, the solenoid is turned "OFF" or "ON" by the
ECM/PCM, depending on if it is a normally open or normally closed solenoid. This blocks or allows
vacuum to the canister. The ECM/PCM may turn "ON" or "OFF" the solenoid valve and allow purge
when the following conditions are met.
^ Engine coolant temperature above a certain temperature.
^ After the engine has been running a specified amount of time.
In some cases the ECM/PCM may also look for these conditions in addition to those listed above in
order to purge the canister.
^ Above a specified road speed.
^ Above a specified throttle opening.
^ Ignition "ON," engine stopped, diagnostic terminal grounded.
The ECM/PCM also uses input from the 02 sensor to regulate purging of the canister. The
ECM/PCM also has diagnostic capabilities to set a Code 26 in the event of a disconnected or
shorted wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 3306
Canister Purge Solenoid: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-3
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Canister Purge Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Page 3307
Canister Purge Solenoid Valve Circuit
Circuit Description:
Canister purge is controlled by a solenoid that allows manifold vacuum to purge the EVAP canister
when deenergized. The PCM supplies a ground to energize the solenoid (purge "OFF"). The EVAP
canister purge solenoid valve controlled by the PCM is pulse width modulated (turned "ON" and
"OFF" several times a second). The duty cycle (pulse width) is determined by the amount of air
flow, and the engine vacuum as determined by the MAP sensor input.
The duty cycle is calculated by the PCM and the output commanded when the following conditions
have been met:
^ Engine run time after start more than 3 minutes.
^ Coolant temperature greater than 80°C.
^ Vehicle speed greater than 15 mph
^ Throttle "OFF" idle.
Also, if the diagnostic "test" terminal is grounded, with the key "ON" and engine "OFF," the EVAP
purge solenoid is de-energized (purge "ON").
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. Checks to see if the solenoid is opened or closed. The solenoid is normally energized in this
step; so it should be closed.
2. Checks for a complete circuit. Normally, there is ignition voltage on CKT 39 and the PCM
provides a ground on CKT 428.
3. Completes functional check by grounding "test" terminal. This should normally de-energize the
solenoid opening the valve which should allow the
vacuum to drop (purge "ON").
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Evaporative Emissions System >
Evaporative Canister Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair
Evaporative Canister Filter: Service and Repair
NOTE: NOT ALL EVAPORATIVE EMISSION CONTROL CANISTERS HAVE A SERVICEABLE
FILTER.
At intervals recommended, usually every 24 months or 30,000 miles, the filter on an open bottom
canister should be replaced,
1. Remove all hoses from the top of the canister and mark. Remove the canister.
2. Remove the filter element by squeezing it out from under the lip surface at bottom of canister
and from under retainer bar, where used.
3. Squeeze the new element under retainer bar, where used, and position it evenly around the
entire bottom of the canister. Tuck the edges under the lip of canister.
4. Reinstall the canister to its original position on the vehicle, following normal service procedures.
5. Reconnect the hoses to the top of the canister, according to the labeling on top of canister.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Specifications
EGR Valve: Specifications
EGR Valve Bolts (2 No.s) 22 ft.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3317
Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Locations > Page 3318
Harness Connector Faces: Digital Exhaust Gas Recirculation (DEGR) Assembly
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Locations > Page 3319
EGR Valve: Description and Operation
EGR Valve (Digital)
PURPOSE
The exhaust gas recirculation (EGR) system is used to reduce oxides of nitrogen (NOx) emissions.
The atmosphere is made up of mostly Nitrogen, with a smaller percentage of oxygen, and a
mixture of other gases. Oxygen and Nitrogen do not normally combine except at very high
temperatures and pressures, conditions which are present in the combustion chamber especially
during hard acceleration. When the engine is under load, the EGR valve admits a small amount of
exhaust gas into the intake manifold to mix with the air/fuel charge. The exhaust gas is essentially
inert (contains no fuel or oxidizer) and reduces peak combustion temperatures and pressures by
absorbing some of the heat of combustion without participating in the actual burn. Greater amounts
of exhaust gas are metered in as engine speed and load are increased.
The digitally controlled EGR valve is designed to accurately supply regulated amounts of exhaust
gas to the intake manifold, independent of manifold vacuum.
OPERATION
EGR solenoid valves get battery power when the ignition is turned "ON" and become energized
when the control module completes the circuit to ground. When a solenoid is energized, the
armature, with attached shaft and swivel pintle, is lifted and the orifice is opened. Three solenoid
valves control exhaust gas flow from the exhaust to the intake manifold through three orifices, to
produce seven combinations of EGR flow. The valves should only open when the engine is at
operating temperature, above idle speed and a vehicle speed present.
The ECM uses the information from the the following sensors to control the flow:
1. Coolant temperature (CTS)
2. Throttle Position Sensor (TPS)
3. Mass Air Flow (MAF) or Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP)
CONSTRUCTION
The pintles that close the EGR orifices are attached to the solenoid shafts with swivels. The swivel
pintle feature insures good sealing of the exhaust gas flow, reducing the need for critical assembly
alignment. The effects of EGR leakage on idle quality are reduced because the shaft and seals are
exposed to the exhaust pressure instead of manifold vacuum. The shafts are sealed from the
exhaust chamber by floating seals held in place by the seal spring. These springs also hold the
upper seals of the armature cavity in the solenoids. The solenoid coils are fastened together to
maximize reliability and to
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Locations > Page 3320
seal the coils from the environment. The coils use a common power terminal with individual ground
terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Exhaust Gas Recirculation > EGR
Valve > Component Information > Locations > Page 3321
EGR Valve: Service and Repair
Digital EGR Valve
REMOVAL:
- Remove electrical connector at solenoid.
- Remove two base flange bolts and EGR.
INSTALLATION:
- Install EGR and flange bolts finger tight.
- Tighten the long bolt first to 15 Nm (11 ft lbs). Then, tighten the short bolt to 15 Nm (11 ft lbs).
Repeat sequence to 30 Nm (22 ft lbs).
- Re-connect electrical connector at solenoid.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Fillpipe Restrictor > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Fillpipe Restrictor: Description and Operation
Fuel Door And Restrictor (Typical)
PURPOSE:
To prevent refueling with leaded fuel, the fuel filter neck has a built-in restrictor and deflector. The
opening in the restrictor will accept only the smaller unleaded gasoline fuel nozzle which must be
fully inserted to bypass the deflector.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Crankcase Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair
Crankcase Filter: Service and Repair
The PCV system should be checked every 15,000 miles and also during regular engine tune-ups. If
the PCV system includes a breather filter, located in the air cleaner housing, this filter should be
replaced whenever the PCV valve or air cleaner is replaced. When a periodic inspection indicates
the PCV is not functioning properly, it should be serviced by replacement only.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Emission Control Systems > Positive Crankcase Ventilation >
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve > Component Information > Service and Repair
Positive Crankcase Ventilation Valve: Service and Repair
The PCV system should be checked every 15,000 miles and also during regular engine tune-ups. If
the PCV system includes a breather filter, located in the air cleaner housing, this filter should be
replaced whenever the PCV valve or air cleaner is replaced. When a periodic inspection indicates
the PCV is not functioning properly, it should be serviced by replacement only.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > Diagnostic
Connector - Fuel Pump > Component Information > Locations
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > Fuel Pressure
Test Port > Component Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Test Port: Service and Repair
Area around fuel pressure connection with GM X-30A or equivalent.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT:
1. Negative battery terminal.
2. Relieve fuel system pressure.
3. Fuel pressure connection and seal. Discard seal.
INSTALL OR CONNECT:
1. New seal on fuel pressure connection.
2. Fuel pressure connection in fuel rail. Tighten Fuel pressure connection assembly to 10.0 N-m
(88 lb. in.).
3. Tighten fuel filler cap.
4. Negative battery terminal.
5. Turn ignition switch to the "ON" position for two seconds, then turn to the "OFF" position for ten
seconds. Again turn to the "ON" position, and check for fuel leaks.
6. Perform the "Idle Learn Procedure." The ECM will need to relearn the IAC valve pintle position
following battery reconnect.
Air Plenum And Fuel Rail Removal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure > Fuel Pressure
Test Port > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3340
Fuel Pressure Connection
REMOVAL:
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Relieve the fuel system pressure, see FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELIEF:
3. Remove intake manifold plenum, see INTAKE MANIFOLD PLENUM.
4. Clean area around the fuel pressure connection with GM X-30A or equivalent.
5. Remove the fuel pressure connection and seal, discard the seal.
INSTALLATION:
1. Place a new seal on the fuel pressure connection assembly.
2. Screw the fuel pressure connection assembly into the fuel rail and tighten to 10.0 N-m (88 lb.
in.).
3. Check for fuel leaks: a.
Connect the negative battery cable.
b. With engine "OFF" and ignition "ON," check for fuel leaks.
c. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
4. Install the intake manifold plenum as per above procedure.
IDLE LEARN PROCEDURE: Any time the battery is disconnected, the programmed position of the
IAC valve pintle is lost, and replaced with a default value. To return the IAC valve pintle to the
correct position, perform the following procedure:
1. After restoring battery power, connect the Tech 1 "SCAN" tool.
2. Select "IAC SYSTEM," then select "IDLE LEARN" in the "MISC TEST" mode.
3. Proceed with idle learn as directed.
^ This procedure allows the ECM memory to be updated with the correct IAC valve pintle position,
for the vehicle, and provide a stable idle speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Release >
System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
WARNING: To reduce the risk of fire and personal injury, it is necessary to relieve the fuel system
pressure before servicing fuel system components.
After relieving system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing fuel lines
or connections. In order to reduce the chance of personal injury, cover fuel line fittings with a shop
towel before disconnecting, to catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved
container when disconnect is completed.
When servicing the fuel system use the following precautions:
a. Put a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the workshop.
b. Be sure shop is supplied with an adequate fire extinguisher.
c. Be sure to disconnect the negative battery cable before any service work is done.
d. Use a suitable container to catch any fuel that may leak from system during service.
e. Always relieve fuel system pressure before disconnecting any lines.
f. If the key must be turned "ON" while servicing fuel system, always disconnect or disable ignition,
to insure no sparks occur near fuel vapors.
PROCEDURE:
Tool required: J34730-1 Fuel Pressure Gauge or equivalent.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable, to avoid fuel pump turn "ON," if an accidental attempt is
made to start the engine.
2. Loosen the fuel filler cap to relieve tank vapor pressure.
3. Connect the fuel pressure gauge to the pressure connection. Wrap a shop towel around the
fitting while connecting the gauge to avoid spillage.
4. Install bleed hose into an approved container and open the valve to bleed the system pressure.
Fuel connections are now safe for servicing.
5. Drain any fuel remaining in the gauge into an approved container.
When repair to the fuel system has been completed, START the engine and check all connections
that were loosened for leaks.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed > System
Information > Specifications
Idle Speed: Specifications
The idle speed is computer controlled and there is no provision for adjustment. If idle speed is
incorrect, refer to Computers and Control Systems / System Diagnosis.
MINIMUM IDLE SPEED
Transmission Gear Idle Speed IAC Counts Open/Closed Loop (2)
N/A N/A (1) 10-20 CL
(1) No idle speed specifications are provided for this vehicle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed > System
Information > Specifications > Page 3347
Idle Speed: Adjustments
The ECM controls idle speed and no adjustment should be attempted.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Controls <-->
[Accelerator Pedal] > Component Information > Service and Repair
Accelerator Controls: Service and Repair
Accelerator Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Controls <-->
[Accelerator Pedal] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3351
Accelerator Cable Underhood
ACCELERATOR CONTROL CABLE
Remove or Disconnect:
1. Left sound insulator.
2. Release cable retainer from lever assembly.
3. Depress cable tangs and push forward toward engine compartment.
4. Clip from throttle lever.
5. Depress tangs on cable trough cable bracket.
Install or Connect:
1. Route cable through cable bracket.
2. Press cable upward through bracket making sure tangs expand and properly seat.
3. Route cable through cowl.
4. Slip accelerator cable through slot in rod and then install retainer in rod, being sure it is seated.
Inspect:
Check for correct opening and closing positions by operating accelerator pedal. Make sure that the
throttle valve reaches wide-open throttle position. If it does not, inspect for damaged or bent
brackets, levers, or other components; or, for poor carpet fit under the accelerator pedal.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Controls <-->
[Accelerator Pedal] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3352
Flexible components (hoses, wires, conduits, etc.) must not be routed within 50 mm (2.0 in.) of
moving parts of accelerator linkage outboard of support unless routing is positively controlled.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Filter Element: >
04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: Customer Interest Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Filter Element: >
04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 3362
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Air Filter Element: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Filter Element: >
04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 3368
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Diagnostic Connector - Fuel
Pump > Component Information > Locations
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fillpipe Restrictor >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Fillpipe Restrictor: Description and Operation
Fuel Door And Restrictor (Typical)
PURPOSE:
To prevent refueling with leaded fuel, the fuel filter neck has a built-in restrictor and deflector. The
opening in the restrictor will accept only the smaller unleaded gasoline fuel nozzle which must be
fully inserted to bypass the deflector.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 93966C > Feb > 93 > Fuel System - Factors That Affect
Economy/Mileage
Fuel: Customer Interest Fuel System - Factors That Affect Economy/Mileage
Number: 93-96-6C
Section: 6C
Date: FEB. 1993
Corporate Bulletin No.: 306502
ASE No.: A1, A8
Subject: FACTORS THAT AFFECT FUEL ECONOMY
Model and Year: ALL YEARS ALL MODELS
BACKGROUND INFORMATION:
EPA fuel economy estimates are posted on the fuel economy label of all new vehicles. The only
intended use of these values is for comparison among the different vehicles. Fuel economy
estimates are generated from data taken during a laboratory test using pre-production prototype
vehicles under extremely controlled conditions using a professional driver, with the vehicle
operating on an instrument similar to a treadmill. The comparisons of current vehicle fuel economy
to the EPA fuel economy estimates is a misuse of the information and should be discouraged.
The EPA GAS MILEAGE GUIDE, available at each dealership, points out that the actual mileage
when driving a vehicle may differ considerably from the estimated mileage. The guide also
describes how vehicles are tested under identical conditions to insure the results can be compared
with confidence.
The EPA GAS MILEAGE GUIDE also points out that city fuel economy estimate simulates a 7.5
mile, stop-and-go trip with an average speed of 20 mph. The trip takes 23 minutes and has 18
stops. About 18 percent of the time is spent idling, as in waiting at traffic lights or in rush hour
traffic. Two kinds of engine starts are used - the cold start, which is similar to starting a car in the
morning after it has been parked all night - and the hot start, similar to restarting a vehicle after it
has been warmed up, driven and stopped for a short time.
The test to determine the highway fuel economy estimate represents a mixture of "non-city" driving.
Segments corresponding to different kinds of rural roads and interstate highways are included. The
test simulates a 10 mile trip and averages 48 mph. The test is run from a hot start and has little
idling time and no stops.
The EPA GAS MILEAGE GUIDE explains that the actual test results are adjusted downward to
arrive at the estimates used in the booklet and on the labels. City estimates are lowered by 10
percent and the highway estimate by 22 percent from the laboratory test results. The guide also
points out that traveling at higher speeds lowers fuel economy and traveling at 65 mph instead of
55 mph lowers fuel economy over 15 percent.
FACTORS THAT AFFECT FUEL ECONOMY:
Axle Ratio
Numerically lower axle ratios generally produce better highway fuel economy. The exception to this
is if the engine is "working" exceptionally hard, (heavy vehicle loads pulling a trailer, small engine in
a large vehicle ... ). In these cases a numerically higher axle may provide better fuel economy.
Numerically higher axle ratios will also tend to provide more fuel economy in congested city traffic
and stop and go conditions.
Brakes
Brake drag (even a minimal amount undetectable by coasting), can have a significant negative
impact on fuel economy. Pull upward on the brake pedal to assure that the stoplight switch and
cruise switch at the brake pedal are full and properly adjusted. A "click" sound when the pedal is
pulled upward indicates that the switch was improperly adjusted. This causes the front brake pads
to lightly rub the rotors, causing a fuel economy loss, without generating excessive heat or brake
pad wear.
Driving Habits
Frequent short trips (less than 5 miles), especially in cooler ambient temperatures (less than 65
degrees), will necessitate fuel enrichment on start-ups, especially after "soaks" with the engine off
for approximately a half hour or more.
Frequent accelerator pedal movement while driving will reduce fuel economy because of fuel
enrichment during the periods of acceleration. Under such driving conditions the torque converter
clutch (TCC) also disengages, contributing to fuel economy losses. Prolonged idle periods reduce
fuel economy especially in cold ambients when vehicle is allowed to "Warm up".
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 93966C > Feb > 93 > Fuel System - Factors That Affect
Economy/Mileage > Page 3383
Fuels
Oxygenated fuels, with methanol and/or ethanol blended into the gasoline have lower energy and
thus reduce fuel economy. Typically there is about a 1 MPG penalty for a vehicle which gets 25 to
30 MPG on 100 percent gasoline.
Using fuels of a lower octane than the vehicle was calibrated to will cause increased "KS" Knock
Sensor system activity. This will result in a net decrease in spark advance and thus poorer fuel
economy. Using fuel of a higher octane than the vehicle was calibrated for WILL NOT increase fuel
economy.
Variations in how much fuel is added to the fuel tank during re-fueling can greatly affect calculated
fuel economy. These effects decrease as the distance traveled and the number of tank fillups
increase.
Green Engine
New vehicles have not yet had an opportunity for the engine to break in, (rings to seat ... ). A typical
engine will take 3 to 5 thousand miles to break in and during this time period a gradual increase in
fuel economy can be expected.
Parasitic Loads
Air conditioning and/or electrical loads, (headlights, heated backglass ... ) also result in lower fuel
economy, (typically less than 1 MPG difference, each 10 AMPs takes approximately .4 MPG).
Road Conditions
Road surface condition impacts fuel economy. Gravel and/or pot holed roads decrease fuel
economy. Hills (vs. level terrain) also negatively impact fuel economy. Even gradual unperceptible
increases in elevation result in real measurable decreases in fuel economy. Similarly, driving in the
rain or snow decreases fuel economy.
Suspension
Vehicle suspension misalignment can cause poor fuel economy. Check all four tires for abnormal
and/or premature tire wear.
New tires, tire rotation, and/or front end alignment may be required to correct fuel economy.
Tires
Performance tires and/or tires with larger "contact areas," (like 60 series aspect ratio), can cause
as much as 3 MPG lower fuel economy when compared to hard "thin" tires. Find out if the tire size
currently on the car is the same as original equipment. Replacement tires tailor than original
equipment tires cause the odometer to read LESS THAN actual distance traveled. This will result in
lower calculated fuel economy than actual fuel economy.
Tire Pressure
Harder tires, (more air pressure, or different tire compositions) result in better fuel economy. Do not
exceed maximum pressure as labeled on the tire, typically 30-35 psi. The disadvantage of this is
that the greater the tire pressure, the harsher the vehicle ride.
Transmission
On 4-Speed automatics, it is possible to drive the vehicle in 3rd gear rather than "overdrive" and
not perceive it. Typically this condition occurs when the shift indicator, or the shift linkage/detent is
misadjusted. Misadjusted shift linkage can also result in improper signals to the ECM, which can
result in less spark advance, and results in a drop in fuel economy.
Driving a vehicle in 3rd gear rather than overdrive at highway speeds typically results in a 3 to 5
MPG penalty.
Torque Converter Clutch operation is essential for good fuel economy. A non-locking torque
converter typically results in a 1 to 2 MPG penalty at highway speeds.
Vehicle Weight
Each 125 lbs. of additional weight results in a .3 MPG loss of fuel economy. Thus, additional
passengers, luggage ... will decrease fuel economy.
Vehicle Wind Resistance
More wind "DRAG" means less fuel economy. Thus, hang-on luggage carders, cat toppers, open
windows and/or open trunk... mean less fuel economy. (See "Driving Habits").
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 05-06-04-022G > Oct > 10 > Fuel System - TOP
TIER Detergent Gasoline (Canada)
Fuel: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline (Canada)
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-06-04-022G
Date: October 27, 2010
Subject: TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Information and Available Brands (Deposits, Fuel
Economy, No Start, Power, Performance, Stall Concerns) - Canada ONLY
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Canada Only)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years and include an additional
gasoline brand as a TOP TIER source. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-06-04-022F
(Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). In the U.S., refer to the latest version of Corporate
Bulletin Number 04-06-04-047I.
A new class of fuel called TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is appearing at retail stations of some fuel
marketers. This gasoline meets detergency standards developed by six automotive companies. All
vehicles will benefit from using TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline over gasoline containing the "Lowest
Additive Concentration" recommended by the Canadian General Standards Board (CGSB). Those
vehicles that have experienced deposit related concerns may especially benefit from use of TOP
TIER Detergent Gasoline.
Intake valve: 16,093 km (10,000 mi) with TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline
Intake valve: 16,093 km (10,000 mi) with Minimum Additive recommended by the CGSB
Top Tier Fuel Availability
Chevron was the first to offer TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline in Canada. Shell became the first
national gasoline retailer to offer TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline across Canada. Petro-Canada
began offering TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline nationally as of October 1, 2006. Sunoco began
offering TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline in March of 2007. Esso began offering TOP TIER Detergent
Gasoline in May of 2010.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 05-06-04-022G > Oct > 10 > Fuel System - TOP
TIER Detergent Gasoline (Canada) > Page 3389
Gasoline Brands That Currently Meet TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Standards
The following gasoline brands meet the TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Standards in all octane
grades :
Chevron Canada (markets in British Columbia and western Alberta)
- Shell Canada (nationally)
- Petro-Canada (nationally)
- Sunoco-Canada (Ontario)
- Esso-Canada (nationally)
What is TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is a new class of gasoline with enhanced detergency and no
metallic additives. It meets new, voluntary deposit control standards developed by six automotive
companies that exceed the detergent recommendations of Canadian standards and does not
contain metallic additives, which can damage vehicle emission control components.
Where Can TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Be Purchased?
The TOP TIER program began in the U.S. and Canada on May 3, 2004. Some fuel marketers have
already joined and introduced TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline. This is a voluntary program and not
all fuel marketers will offer this product. Once fuel marketers make public announcements, they will
appear on a list of brands that meet the TOP TIER standards.
Who developed TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards were developed by six automotive companies: BMW,
General Motors, Honda, Toyota, Volkswagen and Audi.
Why was TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline developed?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline was developed to increase the level of detergent additive in
gasoline. In the U.S., government regulations require that all gasoline sold in the U.S. contain a
detergent additive. However, the requirement is minimal and in many cases, is not sufficient to
keep engines clean. In Canada, gasoline standards recommend adherence to U.S. detergency
requirements but do not require it. In fact, many brands of gasoline in Canada do not contain any
detergent additive. In order to meet TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards, a higher level of
detergent is needed than what is required or recommended, and no metallic additives are allowed.
Also, TOP TIER was developed to give fuel marketers the opportunity to differentiate their product.
Why did the six automotive companies join together to develop TOP TIER?
All six corporations recognized the benefits to both the vehicle and the consumer. Also, joining
together emphasized that low detergency and the intentional addition of metallic additives is an
issue of concern to several automotive companies.
What are the benefits of TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline will help keep engines cleaner than gasoline containing the "Lowest
Additive Concentration" recommended by Canadian standards. Clean engines help provide optimal
fuel economy and engine performance, and also provide reduced emissions. Also, the use of TOP
TIER Detergent Gasoline will help reduce deposit related concerns.
Who should use TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline?
All vehicles will benefit from using TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline over gasoline containing the
"Lowest Additive Concentration" recommended by Canadian standards. Those vehicles that have
experienced deposit related concerns may especially benefit from use of TOP TIER Detergent
Gasoline. More information on TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline can be found at this website,
http://www.toptiergas.com/.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 05-06-04-022G > Oct > 10 > Fuel System - TOP
TIER Detergent Gasoline (Canada) > Page 3390
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 04-06-04-047I > Aug > 09 > Fuel System - 'TOP
TIER' Detergent Gasoline Information
Fuel: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - 'TOP TIER' Detergent Gasoline Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-06-04-047I
Date: August 17, 2009
Subject: TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline (Deposits, Fuel Economy, No Start, Power, Performance,
Stall Concerns) - U.S. Only
Models:
2010 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) (U.S. Only) 2003-2010
HUMMER H2 (U.S. Only) 2006-2010 HUMMER H3 (U.S. Only) 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X (U.S. Only)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and additional sources to the Top Tier
Fuel Retailers list. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-06-04-047H (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System). In Canada, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 05-06-04-022F.
A new class of fuel called TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is appearing at retail stations of some fuel
marketers. This gasoline meets detergency standards developed by six automotive companies. All
vehicles will benefit from using TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline over gasoline containing the "Lowest
Additive Concentration" set by the EPA. Those vehicles that have experienced deposit related
concerns may especially benefit from the use of TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline.
Intake valve: - 10,000 miles with TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline
Intake valve: - 10,000 miles with Legal Minimum additive
Gasoline Brands That Currently Meet TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Standards
As of August 1, 2009, all grades of the following gasoline brands meet the TOP TIER Detergent
Gasoline Standards:
- Chevron
- Chevron-Canada
- QuikTrip
- Conoco
Phillips 66
- 76
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 04-06-04-047I > Aug > 09 > Fuel System - 'TOP
TIER' Detergent Gasoline Information > Page 3395
- Shell
- Shell-Canada
- Entec Stations located in the greater Montgomery, Alabama area.
- MFA Oil Company located throughout Missouri.
- Kwik Trip, Inc. in Minnesota and Wisconsin and Kwik Star convenience stores in Iowa.
The Somerset Refinery, Inc. at Somerset Oil stations in Kentucky.
Aloha Petroleum
- Tri-Par Oil Company
- Turkey Hill Minit Markets
- Texaco
- Petro-Canada
- Sunoco-Canada
- Road Ranger located in Illinois, Indiana, Iowa, Kentucky, Missouri, Ohio and Wisconsin
What is TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is a new class of gasoline with enhanced detergency. It meets new,
voluntary deposit control standards developed by six automotive companies that exceed the
detergent requirements imposed by the EPA.
Where Can TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Be Purchased?
The TOP TIER program began on May 3, 2004 and many fuel marketers have joined the program
and have introduced TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline. This is a voluntary program and not all fuel
marketers will offer this product. Once fuel marketers make public announcements, they will appear
on a list of brands that meet the TOP TIER standards.
Where Can I find the Latest Information on TOP TIER Fuel and Retailers?
On the web, please visit www.toptiergas.com for additional information and updated retailer lists.
Who developed TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards were developed by six automotive companies: Audi,
BMW, General Motors, Honda, Toyota and Volkswagen.
Why was TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline developed?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline was developed to increase the level of detergent additive in
gasoline. The EPA requires that all gasoline sold in the U.S. contain a detergent additive. However,
the requirement is minimal and in many cases, is not sufficient to keep engines clean. In order to
meet TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards, a higher level of detergent is needed than what is
required by the EPA. Also, TOP TIER was developed to give fuel marketers the opportunity to
differentiate their product.
Why did the six automotive companies join together to develop TOP TIER?
All six corporations recognized the benefits to both the vehicle and the consumer. Also, joining
together emphasized that low detergency is an issue of concern to several automotive companies.
What are the benefits of TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline will help keep engines cleaner than gasoline containing the "Lowest
Additive Concentration" set by the EPA. Clean engines help provide optimal fuel economy and
performance and reduced emissions. Also, use of TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline will help reduce
deposit related concerns.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 04-06-00-047 > Jun > 04 > Fuel - Top Tier
Detergent Gasoline Information
Fuel: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Top Tier Detergent Gasoline Information
Bulletin No.: 04-06-00-047
Date: June 24, 2004
ADVANCED SERVICE INFORMATION
Subject: Top Tier Detergent Gasoline (Deposits, Fuel Economy, No Start, Power, Performance,
Stall Concerns)
Models: 2005 and Prior All General Motors Passenger Cars and Trucks (U.S. Only)
A new class of gasoline, called Top Tier Detergent Gasoline, will be appearing at retail stations of
some fuel marketers. This gasoline meets detergency standards developed by four automotive
companies. A description of the concept and benefits of Top Tier is provided in the following
question and answer section.
What is Top Tier Detergent Gasoline?
Top Tier Detergent Gasoline is a new class of gasoline with enhanced detergency. It meets new,
voluntary deposit control standards developed by four automotive companies that exceed the
detergent requirements imposed by the EPA.
Who developed Top Tier Detergent Gasoline standards?
Top Tier Detergent Gasoline standards were developed by four automotive companies: BMW,
General Motors, Honda and Toyota.
Why was Top Tier Detergent Gasoline developed?
Top Tier Detergent Gasoline was developed to increase the level of detergent additive in gasoline.
The EPA requires that all gasoline sold in the U.S. contain a detergent additive. However, the
requirement is minimal and in many cases, is not sufficient to keep engines clean. In order to meet
Top Tier Detergent Gasoline standards, a higher level of detergent is needed than what is required
by the EPA. Also, Top Tier was developed to give fuel marketers the opportunity to differentiate
their product.
Why did the four automotive companies join together to develop Top Tier?
All four corporations recognized the benefits to both the vehicle and the consumer. Also, joining
together emphasized that low detergency is an issue of concern to several automotive companies.
What are the benefits of Top Tier Detergent Gasoline?
Top Tier Detergent Gasoline will help keep engines cleaner than gasoline containing the "Lowest
Additive Concentration" set by the EPA. Clean engines help provide optimal fuel economy and
performance and reduced emissions. Also, use of Top Tier Detergent Gasoline will help reduce
deposit related concerns.
Who should use Top Tier Detergent Gasoline?
All vehicles will benefit from using Top Tier Detergent Gasoline over gasoline containing the
"Lowest Additive Concentration" set by the EPA. Those vehicles that have experienced deposit
related concerns may especially benefit from use of Top Tier Detergent Gasoline.
Where can Top Tier Detergent Gasoline be purchased?
The Top Tier program began on May 3, 2004. Some fuel marketers have already joined and are
making plans to introduce Top Tier Detergent Gasoline. This is a voluntary program and not all fuel
marketers will offer this product. Once fuel marketers make public announcements, a list of all fuel
marketers meeting Top Tier standards will be made available. For now, look for the "Top Tier"
designation at the gas pump.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 570102 > Jun > 95 > Fuel Reformulated/Oxygenated Gasolines
Fuel: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Reformulated/Oxygenated Gasolines
FILE IN SECTION: 0 - General Information
BULLETIN NO.: 57-01-02
DATE: June, 1995
SUBJECT: Reformulated Gasoline (RFG), Oxygenated Gasoline and California Phase 2 RFG
MODELS: 1995 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
General Motors customers will be potentially exposed to a variety of different fuel types. Besides
the conventional gasoline available, new types such as Reformulated Gasoline (RFG), oxygenated
gasoline, and starting in 1996, California Phase 2 RFG. Reformulated Gasoline (RFG) is blended
to burn more cleanly and not to evaporate as readily. RFG must contain a minimum of 2 percent
oxygen, which is usually achieved with ethanol or EPA-approved ethers such as methyl
tertiary-butyl ether (MTBE). This type of fuel is required by the Clean Air Act in the nine worst
ozone non-attainment areas of the country, and may also be required in other areas designated
ozone non-attainment, at the option of the states. RFG is intended to produce approximately 15
percent less pollution than conventional gasoline. Using RFG should reduce the total health risk to
the public by reducing exposure to ozone and air toxins. General Motors supports the use of RFG
as a cost effective means of providing air quality benefits.
Oxygenated gasolines are prevalent in the wintertime for Carbon Monoxide (CO) non-attainment
areas. These fuels contain oxygen components similar to RFG. Approximately 50 percent of the
fuel sold in the U.S. in the wintertime contains an oxygenate component.
Vehicle fuel economy may be slightly reduced, if at all, by the use of gasoline containing
oxygenates. Fuel economy is most affected by engine and vehicle type, driving habits, weather
conditions, and vehicle maintenance.
Properly blended RFG, oxygenated gasoline, and California Phase 2 RFG will have no adverse
effect on vehicle performance or to the durability of engine and fuel system components. In fact,
the General Motors Owner's Manual fuel statements have consistently permitted the use of
properly blended fuels containing up to 10 percent ethanol (since 1980) and up to 15 percent
methyl tertiary-butyl ether (MTBE) for current and all past model year vehicles. These statements
continue to be valid. The use of oxygenate-containing fuels will not invalidate the GM vehicle
warranty.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 93966C > Feb > 93 > Fuel System - Factors That
Affect Economy/Mileage
Fuel: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Factors That Affect Economy/Mileage
Number: 93-96-6C
Section: 6C
Date: FEB. 1993
Corporate Bulletin No.: 306502
ASE No.: A1, A8
Subject: FACTORS THAT AFFECT FUEL ECONOMY
Model and Year: ALL YEARS ALL MODELS
BACKGROUND INFORMATION:
EPA fuel economy estimates are posted on the fuel economy label of all new vehicles. The only
intended use of these values is for comparison among the different vehicles. Fuel economy
estimates are generated from data taken during a laboratory test using pre-production prototype
vehicles under extremely controlled conditions using a professional driver, with the vehicle
operating on an instrument similar to a treadmill. The comparisons of current vehicle fuel economy
to the EPA fuel economy estimates is a misuse of the information and should be discouraged.
The EPA GAS MILEAGE GUIDE, available at each dealership, points out that the actual mileage
when driving a vehicle may differ considerably from the estimated mileage. The guide also
describes how vehicles are tested under identical conditions to insure the results can be compared
with confidence.
The EPA GAS MILEAGE GUIDE also points out that city fuel economy estimate simulates a 7.5
mile, stop-and-go trip with an average speed of 20 mph. The trip takes 23 minutes and has 18
stops. About 18 percent of the time is spent idling, as in waiting at traffic lights or in rush hour
traffic. Two kinds of engine starts are used - the cold start, which is similar to starting a car in the
morning after it has been parked all night - and the hot start, similar to restarting a vehicle after it
has been warmed up, driven and stopped for a short time.
The test to determine the highway fuel economy estimate represents a mixture of "non-city" driving.
Segments corresponding to different kinds of rural roads and interstate highways are included. The
test simulates a 10 mile trip and averages 48 mph. The test is run from a hot start and has little
idling time and no stops.
The EPA GAS MILEAGE GUIDE explains that the actual test results are adjusted downward to
arrive at the estimates used in the booklet and on the labels. City estimates are lowered by 10
percent and the highway estimate by 22 percent from the laboratory test results. The guide also
points out that traveling at higher speeds lowers fuel economy and traveling at 65 mph instead of
55 mph lowers fuel economy over 15 percent.
FACTORS THAT AFFECT FUEL ECONOMY:
Axle Ratio
Numerically lower axle ratios generally produce better highway fuel economy. The exception to this
is if the engine is "working" exceptionally hard, (heavy vehicle loads pulling a trailer, small engine in
a large vehicle ... ). In these cases a numerically higher axle may provide better fuel economy.
Numerically higher axle ratios will also tend to provide more fuel economy in congested city traffic
and stop and go conditions.
Brakes
Brake drag (even a minimal amount undetectable by coasting), can have a significant negative
impact on fuel economy. Pull upward on the brake pedal to assure that the stoplight switch and
cruise switch at the brake pedal are full and properly adjusted. A "click" sound when the pedal is
pulled upward indicates that the switch was improperly adjusted. This causes the front brake pads
to lightly rub the rotors, causing a fuel economy loss, without generating excessive heat or brake
pad wear.
Driving Habits
Frequent short trips (less than 5 miles), especially in cooler ambient temperatures (less than 65
degrees), will necessitate fuel enrichment on start-ups, especially after "soaks" with the engine off
for approximately a half hour or more.
Frequent accelerator pedal movement while driving will reduce fuel economy because of fuel
enrichment during the periods of acceleration. Under such driving conditions the torque converter
clutch (TCC) also disengages, contributing to fuel economy losses. Prolonged idle periods reduce
fuel economy especially in cold ambients when vehicle is allowed to "Warm up".
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 93966C > Feb > 93 > Fuel System - Factors That
Affect Economy/Mileage > Page 3408
Fuels
Oxygenated fuels, with methanol and/or ethanol blended into the gasoline have lower energy and
thus reduce fuel economy. Typically there is about a 1 MPG penalty for a vehicle which gets 25 to
30 MPG on 100 percent gasoline.
Using fuels of a lower octane than the vehicle was calibrated to will cause increased "KS" Knock
Sensor system activity. This will result in a net decrease in spark advance and thus poorer fuel
economy. Using fuel of a higher octane than the vehicle was calibrated for WILL NOT increase fuel
economy.
Variations in how much fuel is added to the fuel tank during re-fueling can greatly affect calculated
fuel economy. These effects decrease as the distance traveled and the number of tank fillups
increase.
Green Engine
New vehicles have not yet had an opportunity for the engine to break in, (rings to seat ... ). A typical
engine will take 3 to 5 thousand miles to break in and during this time period a gradual increase in
fuel economy can be expected.
Parasitic Loads
Air conditioning and/or electrical loads, (headlights, heated backglass ... ) also result in lower fuel
economy, (typically less than 1 MPG difference, each 10 AMPs takes approximately .4 MPG).
Road Conditions
Road surface condition impacts fuel economy. Gravel and/or pot holed roads decrease fuel
economy. Hills (vs. level terrain) also negatively impact fuel economy. Even gradual unperceptible
increases in elevation result in real measurable decreases in fuel economy. Similarly, driving in the
rain or snow decreases fuel economy.
Suspension
Vehicle suspension misalignment can cause poor fuel economy. Check all four tires for abnormal
and/or premature tire wear.
New tires, tire rotation, and/or front end alignment may be required to correct fuel economy.
Tires
Performance tires and/or tires with larger "contact areas," (like 60 series aspect ratio), can cause
as much as 3 MPG lower fuel economy when compared to hard "thin" tires. Find out if the tire size
currently on the car is the same as original equipment. Replacement tires tailor than original
equipment tires cause the odometer to read LESS THAN actual distance traveled. This will result in
lower calculated fuel economy than actual fuel economy.
Tire Pressure
Harder tires, (more air pressure, or different tire compositions) result in better fuel economy. Do not
exceed maximum pressure as labeled on the tire, typically 30-35 psi. The disadvantage of this is
that the greater the tire pressure, the harsher the vehicle ride.
Transmission
On 4-Speed automatics, it is possible to drive the vehicle in 3rd gear rather than "overdrive" and
not perceive it. Typically this condition occurs when the shift indicator, or the shift linkage/detent is
misadjusted. Misadjusted shift linkage can also result in improper signals to the ECM, which can
result in less spark advance, and results in a drop in fuel economy.
Driving a vehicle in 3rd gear rather than overdrive at highway speeds typically results in a 3 to 5
MPG penalty.
Torque Converter Clutch operation is essential for good fuel economy. A non-locking torque
converter typically results in a 1 to 2 MPG penalty at highway speeds.
Vehicle Weight
Each 125 lbs. of additional weight results in a .3 MPG loss of fuel economy. Thus, additional
passengers, luggage ... will decrease fuel economy.
Vehicle Wind Resistance
More wind "DRAG" means less fuel economy. Thus, hang-on luggage carders, cat toppers, open
windows and/or open trunk... mean less fuel economy. (See "Driving Habits").
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 05-06-04-022G > Oct > 10 > Fuel System - TOP TIER
Detergent Gasoline (Canada)
Fuel: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline (Canada)
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-06-04-022G
Date: October 27, 2010
Subject: TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Information and Available Brands (Deposits, Fuel
Economy, No Start, Power, Performance, Stall Concerns) - Canada ONLY
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Canada Only)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years and include an additional
gasoline brand as a TOP TIER source. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-06-04-022F
(Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System). In the U.S., refer to the latest version of Corporate
Bulletin Number 04-06-04-047I.
A new class of fuel called TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is appearing at retail stations of some fuel
marketers. This gasoline meets detergency standards developed by six automotive companies. All
vehicles will benefit from using TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline over gasoline containing the "Lowest
Additive Concentration" recommended by the Canadian General Standards Board (CGSB). Those
vehicles that have experienced deposit related concerns may especially benefit from use of TOP
TIER Detergent Gasoline.
Intake valve: 16,093 km (10,000 mi) with TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline
Intake valve: 16,093 km (10,000 mi) with Minimum Additive recommended by the CGSB
Top Tier Fuel Availability
Chevron was the first to offer TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline in Canada. Shell became the first
national gasoline retailer to offer TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline across Canada. Petro-Canada
began offering TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline nationally as of October 1, 2006. Sunoco began
offering TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline in March of 2007. Esso began offering TOP TIER Detergent
Gasoline in May of 2010.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 05-06-04-022G > Oct > 10 > Fuel System - TOP TIER
Detergent Gasoline (Canada) > Page 3414
Gasoline Brands That Currently Meet TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Standards
The following gasoline brands meet the TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Standards in all octane
grades :
Chevron Canada (markets in British Columbia and western Alberta)
- Shell Canada (nationally)
- Petro-Canada (nationally)
- Sunoco-Canada (Ontario)
- Esso-Canada (nationally)
What is TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is a new class of gasoline with enhanced detergency and no
metallic additives. It meets new, voluntary deposit control standards developed by six automotive
companies that exceed the detergent recommendations of Canadian standards and does not
contain metallic additives, which can damage vehicle emission control components.
Where Can TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Be Purchased?
The TOP TIER program began in the U.S. and Canada on May 3, 2004. Some fuel marketers have
already joined and introduced TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline. This is a voluntary program and not
all fuel marketers will offer this product. Once fuel marketers make public announcements, they will
appear on a list of brands that meet the TOP TIER standards.
Who developed TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards were developed by six automotive companies: BMW,
General Motors, Honda, Toyota, Volkswagen and Audi.
Why was TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline developed?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline was developed to increase the level of detergent additive in
gasoline. In the U.S., government regulations require that all gasoline sold in the U.S. contain a
detergent additive. However, the requirement is minimal and in many cases, is not sufficient to
keep engines clean. In Canada, gasoline standards recommend adherence to U.S. detergency
requirements but do not require it. In fact, many brands of gasoline in Canada do not contain any
detergent additive. In order to meet TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards, a higher level of
detergent is needed than what is required or recommended, and no metallic additives are allowed.
Also, TOP TIER was developed to give fuel marketers the opportunity to differentiate their product.
Why did the six automotive companies join together to develop TOP TIER?
All six corporations recognized the benefits to both the vehicle and the consumer. Also, joining
together emphasized that low detergency and the intentional addition of metallic additives is an
issue of concern to several automotive companies.
What are the benefits of TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline will help keep engines cleaner than gasoline containing the "Lowest
Additive Concentration" recommended by Canadian standards. Clean engines help provide optimal
fuel economy and engine performance, and also provide reduced emissions. Also, the use of TOP
TIER Detergent Gasoline will help reduce deposit related concerns.
Who should use TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline?
All vehicles will benefit from using TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline over gasoline containing the
"Lowest Additive Concentration" recommended by Canadian standards. Those vehicles that have
experienced deposit related concerns may especially benefit from use of TOP TIER Detergent
Gasoline. More information on TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline can be found at this website,
http://www.toptiergas.com/.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 05-06-04-022G > Oct > 10 > Fuel System - TOP TIER
Detergent Gasoline (Canada) > Page 3415
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 04-06-04-047I > Aug > 09 > Fuel System - 'TOP TIER'
Detergent Gasoline Information
Fuel: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - 'TOP TIER' Detergent Gasoline Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-06-04-047I
Date: August 17, 2009
Subject: TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline (Deposits, Fuel Economy, No Start, Power, Performance,
Stall Concerns) - U.S. Only
Models:
2010 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) (U.S. Only) 2003-2010
HUMMER H2 (U.S. Only) 2006-2010 HUMMER H3 (U.S. Only) 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X (U.S. Only)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and additional sources to the Top Tier
Fuel Retailers list. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-06-04-047H (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System). In Canada, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 05-06-04-022F.
A new class of fuel called TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is appearing at retail stations of some fuel
marketers. This gasoline meets detergency standards developed by six automotive companies. All
vehicles will benefit from using TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline over gasoline containing the "Lowest
Additive Concentration" set by the EPA. Those vehicles that have experienced deposit related
concerns may especially benefit from the use of TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline.
Intake valve: - 10,000 miles with TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline
Intake valve: - 10,000 miles with Legal Minimum additive
Gasoline Brands That Currently Meet TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Standards
As of August 1, 2009, all grades of the following gasoline brands meet the TOP TIER Detergent
Gasoline Standards:
- Chevron
- Chevron-Canada
- QuikTrip
- Conoco
Phillips 66
- 76
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 04-06-04-047I > Aug > 09 > Fuel System - 'TOP TIER'
Detergent Gasoline Information > Page 3420
- Shell
- Shell-Canada
- Entec Stations located in the greater Montgomery, Alabama area.
- MFA Oil Company located throughout Missouri.
- Kwik Trip, Inc. in Minnesota and Wisconsin and Kwik Star convenience stores in Iowa.
The Somerset Refinery, Inc. at Somerset Oil stations in Kentucky.
Aloha Petroleum
- Tri-Par Oil Company
- Turkey Hill Minit Markets
- Texaco
- Petro-Canada
- Sunoco-Canada
- Road Ranger located in Illinois, Indiana, Iowa, Kentucky, Missouri, Ohio and Wisconsin
What is TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is a new class of gasoline with enhanced detergency. It meets new,
voluntary deposit control standards developed by six automotive companies that exceed the
detergent requirements imposed by the EPA.
Where Can TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline Be Purchased?
The TOP TIER program began on May 3, 2004 and many fuel marketers have joined the program
and have introduced TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline. This is a voluntary program and not all fuel
marketers will offer this product. Once fuel marketers make public announcements, they will appear
on a list of brands that meet the TOP TIER standards.
Where Can I find the Latest Information on TOP TIER Fuel and Retailers?
On the web, please visit www.toptiergas.com for additional information and updated retailer lists.
Who developed TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards were developed by six automotive companies: Audi,
BMW, General Motors, Honda, Toyota and Volkswagen.
Why was TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline developed?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline was developed to increase the level of detergent additive in
gasoline. The EPA requires that all gasoline sold in the U.S. contain a detergent additive. However,
the requirement is minimal and in many cases, is not sufficient to keep engines clean. In order to
meet TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline standards, a higher level of detergent is needed than what is
required by the EPA. Also, TOP TIER was developed to give fuel marketers the opportunity to
differentiate their product.
Why did the six automotive companies join together to develop TOP TIER?
All six corporations recognized the benefits to both the vehicle and the consumer. Also, joining
together emphasized that low detergency is an issue of concern to several automotive companies.
What are the benefits of TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline?
TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline will help keep engines cleaner than gasoline containing the "Lowest
Additive Concentration" set by the EPA. Clean engines help provide optimal fuel economy and
performance and reduced emissions. Also, use of TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline will help reduce
deposit related concerns.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 04-06-00-047 > Jun > 04 > Fuel - Top Tier Detergent
Gasoline Information
Fuel: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Top Tier Detergent Gasoline Information
Bulletin No.: 04-06-00-047
Date: June 24, 2004
ADVANCED SERVICE INFORMATION
Subject: Top Tier Detergent Gasoline (Deposits, Fuel Economy, No Start, Power, Performance,
Stall Concerns)
Models: 2005 and Prior All General Motors Passenger Cars and Trucks (U.S. Only)
A new class of gasoline, called Top Tier Detergent Gasoline, will be appearing at retail stations of
some fuel marketers. This gasoline meets detergency standards developed by four automotive
companies. A description of the concept and benefits of Top Tier is provided in the following
question and answer section.
What is Top Tier Detergent Gasoline?
Top Tier Detergent Gasoline is a new class of gasoline with enhanced detergency. It meets new,
voluntary deposit control standards developed by four automotive companies that exceed the
detergent requirements imposed by the EPA.
Who developed Top Tier Detergent Gasoline standards?
Top Tier Detergent Gasoline standards were developed by four automotive companies: BMW,
General Motors, Honda and Toyota.
Why was Top Tier Detergent Gasoline developed?
Top Tier Detergent Gasoline was developed to increase the level of detergent additive in gasoline.
The EPA requires that all gasoline sold in the U.S. contain a detergent additive. However, the
requirement is minimal and in many cases, is not sufficient to keep engines clean. In order to meet
Top Tier Detergent Gasoline standards, a higher level of detergent is needed than what is required
by the EPA. Also, Top Tier was developed to give fuel marketers the opportunity to differentiate
their product.
Why did the four automotive companies join together to develop Top Tier?
All four corporations recognized the benefits to both the vehicle and the consumer. Also, joining
together emphasized that low detergency is an issue of concern to several automotive companies.
What are the benefits of Top Tier Detergent Gasoline?
Top Tier Detergent Gasoline will help keep engines cleaner than gasoline containing the "Lowest
Additive Concentration" set by the EPA. Clean engines help provide optimal fuel economy and
performance and reduced emissions. Also, use of Top Tier Detergent Gasoline will help reduce
deposit related concerns.
Who should use Top Tier Detergent Gasoline?
All vehicles will benefit from using Top Tier Detergent Gasoline over gasoline containing the
"Lowest Additive Concentration" set by the EPA. Those vehicles that have experienced deposit
related concerns may especially benefit from use of Top Tier Detergent Gasoline.
Where can Top Tier Detergent Gasoline be purchased?
The Top Tier program began on May 3, 2004. Some fuel marketers have already joined and are
making plans to introduce Top Tier Detergent Gasoline. This is a voluntary program and not all fuel
marketers will offer this product. Once fuel marketers make public announcements, a list of all fuel
marketers meeting Top Tier standards will be made available. For now, look for the "Top Tier"
designation at the gas pump.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Fuel: > 570102 > Jun > 95 > Fuel - Reformulated/Oxygenated
Gasolines
Fuel: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel - Reformulated/Oxygenated Gasolines
FILE IN SECTION: 0 - General Information
BULLETIN NO.: 57-01-02
DATE: June, 1995
SUBJECT: Reformulated Gasoline (RFG), Oxygenated Gasoline and California Phase 2 RFG
MODELS: 1995 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
General Motors customers will be potentially exposed to a variety of different fuel types. Besides
the conventional gasoline available, new types such as Reformulated Gasoline (RFG), oxygenated
gasoline, and starting in 1996, California Phase 2 RFG. Reformulated Gasoline (RFG) is blended
to burn more cleanly and not to evaporate as readily. RFG must contain a minimum of 2 percent
oxygen, which is usually achieved with ethanol or EPA-approved ethers such as methyl
tertiary-butyl ether (MTBE). This type of fuel is required by the Clean Air Act in the nine worst
ozone non-attainment areas of the country, and may also be required in other areas designated
ozone non-attainment, at the option of the states. RFG is intended to produce approximately 15
percent less pollution than conventional gasoline. Using RFG should reduce the total health risk to
the public by reducing exposure to ozone and air toxins. General Motors supports the use of RFG
as a cost effective means of providing air quality benefits.
Oxygenated gasolines are prevalent in the wintertime for Carbon Monoxide (CO) non-attainment
areas. These fuels contain oxygen components similar to RFG. Approximately 50 percent of the
fuel sold in the U.S. in the wintertime contains an oxygenate component.
Vehicle fuel economy may be slightly reduced, if at all, by the use of gasoline containing
oxygenates. Fuel economy is most affected by engine and vehicle type, driving habits, weather
conditions, and vehicle maintenance.
Properly blended RFG, oxygenated gasoline, and California Phase 2 RFG will have no adverse
effect on vehicle performance or to the durability of engine and fuel system components. In fact,
the General Motors Owner's Manual fuel statements have consistently permitted the use of
properly blended fuels containing up to 10 percent ethanol (since 1980) and up to 15 percent
methyl tertiary-butyl ether (MTBE) for current and all past model year vehicles. These statements
continue to be valid. The use of oxygenate-containing fuels will not invalidate the GM vehicle
warranty.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3429
Fuel: Specifications
ALCOHOL FUEL TYPES:
Methyl Tertiary-Butyl Ether (MTBE): Fuel containing Methyl Tertiary-butyl Ether (MTBE) may be
used, providing there is no more than 15% alcohol by volume.
Ethanol: Fuel containing ethanol (ethyl) or grain alcohol may be used, providing there is no more
than 10% ethanol alcohol by volume.
Methanol: Fuel containing methanol (methyl) or wood alcohol may be used, providing there is no
more than 5% methanol by volume. Use of fuel (gasohol) that contains more than 5% methanol
can corrode metal fuel system components and damage plastic and rubber parts.
GASOLINE:
Unleaded gasoline must be used with a minimum octane rating of 87.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Filter > Fuel Pressure
Release > System Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Release: Service and Repair
WARNING: To reduce the risk of fire and personal injury, it is necessary to relieve the fuel system
pressure before servicing fuel system components.
After relieving system pressure, a small amount of fuel may be released when servicing fuel lines
or connections. In order to reduce the chance of personal injury, cover fuel line fittings with a shop
towel before disconnecting, to catch any fuel that may leak out. Place the towel in an approved
container when disconnect is completed.
When servicing the fuel system use the following precautions:
a. Put a "CAUTION FLAMMABLE" sign in the workshop.
b. Be sure shop is supplied with an adequate fire extinguisher.
c. Be sure to disconnect the negative battery cable before any service work is done.
d. Use a suitable container to catch any fuel that may leak from system during service.
e. Always relieve fuel system pressure before disconnecting any lines.
f. If the key must be turned "ON" while servicing fuel system, always disconnect or disable ignition,
to insure no sparks occur near fuel vapors.
PROCEDURE:
Tool required: J34730-1 Fuel Pressure Gauge or equivalent.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable, to avoid fuel pump turn "ON," if an accidental attempt is
made to start the engine.
2. Loosen the fuel filler cap to relieve tank vapor pressure.
3. Connect the fuel pressure gauge to the pressure connection. Wrap a shop towel around the
fitting while connecting the gauge to avoid spillage.
4. Install bleed hose into an approved container and open the valve to bleed the system pressure.
Fuel connections are now safe for servicing.
5. Drain any fuel remaining in the gauge into an approved container.
When repair to the fuel system has been completed, START the engine and check all connections
that were loosened for leaks.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - Fuel Injector Maintenance Cleaning
Fuel Injector: Technical Service Bulletins Fuel System - Fuel Injector Maintenance Cleaning
Bulletin No.: 04-06-04-051B
Date: January 04, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Maintenance Cleaning of Fuel Injectors
Models: 2006 and Prior All General Motors Passenger Cars and Trucks 2003-2006 HUMMER H2
2006 HUMMER H3
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years and update the name and part
number of GM Fuel System Treatment. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-06-04-051A
(Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
General Motors is aware that some companies are marketing tools, equipment and programs to
support fuel injector cleaning as a preventative maintenance procedure. General Motors does not
endorse, support or acknowledge the need for fuel injector cleaning as a preventative maintenance
procedure. Fuel injector cleaning is approved only when performed as directed by a published GM
driveability or DTC diagnostic service procedure.
Due to variation in fuel quality in different areas of the country, the only preventative maintenance
currently endorsed by GM regarding its gasoline engine fuel systems is the addition of GM Fuel
System Treatment PLUS, P/N 88861011 (for U.S. ACDelco(R), use P/N 88861013) (in Canada,
P/N 88861012), added to a tank of fuel at each oil change. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
03-06-04-030A for proper cleaning instructions.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Fuel System - Fuel Injector Maintenance Cleaning > Page 3438
Fuel Injector: Technical Service Bulletins Tools - Introduction Of The Fuel Injector Tester
NO.: 93-I-39 DATE: June, 1993 GROUP: 6 CORP. NO.: 316501R
SUBJECT: INFORMATION ON THE INTRODUCTION OF THE FUEL INJECTOR TESTER TOOL
J - 39021
This bulletin is being revised to add information about the coil test and a list of driveability
problems.
In February, 1993, Kent-Moore shipped a new Fuel Injector Tester, tool J-39021, as part of the
Essential Tool Program. This tool has the capability of performing injector balance and coil tests on
all GM and many non-GM fuel injection systems. The injector balance test is one familiar to most
technicians where fuel pressure drop is measured as an injector is energized for a set period of
time. This fuel pressure drop is compared to that of the other injectors in the vehicle or a published
standard.
The injector coil test is a new test whereby the injector's resistance is measured during normal
gperation by feeding a fixed current through the injector and measuring the voltage across the
injector. Injector coil failures are more accurately detected using this method than by simply
measuring the injectors resistance with an ohmmeter. Refer to the instructions included with the
tool for testing procedures.
This tool, and the injector coil test specifically, were developed to detect deterioration of injector
coils due to the introduction of injector cleaners and fuel blends containing high levels of alcohol.
Alcohol and water carried by the alcohol may attack and corrode injector coils resulting in a change
in coil resistance and one or more of the following driveability symptoms:
^ rough idle
^ engine miss/surge
^ stall after start/hard start
^ fails emission test
^ poor fuel economy
^ exhaust odor
The injector coil test procedure also requires the use of the Digital Voltmeter, J-39200, to measure
the voltage across the injector during the test. The Fuel Injector Tester, J-39021, supplies one of
three fixed current values throughout the duration of the test. Selection of the supply current value
(0.5, 2.5, or 4.0 amps) is based on the injector's specified resistance. When the push-to-start-test
button is pressed, the tool energizes the injector coil for five seconds. The condition of the injector
coil (pass/fail) is determined by the voltage reading displayed on the voltmeter while the injector is
energized. Instructions and specifications for most GM fuel injectors are included with the tool.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3439
Model R620 Fuel Rail Assembly
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3440
Fuel Injector: Description and Operation
MPFI Injector Assembly
MPFI Injector - Cross Section
PURPOSE:
The Multi-Port Fuel Injector is a solenoid-operated device, controlled by the Electronic Control
Module (ECM), that meters the pressurized fuel to a single engine cylinder.
OPERATION:
The ECM energizes the low impedance solenoid to open a normally closed ball valve. This allows
the fuel to flow into the top of the injector, past the ball valve, and through a recessed flow director
plate at the injector outlet. The director plate has six machined holes that control the fuel flow,
generating a conical spray pattern of finely atomized fuel at the injector tip. Fuel from the tip is
directed at the intake valve, causing it to become further atomized and vaporized before entering
the combustion chamber.
An injector that is stuck partly open would cause loss of pressure after engine shut down, so long
crank times would be noticed on some engines. Dieseling could also occur because some fuel
could be delivered to the engine after the ignition is turned "OFF."
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Part 1 of 3
Fuel Injector: Testing and Inspection Part 1 of 3
Chart C-2A (1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Part 1 of 3 > Page 3443
Fuel Injector Tester Circuit
Example
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. This is the set-up step for performing the injector coil test. Also read instructions included with
tools used for test.
2. Engine coolant temperature affects the tool's ability to detect a faulty injector. If engine coolant
temperature is NOT between 5O°F and 95°F the
comparison chart (Part 2 of 3) must be used.
3. The first second of the voltage reading may be inaccurate due to initial current surge, therefore,
record the lowest voltage displayed after the first
second of test. The voltage reading should be within range (see example). The voltage reading
may increase throughout the test as the injector windings warm and the resistance changes. An
erratic voltage reading (one that jumps up and down) indicates an intermittent connection within the
fuel injector.
4. To check the mechanical (fuel delivery) portion of the fuel injector, perform an injector balance
test.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Part 1 of 3 > Page 3444
Fuel Injector: Testing and Inspection Part 2 of 3
Chart C-2A (2 Of 3) Injector Coil Test Procedure
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Part 1 of 3 > Page 3445
Fuel Injector Tester Circuit
Example
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. The first second of the voltage reading may be inaccurate due to initial current surge, therefore,
record the lowest voltage displayed after the first
second of test. The voltage reading may increase throughout the test as the injector windings warm
and the resistance changes. An erratic voltage reading (one that jumps up and down) indicates an
intermittent connection within the fuel injector.
2. From recorded voltages (see example), identify the highest voltage reading recorded (other than
those above 9.5 volts). Subtract all other voltages
from the highest voltage recorded. The subtracted value for any injector must not exceed 0.6 volt.
3. To check the mechanical (fuel delivery) portion of the fuel injector, perform an injector balance
test.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Part 1 of 3 > Page 3446
Fuel Injector: Testing and Inspection Part 3 of 3
Chart C-2A (3 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Part 1 of 3 > Page 3447
Injector Balance Test Circuit
Example
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. Engine cool down period (10 minutes) is necessary to avoid irregular fuel pressure readings due
to "Hot Soak" fuel boiling.
2. Energize tester one time and record pressure drop at the lowest point (Disregard any slight
pressure variations).
3. If the pressure drop of all injectors is within 10 kPa (1.5 psi) of the average fuel pressure drop,
the injectors are flowing properly The actual
amount of pressure drop is calculated by subtracting the second pressure reading from the first
pressure reading.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Injector Cleaning Procedure
Fuel Injector: Service and Repair Fuel Injector Cleaning Procedure
PROCEDURE:
1. Relieve the system pressure, refer to FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELIEF.
2. Disconnect the fuel supply line from the inlet of the fuel rail.
3. Attach the fuel supply line to the return line.
4. Plug the fuel return fitting at the fuel rail or connect to tester/cleaner depending on configuration.
5. Connect the fuel supply hose from the tester/cleaner to the fuel supply manifold.
6. Turn the tester/cleaner "ON." Tester/cleaner should run 10 minutes.
7. START the engine and check the fuel lines for leakage. If there is any sign of leakage, turn the
vehicle and the tester/cleaner "OFF" and repair the location where fuel is leaking. Then return to
Step 6.
8. When the engine speed has stabilized, set the idle speed at 2000 rpm. Run the remainder of the
10 minute cycle to eliminate all the air in the fuel supply hose and fuel rail.
9. Turn power switch "OFF" and disconnect power lines.
10. Disconnect cleaner supply hose from the fuel supply manifold.
11. Connect vehicle fuel lines. START engine and check for leaks. Lubricate O-rings prior to
installation and ensure fuel lines are securely connected.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Injector Cleaning Procedure > Page 3450
Fuel Injector: Service and Repair Fuel Injector(S) Replacement
Air Plenum And Fuel Rail Removal
Multi-Port Fuel Injector
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT:
NOTE: Use care in removing injectors to Prevent damage to the electrical connector pins on the
injector, and the nozzle. The fuel injector is serviced as a complete assembly only. Since it is an
electrical component, it should not be immersed in any type of cleaner.
1. Negative battery terminal.
2. Relieve fuel system pressure.
3. Intake manifold plenum.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Injector Cleaning Procedure > Page 3451
4. Fuel rail assembly.
DISASSEMBLE:
1. Injector retainer clip and discard.
2. MPFI injector assembly.
3. Injector O-ring seals from both ends of injector and discard.
IMPORTANT: Each injector is calibrated for a specific flow rate. When replacing fuel injectors,
order replacements with the identical part number as the old injectors.
ASSEMBLE:
1. Lubricate new injector O-ring seals with clean engine oil, and install on injector assembly.
2. New injector retainer clips on injector assembly. Position open end of clip facing injector
electrical connector.
3. MPFI injector assembly into fuel rail injector socket with electrical connectors facing outward.
Push in far enough to engage retainer clip with machined slots on rail socket.
INSTALL OR CONNECT:
1. Fuel rail assembly.
2. Intake manifold plenum.
Injector Part Number Location
Injector Installation
IDLE LEARN PROCEDURE: Any time the battery is disconnected, the programmed position of the
IAC valve pintle is lost, and replaced with a default value. To return the IAC valve pintle to the
correct position, perform the following procedure:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Injector > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Injector Cleaning Procedure > Page 3452
1. After restoring battery power, connect the Tech 1 "SCAN" tool.
2. Select "IAC SYSTEM," then select "IDLE LEARN" in the "MISC TEST" mode.
3. Proceed with idle learn as directed.
^ This procedure allows the ECM memory to be updated with the correct IAC valve pintle position,
for the vehicle, and provide a stable idle speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Regulator >
Component Information > Locations
Model R620 Fuel Rail Assembly
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Regulator >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3456
Fuel Pressure Regulator: Description and Operation
Fuel Pressure Regulator Assembly
The fuel pressure regulator assembly is a diaphragm-operated relief valve with fuel pump pressure
on one side, and regulator spring pressure and intake manifold vacuum on the other.
The function of the regulator is to maintain a constant pressure differential across the injectors at all
times. The pressure regulator compensates for engine load by increasing fuel pressure as engine
vacuum drops. The pressure regulator is mounted at the end of the fuel rail, and is serviced as a
complete assembly.
The system operates in an acceptable pressure range of 284-325 kPa (41.0-47.0 psi) with the
engine running. If the pressure is too low, poor performance and a Code 44 could result. If the
pressure is too high, excessive odor and a Code 45 could result. CHART A-7 has information on
diagnosing fuel pressure conditions.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Regulator >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3457
Fuel Pressure Regulator: Service and Repair
Fuel Rail Assembly Model R620 Exploded View
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT:
1. Negative battery terminal.
2. Relieve fuel system pressure.
3. Intake manifold plenum.
4. Fuel rail assembly.
DISASSEMBLE:
1. Pressure regulator bracket attaching screws and pressure regulator mounting bracket.
2. Left and right hand fuel rails from pressure regulator base.
3. Base to rail connectors from regulator base, or rails.
4. Connector O-rings, from base to rail connectors and discard.
5. Fuel return O-rings from fuel rails and discard.
ASSEMBLE:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Regulator >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3458
1. Lubricate new fuel return O-rings with lean engine oil, and install on fuel rails. (Fuel return O-ring
diameter is larger than connector O-ring).
2. Lubricate new connector O-rings with engine oil, and install on base to rail connectors.
3. Base to rail connectors into regulator base.
4. Left and right hand fuel rails to regulator base.
5. Pressure regulator mounting bracket with pressure regulator bracket attaching screws. Tighten
Pressure regulator bracket screws to 3.2 Nm (28 in lb). Fuel inlet fitting to 48 Nm (35 ft lb). Fuel
outlet fitting to 40 Nm (30 ft lb).
INSTALL OR CONNECT:
1. Fuel rail assembly.
2. Intake manifold plenum.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Test Port >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Test Port: Service and Repair
Area around fuel pressure connection with GM X-30A or equivalent.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT:
1. Negative battery terminal.
2. Relieve fuel system pressure.
3. Fuel pressure connection and seal. Discard seal.
INSTALL OR CONNECT:
1. New seal on fuel pressure connection.
2. Fuel pressure connection in fuel rail. Tighten Fuel pressure connection assembly to 10.0 N-m
(88 lb. in.).
3. Tighten fuel filler cap.
4. Negative battery terminal.
5. Turn ignition switch to the "ON" position for two seconds, then turn to the "OFF" position for ten
seconds. Again turn to the "ON" position, and check for fuel leaks.
6. Perform the "Idle Learn Procedure." The ECM will need to relearn the IAC valve pintle position
following battery reconnect.
Air Plenum And Fuel Rail Removal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pressure Test Port >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3462
Fuel Pressure Connection
REMOVAL:
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Relieve the fuel system pressure, see FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELIEF:
3. Remove intake manifold plenum, see INTAKE MANIFOLD PLENUM.
4. Clean area around the fuel pressure connection with GM X-30A or equivalent.
5. Remove the fuel pressure connection and seal, discard the seal.
INSTALLATION:
1. Place a new seal on the fuel pressure connection assembly.
2. Screw the fuel pressure connection assembly into the fuel rail and tighten to 10.0 N-m (88 lb.
in.).
3. Check for fuel leaks: a.
Connect the negative battery cable.
b. With engine "OFF" and ignition "ON," check for fuel leaks.
c. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
4. Install the intake manifold plenum as per above procedure.
IDLE LEARN PROCEDURE: Any time the battery is disconnected, the programmed position of the
IAC valve pintle is lost, and replaced with a default value. To return the IAC valve pintle to the
correct position, perform the following procedure:
1. After restoring battery power, connect the Tech 1 "SCAN" tool.
2. Select "IAC SYSTEM," then select "IDLE LEARN" in the "MISC TEST" mode.
3. Proceed with idle learn as directed.
^ This procedure allows the ECM memory to be updated with the correct IAC valve pintle position,
for the vehicle, and provide a stable idle speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
Diagnostic Connector - Fuel Pump > Component Information > Locations
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
Fuel Pressure Test Port > Component Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Pressure Test Port: Service and Repair
Area around fuel pressure connection with GM X-30A or equivalent.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT:
1. Negative battery terminal.
2. Relieve fuel system pressure.
3. Fuel pressure connection and seal. Discard seal.
INSTALL OR CONNECT:
1. New seal on fuel pressure connection.
2. Fuel pressure connection in fuel rail. Tighten Fuel pressure connection assembly to 10.0 N-m
(88 lb. in.).
3. Tighten fuel filler cap.
4. Negative battery terminal.
5. Turn ignition switch to the "ON" position for two seconds, then turn to the "OFF" position for ten
seconds. Again turn to the "ON" position, and check for fuel leaks.
6. Perform the "Idle Learn Procedure." The ECM will need to relearn the IAC valve pintle position
following battery reconnect.
Air Plenum And Fuel Rail Removal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pressure >
Fuel Pressure Test Port > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3471
Fuel Pressure Connection
REMOVAL:
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Relieve the fuel system pressure, see FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELIEF:
3. Remove intake manifold plenum, see INTAKE MANIFOLD PLENUM.
4. Clean area around the fuel pressure connection with GM X-30A or equivalent.
5. Remove the fuel pressure connection and seal, discard the seal.
INSTALLATION:
1. Place a new seal on the fuel pressure connection assembly.
2. Screw the fuel pressure connection assembly into the fuel rail and tighten to 10.0 N-m (88 lb.
in.).
3. Check for fuel leaks: a.
Connect the negative battery cable.
b. With engine "OFF" and ignition "ON," check for fuel leaks.
c. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
4. Install the intake manifold plenum as per above procedure.
IDLE LEARN PROCEDURE: Any time the battery is disconnected, the programmed position of the
IAC valve pintle is lost, and replaced with a default value. To return the IAC valve pintle to the
correct position, perform the following procedure:
1. After restoring battery power, connect the Tech 1 "SCAN" tool.
2. Select "IAC SYSTEM," then select "IDLE LEARN" in the "MISC TEST" mode.
3. Proceed with idle learn as directed.
^ This procedure allows the ECM memory to be updated with the correct IAC valve pintle position,
for the vehicle, and provide a stable idle speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Fuel Pump Relay: Component Locations
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Right hand rear of the engine compartment, behind the right hand strut tower.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3476
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Locations > Page 3477
Harness Connector Faces: Fuel Pump Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Locations > Page 3478
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation
Relay Center
PURPOSE:
To relay power to the fuel pump.
OPERATION:
When the ignition key is first turned to the "ON" position, the ECM/PCM will energize the fuel pump
relay for two seconds. This increases fuel pressure for cranking. If the engine is not running within
two seconds, the ECM/PCM will shut "OFF" the relay and wait until the engine starts. As soon as
the engine is cranked, the ECM/PCM will energize the relay and power the fuel pump.
NOTE: The fuel pump relay may be bypassed by the oil pressure switch activating the fuel pump.
LOCATION:
Relay Center.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump > Fuel Pump Relay
> Component Information > Locations > Page 3479
Fuel Pump Relay: Service and Repair
The fuel pump relay is mounted in the engine compartment.
Fuel Pump Relay
NOTE: Other than checking for loose connections the only service on the fuel pump relay is
replacement.
PROCEDURE
1. Verify that the ignition switch is in the "OFF" position. 2. Disconnect the wiring harness plug. 3.
Remove the fuel pump relay. 4. Install the new fuel pump relay. 5. Connect the wiring harness plug
securely.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Rail: Description and Operation
Model R620 Fuel Rail Assembly
The fuel rail assembly is mounted to the intake manifold/air plenum assembly, and performs
several jobs. It positions the injectors in the intake manifold, it distributes fuel evenly to the
injectors, and it integrates the fuel pressure regulator into the fuel metering system.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3483
Fuel Rail: Service and Repair
Fuel Rail Assembly Model R620 Exploded View
FUEL RAIL ASSEMBLY
An eight digit identification number is stamped on the left hand fuel rail (fueling even cylinders 2, 4,
6), as shown. Refer to this number if servicing or part replacement is required. Part names appear
in the numbered list on the disassembled view.
NOTE: Use care in removing the fuel rail assembly, to prevent damage to the injector electrical
connector terminals and the injector spray tips. Prevent dirt and other contaminants from entering
open lines and passages. Fittings should be capped, and holes plugged, during servicing.
CLEAN: Before removal, the fuel rail assembly may be cleaned with a spray type engine cleaner,
GM X-30A or equivalent, following package instructions. DO NOT soak fuel rails in liquid cleaning
solvent.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT:
1. Negative battery terminal.
2. Relieve fuel system pressure.
3. Intake manifold plenum.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3484
4. Fuel line bracket bolt.
5. Fuel lines at rail. Use a back-up wrench on the fuel rail fittings to prevent them from turning.
6. Fuel inlet and return line O-rings (1, 2), and discard.
7. Vacuum line at pressure regulator.
8. Rail retaining bolts.
9. Injector electrical connectors.
10. Fuel rail assembly.
DISASSEMBLE:
Injector O-ring seal from spray tip end of each injector. Discard seals.
ASSEMBLE:
Lubricate new injector O-ring seals with clean engine oil, and install on spray tip end of each
injector.
INSTALL OR CONNECT:
1. Fuel rail assembly in intake manifold. Tilt rail assembly to install injectors.
2. Fuel rail attaching bolts. Tighten fuel rail attaching bolts to 10 N-m (88 lb. in.).
3. Injector electrical connectors.
4. Vacuum line to pressure regulator.
5. New O-rings (1, 2) on fuel lines.
6. Fuel feed and return lines. Tighten fuel line nuts to 23 N-m (17 lb. ft.). Use a back-up wrench on
the fuel rail fittings to prevent them from turning.
7. Negative battery terminal.
8. Fuel filler cap.
9. Turn ignition switch to the "ON" position for two seconds, then turn to the "OFF" position for ten
seconds. Again turn to the "ON" position, and check for fuel leaks.
10. Intake manifold plenum.
11. Perform the "Idle Learn Procedure." The ECM will need to relearn the IAC valve pintle position
following battery reconnect.
Fuel Rail Assembly Identification
NOTE: An eight digit identification number is stamped on the left hand fuel rail (fueling even
numbered cylinders 2, 4, 6). Refer to this number if servicing or part replacement is required.
CAUTION: When servicing the fuel rail assembly, be careful to prevent dirt and other contaminants
from entering open lines and passages. Fittings should be capped, and holes should be plugged,
during servicing.
^ Any time the fuel system is opened for service, the O-rings should be replaced.
^ Before removal, the fuel rail assembly may be cleaned with a spray type engine cleaner, GM
X30-A or equivalent, following package instructions. DO NOT soak the fuel rails in liquid cleaning
solvent.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3485
Air Plenum And Fuel Rail Removal
REMOVAL:
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Relieve the fuel system pressure, see FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELIEF.
3. Remove the intake manifold plenum, see INTAKE MANIFOLD PLENUM.
4. Remove the fuel line bracket bolt.
5. Remove the fuel lines at the fuel rail. Use a back-up wrench on the fuel fittings to prevent them
from turning.
6. Remove the fuel inlet and return line O-rings and discard.
7. Disconnect the vacuum line at the pressure regulator.
8. Remove the fuel rail retaining bolts.
CAUTION: Use care in removing the fuel rail assembly, to prevent damage to the injector spray
tips, and the injector electrical connector terminals. When removed, support the rail to prevent
damage to its components. The fuel injector is serviced as a complete assembly only. Since it is an
electrical component, it should not be immersed in any liquid cleaner.
9. Remove the injector O-ring from the tip of each injector, and discard.
INSTALLATION:
1. Lubricate the O-ring seals with clean engine oil, and install one on the tip of each injector.
2. Install the fuel rail assembly in the intake manifold. Tilt the fuel rail assembly in the intake
manifold. Tilt rail to install the injectors.
3. Install the fuel rail mounting bolts, and tighten to 10 N-m (88 lb. in.).
4. Connect the fuel injector electrical connectors.
5. Put new O-rings on the fuel lines.
6. Attach the fuel feed and return line and tighten to 23 N-m (17 lb. ft.). Use a back-up wrench on
the fuel fittings to prevent them from turning.
7. Check for fuel leaks: a.
Temporarily connect the negative battery cable.
b. With the engine "OFF" and the ignition "ON," check for fuel leaks.
c. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
8. Install the intake manifold plenum.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Rail > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3486
9. Connect the negative battery cable.
IDLE LEARN PROCEDURE: Any time the battery is disconnected, the programmed position of the
IAC valve pintle is lost, and replaced with a default value. To return the IAC valve pintle to the
correct position, perform the following procedure:
1. After restoring battery power, connect the Tech 1 "SCAN" tool.
2. Select "IAC SYSTEM," then select "IDLE LEARN" in the "MISC TEST" mode.
3. Proceed with idle learn as directed. ^
This procedure allows the ECM memory to be updated with the correct IAC valve pintle position, for
the vehicle, and provide a stable idle speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Return Line > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Fuel Return Line: Description and Operation
Modular Fuel Sender To Tank
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Return Line > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3490
Front Fuel Pipe Routing
Side And Rear Fuel Pipe Routing
Engine Compartment Fuel Pump Routing
Front Fuel Vapor Pipe
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Return Line > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3491
FUEL TANK
The fuel tank is located under the rear of the vehicle and is the fuel reservoir. The tank has a
vertical baffle installed to support the filler tube and to serve as a slosh baffle. The fuel pump and
fuel level sending unit assembly are mounted in the fuel tank as one assembly. The fuel tank
assembly also consists of the fuel filler neck and filler cap.
FUEL FILLER NECK
To help prevent refueling with leaded fuel, the fuel filler neck has a built-in restrictor and deflector.
The opening of the restrictor will accept only the smaller unleaded gasoline nozzle which must be
fully inserted to bypass the deflector. Attempted refueling with a leaded fuel nozzle will result in fuel
splashing back out of the filler neck.
FUEL TANK FILLER CAP
The fuel tank filler neck is equipped with a screw type cap. The threaded part of the cap requires
several turns counterclockwise to remove. The long threaded area was designed to allow any
remaining fuel tank pressure to escape during the cap removal operation. A ratchet type torque
limiting device prevents over-tightening. To install, turn the cap clockwise until a clicking noise is
heard. This signals that the correct torque has been reached and the cap is fully seated.
NOTE: If a fuel filler cap requires replacement, only a cap with the same features should be used.
Failure to use the correct cap can result in a serious malfunction of the system.
FUEL AND VAPOR PIPES
The fuel feed and return pipes extend from the fuel pump/gauge sending unit to the engine
compartment. The pipes are secured to the underbody with clip and screw assemblies. Both fuel
feed pipes and return pipe must be properly routed and retained, and should be inspected
occasionally for leaks, kinks, or dents. If evidence of dirt is found in the fuel rail/injector assembly or
fuel filter during disassembly, the pipes should be disconnected and blown out. Check the fuel
strainer on the fuel pump/fuel gauge assembly for damage or omission.
The vapor pipe extends from the fuel pump/gauge assembly to the canister. However, it does not
follow the same route as the fuel feed pipe.
Due to the fact that the fuel pipes/hoses are under high pressure on fuel injected systems these
systems require special consideration for service.
NOTE: All fuel feed and return line attachments in the system are screw type fittings. Always use a
backup wrench when loosening or tightening the fittings. Screw fittings used on the two systems
utilize "O" rings for the fuel feed and return pipes and the two sizes of "O" rings are not
interchangeable. Any time that the fuel or return pipes are disconnected, inspect the "O" rings for
cuts or other type of damage and replace as necessary. The flare used on these fuel pipes is not
compatible with the flare used on other fuel pipes.
FUEL LINE "O" RINGS
The fuel line "O" rings used are made of Viton. They are brown in color. Viton is less affected than
rubber by the additives used in many fuels. Therefore, rubber should not be used.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Return Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pressure Connection
Fuel Return Line: Service and Repair Fuel Pressure Connection
Area around fuel pressure connection with GM X-30A or equivalent.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT:
1. Negative battery terminal.
2. Relieve fuel system pressure.
3. Fuel pressure connection and seal. Discard seal.
INSTALL OR CONNECT:
1. New seal on fuel pressure connection.
2. Fuel pressure connection in fuel rail. Tighten Fuel pressure connection assembly to 10.0 N-m
(88 lb. in.).
3. Tighten fuel filler cap.
4. Negative battery terminal.
5. Turn ignition switch to the "ON" position for two seconds, then turn to the "OFF" position for ten
seconds. Again turn to the "ON" position, and check for fuel leaks.
6. Perform the "Idle Learn Procedure." The ECM will need to relearn the IAC valve pintle position
following battery reconnect.
Air Plenum And Fuel Rail Removal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Return Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pressure Connection > Page 3494
Fuel Pressure Connection
REMOVAL:
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Relieve the fuel system pressure, see FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE RELIEF:
3. Remove intake manifold plenum, see INTAKE MANIFOLD PLENUM.
4. Clean area around the fuel pressure connection with GM X-30A or equivalent.
5. Remove the fuel pressure connection and seal, discard the seal.
INSTALLATION:
1. Place a new seal on the fuel pressure connection assembly.
2. Screw the fuel pressure connection assembly into the fuel rail and tighten to 10.0 N-m (88 lb.
in.).
3. Check for fuel leaks: a.
Connect the negative battery cable.
b. With engine "OFF" and ignition "ON," check for fuel leaks.
c. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
4. Install the intake manifold plenum as per above procedure.
IDLE LEARN PROCEDURE: Any time the battery is disconnected, the programmed position of the
IAC valve pintle is lost, and replaced with a default value. To return the IAC valve pintle to the
correct position, perform the following procedure:
1. After restoring battery power, connect the Tech 1 "SCAN" tool.
2. Select "IAC SYSTEM," then select "IDLE LEARN" in the "MISC TEST" mode.
3. Proceed with idle learn as directed.
^ This procedure allows the ECM memory to be updated with the correct IAC valve pintle position,
for the vehicle, and provide a stable idle speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Return Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pressure Connection > Page 3495
Fuel Return Line: Service and Repair Fuel Supply/Return/or Emission Pipe Service
Front Fuel Pipe Routing
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Return Line > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Pressure Connection > Page 3496
Side And Rear Fuel Pipe Routing
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Locations
Rear Of Car
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3500
Fuel Supply Line: Description and Operation
Modular Fuel Sender To Tank
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3501
Front Fuel Pipe Routing
Side And Rear Fuel Pipe Routing
Engine Compartment Fuel Pump Routing
Front Fuel Vapor Pipe
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3502
FUEL TANK
The fuel tank is located under the rear of the vehicle and is the fuel reservoir. The tank has a
vertical baffle installed to support the filler tube and to serve as a slosh baffle. The fuel pump and
fuel level sending unit assembly are mounted in the fuel tank as one assembly. The fuel tank
assembly also consists of the fuel filler neck and filler cap.
FUEL FILLER NECK
To help prevent refueling with leaded fuel, the fuel filler neck has a built-in restrictor and deflector.
The opening of the restrictor will accept only the smaller unleaded gasoline nozzle which must be
fully inserted to bypass the deflector. Attempted refueling with a leaded fuel nozzle will result in fuel
splashing back out of the filler neck.
FUEL TANK FILLER CAP
The fuel tank filler neck is equipped with a screw type cap. The threaded part of the cap requires
several turns counterclockwise to remove. The long threaded area was designed to allow any
remaining fuel tank pressure to escape during the cap removal operation. A ratchet type torque
limiting device prevents over-tightening. To install, turn the cap clockwise until a clicking noise is
heard. This signals that the correct torque has been reached and the cap is fully seated.
NOTE: If a fuel filler cap requires replacement, only a cap with the same features should be used.
Failure to use the correct cap can result in a serious malfunction of the system.
FUEL AND VAPOR PIPES
The fuel feed and return pipes extend from the fuel pump/gauge sending unit to the engine
compartment. The pipes are secured to the underbody with clip and screw assemblies. Both fuel
feed pipes and return pipe must be properly routed and retained, and should be inspected
occasionally for leaks, kinks, or dents. If evidence of dirt is found in the fuel rail/injector assembly or
fuel filter during disassembly, the pipes should be disconnected and blown out. Check the fuel
strainer on the fuel pump/fuel gauge assembly for damage or omission.
The vapor pipe extends from the fuel pump/gauge assembly to the canister. However, it does not
follow the same route as the fuel feed pipe.
Due to the fact that the fuel pipes/hoses are under high pressure on fuel injected systems these
systems require special consideration for service.
NOTE: All fuel feed and return line attachments in the system are screw type fittings. Always use a
backup wrench when loosening or tightening the fittings. Screw fittings used on the two systems
utilize "O" rings for the fuel feed and return pipes and the two sizes of "O" rings are not
interchangeable. Any time that the fuel or return pipes are disconnected, inspect the "O" rings for
cuts or other type of damage and replace as necessary. The flare used on these fuel pipes is not
compatible with the flare used on other fuel pipes.
FUEL LINE "O" RINGS
The fuel line "O" rings used are made of Viton. They are brown in color. Viton is less affected than
rubber by the additives used in many fuels. Therefore, rubber should not be used.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3503
Fuel Supply Line: Service and Repair
Front Fuel Pipe Routing
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Supply Line > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3504
Side And Rear Fuel Pipe Routing
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge
Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair
Modular Fuel Sender To Tank
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge
Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3509
Modular Fuel Sender Assembly
NOTE: Always replace fuel sender assembly O-ring when reinstalling fuel sender assembly.
Remove or Disconnect:
1. Negative battery cable.
2. Relieve system fuel pressure.
3. Drain fuel tank. Refer to "DRAINING FUEL TANK."
4. Fuel tank, Refer to "FUEL TANK REPLACEMENT."
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Tank > Fuel Gauge
Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3510
5. While holding, the modular fuel sender assembly down, remove the snap ring from designated
slots located on the retainer.
IMPORTANT:
^ The modular fuel sender assembly may spring up from its position.
^ When removing the modular fuel sender assembly from the fuel tank, be aware that that the
reservoir bucket is full of fuel. It must be tipped slightly during removal to avoid damage to the float.
Discard fuel sender O-ring and replace with a new one.
^ Carefully discard the reservoir fuel into an approved container.
INSTALL OR CONNECT:
1. New O-ring on modular fuel sender to tank.
2. Align tab on front of sender with slot on front of retainer snap ring.
3. Slowly apply pressure to top of spring loaded sender until sender aligns flush with retainer on
tank.
4. Insert snap ring into designated slots.
IMPORTANT:
^ Be sure that the snap ring is fully seated within the tab slots.
5. Fuel tank. Refer to "FUEL TANK REPLACEMENT"
6. Lower vehicle.
7. Refill tank.
INSPECT:
^ Turn ignition to "ON" position for two seconds, then to "OFF" for ten seconds. Again turn to "ON"
position, and check for fuel leak's.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Specifications
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Specifications Actuator Tightening Torque
Actuator Tightening Torque
Idle Air Control Valve 27 in.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3514
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3515
Harness Connector Faces: Idle Air Control Valve
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3516
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Description and Operation
Idle Air Control Valve Assembly (IAC)
PURPOSE:
To control the engine idle speed and prevent stalling due to changes in engine load.
OPERATION:
The IAC valve controls the amount of air bypassed around the throttle plate. If more air is
bypassed, idle speed will increase, and if less air is bypassed, the idle speed will decrease. The
IAC valve accomplishes this by moving a conical shaped pintle in to decrease bypassed air and out
to increase bypassed air. This can be seen as counts as displayed on a "SCAN" tool. Inward
Movement of the pintle = Decreased RPM =Lower Counts. Outward Movement of the pintle =
Increased RPM = Higher Counts. The ECM uses sensor and switch inputs to control the position of
the IAC pintle. If the pintle is stuck open, the idle speed will remain high. If the pintle is stuck
closed, the idle speed will be too low, and stalling may occur. If the pintle is stuck partially open, the
idle speed will be higher than normal, and there will be no response to changes in engine load such
as A/C ("ON") or transmission in ("Drive").
LOCATION:
Throttle body.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Chart C-2B, Idle Air Control (IAC) Valve Check
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Testing and Inspection Chart C-2B, Idle Air Control (IAC)
Valve Check
Chart C-2B Idle Air Control (IAC) Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Chart C-2B, Idle Air Control (IAC) Valve Check > Page
3519
Idle Air Control Circuit
Circuit Description:
The PCM controls engine idle speed with the Idle Air Control (IAC) valve. To increase idle speed,
the PCM retracts the IAC valve pintle away from its seat, allowing more air to bypass the throttle
bore. To decrease idle speed, it extends the IAC valve pintle towards its seat, reducing bypass air
flow. A Tech 1 scan tool will display the PCM commands to the IAC valve in counts. Higher counts
indicate more air bypass (higher idle). Lower counts indicate less air is allowed to bypass (lower
idle).
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. The Tech 1 RPM control mode is used to extend and retract the IAC valve. The valve should
move smoothly within the specified range. If the idle
speed is commanded (IAC extended) too low (below 700 RPM), the engine may stall. This may be
normal and would not indicate a problem. Retracting the IAC beyond its controlled range (above
1500 RPM) will cause a delay before the RPMs start dropping. This too is normal.
2. This test uses the Tech 1 to command the IAC controlled idle speed. The PCM issues
commands to obtain commanded idle speed. The node lights
each should flash red and green to indicate a good circuit as the PCM issues commands. While the
sequence of color is not important if either light is "OFF" or does not flash red and green, check the
circuits for faults, beginning with poor terminal contacts.
Diagnostic Aids:
A slow, unstable or fast idle may be caused by a non-IAC system problem that cannot be
overcome by the IAC valve. Out of control range IAC scan tool counts will be above 60 if idle is too
low and zero counts if idle is too high. The following checks should be made to repair a non-IAC
system problem:
^ Vacuum leak (high idle). If idle is too high, stop the engine. Fully extend (low) IAC with Tech 1
scan tool. Start engine. If idle speed is above 800 RPM, locate and correct vacuum leak including
crankcase ventilation system. Also check for binding of throttle blade or linkage.
^ System too lean (high air/fuel ratio). The idle speed may be too high or too low. Engine speed
may vary tip and down and disconnecting the IAC valve does not help. DTC 44 may be set. Scan
O2S voltage will be less than 300 mV (.3 volt). Check for low regulated fuel pressure, water in the
fuel or a restricted injector.
^ System too rich (low air/fuel ratio). The idle speed will be too low. Scan tool IAC counts will
usually be above 80. System is obviously rich and may exhibit black smoke in exhaust.
Scan tool 02S voltage will be fixed above 800 mV (.8 volt).
Check for high fuel pressure, leaking or sticking injector. Silicone contaminated Oxygen Sensors
(O2S) scan voltage will be slow to respond.
^ Throttle body. Remove IAC valve and inspect bore for foreign material.
^ IAC valve electrical connections. IAC valve connections should be carefully checked for proper
contact.
^ Crankcase ventilation valve. An incorrect or faulty crankcase ventilation valve may result in an
incorrect idle speed.
^ Refer to "Rough, Unstable or Incorrect Idle, Stalling" in "Diagnosis By Symptom."
^ If intermittent poor driveability or idle symptoms are resolved by disconnecting the IAC, carefully
recheck connections, valve terminal resistance or replace IAC. A rapid change of IAC counts are
an indication of a loose connection or connector.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Chart C-2B, Idle Air Control (IAC) Valve Check > Page
3520
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Testing and Inspection Idle Air Control (IAC) Reset
Procedure
IMPORTANT: If installing a new IAC valve, be sure to replace with an identical part. IAC valve
pintle shape and diameter are designed for the specific application.
Measure the distance between tip of IAC valve pintle and mounting flange. If greater than 28 mm,
use ringer pressure to slowly retract the pintle. The force required to retract the pintle of a new
valve will not cause damage to the valve.
Reset IAC valve pintle position:
a. Turn ignition "ON" for five seconds.
b. Turn ignition "OFF" for ten seconds.
c. Start engine, check for proper idle operation.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Service and Repair > Idle Air Control (IAC) Reset Procedure
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Service and Repair Idle Air Control (IAC) Reset
Procedure
IMPORTANT: If installing a new IAC valve, be sure to replace with an identical part. IAC valve
pintle shape and diameter are designed for the specific application.
Measure the distance between tip of IAC valve pintle and mounting flange. If greater than 28 mm,
use ringer pressure to slowly retract the pintle. The force required to retract the pintle of a new
valve will not cause damage to the valve.
Reset IAC valve pintle position:
a. Turn ignition "ON" for five seconds.
b. Turn ignition "OFF" for ten seconds.
c. Start engine, check for proper idle operation.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Service and Repair > Idle Air Control (IAC) Reset Procedure > Page 3523
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Service and Repair Idle Air Control (IAC) Valve
Replacement
Throttle Body Assembly
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Service and Repair > Idle Air Control (IAC) Reset Procedure > Page 3524
IAC Valve
REMOVAL:
1. Disconnect the idle air control (IAC) valve electrical connector.
2. Remove the IAC valve attaching screws.
3. Remove the IAC valve assembly.
4. Clean the IAC valve O-ring sealing surface, pintle valve, seat and air passage. ^
Use carburetor cleaner and a parts cleaning brush to remove carbon deposits. DO NOT use a
cleaner that contains Methyl Ethyl Ketone. It is an extremely strong solvent, and not necessary for
this type of deposit.
^ Shiny spots on the pintle or seat are normal, and do not indicate misalignment or a bent pintle
shaft.
^ If the air passage has heavy deposits, remove the throttle body for complete cleaning.
^ Inspect the IAC valve O-ring for cuts, cracks or distortion. Replace if damaged.
NOTE: If installing a new IAC valve, be sure to replace with an identical part. IAC valve pintle
shape and diameter are designed for specific application.
INSTALLATION:
1. If installing a new IAC valve, measure the distance between the tip of the pintle and the
mounting flange. ^
If greater than 28 mm, use finger pressure to slowly retract the pintle. The force required to retract
the pintle of a new valve will not cause damage to the valve.
2. Lubricate the IAC valve O-ring with clean engine oil.
3. Install the IAC valve assembly.
4. Install the IAC valve attaching screws, and tighten to 3.4 Nm (30 in lb).
5. Connect the IAC valve electrical connector.
6. START the engine and allow it to reach operating temperature.
IDLE LEARN PROCEDURE: Any time the battery is disconnected, the programmed position of the
IAC valve pintle is lost, and replaced with a default value. To return the IAC valve pintle to the
correct position, perform the following procedure:
1. After restoring battery power, connect the Tech 1 "SCAN" tool.
2. Select "IAC SYSTEM," then select "IDLE LEARN" in the "MISC TEST" mode.
3. Proceed with idle learn as directed.
^ This procedure allows the ECM memory to be updated with the correct IAC valve pintle position,
for the vehicle, and provide a stable idle speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Service and Repair > Idle Air Control (IAC) Reset Procedure > Page 3525
Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator - Electronic: Service and Repair Idle Air/Vacuum Signal Housing
Throttle Body Assembly
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT:
1. Negative battery terminal.
2. Vacuum harness connector.
3. IAC valve electrical connector.
4. Idle Air Control (IAC) valve.
5. Idle air/vacuum signal housing screws.
6. Idle air/vacuum signal housing assembly and gasket. Discard gasket.
7. Clean gasket mounting surfaces to ensure a good seal.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Idle Speed/Throttle Actuator Electronic > Component Information > Service and Repair > Idle Air Control (IAC) Reset Procedure > Page 3526
NOTE: Use care in cleaning old gasket material from machined aluminum surfaces. Sharp tools
may damage sealing surfaces.
INSTALL OR CONNECT:
1. New idle air/vacuum signal assembly gasket.
2. Idle air/vacuum signal housing assembly.
3. Idle air/vacuum signal housing screws. Tighten idle air/vacuum signal housing screws (starting in
center and moving outward) to 3.4 N-m (30 lb. in.).
4. Measure Distance between tip of IAC valve pintle and mounting flange. If greater than 28 mm, use ringer pressure to slowly retract the pintle. The force required to retract
the pintle of a new valve will not cause damage to the valve.
5. Lubricate IAC valve O-ring with clean engine, oil.
6. IAC valve assembly.
7. Attaching screws. Tighten IAC valve attaching screws to 3.0 N-m (27 lb. in.).
8. IAC valve electrical connector.
9. Vacuum harness connector.
10. Negative battery terminal.
11. Perform the "Idle Learn Procedure." The ECM will need to relearn the IAC valve pintle position
following battery reconnect.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Plenum >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Intake Air Plenum: Service and Repair
Air Plenum And Fuel Rail Removal
Removing the fuel rail assembly from the engine requires removing the top portion of the tuned
intake manifold, called the "plenum."
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT:
1. Negative battery terminal.
2. Vacuum lines, noting positions of hoses.
3. EGR to plenum nuts.
4. Two throttle body attaching bolts, throttle body and gasket. Discard gasket.
5. Throttle cable bracket bolts.
6. Ignition wire plastic shield bolts.
7. Plenum bolts.
8. Plenum and gaskets. Discard gaskets.
NOTE: Use care in cleaning old gasket material from machined aluminum surfaces. Sharp tools
may damage sealing surfaces.
INSTALL OR CONNECT:
1. New plenum gaskets.
2. Plenum.
3, Plenum bolts. Tighten plenum bolts to 10 N-m (88 lb. in.).
4. Ignition wire plastic shield bolts.
5. Throttle body with new gasket.
6. Throttle body bolts. Tighten throttle body bolts to 25 N-m (18 lb. ft.).
7. EGR to plenum nuts.
8. Throttle cable bracket bolts.
9. Vacuum lines.
10. Negative battery terminal.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Plenum >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 3530
11. With the engine "OFF," check to see that the accelerator pedal is free: Depress pedal to the
floor and release.
12. Perform the "Idle Learn Procedure." The ECM will need to relearn the IAC valve pintle position
following battery reconnect.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel
Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch
Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump): Locations Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch
RH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel
Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch > Page 3535
RH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel
Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch > Page 3536
Fuel Pump / Oil Pressure Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel
Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Page 3537
Harness Connector Faces: Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Fuel Pump Relay: Component Locations
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Right hand rear of the engine compartment, behind the right hand strut tower.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3543
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 3544
Harness Connector Faces: Fuel Pump Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 3545
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation
Relay Center
PURPOSE:
To relay power to the fuel pump.
OPERATION:
When the ignition key is first turned to the "ON" position, the ECM/PCM will energize the fuel pump
relay for two seconds. This increases fuel pressure for cranking. If the engine is not running within
two seconds, the ECM/PCM will shut "OFF" the relay and wait until the engine starts. As soon as
the engine is cranked, the ECM/PCM will energize the relay and power the fuel pump.
NOTE: The fuel pump relay may be bypassed by the oil pressure switch activating the fuel pump.
LOCATION:
Relay Center.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Relays and Modules - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 3546
Fuel Pump Relay: Service and Repair
The fuel pump relay is mounted in the engine compartment.
Fuel Pump Relay
NOTE: Other than checking for loose connections the only service on the fuel pump relay is
replacement.
PROCEDURE
1. Verify that the ignition switch is in the "OFF" position. 2. Disconnect the wiring harness plug. 3.
Remove the fuel pump relay. 4. Install the new fuel pump relay. 5. Connect the wiring harness plug
securely.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump
Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch
Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump): Locations Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch
RH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump
Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch > Page 3552
RH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Fuel Pump
Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch > Page 3553
Fuel Pump / Oil Pressure Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Oil Pressure Switch (For Fuel Pump) > Component Information > Locations > Page 3554
Harness Connector Faces: Fuel Pump Switch/Oil Pressure Sender/Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
At Closed Throttle < 0.9 V
At Wide Open Throttle 4.7 V
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications >
Page 3559
Throttle Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor 18 in.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 3560
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3563
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3564
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3565
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3566
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3567
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3568
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3569
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3570
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3571
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3572
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3573
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3574
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3575
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3576
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3577
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3578
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3579
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3580
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3581
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3582
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3583
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3584
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3585
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3586
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3587
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3588
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3589
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3590
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3591
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3592
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3593
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3594
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and
Instructions > Page 3595
Throttle Position Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3596
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Throttle Position Sensor (TPS)
PURPOSE:
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) is a potentiometer that senses throttle angle and sends a signal
to the ECM. This input to the ECM is used to control the fuel system on acceleration and
deceleration.
OPERATION:
The TPS has three internal circuits. One to ground, a second from the ECM as a 5.0 volt reference
source and a third circuit is used by the ECM to measure the output voltage. As the throttle angle
changes (pressing down on accelerator pedal) the TPS voltage output varies from about .5 volt at
idle to about 4.9 volts at wide open throttle (WOT).
LOCATION:
Side of throttle body opposite of throttle lever.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3597
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
N/A: TPS is not adjustable on this engine.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3598
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Throttle Position Sensor
Typical Throttle Body Assembly
REMOVAL:
1. Disconnect the Throttle Position Sensor electrical connector.
2. Remove the Throttle Position Sensor mounting screws.
3. Remove the Throttle Position Sensor.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3599
NOTE: The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) is an electrical component and must not be soaked in
any liquid cleaner or solvent, damage may result.
INSTALLATION:
1. With the throttle valve closed, position the Throttle Position Sensor on the throttle shaft, then
align the screw holes.
2. Install the Throttle Position Sensor screws and tighten to 2.0 N-m (18 lb. in.).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Sensors and Switches - Fuel
Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Switch > Component Information > Locations
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Throttle Body: Description and Operation
Typical Throttle Body Assembly
The throttle body assembly is attached to the intake manifold air plenum, and is used to control air
flow into the engine, controlling engine output. The throttle valve within the throttle body is opened
by the driver through the accelerator controls. During engine idle, the throttle valve is closed, and
air flow is handled by the Idle Air Control (IAC) Valve. To prevent the throttle valve icing during cool
weather operation, engine coolant is directed through the coolant cavity on the bottom of the
throttle body.
The throttle body also provides the location for mounting the Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) and for
sensing changes in engine vacuum due to throttle valve position. Vacuum ports are located at,
above, or below the throttle valve to generate vacuum signals needed by various components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Coolant Cavity Cover
Throttle Body: Service and Repair Coolant Cavity Cover
Throttle Body Assembly
Remove or Disconnect:
Throttle body from intake plenum.
Refer to "Throttle Body Assembly."
Disassemble:
1. Coolant cover attaching screws (45).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Coolant Cavity Cover > Page 3608
2. Coolant cavity cover (40) and O-ring (46). Discard O-ring.
Clean O-ring sealing surfaces. Inspect sealing surfaces for corrosion or damage that could cause a
coolant leak. Replace coolant cavity cover or throttle body if necessary.
Assemble:
1. Lubricate new coolant cover O-ring (46) with ethylene glycol antifreeze.
2. O-ring in cavity of throttle body.
3. Coolant cavity cover (40). Hold cover in place.
4. Coolant cover attaching screws (45).
Tighten:
Attaching screws to 3.O N-m (27 lb. in.).
Install or Connect: Throttle body to intake plenum. Refer to "Throttle Body Assembly."
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Coolant Cavity Cover > Page 3609
Throttle Body: Service and Repair Throttle Body Assembly Removal and Replacement
Typical Throttle Body Assembly
Throttle Body Removal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Body > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Coolant Cavity Cover > Page 3610
Throttle Body Identification
The throttle body assembly repair procedures cover component replacement with the unit on the
vehicle. However, throttle body replacement requires that the complete unit be removed from the
engine. An eight digit part identification number is stamped on the bottom of the throttle body
casting next to the coolant cover. Refer to this number if servicing, or part replacement is required.
For identification of parts during repair, refer to the disassembled view.
Clean The throttle bore and valve deposits may be cleaned on-vehicle, using carburetor cleaner
and a parts cleaning brush. Follow instructions on container. DO NOT use a cleaner that contains
methyl ethyl ketone, an extremely strong solvent, and not necessary for this type of deposit.
The throttle body metal parts may be clean following disassembly, in a cold immersion-type cleaner
such as GM X-55 or equivalent.
NOTE: The TPS and IAC valve should not come in contact with solvent or cleaner, as the may be
damaged.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT:
1. Negative battery terminal.
2. Partially drain radiator, to allow coolant hoses a throttle body to be removed.
3. Air inlet duct.
4. IAC valve and TPS electrical connectors.
5. Vacuum harness connector.
6. Coolant hoses at throttle body.
7. Throttle, TV (transmission control), and cruise control cables.
8. Throttle body retaining bolts.
9. Throttle body assembly.
10. Flange gasket and discard.
NOTE: Use care in cleaning old gasket material from machined aluminum surfaces. Sharp tools
may damage sealing surfaces. Clean gasket surface on intake manifold.
INSTALL OR CONNECT:
1. New flange gasket.
2. Throttle body assembly.
3. Throttle body retaining bolts. Tighten Throttle body attaching bolts to 25.0 N-m (18 lb. ft.).
4. Throttle, TV (transmission control) and cruise control cables.
IMPORTANT: Make sure throttle and cruise control linkage does not hold throttle open.
5. Coolant hoses to throttle body.
6. Vacuum harness connector.
7. IAC valve and TPS electrical connectors.
8. Air inlet duct.
9. Refill radiator to replace lost coolant.
10. Negative battery terminal. With the engine "OFF," check to see that the accelerator pedal is
free: Depress pedal to the floor and release.
11. Perform the "Idle Learn Procedure." The ECM will need to relearn the IAC valve pintle position
following battery reconnect.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable/Linkage >
Component Information > Adjustments
Throttle Cable/Linkage: Adjustments
The accelerator control system is cable type. There are no linkage adjustments. The specific cable
for each application must be used. Only the specific replacement part will work.
Check for correct opening and closing positions by operating the accelerator pedal. Make sure that
the throttle valve reaches the wide open and fully closed throttle positions. If it does not, inspect for
damaged or bent brackets, levers, or other components, or for poor carpet fit under the accelerator
pedal.
If any binding is present in the linkage, check for:
1. Proper routing of the throttle cable.
2. Kinked or damaged cable.
3. Free movement of: a.
Throttle lever at the throttle body.
b. Cable at throttle body or control lever/pulley.
c. Accelerator lever at bearing support.
d. Pedal at lever.
Whenever disconnecting or replacing parts, lubricate the pivot points with Accelerator Linkage
Lubricant 1052541 or equivalent.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable/Linkage >
Component Information > Adjustments > Page 3614
Throttle Cable/Linkage: Service and Repair
Accelerator Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable/Linkage >
Component Information > Adjustments > Page 3615
Accelerator Cable Underhood
ACCELERATOR CONTROL CABLE
Remove or Disconnect:
1. Left sound insulator.
2. Release cable retainer from lever assembly.
3. Depress cable tangs and push forward toward engine compartment.
4. Clip from throttle lever.
5. Depress tangs on cable trough cable bracket.
Install or Connect:
1. Route cable through cable bracket.
2. Press cable upward through bracket making sure tangs expand and properly seat.
3. Route cable through cowl.
4. Slip accelerator cable through slot in rod and then install retainer in rod, being sure it is seated.
Inspect:
Check for correct opening and closing positions by operating accelerator pedal. Make sure that the
throttle valve reaches wide-open throttle position. If it does not, inspect for damaged or bent
brackets, levers, or other components; or, for poor carpet fit under the accelerator pedal.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Cable/Linkage >
Component Information > Adjustments > Page 3616
Flexible components (hoses, wires, conduits, etc.) must not be routed within 50 mm (2.0 in.) of
moving parts of accelerator linkage outboard of support unless routing is positively controlled.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor: Electrical Specifications
At Closed Throttle < 0.9 V
At Wide Open Throttle 4.7 V
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Electrical Specifications > Page 3621
Throttle Position Sensor: Mechanical Specifications
Throttle Position Sensor 18 in.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3622
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3625
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3626
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3627
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3628
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3629
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3630
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3631
Throttle Position Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3632
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3633
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3634
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3635
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3636
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3637
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3638
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3639
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3640
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3641
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3642
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3643
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3644
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3645
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3646
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3647
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3648
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3649
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3650
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3651
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3652
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3653
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3654
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3655
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3656
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 3657
Throttle Position Sensor Circuit
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3658
Throttle Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Throttle Position Sensor (TPS)
PURPOSE:
The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) is a potentiometer that senses throttle angle and sends a signal
to the ECM. This input to the ECM is used to control the fuel system on acceleration and
deceleration.
OPERATION:
The TPS has three internal circuits. One to ground, a second from the ECM as a 5.0 volt reference
source and a third circuit is used by the ECM to measure the output voltage. As the throttle angle
changes (pressing down on accelerator pedal) the TPS voltage output varies from about .5 volt at
idle to about 4.9 volts at wide open throttle (WOT).
LOCATION:
Side of throttle body opposite of throttle lever.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3659
Throttle Position Sensor: Adjustments
N/A: TPS is not adjustable on this engine.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3660
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Throttle Position Sensor
Typical Throttle Body Assembly
REMOVAL:
1. Disconnect the Throttle Position Sensor electrical connector.
2. Remove the Throttle Position Sensor mounting screws.
3. Remove the Throttle Position Sensor.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 3661
NOTE: The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) is an electrical component and must not be soaked in
any liquid cleaner or solvent, damage may result.
INSTALLATION:
1. With the throttle valve closed, position the Throttle Position Sensor on the throttle shaft, then
align the screw holes.
2. Install the Throttle Position Sensor screws and tighten to 2.0 N-m (18 lb. in.).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Switch >
Component Information > Locations
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Firing Order > Component Information >
Specifications > Ignition Firing Order
Firing Order: Specifications Ignition Firing Order
Firing Order .........................................................................................................................................
............................................................... 1-2-3-4-5-6
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Timing > Number One Cylinder >
Component Information > Locations > Number 1 Cylinder Location
Number One Cylinder: Locations Number 1 Cylinder Location
NUMBER ONE CYLINDER LOCATION
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Timing > Timing Marks and Indicators
> System Information > Locations
Timing Marks and Indicators: Locations
The ECM controls ignition timing therefore no provisions for adjustment are required. No timing
marks are provided on this engine.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Crankshaft Position Sensor
RH rear of engine, on exhaust manifold
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3681
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Typical DIS Crankshaft Sensor
PURPOSE:
The crankshaft sensor provides a signal through the Direct Ignition (DI), which the ECM uses as
reference to calculate rpm and crankshaft position.
OPERATION:
This sensor protrudes into the block, within approximately .050" of the engine crankshaft reluctor.
The reluctor is a special wheel cast into the crankshaft with seven slots cast into it, six of which are
evenly spaced 60° apart. A seventh slot is spaced 10° from one of the other slots and serves to
generate a "sync pulse." As the reluctor rotates as part of the crankshaft, the slots change the
magnetic field of the sensor, creating an induced voltage pulse.
Based on the crank sensor pulses, the ignition module sends reference signals to the ECM which
are used to indicate crankshaft position and engine speed.
LOCATION:
This sensor is mounted remotely from the ignition module, right hand side of engine, at the end of
the crank shaft.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3682
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Remove or Disconnect
1. Sensor harness connector. 2. Sensor to block bolt. 3. Sensor from engine.
Inspect ^
Sensor O-ring for wear, cracks or leakage. Replace if necessary. Lube new O-ring with engine oil
before installing.
Install or Connect
1. Sensor into hole in block. 2. Sensor to block bolt.
^ Torque to 8 N.m (71 lb. in.).
3. Sensor harness connector.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug Wire <--> [Ignition Cable] >
Component Information > Specifications
Spark Plug Wire: Specifications
Spark Plug Wire Resistance Values:
0-15 inch cable ....................................................................................................................................
............................................... 3,000-10,000 ohms.
15-25 inch cable ..................................................................................................................................
............................................... 4,000-15,000 ohms.
25-35 inch cable ..................................................................................................................................
............................................... 6,000-20,000 ohms.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug Wire <--> [Ignition Cable] >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3686
Spark Plug Wire Routing
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Specifications
Ignition Coil: Specifications
IGNITION COIL RESISTANCE
Primary Resistance .............................................................................................................................
.......................................................... Not Specified Secondary Resistance .......................................
..................................................................................................................................5,000 - 10,000
ohms
NOTE: Secondary resistance measured across each coil's two towers with coil removed from
vehicle.
NOTE: Winding resistance (ohms at 75°F or 24°C)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Coil > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 3690
Ignition Coil: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative battery cable.
2. Coil retaining screws.
3. Coils from module.
INSTALLATION
1. Coils to module.
2. Coil retaining screws. Torque to 4.5 N-m (40 lbs in.)
3. Negative battery cable.
IDLE LEARN PROCEDURE: Any time the battery is disconnected, the programmed position of the
IAC valve pintle is lost, and replaced with a default value. To return the IAC valve pintle to the
correct position, perform the following procedure:
1. After restoring battery power, connect the Tech 1 "SCAN" tool.
2. Select "IAC SYSTEM," then select "IDLE LEARN" in the "MISC TEST" mode.
3. Proceed with idle learn as directed. ^
This procedure allows the ECM memory to be updated with the correct IAC valve pintle position, for
the vehicle, and provide a stable idle speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > Manual
RH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > Manual > Page 3695
RH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3696
Harness Connector Faces: Electronic Ignition (EI) System
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Ignition Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3697
Ignition Control Module: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative battery cable.
2. Ignition Coils.
3. Module from assembly plate.
INSTALLATION
1. Module to assembly plate.
2. Ignition Coils.
3. Negative battery cable.
IDLE LEARN PROCEDURE: Any time the battery is disconnected, the programmed position of the
IAC valve pintle is lost, and replaced with a default value. To return the IAC valve pintle to the
correct position, perform the following procedure:
1. After restoring battery power, connect the Tech 1 "SCAN" tool.
2. Select "IAC SYSTEM," then select "IDLE LEARN" in the "MISC TEST" mode.
3. Proceed with idle learn as directed. ^
This procedure allows the ECM memory to be updated with the correct IAC valve pintle position, for
the vehicle, and provide a stable idle speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Knock Sensor: Component Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 3702
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 3703
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE:
The knock sensor is used to detect engine detonation (ping). The ECM will retard the electronic
spark timing based on the signal received.
OPERATION:
The knock sensor detects abnormal vibration in the engine. Then, the knock sensor produces an
AC signal which increases with the severity of the knock. The ECM reads this signal and retards
the timing until the knock is stopped.
LOCATION:
Engine block near the cylinders.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 3704
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-5
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Knock Sensor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 3705
Knock Sensor Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Knock Sensor (KS) is used to detect engine detonation and the PCM will retard the ignition
control timing based on the signal being received. The circuitry, within the knock sensor, causes
the PCMs 5 volts to be pulled down so that under a no knock condition, CKT 496 would measure
about 2.5 volts. The knock sensor produces an AC signal, which rides on the 2.5 volts DC voltage.
The amplitude and frequency are dependent upon the knock level.
The EPROM used with this engine contains the functions which were part of remotely mounted
knock sensor modules used on other GM vehicles. The knock sensor portion of the EPROM then
sends a signal to other parts of the PCM which adjusts the spark timing to retard the spark and
reduce the detonation.
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. With engine idling, there should not be a knock signal present at the PCM, because detonation is
not likely under a no load condition.
2. Tapping on the engine lift bracket should simulate a knock signal to determine if the sensor is
capable of detecting detonation. If no knock is
detected, try tapping on engine block closer to sensor before replacing sensor.
3. If the engine has an internal problem which is creating a knock, the knock sensor may be
responding to the internal failure.
4. This test determines if the knock sensor is faulty or if the KS portion of the EPROM is faulty. If it
is determined that the EPROM is faulty, be sure
that it is properly installed and latched into place. If not properly installed, repair and retest.
Diagnostic Aids:
While observing knock signal on the Tech 1 scan tool, there should be an indication that knock is
present, when detonation can be heard. Detonation is most likely to occur under high engine load
conditions.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System >
Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Manual
RH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System >
Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Manual > Page 3711
RH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System >
Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 3712
Harness Connector Faces: Electronic Ignition (EI) System
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Relays and Modules - Ignition System >
Ignition Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 3713
Ignition Control Module: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect negative battery cable.
2. Ignition Coils.
3. Module from assembly plate.
INSTALLATION
1. Module to assembly plate.
2. Ignition Coils.
3. Negative battery cable.
IDLE LEARN PROCEDURE: Any time the battery is disconnected, the programmed position of the
IAC valve pintle is lost, and replaced with a default value. To return the IAC valve pintle to the
correct position, perform the following procedure:
1. After restoring battery power, connect the Tech 1 "SCAN" tool.
2. Select "IAC SYSTEM," then select "IDLE LEARN" in the "MISC TEST" mode.
3. Proceed with idle learn as directed. ^
This procedure allows the ECM memory to be updated with the correct IAC valve pintle position, for
the vehicle, and provide a stable idle speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Crankshaft Position Sensor
RH rear of engine, on exhaust manifold
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3718
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
Typical DIS Crankshaft Sensor
PURPOSE:
The crankshaft sensor provides a signal through the Direct Ignition (DI), which the ECM uses as
reference to calculate rpm and crankshaft position.
OPERATION:
This sensor protrudes into the block, within approximately .050" of the engine crankshaft reluctor.
The reluctor is a special wheel cast into the crankshaft with seven slots cast into it, six of which are
evenly spaced 60° apart. A seventh slot is spaced 10° from one of the other slots and serves to
generate a "sync pulse." As the reluctor rotates as part of the crankshaft, the slots change the
magnetic field of the sensor, creating an induced voltage pulse.
Based on the crank sensor pulses, the ignition module sends reference signals to the ECM which
are used to indicate crankshaft position and engine speed.
LOCATION:
This sensor is mounted remotely from the ignition module, right hand side of engine, at the end of
the crank shaft.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Crankshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3719
Crankshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Crankshaft Position Sensor
Remove or Disconnect
1. Sensor harness connector. 2. Sensor to block bolt. 3. Sensor from engine.
Inspect ^
Sensor O-ring for wear, cracks or leakage. Replace if necessary. Lube new O-ring with engine oil
before installing.
Install or Connect
1. Sensor into hole in block. 2. Sensor to block bolt.
^ Torque to 8 N.m (71 lb. in.).
3. Sensor harness connector.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Knock Sensor: Component Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3724
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3725
Knock Sensor: Description and Operation
PURPOSE:
The knock sensor is used to detect engine detonation (ping). The ECM will retard the electronic
spark timing based on the signal received.
OPERATION:
The knock sensor detects abnormal vibration in the engine. Then, the knock sensor produces an
AC signal which increases with the severity of the knock. The ECM reads this signal and retards
the timing until the knock is stopped.
LOCATION:
Engine block near the cylinders.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3726
Knock Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-5
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Sensors and Switches - Ignition System >
Knock Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 3727
Knock Sensor Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Knock Sensor (KS) is used to detect engine detonation and the PCM will retard the ignition
control timing based on the signal being received. The circuitry, within the knock sensor, causes
the PCMs 5 volts to be pulled down so that under a no knock condition, CKT 496 would measure
about 2.5 volts. The knock sensor produces an AC signal, which rides on the 2.5 volts DC voltage.
The amplitude and frequency are dependent upon the knock level.
The EPROM used with this engine contains the functions which were part of remotely mounted
knock sensor modules used on other GM vehicles. The knock sensor portion of the EPROM then
sends a signal to other parts of the PCM which adjusts the spark timing to retard the spark and
reduce the detonation.
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. With engine idling, there should not be a knock signal present at the PCM, because detonation is
not likely under a no load condition.
2. Tapping on the engine lift bracket should simulate a knock signal to determine if the sensor is
capable of detecting detonation. If no knock is
detected, try tapping on engine block closer to sensor before replacing sensor.
3. If the engine has an internal problem which is creating a knock, the knock sensor may be
responding to the internal failure.
4. This test determines if the knock sensor is faulty or if the KS portion of the EPROM is faulty. If it
is determined that the EPROM is faulty, be sure
that it is properly installed and latched into place. If not properly installed, repair and retest.
Diagnostic Aids:
While observing knock signal on the Tech 1 scan tool, there should be an indication that knock is
present, when detonation can be heard. Detonation is most likely to occur under high engine load
conditions.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Ignition System > Spark Plug > Component Information >
Specifications
Spark Plug: Specifications
Spark Plug Gap ...................................................................................................................................
...................................................... .045 in. (1.14 mm)
NOTE: Check the gap specifications given on the Emissions Control Label. If the gap is different
from what is listed here, use the information on the label.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 3738
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Connector Locations
Behind LH Side Of I/P
LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications
Shift Solenoid: Specifications
Intermediate Servo Cover ....................................................................................................................
................................................................... 8 Ft. Lbs. Solenoid To Valve Body ..................................
....................................................................................................................................................... 8
Ft. Lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3746
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3747
Harness Connector Faces: Automatic Transaxle (Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3748
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Description and Operation
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid
PURPOSE:
The Transmission Converter Clutch (TCC) feature eliminates the power loss of the torque
converter stage when the vehicle is in a cruise mode.
OPERATION:
The TCC system uses a solenoid operated valve in the automatic transmission to couple the
engine flexplate to the output shaft of the transaxle through the torque converter. This reduces the
slippage losses in the converter, which increases fuel economy. For the converter clutch to apply,
at least two conditions must be met.
1. Internal transmission fluid pressure must be correct.
2. The ECM/PCM completes a ground circuit to energize the TCC solenoid in the transmission,
which moves a check ball in the fluid line.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Solenoid
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Service and Repair Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Solenoid
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH (TCC) SOLENOID & SWITCHES
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid & Switches
Auxiliary Valve Body, Valve Body And Oil Pump Assembly
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Solenoid > Page 3751
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Valve body cover. Refer to "Valve Body Cover". 2. Wiring harness from case electrical connector
and leads from pressure switch. 3. Torque converter clutch solenoid bolt to auxiliary valve body. 4.
3rd clutch pressure switch. 5. Second clutch switch, if applicable.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Second clutch switch, if applicable.
TIGHTEN
^ Switch to 11 Nm (97 lbs. in.).
2. 3rd clutch pressure switch.
TIGHTEN
^ Switch to 11 Nm (97 lbs. in.).
3. Torque converter clutch solenoid bolt to auxiliary valve body. Install new O-ring. 4. Wire harness
to case and switches. 5. Valve body cover with a new gasket.
ADJUST
^ Fluid level.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Solenoid > Page 3752
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Service and Repair Valve Body Cover
VALVE BODY COVER
Side Cover And Control Valve View
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Raise vehicle and suitably support. 2. Drain oil. 3. Left front tire and wheel assembly. 4. Left
splash shield. 5. Valve body cover to transaxle bolts.
INSPECT
^ Bolts
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Valve body cover with a new gasket and bolts.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Solenoid > Page 3753
Valve Body Cover
NOTE: It is necessary to use GM thread locker (P/N 12345382) or equivalent non-locking sealant
to reduce the potential for fluid leaks on the indicated bolts.
2. Left splash shield. 3. Left front tire and wheel assembly. 4. Lower vehicle.
ADJUST:
^ Oil level.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Shift Indicator: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
This lamp is used on most models equipped with manual transmission.
OPERATION
The Upshift lamp is illuminated to inform the driver of ideal shift points, with improved fuel economy
as the specific objective. When the light is illuminated, the transmission should be shifted to the
next highest gear, if driving conditions permit such an action.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 3759
Shift Indicator: Service and Repair
If upshift indicator is not working properly, perform the following test. 1. Disconnect ECM connector
C1. 2. Place ignition switch in run. 3. Measure voltage at terminal A2 of ECM connector. 4. If
battery voltage is present, further ECM diagnosis is necessary. 5. If battery voltage is not present,
repair open circuit in brown/black wire, circuit 456.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Brake Switch - TCC: Component Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 3766
Brake Switch - TCC: Connector Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations >
Page 3767
Harness Connector Faces: Brake Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Specifications
Pressure Switch ...................................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 8 Ft. Lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3775
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3776
Harness Connector Faces: Park/Neutral Position Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3777
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Park/Neutral Switch (Auto. Trans)
PURPOSE:
The PARK/NEUTRAL (P/N) switch indicates to the computer when the transmission is in PARK or
NEUTRAL. This information is used by the ECM for Idle Air Control (IAC), Torque Converter Clutch
(TCC) and Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) operation.
OPERATION:
The P/N switch contacts are a part of the neutral switch and are closed to ground in park or neutral
and open in drive ranges and reverse. The ECM supplies ignition voltage through a current limiting
resistor to the switch and senses a closed circuit when voltage drops to less than 1 volt.
NOTE: DO NOT drive the vehicle with the PARK/NEUTRAL switch disconnected, since idle quality
may be affected.
LOCATION:
Top of transaxle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3778
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-1A
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 3779
Park/Neutral Position Switch Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Park/Neutral Position (PNP) switch contacts shown are a part of the Park/Neutral position
switch and are closed to ground in park or neutral, and open in drive ranges.
The PCM supplies ignition voltage through a pull up resistor to CKT 434 and senses a closed
switch when the voltage on CKT 434 drops to less than one volt.
The PCM uses the PNP signal as one of the inputs to control:
^ Idle speed.
^ VSS diagnostics.
^ EGR.
If CKT 434 indicates PNP (grounded), while in drive range, the EGR would be inoperative, resulting
in possible detonation.
If CKT 434 indicates drive (open) a sag in the idle may occur when the gear selector is moved into
drive range.
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. Checks for a closed switch to ground in park position. Different makes of scan toots will display
the PNP switch differently. Refer to tool
operator's manual for type of display used for a specific tool.
2. Checks for an open switch in drive range.
3. Be sure Tech 1 scan tool indicates drive, even while wiggling shifter, to test for an intermittent or
misadjusted switch in drive range.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > PROM - Powertrain Control Module Reprogramming
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Technical Service Bulletins PROM - Powertrain
Control Module Reprogramming
File In Section: 06 - Engine/Propulsion System
Bulletin No.: 99-06-04-053
Date: November, 1999
INFORMATION
Subject: Powertrain Control Module (PCM) Reprogramming (Do Not Reprogram Using the Same
Download Files as Those Already Present in The Control Module)
Models: 1990-2000 Passenger Cars and Trucks with Reprogrammable PCM
It is strongly recommended to NOT reinstall the same software and/or calibration download file(s)
into the powertrain control module as those that are already present in the PCM. There is no
technical reason that the download files inside the PCM would ever become corrupted after the
control module had previously been successfully programmed. A P0601 (Control Module Read
Only Memory) Diagnostic Trouble Code would set in memory and the MIL would be illuminated if
the controller memory became corrupted.
The Techline Information System 2000 (TIS 2000) PC, combined with vehicle information gained
through the Tech 2, can determine when an attempt to reprogram a PCM using the same download
files (as those already in the control module) is being requested. If this is attempted, the TIS 2000
PC currently displays the following message:
Notice:
THE CALIBRATION SELECTED IS THE CURRENT CALIBRATION IN THE CONTROL MODULE.
PROGRAMMING WITH THE SAME DOWNLOAD FILES IS NOT AN EFFECTIVE REPAIR.
SELECT ( YES ) TO CONTINUE PROGRAMMING THE CONTROL MODULE,OR ( NO ) TO
CANCEL.
Effective in the first quarter of 2000, the TIS 2000 PC will indicate:
Important:
THE CALIBRATION SELECTED IS ALREADY THE CURRENT CALIBRATION IN THE CONTROL
MODULE. REPROGRAMMING WITH THE SAME DOWNLOAD FILE IS NOT ALLOWED.
Certain learned values, such as: (but not limited to)
^ fuel trim (previously known as block learn memory),
^ IAC learned position in various park/neutral and air conditioning on/off combinations,
^ certain OBDII diagnostic thresholds,
^ automatic transmission shift adapts
will revert back to their unlearned starting point values after a reprogramming event occurs.
It is feasible that the engine or transmission might temporarily operate differently after a
reprogramming event, until these values are re-learned. Relearning occurs while operating the
vehicle through normal driving routines. If the same download files are simply reinstalled, any
changes noticed in engine operation will likely disappear in a short amount of time and/or driving
distance.
Reprogramming the control module with the same download files that already exist in the module
will only accomplish a warranty claim for a non-effective repair, and a likely comeback.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > PROM - Powertrain Control Module Reprogramming > Page 3784
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Technical Service Bulletins SPS/FLASH EPROM Programming
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 53-65-08
Date: January, 1996
INFORMATION
Subject: SPS/FLASH EPROM Programming
Models: 1993-96 Passenger Cars and Trucks Applicable Reprogrammable Vehicles
This bulletin is being issued to assist technicians in reprogramming vehicles and should be used in
conjunction with instructions provided on your Techline Terminal and in your Techline Terminal
User's Manual.
THE TECHLINE TERMINAL (T-20, T-50, T-60) HAS BEEN ABLE TO DO 1996 VEHICLE
PROGRAMMING THROUGH THE DIRECT METHOD SINCE 1996 VEHICLES HAVE BEEN
AVAILABLE IN THE DEALERSHIPS/RETAIL FACILITIES. THE TECHLINE CD-ROM TITLED
DISC 13 CONTAINS THE SOFTWARE NEEDED TO PROGRAM ALL 1996 VEHICLES WITH A
TECH 1 (REMOTE PROGRAMMING METHOD).
SPS Tips
1. BATTERY VOLTAGE SHOULD BE CHECKED. A FULLY CHARGED BATTERY IS
NECESSARY BEFORE REPROGRAMMING TAKES PLACE. THE VEHICLE BATTERY SHOULD
NOT BE CONNECTED TO A BATTERY CHARGER DURING A PROGRAMMING EVENT
INCORRECT VOLTAGE COULD CAUSE PROGRAMMING AND/OR CONTROL MODULE
FAILURE. During programming, the control module depends on the battery as its sole source of
power. Also during programming, the vehicle's components (i.e. blower motor) are set to a default
mode which may be turned on, placing additional draw on the vehicle's battery. If the voltage goes
outside the specified range (11 to 14 volts) the controllers and the Techline equipment will stop
communicating. If this happens, it could cause the control module to become inoperable and
require replacement.
2. CHECK THE INTEGRITY OF THE TECH 1 CABLES, MAKE SURE THEY ARE NOT FRAYED,
BROKEN OR TWISTED. Loss of communication for any reason will require additional time in
completing the reprogramming event.
3. IF USING A TECH 1, YOUR MASS STORAGE CARTRIDGE (MSC) MUST BE UPDATED TO
REFLECT THE MOST CURRENT UPDATE OFFERED ON THE TECHLINE CD-ROM. DISC 13,
1995 WAS THE FIRST CD-ROM THAT HAD REMOTE PROGRAMMING SUPPORT If your MSC
is not updated to reflect the current software version on the Techline Terminal, in some situations
the software will not be capable of interpreting the information that is requested from the vehicle.
4. T-100 TERMINALS (CAMS) ARE NOT CAPABLE OF PROGRAMMING OBD II VEHICLES
THROUGH THE DIRECT METHOD. A TECH 1 MUST BE USED (REMOTE METHOD) WHEN
REPROGRAMMING WITH A T-100. The T-100 terminals communicate with vehicles through a
DLC (ALDL) card and cable found within the T-100's computer. The DLC (ALDL) card is not
capable of communicating at the new baud rate used with OBD II.
5. PROGRAMMING IS NOT NEEDED IF THE CURRENT CALIBRATION IS THE SAME AS THE
SELECTED CALIBRATION.
6. IF PROGRAMMING A NEW CONTROL MODULE, YOU MUST REQUEST INFORMATION
FROM THE NEW CONTROL MODULE. The security information that is needed for a control
module to be programmed is stored in the new control module. The security information must be
requested from the control module to be programmed. At that point, the control module can be
successfully programmed. This requesting of security information takes place in both the direct and
remote methods. The request is automatic when using the direct method. Looking at the calibration
stored in the old controller may be helpful in selecting the calibration from the CD-ROM for the new
controller.
7. WHEN PROGRAMMING OBD II VEHICLES WITH A TECH 1 (REMOTE PROGRAMMING
METHOD), A VEHICLE INTERFACE MODULE (VIM) IS REQUIRED. The VIM allows the Tech 1
to communicate with the OBD II vehicles. The VIM is necessary for all other Tech 1 diagnostics on
OBD II vehicles. VIMs are no longer on backorder. If you are interested in obtaining additional
VIMs, call 1-800-GM-TOOLS and ask for VIM kit part number 7000041.
8. DISCONNECT THE TECH I AND VIM FROM THE VEHICLE BETWEEN RETRIEVING DATA
AND PROGRAMMING THE VEHICLE. If the VIM remains powered up after data is requested, a
communication problem may result when the reprogramming function is performed.
9. WHEN CONNECTING THE TECH 1 TO A TECHLINE TERMINAL (EXCEPT T-100 CAMS),
ALWAYS CONNECT THE FLAT GRAY R5232 CABLE FIRST AND THEN THE POWER
ADAPTER. FAILURE TO DO SO COULD RESULT IN A LOSS OF INFORMATION
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > PROM - Powertrain Control Module Reprogramming > Page 3785
STORED ON THE TECH 1. When power is turned on to the Tech 1, it looks for the RS232
connection. If it does not see the connection, the Tech 1 in some cases, will erase the information
stored for download.
10. DO NOT DISCONTINUE OR INTERRUPT THE PROGRAM LOADING PROCESS TO THE
VEHICLE. This will result in a programming error and could prevent the Electronic Control Module
(ECM) from functioning properly.
11. AFTER PROGRAMMING IS COMPLETE, PRESS "EXIT". MAKE SURE THE KEY IS CYCLED
OFF FOR APPROXIMATELY 10 SECONDS THEN BACK ON. Some vehicles will lose component
settings (PMC/IAC Valve). Cycling the key off two times (Off for 30 seconds, On for 10 then repeat
a second time) will allow for resetting of the components. Start the vehicle to ensure programming
was successful.
FOR CADILLAC VEHICLES ONLY a. DUE TO OTHER MODULES ON THE DATA LINE TRYING TO COMMUNICATE WITH THE
ECM DURING PROGRAMMING, SOME COMMUNICATION CODES MAY BE SET After
programming is complete, clear any codes and verify they do not reset.
b. TO HELP MINIMIZE BATTERY DRAW DURING ECM PROGRAMMING, DISCONNECT THE
BLOWER MOTOR (AT THE CONNECTOR, NOT THE FUSE) PRIOR TO PROGRAMMING. When
programming is complete, reconnect the blower motor.
12. 1997 VEHICLES REQUIRE REPROGRAMMING BE DONE USING A TECH 2. OBD II vehicle
calibration size and complexity will require more memory than the Tech 1 has available. Tech 2 will
be an essential tool in the first quarter of 1996 containing limited 1996 applications and updates.
13. STG HAS ISSUED BULLETINS (# 53-65-04 and # 53-65-05 - (SEE CHART EXCERPTED
FROM 53-65-05 FOR USE AS A QUICK REFERENCE GUIDE), DEVELOPED QUICK
REFERENCE GUIDES (P/N SPSCARD-1 AVAILABLE THROUGH YOUR LOCAL GM TRAINING
CENTER), PRODUCED CPT VIDEOS (CPT # 56010.00-B), HAD PULSAT BROADCASTS, AND
OFFERS GM TRAINING CENTER CLASSROOM COURSES. As you work through
reprogramming, keep the above-mentioned material in mind as resources to assist you if difficulty
is encountered. As always, the Techline Customer Support Center (1-800-828-6860 English,
1-800-503-3222 French) is always available to assist the technician with any situation.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > PROM - Powertrain Control Module Reprogramming > Page 3786
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > PROM - Powertrain Control Module Reprogramming > Page 3787
SPS/EEPROM Programming
1993 to current Reprogrammable Vehicles
Note: If programming a new control module you must request info from the new control module
first. Battery voltage should be checked and at full charge before reprogramming takes place.
System to be programmed should NOT be connected to a battery charger. Incorrect voltage could
cause programming and/or control module failure.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3788
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Service Precautions
A PROM is a sensitive electronic part and must be handled with care. If the connector terminals
(pins) on the bottom of the PROM are exposed, avoid touching them. Pins can be broken easily,
and the PROM can be damaged by static electric discharge. Follow these guidelines when
replacing a PROM:
^ Disconnect the battery ground cable before removing a PROM. Reconnect the cable after the
new PROM is installed.
^ DO NOT try to remove a PROM from its plastic PROM carrier.
^ Note the direction in which the original PROM and its carrier were installed in the ECM, and
install the replacement PROM in the same direction. Most PROM's are marked with a notch at one
end for orientation. Many PROM's can be installed in a reversed direction, which will destroy the
PROM when power is applied.
CAUTION: A PROM can be damaged by static electric discharge. Avoid damage as follows:
^ DO NOT remove a PROM from its packing material until you are ready to install it. DO NOT hold
a PROM by its pins.
^ Before entering a vehicle to remove or replace a PROM, touch an exposed metal part of the
vehicle to discharge any static charge from your body or use anti-static wrist straps.
^ Avoid sliding across upholstery or carpeting when removing or installing a PROM. If this is not
possible, touch an exposed metal part of the vehicle with your free hand before removing a PROM
or installing a new one in its socket in the ECM.
^ When available, use an antistatic grounding strap attached to your wrist and clipped to a metal
part of the vehicle body to prevent static charges from accumulating. Antistatic, conductive
floormats are also available.
^ For some vehicles, it may be desirable to remove the ECM when replacing the PROM.
^ NOTE: See POWERTRAIN MANAGEMENT / SERVICE PRECAUTIONS / VEHICLE DAMAGE
WARNINGS / ELECTRICAL PRECAUTIONS
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Introducing the GM PROM Cross Reference Index
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Introducing the GM PROM Cross
Reference Index
This PROM cross reference index provides tables that let you use a PROM identification (ID) code
to identify the PROM installed in the engine control module (ECM) on most GM vehicles. The code
can be either - or both - the internal "scan ID" code or the external PROM code. From the PROM
identification, you can find the part number of the PROM and trace the PROM history to determine
if any revised PROM's have been issued to supersede the one in the vehicle.
The PROM history for a specific vehicle lists a succession of superseding PROM's ending with the
most recent PROM released as a service part for the vehicle. PROM's that were released as
service parts and explained in a technical service bulletin (TSB) are listed with a description of why
the PROM was issued. In most cases, the applicable TSB also is referenced.
This index lists ECM PROM's for the 1980-95 vehicles. It does not contain ID codes and part
numbers for all PROM's used in all GM vehicles. NOTE: GM flash PROM's (EEPROM's) can only
be updated at GM Dealerships with factory-supplied equipment. These cars will not display a
PROM ID.
By following the steps outlined below, you can use the PROM index to determine if the problem
you are diagnosing can possibly be corrected by installing a revised PROM. The PROM index
tables are organized by model year, engine displacement, and engine code (the eighth digit of the
Vehicle Identification Number). The table columns are arranged as shown below:
Example of Table Column Arrangement
SCAN PROM PROM PART SUPERSEDING TSB REFERENCE
ID CODE (BCC) NUMBER ID PART NUMBER NUMBER
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5)
..............................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................
9461 8958 AMU 16058955R 8290 01228290 86194
Column 1, SCAN ID:
The scan ID is the internal PROM identification number transmitted on the ECM data stream and
displayed by the scanner as PROM ID. The PROM records for each year and engine are listed
numerically by this scan ID.
Column 2, PROM CODE:
These are the numbers and letters marked on the top of the PROM itself. The numbers are often
referred to as the "external PROM ID." The letters are often called the "broadcast code." Together
they are the external PROM code.
Column 3, PROM P/N:
This is the GM part number for the PROM identified by the codes in columns 1 and 2.
Column 4, SUPERSEDING ID PROM PART NUMBER:
Use the superseding scan ID to locate the newer PROM in the table. If the scan ID for the
superseding PROM is not known, the PROM broadcast code is listed here. If the PROM is
superseded by a newer PROM, that part number is listed here.
Column 5, TSB REFERENCE NUMBER
The TSB NUMBER column identifies the original TSB that released this PROM for service.
Whenever possible you should refer to the TSB for additional information before changing a
PROM. The bulletin may list other parts that must be installed when the PROM is changed, or it
may provide additional troubleshooting information. To find a TSB, see Reading Technical Service
Bulletins. See: Reading Technical Service Bulletins This will display all the TSB's for that particular
vehicle.
EXPANDED FOOTNOTES Here you will find SUPERSEDING SCAN ID, PROM PART NUMBERS,
symptoms and additional parts that need to be replaced when servicing the PROM.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Introducing the GM PROM Cross Reference Index > Page 3791
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Introducing the GM PROM Cross
Reference Index
This PROM cross reference index provides tables that let you use a PROM identification (ID) code
to identify the PROM installed in the engine control module (ECM) on most GM vehicles. The code
can be either - or both - the internal "scan ID" code or the external PROM code. From the PROM
identification, you can find the part number of the PROM and trace the PROM history to determine
if any revised PROM's have been issued to supersede the one in the vehicle.
The PROM history for a specific vehicle lists a succession of superseding PROM's ending with the
most recent PROM released as a service part for the vehicle. PROM's that were released as
service parts and explained in a technical service bulletin (TSB) are listed with a description of why
the PROM was issued. In most cases, the applicable TSB also is referenced.
This index lists ECM PROM's for the 1980-95 vehicles. It does not contain ID codes and part
numbers for all PROM's used in all GM vehicles. NOTE: GM flash PROM's (EEPROM's) can only
be updated at GM Dealerships with factory-supplied equipment. These cars will not display a
PROM ID.
By following the steps outlined below, you can use the PROM index to determine if the problem
you are diagnosing can possibly be corrected by installing a revised PROM. The PROM index
tables are organized by model year, engine displacement, and engine code (the eighth digit of the
Vehicle Identification Number). The table columns are arranged as shown below:
Example of Table Column Arrangement
SCAN PROM PROM PART SUPERSEDING TSB REFERENCE
ID CODE (BCC) NUMBER ID PART NUMBER NUMBER
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5)
..............................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................
9461 8958 AMU 16058955R 8290 01228290 86194
Column 1, SCAN ID:
The scan ID is the internal PROM identification number transmitted on the ECM data stream and
displayed by the scanner as PROM ID. The PROM records for each year and engine are listed
numerically by this scan ID.
Column 2, PROM CODE:
These are the numbers and letters marked on the top of the PROM itself. The numbers are often
referred to as the "external PROM ID." The letters are often called the "broadcast code." Together
they are the external PROM code.
Column 3, PROM P/N:
This is the GM part number for the PROM identified by the codes in columns 1 and 2.
Column 4, SUPERSEDING ID PROM PART NUMBER:
Use the superseding scan ID to locate the newer PROM in the table. If the scan ID for the
superseding PROM is not known, the PROM broadcast code is listed here. If the PROM is
superseded by a newer PROM, that part number is listed here.
Column 5, TSB REFERENCE NUMBER
The TSB NUMBER column identifies the original TSB that released this PROM for service.
Whenever possible you should refer to the TSB for additional information before changing a
PROM. The bulletin may list other parts that must be installed when the PROM is changed, or it
may provide additional troubleshooting information. To find a TSB, see Reading Technical Service
Bulletins. See: Reading Technical Service Bulletins This will display all the TSB's for that particular
vehicle.
EXPANDED FOOTNOTES Here you will find SUPERSEDING SCAN ID, PROM PART NUMBERS,
symptoms and additional parts that need to be replaced when servicing the PROM.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Introducing the GM PROM Cross Reference Index > Page 3792
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Additional PROM Information
New ECM PROMs for GM vehicles may be released for service at any time. The information in this
system is accurate to the best of the publisher's knowledge and the publication date of the disk.
Before ordering a PROM, consult with a GM parts and service dealer to verify the latest part
number information. Scanner PROM ID information for earlier-model vehicles (1980-83) is less
complete than for later models. To accurately identify PROM's in earlier vehicles, it may be
necessary to check the external PROM code marked on the PROM.
General Motors has often recommended that dealership technicians check the PROM history of a
vehicle and install the most recent PROM revision before performing other diagnostic operations.
Each succeeding PROM revision for a specific vehicle includes all previous revisions. Therefore,
whenever you consider changing a PROM, review the entire PROM history to see if any revision
covered the current driveability problem. Installing the most recent PROM revision may be
impractical however for an independent service facility, particularly if the latest PROM revision does
not address the specific driveability problem of the vehicle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Introducing the GM PROM Cross Reference Index > Page 3793
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Additional PROM Information
New ECM PROMs for GM vehicles may be released for service at any time. The information in this
system is accurate to the best of the publisher's knowledge and the publication date of the disk.
Before ordering a PROM, consult with a GM parts and service dealer to verify the latest part
number information. Scanner PROM ID information for earlier-model vehicles (1980-83) is less
complete than for later models. To accurately identify PROM's in earlier vehicles, it may be
necessary to check the external PROM code marked on the PROM.
General Motors has often recommended that dealership technicians check the PROM history of a
vehicle and install the most recent PROM revision before performing other diagnostic operations.
Each succeeding PROM revision for a specific vehicle includes all previous revisions. Therefore,
whenever you consider changing a PROM, review the entire PROM history to see if any revision
covered the current driveability problem. Installing the most recent PROM revision may be
impractical however for an independent service facility, particularly if the latest PROM revision does
not address the specific driveability problem of the vehicle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Introducing the GM PROM Cross Reference Index > Page 3794
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID PROM/MEMCAL Identification
Marks
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 44-65-01
Date: October, 1994
Subject: New PROM/MEMCAL Identification Markings
Models: 1995 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
Note:
For the purposes of this document, the terms PROM and MEMCAL will be used interchangeably.
To simplify identification of service PROMs. a new external marking format will be implemented.
Parts manufactured after Sept. 1994 will feature these new markings. This change will place the full
8-digit service part number on the PROM, in place of the old 4-digit "EXTERNAL ID" number. In the
past, parts and service personnel could not identify a PROM without using a cross-reference table
that matched external IDs and service numbers. In the future, the cross-reference table will not be
required for PROMs; parts will be ordered directly from the number appearing on the PROM.
However, the label will retain the broadcast code alpha characters to allow continued use of
cross-reference charts, if so desired.
Old Marking Format:
New Marking Format:
^ Ordering the above PROM from the old marking format would require using a cross-reference
chart to determine a service part number, based on the BROAD CAST CODE and EXTERNAL ID
NUMBERS.
^ To order from the new format, simply combine the 2nd and 3rd lines to form an 8-digit part
number that can be directly ordered from SPO (number 16134624 in the above example).
As these changes are phased into the parts inventory, it should be noted that dealers will continue
to see parts with both formats for some time in the future. This is because:
^ Millions of vehicles have already been built with the old format.
^ SPO has existing stock of MEMCALs and PROMs with the old format.
^ PROMS with 7-digit part numbers (representing less than 10% of current part numbers) will
continue to use the old format. The 7-digit part numbers are easily identified because they always
begin with "122xxxx".
Due to manufacturing processes, more than one 8-digit part number may appear on a MEMCAL. In
this event, service personnel should use the label on the exterior cover of the MEMCAL assembly.
To avoid confusion, only the service label will include the BROAD CAST CODE, consisting of letter
characters (I.E., ARCL).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Introducing the GM PROM Cross Reference Index > Page 3795
CHANGES TO MEMCAL/PROM LABELING FORMATS
^ MEMCALs may use either INK-JET or ADHESIVE labels, as shown.
^ PROMs will always use ADHESIVE labels with the same format as shown for MEMCALs. These
changes will become effective on parts manufactured after 10/94.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Introducing the GM PROM Cross Reference Index > Page 3796
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID PROM/MEMCAL Identification
Marks
File In Section: 6E - Engine Fuel & Emission
Bulletin No.: 44-65-01
Date: October, 1994
Subject: New PROM/MEMCAL Identification Markings
Models: 1995 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
Note:
For the purposes of this document, the terms PROM and MEMCAL will be used interchangeably.
To simplify identification of service PROMs. a new external marking format will be implemented.
Parts manufactured after Sept. 1994 will feature these new markings. This change will place the full
8-digit service part number on the PROM, in place of the old 4-digit "EXTERNAL ID" number. In the
past, parts and service personnel could not identify a PROM without using a cross-reference table
that matched external IDs and service numbers. In the future, the cross-reference table will not be
required for PROMs; parts will be ordered directly from the number appearing on the PROM.
However, the label will retain the broadcast code alpha characters to allow continued use of
cross-reference charts, if so desired.
Old Marking Format:
New Marking Format:
^ Ordering the above PROM from the old marking format would require using a cross-reference
chart to determine a service part number, based on the BROAD CAST CODE and EXTERNAL ID
NUMBERS.
^ To order from the new format, simply combine the 2nd and 3rd lines to form an 8-digit part
number that can be directly ordered from SPO (number 16134624 in the above example).
As these changes are phased into the parts inventory, it should be noted that dealers will continue
to see parts with both formats for some time in the future. This is because:
^ Millions of vehicles have already been built with the old format.
^ SPO has existing stock of MEMCALs and PROMs with the old format.
^ PROMS with 7-digit part numbers (representing less than 10% of current part numbers) will
continue to use the old format. The 7-digit part numbers are easily identified because they always
begin with "122xxxx".
Due to manufacturing processes, more than one 8-digit part number may appear on a MEMCAL. In
this event, service personnel should use the label on the exterior cover of the MEMCAL assembly.
To avoid confusion, only the service label will include the BROAD CAST CODE, consisting of letter
characters (I.E., ARCL).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Introducing the GM PROM Cross Reference Index > Page 3797
CHANGES TO MEMCAL/PROM LABELING FORMATS
^ MEMCALs may use either INK-JET or ADHESIVE labels, as shown.
^ PROMs will always use ADHESIVE labels with the same format as shown for MEMCALs. These
changes will become effective on parts manufactured after 10/94.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Introducing the GM PROM Cross Reference Index > Page 3798
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Reading Technical Service
Bulletins
Always read any Technical Service Bulletins (TSB's) referenced before replacing a PROM.
Service bulletins list parts that must be installed when a PROM is changed, and provide information
on trouble codes, troubleshooting and driveability problems for which the PROM was released.
To find applicable TSB's:
Complete TSB Listing
1. Hold down right mouse button and select "Vehicle" in the "Pull Right Menu". 2. Select the TSB
ICON. 3. Select "All Technical Service Bulletins by Number, Date, and Title". 4. Select "Sort by
Number", "Sort by Date", or "Sort by Title". 5. Scroll up or down to find the desired TSB.
PROM TSB Listing Only
1. Hold down right mouse button and select "Technical Service Bulletins" in the "Pull Right Menu".
2. Select "All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory". 3. Select
"Sort by Number", "Sort by Date", or "Sort by Title". 4. Scroll up or down to find the desired TSB.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Introducing the GM PROM Cross Reference Index > Page 3799
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Reading Technical Service
Bulletins
Always read any Technical Service Bulletins (TSB's) referenced before replacing a PROM.
Service bulletins list parts that must be installed when a PROM is changed, and provide information
on trouble codes, troubleshooting and driveability problems for which the PROM was released.
To find applicable TSB's:
Complete TSB Listing
1. Hold down right mouse button and select "Vehicle" in the "Pull Right Menu". 2. Select the TSB
ICON. 3. Select "All Technical Service Bulletins by Number, Date, and Title". 4. Select "Sort by
Number", "Sort by Date", or "Sort by Title". 5. Scroll up or down to find the desired TSB.
PROM TSB Listing Only
1. Hold down right mouse button and select "Technical Service Bulletins" in the "Pull Right Menu".
2. Select "All Technical Service Bulletins for PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory". 3. Select
"Sort by Number", "Sort by Date", or "Sort by Title". 4. Scroll up or down to find the desired TSB.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Footnotes 1 Thru 50
[1] Also needs EGR P/N 1706739.
[2] Also requires EGR P/N 17111295.
[3] Requires Throttle Body service P/N 17067142, EGR valve service P/N 17067111, Injector
service kit P/N 17067976.
[4] Requires Throttle Body service P/N 17067142, EGR valve service P/N 17067107, Injector
service kit P/N 17067976.
[5] Requires Throttle Body service P/N 17067144, EGR valve service P/N 17067110, Injector
service kit P/N 17067976.
[6] PROM I.D. 7080 KJ is also acceptable for PROM I.D. 5853 KJ only. Requires Throttle Body
service P/N 17067144, EGR valve service P/N 17067108 (FED), 17067144 (CAL), Injector service
kit P/N 17067976.
[7] Required Throttle Body service P/N 17067142, EGR valve service P/N 17067107 (FED),
17068210 (CAL), Injector service kit P/N 17067976.
[8] Requires Throttle Body service P/N 17068019, EGR valve service P/N 17067109, Injector
service kit P/N 17067976.
[9] For Federal - Use 01226047 (PROM CODE 7654 BKW). For California - Use 01226049 (PROM
CODE 7665 BKY).
[10] For Federal - Use 01226054. For California - Use 01226056
[11] For Federal - Use 01226055. For California - Use 01226057.
[12] For Federal - Use 01226046 (PROM CODE 7648 BKU). For California - Use 01226049
(PROM CODE 7665 BKY).
[13] For federal - Use 01226046 (PROM CODE 7648 BKU). For California - Use 01226048 (PROM
CODE 7659 BKX).
[14] ECM may have been replaced by service ECM P/N 16019710 (1225500).
[15] ECM may also be 16018161. ECM may also have been replaced by service ECM P/N
16018000 (1225330).
[16] ECM may also be 16018201. ECM may also have been replaced by service ECM P/N
16018000 (1225330).
[17] ECM may also be 16018211. ECM may have been replaced by service ECM P/N 16018000
(1225330).
[18] ECM may also be 16023761. ECM may have been replaced by service ECM P/N 16018000
(1225330).
[19] ECM may also be 16018101. ECM may have been replaced by service ECM P/N 16018000
(1225330).
[20] For 2-board ECM only.
[21] May need EGR valve P/N 17079563. Original equipment P/N 16029014.
[22] Original equipment PROM P/N 16017094, now 16025254
[23] Original equipment PROM P/N 16017224, now 16025264.
[24] Also needs EGR valve P/N 17079013. Original equipment PROM P/N 16030034 (PROM ID:
BOH).
[25] Requires kit P/N 25522748 containing: Wiring harness jumper P/N 12043500, Relay P/N
25522747, Foam P/N 25522723, EGR P/N 17079799.
[26] Needs EGR valve P/N 17079818.
[27] For (MY7) - Use 01226473 (SCAN I.D. = 3941). For (M19) - Use 01226474 (SCAN I.D. =
3951).
[28] For (MY7) or (M19, C60) - Use 01226473 (SCAN I.D. = 3941). For (M19) - Use 01226474
(SCAN I.D. = 3951).
[29] ECM may also be 16023561(M5), or 16033061(M4 with A/C).
[30] For F62 axle - Use 01226441 (SCAN I.D. = 3622). For F17 axle - Use 01226439 (SCAN I.D. =
3332).
[31] For one_board ECM only.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 3802
[32] Requires Thermac Sensor P/N 8997916.
[33] For Federal - Use 01227729 (SCAN I.D. = 7729). For California - Use 01227728 (SCAN I.D. =
7728).
[34] Use 01227629 (SCAN I.D. = 7629) only to resolve surge or chuggle.
[35] Use 01227381 (SCAN I.D. = 7381) only to resolve chuggle.
[36] Use 01227386 (SCAN I.D. = 7386) only to resolve chuggle.
[37] Retrofit PROM - Does not supersede the regular replacement service PROM. To be used only
as required to resolve cases of chuggle.
[38] Retrofit PROM - Supersedes all previous service PROM part numbers. To be used as both the
regular service replacement (PROM-damaged or
defective), and to resolve cases of chuggle.
[39] Retrofit PROM - Supersedes all previous service PROM part numbers. To be used as both the
regular service replacement (PROM-damaged or
defective), and to resolve cases of chuggle, detonation, or flatness.
[40] Retrofit PROM - Does not supersede the regular replacement service PROMS. To be used
only as required to resolve cases of chuggle, detonation,
or flatness.
[41] Need EGR valve P/N 17111577 (Federal only).
[42] For use with P215/65 tires - use 01228290 (SCAN I.D. = 8290). For use with P235/60,
P245/50 tires - use 01228291 (SCAN I.D. = 8291).
[43] For use with P215/65 tires - use 01228292 (SCAN I.D. - 8292). For use with P235/60, P245/50
tires - use 01228293 (SCAN I.D. = 8293).
[44] Use 16143570 (SCAN I.D. = 3531) for hot hard restart (Requires Fuel Pump P/N 25115764,
Fuel Sender P/N 25093526). Use 16143459 (SCAN
I.D. = 3571) for Code 42, Spark Knock, High Idle.
[45] Use 16143455 (SCAN I.D. = 3511) for hot hard restart (Requires Fuel Pump P/N 25115764,
Fuel Sender P/N 25093526). Use 16143453 (SCAN
I.D. = 3501) for Code 42, Spark Knock, High Idle.
[46] Use 16143575 (SCAN I.D. = 3541) for hot hard restart (Requires Fuel Pump P/N 25115764).
Use 16143460 (SCAN I.D. = 3581) for Code 42,
Spark Knock, High Idle.
[47] Use 16143580 (SCAN I.D. = 3551) for hot hard restart (Requires Fuel Pump P/N 25115764).
Use 16143462 (SCAN I.D. = 3591) for Code 42,
Spark Knock, High Idle.
[48] Use 16143457 (SCAN I.D. = 3521) for hot hard restart (Requires Fuel Pump P/N 25115925,
Fuel Sender P/N 25092778). Use 16143466 (SCAN
I.D. = 3481) for Code 42, Spark Knock, High Idle.
[49] Use 16143452 (SCAN I.D. = 3491) for hot hard restart (Requires Fuel Pump P/N 25115925,
Fuel Sender P/N 25092778). Use 16143463 (SCAN
I.D. = 3451) for Code 42, Spark Knock, High Idle.
[50] Needs air injection service kit (P/N 10115773) and new vehicle emission control label.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 3803
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Footnotes 51 Thru 100
[51] Must be ordered with service kit P/N 10115773.
[52] With this PROM installed, use 1987-88 2.8L speed density engine driveability and emissions
manual.
[53] PROM update eliminates MAF sensor, replacing it with a speed density system. With a 1990
or earlier primary cartridge, I.D. vehicle on scanner
as a 1989 model (VIN = K-1-W).
[54] For 2WD use 16120099 (SCAN I.D. = 9941). For 4WD use 16120109 (SCAN I.D. = 9901).
[55] For 2.73 (GU2) Axle use 16120077 (SCAN I.D. = 9891). For 3.08 (GU4) Axle use 16120082
(SCAN I.D. = 9901). For 3.42 (GU6) and 3.73
(GT4) Axles use 16120086 (SCAN I.D. = 9911).
[56] For 2WD use 16120042 (SCAN I.D. = 9991). For 4WD use 16120129 (SCAN I.D. = 0011).
[57] Needs accelerator pump check ball spring P/N 17069583.
[58] For false Code 44 on long coast down, use retrofit service PROM 01228486 AAND 1050. For
regular service replacement, use PROM 16062797
AAND 2798.
[59] For false Code 44 on long coast down, use retrofit service PROM 01228487 AANF 1052. For
regular service replacement, use PROM 16062801
AANF 2802.
[60] USE 16143545 (SCAN I.D. = 3461) For hot hard restart (Requires Fuel Pump P/N 25115764,
Fuel Sender P/N 25093744). Use 16143465 (SCAN
I.D. = 3471) for Code 42, Spark Knock, High Idle.
[61] With this PROM installed, use 1987-88 2.8L speed density engine driveability and emissions
manual.
[62] For use with model C1 Trucks - Use 16121162 (SCAN I.D. = 3511). For use with model C2, K,
K2, AND K1000 Trucks - use 16121166 (SCAN
I.D. = 3521).
[63] Also requires installation of new EGR valve package P/N 17112238 (Contains EGR valve P/N
17090078 and a gasket).
[64] Use 16181863 (SCAN I.D. = 0844) for cold start stall. Use 16181859 (SCAN I.D. = 0834) only
if required to solve both cold start stall and
chuggle.
[65] Use 16181871 (SCAN I.D. = 0864) for cold start stall. Use 16181867 (SCAN I.D. = 0854) only
if required to solve both cold start stall and
chuggle.
[66] Use 16165848 (SCAN I.D. = 5614) for cold start stall. Use 16165843 (SCAN I.D. = 5624) only
if required to solve both cold start stall and
chuggle.
[67] Do not rely on the scanner ID to determine which PROM is in a vehicle. Look at the BCC on
the PROM to be sure. Do not confuse with some
1991 models with a 2.84 axle ratio and a Federal emissions pkg which used scanner ID 5644 but
had a BCC of AWJD.
[68] This PROM may have a negative impact on fuel economy.
[69] Cannot be used on vehicles that do not have digital EGR valves.
[70] Use 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) for cold start stall. Use 16165829 (SCAN I.D. = 5644) only
if required to solve both cold start stall and
chuggle.
[71] Use 16181883 (SCAN I.D. = 0894) for cold start stall. Use 16181875 (SCAN I.D. = 0874) only
if required to solve both cold start stall and
chuggle.
[72] Use 16181887 (SCAN I.D. = 0904) for cold start stall. Use 16181879 (SCAN I.D. = 0884) only
if required to solve both cold start stall and
chuggle.
[73] This PROM may have a negative impact on fuel economy.
[74] PROM can only be used with ECM P/N 16144288.
[75] Make certain the vehicle has been updated with previously attempted service fixes as follows:
EGR valve P/N 17090156 (stamped on valve)
17112373 (GMSPO kit), PCV valve P/N 25098542, ESC module P/N 16175099 (BCC=BARC).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 3804
[76] For vehicles with sleeve bearing engines.
[77] Combination detonation and neutral gear rattle PROM available.
[78] Needs ESC P/N 16175099.
[79] Model 2DDM Transmissions - Check dealer records to see if the torque converter has already
been replaced with P/N 8650935 (Tagged BCC:
DGAF). Trans. with torque converters with P/N 8656959 (Tagged BCC: DG5F) need to replace it
with P/N 8650935.
[80] For dedicated natural gas vehicles. Order with kit P/N 12545589 unless the only problem is
idle fluctuation.
[81] For chuggle at 40-45 condition, use PROM only. For tip-in hesitation only, use EGR valve only
- P/N 17078431. For cold driveability hesitation,
use both PROM and EGR.
[82] Requires supplementary tune-up label, spark bypass relay kit P/N 14086983, spark plugs P/N
5614009, sun visor starting label P/N 14085150.
Also, remove and discard fuse labeled "crank" from fuse BLK #2 position (3 Amp. Fuse).
[83] Manual transmission cars should also be updated with the clutch anticipate switch per dealer
service bulletin number. 91-472-7C.
[84] Cold driveability, use with PROM 0051 AAF (G057). REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17067142, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N
17067111, INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[85] Cold driveability, use with PROM 0050 AAF (G057). REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17067142, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N
17067111, INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[86] Exhaust noise (requires catalytic converter), cold driveability, use with PROM 5884 BH (G057).
REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17068019, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N 17067109, INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[87] Exhaust noise (requires catalytic converter), cold driveability, use with PROM 5869 BH (G057).
REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17068019, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N 17067109, INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[88] Exhaust noise (requires catalytic converter), cold driveability, use with PROM 5779 KB (G057).
REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17067144, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N 17067110, INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[89] Exhaust noise (requires catalytic converter), cold driveability, use with PROM 5778 KB (G057).
REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17067144, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N 17067110, INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[90] Cold driveability, use with PROM 5854 KJ (G057). PROM I.D. 7080 KJ IS ALSO
ACCEPTABLE FOR PROM I.D. 5853 KJ ONLY.
REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE P/N 17067144, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N 17067108
(FED), 17067144 (CAL), INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[91] Cold driveability, use with PROM 5853 KJ (G057). PROM I.D. 7080 KJ IS ALSO
ACCEPTABLE FOR PROM I.D. 5853 KJ ONLY.
REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE P/N 17067144, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N 17067108
(FED), 17067144 (CAL), INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[92] Cold driveability, use with PROM 5861 KK (G057). REQUIRED THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17067142, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N
17067107 (FED), 17068210 (CAL), INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[93] Cold driveability, use with PROM 5860 KK (G057). REQUIRED THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17067142, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N
17067107 (FED), 17068210 (CAL), INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[94] Exhaust noise (requires catalytic converter), cold driveability, use with PROM 5786 LW
(G057). REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17067142, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N 17067107, INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[95] Exhaust noise (requires catalytic converter), cold driveability, use with PROM 5785 LW
(G057). REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17067142, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N 17067107, INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[96] Cold driveability, use with PROM 7088 LY (G057). REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17067142, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N
17067111, INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[97] Cold driveability, use with PROM 7087 LY (G057). REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17067142, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N
17067111, INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[98] Chuggle at 40-45 mph, cold driveability hesitation. FOR CHUGGLE AT 40-45 CONDITION,
USE PROM ONLY. FOR TIP-IN HESITATION
ONLY, USE EGR VALVE ONLY - P/N 17078431. FOR COLD DRIVEABILITY HESITATION, USE
BOTH PROM AND EGR.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 3805
[99] Driveability correction for heavy chuggle. REQUIRES KIT P/N 25522748 CONTAINING:
WIRING HARNESS JUMPER P/N 12043500,
RELAY P/N 25522747, FOAM P/N 25522723, EGR P/N 17079799.
[100] Cold startability adjustment. REQUIRES SUPPLEMENTARY TUNE-UP LABEL, SPARK
BYPASS RELAY KIT P/N 14086983, SPARK
PLUGS P/N 5614009, SUN VISOR STARTING LABEL P/N 14085150. ALSO, REMOVE AND
DISCARD FUSE LABELED "CRANK" FROM FUSE BLK #2 POSITION (3 AMP. FUSE).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 3806
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Footnotes 101 Thru 150
[101] Driveability correction for heavy chuggle. REQUIRES KIT P/N 25522748 CONTAINING:
WIRING HARNESS JUMPER P/N 12043500,
RELAY P/N 25522747, FOAM P/N 25522723, EGR P/N 17079799.
[102] Cold startability adjustment. REQUIRES SUPPLEMENTARY TUNE-UP LABEL, SPARK
BYPASS RELAY KIT P/N 14086983, SPARK
PLUGS P/N 5614009, SUN VISOR STARTING LABEL P/N 14085150. ALSO, REMOVE AND
DISCARD FUSE LABELED "CRANK" FROM FUSE BLK #2 POSITION (3 AMP. FUSE).
[103] Cold startability adjustment. REQUIRES SUPPLEMENTARY TUNE-UP LABEL, SPARK
BYPASS RELAY KIT P/N 14086983, SPARK
PLUGS P/N 5614009, SUN VISOR STARTING LABEL P/N 14085150. ALSO, REMOVE AND
DISCARD FUSE LABELED "CRANK" FROM FUSE BLK #2 POSITION (3 AMP. FUSE).
[104] Cold startability adjustment. REQUIRES SUPPLEMENTARY TUNE-UP LABEL, SPARK
BYPASS RELAY KIT P/N 14086983, SPARK
PLUGS P/N 5614009, SUN VISOR STARTING LABEL P/N 14085150. ALSO, REMOVE AND
DISCARD FUSE LABELED "CRANK" FROM FUSE BLK #2 POSITION (3 AMP. FUSE).
[105] Surge. RETROFIT PROM - DOES NOT SUPERSEDE THE REGULAR REPLACEMENT
SERVICE PROM. TO BE USED ONLY AS
REQUIRED TO RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE.
[106] Surge and CODE 51. RETROFIT PROM - SUPERSEDES ALL PREVIOUS SERVICE PROM
PART NUMBERS. TO BE USED AS BOTH
THE REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT (PROM-DAMAGED OR DEFECTIVE), AND TO
RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE.
[107] Surge and CODE 51. RETROFIT PROM - SUPERSEDES ALL PREVIOUS SERVICE PROM
PART NUMBERS. TO BE USED AS BOTH
THE REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT (PROM-DAMAGED OR DEFECTIVE), AND TO
RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE.
[108] Surge and CODE 51. RETROFIT PROM - SUPERSEDES ALL PREVIOUS SERVICE PROM
PART NUMBERS. TO BE USED AS BOTH
THE REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT (PROM-DAMAGED OR DEFECTIVE), AND TO
RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE.
[109] Surge and CODE 51. RETROFIT PROM - SUPERSEDES ALL PREVIOUS SERVICE PROM
PART NUMBERS. TO BE USED AS BOTH
THE REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT (PROM-DAMAGED OR DEFECTIVE), AND TO
RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE.
[110] Surge. RETROFIT PROM - SUPERSEDES ALL PREVIOUS SERVICE PROM PART
NUMBERS. TO BE USED AS BOTH THE
REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT (PROM-DAMAGED OR DEFECTIVE), AND TO RESOLVE
CASES OF CHUGGLE.
[111] Surge and CODE 51. RETROFIT PROM - SUPERSEDES ALL PREVIOUS SERVICE PROM
PART NUMBERS. TO BE USED AS BOTH
THE REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT (PROM-DAMAGED OR DEFECTIVE), AND TO
RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE.
[112] Surge and CODE 51. RETROFIT PROM - SUPERSEDES ALL PREVIOUS SERVICE PROM
PART NUMBERS. TO BE USED AS BOTH
THE REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT (PROM-DAMAGED OR DEFECTIVE), AND TO
RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE, DETONATION, OR FLATNESS.
[113] Surge and CODE 51. RETROFIT PROM - SUPERSEDES ALL PREVIOUS SERVICE PROM
PART NUMBERS. TO BE USED AS BOTH
THE REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT (PROM-DAMAGED OR DEFECTIVE), AND TO
RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE, DETONATION, OR FLATNESS.
[114] Surge, flatness or tip-in hesitation. RETROFIT PROM - DOES NOT SUPERSEDE THE
REGULAR REPLACEMENT SERVICE PROMS.
TO BE USED ONLY AS REQUIRED TO RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE, DETONATION, OR
FLATNESS.
[115] FOR USE WITH P215/65 TIRES - USE 01228290 (SCAN I.D. = 8290). FOR USE WITH
P235/60, P245/50 TIRES - USE 01228291 (SCAN
I.D. = 8291).
[116] FOR USE WITH P215/65 TIRES - USE 01228290 (SCAN I.D. = 8290). FOR USE WITH
P235/60, P245/50 TIRES - USE 01228291 (SCAN
I.D. = 8291).
[117] Spark knock only. USE 16143570 (SCAN I.D. = 3531) FOR HOT HARD RESTART
(REQUIRES FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764, FUEL
SENDER P/N 25093526). USE 16143459 (SCAN I.D. = 3571) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK,
HIGH IDLE.
[118] Spark knock only. USE 16143455 (SCAN I.D. = 3511) FOR HOT HARD RESTART
(REQUIRES FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764, FUEL
SENDER P/N 25093526). USE 16143453 (SCAN I.D. = 3501) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK,
HIGH IDLE.
[119] Spark knock. USE 16143575 (SCAN I.D. = 3541) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES
FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764). USE 16143460
(SCAN I.D. = 3581) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[120] Detonation. USE 16143580 (SCAN I.D. = 3551) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES
FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764). USE 16143462
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 3807
(SCAN I.D. = 3591) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[121] Stall, sags, hesitation. USE 16143575 (SCAN I.D. = 3541) FOR HOT HARD RESTART
(REQUIRES FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764). USE
16143460 (SCAN I.D. = 3581) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[122] USE 16143575 (SCAN I.D. = 3541) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764). USE 16143460 (SCAN I.D. =
3581) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[123] USE 16143570 (SCAN I.D. = 3531) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER P/N 25093526).
USE 16143459 (SCAN I.D. = 3571) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[124] USE 16143455 (SCAN I.D. = 3511) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER P/N 25093526).
USE 16143453 (SCAN I.D. = 3501) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[125] USE 16143457 (SCAN I.D. = 3521) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115925, FUEL SENDER P/N 25092778).
USE 16143466 (SCAN I.D. = 3481) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[126] USE 16143452 (SCAN I.D. = 3491) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115925, FUEL SENDER P/N 25092778).
USE 16143463 (SCAN I.D. = 3451) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[127] USE 16143457 (SCAN I.D. = 3521) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115925, FUEL SENDER P/N 25092778).
USE 16143466 (SCAN I.D. = 3481) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[128] USE 16143452 (SCAN I.D. = 3491) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115925, FUEL SENDER P/N 25092778).
USE 16143463 (SCAN I.D. = 3451) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[129] Engine stall and/or hesitation after cold start. NEEDS AIR INJECTION SERVICE KIT (P/N
10115773) AND NEW VEHICLE EMISSION
CONTROL LABEL.
[130] Engine stall and/or hesitation after cold start. NEEDS AIR INJECTION SERVICE KIT (P/N
10115773) AND NEW VEHICLE EMISSION
CONTROL LABEL.
[131] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. WITH THIS PROM INSTALLED, USE
1987-88 2.8L SPEED DENSITY ENGINE
DRIVEABILITY AND EMISSIONS MANUAL.
[132] Cold stall and chuggle. DO NOT RELY ON THE SCANNER ID TO DETERMINE WHICH
PROM IS IN A VEHICLE. LOOK AT THE
BCC ON THE PROM TO BE SURE. DO NOT CONFUSE WITH SOME 1991 MODELS WITH A
2.84 AXLE RATIO AND A FEDERAL EMISSIONS PKG. WITH USED SCANNER ID 5644 BUT
HAD A BCC OF AWJD.
[133] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. WITH THIS PROM INSTALLED, USE
1987-88 2.8L SPEED DENSITY ENGINE
DRIVEABILITY AND EMISSIONS MANUAL.
[134] Tip-in hesitation on acceleration; engine stall or sag on cold start; engine stall on
deceleration; check engine light with CODES 23,25,33, or 34;
or engine speed flare on clutch operation, with manual transmission equipped vehicle. WITH THIS
PROM INSTALLED, USE 1987-88 2.8L SPEED DENSITY ENGINE DRIVEABILITY AND
EMISSIONS MANUAL.
[135] Tip-in hesitation on acceleration; engine stall or sag on cold start; engine stall on
deceleration; check engine light with CODES 23,25,33, or 34;
or engine speed flare on declutch operation with manual transmission equipped vehicle. WITH
THIS PROM INSTALLED, USE 1987-88 2.8L SPEED DENSITY ENGINE DRIVEABILITY AND
EMISSIONS MANUAL.
[136] Driveability conditions, and/or CODES 23,25,33,34. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[137] Driveability conditions, and/or CODES 23,25,33,34. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[138] Driveability conditions, and/or CODES 23,25,33,34. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[139] Driveability conditions, and/or CODES 23,25,33,34. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 3808
[140] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[141] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[142] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[143] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[144] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[145] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[146] PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED DENSITY
SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER
PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[147] PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED DENSITY
SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER
PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[148] PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED DENSITY
SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER
PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[149] Tip-in hesitation on acceleration; engine stall or sag on cold start; engine stall on
deceleration; check engine light with CODES 23,25,33, or 34;
or engine speed flare on declutch operation with manual transmission equipped vehicle. PROM
UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED DENSITY SYSTEM.
WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON SCANNER AS A 1989
MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[150] Tip-in hesitation on acceleration; engine stall or sag on cold start; engine stall on
deceleration; check engine light with CODES 23,25,33, or 34;
or engine speed flare on declutch operation with manual transmission equipped vehicle. PROM
UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED DENSITY SYSTEM.
WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON SCANNER AS A 1989
MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 3809
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Footnotes 151 Thru 200
[151] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[152] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[153] Driveability improvement and eliminate FALSE "Service Engine Soon" lights. FOR 2WD USE
16120099 (SCAN I.D. = 9941). FOR 4WD
USE 16120109 (SCAN I.D. = 9901).
[154] Driveability improvement and eliminate FALSE "Service Engine Soon" lights. FOR 2.73
(GU2) AXLE USE 16120077 (SCAN I.D. = 9891).
FOR 3.08 (GU4) AXLE USE 16120082 (SCAN I.D. = 9901). FOR 3.42 (GU6) AND 3.73 (GT4)
AXLES USE 16120086 (SCAN I.D. = 9911).
[155] Driveability improvement and eliminate FALSE "Service Engine Soon" lights. FOR 2WD USE
16120042 (SCAN I.D. = 9991). FOR 4WD
USE 16120129 (SCAN I.D. = 0011).
[156] Prom calibration. FOR FALSE CODE 44 ON LONG COAST DOWN, USE RETROFIT
SERVICE PROM 01228486 AAND 1050. FOR
REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT, USE PROM 16062797 AAND 2798.
[157] FOR FALSE CODE 44 ON LONG COAST DOWN, USE RETROFIT SERVICE PROM
01228487 AANF 1052. FOR REGULAR SERVICE
REPLACEMENT, USE PROM 16062801 AANF 2802.
[158] Spark knock only. USE 16143570 (SCAN I.D. = 3531) FOR HOT HARD RESTART
(REQUIRES FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764, FUEL
SENDER P/N 25093526). USE 16143459 (SCAN I.D. = 3571) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK,
HIGH IDLE.
[159] Spark knock only. USE 16143455 (SCAN I.D. = 3511) FOR HOT HARD RESTART
(REQUIRES FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764, FUEL
SENDER P/N 25093526). USE 16143453 (SCAN I.D. = 3501) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK,
HIGH IDLE.
[160] Detonation. USE 16143580 (SCAN I.D. = 3551) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES
FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764). USE 16143462
(SCAN I.D. = 3591) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[161] USE 16143545 (SCAN I.D. = 3461) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER P/N 25093744).
USE 16143465 (SCAN I.D. = 3471) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[162] USE 16143570 (SCAN I.D. = 3531) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER P/N 25093526).
USE 16143459 (SCAN I.D. = 3571) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[163] USE 16143545 (SCAN I.D. = 3461) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER P/N 25093744).
USE 16143465 (SCAN I.D. = 3471) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[164] USE 16143570 (SCAN I.D. = 3531) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER P/N 25093526).
USE 16143459 (SCAN I.D. = 3571) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[165] USE 16143455 (SCAN I.D. = 3511) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER P/N 25093526).
USE 16143453 (SCAN I.D. = 3501) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[166] Hard start when hot and detonation. USE 16143457 (SCAN I.D. = 3521) FOR HOT HARD
RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP P/N
25115925, FUEL SENDER P/N 25092778). USE 16143466 (SCAN I.D. = 3481) FOR CODE 42,
SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[167] Hard start when hot and detonation. USE 16143452 (SCAN I.D. = 3491) FOR HOT HARD
RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP P/N
25115925, FUEL SENDER P/N 25092778). USE 16143463 (SCAN I.D. = 3451) FOR CODE 42,
SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[168] Engine stall and/or hesitation after cold start. NEEDS AIR INJECTION SERVICE KIT (P/N
10115773) AND NEW VEHICLE EMISSION
CONTROL LABEL.
[169] Cold stall and chuggle. DO NOT RELY ON THE SCANNER ID TO DETERMINE WHICH
PROM IS IN A VEHICLE. LOOK AT THE
BCC ON THE PROM TO BE SURE. DO NOT CONFUSE WITH SOME 1991 MODELS WITH A
2.84 AXLE RATIO AND A FEDERAL EMISSIONS PKG. WHICH USED SCANNER ID 5644 BUT
HAD A BCC OF AWJD.
[170] Engine stall and/or hesitation after cold start. NEEDS AIR INJECTION SERVICE KIT (P/N
10115773) AND NEW VEHICLE EMISSION
CONTROL LABEL.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 3810
[171] Engine stall and/or hesitation after cold start. MUST BE ORDERED WITH SERVICE KIT P/N
10115773.
[172] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. WITH THIS PROM INSTALLED, USE
1987-88 2.8L SPEED DENSITY ENGINE
DRIVEABILITY AND EMISSIONS MANUAL.
[173] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. WITH THIS PROM INSTALLED, USE
1987-88 2.8L SPEED DENSITY ENGINE
DRIVEABILITY AND EMISSIONS MANUAL.
[174] Driveability conditions, and/or CODES 23,25,33,34. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[175] Driveability conditions, and/or CODES 23,25,33,34. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[176] Driveability conditions, and/or CODES 23,25,33,34. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[177] Driveability conditions, and/or CODES 23,25,33,34. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[178] Driveability conditions, and/or CODES 23,25,33,34. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[179] Driveability conditions, and/or CODES 23,25,33,34. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[180] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[181] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[182] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[183] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[184] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[185] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[186] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[187] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[188] Driveability conditions, and/or CODES 23,25,33,34. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 3811
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[189] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[190] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[191] Information on PROM calibrations. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR,
REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED DENSITY SYSTEM.
WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON SCANNER AS A 1989
MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[192] Information on PROM calibrations. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR,
REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED DENSITY SYSTEM.
WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON SCANNER AS A 1989
MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[193] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[194] Driveability conditions and/or stored engine codes. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[195] FOR USE WITH MODEL C1 TRUCKS - USE 16121162 (SCAN I.D. = 3511). FOR USE
WITH MODEL C2, K, K2, AND K1000 TRUCKS USE 16121166 (SCAN I.D. = 3521).
[196] Engine surge. ALSO REQUIRES INSTALLATION OF NEW EGR VALVE PACKAGE P/N
17112238 (CONTAINS EGR VALVE P/N
17090078 AND A GASKET).
[197] Engine stall and/or hesitation after cold start. NEEDS AIR INJECTION SERVICE KIT (P/N
10115773) AND NEW VEHICLE EMISSION
CONTROL LABEL.
[198] Engine stall and/or hesitation after cold start. NEEDS AIR INJECTION SERVICE KIT (P/N
10115773) AND NEW VEHICLE EMISSION
CONTROL LABEL.
[199] Cold stall and chuggle. DO NOT RELY ON THE SCANNER ID TO DETERMINE WHICH
PROM IS IN A VEHICLE. LOOK AT THE
BCC ON THE PROM TO BE SURE. DO NOT CONFUSE WITH SOME 1991 MODELS WITH A
2.84 AXLE RATIO AND A FEDERAL EMISSIONS PKG. WHICH USED SCANNER ID 5644 BUT
HAD A BCC OF AWJD.
[200] Cold stall and chuggle. DO NOT RELY ON THE SCANNER ID TO DETERMINE WHICH
PROM IS IN A VEHICLE. LOOK AT THE
BCC ON THE PROM TO BE SURE. DO NOT CONFUSE WITH SOME 1991 MODELS WITH A
2.84 AXLE RATIO AND A FEDERAL EMISSIONS PKG. WHICH USED SCANNER ID 5644 BUT
HAD A BCC OF AWJD.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 3812
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Footnotes 201 Thru 250
[201] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16181863 (SCAN I.D. = 0844) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16181859 (SCAN I.D. = 0834) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[202] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16181863 (SCAN I.D. = 0844) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16181859 (SCAN I.D. = 0834) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[203] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16181863 (SCAN I.D. = 0844) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16181859 (SCAN I.D. = 0834) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[204] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16181871 (SCAN I.D. = 0864) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16181867 (SCAN I.D. = 0854) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[205] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16181871 (SCAN I.D. = 0864) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16181867 (SCAN I.D. = 0854) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[206] Cold stall and chuggle. DO NOT RELY ON THE SCANNER ID TO DETERMINE WHICH
PROM IS IN A VEHICLE. LOOK AT THE
BCC ON THE PROM TO BE SURE. DO NOT CONFUSE WITH SOME 1991 MODELS WITH A
2.84 AXLE RATIO AND A FEDERAL EMISSIONS PKG. WHICH USED SCANNER ID 5644 BUT
HAD A BCC OF AWJD.
[207] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165848 (SCAN I.D. = 5614) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165843 (SCAN I.D. = 5624) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[208] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165829 (SCAN I.D. = 5644) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[209] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165829 (SCAN I.D. = 5644) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[210] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165848 (SCAN I.D. = 5614) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165843 (SCAN I.D. = 5624) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[211] Engine stall, long cranks/idle/decel/surge. CANNOT BE USED ON VEHICLES THAT DO
NOT HAVE DIGITAL EGR VALVES.
[212] Cold stall and chuggle. DO NOT RELY ON THE SCANNER ID TO DETERMINE WHICH
PROM IS IN A VEHICLE. LOOK AT THE
BCC ON THE PROM TO BE SURE. DO NOT CONFUSE WITH SOME 1991 MODELS WITH A
2.84 AXLE RATIO AND A FEDERAL EMISSIONS PKG. WHICH USED SCANNER ID 5644 BUT
HAD A BCC OF AWJD.
[213] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165848 (SCAN I.D. = 5614) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165843 (SCAN I.D. = 5624) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[214] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165829 (SCAN I.D. = 5644) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[215] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165829 (SCAN I.D. = 5644) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[216] Cold start extended crank. Engine starts with ignition key cycled. USE 16181883 (SCAN I.D.
= 0894) FOR COLD START STALL. USE
16181875 (SCAN I.D. = 0874) ONLY IF REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND
CHUGGLE.
[217] Cold start extended crank, engine starts with ignition key cycled. USE 16181883 (SCAN I.D.
= 0894) FOR COLD START STALL. USE
16181875 (SCAN I.D. = 0874) ONLY IF REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND
CHUGGLE.
[218] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16181887 (SCAN I.D. = 0904) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16181879 (SCAN I.D. = 0884) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[219] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16181887 (SCAN I.D. = 0904) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16181879 (SCAN I.D. = 0884) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[220] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165848 (SCAN I.D. = 5614) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165843 (SCAN I.D. = 5624) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[221] Surge or chuggle on decel and/or rough idle. PROM CAN ONLY BE USED WITH ECM P/N
16144288.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 3813
[222] Surge or chuggle on decel and/or rough idle. PROM CAN ONLY BE USED WITH ECM P/N
16144288.
[223] Engine stall. MANUAL TRANSMISSION CARS SHOULD ALSO BE UPDATED WITH THE
CLUTCH ANTICIPATE SWITCH PER
DEALER SERVICE BULLETIN NO. 91-472-7C.
[224] USE 16165848 (SCAN I.D. = 5614) FOR COLD START STALL. USE 16165843 (SCAN I.D.
= 5624) ONLY IF REQUIRED TO SOLVE
BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[225] USE 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) FOR COLD START STALL. USE 16165829 (SCAN I.D.
= 5644) ONLY IF REQUIRED TO SOLVE
BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[226] USE 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) FOR COLD START STALL. USE 16165829 (SCAN I.D.
= 5644) ONLY IF REQUIRED TO SOLVE
BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[227] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165848 (SCAN I.D. = 5614) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165843 (SCAN I.D. = 5624) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[228] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165829 (SCAN I.D. = 5644) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[229] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165829 (SCAN I.D. = 5644) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[230] Surge or chuggle on decel and/or rough idle. PROM CAN ONLY BE USED WITH ECM P/N
16144288.
[231] MAKE CERTAIN THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN UPDATED WITH PREVIOUSLY ATTEMPTED
SERVICE FIXES AS FOLLOWS: EGR
VALVE P/N 17090156 (STAMPED ON VALVE) 17112373 (GMSPO KIT), PCV VALVE P/N
25098542, ESC MODULE P/N 16175099 (BCC=BARC).
[232] Driveability improvements. MAKE CERTAIN THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN UPDATED WITH
PREVIOUSLY ATTEMPTED SERVICE
FIXES AS FOLLOWS: EGR VALVE P/N 17090156 (STAMPED ON VALVE) 17112373 (GMSPO
KIT), PCV VALVE P/N 25098542, ESC MODULE P/N 16175099 (BCC=BARC).
[233] Driveability improvements. MAKE CERTAIN THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN UPDATED WITH
PREVIOUSLY ATTEMPTED SERVICE
FIXES AS FOLLOWS: EGR VALVE P/N 17090156 (STAMPED ON VALVE) 17112373 (GMSPO
KIT), PCV VALVE P/N 25098542, ESC MODULE P/N 16175099 (BCC=BARC).
[234] Driveablity improvements. MAKE CERTAIN THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN UPDATED WITH
PREVIOUSLY ATTEMPTED SERVICE
FIXES AS FOLLOWS: EGR VALVE P/N 17090156 (STAMPED ON VALVE) 17112373 (GMSPO
KIT), PCV VALVE P/N 25098542, ESC MODULE P/N 16175099 (BCC=BARC).
[235] Driveability improvements. MAKE CERTAIN THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN UPDATED WITH
PREVIOUSLY ATTEMPTED SERVICE
FIXES AS FOLLOWS: EGR VALVE P/N 17090156 (STAMPED ON VALVE) 17112373 (GMSPO
KIT), PCV VALVE P/N 25098542, ESC MODULE P/N 16175099 (BCC=BARC).
[236] Center Port Fuel Injection noise. FOR VEHICLES WITH SLEEVE BEARING ENGINES.
[237] Neutral gear rattle only. COMBINATION DETONATION AND NEUTRAL GEAR RATTLE
PROM AVAILABLE.
[238] Driveability improvements. MAKE CERTAIN THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN UPDATED WITH
PREVIOUSLY ATTEMPTED SERVICE
FIXES AS FOLLOWS: EGR VALVE P/N 17090156 (STAMPED ON VALVE) 17112373 (GMSPO
KIT), PCV VALVE P/N 25098542, ESC MODULE P/N 16175099 (BCC=BARC).
[239] TCC chuggle. MODEL 2DDM TRANSMISSIONS - CHECK DEALER RECORDS TO SEE IF
THE TORQUE CONVERTER HAS
ALREADY BEEN REPLACED WITH P/N 8650935 (TAGGED BCC: DGAF). TRANS. WITH
TORQUE CONVERTERS WITH P/N 8656959 (TAGGED BCC: DG5F) NEED TO REPLACE IT
WITH P/N 8650935.
[240] Unstable idle in park or neutral/poor driveability. FOR DEDICATED NATURAL GAS
VEHICLES. ORDER WITH KIT P/N 12545589
UNLESS THE ONLY PROBLEM IS IDLE FLUCTUATION.
[241] Driveability improvements. MAKE CERTAIN THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN UPDATED WITH
PREVIOUSLY ATTEMPTED SERVICE
FIXES AS FOLLOWS: EGR VALVE P/N 17090156 (STAMPED ON VALVE) 17112373 (GMSPO
KIT), PCV VALVE P/N 25098542, ESC MODULE P/N 16175099 (BCC=BARC).
[242] Information on PROM calibrations. CANNOT BE USED ON VEHICLES THAT DO NOT
HAVE DIGITAL EGR VALVES.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 3814
[243] TCC chuggle. MODEL 2DDM TRANSMISSIONS - CHECK DEALER RECORDS TO SEE IF
THE TORQUE CONVERTER HAS
ALREADY BEEN REPLACED WITH P/N 8650935 (TAGGED BCC: DGAF). TRANS. WITH
TORQUE CONVERTERS WITH P/N 8656959 (TAGGED BCC: DG5F) NEED TO REPLACE IT
WITH P/N 8650935.
[244] TCC chuggle. MODEL 2DDM TRANSMISSIONS - CHECK DEALER RECORDS TO SEE IF
THE TORQUE CONVERTER HAS
ALREADY BEEN REPLACED WITH P/N 8650935 (TAGGED BCC: DGAF). TRANS. WITH
TORQUE CONVERTERS WITH P/N 8656959 (TAGGED BCC: DG5F) NEED TO REPLACE IT
WITH P/N 8650935.
[245] Tip-in hesitation on acceleration; engine stall or sag on cold start; engine stall on
deceleration; check engine light with CODES 23,25,33, or 34;
or engine speed flare on declutch operation with manual transmission equipped vehicle.
[246] Tip-in hesitation on acceleration; engine stall or sag on cold start; engine stall on
deceleration; check engine light with CODES 23,25,33, or 34;
or engine speed flare on declutch operation with manual transmission equipped vehicle.
[247] Check engine light comes on while idling on vehicles equipped with Computer Controlled
Emission System (C.C.E.S.), driven in altitudes above
3000 feet.
[248] Engine may stop running during parking maneuver or during coast down at low speeds during
ambient temperature above 85°F.
[249] Tip-in hesitation on acceleration; engine stall or sag on cold start; engine stall on
deceleration; check engine light with CODES 23,25,33, or 34;
or engine speed flare on declutch operation with manual transmission equipped vehicle.
[250] Surge on acceleration and/or at road load speeds, false "Service Engine Soon" light (CODE
32), poor driveability during warm up, Detonation
under load.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 3815
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Footnotes 251 Thru 300
[251] Hesitation or sag during the first two minutes of cold operation while vehicle is under
moderate to heavy throttle drive away, or TCC chuggle.
[252] Cold start-stall, hesitation, or sag when the engine coolant is between 36°F to 111°F (2°C to
44°C); or Inadequate AC performance when driving
at a steady speed and throttle position, between 24 to 64 MPH, when the cruise control is not being
used.
[253] Lack of throttle response on trucks equipped with governors; or hot restart driveaway sag,
both governor and non-governor trucks.
[254] Intermittent stall after cold start; engine stalling on coast down; hesitation cold; or ECM
CODES E22,E26,E32,E55,E70, and/or E85
[255] PROM I.D. 7080 KJ is also acceptable for PROM I.D. 5853 KJ only. Requires Throttle body
service P/N 17067144, EGR valve] service P/N
17067108 (FED), 17067144 (CAL), Injector service kit P/N 17067976.
[256] Requires Throttle body service P/N 17067142, EGR valve service P/N 17067107 (FED),
17068210 (CAL), Injector service kit P/N 17067976.
[257] FOR CHUGGLE AT 40-45 CONDITION, USE PROM ONLY. FOR TIP-IN HESITATION
ONLY, USE EGR VALVE ONLY - P/N
17078431. FOR COLD DRIVEABILITY HESITATION, USE BOTH PROM AND EGR.
[258] REQUIRES SUPPLEMENTARY TUNE-UP LABEL, SPARK BYPASS RELAY KIT P/N 015
14086983, SPARK PLUGS P/N 5614009, SUN
VISOR STARTING LABEL P/N 015 14085150. ALSO, REMOVE AND DISCARD FUSE LABELED
"CRANK" FROM FUSE BLK #2 POSITION (3 AMP. FUSE).
[259] DO NOT RELY ON THE SCANNER ID TO DETERMINE WHICH PROM IS IN A VEHICLE.
LOOK AT THE BCC ON THE PROM TO
BE SURE. DO NOT CONFUSE WITH SOME 1991 MODELS WITH A 2.84 AXLE RATIO AND A
FEDERAL EMISSIONS PACKAGE WITH USED SCANNER ID 5644 BUT HAD A
[260] DO NOT RELY ON THE SCANNER ID TO DETERMINE WHICH PROM IS IN A VEHICLE.
LOOK AT THE BCC ON THE PROM TO
BE SURE. DO NOT CONFUSE WITH SOME 1991 MODELS WITH A 2.84 AXLE RATIO AND A
FEDERAL EMISSIONS PACKAGE WITH USED SCANNER ID 5644 BUT HAD A
[261] DO NOT RELY ON THE SCANNER ID TO DETERMINE WHICH PROM IS IN A VEHICLE.
LOOK AT THE BCC ON THE PROM TO
BE SURE. DO NOT CONFUSE WITH SOME 1991 MODELS WITH A 2.84 AXLE RATIO AND A
FEDERAL EMISSIONS PACKAGE WITH USED SCANNER ID 5644 BUT HAD A
[262] MAKE CERTAIN THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN UPDATED WITH PREVIOUSLY AT TEMPTED
SERVICE FIXES AS FOLLOWS: EGR
VALVE P/N 17090156 (STAMPED ON VALVE) 17112373 (GMSPO KIT), PCV VALVE P/N
25098542, ESC MODULE P/N 16175099 (BCC=BARC).
[263] MAKE CERTAIN THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN UPDATED WITH PREVIOUSLY ATTEMPTED
SERVICE FIXES AS FOLLOWS: EGR
VALVE P/N 17090156 (STAMPED ON VALVE) 17112373 (GMSPO KIT), PCV VALVE P/N
25098542, ESC MODULE P/N 16175099 (BCC=BARC).
[264] MODEL 2DDM TRANS. CARS - CHECK DLR. RECORDS TO SEE IF THE TORQUE
CONVERTER HAS ALREADY BEEN REPLACED
WITH PN 8650935 (BCC: DGAF). TRANSMISSIONS WITH TORQUE CONVERTERS WITH PN
8656959 (BCC: DG5F) NEED TO HAVE THE TORQUE CONVERTER REPLACED W
[265] MODEL 2DDM TRANS. CARS - CHECK DLR. RECORDS TO SEE IF THE TORQUE
CONVERTER HAS ALREADY BEEN REPLACED
WITH PN 8650935 (BCC: DGAF). TRANSMISSIONS WITH TORQUE CONVERTERS WITH PN
8656959 (BCC: DG5F) NEED TO HAVE THE TORQUE CONVERTER REPLACED W
[266] Vehicles equipped with Computer Controlled Emission System (C.C.E.S) experience a Check
Engine Light coming on while idling, usually when
idling time exceeds 2 minutes with transmission in gear in altitudes above 3000 feet.
[267] Cold driveability, use with PROM 5854 KJ (G057). PROM I.D. 7080 KJ IS ALSO
ACCEPTABLE FOR PROM I.D. 5853 KJ ONLY.
REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE P/N 17067144, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N 17067108
(FED), 17067144 (CAL), INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[268] Cold driveability, use with PROM 5853 KJ (G057). PROM I.D. 7079 KJ IS ALSO
ACCEPTABLE FOR PROM I.D. 5854 KJ ONLY.
REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE P/N 17067144, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N 17067108
(FED), 17067144 (CAL), INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[269] Cold driveability, use with PROM 5861 KK (G057). REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17067142, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N
17067107 (FED), 17068210 (CAL), INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 3816
[270] Cold driveability, use with PROM 5860 KK (G057). REQUIRES THROTTLE BODY SERVICE
P/N 17067142, EGR VALVE SERVICE P/N
17067107 (FED), 17068210 (CAL), INJECTOR SERVICE KIT P/N 17067976.
[271] Tip-in hesitation, lack low speed performance. Used with Manual transaxle vehicles with A/C
only. Requires EGR TVS P/N 373510, and A.I.R.
valve P/N 17082701.
[272] Weak drive-away after cold start, requires EGR TVS P/N 373510. Also, for CALIFORNIA
emissions, manual transaxle, replace A.I.R.
management valve with PN 17082701.
[273] Level road surge, tip-in hesitation, lack of low speed performance - for automatic transaxles
only. (Requires EGR valve P/N 17068212). FOR
FEDERAL - USE 01226055. FOR CALIFORNIA - USE 01226057.
[274] Stall in coast down with clutch disengaged and A/C on, weak drive away after cold start ,
requires EGR TVS P/N 373510. Also, for
CALIFORNIA emissions, manual transaxle, replace A.I.R. management valve with PN 17082701.
[275] Idle shake, detonation (G043). FOR 2.5L EFI, AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE, AND FIRST
DESIGN (3-BOARD) ECM. THE SECOND
DESIGN (2-BOARD) ECM HAS THE SPARK REVISION ALREADY INCORPORATED IN ITS
PROM.
[276] Chuggle/surge at 40-45 MPH, tip-in hesitation/sag, spark knock, requires EGR valve (G032).
FOR CHUGGLE AT 40-45 CONDITION, USE
PROM ONLY. FOR TIP-IN HESITATION ONLY, USE EGR VALVE ONLY - P/N 17078431. FOR
COLD DRIVEABILITY HESITATION, USE BOTH PROM AND EGR.
[277] Chuggle and surge at 35-55 MPH, requires EGR kit. REQUIRES KIT P/N 25522748
CONTAINING: WIRING HARNESS JUMPER P/N
12043500, RELAY P/N 25522747, FOAM P/N 25522723, EGR P/N 17079799.
[278] CODE 42, spark knock, cold startability, plug fouling (G040). REQUIRES SUPPLEMENTARY
TUNE-UP LABEL, SPARK BYPASS RELAY
KIT P/N 14086983, SPARK PLUGS P/N 5614009, SUN VISOR STARTING LABEL P/N 14085150.
ALSO, REMOVE AND DISCARD FUSE LABELED "CRANK" FROM FUSE BLK #2 POSITION (3
AMP. FUSE).
[279] Chuggle and surge at 35-55 MPH, requires EGR kit (G040). REQUIRES KIT P/N 25522748
CONTAINING: WIRING HARNESS JUMPER
P/N 12043500, RELAY P/N 25522747, FOAM P/N 25522723, EGR P/N 17079799.
[280] Cold hesitation/sag, warm surge (G082). RETROFIT PROM SUPERSEDES ALL PREVIOUS
SERVICE PROM PART NUMBERS. TO BE
USED AS BOTH THE REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT (PROM-DAMAGED OF
DEFECTIVE), AND TO RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE, DETONATION, OR FLATNESS.
[281] TCC chuggle or surge (G043). WHEN INSTALLING PROM IN A CANADIAN 1985 NB, A
CODE 13 WILL OCCUR AS THE VEHICLE
WAS NOT EQUIPPED WITH AN O2 SENSOR. TO ELIMINATE THE CODE 13, NEED TO
INSTALL O2 SENSOR # 8990741 AND CONNECT TO THE EXISTING PURPLE WIRE AND
CONNECTOR IN THE
[282] Surge or chuggle at 52-60 MPH (G071). RETROFIT PROM - DOES NOT SUPERSEDE THE
REGULAR REPLACEMENT SERVICE
PROM. TO BE USED ONLY AS REQUIRED TO RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE.
[283] Surge or chuggle at 52-60 MPH (G071). RETROFIT PROM - SUPERSEDES ALL
PREVIOUS SERVICE PROM PART NUMBERS. TO BE
USED AS BOTH THE REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT (PROM-DAMAGED OR
DEFECTIVE), AND TO RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE.
[284] Chuggle, hesitation, tip-in spark knock. RETROFIT PROM - SUPERSEDES ALL PREVIOUS
SERVICE PROM PART NUMBERS. TO BE
USED AS BOTH THE REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT (PROM-DAMAGED OR
DEFECTIVE), AND TO RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE, DETONATION, OR FLATNESS.
[285] Chuggle, hesitation, tip-in spark knock. RETROFIT PROM - DOES NOT SUPERSEDE THE
REGULAR REPLACEMENT SERVICE
PROMS. TO BE USED ONLY AS REQUIRED TO RESOLVE CASES OF CHUGGLE,
DETONATION, OR FLATNESS.
[286] FOR USE WITH P215/65 TIRES - USE 01228290 (SCAN I.D. = 8290). FOR USE WITH
P235/60, P245/50 TIRES - USE 01228291 (SCAN
I.D. = 8291).
[287] FOR USE WITH P215/65 TIRES - USE 01228292 (SCAN I.D. = 8292). FOR USE WITH
P235/60, P245/50 TIRES - USE 01228293 (SCAN
I.D. = 8293).
[288] FALSE CODES 33, 34, 43, rough idle, chuggle, hesitation (G006,G007). USED WITH VIN
#119016 OR LATER ALUMINUM HEAD
CORVETTES AND ALL CONVERTIBLE MODELS WITH AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION, 2.59
(GM1) AXLE ONLY.
[289] FALSE CODES 33, 34, 43, rough idle, chuggle, hesitation (G006,G007). USED FOR VIN
#119016 OR LATER ALUMINUM HAED
CORVETTES AND ALL CONVERTIBLE MODELS WITH AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION, 2.73
(GU2)/3.07 (G44) AXLE ONLY.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 3817
[290] Spark knock. USE 16143570 (SCAN I.D. = 3531) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES
FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER
P/N 25093526). USE 16143459 (SCAN I.D. = 3571) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[291] Spark knock. USE 16143455 (SCAN I.D. = 3511) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES
FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER
P/N 25093526). USE 16143453 (SCAN I.D. = 3501) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[292] Spark knock (G055). USE 16143575 (SCAN I.D. = 3541) FOR HOT HARD RESTART
(REQUIRES FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764). USE
16143460 (SCAN I.D. = 3581) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[293] Spark knock (G043). USE 16143580 (SCAN I.D. = 3551) FOR HOT HARD RESTART
(REQUIRES FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764). USE
16143462 (SCAN I.D. = 3591) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[294] Stalling, tip-in hesitation/sag, rough idle, cold driveability. USE 16143575 (SCAN I.D. = 3541)
FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES
FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764). USE 16143460 (SCAN I.D. = 3581) FOR CODE 42, SPARK
KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[295] Hard hot restart (requires rubber bumper pkg PN 25004553, and a pulsator package PN
25094266), or CODE 42, intermittent high idle, spark
knock (G055).
[296] USE 16143575 (SCAN I.D. = 3541) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764). USE 16143460 (SCAN I.D. =
3581) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[297] USE 16143570 (SCAN I.D. = 3531) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER P/N 25093526).
USE 16143459 (SCAN I.D. = 3571) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[298] USE 16143455 (SCAN I.D. = 3511) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER P/N 25093526).
USE 16143453 (SCAN I.D. = 3501) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[299] USE 16143455 (SCAN I.D. = 3511) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER P/N 25093526).
USE 16143453 (SCAN I.D. = 3501) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[300] Spark knock. USE 16143457 (SCAN I.D. = 3521) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES
FUEL PUMP P/N 25115925, FUEL SENDER
P/N 25092778). USE 16143466 (SCAN I.D. = 3481) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 3818
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Footnotes 301 Thru 350
[301] Spark knock. USE 16143452 (SCAN I.D. = 3491) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES
FUEL PUMP P/N 25115925, FUEL SENDER
P/N 25092778). USE 16143463 (SCAN I.D. = 3451) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[302] Hard start hot (requires installation of a rubber bumper pkg PN 25004553, and a pulsator pkg
PN 25094266) or CODE 42, high idle, spark knock
(G055).
[303] USE 16143457 (SCAN I.D. = 3521) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115925, FUEL SENDER P/N 25092778).
USE 16143466 (SCAN I.D. = 3481) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[304] Hard hot restart (requires rubber bumper pkg PN 25004553, and a pulsator package PN
25094266), or CODE 42, intermittent high idle, spark
knock (G055).
[305] USE 16143452 (SCAN I.D. = 3491) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115925, FUEL SENDER P/N 25092778).
USE 16143463 (SCAN I.D. = 3451) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[306] Tip-in hesitation,stall,CODES 23,25,33,or 34, or speed flare on declutch op. w/man. trans.
(CODE 23 or 25 require MAT sensor model year
diagnostics) (G027). WITH THIS PROM INSTALLED, USE 1987-88 2.8L SPEED DENSITY
ENGINE DRIVEABILITY AND EMISSIONS MANUAL.
[307] CODES 23, 25, 33, 34, driveability and stalling (G027). PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[308] Tip-in hesitation,stall,CODES 23,25,33,or 34, or speed flare on declutch op. w/man. trans.
(CODE 23 or 25 require MAT sensor model year
diagnostics). PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[309] Code 23, 25, 33, 34, driveability and stalling. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR,
REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED DENSITY
SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON SCANNER AS
A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[310] Tip-in hesitation,stall,CODES 23,25,33,or 34, or speed flare on declutch op. w/man. trans.
(CODE 23 or 25 require MAT sensor model year
diagnostics) (G027). PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A
SPEED DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE
ON SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[311] High emissions, exhaust odor, starting and driveability problems (G046). Requires Connector
Bleed Assembly P/N 10105820
[312] FALSE CODES 43, 54, unstable idle. FOR 2.73 (GU2) AXLE USE 16120077 (SCAN I.D. =
9891). FOR 3.08 (GU4) AXLE USE 16120082
(SCAN I.D. = 9901). FOR 3.42 (GU6) AND 3.73 (GT4) AXLES USE 16120086 (SCAN I.D. = 9911).
[313] Running change. FOR FALSE CODE 44 ON LONG COAST DOWN, USE RETROFIT
SERVICE PROM 01228486 SCAN I.D. 8486, AAND
1050. FOR REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT, USE PROM 16062797 SCAN I.D. 2223, AAND
2798.
[314] Running change. FOR FALSE CODE 44 ON LONG COAST DOWN, USE RETROFIT
SERVICE PROM 01228487 SCAN I.D. 8487, AANF
1052. FOR REGULAR SERVICE REPLACEMENT, USE PROM 16062801 SCAN I.D. 2233, AANF
2802.
[315] Surge on acceleration and/or at road load speeds, false "Service Engine Soon" light (CODE
32), poor driveability during warm up, Detonation
under load (G052).
[316] Spark knock. USE 16143570 (SCAN I.D. = 3531) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES
FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER
P/N 25093526). USE 16143459 (SCAN I.D. = 3571) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[317] Spark knock. USE 16143455 (SCAN I.D. = 3511) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES
FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER
P/N 25093526). USE 16143453 (SCAN I.D. = 3501) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[318] Spark knock (G043). USE 16143580 (SCAN I.D. = 3551) FOR HOT HARD RESTART
(REQUIRES FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764). USE
16143462 (SCAN I.D. = 3591) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[319] Spark knock (G055). USE 16143545 (SCAN I.D. = 3461) FOR HOT HARD RESTART
(REQUIRES FUEL PUMP P/N 25115764, FUEL
SENDER P/N 25093744). USE 16143465 (SCAN I.D. = 3471) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK,
HIGH IDLE.
[320] CODE 42, spark knock, intermittent high idle. IF MAJOR CONDITION IS HARD HOT
ENGINE RESTART, PROM ALSO REQUIRES
INSTALLATION OF A RUBBER BUMPER PKG PN 25004553, AND PULSATOR PKG PN
25094266.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 3819
[321] USE 16143545 (SCAN I.D. = 3461) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER P/N 25093744).
USE 16143465 (SCAN I.D. = 3471) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[322] USE 16143570 (SCAN I.D. = 3531) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER P/N 25093526).
USE 16143459 (SCAN I.D. = 3571) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[323] USE 16143455 (SCAN I.D. = 3511) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES FUEL PUMP
P/N 25115764, FUEL SENDER P/N 25093526).
USE 16143453 (SCAN I.D. = 3501) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[324] Spark knock. USE 16143457 (SCAN I.D. = 3521) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES
FUEL PUMP P/N 25115925, FUEL SENDER
P/N 25092778). USE 16143466 (SCAN I.D. = 3481) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[325] Spark knock. USE 16143452 (SCAN I.D. = 3491) FOR HOT HARD RESTART (REQUIRES
FUEL PUMP P/N 25115925, FUEL SENDER
P/N 25092778). USE 16143463 (SCAN I.D. = 3451) FOR CODE 42, SPARK KNOCK, HIGH IDLE.
[326] Tip-in hesitation, stall, CODES 23, 25, 33, or 34, or speed flare on declutch op. w/man. trans.
(CODE 23 or 25 require MAT sensor model year
diagnostics) (G027). WITH THIS PROM INSTALLED, USE 1987-88 2.8L SPEED DENSITY
ENGINE DRIVEABILITY AND EMISSIONS MANUAL.
[327] CODES 23, 25, 33, 34. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH
A SPEED DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A
1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL
(VIN = K-1-W).
[328] Tip-in hesitation,stall,CODES 23,25,33,or 34, or speed flare on declutch op. w/ man. trans.
(CODE 23 or 25 require MAT sensor model year
diagnostics). PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[329] Tip-in hesitation,stall,CODES 23,25,33,or 34, or speed flare on declutch op. w/ man. trans.
(CODE 23 or 25 require MAT sensor model year
diagnostics) (G027). PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A
SPEED DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE
ON SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[330] CODES 23, 25, 33, 34, driveability and stalling (G027). PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF
SENSOR, REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED
DENSITY SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON
SCANNER AS A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[331] Code 23, 25, 33, 34, driveability and stalling. PROM UPDATE ELIMINATES MAF SENSOR,
REPLACING IT WITH A SPEED DENSITY
SYSTEM. WITH A 1990 OR EARLIER PRIMARY CARTRIDGE, I.D. VEHICLE ON SCANNER AS
A 1989 MODEL (VIN = K-1-W).
[332] FOR USE WITH MODEL C1 TRUCKS - USE 16121162 (SCAN I.D. = 3511). FOR USE
WITH MODEL C2, K, K2, AND K1000 TRUCKS USE 16121166 (SCAN I.D. = 3521).
[333] Surge on acceleration and/or at road load speeds, false "Service Engine Soon" light (CODE
32), poor driveability during warm up, Detonation
under load (G052).
[334] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16181863 (SCAN I.D. = 0844) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16181859 (SCAN I.D. = 0834) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[335] [Cold engine extended crank. USE 16181871 (SCAN I.D. = 0864) FOR COLD START
STALL. USE 16181867 (SCAN I.D. = 0854) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[336] Engine does not stay running on initial cold start and chuggle at 35-45 MPH with TCC
engaged. New MEM-CAL may affect fuel economy. DO
NOT RELY ON THE SCANNER ID TO DETERMINE WHICH PROM IS IN A VEHICLE. LOOK AT
THE BCC ON THE PROM TO BE SURE. DO NOT CONFUSE WITH SOME 1991 MODELS WITH
A 2.84 AXLE RATIO AND A FEDERAL EMISSIONS PACKAGE WITH SCANNER ID 5644 BUT A
BCC OF A]
[337] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165848 (SCAN I.D. = 5614) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165843 (SCAN I.D. = 5624) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[338] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165829 (SCAN I.D. = 5644) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[339] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165829 (SCAN I.D. = 5644) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[340] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165848 (SCAN I.D. = 5614) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165843 (SCAN I.D. = 5624) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 3820
[341] Hesitation or sag during the first two minutes of cold operation while vehicle is under
moderate to heavy throttle driveaway, or TCC chuggle.
[342] Cold start-stall, hesitation, or sag when the engine coolant is between 36°F - 111°F (2°C 44°C); or Inadequate A/C performance when driving at
steady speed and throttle position, between 24 - 64 MPH, when the cruise control is not being
used.
[343] Engine does not stay running on initial cold start and chuggle at 35-45 MPH with TCC
engaged. New MEM-CAL may affect fuel economy. DO
NOT RELY ON THE SCANNER ID TO DETERMINE WHICH PROM IS IN A VEHICLE. LOOK AT
THE BCC ON THE PROM TO BE SURE. DO NOT CONFUSE WITH SOME 1991 MODELS WITH
A 2.84 AXLE RATIO AND A FEDERAL EMISSIONS PACKAGE WITH SCANNER ID 5644 BUT A
BCC OF A
[344] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165848 (SCAN I.D. = 5614) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165843 (SCAN I.D. = 5624) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[345] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165829 (SCAN I.D. = 5644) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[346] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16181883 (SCAN I.D. = 0894) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16181875 (SCAN I.D. = 0874) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[347] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16181887 (SCAN I.D. = 0904) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16181879 (SCAN I.D. = 0884) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[348] Service Engine Soon light (SES) with a code 43 or tip-in sag, tip-in hesitation, surge at WOT,
or spark detonation when cold.
[349] Engine stall. MANUAL TRANSMISSION CARS SHOULD ALSO BE UPDATED WITH THE
CLUTCH ANTICIPATE SWITCH PER
DEALER SERVICE BULLETIN NO. 91-472-7C.
[350] Engine does not stay running on initial cold start and chuggle at 35-45 MPH with TCC
engaged. New MEM-CAL may affect fuel economy. DO
NOT RELY ON THE SCANNER ID TO DETERMINE WHICH PROM IS IN A VEHICLE. LOOK AT
THE BCC ON THE PROM TO BE SURE. DO NOT CONFUSE WITH SOME 1991 MODELS WITH
A 2.84 AXLE RATIO AND A FEDERAL EMISSIONS PACKAGE WITH SCANNER ID 5644 BUT A
BCC OF A.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Footnotes 1 Thru 50 > Page 3821
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Application and ID Footnotes 351 Thru 400
[351] USE 16165848 (SCAN I.D. = 5614) FOR COLD START STALL. USE 16165843 (SCAN I.D.
= 5624) ONLY IF REQUIRED TO SOLVE
BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[352] USE 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) FOR COLD START STALL. USE 16165829 (SCAN I.D.
= 5644) ONLY IF REQUIRED TO SOLVE
BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[353] Cold engine extended crank. USE 16165839 (SCAN I.D. = 5634) FOR COLD START STALL.
USE 16165829 (SCAN I.D. = 5644) ONLY IF
REQUIRED TO SOLVE BOTH COLD START STALL AND CHUGGLE.
[354] Lack of throttle response on trucks equipped with governors; or hot restart driveaway sag,
both governor and non-governor trucks.
[355] Low speed driveability or detonation. MAKE CERTAIN THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN UPDATED
WITH PREVIOUSLY ATTEMPTED
SERVICE FIXES AS FOLLOWS: EGR VALVE P/N 17090156 (STAMPED ON VALVE) 17112373
(GMSPO KIT), PCV VALVE P/N 25098542, ESC MODULE P/N 16175099 (BCC=BARC).
[356] Tip-in hesitation, sag, backfire, spark knock. MAKE CERTAIN THE VEHICLE HAS BEEN
UPDATED WITH PREVIOUSLY ATTEMPTED
SERVICE FIXES AS FOLLOWS: EGR VALVE P/N 17090156 (STAMPED ON VALVE) 17112373
(GMSPO KIT), PCV VALVE P/N 25098542, ESC MODULE P/N 16175099 (BCC=BARC).
[357] Hesitation or sag during the first two minutes of cold operation while vehicle is under
moderate to heavy throttle driveaway, or TCC chuggle.
[358] Sustained detonation/knock. AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSIONS REQUIRE TORQUE
CONVERTER CLUTCH (TCC) CALIBRATION. USE
OF THIS PROM IN A NON-DETONATING ENGINE MAY RESULT IN DEGRADED
DRIVEABILITY.
[359] High emissions, exhaust odor, starting and driveability problems (G046). Requires Connector
Bleed Assembly P/N 10105820
[360] Neutral gear rattle. MAY ALSO REQUIRE CLUTCH DRIVEN PLATE P/N 15961141, AND
CLUTCH PILOT BEARING P/N 14061685.
COMBINATION DETONATION AND NEUTRAL GEAR RATTLE PROM AVAILABLE.
[361] Malfunction Indicator Lamp (check engine light) illuminates and may set a DTC 24 (VSS
Circuit Fault) during a California State Emissions Test.
[362] Higher than normal hydrocarbon emissions during the idle portion of the inspection and
maintenance test. Also, may exhibit a slight detonation
during a light throttle acceleration
[363] TCC chuggle. MODEL 2DDM TRANS. - CHECK DEALER RECORDS TO SEE IF THE
TORQUE CONVERTER HAS BEEN REPLACED
WITH P/N 8650935 (BCC: DGAF). TRANS. WITH TORQUE CONVERTERS WITH P/N 8656959
(BCC: DG5F) NEED TO HAVE THE TORQUE CONVERTER REPLACED WITH P/N 8650935.
[364] Cold start stall, cold tip in hesitation and/or a cold rough idle after extended idling.
Additionally, in 40-50°F ambient temp., fogging on the
inside of the front windshield which does not clear with the defroster on occurs.
[365] Poor throttle response, stall, misfire, poor cold or hot start, extended crank of the starter with
a hot engine, and/or vehicle will start and then stall
when the engine is hot. MT vehicles may also experience decel. stall and poor accel. performance.
[366] Poor throttle response, stalling, misfire, poor cold or hot starting, extended cranking of the
starter with a hot engine, and/or vehicle will start and
then stall when the engine is hot. USED WITH MANUAL TRANSMISSION ONLY.
[367] MIL illuminates and/or store a DTC 32 (EGR error) with no noticeable driveability concern,
usually occurring while climbing a grade.
[368] MIL illuminates and/or store a DTC 32 (EGR error) with no noticeable driveability concern,
usually occurring while climbing a grade, towing a
trailer or driving into a strong head wind.
[369] High emissions, exhaust odor, starting and driveability problems (G046). Requires Connector
Bleed Assembly P/N 10105820
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Application and ID > Expanded Footnotes > Page 3822
Prom Information
Scan Prom Prom Prom Superseding
ID Code Bcc Part # ID Part # TSB Reference #
0121 0127 BFAD 16190126
0131 0130 BFAF 16190129
0141 0135 BFAH 16190133
0151 0138 BFAJ 16190137
3221 3200 BFUZ 16193199
6211 6354 BATX 16176352
6221 6358 BATY 16176357
6231 6364 BATZ 16176362
6241 6368 BAUA 16176367
6551 6578 BDJS 16186544
6981 6927 BJBR 16196924
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Description and Operation > CALPAK
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Description and Operation CALPAK
CAUTION:
If the computer is found to be defective and needs replacement, remove the old CALPAK and
PROM, then place both into the replacement computer. When replacing the COMPUTER always
transfer the BROADCAST CODE and PRODUCTION ECM/PCM NUMBER to the service label on
the replacement computer.
DESCRIPTION:
The resistor network calibration called a CALPAK is located inside the computer. Its appearance
and service is similar to the PROM. The CALPAK allows fuel to be delivered if other parts of the
computer fail. The CALPAK provides the computer with calibrations for:
^ Cold Start Cranking.
^ Limp home fuel (fuel backup mode).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Description and Operation > CALPAK > Page 3825
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Description and Operation EEPROM
CAUTION:
The EEPROM is soldered to the COMPUTER and cannot be serviced separately. Reprogramming
of EEPROM information is necessary when replacing a COMPUTER, or when changing the engine
and/or transaxle calibrations. Failure to do this will cause the vehicle to have a no start or poor
running condition.
It is essential that a replacement COMPUTER be reprogrammed with the correct VIN, option
content, tire size, and calibration information. Reprogramming of the EEPROM is only possible with
the Service Stall System (SSS) hardware available at authorized dealer locations. Check with a
dealer before performing COMPUTER replacement or EEPROM reprogramming.
DESCRIPTION:
The term EEPROM is defined as Electronically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
(EEPROM) in the COMPUTER. The EEPROM stores vehicle information such as engine and
transaxle calibrations, vehicle identification number, programmable vehicle option content and
MALF history. Vehicle information stored on the EEPROM has a major effect on how the vehicle
will operate.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Description and Operation > CALPAK > Page 3826
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Description and Operation EPROM
CAUTION:
The EPROM is serviceable in some applications and can be removed for replacement. If the
COMPUTER is found to be defective and needs replacement, remove the old EPROM if applicable
and place into the new computer. When replacing the COMPUTER always transfer the
BROADCAST CODE and PRODUCTION ECM/PCM NUMBER to the service label on the
replacement computer.
DESCRIPTION:
The term EPROM means Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EPROM). The EPROM
functions in the same manner as a regular PROM and is programmed with data pertaining to the
vehicles weight, engine, transmission, axle ratio etc. Automotive technicians do not ERASE or
PROGRAM the EPROM in the field. Instead, the EPROM is serviced in one of two manners. Some
applications are soldered to the circuit board and require both the computer and EPROM to be
replaced as a complete unit. Other applications allow for the EPROM only to replaced.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Description and Operation > CALPAK > Page 3827
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Description and Operation MEMCAL
CAUTION:
If the COMPUTER is found to be defective and needs replacement, remove the old MEMCAL and
place it into the replacement computer. When replacing the COMPUTER always transfer the
BROADCAST CODE and PRODUCTION ECM/PCM NUMBER to the service label on the
replacement computer.
DESCRIPTION:
The MEMCAL assembly contains both the functions of the PROM and the CALPAK. Like the
PROM, it contains the calibrations needed for a specific vehicle. It also is the fuel back up control
for the computer should it become damaged or faulty.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Description and Operation > CALPAK > Page 3828
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Description and Operation PROM
CAUTION:
If the computer is found to be defective and needs replacement, remove the old PROM and place it
into the replacement computer. Some ECM's are equipped with another chip called a CALPAK. If
the computer is equipped with a CALPAK chip, it will be located next to the PROM and must be
transferred along with the PROM. When replacing the computer always transfer the BROADCAST
CODE and PRODUCTION ECM/PCM NUMBER to the service label on the replacement computer.
DESCRIPTION:
To allow one type of computer to be used for many different vehicles, a device called a
Programable Read Only Memory (PROM) unit is used. The PROM is located inside the computer
and has system calibration information based upon the vehicle's axle ratio, engine, transmission,
weight, and other specific configurations of the vehicle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 3829
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Testing and Inspection
Some control modules may have problems due to cracked solder joints on the circuit board. These
internal control module problems can cause the following symptoms:
^ Failure to start or vehicle is stalling.
^ The "CHECK ENGINE" "SERVICE ENGINE SOON" or "MALFUNCTION INDICATOR" light will
flash or light up, but no trouble codes will be present.
^ Vehicle instrument panel displays may be inoperative.
^ The control module may or may not communicate with the scanner.
^ Other intermittent driveability problems.
Incorrect PROM or MEMCAL removal and replacement can create solder joint problems or
aggravate an existing condition. See PROM or MEMCAL INSTALLATION for proper procedures.
If a solder joint problem results in a "hard" failure, normal test procedures will usually pinpoint a
faulty control module. Many symptoms caused by poor solder joints in the control module result in
intermittent problems, but they may be hard to duplicate during troubleshooting. Control modules
with solder joint problems are sensitive to heat and vibration. You can check for these internal
control module problems in either, or both, of the following ways:
^ Remove the control module from its mounting bracket and extend it on the harness so that you
can expose it to the vehicle heater ducts. Alternatively, use the flexible duct to route air from the
heater to the control module location. Then run the engine and operate the heater at the "MAX
HEAT" position. This exposes the control module to approximately 140°F.
^ With the engine running, tap on the control module several times with your hand or finger tips to
simulate vehicle vibration.
If the engine stumbles or stalls, the "CHECK ENGINE" "SERVICE ENGINE SOON" or
"MALFUNCTION INDICATOR" light flashes, or any of the previous symptoms occur, the control
module may have bad solder joints on the circuit board.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Service and Repair > CALPAK
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Service and Repair CALPAK
1. Remove ECM from vehicle.
2. Remove ECM access cover.
3. Remove Calibration Pack (CALPAK) using removal tool shown. Grasp the CALPAK carrier on
the narrow ends only. Gently rock the carrier from
end to end while applying a firm upward force.
4. Inspect the reference end of the CALPAK carrier and carefully set aside. Do not remove the
CALPAK from the carrier to confirm CALPAK
correctness. The notch in the CALPAK is referenced to the small notch in the carrier. The small
notch of the carrier must be aligned with the small notch in the socket.
CAUTION: ANY TIME THE CALPAK IS INSTALLED BACKWARDS AND THE IGNITION SWITCH
IS TURNED ON, THE CALPAK IS DESTROYED.
5. Install the CALPACK by pressing on the CALPAK carrier until it is firmly seated in the socket. Do
not press on the CALPAK, only the carrier.
6. Install ECM access cover.
7. Install ECM and perform a DIAGNOSTIC CIRCUIT CHECK to confirm proper installation.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Service and Repair > CALPAK > Page 3832
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Service and Repair EEPROM
CAUTION:
The Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM) is a permanent memory that is
physically soldered to the circuit boards within the computer. It is not serviceable and should not be
removed for replacement. If COMPUTER replacement is performed, reprogramming of the
EEPROM will be necessary. Failure to do this will cause the vehicle to have a no start or poor
running condition. Reprogramming of the EEPROM is only possible with the Service Stall System
(SSS) hardware available at authorized dealer locations. Check with a dealer before performing
COMPUTER replacement or EEPROM reprogramming.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Service and Repair > CALPAK > Page 3833
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Service and Repair EPROM
REMOVAL:
^ DO NOT remove an EPROM from its packing material until you are ready to install it. DO NOT
hold an EPROM by its pins.
^ Before entering a vehicle to remove or replace an EPROM, touch an exposed metal part of the
vehicle to discharge any static charge from your body or use anti-static wrist straps. Avoid sliding
across upholstery or carpeting when removing or installing an EPROM. If this is not possible, touch
an exposed metal part of the vehicle with your free hand before removing or replacing an EPROM.
^ When available, use an antistatic grounding strap attached to your wrist and clipped to a metal
part of the vehicle body to prevent static charges from accumulating. Antistatic conductive
floormats are also available.
^ It may be desirable to remove the computer for EPROM replacement.
^ Remove computer access cover.
^ Unlock the locking levers by pressing outward toward the sides of the EPROM.
^ Remove EPROM from its socket
INSTALLATION:
EPROM/MEM-CAL Unit Installation
^ Install the replacement EPROM in the same direction.
^ VERY GENTLY PRESS down on the ends of the EPROM until the locking levers are rotated
toward the sides of the EPROM.
^ NOTE: To avoid Computer damage, do not press on the ends of the EPROM until the levers
snap into place. Do not use any vertical force beyond the minimum required to engage the EPROM
into its socket.
^ While continuing light pressure on the ends of the EPROM, use your index fingers to press the
locking levers inward until they are snapped into place. Listen for the click.
^ Install the access cover on the computer.
^ Perform FUNCTIONAL CHECK
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Service and Repair > CALPAK > Page 3834
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Service and Repair MEMCAL
CONDITION:
When installing a service replacement computer, the use of incorrect MEMCAL installation
procedures may cause the computer to fail before it can be installed in the vehicle. This condition
may appear as if the computer were defective when shipped to the dealership, when in fact it was
damaged while being installed. In addition this condition may also occur when installing an updated
MEMCAL into the vehicles original equipment computer.
CAUSE:
Excessive vertical force may be applied to the MEMCAL resulting in flexing of the circuit board and
damage to the connections between the circuit board and attached components. Excessive vertical
force may be generated in two ways.
^ Incorrect MEMCAL installation procedures.
^ Interference between MEMCAL and cover.
IMPORTANT CORRECTION:
This procedure supersedes any instructions regarding MEMCAL installation dated prior to
September 1990.
1. Inspect the MEMCAL to determine if a cork spacer is glued to the top side of the MEMCAL
assembly. If so, remove it prior to installation.
2. Align small notches with matching notches in Computer MEMCAL socket.
3. VERY GENTLY PRESS down on the ends of the MEMCAL until the locking levers are rotated
toward the sides of the MEMCAL.
NOTE: To avoid computer damage, do not press on the ends of the MEMCAL until the levers snap
into place. Do not use any vertical force beyond the minimum required to engage the MEMCAL into
its socket.
4. While continuing light pressure on the ends of the MEMCAL, use your index fingers to press the
locking levers inward until they are snapped into
place. Listen for the click.
5. Install MEMCAL cover and install computer cover.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Powertrain Management > PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory > Component
Information > Service and Repair > CALPAK > Page 3835
PROM - Programmable Read Only Memory: Service and Repair PROM
1. Remove ECM from vehicle.
2. Remove ECM access cover.
PROM Removal
3. Remove PROM using the rocker-type PROM removal tool shown. Engage one end of the PROM
carrier with the hook end of the tool. Press on
the vertical bar end of the tool and rock the engaged end of the PROM carrier up as far as
possible. Engage the opposite end of the PROM carrier in the same manner and rock this end up
as far as possible. Repeat this process until the PROM carrier and PROM are free of the PROM
socket. The PROM carrier with the PROM in it should lift off of the PROM socket easily.
4. Inspect the reference end of the PROM carrier and carefully set aside. Do not remove the PROM
from the carrier to confirm PROM correctness.
The notch in the PROM is referenced to the small notch in the carrier. The small notch of the
carrier must be aligned with the small notch in the socket.
CAUTION: ANY TIME THE PROM IS INSTALLED BACKWARDS AND THE IGNITION SWITCH IS
TURNED ON, THE PROM IS DESTROYED.
5. Install PROM by pressing on the PROM carrier until it is firmly seated in the socket. Do not press
on the PROM, only the carrier.
6. Install ECM access cover.
7. Install ECM and perform a DIAGNOSTIC CIRCUIT CHECK to confirm proper installation.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations >
Page 3843
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Connector Locations
Behind LH Side Of I/P
LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Shift Solenoid: Specifications
Intermediate Servo Cover ....................................................................................................................
................................................................... 8 Ft. Lbs. Solenoid To Valve Body ..................................
....................................................................................................................................................... 8
Ft. Lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 3851
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3852
Harness Connector Faces: Automatic Transaxle (Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3853
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Description and Operation
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid
PURPOSE:
The Transmission Converter Clutch (TCC) feature eliminates the power loss of the torque
converter stage when the vehicle is in a cruise mode.
OPERATION:
The TCC system uses a solenoid operated valve in the automatic transmission to couple the
engine flexplate to the output shaft of the transaxle through the torque converter. This reduces the
slippage losses in the converter, which increases fuel economy. For the converter clutch to apply,
at least two conditions must be met.
1. Internal transmission fluid pressure must be correct.
2. The ECM/PCM completes a ground circuit to energize the TCC solenoid in the transmission,
which moves a check ball in the fluid line.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Solenoid
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Service and Repair Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Solenoid
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH (TCC) SOLENOID & SWITCHES
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid & Switches
Auxiliary Valve Body, Valve Body And Oil Pump Assembly
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Solenoid > Page 3856
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Valve body cover. Refer to "Valve Body Cover". 2. Wiring harness from case electrical connector
and leads from pressure switch. 3. Torque converter clutch solenoid bolt to auxiliary valve body. 4.
3rd clutch pressure switch. 5. Second clutch switch, if applicable.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Second clutch switch, if applicable.
TIGHTEN
^ Switch to 11 Nm (97 lbs. in.).
2. 3rd clutch pressure switch.
TIGHTEN
^ Switch to 11 Nm (97 lbs. in.).
3. Torque converter clutch solenoid bolt to auxiliary valve body. Install new O-ring. 4. Wire harness
to case and switches. 5. Valve body cover with a new gasket.
ADJUST
^ Fluid level.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Solenoid > Page 3857
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Service and Repair Valve Body Cover
VALVE BODY COVER
Side Cover And Control Valve View
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Raise vehicle and suitably support. 2. Drain oil. 3. Left front tire and wheel assembly. 4. Left
splash shield. 5. Valve body cover to transaxle bolts.
INSPECT
^ Bolts
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Valve body cover with a new gasket and bolts.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Solenoid > Page 3858
Valve Body Cover
NOTE: It is necessary to use GM thread locker (P/N 12345382) or equivalent non-locking sealant
to reduce the potential for fluid leaks on the indicated bolts.
2. Left splash shield. 3. Left front tire and wheel assembly. 4. Lower vehicle.
ADJUST:
^ Oil level.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3865
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Connector Locations
Behind LH Side Of I/P
LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Shift Solenoid: Specifications
Intermediate Servo Cover ....................................................................................................................
................................................................... 8 Ft. Lbs. Solenoid To Valve Body ..................................
....................................................................................................................................................... 8
Ft. Lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations >
Page 3873
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3874
Harness Connector Faces: Automatic Transaxle (Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3875
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Description and Operation
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid
PURPOSE:
The Transmission Converter Clutch (TCC) feature eliminates the power loss of the torque
converter stage when the vehicle is in a cruise mode.
OPERATION:
The TCC system uses a solenoid operated valve in the automatic transmission to couple the
engine flexplate to the output shaft of the transaxle through the torque converter. This reduces the
slippage losses in the converter, which increases fuel economy. For the converter clutch to apply,
at least two conditions must be met.
1. Internal transmission fluid pressure must be correct.
2. The ECM/PCM completes a ground circuit to energize the TCC solenoid in the transmission,
which moves a check ball in the fluid line.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Torque
Converter Clutch (TCC) Solenoid
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Service and Repair Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Solenoid
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH (TCC) SOLENOID & SWITCHES
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid & Switches
Auxiliary Valve Body, Valve Body And Oil Pump Assembly
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Torque
Converter Clutch (TCC) Solenoid > Page 3878
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Valve body cover. Refer to "Valve Body Cover". 2. Wiring harness from case electrical connector
and leads from pressure switch. 3. Torque converter clutch solenoid bolt to auxiliary valve body. 4.
3rd clutch pressure switch. 5. Second clutch switch, if applicable.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Second clutch switch, if applicable.
TIGHTEN
^ Switch to 11 Nm (97 lbs. in.).
2. 3rd clutch pressure switch.
TIGHTEN
^ Switch to 11 Nm (97 lbs. in.).
3. Torque converter clutch solenoid bolt to auxiliary valve body. Install new O-ring. 4. Wire harness
to case and switches. 5. Valve body cover with a new gasket.
ADJUST
^ Fluid level.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Torque
Converter Clutch (TCC) Solenoid > Page 3879
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Service and Repair Valve Body Cover
VALVE BODY COVER
Side Cover And Control Valve View
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Raise vehicle and suitably support. 2. Drain oil. 3. Left front tire and wheel assembly. 4. Left
splash shield. 5. Valve body cover to transaxle bolts.
INSPECT
^ Bolts
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Valve body cover with a new gasket and bolts.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Actuators and
Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Torque
Converter Clutch (TCC) Solenoid > Page 3880
Valve Body Cover
NOTE: It is necessary to use GM thread locker (P/N 12345382) or equivalent non-locking sealant
to reduce the potential for fluid leaks on the indicated bolts.
2. Left splash shield. 3. Left front tire and wheel assembly. 4. Lower vehicle.
ADJUST:
^ Oil level.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Band, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Revised Intermediate Band Friction Material
Band: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Revised Intermediate Band Friction Material
Group Ref.: 7 - Transmission
Bulletin No.: 477122
Date: June, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: REVISED INTERMEDIATE BAND FRICTION MATERIAL
MODELS: 1994 BUICK CENTURY AND SKYLARK 1994 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA,
BERETTA AND LUMINA MINIVAN 1994 OLDSMOBILE CUTLASS CIERA, ACHIEVA AND
SILHOUETTE 1994 PONTIAC SUNBIRD, GRAND AM AND TRANS SPORT
TRANSAXLE APPLICATIONS: HYDRA-MATIC 3T40 (RPO MD9)
TRANSAXLE MODELS: ALL 1994 3T40 MODELS
A revised Intermediate Band was introduced at the start of 1994 model year production. The
Intermediate Band friction material was changed from a brown material to a gray/black material.
This change was made to enhance durability.
When servicing a 1994 Hydra-Matic 3T40 transaxle, do NOT assume that the Intermediate Band is
burned/damaged due to its dark color. This dark color is normal. Inspect the Intermediate Band for
scoring, chunking or heavily worn friction material.
Inspect the Direct Clutch Housing and Drum Assembly for scoring or signs of excessive heat. The
Intermediate Band and/or Direct Clutch Housing and Drum Assembly should be replaced ONLY if
the above listed damage is found.
This revised Intermediate Band will service all past model Hydra-Matic 3T40 transaxles and will
supersede the previous Intermediate Band when service stock is depleted.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Band Apply Servo, A/T
> Component Information > Service and Repair
Band Apply Servo: Service and Repair
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Remove transaxle oil pan and gasket, then remove screen and
O-ring. 3. Remove reverse oil pipe retaining brackets, intermediate servo cover and gasket. 4.
Remove accumulator valve and spring. 5. Remove intermediate servo assembly. 6. Reverse
procedure to install.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Bell Housing, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Bell Housing: Specifications
Converter Shield ..................................................................................................................................
............................................................... 97 Inch Lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Brake Switch - TCC: Component Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3895
Brake Switch - TCC: Connector Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Brake Switch - TCC >
Component Information > Locations > Page 3896
Harness Connector Faces: Brake Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Case, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Case: Service and Repair
TRANSAXLE SIDE CASE COVER
1. Remove valve body cover and gasket as described under Valve Body. See: Valve Body/Service
and Repair 2. Loosen lefthand side drive axle nut one turn. 3. Remove left side brake caliper and
rotor. 4. Remove drive axle shaft nut and washer. 5. Loosen hub/bearing to knuckle attaching bolts
6. Using front hub spindle remover tool No. J-28733-A or equivalent, push axle splines back out of
hub bearing. 7. Remove hub/bearing to knuckle attaching bolts. Protect axle seals from damage
during handling. 8. Remove ABS sensor mounting bolt and position aside to prevent damage. 9.
Remove hub/bearing assembly.
10. Using axle shaft remover tool No. J-33008 and slide hammer tool No. J-2619-01 or equivalents,
remove left side axle shaft from transaxle. 11. Disconnect TCC wires from case connector. 12.
Remove auxiliary valve body and control valve assembly. Do not lose check balls. 13. Remove oil
pump drive shaft. 14. Remove shifter bracket bolts and position bracket aside. 15. Remove manual
valve linkage, spacer plate and gaskets. 16. Remove side case cover attaching bolts and manual
valve. 17. Check drive link as follows:
a. Midway between sprockets, and at right angles to drive link, push bottom strand of the drive link
until all slack is removed and mark case with
a pencil on bottom side of drive link.
b. Push bottom strand up in the same manner and put a second mark on the case, ensure both
marks are made at the same point on the chain. c. Measure distance between two marks. d. If
distance exceeds 7/8 inch, replace drive link.
18. Reverse procedure to install. Using a new drive axle nut and tighten to specification.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Channel Plate, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T Control - DTC P0756 Diagnostic Tips
Channel Plate: Technical Service Bulletins A/T Control - DTC P0756 Diagnostic Tips
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-036H
Date: January 29, 2009
Subject: Diagnostic Tips for Automatic Transmission DTC P0756, Second, Third, Fourth Gear Start
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
with 4L60-E, 4L65-E or 4L70E Automatic Transmission (RPOs M30, M32 or M70)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2009 model year and add details regarding spacer plates.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 01-07-30-036G (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Some dealership technicians may have difficulty diagnosing DTC P0756, 2-3 Shift Valve
Performance on 4L60-E, 4L65-E or 4L70E automatic transmissions. As detailed in the Service
Manual, when the PCM detects a 4-3-3-4 shift pattern, DTC P0756 will set. Some customers may
also describe a condition of a second, third or fourth gear start that may have the same causes but
has not set this DTC yet. Below are some tips when diagnosing this DTC:
^ This is a performance code. This means that a mechanical malfunction exists.
^ This code is not set by electrical issues such as a damaged wiring harness or poor electrical
connections. Electrical problems would cause a DTC P0758, P0787 or P0788 to set.
^ The most likely cause is chips/debris plugging the filtered AFL oil at orifice # 29 on the top of the
spacer plate (48). This is a very small hole and is easily plugged by a small amount of debris. It is
important to remove the spacer plate and inspect orifice # 29 and the immediate area for the
presence of chips/debris. Also, the transmission case passage directly above this orifice and the
valve body passage directly below should be inspected and cleaned of any chips/debris. For 2003
and newer vehicles the spacer plate should be replaced. The service replacement spacer plate is a
bonded style with gaskets and solenoid filter screens bonded to the spacer plate. These screens
can help to prevent plugging of orifice # 29 caused by small debris or chips.
^ This code could be set if the 2-3 shift valve (368) were stuck or hung-up in its bore. Inspect the
2-3 shift valve (368) and the 2-3 shuttle valve (369) for free movement or damage and clean the
valves, the bore and the valve body passages.
^ This code could be set by a 2-3 shift solenoid (367b) if it were cracked, broken or leaking. Refer
to Shift Solenoid Leak Test in the appropriate Service Manual for the leak test procedure. Based on
parts return findings, a damaged or leaking shift solenoid is the least likely cause of this condition.
Simply replacing a shift solenoid will not correct this condition unless the solenoid has been found
to be cracked, broken or leaking.
It is important to also refer to the appropriate Service Manual or Service Information (SI) for further
possible causes of this condition.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Clutch: > 08-07-30-027 > Jun > 08 > A/T - No
Movement in Drive or 3rd Gear
Clutch: Customer Interest A/T - No Movement in Drive or 3rd Gear
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 08-07-30-027
Date: June 04, 2008
Subject: No Movement When Transmission is Shifted to Drive or Third - Normal Operation When
Shifted to Second, First or Reverse (Replace Forward Sprag Assembly)
Models: 1982 - 2005 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2006 - 2007 Buick Rainier 2006
Cadillac Escalade, Escalade ESV, Escalade EXT 2006 Chevrolet SSR 2006 - 2008 Chevrolet
Avalanche, Colorado, Express, Silverado Classic, Silverado, Suburban, Tahoe, TrailBlazer 2006
GMC Yukon Denali, Yukon Denali XL 2006 - 2008 GMC Canyon, Envoy, Savana, Sierra Classic,
Sierra, Yukon, Yukon XL 2006 Pontiac GTO 2006 - 2007 HUMMER H2 2006 - 2008 HUMMER H3
2006 - 2008 Saab 9-7X
with 4L60, 4L60E, 4L65E or 4L70E Automatic Transmission (RPOs MD8, M30, M32, M33 or M70)
Condition
Some customers may comment that the vehicle has no movement when the transmission is shifted
to DRIVE or THIRD position, but there is normal operation when it is shifted to SECOND, FIRST or
REVERSE position.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a damaged forward sprag assembly (642).
Correction
When inspecting the sprag, it is important to test the sprag for proper operation by holding the outer
race (644) with one hand while rotating the input sun gear (640) with the other hand. The sun gear
should rotate only in the counterclockwise direction with the input sun gear facing upward. If the
sprag rotates in both directions or will not rotate in either direction, the sprag elements should be
inspected by removing one of the sprag assembly retaining rings (643). Refer to SI Unit Repair
section for forward clutch sprag disassembly procedures.
If the sprag is found to be damaged, make repairs to the transmission as necessary. A new forward
roller clutch sprag assembly is now available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Clutch: > 08-07-30-027 > Jun > 08 > A/T - No
Movement in Drive or 3rd Gear > Page 3912
If clutch debris is found, it is also very important to inspect the Pressure Control (PC) solenoid
valve (377) fluid screens. Clean or replace the PC solenoid (377) as necessary. It is also important
to flush and flow check the transmission oil cooler using J45096. Refer to SI Automatic
Transmission Oil Cooler Flushing and Flow Test for the procedure.
The notches above each sprag must point up as shown when assembled into the outer race.
Bearing Assembly, Input Sun Gear
Snap Ring, Overrun Clutch Hub Retaining
Hub, Overrun Clutch
Wear Plate, Sprag Assembly
Retainer and Race Assembly, Sprag
Forward Sprag Assembly
Retainer Rings, Sprag Assembly
Outer Race, Forward Clutch
Washer, Thrust (Input Carrier to Race)
The following information applies when this sprag is used in 1982-86 transmissions.
The new design sprag can be used on models 1982 through 1986, by replacing the entire
assembly (637 - 644). Individual components are NOT
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Clutch: > 08-07-30-027 > Jun > 08 > A/T - No
Movement in Drive or 3rd Gear > Page 3913
interchangeable.
Important:
The wear plate (640) and input thrust washer (660) are not required with the new sprag. Use of the
thrust washer and wear plate with the new sprag assembly will cause a misbuild (correct end play
cannot be obtained).
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 08-07-30-027 > Jun >
08 > A/T - No Movement in Drive or 3rd Gear
Clutch: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - No Movement in Drive or 3rd Gear
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 08-07-30-027
Date: June 04, 2008
Subject: No Movement When Transmission is Shifted to Drive or Third - Normal Operation When
Shifted to Second, First or Reverse (Replace Forward Sprag Assembly)
Models: 1982 - 2005 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2006 - 2007 Buick Rainier 2006
Cadillac Escalade, Escalade ESV, Escalade EXT 2006 Chevrolet SSR 2006 - 2008 Chevrolet
Avalanche, Colorado, Express, Silverado Classic, Silverado, Suburban, Tahoe, TrailBlazer 2006
GMC Yukon Denali, Yukon Denali XL 2006 - 2008 GMC Canyon, Envoy, Savana, Sierra Classic,
Sierra, Yukon, Yukon XL 2006 Pontiac GTO 2006 - 2007 HUMMER H2 2006 - 2008 HUMMER H3
2006 - 2008 Saab 9-7X
with 4L60, 4L60E, 4L65E or 4L70E Automatic Transmission (RPOs MD8, M30, M32, M33 or M70)
Condition
Some customers may comment that the vehicle has no movement when the transmission is shifted
to DRIVE or THIRD position, but there is normal operation when it is shifted to SECOND, FIRST or
REVERSE position.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a damaged forward sprag assembly (642).
Correction
When inspecting the sprag, it is important to test the sprag for proper operation by holding the outer
race (644) with one hand while rotating the input sun gear (640) with the other hand. The sun gear
should rotate only in the counterclockwise direction with the input sun gear facing upward. If the
sprag rotates in both directions or will not rotate in either direction, the sprag elements should be
inspected by removing one of the sprag assembly retaining rings (643). Refer to SI Unit Repair
section for forward clutch sprag disassembly procedures.
If the sprag is found to be damaged, make repairs to the transmission as necessary. A new forward
roller clutch sprag assembly is now available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 08-07-30-027 > Jun >
08 > A/T - No Movement in Drive or 3rd Gear > Page 3919
If clutch debris is found, it is also very important to inspect the Pressure Control (PC) solenoid
valve (377) fluid screens. Clean or replace the PC solenoid (377) as necessary. It is also important
to flush and flow check the transmission oil cooler using J45096. Refer to SI Automatic
Transmission Oil Cooler Flushing and Flow Test for the procedure.
The notches above each sprag must point up as shown when assembled into the outer race.
Bearing Assembly, Input Sun Gear
Snap Ring, Overrun Clutch Hub Retaining
Hub, Overrun Clutch
Wear Plate, Sprag Assembly
Retainer and Race Assembly, Sprag
Forward Sprag Assembly
Retainer Rings, Sprag Assembly
Outer Race, Forward Clutch
Washer, Thrust (Input Carrier to Race)
The following information applies when this sprag is used in 1982-86 transmissions.
The new design sprag can be used on models 1982 through 1986, by replacing the entire
assembly (637 - 644). Individual components are NOT
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Clutch, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Clutch: > 08-07-30-027 > Jun >
08 > A/T - No Movement in Drive or 3rd Gear > Page 3920
interchangeable.
Important:
The wear plate (640) and input thrust washer (660) are not required with the new sprag. Use of the
thrust washer and wear plate with the new sprag assembly will cause a misbuild (correct end play
cannot be obtained).
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Automatic
Transmission Dipstick - Dipstick Tube > Component Information > Specifications
Automatic Transmission Dipstick - Dipstick Tube: Specifications
Fill Tube Bolt ........................................................................................................................................
................................................................ 31 Ft. Lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-037E
Date: April 07, 2011
Subject: Release of DEXRON(R)-VI Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF)
Models:
2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003-2008 HUMMER H2 2006-2008
HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saturn Relay 2005 and Prior Saturn L-Series 2005-2007 Saturn ION
2005-2008 Saturn VUE with 4T45-E 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X Except 2008 and Prior Chevrolet Aveo,
Equinox Except 2006 and Prior Chevrolet Epica Except 2007 and Prior Chevrolet Optra Except
2008 and Prior Pontiac Torrent, Vibe, Wave Except 2003-2005 Saturn ION with CVT or AF23 Only
Except 1991-2002 Saturn S-Series Except 2008 and Prior Saturn VUE with CVT, AF33 or 5AT
(MJ7/MJ8) Transmission Only Except 2008 Saturn Astra
Attention:
DEXRON(R)-VI Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF) is the only approved fluid for warranty repairs
for General Motors transmissions/transaxles requiring DEXRON(R)-III and/or prior DEXRON(R)
transmission fluids.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-037D (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
MANUAL TRANSMISSIONS / TRANSFER CASES and POWER STEERING
The content of this bulletin does not apply to manual transmissions or transfer cases. Any vehicle
that previously required DEXRON(R)-III for a manual transmission or transfer case should now use
P/N 88861800. This fluid is labeled Manual Transmission and Transfer Case Fluid. Some manual
transmissions and transfer cases require a different fluid. Appropriate references should be
checked when servicing any of these components.
Power Steering Systems should now use P/N 9985010 labeled Power Steering Fluid.
Consult the Parts Catalog, Owner's Manual, or Service Information (SI) for fluid recommendations.
Some of our customers and/or General Motors dealerships/Saturn Retailers may have some
concerns with DEXRON(R)-VI and DEXRON(R)-III Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF) and
transmission warranty claims. DEXRON(R)-VI is the only approved fluid for warranty repairs for
General Motors transmissions/transaxles requiring DEXRON(R)-III and/or prior DEXRON(R)
transmission fluids (except as noted above). Please remember that the clean oil reservoirs of the
J-45096 - Flushing and Flow Tester machine should be purged of DEXRON(R)-III and filled with
DEXRON(R)-VI for testing, flushing or filling General Motors transmissions/transaxles (except as
noted above).
DEXRON(R)-VI can be used in any proportion in past model vehicles equipped with an automatic
transmission/transaxle in place of DEXRON(R)-III (i.e. topping off the fluid in the event of a repair
or fluid change). DEXRON(R)-VI is also compatible with any former version of DEXRON(R) for use
in automatic transmissions/transaxles.
DEXRON(R)-VI ATF
General Motors Powertrain has upgraded to DEXRON(R)-VI ATF with the start of 2006 vehicle
production.
Current and prior automatic transmission models that had used DEXRON(R)-III must now only use
DEXRON(R)-VI.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 3928
All 2006 and future model transmissions that use DEXRON(R)-VI are to be serviced ONLY with
DEXRON(R)-VI fluid.
DEXRON(R)-VI is an improvement over DEXRON(R)-III in the following areas:
* These ATF change intervals remain the same as DEXRON(R)-III for the time being.
2006-2008 Transmission Fill and Cooler Flushing
Some new applications of the 6L80 six speed transmission will require the use of the J 45096 Flushing and Flow Tester to accomplish transmission fluid fill. The clean oil reservoir of the
machine should be purged of DEXRON(R)-III and filled with DEXRON(R)-VI.
Parts Information
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 3929
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Water Or Coolant Contamination Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-07-30-035B
Date: November 01, 2010
Subject: Information on Water or Ethylene Glycol in Transmission Fluid
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks with Automatic Transmission
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-07-30-035A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Water or ethylene glycol in automatic transmission fluid (ATF) is harmful to internal transmission
components and will have a negative effect on reliability and durability of these parts. Water or
ethylene glycol in ATF will also change the friction of the clutches, frequently resulting in shudder
during engagement or gear changes, especially during torque converter clutch engagement.
Indications of water in the ATF may include:
- ATF blowing out of the transmission vent tube.
- ATF may appear cloudy or, in cases of extreme contamination, have the appearance of a
strawberry milkshake.
- Visible water in the oil pan.
- A milky white substance inside the pan area.
- Spacer plate gaskets that appear to be glued to the valve body face or case.
- Spacer plate gaskets that appear to be swollen or wrinkled in areas where they are not
compressed.
- Rust on internal transmission iron/steel components.
If water in the ATF has been found and the source of the water entry has not been identified, or if a
leaking in-radiator transmission oil cooler is suspected (with no evidence of cross-contamination in
the coolant recovery reservoir), a simple and quick test kit is available that detects the presence of
ethylene glycol in ATF. The "Gly-Tek" test kit, available from the Nelco Company, should be
obtained and the ATF tested to make an accurate decision on the need for radiator replacement.
This can help to prevent customer comebacks if the in-radiator transmission oil cooler is leaking
and reduce repair expenses by avoiding radiator replacement if the cooler is not leaking. These
test kits can be obtained from:
Nelco Company
Test kits can be ordered by phone or through the website listed above. Orders are shipped
standard delivery time but can be shipped on a next day delivery basis for an extra charge. One
test kit will complete 10 individual fluid sample tests. For vehicles repaired under warranty, the cost
of the complete test kit plus shipping charges should be divided by 10 and submitted on the
warranty claim as a net item.
The transmission should be repaired or replaced based on the normal cost comparison procedure.
Important If water or coolant is found in the transmission, the following components MUST be
replaced.
- Replace all of the rubber-type seals.
- Replace all of the composition-faced clutch plates and/or bands.
- Replace all of the nylon parts.
- Replace the torque converter.
- Thoroughly clean and rebuild the transmission, using new gaskets and oil filter.
Important The following steps must be completed when repairing or replacing.
Flush and flow check the transmission oil cooler using J 45096. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
02-07-30-052F- Automatic Transmission Oil Cooler Flush and Flow Test Essential Tool J 45096
TransFlow.
- Thoroughly inspect the engine cooling system and hoses and clean/repair as necessary.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 3930
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 3931
Fluid - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - DEXRON III Fluid Introduction
File In Section: 0 - General Information
Bulletin No.: 57-02-01
Date: March, 1995
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
Subject: Section 0 - General Information - DEXRON(R)-III Transmission Fluid Introduction
Models: 1995 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
General Motors has phased in a new automatic transmission fluid, DEXRON(R)-III, that does not
need replacing under normal service. DEXRON(R)-III is designed to help the transmission deliver
the best possible performance under all conditions. Refer to Figure 1.
The improvements in DEXRON(R)-III include better friction stability, more high temperature
oxidation stability and better material compatibility. DEXRON(R)-III has the same low temperature
fluidity as DEXRON(R)-IIE, for better transmission performance in cold weather.
DEXRON(R)-IIE and DEXRON(R)-III are fully compatible.
DEXRON(R)-III is fully compatible with any General Motors passenger vehicle or light truck with
automatic transmission and built since 1949.
Dealers should require their supplier to include the DEXRON(R)-III license number on all automatic
transmission fluid invoices.
Starting February 1, 1994 DEXRON(R)-III was phased into all North American assembly plants.
DEXRON(R)-III fluid is available from GMSPO (see fluid numbers below):
U.S.
1 Quart 12346143
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - DEXRON(R)-VI Fluid Information > Page 3932
1 Gallon 12346144
55 Gallon 12346145
In Canada
1 Liter 10952622
4 Liter 10952623
200 Liter 10952624
The 1995 Automatic Transmission/Transaxle fluid change intervals are the following:
(1994 and prior should use the schedules as written in the Owner's Manual.)
If the vehicle is mainly driven under one or more of these conditions:
In heavy city traffic where the outside temperature regularly reaches 90°F (32°C) or higher.
In hilly or mountainous terrain.
When doing frequent trailer towing.
Uses such as found in taxi, police car or delivery service.
Change the fluid and filter every 50,000 miles (63,000 km).
If the vehicle is not used mainly under any of these conditions, the fluid and filter do not require
periodic changing for vehicles under 8,600 GVWR.
Vehicles over 8,600 GVWR change the fluid and filter every 50,000 miles (83,000 km) regardless
of driving conditions.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - A/T: Capacity Specifications
CAPACITIES .......................................................................................................................................
................................................................ QUARTS
Pan Capacity .......................................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 4.0 Total (Overhaul) Capacity Without Torque
Converter .............................................................................................................................................
................................................. 7.0 With Torque Converter ................................................................
................................................................................................................................... 9.0
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 3935
Fluid - A/T: Fluid Type Specifications
Fluid Type ............................................................................................................................................
................................................................ Dexron IIE
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3936
Fluid - A/T: Service and Repair
NOTE: Use only Dexron IIE automatic transmission fluid
To check fluid, drive vehicle for at least 15 minutes to bring fluid to operating temperature (200°F).
With vehicle on a level surface and engine idling in Park and parking brake applied, the level on the
dipstick should be at the ``Full'' mark. To bring the fluid level from the ADD mark to the FULL mark
requires one pint of fluid. If vehicle cannot be driven sufficiently to bring fluid to operating
temperature, the level on the dipstick should be between the two dimples on the dipstick with fluid
temperature at 70°F. Note that the two dimples are located above the FULL mark. If additional fluid
is required, use only Dexron II automatic transmission fluid. An early change to a darker color from
the usual red color and or a strong odor that is usually associated with overheated fluid is normal
and should not be considered as a positive sign of required maintenance or unit failure. When
adding fluid, do not overfill, as foaming and loss of fluid through the vent may occur as the fluid
heats up. Also, if fluid level is too low, complete loss of drive may occur especially when cold,
which can cause transmission failure. Every 100,000 miles, the oil should be drained, the oil pan
removed, the screen cleaned and fresh fluid added. For vehicles subjected to more severe use
such as heavy city traffic especially in hot weather, prolonged periods of idling or towing, this
maintenance should be performed every 15,000 miles.
1. Raise and support vehicle, then position drain pan under oil pan.
2. Remove front and side oil pan attaching bolts, then loosen rear pan attaching bolts.
3. Carefully pry oil pan loose from transaxle case and allow fluid to drain.
4. Remove remaining attaching bolt, oil pan and gasket. Thoroughly clean pan before reinstalling.
5. Remove and discard screen and O-ring seal.
6. Install replacement screen and O-ring seal, locating screen against dipstick stop.
7. Install gasket on oil pan, then install pan and torque attaching bolts to 8 ft. lbs.
8. Lower vehicle and add approximately 4 qts. of fluid.
9. With selector in park, parking brake applied and engine at idle speed and operating temperature,
check fluid level and add fluid as necessary. Do
not race engine. Move shift lever through ranges, then back to ``Park'' position.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Filter - A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Transaxle Oil Filter Differences
Fluid Filter - A/T: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Transaxle Oil Filter Differences
GROUP REF.: Transmission
BULLETIN NO.: 477103
DATE: March, 1994
SUBJECT: TRANSAXLE OIL FILTER DIFFERENCES
MODELS: 1985-94 PASSENGER CARS AND U VANS WITH 4T60 OR 4T60-E TRANSAXLES
TRANSAXLE APPLICATIONS: HYDRA-MATIC 4T60 (RPO ME9) HYDRA-MATIC 4T60-E (RPO
M13)
TRANSAXLE MODELS: ALL
At the start of the 1993 model year, 4T6O transaxle oil filters were revised in appearance. This
revision made the 4T60 transaxle oil filter similar in appearance to the 4T60-E transaxle oil filter.
Current and previous design 4T6O transaxle oil filters can be used on any 4T6O transaxle. 4T60
and 4T60-E transaxle oil filters are NOT interchangeable. Refer to the current GMSPO catalog for
4T60 and 4T60-E transaxle oil filter part numbers.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Line/Hose, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Line/Hose: Specifications
Auxiliary Oil Cooler Bolts .....................................................................................................................
................................................................ 12 in. lbs. Oil Cooler Line To Radiator ................................
................................................................................................................................................. 23 Ft.
Lbs. Oil Cooler Line To Transaxle Case ..............................................................................................
........................................................................ 16 Ft. Lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pan, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Pan: Specifications
Oil Pan & Valve Body Cover ................................................................................................................
........................................................... 133 Inch Lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pressure
Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Specifications
Pressure Switch ...................................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 8 Ft. Lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid Pump, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Pump: Specifications
Pump Cover To Case Cover (6mm) ....................................................................................................
.................................................................... 8 Ft. Lbs. Pump Cover To Case Cover (8mm) ...............
....................................................................................................................................................... 18
Ft. Lbs. Pump Cover To Valve Body ...................................................................................................
................................................................................ 8 Ft. Lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Governor, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Governor: Specifications
Governor Cover To Case ....................................................................................................................
............................................................. 133 Inch Lbs. Speedometer Driven Gear To Governor
Cover ..................................................................................................................................................
75 Inch Lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Governor, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 3956
Governor: Service and Repair
Fig. 11 Governor Assembly
REPLACE
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Remove engine to transaxle brace attaching bolts, then the heat
shield if equipped. 3. Remove speedometer cable or wire connector from transaxle. 4. Remove
speedometer driven gear and sleeve assembly or speed sensor if equipped. 5. Remove governor
cover and O-ring. 6. Remove speedometer drive gear thrust washer and gear, then the governor
assembly, Fig. 11. 7. Reverse procedure to install.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Description and Operation
Shift Indicator: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
This lamp is used on most models equipped with manual transmission.
OPERATION
The Upshift lamp is illuminated to inform the driver of ideal shift points, with improved fuel economy
as the specific objective. When the light is illuminated, the transmission should be shifted to the
next highest gear, if driving conditions permit such an action.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Lamps and Indicators A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 3961
Shift Indicator: Service and Repair
If upshift indicator is not working properly, perform the following test. 1. Disconnect ECM connector
C1. 2. Place ignition switch in run. 3. Measure voltage at terminal A2 of ECM connector. 4. If
battery voltage is present, further ECM diagnosis is necessary. 5. If battery voltage is not present,
repair open circuit in brown/black wire, circuit 456.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Output Shaft, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - 2-3 Upshift or 3-2 Downshift Clunk Noise
Output Shaft: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 2-3 Upshift or 3-2 Downshift Clunk Noise
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-042F
Date: February 05, 2010
Subject: Information on 2-3 Upshift or 3-2 Downshift Clunk Noise
Models:
2010 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3
2005-2009 Saab 9-7X with 4L60-E, 4L65-E or 4L70-E Automatic Transmission (RPOs M30, M32,
M70)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2010 model year and 4L70E transmission.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 01-07-30-042E (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Important For 2005 model year fullsize utilities and pickups, refer to Corporate Bulletin
05-07-30-012.
Some vehicles may exhibit a clunk noise that can be heard on a 2-3 upshift or a 3-2 downshift.
During a 2-3 upshift, the 2-4 band is released and the 3-4 clutch is applied. The timing of this shift
can cause a momentary torque reversal of the output shaft that results in a clunk noise. This same
torque reversal can also occur on a 3-2 downshift when the 3-4 clutch is released and the 2-4 band
applied. This condition may be worse on a 4-wheel drive vehicle due to the additional tolerances in
the transfer case.
This is a normal condition. No repairs should be attempted.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Parking Pawl, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Grinding/Growling Noise in Park on Incline
Parking Pawl: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Grinding/Growling Noise in Park on Incline
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 99-07-30-030F
Date: May 01, 2008
Subject: Grinding and/or Growling Noise in Park on Incline
Models: 2009 and Prior Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn)
with Hydra-Matic Front Wheel Drive (FWD) Automatic Transmissions
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
99-07-30-030E (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Service Information
Owners of some vehicles equipped with Hydra-Matic front wheel drive transaxles may comment on
a grinding and/or growling noise that is noticeable when standing in PARK on a hill or slope with
the engine running and the parking brake not applied. Under these conditions, the weight of the
vehicle puts a load on the parking pawl which can create a "ground-out" path through the drive
axles, front struts, springs and spring towers. Normal engine noise can be transmitted to the
passenger compartment through the "ground-out" path.
Owners concerned about this condition should be advised to apply the parking brake prior to
shifting into PARK. This is the recommended procedure described in the Owners Manual. Applying
the parking brake first will put the load of the vehicle on the rear brakes rather than on the parking
pawl.
Refer the owner to the appropriate Owner Manual for additional details and instructions.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Parking Pawl, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 3970
Parking Pawl: Service and Repair
REPLACE
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Remove transaxle oil pan. 3. Remove oil strainer and filter seal. 4.
Remove fluid level indicator stop. 5. Remove rod retainer and parking lock bracket. 6. Remove clip,
pin, rod and spring. 7. Reverse procedure to install.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Brake Switch - TCC: Component Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 3976
Brake Switch - TCC: Connector Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations > Page 3977
Harness Connector Faces: Brake Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Specifications
Pressure Switch ...................................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 8 Ft. Lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
3985
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3986
Harness Connector Faces: Park/Neutral Position Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3987
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Park/Neutral Switch (Auto. Trans)
PURPOSE:
The PARK/NEUTRAL (P/N) switch indicates to the computer when the transmission is in PARK or
NEUTRAL. This information is used by the ECM for Idle Air Control (IAC), Torque Converter Clutch
(TCC) and Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) operation.
OPERATION:
The P/N switch contacts are a part of the neutral switch and are closed to ground in park or neutral
and open in drive ranges and reverse. The ECM supplies ignition voltage through a current limiting
resistor to the switch and senses a closed circuit when voltage drops to less than 1 volt.
NOTE: DO NOT drive the vehicle with the PARK/NEUTRAL switch disconnected, since idle quality
may be affected.
LOCATION:
Top of transaxle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3988
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-1A
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sensors and Switches A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 3989
Park/Neutral Position Switch Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Park/Neutral Position (PNP) switch contacts shown are a part of the Park/Neutral position
switch and are closed to ground in park or neutral, and open in drive ranges.
The PCM supplies ignition voltage through a pull up resistor to CKT 434 and senses a closed
switch when the voltage on CKT 434 drops to less than one volt.
The PCM uses the PNP signal as one of the inputs to control:
^ Idle speed.
^ VSS diagnostics.
^ EGR.
If CKT 434 indicates PNP (grounded), while in drive range, the EGR would be inoperative, resulting
in possible detonation.
If CKT 434 indicates drive (open) a sag in the idle may occur when the gear selector is moved into
drive range.
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. Checks for a closed switch to ground in park position. Different makes of scan toots will display
the PNP switch differently. Refer to tool
operator's manual for type of display used for a specific tool.
2. Checks for an open switch in drive range.
3. Be sure Tech 1 scan tool indicates drive, even while wiggling shifter, to test for an intermittent or
misadjusted switch in drive range.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Shift Interlock Cable > Component Information > Adjustments
Shift Interlock Cable: Adjustments
Fig. 3 Terminal Stop Position.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Shift Interlock Cable > Component Information > Adjustments > Page 3994
Fig. 4 Park/Lock Cable Position.
1. Place floor shift lever in Park. 2. Turn steering column lock cylinder to lock. 3. Unseat body
housing lock from body housing. 4. With body housing still attached to shift control mounting
bracket, adjust outer cable conduit to obtain proper location for white plastic housing in
the ignition switch, Fig. 3.
5. White plastic collar must either be flush or recessed approximately 0.04 inch within ignition park
lock housing, Fig. 4. 6. While holding outer cable conduit in position, seat body housing lock in
body housing.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Shift Interlock Cable > Component Information > Adjustments > Page 3995
Shift Interlock Cable: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Remove steering wheel. 2. Place key in RUN position, then disconnect park lock cable from lock
cylinder housing assembly. 3. On models with column shift, disconnect park lock cable from shift
gate assembly.
INSTALLATION
1. Place key in RUN position and shift lever in PARK position. 2. Snap connector body of cable
assembly to lock cylinder, ensuring locking tab is fully engaged into lock cylinder housing. 3. On
models with column shift, place key in Off-Lock position and pull key half way out of lock cylinder
housing. 4. Route cable end fitting through park lock latch, then depress adjuster button and snap
cable adjuster assembly to shift gate assembly. 5. Snap cable into cable retainer, then depress
adjuster button and pull cable sheathing towards lock cylinder to remove lash from system. 6.
Release sheathing, then release button.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Interlock, A/T >
Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4000
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Connector Locations
Behind LH Side Of I/P
LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Solenoid, A/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Shift Solenoid: Specifications
Intermediate Servo Cover ....................................................................................................................
................................................................... 8 Ft. Lbs. Solenoid To Valve Body ..................................
....................................................................................................................................................... 8
Ft. Lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T >
Shift Cable, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Shift Cable: Specifications
Shift Cable Bracket Bolts .....................................................................................................................
................................................................. 20 Ft. Lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, A/T >
Shift Cable, A/T > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4008
Shift Cable: Adjustments
Fig.5 Shift Control Cable Adjustment
1. Apply parking brake and block wheels. 2. Position range selector into the NEUTRAL position. 3.
Lift up range selector cable locking button. 4. Remove range selector cable end from transaxle
range selector level, Fig. 5. 5. Position range selector lever into LOW position. 6. Position transaxle
range selector lever into LOW position. Obtain LOW position by rotating transaxle range selector
lever toward front of vehicle
until it stops.
7. Snap range selector cable end onto transaxle range selector lever. 8. Press range selector cable
locking button down into the locked position. 9. Position range selector lever into PARK position.
10. Remove wheel blocks and release parking brake.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Speedometer Gear,
A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Speedometer Gear, A/T: Specifications
Speedometer Driven Gear To Governor Cover
.................................................................................................................................................. 75
Inch Lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sun Gear > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sun Gear: > 00-07-30-022D > Jun > 08 > A/T - 4L60/65E,
No Reverse/2nd or 4th Gear
Sun Gear: Customer Interest A/T - 4L60/65E, No Reverse/2nd or 4th Gear
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 00-07-30-022D
Date: June 10, 2008
Subject: No Reverse, Second Gear or Fourth Gear (Replace Reaction Sun Shell with More Robust
Heat Treated Parts)
Models: 1993 - 2005 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003 - 2005 HUMMER H2
with 4L60/65-E Automatic Transmission (RPOs M30 or M32)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add 2005 model year to the parts information. Please
discard Corporate Bulletin Number 00-07-30-022C (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a no reverse, no second or no fourth gear condition. First and
third gears will operate properly.
Cause
The reaction sun gear (673) may not hold inside the reaction sun shell (670).
Correction
Important:
There are FOUR distinct groups of vehicles and repair procedures involved. Vehicles built in the
2001 model year and prior that make use of a reaction shaft to shell thrust washer:
^ The sun shell can be identified by four square holes used to retain the thrust washer. Use
reaction sun shell P/N 24228345, reaction carrier to shell thrust washer (699B) P/N 8642202 and
reaction sun gear shell thrust washer (674) P/N 8642331er (674) P/N 8642331along with the
appropriate seals and washers listed below.
^ Vehicles built in the 2001 model year and prior that have had previous service to the reaction sun
shell: It is possible that some 2001 and prior model year vehicles have had previous service to the
reaction sun shell. At the time of service, these vehicles may have been updated with a Reaction
Sun Shell Kit (Refer to Service Bulletin 020730003) without four square holes to retain the thrust
washer. If it is found in a 2001 model year and prior vehicles that the reaction sun shell DOES NOT
have four square holes to retain the thrust washer, these vehicles must be serviced with P/Ns
24229825 (674), 24217328 and 8642331 along with the appropriate seals and washers listed
below.
^ Vehicles built in the 2001 model year and later that make use of a reaction shaft to shell thrust
bearing: The sun shell can be identified by no holes to retain the thrust washer. Use reaction sun
shell, P/N 24229825, reaction carrier shaft to shell thrust bearing (669A), P/N 24217328 and
reaction sun gear shell thrust washer (674), P/N 8642331 along with the appropriate seals and
washers listed below.
^ Vehicles built from November, 2001 through June, 2002: These vehicles should have the reaction
carrier shaft replaced when the sun shell is replaced. Use shell kit P/N 24229853, which contains a
sun shell (670), a reaction carrier shaft (666), a reaction carrier shaft to shell thrust bearing (669A)
and a reaction sun gear shell thrust washer (674). The appropriate seals and washers listed below
should also be used.
When servicing the transmission as a result of this condition, the transmission oil cooler and lines
MUST be flushed. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 02-07-30-052.
Follow the service procedure below for diagnosis and correction of the no reverse, no second, no
forth condition.
Important:
If metallic debris is found on the transmission magnet, the transmission must be completely
disassembled and cleaned. Metallic debris is defined as broken parts and pieces of internal
transmission components. This should not be confused with typical "normal" fine particles found on
all transmission magnets. Failure to properly clean the transmission case and internal components
may lead to additional repeat repairs.
1. Remove the transmission oil pan and inspect the magnet in the bottom of the pan for metal
debris. Refer to SI Document ID # 825141.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sun Gear > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sun Gear: > 00-07-30-022D > Jun > 08 > A/T - 4L60/65E,
No Reverse/2nd or 4th Gear > Page 4020
2. Remove the transmission from the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate SI document.
Important:
^ Inspect all the transmission components for damage or wear. Replace all damaged or worn
components. The parts shown above should be sufficient to correct this concern.
^ This condition does not normally require replacement of the transmission completely.
Components such as clutches, valve body, pump and torque converters will NOT require
replacement to correct this condition.
Disassemble the transmission and replace the appropriate parts listed below. Refer to the Unit
Repair Manual - Repair Instructions.
3. Reinstall the transmission in the vehicle. Refer to appropriate service information.
When servicing the transmission as a result of this condition, the transmission oil cooler and lines
MUST be flushed. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 02-07-30-052.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sun Gear > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Sun Gear: > 00-07-30-022D > Jun > 08 > A/T - 4L60/65E,
No Reverse/2nd or 4th Gear > Page 4021
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sun Gear > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sun Gear: > 00-07-30-022D > Jun > 08 > A/T
- 4L60/65E, No Reverse/2nd or 4th Gear
Sun Gear: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - 4L60/65E, No Reverse/2nd or 4th Gear
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 00-07-30-022D
Date: June 10, 2008
Subject: No Reverse, Second Gear or Fourth Gear (Replace Reaction Sun Shell with More Robust
Heat Treated Parts)
Models: 1993 - 2005 GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003 - 2005 HUMMER H2
with 4L60/65-E Automatic Transmission (RPOs M30 or M32)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add 2005 model year to the parts information. Please
discard Corporate Bulletin Number 00-07-30-022C (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a no reverse, no second or no fourth gear condition. First and
third gears will operate properly.
Cause
The reaction sun gear (673) may not hold inside the reaction sun shell (670).
Correction
Important:
There are FOUR distinct groups of vehicles and repair procedures involved. Vehicles built in the
2001 model year and prior that make use of a reaction shaft to shell thrust washer:
^ The sun shell can be identified by four square holes used to retain the thrust washer. Use
reaction sun shell P/N 24228345, reaction carrier to shell thrust washer (699B) P/N 8642202 and
reaction sun gear shell thrust washer (674) P/N 8642331er (674) P/N 8642331along with the
appropriate seals and washers listed below.
^ Vehicles built in the 2001 model year and prior that have had previous service to the reaction sun
shell: It is possible that some 2001 and prior model year vehicles have had previous service to the
reaction sun shell. At the time of service, these vehicles may have been updated with a Reaction
Sun Shell Kit (Refer to Service Bulletin 020730003) without four square holes to retain the thrust
washer. If it is found in a 2001 model year and prior vehicles that the reaction sun shell DOES NOT
have four square holes to retain the thrust washer, these vehicles must be serviced with P/Ns
24229825 (674), 24217328 and 8642331 along with the appropriate seals and washers listed
below.
^ Vehicles built in the 2001 model year and later that make use of a reaction shaft to shell thrust
bearing: The sun shell can be identified by no holes to retain the thrust washer. Use reaction sun
shell, P/N 24229825, reaction carrier shaft to shell thrust bearing (669A), P/N 24217328 and
reaction sun gear shell thrust washer (674), P/N 8642331 along with the appropriate seals and
washers listed below.
^ Vehicles built from November, 2001 through June, 2002: These vehicles should have the reaction
carrier shaft replaced when the sun shell is replaced. Use shell kit P/N 24229853, which contains a
sun shell (670), a reaction carrier shaft (666), a reaction carrier shaft to shell thrust bearing (669A)
and a reaction sun gear shell thrust washer (674). The appropriate seals and washers listed below
should also be used.
When servicing the transmission as a result of this condition, the transmission oil cooler and lines
MUST be flushed. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 02-07-30-052.
Follow the service procedure below for diagnosis and correction of the no reverse, no second, no
forth condition.
Important:
If metallic debris is found on the transmission magnet, the transmission must be completely
disassembled and cleaned. Metallic debris is defined as broken parts and pieces of internal
transmission components. This should not be confused with typical "normal" fine particles found on
all transmission magnets. Failure to properly clean the transmission case and internal components
may lead to additional repeat repairs.
1. Remove the transmission oil pan and inspect the magnet in the bottom of the pan for metal
debris. Refer to SI Document ID # 825141.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sun Gear > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sun Gear: > 00-07-30-022D > Jun > 08 > A/T
- 4L60/65E, No Reverse/2nd or 4th Gear > Page 4027
2. Remove the transmission from the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate SI document.
Important:
^ Inspect all the transmission components for damage or wear. Replace all damaged or worn
components. The parts shown above should be sufficient to correct this concern.
^ This condition does not normally require replacement of the transmission completely.
Components such as clutches, valve body, pump and torque converters will NOT require
replacement to correct this condition.
Disassemble the transmission and replace the appropriate parts listed below. Refer to the Unit
Repair Manual - Repair Instructions.
3. Reinstall the transmission in the vehicle. Refer to appropriate service information.
When servicing the transmission as a result of this condition, the transmission oil cooler and lines
MUST be flushed. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 02-07-30-052.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Sun Gear > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Sun Gear: > 00-07-30-022D > Jun > 08 > A/T
- 4L60/65E, No Reverse/2nd or 4th Gear > Page 4028
Parts Information
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Valve
Cable/Linkage, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Throttle Valve Cable/Linkage: Specifications
TV Cable To Case ...............................................................................................................................
......................................................... 75-80 Inch Lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Valve
Cable/Linkage, A/T > Component Information > Adjustments > Lock TAB Adjusting Cable
Throttle Valve Cable/Linkage: Adjustments Lock TAB Adjusting Cable
Fig. 5 Detent/TV Cable Adjuster. Lock Tab Adjusting Cable
1. Depress and hold readjust tab, Fig. 5. 2. Move slider back through fitting in direction away from
throttle idler lever until slider stops against fitting, then release readjust tab. 3. Rotate throttle idler
lever to full travel stop position, then release throttle lever.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Throttle Valve
Cable/Linkage, A/T > Component Information > Adjustments > Lock TAB Adjusting Cable > Page 4034
Throttle Valve Cable/Linkage: Adjustments Less Lock TAB Adjusting Cable
Fig. 6 Detent/TV Cable Adjustment.
1. Ensure cable is in Non-Adjusted position as shown, Fig. 6 . 2. Using a suitable torque wrench,
rotate idler pulley counterclockwise to 65 inch lbs. 3. Ensure cable moves freely, then test drive
vehicle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Torque Converter Replacement Information
Torque Converter: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Torque Converter Replacement Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-010C
Date: May 12, 2008
Subject: Automatic Transmission/Transaxle Torque Converter Replacement
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009
and Prior Saturn Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Except VTi Equipped Vehicles (RPO M16 and M75)
2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
with ALL Automatic Transmissions and Transaxles
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2007-2009 model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 01-07-30-010B (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The purpose of this bulletin is to help technicians determine when a torque converter should be
replaced. Below is a list of general guidelines to follow.
The converter should NOT be replaced if the following apply:
^ DTC P0742 - TCC stuck on is set. This code is almost always the result of a controls condition
(i.e. stuck TCC solenoid/valve). Experience has shown that this code rarely indicates a mechanical
concern within the torque converter.
^ The fluid has an odor or is discolored but no evidence of metal contamination.
^ Fine metal particles (traces of metal flakes/gray color to fluid ) are found in the converter. This is
not harmful to the torque converter.
^ The vehicle has been exposed to high mileage.
^ A small amount of wear appears on the hub where the oil pump drive gear mates to the converter
(RWD only). A certain amount of such wear is normal for both the hub and oil pump gear. Neither
the converter nor the front pump assembly should be replaced.
The torque converter should be replaced under any of the following conditions:
^ The vehicle has TCC shudder and/or no TCC apply. First complete all electrical and hydraulic
diagnosis and check for proper engine operation. The converter clutch may be damaged. Also the
converter bushing and/or internal 0-ring may be damaged.
^ Evidence of damage to the oil pump assembly pump shaft turbine shaft drive sprocket support
and bearing or metal chips/debris in the converter.
^ Metal chips/debris are found in the converter or when flushing the cooler and the cooler lines.
^ External leaks in the hub weld area lug weld or closure weld.
^ Converter pilot is broken damaged or fits poorly into the crankshaft.
^ The converter hub is scored or damaged.
^ The transmission oil is contaminated with engine coolant engine oil or water.
^ If excessive end play is found after measuring the converter for proper end play (refer to Service
Manual).
^ If metal chips/debris are found in the fluid filter or on the magnet and no internal parts in the unit
are worn or damaged. This indicates that the material came from the converter.
^ The converter has an unbalanced condition that results in a vibration that cannot be corrected by
following Converter Vibration Procedures.
^ Blue converter or dark circular ring between lugs. This condition will also require a complete
cleaning of the cooler and a check for adequate flow
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Torque Converter Replacement Information > Page 4039
through the cooler.
^ Converter bearing noise determined by noise from the bell housing area in Drive or Reverse at
idle. The noise is gone in Neutral and Park.
^ If silicon from the viscous clutch is found in the lower pan (4T80-E ONLY).
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4044
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4045
Harness Connector Faces: Automatic Transaxle (Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4046
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Description and Operation
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid
PURPOSE:
The Transmission Converter Clutch (TCC) feature eliminates the power loss of the torque
converter stage when the vehicle is in a cruise mode.
OPERATION:
The TCC system uses a solenoid operated valve in the automatic transmission to couple the
engine flexplate to the output shaft of the transaxle through the torque converter. This reduces the
slippage losses in the converter, which increases fuel economy. For the converter clutch to apply,
at least two conditions must be met.
1. Internal transmission fluid pressure must be correct.
2. The ECM/PCM completes a ground circuit to energize the TCC solenoid in the transmission,
which moves a check ball in the fluid line.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Solenoid
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Service and Repair Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Solenoid
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH (TCC) SOLENOID & SWITCHES
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid & Switches
Auxiliary Valve Body, Valve Body And Oil Pump Assembly
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Solenoid > Page
4049
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Valve body cover. Refer to "Valve Body Cover". 2. Wiring harness from case electrical connector
and leads from pressure switch. 3. Torque converter clutch solenoid bolt to auxiliary valve body. 4.
3rd clutch pressure switch. 5. Second clutch switch, if applicable.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Second clutch switch, if applicable.
TIGHTEN
^ Switch to 11 Nm (97 lbs. in.).
2. 3rd clutch pressure switch.
TIGHTEN
^ Switch to 11 Nm (97 lbs. in.).
3. Torque converter clutch solenoid bolt to auxiliary valve body. Install new O-ring. 4. Wire harness
to case and switches. 5. Valve body cover with a new gasket.
ADJUST
^ Fluid level.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Solenoid > Page
4050
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Service and Repair Valve Body Cover
VALVE BODY COVER
Side Cover And Control Valve View
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Raise vehicle and suitably support. 2. Drain oil. 3. Left front tire and wheel assembly. 4. Left
splash shield. 5. Valve body cover to transaxle bolts.
INSPECT
^ Bolts
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Valve body cover with a new gasket and bolts.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Torque Converter
Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair > Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Solenoid > Page
4051
Valve Body Cover
NOTE: It is necessary to use GM thread locker (P/N 12345382) or equivalent non-locking sealant
to reduce the potential for fluid leaks on the indicated bolts.
2. Left splash shield. 3. Left front tire and wheel assembly. 4. Lower vehicle.
ADJUST:
^ Oil level.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Fluid Oil Cooler Flush
Transmission Cooler: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Fluid Oil Cooler Flush
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 02-07-30-052G
Date: March 02, 2011
Subject: Automatic Transmission Oil Cooler Flush and Flow Test Essential Tool J 45096
TransFlow(R)
Models:
2011 and Prior Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2003-2010 HUMMER H2 2006-2010
HUMMER H3 with Automatic Transmission/Transaxle including Allison(R) Transmissions
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 02-07-30-052F (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Important All labor operations that include removal of the transmission from the vehicle include
labor time to flush the transmission oil cooler system.
The J 45096 transmission oil cooling system flush and flow test tool replaces current tool J
35944-A. J 45096 is a self-contained unit utilizing a 12-volt flow meter, shop air supply and
DEXRON(R) VI automatic transmission fluid (ATF). In the flush mode, transmission fluid is cycled
through the transmission oil cooling system. High-pressure air is automatically injected into the fluid
stream adding agitation to the ATF oil to enhance the removal of contaminated ATF oil and debris.
In the flow mode, an electronic flow meter is used to measure the flow capability of the ATF oil
cooling system. A digital display indicates the ATF oil flow rate in gallons per minute (GPM) along
with the amount of ATF oil in the supply vessel, supply vessel ATF oil temperature, machine cycles
and the operating mode. The supply oil vessel has 30 L (32 qt) capacity and the waste oil vessel
has 32 L (34 qt) capacity. The waste oil vessel is constructed of a translucent composite material
that allows the user to easily identify the oil level. The waste oil vessel can accommodate vacuum
evacuation and gravity draining. In the code mode, a random, encrypted code is generated that can
be used for verification of flow test results.
Current essential cooler line adapters are used to connect the J 45096 to the automatic
transmission oil cooler lines that allows J 45096 to adapt to General Motors passenger cars and
light duty trucks, current and past models (except the Pontiac Vibe, Wave and Chevrolet Aveo).
The tool may be adapted for use on the Pontiac Vibe, Wave and Chevrolet Aveo by dealership
personnel with a barbed hose connector and rubber hose obtained locally. The
Vibe's/Wave's/Aveo's transmission has a transmission oil requirement which is slightly different
than DEXRON(R) VI ATF. However, flushing the cooler with DEXRON(R) VI automatic
transmission fluid is an acceptable service procedure. Very little fluid remains in the cooler after the
flush procedure and the residual DEXRON(R) VI ATF in the cooler is compatible with the
Vibe's/Wave's/Aveo's transmission fluid.
Notice
Insufficient oil flow through the ATF oil cooling system will cause premature transmission failure.
The required minimum ATF oil flow rate reading is directly related to the supply oil temperature.
Refer to the flow rate reference chart for the oil flow rate specification based on the temperature of
the ATF in the supply vessel.
Helpful Hints for Maintaining the Temperature at or above 18°C (65°F)
Important
- The temperature of the supply vessel oil must be 18°C (65°F) or greater for J 45096 to operate. It
is recommended to store the J 45096 in an area of the dealership where the room temperature
remains at or above 18°C (65°F) when not in use.
- Do not attempt to increase the fluid temperature in the Transflow(R) machine with an engine oil
dipstick, or any other immersion type heater. The Transflow(R) machine has a check valve in the
supply reservoir. Inserting a heater will damage the check valve and the subsequent repair
expense would be the dealer's responsibility.
- A heater blanket, P/N J-45096-10, is available for the Transflow(R) transmission cooling system
flushing tool. This heater fastens around the Transflow(R) internal supply vessel and runs on 110
volts AC. The heater will warm the ATF in the supply vessel to at least 18°C (65° F) and has a
thermostat to hold a constant temperature.
Store the Transmission Cooling System Service Tool, J 45096, Transflow(R) machine in a room
where the temperature is maintained at or above 18°C (65°F).
Keep the ATF level in the reservoir low when the Transmission Cooling System Service Tool, J
45096, Transflow(R), is not in use. Store several gallons of oil in an area where the temperature is
maintained at or above 18°C (65°F). Fill the reservoir of the J 45096 as needed before using the
machine on
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Fluid Oil Cooler Flush > Page 4056
each repair.
With the ATF in a tightly sealed container, place the container in a tub of hot water for a period of
time. Then pour the ATF into the reservoir. This method works best with a low fluid level in the
reservoir.
Place the Transflow(R) machine in the direct sunlight with the cabinet door open to expose the
reservoir to the rays of the warm sun.
Flush / Flow Test Procedure
Important All labor operations that include removal of the transmission from the vehicle and require
the transmission oil pan or transmission side cover to be removed include labor time to flush the
transmission oil cooler system.
Refer to SI for Automatic Transmission Oil Cooler Flushing and Flow Test J 45096 for the
appropriate procedure.
Important The J 45096 can be used to flush the transmission oil cooler system on an Allison
equipped vehicle, but the flow meter should not be utilized. Refer to SI for Automatic Transmission
Oil Cooler Flushing and Flow Test J 45096 for the appropriate flow check procedure.
Machine Displays
After completion of the flush and flow test, the following information is to be recorded on the repair
order. This information is displayed on the Transmission Cooling System Service Tool, J 45096,
Transflow(R) machine when the dial is in the code position.
- Tested flow rate (displayed in Gallons Per Minute (GPM)
- Temperature (displayed is degrees Fahrenheit)
- Cycle number (a number)
- Seven digit Alpha/Numeric flow code (i.e. A10DFB2)
Warranty Information
Important All labor operations that include removal of the transmission from the vehicle include
labor time to flush the transmission oil cooler system.
Performing a transmission oil cooling system flush and flow test will use between 4.7-7.5 L (5-8 qts)
of DEXRON(R)VI transmission fluid. The amount
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Fluid Oil Cooler Flush > Page 4057
of transmission fluid (ATF), (DEXRON(R)VI) (fluid) that is to be charged for the flush portion of the
repair should not exceed the allowable charge for 7.5 L (2 gal) of fluid. This expense should be
shown in the Parts Section of the warranty claim document.
The Seven digit Alpha/Numeric flow code, i.e. A10DFB2, "MUST" be written on the job card and
placed in the comments section of the warranty claim. Any repair that requires the technician to
contact the Product Quality Center (PQC) must also include the seven digit flow code. The agent
will request the seven digit flow code and add the information to the PQC case prior to providing
authorization for the warranty claim.
The Seven digit Alpha/Numeric flow code, i.e. A10DFB2, "MUST" be written on the job card,
entered in the warranty claim labor operation Flush Code additional field (when available) and
placed in the comments section of the warranty claim. Any repair that requires the technician to
contact the Product Quality Center (PQC) must also include the seven digit flow code. The agent
will request the seven digit flow code and add the information to the PQC case prior to providing
authorization for the warranty claim.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Fluid Oil Cooler Flush > Page 4058
Transmission Cooler: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Water Or Coolant Contamination
Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-07-30-035B
Date: November 01, 2010
Subject: Information on Water or Ethylene Glycol in Transmission Fluid
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks with Automatic Transmission
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-07-30-035A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Water or ethylene glycol in automatic transmission fluid (ATF) is harmful to internal transmission
components and will have a negative effect on reliability and durability of these parts. Water or
ethylene glycol in ATF will also change the friction of the clutches, frequently resulting in shudder
during engagement or gear changes, especially during torque converter clutch engagement.
Indications of water in the ATF may include:
- ATF blowing out of the transmission vent tube.
- ATF may appear cloudy or, in cases of extreme contamination, have the appearance of a
strawberry milkshake.
- Visible water in the oil pan.
- A milky white substance inside the pan area.
- Spacer plate gaskets that appear to be glued to the valve body face or case.
- Spacer plate gaskets that appear to be swollen or wrinkled in areas where they are not
compressed.
- Rust on internal transmission iron/steel components.
If water in the ATF has been found and the source of the water entry has not been identified, or if a
leaking in-radiator transmission oil cooler is suspected (with no evidence of cross-contamination in
the coolant recovery reservoir), a simple and quick test kit is available that detects the presence of
ethylene glycol in ATF. The "Gly-Tek" test kit, available from the Nelco Company, should be
obtained and the ATF tested to make an accurate decision on the need for radiator replacement.
This can help to prevent customer comebacks if the in-radiator transmission oil cooler is leaking
and reduce repair expenses by avoiding radiator replacement if the cooler is not leaking. These
test kits can be obtained from:
Nelco Company
Test kits can be ordered by phone or through the website listed above. Orders are shipped
standard delivery time but can be shipped on a next day delivery basis for an extra charge. One
test kit will complete 10 individual fluid sample tests. For vehicles repaired under warranty, the cost
of the complete test kit plus shipping charges should be divided by 10 and submitted on the
warranty claim as a net item.
The transmission should be repaired or replaced based on the normal cost comparison procedure.
Important If water or coolant is found in the transmission, the following components MUST be
replaced.
- Replace all of the rubber-type seals.
- Replace all of the composition-faced clutch plates and/or bands.
- Replace all of the nylon parts.
- Replace the torque converter.
- Thoroughly clean and rebuild the transmission, using new gaskets and oil filter.
Important The following steps must be completed when repairing or replacing.
Flush and flow check the transmission oil cooler using J 45096. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
02-07-30-052F- Automatic Transmission Oil Cooler Flush and Flow Test Essential Tool J 45096
TransFlow.
- Thoroughly inspect the engine cooling system and hoses and clean/repair as necessary.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Fluid Oil Cooler Flush > Page 4059
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Fluid Oil Cooler Flush > Page 4060
Transmission Cooler: Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Oil Cooler Flushing Frequently Asked
Questions
File In Section: 07 - Transmission/Transaxle
Bulletin No.: 03-07-30-027
Date: June, 2003
INFORMATION
Subject: Most Frequently Asked Questions and Answers for J 45096 TransFlow Transmission Oil
Cooling System Flushing Machine
Models: 2004 and Prior Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks with Automatic
Transmission/Transaxle
2004 and Prior HUMMER H2
This bulletin is issued to help answer the most frequently asked questions and concerns about
essential tool J 45096.
Q: Why doesn't the machine work below 18°C (65°F)?
A: The flow characteristics of ATF at temperatures below 18°C (65°F) does not provide accurate
flow test results with the electronics used in the J
45096.
Q: Why didn't the unit come with a tank heater?
A: The vast majority of dealerships do not require a heater to keep the ATF above 18°C (65°F). As
a result, the heater was deleted as a cost-savings
measure. A tank heater, J 45096-10, is currently available from Kent-Moore if your dealership
requires it. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 03-07-30-002A for suggestions on warming the ATF
without using a heater blanket.
Q: Why does the machine fail new oil coolers?
A: Several reasons have been found. The most likely reason is the air pressure at the air hose
connected to the J 45096 is less than 586 kPa (85 psi).
Other reasons include a twisted hose inside the J 45096 at the bulkhead as a result of the nut
turning when the waste or supply hose was installed, the internal pressure regulator was
improperly set at the factory or a problem with the cooler lines on the vehicle. Perform the J 45096
self-test as described on pages 9 and 10 of the Operation Manual. If a problem is still detected,
refer to Troubleshooting on page 19 of the Operation Manual. If a problem still persists, contact
Kent-Moore Customer Service at 1-800-345-2233.
Q: What is the difference between steel and aluminum oil coolers?
A: The aluminum oil cooler tube is slightly thinner in construction than the steel oil cooler tube,
which affects the oil flow rate. The fitting that is
protruding out of the radiator tank easily identifies the aluminum oil cooler. Refer to the Quick
Reference card provided with the J 45096 in order to identify the proper flow rate for the aluminum
oil cooler.
Q: Why can't I use TransFlow for Allison transmission cooling Systems?
A: Validation of TransFlow is currently under development for light duty trucks equipped with the
Allison automatic transmission. TransFlow is based
on the existing MINIMUM flow rate specification through the transmission oil cooling system. The
Allison transmission oil cooling system only has MAXIMUM oil flow rates specified and J 45096
does not have the capability to test the transmission oil cooling system at the maximum oil flow rate
specification.
Q: Why doesn't GM publish a specification for auxiliary transmission oil coolers?
A: The auxiliary oil cooler used with GM vehicles does not contain an internal turbulator plate like
the radiator tank oil cooler does. Therefore, there is
no internal restriction that would affect the flow rate through the oil cooling system so a
specification for auxiliary oil cooler is not required. Keep in mind, kinks and damage to the auxiliary
cooler and lines can affect the flow rate through the system.
Q: Why did GM drop the labor time for transmission repairs?
A: The labor for flushing and flow testing the transmission oil cooling system is included with the
R&R; labor of the "K" labor operations that require
transmission removal. The time required to use the J 45096 to perform the flush and flow test is
much less than that of the J 35944-A. The warranty labor savings allowed GM to provide the J
45096 at no cost to dealerships.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Cooler,
A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T - Fluid Oil Cooler Flush > Page 4061
Q: Why didn't the machine come with the adapters to hook up to the car?
A: The J 45096 was designed to use the previously released essential cooler line adapters for the J
35944-A. All adapters are listed on page 17 of the
Operation Manual and can be ordered from Kent-Moore at 1-800-345-2233.
Q: How do I connect the J 45096 to a Catera, Prizm or a Vibe?
A: These vehicles, along with many other models, only require barbed fittings to connect to the
rubber cooler hose. These fittings are commercially
available and already found in many shops.
Q: Why didn't I receive an Operation Manual with the machine?
A: The Operation Manual was packaged in the upper portion of the shipping carton. If the shipping
carton was lifted off the base without opening the
top of the carton, the Operation Manual could have been discarded with the carton. Replacement
Operation Manual packages can be obtained from Kent-Moore Customer Service at
1-800-345-2233.
Q: Why can't I re-use the transmission fluid I use for flushing?
A: The very fine metal and clutch material debris from the transmission failure in the ATF causes
failures with the hall effect speed sensors that are used
to measure the flow rate. To avoid costly repairs, expensive filters, regular maintenance and
problems caused by a partially restricted filter, the filter was not included.
Q: What do I do if I need service on my machine?
A: Call Kent-Moore Customer Service at 1-800-345-2233. The J 45096 has a one-year warranty.
Q: Can I flush and flow engine oil coolers?
A: The engine oil cooler flow rates, the appropriate adapters and an acceptable procedure are
currently under development.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Mount,
A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Mount: Specifications
Engine Mount Bolts .............................................................................................................................
................................................................. 34 Ft. Lbs. Frame Insulator Bolts ......................................
...................................................................................................................................................... 40
Ft. Lbs. Frame To Crossmember Bolts ...............................................................................................
............................................................................... 37 Ft. Lbs. Transaxle Control Lever ....................
..............................................................................................................................................................
..... 15 Ft. Lbs. Transaxle Mount Pipe Expansion Bolt .........................................................................
........................................................................................ 41 Ft. Lbs. Transaxle Mount Support Brace
Nuts .....................................................................................................................................................
.............. 18 Ft. Lbs. Transaxle Mount Through Bolts .........................................................................
.................................................................................................. 82 Ft. Lbs. Transaxle Mount To
Support Bolts .......................................................................................................................................
................................ 49 Ft. Lbs. Transaxle Mount To Transaxle Bolts ................................................
.................................................................................................................... 41 Ft. Lbs. Transaxle To
Engine Mount Bolts .............................................................................................................................
........................................... 55 Ft. Lbs. Transaxle Support Assembly Bolts ........................................
............................................................................................................................... 55 Ft. Lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4069
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4070
Harness Connector Faces: Park/Neutral Position Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4071
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Park/Neutral Switch (Auto. Trans)
PURPOSE:
The PARK/NEUTRAL (P/N) switch indicates to the computer when the transmission is in PARK or
NEUTRAL. This information is used by the ECM for Idle Air Control (IAC), Torque Converter Clutch
(TCC) and Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) operation.
OPERATION:
The P/N switch contacts are a part of the neutral switch and are closed to ground in park or neutral
and open in drive ranges and reverse. The ECM supplies ignition voltage through a current limiting
resistor to the switch and senses a closed circuit when voltage drops to less than 1 volt.
NOTE: DO NOT drive the vehicle with the PARK/NEUTRAL switch disconnected, since idle quality
may be affected.
LOCATION:
Top of transaxle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4072
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-1A
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Position
Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 4073
Park/Neutral Position Switch Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Park/Neutral Position (PNP) switch contacts shown are a part of the Park/Neutral position
switch and are closed to ground in park or neutral, and open in drive ranges.
The PCM supplies ignition voltage through a pull up resistor to CKT 434 and senses a closed
switch when the voltage on CKT 434 drops to less than one volt.
The PCM uses the PNP signal as one of the inputs to control:
^ Idle speed.
^ VSS diagnostics.
^ EGR.
If CKT 434 indicates PNP (grounded), while in drive range, the EGR would be inoperative, resulting
in possible detonation.
If CKT 434 indicates drive (open) a sag in the idle may occur when the gear selector is moved into
drive range.
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. Checks for a closed switch to ground in park position. Different makes of scan toots will display
the PNP switch differently. Refer to tool
operator's manual for type of display used for a specific tool.
2. Checks for an open switch in drive range.
3. Be sure Tech 1 scan tool indicates drive, even while wiggling shifter, to test for an intermittent or
misadjusted switch in drive range.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Transmission Pressure
Test Port, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Transmission Pressure Test Port: Specifications
Line Pressure Take-Off .......................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 8 Ft. Lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/T Control - DTC P0756 Diagnostic Tips
Valve Body: Technical Service Bulletins A/T Control - DTC P0756 Diagnostic Tips
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 01-07-30-036H
Date: January 29, 2009
Subject: Diagnostic Tips for Automatic Transmission DTC P0756, Second, Third, Fourth Gear Start
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
with 4L60-E, 4L65-E or 4L70E Automatic Transmission (RPOs M30, M32 or M70)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2009 model year and add details regarding spacer plates.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 01-07-30-036G (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
Some dealership technicians may have difficulty diagnosing DTC P0756, 2-3 Shift Valve
Performance on 4L60-E, 4L65-E or 4L70E automatic transmissions. As detailed in the Service
Manual, when the PCM detects a 4-3-3-4 shift pattern, DTC P0756 will set. Some customers may
also describe a condition of a second, third or fourth gear start that may have the same causes but
has not set this DTC yet. Below are some tips when diagnosing this DTC:
^ This is a performance code. This means that a mechanical malfunction exists.
^ This code is not set by electrical issues such as a damaged wiring harness or poor electrical
connections. Electrical problems would cause a DTC P0758, P0787 or P0788 to set.
^ The most likely cause is chips/debris plugging the filtered AFL oil at orifice # 29 on the top of the
spacer plate (48). This is a very small hole and is easily plugged by a small amount of debris. It is
important to remove the spacer plate and inspect orifice # 29 and the immediate area for the
presence of chips/debris. Also, the transmission case passage directly above this orifice and the
valve body passage directly below should be inspected and cleaned of any chips/debris. For 2003
and newer vehicles the spacer plate should be replaced. The service replacement spacer plate is a
bonded style with gaskets and solenoid filter screens bonded to the spacer plate. These screens
can help to prevent plugging of orifice # 29 caused by small debris or chips.
^ This code could be set if the 2-3 shift valve (368) were stuck or hung-up in its bore. Inspect the
2-3 shift valve (368) and the 2-3 shuttle valve (369) for free movement or damage and clean the
valves, the bore and the valve body passages.
^ This code could be set by a 2-3 shift solenoid (367b) if it were cracked, broken or leaking. Refer
to Shift Solenoid Leak Test in the appropriate Service Manual for the leak test procedure. Based on
parts return findings, a damaged or leaking shift solenoid is the least likely cause of this condition.
Simply replacing a shift solenoid will not correct this condition unless the solenoid has been found
to be cracked, broken or leaking.
It is important to also refer to the appropriate Service Manual or Service Information (SI) for further
possible causes of this condition.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4081
Valve Body: Specifications
Oil Pan & Valve Body Cover ................................................................................................................
........................................................... 133 Inch Lbs. Solenoid To Valve Body ....................................
..................................................................................................................................................... 8 Ft.
Lbs. Valve Body Cover Bolts ...............................................................................................................
................................................................... 124 Inch Lbs. Valve Body To Case .................................
............................................................................................................................................................
18 Ft. Lbs. Valve Body To Case Cover ...............................................................................................
..................................................................................... 8 Ft. Lbs. Valve Body To Driven Sprocket
Support
.............................................................................................................................................................
18 Ft. Lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4082
3T40 (125C)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Valve Body Cover
Valve Body: Service and Repair Valve Body Cover
VALVE BODY COVER
Side Cover And Control Valve View
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Raise vehicle and suitably support. 2. Drain oil. 3. Left front tire and wheel assembly. 4. Left
splash shield. 5. Valve body cover to transaxle bolts.
INSPECT
^ Bolts
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Valve body cover with a new gasket and bolts.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Valve Body Cover > Page 4085
Valve Body Cover
NOTE: It is necessary to use GM thread locker (P/N 12345382) or equivalent non-locking sealant
to reduce the potential for fluid leaks on the indicated bolts.
2. Left splash shield. 3. Left front tire and wheel assembly. 4. Lower vehicle.
ADJUST:
^ Oil level.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Automatic Transmission/Transaxle > Valve Body, A/T >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Valve Body Cover > Page 4086
Valve Body: Service and Repair Auxiliary Valve Body, Valve Body & Oil Pump Assembly
AUXILIARY VALVE BODY, VALVE BODY & OIL PUMP ASSEMBLY
Fig. 8 Valve Body Bolt Location
Fig. 9 Check Ball Locations
1. Disconnect battery ground cable, then the TV cable. 2. Raise and support vehicle. 3. Remove
left front wheel and tire assembly. 4. Remove valve body cover retaining bolts and the cover. 5.
Remove TCC solenoid retaining bolt and the solenoid. Disconnect TCC solenoid and 3rd gear
pressure switch electrical connectors. 6. Remove bolt securing linkage/bracket to valve body, then
remove TV linkage. 7. Remove remaining valve body retaining bolts, then the valve body and six
check balls. Do not remove the bolts marked A, Fig. 8, at this time. 8. Remove bolt A and separate
auxiliary valve body from the valve body. 9. Remove oil pump drive rod, auxiliary valve body and
cover.
10. Remove oil pump assembly. 11. Reverse procedure to install noting the following:
a. Tighten bolts in a clockwise pattern, starting from center. b. Refer to Fig. 9 for check ball
locations. c. Adjust TV cable and fluid level.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Fluid >
Component Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Clutch Fluid: Capacity Specifications
Fill the clutch master cylinder to the "Full" or "MAX" mark on the reservoir. Do not overfill.
Caution: Should accidental spillage occur, rinse the area thoroughly with water. Pay special
attention to any electrical wires, parts, harnesses, rubber or painted surfaces.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Fluid >
Component Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 4093
Clutch Fluid: Fluid Type Specifications
Hydraulic Clutch Fluid
........................................................................................................................................ GM P/N
12345347 or DOT 3 Brake Fluid
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Master
Cylinder > Component Information > Specifications
Clutch Master Cylinder: Specifications
Clutch Master Cylinder To Front Dash ................................................................................................
................................................................... 16 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Master
Cylinder > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4097
Clutch Master Cylinder: Description and Operation
Fig. 1 Hydraulic Clutch Assembly
On these models, a hydraulic clutch system is used, Fig. 1. The system consists of a dash
mounted master cylinder with integral reservoir, a transmission mounted slave cylinder and high
pressure tubing to connect the two components. The hydraulic clutch system provides automatic
clutch adjustment, therefore, there is no provision for adjustment.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Master
Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Bleeding Hydraulic System
Clutch Master Cylinder: Service and Repair Bleeding Hydraulic System
Preliminary Information
CLUTCH HYDRAULIC SYSTEM
The clutch hydraulic system is serviced as a complete unit and has been bled of air and filled with
fluid. Individual components of the system are not available separetely.
Bleeding Hydraulic System
Bleeding is necessary whenever the level of fluid in the reservoir has been allowed to fall so low
that air has been drawn into the master cylinder.
NOTICE: Never, under any circumstances, use fluid which has been bled from a system to fill the
reservoir as it may be aerated, have too much moisture content and possibly be contaminated.
Bleeding Procedure With Bleed Screw
Bleeding Procedure With Bleed Screw
1. Remove the cap and diaphragm.
Clean ^
Dirt and grease from the cap to ensure that no foreign substances enter the system.
2. Fill reservoir to top step with Hydraulic Clutch Fluid GM P/N 12345347 or equivalent. 3. Fully
loosen the bleed screw on the actuator cylinder body next to the inlet connection.
Important ^
For efficient gravity fill, the reservoir must be kept full at all times.
Tighten ^
Bleed screw to 2 N.m (17 lbs. in.) when a steady stream of fluid comes from the bleed screw.
4. Install the diaphragm and cap to reservoir.
Inspect ^
Fluid level in reservoir
5. Fill reservoir with Hydraulic Clutch Fluid GM P/N 12345347 or equivalent. 6. Start the engine and
push the clutch to the floor. Wait ten seconds and select reverse gear. There should be no grating
of gears. If there is, the
hydraulic system may still contain air. If this is the condition, repeat bleeding procedure.
Bleeding Procedure Without Bleed Screw
Bleeding Procedure Without Bleed Screw for Isuzu Transaxle
1. Remove the hydraulic actuator cylinder from the transaxle. 2. Loosen the clutch master cylinder
mounting nuts to the ends of the studs. Do not remove the master cylinder. 3. Remove the
reservoir cap and diaphragm.
Clean ^
Dirt and grease from the cap to ensure no foreign substances will enter the system.
Measure ^
Depress hydraulic actuator cylinder pushrod approximately 20.0 mm (0.787 in.) into the actuator
cylinder bore and hold.
4. Install the diaphragm and cap on the reservoir while holding actuator cylinder pushrod in as
described. 5. Release the actuator cylinder pushrod. 6. Hold the actuator cylinder vertically with the
pushrod end facing down.
Important ^
Actuator cylinder should be lower than the master cylinder.
7. Press the pushrod into the actuator cylinder bore with short 10.0 mm (0.390 in.) strokes.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Master
Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Bleeding Hydraulic System > Page 4100
Inspect ^
Reservoir for air bubbles
8. Continue until air bubbles are no longer entering the reservoir. 9. Install the actuator cylinder on
the transaxle
10. Install the clutch master cylinder mounting nuts
Tighten ^
Nuts evenly to 21 N.m (16 lbs. ft.).
Inspect ^
Fluid level in reservoir. Fill reservoir with Hydraulic Clutch Fluid GM P/N 12345347 or equivalent.
11. Start the engine and push the clutch to the floor. Wait ten seconds and select reverse gear.
There should be no grating of gears. If so, hydraulic
system may still contain air. If this is the condition, repeat bleeding procedure.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Master
Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Bleeding Hydraulic System > Page 4101
Clutch Master Cylinder: Service and Repair Removal and Installation
REMOVAL
1. Remove air intake dust from air cleaner.
2. Disconnect negative and positive battery cables from battery.
3. Remove left fender brace and battery.
4. Disconnect MAT sensor lead at air cleaner.
5. Disconnect mass air flow sensor lead, then remove PCV retaining clamp from air intake duct.
6. Remove clamp retaining air intake duct to throttle body.
7. Remove mass air flow mounting bolt and air cleaner bracket mounting bolts at battery tray.
8. Remove air cleaner, mass air flow sensor and air intake duct as an assembly.
9. Disconnect electrical lead at washer bottle, then remove attaching bolts and washer bottle.
10. Remove cruise control mounting bracket retaining nuts from strut tower, if equipped.
11. Remove sound insulator from inside of vehicle.
12. Disconnect clutch master cylinder push rod from clutch pedal.
13. Remove clutch master cylinder retaining nuts at front of dash.
14. Remove actuator cylinder retaining nuts at transaxle.
15. Remove hydraulic system as a unit from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Install actuator cylinder to transaxle support bracket aligning push rod into pocket on lever. Do
not remove plastic push rod retainer from actuator cylinder. Retainer will break off on first clutch
pedal application. Torque nuts evenly to 16 ft. lbs.
2. Install clutch master cylinder to front dash. Torque nuts evenly to 16 ft. lbs.
3. Remove pedal restrictor from pushrod. Lubricate push rod bushing on clutch pedal, then connect
push rod to clutch pedal and install retaining clip.
4. Check cruise control switch adjustment at clutch pedal. If adjustment is necessary, do not exert
an upward force on clutch pedal pad of more than 20 ft. lbs. or damage to master cylinder pushrod
retaining ring may result.
5. Install sound insulator.
6. Press clutch pedal down several times. This will break plastic retaining straps on actuator
cylinder push rod. Do not remove plastic button on pushrod.
7. Install washer bottle.
8. Install air cleaner, mass air flow sensor and air intake duct.
9. Install clamp retaining air intake duct to throttle body.
10. Install PCV pipe retaining clamp.
11. Connect mass air flow and MAT sensor leads.
12. Install battery and left fender brace.
13. Connect positive and negative battery cables, then air intake duct to air cleaner.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Master
Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Bleeding Hydraulic System > Page 4102
Clutch Master Cylinder: Service and Repair Clutch Master & Actuator Cylinders
(Figure 1) Clutch Master Cylinder and Pedal
(Figure 2) Disconnecting Clutch Actuator Cylinder Line
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Master
Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Bleeding Hydraulic System > Page 4103
(Figure 3) Connecting Clutch Actuator Cylinder Line
(Figure 4) Clutch Actuator
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Air intake duct from air cleaner. 2. Negative and positive battery cables from battery. 3. Left
fender brace and battery. 4. Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor lead at air cleaner. 5. Mass air
flow sensor lead, then remove Positive Crankcase Ventilation (PCV) retaining clamp from air intake
duct. 6. Clamp retaining air intake duct to throttle body. 7. Mass air flow mounting bolt and air
cleaner bracket mounting bolts at battery tray. 8. Air cleaner, mass air flow sensor and air intake
duct as an assembly. 9. Electrical lead at washer bottle, then remove attaching bolts and washer
bottle.
10. Cruise control mounting bracket retaining nuts from strut tower, if equipped. 11. Sound insulator
from inside of vehicle. 12. Clutch master cylinder pushrod from clutch pedal. 14. Actuator cylinder
quick disconnect from master cylinder line, (figure 2). 15. Transaxle from vehicle, refer to Manual
Transmission/Transaxle / Service and Repair. 16. Clutch actuator from transaxle, (figure 4).
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Actuator cylinder to transaxle. 2. Transaxle assembly. 3. Actuator cylinder quick connect to
clutch master cylinder line, (figure 3).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Master
Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Bleeding Hydraulic System > Page 4104
2. Master cylinder to front of dash and tighten nuts to 23 Nm (17 ft lbs). 3. Remove pedal restrictor
from pushrod. Lubricate pushrod bushing on clutch pedal, then connect pushrod to clutch pedal
and install retaining clip. 4. If equipped with cruise control, check switch adjustment at clutch pedal.
NOTE: If adjustment is necessary, do not exert an upward force on clutch pedal pad of more than
89 Nm (20 ft lbs) or damage to master cylinder pushrod retaining ring may result.
5. Sound insulator and then bleed system, refer to Clutch, M/T / Service and Repair. 7. Washer
bottle and electrical connection. 8. Air cleaner, mass air flow sensor and air intake duct. 9. Clamp
retaining air intake duct to throttle body.
10. PCV pipe retaining clamp. 11. Mass air flow and IAT sensor leads. 12. Battery and left fender
brace. 13. Positive and negative battery cables, then air intake duct to air cleaner.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Slave
Cylinder > Component Information > Specifications > Clutch Specs
Clutch Slave Cylinder: Specifications Clutch Specs
Clutch Actuator Cylinder ......................................................................................................................
.................................................................. 16 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Slave
Cylinder > Component Information > Specifications > Clutch Specs > Page 4109
Clutch Slave Cylinder: Specifications GM Getrag 284 Manual Transaxle
Clutch Acuator Stud .............................................................................................................................
................................................................ 9-10 lbs. ft.
Clutch Release Pivot Nut .....................................................................................................................
................................................................... 17 lbs. ft.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Slave
Cylinder > Component Information > Specifications > Page 4110
Clutch Slave Cylinder: Description and Operation
Fig. 1 Hydraulic Clutch Assembly
On these models, a hydraulic clutch system is used, Fig. 1. The system consists of a dash
mounted master cylinder with integral reservoir, a transmission mounted slave cylinder and high
pressure tubing to connect the two components. The hydraulic clutch system provides automatic
clutch adjustment, therefore, there is no provision for adjustment.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Slave
Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Bleeding Hydraulic System
Clutch Slave Cylinder: Service and Repair Bleeding Hydraulic System
Preliminary Information
CLUTCH HYDRAULIC SYSTEM
The clutch hydraulic system is serviced as a complete unit and has been bled of air and filled with
fluid. Individual components of the system are not available separetely.
Bleeding Hydraulic System
Bleeding is necessary whenever the level of fluid in the reservoir has been allowed to fall so low
that air has been drawn into the master cylinder.
NOTICE: Never, under any circumstances, use fluid which has been bled from a system to fill the
reservoir as it may be aerated, have too much moisture content and possibly be contaminated.
Bleeding Procedure With Bleed Screw
Bleeding Procedure With Bleed Screw
1. Remove the cap and diaphragm.
Clean ^
Dirt and grease from the cap to ensure that no foreign substances enter the system.
2. Fill reservoir to top step with Hydraulic Clutch Fluid GM P/N 12345347 or equivalent. 3. Fully
loosen the bleed screw on the actuator cylinder body next to the inlet connection.
Important ^
For efficient gravity fill, the reservoir must be kept full at all times.
Tighten ^
Bleed screw to 2 N.m (17 lbs. in.) when a steady stream of fluid comes from the bleed screw.
4. Install the diaphragm and cap to reservoir.
Inspect ^
Fluid level in reservoir
5. Fill reservoir with Hydraulic Clutch Fluid GM P/N 12345347 or equivalent. 6. Start the engine and
push the clutch to the floor. Wait ten seconds and select reverse gear. There should be no grating
of gears. If there is, the
hydraulic system may still contain air. If this is the condition, repeat bleeding procedure.
Bleeding Procedure Without Bleed Screw
Bleeding Procedure Without Bleed Screw for Isuzu Transaxle
1. Remove the hydraulic actuator cylinder from the transaxle. 2. Loosen the clutch master cylinder
mounting nuts to the ends of the studs. Do not remove the master cylinder. 3. Remove the
reservoir cap and diaphragm.
Clean ^
Dirt and grease from the cap to ensure no foreign substances will enter the system.
Measure ^
Depress hydraulic actuator cylinder pushrod approximately 20.0 mm (0.787 in.) into the actuator
cylinder bore and hold.
4. Install the diaphragm and cap on the reservoir while holding actuator cylinder pushrod in as
described. 5. Release the actuator cylinder pushrod. 6. Hold the actuator cylinder vertically with the
pushrod end facing down.
Important ^
Actuator cylinder should be lower than the master cylinder.
7. Press the pushrod into the actuator cylinder bore with short 10.0 mm (0.390 in.) strokes.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Slave
Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Bleeding Hydraulic System > Page 4113
Inspect ^
Reservoir for air bubbles
8. Continue until air bubbles are no longer entering the reservoir. 9. Install the actuator cylinder on
the transaxle
10. Install the clutch master cylinder mounting nuts
Tighten ^
Nuts evenly to 21 N.m (16 lbs. ft.).
Inspect ^
Fluid level in reservoir. Fill reservoir with Hydraulic Clutch Fluid GM P/N 12345347 or equivalent.
11. Start the engine and push the clutch to the floor. Wait ten seconds and select reverse gear.
There should be no grating of gears. If so, hydraulic
system may still contain air. If this is the condition, repeat bleeding procedure.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Slave
Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Bleeding Hydraulic System > Page 4114
Clutch Slave Cylinder: Service and Repair Clutch Master & Actuator Cylinder
(Figure 1) Clutch Master Cylinder and Pedal
(Figure 2) Disconnecting Clutch Actuator Cylinder Line
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Slave
Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Bleeding Hydraulic System > Page 4115
(Figure 3) Connecting Clutch Actuator Cylinder Line
(Figure 4) Clutch Actuator
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Air intake duct from air cleaner. 2. Negative and positive battery cables from battery. 3. Left
fender brace and battery. 4. Intake Air Temperature (IAT) sensor lead at air cleaner. 5. Mass air
flow sensor lead, then remove Positive Crankcase Ventilation (PCV) retaining clamp from air intake
duct. 6. Clamp retaining air intake duct to throttle body. 7. Mass air flow mounting bolt and air
cleaner bracket mounting bolts at battery tray. 8. Air cleaner, mass air flow sensor and air intake
duct as an assembly. 9. Electrical lead at washer bottle, then remove attaching bolts and washer
bottle.
10. Cruise control mounting bracket retaining nuts from strut tower, if equipped. 11. Sound insulator
from inside of vehicle. 12. Clutch master cylinder pushrod from clutch pedal. 14. Actuator cylinder
quick disconnect from master cylinder line, (figure 2). 15. Transaxle from vehicle, refer to Manual
Transmission/Transaxle / Service and Repair. 16. Clutch actuator from transaxle, (figure 4).
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Actuator cylinder to transaxle. 2. Transaxle assembly. 3. Actuator cylinder quick connect to
clutch master cylinder line, (figure 3).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Hydraulic System > Clutch Slave
Cylinder > Component Information > Service and Repair > Bleeding Hydraulic System > Page 4116
2. Master cylinder to front of dash and tighten nuts to 23 Nm (17 ft lbs). 3. Remove pedal restrictor
from pushrod. Lubricate pushrod bushing on clutch pedal, then connect pushrod to clutch pedal
and install retaining clip. 4. If equipped with cruise control, check switch adjustment at clutch pedal.
NOTE: If adjustment is necessary, do not exert an upward force on clutch pedal pad of more than
89 Nm (20 ft lbs) or damage to master cylinder pushrod retaining ring may result.
5. Sound insulator and then bleed system, refer to Clutch, M/T / Service and Repair. 7. Washer
bottle and electrical connection. 8. Air cleaner, mass air flow sensor and air intake duct. 9. Clamp
retaining air intake duct to throttle body.
10. PCV pipe retaining clamp. 11. Mass air flow and IAT sensor leads. 12. Battery and left fender
brace. 13. Positive and negative battery cables, then air intake duct to air cleaner.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Pedal Assembly > Component
Information > Adjustments
Clutch Pedal Assembly: Adjustments
Fig. 1 Hydraulic Clutch Assembly
These models use a hydraulic clutch system, Fig. 1. The system consists of a dash mounted
master cylinder with integral reservoir, a transmission mounted slave cylinder and high pressure
tubing to connect the two components.
The hydraulic clutch system provides automatic clutch adjustment, therefore, there is no provision
for adjustment.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 4124
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 4125
Clutch Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect clutch switch electrical connector.
2. Remove clutch bracket and switch attaching nuts, then remove switch.
3. Reverse procedure to install.
Torque switch attaching nuts to 53 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Clutch Release Fork, M/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Clutch Release Fork: Specifications
Clutch Fork Assembly Pivot Bolt .........................................................................................................
................................................................... 24 lbs. ft.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Clutch, M/T > Pressure Plate > Component Information >
Specifications
Pressure Plate: Specifications
Clutch Cover to Flywheel Bolt 24 Nm + Rotate an additional 30 degrees. 18 lb. ft. + Rotate an
additional 30 degrees.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle: Customer Interest Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability
Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 4140
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Continuously Variable
Transmission/Transaxle: > 04-06-01-029E > Apr > 10 > Vehicle - Engine Crankcase and Subsystems Flushing Info.
Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle: All Technical Service Bulletins Vehicle - Engine
Crankcase and Subsystems Flushing Info.
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-06-01-029E
Date: April 29, 2010
Subject: Unnecessary Flushing Services, Additive Recommendations and Proper Utilization of GM
Simplified Maintenance Schedule to Enhance Customer Service Experience
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years and add information about the
proper transmission flush procedure. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-06-01-029D
(Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
An Overview of Proper Vehicle Service
General Motors is aware that some companies are marketing tools and equipment to support a
subsystem flushing procedures. These dedicated machines are in addition to many engine oil,
cooling system, fuel system, A/C, transmission flush and steering system additives available to the
consumer. GM Vehicles under normal usage do not require any additional procedures or additives
beyond what is advised under the former Vehicle Maintenance Schedules or the current Simplified
Maintenance Schedules. Do not confuse machines available from Kent-Moore/SPX that are
designed to aid and accelerate the process of fluid changing with these flushing machines.
Engine Crankcase Flushing
General Motors Corporation does not endorse or recommend engine crankcase flushing for any of
its gasoline engines. Analysis of some of the aftermarket materials used for crankcase flushing
indicate incompatibility with GM engine components and the potential for damage to some engine
seals and bearings. Damage to engine components resulting from crankcase flushing IS NOT
COVERED under the terms of the New Vehicle Warranty.
GM Authorized Service Information: Detailed, Descriptive, and Complete
If a specific model vehicle or powertrain need is identified, GM will issue an Authorized Service
Document containing a procedure and, if required, provide, make available, or require the specific
use of a machine, tool or chemical to accomplish proper vehicle servicing. An example of this is
fuel injector cleaning. Due to variation in fuel quality in different areas of the country, GM has
recognized the need for fuel injector cleaning methods on some engines, though under normal
circumstances, this service is not part of the maintenance requirements.
GM has published several gasoline fuel injector cleaning bulletins that fully outline the methods to
be used in conjunction with GM Part Numbered solutions to accomplish proper and safe cleaning
of the fuel injectors with preventative maintenance suggestions to maintain optimum performance.
You may refer to Corporate Bulletin Numbers 03-06-04-030 and 04-06-04-051 for additional
information on this subject.
Subsystem Flushing
Flushing of A/C lines, radiators, transmission coolers, and power steering systems are recognized
practices to be performed after catastrophic failures or extreme corrosion when encountered in
radiators. For acceptable A/C flushing concerns, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 01-01-38-006.
This practice is NOT required or recommended for normal service operations.
The use of external transmission fluid exchange or flush machines is NOT recommended for the
automatic or manual transmission. Use of external machines to replace the fluid may affect the
operation or durability of the transmission. Transmission fluid should only be replaced by draining
and refilling following directions in SI. Refer to Automatic/Manual Transmission Fluid and Filter
Replacement.
Approved Transmission Flushing Tool (Transmission Cooler Only)
The Automatic Transmission Oil Cooler Flush and Flow Test Tool is recommended for GM
vehicles. Refer to Transmission Fluid Cooler Flushing and Flow Test in SI using the J 45096.
Service Is Important to You and Your Customer
General Motors takes great pride in offering our dealerships and customers high quality vehicles
that require extremely low maintenance over the life of the vehicle. This low cost of ownership
builds repeat sales and offers our customers measurable economy of operation against competing
vehicles.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Continuously Variable
Transmission/Transaxle: > 04-06-01-029E > Apr > 10 > Vehicle - Engine Crankcase and Subsystems Flushing Info. > Page
4146
Providing responsible services at the proper intervals will greatly aid your dealership with repeat
business, and additional services when required. Most customers appreciate and gain trust in the
dealership that informs and offers them just what they need for continued trouble-free operation.
Examine your service department's practices and verify that all Service Consultants and
Technicians focus on customer satisfaction, vehicle inspections, and other products at time of
service. Use this opportunity to upgrade the services you provide to your customers. Here are a
few suggestions:
- Take the time required to align your dealership service practices with the new GM Simplified
Maintenance Schedule. Use the new vehicle Owner's Manual Maintenance I and II schedules to
create a "mirror image" in your advertising and dealer service pricing that is easily understandable
to your customer. Taking advantage of this new service strategy may greatly increase your
dealership service sales and customer retention while decreasing the frequency of visits and
inconvenience to your customer.
- Review your program to ensure that all vehicles coming in are evaluated for safety and wear
items. Examine all vehicles for tire condition, signs of misalignment, brake wear, exterior lamp
functionality, exhaust condition, A/C cooling performance, SRS or Air Bag MIL, along with Service
Engine Soon or Check Engine indicators. If the Service Engine Soon or Check Engine MIL is
illuminated, it is vital that you inform the customer of the concerns with ignoring the indicator and
what the required repair would cost. In addition to the possibility of increased emissions and
driveability concerns, many customers are unaware that lower gas mileage may also result, with
additional cost to the customer.
- Be complete in your service recommendations. Some sales opportunities are not being fully
pursued nationally. Focus on overlooked but required maintenance that has real benefits to the
customer. Many vehicles are equipped with cabin air filters. If these filters are used beyond
replacement time, they may impede airflow decreasing A/C and heating performance. Make sure
these filters are part of your recommended service. Note that some of our vehicles may not have
been factory equipped but will accept the filters as an accessory.
- Express the value in maintaining the finish quality of the customer's vehicle at the Maintenance I
and II visits. More fully utilize the vehicle prep personnel you already have in place. In today's
world, many people simply ignore the finish of their vehicle, at best infrequently using an automatic
car wash for exterior cleaning. Offer vehicle detailing services in stages from just a wash and wax
to a complete interior cleaning. When paired with the Simplified Maintenance visit, this will increase
customer satisfaction. On return, the customer gets a visibly improved vehicle that will be a source
of pride of ownership along with a vehicle that is now fully maintained. Also, reinforce the improved
resale value of a completely maintained vehicle.
- For customers who clean and maintain the appearance of their vehicles themselves encourage
the use of GM Vehicle Care products. Many customers may have never used GM Car Wash/Wax
Concentrate, GM Cleaner Wax or a longtime product, GM Glass Cleaner, which is a favorite of
many customers who try it just once. If your dealership give samples of these products with new
car purchases, customers may already be sold on the product but not willing to make a special trip
to the dealership. Capitalize on sales at this time. Stock shelves right at the Service counter with
these products and consider instituting compensation programs for Service Consultants who
suggest these products. Many consumers faced with an intimidating wall full of car care products
sold at local auto parts stores may find it comforting to purchase a fully tested product sold by GM
that they know will not harm the finish of their vehicle. We suggest these competitively priced basic
vehicle care products to emphasize:
In USA:
- #12378401 GM Vehicle Care Wash/Wax Concentrate 16 fl. oz. (0.473L)
- #89021822 GM Vehicle Care Glass Cleaner Aerosol 18 oz. (510 g)
- #12377966 GM Vehicle Care Cleaner Wax 16 fl. oz. (0.473L)
- #1052929 GM Vehicle Care Chrome and Wire Wheel Cleaner 16 fl. oz. (0.473L)
- #88861431 GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator 24 fl. oz. (0.710L)
In Canada:
- #10953203 GM Vehicle Care Wash & Wax Concentrate 473 mL
- #992727 GM Glass Cleaner Aerosol 500 g
- #10952905 GM Vehicle Care Liquid Cleaner/Wax 473 mL
- #10953013 GM Vehicle Care Chrome Cleaner and Polish 454 mL
- #10953202 GM Vehicle Care Wheel Brite 473 mL
- #88901678 GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator 473 mL
- Display signboards with the installed price for popular GM Accessories such as running boards
and Tonneau Covers. Customers may not think to ask about these desirable items at the time of a
service visit.
- Finally, take advantage of the GM Goodwrench initiatives (Tire Program, Goodwrench Credit
Card, etc. / Dealer Marketing Association (DMA) Promotions in Canada) to provide the customer
with more reasons to identify your dealership as the best place to go for parts and service.
Remember to utilize ALL of the service aspects you possess in your dealership to satisfy and
provide value to your customer. Many businesses exist profitably as an oil change location, a
vehicle repair facility, or a detailing shop alone. You already have the capabilities of all three and
provide these services with the inherent trust of your customer, under the GM Mark of Excellence.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Continuously Variable
Transmission/Transaxle: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine, A/T Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON
Bulletin No.: 04-07-30-013B
Date: February 01, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Automatic Transmission Shift, Engine Driveability Concerns or Service Engine Soon
(SES) Light On as a Result of the Use of an Excessively/Over-Oiled Aftermarket, Reusable Air
Filter
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2007 and Prior Saturn Models 2003-2007
HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add models and model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-07-30-013A (Section 07 - Transmission/Transaxle).
The use of an excessively/over-oiled aftermarket, reusable air filter may result in:
Service Engine Soon (SES) light on
Transmission shift concerns, slipping and damaged clutch(es) or band(s)
Engine driveability concerns, poor acceleration from a stop, limited engine RPM range
The oil that is used on these air filter elements may be transferred onto the Mass Air Flow (MAF)
sensor causing contamination of the sensor. As a result, the Grams per Second (GPS) signal from
the MAF may be low and any or all of the concerns listed above may occur.
When servicing a vehicle with any of these concerns, be sure to check for the presence of an
aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter. The MAF, GPS reading should be compared
to a like vehicle with an OEM air box and filter under the same driving conditions to verify the
concern.
The use of an aftermarket reusable air filter DOES NOT void the vehicle's warranty.
If an aftermarket reusable air filter is used, technicians should inspect the MAF sensor element and
the air induction hose for contamination of oil prior to making warranty repairs.
Transmission or engine driveability concerns (related to the MAF sensor being contaminated with
oil) that are the result of the use of an aftermarket reusable, excessively/over-oiled air filter are not
considered to be warrantable repair items.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Continuously Variable
Transmission/Transaxle: > 04-07-30-013B > Feb > 07 > Engine, A/T - Shift/Driveability Concerns/MIL ON > Page 4151
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Continuously Variable
Transmission/Transaxle: > 04-06-01-029E > Apr > 10 > Vehicle - Engine Crankcase and Subsystems Flushing Info.
Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle: All Technical Service Bulletins Vehicle - Engine
Crankcase and Subsystems Flushing Info.
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-06-01-029E
Date: April 29, 2010
Subject: Unnecessary Flushing Services, Additive Recommendations and Proper Utilization of GM
Simplified Maintenance Schedule to Enhance Customer Service Experience
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years and add information about the
proper transmission flush procedure. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 04-06-01-029D
(Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
An Overview of Proper Vehicle Service
General Motors is aware that some companies are marketing tools and equipment to support a
subsystem flushing procedures. These dedicated machines are in addition to many engine oil,
cooling system, fuel system, A/C, transmission flush and steering system additives available to the
consumer. GM Vehicles under normal usage do not require any additional procedures or additives
beyond what is advised under the former Vehicle Maintenance Schedules or the current Simplified
Maintenance Schedules. Do not confuse machines available from Kent-Moore/SPX that are
designed to aid and accelerate the process of fluid changing with these flushing machines.
Engine Crankcase Flushing
General Motors Corporation does not endorse or recommend engine crankcase flushing for any of
its gasoline engines. Analysis of some of the aftermarket materials used for crankcase flushing
indicate incompatibility with GM engine components and the potential for damage to some engine
seals and bearings. Damage to engine components resulting from crankcase flushing IS NOT
COVERED under the terms of the New Vehicle Warranty.
GM Authorized Service Information: Detailed, Descriptive, and Complete
If a specific model vehicle or powertrain need is identified, GM will issue an Authorized Service
Document containing a procedure and, if required, provide, make available, or require the specific
use of a machine, tool or chemical to accomplish proper vehicle servicing. An example of this is
fuel injector cleaning. Due to variation in fuel quality in different areas of the country, GM has
recognized the need for fuel injector cleaning methods on some engines, though under normal
circumstances, this service is not part of the maintenance requirements.
GM has published several gasoline fuel injector cleaning bulletins that fully outline the methods to
be used in conjunction with GM Part Numbered solutions to accomplish proper and safe cleaning
of the fuel injectors with preventative maintenance suggestions to maintain optimum performance.
You may refer to Corporate Bulletin Numbers 03-06-04-030 and 04-06-04-051 for additional
information on this subject.
Subsystem Flushing
Flushing of A/C lines, radiators, transmission coolers, and power steering systems are recognized
practices to be performed after catastrophic failures or extreme corrosion when encountered in
radiators. For acceptable A/C flushing concerns, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 01-01-38-006.
This practice is NOT required or recommended for normal service operations.
The use of external transmission fluid exchange or flush machines is NOT recommended for the
automatic or manual transmission. Use of external machines to replace the fluid may affect the
operation or durability of the transmission. Transmission fluid should only be replaced by draining
and refilling following directions in SI. Refer to Automatic/Manual Transmission Fluid and Filter
Replacement.
Approved Transmission Flushing Tool (Transmission Cooler Only)
The Automatic Transmission Oil Cooler Flush and Flow Test Tool is recommended for GM
vehicles. Refer to Transmission Fluid Cooler Flushing and Flow Test in SI using the J 45096.
Service Is Important to You and Your Customer
General Motors takes great pride in offering our dealerships and customers high quality vehicles
that require extremely low maintenance over the life of the vehicle. This low cost of ownership
builds repeat sales and offers our customers measurable economy of operation against competing
vehicles.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Continuously Variable Transmission/Transaxle, CVT >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Continuously Variable
Transmission/Transaxle: > 04-06-01-029E > Apr > 10 > Vehicle - Engine Crankcase and Subsystems Flushing Info. > Page
4157
Providing responsible services at the proper intervals will greatly aid your dealership with repeat
business, and additional services when required. Most customers appreciate and gain trust in the
dealership that informs and offers them just what they need for continued trouble-free operation.
Examine your service department's practices and verify that all Service Consultants and
Technicians focus on customer satisfaction, vehicle inspections, and other products at time of
service. Use this opportunity to upgrade the services you provide to your customers. Here are a
few suggestions:
- Take the time required to align your dealership service practices with the new GM Simplified
Maintenance Schedule. Use the new vehicle Owner's Manual Maintenance I and II schedules to
create a "mirror image" in your advertising and dealer service pricing that is easily understandable
to your customer. Taking advantage of this new service strategy may greatly increase your
dealership service sales and customer retention while decreasing the frequency of visits and
inconvenience to your customer.
- Review your program to ensure that all vehicles coming in are evaluated for safety and wear
items. Examine all vehicles for tire condition, signs of misalignment, brake wear, exterior lamp
functionality, exhaust condition, A/C cooling performance, SRS or Air Bag MIL, along with Service
Engine Soon or Check Engine indicators. If the Service Engine Soon or Check Engine MIL is
illuminated, it is vital that you inform the customer of the concerns with ignoring the indicator and
what the required repair would cost. In addition to the possibility of increased emissions and
driveability concerns, many customers are unaware that lower gas mileage may also result, with
additional cost to the customer.
- Be complete in your service recommendations. Some sales opportunities are not being fully
pursued nationally. Focus on overlooked but required maintenance that has real benefits to the
customer. Many vehicles are equipped with cabin air filters. If these filters are used beyond
replacement time, they may impede airflow decreasing A/C and heating performance. Make sure
these filters are part of your recommended service. Note that some of our vehicles may not have
been factory equipped but will accept the filters as an accessory.
- Express the value in maintaining the finish quality of the customer's vehicle at the Maintenance I
and II visits. More fully utilize the vehicle prep personnel you already have in place. In today's
world, many people simply ignore the finish of their vehicle, at best infrequently using an automatic
car wash for exterior cleaning. Offer vehicle detailing services in stages from just a wash and wax
to a complete interior cleaning. When paired with the Simplified Maintenance visit, this will increase
customer satisfaction. On return, the customer gets a visibly improved vehicle that will be a source
of pride of ownership along with a vehicle that is now fully maintained. Also, reinforce the improved
resale value of a completely maintained vehicle.
- For customers who clean and maintain the appearance of their vehicles themselves encourage
the use of GM Vehicle Care products. Many customers may have never used GM Car Wash/Wax
Concentrate, GM Cleaner Wax or a longtime product, GM Glass Cleaner, which is a favorite of
many customers who try it just once. If your dealership give samples of these products with new
car purchases, customers may already be sold on the product but not willing to make a special trip
to the dealership. Capitalize on sales at this time. Stock shelves right at the Service counter with
these products and consider instituting compensation programs for Service Consultants who
suggest these products. Many consumers faced with an intimidating wall full of car care products
sold at local auto parts stores may find it comforting to purchase a fully tested product sold by GM
that they know will not harm the finish of their vehicle. We suggest these competitively priced basic
vehicle care products to emphasize:
In USA:
- #12378401 GM Vehicle Care Wash/Wax Concentrate 16 fl. oz. (0.473L)
- #89021822 GM Vehicle Care Glass Cleaner Aerosol 18 oz. (510 g)
- #12377966 GM Vehicle Care Cleaner Wax 16 fl. oz. (0.473L)
- #1052929 GM Vehicle Care Chrome and Wire Wheel Cleaner 16 fl. oz. (0.473L)
- #88861431 GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator 24 fl. oz. (0.710L)
In Canada:
- #10953203 GM Vehicle Care Wash & Wax Concentrate 473 mL
- #992727 GM Glass Cleaner Aerosol 500 g
- #10952905 GM Vehicle Care Liquid Cleaner/Wax 473 mL
- #10953013 GM Vehicle Care Chrome Cleaner and Polish 454 mL
- #10953202 GM Vehicle Care Wheel Brite 473 mL
- #88901678 GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator 473 mL
- Display signboards with the installed price for popular GM Accessories such as running boards
and Tonneau Covers. Customers may not think to ask about these desirable items at the time of a
service visit.
- Finally, take advantage of the GM Goodwrench initiatives (Tire Program, Goodwrench Credit
Card, etc. / Dealer Marketing Association (DMA) Promotions in Canada) to provide the customer
with more reasons to identify your dealership as the best place to go for parts and service.
Remember to utilize ALL of the service aspects you possess in your dealership to satisfy and
provide value to your customer. Many businesses exist profitably as an oil change location, a
vehicle repair facility, or a detailing shop alone. You already have the capabilities of all three and
provide these services with the inherent trust of your customer, under the GM Mark of Excellence.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Service and Repair > Cross Groove Design Front Axle
Constant Velocity Joint: Service and Repair Cross Groove Design Front Axle
Fig. 15 Cross Groove Inner Joint Seal Replacement. With Cross Groove Inner Joint.
For removal and installation procedures refer to Fig. 15 .
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Service and Repair > Cross Groove Design Front Axle > Page 4164
Constant Velocity Joint: Service and Repair Outer Constant Velocity Joint & Seal
Fig. 16 Outer Constant Velocity Joint Seal Replacement.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Service and Repair > Cross Groove Design Front Axle > Page 4165
Fig. 17 Outer Constant Velocity Joint.
For removal and installation procedures refer to Fig. 16 and 17 .
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Service and Repair > Cross Groove Design Front Axle > Page 4166
Constant Velocity Joint: Service and Repair Inner Tripot & Seal
Fig. 18 Inner Tripot Seal Replacement.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Service and Repair > Cross Groove Design Front Axle > Page 4167
Fig. 19 Inner Tripot Seal Replacement (Part 1 Of 2).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Service and Repair > Cross Groove Design Front Axle > Page 4168
Fig. 19 Inner Tripot Seal Replacement (Part 2 Of 2).
For removal and installation procedures, refer to Figs. 18 and 19 .
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint > Component Information > Service and Repair > Cross Groove Design Front Axle > Page 4169
Constant Velocity Joint: Service and Repair Deflector Ring
Fig. 20 Deflector Ring Replacement.
For removal and installation procedures, refer to Fig. 20 .
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Cross Groove Design Front Axle
Constant Velocity Joint Boot: Service and Repair Cross Groove Design Front Axle
Fig. 15 Cross Groove Inner Joint Seal Replacement. With Cross Groove Inner Joint.
For removal and installation procedures refer to Fig. 15 .
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Cross Groove Design Front Axle > Page
4174
Constant Velocity Joint Boot: Service and Repair Outer Constant Velocity Joint & Seal
Fig. 16 Outer Constant Velocity Joint Seal Replacement.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Cross Groove Design Front Axle > Page
4175
Fig. 17 Outer Constant Velocity Joint.
For removal and installation procedures refer to Fig. 16 and 17 .
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Cross Groove Design Front Axle > Page
4176
Constant Velocity Joint Boot: Service and Repair Inner Tripot & Seal
Fig. 18 Inner Tripot Seal Replacement.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Cross Groove Design Front Axle > Page
4177
Fig. 19 Inner Tripot Seal Replacement (Part 1 Of 2).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Cross Groove Design Front Axle > Page
4178
Fig. 19 Inner Tripot Seal Replacement (Part 2 Of 2).
For removal and installation procedures, refer to Figs. 18 and 19 .
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Axle Shaft Assembly >
Constant Velocity Joint Boot > Component Information > Service and Repair > Cross Groove Design Front Axle > Page
4179
Constant Velocity Joint Boot: Service and Repair Deflector Ring
Fig. 20 Deflector Ring Replacement.
For removal and installation procedures, refer to Fig. 20 .
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > By Symptom for Seals and Gaskets: > 477133 > Aug > 94 >
Axle Oil Seal, Right - Leaks at the Axle Tripod Shank
Seals and Gaskets: By Symptom Axle Oil Seal, Right - Leaks at the Axle Tripod Shank
Group Ref.: 7 - Transmission
Bulletin No.: 477133
Date: August, 1994
SUBJECT: RIGHT AXLE OIL SEAL LEAKS (INSTALL REVISED RIGHT AXLE OIL SEAL)
MODELS: 1992-93
BUICK RIVIERA
1992-94 BUICK CENTURY, PARK AVENUE, LE SABRE, SKYLARK AND REGAL
1992 CADILLAC ALLANTE
1992-93 CADILLAC FLEETWOOD (FWD), SIXTY SPECIAL, ELDORADO AND SEVILLE
1992-94 CADILLAC DE VILLE
1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, BERETTA, CORSICA, LUMINA AND LUMINA APV
1992 OLDSMOBILE TORONADO
1992-94 OLDSMOBILE CUTLASS CIERA, NINETY EIGHT, EIGHTY EIGHT, ACHIEVA,
CUTLASS SUPREME AND SILHOUETTE
1992-94 PONTIAC SUNBIRD, BONNEVILLE, GRAND AM, GRAND PRIX AND TRANS SPORT
TRANSAXLE APPLICATIONS: HYDRA-MATIC 3T40 (RPO MD9) HYDRA-MATIC 4T60 (RPO
ME9) HYDRA-MATIC 4T60-E (RPO M13)
TRANSAXLE MODELS: 1992-94 MODELS BUILT BEFORE JUNE 6, 1994 (JULIAN DATE 157)
CONDITION: Some owners may experience an oil leak that is diagnosed as a right axle oil seal
leak at the axle tripot shank.
CAUSE: This condition may be caused by inadequate seal contact to the axle tripot shank.
CORRECTION: A revised Right Axle Oil Seal was implemented in production to reduce the
potential for axle oil seal leaks and is available for service. The revised Right Axle Oil Seal extends
over the axle tripot shank an additional 2 mm (refer to Figure 1).
SERVICE INFORMATION: When Right Axle Oil Seal replacement is required on any 1992-1994
Hydra-Matic 3T40, 4T60 or 4T60-E transaxle, install the revised Right Axle Oil Seal listed under
"Service Parts Information". The previous Right Axle Oil Seal was blue in color. The revised Right
Axle Oil Seal is green.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > By Symptom for Seals and Gaskets: > 477133 > Aug > 94 >
Axle Oil Seal, Right - Leaks at the Axle Tripod Shank > Page 4188
IMPORTANT:
WHEN A DRIVE AXLE IS REMOVED FROM THE TRANSAXLE FOR ANY REASON, THE AXLE
SEALING SURFACE (TRIPOT SHANK) SHOULD BE INSPECTED FOR CORROSION. IF
CORROSION IS EVIDENT, THE SURFACE SHOULD BE CLEANED WITH 320 GRIT CLOTH OR
EQUIVALENT. AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID MAY BE USED TO CLEAN OFF ANY
REMAINING DEBRIS. THE SURFACE SHOULD BE WIPED DRY AND THE DRIVE AXLE
REINSTALLED FREE OF ANY BUILD UP.
SERVICE PARTS INFORMATION:
The table lists Left and Right Axle Oil Seal usage for all Hydra-matic 3T40, 4T60 and 4T60-E
transaxles:
PARTS INFORMATION: Parts are expected to be available on September 5, 1994.
WARRANTY INFORMATION: For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 477133
> Aug > 94 > Axle Oil Seal, Right - Leaks at the Axle Tripod Shank
Seals and Gaskets: All Technical Service Bulletins Axle Oil Seal, Right - Leaks at the Axle Tripod
Shank
Group Ref.: 7 - Transmission
Bulletin No.: 477133
Date: August, 1994
SUBJECT: RIGHT AXLE OIL SEAL LEAKS (INSTALL REVISED RIGHT AXLE OIL SEAL)
MODELS: 1992-93
BUICK RIVIERA
1992-94 BUICK CENTURY, PARK AVENUE, LE SABRE, SKYLARK AND REGAL
1992 CADILLAC ALLANTE
1992-93 CADILLAC FLEETWOOD (FWD), SIXTY SPECIAL, ELDORADO AND SEVILLE
1992-94 CADILLAC DE VILLE
1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, BERETTA, CORSICA, LUMINA AND LUMINA APV
1992 OLDSMOBILE TORONADO
1992-94 OLDSMOBILE CUTLASS CIERA, NINETY EIGHT, EIGHTY EIGHT, ACHIEVA,
CUTLASS SUPREME AND SILHOUETTE
1992-94 PONTIAC SUNBIRD, BONNEVILLE, GRAND AM, GRAND PRIX AND TRANS SPORT
TRANSAXLE APPLICATIONS: HYDRA-MATIC 3T40 (RPO MD9) HYDRA-MATIC 4T60 (RPO
ME9) HYDRA-MATIC 4T60-E (RPO M13)
TRANSAXLE MODELS: 1992-94 MODELS BUILT BEFORE JUNE 6, 1994 (JULIAN DATE 157)
CONDITION: Some owners may experience an oil leak that is diagnosed as a right axle oil seal
leak at the axle tripot shank.
CAUSE: This condition may be caused by inadequate seal contact to the axle tripot shank.
CORRECTION: A revised Right Axle Oil Seal was implemented in production to reduce the
potential for axle oil seal leaks and is available for service. The revised Right Axle Oil Seal extends
over the axle tripot shank an additional 2 mm (refer to Figure 1).
SERVICE INFORMATION: When Right Axle Oil Seal replacement is required on any 1992-1994
Hydra-Matic 3T40, 4T60 or 4T60-E transaxle, install the revised Right Axle Oil Seal listed under
"Service Parts Information". The previous Right Axle Oil Seal was blue in color. The revised Right
Axle Oil Seal is green.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Seals and Gaskets, Drive
Axles > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seals and Gaskets: > 477133
> Aug > 94 > Axle Oil Seal, Right - Leaks at the Axle Tripod Shank > Page 4194
IMPORTANT:
WHEN A DRIVE AXLE IS REMOVED FROM THE TRANSAXLE FOR ANY REASON, THE AXLE
SEALING SURFACE (TRIPOT SHANK) SHOULD BE INSPECTED FOR CORROSION. IF
CORROSION IS EVIDENT, THE SURFACE SHOULD BE CLEANED WITH 320 GRIT CLOTH OR
EQUIVALENT. AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID MAY BE USED TO CLEAN OFF ANY
REMAINING DEBRIS. THE SURFACE SHOULD BE WIPED DRY AND THE DRIVE AXLE
REINSTALLED FREE OF ANY BUILD UP.
SERVICE PARTS INFORMATION:
The table lists Left and Right Axle Oil Seal usage for all Hydra-matic 3T40, 4T60 and 4T60-E
transaxles:
PARTS INFORMATION: Parts are expected to be available on September 5, 1994.
WARRANTY INFORMATION: For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Specifications
Front Suspension
Hub and Bearing Assembly to Steering Knuckle Bolts
........................................................................................................................ 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Wheel Bearing Removal and Installation
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front Wheel Bearing Removal and Installation
FRONT WHEEL BEARINGS AND/OR HUB
Fig. 2 Modified Outer Seal Protector
Fig. 3 Removing And Installing Shaft Nut
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Remove tire and wheel assembly, then install modified outer seal
protector No. J 34754 or equivalent, Fig. 2. 3. Insert a drift punch through the rotor, Fig. 3 , then
remove axle shaft nut and washer. 4. Remove ball joint, then using tool No. J-28733-A, or
equivalent, disengage axle from hub and bearing assembly. 5. On all models, move axle shaft
inward, then remove caliper attaching bolts and support caliper. 6. Remove brake rotor, then hub
and bearing assembly attaching bolts. 7. Remove hub and bearing assembly.
INSTALLATION
1. Install hub and bearing assembly, tighten attaching bolts to specification. 2. Install hub and
bearing seal, then the brake rotor. 3. Install caliper, tighten attaching bolts to specification. 4. Move
axle shaft outward, then insert drift punch through rotor, Fig. 3. 5. Install washer and new shaft nut,
tighten shaft nut to specification. 6. Install ball joint, then remove drift punch and seal protector. 7.
Install tire and wheel assembly, then lower vehicle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Front Wheel Bearing Removal and Installation > Page 4200
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear
REAR HUB AND/OR BEARINGS
1. Raise and support vehicle, then remove wheel and tire assembly and brake drum.
CAUTION: Do not hammer brake drum since damage to bearing may result.
2. Remove four hub/bearing assembly to rear axle attaching bolts, then the hub/bearing assembly
from axle.
NOTE: The upper rear hub attaching bolt may not clear brake shoe when removing hub and
bearing assembly. Partially remove hub and bearing assembly prior to removing this bolt.
3. Reverse procedure to install. Torque hub attaching bolts to specification.
CAUTION: Use care not to drop hub/bearing assembly since damage to bearing may result.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive Axles, Bearings and Joints > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut >
Component Information > Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
Component ..........................................................................................................................................
....................................................... Torque/Ft. Lbs.
Axle Nut ...............................................................................................................................................
............................................................................ 184
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair
Drive/Propeller Shaft: Service and Repair
Fig. 7 Axle Shaft Nut Removal.
Fig. 8 Drive Axle Outer Joint Removal.
Fig. 9 Inner Axle Joint Replacement.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Drive/Propeller Shafts, Bearings and Joints > Drive/Propeller
Shaft > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 4209
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Raise and support vehicle, then remove wheel and tire
assembly. 3. Install drive axle seal protector tool No. J-34754, or equivalent, on outer joint. 4. Insert
a screwdriver or drift into caliper and rotor to prevent rotor from turning, then remove hub nut and
washer, Fig. 7 . 5. Remove lower ball joint cotter pin and nut, then loosen joint using remover tool
No. J-29330, or equivalent. If right axle is being removed, turn
wheel to left, if left axle is being removed, turn wheel to right.
6. Insert a prybar between suspension support and lower control arm and separate joint. 7. Using
puller tool No. J-28733-A, or equivalent, separate axle from hub and bearing, Fig. 8 . 8. Move strut
and knuckle assembly rearward. 9. Remove inner joint from transaxle or intermediate shaft (if
equipped) using puller tool No. J-28468 or J-33008 attached to tool Nos. J-29794 and
J-2619-01, or equivalents, Fig. 9 .
10. Remove drive axle from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Install seal protector tool No. J-37292-B, or equivalent, into transaxle. 2. Install drive axle into the
transaxle by placing a screwdriver into groove on joint housing and tapping until seated, Fig. 9 . 3.
Lubricate inside diameter of seal lips and completely fill cavity between hub and bearing assembly
and seal with chassis grease. 4. Install drive axle into hub and bearing assembly. 5. Attach lower
ball joint to knuckle and tighten to specification. 6. Install hub nut and washer, Fig. 7 . 7. Insert a
screwdriver or drift into caliper and rotor to prevent rotor from turning, then tighten axle nut to
specification. 8. Remove both seal protectors and install wheel and tire assembly. 9. Lower vehicle
and connect battery ground cable.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Flex Plate > Component Information > Specifications >
Tightening Specifications (Flex Plate to Converter)
Flex Plate: Specifications Tightening Specifications (Flex Plate to Converter)
Flywheel To Torque Converter ............................................................................................................
................................................................. 46 Ft. Lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Description and Operation
Shift Indicator: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
This lamp is used on most models equipped with manual transmission.
OPERATION
The Upshift lamp is illuminated to inform the driver of ideal shift points, with improved fuel economy
as the specific objective. When the light is illuminated, the transmission should be shifted to the
next highest gear, if driving conditions permit such an action.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps
and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4219
Shift Indicator: Service and Repair
If upshift indicator is not working properly, perform the following test. 1. Disconnect ECM connector
C1. 2. Place ignition switch in run. 3. Measure voltage at terminal A2 of ECM connector. 4. If
battery voltage is present, further ECM diagnosis is necessary. 5. If battery voltage is not present,
repair open circuit in brown/black wire, circuit 456.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Case, M/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Case: Specifications
Transaxle Case ...................................................................................................................................
..................................................................... 20 lbs. ft.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Differential, Manual
Transaxle > Differential Carrier Assembly, M/T > Carrier Pinion Shaft, M/T > Component Information > Specifications
Carrier Pinion Shaft: Specifications
Differential Pinion Gear Shaft ..............................................................................................................
................................................................... 17 lbs. ft.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Differential, Manual
Transaxle > Ring Gear, M/T > Component Information > Specifications
Ring Gear: Specifications
Differential Ring Gear ..........................................................................................................................
................................................................... 63 lbs. ft.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Drain Plug, M/T >
Component Information > Specifications
Drain Plug: Specifications
Drain Plug ............................................................................................................................................
................................................................... 18 lbs. ft.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Drain Plug, M/T >
Component Information > Locations > With NVG-T550 5 Speed Manual Transaxle
Drain Plug: Locations With NVG-T550 5 Speed Manual Transaxle
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Drain Plug, M/T >
Component Information > Locations > With NVG-T550 5 Speed Manual Transaxle > Page 4237
1 of 2
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Drain Plug, M/T >
Component Information > Locations > With NVG-T550 5 Speed Manual Transaxle > Page 4238
Drain Plug: Locations With Isuzu 76mm 5 Speed Manual Transaxle
Part 1 Of 2
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Drain Plug, M/T >
Component Information > Locations > With NVG-T550 5 Speed Manual Transaxle > Page 4239
Part 2 Of 2
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Fill Plug, M/T >
Component Information > Locations > With NVG-T550 5 Speed Manual Transaxle
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Fill Plug, M/T >
Component Information > Locations > With NVG-T550 5 Speed Manual Transaxle > Page 4244
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - M/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications
Fluid - M/T: Capacity Specifications
NVG-T550 5 Speed Manual Transaxle Fluid Capacity Approx. 2.0 liters 2.1 quarts
Isuzu 76mm 5 Speed Manual Transaxle Fluid Capacity Approx. 1.9 Liters 2.0 Quarts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - M/T > Component
Information > Specifications > Capacity Specifications > Page 4249
Fluid - M/T: Fluid Type Specifications
NVG-T550 5 Speed Manual Transaxle Fluid Type Synchromesh Transmission Fluid (GM Part No
12345349) or equivalent.
Isuzu 76mm 5 Speed Manual Transaxle Fluid Type Synchromesh Transmission Fluid (GM Part No
12345349) or equivalent.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - M/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > With Isuzu 76mm 5 Speed Manual Transaxle
Fluid - M/T: Service and Repair With Isuzu 76mm 5 Speed Manual Transaxle
FLUID LEVEL
INSPECT
^ Fluid level only when the engine is "OFF", the vehicle is level and the transaxle is cold. To check
the fluid level, remove and read the fluid level indicator. If it indicates "Add" or below, use
synchromesh transaxle fluid GM P/N 12345349 or equivalent lubricant to fill transaxle to the "Full"
level.
IMPORTANT: The fluid level indicator must be fully seated during vehicle operation or leakage will
occur at the vent plug.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Fluid - M/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > With Isuzu 76mm 5 Speed Manual Transaxle > Page 4252
Fluid - M/T: Service and Repair With NVG-T550 5 Speed Manual Transaxle
FLUID LEVEL
INSPECT
^ Fluid level only when the engine is "OFF", the vehicle is level and the transaxle is cold. To check
the fluid level, remove and read the fluid level indicator. If it indicates "Add" or below, use
synchromesh transaxle fluid GM P/N 12345349 or equivalent lubricant to fill transaxle to the "Full"
level.
IMPORTANT: The fluid level indicator must be fully seated during vehicle operation or leakage will
occur at the vent plug.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Gear, M/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Gear: Specifications
Input Gear Bearing Retainer ................................................................................................................
................................................................... 24 lbs. ft. End Plate To Gear Housing .............................
........................................................................................................................................................ 20
lbs. ft.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Reverse Gear Shaft >
Component Information > Specifications
Reverse Gear Shaft: Specifications
Reverse Idler Shaft ..............................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 21 lbs. ft.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shifter M/T > Component
Information > Specifications
Shifter M/T: Specifications
Shift Lever Nut .....................................................................................................................................
................................................................... 63 lbs. ft.
Select Lever Retainer ..........................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 17 lbs. ft.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, M/T > Shift
Cable, M/T > Component Information > Adjustments
Shift Cable: Adjustments
Fig. 4 Isuzu Five Speed Manual Transaxle Shift Cable Adjustment
Fig. 5 Muncie Five Speed Manual Transaxle Shift Cable Assembly
ISUZU
Refer to Fig. 4, for exploded view of shifter cables.
MUNCIE
Refer to Fig. 5 for exploded view of shifter cables.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Manual Transmission/Transaxle > Shift Linkage, M/T > Shift
Rail, M/T > Component Information > Specifications
Shift Rail: Specifications
Shift Rail Interlock Plate ......................................................................................................................
................................................................... 15 lbs. ft.
Reverse Shift Guide Rail Screw ..........................................................................................................
.................................................................... 44 lbs. ft.
Shift Shaft Detent Screw .....................................................................................................................
................................................................... 6-7 lbs. ft.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Brake Switch - TCC: Component Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page
4275
Brake Switch - TCC: Connector Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations > Page 4276
Harness Connector Faces: Brake Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Specifications
Pressure Switch ...................................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 8 Ft. Lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 4284
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page
4285
Harness Connector Faces: Park/Neutral Position Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page
4286
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Park/Neutral Switch (Auto. Trans)
PURPOSE:
The PARK/NEUTRAL (P/N) switch indicates to the computer when the transmission is in PARK or
NEUTRAL. This information is used by the ECM for Idle Air Control (IAC), Torque Converter Clutch
(TCC) and Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) operation.
OPERATION:
The P/N switch contacts are a part of the neutral switch and are closed to ground in park or neutral
and open in drive ranges and reverse. The ECM supplies ignition voltage through a current limiting
resistor to the switch and senses a closed circuit when voltage drops to less than 1 volt.
NOTE: DO NOT drive the vehicle with the PARK/NEUTRAL switch disconnected, since idle quality
may be affected.
LOCATION:
Top of transaxle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page
4287
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-1A
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain >
Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page
4288
Park/Neutral Position Switch Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Park/Neutral Position (PNP) switch contacts shown are a part of the Park/Neutral position
switch and are closed to ground in park or neutral, and open in drive ranges.
The PCM supplies ignition voltage through a pull up resistor to CKT 434 and senses a closed
switch when the voltage on CKT 434 drops to less than one volt.
The PCM uses the PNP signal as one of the inputs to control:
^ Idle speed.
^ VSS diagnostics.
^ EGR.
If CKT 434 indicates PNP (grounded), while in drive range, the EGR would be inoperative, resulting
in possible detonation.
If CKT 434 indicates drive (open) a sag in the idle may occur when the gear selector is moved into
drive range.
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. Checks for a closed switch to ground in park position. Different makes of scan toots will display
the PNP switch differently. Refer to tool
operator's manual for type of display used for a specific tool.
2. Checks for an open switch in drive range.
3. Be sure Tech 1 scan tool indicates drive, even while wiggling shifter, to test for an intermittent or
misadjusted switch in drive range.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Interlock Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 4296
Shift Interlock Solenoid: Connector Locations
Behind LH Side Of I/P
LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Shift Solenoid, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications
Shift Solenoid: Specifications
Intermediate Servo Cover ....................................................................................................................
................................................................... 8 Ft. Lbs. Solenoid To Valve Body ..................................
....................................................................................................................................................... 8
Ft. Lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4304
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4305
Harness Connector Faces: Automatic Transaxle (Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4306
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Description and Operation
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid
PURPOSE:
The Transmission Converter Clutch (TCC) feature eliminates the power loss of the torque
converter stage when the vehicle is in a cruise mode.
OPERATION:
The TCC system uses a solenoid operated valve in the automatic transmission to couple the
engine flexplate to the output shaft of the transaxle through the torque converter. This reduces the
slippage losses in the converter, which increases fuel economy. For the converter clutch to apply,
at least two conditions must be met.
1. Internal transmission fluid pressure must be correct.
2. The ECM/PCM completes a ground circuit to energize the TCC solenoid in the transmission,
which moves a check ball in the fluid line.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Solenoid
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Service and Repair Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Solenoid
TORQUE CONVERTER CLUTCH (TCC) SOLENOID & SWITCHES
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid & Switches
Auxiliary Valve Body, Valve Body And Oil Pump Assembly
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Solenoid > Page 4309
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Valve body cover. Refer to "Valve Body Cover". 2. Wiring harness from case electrical connector
and leads from pressure switch. 3. Torque converter clutch solenoid bolt to auxiliary valve body. 4.
3rd clutch pressure switch. 5. Second clutch switch, if applicable.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Second clutch switch, if applicable.
TIGHTEN
^ Switch to 11 Nm (97 lbs. in.).
2. 3rd clutch pressure switch.
TIGHTEN
^ Switch to 11 Nm (97 lbs. in.).
3. Torque converter clutch solenoid bolt to auxiliary valve body. Install new O-ring. 4. Wire harness
to case and switches. 5. Valve body cover with a new gasket.
ADJUST
^ Fluid level.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Solenoid > Page 4310
Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid: Service and Repair Valve Body Cover
VALVE BODY COVER
Side Cover And Control Valve View
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Raise vehicle and suitably support. 2. Drain oil. 3. Left front tire and wheel assembly. 4. Left
splash shield. 5. Valve body cover to transaxle bolts.
INSPECT
^ Bolts
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Valve body cover with a new gasket and bolts.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Actuators and Solenoids Transmission and Drivetrain > Actuators and Solenoids - A/T > Torque Converter Clutch Solenoid, A/T > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Solenoid > Page 4311
Valve Body Cover
NOTE: It is necessary to use GM thread locker (P/N 12345382) or equivalent non-locking sealant
to reduce the potential for fluid leaks on the indicated bolts.
2. Left splash shield. 3. Left front tire and wheel assembly. 4. Lower vehicle.
ADJUST:
^ Oil level.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Description and
Operation
Shift Indicator: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
This lamp is used on most models equipped with manual transmission.
OPERATION
The Upshift lamp is illuminated to inform the driver of ideal shift points, with improved fuel economy
as the specific objective. When the light is illuminated, the transmission should be shifted to the
next highest gear, if driving conditions permit such an action.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Lamps and Indicators Transmission and Drivetrain > Lamps and Indicators - A/T > Shift Indicator > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 4317
Shift Indicator: Service and Repair
If upshift indicator is not working properly, perform the following test. 1. Disconnect ECM connector
C1. 2. Place ignition switch in run. 3. Measure voltage at terminal A2 of ECM connector. 4. If
battery voltage is present, further ECM diagnosis is necessary. 5. If battery voltage is not present,
repair open circuit in brown/black wire, circuit 456.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Brake Switch - TCC: Component Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 4324
Brake Switch - TCC: Connector Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Brake Switch - TCC > Component Information > Locations >
Page 4325
Harness Connector Faces: Brake Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information >
Specifications
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Specifications
Pressure Switch ...................................................................................................................................
.................................................................... 8 Ft. Lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4333
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4334
Harness Connector Faces: Park/Neutral Position Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4335
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Description and Operation
Park/Neutral Switch (Auto. Trans)
PURPOSE:
The PARK/NEUTRAL (P/N) switch indicates to the computer when the transmission is in PARK or
NEUTRAL. This information is used by the ECM for Idle Air Control (IAC), Torque Converter Clutch
(TCC) and Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) operation.
OPERATION:
The P/N switch contacts are a part of the neutral switch and are closed to ground in park or neutral
and open in drive ranges and reverse. The ECM supplies ignition voltage through a current limiting
resistor to the switch and senses a closed circuit when voltage drops to less than 1 volt.
NOTE: DO NOT drive the vehicle with the PARK/NEUTRAL switch disconnected, since idle quality
may be affected.
LOCATION:
Top of transaxle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4336
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-1A
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Transmission and Drivetrain > Transmission Control Systems > Sensors and Switches Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component
Information > Locations > Page 4337
Park/Neutral Position Switch Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Park/Neutral Position (PNP) switch contacts shown are a part of the Park/Neutral position
switch and are closed to ground in park or neutral, and open in drive ranges.
The PCM supplies ignition voltage through a pull up resistor to CKT 434 and senses a closed
switch when the voltage on CKT 434 drops to less than one volt.
The PCM uses the PNP signal as one of the inputs to control:
^ Idle speed.
^ VSS diagnostics.
^ EGR.
If CKT 434 indicates PNP (grounded), while in drive range, the EGR would be inoperative, resulting
in possible detonation.
If CKT 434 indicates drive (open) a sag in the idle may occur when the gear selector is moved into
drive range.
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. Checks for a closed switch to ground in park position. Different makes of scan toots will display
the PNP switch differently. Refer to tool
operator's manual for type of display used for a specific tool.
2. Checks for an open switch in drive range.
3. Be sure Tech 1 scan tool indicates drive, even while wiggling shifter, to test for an intermittent or
misadjusted switch in drive range.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 415012 > Oct > 94 > ABS Warning Lamp ON,
DTC's 46 and 86 Set
ABS Light: Customer Interest ABS Warning Lamp ON, DTC's 46 and 86 Set
File In Section: 5 - Brakes Bulletin No.: 41-50-12 Date: October, 1994
Subject: Antilock Brake System (ABS)/Brake Warning Indicator Lamp On (Reprogram EBCM)
Models: 1993
Buick Skylark
1993 Chevrolet Beretta, Corsica
1993-1994 Chevrolet Cavalier
1993 Oldsmobile Achieva
1993 Pontiac Grand Am
1993-1994 Pontiac Sunbird
Condition
Some owners may experience an Antilock Brake System (ABS) indicator lamp or brake warning
lamp coming on prematurely. This may result in the combination of ABS diagnostic trouble codes
46 and 86 being set.
Correction
Reprogram EBCM using TECH 1 and cartridge.
The Service Technology Group has released a reprogramming procedure for servicing the
above-mentioned vehicles with the combination of ABS brake diagnostic trouble codes 46 and 86.
This procedure is available in the mass storage cartridge through a CD ROM software release. The
following criteria must be met before reprogramming the EBCM:
The combination of DTC 46 and 86 must be present in EBCM memory.
Only vehicles with verified DTC 46 and 86 can be reprogrammed.
Prior to reprogramming, if any diagnostic trouble codes other than 46 and 86 are present, proceed
to the vehicle's service manual, SECTION 5E1, for diagnosis of these codes first.
The information required to reprogram the EBCM properly will first be available in the September
1994 CD ROM release. After updating the TECH 1 cartridge and connecting the TECH 1 to the
vehicle, select "ABS VI REPRGM" from the Applications menu. The TECH 1 should display the
following...
The reprogramming process is started by pressing the "ENTER" key. The ignition key must be in
the "run" position (engine off) and the vehicle stopped for the reprogramming to take place. The
user is informed by the following screen that the test is in progress.
If the vehicle has previously been reprogrammed, it cannot be reprogrammed again, and the
following screens will be displayed on the TECH 1.
Press the "EXIT" key to continue if the above screen is displayed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 415012 > Oct > 94 > ABS Warning Lamp ON,
DTC's 46 and 86 Set > Page 4348
If the reprogramming is successful, the operator may hear the motors rehome and will see the
following screens displayed on the TECH 1:
Press the "EXIT" key to complete the reprogramming process. If any other problems are
encountered during reprogramming, the TECH 1 cartridge will notify the user appropriately.
After reprogramming, clear codes using the 1988-1995 Chassis selection of the Tech 1 Mass
Storage Cartridge.
WITH FOOT OFF BRAKE PEDAL, start the engine twice and allow it to run for at least 10 seconds
each time. If any codes return (including 46 and 86), proceed to the vehicle's service manual,
SECTION 5E1, for further diagnosis.
If there are any questions regarding the usage of this reprogramming procedure or diagnosis of the
ABS Vi brake system, please contact Delco Chassis Technical Assistance at 1-800-523-0203.
Warranty Information For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Labor Time
H 2504 0.2 Hours
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 415012 > Oct > 94 > ABS Warning
Lamp ON, DTC's 46 and 86 Set
ABS Light: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS Warning Lamp ON, DTC's 46 and 86 Set
File In Section: 5 - Brakes Bulletin No.: 41-50-12 Date: October, 1994
Subject: Antilock Brake System (ABS)/Brake Warning Indicator Lamp On (Reprogram EBCM)
Models: 1993
Buick Skylark
1993 Chevrolet Beretta, Corsica
1993-1994 Chevrolet Cavalier
1993 Oldsmobile Achieva
1993 Pontiac Grand Am
1993-1994 Pontiac Sunbird
Condition
Some owners may experience an Antilock Brake System (ABS) indicator lamp or brake warning
lamp coming on prematurely. This may result in the combination of ABS diagnostic trouble codes
46 and 86 being set.
Correction
Reprogram EBCM using TECH 1 and cartridge.
The Service Technology Group has released a reprogramming procedure for servicing the
above-mentioned vehicles with the combination of ABS brake diagnostic trouble codes 46 and 86.
This procedure is available in the mass storage cartridge through a CD ROM software release. The
following criteria must be met before reprogramming the EBCM:
The combination of DTC 46 and 86 must be present in EBCM memory.
Only vehicles with verified DTC 46 and 86 can be reprogrammed.
Prior to reprogramming, if any diagnostic trouble codes other than 46 and 86 are present, proceed
to the vehicle's service manual, SECTION 5E1, for diagnosis of these codes first.
The information required to reprogram the EBCM properly will first be available in the September
1994 CD ROM release. After updating the TECH 1 cartridge and connecting the TECH 1 to the
vehicle, select "ABS VI REPRGM" from the Applications menu. The TECH 1 should display the
following...
The reprogramming process is started by pressing the "ENTER" key. The ignition key must be in
the "run" position (engine off) and the vehicle stopped for the reprogramming to take place. The
user is informed by the following screen that the test is in progress.
If the vehicle has previously been reprogrammed, it cannot be reprogrammed again, and the
following screens will be displayed on the TECH 1.
Press the "EXIT" key to continue if the above screen is displayed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 415012 > Oct > 94 > ABS Warning
Lamp ON, DTC's 46 and 86 Set > Page 4354
If the reprogramming is successful, the operator may hear the motors rehome and will see the
following screens displayed on the TECH 1:
Press the "EXIT" key to complete the reprogramming process. If any other problems are
encountered during reprogramming, the TECH 1 cartridge will notify the user appropriately.
After reprogramming, clear codes using the 1988-1995 Chassis selection of the Tech 1 Mass
Storage Cartridge.
WITH FOOT OFF BRAKE PEDAL, start the engine twice and allow it to run for at least 10 seconds
each time. If any codes return (including 46 and 86), proceed to the vehicle's service manual,
SECTION 5E1, for further diagnosis.
If there are any questions regarding the usage of this reprogramming procedure or diagnosis of the
ABS Vi brake system, please contact Delco Chassis Technical Assistance at 1-800-523-0203.
Warranty Information For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Labor Time
H 2504 0.2 Hours
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for ABS Light: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec >
10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control
Modules
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D
Date: December 08, 2010
Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle
Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion
(Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Attention:
This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body
electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the
point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal
surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011
model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
- An intermittent no crank/no start
- Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination
- Intermittent service lamp illumination
- Intermittent service message(s) being displayed
The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as
fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector.
This may be caused by any of the following conditions:
- Vibration
- Thermal cycling
- Poor connection/terminal retention
- Micro motion
- A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement
On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent
connections.
On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and
may cause a device to become inoperative.
Representative List of Control Modules and Components
The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected
by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or
component for every vehicle.
- Blower Control Module
- Body Control Module (BCM)
- Communication Interface Module (CIM)
- Cooling Fan Control Module
- Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
- Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM)
- Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module
- Engine Control Module (ECM)
- Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for ABS Light: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec >
10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 4360
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for ABS Light: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec >
10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 4361
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for ABS Light: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec >
10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 4362
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for ABS Light: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct >
10 > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair
Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 10-08-45-001B
Date: October 25, 2010
Subject: Information for Electrical Ground Repair - Use New Replacement Fasteners with
Conductive Finish
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year and update the Warranty
Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-08-45-001A (Section 08 - Body and
Accessories).
Electrical Ground Repair Overview
Proper electrical system function relies on secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground
connections. Loose, stripped, or corroded connections increase the possibility of improper system
function and loss of module communication. These conditions may also lead to unnecessary
repairs and component replacement.
In general, electrical ground connections are accomplished using one, or a combination of the
following attachment methods:
- Welded M6 stud and nut
- Welded M6 nut and bolt
- Welded M8 nut and bolt
Determine which attachment method is used and perform the appropriate or alternative repair as
described in this bulletin.
M6 Weld Stud Replacement
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. Select a location adjacent the damaged or missing M6 ground stud having 20 mm (0.79 in)
clearance behind the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in)
clearance surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange.
2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site
and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
3. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel.
4. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is
visible.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for ABS Light: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct >
10 > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 4367
Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of
0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any
air gaps to ensure a good ground.
5. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit.
6. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool
(2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet
stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3).
7. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive
rivet stud. 8. Ensure the rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement. 9.
Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent.
Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the
installation of the ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable and
corrosion-free electrical ground.
10. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 11. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective
material applied to the rivet stud threads. 12. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet
stud threads. 13. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet
stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 14. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet
stud.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for ABS Light: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct >
10 > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 4368
15. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 16. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the rivet stud. 17. Select a M6
conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 18. Install the M6 conductive
nut to the rivet stud and:
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
19. Verify proper system operation.
M6 Weld Nut
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M6 weld nut at the electrical ground location is damaged or stripped, a M7 conductive
self-threading bolt may be used to secure the ground
wire terminal.
2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the weld nut and allow to dry. 3. Remove any loose metal particles from the damaged
or stripped weld nut with a stiff brush. 4. Select a M7 conductive self-threading bolt. Refer to the
Parts Information section of this bulletin 5. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N
12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M7 conductive self-threading
bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
6. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 7. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M7 conductive self-threading bolt.
8. Install the M7 conductive self-threading bolt and:
Tighten Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb in).
9. Verify proper system operation.
M6 Weld Nut Alternative Repair
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6 conductive bolt
and a M6 conductive nut may be used to secure
the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M6 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind
the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance
surrounding the new electrical ground site.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the ground location and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 8.5 mm (0.33 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the
area surrounding the 8.5 mm (0.33 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M6 conductive
bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M6 conductive bolt to the ground
location.
10. Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the
M6 conductive nut to the bolt and:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for ABS Light: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct >
10 > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 4369
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free
electrical ground.
12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation.
M8 Weld Nut
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M8
conductive bolt and a M8 conductive nut may be
used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this
bulletin.
2. Select a location adjacent the M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind the panel
surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance surrounding
the new electrical ground site.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the ground location and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the
area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M8 conductive
bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M8 conductive bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M8 conductive bolt to the ground
location.
10. Select a M8 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the
M8 conductive nut to the bolt and:
Tighten Tighten to 22 Nm (16 lb ft).
Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free
electrical ground.
12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation.
M8 Weld Nut Alternative Repair
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is not accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6
conductive rivet stud and a M6 conductive nut
may be used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal.
2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind
the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance
surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site
and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for ABS Light: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct >
10 > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 4370
5. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) until bare metal is
visible.
Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of
0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any
air gaps to ensure a good ground.
6. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit.
7. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool
(2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet
stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3).
8. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive
rivet stud. 9. Ensure the new rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement.
10. Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for ABS Light: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct >
10 > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 4371
Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the
installation of the electrical ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable
and corrosion-free electrical ground.
11. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 12. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective
material applied to the rivet stud threads. 13. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet
stud threads. 14. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet
stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 15. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet
stud.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
16. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 17. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M6 conductive rivet stud. 18.
Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 19. Install the M6
conductive nut to the rivet stud and:
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in)
20. Verify proper system operation.
Parts Information
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for ABS Light: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct >
10 > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 4372
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for ABS Light: > 06-08-45-004 > May > 06
> Electrical - Instrument Panel & General Wiring Repair
Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Instrument Panel & General Wiring
Repair
Bulletin No.: 06-08-45-004
Date: May 02, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Instrument Panel (I/P), Body and General Wiring Harness Repair
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Trucks 2003-2007 HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3
Important:
A part restriction has been implemented on all Body and I/P harnesses and is being administered
by the PQC. If a body or I/P harness replacement is required, it can take 12-28 weeks for a
harness to be built and delivered to a dealer. The dealer technician is expected to repair any
harness damage as the first and best choice before replacing a harness.
In an effort to standardize repair practices, General Motors is requiring that all wiring harnesses be
repaired instead of replaced. If there is a question concerning which connector and/or terminal you
are working on, refer to the information in the appropriate Connector End Views in SI. The
Instruction Manual J 38125-620, which is sent with each new update of the J 38125 Terminal
Repair Kit, also has terminal crimping and terminal remove information.
Important:
There are some parts in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit (i.e. SIR connector CPAs and heat shrink
tube (used in high heat area pigtail replacement) and some TPAs that are not available from
GMSPO. It is vitally important that each update to the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit be done as soon
as it arrives at the dealer.
Utilize the Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125) to achieve an effective wiring repair. The Terminal Repair
Kit has been an essential tool for all GM Dealers since 1987. Replacement terminals and tools for
this kit are available through SPX/Kent Moore. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 06-08-45-001
for more information.
The Instruction Manual J 38125-620, which is sent with each new update to the J 38125 Terminal
Repair Kit, also has terminal crimping and terminal removal information.
U.S. Dealers Only - Training courses (including Tech Assists, Emerging Issues, Web, IDL and
Hands-on) are available through the GM Training website. Refer to Resources and then Training
Materials for a complete list of available courses.
Canadian Dealers Only - Refer to the Training section of GM infoNet for a complete list of available
courses and a copy of the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit Instruction Manual.
Wiring repair information is also available in Service Information (SI). The Wiring Repair section
contains information for the following types of wiring repairs:
- Testing for intermittent conditions and poor conditions
- Flat wire repairs
- GMLAN wiring repairs
- High temperature wiring repairs
- Splicing copper wire using splice clips
- Splicing copper wire using splice sleeves
- Splicing twisted or shielded cable
- Splicing inline harness diodes
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for ABS Light: > 06-08-45-004 > May > 06
> Electrical - Instrument Panel & General Wiring Repair > Page 4377
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for ABS Light: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec >
10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 4383
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for ABS Light: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec >
10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 4384
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for ABS Light: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec >
10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 4385
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for ABS Light: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct >
10 > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 4390
Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of
0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any
air gaps to ensure a good ground.
5. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit.
6. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool
(2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet
stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3).
7. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive
rivet stud. 8. Ensure the rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement. 9.
Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent.
Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the
installation of the ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable and
corrosion-free electrical ground.
10. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 11. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective
material applied to the rivet stud threads. 12. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet
stud threads. 13. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet
stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 14. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet
stud.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for ABS Light: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct >
10 > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 4391
15. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 16. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the rivet stud. 17. Select a M6
conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 18. Install the M6 conductive
nut to the rivet stud and:
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
19. Verify proper system operation.
M6 Weld Nut
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M6 weld nut at the electrical ground location is damaged or stripped, a M7 conductive
self-threading bolt may be used to secure the ground
wire terminal.
2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the weld nut and allow to dry. 3. Remove any loose metal particles from the damaged
or stripped weld nut with a stiff brush. 4. Select a M7 conductive self-threading bolt. Refer to the
Parts Information section of this bulletin 5. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N
12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M7 conductive self-threading
bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
6. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 7. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M7 conductive self-threading bolt.
8. Install the M7 conductive self-threading bolt and:
Tighten Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb in).
9. Verify proper system operation.
M6 Weld Nut Alternative Repair
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6 conductive bolt
and a M6 conductive nut may be used to secure
the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M6 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind
the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance
surrounding the new electrical ground site.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the ground location and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 8.5 mm (0.33 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the
area surrounding the 8.5 mm (0.33 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M6 conductive
bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M6 conductive bolt to the ground
location.
10. Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the
M6 conductive nut to the bolt and:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for ABS Light: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct >
10 > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 4392
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free
electrical ground.
12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation.
M8 Weld Nut
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M8
conductive bolt and a M8 conductive nut may be
used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this
bulletin.
2. Select a location adjacent the M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind the panel
surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance surrounding
the new electrical ground site.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the ground location and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the
area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M8 conductive
bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M8 conductive bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M8 conductive bolt to the ground
location.
10. Select a M8 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the
M8 conductive nut to the bolt and:
Tighten Tighten to 22 Nm (16 lb ft).
Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free
electrical ground.
12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation.
M8 Weld Nut Alternative Repair
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is not accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6
conductive rivet stud and a M6 conductive nut
may be used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal.
2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind
the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance
surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site
and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for ABS Light: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct >
10 > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 4393
5. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) until bare metal is
visible.
Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of
0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any
air gaps to ensure a good ground.
6. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit.
7. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool
(2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet
stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3).
8. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive
rivet stud. 9. Ensure the new rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement.
10. Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for ABS Light: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct >
10 > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 4394
Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the
installation of the electrical ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable
and corrosion-free electrical ground.
11. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 12. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective
material applied to the rivet stud threads. 13. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet
stud threads. 14. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet
stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 15. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet
stud.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
16. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 17. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M6 conductive rivet stud. 18.
Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 19. Install the M6
conductive nut to the rivet stud and:
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in)
20. Verify proper system operation.
Parts Information
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for ABS Light: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct >
10 > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 4395
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for ABS Light: > 06-08-45-004 > May > 06
> Electrical - Instrument Panel & General Wiring Repair > Page 4400
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Anti-Lock Warning Lamp
ABS Light: Description and Operation Anti-Lock Warning Lamp
DESCRIPTION
This lamp will be illuminated when the ignition switch is placed in the ON position. The lamp may
be illuminated for as long as 30 seconds as a bulb and system check. If lamp remains illuminated
or comes on while operating the vehicle, a problem in the anti-lock brake system is indicated.
OPERATION
When lamp is illuminated, place ignition switch in OFF position, then restart engine. If lamp still
remains illuminated, the antilock brake system should be serviced. The brake system will remain
functional, but without the anti-lock function. After servicing the anti-lock brake system the lamp will
automatically reset.
NOTE: On some models it may be necessary to operate vehicle at a speed over 18 mph to reset
lamp.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Anti-Lock Warning Lamp > Page 4403
ABS Light: Description and Operation Anti-Lock Warning Lamp (Amber)
DESCRIPTION
The ABS warning light operates on a signal it receives from the EBCM/EBTCM. If the
EBCM/EBTCM detects a fault that does not interfere immediately with ABS operation, the ABS
warning lamp will flash. However, ABS operation will continue. If the EBCM/EBTCM detects a fault
that does interfere with ABS operation, the ABS warning lamp will stay lit and ABS operation will be
suspended until the fault is repaired. In any case, the warning lamp is indicating that the system be
serviced as soon as possible.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Light >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Anti-Lock Warning Lamp > Page 4404
ABS Light: Description and Operation Anti-Lock Warning Lamp (Red)
DESCRIPTION
This warning lamp can be activated by a low brake fluid condition, a closed parking brake switch, a
bulb test switch section of the ignition switch is closed or under the control of the EBCM/EBTCM
when certain ABS diagnostic trouble codes are set.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Main
Relay > Component Information > Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Main
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 4408
Harness Connector Faces: Electronic Brake Control Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Actuator
Motor <--> [Brake Fluid Pump] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for ABS Actuator
Motor: > 535010 > May > 95 > ABS - Lamp ON/DTC's 42 and 86 Set
ABS Actuator Motor: Customer Interest ABS - Lamp ON/DTC's 42 and 86 Set
FILE IN SECTION: 5 - Brakes
BULLETIN NO.: 53-50-10
DATE: May, 1995
SUBJECT: Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Light On - Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) 42 and 86
Set (Replace Hydraulic Modulator)
MODELS: 1993-95
Buick Skylark
1993-95 Chevrolet Beretta, Corsica, Cavalier
1993-95 Oldsmobile Achieva
1993-95 Pontiac Grand Am
1993-94 Pontiac Sunbird
1995 Pontiac Sunfire
CONDITION
Some owners may comment that the Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) light remains on. Diagnostic
Trouble Codes (DTC's) 42 and 86 will be set. DTC's will usually set 5 to 8 drive cycles in a row and
then become history codes.
CAUSE
DTC's will be set due to a momentary delay within the ABS hydraulic modulator.
CORRECTION
Important:
If DTC 42 is current DTC, the Diagnostic Trouble Tree in Section 5E1 of the Service Manual will
lead to replacement of the motor pack. If the following diagnosis does not lead to replacement of
the hydraulic modulator, then the motor pack should be replaced.
Diagnosis
^ If DTC 42 has set 10 or less drive cycles and is no longer a current code (ABS not operating,
ABS indicator off), replace the hydraulic modulator.
^ If DTC is current, cycle the system by starting the engine with your foot off the brake pedal. If the
ABS indicator remains on, turn the ignition off and repeat the procedure. If within 10 cycles the ABS
indicator is off and the code is no longer current, replace the hydraulic modulator.
^ If the above diagnosis does not lead to replacement of the modulator, follow DTC 42 Trouble
Tree in Section 5E1 of the Service Manual.
Repair Procedure
If the condition is confirmed through the above diagnosis, the hydraulic modulator must be
replaced, P/N 18023364. This is a new part number that has been released. Do not use previously
released hydraulic modulator part numbers. Refer to Section 5E1 of the Service Manual for
hydraulic modulator replacement procedure.
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor
Operation Labor Time
H2518 Use published labor operation time.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Actuator
Motor <--> [Brake Fluid Pump] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
ABS Actuator Motor: > 535010 > May > 95 > ABS - Lamp ON/DTC's 42 and 86 Set
ABS Actuator Motor: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS - Lamp ON/DTC's 42 and 86 Set
FILE IN SECTION: 5 - Brakes
BULLETIN NO.: 53-50-10
DATE: May, 1995
SUBJECT: Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Light On - Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) 42 and 86
Set (Replace Hydraulic Modulator)
MODELS: 1993-95
Buick Skylark
1993-95 Chevrolet Beretta, Corsica, Cavalier
1993-95 Oldsmobile Achieva
1993-95 Pontiac Grand Am
1993-94 Pontiac Sunbird
1995 Pontiac Sunfire
CONDITION
Some owners may comment that the Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) light remains on. Diagnostic
Trouble Codes (DTC's) 42 and 86 will be set. DTC's will usually set 5 to 8 drive cycles in a row and
then become history codes.
CAUSE
DTC's will be set due to a momentary delay within the ABS hydraulic modulator.
CORRECTION
Important:
If DTC 42 is current DTC, the Diagnostic Trouble Tree in Section 5E1 of the Service Manual will
lead to replacement of the motor pack. If the following diagnosis does not lead to replacement of
the hydraulic modulator, then the motor pack should be replaced.
Diagnosis
^ If DTC 42 has set 10 or less drive cycles and is no longer a current code (ABS not operating,
ABS indicator off), replace the hydraulic modulator.
^ If DTC is current, cycle the system by starting the engine with your foot off the brake pedal. If the
ABS indicator remains on, turn the ignition off and repeat the procedure. If within 10 cycles the ABS
indicator is off and the code is no longer current, replace the hydraulic modulator.
^ If the above diagnosis does not lead to replacement of the modulator, follow DTC 42 Trouble
Tree in Section 5E1 of the Service Manual.
Repair Procedure
If the condition is confirmed through the above diagnosis, the hydraulic modulator must be
replaced, P/N 18023364. This is a new part number that has been released. Do not use previously
released hydraulic modulator part numbers. Refer to Section 5E1 of the Service Manual for
hydraulic modulator replacement procedure.
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor
Operation Labor Time
H2518 Use published labor operation time.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Actuator
Motor <--> [Brake Fluid Pump] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4422
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > ABS Actuator
Motor <--> [Brake Fluid Pump] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4423
Harness Connector Faces: ABS Actuator Motor Assembly
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Brake Fluid
Solenoid Valve Relay > Component Information > Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Diagnostic
Connector - ABS > Component Information > Locations
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Electronic Brake
Control Module: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 & C1286)
Electronic Brake Control Module: Customer Interest Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246
& C1286)
File In Section: 5 - Brakes
Bulletin No.: 73-50-26
Date: August, 1997
Subject: ABS Light On - DTC's 46 and 86 Set (Perform Diagnostic Procedure, Replace Center ABS
Motor Pinion)
Models: 1991-97 Buick Skylark 1992-97 Buick Regal 1994-97 Buick Century 1992-96 Chevrolet
Beretta, Corsica, Lumina APV 1992-97 Chevrolet Cavalier, Lumina, 1993-97 Chevrolet Camaro
1995-97 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 1997
Chevrolet Malibu, Venture
1993-97 Geo Prizm 1995-97 Geo Metro 1996-97 Geo Tracker 1991
Oldsmobile Calais
1992-96 Oldsmobile Cutlass Ciera 1992-97 Oldsmobile Achieva, Cutlass Supreme, Silhouette
1997
Oldsmobile Cutlass
1998 Oldsmobile Intrigue
1991-97 Pontiac Grand Am 1992-94 Pontiac Sunbird 1992-97 Pontiac Grand Prix, Trans Sport
1993-97 Pontiac Firebird, Trans Am 1995-97 Pontiac Sunfire
Condition
Some owners may comment that the ABS light is on with Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) 46
and 86 set (rear ABS channel will not move) as current or history. (DTC's 46 and 86 will be
displayed as C1246 and C1286 on 1997 and 1998 model year vehicles).
Cause
A condition exists where the ABS motor pack gear (pinion) will bind on the motor armature shaft
causing the motor not to move when commanded by the EBCM. This condition is aggravated by
light corrosion between the pinion and shaft. Therefore, it may occur more frequently when the
weather is hot and humid.
Important:
Other EBCM and ABS motor pack concerns can also cause this condition, but they are not as
common as the above cause.
Correction
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Electronic Brake
Control Module: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 & C1286) > Page 4438
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Electronic Brake
Control Module: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 & C1286) > Page 4439
Follow the included procedure (Attachments 1 and 2) for diagnosis. This condition may correct
itself before the owner is able to bring the vehicle in for service. Therefore, if DTC 46 is set in
history, and is not currently setting, the included procedure will instruct you to replace the center
ABS motor pinion. The new pinion has a Teflon insert which reduces friction between the pinion
and motor armature shaft.
Pinion Replacement
If the included procedure instructs you to replace the center ABS motor pinion, use P/N 18029776.
Please note that the new pinion is a direct replacement part which requires no modifications to the
motor shaft. Follow the pinion replacement procedure included with the new pinion. Complete
motor pack replacement is not required.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Labor Time
H2506 Use published labor
operation time.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Electronic
Brake Control Module: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 & C1286)
Electronic Brake Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 &
86 (C1246 & C1286)
File In Section: 5 - Brakes
Bulletin No.: 73-50-26
Date: August, 1997
Subject: ABS Light On - DTC's 46 and 86 Set (Perform Diagnostic Procedure, Replace Center ABS
Motor Pinion)
Models: 1991-97 Buick Skylark 1992-97 Buick Regal 1994-97 Buick Century 1992-96 Chevrolet
Beretta, Corsica, Lumina APV 1992-97 Chevrolet Cavalier, Lumina, 1993-97 Chevrolet Camaro
1995-97 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 1997
Chevrolet Malibu, Venture
1993-97 Geo Prizm 1995-97 Geo Metro 1996-97 Geo Tracker 1991
Oldsmobile Calais
1992-96 Oldsmobile Cutlass Ciera 1992-97 Oldsmobile Achieva, Cutlass Supreme, Silhouette
1997
Oldsmobile Cutlass
1998 Oldsmobile Intrigue
1991-97 Pontiac Grand Am 1992-94 Pontiac Sunbird 1992-97 Pontiac Grand Prix, Trans Sport
1993-97 Pontiac Firebird, Trans Am 1995-97 Pontiac Sunfire
Condition
Some owners may comment that the ABS light is on with Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) 46
and 86 set (rear ABS channel will not move) as current or history. (DTC's 46 and 86 will be
displayed as C1246 and C1286 on 1997 and 1998 model year vehicles).
Cause
A condition exists where the ABS motor pack gear (pinion) will bind on the motor armature shaft
causing the motor not to move when commanded by the EBCM. This condition is aggravated by
light corrosion between the pinion and shaft. Therefore, it may occur more frequently when the
weather is hot and humid.
Important:
Other EBCM and ABS motor pack concerns can also cause this condition, but they are not as
common as the above cause.
Correction
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Electronic
Brake Control Module: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 & C1286) > Page 4445
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Electronic
Brake Control Module: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 & C1286) > Page 4446
Follow the included procedure (Attachments 1 and 2) for diagnosis. This condition may correct
itself before the owner is able to bring the vehicle in for service. Therefore, if DTC 46 is set in
history, and is not currently setting, the included procedure will instruct you to replace the center
ABS motor pinion. The new pinion has a Teflon insert which reduces friction between the pinion
and motor armature shaft.
Pinion Replacement
If the included procedure instructs you to replace the center ABS motor pinion, use P/N 18029776.
Please note that the new pinion is a direct replacement part which requires no modifications to the
motor shaft. Follow the pinion replacement procedure included with the new pinion. Complete
motor pack replacement is not required.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Labor Time
H2506 Use published labor
operation time.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Antilock Brake Module
Electronic Brake Control Module: Locations Antilock Brake Module
Fig. 1 TYPICAL ABS Components
Refer to Fig. 1 for system component locations.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Antilock Brake Module > Page 4449
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1
Electronic Brake Control Module: Diagrams C1
Harness Connector Faces: Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)- C1
Harness Connector Faces: Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)- C1 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 > Page 4452
Electronic Brake Control Module: Diagrams C2
Harness Connector Faces: Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)- C2
Harness Connector Faces: Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)- C2 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 > Page 4453
Electronic Brake Control Module: Diagrams C3
Harness Connector Faces: Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)- C3
Harness Connector Faces: Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)- C3 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4454
Electronic Brake Control Module: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The ABS system is controlled by a microprocessor based Electronic Brake Control Module
(EBCM). Inputs to the system include four wheel speed sensors, brakes, ignition switch and
unswitched battery voltage. Outputs include three bi-directional motor controls, three lamp controls,
two solenoid controls and the system enable relay. A serial data line, located in terminal 9 of the
Data Link Connector (DLC), is provided for service diagnostic tools and assembly plant testing.
The EBCM monitors the speed of each wheel. If any wheel begins to approach lock-up and the
brake switch is on, the EBCM controls the motors and solenoids to reduce brake pressure to the
wheel approaching lock-up. Once the wheel regains traction, brake pressure is increased until
wheel begins to approach lock-up. This cycle repeats until either vehicle comes to a stop, the brake
is released or no wheels approach lock-up. Additionally, the EBCM monitors itself, each input and
each output for proper operation. If any system fault is detected, the EBCM will store a DTC in
nonvolatile memory.
On a EBTCM, the ABS portion of the module operates the same as a EBCM. A EBTCM is used if
the vehicle is equipped with either the Enhanced Traction System (ETS) or Traction Control
System (TCS). The ETS or TCS portion of the EBTCM monitors wheel spin slip through the drive
wheels speed sensors. If the wheels begin to slip, the EBTCM determines the desired wheel torque
needed to minimize wheel slip. This information is sent to the PCM through the Serial data link. On
models equipped w/ETS, the PCM controls engine torque by ignition retard and transmission shifts.
On models equipped w/TCS, the PCM controls engine torque by ignition retard, transmission shifts
and applies brakes several times until the vehicle regains traction. Once the vehicle regains
traction, brake pressure is decreased and engine torque reduction is no longer requested. This
cycle repeats until traction control is no longer necessary.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Electronic
Brake Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4455
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
Fig. 800 EBCM Assembly Removal.
1. Disconnect EBCM electrical connectors, Fig.800. 2. Remove ECU to dash panel attaching
screws, then the ECU from dash panel. 3. Reverse procedure to install, noting the following:
a. Ensure plastic grommets, if equipped, are located properly. b. Bleed brake system as described
under Brake System Bleed. See: Brake Bleeding
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Assembly, Traction Control > Component Information > Description and Operation
Hydraulic Assembly: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The ABS hydraulic modulator/motor pack assembly controls hydraulic pressure to front and rear
calipers or rear wheel cylinders by modulating hydraulic pressure to prevent wheel lock-up.
The basic ABS hydraulic modulator configuration consists of gear subassemblies, ball screws,
nuts, pistons and hydraulic check valves. The ABS motor pack consists of three motors, three drive
gears and three ESB's.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 &
C1286)
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Customer Interest Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 &
86 (C1246 & C1286)
File In Section: 5 - Brakes
Bulletin No.: 73-50-26
Date: August, 1997
Subject: ABS Light On - DTC's 46 and 86 Set (Perform Diagnostic Procedure, Replace Center ABS
Motor Pinion)
Models: 1991-97 Buick Skylark 1992-97 Buick Regal 1994-97 Buick Century 1992-96 Chevrolet
Beretta, Corsica, Lumina APV 1992-97 Chevrolet Cavalier, Lumina, 1993-97 Chevrolet Camaro
1995-97 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 1997
Chevrolet Malibu, Venture
1993-97 Geo Prizm 1995-97 Geo Metro 1996-97 Geo Tracker 1991
Oldsmobile Calais
1992-96 Oldsmobile Cutlass Ciera 1992-97 Oldsmobile Achieva, Cutlass Supreme, Silhouette
1997
Oldsmobile Cutlass
1998 Oldsmobile Intrigue
1991-97 Pontiac Grand Am 1992-94 Pontiac Sunbird 1992-97 Pontiac Grand Prix, Trans Sport
1993-97 Pontiac Firebird, Trans Am 1995-97 Pontiac Sunfire
Condition
Some owners may comment that the ABS light is on with Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) 46
and 86 set (rear ABS channel will not move) as current or history. (DTC's 46 and 86 will be
displayed as C1246 and C1286 on 1997 and 1998 model year vehicles).
Cause
A condition exists where the ABS motor pack gear (pinion) will bind on the motor armature shaft
causing the motor not to move when commanded by the EBCM. This condition is aggravated by
light corrosion between the pinion and shaft. Therefore, it may occur more frequently when the
weather is hot and humid.
Important:
Other EBCM and ABS motor pack concerns can also cause this condition, but they are not as
common as the above cause.
Correction
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 &
C1286) > Page 4467
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 &
C1286) > Page 4468
Follow the included procedure (Attachments 1 and 2) for diagnosis. This condition may correct
itself before the owner is able to bring the vehicle in for service. Therefore, if DTC 46 is set in
history, and is not currently setting, the included procedure will instruct you to replace the center
ABS motor pinion. The new pinion has a Teflon insert which reduces friction between the pinion
and motor armature shaft.
Pinion Replacement
If the included procedure instructs you to replace the center ABS motor pinion, use P/N 18029776.
Please note that the new pinion is a direct replacement part which requires no modifications to the
motor shaft. Follow the pinion replacement procedure included with the new pinion. Complete
motor pack replacement is not required.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Labor Time
H2506 Use published labor
operation time.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: > 535010 > May > 95 > ABS - Lamp ON/DTC's 42 and 86 Set
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Customer Interest ABS - Lamp ON/DTC's 42 and 86
Set
FILE IN SECTION: 5 - Brakes
BULLETIN NO.: 53-50-10
DATE: May, 1995
SUBJECT: Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Light On - Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) 42 and 86
Set (Replace Hydraulic Modulator)
MODELS: 1993-95
Buick Skylark
1993-95 Chevrolet Beretta, Corsica, Cavalier
1993-95 Oldsmobile Achieva
1993-95 Pontiac Grand Am
1993-94 Pontiac Sunbird
1995 Pontiac Sunfire
CONDITION
Some owners may comment that the Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) light remains on. Diagnostic
Trouble Codes (DTC's) 42 and 86 will be set. DTC's will usually set 5 to 8 drive cycles in a row and
then become history codes.
CAUSE
DTC's will be set due to a momentary delay within the ABS hydraulic modulator.
CORRECTION
Important:
If DTC 42 is current DTC, the Diagnostic Trouble Tree in Section 5E1 of the Service Manual will
lead to replacement of the motor pack. If the following diagnosis does not lead to replacement of
the hydraulic modulator, then the motor pack should be replaced.
Diagnosis
^ If DTC 42 has set 10 or less drive cycles and is no longer a current code (ABS not operating,
ABS indicator off), replace the hydraulic modulator.
^ If DTC is current, cycle the system by starting the engine with your foot off the brake pedal. If the
ABS indicator remains on, turn the ignition off and repeat the procedure. If within 10 cycles the ABS
indicator is off and the code is no longer current, replace the hydraulic modulator.
^ If the above diagnosis does not lead to replacement of the modulator, follow DTC 42 Trouble
Tree in Section 5E1 of the Service Manual.
Repair Procedure
If the condition is confirmed through the above diagnosis, the hydraulic modulator must be
replaced, P/N 18023364. This is a new part number that has been released. Do not use previously
released hydraulic modulator part numbers. Refer to Section 5E1 of the Service Manual for
hydraulic modulator replacement procedure.
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor
Operation Labor Time
H2518 Use published labor operation time.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 &
C1286)
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - ABS Light
ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 & C1286)
File In Section: 5 - Brakes
Bulletin No.: 73-50-26
Date: August, 1997
Subject: ABS Light On - DTC's 46 and 86 Set (Perform Diagnostic Procedure, Replace Center ABS
Motor Pinion)
Models: 1991-97 Buick Skylark 1992-97 Buick Regal 1994-97 Buick Century 1992-96 Chevrolet
Beretta, Corsica, Lumina APV 1992-97 Chevrolet Cavalier, Lumina, 1993-97 Chevrolet Camaro
1995-97 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 1997
Chevrolet Malibu, Venture
1993-97 Geo Prizm 1995-97 Geo Metro 1996-97 Geo Tracker 1991
Oldsmobile Calais
1992-96 Oldsmobile Cutlass Ciera 1992-97 Oldsmobile Achieva, Cutlass Supreme, Silhouette
1997
Oldsmobile Cutlass
1998 Oldsmobile Intrigue
1991-97 Pontiac Grand Am 1992-94 Pontiac Sunbird 1992-97 Pontiac Grand Prix, Trans Sport
1993-97 Pontiac Firebird, Trans Am 1995-97 Pontiac Sunfire
Condition
Some owners may comment that the ABS light is on with Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) 46
and 86 set (rear ABS channel will not move) as current or history. (DTC's 46 and 86 will be
displayed as C1246 and C1286 on 1997 and 1998 model year vehicles).
Cause
A condition exists where the ABS motor pack gear (pinion) will bind on the motor armature shaft
causing the motor not to move when commanded by the EBCM. This condition is aggravated by
light corrosion between the pinion and shaft. Therefore, it may occur more frequently when the
weather is hot and humid.
Important:
Other EBCM and ABS motor pack concerns can also cause this condition, but they are not as
common as the above cause.
Correction
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 &
C1286) > Page 4478
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 &
C1286) > Page 4479
Follow the included procedure (Attachments 1 and 2) for diagnosis. This condition may correct
itself before the owner is able to bring the vehicle in for service. Therefore, if DTC 46 is set in
history, and is not currently setting, the included procedure will instruct you to replace the center
ABS motor pinion. The new pinion has a Teflon insert which reduces friction between the pinion
and motor armature shaft.
Pinion Replacement
If the included procedure instructs you to replace the center ABS motor pinion, use P/N 18029776.
Please note that the new pinion is a direct replacement part which requires no modifications to the
motor shaft. Follow the pinion replacement procedure included with the new pinion. Complete
motor pack replacement is not required.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Labor Time
H2506 Use published labor
operation time.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins
for Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: > 535010 > May > 95 > ABS - Lamp ON/DTC's 42 and 86 Set
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS - Lamp
ON/DTC's 42 and 86 Set
FILE IN SECTION: 5 - Brakes
BULLETIN NO.: 53-50-10
DATE: May, 1995
SUBJECT: Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Light On - Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) 42 and 86
Set (Replace Hydraulic Modulator)
MODELS: 1993-95
Buick Skylark
1993-95 Chevrolet Beretta, Corsica, Cavalier
1993-95 Oldsmobile Achieva
1993-95 Pontiac Grand Am
1993-94 Pontiac Sunbird
1995 Pontiac Sunfire
CONDITION
Some owners may comment that the Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) light remains on. Diagnostic
Trouble Codes (DTC's) 42 and 86 will be set. DTC's will usually set 5 to 8 drive cycles in a row and
then become history codes.
CAUSE
DTC's will be set due to a momentary delay within the ABS hydraulic modulator.
CORRECTION
Important:
If DTC 42 is current DTC, the Diagnostic Trouble Tree in Section 5E1 of the Service Manual will
lead to replacement of the motor pack. If the following diagnosis does not lead to replacement of
the hydraulic modulator, then the motor pack should be replaced.
Diagnosis
^ If DTC 42 has set 10 or less drive cycles and is no longer a current code (ABS not operating,
ABS indicator off), replace the hydraulic modulator.
^ If DTC is current, cycle the system by starting the engine with your foot off the brake pedal. If the
ABS indicator remains on, turn the ignition off and repeat the procedure. If within 10 cycles the ABS
indicator is off and the code is no longer current, replace the hydraulic modulator.
^ If the above diagnosis does not lead to replacement of the modulator, follow DTC 42 Trouble
Tree in Section 5E1 of the Service Manual.
Repair Procedure
If the condition is confirmed through the above diagnosis, the hydraulic modulator must be
replaced, P/N 18023364. This is a new part number that has been released. Do not use previously
released hydraulic modulator part numbers. Refer to Section 5E1 of the Service Manual for
hydraulic modulator replacement procedure.
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor
Operation Labor Time
H2518 Use published labor operation time.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly
Removal and Instalation
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Service and Repair Hydraulic Modulator Assembly
Removal and Instalation
HYDRAULIC MODULATOR-MASTER CYLINDER ASSEMBLY
CAUTION:To help avoid personal injury, due to a retained load on the hydraulic modulator, the
gear tension relief function of the Tech 1 must be performed prior to removal of the ABS hydraulic
modulator/master cylinder assembly.
Remove or Disconnect
1. Using Tech 1, perform "Gear Tension Relief Sequence".
2. Two solenoid electrical connectors. 3. Fluid level sensor electrical connector. 4. 6-way ABS
motor pack electrical connector. 5. Four brakes pipes. 6. Two nuts attaching ABS hydraulic
modulator/master cylinder assembly to vacuum booster. 7. ABS hydraulic modulator/master
cylinder assembly.
Install or Connect
1. ABS hydraulic modulator/master cylinder assembly in vehicle. 2. Two nuts attaching ABS
hydraulic modulator/master cylinder assembly to vacuum booster
Tighten ^
Nuts to 27 N.m (20 lb. ft.).
3. Four brake pipes to ABS hydraulic modulator/master cylinder assembly. 4. ABS motor pack
6-way electrical connector. 5. Fluid level sensor electrical connector. 6. Two solenoid electrical
connectors.
Important
7. Bleed hydraulic system.
Tighten ^
Tube nuts to 24 N.m (18 lb. ft.).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly
Removal and Instalation > Page 4486
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Service and Repair Hydraulic Modulator Assembly
Unit Repair
Gear Tension Relief Sequence
Gear Tension Relief Sequence
When the displacement cylinder pistons are in their topmost position, each motor has prevailing
torque due to the force necessary to ensure each piston is held firmly at the top of its travel. This
torque results in "gear tension," or force on each gear that makes motor pack separation difficult.
To avoid injury, or damage to the gears, the "Gear Tension Relief Sequence" briefly reverses each
motor to eliminate the prevailing torque.
Always perform the "Gear Tension Relief Sequence" with the scan tool prior to removing the
hydraulic modulator-master cylinder assembly from the vehicle.
Gear Cover
Gear Cover
CAUTION: To help avoid personal injury, due to a retained load on the ABS hydraulic modulator,
the gear tension relief function of the Tech 1 must be performed prior to removal of the ABS
hydraulic modulator-master cylinder assembly.
NOTICE: The following service procedures shall be performed only after the ABS hydraulic
modulator-master cylinder assembly has been removed from the vehicle. Do not perform these
procedures with the unit installed on the vehicle. Complete overhaul of the ABS hydraulic
modulator-master cylinder assembly is not authorized. These steps will break the unit down into
major components for replacement purposes.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly
Removal and Instalation > Page 4487
ABS Brake Modulator/Master Cylinder Assembly Components
DISASSEMBLE
1. Torx head screws attaching gear cover. 2. Remove gear cover.
ASSEMBLE
1. Gear cover to Antilock Brake System brake modulator/master cylinder assembly. 2. Torx head
screws.
Tighten
^ Tighten torx screws to 4 Nm (35 inch lbs.).
ABS Motor Pack
MOTOR PACK
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly
Removal and Instalation > Page 4488
CAUTION: To help avoid personal injury, due to a retained load on the ABS hydraulic modulator,
the gear tension relief function of the Tech 1 must be performed prior to removal of the ABS
hydraulic modulator-master cylinder assembly.
NOTICE: The following service procedures shall be performed only after the ABS hydraulic
modulator-master cylinder assembly has been removed from the vehicle. Do not perform these
procedures with the unit installed on the vehicle. Complete overhaul of the ABS hydraulic
modulator-master cylinder assembly is not authorized. These steps will break the unit down into
major components for replacement purposes.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly
Removal and Instalation > Page 4489
ABS Brake Modulator/Master Cylinder Assembly Components
Disassemble
1. Remove gear cover. 2. Four Torx head screws attaching ABS brake motor pack.
Important
^ Use care when handling the motor pack to ensure the motor pack connectors are not damaged,
or accidental intrusion of brake fluid into the motor pack does not occur. This may result in a
premature failure of the motor pack.
^ Take care in handling the motor packs. If dropped or damaged during handling, the motor packs
must be replaced.
3. Remove ABS motor pack.
Important
^ If disassembly of the brake modulator-master cylinder assembly was due to an ABS hydraulic
functional test that did not pass, the Automated ABS brake motor pack Diagnosis Test described in
this section should be performed at this time to isolate the ABS brake motor pack or brake
modulator.
^ No repair of the motor pack is authorized. Replace as an assembly.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly
Removal and Instalation > Page 4490
ABS Brake Modulator/Master Cylinder Assembly Components
Assemble
1. With the brake modulator upside down, and the gears facing you, rotate each ABS brake
modulator gear counterclockwise until movement stops.
This procedure will position the pistons on the ABS brake modulator very close to the top of the
modulator bore. This will simplify the brake bleeding procedure.
2. Motor pack to brake modulator assembly.
Important
^ Take care in handling the motor packs. If dropped or damaged during handling the ABS brake
motor pack must be replaced.
^ Align each of the three ABS brake motor pack pinions with the brake modulator gears.
3. Four Torx head screws.
Tighten
^ Torx head screws to 4.5 Nm (40 inch lbs.).
4. Gear cover to ABS brake modulator-brake master cylinder assembly.
Gear Replacement
GEAR REPLACEMENT
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly
Removal and Instalation > Page 4491
CAUTION: To help avoid personal injury, due to a retained load on the ABS hydraulic modulator,
the gear tension relief function of the Tech 1 must be performed prior to removal of the ABS
hydraulic modulator/master cylinder assembly.
NOTICE: The following service procedures shall be performed only after the ABS hydraulic
modulator/master cylinder assembly has been removed from the vehicle. Do not perform these
procedures with the unit installed on the vehicle. Complete overhaul of the ABS hydraulic
modulator/ master cylinder assembly is not authorized -only the following steps. These steps will
break the unit down into major components for replacement purposes.
Important ^
Do not attempt to repair damaged motor packs or hydraulic modulators. Other than modulator drive
gears replacement, repair of these assemblies is not authorized. Do not lubricate or oil gears on
motor pack.
CAUTION: The modulator drive gears are under spring load and will turn during disassembly. After
removing hydraulic modulator drive gear cover, exercise extreme care not to place fingers into the
gear set, since fingers can be pinched by rotating gears.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. ABS brake modulator/master cylinder assembly. 2. Torx head screws attaching gear cover. 3.
Four ABS brake motor pack to ABS brake modulator Torx head screws.
Important
^ Take care in handling the ABS motor pack. If dropped or damaged in the handling, the ABS
motor pack must be replaced.
4. Separate motor pack from brake modulator. 5. Three modulator drive gears from modulator drive
shaft retaining nuts.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly
Removal and Instalation > Page 4492
Gear Removal
6. Gears from modulator.
NOTICE: Do not allow gear to turn while removing the retaining nut, since the modulator piston can
hit the top of the modulator bore, damaging the piston. Place a screwdriver through the holes in the
gear (not between the gears) into the recessed hole in the modulator base. This will prevent the
gear from turning, aiding in gear removal.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
Gear Position
NOTICE: Do not allow gear to turn while tightening the retaining nut, since the modulator piston
can bottom out in the modulator bore damaging the piston. Turn the modulator gear to position the
piston in the center of its travel. Place a screwdriver through the hole in the gears (not between the
gears) into the recessed hole in the modulator base.This will prevent the gear from turning, aiding
in gear installation.
1. Position ABS brake modulator drive gears onto brake modulator drive shaft. 2. Install three gear
retaining nuts.
Tighten Nuts
^ Nuts to 8.5 Nm (76 inch lbs.).
Gear Position
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly
Removal and Instalation > Page 4493
3. With the ABS hydraulic modulator upside down, and the gears facing you, rotate each ABS
brake modulator gear counterclockwise until
movement stops. This procedure will position the pistons on the ABS brake modulator very close to
the top of the modulator bore. This will simplify the brake bleeding procedure.
4. Position the motor pack onto brake modulator, aligning the three motor pack gears with the
modulator gears.
Important
^ Take care in handling the ABS motor pack. If dropped or damaged during handling, the ABS
motor pack must be replaced.
5. Four motor pack to brake modulator Torx head screws.
Tighten
^ Torx head screws 4.5 Nm (40 inch lbs.).
6. Gear cover onto brake modulator with Torx head screws.
Tighten
^ Torx head screws 4 Nm (35 inch lbs.).
7. Brake Modulator to Master Cylinder assembly.
ABS Hydraulic Modulator
Hydraulic Modulator
CAUTION: To help avoid personal injury, due to a retained load on the ABS hydraulic modulator,
the gear tension relief function of the Tech 1 must be performed prior to removal of the ABS
hydraulic modulator/master cylinder assembly.
NOTICE: The following service procedures shall be performed only after the ABS hydraulic
modulator-master cylinder assembly has been removed from the vehicle. Do not perform these
procedures with the unit installed on the vehicle. Complete overhaul of the ABS hydraulic
modulator-master cylinder assembly is not authorized. These steps will break the unit down into
major components for replacement purposes.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly
Removal and Instalation > Page 4494
ABS Brake Modulator/Master Cylinder Assembly Components
Disassemble
1. Remove gear cover. 2. Remove ABS motor pack. 3. Two ABS hydraulic modulator to master
cylinder banjo bolts; separate hydraulic modulator from master cylinder. 4. Two transfer tubes with
O-rings from master cylinder or ABS Hydraulic modulator. 5. Banjo bolt O-rings from master
cylinder and ABS hydraulic modulator.
Important
^ If ABS hydraulic modulator is to be replaced, install the three gears in the same location on
replacement hydraulic modulator.
^ No repair of the ABS hydraulic modulator is authorized. Replace as an assembly.
^ Refer to master cylinder for service and repair.
^ Use new transfer tube assemblies when assembling the ABS hydraulic modulator/master cylinder
assembly. Make sure two O-rings are properly installed on each transfer tube.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly
Removal and Instalation > Page 4495
ABS Brake Modulator/Master Cylinder Assembly Components
Assemble
1. Two transfer assemblies.
^ Lubricate transfer tube assembly O-rings with clean brake fluid.
^ Install transfer tube assemblies in ports in ABS brake modulator and push in by hand to bottom.
2. Lubricate new banjo bolt O-ring with clean brake fluid and install into the master cylinder and
ABS hydraulic modulator. 3. ABS hydraulic modulator to master cylinder.
^ Clamp mounting flange of master cylinder in a vise.
^ Hold ABS hydraulic modulator and rock into position on master cylinder, inserting transfer tube
assemblies into master cylinder ports.
4. Two ABS hydraulic modulator to master cylinder banjo bolts.
Tighten
^ Banjo bolts to 24 Nm (17 ft. lbs.).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly
Removal and Instalation > Page 4496
Gear Position
5. With the ABS hydraulic modulator upside down, and the gears facing you, rotate each ABS
hydraulic modulator gear counterclockwise until
movement stops. This procedure will position the pistons very close to the top of the modulator
bore simplifying the brake bleeding procedure.
6. ABS motor pack to ABS hydraulic modulator-master cylinder assembly. 7. Gear cover to ABS
hydraulic modulator-master cylinder assembly.
Master Cylinder
Brake Master Cylinder Unit Repair
The Unit Repair Procedure for the Brake Master Cylinder is located under Hydraulic System,
Brakes / Master Cylinder / Service and Repair / Procedures / Brake Master Cylinder Disassembly
and Assembly
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly
Removal and Instalation > Page 4497
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Service and Repair Hydraulic Modulator Solenoid
Assembly
ABS HYDRAULIC MODULATOR SOLENOID
Hydraulic Modulator Solenoid Assembly
1. Remove solenoid electrical connector. 2. Remove Torx® head bolts. 3. Remove solenoid.
Important
^ Be sure the seal is still attached to the solenoid when it is removed. If not, check solenoid bore in
modulator.
^ Do not attempt to disassemble solenoid, it is serviceable only as an assembly. Lubricate seal on
new solenoid with clean brake fluid.
^ Verify that the solenoid lip seal is properly positioned before solenoid is installed in Hydraulic
Modulator.
^ Position solenoid so that its electrical connector will face the same direction as the solenoid that
was removed.
^ By hand, press down firmly solenoid until its flange seats on the hydraulic modulator.
4. Reinstall Torx head bolts.
Tighten
^ Bolts to 4.5 N.m. (40 lb. in.).
5. Reinstall solenoid electrical connector to solenoid.
Important
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly
Removal and Instalation > Page 4498
^ Make sure the solenoid connectors are installed on correct solenoids.
^ It is necessary to bleed hydraulic modulator master cylinder assembly. Refer to Brake System
Bleeding. See: Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair/With ABS System
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 63-50-15B > Mar > 98 > ABS
Indicator Lamp On, DTC 21,22,32 or 33 Set
Wheel Speed Sensor: Customer Interest ABS Indicator Lamp On, DTC 21,22,32 or 33 Set
File In Section: 5 - Brakes
Bulletin No.: 63-50-15B
Date: March, 1998
Subject: ABS Indicator Lamp ON, DTC 21, 22, 32 or 33 Set (Install Front ABS Wheel Speed
Sensor Wiring Harness Connector Kit)
Models: 1992-97 Buick Skylark 1991-96 Chevrolet Beretta, Corsica 1992-97 Chevrolet Cavalier
1992-97 Oldsmobile Achieva 1992-94 Pontiac Sunbird 1995-97 Pontiac Sunfire 1992-97 Pontiac
Grand Am
This bulletin is being revised to update parts and applicable model information. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 63-50-15A - (Section 5 - Brakes)
Condition
Some owners may comment that the ABS indicator lamp is "ON". Also, malfunction DTC 21, 22, 32
or 33 could set.
Cause
The right front and left front ABS wheel speed sensor wiring harness could be damaged and result
in an open circuit. The wiring harness may be damaged approximately 4 inches (10 cm) back from
the harness connector to the wheel speed sensor. This allows moisture to enter the harness
causing corrosion and resulting in the open circuit.
Correction
A thorough inspection for corrosion and/or damage should be performed on suspect vehicles. It
may be necessary to move the protective conduit away in order to inspect the wiring properly. If a
failure occurs and damage is found, install the front ABS wheel speed sensor wiring harness
connector kit(s). The kit includes instructions, splices, and "pigtail" connector.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 63-50-15B > Mar > 98 > ABS
Indicator Lamp On, DTC 21,22,32 or 33 Set > Page 4507
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Description Labor Time
H2530 Right Side Use published
H2531 Left Side Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 63-50-15B > Mar > 98 >
ABS Indicator Lamp On, DTC 21,22,32 or 33 Set
Wheel Speed Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS Indicator Lamp On, DTC 21,22,32 or 33
Set
File In Section: 5 - Brakes
Bulletin No.: 63-50-15B
Date: March, 1998
Subject: ABS Indicator Lamp ON, DTC 21, 22, 32 or 33 Set (Install Front ABS Wheel Speed
Sensor Wiring Harness Connector Kit)
Models: 1992-97 Buick Skylark 1991-96 Chevrolet Beretta, Corsica 1992-97 Chevrolet Cavalier
1992-97 Oldsmobile Achieva 1992-94 Pontiac Sunbird 1995-97 Pontiac Sunfire 1992-97 Pontiac
Grand Am
This bulletin is being revised to update parts and applicable model information. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 63-50-15A - (Section 5 - Brakes)
Condition
Some owners may comment that the ABS indicator lamp is "ON". Also, malfunction DTC 21, 22, 32
or 33 could set.
Cause
The right front and left front ABS wheel speed sensor wiring harness could be damaged and result
in an open circuit. The wiring harness may be damaged approximately 4 inches (10 cm) back from
the harness connector to the wheel speed sensor. This allows moisture to enter the harness
causing corrosion and resulting in the open circuit.
Correction
A thorough inspection for corrosion and/or damage should be performed on suspect vehicles. It
may be necessary to move the protective conduit away in order to inspect the wiring properly. If a
failure occurs and damage is found, install the front ABS wheel speed sensor wiring harness
connector kit(s). The kit includes instructions, splices, and "pigtail" connector.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 63-50-15B > Mar > 98 >
ABS Indicator Lamp On, DTC 21,22,32 or 33 Set > Page 4513
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Description Labor Time
H2530 Right Side Use published
H2531 Left Side Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
Relay Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control
Modules
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D
Date: December 08, 2010
Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle
Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion
(Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Attention:
This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body
electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the
point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal
surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011
model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
- An intermittent no crank/no start
- Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination
- Intermittent service lamp illumination
- Intermittent service message(s) being displayed
The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as
fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector.
This may be caused by any of the following conditions:
- Vibration
- Thermal cycling
- Poor connection/terminal retention
- Micro motion
- A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement
On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent
connections.
On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and
may cause a device to become inoperative.
Representative List of Control Modules and Components
The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected
by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or
component for every vehicle.
- Blower Control Module
- Body Control Module (BCM)
- Communication Interface Module (CIM)
- Cooling Fan Control Module
- Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
- Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM)
- Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module
- Engine Control Module (ECM)
- Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 4519
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 4520
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 4521
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 4527
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 4528
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed Sensor: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 4529
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Wheel Speed Sensor: Component Locations
LH Front Wheel (RH Similar)
LH Rear ABS Wheel Speed Sensor
LH Rear ABS Wheel Speed Sensor is located Rear of LH rear Wheel Hub
LH Rear Wheel (RH Similar)
Wheel Speed Sensors
These sensors located on the front steering knuckles and under the wheel bearing dust caps on
the rear wheels.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4532
Wheel Speed Sensor: Connector Locations
LH Front Wheel (RH Similar)
LH Rear Wheel (RH Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4533
Wheel Speed Sensor: Harness Locations
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
RH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4534
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
These sensors located on the front steering knuckles and under the wheel bearing dust caps on
the rear wheels, send a low voltage signal to the EBCM/EBTCM. This signal is produced by
rotating a toothed ring around the sensor pole piece, which produces a magnetic field that
increases and decreases in magnitude.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Front
Fig. 802 Front Wheel Speed Sensor Removal.
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect wheel sensor electrical connector, Fig. 802. 3. Remove
sensor attaching bolt, then the sensor from the mounting bracket. 4. Reverse procedure to install,
noting the following:
a. Ensure sensor is properly aligned and lays flat against bracket bosses, then torque attaching bolt
to 9 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 4537
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Rear
Fig. 803 Rear Wheel Bearing & Speed Sensor Removal.
1. Raise and support vehicle, then remove rear wheel and tire assembly. 2. Remove rear brake
drum, then disconnect sensor electrical connector, Fig. 803. 3. Remove wheel bearing and sensor
attaching nuts and bolts, then bearing and sensor assembly. After bolts are removed, the rear
brake assembly
will be held in place by the hydraulic pipe. Use care not to bump or exert any force on the brake
assembly to prevent any damage to the hydraulic pipe.
4. Reverse procedure to install, noting the following:
a. Align bolt holes in wheel bearing and speed sensor assembly, drum brake assembly and rear
suspension bracket. b. When installing bolts, rotate axle flange to align large hole with each bolt
location, then install bolt while holding nut. c. Torque bolts to 37 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
With ABS System
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair With ABS System
Manual Bleeding
1. Remove master cylinder reservoir cover, then fill reservoir as necessary. 2. Attach one end of a
clear plastic hose to rear bleeder valve of the brake control assembly, then put opposite end of the
hose into a clean container. 3. While depressing brake pedal, slowly open bleeder valve, until fluid
begins to flow. 4. Close valve and release brake pedal, then repeat procedure for front bleeder
valve. 5. Ensure master cylinder is full, then raise and support vehicle. 6. Bleed wheel cylinders
and calipers using the following sequence:
a. Right rear. b. Left rear. c. Right front. d. Left front.
7. Lower vehicle and check fluid level in reservoir, fill as necessary. 8. Turn on ignition and note
pedal travel and feel as follows:
a. If pedal feels firm and constant, start the engine and recheck pedal travel. If pedal still feels firm
and constant, continue procedure. b. If pedal feels soft or has excessive travel either initially or
after engine is started, repeat bleeding procedure.
9. Road test vehicle, make several normal stops from a moderate speed, then make one or two
ABS stops at approximately 50 mph.
10. Ensure pedal is still firm and constant.
Pressure Bleeding
NOTE: To prevent air, moisture and other contaminants from entering system, only diaphragm type
pressure bleeding equipment should be used.
1. Attach bleeder adapter tool No. J35589, or equivalent, to master cylinder reservoir, then the
adapter tool to the pressure bleeder. 2. Connect a clear plastic hose to the front bleeder valve on
the control assembly, then put opposite end of the hose into a clean container partially
filled with brake fluid.
3. Set pressure bleeder to 5-10 psi and wait for approximately 30 seconds to ensure there is no
leakage. 4. Set pressure bleed equipment to 30-35 psi. 5. Slowly open bleeder valve and allow fluid
to flow into container until no air bubbles are seen in fluid, then close the bleeder valve and torque
to
65 inch lbs.
6. Attach bleeder hose to rear bleeder valve of the control assembly and repeat preceding step. 7.
Position a cloth under hydraulic brake pipe connections. 8. Working from front of the control
assembly to the rear, slowly turn each pipe nut and check for air in escaping fluid. 9. When air flow
ceases, torque pipe nut to 13 ft. lbs.
10. Raise and support vehicle, then bleed wheel cylinders and calipers using the following
sequence:
a. Right rear. b. Left rear. c. Right front. d. Left front.
11. Lower vehicle and remove bleeder adapter tool from master cylinder. 12. Check fluid level in
reservoir, fill as necessary. 13. Turn ignition switch to On position and note pedal travel and feel as
follows:
a. If pedal feels firm and constant, start the engine and recheck pedal travel. If pedal still feels firm
and constant, continue procedure. b. If pedal feels soft or has excessive travel either initially or
after engine is started, repeat bleeding procedure.
14. Road test vehicle, make several normal stops from a moderate speed, then make one or two
ABS stops at approximately 50 mph. 15. Ensure pedal is still firm and constant.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
With ABS System > Page 4542
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Without ABS System
Manual
Fig. 210 Brake System Manual Bleed.
NOTE: Pressure bleeding is recommended for all hydraulic systems. However, if a pressure
bleeder is unavailable, use the following procedure. Brake fluid damages painted surfaces.
Immediately clean any spilled fluid.
1. Remove vacuum reserve by pumping brakes several times with engine off. 2. Fill master cylinder
reservoir with clean brake fluid. Check fluid level often during bleeding procedure; do not let
reservoir fall below half full. 3. If necessary, bleed master cylinder as follows:
a. Disconnect master cylinder forward brake line connection until fluid flows from reservoir.
Reconnect and tighten brake line. b. Instruct an assistant to slowly depress brake pedal one time
and hold. c. Crack open front brake line connection again, purging air from cylinder. d. Retighten
connection and slowly release brake pedal. e. Wait 15 seconds, then repeat until all air is purged. f.
Bleed the rearward (nearest the cowl) brake line connection by repeating steps a through e.
4. Loosen, then slightly retighten bleeder valves at all four wheels. Repair any broken, stripped or
frozen valves at this time. 5. Proceed to appropriate wheel first and follow set sequence according
to Wheel Bleeding Sequence. 6. Place transparent tube over bleeder valve, then allow tube to
hang down into transparent container, Fig. 16. Ensure end of tube is submerged in
clean brake fluid.
7. Instruct an assistant to slowly depress brake pedal one time and hold. 8. Crack open bleeder
valve, purging air from cylinder. Retighten bleeder screw and slowly release pedal. 9. Wait 15
seconds, then repeat steps 7 and 8. Repeat these steps until all air is bled from system.
Pressure
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
With ABS System > Page 4543
Fig. 21 Installing Pressure Bleeder Adapter
Fig. 210 Brake System Manual Bleed.
1. Loosen, then slightly retighten bleeder valves at all four wheels. Repair any broken, stripped or
frozen valves at this time. 2. Using a diaphragm type pressure bleeder, install suitable bleeder
adapter to master cylinder, Fig. 17. 3. Charge bleeder ball to 20-25 psi. 4. Connect pressure
bleeder line to adapter. 5. Open line valve on pressure bleeder, then depress bleed-off valve on
adapter until a small amount of brake fluid is released. 6. Raise and support vehicle. 7. Proceed to
appropriate wheel first and follow set sequence according to Wheel Bleeding Sequence. 8. Place
transparent tube over bleeder valve, then allow tube to hang down into transparent container, Fig.
16. Ensure end of tube is submerged in
clean brake fluid.
9. Open bleeder valve 1/2 to 3/4 turn and allow fluid to flow into container until all air is purged from
line.
Front Disc Brakes
NOTE: Pressure bleeding is recommended for all hydraulic disc brake systems.
The disc brake hydraulic system can be bled manually or with pressure bleeding equipment. On
vehicles with disc brakes the brake pedal will require more pumping and frequent checking of fluid
level in master cylinder during bleeding operation.
Never use brake fluid that has been drained from hydraulic system when bleeding the brakes. Be
sure the disc brake pistons are returned to their normal positions and that the shoe and lining
assemblies are properly seated. Before driving the vehicle, check brake operation to be sure that a
firm
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Bleeding > System Information > Service and Repair >
With ABS System > Page 4544
pedal has been obtained.
Wheel Bleeding Sequence
Rear wheel drive models: if manual bleeding, RR-LR-RF-LF; if pressure bleeding, bleed front
brakes together and rear brakes together. Front wheel drive models: RR-LF-LR-RF
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Brake Warning Indicator: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4549
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4550
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4551
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4552
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4553
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4554
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4555
Brake Warning Indicator: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4556
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4557
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4558
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4559
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4560
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4561
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4562
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4563
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4564
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4565
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4566
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4567
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4568
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4569
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4570
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4571
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4572
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4573
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4574
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4575
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4576
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4577
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4578
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4579
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4580
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4581
Brake Warning
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Brake Warning System
Brake Warning Indicator: Description and Operation Brake Warning System
DESCRIPTION
The "Brake" warning indicator will be illuminated when a low brake fluid level in the master cylinder
is sensed or when the Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM) lights it in response to certain
diagnostic trouble codes.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Brake Warning System > Page 4584
Brake Warning Indicator: Description and Operation Circuit Operation
Battery voltage is applied to the BRAKE Indicator when the Ignition Switch is in RUN, BULB TEST
or START. Three switches are connected in parallel to the BRAKE Indicator. When any one of
these switches closes, ground is provided and the indicator lights.
The Ignition Switch provides a ground when it is in the BULB TEST and START positions.
The Park Brake Switch provides a ground when the Park Brake is applied.
The Brake Fluid Level Switch closes to light the BRAKE Indicator when there is low brake fluid in
one of the two hydraulic brake systems. This could be caused by a leak in one of the brake lines.
The switch can be reset to an open position by refilling the reservoir, however this can only be
accomplished after the faulty system has been repaired.
The Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM) will cause the BRAKE Indicator to light only when the
Antilock Brake System degrades the base brake system.
In cars with Daytime Running Lights, the Daytime Running Lights remain off if the BRAKE Indicator
is lit.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Brake Warning System > Page 4585
Brake Warning Indicator: Description and Operation Brake Pressure Warning Lamp
DESCRIPTION
The warning lamp should illuminate when the ignition switch is in the start position, and turn off
when the switch returns to run. If the brake lamp remains on after the ignition returns to run, check
fluid level in master cylinder reservoir and inspect parking brake. If the warning lamp does not turn
on during cranking, check for defective bulb or blown fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Brake Warning Indicator: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Circuit Operation
Battery voltage is applied to the BRAKE Indicator when the Ignition Switch is in RUN, BULB TEST
or START. Three switches are connected in parallel to the BRAKE Indicator. When any one of
these switches closes, ground is provided and the indicator lights.
The Ignition Switch provides a ground when it is in the BULB TEST and START positions.
The Park Brake Switch provides a ground when the Park Brake is applied.
The Brake Fluid Level Switch closes to light the BRAKE Indicator when there is low brake fluid in
one of the two hydraulic brake systems. This could be caused by a leak in one of the brake lines.
The switch can be reset to an open position by refilling the reservoir, however this can only be
accomplished after the faulty system has been repaired.
The Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM) will cause the BRAKE Indicator to light only when the
Antilock Brake System degrades the base brake system.
In cars with Daytime Running Lights, the Daytime Running Lights remain off if the BRAKE Indicator
is lit.
System Diagnosis
Refer to Symptom Table for listed symptoms and refer Diagnostic Tests for Diagnostic procedures.
See: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/Symptom Table See: Symptom Related Diagnostic
Procedures/Diagnostic Tests
System Check
System Check Table
Refer to the System Diagnosis given if other results occur. See: System Diagnosis
Troubleshooting Hints
TRY THE FOLLOWING CHECKS BEFORE DOING THE SYSTEM CHECK
1. Check GAGES Fuse by operating the Rear Defogger and observing the Indicator with the
Ignition Switch in RUN and engine off. 2. Check ground G100 by operating the Blower Motor. 3. If
the BRAKE Indicator does not light for a particular condition, check the suspect switch for battery
voltage at the TAN/WHT (33) terminal and a
good ground circuit. If the TAN/WHT (33) wires are good to suspect switch, check 150 (BLK) wire
for an open (see schematic). If OK, replace suspect switch.
^ Go to System Check for a guide to normal operation. See: System Check
^ Go to System Diagnosis for diagnostic tests. See: System Diagnosis
^ Refer to Starting and Charging for Ignition Switch access information. See: Starting and Charging
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Warning Indicator > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 4588
Brake Warning Indicator: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Symptom Table
Symptom Table:
Chart A: BRAKE Indicator remains on with ignition switch in RUN and park brake off. See:
Diagnostic Tests
Diagnostic Tests
1. Put Ignition Switch in RUN. Disconnect the Park Brake Switch and Brake Fluid Level Switch and
observe BRAKE Indicator.
^ If BRAKE Indicator goes out when a switch is disconnected, replace suspect switch.
^ If BRAKE Indicator stays on and vehicle is equipped with Daytime Running Lights, go to step 2. If
vehicle is not equipped with Daytime Running Lights, go to step 3.
2. Disconnect Daytime Running Lights (DRL) Module and observe BRAKE Indicator with the
Ignition Switch in RUN.
^ If BRAKE Indicator goes out when module is disconnected, replace the module.
^ If BRAKE Indicator stays on, go to step 3.
3. Disconnect the Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM) connector C2.
^ If BRAKE Indicator goes out, refer to Brakes and Traction Control. See:
^ If BRAKE Indicator stays on, go to step 4.
4. With the Ignition Switch in RUN and connector disconnected, check for continuity between the
Ignition Switch half of terminal D/C1 and F/C2.
^ If there is continuity, replace the Ignition Switch.
^ If there is no continuity, check for a short to ground in the 33 (TAN/WHT) wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Specifications > Bore Diameter
Brake Caliper: Specifications
Front Caliper Bore Diameter 2.244 in
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Specifications > Bore Diameter > Page 4594
Brake Caliper: Specifications Tightening Specifications
Brake Hose to Caliper .........................................................................................................................
.................................................... 44 Nm (32 ft. lbs.) Caliper Bleed Screw .........................................
.......................................................................................................................................... 12 Nm (9 ft.
lbs.) Caliper Mounting Bolts .................................................................................................................
........................................................... 52 Nm (38 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal/Installation
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Removal/Installation
Fig. 8 Piston Compressing W/Pliers.
Fig. 9 Caliper Mounting Bolts Replacement.
REMOVAL
1. Remove approximately 2/3 of brake fluid from master cylinder.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal/Installation > Page 4597
2. Raise and support front of vehicle, then remove wheel and tire assembly. 3. Position suitable
pliers over inboard pad and housing as shown in Fig. 8, and squeeze pliers to compress caliper
piston. 4. If caliper assembly is being removed for service, remove inlet fitting attaching bolt, copper
washer, and inlet fitting from caliper housing. Plug
opening in inlet fitting to prevent fluid loss and contamination. Do not crimp brake hose, as this may
damage internal structure of hose. If only shoe and lining assemblies are to be replaced, do not
disconnect brake line fitting from caliper.
5. Remove Allen head caliper mounting bolts, Fig. 9. If bolts show signs of corrosion, use new bolts
when installing caliper assembly. 6. Remove caliper assembly from disc. If only shoe and lining
assemblies are to be replaced, using a length of wire suspend caliper from spring coil.
Never allow caliper to hang from brake hose.
Fig. 9 Caliper Mounting Bolts Replacement.
Fig. 13 Caliper & Stops Clearance Inspection.
CALIPER INSTALLATION
1. Position caliper assembly over disc and align mounting bolt holes. If brake hoses were not
disconnected during removal, use care not to kink hoses
during installation.
2. Install mounting bolts and tighten to specifications, Fig. 9. 3. Check dimensions between each
caliper stop and caliper, Fig. 13. If necessary remove caliper and file ends of bracket to provide
proper clearance. 4. If brake hose fitting was disconnected during removal, install brake hose
fitting. 5. Fill master cylinder. Bleed brake system if brake line was disconnected and recheck
master cylinder fluid level. 6. Install wheel and tire assembly on vehicle, then lower vehicle and
check brake system operation. Before moving vehicle, pump brake pedal
several times to be sure it is firm. Do not move vehicle until a firm pedal is obtained.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal/Installation > Page 4598
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Disassemble/Assemble
Fig. 10 Caliper Piston Removal.
Fig. 11 Dust Boot Removal.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal/Installation > Page 4599
Fig. 12 Dust Boot Installation In Caliper.
REMOVAL
1. Remove approximately 2/3 of brake fluid from master cylinder. 2. Raise and support front of
vehicle, then remove wheel and tire assembly. 3. Position suitable pliers over inboard pad and
housing as shown in Fig. 8, and squeeze pliers to compress caliper piston. 4. If caliper assembly is
being removed for service, remove inlet fitting attaching bolt, copper washer, and inlet fitting from
caliper housing. Plug
opening in inlet fitting to prevent fluid loss and contamination. Do not crimp brake hose, as this may
damage internal structure of hose. If only shoe and lining assemblies are to be replaced, do not
disconnect brake line fitting from caliper.
5. Remove Allen head caliper mounting bolts, Fig. 9. If bolts show signs of corrosion, use new bolts
when installing caliper assembly. 6. Remove caliper assembly from disc. If only shoe and lining
assemblies are to be replaced, using a length of wire suspend caliper from spring coil.
Never allow caliper to hang from brake hose.
DISASSEMBLE
1. Clean outside of caliper, then drain brake fluid from caliper. 2. Use clean shop towels to pad
interior of caliper assembly, then remove piston by directing compressed air into caliper brake hose
inlet hole, Fig.
10. Use just enough air pressure to ease piston out of bore. Do not place fingers in front of piston
for any reason when applying compressed air. This could result in serious personal injury.
3. Using a screwdriver, remove dust boot from caliper bore, Fig. 11. 4. Using a small piece of wood
or plastic, remove piston seal from bore. Do not use a metal tool of any kind to remove seal as it
may damage
bore.
5. Remove bleeder valve. 6. Inspect piston for scoring, nicks, corrosion, and wear and replace as
needed. 7. Inspect caliper housing and seal groove for corrosion, nicks, scoring and excessive
wear, and use crocus cloth to polish away corrosion from
housing bore. Replace caliper housing if corrosion in and around seal groove will not clean up with
crocus cloth.
8. Clean all parts with denatured alcohol. Dry with unlubricated compressed air. Blow out all
passages in housing and bleeder valve.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Brake Pad: > 435006A > May > 95 > Brakes - Longer Life Front Brake
Pad Lining
Brake Pad: Customer Interest Brakes - Longer Life Front Brake Pad Lining
FILE IN SECTION: 5 - Brakes
BULLETIN NO.: 43-50-06A
DATE: May, 1995
SUBJECT: Longer Life Front Brake Lining (Install New Brake Pads)
MODELS: 1991-95
Buick Skylark
1992-95 Chevrolet Cavalier; Corsica, Beretta
1991 Oldsmobile Cutlass Calais
1992-95 Oldsmobile Achieva
1991-95 Pontiac Grand Am
1992-94 Pontiac Sunbird
1995 Pontiac Sunfire
This bulletin is being revised to include the 1995 model year and revise part number information.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 43-50-6 (Section 5 - Brakes).
CONDITION
Some owners may comment on the life of the front brake linings.
CORRECTION
This condition can be addressed by replacing front brake pads with new 8100 lining compound,
P/N 12510050, (Canadian P/N 18022395). The new brake pads incorporate wear sensors on each
brake pad.
Important:
DO NOT resurface rotors unless there is a pulsation concern or deep scoring in excess of .060 (up
to the head on a dime) is measured. U.S. Dealers - Pontiac vehicles should replace rotors; not
resurface if the above conditions are met. Canadian Dealers - use current policy.
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor
Operation Labor Time
H0042 Use published labor operation time.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Brake Pad: > 435006A > May > 95 > Brakes - Longer Life
Front Brake Pad Lining
Brake Pad: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Longer Life Front Brake Pad Lining
FILE IN SECTION: 5 - Brakes
BULLETIN NO.: 43-50-06A
DATE: May, 1995
SUBJECT: Longer Life Front Brake Lining (Install New Brake Pads)
MODELS: 1991-95
Buick Skylark
1992-95 Chevrolet Cavalier; Corsica, Beretta
1991 Oldsmobile Cutlass Calais
1992-95 Oldsmobile Achieva
1991-95 Pontiac Grand Am
1992-94 Pontiac Sunbird
1995 Pontiac Sunfire
This bulletin is being revised to include the 1995 model year and revise part number information.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 43-50-6 (Section 5 - Brakes).
CONDITION
Some owners may comment on the life of the front brake linings.
CORRECTION
This condition can be addressed by replacing front brake pads with new 8100 lining compound,
P/N 12510050, (Canadian P/N 18022395). The new brake pads incorporate wear sensors on each
brake pad.
Important:
DO NOT resurface rotors unless there is a pulsation concern or deep scoring in excess of .060 (up
to the head on a dime) is measured. U.S. Dealers - Pontiac vehicles should replace rotors; not
resurface if the above conditions are met. Canadian Dealers - use current policy.
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor
Operation Labor Time
H0042 Use published labor operation time.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Pad > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4613
Brake Pad: Service and Repair
Fig. 1 Exploded View Of Disc Brake Caliper Assembly.
1. Remove approximately 2/3 of brake fluid from master cylinder. 2. Raise and support vehicle. 3.
Mark relationship between front wheel and axle, then remove wheel and tire assembly. 4. Remove
2 caliper slide pins from bracket. 5. Unfasten caliper, and support with a length of wire, leaving
hydraulic lines connected. 6. Remove brake pads, shims, wear indicators and retainers, Fig. 1. 7.
Reverse procedure to install.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes - Rotor Lateral Runout Correction Information
Brake Rotor/Disc: Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Rotor Lateral Runout Correction Information
Bulletin No.: 01-05-23-001B
Date: January 31, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Brake Align(R) System for Brake Rotor Lateral Runout Correction
Models: 2008 and Prior Passenger Cars
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
01-05-23-001A (Section 05 - Brakes).
This bulletin is being issued to update General Motors position on correcting brake rotor lateral
runout (Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 00-05-22-002B for additional brake rotor service
procedures).
Certain conditions may apply to individual vehicles regarding specific repairs. Refer to those
specific repairs in applicable service bulletins. Make sure other possible sources of brake pulsation,
such as ABS pedal feedback, have been addressed before checking rotor runout.
Anytime a new or refinished rotor is installed on a vehicle, the rotor must have .050 mm (.002 in) or
less of lateral runout. This specification is important to prevent comebacks for brake pulsation. Until
now, the only acceptable methods to correct brake rotor runout were to index or replace the rotor or
to refinish the rotor using an on-vehicle brake lathe.
GM has approved a new technology for the correction of lateral runout on new or refinished rotors.
This new method is called Brake align(R)*. It will allow the technician to meet the .050 mm (.002 in)
or less requirement for lateral runout by installing a specially selected, tapered correction plate
between the rotor and the hub. The Brake Align(R) Correction system does NOT require the use of
an on-vehicle brake lathe to correct for lateral runout.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products from this firm or for any such items which may be available from
other sources.
The Brake Align(R) Starter Kit will include an ample supply of Correction Plates, in various
correction sizes, that will cover most current GM passenger car applications. It will also include a
Brake Align(R) tool kit containing a dial indicator and retaining washers along with other useful
tools.
Service Procedure
Follow all the procedures referred to in Corporate Bulletin Number 00-05-22-002B. Dealers who
have purchased the Brake Align(R) Starter Kit may use the following simplified runout correction
procedure:
The existing rotors must first be machined on an approved, well-maintained bench lathe to
guarantee smooth, flat, and parallel surfaces. Should the rotors require replacement, please note
that it is not necessary to machine new rotors.
Make sure all the mating surfaces of the rotor and the hub are clean, using the J 42450-A wheel
Hub Cleaning Kit. Mount the new or refinished rotor onto the vehicle hub using the retaining
washers provided in the kit. Do not reinstall the caliper or wheel at this time.
Tighten all the wheel nuts to the proper specification, using J 39544 Torque Socket or the
equivalent.
Fasten the dial indicator to the steering knuckle so that the indicator needle contacts the rotor
friction surface approximately 12.7 mm (1/2 in) from the rotors outer edge.
Rotate the rotor and observe the total lateral runout.
Index the rotor on the hub to achieve the lowest amount of lateral runout. This will require removal
and reassembly of the rotor until the lowest total lateral runout reading is obtained. If this reading is
.050 mm (.002 in) or less, the assembled rotor is within specification. The brake system may be
reassembled.
If total lateral runout is greater than .050 mm (.002 in), proceed with determining the correct Brake
Align(R) Correction as follows:
Rotate the rotor to locate the lowest dial indicator reading and set the dial to zero. Rotate the rotor
to determine and locate the highest amount of lateral runout.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes - Rotor Lateral Runout Correction Information > Page 4618
Note the AMOUNT and LOCATION of the "high spot" on the rotor and mark the closest wheel stud
relative to this location.
Remove the rotor.
Select the appropriate Brake Align(R) Runout Correction Plate for this vehicle using the Application
Chart. Make sure the selection corrects the amount of runout that was diagnosed.
Never attempt to stack two or more Correction Plates together on one hub.
Never attempt to re-use a previously installed Correction Plate.
Following the Brake Align(R) procedures and diagram, install the Correction Plate onto the vehicle
between the hub and the rotor. The V-notch in the Correction Plate is to be installed and aligned
with the noted location of the "high spot" on the vehicle hub and marked wheel stud.
Install the rotor onto the vehicle with the Correction Plate placed between the hub and the rotor. Be
sure to install the rotor onto the hub in the same location as identified in Step 7.
The rotor should then be secured onto the hub and tightened to the proper specification. The rotor
should be dial indicated once more to assure that the rotor is now within specification.
The brake system is now ready for the remaining service and assembly. Once the caliper has been
installed, check to ensure that the rotor rotates freely.
Parts Information
Brake Align(R) Runout Correction Plates are available through the suppliers shown.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes - Rotor Lateral Runout Correction Information > Page 4619
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes - Rotor Lateral Runout Correction Information > Page 4620
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes - Rotor Lateral Runout Correction Information > Page 4621
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes - Rotor Lateral Runout Correction Information > Page 4622
Brake Align Order Form
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes - Rotor Lateral Runout Correction Information > Page 4623
Brake Rotor/Disc: Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Rotor & Hub Flange Cleaning Tool Revision
File In Section: 5 - Brakes
Bulletin No.: 73-50-37
Date: January, 1998
INFORMATION
Subject: Revision to J 42450 Tool; Proper Brake Rotor and Hub Flange Surface Cleaning
Models: 1998 and Prior Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks - with Disc Brakes (Rotor and Hub
Separate)
This bulletin is being revised to update the following text.
This bulletin is being issued to inform the dealer about a revision to tool J 42450 and reinforce the
need for proper hub flange and brake rotor mating surface cleaning during service.
Tool J 42450 is a cleaning pad arbor and pad system that fits over the wheel stud and cleans the
portion of the hub surface that is very difficult to reach with normal rotary cleaning pads. Tool J
42450 is being revised to J 42450-A to improve the hook and loop material retention. Any dealer
experiencing problems with tool J 42450 should contact Kent-Moore at 1-800-345-2233 for a
revised arbor at no charge.
Anytime the brake rotor has been separated from the hub bearing flange or if rotor machining is
necessary, the rotor and hub should be marked to maintain the original position. Clean the hub
flange of all dirt and foreign material using special tool J 42450 or J 42450-A. Clean both sides of
the brake rotor hub using an aggressive (80 grit) abrasive sanding pad on a rotary disc.
Properly cleaning the rotor surfaces before rotor machining or reassembly ensures that dirt and
corrosion will not add lateral runout to the rotor. Proper cleaning of the hub flange will also minimize
the stack-up of lateral runout. On reassembly, the rotor should be reinstalled aligning the marks
made on disassembly.
Always use a torque wrench or the appropriate Torque Socket found in J 39544-KIT on an impact
wrench when installing the wheel and tire assembly. Torque all wheel nuts using the correct
sequence and torque. Refer to the Tire and Wheel Sub-Section in the applicable Service Manual.
Excessive torque or torque variation between wheel nuts may cause distortion of the hub and rotor
mating surface. This distortion may cause lateral runout and lead to brake pulsation.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes - Rotor Lateral Runout Correction Information > Page 4624
Technical Service Bulletin # 23-50-05B Date: 971101
Brakes - Rotor Warranty Service Procedure
File In Section: 5 - Brakes
Bulletin No.: 23-50-05B
Date: November, 1997
INFORMATION
Subject: Brake Rotor Warranty Service Procedure
Model: 1994-98 GM Passenger Cars
This bulletin outlines GM's procedures for brake rotor service for all applicable GM passenger cars
and supersedes Corporate Bulletin Number 23-50-05A Section 5 - Brakes).
Important:
Rotors should only be turned when one or more of the following rotor surface conditions exist:
1. Severe Scoring - depth in excess of 1.5 mm (0.060 in.). 2. Pulsation Concerns from:
a. Thickness variation in excess of 0.025 mm (0.001 in.). b. Corrosion on rotor braking surfaces.
Rotors are NOT to be resurfaced in an attempt to correct:
1. Noise/squeal. 2. Cosmetic corrosion. 3. Routine pad replacement. 4. Discoloration and/or "hard
spots".
Explanation of Brake Rotor Warranty Service Procedure
Research and testing has determined:
1. Rotor refacing during normal pad replacement is not necessary.
2. Rotor refacing for cosmetic corrosion is unnecessary. Clean-up of braking surfaces can be
accomplished by 10-15 moderate stops from 62-75 km/h (35-40 mph) with cooling time between
stops.
3. Rotor service is ineffective in correcting BRAKE SQUEAL, and/or PREMATURE LINING WEAR
OUT, and should NOT be used to address these conditions.
4. When installing new rotors, DO NOT reface them.
5. Ensure bearing flanges are free of corrosion when installing rotors to prevent inducing lateral
runout. Use Kent Moore tool J 42450 to clean the corrosion around the wheel studs.
Brake Service Techniques
EVERY brake service should include:
1. Clean and lube all metal-to-metal contact points (i.e.; caliper to knuckle, pad to knuckle, etc.).
2. Clean and lube slide pins.
3. Set correct clearances - caliper to knuckle, etc.
4. Clean rotor and hub mounting surfaces. Use Kent Moore tool J 42450 to clean around wheel
studs.
Pulsation
Brake pulsation concerns may result from two basic conditions:
1. Thickness variation.
2. Excessive corrosion.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes - Rotor Lateral Runout Correction Information > Page 4625
Rotor thickness variation is the result of uneven rotor wear caused by excessive lateral runout
(>0.076 mm; >0.003 in.). Lateral runout can be induced by:
1. Distortion of the braking surface by applying uneven and/or excessive wheel nut torque.
(This could be the result of a recent tire change, rotation, etc.).
2. Improperly refacing rotors.
Brake Noise
Important:
SOME BRAKE NOISE IS NORMAL.
Brake noise is caused by a "slip stick" type vibration of brake components. Some intermittent brake
noise may be normal. Performing 3-4 aggressive stops may temporarily reduce or eliminate most
brake squeal. If the noise persists, a brake dampening compound may be applied to the back of
each pad. Use Permatex Disc Brake Quiet # 126HB or equivalent. Also, clean and lube all
metal-to-metal contact areas between pads, pad guides, caliper and knuckles with a thin layer of
high temperature silicone grease. This allows parts to slide freely and not vibrate when moving
relative to each other.
Rotor Grooving
Excessive grooving can be caused by foreign material in contact with the rotor, but most often rotor
grooving is the result of normal brake wear. DO NOT RESURFACE ROTORS FOR LIGHT
GROOVING. Resurface rotors only when grooves of 1.5 mm (0.060 in.) or deeper are present.
A dime may be used to determine disc brake groove depth. Place a dime in the groove, with
Roosevelt's head toward the groove. If the dime goes into the groove beyond the top of his head,
the groove exceeds 1.5 mm (0.060 in.) and the rotor should be serviced. (In Canada, if any portion
of the letters of "In Canada" are covered, the rotor should serviced.)
It the groove is too narrow for the dime to be inserted, it is not a cause for concern.
High Pedal Effort
Follow Service Manual diagnostic procedures for this condition. Service rotors if they have been
recently resurfaced. (The surface finish may be out-of-specification).
Lightly Rusted Rotors
Light surface rust on rotor braking surfaces is often cosmetic and can be eliminated during a few
normal driving stops. Rusting may occur when a vehicle is not driven for extended periods. Rotors
with surface rust on unsold new cars can usually be burnished clean by performing 15 moderate
stops from 62-75 km/h (35-40 mph) with cooling time between stops.
Facts About Brake Service
^ Original equipment rotor surfaces are ground to ensure smooth finish and parallelism between
mounting and friction surfaces. New rotors should not be resurfaced before installation.
^ Improper tightening of wheel nuts can induce lateral runout (distortion of braking surfaces) which
will lead to uneven wear. As high spots are worn down, resulting thickness variation will cause
brake pulsation.
^ Ensure wheel bearing flange is clean and free of corrosion before installing new rotors. A new
essential tool (Kent Moore tool J 42450) will soon be sent to all dealers. This tool makes it easier to
clean corrosion around the wheel studs.
^ Always mark the position of rotor on the hub before removal, and reinstall the rotor in the same
position.
^ Rotors with perceived hard spots or discoloration should not be serviced. These conditions are
normal.
^ Installation of new rotors does not require pad replacement. Do NOT replace pads unless their
condition requires it.
^ It is NOT necessary to replace rotors in pairs. Rotors may be serviced individually.
^ A TORQUE LIMITING SOCKET OR TORQUE WRENCH MUST BE USED to insure that the
wheel nuts are tightened to specification. This should be done in 3 steps using the star pattern.
1. Snug the nuts down by hand. 2. Using the star pattern and a torque limiting socket or torque
wrench, tighten the wheel nuts to about half the final torque. 3. Tighten the wheel nuts to
specification using the star pattern and a torque limiting socket or torque wrench.
^ NEVER use lubricants or penetrating fluids on wheel studs, nuts, or mounting surfaces. Wheel
nuts, studs, and mounting surfaces must be clean and dry.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4626
Brake Rotor/Disc: Specifications Front Rotor
Front Rotor
Nominal Thickness 0.806 in
Minimum Refinish Thickness 0.751 in
Thickness Variation (Parallelism) 0.0005 in
Lateral Runout (T.I.R.) 0.003 in
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Disc Brake System > Brake Rotor/Disc > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4627
Brake Rotor/Disc: Service and Repair
1. Raise and support vehicle, then remove tire and wheel assembly. 2. Remove caliper assembly
from rotor as described in Caliper Service. Refer to Brake Caliper/Service and Repair 3. Remove
caliper assembly mounting bracket attaching bolts, then the mounting bracket. 4. Remove rotor
from hub and bearing assembly. 5. Reverse procedure to install.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Backing Plate > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Backing Plate: > 00-05-24-001 > Apr > 00 > Rear Drum
Brakes - Sticking/Won't Release
Backing Plate: Customer Interest Rear Drum Brakes - Sticking/Won't Release
File in Section: 05 - Brakes
Bulletin No.: 00-05-24-001
Date: April, 2000
TECHNICAL
Subject: Snow Intrusion Into Rear Drum Brake Assemblies
Models: 1985-87 Buick Somerset 1985-89 Buick Skyhawk 1985-98 Buick Skylark 1985-88 Cadillac
Cimarron 1985-2000 Chevrolet Cavalier 1985-88 Oldsmobile Firenza 1985-91 Oldsmobile Cutlass
Calais 1992-98 Oldsmobile Achieva 1985-94 Pontiac Sunbird 1985-98 Pontiac Grand Am
1995-2000 Pontiac Sunfire
Condition: Some customers may comment that after operating their vehicle in snow and then
parking the vehicle for an extended period, the rear brakes appear to remain applied.
Cause: On rare occasions, light powdery snow may enter one or both of the vehicle's rear drum
brake assemblies. If the vehicle is parked prior to the snow melt (water) being expelled, this may
result in the rear brake shoe(s) adhering/freezing to the brake drum(s). Normally, the brake shoe(s)
will break free of the drum upon placing the vehicle in gear. However, cases have been noted
where vehicle movement has been restricted until the brake assemblies have had an opportunity to
thaw.
Correction: Replace existing rear brake backing plates with new backing plates, P/N 18015841.
Refer to the Drum Brakes sub-section in the Service Manual for replacement procedures.
Parts Information
Parts are expected to be available from GMSPO, April 10, 2000.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use as shown.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Backing Plate > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Backing Plate: > 00-05-24-001 > Apr > 00 >
Rear Drum Brakes - Sticking/Won't Release
Backing Plate: All Technical Service Bulletins Rear Drum Brakes - Sticking/Won't Release
File in Section: 05 - Brakes
Bulletin No.: 00-05-24-001
Date: April, 2000
TECHNICAL
Subject: Snow Intrusion Into Rear Drum Brake Assemblies
Models: 1985-87 Buick Somerset 1985-89 Buick Skyhawk 1985-98 Buick Skylark 1985-88 Cadillac
Cimarron 1985-2000 Chevrolet Cavalier 1985-88 Oldsmobile Firenza 1985-91 Oldsmobile Cutlass
Calais 1992-98 Oldsmobile Achieva 1985-94 Pontiac Sunbird 1985-98 Pontiac Grand Am
1995-2000 Pontiac Sunfire
Condition: Some customers may comment that after operating their vehicle in snow and then
parking the vehicle for an extended period, the rear brakes appear to remain applied.
Cause: On rare occasions, light powdery snow may enter one or both of the vehicle's rear drum
brake assemblies. If the vehicle is parked prior to the snow melt (water) being expelled, this may
result in the rear brake shoe(s) adhering/freezing to the brake drum(s). Normally, the brake shoe(s)
will break free of the drum upon placing the vehicle in gear. However, cases have been noted
where vehicle movement has been restricted until the brake assemblies have had an opportunity to
thaw.
Correction: Replace existing rear brake backing plates with new backing plates, P/N 18015841.
Refer to the Drum Brakes sub-section in the Service Manual for replacement procedures.
Parts Information
Parts are expected to be available from GMSPO, April 10, 2000.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use as shown.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Backing Plate > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4642
Backing Plate: Testing and Inspection
Inspect backing plate shoe contact surface for grooves that may restrict shoe movement and
cannot be removed by lightly sanding with emery cloth or other suitable abrasive. If backing plate
exhibits above condition, it should be replaced. Also inspect for signs of cracks, warpage and
excessive rust, indicating need for replacement.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Drum > Component Information
> Specifications > Drum Brake Specifications
Brake Drum: Specifications
Drum Diameter 7.874-7.890 in
Maximum Diameter 7.899 in
Discard Diameter 7.929 in
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Drum > Component Information
> Specifications > Drum Brake Specifications > Page 4647
Brake Drum: Specifications
Brake Hose To Caliper 32 ft.lb
Caliper Bleeder Screw 9 ft.lb
Caliper Mounting Bolts 38 ft.lb
Master Cylinder To Booster 20 ft.lb
Wheel Cylinder Bleeder Screw 5 ft.lb
Wheel Cylinder Line Fitting 18 ft.lb
Wheel Cylinder To Backing Plate 15 ft.lb
Wheel Lug Nuts 100 ft.lb
Wheel Speed Sensor Mounting Bolts 5 ft.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Drum > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 4648
Brake Drum: Testing and Inspection
Any time the brake drums are removed for brake service, the braking surface diameter should be
checked with a suitable brake drum micrometer at several points to determine if they are within the
safe oversize limit stamped on the brake drum outer surface. If the braking surface diameter
exceeds specifications, the drum must be replaced. If the braking surface diameter is within
specifications, drums should be cleaned and inspected for cracks, scores, deep grooves, taper, out
of round and heat spotting. If drums are cracked or heat spotted, they must be replaced. Minor
scores should be removed with sandpaper. Grooves and large scores can only be removed by
machining with special equipment, as long as the braking surface is within specifications stamped
on brake drum outer surface. Any brake drum sufficiently out of round to cause vehicle vibration or
noise while braking or showing taper should also be machined, removing only enough stock to true
up the brake drum.
After a brake drum is machined, wipe the braking surface diameter with a denatured alcohol
soaked cloth. If one brake drum is machined, the other should also be machined to the same
diameter to maintain equal braking forces.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Drum > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 4649
Brake Drum: Service and Repair
Fig. 1 Drum Brake Assembly. Type 1.
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support rear of vehicle, then remove tire and wheel assembly. 2. Remove brake drum.
If brake lining is dragging on brake drum, back off brake adjustment by rotating. adjustment screw.
Refer to individual car
chapter for procedure. If brake drum is rusted or corroded to axle flange and cannot be removed,
lightly tap axle flange to drum mounting surface with a suitable hammer.
3. Using brake spring pliers or equivalent, unhook primary and secondary return springs, Fig. 1.
Observe location of brake parts being removed to
aid during installation.
4. Remove brake hold-down springs with suitable tool. 5. Lift actuating lever, then unhook actuating
link from anchor pin and remove. 6. Remove actuating lever(s) and return spring. 7. Spread shoes
apart and remove parking brake strut and spring. 8. Disconnect parking brake cable from lever,
then remove brake shoes from backing plate. 9. Separate brake shoes by removing adjusting
screw and spring, then unhook parking brake lever from shoe assembly.
10. Clean dirt from brake drum, backing plate and all other components. Do not use compressed
air or dry brush to clean brake parts. Many
brake parts contain asbestos fibers which, if inhaled, can cause serious injury. Clean brake parts
with a water soaked rag or a suitable vacuum cleaner to minimize airborne dust.
INSTALLATION
1. Lubricate parking brake lever fulcrum with suitable brake lube, then attach lever to brake shoe.
Ensure lever operates smoothly. 2. Connect brake shoes with adjusting screw spring, then position
adjusting screw. Ensure adjusting screw star wheel does not contact adjusting
screw spring after installation and also ensure righthand thread adjusting screw is installed on left
side of vehicle and lefthand thread adjusting screw is installed on right side of vehicle. When brake
shoe installation is completed, ensure starwheel lines up with adjusting hole in backing plate
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Drum > Component Information
> Specifications > Page 4650
.
3. Lightly lubricate backing plate shoe contact surfaces with suitable brake lube, then the area
where parking brake cable contacts backing plate. 4. Install brake shoes on backing plate while
engaging wheel cylinder links (if equipped) with shoe webbing. Connect parking brake cable to
parking
brake lever. The primary shoe (short lining) faces towards front of vehicle.
5. Install actuating levers, actuating link and return spring, Fig. 1. 6. Install hold-down springs with
suitable tool. 7. Install primary and secondary shoe return springs using brake spring pliers or
equivalent. 8. Using suitable brake drum to shoe gauge, measure brake drum inside diameter.
Adjust brake shoes to dimension obtained on outside portion of
gauge.
9. Install brake drum, wheel and tire assembly.
10. If any hydraulic connections have been opened, bleed brake system. 11. Adjust parking brake.
Refer to individual car chapters for procedures. 12. Inspect all hydraulic lines and connections for
leakage and repair as necessary. 13. Check master cylinder fluid level and replenish as necessary.
14. Check brake pedal for proper feel and return. 15. Lower vehicle and road test. Do not severely
apply brakes immediately after installation of new brake linings or permanent damage may
occur to linings, and/or brake drums may become scored. Brakes must be used moderately during
first several hundred miles of operation to ensure proper burnishing of linings.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection
Brake Shoe: Testing and Inspection
INSPECTION
Inspect brake linings for excessive wear, damage, oil, grease or brake fluid contamination. If any of
the above conditions exists, brake linings should be replaced. Do not attempt to replace only one
set of brake shoes; they should be replaced as an axle set only to maintain equal braking forces.
Examine brake shoe webbing, hold-down and return springs for signs of overheating indicated by a
slight blue color. If any component exhibits overheating signs, replace hold-down and return
springs with new ones. Overheated springs lose their pull and could cause brake linings to wear
out prematurely. Inspect all springs for sags, bends and external damage and replace as
necessary.
Inspect hold-down retainers and pins for bends, rust and corrosion. If any of the above is found,
replace as required.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information
> Adjustments > Service Brake Adjustment
Brake Shoe: Adjustments Service Brake Adjustment
Fig. 4 Inside Diameter Of Brake Drum Measurement.
Fig. 5 Outside Diameter Of Brake Shoes Measurement.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information
> Adjustments > Service Brake Adjustment > Page 4656
Fig. 6 Backing Off Brake Shoe Adjustment.
In as much as there is no way to adjust these brakes with the drums installed, the following
procedure is mandatory after new linings are installed, or it becomes necessary to change the
length of the brake shoe adjusting screw. 1. With brake drums removed, position the caliper shown
in Fig. 4, to the inside diameter of the drum, then tighten the clamp screw. 2. Next position brake
shoe end of the caliper tool over the brake shoes as shown in Fig. 5. 3. Rotate the gauge slightly
around the shoes to ensure the gauge contacts the linings at the largest diameter. 4. Adjust brake
shoes until the gauge is a snug fit on the linings at the point of largest lining diameter. If it is
necessary to back off the brake shoe
adjustment, it will be necessary to hold the adjuster lever away from the adjuster screw, Fig. 6.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information
> Adjustments > Service Brake Adjustment > Page 4657
Brake Shoe: Adjustments Brake Adjustments
These brakes have self-adjusting shoe mechanisms that ensure correct lining-to-drum clearances
at all times. The automatic adjusters operate only when the brakes are applied as the car is moving
rearward.
Although the brakes are self-adjusting, an initial adjustment is necessary after the brake shoes
have been relined or replaced, or when the length of the adjusting screw has been changed during
some other service operation.
Frequent usage of an automatic transmission forward range to halt reverse vehicle motion may
prevent the automatic adjusters from functioning, thereby inducing low pedal heights. Should low
pedal heights be encountered, it is recommended that numerous forward and reverse stops be
made until satisfactory pedal height is obtained. If a low pedal condition cannot be corrected by
making numerous reverse stops (provided the hydraulic system is free of air) it indicates that the
self-adjusting mechanism is not functioning. Therefore, it will be necessary to remove the brake
drum, clean, free up and lubricate the adjusting mechanism. Then adjust the brakes as follows,
being sure the parking brake is fully released.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information
> Adjustments > Page 4658
Brake Shoe: Service and Repair
Fig. 1 Drum Brake Assembly. Type 1.
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support rear of vehicle, then remove tire and wheel assembly. 2. Remove brake drum.
If brake lining is dragging on brake drum, back off brake adjustment by rotating. adjustment screw.
Refer to individual car
chapter for procedure. If brake drum is rusted or corroded to axle flange and cannot be removed,
lightly tap axle flange to drum mounting surface with a suitable hammer.
3. Using brake spring pliers or equivalent, unhook primary and secondary return springs, Fig. 1.
Observe location of brake parts being removed to
aid during installation.
4. Remove brake hold-down springs with suitable tool. 5. Lift actuating lever, then unhook actuating
link from anchor pin and remove. 6. Remove actuating lever(s) and return spring. 7. Spread shoes
apart and remove parking brake strut and spring. 8. Disconnect parking brake cable from lever,
then remove brake shoes from backing plate. 9. Separate brake shoes by removing adjusting
screw and spring, then unhook parking brake lever from shoe assembly.
10. Clean dirt from brake drum, backing plate and all other components. Do not use compressed
air or dry brush to clean brake parts. Many
brake parts contain asbestos fibers which, if inhaled, can cause serious injury. Clean brake parts
with a water soaked rag or a suitable vacuum cleaner to minimize airborne dust.
INSTALLATION
1. Lubricate parking brake lever fulcrum with suitable brake lube, then attach lever to brake shoe.
Ensure lever operates smoothly. 2. Connect brake shoes with adjusting screw spring, then position
adjusting screw. Ensure adjusting screw star wheel does not contact adjusting
screw spring after installation and also ensure righthand thread adjusting screw is installed on left
side of vehicle and lefthand thread adjusting screw is installed on right side of vehicle. When brake
shoe installation is completed, ensure starwheel lines up with adjusting hole in backing plate
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Brake Shoe > Component Information
> Adjustments > Page 4659
.
3. Lightly lubricate backing plate shoe contact surfaces with suitable brake lube, then the area
where parking brake cable contacts backing plate. 4. Install brake shoes on backing plate while
engaging wheel cylinder links (if equipped) with shoe webbing. Connect parking brake cable to
parking
brake lever. The primary shoe (short lining) faces towards front of vehicle.
5. Install actuating levers, actuating link and return spring, Fig. 1. 6. Install hold-down springs with
suitable tool. 7. Install primary and secondary shoe return springs using brake spring pliers or
equivalent. 8. Using suitable brake drum to shoe gauge, measure brake drum inside diameter.
Adjust brake shoes to dimension obtained on outside portion of
gauge.
9. Install brake drum, wheel and tire assembly.
10. If any hydraulic connections have been opened, bleed brake system. 11. Adjust parking brake.
Refer to individual car chapters for procedures. 12. Inspect all hydraulic lines and connections for
leakage and repair as necessary. 13. Check master cylinder fluid level and replenish as necessary.
14. Check brake pedal for proper feel and return. 15. Lower vehicle and road test. Do not severely
apply brakes immediately after installation of new brake linings or permanent damage may
occur to linings, and/or brake drums may become scored. Brakes must be used moderately during
first several hundred miles of operation to ensure proper burnishing of linings.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes - Wheel Cylinder Inspection Guidelines
Wheel Cylinder: Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Wheel Cylinder Inspection Guidelines
Bulletin No.: 03-05-24-001A
Date: March 21, 2005
INFORMATION
Subject: Service Information Regarding Rear Brake Drum Wheel Cylinder Inspections
Models: 2005 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2005 and Prior Saturn Vehicles
with Rear Drum Brakes
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised add model years and include all GM vehicles. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 03-05-24-001 (Section 03 - Suspension).
This bulletin provides information on proper inspection of rear drum brake wheel cylinders.
Important:
It is not recommended that dust boots be removed during inspection processes as dirt and debris
could contaminate the wheel cylinder bore causing premature wear of the wheel cylinder. In
addition, most bores should look damp and some lubricant may drip out from under the boot as a
result of lubricant being present.
All rear drum brake wheel cylinders are assembled with a lubricant to aid in assembly, provide an
anti-corrosion coating to the cylinder bore, and lubricate internal rubber components. As a result of
this lubrication process, it is not uncommon for some amount of lubricant to accumulate at the ends
of the cylinder under the dust boot.
Over time, the lubricant may work its way to the outside of the boot and cause an area of the boot
to look damp. Evidence of a damp area on the boot does not indicate a leak in the cylinder.
However, if there is excessive wetness (i.e. drips) coming from the boot area of the wheel cylinder,
it could indicate a brake hydraulic fluid leak requiring wheel cylinder replacement. (Refer to the
Wheel Cylinder Replacement procedures in the appropriate Service Manual.)
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Specifications > Bore Dimensions
Wheel Cylinder: Specifications
Wheel Cylinder Bore Diameter 0.625 in
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Specifications > Bore Dimensions > Page 4666
Wheel Cylinder: Specifications
Wheel Cylinder Bleeder Screw 5 ft.lb
Wheel Cylinder Line Fitting 18 ft.lb
Wheel Cylinder To Backing Plate 15 ft.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Drum Brake System > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4667
Wheel Cylinder: Service and Repair
Fig. 33 Exploded View Of Wheel Cylinder
1. Raise and support vehicle.
2. Remove wheel, drum and brake shoes.
3. Disconnect hydraulic line at wheel cylinder. Do not pull metal line away from cylinder, as this
may kink or bend line. Line will separate from cylinder when cylinder is moved away from brake
backing plate.
4. Remove wheel cylinder-to-brake plate attaching screws, then the wheel cylinder.
5. Remove boots, pistons, springs and cups from cylinder, Fig. 33.
6. Clean all parts with brake fluid.
7. Inspect cylinder bore. A scored bore may be honed as long as the diameter is not increased by
more than .005 inch. Replace worn or damaged parts as necessary.
8. Ensure hands are clean before proceeding with assembly. Lubricate cylinder wall and rubber
cups with brake fluid, then install springs, cups, pistons and boots in housing.
9. Wipe end of hydraulic line to remove any foreign matter, then place wheel cylinder in position.
Enter tubing into cylinder and start threads on fitting.
10. Secure cylinder to backing plate, then complete tightening of tubing fitting.
11. Install brake shoes, drum and wheel.
12. Bleed system as outlined previously, then adjust brakes.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > With ABS System
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair With ABS System
Manual Bleeding
1. Remove master cylinder reservoir cover, then fill reservoir as necessary. 2. Attach one end of a
clear plastic hose to rear bleeder valve of the brake control assembly, then put opposite end of the
hose into a clean container. 3. While depressing brake pedal, slowly open bleeder valve, until fluid
begins to flow. 4. Close valve and release brake pedal, then repeat procedure for front bleeder
valve. 5. Ensure master cylinder is full, then raise and support vehicle. 6. Bleed wheel cylinders
and calipers using the following sequence:
a. Right rear. b. Left rear. c. Right front. d. Left front.
7. Lower vehicle and check fluid level in reservoir, fill as necessary. 8. Turn on ignition and note
pedal travel and feel as follows:
a. If pedal feels firm and constant, start the engine and recheck pedal travel. If pedal still feels firm
and constant, continue procedure. b. If pedal feels soft or has excessive travel either initially or
after engine is started, repeat bleeding procedure.
9. Road test vehicle, make several normal stops from a moderate speed, then make one or two
ABS stops at approximately 50 mph.
10. Ensure pedal is still firm and constant.
Pressure Bleeding
NOTE: To prevent air, moisture and other contaminants from entering system, only diaphragm type
pressure bleeding equipment should be used.
1. Attach bleeder adapter tool No. J35589, or equivalent, to master cylinder reservoir, then the
adapter tool to the pressure bleeder. 2. Connect a clear plastic hose to the front bleeder valve on
the control assembly, then put opposite end of the hose into a clean container partially
filled with brake fluid.
3. Set pressure bleeder to 5-10 psi and wait for approximately 30 seconds to ensure there is no
leakage. 4. Set pressure bleed equipment to 30-35 psi. 5. Slowly open bleeder valve and allow fluid
to flow into container until no air bubbles are seen in fluid, then close the bleeder valve and torque
to
65 inch lbs.
6. Attach bleeder hose to rear bleeder valve of the control assembly and repeat preceding step. 7.
Position a cloth under hydraulic brake pipe connections. 8. Working from front of the control
assembly to the rear, slowly turn each pipe nut and check for air in escaping fluid. 9. When air flow
ceases, torque pipe nut to 13 ft. lbs.
10. Raise and support vehicle, then bleed wheel cylinders and calipers using the following
sequence:
a. Right rear. b. Left rear. c. Right front. d. Left front.
11. Lower vehicle and remove bleeder adapter tool from master cylinder. 12. Check fluid level in
reservoir, fill as necessary. 13. Turn ignition switch to On position and note pedal travel and feel as
follows:
a. If pedal feels firm and constant, start the engine and recheck pedal travel. If pedal still feels firm
and constant, continue procedure. b. If pedal feels soft or has excessive travel either initially or
after engine is started, repeat bleeding procedure.
14. Road test vehicle, make several normal stops from a moderate speed, then make one or two
ABS stops at approximately 50 mph. 15. Ensure pedal is still firm and constant.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > With ABS System > Page 4673
Brake Bleeding: Service and Repair Without ABS System
Manual
Fig. 210 Brake System Manual Bleed.
NOTE: Pressure bleeding is recommended for all hydraulic systems. However, if a pressure
bleeder is unavailable, use the following procedure. Brake fluid damages painted surfaces.
Immediately clean any spilled fluid.
1. Remove vacuum reserve by pumping brakes several times with engine off. 2. Fill master cylinder
reservoir with clean brake fluid. Check fluid level often during bleeding procedure; do not let
reservoir fall below half full. 3. If necessary, bleed master cylinder as follows:
a. Disconnect master cylinder forward brake line connection until fluid flows from reservoir.
Reconnect and tighten brake line. b. Instruct an assistant to slowly depress brake pedal one time
and hold. c. Crack open front brake line connection again, purging air from cylinder. d. Retighten
connection and slowly release brake pedal. e. Wait 15 seconds, then repeat until all air is purged. f.
Bleed the rearward (nearest the cowl) brake line connection by repeating steps a through e.
4. Loosen, then slightly retighten bleeder valves at all four wheels. Repair any broken, stripped or
frozen valves at this time. 5. Proceed to appropriate wheel first and follow set sequence according
to Wheel Bleeding Sequence. 6. Place transparent tube over bleeder valve, then allow tube to
hang down into transparent container, Fig. 16. Ensure end of tube is submerged in
clean brake fluid.
7. Instruct an assistant to slowly depress brake pedal one time and hold. 8. Crack open bleeder
valve, purging air from cylinder. Retighten bleeder screw and slowly release pedal. 9. Wait 15
seconds, then repeat steps 7 and 8. Repeat these steps until all air is bled from system.
Pressure
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > With ABS System > Page 4674
Fig. 21 Installing Pressure Bleeder Adapter
Fig. 210 Brake System Manual Bleed.
1. Loosen, then slightly retighten bleeder valves at all four wheels. Repair any broken, stripped or
frozen valves at this time. 2. Using a diaphragm type pressure bleeder, install suitable bleeder
adapter to master cylinder, Fig. 17. 3. Charge bleeder ball to 20-25 psi. 4. Connect pressure
bleeder line to adapter. 5. Open line valve on pressure bleeder, then depress bleed-off valve on
adapter until a small amount of brake fluid is released. 6. Raise and support vehicle. 7. Proceed to
appropriate wheel first and follow set sequence according to Wheel Bleeding Sequence. 8. Place
transparent tube over bleeder valve, then allow tube to hang down into transparent container, Fig.
16. Ensure end of tube is submerged in
clean brake fluid.
9. Open bleeder valve 1/2 to 3/4 turn and allow fluid to flow into container until all air is purged from
line.
Front Disc Brakes
NOTE: Pressure bleeding is recommended for all hydraulic disc brake systems.
The disc brake hydraulic system can be bled manually or with pressure bleeding equipment. On
vehicles with disc brakes the brake pedal will require more pumping and frequent checking of fluid
level in master cylinder during bleeding operation.
Never use brake fluid that has been drained from hydraulic system when bleeding the brakes. Be
sure the disc brake pistons are returned to their normal positions and that the shoe and lining
assemblies are properly seated. Before driving the vehicle, check brake operation to be sure that a
firm
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair > With ABS System > Page 4675
pedal has been obtained.
Wheel Bleeding Sequence
Rear wheel drive models: if manual bleeding, RR-LR-RF-LF; if pressure bleeding, bleed front
brakes together and rear brakes together. Front wheel drive models: RR-LF-LR-RF
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Specifications > Bore Diameter
Brake Caliper: Specifications
Front Caliper Bore Diameter 2.244 in
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Specifications > Bore Diameter > Page 4680
Brake Caliper: Specifications Tightening Specifications
Brake Hose to Caliper .........................................................................................................................
.................................................... 44 Nm (32 ft. lbs.) Caliper Bleed Screw .........................................
.......................................................................................................................................... 12 Nm (9 ft.
lbs.) Caliper Mounting Bolts .................................................................................................................
........................................................... 52 Nm (38 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal/Installation
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Removal/Installation
Fig. 8 Piston Compressing W/Pliers.
Fig. 9 Caliper Mounting Bolts Replacement.
REMOVAL
1. Remove approximately 2/3 of brake fluid from master cylinder.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal/Installation > Page 4683
2. Raise and support front of vehicle, then remove wheel and tire assembly. 3. Position suitable
pliers over inboard pad and housing as shown in Fig. 8, and squeeze pliers to compress caliper
piston. 4. If caliper assembly is being removed for service, remove inlet fitting attaching bolt, copper
washer, and inlet fitting from caliper housing. Plug
opening in inlet fitting to prevent fluid loss and contamination. Do not crimp brake hose, as this may
damage internal structure of hose. If only shoe and lining assemblies are to be replaced, do not
disconnect brake line fitting from caliper.
5. Remove Allen head caliper mounting bolts, Fig. 9. If bolts show signs of corrosion, use new bolts
when installing caliper assembly. 6. Remove caliper assembly from disc. If only shoe and lining
assemblies are to be replaced, using a length of wire suspend caliper from spring coil.
Never allow caliper to hang from brake hose.
Fig. 9 Caliper Mounting Bolts Replacement.
Fig. 13 Caliper & Stops Clearance Inspection.
CALIPER INSTALLATION
1. Position caliper assembly over disc and align mounting bolt holes. If brake hoses were not
disconnected during removal, use care not to kink hoses
during installation.
2. Install mounting bolts and tighten to specifications, Fig. 9. 3. Check dimensions between each
caliper stop and caliper, Fig. 13. If necessary remove caliper and file ends of bracket to provide
proper clearance. 4. If brake hose fitting was disconnected during removal, install brake hose
fitting. 5. Fill master cylinder. Bleed brake system if brake line was disconnected and recheck
master cylinder fluid level. 6. Install wheel and tire assembly on vehicle, then lower vehicle and
check brake system operation. Before moving vehicle, pump brake pedal
several times to be sure it is firm. Do not move vehicle until a firm pedal is obtained.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal/Installation > Page 4684
Brake Caliper: Service and Repair Disassemble/Assemble
Fig. 10 Caliper Piston Removal.
Fig. 11 Dust Boot Removal.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Caliper > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Removal/Installation > Page 4685
Fig. 12 Dust Boot Installation In Caliper.
REMOVAL
1. Remove approximately 2/3 of brake fluid from master cylinder. 2. Raise and support front of
vehicle, then remove wheel and tire assembly. 3. Position suitable pliers over inboard pad and
housing as shown in Fig. 8, and squeeze pliers to compress caliper piston. 4. If caliper assembly is
being removed for service, remove inlet fitting attaching bolt, copper washer, and inlet fitting from
caliper housing. Plug
opening in inlet fitting to prevent fluid loss and contamination. Do not crimp brake hose, as this may
damage internal structure of hose. If only shoe and lining assemblies are to be replaced, do not
disconnect brake line fitting from caliper.
5. Remove Allen head caliper mounting bolts, Fig. 9. If bolts show signs of corrosion, use new bolts
when installing caliper assembly. 6. Remove caliper assembly from disc. If only shoe and lining
assemblies are to be replaced, using a length of wire suspend caliper from spring coil.
Never allow caliper to hang from brake hose.
DISASSEMBLE
1. Clean outside of caliper, then drain brake fluid from caliper. 2. Use clean shop towels to pad
interior of caliper assembly, then remove piston by directing compressed air into caliper brake hose
inlet hole, Fig.
10. Use just enough air pressure to ease piston out of bore. Do not place fingers in front of piston
for any reason when applying compressed air. This could result in serious personal injury.
3. Using a screwdriver, remove dust boot from caliper bore, Fig. 11. 4. Using a small piece of wood
or plastic, remove piston seal from bore. Do not use a metal tool of any kind to remove seal as it
may damage
bore.
5. Remove bleeder valve. 6. Inspect piston for scoring, nicks, corrosion, and wear and replace as
needed. 7. Inspect caliper housing and seal groove for corrosion, nicks, scoring and excessive
wear, and use crocus cloth to polish away corrosion from
housing bore. Replace caliper housing if corrosion in and around seal groove will not clean up with
crocus cloth.
8. Clean all parts with denatured alcohol. Dry with unlubricated compressed air. Blow out all
passages in housing and bleeder valve.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brake Fluid - Level & Filling Recommendations
Brake Fluid: Technical Service Bulletins Brake Fluid - Level & Filling Recommendations
File In Section: 05 - Brakes
Bulletin No.: 00-05-22-004
Date: May, 2000
INFORMATION
Subject: Brake Fluid Level and Filling Recommendations
Models: 2001 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
Many dealers and after-market repair shops advertise multi-point fluid "top-ups" in conjunction with
oil changes or regular maintenance packages. These offers often include adding brake fluid to the
master cylinder reservoir. There are only two reasons why the brake fluid level in the brake
reservoir might go down. The first is that the brake fluid level goes down an acceptable level during
normal brake lining wear. When the linings are replaced, the fluid will return to it's original level.
The second possible reason for a low fluid level is that fluid is leaking out of the brake system. If
fluid is leaking, the brake system requires repair and adding additional fluid will not correct the leak.
If the system was properly filled during delivery of the vehicle, no additional fluid should be required
under most circumstances between brake pad and/or shoe replacements. This information can be
reinforced with the customer by referring them to the Brake Fluid section of their vehicle's Owner's
Manual.
Guidelines
GM vehicles have incorporated a variety of brake fluid reservoir styles. The following guidelines are
restricted to the plastic bodied fluid reservoirs and do not affect the original service
recommendations for the older style metal bodied units.
You may encounter both black plastic and translucent style reservoirs. You may have reservoirs
with:
^ A MAX fill mark only
^ A MIN fill mark only
^ Both MAX and MIN marks
The translucent style reservoirs do not have to have the covers removed in order to view the fluid
level. It is a good practice not to remove the reservoir cover unless necessary to reduce the
possibility of contaminating the system. Use the following guidelines to assist in determining the
proper fluid level.
Important:
When adding brake fluid, use Delco Supreme II(R) Brake Fluid, GM P/N 12377967 or equivalent
brand bearing the DOT-3 rating only.
Important:
At no time should the fluid level be allowed to remain in an overfilled condition. Overfilling the brake
reservoir may put unnecessary stress on the seals and cover of the reservoir. Use the following
guidelines to properly maintain the fluid level. If the reservoir is overfilled, siphon out the additional
fluid to comply with the guidelines below.
Important:
If under any circumstance the brake fluid level is extremely low in the reservoir or the BRAKE
warning indicator is illuminated, the brake system should be checked for leaks and the system
repaired in addition to bringing the fluid level up to the recommended guidelines outlined below. A
leaking brake system will have reduced braking performance and will eventually not work at all.
Important:
Some vehicles have reservoirs that are very sensitive to brake fluid levels and may cause the
BRAKE indicator to flicker on turns as the fluid approaches the minimum required level. If you
encounter a vehicle with this concern, increase the fluid level staying within the guidelines outlined
below.
^ If the reservoir has a MAX level indicator, the reservoir should be returned to the MAX marking
only at the time new brake pads and/or shoes are installed. If the reservoir fluid level is at the
half-way point or above do not attempt to add additional brake fluid during routine fluid checks.
^ If the reservoir has both MAX and MIN indicators, the fluid level should be maintained above the
MIN indicator during routine fluid checks and returned to the MAX indication only after new brake
pads and/or shoes are installed.
^ For reservoirs with only a MIN indication, the fluid level should be maintained above the MIN
indicator during routine fluid checks. Return the
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brake Fluid - Level & Filling Recommendations > Page 4690
reservoir fluid level to full only after installing new brake pads and/or shoes. A full reservoir is
indicated on translucent, snap cover reservoirs by a fluid level even with the top level of the view
window imprinted into the side of the reservoir. On screw top models in black or translucent plastic,
the full level is just below the bottom of the filler neck.
Parts Information
Part Number Description
12377967 Brake Fluid
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4691
Brake Fluid: Specifications
Brake System DOT 3
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch
> Component Information > Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 4695
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
OPERATION
This sensor mounted on the master cylinder will activate the Brake Warning lamp if a low brake
fluid level is detected. The lamp will turn off once the fluid level is corrected.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Pressure
Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
Brake Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
Fig. 3 Pressure Differential Valve & Brake Warning Lamp Switch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Fluid Pressure
Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4699
Fig. 4 Dual Master Cylinder W/Built In Warning Lamp Switch.
DESCRIPTION
In Fig. 3, as pressure falls in one system, the other system's normal pressure forces the piston to
the inoperative side, contacting the switch terminal, causing the warning lamp on the instrument
panel to glow.
In Fig. 4 shows the switch mounted directly in the master cylinder assembly. Whenever there is a
specified differential pressure, the switch piston will activate the brake failure warning switch and
cause the brake warning lamp to glow.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake
Proportioning/Combination Valve > Component Information > Description and Operation > Brake Distribution Valve & Switch
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Description and Operation Brake Distribution Valve &
Switch
Fig. 12 Distribution Switch. Diagonally Split Brake System
Fig. 16 Brake Distribution Switch. Normal
Fig. 16 Brake Distribution Switch. Normal
DESCRIPTION
This switch assembly, Fig. 12. is used on some diagonally split brake systems and Corvette four
wheel disc brake systems. It is connected to the outlet ports of the master cylinder and to the brake
warning lamp and warns the driver if either the primary or secondary brake system has failed.
OPERATION
When hydraulic pressure is equal in both primary and secondary brake systems, the switch
remains centered, Fig. 13. If pressure fails in one of the systems, the piston moves toward the
inoperative side, Fig. 14. The shoulder of the piston contacts the switch terminal, providing a
ground and lighting the warning lamp.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake
Proportioning/Combination Valve > Component Information > Description and Operation > Brake Distribution Valve & Switch
> Page 4704
Brake Proportioning/Combination Valve: Description and Operation Combination Valve
Combination Valve
Fig. 5 Combination Valve
DESCRIPTION
The combination valve, Fig. 5 is a metering valve, failure warning switch, and a proportioner in one
assembly and is used on disc brake applications.
OPERATION
The metering valve delays front disc braking until the rear drum brake shoes contact the drum. The
failure warning switch is actuated in event of front or rear brake system failure, in turn activating a
dash warning lamp. The proportioner balances front to rear braking action during rapid
deceleration.
Metering Valve
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake
Proportioning/Combination Valve > Component Information > Description and Operation > Brake Distribution Valve & Switch
> Page 4705
Fig. 6 Metering Valve. Initial Braking
Fig. 7 Metering Valve. Continued Braking
DESCRIPTION
When the brakes are not applied, the metering valve permits the brake fluid to flow through the
valve, thus allowing the fluid to expand and contract with temperature changes.
OPERATION
When the brakes are initially applied, the metering valve stem moves to the left, preventing fluid to
flow through the valve to the front disc brakes. This is accomplished by the smooth end of the
metering valve stem contacting the metering valve seal lip at 4 to 30 psi, Fig. 6. The metering valve
spring holds the retainer against the seal until a predetermined pressure is produced at the valve
inlet port which overcomes the spring pressure and permits hydraulic pressure to actuate the front
disc brakes, Fig. 7. The increased pressure into the valve is metered through the valve seal, to the
front disc brakes, producing an increased force on the diaphragm. The diaphragm then pulls the
pin, in turn pulling the retainer and reduces the spring pressure on the metering valve seal.
Eventually, the pressure reaches a point at which the spring is pulled away by the diaphragm pin
and retainer, leaving the metering valve unrestricted, permitting full pressure to pass through the
metering valve.
Failure Warning Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake
Proportioning/Combination Valve > Component Information > Description and Operation > Brake Distribution Valve & Switch
> Page 4706
Fig. 8 Failure Warning Switch. Rear System Failure
DESCRIPTION
If the rear brake system fails, the front system pressure forces the switch piston to the right, Fig. 8.
The switch pin is then forced up into the switch, completing the electrical circuit and activates the
dash warning lamp.
OPERATION
When repairs are made and pressure returns to the system, the piston moves to the left, resetting
the switch. The detent on the piston requires approximately 100 to 450 psi to permit full reset of the
piston. In event of front brake system failure, the piston moves to the left and the same sequence
of events is followed as for rear system failure except the piston resets to the right.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Assembly, Traction
Control > Component Information > Description and Operation
Hydraulic Assembly: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The ABS hydraulic modulator/motor pack assembly controls hydraulic pressure to front and rear
calipers or rear wheel cylinders by modulating hydraulic pressure to prevent wheel lock-up.
The basic ABS hydraulic modulator configuration consists of gear subassemblies, ball screws,
nuts, pistons and hydraulic check valves. The ABS motor pack consists of three motors, three drive
gears and three ESB's.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Hydraulic Control Assembly
- Antilock Brakes: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 & C1286)
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Customer Interest Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 &
86 (C1246 & C1286)
File In Section: 5 - Brakes
Bulletin No.: 73-50-26
Date: August, 1997
Subject: ABS Light On - DTC's 46 and 86 Set (Perform Diagnostic Procedure, Replace Center ABS
Motor Pinion)
Models: 1991-97 Buick Skylark 1992-97 Buick Regal 1994-97 Buick Century 1992-96 Chevrolet
Beretta, Corsica, Lumina APV 1992-97 Chevrolet Cavalier, Lumina, 1993-97 Chevrolet Camaro
1995-97 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 1997
Chevrolet Malibu, Venture
1993-97 Geo Prizm 1995-97 Geo Metro 1996-97 Geo Tracker 1991
Oldsmobile Calais
1992-96 Oldsmobile Cutlass Ciera 1992-97 Oldsmobile Achieva, Cutlass Supreme, Silhouette
1997
Oldsmobile Cutlass
1998 Oldsmobile Intrigue
1991-97 Pontiac Grand Am 1992-94 Pontiac Sunbird 1992-97 Pontiac Grand Prix, Trans Sport
1993-97 Pontiac Firebird, Trans Am 1995-97 Pontiac Sunfire
Condition
Some owners may comment that the ABS light is on with Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) 46
and 86 set (rear ABS channel will not move) as current or history. (DTC's 46 and 86 will be
displayed as C1246 and C1286 on 1997 and 1998 model year vehicles).
Cause
A condition exists where the ABS motor pack gear (pinion) will bind on the motor armature shaft
causing the motor not to move when commanded by the EBCM. This condition is aggravated by
light corrosion between the pinion and shaft. Therefore, it may occur more frequently when the
weather is hot and humid.
Important:
Other EBCM and ABS motor pack concerns can also cause this condition, but they are not as
common as the above cause.
Correction
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Hydraulic Control Assembly
- Antilock Brakes: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 & C1286) > Page 4718
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Hydraulic Control Assembly
- Antilock Brakes: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 & C1286) > Page 4719
Follow the included procedure (Attachments 1 and 2) for diagnosis. This condition may correct
itself before the owner is able to bring the vehicle in for service. Therefore, if DTC 46 is set in
history, and is not currently setting, the included procedure will instruct you to replace the center
ABS motor pinion. The new pinion has a Teflon insert which reduces friction between the pinion
and motor armature shaft.
Pinion Replacement
If the included procedure instructs you to replace the center ABS motor pinion, use P/N 18029776.
Please note that the new pinion is a direct replacement part which requires no modifications to the
motor shaft. Follow the pinion replacement procedure included with the new pinion. Complete
motor pack replacement is not required.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Labor Time
H2506 Use published labor
operation time.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Hydraulic Control Assembly
- Antilock Brakes: > 535010 > May > 95 > ABS - Lamp ON/DTC's 42 and 86 Set
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Customer Interest ABS - Lamp ON/DTC's 42 and 86
Set
FILE IN SECTION: 5 - Brakes
BULLETIN NO.: 53-50-10
DATE: May, 1995
SUBJECT: Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Light On - Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) 42 and 86
Set (Replace Hydraulic Modulator)
MODELS: 1993-95
Buick Skylark
1993-95 Chevrolet Beretta, Corsica, Cavalier
1993-95 Oldsmobile Achieva
1993-95 Pontiac Grand Am
1993-94 Pontiac Sunbird
1995 Pontiac Sunfire
CONDITION
Some owners may comment that the Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) light remains on. Diagnostic
Trouble Codes (DTC's) 42 and 86 will be set. DTC's will usually set 5 to 8 drive cycles in a row and
then become history codes.
CAUSE
DTC's will be set due to a momentary delay within the ABS hydraulic modulator.
CORRECTION
Important:
If DTC 42 is current DTC, the Diagnostic Trouble Tree in Section 5E1 of the Service Manual will
lead to replacement of the motor pack. If the following diagnosis does not lead to replacement of
the hydraulic modulator, then the motor pack should be replaced.
Diagnosis
^ If DTC 42 has set 10 or less drive cycles and is no longer a current code (ABS not operating,
ABS indicator off), replace the hydraulic modulator.
^ If DTC is current, cycle the system by starting the engine with your foot off the brake pedal. If the
ABS indicator remains on, turn the ignition off and repeat the procedure. If within 10 cycles the ABS
indicator is off and the code is no longer current, replace the hydraulic modulator.
^ If the above diagnosis does not lead to replacement of the modulator, follow DTC 42 Trouble
Tree in Section 5E1 of the Service Manual.
Repair Procedure
If the condition is confirmed through the above diagnosis, the hydraulic modulator must be
replaced, P/N 18023364. This is a new part number that has been released. Do not use previously
released hydraulic modulator part numbers. Refer to Section 5E1 of the Service Manual for
hydraulic modulator replacement procedure.
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor
Operation Labor Time
H2518 Use published labor operation time.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 & C1286)
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - ABS Light
ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 & C1286)
File In Section: 5 - Brakes
Bulletin No.: 73-50-26
Date: August, 1997
Subject: ABS Light On - DTC's 46 and 86 Set (Perform Diagnostic Procedure, Replace Center ABS
Motor Pinion)
Models: 1991-97 Buick Skylark 1992-97 Buick Regal 1994-97 Buick Century 1992-96 Chevrolet
Beretta, Corsica, Lumina APV 1992-97 Chevrolet Cavalier, Lumina, 1993-97 Chevrolet Camaro
1995-97 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 1997
Chevrolet Malibu, Venture
1993-97 Geo Prizm 1995-97 Geo Metro 1996-97 Geo Tracker 1991
Oldsmobile Calais
1992-96 Oldsmobile Cutlass Ciera 1992-97 Oldsmobile Achieva, Cutlass Supreme, Silhouette
1997
Oldsmobile Cutlass
1998 Oldsmobile Intrigue
1991-97 Pontiac Grand Am 1992-94 Pontiac Sunbird 1992-97 Pontiac Grand Prix, Trans Sport
1993-97 Pontiac Firebird, Trans Am 1995-97 Pontiac Sunfire
Condition
Some owners may comment that the ABS light is on with Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) 46
and 86 set (rear ABS channel will not move) as current or history. (DTC's 46 and 86 will be
displayed as C1246 and C1286 on 1997 and 1998 model year vehicles).
Cause
A condition exists where the ABS motor pack gear (pinion) will bind on the motor armature shaft
causing the motor not to move when commanded by the EBCM. This condition is aggravated by
light corrosion between the pinion and shaft. Therefore, it may occur more frequently when the
weather is hot and humid.
Important:
Other EBCM and ABS motor pack concerns can also cause this condition, but they are not as
common as the above cause.
Correction
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 & C1286) >
Page 4729
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 & C1286) >
Page 4730
Follow the included procedure (Attachments 1 and 2) for diagnosis. This condition may correct
itself before the owner is able to bring the vehicle in for service. Therefore, if DTC 46 is set in
history, and is not currently setting, the included procedure will instruct you to replace the center
ABS motor pinion. The new pinion has a Teflon insert which reduces friction between the pinion
and motor armature shaft.
Pinion Replacement
If the included procedure instructs you to replace the center ABS motor pinion, use P/N 18029776.
Please note that the new pinion is a direct replacement part which requires no modifications to the
motor shaft. Follow the pinion replacement procedure included with the new pinion. Complete
motor pack replacement is not required.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Labor Time
H2506 Use published labor
operation time.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Hydraulic
Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: > 535010 > May > 95 > ABS - Lamp ON/DTC's 42 and 86 Set
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS - Lamp
ON/DTC's 42 and 86 Set
FILE IN SECTION: 5 - Brakes
BULLETIN NO.: 53-50-10
DATE: May, 1995
SUBJECT: Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Light On - Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) 42 and 86
Set (Replace Hydraulic Modulator)
MODELS: 1993-95
Buick Skylark
1993-95 Chevrolet Beretta, Corsica, Cavalier
1993-95 Oldsmobile Achieva
1993-95 Pontiac Grand Am
1993-94 Pontiac Sunbird
1995 Pontiac Sunfire
CONDITION
Some owners may comment that the Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) light remains on. Diagnostic
Trouble Codes (DTC's) 42 and 86 will be set. DTC's will usually set 5 to 8 drive cycles in a row and
then become history codes.
CAUSE
DTC's will be set due to a momentary delay within the ABS hydraulic modulator.
CORRECTION
Important:
If DTC 42 is current DTC, the Diagnostic Trouble Tree in Section 5E1 of the Service Manual will
lead to replacement of the motor pack. If the following diagnosis does not lead to replacement of
the hydraulic modulator, then the motor pack should be replaced.
Diagnosis
^ If DTC 42 has set 10 or less drive cycles and is no longer a current code (ABS not operating,
ABS indicator off), replace the hydraulic modulator.
^ If DTC is current, cycle the system by starting the engine with your foot off the brake pedal. If the
ABS indicator remains on, turn the ignition off and repeat the procedure. If within 10 cycles the ABS
indicator is off and the code is no longer current, replace the hydraulic modulator.
^ If the above diagnosis does not lead to replacement of the modulator, follow DTC 42 Trouble
Tree in Section 5E1 of the Service Manual.
Repair Procedure
If the condition is confirmed through the above diagnosis, the hydraulic modulator must be
replaced, P/N 18023364. This is a new part number that has been released. Do not use previously
released hydraulic modulator part numbers. Refer to Section 5E1 of the Service Manual for
hydraulic modulator replacement procedure.
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor
Operation Labor Time
H2518 Use published labor operation time.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly Removal and Instalation
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Service and Repair Hydraulic Modulator Assembly
Removal and Instalation
HYDRAULIC MODULATOR-MASTER CYLINDER ASSEMBLY
CAUTION:To help avoid personal injury, due to a retained load on the hydraulic modulator, the
gear tension relief function of the Tech 1 must be performed prior to removal of the ABS hydraulic
modulator/master cylinder assembly.
Remove or Disconnect
1. Using Tech 1, perform "Gear Tension Relief Sequence".
2. Two solenoid electrical connectors. 3. Fluid level sensor electrical connector. 4. 6-way ABS
motor pack electrical connector. 5. Four brakes pipes. 6. Two nuts attaching ABS hydraulic
modulator/master cylinder assembly to vacuum booster. 7. ABS hydraulic modulator/master
cylinder assembly.
Install or Connect
1. ABS hydraulic modulator/master cylinder assembly in vehicle. 2. Two nuts attaching ABS
hydraulic modulator/master cylinder assembly to vacuum booster
Tighten ^
Nuts to 27 N.m (20 lb. ft.).
3. Four brake pipes to ABS hydraulic modulator/master cylinder assembly. 4. ABS motor pack
6-way electrical connector. 5. Fluid level sensor electrical connector. 6. Two solenoid electrical
connectors.
Important
7. Bleed hydraulic system.
Tighten ^
Tube nuts to 24 N.m (18 lb. ft.).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly Removal and Instalation >
Page 4737
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Service and Repair Hydraulic Modulator Assembly
Unit Repair
Gear Tension Relief Sequence
Gear Tension Relief Sequence
When the displacement cylinder pistons are in their topmost position, each motor has prevailing
torque due to the force necessary to ensure each piston is held firmly at the top of its travel. This
torque results in "gear tension," or force on each gear that makes motor pack separation difficult.
To avoid injury, or damage to the gears, the "Gear Tension Relief Sequence" briefly reverses each
motor to eliminate the prevailing torque.
Always perform the "Gear Tension Relief Sequence" with the scan tool prior to removing the
hydraulic modulator-master cylinder assembly from the vehicle.
Gear Cover
Gear Cover
CAUTION: To help avoid personal injury, due to a retained load on the ABS hydraulic modulator,
the gear tension relief function of the Tech 1 must be performed prior to removal of the ABS
hydraulic modulator-master cylinder assembly.
NOTICE: The following service procedures shall be performed only after the ABS hydraulic
modulator-master cylinder assembly has been removed from the vehicle. Do not perform these
procedures with the unit installed on the vehicle. Complete overhaul of the ABS hydraulic
modulator-master cylinder assembly is not authorized. These steps will break the unit down into
major components for replacement purposes.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly Removal and Instalation >
Page 4738
ABS Brake Modulator/Master Cylinder Assembly Components
DISASSEMBLE
1. Torx head screws attaching gear cover. 2. Remove gear cover.
ASSEMBLE
1. Gear cover to Antilock Brake System brake modulator/master cylinder assembly. 2. Torx head
screws.
Tighten
^ Tighten torx screws to 4 Nm (35 inch lbs.).
ABS Motor Pack
MOTOR PACK
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly Removal and Instalation >
Page 4739
CAUTION: To help avoid personal injury, due to a retained load on the ABS hydraulic modulator,
the gear tension relief function of the Tech 1 must be performed prior to removal of the ABS
hydraulic modulator-master cylinder assembly.
NOTICE: The following service procedures shall be performed only after the ABS hydraulic
modulator-master cylinder assembly has been removed from the vehicle. Do not perform these
procedures with the unit installed on the vehicle. Complete overhaul of the ABS hydraulic
modulator-master cylinder assembly is not authorized. These steps will break the unit down into
major components for replacement purposes.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly Removal and Instalation >
Page 4740
ABS Brake Modulator/Master Cylinder Assembly Components
Disassemble
1. Remove gear cover. 2. Four Torx head screws attaching ABS brake motor pack.
Important
^ Use care when handling the motor pack to ensure the motor pack connectors are not damaged,
or accidental intrusion of brake fluid into the motor pack does not occur. This may result in a
premature failure of the motor pack.
^ Take care in handling the motor packs. If dropped or damaged during handling, the motor packs
must be replaced.
3. Remove ABS motor pack.
Important
^ If disassembly of the brake modulator-master cylinder assembly was due to an ABS hydraulic
functional test that did not pass, the Automated ABS brake motor pack Diagnosis Test described in
this section should be performed at this time to isolate the ABS brake motor pack or brake
modulator.
^ No repair of the motor pack is authorized. Replace as an assembly.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly Removal and Instalation >
Page 4741
ABS Brake Modulator/Master Cylinder Assembly Components
Assemble
1. With the brake modulator upside down, and the gears facing you, rotate each ABS brake
modulator gear counterclockwise until movement stops.
This procedure will position the pistons on the ABS brake modulator very close to the top of the
modulator bore. This will simplify the brake bleeding procedure.
2. Motor pack to brake modulator assembly.
Important
^ Take care in handling the motor packs. If dropped or damaged during handling the ABS brake
motor pack must be replaced.
^ Align each of the three ABS brake motor pack pinions with the brake modulator gears.
3. Four Torx head screws.
Tighten
^ Torx head screws to 4.5 Nm (40 inch lbs.).
4. Gear cover to ABS brake modulator-brake master cylinder assembly.
Gear Replacement
GEAR REPLACEMENT
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly Removal and Instalation >
Page 4742
CAUTION: To help avoid personal injury, due to a retained load on the ABS hydraulic modulator,
the gear tension relief function of the Tech 1 must be performed prior to removal of the ABS
hydraulic modulator/master cylinder assembly.
NOTICE: The following service procedures shall be performed only after the ABS hydraulic
modulator/master cylinder assembly has been removed from the vehicle. Do not perform these
procedures with the unit installed on the vehicle. Complete overhaul of the ABS hydraulic
modulator/ master cylinder assembly is not authorized -only the following steps. These steps will
break the unit down into major components for replacement purposes.
Important ^
Do not attempt to repair damaged motor packs or hydraulic modulators. Other than modulator drive
gears replacement, repair of these assemblies is not authorized. Do not lubricate or oil gears on
motor pack.
CAUTION: The modulator drive gears are under spring load and will turn during disassembly. After
removing hydraulic modulator drive gear cover, exercise extreme care not to place fingers into the
gear set, since fingers can be pinched by rotating gears.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. ABS brake modulator/master cylinder assembly. 2. Torx head screws attaching gear cover. 3.
Four ABS brake motor pack to ABS brake modulator Torx head screws.
Important
^ Take care in handling the ABS motor pack. If dropped or damaged in the handling, the ABS
motor pack must be replaced.
4. Separate motor pack from brake modulator. 5. Three modulator drive gears from modulator drive
shaft retaining nuts.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly Removal and Instalation >
Page 4743
Gear Removal
6. Gears from modulator.
NOTICE: Do not allow gear to turn while removing the retaining nut, since the modulator piston can
hit the top of the modulator bore, damaging the piston. Place a screwdriver through the holes in the
gear (not between the gears) into the recessed hole in the modulator base. This will prevent the
gear from turning, aiding in gear removal.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
Gear Position
NOTICE: Do not allow gear to turn while tightening the retaining nut, since the modulator piston
can bottom out in the modulator bore damaging the piston. Turn the modulator gear to position the
piston in the center of its travel. Place a screwdriver through the hole in the gears (not between the
gears) into the recessed hole in the modulator base.This will prevent the gear from turning, aiding
in gear installation.
1. Position ABS brake modulator drive gears onto brake modulator drive shaft. 2. Install three gear
retaining nuts.
Tighten Nuts
^ Nuts to 8.5 Nm (76 inch lbs.).
Gear Position
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly Removal and Instalation >
Page 4744
3. With the ABS hydraulic modulator upside down, and the gears facing you, rotate each ABS
brake modulator gear counterclockwise until
movement stops. This procedure will position the pistons on the ABS brake modulator very close to
the top of the modulator bore. This will simplify the brake bleeding procedure.
4. Position the motor pack onto brake modulator, aligning the three motor pack gears with the
modulator gears.
Important
^ Take care in handling the ABS motor pack. If dropped or damaged during handling, the ABS
motor pack must be replaced.
5. Four motor pack to brake modulator Torx head screws.
Tighten
^ Torx head screws 4.5 Nm (40 inch lbs.).
6. Gear cover onto brake modulator with Torx head screws.
Tighten
^ Torx head screws 4 Nm (35 inch lbs.).
7. Brake Modulator to Master Cylinder assembly.
ABS Hydraulic Modulator
Hydraulic Modulator
CAUTION: To help avoid personal injury, due to a retained load on the ABS hydraulic modulator,
the gear tension relief function of the Tech 1 must be performed prior to removal of the ABS
hydraulic modulator/master cylinder assembly.
NOTICE: The following service procedures shall be performed only after the ABS hydraulic
modulator-master cylinder assembly has been removed from the vehicle. Do not perform these
procedures with the unit installed on the vehicle. Complete overhaul of the ABS hydraulic
modulator-master cylinder assembly is not authorized. These steps will break the unit down into
major components for replacement purposes.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly Removal and Instalation >
Page 4745
ABS Brake Modulator/Master Cylinder Assembly Components
Disassemble
1. Remove gear cover. 2. Remove ABS motor pack. 3. Two ABS hydraulic modulator to master
cylinder banjo bolts; separate hydraulic modulator from master cylinder. 4. Two transfer tubes with
O-rings from master cylinder or ABS Hydraulic modulator. 5. Banjo bolt O-rings from master
cylinder and ABS hydraulic modulator.
Important
^ If ABS hydraulic modulator is to be replaced, install the three gears in the same location on
replacement hydraulic modulator.
^ No repair of the ABS hydraulic modulator is authorized. Replace as an assembly.
^ Refer to master cylinder for service and repair.
^ Use new transfer tube assemblies when assembling the ABS hydraulic modulator/master cylinder
assembly. Make sure two O-rings are properly installed on each transfer tube.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly Removal and Instalation >
Page 4746
ABS Brake Modulator/Master Cylinder Assembly Components
Assemble
1. Two transfer assemblies.
^ Lubricate transfer tube assembly O-rings with clean brake fluid.
^ Install transfer tube assemblies in ports in ABS brake modulator and push in by hand to bottom.
2. Lubricate new banjo bolt O-ring with clean brake fluid and install into the master cylinder and
ABS hydraulic modulator. 3. ABS hydraulic modulator to master cylinder.
^ Clamp mounting flange of master cylinder in a vise.
^ Hold ABS hydraulic modulator and rock into position on master cylinder, inserting transfer tube
assemblies into master cylinder ports.
4. Two ABS hydraulic modulator to master cylinder banjo bolts.
Tighten
^ Banjo bolts to 24 Nm (17 ft. lbs.).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly Removal and Instalation >
Page 4747
Gear Position
5. With the ABS hydraulic modulator upside down, and the gears facing you, rotate each ABS
hydraulic modulator gear counterclockwise until
movement stops. This procedure will position the pistons very close to the top of the modulator
bore simplifying the brake bleeding procedure.
6. ABS motor pack to ABS hydraulic modulator-master cylinder assembly. 7. Gear cover to ABS
hydraulic modulator-master cylinder assembly.
Master Cylinder
Brake Master Cylinder Unit Repair
The Unit Repair Procedure for the Brake Master Cylinder is located under Hydraulic System,
Brakes / Master Cylinder / Service and Repair / Procedures / Brake Master Cylinder Disassembly
and Assembly
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly Removal and Instalation >
Page 4748
Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes: Service and Repair Hydraulic Modulator Solenoid
Assembly
ABS HYDRAULIC MODULATOR SOLENOID
Hydraulic Modulator Solenoid Assembly
1. Remove solenoid electrical connector. 2. Remove Torx® head bolts. 3. Remove solenoid.
Important
^ Be sure the seal is still attached to the solenoid when it is removed. If not, check solenoid bore in
modulator.
^ Do not attempt to disassemble solenoid, it is serviceable only as an assembly. Lubricate seal on
new solenoid with clean brake fluid.
^ Verify that the solenoid lip seal is properly positioned before solenoid is installed in Hydraulic
Modulator.
^ Position solenoid so that its electrical connector will face the same direction as the solenoid that
was removed.
^ By hand, press down firmly solenoid until its flange seats on the hydraulic modulator.
4. Reinstall Torx head bolts.
Tighten
^ Bolts to 4.5 N.m. (40 lb. in.).
5. Reinstall solenoid electrical connector to solenoid.
Important
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Hydraulic Control Assembly Antilock Brakes > Component Information > Service and Repair > Hydraulic Modulator Assembly Removal and Instalation >
Page 4749
^ Make sure the solenoid connectors are installed on correct solenoids.
^ It is necessary to bleed hydraulic modulator master cylinder assembly. Refer to Brake System
Bleeding. See: Brake Bleeding/Service and Repair/With ABS System
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Specifications
Brake Master Cylinder: Specifications
Master Cylinder Bore Dia., Inch ...........................................................................................................
........................................................................ 0.874 Front Caliper Bore Dia., Inch ............................
............................................................................................................................................................
2.244 Wheel Cylinder Bore Dia., Inch .................................................................................................
................................................................................... 0.625
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Master Cylinder Removal and Installation
Brake Master Cylinder: Service and Repair Brake Master Cylinder Removal and Installation
Brake Master Cylinder Removal
In order to separate the Brake Master Cylinder from the ABS Modulator assembly, the Module
must be disassembled using the procedure outlined under the Antilock Brakes/Traction Control
Systems / Hydraulic Control Assembly - Antilock Brakes / Service and Repair / Procedures.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Master Cylinder Removal and Installation > Page 4755
Brake Master Cylinder: Service and Repair Brake Master Cylinder Disassembly and Assembly
Dual Master Cylinder Assembly
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Master Cylinder Removal and Installation > Page 4756
Compact Master Cylinder Assembly
Master Cylinder Reservoir Removal. Composite Type
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Brake Master Cylinder >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Brake Master Cylinder Removal and Installation > Page 4757
DISASSEMBLE
1. Remove master cylinder from vehicle as follows:
a. Disconnect and plug hydraulic lines. b. Remove two master cylinder attaching nuts, then the
master cylinder.
2. Remove reservoir cover and diaphragm. Discard old brake fluid in reservoir. 3. Inspect cover and
diaphragm. Replace if cut, cracked or deformed. 4. Remove fluid level switch, if equipped. 5. On
models with compact master cylinder, remove proportioner valve assembly. 6. On all models,
depress primary piston and remove lock ring. 7. Plug primary fluid outlet (outlet nearest to cowl
when master cylinder is installed), then apply compressed air into secondary fluid outlet to remove
primary and secondary pistons.
8. Remove spring retainer and seals from secondary piston. 9. Clamp master cylinder in a vise as ,
then remove reservoir using a pry bar. Remove reservoir grommets.
10. Inspect master cylinder bore for corrosion. Do not use abrasive material on master cylinder
bore. Replace if bore is corroded.
ASSEMBLE
Clean all parts not included in repair kit with brake fluid. Do not dry with compressed air. Lubricate
all rubber parts with clean brake fluid prior to installation. 1. Lubricate new reservoir grommets with
silicone brake lube, then press grommets into master cylinder body. Ensure grommets are properly
seated. 2. Lay reservoir upside down on flat, hard surface. Press master cylinder body onto
reservoir using rocking motion. 3. Install new seals on secondary piston, then the spring retainer. 4.
Install spring and secondary piston assembly into cylinder. 5. Install primary piston. Depress
primary piston into cylinder, then install lock ring. 6. Install fluid level switch, if equipped. 7. On
models with compact master cylinder, install proportioner valve assembly. 8. On all models, fit
diaphragm into reservoir cover, then install cover onto reservoir. 9. Install master cylinder and
bleed brake system.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Brakes - Wheel Cylinder Inspection Guidelines
Wheel Cylinder: Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - Wheel Cylinder Inspection Guidelines
Bulletin No.: 03-05-24-001A
Date: March 21, 2005
INFORMATION
Subject: Service Information Regarding Rear Brake Drum Wheel Cylinder Inspections
Models: 2005 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2005 and Prior Saturn Vehicles
with Rear Drum Brakes
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised add model years and include all GM vehicles. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 03-05-24-001 (Section 03 - Suspension).
This bulletin provides information on proper inspection of rear drum brake wheel cylinders.
Important:
It is not recommended that dust boots be removed during inspection processes as dirt and debris
could contaminate the wheel cylinder bore causing premature wear of the wheel cylinder. In
addition, most bores should look damp and some lubricant may drip out from under the boot as a
result of lubricant being present.
All rear drum brake wheel cylinders are assembled with a lubricant to aid in assembly, provide an
anti-corrosion coating to the cylinder bore, and lubricate internal rubber components. As a result of
this lubrication process, it is not uncommon for some amount of lubricant to accumulate at the ends
of the cylinder under the dust boot.
Over time, the lubricant may work its way to the outside of the boot and cause an area of the boot
to look damp. Evidence of a damp area on the boot does not indicate a leak in the cylinder.
However, if there is excessive wetness (i.e. drips) coming from the boot area of the wheel cylinder,
it could indicate a brake hydraulic fluid leak requiring wheel cylinder replacement. (Refer to the
Wheel Cylinder Replacement procedures in the appropriate Service Manual.)
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Specifications > Bore Dimensions
Wheel Cylinder: Specifications
Wheel Cylinder Bore Diameter 0.625 in
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Specifications > Bore Dimensions > Page 4764
Wheel Cylinder: Specifications
Wheel Cylinder Bleeder Screw 5 ft.lb
Wheel Cylinder Line Fitting 18 ft.lb
Wheel Cylinder To Backing Plate 15 ft.lb
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Hydraulic System, Brakes > Wheel Cylinder > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 4765
Wheel Cylinder: Service and Repair
Fig. 33 Exploded View Of Wheel Cylinder
1. Raise and support vehicle.
2. Remove wheel, drum and brake shoes.
3. Disconnect hydraulic line at wheel cylinder. Do not pull metal line away from cylinder, as this
may kink or bend line. Line will separate from cylinder when cylinder is moved away from brake
backing plate.
4. Remove wheel cylinder-to-brake plate attaching screws, then the wheel cylinder.
5. Remove boots, pistons, springs and cups from cylinder, Fig. 33.
6. Clean all parts with brake fluid.
7. Inspect cylinder bore. A scored bore may be honed as long as the diameter is not increased by
more than .005 inch. Replace worn or damaged parts as necessary.
8. Ensure hands are clean before proceeding with assembly. Lubricate cylinder wall and rubber
cups with brake fluid, then install springs, cups, pistons and boots in housing.
9. Wipe end of hydraulic line to remove any foreign matter, then place wheel cylinder in position.
Enter tubing into cylinder and start threads on fitting.
10. Secure cylinder to backing plate, then complete tightening of tubing fitting.
11. Install brake shoes, drum and wheel.
12. Bleed system as outlined previously, then adjust brakes.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Cable > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection
Parking Brake Cable: Testing and Inspection
Inspect parking brake cable end for kinks, fraying and elongation and replace as necessary. Use a
small hose clamp to compress clamp where it enters backing plate to remove.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Console
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Parking Brake System > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4774
Console
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Power Brake Unit
Vacuum Brake Booster: Description and Operation Power Brake Unit
Fig. 1 Exploded View Of AC-Delco Tandem Diaphragm Booster
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Power Brake Unit > Page 4780
Fig. 2 Exploded View Of Power Head Assembly. AC-Delco Tandem Diaphragm Booster
DESCRIPTION
This unit utilizes a vacuum power chamber, consisting of a front and rear shell, housing divider,
front and rear diaphragm, plate assemblies, hydraulic pushrod and a diaphragm return spring, Fig.
1 and 2 .
OPERATION
In normal operating mode, with service brakes in released position, the booster operates with
vacuum on both sides of its diaphragms. When brakes are applied, air at atmospheric pressure is
admitted to one side of each diaphragm to provide power assist. When the service brake is
released, atmospheric air is shut off from one side of each diaphragm. The air is then drawn from
the booster through the vacuum check valve to the vacuum source.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Power Brake Unit > Page 4781
Vacuum Brake Booster: Description and Operation General Service
Two basic types of power assist mechanisms are used: vacuum assist diaphragm assemblies,
which use engine vacuum or, in some cases vacuum pressure developed by an external vacuum
pump. The second type is a hydraulic pressure assist mechanism, which use pressure developed
by an external pump (usually the power steering pump). Both systems act to increase the force
exerted on the master cylinder piston by the operator. This in turn increases the hydraulic pressure
delivered to the wheel cylinders, while decreasing driver effort necessary to obtain acceptable
stopping performance.
Vacuum assist units are similar in operation and get their energy by opposing engine vacuum to
atmospheric pressure. A piston and cylinder, flexible diaphragm (bellows) utilize this energy to
provide brake assistance. The fundamental difference between these types of vacuum assist
systems lies simply in how the diaphragm within the power unit is suspended when the brakes are
not applied.
In order to properly diagnose vacuum assist system malfunctions it is important to know whether
the diaphragm within a power unit is air suspended or vacuum suspended. Air-suspended units are
under atmospheric pressure until the brakes are applied. Engine vacuum is then admitted, causing
the piston or diaphragm to move (or the bellows to collapse). Vacuum-suspended types are
balanced with engine vacuum until the brake pedal is depressed, allowing atmospheric pressure to
unbalance the unit and apply force to the brake system.
Regardless of whether the brakes are vacuum or hydraulically assisted, certain general service
procedures apply. Only specified, clean brake fluid should be used in brake system. On
hydro-boost systems, use of the specified hydraulic fluid in the boost circuit is essential to proper
system operation. Care must be taken not to mix the fluids of the two separate operating circuits.
Use of improper fluids, or contaminated fluid will cause damage to the seals and valves.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Brakes Grab
Vacuum Brake Booster: Testing and Inspection Brakes Grab
1. Faulty control valve.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Brakes Grab > Page 4784
Vacuum Brake Booster: Testing and Inspection Hard Pedal
1. Internal vacuum leak. 2. Faulty control valve.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Brakes Grab > Page 4785
Vacuum Brake Booster: Testing and Inspection Slow or No Release
1. Faulty pushrod adjustment. 2. Bind in linkage.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Adjustments > Gauge Method
Vacuum Brake Booster: Adjustments Gauge Method
Fig. 7 Master Cylinder Pushrod Adjustment. AC-Delco Type Vacuum Booster
On these models, the master cylinder pushrod length is fixed and is usually only checked after the
unit has been overhauled. 1. Assemble booster unit and install pushrod, ensuring pushrod is fully
seated. 2. Position go/no go gauge furnished in repair kit over pushrod as shown in Fig. 7 3. If
pushrod height is not within limits of gauge, install service adjustable pushrod and adjust rod to
obtain correct height. 4. Install power unit and check adjustment, ensuring master cylinder
compensating port is open with engine running and brake pedal released.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Adjustments > Gauge Method > Page 4788
Vacuum Brake Booster: Adjustments Air Method
1. Be sure master cylinder attaching nuts are tight. 2. Remove master cylinder filler cap. 3. With
brake released, force compressed air into the hydraulic outlet of the master cylinder. Regulate air
pressure to a value of approximately 5
psi, to prevent spraying brake fluid from master cylinder. Care must be taken not to allow brake
fluid to contact painted surfaces of vehicle, skin or eyes, as damage or personal injury will result.
4. If air passes through the compensating port, which is the smaller of the two holes in the bottom
of the master cylinder reservoir, the adjustment is
satisfactory.
5. If air does not flow through the compensating port, adjust the pushrod as required, either by
means of the adjustment screw (if provided) or by
adding shims between the master cylinder and power unit shell until the air flows freely.
6. Reconnect brake lines and bleed system.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Adjustments > Page 4789
Vacuum Brake Booster: Service and Repair
Fig. 1 Exploded View Of AC-Delco Tandem Diaphragm Booster
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Adjustments > Page 4790
Fig. 2 Exploded View Of Power Head Assembly. AC-Delco Tandem Diaphragm Booster
DISASSEMBLE
1. Remove pedal pushrod boot, silencer, check valve, vacuum switch and grommets, as equipped,
then the front housing seal. 2. Scribe matching marks between front and rear housing sections,
then mount booster assembly in suitable holding fixture with rear housing facing
up.
3. Apply pressure to housing with holding fixture forcing screw and rotate rear housing
counterclockwise to unlock housing halves. 4. Slowly release spring tension, then remove booster
assembly from holding fixture. Do not allow spring tension to release suddenly, as damage
or personal injury may result.
5. Lift off rear housing, then remove primary power piston bearing from housing. 6. Remove power
piston group and return spring from front housing, Fig. 1 . 7. Remove master cylinder piston rod
and reaction retainer from front of piston, then the silencer from the rear of the assembly, Fig. 2 . 8.
Hold piston assembly at edges of divider and strike pedal pushrod against work surface to dislodge
diaphragm retainer. 9. Remove primary diaphragm and support plate, secondary power piston
bearing and housing divider, then the secondary diaphragm and support
plate from piston, noting installation position of components.
10. Clean and inspect components as outlined in General Service, then replace as needed. Do not
disassemble power piston. If service is required,
power piston must be replaced as an assembly.
ASSEMBLE
1. Position power piston assembly on work surface with pedal pushrod facing up. 2. Lubricate inner
lip of secondary diaphragm, fit diaphragm over support plate, then install assembly onto power
piston. 3. Install secondary power piston bearing into divider with flat surface of bearing on side of
divider with 6 lugs, Fig. 2 . 4. Install guide sleeve tool No. J-28458, or equivalent, over power
piston, lubricate inner diameter of secondary bearing, then install divider assembly
with lugged side facing up.
5. Lubricate inner lip of primary diaphragm. Fit diaphragm over support plate, then install
diaphragm assembly on power piston. 6. Ensure diaphragms and support plates are properly
positioned.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Power Brake Assist > Vacuum Brake Booster > Component
Information > Adjustments > Page 4791
7. Install new diaphragm retainer, then seat retainer on power piston using guide sleeve tool No.
J-28458, or equivalent, and tap with a hammer. 8. Install primary power piston bearing in rear
housing, then lubricate inner diameter of bearing. 9. Mount front housing in holding fixture tool No.
J-23456, or equivalent, then install diaphragm return spring, power piston group and the rear
housing assembly, Fig. 1 .
10. Ensure housing scribe marks are properly aligned, then press housing sections together with
holding fixture forcing screw. Assembling of housing
can be facilitated by applying vacuum to front housing port. Block opening for vacuum switch, if
equipped.
11. Rotate rear housing clockwise to lock housing, then stake two tabs 180degrees apart to secure
assembly. Do not stake tabs which have previously
been used.
12. Lubricate grommets and front seal, install grommets, check valve and vacuum switch, as
equipped, then the front housing seal. 13. Install silencer and pedal pushrod boot.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS
Main Relay > Component Information > Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > ABS
Main Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 4796
Harness Connector Faces: Electronic Brake Control Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Solenoid Valve Relay > Component Information > Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control >
Electronic Brake Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Electronic
Brake Control Module: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 & C1286)
Electronic Brake Control Module: Customer Interest Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246
& C1286)
File In Section: 5 - Brakes
Bulletin No.: 73-50-26
Date: August, 1997
Subject: ABS Light On - DTC's 46 and 86 Set (Perform Diagnostic Procedure, Replace Center ABS
Motor Pinion)
Models: 1991-97 Buick Skylark 1992-97 Buick Regal 1994-97 Buick Century 1992-96 Chevrolet
Beretta, Corsica, Lumina APV 1992-97 Chevrolet Cavalier, Lumina, 1993-97 Chevrolet Camaro
1995-97 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 1997
Chevrolet Malibu, Venture
1993-97 Geo Prizm 1995-97 Geo Metro 1996-97 Geo Tracker 1991
Oldsmobile Calais
1992-96 Oldsmobile Cutlass Ciera 1992-97 Oldsmobile Achieva, Cutlass Supreme, Silhouette
1997
Oldsmobile Cutlass
1998 Oldsmobile Intrigue
1991-97 Pontiac Grand Am 1992-94 Pontiac Sunbird 1992-97 Pontiac Grand Prix, Trans Sport
1993-97 Pontiac Firebird, Trans Am 1995-97 Pontiac Sunfire
Condition
Some owners may comment that the ABS light is on with Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) 46
and 86 set (rear ABS channel will not move) as current or history. (DTC's 46 and 86 will be
displayed as C1246 and C1286 on 1997 and 1998 model year vehicles).
Cause
A condition exists where the ABS motor pack gear (pinion) will bind on the motor armature shaft
causing the motor not to move when commanded by the EBCM. This condition is aggravated by
light corrosion between the pinion and shaft. Therefore, it may occur more frequently when the
weather is hot and humid.
Important:
Other EBCM and ABS motor pack concerns can also cause this condition, but they are not as
common as the above cause.
Correction
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control >
Electronic Brake Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Electronic
Brake Control Module: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 & C1286) > Page 4808
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control >
Electronic Brake Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Electronic
Brake Control Module: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 & C1286) > Page 4809
Follow the included procedure (Attachments 1 and 2) for diagnosis. This condition may correct
itself before the owner is able to bring the vehicle in for service. Therefore, if DTC 46 is set in
history, and is not currently setting, the included procedure will instruct you to replace the center
ABS motor pinion. The new pinion has a Teflon insert which reduces friction between the pinion
and motor armature shaft.
Pinion Replacement
If the included procedure instructs you to replace the center ABS motor pinion, use P/N 18029776.
Please note that the new pinion is a direct replacement part which requires no modifications to the
motor shaft. Follow the pinion replacement procedure included with the new pinion. Complete
motor pack replacement is not required.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Labor Time
H2506 Use published labor
operation time.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control >
Electronic Brake Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Electronic Brake Control Module: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 & C1286)
Electronic Brake Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 &
86 (C1246 & C1286)
File In Section: 5 - Brakes
Bulletin No.: 73-50-26
Date: August, 1997
Subject: ABS Light On - DTC's 46 and 86 Set (Perform Diagnostic Procedure, Replace Center ABS
Motor Pinion)
Models: 1991-97 Buick Skylark 1992-97 Buick Regal 1994-97 Buick Century 1992-96 Chevrolet
Beretta, Corsica, Lumina APV 1992-97 Chevrolet Cavalier, Lumina, 1993-97 Chevrolet Camaro
1995-97 Chevrolet Monte Carlo 1997
Chevrolet Malibu, Venture
1993-97 Geo Prizm 1995-97 Geo Metro 1996-97 Geo Tracker 1991
Oldsmobile Calais
1992-96 Oldsmobile Cutlass Ciera 1992-97 Oldsmobile Achieva, Cutlass Supreme, Silhouette
1997
Oldsmobile Cutlass
1998 Oldsmobile Intrigue
1991-97 Pontiac Grand Am 1992-94 Pontiac Sunbird 1992-97 Pontiac Grand Prix, Trans Sport
1993-97 Pontiac Firebird, Trans Am 1995-97 Pontiac Sunfire
Condition
Some owners may comment that the ABS light is on with Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) 46
and 86 set (rear ABS channel will not move) as current or history. (DTC's 46 and 86 will be
displayed as C1246 and C1286 on 1997 and 1998 model year vehicles).
Cause
A condition exists where the ABS motor pack gear (pinion) will bind on the motor armature shaft
causing the motor not to move when commanded by the EBCM. This condition is aggravated by
light corrosion between the pinion and shaft. Therefore, it may occur more frequently when the
weather is hot and humid.
Important:
Other EBCM and ABS motor pack concerns can also cause this condition, but they are not as
common as the above cause.
Correction
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control >
Electronic Brake Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Electronic Brake Control Module: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 & C1286) > Page
4815
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control >
Electronic Brake Control Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Electronic Brake Control Module: > 73-50-26 > Aug > 97 > Brakes - ABS Light ON, DTC 46 & 86 (C1246 & C1286) > Page
4816
Follow the included procedure (Attachments 1 and 2) for diagnosis. This condition may correct
itself before the owner is able to bring the vehicle in for service. Therefore, if DTC 46 is set in
history, and is not currently setting, the included procedure will instruct you to replace the center
ABS motor pinion. The new pinion has a Teflon insert which reduces friction between the pinion
and motor armature shaft.
Pinion Replacement
If the included procedure instructs you to replace the center ABS motor pinion, use P/N 18029776.
Please note that the new pinion is a direct replacement part which requires no modifications to the
motor shaft. Follow the pinion replacement procedure included with the new pinion. Complete
motor pack replacement is not required.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Labor Time
H2506 Use published labor
operation time.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control >
Electronic Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Antilock Brake Module
Electronic Brake Control Module: Locations Antilock Brake Module
Fig. 1 TYPICAL ABS Components
Refer to Fig. 1 for system component locations.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control >
Electronic Brake Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Antilock Brake Module > Page 4819
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control >
Electronic Brake Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1
Electronic Brake Control Module: Diagrams C1
Harness Connector Faces: Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)- C1
Harness Connector Faces: Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)- C1 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control >
Electronic Brake Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 > Page 4822
Electronic Brake Control Module: Diagrams C2
Harness Connector Faces: Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)- C2
Harness Connector Faces: Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)- C2 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control >
Electronic Brake Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > C1 > Page 4823
Electronic Brake Control Module: Diagrams C3
Harness Connector Faces: Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)- C3
Harness Connector Faces: Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)- C3 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control >
Electronic Brake Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4824
Electronic Brake Control Module: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The ABS system is controlled by a microprocessor based Electronic Brake Control Module
(EBCM). Inputs to the system include four wheel speed sensors, brakes, ignition switch and
unswitched battery voltage. Outputs include three bi-directional motor controls, three lamp controls,
two solenoid controls and the system enable relay. A serial data line, located in terminal 9 of the
Data Link Connector (DLC), is provided for service diagnostic tools and assembly plant testing.
The EBCM monitors the speed of each wheel. If any wheel begins to approach lock-up and the
brake switch is on, the EBCM controls the motors and solenoids to reduce brake pressure to the
wheel approaching lock-up. Once the wheel regains traction, brake pressure is increased until
wheel begins to approach lock-up. This cycle repeats until either vehicle comes to a stop, the brake
is released or no wheels approach lock-up. Additionally, the EBCM monitors itself, each input and
each output for proper operation. If any system fault is detected, the EBCM will store a DTC in
nonvolatile memory.
On a EBTCM, the ABS portion of the module operates the same as a EBCM. A EBTCM is used if
the vehicle is equipped with either the Enhanced Traction System (ETS) or Traction Control
System (TCS). The ETS or TCS portion of the EBTCM monitors wheel spin slip through the drive
wheels speed sensors. If the wheels begin to slip, the EBTCM determines the desired wheel torque
needed to minimize wheel slip. This information is sent to the PCM through the Serial data link. On
models equipped w/ETS, the PCM controls engine torque by ignition retard and transmission shifts.
On models equipped w/TCS, the PCM controls engine torque by ignition retard, transmission shifts
and applies brakes several times until the vehicle regains traction. Once the vehicle regains
traction, brake pressure is decreased and engine torque reduction is no longer requested. This
cycle repeats until traction control is no longer necessary.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control >
Electronic Brake Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4825
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair
Fig. 800 EBCM Assembly Removal.
1. Disconnect EBCM electrical connectors, Fig.800. 2. Remove ECU to dash panel attaching
screws, then the ECU from dash panel. 3. Reverse procedure to install, noting the following:
a. Ensure plastic grommets, if equipped, are located properly. b. Bleed brake system as described
under Brake System Bleed. See: Brake Bleeding
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Level Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 4830
Brake Fluid Level Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
OPERATION
This sensor mounted on the master cylinder will activate the Brake Warning lamp if a low brake
fluid level is detected. The lamp will turn off once the fluid level is corrected.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation
Brake Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
Fig. 3 Pressure Differential Valve & Brake Warning Lamp Switch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake
Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 4834
Fig. 4 Dual Master Cylinder W/Built In Warning Lamp Switch.
DESCRIPTION
In Fig. 3, as pressure falls in one system, the other system's normal pressure forces the piston to
the inoperative side, contacting the switch terminal, causing the warning lamp on the instrument
panel to glow.
In Fig. 4 shows the switch mounted directly in the master cylinder assembly. Whenever there is a
specified differential pressure, the switch piston will activate the brake failure warning switch and
cause the brake warning lamp to glow.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Console
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4839
Console
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Wheel Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 63-50-15B > Mar > 98
> ABS Indicator Lamp On, DTC 21,22,32 or 33 Set
Wheel Speed Sensor: Customer Interest ABS Indicator Lamp On, DTC 21,22,32 or 33 Set
File In Section: 5 - Brakes
Bulletin No.: 63-50-15B
Date: March, 1998
Subject: ABS Indicator Lamp ON, DTC 21, 22, 32 or 33 Set (Install Front ABS Wheel Speed
Sensor Wiring Harness Connector Kit)
Models: 1992-97 Buick Skylark 1991-96 Chevrolet Beretta, Corsica 1992-97 Chevrolet Cavalier
1992-97 Oldsmobile Achieva 1992-94 Pontiac Sunbird 1995-97 Pontiac Sunfire 1992-97 Pontiac
Grand Am
This bulletin is being revised to update parts and applicable model information. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 63-50-15A - (Section 5 - Brakes)
Condition
Some owners may comment that the ABS indicator lamp is "ON". Also, malfunction DTC 21, 22, 32
or 33 could set.
Cause
The right front and left front ABS wheel speed sensor wiring harness could be damaged and result
in an open circuit. The wiring harness may be damaged approximately 4 inches (10 cm) back from
the harness connector to the wheel speed sensor. This allows moisture to enter the harness
causing corrosion and resulting in the open circuit.
Correction
A thorough inspection for corrosion and/or damage should be performed on suspect vehicles. It
may be necessary to move the protective conduit away in order to inspect the wiring properly. If a
failure occurs and damage is found, install the front ABS wheel speed sensor wiring harness
connector kit(s). The kit includes instructions, splices, and "pigtail" connector.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Wheel Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 63-50-15B > Mar > 98
> ABS Indicator Lamp On, DTC 21,22,32 or 33 Set > Page 4848
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Description Labor Time
H2530 Right Side Use published
H2531 Left Side Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Wheel Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 63-50-15B
> Mar > 98 > ABS Indicator Lamp On, DTC 21,22,32 or 33 Set
Wheel Speed Sensor: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS Indicator Lamp On, DTC 21,22,32 or 33
Set
File In Section: 5 - Brakes
Bulletin No.: 63-50-15B
Date: March, 1998
Subject: ABS Indicator Lamp ON, DTC 21, 22, 32 or 33 Set (Install Front ABS Wheel Speed
Sensor Wiring Harness Connector Kit)
Models: 1992-97 Buick Skylark 1991-96 Chevrolet Beretta, Corsica 1992-97 Chevrolet Cavalier
1992-97 Oldsmobile Achieva 1992-94 Pontiac Sunbird 1995-97 Pontiac Sunfire 1992-97 Pontiac
Grand Am
This bulletin is being revised to update parts and applicable model information. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 63-50-15A - (Section 5 - Brakes)
Condition
Some owners may comment that the ABS indicator lamp is "ON". Also, malfunction DTC 21, 22, 32
or 33 could set.
Cause
The right front and left front ABS wheel speed sensor wiring harness could be damaged and result
in an open circuit. The wiring harness may be damaged approximately 4 inches (10 cm) back from
the harness connector to the wheel speed sensor. This allows moisture to enter the harness
causing corrosion and resulting in the open circuit.
Correction
A thorough inspection for corrosion and/or damage should be performed on suspect vehicles. It
may be necessary to move the protective conduit away in order to inspect the wiring properly. If a
failure occurs and damage is found, install the front ABS wheel speed sensor wiring harness
connector kit(s). The kit includes instructions, splices, and "pigtail" connector.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Wheel Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 63-50-15B
> Mar > 98 > ABS Indicator Lamp On, DTC 21,22,32 or 33 Set > Page 4854
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Description Labor Time
H2530 Right Side Use published
H2531 Left Side Labor Operation Time
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Wheel Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed
Sensor: > 09-09-40-001A > Feb > 11 > Restraints - Seat Belt Warning Lamp On/Buckling Issues
Seat Belt Buckle: All Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Seat Belt Warning Lamp On/Buckling
Issues
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 09-09-40-001A
Date: February 02, 2011
Subject: Seat Belt Buckle Latching Issues and/or Seat Belt Warning Lights Illuminated
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7 X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 09-09-40-001 (Section 09 - Restraints).
This bulletin is being published to advise dealers about seat belt buckles not operating and/or seat
belt warning light illumination, as well as difficulty latching and unlatching the buckle or the buckle
release button sticking.
Analysis of warranty data has determined that this condition may be caused by sticky beverages
being spilled onto or into the seat belt buckle assembly. Foreign debris from food, candy wrappers,
paper and coins can also contribute to this condition.
Important If foreign material (debris) or sticky liquids are the cause of the concern, show the
customer the condition of the component (buckle assembly) and explain how it is affecting the
function of the restraint system. Strongly recommend that the component be replaced. Point out the
fact that this is not a manufacturing defect and is not covered by the new vehicle warranty. If the
customer declines to have parts replaced, the service department management must make a
notation on the service record that the lack of functionality of seating position with an inoperative
buckle was fully explained to the customer. The service department management must advise the
customer that having a non-functioning buckle in a seating position voids ability to use that seating
position (no one should ride in the seat). Also make the customer aware that it may be against the
law to ride in a vehicle without wearing a restraint system.
Important Never insert anything other than the seat belt latch plate into the buckle assembly. Do
not attempt to dig anything out of a buckle with a tool. Never try to wash out a buckle to remove a
spilled liquid as this may damage the buckle.
Use the following steps to determine the cause of the concern.
1. Inspect the buckle assembly with a light shining on the latch plate insertion area. Look for any
debris or foreign objects in the buckle. 2. If any debris or foreign objects are observed, try to
vacuum out the item. After the foreign material is removed, latch and unlatch the seat belt. If
the system functions properly, do not replace the seat belt buckle assembly.
3. If the condition has not been corrected, inspect the buckle assembly for any sticky residue. If
sticky residue is found, inform the customer that a
substance was spilled on the seat belt buckle assembly causing the malfunction. The buckle
assembly will need to be replaced at the customer's expense.
4. Refer to SI for seat belt component replacement.
Important If foreign material (debris) or sticky liquids are the cause of the concern, show the
customer the condition of the component (buckle assembly) and explain how it is affecting the
function of the restraint system. Strongly recommend that the component be replaced at the
customer's expense. Point out the fact that this is not a manufacturing defect and is not covered by
the new vehicle warranty. If the customer declines to have parts replaced, the service department
management must make a notation on the service record that the lack of functionality of seating
position with an inoperative buckle was fully explained to the customer. The service department
management must advise customer that having a non-functioning buckle in a seating position voids
ability to use that seating position (no one should ride in the seat). Also make the customer aware
that it may be against the law to ride in a vehicle without wearing a restraint system.
5. If further restraint diagnosis is required, refer to Seat Belt System Operational and Functional
Checks in SI.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Wheel Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed
Sensor: > 09-09-40-001A > Feb > 11 > Restraints - Seat Belt Warning Lamp On/Buckling Issues > Page 4860
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Wheel Speed Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheel Speed
Sensor: > 09-09-40-001A > Feb > 11 > Restraints - Seat Belt Warning Lamp On/Buckling Issues > Page 4866
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Wheel Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Wheel Speed Sensor: Component Locations
LH Front Wheel (RH Similar)
LH Rear ABS Wheel Speed Sensor
LH Rear ABS Wheel Speed Sensor is located Rear of LH rear Wheel Hub
LH Rear Wheel (RH Similar)
Wheel Speed Sensors
These sensors located on the front steering knuckles and under the wheel bearing dust caps on
the rear wheels.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Wheel Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4869
Wheel Speed Sensor: Connector Locations
LH Front Wheel (RH Similar)
LH Rear Wheel (RH Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Wheel Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4870
Wheel Speed Sensor: Harness Locations
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
RH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Wheel Speed Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 4871
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
These sensors located on the front steering knuckles and under the wheel bearing dust caps on
the rear wheels, send a low voltage signal to the EBCM/EBTCM. This signal is produced by
rotating a toothed ring around the sensor pole piece, which produces a magnetic field that
increases and decreases in magnitude.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Wheel Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Front
Fig. 802 Front Wheel Speed Sensor Removal.
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Disconnect wheel sensor electrical connector, Fig. 802. 3. Remove
sensor attaching bolt, then the sensor from the mounting bracket. 4. Reverse procedure to install,
noting the following:
a. Ensure sensor is properly aligned and lays flat against bracket bosses, then torque attaching bolt
to 9 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Brakes and Traction Control > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control >
Wheel Speed Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Front > Page 4874
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Rear
Fig. 803 Rear Wheel Bearing & Speed Sensor Removal.
1. Raise and support vehicle, then remove rear wheel and tire assembly. 2. Remove rear brake
drum, then disconnect sensor electrical connector, Fig. 803. 3. Remove wheel bearing and sensor
attaching nuts and bolts, then bearing and sensor assembly. After bolts are removed, the rear
brake assembly
will be held in place by the hydraulic pipe. Use care not to bump or exert any force on the brake
assembly to prevent any damage to the hydraulic pipe.
4. Reverse procedure to install, noting the following:
a. Align bolt holes in wheel bearing and speed sensor assembly, drum brake assembly and rear
suspension bracket. b. When installing bolts, rotate axle flange to align large hole with each bolt
location, then install bolt while holding nut. c. Torque bolts to 37 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 4881
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Clutch Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 4882
Clutch Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect clutch switch electrical connector.
2. Remove clutch bracket and switch attaching nuts, then remove switch.
3. Reverse procedure to install.
Torque switch attaching nuts to 53 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Neutral Safety Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4887
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4888
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4889
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4890
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4891
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4892
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4893
Neutral Safety Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4894
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4895
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4896
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4897
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4898
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4899
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4900
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4901
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4902
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4903
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4904
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4905
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4906
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4907
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4908
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4909
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4910
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4911
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4912
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4913
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4914
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4915
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4916
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4917
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4918
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4919
Neutral Safety Switch: Description and Operation
Fig. 6 Back-up Light/Neutral Start Switch Replacement
On vehicles equipped with automatic transmission, the neutral start and back-up light switches are
combined into one unit and must be replaced as an assembly.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 4920
Neutral Safety Switch: Service and Repair
Fig. 6 Back-up Light/Neutral Start Switch Replacement
NOTE: On vehicles equipped with automatic transmission, the neutral start and back-up light
switches are combined into one unit and must be replaced as an assembly. 1. Disconnect battery
ground cable and shift linkage. 2. Disconnect electrical connector from switch. 3. Remove switch
mounting bolts, then switch assembly, Fig. 6. 4. If same switch is to be reinstalled, proceed as
follows:
a. Place shift shaft in Neutral position. b. Align flats of shift shaft with switch, then install switch. c.
Loosely install mounting bolts. d. Insert gauge pin, Fig. 6, in service adjustment hole and rotate
switch until pin drops in to a depth of 9 mm (9/64 inch). e. Torque mounting bolts to 18 ft. lbs.
5. If a new switch is to be installed, proceed as follows:
a. Place shift shaft in Neutral position. b. Align flats of shift shaft with switch, then install switch. c. If
bolt holes do not align with mounting boss on transaxle, verify shift shaft is in Neutral position, do
not rotate switch. Switch is pinned in
Neutral position. If switch has been rotated and the pin broken, use procedure outlined in step 4.
d. Torque mounting bolts to 18 ft. lbs.
6. Verify engine will only start in Park or Neutral positions.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Battery Cable: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4926
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4927
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4928
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4929
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4930
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4931
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4932
Battery Cable: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4933
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4934
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4935
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4936
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4937
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4938
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4939
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4940
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4941
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4942
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4943
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4944
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4945
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4946
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4947
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4948
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4949
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4950
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4951
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4952
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4953
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4954
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4955
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4956
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Battery > Battery Cable > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4957
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Tools - Released for CS Generator Diagnosis
Alternator: Technical Service Bulletins Tools - Released for CS Generator Diagnosis
File In Section: 6 - Engine
Bulletin No.: 83-64-09
Date: March, 1998
INFORMATION
Subject: New Tool J 41450-B, Released for CS Generator Diagnosis
Models: 1988-98 Passenger Cars and Light Trucks with CS-Series Generators
A new CS-Series Generator Tester, J 41450-B, has been sent to all dealers as part of the Essential
Tool Package. This tool will work on all CS-Series generators for past model years. The tool is
shown in Figure 1.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Tools - Released for CS Generator Diagnosis > Page 4963
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Tools - Released for CS Generator Diagnosis > Page 4964
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Tools - Released for CS Generator Diagnosis > Page 4965
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Tools - Released for CS Generator Diagnosis > Page 4966
Generator Not Operating Properly
The charts shown can be used in place of the diagnostic procedures in previous Service Manuals
when this new tool is used. This information will be included in the 1999 Service Manual.
Inspect the following before testing the generator:
^ The battery. Make sure the vehicle battery is in good condition and fully charged. Refer to Battery
Load Test.
^ The built in hydrometer in the battery. The green eye must be showing in the hydrometer.
^ The voltage across the battery terminals with all the loads OFF should be above 12 V. Refer to
Battery Load Test.
^ Make sure the battery connections are clean and tight.
^ The drive belt for damage or looseness.
^ The wiring harness at the generator. Make sure the harness connector is tight and latched. Make
sure the output terminal of the generator is connected to the vehicle battery (positive) generator
lead.
^ All the charging system related fuses and electrical connections for damage or looseness. Refer
to the starter and charging system schematics.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 4967
Alternator: Specifications
Alternator Model [06] ...........................................................................................................................
..................................................................... CS-130 Rated Hot Output Amps ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. 100
[06] Service part identification code K60 (100 amp. alternator). Refer to the service parts
identification label located on the deck lid or the spare tire
cover.
Alternator Model [07] ...........................................................................................................................
..................................................................... CS-130 Rated Hot Output Amps ...................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. 105
[07] Service part identification code K68 (105 amp. alternator). Refer to the service parts
identification label located on the deck lid or the spare tire
cover.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Alternator: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4970
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4971
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4972
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4973
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4974
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4975
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4976
Alternator: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4977
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4978
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4979
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4980
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4981
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4982
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4983
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4984
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4985
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4986
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4987
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4988
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4989
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4990
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4991
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4992
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4993
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4994
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4995
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4996
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4997
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4998
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 4999
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5000
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5001
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5002
Harness Connector Faces: Generator
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 5003
Alternator: Service Precautions
1. Be certain that battery polarity is correct when servicing units. Reversed battery polarity will
damage rectifiers and regulators. 2. If booster battery is used for starting, be sure to use correct
polarity in hook up. 3. When a fast charger is used to charge a vehicle battery, the vehicle battery
cables should be disconnected unless the fast charger is equipped with a
special Alternator Protector, in which case the vehicle battery cables need not be disconnected.
Also the fast charger should never be used to start a vehicle as damage to rectifiers will result.
4. Unless the system includes a load relay or field relay, grounding the alternator output terminal
will damage the alternator and/or circuits. This is
true even when the system is not in operation since no circuit breaker is used and the battery is
applied to the alternator output terminal at all times. The field or load relay acts as a circuit breaker
in that it is controlled by the ignition switch.
5. Before making any on vehicle tests of the alternator or regulator, the battery should be checked
and the circuit inspected for faulty wiring or
insulation. loose or corroded connections and poor ground circuits.
6. Check alternator belt tension to be sure the belt is tight enough to prevent slipping under load. 7.
The ignition switch should be off and the battery ground cable disconnected before making any test
connections to prevent damage to the system. 8. The vehicle battery must be fully charged or a
fully charged battery may be installed for test purposes.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 5004
Alternator: Description and Operation
Fig. 1 Exploded View Of CS Type Alternator Rotor Drive End
Fig. 2 Exploded View Of CS Type Alternator Slip Ring End Components
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 5005
DESCRIPTION
The CS alternator is available in three sizes: CS-121, CS-130, CS-130D and CS-144. The
numerals denote the outer diameter of the stator laminations in millimeters and the letters CS stand
for charging system. The CS-144 can be serviced. The CS-121 and CS-130 series are serviced as
an assembly only.
The CS alternators, Fig. 1 and 2 , use a new type regulator and a diode trio is not used. A delta
stator, rectifier bridge, and rotor with slip rings and brushes are electrically similar to earlier
alternators. A conventional fan mounted next to the pulley pulls air through the assembly for
cooling. An internal fan mounted on the rotor pulls air through the slip ring end frame to cool
rectifier, bridge and regulator. Air is expelled through openings in the end frame. No periodic
maintenance is required.
OPERATION
CS-130 and CS-144 alternators may be used with only two connections. The battery positive BAT
terminal must be connected to a battery during operation. The second required connection is
through the indicator light, or a suitable external resistor to L terminal of the regulator which serves
to turn unit On at start up. Three other regulator terminals are available for optional use in vehicle
systems. The P terminal is connected to the stator, and may be connected to a tachometer or other
device. The F terminal is connected internally to field positive, and may be used as a fault indicator.
The S terminal may be connected externally to a voltage, such as battery voltage, to sense voltage
to be controlled.
The regulator voltage setting varies with temperature, and limits system voltage by controlling rotor
field current. Unlike others regulators, this regulator switches field current On and Off at a fixed
frequency about 400 cycles per second. By varying On-Off time, correct average field current is
obtained to provide proper system voltage. At high speeds, the On time may be 10% and Off time
90%. At low speeds with high electrical loads, On-Off time may be 90% and 10% respectively.
Alternator systems on some applications are controlled by a Body Control Module (BCM). If cause
of a system malfunction cannot be determined using the following test procedure, a problem in the
electronic control system is indicated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Charging System > Alternator > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 5006
Alternator: Testing and Inspection
If charge indicator light works abnormally, perform the following test procedure:
1. Visually check belt and wiring. 2. With engine control switch ON and engine stopped, charge
indicator lamp should be on. If lamp is not on, detach wiring harness at generator and
ground "L" terminal. If lamp lights, generator is faulty. If lamp does not light, locate open circuit
between grounding lead and ignition switch and check for a faulty bulb.
3. With engine control switch ON and engine running at a moderate speed, charge indicator lamp
should be off. If lamp is not off, detach wiring
harness at generator. If lamp goes off, generator is faulty. If lamp stays on, check for grounded "L"
terminal in wire harness.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 5012
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Clutch Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5013
Clutch Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect clutch switch electrical connector.
2. Remove clutch bracket and switch attaching nuts, then remove switch.
3. Reverse procedure to install.
Torque switch attaching nuts to 53 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Key > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Locks - Key Code Security Rules and Information
Key: Technical Service Bulletins Locks - Key Code Security Rules and Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 10-00-89-010
Date: May 27, 2010
Subject: Key Code Security Rules and Information on GM KeyCode Look-Up Application (Canada
Only)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior
Saturn and Saab 2002 and Prior Isuzu
Attention:
This bulletin has been created to address potential issues and questions regarding KeyCode
security. This bulletin should be read by all parties involved in KeyCode activity, including dealer
operator, partner security coordinator, sales, service and parts departments. A copy of this bulletin
should be printed and maintained in the parts department for use as a reference.
Important U.S. dealers should refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 10-00-89-009.
Where Are Key Codes Located?
General Motors provides access to KeyCodes through three sources when a vehicle is delivered to
a dealer. Vehicle KeyCodes are located on the original vehicle invoice to the dealership. There is a
small white bar coded tag sent with most new vehicles that also has the key code printed on it.
Dealerships should make a practice of comparing the tag's keycode numbers to the keycode listed
on the invoice. Any discrepancy should be reported immediately to the GM of Canada Key Code
Inquiry Desk. Remember to remove the key tag prior to showing vehicles to potential customers.
The third source for Key codes is through the GM KeyCode Look-Up feature within the
OEConnection D2DLink application. KeyCode Look-Up currently goes back 17 previous model
years from the current model year.
When a vehicle is received by the dealership, care should be taken to safeguard the original
vehicle invoice and KeyCode tag provided with the vehicle. Potential customers should not have
access to the invoice or this KeyCode tag prior to the sale being completed. After a sale has been
completed, the KeyCode information belongs to the customer and General Motors.
Tip
Only the original invoice contains key code information, a re-printed invoice does not.
GM KeyCode Look-Up Application for GM of Canada Dealers
All dealers should review the General Motors of Canada KeyCode Look-Up Policies and
Procedures (Service Policy & Procedures Manual Section 3.1.6 "Replacement of VIN plates &
keys").
Please note that the KeyCode Access site is restricted. Only authorized users should be using this
application. Please see your Parts Manager for site authorized users. KeyCode Look-Up currently
goes back 17 years from current model year.
Important notes about security:
- Users may not access the system from multiple computers simultaneously.
- Users may only request one KeyCode at a time.
- KeyCode information will only be available on the screen for 2 minutes.
- Each user is personally responsible for maintaining and protecting their password.
- Never share your password with others.
- User Id's are suspended after 6 consecutive failed attempts.
- User Id's are disabled if not used for 90 days.
- Processes must be in place for regular dealership reviews.
- The Parts Manager (or assigned management) must have processes in place for employee
termination or life change events. Upon termination individuals access must be turned off
immediately and access should be re-evaluated upon any position changes within the dealership.
- If you think your password or ID security has been breached, contact Dealer Systems Support at
1-800-265-0573.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Key > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Locks - Key Code Security Rules and Information > Page 5018
Each user will be required to accept the following agreement each time the KeyCode application is
used.
Key Code User Agreement
- Key codes are proprietary information belonging to General Motors Corporation and to the vehicle
owner.
- Unauthorized access to, or use of, key code information is unlawful and may subject the user to
criminal and civil penalties.
- This information should be treated as strictly confidential and should not be disclosed to anyone
unless authorized.
I will ensure that the following information is obtained prior to releasing any Key Code information:
1. Government issued picture ID (Drivers License) 2. Registration or other proof of ownership.
Registration should have normal markings from the Province that issued the registration and
possibly the
receipt for payment recorded as well.
Important
- GM takes this agreement seriously. Each user must be certain of vehicle ownership before giving
out key codes.
- When the ownership of the vehicle is in doubt, dealership personnel should not provide the
information.
Key code requests should never be received via a fax or the internet and key codes should never
be provided to anyone in this manner. A face to face contact with the owner of the vehicle is the
expected manner that dealers will use to release a key code or as otherwise stipulated in this
bulletin or other materials.
- Key codes should NEVER be sent via a fax or the internet.
- Each Dealership should create a permanent file to document all KeyCode Look Up transactions.
Requests should be filed by VIN and in each folder retain copies of the following:
- Government issued picture ID (Drivers License)
- Registration or other proof of ownership.
- Copy of the paid customer receipt which has the name of the employee who cut and sold the key
to the customer.
- Do not put yourself or your Dealership in the position of needing to "explain" a KeyCode Look Up
to either GM or law enforcement officials.
- Dealership Management has the ability to review all KeyCode Look-Up transactions.
- Dealership KeyCode documentation must be retained for two years.
Frequently Asked Questions (FAQs) for GM of Canada Dealers
How do I request a KeyCode for customer owned vehicle that is not registered?
Scrapped, salvaged or stored vehicles that do not have a current registration should still have the
ownership verified by requesting the vehicle title, current insurance policy and / or current lien
holder information from the customers financing source. If you cannot determine if the customer is
the owner of the vehicle, do not provide the key code information. In these cases, a short
description of the vehicle (scrapped, salvaged, etc.) and the dealership location should be kept on
file. Any clarifying explanation should be entered into the comments field.
How do I document a KeyCode request for a vehicle that is being repossessed?
The repossessor must document ownership of the vehicle by providing a court ordered
repossession order and lien-holder documents prior to providing key code information. Copies of
the repossessors Drivers License and a business card should be retained by the dealership for
documentation.
What do I do if the registration information is locked in the vehicle?
Every effort should be made to obtain complete information for each request. Each Dealership will
have to decide on a case by case basis if enough information is available to verify the customer's
ownership of the vehicle. Other forms of documentation include vehicle title, insurance policy, and
or current lien information from the customers financing source. Dealership Management must be
involved in any request without complete information. If you cannot determine if the customer is the
owner of the vehicle, do not provide the key code information.
Can I get a print out of the information on the screen?
It is important to note that the Key Code Look Up Search Results contain sensitive and/or
proprietary information. For this reason GM recommends against printing it. If the Search Results
must be printed, store and/or dispose of the printed copy properly to minimize the risk of improper
or illegal use.
Who in the dealership has access to the KeyCode application?
Dealership Parts Manager (or assigned management) will determine, and control, who is
authorized to access the KeyCode Look Up application. However, we anticipate that dealership
parts and service management will be the primary users of the application. The KeyCode Look Up
application automatically tracks each user activity session. Information tracked by the system
includes: User name, User ID, all other entered data and the date/time of access.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Key > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Locks - Key Code Security Rules and Information > Page 5019
What if I input the VIN incorrectly?
If an incorrect VIN is entered into the system (meaning that the system does not recognize the VIN
or that the VIN has been entered incorrectly) the system will return an error message.
If I am an authorized user for the KeyCode application, can I access the application from home?
Yes.
What if I suspect key code misuse?
Your dealership should communicate the proper procedures for requesting key codes. Any
suspicious activity either within the dealership or externally should be reported to Dealer Systems
Support at 1-800-265-0573 or GM of Canada Key Code Inquiry Desk at 1-905-644-4892.
Whose key codes can I access through the system?
At this time the following Canadian vehicle codes are available through the system: Chevrolet,
Cadillac, Buick, Pontiac, GMC, HUMMER (H2 and H3 only), Oldsmobile, Saturn, Saab and Isuzu
(up to 2002 model year) for a maximum of 17 model years.
What should I do if I enter a valid VIN and the system does not produce any key code information?
Occasionally, the KeyCode Look Up application may not produce a key code for a valid VIN. This
may be the result of new vehicle information not yet available. In addition, older vehicle information
may have been sent to an archive status. If you do not receive a key code returned for valid VIN,
you should contact GM of Canada Key Code Inquiry Desk at 1-905-644-4892.
How do I access KeyCodes if the KeyCode Look-up system is down?
If the KeyCode Look-up system is temporarily unavailable, you can contact the original selling
dealer who may have it on file or contact GM of Canada Key Code Inquiry Desk at
1-905-644-4892. If the customer is dealing with an emergency lock-out situation, you need to have
the customer contact Roadside assistance, OnStar if subscribed, or 911.
What should I do if the KeyCode from the look-up system does not work on the vehicle?
On occasion a dealer may encounter a KeyCode that will not work on the vehicle in question. In
cases where the KeyCode won't work you will need to verify with the manufacturer of the cutting
equipment that the key has been cut correctly. If the key has been cut correctly you may be able to
verify the proper KeyCode was given through the original selling dealer. When unable to verify the
KeyCode through the original selling dealer contact GM of Canada Key Code Inquiry Desk at
1-905-644-4892. If the key has been cut correctly and the code given does not work, the lock
cylinder may have been changed. In these situations following the proper SI document for recoding
a key or replacing the lock cylinder may be necessary.
How long do I have to keep KeyCode Records?
Dealership KeyCode documentation must be retained for two years.
Can I get a KeyCode changed in the Look-Up system?
Yes, KeyCodes can be changed in the Look-Up system if a lock cylinder has been changed.
Contact GM of Canada Key Code Inquiry Desk at 1-905-644-4892.
What information do I need before I can provide a driver of a company fleet vehicle Keys or
KeyCode information?
The dealership should have a copy of the individual's driver's license, proof of employment and
registration. If there is any question as to the customer's employment by the fleet company, the
dealer should attempt to contact the fleet company for verification. If there is not enough
information to determine ownership and employment, this information should not be provided.
How do I document a request from an Independent Repair facility for a KeyCode or Key?
The independent must provide a copy of their driver's license, proof of employment and signed
copy of the repair order for that repair facility. The repair order must include customer's name,
address, VIN, city, province and license plate number. Copies of this information must be included
in your dealer KeyCode file.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Key > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Locks - Key Code Security Rules and Information > Page 5020
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Neutral Safety Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5025
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5026
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5027
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5028
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5029
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5030
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5031
Neutral Safety Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5032
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5033
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5034
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5035
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5036
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5037
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5038
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5039
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5040
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5041
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5042
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5043
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5044
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5045
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5046
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5047
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5048
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5049
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5050
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5051
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5052
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5053
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5054
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5055
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5056
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 5057
Neutral Safety Switch: Description and Operation
Fig. 6 Back-up Light/Neutral Start Switch Replacement
On vehicles equipped with automatic transmission, the neutral start and back-up light switches are
combined into one unit and must be replaced as an assembly.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Neutral Safety Switch > Component Information
> Diagrams > Page 5058
Neutral Safety Switch: Service and Repair
Fig. 6 Back-up Light/Neutral Start Switch Replacement
NOTE: On vehicles equipped with automatic transmission, the neutral start and back-up light
switches are combined into one unit and must be replaced as an assembly. 1. Disconnect battery
ground cable and shift linkage. 2. Disconnect electrical connector from switch. 3. Remove switch
mounting bolts, then switch assembly, Fig. 6. 4. If same switch is to be reinstalled, proceed as
follows:
a. Place shift shaft in Neutral position. b. Align flats of shift shaft with switch, then install switch. c.
Loosely install mounting bolts. d. Insert gauge pin, Fig. 6, in service adjustment hole and rotate
switch until pin drops in to a depth of 9 mm (9/64 inch). e. Torque mounting bolts to 18 ft. lbs.
5. If a new switch is to be installed, proceed as follows:
a. Place shift shaft in Neutral position. b. Align flats of shift shaft with switch, then install switch. c. If
bolt holes do not align with mounting boss on transaxle, verify shift shaft is in Neutral position, do
not rotate switch. Switch is pinned in
Neutral position. If switch has been rotated and the pin broken, use procedure outlined in step 4.
d. Torque mounting bolts to 18 ft. lbs.
6. Verify engine will only start in Park or Neutral positions.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Starter Drive/Bendix >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Clutch Failure - A/C Delco
Starter Drive/Bendix: Testing and Inspection Drive Clutch Failure - A/C Delco
The overrunning clutch type drive seldom becomes so worn that it fails to engage since it is directly
activated by a fork and lever. The only thing that is likely to happen is that, once engaged, it will not
turn the engine because the clutch itself is worn out. A much more frequent difficulty and one that
rapidly wears ring gear and teeth is partial engagement. Proper meshing of the pinion is controlled
by the end clearance between the pinion gear and the starter housing or pinion stop, if used.
On some starters, the solenoids are completely enclosed in the starter housing and the pinion
clearance is not adjustable. If the clearance is not correct, the starter must be disassembled and
checked for excessive wear of solenoid linkage, shift lever mechanism, or improper assembly of
parts.
Failure of the overrunning clutch drive to disengage is usually caused by binding between the
armature shaft and the drive. If the drive, particularly the clutch, shows signs of overheating it
indicates that it is not disengaging immediately after the engine starts. If the clutch is forced to
overrun too long, it overheats and turns a bluish color. For the cause of the binding, look for rust or
gum between the armature shaft and the drive, or for burred splines. Excess oil on the drive will
lead to gumming, and inadequate air circulation in the flywheel housing will cause rust.
Overrunning clutch drives cannot be overhauled in the field so they must be replaced. In cleaning,
never soak them in a solvent because the solvent may enter the clutch and dissolve the sealed-in
lubricant. Wipe them off lightly with kerosene and lubricate them sparingly with SAE 10 or 10W oil.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Starter Drive/Bendix >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Clutch Failure - A/C Delco > Page 5064
Starter Drive/Bendix: Testing and Inspection Drive Failure - A/C Delco
When a Bendix type drive doesn't engage the cause usually is one of three things: either the drive
spring is broken, one of the drive spring bolts has sheared off, or the screw shaft threads won't
allow the pinion to travel toward the flywheel. In the first two cases, remove the drive by unscrewing
the setscrew under the last coil of the drive spring and replace the broken parts. Gummed or rusty
screw shaft threads are fairly common causes of Bendix drive failure and are easily cleaned with a
little kerosene or steel wool, depending on the trouble. Here again, as in the case of overrunning
clutch drives, use light oil sparingly, and be sure the flywheel housing has adequate ventilation.
There is usually a breather hole in the bottom of the flywheel housing which should be open.
The failure of a Bendix drive to disengage or to mesh properly is most often caused by gummed or
rusty screw shaft threads. When this is not true, look for mechanical failure within the drive itself.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Motor > Starter Drive/Bendix >
Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Drive Clutch Failure - A/C Delco > Page 5065
Starter Drive/Bendix: Testing and Inspection Starter Drive Troubles - AC Delco
Starter drive troubles are easy to diagnose and they usually cannot be confused with ordinary
starter difficulties. If the starter does not turn over at all or if it drags, look for trouble in the starter or
electrical supply system. Concentrate on the starter drive or ring gear if the starter is noisy, if it
turns but does not engage the engine, or if the starter won't disengage after the engine is started.
After the starter is removed, the trouble can usually be located quickly.
Worn or chipped ring gear or starter pinion are the usual causes of noisy operation. Before
replacing either or both of these parts try to find out what caused the damage. With the Bendix type
drive, incomplete engagement of the pinion with the ring gear is a common cause of tooth damage.
The wrong pinion clearance on starter drives of the overrunning clutch type leads to poor meshing
of the pinion and ring gear and too rapid tooth wear.
A less common cause of noise with either type of drive is a bent starter armature shaft. When this
shaft is bent, the pinion gear alternately binds and then only partly meshes with the ring gear. Most
manufacturers specify a maximum of 0.003 inch radial runout on the armature shaft.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Locations
LH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Starter Solenoid: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5071
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5072
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5073
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5074
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5075
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5076
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5077
Starter Solenoid: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5078
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5079
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5080
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5081
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5082
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5083
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5084
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5085
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5086
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5087
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5088
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5089
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5090
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5091
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5092
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5093
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5094
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5095
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5096
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5097
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5098
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5099
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5100
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5101
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5102
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Starting System > Starter Solenoid > Component Information >
Diagrams > Page 5103
Starter Solenoid: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The solenoid switch on a cranking motor not only closes the circuit between the battery and the
cranking motor but also shifts the drive pinion into mesh with the engine flywheel ring gear. This is
done by means of a linkage between the solenoid switch plunger and the shift lever on the cranking
motor.
OPERATION
There are two windings in the solenoid; a pull-in winding and a hold-in winding. Both windings are
energized when the external control switch is closed. They produce a magnetic field which pulls the
plunger in so that the drive pinion is shifted into mesh, and the main contacts in the solenoid switch
are closed to connect the battery directly to the cranking motor. Closing the main switch contacts
shorts out the pull-in winding since this winding is connected across the main contacts. The
magnetism produced by the hold-in winding is sufficient to hold the plunger in, and shorting out the
pull-in winding reduces drain on the battery. When the control switch is opened, it disconnects the
hold-in winding from the battery. When the hold-in winding is disconnected from the battery, the
shift lever spring withdraws the plunger from the solenoid, opening the solenoid switch contacts
and at the same time withdrawing the drive pinion from mesh. Proper operation of the switch
depends on maintaining a definite balance between the magnetic strength of the pull-in and hold-in
windings.
This balance is established in the design by the size of the wire and the number of turns specified.
An open circuit in the hold-in winding or attempts to crank with a discharged battery will cause the
switch to chatter.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Specifications
Circuit Breaker: Specifications
Fuse Block Details: Front View Of Fuse Block
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 5108
Fuse Block Details: Description
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Locations > DRL-In-Line Fuse
Circuit Breaker: Locations DRL-In-Line Fuse
DRL-In-Line Fuse is located LH rear of Engine Compartment, near EBCM
DRL-In-Line Fuse is located LH rear of Engine Compartment, near EBCM
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Locations > DRL-In-Line Fuse > Page 5111
Circuit Breaker: Locations Front View of Fuse Block
Fuse Block Details: Front View Of Fuse Block
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Locations > DRL-In-Line Fuse > Page 5112
Fuse Block Details: Description
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Locations > DRL-In-Line Fuse > Page 5113
Circuit Breaker: Locations Fuse Block
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Locations > DRL-In-Line Fuse > Page 5114
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Locations > DRL-In-Line Fuse > Page 5115
LH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Locations > DRL-In-Line Fuse > Page 5116
LH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Breaker: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5119
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5120
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5121
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5122
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5123
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5124
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5125
Circuit Breaker: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5126
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5127
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5128
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5129
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5130
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5131
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5132
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5133
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5134
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5135
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5136
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5137
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5138
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5139
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5140
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5141
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5142
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5143
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5144
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5145
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5146
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5147
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5148
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5149
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5150
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5151
Circuit Breaker: Electrical Diagrams
Fuse Block Details: WDO Circuit Breaker And HTR-A/C Fuse (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5152
Fuse Block Details: WDO Circuit Breaker And HTR-A/C Fuse (Part 2 Of 2)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5153
Fuse Block Details: RDO 1 Fuse, S/LP Fuse, And PWR ACC Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5154
Circuit Breaker: Application and ID
Fuse Block Details: Front View Of Fuse Block
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5155
Fuse Block Details: Description
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Convenience Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Locations
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Convenience Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Harness Connector
Harness Connector Faces: Convenience Center
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Convenience Center <-->
[Electrical Accessory Panel] > Component Information > Diagrams > Harness Connector > Page 5161
Harness Connector Faces: Convenience Center (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Aftermarket Fuse Warning
Fuse: Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Aftermarket Fuse Warning
Bulletin No.: 07-08-45-002
Date: September 05, 2007
ADVANCED SERVICE INFORMATION
Subject: Service Alert: Concerns With Aftermarket Fuses in GM Vehicles
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2008 and
Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2008 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Concerns with Harbor Freight Tools "Storehouse" Branded Blade Type Fuses
General Motors has become aware of a fuse recall by Harbor Freight Tools/Storehouse for a
variety of aftermarket fuses. In two cases, these fuses have not provided protection for the wiring
system of the vehicles they were customer installed in.
Upon testing the 15 amp version, it was found that the fuse still would not "open" when shorted
directly across the battery terminals.
How to Identify These Fuses
Packed in a 120 piece set, the fuse has a translucent, hard plastic, blue body with the amperage
stamped into the top. There are no white painted numbers on the fuse to indicate amperage. There
are no identifying marks on the fuse to tell who is making it. The fuses are known to be distributed
by Harbor Freight Tools but there may be other marketers, and packaging of this style of fuse. It
would be prudent to replace these fuses if found in a customers vehicle. Likewise, if wiring
overheating is found you should check the fuse panel for the presence of this style of fuse.
All GM dealers should use genuine GM fuses on the vehicles they service. You should also
encourage the use of GM fuses to your customers to assure they are getting the required electrical
system protection. GM has no knowledge of any concerns with other aftermarket fuses. If
additional information becomes available, this bulletin will be updated.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5166
Fuse: Specifications
Fuse Block Details: Front View Of Fuse Block
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 5167
Fuse Block Details: Description
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Fuse Rating - Front View of Fuse Block
Fuse: Locations Fuse Rating - Front View of Fuse Block
Fuse Block Details: Front View Of Fuse Block
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Fuse Rating - Front View of Fuse Block > Page 5170
Fuse Block Details: Description
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Fuse Rating - Front View of Fuse Block > Page 5171
Fuse: Locations DRL-In-Line Fuse
DRL-In-Line Fuse is located LH rear of Engine Compartment, near EBCM
DRL-In-Line Fuse is located LH rear of Engine Compartment, near EBCM
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Fuse Rating - Front View of Fuse Block > Page 5172
Fuse: Locations Fuse Block
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Fuse Rating - Front View of Fuse Block > Page 5173
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Fuse Rating - Front View of Fuse Block > Page 5174
LH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Fuse Rating - Front View of Fuse Block > Page 5175
LH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5176
Fuse: Application and ID
Fuse Block Details: Front View Of Fuse Block
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information >
Locations > Page 5177
Fuse Block Details: Description
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
Fuse Block: Component Locations
The fuse panel is located on the left side of the instrument panel. To gain access to the panel, pivot
access door downward.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 5182
Fuse Block: Fuse and Fusible Link Locations
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 5183
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 5184
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuse Block: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5187
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5188
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5189
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5190
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5191
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5192
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5193
Fuse Block: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5194
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5195
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5196
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5197
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5198
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5199
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5200
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5201
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5202
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5203
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5204
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5205
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5206
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5207
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5208
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5209
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5210
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5211
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5212
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5213
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5214
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5215
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5216
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5217
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5218
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5219
Fuse Block: Electrical Diagrams
Fuse Block Details: Gages Fuse, F/P Fuse, Turn B/U Fuse And ECM Fuse (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5220
Fuse Block Details: Gages Fuse, F/P Fuse, Turn B/U Fuse And ECM Fuse (Part 2 Of 2)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5221
Fuse Block Details: WDO Circuit Breaker And HTR-A/C Fuse (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5222
Fuse Block Details: WDO Circuit Breaker And HTR-A/C Fuse (Part 2 Of 2)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5223
Fuse Block Details: Wiper Fuse, Cruise Fuse, RDO 2 Fuse And CIG LTR Fuse
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5224
Fuse Block Details: RDO 1 Fuse, S/LP Fuse, And PWR ACC Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5225
Fuse Block Details: CTSY Fuse (Coupe, Sedan And Station Wagon)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5226
Fuse Block Details: CTSY Fuse (Convertible)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5227
Fuse Block: Application and ID
Fuse Block Details: Front View Of Fuse Block
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 5228
Fuse Block Details: Description
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fusible Link > Component
Information > Locations > Fusible Link D
LH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Fusible Link > Component
Information > Locations > Fusible Link D > Page 5233
LH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair
Grounding Point: Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 10-08-45-001B
Date: October 25, 2010
Subject: Information for Electrical Ground Repair - Use New Replacement Fasteners with
Conductive Finish
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year and update the Warranty
Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-08-45-001A (Section 08 - Body and
Accessories).
Electrical Ground Repair Overview
Proper electrical system function relies on secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground
connections. Loose, stripped, or corroded connections increase the possibility of improper system
function and loss of module communication. These conditions may also lead to unnecessary
repairs and component replacement.
In general, electrical ground connections are accomplished using one, or a combination of the
following attachment methods:
- Welded M6 stud and nut
- Welded M6 nut and bolt
- Welded M8 nut and bolt
Determine which attachment method is used and perform the appropriate or alternative repair as
described in this bulletin.
M6 Weld Stud Replacement
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. Select a location adjacent the damaged or missing M6 ground stud having 20 mm (0.79 in)
clearance behind the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in)
clearance surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange.
2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site
and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
3. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel.
4. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is
visible.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5238
Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of
0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any
air gaps to ensure a good ground.
5. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit.
6. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool
(2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet
stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3).
7. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive
rivet stud. 8. Ensure the rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement. 9.
Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent.
Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the
installation of the ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable and
corrosion-free electrical ground.
10. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 11. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective
material applied to the rivet stud threads. 12. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet
stud threads. 13. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet
stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 14. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet
stud.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5239
15. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 16. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the rivet stud. 17. Select a M6
conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 18. Install the M6 conductive
nut to the rivet stud and:
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
19. Verify proper system operation.
M6 Weld Nut
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M6 weld nut at the electrical ground location is damaged or stripped, a M7 conductive
self-threading bolt may be used to secure the ground
wire terminal.
2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the weld nut and allow to dry. 3. Remove any loose metal particles from the damaged
or stripped weld nut with a stiff brush. 4. Select a M7 conductive self-threading bolt. Refer to the
Parts Information section of this bulletin 5. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N
12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M7 conductive self-threading
bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
6. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 7. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M7 conductive self-threading bolt.
8. Install the M7 conductive self-threading bolt and:
Tighten Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb in).
9. Verify proper system operation.
M6 Weld Nut Alternative Repair
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6 conductive bolt
and a M6 conductive nut may be used to secure
the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M6 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind
the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance
surrounding the new electrical ground site.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the ground location and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 8.5 mm (0.33 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the
area surrounding the 8.5 mm (0.33 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M6 conductive
bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M6 conductive bolt to the ground
location.
10. Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the
M6 conductive nut to the bolt and:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5240
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free
electrical ground.
12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation.
M8 Weld Nut
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M8
conductive bolt and a M8 conductive nut may be
used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this
bulletin.
2. Select a location adjacent the M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind the panel
surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance surrounding
the new electrical ground site.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the ground location and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the
area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M8 conductive
bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M8 conductive bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M8 conductive bolt to the ground
location.
10. Select a M8 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the
M8 conductive nut to the bolt and:
Tighten Tighten to 22 Nm (16 lb ft).
Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free
electrical ground.
12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation.
M8 Weld Nut Alternative Repair
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is not accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6
conductive rivet stud and a M6 conductive nut
may be used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal.
2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind
the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance
surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site
and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5241
5. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) until bare metal is
visible.
Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of
0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any
air gaps to ensure a good ground.
6. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit.
7. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool
(2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet
stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3).
8. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive
rivet stud. 9. Ensure the new rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement.
10. Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5242
Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the
installation of the electrical ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable
and corrosion-free electrical ground.
11. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 12. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective
material applied to the rivet stud threads. 13. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet
stud threads. 14. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet
stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 15. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet
stud.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
16. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 17. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M6 conductive rivet stud. 18.
Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 19. Install the M6
conductive nut to the rivet stud and:
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in)
20. Verify proper system operation.
Parts Information
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5243
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set
By Various Control Modules
Wiring Harness: Customer Interest Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D
Date: December 08, 2010
Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle
Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion
(Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Attention:
This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body
electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the
point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal
surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011
model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
- An intermittent no crank/no start
- Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination
- Intermittent service lamp illumination
- Intermittent service message(s) being displayed
The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as
fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector.
This may be caused by any of the following conditions:
- Vibration
- Thermal cycling
- Poor connection/terminal retention
- Micro motion
- A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement
On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent
connections.
On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and
may cause a device to become inoperative.
Representative List of Control Modules and Components
The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected
by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or
component for every vehicle.
- Blower Control Module
- Body Control Module (BCM)
- Communication Interface Module (CIM)
- Cooling Fan Control Module
- Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
- Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM)
- Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module
- Engine Control Module (ECM)
- Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set
By Various Control Modules > Page 5252
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set
By Various Control Modules > Page 5253
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set
By Various Control Modules > Page 5254
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL
ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control
Modules
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D
Date: December 08, 2010
Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle
Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion
(Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Attention:
This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body
electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the
point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal
surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011
model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
- An intermittent no crank/no start
- Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination
- Intermittent service lamp illumination
- Intermittent service message(s) being displayed
The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as
fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector.
This may be caused by any of the following conditions:
- Vibration
- Thermal cycling
- Poor connection/terminal retention
- Micro motion
- A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement
On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent
connections.
On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and
may cause a device to become inoperative.
Representative List of Control Modules and Components
The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected
by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or
component for every vehicle.
- Blower Control Module
- Body Control Module (BCM)
- Communication Interface Module (CIM)
- Cooling Fan Control Module
- Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
- Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM)
- Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module
- Engine Control Module (ECM)
- Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL
ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 5260
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL
ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 5261
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL
ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 5262
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical Information For Electrical Ground Repair
Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 10-08-45-001B
Date: October 25, 2010
Subject: Information for Electrical Ground Repair - Use New Replacement Fasteners with
Conductive Finish
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year and update the Warranty
Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-08-45-001A (Section 08 - Body and
Accessories).
Electrical Ground Repair Overview
Proper electrical system function relies on secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground
connections. Loose, stripped, or corroded connections increase the possibility of improper system
function and loss of module communication. These conditions may also lead to unnecessary
repairs and component replacement.
In general, electrical ground connections are accomplished using one, or a combination of the
following attachment methods:
- Welded M6 stud and nut
- Welded M6 nut and bolt
- Welded M8 nut and bolt
Determine which attachment method is used and perform the appropriate or alternative repair as
described in this bulletin.
M6 Weld Stud Replacement
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. Select a location adjacent the damaged or missing M6 ground stud having 20 mm (0.79 in)
clearance behind the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in)
clearance surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange.
2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site
and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
3. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel.
4. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is
visible.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5267
Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of
0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any
air gaps to ensure a good ground.
5. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit.
6. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool
(2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet
stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3).
7. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive
rivet stud. 8. Ensure the rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement. 9.
Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent.
Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the
installation of the ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable and
corrosion-free electrical ground.
10. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 11. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective
material applied to the rivet stud threads. 12. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet
stud threads. 13. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet
stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 14. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet
stud.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5268
15. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 16. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the rivet stud. 17. Select a M6
conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 18. Install the M6 conductive
nut to the rivet stud and:
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
19. Verify proper system operation.
M6 Weld Nut
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M6 weld nut at the electrical ground location is damaged or stripped, a M7 conductive
self-threading bolt may be used to secure the ground
wire terminal.
2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the weld nut and allow to dry. 3. Remove any loose metal particles from the damaged
or stripped weld nut with a stiff brush. 4. Select a M7 conductive self-threading bolt. Refer to the
Parts Information section of this bulletin 5. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N
12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M7 conductive self-threading
bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
6. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 7. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M7 conductive self-threading bolt.
8. Install the M7 conductive self-threading bolt and:
Tighten Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb in).
9. Verify proper system operation.
M6 Weld Nut Alternative Repair
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6 conductive bolt
and a M6 conductive nut may be used to secure
the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M6 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind
the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance
surrounding the new electrical ground site.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the ground location and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 8.5 mm (0.33 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the
area surrounding the 8.5 mm (0.33 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M6 conductive
bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M6 conductive bolt to the ground
location.
10. Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the
M6 conductive nut to the bolt and:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5269
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free
electrical ground.
12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation.
M8 Weld Nut
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M8
conductive bolt and a M8 conductive nut may be
used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this
bulletin.
2. Select a location adjacent the M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind the panel
surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance surrounding
the new electrical ground site.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the ground location and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the
area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M8 conductive
bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M8 conductive bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M8 conductive bolt to the ground
location.
10. Select a M8 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the
M8 conductive nut to the bolt and:
Tighten Tighten to 22 Nm (16 lb ft).
Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free
electrical ground.
12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation.
M8 Weld Nut Alternative Repair
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is not accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6
conductive rivet stud and a M6 conductive nut
may be used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal.
2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind
the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance
surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site
and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5270
5. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) until bare metal is
visible.
Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of
0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any
air gaps to ensure a good ground.
6. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit.
7. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool
(2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet
stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3).
8. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive
rivet stud. 9. Ensure the new rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement.
10. Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5271
Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the
installation of the electrical ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable
and corrosion-free electrical ground.
11. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 12. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective
material applied to the rivet stud threads. 13. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet
stud threads. 14. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet
stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 15. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet
stud.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
16. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 17. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M6 conductive rivet stud. 18.
Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 19. Install the M6
conductive nut to the rivet stud and:
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in)
20. Verify proper system operation.
Parts Information
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5272
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 06-08-45-004 > May > 06 > Electrical Instrument Panel & General Wiring Repair
Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Instrument Panel & General Wiring
Repair
Bulletin No.: 06-08-45-004
Date: May 02, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Instrument Panel (I/P), Body and General Wiring Harness Repair
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Trucks 2003-2007 HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3
Important:
A part restriction has been implemented on all Body and I/P harnesses and is being administered
by the PQC. If a body or I/P harness replacement is required, it can take 12-28 weeks for a
harness to be built and delivered to a dealer. The dealer technician is expected to repair any
harness damage as the first and best choice before replacing a harness.
In an effort to standardize repair practices, General Motors is requiring that all wiring harnesses be
repaired instead of replaced. If there is a question concerning which connector and/or terminal you
are working on, refer to the information in the appropriate Connector End Views in SI. The
Instruction Manual J 38125-620, which is sent with each new update of the J 38125 Terminal
Repair Kit, also has terminal crimping and terminal remove information.
Important:
There are some parts in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit (i.e. SIR connector CPAs and heat shrink
tube (used in high heat area pigtail replacement) and some TPAs that are not available from
GMSPO. It is vitally important that each update to the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit be done as soon
as it arrives at the dealer.
Utilize the Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125) to achieve an effective wiring repair. The Terminal Repair
Kit has been an essential tool for all GM Dealers since 1987. Replacement terminals and tools for
this kit are available through SPX/Kent Moore. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 06-08-45-001
for more information.
The Instruction Manual J 38125-620, which is sent with each new update to the J 38125 Terminal
Repair Kit, also has terminal crimping and terminal removal information.
U.S. Dealers Only - Training courses (including Tech Assists, Emerging Issues, Web, IDL and
Hands-on) are available through the GM Training website. Refer to Resources and then Training
Materials for a complete list of available courses.
Canadian Dealers Only - Refer to the Training section of GM infoNet for a complete list of available
courses and a copy of the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit Instruction Manual.
Wiring repair information is also available in Service Information (SI). The Wiring Repair section
contains information for the following types of wiring repairs:
- Testing for intermittent conditions and poor conditions
- Flat wire repairs
- GMLAN wiring repairs
- High temperature wiring repairs
- Splicing copper wire using splice clips
- Splicing copper wire using splice sleeves
- Splicing twisted or shielded cable
- Splicing inline harness diodes
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 06-08-45-004 > May > 06 > Electrical Instrument Panel & General Wiring Repair > Page 5277
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 477133 > Aug > 94 > Axle Oil
Seal, Right - Leaks at the Axle Tripod Shank
Seals and Gaskets: All Technical Service Bulletins Axle Oil Seal, Right - Leaks at the Axle Tripod
Shank
Group Ref.: 7 - Transmission
Bulletin No.: 477133
Date: August, 1994
SUBJECT: RIGHT AXLE OIL SEAL LEAKS (INSTALL REVISED RIGHT AXLE OIL SEAL)
MODELS: 1992-93
BUICK RIVIERA
1992-94 BUICK CENTURY, PARK AVENUE, LE SABRE, SKYLARK AND REGAL
1992 CADILLAC ALLANTE
1992-93 CADILLAC FLEETWOOD (FWD), SIXTY SPECIAL, ELDORADO AND SEVILLE
1992-94 CADILLAC DE VILLE
1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, BERETTA, CORSICA, LUMINA AND LUMINA APV
1992 OLDSMOBILE TORONADO
1992-94 OLDSMOBILE CUTLASS CIERA, NINETY EIGHT, EIGHTY EIGHT, ACHIEVA,
CUTLASS SUPREME AND SILHOUETTE
1992-94 PONTIAC SUNBIRD, BONNEVILLE, GRAND AM, GRAND PRIX AND TRANS SPORT
TRANSAXLE APPLICATIONS: HYDRA-MATIC 3T40 (RPO MD9) HYDRA-MATIC 4T60 (RPO
ME9) HYDRA-MATIC 4T60-E (RPO M13)
TRANSAXLE MODELS: 1992-94 MODELS BUILT BEFORE JUNE 6, 1994 (JULIAN DATE 157)
CONDITION: Some owners may experience an oil leak that is diagnosed as a right axle oil seal
leak at the axle tripot shank.
CAUSE: This condition may be caused by inadequate seal contact to the axle tripot shank.
CORRECTION: A revised Right Axle Oil Seal was implemented in production to reduce the
potential for axle oil seal leaks and is available for service. The revised Right Axle Oil Seal extends
over the axle tripot shank an additional 2 mm (refer to Figure 1).
SERVICE INFORMATION: When Right Axle Oil Seal replacement is required on any 1992-1994
Hydra-Matic 3T40, 4T60 or 4T60-E transaxle, install the revised Right Axle Oil Seal listed under
"Service Parts Information". The previous Right Axle Oil Seal was blue in color. The revised Right
Axle Oil Seal is green.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 477133 > Aug > 94 > Axle Oil
Seal, Right - Leaks at the Axle Tripod Shank > Page 5283
IMPORTANT:
WHEN A DRIVE AXLE IS REMOVED FROM THE TRANSAXLE FOR ANY REASON, THE AXLE
SEALING SURFACE (TRIPOT SHANK) SHOULD BE INSPECTED FOR CORROSION. IF
CORROSION IS EVIDENT, THE SURFACE SHOULD BE CLEANED WITH 320 GRIT CLOTH OR
EQUIVALENT. AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID MAY BE USED TO CLEAN OFF ANY
REMAINING DEBRIS. THE SURFACE SHOULD BE WIPED DRY AND THE DRIVE AXLE
REINSTALLED FREE OF ANY BUILD UP.
SERVICE PARTS INFORMATION:
The table lists Left and Right Axle Oil Seal usage for all Hydra-matic 3T40, 4T60 and 4T60-E
transaxles:
PARTS INFORMATION: Parts are expected to be available on September 5, 1994.
WARRANTY INFORMATION: For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Starting and Charging > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 477133 > Aug > 94 > Axle Oil
Seal, Right - Leaks at the Axle Tripod Shank > Page 5289
IMPORTANT:
WHEN A DRIVE AXLE IS REMOVED FROM THE TRANSAXLE FOR ANY REASON, THE AXLE
SEALING SURFACE (TRIPOT SHANK) SHOULD BE INSPECTED FOR CORROSION. IF
CORROSION IS EVIDENT, THE SURFACE SHOULD BE CLEANED WITH 320 GRIT CLOTH OR
EQUIVALENT. AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID MAY BE USED TO CLEAN OFF ANY
REMAINING DEBRIS. THE SURFACE SHOULD BE WIPED DRY AND THE DRIVE AXLE
REINSTALLED FREE OF ANY BUILD UP.
SERVICE PARTS INFORMATION:
The table lists Left and Right Axle Oil Seal usage for all Hydra-matic 3T40, 4T60 and 4T60-E
transaxles:
PARTS INFORMATION: Parts are expected to be available on September 5, 1994.
WARRANTY INFORMATION: For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Specifications
Circuit Breaker: Specifications
Fuse Block Details: Front View Of Fuse Block
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 5294
Fuse Block Details: Description
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Locations >
DRL-In-Line Fuse
Circuit Breaker: Locations DRL-In-Line Fuse
DRL-In-Line Fuse is located LH rear of Engine Compartment, near EBCM
DRL-In-Line Fuse is located LH rear of Engine Compartment, near EBCM
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Locations >
DRL-In-Line Fuse > Page 5297
Circuit Breaker: Locations Front View of Fuse Block
Fuse Block Details: Front View Of Fuse Block
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Locations >
DRL-In-Line Fuse > Page 5298
Fuse Block Details: Description
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Locations >
DRL-In-Line Fuse > Page 5299
Circuit Breaker: Locations Fuse Block
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Locations >
DRL-In-Line Fuse > Page 5300
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Locations >
DRL-In-Line Fuse > Page 5301
LH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Locations >
DRL-In-Line Fuse > Page 5302
LH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Circuit Breaker: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5305
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5306
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5307
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5308
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5309
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5310
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5311
Circuit Breaker: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5312
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5313
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5314
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5315
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5316
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5317
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5318
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5319
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5320
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5321
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5322
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5323
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5324
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5325
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5326
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5327
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5328
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5329
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5330
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5331
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5332
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5333
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5334
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5335
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5336
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5337
Circuit Breaker: Electrical Diagrams
Fuse Block Details: WDO Circuit Breaker And HTR-A/C Fuse (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5338
Fuse Block Details: WDO Circuit Breaker And HTR-A/C Fuse (Part 2 Of 2)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5339
Fuse Block Details: RDO 1 Fuse, S/LP Fuse, And PWR ACC Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5340
Circuit Breaker: Application and ID
Fuse Block Details: Front View Of Fuse Block
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Circuit Breaker > Component Information > Diagrams >
Page 5341
Fuse Block Details: Description
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Convenience Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Locations
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Convenience Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Harness Connector
Harness Connector Faces: Convenience Center
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Convenience Center <--> [Electrical Accessory Panel] >
Component Information > Diagrams > Harness Connector > Page 5347
Harness Connector Faces: Convenience Center (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Electrical - Aftermarket Fuse Warning
Fuse: Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Aftermarket Fuse Warning
Bulletin No.: 07-08-45-002
Date: September 05, 2007
ADVANCED SERVICE INFORMATION
Subject: Service Alert: Concerns With Aftermarket Fuses in GM Vehicles
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2008 and
Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2008 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Concerns with Harbor Freight Tools "Storehouse" Branded Blade Type Fuses
General Motors has become aware of a fuse recall by Harbor Freight Tools/Storehouse for a
variety of aftermarket fuses. In two cases, these fuses have not provided protection for the wiring
system of the vehicles they were customer installed in.
Upon testing the 15 amp version, it was found that the fuse still would not "open" when shorted
directly across the battery terminals.
How to Identify These Fuses
Packed in a 120 piece set, the fuse has a translucent, hard plastic, blue body with the amperage
stamped into the top. There are no white painted numbers on the fuse to indicate amperage. There
are no identifying marks on the fuse to tell who is making it. The fuses are known to be distributed
by Harbor Freight Tools but there may be other marketers, and packaging of this style of fuse. It
would be prudent to replace these fuses if found in a customers vehicle. Likewise, if wiring
overheating is found you should check the fuse panel for the presence of this style of fuse.
All GM dealers should use genuine GM fuses on the vehicles they service. You should also
encourage the use of GM fuses to your customers to assure they are getting the required electrical
system protection. GM has no knowledge of any concerns with other aftermarket fuses. If
additional information becomes available, this bulletin will be updated.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 5352
Fuse: Specifications
Fuse Block Details: Front View Of Fuse Block
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 5353
Fuse Block Details: Description
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Fuse Rating
- Front View of Fuse Block
Fuse: Locations Fuse Rating - Front View of Fuse Block
Fuse Block Details: Front View Of Fuse Block
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Fuse Rating
- Front View of Fuse Block > Page 5356
Fuse Block Details: Description
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Fuse Rating
- Front View of Fuse Block > Page 5357
Fuse: Locations DRL-In-Line Fuse
DRL-In-Line Fuse is located LH rear of Engine Compartment, near EBCM
DRL-In-Line Fuse is located LH rear of Engine Compartment, near EBCM
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Fuse Rating
- Front View of Fuse Block > Page 5358
Fuse: Locations Fuse Block
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Fuse Rating
- Front View of Fuse Block > Page 5359
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Fuse Rating
- Front View of Fuse Block > Page 5360
LH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Fuse Rating
- Front View of Fuse Block > Page 5361
LH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Page 5362
Fuse: Application and ID
Fuse Block Details: Front View Of Fuse Block
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse > Component Information > Locations > Page 5363
Fuse Block Details: Description
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Fuse Block: Component Locations
The fuse panel is located on the left side of the instrument panel. To gain access to the panel, pivot
access door downward.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 5368
Fuse Block: Fuse and Fusible Link Locations
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 5369
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 5370
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Fuse Block: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5373
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5374
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5375
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5376
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5377
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5378
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5379
Fuse Block: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5380
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5381
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5382
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5383
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5384
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5385
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5386
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5387
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5388
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5389
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5390
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5391
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5392
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5393
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5394
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5395
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5396
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5397
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5398
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5399
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5400
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5401
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5402
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5403
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5404
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5405
Fuse Block: Electrical Diagrams
Fuse Block Details: Gages Fuse, F/P Fuse, Turn B/U Fuse And ECM Fuse (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5406
Fuse Block Details: Gages Fuse, F/P Fuse, Turn B/U Fuse And ECM Fuse (Part 2 Of 2)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5407
Fuse Block Details: WDO Circuit Breaker And HTR-A/C Fuse (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5408
Fuse Block Details: WDO Circuit Breaker And HTR-A/C Fuse (Part 2 Of 2)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5409
Fuse Block Details: Wiper Fuse, Cruise Fuse, RDO 2 Fuse And CIG LTR Fuse
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5410
Fuse Block Details: RDO 1 Fuse, S/LP Fuse, And PWR ACC Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5411
Fuse Block Details: CTSY Fuse (Coupe, Sedan And Station Wagon)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 5412
Fuse Block Details: CTSY Fuse (Convertible)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
5413
Fuse Block: Application and ID
Fuse Block Details: Front View Of Fuse Block
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fuse Block > Component Information > Diagrams > Page
5414
Fuse Block Details: Description
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fusible Link > Component Information > Locations >
Fusible Link D
LH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Fusible Link > Component Information > Locations >
Fusible Link D > Page 5419
LH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair
Grounding Point: Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 10-08-45-001B
Date: October 25, 2010
Subject: Information for Electrical Ground Repair - Use New Replacement Fasteners with
Conductive Finish
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year and update the Warranty
Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-08-45-001A (Section 08 - Body and
Accessories).
Electrical Ground Repair Overview
Proper electrical system function relies on secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground
connections. Loose, stripped, or corroded connections increase the possibility of improper system
function and loss of module communication. These conditions may also lead to unnecessary
repairs and component replacement.
In general, electrical ground connections are accomplished using one, or a combination of the
following attachment methods:
- Welded M6 stud and nut
- Welded M6 nut and bolt
- Welded M8 nut and bolt
Determine which attachment method is used and perform the appropriate or alternative repair as
described in this bulletin.
M6 Weld Stud Replacement
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. Select a location adjacent the damaged or missing M6 ground stud having 20 mm (0.79 in)
clearance behind the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in)
clearance surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange.
2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site
and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
3. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel.
4. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is
visible.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5424
Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of
0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any
air gaps to ensure a good ground.
5. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit.
6. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool
(2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet
stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3).
7. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive
rivet stud. 8. Ensure the rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement. 9.
Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent.
Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the
installation of the ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable and
corrosion-free electrical ground.
10. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 11. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective
material applied to the rivet stud threads. 12. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet
stud threads. 13. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet
stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 14. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet
stud.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5425
15. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 16. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the rivet stud. 17. Select a M6
conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 18. Install the M6 conductive
nut to the rivet stud and:
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
19. Verify proper system operation.
M6 Weld Nut
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M6 weld nut at the electrical ground location is damaged or stripped, a M7 conductive
self-threading bolt may be used to secure the ground
wire terminal.
2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the weld nut and allow to dry. 3. Remove any loose metal particles from the damaged
or stripped weld nut with a stiff brush. 4. Select a M7 conductive self-threading bolt. Refer to the
Parts Information section of this bulletin 5. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N
12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M7 conductive self-threading
bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
6. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 7. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M7 conductive self-threading bolt.
8. Install the M7 conductive self-threading bolt and:
Tighten Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb in).
9. Verify proper system operation.
M6 Weld Nut Alternative Repair
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6 conductive bolt
and a M6 conductive nut may be used to secure
the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M6 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind
the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance
surrounding the new electrical ground site.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the ground location and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 8.5 mm (0.33 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the
area surrounding the 8.5 mm (0.33 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M6 conductive
bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M6 conductive bolt to the ground
location.
10. Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the
M6 conductive nut to the bolt and:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5426
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free
electrical ground.
12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation.
M8 Weld Nut
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M8
conductive bolt and a M8 conductive nut may be
used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this
bulletin.
2. Select a location adjacent the M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind the panel
surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance surrounding
the new electrical ground site.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the ground location and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the
area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M8 conductive
bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M8 conductive bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M8 conductive bolt to the ground
location.
10. Select a M8 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the
M8 conductive nut to the bolt and:
Tighten Tighten to 22 Nm (16 lb ft).
Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free
electrical ground.
12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation.
M8 Weld Nut Alternative Repair
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is not accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6
conductive rivet stud and a M6 conductive nut
may be used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal.
2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind
the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance
surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site
and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5427
5. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) until bare metal is
visible.
Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of
0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any
air gaps to ensure a good ground.
6. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit.
7. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool
(2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet
stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3).
8. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive
rivet stud. 9. Ensure the new rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement.
10. Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5428
Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the
installation of the electrical ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable
and corrosion-free electrical ground.
11. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 12. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective
material applied to the rivet stud threads. 13. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet
stud threads. 14. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet
stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 15. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet
stud.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
16. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 17. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M6 conductive rivet stud. 18.
Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 19. Install the M6
conductive nut to the rivet stud and:
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in)
20. Verify proper system operation.
Parts Information
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Grounding Point > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5429
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control
Modules
Wiring Harness: Customer Interest Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D
Date: December 08, 2010
Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle
Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion
(Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Attention:
This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body
electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the
point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal
surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011
model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
- An intermittent no crank/no start
- Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination
- Intermittent service lamp illumination
- Intermittent service message(s) being displayed
The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as
fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector.
This may be caused by any of the following conditions:
- Vibration
- Thermal cycling
- Poor connection/terminal retention
- Micro motion
- A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement
On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent
connections.
On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and
may cause a device to become inoperative.
Representative List of Control Modules and Components
The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected
by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or
component for every vehicle.
- Blower Control Module
- Body Control Module (BCM)
- Communication Interface Module (CIM)
- Cooling Fan Control Module
- Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
- Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM)
- Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module
- Engine Control Module (ECM)
- Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control
Modules > Page 5438
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control
Modules > Page 5439
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control
Modules > Page 5440
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL
ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control
Modules
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D
Date: December 08, 2010
Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle
Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion
(Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Attention:
This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body
electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the
point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal
surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011
model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
- An intermittent no crank/no start
- Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination
- Intermittent service lamp illumination
- Intermittent service message(s) being displayed
The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as
fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector.
This may be caused by any of the following conditions:
- Vibration
- Thermal cycling
- Poor connection/terminal retention
- Micro motion
- A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement
On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent
connections.
On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and
may cause a device to become inoperative.
Representative List of Control Modules and Components
The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected
by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or
component for every vehicle.
- Blower Control Module
- Body Control Module (BCM)
- Communication Interface Module (CIM)
- Cooling Fan Control Module
- Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
- Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM)
- Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module
- Engine Control Module (ECM)
- Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL
ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 5446
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL
ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 5447
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL
ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 5448
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information
For Electrical Ground Repair
Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 10-08-45-001B
Date: October 25, 2010
Subject: Information for Electrical Ground Repair - Use New Replacement Fasteners with
Conductive Finish
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year and update the Warranty
Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-08-45-001A (Section 08 - Body and
Accessories).
Electrical Ground Repair Overview
Proper electrical system function relies on secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground
connections. Loose, stripped, or corroded connections increase the possibility of improper system
function and loss of module communication. These conditions may also lead to unnecessary
repairs and component replacement.
In general, electrical ground connections are accomplished using one, or a combination of the
following attachment methods:
- Welded M6 stud and nut
- Welded M6 nut and bolt
- Welded M8 nut and bolt
Determine which attachment method is used and perform the appropriate or alternative repair as
described in this bulletin.
M6 Weld Stud Replacement
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. Select a location adjacent the damaged or missing M6 ground stud having 20 mm (0.79 in)
clearance behind the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in)
clearance surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange.
2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site
and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
3. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel.
4. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is
visible.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information
For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5453
Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of
0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any
air gaps to ensure a good ground.
5. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit.
6. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool
(2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet
stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3).
7. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive
rivet stud. 8. Ensure the rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement. 9.
Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent.
Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the
installation of the ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable and
corrosion-free electrical ground.
10. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 11. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective
material applied to the rivet stud threads. 12. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet
stud threads. 13. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet
stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 14. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet
stud.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information
For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5454
15. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 16. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the rivet stud. 17. Select a M6
conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 18. Install the M6 conductive
nut to the rivet stud and:
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
19. Verify proper system operation.
M6 Weld Nut
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M6 weld nut at the electrical ground location is damaged or stripped, a M7 conductive
self-threading bolt may be used to secure the ground
wire terminal.
2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the weld nut and allow to dry. 3. Remove any loose metal particles from the damaged
or stripped weld nut with a stiff brush. 4. Select a M7 conductive self-threading bolt. Refer to the
Parts Information section of this bulletin 5. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N
12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M7 conductive self-threading
bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
6. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 7. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M7 conductive self-threading bolt.
8. Install the M7 conductive self-threading bolt and:
Tighten Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb in).
9. Verify proper system operation.
M6 Weld Nut Alternative Repair
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6 conductive bolt
and a M6 conductive nut may be used to secure
the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M6 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind
the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance
surrounding the new electrical ground site.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the ground location and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 8.5 mm (0.33 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the
area surrounding the 8.5 mm (0.33 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M6 conductive
bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M6 conductive bolt to the ground
location.
10. Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the
M6 conductive nut to the bolt and:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information
For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5455
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free
electrical ground.
12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation.
M8 Weld Nut
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M8
conductive bolt and a M8 conductive nut may be
used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this
bulletin.
2. Select a location adjacent the M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind the panel
surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance surrounding
the new electrical ground site.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the ground location and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the
area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M8 conductive
bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M8 conductive bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M8 conductive bolt to the ground
location.
10. Select a M8 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the
M8 conductive nut to the bolt and:
Tighten Tighten to 22 Nm (16 lb ft).
Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free
electrical ground.
12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation.
M8 Weld Nut Alternative Repair
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is not accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6
conductive rivet stud and a M6 conductive nut
may be used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal.
2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind
the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance
surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site
and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information
For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5456
5. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) until bare metal is
visible.
Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of
0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any
air gaps to ensure a good ground.
6. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit.
7. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool
(2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet
stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3).
8. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive
rivet stud. 9. Ensure the new rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement.
10. Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information
For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5457
Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the
installation of the electrical ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable
and corrosion-free electrical ground.
11. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 12. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective
material applied to the rivet stud threads. 13. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet
stud threads. 14. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet
stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 15. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet
stud.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
16. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 17. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M6 conductive rivet stud. 18.
Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 19. Install the M6
conductive nut to the rivet stud and:
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in)
20. Verify proper system operation.
Parts Information
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information
For Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5458
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 06-08-45-004 > May > 06 > Electrical - Instrument
Panel & General Wiring Repair
Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Instrument Panel & General Wiring
Repair
Bulletin No.: 06-08-45-004
Date: May 02, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Instrument Panel (I/P), Body and General Wiring Harness Repair
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Trucks 2003-2007 HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3
Important:
A part restriction has been implemented on all Body and I/P harnesses and is being administered
by the PQC. If a body or I/P harness replacement is required, it can take 12-28 weeks for a
harness to be built and delivered to a dealer. The dealer technician is expected to repair any
harness damage as the first and best choice before replacing a harness.
In an effort to standardize repair practices, General Motors is requiring that all wiring harnesses be
repaired instead of replaced. If there is a question concerning which connector and/or terminal you
are working on, refer to the information in the appropriate Connector End Views in SI. The
Instruction Manual J 38125-620, which is sent with each new update of the J 38125 Terminal
Repair Kit, also has terminal crimping and terminal remove information.
Important:
There are some parts in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit (i.e. SIR connector CPAs and heat shrink
tube (used in high heat area pigtail replacement) and some TPAs that are not available from
GMSPO. It is vitally important that each update to the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit be done as soon
as it arrives at the dealer.
Utilize the Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125) to achieve an effective wiring repair. The Terminal Repair
Kit has been an essential tool for all GM Dealers since 1987. Replacement terminals and tools for
this kit are available through SPX/Kent Moore. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 06-08-45-001
for more information.
The Instruction Manual J 38125-620, which is sent with each new update to the J 38125 Terminal
Repair Kit, also has terminal crimping and terminal removal information.
U.S. Dealers Only - Training courses (including Tech Assists, Emerging Issues, Web, IDL and
Hands-on) are available through the GM Training website. Refer to Resources and then Training
Materials for a complete list of available courses.
Canadian Dealers Only - Refer to the Training section of GM infoNet for a complete list of available
courses and a copy of the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit Instruction Manual.
Wiring repair information is also available in Service Information (SI). The Wiring Repair section
contains information for the following types of wiring repairs:
- Testing for intermittent conditions and poor conditions
- Flat wire repairs
- GMLAN wiring repairs
- High temperature wiring repairs
- Splicing copper wire using splice clips
- Splicing copper wire using splice sleeves
- Splicing twisted or shielded cable
- Splicing inline harness diodes
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 06-08-45-004 > May > 06 > Electrical - Instrument
Panel & General Wiring Repair > Page 5463
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information For
Electrical Ground Repair
Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Information For Electrical Ground Repair
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 10-08-45-001B
Date: October 25, 2010
Subject: Information for Electrical Ground Repair - Use New Replacement Fasteners with
Conductive Finish
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year and update the Warranty
Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 10-08-45-001A (Section 08 - Body and
Accessories).
Electrical Ground Repair Overview
Proper electrical system function relies on secure, stable and corrosion-free electrical ground
connections. Loose, stripped, or corroded connections increase the possibility of improper system
function and loss of module communication. These conditions may also lead to unnecessary
repairs and component replacement.
In general, electrical ground connections are accomplished using one, or a combination of the
following attachment methods:
- Welded M6 stud and nut
- Welded M6 nut and bolt
- Welded M8 nut and bolt
Determine which attachment method is used and perform the appropriate or alternative repair as
described in this bulletin.
M6 Weld Stud Replacement
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. Select a location adjacent the damaged or missing M6 ground stud having 20 mm (0.79 in)
clearance behind the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in)
clearance surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange.
2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site
and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
3. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel.
4. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is
visible.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information For
Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5469
Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of
0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any
air gaps to ensure a good ground.
5. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit.
6. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool
(2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet
stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3).
7. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive
rivet stud. 8. Ensure the rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement. 9.
Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent.
Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the
installation of the ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable and
corrosion-free electrical ground.
10. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 11. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective
material applied to the rivet stud threads. 12. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet
stud threads. 13. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet
stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 14. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet
stud.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information For
Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5470
15. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 16. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the rivet stud. 17. Select a M6
conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 18. Install the M6 conductive
nut to the rivet stud and:
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
19. Verify proper system operation.
M6 Weld Nut
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M6 weld nut at the electrical ground location is damaged or stripped, a M7 conductive
self-threading bolt may be used to secure the ground
wire terminal.
2. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the weld nut and allow to dry. 3. Remove any loose metal particles from the damaged
or stripped weld nut with a stiff brush. 4. Select a M7 conductive self-threading bolt. Refer to the
Parts Information section of this bulletin 5. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric Lubricant GM P/N
12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M7 conductive self-threading
bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
6. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 7. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M7 conductive self-threading bolt.
8. Install the M7 conductive self-threading bolt and:
Tighten Tighten to 9 Nm (80 lb in).
9. Verify proper system operation.
M6 Weld Nut Alternative Repair
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6 conductive bolt
and a M6 conductive nut may be used to secure
the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M6 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind
the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance
surrounding the new electrical ground site.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the ground location and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 8.5 mm (0.33 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the
area surrounding the 8.5 mm (0.33 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M6 conductive
bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M6 conductive bolt to the ground
location.
10. Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the
M6 conductive nut to the bolt and:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information For
Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5471
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in).
Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free
electrical ground.
12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation.
M8 Weld Nut
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is accessible from both sides of the panel, a M8
conductive bolt and a M8 conductive nut may be
used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal. Refer to the Parts Information section of this
bulletin.
2. Select a location adjacent the M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind the panel
surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance surrounding
the new electrical ground site.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the surface
surrounding the ground location and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel. 5. Remove paint and primer from the
area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole until bare metal is visible. 6. Select a M8 conductive
bolt. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 7. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M8 conductive bolt.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
8. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 9. Install the electrical ground wire terminal and the M8 conductive bolt to the ground
location.
10. Select a M8 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 11. Install the
M8 conductive nut to the bolt and:
Tighten Tighten to 22 Nm (16 lb ft).
Note The repair area MUST BE properly refinished to maintain a secure, stable and corrosion-free
electrical ground.
12. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 13. Verify proper system operation.
M8 Weld Nut Alternative Repair
Caution
Use only the GM-approved replacement fasteners with conductive finish for electrical ground
repair.
1. If the M8 weld nut electrical ground location is not accessible from both sides of the panel, a M6
conductive rivet stud and a M6 conductive nut
may be used to secure the electrical ground wire terminal.
2. Select a location adjacent the damaged M8 weld nut having 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance behind
the panel surface and 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance
surrounding the M6 conductive rivet stud flange.
3. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, remove any grease from the repair site
and allow to dry.
Note Ensure 20 mm (0.79 in) clearance is maintained behind the panel to be drilled.
4. Drill a 10 mm (0.40 in) diameter hole through the panel.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information For
Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5472
5. Remove paint and primer from the area surrounding the 10 mm (0.40 in) until bare metal is
visible.
Important The M6 conductive rivet stud as shown, can accommodate a panel thickness range of
0.7-4.2 mm (0.03-0.17 in). If there are layers of sheet metal, they should be touching without any
air gaps to ensure a good ground.
6. Select a M6 conductive rivet stud. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin.
Note Use the GE-50317 rivet stud tool kit.
7. Place the M6 conductive rivet stud (1) in the 10 mm (0.40 in) hole. Assemble the rivet stud tool
(2) with the groove and flare side facing the rivet
stud, then the washer and the M6 nut (3).
8. Using a wrench on the rivet stud tool, and a socket on the M6 nut, secure the M6 conductive
rivet stud. 9. Ensure the new rivet stud is securely fastened, WITHOUT ANY detectable movement.
10. Completely wrap the threads of the rivet stud with painters tape or equivalent.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information For
Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5473
Note The rivet stud and surrounding panel area MUST BE properly refinished PRIOR to the
installation of the electrical ground wire terminal and conductive nut to maintain a secure, stable
and corrosion-free electrical ground.
11. Refinish the repair area using an anti-corrosion primer. Refer to Anti-Corrosion Treatment and
Repair in SI. 12. Allow the refinished repair area to cure sufficiently before removing the protective
material applied to the rivet stud threads. 13. Remove the painters tape or equivalent from the rivet
stud threads. 14. Using GM approved residue-free solvent or equivalent, thoroughly clean the rivet
stud threads to remove any adhesive and allow to dry. 15. Using a small brush, apply Dielectric
Lubricant GM P/N 12377900 (Canadian P/N 10953529) to the threads of the M6 conductive rivet
stud.
Note Fretting corrosion is a build-up of insulating, oxidized wear debris that can form when there is
a small motion between electrical contacts. The oxidized wear debris can accumulate at the
electrical contact points causing the electrical resistance across the connection to increase.
16. Carefully remove ANY corrosion or contamination that may be present on the electrical ground
wire terminal. 17. Install the electrical ground wire terminal to the M6 conductive rivet stud. 18.
Select a M6 conductive nut. Refer to the Parts Information section of this bulletin. 19. Install the M6
conductive nut to the rivet stud and:
Tighten Tighten to 8 Nm (71 lb in)
20. Verify proper system operation.
Parts Information
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 10-08-45-001B > Oct > 10 > Electrical - Information For
Electrical Ground Repair > Page 5474
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 06-08-45-004 > May > 06 > Electrical - Instrument Panel
& General Wiring Repair
Wiring Harness: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - Instrument Panel & General Wiring
Repair
Bulletin No.: 06-08-45-004
Date: May 02, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Instrument Panel (I/P), Body and General Wiring Harness Repair
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Cars and Trucks 2003-2007 HUMMER H2 2006-2007 HUMMER H3
Important:
A part restriction has been implemented on all Body and I/P harnesses and is being administered
by the PQC. If a body or I/P harness replacement is required, it can take 12-28 weeks for a
harness to be built and delivered to a dealer. The dealer technician is expected to repair any
harness damage as the first and best choice before replacing a harness.
In an effort to standardize repair practices, General Motors is requiring that all wiring harnesses be
repaired instead of replaced. If there is a question concerning which connector and/or terminal you
are working on, refer to the information in the appropriate Connector End Views in SI. The
Instruction Manual J 38125-620, which is sent with each new update of the J 38125 Terminal
Repair Kit, also has terminal crimping and terminal remove information.
Important:
There are some parts in the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit (i.e. SIR connector CPAs and heat shrink
tube (used in high heat area pigtail replacement) and some TPAs that are not available from
GMSPO. It is vitally important that each update to the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit be done as soon
as it arrives at the dealer.
Utilize the Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125) to achieve an effective wiring repair. The Terminal Repair
Kit has been an essential tool for all GM Dealers since 1987. Replacement terminals and tools for
this kit are available through SPX/Kent Moore. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 06-08-45-001
for more information.
The Instruction Manual J 38125-620, which is sent with each new update to the J 38125 Terminal
Repair Kit, also has terminal crimping and terminal removal information.
U.S. Dealers Only - Training courses (including Tech Assists, Emerging Issues, Web, IDL and
Hands-on) are available through the GM Training website. Refer to Resources and then Training
Materials for a complete list of available courses.
Canadian Dealers Only - Refer to the Training section of GM infoNet for a complete list of available
courses and a copy of the J 38125 Terminal Repair Kit Instruction Manual.
Wiring repair information is also available in Service Information (SI). The Wiring Repair section
contains information for the following types of wiring repairs:
- Testing for intermittent conditions and poor conditions
- Flat wire repairs
- GMLAN wiring repairs
- High temperature wiring repairs
- Splicing copper wire using splice clips
- Splicing copper wire using splice sleeves
- Splicing twisted or shielded cable
- Splicing inline harness diodes
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Power and Ground Distribution > Wiring Harness > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wiring Harness: > 06-08-45-004 > May > 06 > Electrical - Instrument Panel
& General Wiring Repair > Page 5479
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 333213 > Nov > 93 > Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull
Alignment: Customer Interest Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull
Group Ref.: Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 333213
Date: November, 1993
SUBJECT: VEHICLE MAY LEAD OR PULL (DIAGNOSE/SERVICE PROCEDURE)
MODELS: 1992-94 BUICK SKYLARK 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND
BERETTA 1992-94 OLDSMOBILE ACHIEVA 1992-94 PONTIAC SUNBIRD AND GRAND AM
CONDITION: Some owners may experience that the vehicle may lead or pull.
CORRECTION: DO NOT replace the steering gear to fix a lead or pull on 1993-94 vehicles as this
will not solve the problem. It may temporarily mask the problem due to the higher internal friction in
the new gear. However, the condition will resurface when the gear is worn in with mileage.
On 1992-94 vehicles, the following procedure should be followed for lead and pull conditions:
- Consult J/L/N lead/pull Corporate Bulletin # 073002. Previous divisional publication numbers
were:
Chevrolet 92-5O-3B
Pontiac 92-3-3
Oldsmobile 92-T-20
GM of Canada 92-3-110
- Consult J/L/N memory steer Corporate Bulletin # 233303R. Previous divisional publication
numbers were:
Chevrolet 93-171-3B
Buick 93-3-8
Pontiac 93-3-10
Oldsmobile 93-T-60
GM of Canada 93-3C-102
If the problem still exists, check system flows and pressures using gauge J 5176-D or J 25323-B.
System flow should be 1.9 gpm - 2.3 gpm, back pressure at or less than 100 psi with wheels
straight ahead and the engine at idle. If flows or pressures are out of specification, look for pinched
or crimped steering hoses and check for blockages by blowing air through the steering lines.
If problem still exists for 1992 V-6 vehicles only, evaluate vehicle for steering system induced
lead/pull by coasting with vehicle in neutral and engine off. Restart the vehicle. A steering induced
lead/pull will result in a significant, abrupt pull to the right. If this occurs, remove power steering
cooler lines from the steering system, (refer to Section 3B in the Service Manual). Use the following
hoses to connect directly from the steering gear to the pump reservoir inlet tube.
1. LHO engine (VIN T): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26038210
2. LG7 engine (VIN N): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26031205
If problem still persists on 1992 vehicles only, steering gear replacement can be attempted.
1993-94 vehicles have updated steering racks and should not require replacement for lead/pull
conditions. Also on 1993-94 vehicles, there are no cooler lines; therefore, the above by-pass hoses
do not apply. This is the latest information which should resolve any lead/pull conditions.
Parts are expected to be available on November 8, 1993.
WARRANTY INFORMATION: For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Number: T3385
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 333213 > Nov > 93 > Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull > Page 5489
Labor Time: 0.6 hr.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
Bulletin No.: 05-03-07-009C
Date: December 09, 2010
Subject: Wheel Alignment Specifications, Requirements and Recommendations for GM Vehicles
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being extensively revised to provide technicians and warranty
administrators with an all inclusive guide for wheel alignments. PLEASE FAMILIARIZE YOURSELF
WITH THESE UPDATES BEFORE PERFORMING YOUR NEXT GM WHEEL ALIGNMENT
SERVICE. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-07-009B (Section 03 - Suspension).
Purpose
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide retail, wholesale and fleet personnel with General Motors'
warranty service requirements and recommendations for customer concerns related to wheel
alignment. For your convenience, this bulletin updates and centralizes all of GM's Standard Wheel
Alignment Service Procedures, Policy Guidelines and bulletins on wheel alignment warranty
service.
Important PLEASE FAMILIARIZE YOURSELF WITH THESE UPDATES BEFORE PERFORMING
YOUR NEXT GM WHEEL ALIGNMENT SERVICE.
The following five (5) key steps are a summary of this bulletin and are REQUIRED in completing a
successful wheel alignment service.
1. Verify the vehicle is in an Original Equipment condition for curb weight, tires, wheels, suspension
and steering configurations. Vehicles
modified in any of these areas are not covered for wheel alignment warranty.
2. Review the customer concern relative to "Normal Operation" definitions. 3. Verify that vehicle is
within the "Mileage Policy" range. 4. Document wheel alignment warranty claims appropriately for
labor operations E2000 and E2020.
The following information must be documented or attached to the repair order:
- Customer concern in detail
- What corrected the customer concern?
- If a wheel alignment is performed:
- Consult SI for proper specifications.
- Document the "Before" AND "After" wheel alignment measurements/settings.
- Completed "Wheel Alignment Repair Order Questionnaire" (form attached to this bulletin)
5. Use the proper wheel alignment equipment (preferred with print-out capability), process and the
appropriate calibration maintenance schedules.
Important If it is determined that a wheel alignment is necessary under warranty, use the proper
labor code for the repair. E2000 for Steering Wheel Angle and/or Front Toe set or E2020 for Wheel
Alignment Check/Adjust includes Caster, Camber and Toe set (Wheel alignment labor time for
other component repairs is to be charged to the component that causes a wheel alignment
operation.).
The following flowchart is to help summarize the information detailed in this bulletin and should be
used whenever a wheel alignment is performed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 5495
Verify Original Equipment Condition of the Vehicle
- Verify that Original Equipment Tires and Wheels or Official GM Accessory Tires and Wheels are
on the vehicle.
- Verify that aftermarket suspension "Lift" or "Lowering" Kits or other suspension alterations have
NOT been done to the vehicle.
- Check for accidental damage to the vehicle; for example, severe pothole or curb impacts, collision
damage that may have affected the wheel alignment of the vehicle; e.g., engine cradles,
suspension control arms, axles, wheels, wheel covers, tires may show evidence of damage/impact.
- Check to be sure vehicle has seen "Normal Use" rather than abuse; e.g., very aggressive driving
may show up by looking at the tires and condition of the vehicle.
- Check for other additional equipment items that may significantly affect vehicle mass such as
large tool boxes, campers, snow plow packages (without the snowplow RPO), etc., especially in
trucks and cutaway/incomplete vehicles. Significant additional mass can affect trim height and
wheel alignment of the vehicle and may necessitate a customer pay wheel alignment when placed
semi-permanently in the vehicle (Upfitter instructions are to realign the vehicle after placement of
these types of items. (This typically applies to trucks and incomplete vehicles that can be upfit with
equipment such as the above.)
Customer Concerns, "Normal Operation" Conditions and "Mileage Policy"
Possible Concerns
The following are typical conditions that may require wheel alignment warranty service:
1. Lead/Pull: defined as "at a constant highway speed on a typical straight road, the amount of
effort required at the steering wheel to maintain the
vehicle's straight heading."
Important Please evaluate for the condition with hands-on the steering wheel. Follow the "Vehicle
Leads/Pulls" diagnostic tree located in SI to determine the cause of a lead/pull concern. Lead/Pull
concerns can be due to road crown or road slope, tires, wheel alignment or even in rare
circumstances a steering gear issue. Lead/pull concerns due to road crown are considered
"Normal Operation" and are NOT a warrantable condition -- the customer should be advised that
this is "Normal Operation."
Important Some customers may comment on a "Lead/Pull" when they hold the steering wheel in a
level condition. If so, this is more likely a "steering wheel angle" concern because the customer is
"steering" the vehicle to obtain a "level" steering wheel.
2. Steering wheel angle to the left or right (counter-clockwise or clockwise, respectively): Defined
as the steering wheel angle (clocking)
deviation from "level" while maintaining a straight heading on a typical straight road.
3. Irregular or Premature tire wear: Slight to very slight "feathering" or "edge" wear on the
shoulders of tires is NOT considered unusual and
should even out with a tire rotation; if the customer is concerned about a "feathering" condition of
the tires, the customer could be advised to rotate the tires earlier than the next scheduled
mileage/maintenance interval (but no later than the next interval). Be sure to understand the
customer's driving habits as this will also heavily influence the tire wear performance; tire wear from
aggressive or abusive driving habits is NOT a warrantable condition.
Important Slight or mild feathering, cupping, edge or heel/toe wear of tire tread shoulders is
"normal" and can show up very early in a tire/vehicle service mileage; in fact, some new tires can
show evidence of feathering from the factory. These issues do NOT affect the overall performance
and tread life of the tire. Dealer personnel should always check the customer's maintenance
records to ensure that tire inflation pressure is being maintained to placard and that the tires are
being rotated (modified-X pattern) at the proper mileage intervals. Wheel alignments are NOT to be
performed for the types of "Normal" Tire Feathering shown in Figures 1-4 below.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 5496
Figure 1: Full Tread View - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear on the Shoulder/Adjacent/Center
Ribs
Figure 2: Tire Shoulder View Example 1 - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear on the Shoulder
Figure 3: Tire Shoulder View Example 2 - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear
Figure 4: Detail Side View of Tire Shoulder Area - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear
Important When a wheel alignment is deemed necessary for tire wear, be sure to document on the
repair order, in as much detail as possible, the severity and type of tire wear (e.g., severe center
wear or severe inside or outside shoulder wear) and the position of the tire on the vehicle (RF, LF,
LR, RR). Please note the customer's concern with the wear such as, noise, appearance, wear life,
etc. A field product report with pictures of the tire wear condition is recommended. Refer to
Corporate Bulletin Number 02-00-89-002J and #07-00-89-036C.
4. Other repairs that affect wheel alignment; e.g., certain component replacement such as
suspension control arm replacement, engine cradle
adjustment/replace, steering gear replacement, steering tie rod replace, suspension strut/shock,
steering knuckle, etc. may require a wheel alignment.
Important If other components or repairs are identified as affecting the wheel alignment, policy calls
for the wheel alignment labor time to be charged to the replaced/repaired component's labor
operation time rather than the wheel alignment labor operations.
Important Vibration type customer concerns are generally NOT due to wheel alignment except in
the rare cases; e.g., extreme diagonal wear across the tread. In general, wheel alignments are
NOT to be performed as an investigation/correction for vibration concerns.
"Normal Operation" Conditions
Vehicle Lead/Pull Due to Road Crown or Slope:
As part of "Normal Operation," vehicles will follow side-to-side or left to right road crown or slope.
Be sure to verify from the customer the types of roads they are driving as they may not recognize
the influence of road crown on vehicle lead/pull and steering wheel angle. If a vehicle requires
significant steering effort to prevent it from "climbing" the road crown there may be an issue to be
looked into further.
Important
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 5497
A wheel alignment will generally NOT correct vehicles that follow the road crown since this is within
"Normal Operation."
Mileage Policy
The following mileage policy applies for E2020 and E2000 labor operations: Note
Wheel Alignment is NOT covered under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty for Express and Savana
Cutaway vehicles as these vehicles require Upfitters to set the wheel alignment after completing
the vehicles.
- 0-800 km (0-500 mi): E2000/E2020 claims ONLY allowed with Call Center Authorization. Due to
the tie down during shipping, the vehicle's suspension requires some time to reach normal
operating position. For this reason, new vehicles are generally NOT to be aligned until they have
accumulated at least 800 km (500 mi). A field product report should accompany any claim within
this mileage range.
- 801-12,000 km (501-7,500 mi):
- If a vehicle came from the factory with incorrect alignment settings, any resulting off-angle
steering wheel, lead/pull characteristics or the rare occurrence of excessive tire wear would be
apparent early in the life of the vehicle. The following policy applies:
- Vehicles 100% Factory Set/Measured for Caster/Camber/Toe - Escalade/ESV/EXT,
Tahoe/Suburban, Yukon/XL/Denali, Silverado/Sierra, Express/Savana, Corvette and
Colorado/Canyon: E2000/E2020 Claims: Call Center Authorization Required
- All Vehicles NOT 100% Factory Set/Measured for Caster/Camber/Toe as noted above:
E2000/E2020 Claims: Dealer Service Manager Authorization Required
- 12,001 km and beyond (7,501 miles and beyond): During this period, customers are responsible
for the wheel alignment expense or dealers may provide on a case-by case basis a one-time
customer enthusiasm claim up to 16,000 km (10,000 mi). In the event that a defective component
required the use of the subject labor operations, the identified defective component labor operation
will include the appropriate labor time for a wheel alignment as an add condition to the component
repair.
Important Only one wheel alignment labor operation claim (E2000 or E2020) may be used per VIN.
Warranty Documentation Requirements
When a wheel alignment service has been deemed necessary, the following items will need to be
clearly documented on/with the repair order:
- Customer concern in detail
- What corrected the customer concern?
- If a wheel alignment is performed:
- Consult SI for proper specifications.
- Document the "Before" AND "After" wheel alignment measurements/settings.
- Completed "Wheel Alignment Repair Order Questionnaire" (form attached to this bulletin)
1. Document the customer concern in as much detail as possible on the repair order and in the
warranty administration system. Preferred examples:
- Steering wheel is off angle in the counterclockwise direction by approximately x degrees or
clocking position.
- Vehicle lead/pulls to the right at approximately x-y mph. Vehicle will climb the road crown. Severe,
Moderate or Slight.
- RF and LF tires are wearing on the outside shoulders with severe feathering.
Important In the event of a lead/pull or steering wheel angle concern, please note the direction of
lead/pull (left or right) or direction of steering wheel angle (clockwise or counterclockwise) on the
repair order and within the warranty claim verbatim.
Important In the event of a tire wear concern, please note the position on the vehicle and where the
wear is occurring on the tire; i.e., the RF tire is wearing on the inside shoulder.
2. Document the technician's findings on cause and correction of the issue. Examples:
- Reset LF toe from 0.45 degrees to 0.10 degrees and RF toe from -0.25 degrees to 0.10 degrees
to correct the steering wheel angle from 5 degrees counterclockwise to 0 degrees.
- Reset LF camber from 0.25 degrees to -0.05 degrees to correct the cross-camber condition of
+0.30 degrees to 0.00 degrees on the vehicle.
- Front Sum toe was found to be 0.50 degrees, reset to 0.20 degrees.
3. Print-out the "Before" and "After" wheel alignment measurements/settings and attach them to the
Repair Order or if print-out capability is not
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 5498
available, measurements may also be clearly and legibly handwritten into the Wheel Alignment
Repair Order Questionnaire attached to this bulletin.
4. Attach the Wheel Alignment Repair Order Questionnaire below along with the print-out of
"Before" and "After" wheel alignment measurements to
the Repair Order and retain for use by GM.
Wheel Alignment Equipment and Process
Wheel alignments must be performed with a quality machine that will give accurate results when
performing checks. "External Reference" (image-based camera technology) is preferred. Please
refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 05-00-89-029B: General Motors Dealership Critical Equipment
Requirements and Recommendations.
Requirements:
- Computerized four wheel alignment system.
- Computer capable of printing before and after alignment reports.
- Computer capable of time and date stamp printout.
- Racking system must have jacking capability
- Racking system must be capable of level to 1.6 mm (1/16 in)
- Appropriate wheel stops and safety certification
- Built-in turn plates and slip plates
- Wheel clamps capable of attaching to 20" or larger wheels
- Racking capable of accepting any GM passenger car or light duty truck
- Operator properly trained and ASE-certified (U.S. only) in wheel alignment
Recommendations:
Racking should have front and rear jacking capability.
Equipment Maintenance and Calibration:
Alignment machines must be regularly calibrated in order to give correct information. Most
manufacturers recommend the following:
- Alignment machines with "internal reference" sensors should be checked (and calibrated, if
necessary) every six months.
- Alignment machines with "external reference" (image-based camera technology) should be
checked (and calibrated, if necessary) once a year.
- Racks must be kept level to within 1.6 mm (1/16 in).
- If any instrument that is part of the alignment machine is dropped or damaged in some way,
check the calibration immediately.
Check with the manufacturer of your specific equipment for their recommended service/calibration
schedule.
Wheel Alignment Process
When performing wheel alignment measurement and/or adjustment, the following steps should be
taken:
Preliminary Steps:
1. Verify that the vehicle has a full tank of fuel (compensate as necessary). 2. Inspect the wheels
and the tires for damage. 3. Inspect the tires for the proper inflation and irregular tire wear. 4.
Inspect the wheel bearings for excessive play. 5. Inspect all suspension and steering parts for
looseness, wear, or damage. 6. Inspect the steering wheel for excessive drag or poor return due to
stiff or rusted linkage or suspension components. 7. Inspect the vehicle trim height. 8. Compensate
for frame angle on targeted vehicles (refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications in SI).
Satisfactory vehicle operation may occur over a wide range of alignment angles. However, if the
wheel alignment angles are not within the range of specifications, adjust the wheel alignment to the
specifications. Refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications in SI. Give consideration to excess loads,
such as tool boxes, sample cases, etc. Follow the wheel alignment equipment manufacturer's
instructions.
Measure/Adjust:
Important Prior to making any adjustments to wheel alignment on a vehicle, technicians must verify
that the wheel alignment specifications loaded into their wheel alignment machine are up-to-date
by comparing these to the wheel alignment specifications for the appropriate model and model year
in SI. Using incorrect and/or outdated specifications may result in unnecessary adjustments,
irregular and/or premature tire wear and repeat customer concerns
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 5499
Important When performing adjustments to vehicles requiring a 4-wheel alignment, set the rear
wheel alignment angles first in order to obtain proper front wheel alignment angles.
Perform the following steps in order to measure the front and rear alignment angles:
1. Install the alignment equipment according to the manufacturer's instructions. 2. Jounce the front
and the rear bumpers 3 times prior to checking the wheel alignment. 3. Measure the alignment
angles and record the readings.
If necessary, adjust the wheel alignment to vehicle specification and record the before and after
measurements. Refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications in SI.
Important Technicians must refer to SI for the correct wheel alignment specifications. SI is the only
source of GM wheel alignment specifications that is kept up-to-date throughout the year.
Test drive vehicle to ensure proper repair.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 5500
Frame Angle Measurement (Express / Savana Only) ........
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 5501
What corrected the customer concern and was the repair verified?
Please Explain: .............
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 333213 > Nov > 93 > Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull
Group Ref.: Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 333213
Date: November, 1993
SUBJECT: VEHICLE MAY LEAD OR PULL (DIAGNOSE/SERVICE PROCEDURE)
MODELS: 1992-94 BUICK SKYLARK 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND
BERETTA 1992-94 OLDSMOBILE ACHIEVA 1992-94 PONTIAC SUNBIRD AND GRAND AM
CONDITION: Some owners may experience that the vehicle may lead or pull.
CORRECTION: DO NOT replace the steering gear to fix a lead or pull on 1993-94 vehicles as this
will not solve the problem. It may temporarily mask the problem due to the higher internal friction in
the new gear. However, the condition will resurface when the gear is worn in with mileage.
On 1992-94 vehicles, the following procedure should be followed for lead and pull conditions:
- Consult J/L/N lead/pull Corporate Bulletin # 073002. Previous divisional publication numbers
were:
Chevrolet 92-5O-3B
Pontiac 92-3-3
Oldsmobile 92-T-20
GM of Canada 92-3-110
- Consult J/L/N memory steer Corporate Bulletin # 233303R. Previous divisional publication
numbers were:
Chevrolet 93-171-3B
Buick 93-3-8
Pontiac 93-3-10
Oldsmobile 93-T-60
GM of Canada 93-3C-102
If the problem still exists, check system flows and pressures using gauge J 5176-D or J 25323-B.
System flow should be 1.9 gpm - 2.3 gpm, back pressure at or less than 100 psi with wheels
straight ahead and the engine at idle. If flows or pressures are out of specification, look for pinched
or crimped steering hoses and check for blockages by blowing air through the steering lines.
If problem still exists for 1992 V-6 vehicles only, evaluate vehicle for steering system induced
lead/pull by coasting with vehicle in neutral and engine off. Restart the vehicle. A steering induced
lead/pull will result in a significant, abrupt pull to the right. If this occurs, remove power steering
cooler lines from the steering system, (refer to Section 3B in the Service Manual). Use the following
hoses to connect directly from the steering gear to the pump reservoir inlet tube.
1. LHO engine (VIN T): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26038210
2. LG7 engine (VIN N): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26031205
If problem still persists on 1992 vehicles only, steering gear replacement can be attempted.
1993-94 vehicles have updated steering racks and should not require replacement for lead/pull
conditions. Also on 1993-94 vehicles, there are no cooler lines; therefore, the above by-pass hoses
do not apply. This is the latest information which should resolve any lead/pull conditions.
Parts are expected to be available on November 8, 1993.
WARRANTY INFORMATION: For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Number: T3385
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 333213 > Nov > 93 > Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull > Page 5506
Labor Time: 0.6 hr.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications
Alignment: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment Specifications
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
Bulletin No.: 05-03-07-009C
Date: December 09, 2010
Subject: Wheel Alignment Specifications, Requirements and Recommendations for GM Vehicles
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being extensively revised to provide technicians and warranty
administrators with an all inclusive guide for wheel alignments. PLEASE FAMILIARIZE YOURSELF
WITH THESE UPDATES BEFORE PERFORMING YOUR NEXT GM WHEEL ALIGNMENT
SERVICE. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-07-009B (Section 03 - Suspension).
Purpose
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide retail, wholesale and fleet personnel with General Motors'
warranty service requirements and recommendations for customer concerns related to wheel
alignment. For your convenience, this bulletin updates and centralizes all of GM's Standard Wheel
Alignment Service Procedures, Policy Guidelines and bulletins on wheel alignment warranty
service.
Important PLEASE FAMILIARIZE YOURSELF WITH THESE UPDATES BEFORE PERFORMING
YOUR NEXT GM WHEEL ALIGNMENT SERVICE.
The following five (5) key steps are a summary of this bulletin and are REQUIRED in completing a
successful wheel alignment service.
1. Verify the vehicle is in an Original Equipment condition for curb weight, tires, wheels, suspension
and steering configurations. Vehicles
modified in any of these areas are not covered for wheel alignment warranty.
2. Review the customer concern relative to "Normal Operation" definitions. 3. Verify that vehicle is
within the "Mileage Policy" range. 4. Document wheel alignment warranty claims appropriately for
labor operations E2000 and E2020.
The following information must be documented or attached to the repair order:
- Customer concern in detail
- What corrected the customer concern?
- If a wheel alignment is performed:
- Consult SI for proper specifications.
- Document the "Before" AND "After" wheel alignment measurements/settings.
- Completed "Wheel Alignment Repair Order Questionnaire" (form attached to this bulletin)
5. Use the proper wheel alignment equipment (preferred with print-out capability), process and the
appropriate calibration maintenance schedules.
Important If it is determined that a wheel alignment is necessary under warranty, use the proper
labor code for the repair. E2000 for Steering Wheel Angle and/or Front Toe set or E2020 for Wheel
Alignment Check/Adjust includes Caster, Camber and Toe set (Wheel alignment labor time for
other component repairs is to be charged to the component that causes a wheel alignment
operation.).
The following flowchart is to help summarize the information detailed in this bulletin and should be
used whenever a wheel alignment is performed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 5512
Verify Original Equipment Condition of the Vehicle
- Verify that Original Equipment Tires and Wheels or Official GM Accessory Tires and Wheels are
on the vehicle.
- Verify that aftermarket suspension "Lift" or "Lowering" Kits or other suspension alterations have
NOT been done to the vehicle.
- Check for accidental damage to the vehicle; for example, severe pothole or curb impacts, collision
damage that may have affected the wheel alignment of the vehicle; e.g., engine cradles,
suspension control arms, axles, wheels, wheel covers, tires may show evidence of damage/impact.
- Check to be sure vehicle has seen "Normal Use" rather than abuse; e.g., very aggressive driving
may show up by looking at the tires and condition of the vehicle.
- Check for other additional equipment items that may significantly affect vehicle mass such as
large tool boxes, campers, snow plow packages (without the snowplow RPO), etc., especially in
trucks and cutaway/incomplete vehicles. Significant additional mass can affect trim height and
wheel alignment of the vehicle and may necessitate a customer pay wheel alignment when placed
semi-permanently in the vehicle (Upfitter instructions are to realign the vehicle after placement of
these types of items. (This typically applies to trucks and incomplete vehicles that can be upfit with
equipment such as the above.)
Customer Concerns, "Normal Operation" Conditions and "Mileage Policy"
Possible Concerns
The following are typical conditions that may require wheel alignment warranty service:
1. Lead/Pull: defined as "at a constant highway speed on a typical straight road, the amount of
effort required at the steering wheel to maintain the
vehicle's straight heading."
Important Please evaluate for the condition with hands-on the steering wheel. Follow the "Vehicle
Leads/Pulls" diagnostic tree located in SI to determine the cause of a lead/pull concern. Lead/Pull
concerns can be due to road crown or road slope, tires, wheel alignment or even in rare
circumstances a steering gear issue. Lead/pull concerns due to road crown are considered
"Normal Operation" and are NOT a warrantable condition -- the customer should be advised that
this is "Normal Operation."
Important Some customers may comment on a "Lead/Pull" when they hold the steering wheel in a
level condition. If so, this is more likely a "steering wheel angle" concern because the customer is
"steering" the vehicle to obtain a "level" steering wheel.
2. Steering wheel angle to the left or right (counter-clockwise or clockwise, respectively): Defined
as the steering wheel angle (clocking)
deviation from "level" while maintaining a straight heading on a typical straight road.
3. Irregular or Premature tire wear: Slight to very slight "feathering" or "edge" wear on the
shoulders of tires is NOT considered unusual and
should even out with a tire rotation; if the customer is concerned about a "feathering" condition of
the tires, the customer could be advised to rotate the tires earlier than the next scheduled
mileage/maintenance interval (but no later than the next interval). Be sure to understand the
customer's driving habits as this will also heavily influence the tire wear performance; tire wear from
aggressive or abusive driving habits is NOT a warrantable condition.
Important Slight or mild feathering, cupping, edge or heel/toe wear of tire tread shoulders is
"normal" and can show up very early in a tire/vehicle service mileage; in fact, some new tires can
show evidence of feathering from the factory. These issues do NOT affect the overall performance
and tread life of the tire. Dealer personnel should always check the customer's maintenance
records to ensure that tire inflation pressure is being maintained to placard and that the tires are
being rotated (modified-X pattern) at the proper mileage intervals. Wheel alignments are NOT to be
performed for the types of "Normal" Tire Feathering shown in Figures 1-4 below.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 5513
Figure 1: Full Tread View - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear on the Shoulder/Adjacent/Center
Ribs
Figure 2: Tire Shoulder View Example 1 - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear on the Shoulder
Figure 3: Tire Shoulder View Example 2 - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear
Figure 4: Detail Side View of Tire Shoulder Area - "NORMAL" Tire "Feathering" Wear
Important When a wheel alignment is deemed necessary for tire wear, be sure to document on the
repair order, in as much detail as possible, the severity and type of tire wear (e.g., severe center
wear or severe inside or outside shoulder wear) and the position of the tire on the vehicle (RF, LF,
LR, RR). Please note the customer's concern with the wear such as, noise, appearance, wear life,
etc. A field product report with pictures of the tire wear condition is recommended. Refer to
Corporate Bulletin Number 02-00-89-002J and #07-00-89-036C.
4. Other repairs that affect wheel alignment; e.g., certain component replacement such as
suspension control arm replacement, engine cradle
adjustment/replace, steering gear replacement, steering tie rod replace, suspension strut/shock,
steering knuckle, etc. may require a wheel alignment.
Important If other components or repairs are identified as affecting the wheel alignment, policy calls
for the wheel alignment labor time to be charged to the replaced/repaired component's labor
operation time rather than the wheel alignment labor operations.
Important Vibration type customer concerns are generally NOT due to wheel alignment except in
the rare cases; e.g., extreme diagonal wear across the tread. In general, wheel alignments are
NOT to be performed as an investigation/correction for vibration concerns.
"Normal Operation" Conditions
Vehicle Lead/Pull Due to Road Crown or Slope:
As part of "Normal Operation," vehicles will follow side-to-side or left to right road crown or slope.
Be sure to verify from the customer the types of roads they are driving as they may not recognize
the influence of road crown on vehicle lead/pull and steering wheel angle. If a vehicle requires
significant steering effort to prevent it from "climbing" the road crown there may be an issue to be
looked into further.
Important
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 5514
A wheel alignment will generally NOT correct vehicles that follow the road crown since this is within
"Normal Operation."
Mileage Policy
The following mileage policy applies for E2020 and E2000 labor operations: Note
Wheel Alignment is NOT covered under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty for Express and Savana
Cutaway vehicles as these vehicles require Upfitters to set the wheel alignment after completing
the vehicles.
- 0-800 km (0-500 mi): E2000/E2020 claims ONLY allowed with Call Center Authorization. Due to
the tie down during shipping, the vehicle's suspension requires some time to reach normal
operating position. For this reason, new vehicles are generally NOT to be aligned until they have
accumulated at least 800 km (500 mi). A field product report should accompany any claim within
this mileage range.
- 801-12,000 km (501-7,500 mi):
- If a vehicle came from the factory with incorrect alignment settings, any resulting off-angle
steering wheel, lead/pull characteristics or the rare occurrence of excessive tire wear would be
apparent early in the life of the vehicle. The following policy applies:
- Vehicles 100% Factory Set/Measured for Caster/Camber/Toe - Escalade/ESV/EXT,
Tahoe/Suburban, Yukon/XL/Denali, Silverado/Sierra, Express/Savana, Corvette and
Colorado/Canyon: E2000/E2020 Claims: Call Center Authorization Required
- All Vehicles NOT 100% Factory Set/Measured for Caster/Camber/Toe as noted above:
E2000/E2020 Claims: Dealer Service Manager Authorization Required
- 12,001 km and beyond (7,501 miles and beyond): During this period, customers are responsible
for the wheel alignment expense or dealers may provide on a case-by case basis a one-time
customer enthusiasm claim up to 16,000 km (10,000 mi). In the event that a defective component
required the use of the subject labor operations, the identified defective component labor operation
will include the appropriate labor time for a wheel alignment as an add condition to the component
repair.
Important Only one wheel alignment labor operation claim (E2000 or E2020) may be used per VIN.
Warranty Documentation Requirements
When a wheel alignment service has been deemed necessary, the following items will need to be
clearly documented on/with the repair order:
- Customer concern in detail
- What corrected the customer concern?
- If a wheel alignment is performed:
- Consult SI for proper specifications.
- Document the "Before" AND "After" wheel alignment measurements/settings.
- Completed "Wheel Alignment Repair Order Questionnaire" (form attached to this bulletin)
1. Document the customer concern in as much detail as possible on the repair order and in the
warranty administration system. Preferred examples:
- Steering wheel is off angle in the counterclockwise direction by approximately x degrees or
clocking position.
- Vehicle lead/pulls to the right at approximately x-y mph. Vehicle will climb the road crown. Severe,
Moderate or Slight.
- RF and LF tires are wearing on the outside shoulders with severe feathering.
Important In the event of a lead/pull or steering wheel angle concern, please note the direction of
lead/pull (left or right) or direction of steering wheel angle (clockwise or counterclockwise) on the
repair order and within the warranty claim verbatim.
Important In the event of a tire wear concern, please note the position on the vehicle and where the
wear is occurring on the tire; i.e., the RF tire is wearing on the inside shoulder.
2. Document the technician's findings on cause and correction of the issue. Examples:
- Reset LF toe from 0.45 degrees to 0.10 degrees and RF toe from -0.25 degrees to 0.10 degrees
to correct the steering wheel angle from 5 degrees counterclockwise to 0 degrees.
- Reset LF camber from 0.25 degrees to -0.05 degrees to correct the cross-camber condition of
+0.30 degrees to 0.00 degrees on the vehicle.
- Front Sum toe was found to be 0.50 degrees, reset to 0.20 degrees.
3. Print-out the "Before" and "After" wheel alignment measurements/settings and attach them to the
Repair Order or if print-out capability is not
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 5515
available, measurements may also be clearly and legibly handwritten into the Wheel Alignment
Repair Order Questionnaire attached to this bulletin.
4. Attach the Wheel Alignment Repair Order Questionnaire below along with the print-out of
"Before" and "After" wheel alignment measurements to
the Repair Order and retain for use by GM.
Wheel Alignment Equipment and Process
Wheel alignments must be performed with a quality machine that will give accurate results when
performing checks. "External Reference" (image-based camera technology) is preferred. Please
refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 05-00-89-029B: General Motors Dealership Critical Equipment
Requirements and Recommendations.
Requirements:
- Computerized four wheel alignment system.
- Computer capable of printing before and after alignment reports.
- Computer capable of time and date stamp printout.
- Racking system must have jacking capability
- Racking system must be capable of level to 1.6 mm (1/16 in)
- Appropriate wheel stops and safety certification
- Built-in turn plates and slip plates
- Wheel clamps capable of attaching to 20" or larger wheels
- Racking capable of accepting any GM passenger car or light duty truck
- Operator properly trained and ASE-certified (U.S. only) in wheel alignment
Recommendations:
Racking should have front and rear jacking capability.
Equipment Maintenance and Calibration:
Alignment machines must be regularly calibrated in order to give correct information. Most
manufacturers recommend the following:
- Alignment machines with "internal reference" sensors should be checked (and calibrated, if
necessary) every six months.
- Alignment machines with "external reference" (image-based camera technology) should be
checked (and calibrated, if necessary) once a year.
- Racks must be kept level to within 1.6 mm (1/16 in).
- If any instrument that is part of the alignment machine is dropped or damaged in some way,
check the calibration immediately.
Check with the manufacturer of your specific equipment for their recommended service/calibration
schedule.
Wheel Alignment Process
When performing wheel alignment measurement and/or adjustment, the following steps should be
taken:
Preliminary Steps:
1. Verify that the vehicle has a full tank of fuel (compensate as necessary). 2. Inspect the wheels
and the tires for damage. 3. Inspect the tires for the proper inflation and irregular tire wear. 4.
Inspect the wheel bearings for excessive play. 5. Inspect all suspension and steering parts for
looseness, wear, or damage. 6. Inspect the steering wheel for excessive drag or poor return due to
stiff or rusted linkage or suspension components. 7. Inspect the vehicle trim height. 8. Compensate
for frame angle on targeted vehicles (refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications in SI).
Satisfactory vehicle operation may occur over a wide range of alignment angles. However, if the
wheel alignment angles are not within the range of specifications, adjust the wheel alignment to the
specifications. Refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications in SI. Give consideration to excess loads,
such as tool boxes, sample cases, etc. Follow the wheel alignment equipment manufacturer's
instructions.
Measure/Adjust:
Important Prior to making any adjustments to wheel alignment on a vehicle, technicians must verify
that the wheel alignment specifications loaded into their wheel alignment machine are up-to-date
by comparing these to the wheel alignment specifications for the appropriate model and model year
in SI. Using incorrect and/or outdated specifications may result in unnecessary adjustments,
irregular and/or premature tire wear and repeat customer concerns
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 5516
Important When performing adjustments to vehicles requiring a 4-wheel alignment, set the rear
wheel alignment angles first in order to obtain proper front wheel alignment angles.
Perform the following steps in order to measure the front and rear alignment angles:
1. Install the alignment equipment according to the manufacturer's instructions. 2. Jounce the front
and the rear bumpers 3 times prior to checking the wheel alignment. 3. Measure the alignment
angles and record the readings.
If necessary, adjust the wheel alignment to vehicle specification and record the before and after
measurements. Refer to Wheel Alignment Specifications in SI.
Important Technicians must refer to SI for the correct wheel alignment specifications. SI is the only
source of GM wheel alignment specifications that is kept up-to-date throughout the year.
Test drive vehicle to ensure proper repair.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 5517
Frame Angle Measurement (Express / Savana Only) ........
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Alignment: > 05-03-07-009C > Dec > 10 > Steering/Suspension - Wheel Alignment
Specifications > Page 5518
What corrected the customer concern and was the repair verified?
Please Explain: .............
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 5519
Alignment: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 333213 Date: 931101
Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull
Group Ref.: Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 333213
Date: November, 1993
SUBJECT: VEHICLE MAY LEAD OR PULL (DIAGNOSE/SERVICE PROCEDURE)
MODELS: 1992-94 BUICK SKYLARK 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND
BERETTA 1992-94 OLDSMOBILE ACHIEVA 1992-94 PONTIAC SUNBIRD AND GRAND AM
CONDITION: Some owners may experience that the vehicle may lead or pull.
CORRECTION: DO NOT replace the steering gear to fix a lead or pull on 1993-94 vehicles as this
will not solve the problem. It may temporarily mask the problem due to the higher internal friction in
the new gear. However, the condition will resurface when the gear is worn in with mileage.
On 1992-94 vehicles, the following procedure should be followed for lead and pull conditions:
- Consult J/L/N lead/pull Corporate Bulletin # 073002. Previous divisional publication numbers
were:
Chevrolet 92-5O-3B
Pontiac 92-3-3
Oldsmobile 92-T-20
GM of Canada 92-3-110
- Consult J/L/N memory steer Corporate Bulletin # 233303R. Previous divisional publication
numbers were:
Chevrolet 93-171-3B
Buick 93-3-8
Pontiac 93-3-10
Oldsmobile 93-T-60
GM of Canada 93-3C-102
If the problem still exists, check system flows and pressures using gauge J 5176-D or J 25323-B.
System flow should be 1.9 gpm - 2.3 gpm, back pressure at or less than 100 psi with wheels
straight ahead and the engine at idle. If flows or pressures are out of specification, look for pinched
or crimped steering hoses and check for blockages by blowing air through the steering lines.
If problem still exists for 1992 V-6 vehicles only, evaluate vehicle for steering system induced
lead/pull by coasting with vehicle in neutral and engine off. Restart the vehicle. A steering induced
lead/pull will result in a significant, abrupt pull to the right. If this occurs, remove power steering
cooler lines from the steering system, (refer to Section 3B in the Service Manual). Use the following
hoses to connect directly from the steering gear to the pump reservoir inlet tube.
1. LHO engine (VIN T): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26038210
2. LG7 engine (VIN N): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26031205
If problem still persists on 1992 vehicles only, steering gear replacement can be attempted.
1993-94 vehicles have updated steering racks and should not require replacement for lead/pull
conditions. Also on 1993-94 vehicles, there are no cooler lines; therefore, the above by-pass hoses
do not apply. This is the latest information which should resolve any lead/pull conditions.
Parts are expected to be available on November 8, 1993.
WARRANTY INFORMATION:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 5520
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Number: T3385
Labor Time: 0.6 hr.
Technical Service Bulletin # 333213 Date: 931101
Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull
Group Ref.: Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 333213
Date: November, 1993
SUBJECT: VEHICLE MAY LEAD OR PULL (DIAGNOSE/SERVICE PROCEDURE)
MODELS: 1992-94 BUICK SKYLARK 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND
BERETTA 1992-94 OLDSMOBILE ACHIEVA 1992-94 PONTIAC SUNBIRD AND GRAND AM
CONDITION: Some owners may experience that the vehicle may lead or pull.
CORRECTION: DO NOT replace the steering gear to fix a lead or pull on 1993-94 vehicles as this
will not solve the problem. It may temporarily mask the problem due to the higher internal friction in
the new gear. However, the condition will resurface when the gear is worn in with mileage.
On 1992-94 vehicles, the following procedure should be followed for lead and pull conditions:
- Consult J/L/N lead/pull Corporate Bulletin # 073002. Previous divisional publication numbers
were:
Chevrolet 92-5O-3B
Pontiac 92-3-3
Oldsmobile 92-T-20
GM of Canada 92-3-110
- Consult J/L/N memory steer Corporate Bulletin # 233303R. Previous divisional publication
numbers were:
Chevrolet 93-171-3B
Buick 93-3-8
Pontiac 93-3-10
Oldsmobile 93-T-60
GM of Canada 93-3C-102
If the problem still exists, check system flows and pressures using gauge J 5176-D or J 25323-B.
System flow should be 1.9 gpm - 2.3 gpm, back pressure at or less than 100 psi with wheels
straight ahead and the engine at idle. If flows or pressures are out of specification, look for pinched
or crimped steering hoses and check for blockages by blowing air through the steering lines.
If problem still exists for 1992 V-6 vehicles only, evaluate vehicle for steering system induced
lead/pull by coasting with vehicle in neutral and engine off. Restart the vehicle. A steering induced
lead/pull will result in a significant, abrupt pull to the right. If this occurs, remove power steering
cooler lines from the steering system, (refer to Section 3B in the Service Manual). Use the following
hoses to connect directly from the steering gear to the pump reservoir inlet tube.
1. LHO engine (VIN T): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26038210
2. LG7 engine (VIN N): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26031205
If problem still persists on 1992 vehicles only, steering gear replacement can be attempted.
1993-94 vehicles have updated steering racks and should not require replacement for lead/pull
conditions. Also on 1993-94 vehicles, there are no cooler lines; therefore, the above by-pass hoses
do not apply. This is the latest information which should resolve any lead/pull conditions.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 5521
Parts are expected to be available on November 8, 1993.
WARRANTY INFORMATION: For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Number: T3385
Labor Time: 0.6 hr.
Technical Service Bulletin # 333213 Date: 931101
Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull
Group Ref.: Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 333213
Date: November, 1993
SUBJECT: VEHICLE MAY LEAD OR PULL (DIAGNOSE/SERVICE PROCEDURE)
MODELS: 1992-94 BUICK SKYLARK 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND
BERETTA 1992-94 OLDSMOBILE ACHIEVA 1992-94 PONTIAC SUNBIRD AND GRAND AM
CONDITION: Some owners may experience that the vehicle may lead or pull.
CORRECTION: DO NOT replace the steering gear to fix a lead or pull on 1993-94 vehicles as this
will not solve the problem. It may temporarily mask the problem due to the higher internal friction in
the new gear. However, the condition will resurface when the gear is worn in with mileage.
On 1992-94 vehicles, the following procedure should be followed for lead and pull conditions:
- Consult J/L/N lead/pull Corporate Bulletin # 073002. Previous divisional publication numbers
were:
Chevrolet 92-5O-3B
Pontiac 92-3-3
Oldsmobile 92-T-20
GM of Canada 92-3-110
- Consult J/L/N memory steer Corporate Bulletin # 233303R. Previous divisional publication
numbers were:
Chevrolet 93-171-3B
Buick 93-3-8
Pontiac 93-3-10
Oldsmobile 93-T-60
GM of Canada 93-3C-102
If the problem still exists, check system flows and pressures using gauge J 5176-D or J 25323-B.
System flow should be 1.9 gpm - 2.3 gpm, back pressure at or less than 100 psi with wheels
straight ahead and the engine at idle. If flows or pressures are out of specification, look for pinched
or crimped steering hoses and check for blockages by blowing air through the steering lines.
If problem still exists for 1992 V-6 vehicles only, evaluate vehicle for steering system induced
lead/pull by coasting with vehicle in neutral and engine off. Restart the vehicle. A steering induced
lead/pull will result in a significant, abrupt pull to the right. If this occurs, remove power steering
cooler lines from the steering system, (refer to Section 3B in the Service Manual). Use the following
hoses to connect directly from the steering gear to the pump reservoir inlet tube.
1. LHO engine (VIN T): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26038210
2. LG7 engine (VIN N): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26031205
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 5522
If problem still persists on 1992 vehicles only, steering gear replacement can be attempted.
1993-94 vehicles have updated steering racks and should not require replacement for lead/pull
conditions. Also on 1993-94 vehicles, there are no cooler lines; therefore, the above by-pass hoses
do not apply. This is the latest information which should resolve any lead/pull conditions.
Parts are expected to be available on November 8, 1993.
WARRANTY INFORMATION: For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Number: T3385
Labor Time: 0.6 hr.
Technical Service Bulletin # 333213 Date: 931101
Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull
Group Ref.: Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 333213
Date: November, 1993
SUBJECT: VEHICLE MAY LEAD OR PULL (DIAGNOSE/SERVICE PROCEDURE)
MODELS: 1992-94 BUICK SKYLARK 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND
BERETTA 1992-94 OLDSMOBILE ACHIEVA 1992-94 PONTIAC SUNBIRD AND GRAND AM
CONDITION: Some owners may experience that the vehicle may lead or pull.
CORRECTION: DO NOT replace the steering gear to fix a lead or pull on 1993-94 vehicles as this
will not solve the problem. It may temporarily mask the problem due to the higher internal friction in
the new gear. However, the condition will resurface when the gear is worn in with mileage.
On 1992-94 vehicles, the following procedure should be followed for lead and pull conditions:
- Consult J/L/N lead/pull Corporate Bulletin # 073002. Previous divisional publication numbers
were:
Chevrolet 92-5O-3B
Pontiac 92-3-3
Oldsmobile 92-T-20
GM of Canada 92-3-110
- Consult J/L/N memory steer Corporate Bulletin # 233303R. Previous divisional publication
numbers were:
Chevrolet 93-171-3B
Buick 93-3-8
Pontiac 93-3-10
Oldsmobile 93-T-60
GM of Canada 93-3C-102
If the problem still exists, check system flows and pressures using gauge J 5176-D or J 25323-B.
System flow should be 1.9 gpm - 2.3 gpm, back pressure at or less than 100 psi with wheels
straight ahead and the engine at idle. If flows or pressures are out of specification, look for pinched
or crimped steering hoses and check for blockages by blowing air through the steering lines.
If problem still exists for 1992 V-6 vehicles only, evaluate vehicle for steering system induced
lead/pull by coasting with vehicle in neutral and engine off. Restart the vehicle. A steering induced
lead/pull will result in a significant, abrupt pull to the right. If this occurs, remove power steering
cooler lines from the steering system, (refer to Section 3B in the Service Manual). Use the following
hoses to connect directly from the steering gear to the pump reservoir inlet tube.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Alignment: > Page 5523
1. LHO engine (VIN T): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26038210
2. LG7 engine (VIN N): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26031205
If problem still persists on 1992 vehicles only, steering gear replacement can be attempted.
1993-94 vehicles have updated steering racks and should not require replacement for lead/pull
conditions. Also on 1993-94 vehicles, there are no cooler lines; therefore, the above by-pass hoses
do not apply. This is the latest information which should resolve any lead/pull conditions.
Parts are expected to be available on November 8, 1993.
WARRANTY INFORMATION: For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Number: T3385
Labor Time: 0.6 hr.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Vehicle Ride
(Trim) Height Specifications
Alignment: Specifications Vehicle Ride (Trim) Height Specifications
Model ...................................................................................................................................................
............................................ Cavalier Station Wagon Tire Size ...........................................................
................................................................................................................................................
185/75R x 14 Engine ...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................................. 2.2L Ride Height Measurements in
Inches [01]
Dimension Z ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 3.62 Dimension J ........................................................
.........................................................................................................................................................
9.53 Dimension K ................................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 9.65
[01] Maximum variation side to side & front to rear is 3/4 inch.
Model ...................................................................................................................................................
............................................ Cavalier Station Wagon Tire Size ...........................................................
................................................................................................................................................
195/70R x 14 Engine ...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................................. 2.2L Ride Height Measurements in
Inches [01]
Dimension Z ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 3.78 Dimension J ........................................................
.........................................................................................................................................................
9.53 Dimension K ................................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 9.65
[01] Maximum variation side to side & front to rear is 3/4 inch.
Model ...................................................................................................................................................
............................................ Cavalier Station Wagon Tire Size ...........................................................
................................................................................................................................................
195/70R x 14 Engine ...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................................. 3.1L Ride Height Measurements in
Inches [01]
Dimension Z ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 3.82 Dimension J ........................................................
.........................................................................................................................................................
9.53 Dimension K ................................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 9.65
[01] Maximum variation side to side & front to rear is 3/4 inch.
Model ...................................................................................................................................................
........................................... Cavalier Coupe & Sedan Tire Size ..........................................................
.................................................................................................................................................
185/75R x 14 Engine ...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................................. 2.2L Ride Height Measurements in
Inches [01]
Dimension Z ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 3.42 Dimension J ........................................................
.........................................................................................................................................................
9.26 Dimension K ................................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 9.13
[01] Maximum variation side to side & front to rear is 3/4 inch.
Model ...................................................................................................................................................
........................................... Cavalier Coupe & Sedan Tire Size ..........................................................
.................................................................................................................................................
195/70R x 14 Engine ...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................................... 2.2 Ride Height Measurements in
Inches [01]
Dimension Z ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 3.58 Dimension J ........................................................
.........................................................................................................................................................
9.26 Dimension K ................................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 9.13
[01] Maximum variation side to side & front to rear is 3/4 inch.
Model ...................................................................................................................................................
........................................... Cavalier Coupe & Sedan Tire Size ..........................................................
.................................................................................................................................................
195/70R x 14 Engine ...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................................. 3.1L Ride Height Measurements in
Inches [01]
Dimension Z ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 3.62 Dimension J ........................................................
.........................................................................................................................................................
9.26 Dimension K ................................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 9.13
[01] Maximum variation side to side & front to rear is 3/4 inch. Model ................................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. Cavalier Z24 Tire Size ......................................................................................................................
..................................................................................... 205/60R x 15 Engine .....................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.......................... 3.1L
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Vehicle Ride
(Trim) Height Specifications > Page 5526
Ride Height Measurements in Inches [01]
Dimension Z ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 3.58 Dimension J ........................................................
.........................................................................................................................................................
9.26 Dimension K ................................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 9.13
[01] Maximum variation side to side & front to rear is 3/4 inch.
Model ...................................................................................................................................................
............................................ Cavalier Station Wagon Tire Size ...........................................................
................................................................................................................................................
185/75R x 14 Engine ...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................................. 2.2L Ride Height Measurements in
Inches [01]
Dimension Z ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 9/32 Dimension J ........................................................
.........................................................................................................................................................
9.53 Dimension K ................................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 9.65
[01] Maximum variation side to side & front to rear is 3/4 inch.
Model ...................................................................................................................................................
............................................ Cavalier Station Wagon Tire Size ...........................................................
................................................................................................................................................
195/70R x 14 Engine ...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................................. 2.2L Ride Height Measurements in
Inches [01]
Dimension Z ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 7/16 Dimension J ........................................................
.........................................................................................................................................................
9.53 Dimension K ................................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 9.65
[01] Maximum variation side to side & front to rear is 3/4 inch.
Model ...................................................................................................................................................
............................................ Cavalier Station Wagon Tire Size ...........................................................
................................................................................................................................................
195/70R x 14 Engine ...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................................. 3.1L Ride Height Measurements in
Inches [01]
Dimension Z ........................................................................................................................................
...................................................................... 31/64 Dimension J ........................................................
.........................................................................................................................................................
9.53 Dimension K ................................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 9.65
[01] Maximum variation side to side & front to rear is 3/4 inch.
Model ...................................................................................................................................................
................................................. Cavalier Convertible Tire Size ...........................................................
................................................................................................................................................
185/75R x 14 Engine ...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................................... All Ride Height Measurements in
Inches [01]
Dimension Z ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 5/64 Dimension J ........................................................
.........................................................................................................................................................
9.26 Dimension K ................................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 9.13
[01] Maximum variation side to side & front to rear is 3/4 inch.
Model ...................................................................................................................................................
........................................... Cavalier Coupe & Sedan Tire Size ..........................................................
.................................................................................................................................................
195/70R x 14 Engine ...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................................... All Ride Height Measurements in
Inches [01]
Dimension Z ........................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 5/64 Dimension J ........................................................
.........................................................................................................................................................
9.26 Dimension K ................................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 9.13
[01] Maximum variation side to side & front to rear is 3/4 inch.
Model ...................................................................................................................................................
............................................................. Cavalier Z24 Tire Size ...........................................................
................................................................................................................................................
205/60R x 15 Engine ...........................................................................................................................
.................................................................................................. 3.1L Ride Height Measurements in
Inches [01]
Dimension Z ........................................................................................................................................
...................................................................... 15/64 Dimension J ........................................................
.........................................................................................................................................................
9.26 Dimension K ................................................................................................................................
............................................................................... 9.13
[01] Maximum variation side to side & front to rear is 3/4 inch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Vehicle Ride
(Trim) Height Specifications > Page 5527
Alignment: Specifications Alignment Specifications
Front Alignment Specifications
CASTER ANGLE, DEGREES [1]
Desired ................................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ +1.3 Limits ..................................................................
............................................................................................................................................ +0.3 to
+2.3
CAMBER ANGLE, DEGREES
Desired ................................................................................................................................................
....................................................................... -0.15 Limits ..................................................................
.......................................................................................................................................... -0.85 to +
0.5
TOTAL TOE, DEGREES .....................................................................................................................
....................................................................... +0.2
[1] Non-adjustable, for inspection purposes only.
Rear Alignment Specifications
Camber Angle, Degrees ......................................................................................................................
........................................................................... [01]
Limits ...................................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... - .85 to +.35 Desired .................................................................
.....................................................................................................................................................
-0.25
Thrust Angle, Degrees .........................................................................................................................
.......................................................................... [01]
Limits ...................................................................................................................................................
.......................................................... - .35 to +.35 Desired .................................................................
........................................................................................................................................................... 0
Total Toe, Degrees ..............................................................................................................................
........................................................................... [01]
Limits ...................................................................................................................................................
........................................................... -.06 to +.56 Desired .................................................................
...................................................................................................................................................... 0.25
[01] -- Non-adjustable, for inspection purposes only.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair >
Ride/Trim Height Measurement and Adjustment
Alignment: Service and Repair Ride/Trim Height Measurement and Adjustment
Fig. 3 Vehicle Ride Height Measurement Locations
Refer to Fig. 3, for ride height measurements and for specifications refer to Vehicle Ride Height
Specifications. When checking ride height measurements, fuel tank should be full, tires at should
be correct pressure, front seat should be rearward position, trunk should be empty except for spare
tire and jack and vehicle should be on level ground. If fuel tank is not full, add weight to trunk to
compensate for amount fuel vehicle is below the full level.
Prior to checking ride height, lift front bumper upward approximately 1.5 inches and gently release
(3 times), then check front ride height. Push front bumper downward approximately 1.5 inches and
gently release (3 times), then recheck front ride height. Average of both readings to determine
vehicle ride height. Check rear ride height in same manner, lifting and pushing rear bumper.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair >
Ride/Trim Height Measurement and Adjustment > Page 5530
Alignment: Service and Repair Front Wheel Alignment
Preliminary Inspection
CASTER ALIGNMENT CHECK
Caster is not adjustable. If caster angle is not within specifications, inspect for suspension support
misalignment or front suspension damage.
TOE ALIGNMENT CHECK
Toe setting is the only adjustment normally required. However, in special circumstances, such as
damage due to road hazard or collision, camber may be adjusted by modifying the strut assembly.
Front Caster Adjustment
Caster is not adjustable. If caster angle is not within specifications, inspect for suspension support
misalignment or front suspension damage.
Front Camber Adjustment
Fig. 1 Modifying Strut Bracket To Adjust Camber
Toe setting is the only adjustment normally required. However, in special circumstances, such as
damage due to road hazard or collision, camber may be adjusted by modifying the strut assembly.
1. Secure bottom of strut assembly in a suitable vise.
2. Enlarge bottom holes in outer flanges with a round file until holes in outer flanges match slots in
inner flanges, Fig. 1.
3. Connect strut to steering knuckle and install bolts finger tight.
4. Grasp top of tire firmly, then move tire inboard or outboard until correct camber reading is
obtained. Tighten retaining bolts enough to secure camber setting.
5. Remove wheel and tire and tighten strut to steering knuckle retaining bolts. On 1989-90 models,
Torque strut to steering knuckle retaining bolts to 135 ft. lbs. On 1991-92 models, Torque strut to
steering knuckle attaching bolt to 133 ft. lbs.
Front Toe Adjustment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair >
Ride/Trim Height Measurement and Adjustment > Page 5531
Fig. 2 Adjusting Toe
Toe-out is controlled by tie rod position. Adjustment is made by loosening the clamp bolts at the
steering knuckle end of the tie rods and rotating the rods to obtain proper toe setting, Fig. 2. After
correct toe setting is obtained, tighten clamp bolts. Torque clamp bolts to 41 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors
and Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Center Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors
and Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations >
Page 5538
Center Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors
and Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 5539
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation
Power Steering Pressure Switch
PURPOSE
To sense high pressure in the steering box and signal the ECM to adjust the idle speed
accordingly.
OPERATION
The Power Steering Pressure Switch (PSPS) opens during high pressure power steering
situations. When the power steering switch is open, power to the A/C relay is shut "OFF," resulting
in A/C compressor clutch disengagement. Also, a signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM uses this
signal to compensate for the additional engine load by moving the IAC valve.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors
and Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 5540
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-1E
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Sensors and Switches - Steering and Suspension > Sensors
and Switches - Steering > Power Steering Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 5541
Power Steering Pressure Switch Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Power Steering Pressure (PSP) switch is normally open to ground and CKT 495 will be near
the battery voltage.
Turning the steering wheel increases power steering oil pressure and its load on an idling engine.
The pressure switch will close before the load can cause an idle problem.
Closing the switch causes CKT 495 to read less than 1 volt. The PCM will increase the idle air rate
and disengage the A/C relay.
^ A pressure switch that will not close or an open CKT 495 or 450, may cause the engine to stop
when power steering loads are high.
^ A switch that will not open, or a CKT 495 shorted to ground, may affect idle quality and will cause
the A/C relay to be de-energized.
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. Different makes of scan tools may display the state of this switch in different ways. Refer to scan
tool operator's manual to determine how this
input is displayed.
2. Checks to determine if CKT 495 is shorted to ground.
3. This should simulate a closed switch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Front Steering Knuckle: Service and Repair
1. Raise and support vehicle, then remove wheel and tire.
2. Remove front hub and bearing. Refer to Transmission and Drivetrain / Drive Axles, Bearings and
Joints / Wheel Bearing. See: Suspension/Wheel Bearing/Service and Repair
3. Using tool J-29330, on 1989-90 models or J-38892, on 1991-92 models, separate ball joint from
steering knuckle.
4. Remove strut to steering knuckle attaching bolts, then disconnect strut from steering knuckle.
5. Assemble strut to new steering knuckle and install attaching bolts finger tight.
6. Insert ball joint stud into steering knuckle and torque stud nut to specification.
7. Torque strut to steering knuckle bolts to specification.
8. Reverse removal procedure to complete installation.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Bleeding > System
Information > Service and Repair
Power Steering Bleeding: Service and Repair
Fig. 12 Power Steering System Bleed Procedure.
Bleed power steering system after any component replacement, disconnecting fluid line or in case
of steering system noise. Bleed system to prevent pump damage, stop steering noise and to
ensure proper system operation. Before bleeding, inspect steering system. Check and correct if
needed power steering lines touching frame body or engine. Also check all hose connections for
looseness or leaks and tighten.
Refer to Fig. 12 for proper bleeding procedure.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Fluid: > 033206 > Mar > 94 >
P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold
Power Steering Fluid: Customer Interest P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold
Group Ref.: Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 033206
Date: March 1994
SUBJECT: REDUCED POWER STEERING ASSIST AT LOW AMBIENT TEMPERATURES (NEW
POWER STEERING FLUID)
MODELS: 1994 AND PRIOR PASSENGER CARS AND LIGHT DUTY TRUCKS
Applications:
Appropriate for all passenger vehicles, but particularly beneficial in 1980 and later FWD Models
equipped with Power Rack and Pinion Steering.
CONDITION:
Comments of reduced power steering assist at low ambient temperatures (approximately 10°F and
lower) may be noted by some vehicle operators when turning the steering wheel in BOTH the right
and left direction during warm-up after cold start. All vehicles with power steering exhibit this
condition to varying degrees, but condition may be more noticeable with power rack and pinion
steering systems that typically have longer hoses and cooler lines.
Note:
This condition, which is related to power steering fluid viscosity, should not, however, be confused
with conditions having similar symptoms such as that described divisional Special Policy numbers
listed:
CAUSE:
In cold weather, power steering fluid thickens in the same manner as any other petroleum-based oil
or fluid. Upon cold starting, the fluid resists movement through the system and the driver senses
reduced power assist (sometimes referred to as "stiff steer"). As the vehicle operates and fluid
circulates through the power steering system, the fluid warms and thins to its normal operating
viscosity.
CORRECTION: Saginaw Division has developed a new Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid for
use in cold climates. Compared with conventional power steering fluid, this new fluid flows better at
low temperatures and resists the thickening which contributes to reduced power assist upon start
up.
RACK AND PINION STEERING SYSTEMS Reduced power assist upon cold weather starting may
be more noticeable in Power Rack and Pinion steering systems that may contain six or more feet of
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Fluid: > 033206 > Mar > 94 >
P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold > Page 5558
pressure and return hose along with long cooler lines. Such long systems contain greater volumes
of fluid and vehicles so equipped tend to have longer periods of reduced power assist. The new
fluid performs particularly well with current designed Rack and Pinion steering systems and special
remanufactured Rack and Pinion Steering Assemblies.
PARTS INFORMATION:
Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid is available from GMSPO. Order as:
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
SERVICE PROCEDURE: The power steering fluid replacement procedure is a two-stage process:
first, flushing the old fluid from the system with new fluid; and second, bleeding the system to
remove any trapped air. The two sequences outline the steps in each procedure.
FLUSHING THE POWER STEERING SYSTEM 1.
Raise the front end of the vehicle off the ground until the wheels are free to turn.
2. Remove the fluid return line at the pump reservoir inlet connector.
3. Plug the inlet connector port on the pump reservoir.
4. Position the fluid return line toward a large container in order to catch the draining fluid.
5. While a second person fills the reservoir with new Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid, start
and run the engine at idle.
6. Turn the steering wheel from stop to stop.
NOTICE:
Do not hold the wheel against stops while flushing the system, Holding steering wheel against
wheel stops will cause high system pressure, overheating, and damage to the pump and/or gear.
7. Continue draining until all of the old fluid is cleared from the power steering system. Addition of
approximately 1 quart of new fluid will be required to flush system.
8. Unplug pump reservoir inlet and reconnect return line.
9. Turn engine off, and fill reservoir to the "Full Cold" mark.
10. Continue with following procedure "Bleeding the Power Steering System".
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Fluid: > 033206 > Mar > 94 >
P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold > Page 5559
BLEEDING THE POWER STEERING SYSTEM After replacing the fluid or servicing the power
steering hydraulic system, you must bleed air from the system. Air in the system prevents an
accurate fluid level reading, causes pump cavitation noise and over time could damage the pump.
To bleed the power steering system proceed as follows:
1. Begin with the engine off, front wheels off the ground, and wheels turned all the way to the left.
2. Add Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid to the "FULL COLD" mark on the fluid level
indicator.
3. Bleed the system by turning the wheels from side to side without hitting stops.
Important:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Fluid: > 033206 > Mar > 94 >
P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold > Page 5560
This may require turning the wheels from side to side twenty times. On systems with long return
lines or fluid coolers, turning steering wheel lock-to-lock forty times may be required. Keep the fluid
level at the "FULL COLD" mark. Fluid with air In it has a light tan appearance. This air must be
eliminated from the fluid before normal steering action can be obtained.
4. Start the engine. With the engine idling, recheck the fluid level. If necessary, add fluid to bring
the level to the "FULL COLD" mark.
5. Return the wheels to the center position. Lower front wheels to the ground. Continue running the
engine for two or three minutes.
6. Test the vehicle to be sure the steering functions normally and is free from noise.
Important:
Inspect for fluid leakage at connection points along the power steering system.
7. Recheck the fluid level as described in Steps 3 and 4 except that the fluid level should now be
up to the "FULL HOT" mark after the system has stabilized at its normal operating temperature.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 033206 >
Mar > 94 > P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold
Power Steering Fluid: All Technical Service Bulletins P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold
Group Ref.: Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 033206
Date: March 1994
SUBJECT: REDUCED POWER STEERING ASSIST AT LOW AMBIENT TEMPERATURES (NEW
POWER STEERING FLUID)
MODELS: 1994 AND PRIOR PASSENGER CARS AND LIGHT DUTY TRUCKS
Applications:
Appropriate for all passenger vehicles, but particularly beneficial in 1980 and later FWD Models
equipped with Power Rack and Pinion Steering.
CONDITION:
Comments of reduced power steering assist at low ambient temperatures (approximately 10°F and
lower) may be noted by some vehicle operators when turning the steering wheel in BOTH the right
and left direction during warm-up after cold start. All vehicles with power steering exhibit this
condition to varying degrees, but condition may be more noticeable with power rack and pinion
steering systems that typically have longer hoses and cooler lines.
Note:
This condition, which is related to power steering fluid viscosity, should not, however, be confused
with conditions having similar symptoms such as that described divisional Special Policy numbers
listed:
CAUSE:
In cold weather, power steering fluid thickens in the same manner as any other petroleum-based oil
or fluid. Upon cold starting, the fluid resists movement through the system and the driver senses
reduced power assist (sometimes referred to as "stiff steer"). As the vehicle operates and fluid
circulates through the power steering system, the fluid warms and thins to its normal operating
viscosity.
CORRECTION: Saginaw Division has developed a new Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid for
use in cold climates. Compared with conventional power steering fluid, this new fluid flows better at
low temperatures and resists the thickening which contributes to reduced power assist upon start
up.
RACK AND PINION STEERING SYSTEMS Reduced power assist upon cold weather starting may
be more noticeable in Power Rack and Pinion steering systems that may contain six or more feet of
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 033206 >
Mar > 94 > P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold > Page 5566
pressure and return hose along with long cooler lines. Such long systems contain greater volumes
of fluid and vehicles so equipped tend to have longer periods of reduced power assist. The new
fluid performs particularly well with current designed Rack and Pinion steering systems and special
remanufactured Rack and Pinion Steering Assemblies.
PARTS INFORMATION:
Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid is available from GMSPO. Order as:
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
SERVICE PROCEDURE: The power steering fluid replacement procedure is a two-stage process:
first, flushing the old fluid from the system with new fluid; and second, bleeding the system to
remove any trapped air. The two sequences outline the steps in each procedure.
FLUSHING THE POWER STEERING SYSTEM 1.
Raise the front end of the vehicle off the ground until the wheels are free to turn.
2. Remove the fluid return line at the pump reservoir inlet connector.
3. Plug the inlet connector port on the pump reservoir.
4. Position the fluid return line toward a large container in order to catch the draining fluid.
5. While a second person fills the reservoir with new Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid, start
and run the engine at idle.
6. Turn the steering wheel from stop to stop.
NOTICE:
Do not hold the wheel against stops while flushing the system, Holding steering wheel against
wheel stops will cause high system pressure, overheating, and damage to the pump and/or gear.
7. Continue draining until all of the old fluid is cleared from the power steering system. Addition of
approximately 1 quart of new fluid will be required to flush system.
8. Unplug pump reservoir inlet and reconnect return line.
9. Turn engine off, and fill reservoir to the "Full Cold" mark.
10. Continue with following procedure "Bleeding the Power Steering System".
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 033206 >
Mar > 94 > P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold > Page 5567
BLEEDING THE POWER STEERING SYSTEM After replacing the fluid or servicing the power
steering hydraulic system, you must bleed air from the system. Air in the system prevents an
accurate fluid level reading, causes pump cavitation noise and over time could damage the pump.
To bleed the power steering system proceed as follows:
1. Begin with the engine off, front wheels off the ground, and wheels turned all the way to the left.
2. Add Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid to the "FULL COLD" mark on the fluid level
indicator.
3. Bleed the system by turning the wheels from side to side without hitting stops.
Important:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Fluid >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Fluid: > 033206 >
Mar > 94 > P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold > Page 5568
This may require turning the wheels from side to side twenty times. On systems with long return
lines or fluid coolers, turning steering wheel lock-to-lock forty times may be required. Keep the fluid
level at the "FULL COLD" mark. Fluid with air In it has a light tan appearance. This air must be
eliminated from the fluid before normal steering action can be obtained.
4. Start the engine. With the engine idling, recheck the fluid level. If necessary, add fluid to bring
the level to the "FULL COLD" mark.
5. Return the wheels to the center position. Lower front wheels to the ground. Continue running the
engine for two or three minutes.
6. Test the vehicle to be sure the steering functions normally and is free from noise.
Important:
Inspect for fluid leakage at connection points along the power steering system.
7. Recheck the fluid level as described in Steps 3 and 4 except that the fluid level should now be
up to the "FULL HOT" mark after the system has stabilized at its normal operating temperature.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 333213 > Nov > 93 > Alignment - Vehicle May
Lead or Pull
Power Steering Line/Hose: Customer Interest Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull
Group Ref.: Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 333213
Date: November, 1993
SUBJECT: VEHICLE MAY LEAD OR PULL (DIAGNOSE/SERVICE PROCEDURE)
MODELS: 1992-94 BUICK SKYLARK 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND
BERETTA 1992-94 OLDSMOBILE ACHIEVA 1992-94 PONTIAC SUNBIRD AND GRAND AM
CONDITION: Some owners may experience that the vehicle may lead or pull.
CORRECTION: DO NOT replace the steering gear to fix a lead or pull on 1993-94 vehicles as this
will not solve the problem. It may temporarily mask the problem due to the higher internal friction in
the new gear. However, the condition will resurface when the gear is worn in with mileage.
On 1992-94 vehicles, the following procedure should be followed for lead and pull conditions:
- Consult J/L/N lead/pull Corporate Bulletin # 073002. Previous divisional publication numbers
were:
Chevrolet 92-5O-3B
Pontiac 92-3-3
Oldsmobile 92-T-20
GM of Canada 92-3-110
- Consult J/L/N memory steer Corporate Bulletin # 233303R. Previous divisional publication
numbers were:
Chevrolet 93-171-3B
Buick 93-3-8
Pontiac 93-3-10
Oldsmobile 93-T-60
GM of Canada 93-3C-102
If the problem still exists, check system flows and pressures using gauge J 5176-D or J 25323-B.
System flow should be 1.9 gpm - 2.3 gpm, back pressure at or less than 100 psi with wheels
straight ahead and the engine at idle. If flows or pressures are out of specification, look for pinched
or crimped steering hoses and check for blockages by blowing air through the steering lines.
If problem still exists for 1992 V-6 vehicles only, evaluate vehicle for steering system induced
lead/pull by coasting with vehicle in neutral and engine off. Restart the vehicle. A steering induced
lead/pull will result in a significant, abrupt pull to the right. If this occurs, remove power steering
cooler lines from the steering system, (refer to Section 3B in the Service Manual). Use the following
hoses to connect directly from the steering gear to the pump reservoir inlet tube.
1. LHO engine (VIN T): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26038210
2. LG7 engine (VIN N): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26031205
If problem still persists on 1992 vehicles only, steering gear replacement can be attempted.
1993-94 vehicles have updated steering racks and should not require replacement for lead/pull
conditions. Also on 1993-94 vehicles, there are no cooler lines; therefore, the above by-pass hoses
do not apply. This is the latest information which should resolve any lead/pull conditions.
Parts are expected to be available on November 8, 1993.
WARRANTY INFORMATION: For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Number: T3385
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 333213 > Nov > 93 > Alignment - Vehicle May
Lead or Pull > Page 5577
Labor Time: 0.6 hr.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 333213 > Nov > 93 > Alignment Vehicle May Lead or Pull
Power Steering Line/Hose: All Technical Service Bulletins Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull
Group Ref.: Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 333213
Date: November, 1993
SUBJECT: VEHICLE MAY LEAD OR PULL (DIAGNOSE/SERVICE PROCEDURE)
MODELS: 1992-94 BUICK SKYLARK 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND
BERETTA 1992-94 OLDSMOBILE ACHIEVA 1992-94 PONTIAC SUNBIRD AND GRAND AM
CONDITION: Some owners may experience that the vehicle may lead or pull.
CORRECTION: DO NOT replace the steering gear to fix a lead or pull on 1993-94 vehicles as this
will not solve the problem. It may temporarily mask the problem due to the higher internal friction in
the new gear. However, the condition will resurface when the gear is worn in with mileage.
On 1992-94 vehicles, the following procedure should be followed for lead and pull conditions:
- Consult J/L/N lead/pull Corporate Bulletin # 073002. Previous divisional publication numbers
were:
Chevrolet 92-5O-3B
Pontiac 92-3-3
Oldsmobile 92-T-20
GM of Canada 92-3-110
- Consult J/L/N memory steer Corporate Bulletin # 233303R. Previous divisional publication
numbers were:
Chevrolet 93-171-3B
Buick 93-3-8
Pontiac 93-3-10
Oldsmobile 93-T-60
GM of Canada 93-3C-102
If the problem still exists, check system flows and pressures using gauge J 5176-D or J 25323-B.
System flow should be 1.9 gpm - 2.3 gpm, back pressure at or less than 100 psi with wheels
straight ahead and the engine at idle. If flows or pressures are out of specification, look for pinched
or crimped steering hoses and check for blockages by blowing air through the steering lines.
If problem still exists for 1992 V-6 vehicles only, evaluate vehicle for steering system induced
lead/pull by coasting with vehicle in neutral and engine off. Restart the vehicle. A steering induced
lead/pull will result in a significant, abrupt pull to the right. If this occurs, remove power steering
cooler lines from the steering system, (refer to Section 3B in the Service Manual). Use the following
hoses to connect directly from the steering gear to the pump reservoir inlet tube.
1. LHO engine (VIN T): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26038210
2. LG7 engine (VIN N): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26031205
If problem still persists on 1992 vehicles only, steering gear replacement can be attempted.
1993-94 vehicles have updated steering racks and should not require replacement for lead/pull
conditions. Also on 1993-94 vehicles, there are no cooler lines; therefore, the above by-pass hoses
do not apply. This is the latest information which should resolve any lead/pull conditions.
Parts are expected to be available on November 8, 1993.
WARRANTY INFORMATION: For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Number: T3385
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 333213 > Nov > 93 > Alignment Vehicle May Lead or Pull > Page 5583
Labor Time: 0.6 hr.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 033206
> Mar > 94 > P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold
Power Steering Fluid: All Technical Service Bulletins P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold
Group Ref.: Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 033206
Date: March 1994
SUBJECT: REDUCED POWER STEERING ASSIST AT LOW AMBIENT TEMPERATURES (NEW
POWER STEERING FLUID)
MODELS: 1994 AND PRIOR PASSENGER CARS AND LIGHT DUTY TRUCKS
Applications:
Appropriate for all passenger vehicles, but particularly beneficial in 1980 and later FWD Models
equipped with Power Rack and Pinion Steering.
CONDITION:
Comments of reduced power steering assist at low ambient temperatures (approximately 10°F and
lower) may be noted by some vehicle operators when turning the steering wheel in BOTH the right
and left direction during warm-up after cold start. All vehicles with power steering exhibit this
condition to varying degrees, but condition may be more noticeable with power rack and pinion
steering systems that typically have longer hoses and cooler lines.
Note:
This condition, which is related to power steering fluid viscosity, should not, however, be confused
with conditions having similar symptoms such as that described divisional Special Policy numbers
listed:
CAUSE:
In cold weather, power steering fluid thickens in the same manner as any other petroleum-based oil
or fluid. Upon cold starting, the fluid resists movement through the system and the driver senses
reduced power assist (sometimes referred to as "stiff steer"). As the vehicle operates and fluid
circulates through the power steering system, the fluid warms and thins to its normal operating
viscosity.
CORRECTION: Saginaw Division has developed a new Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid for
use in cold climates. Compared with conventional power steering fluid, this new fluid flows better at
low temperatures and resists the thickening which contributes to reduced power assist upon start
up.
RACK AND PINION STEERING SYSTEMS Reduced power assist upon cold weather starting may
be more noticeable in Power Rack and Pinion steering systems that may contain six or more feet of
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 033206
> Mar > 94 > P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold > Page 5589
pressure and return hose along with long cooler lines. Such long systems contain greater volumes
of fluid and vehicles so equipped tend to have longer periods of reduced power assist. The new
fluid performs particularly well with current designed Rack and Pinion steering systems and special
remanufactured Rack and Pinion Steering Assemblies.
PARTS INFORMATION:
Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid is available from GMSPO. Order as:
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
SERVICE PROCEDURE: The power steering fluid replacement procedure is a two-stage process:
first, flushing the old fluid from the system with new fluid; and second, bleeding the system to
remove any trapped air. The two sequences outline the steps in each procedure.
FLUSHING THE POWER STEERING SYSTEM 1.
Raise the front end of the vehicle off the ground until the wheels are free to turn.
2. Remove the fluid return line at the pump reservoir inlet connector.
3. Plug the inlet connector port on the pump reservoir.
4. Position the fluid return line toward a large container in order to catch the draining fluid.
5. While a second person fills the reservoir with new Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid, start
and run the engine at idle.
6. Turn the steering wheel from stop to stop.
NOTICE:
Do not hold the wheel against stops while flushing the system, Holding steering wheel against
wheel stops will cause high system pressure, overheating, and damage to the pump and/or gear.
7. Continue draining until all of the old fluid is cleared from the power steering system. Addition of
approximately 1 quart of new fluid will be required to flush system.
8. Unplug pump reservoir inlet and reconnect return line.
9. Turn engine off, and fill reservoir to the "Full Cold" mark.
10. Continue with following procedure "Bleeding the Power Steering System".
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 033206
> Mar > 94 > P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold > Page 5590
BLEEDING THE POWER STEERING SYSTEM After replacing the fluid or servicing the power
steering hydraulic system, you must bleed air from the system. Air in the system prevents an
accurate fluid level reading, causes pump cavitation noise and over time could damage the pump.
To bleed the power steering system proceed as follows:
1. Begin with the engine off, front wheels off the ground, and wheels turned all the way to the left.
2. Add Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid to the "FULL COLD" mark on the fluid level
indicator.
3. Bleed the system by turning the wheels from side to side without hitting stops.
Important:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 033206
> Mar > 94 > P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold > Page 5591
This may require turning the wheels from side to side twenty times. On systems with long return
lines or fluid coolers, turning steering wheel lock-to-lock forty times may be required. Keep the fluid
level at the "FULL COLD" mark. Fluid with air In it has a light tan appearance. This air must be
eliminated from the fluid before normal steering action can be obtained.
4. Start the engine. With the engine idling, recheck the fluid level. If necessary, add fluid to bring
the level to the "FULL COLD" mark.
5. Return the wheels to the center position. Lower front wheels to the ground. Continue running the
engine for two or three minutes.
6. Test the vehicle to be sure the steering functions normally and is free from noise.
Important:
Inspect for fluid leakage at connection points along the power steering system.
7. Recheck the fluid level as described in Steps 3 and 4 except that the fluid level should now be
up to the "FULL HOT" mark after the system has stabilized at its normal operating temperature.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 033206
> Mar > 94 > P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold > Page 5597
pressure and return hose along with long cooler lines. Such long systems contain greater volumes
of fluid and vehicles so equipped tend to have longer periods of reduced power assist. The new
fluid performs particularly well with current designed Rack and Pinion steering systems and special
remanufactured Rack and Pinion Steering Assemblies.
PARTS INFORMATION:
Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid is available from GMSPO. Order as:
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
SERVICE PROCEDURE: The power steering fluid replacement procedure is a two-stage process:
first, flushing the old fluid from the system with new fluid; and second, bleeding the system to
remove any trapped air. The two sequences outline the steps in each procedure.
FLUSHING THE POWER STEERING SYSTEM 1.
Raise the front end of the vehicle off the ground until the wheels are free to turn.
2. Remove the fluid return line at the pump reservoir inlet connector.
3. Plug the inlet connector port on the pump reservoir.
4. Position the fluid return line toward a large container in order to catch the draining fluid.
5. While a second person fills the reservoir with new Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid, start
and run the engine at idle.
6. Turn the steering wheel from stop to stop.
NOTICE:
Do not hold the wheel against stops while flushing the system, Holding steering wheel against
wheel stops will cause high system pressure, overheating, and damage to the pump and/or gear.
7. Continue draining until all of the old fluid is cleared from the power steering system. Addition of
approximately 1 quart of new fluid will be required to flush system.
8. Unplug pump reservoir inlet and reconnect return line.
9. Turn engine off, and fill reservoir to the "Full Cold" mark.
10. Continue with following procedure "Bleeding the Power Steering System".
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 033206
> Mar > 94 > P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold > Page 5598
BLEEDING THE POWER STEERING SYSTEM After replacing the fluid or servicing the power
steering hydraulic system, you must bleed air from the system. Air in the system prevents an
accurate fluid level reading, causes pump cavitation noise and over time could damage the pump.
To bleed the power steering system proceed as follows:
1. Begin with the engine off, front wheels off the ground, and wheels turned all the way to the left.
2. Add Low Temperature Climate Service Fluid to the "FULL COLD" mark on the fluid level
indicator.
3. Bleed the system by turning the wheels from side to side without hitting stops.
Important:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Line/Hose >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 033206
> Mar > 94 > P/S - Reduced Assist When Cold > Page 5599
This may require turning the wheels from side to side twenty times. On systems with long return
lines or fluid coolers, turning steering wheel lock-to-lock forty times may be required. Keep the fluid
level at the "FULL COLD" mark. Fluid with air In it has a light tan appearance. This air must be
eliminated from the fluid before normal steering action can be obtained.
4. Start the engine. With the engine idling, recheck the fluid level. If necessary, add fluid to bring
the level to the "FULL COLD" mark.
5. Return the wheels to the center position. Lower front wheels to the ground. Continue running the
engine for two or three minutes.
6. Test the vehicle to be sure the steering functions normally and is free from noise.
Important:
Inspect for fluid leakage at connection points along the power steering system.
7. Recheck the fluid level as described in Steps 3 and 4 except that the fluid level should now be
up to the "FULL HOT" mark after the system has stabilized at its normal operating temperature.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Steering - System Bleed Procedures
Power Steering Pump: Technical Service Bulletins Steering - System Bleed Procedures
Group Ref.: Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 383001
Date: December, 1993
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: ILLUSTRATED STEERING SYSTEM BLEED PROCEDURE
MODELS: 1994 AND PRIOR PASSENGER CARS AND LIGHT DUTY TRUCKS
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING REVISED TO ADD THE 1994 MODEL YEAR AND CHANGE THE
ARTWORK. PREVIOUS DIVISIONAL PUBLICATION NUMBERS WERE:
BUICK 93-3-5 3/02/93
CADILLAC T-93-76 5/12/93
CHEVROLET 93-146-3B 3/29/93
GM OF CANADA 93-3-102 5/05/93
OLDSMOBILE 2-93-59 (S.G.) 5/14/93
The steering system in 1994 and prior model year cars and light duty trucks should be bled after
any of the following:
- A power steering component is replaced.
- A fluid line is disconnected.
- A customer comments on steering system noise.
Bleeding air from the steering system should be done in order to prevent pump damage, ensure
proper operation, and to eliminate steering system noise.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Steering - System Bleed Procedures > Page 5604
The illustration presents a pictorial illustration of the bleed procedure. This new procedure replaces
previous steering system bleed procedures.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Steering - System Bleed Procedures > Page 5605
SERVICE PARTS INFORMATION
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal/Installation
Power Steering Pump: Service and Repair Removal/Installation
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove serpentine belt.
3. Remove power steering pump attaching pressure lines.
4. Remove power steering pump attaching bolts.
5. Remove pump assembly, then transfer power steering pump pulley.
6. Reverse to install. Torque attaching bolts to specifications.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal/Installation > Page 5608
Power Steering Pump: Service and Repair Disassembly/Assembly
CB Series Pump
Fig. 5 Exploded View Of CB Series Power Steering Pump
Fig. 6 Return Tube Removal. CB Series Power Steering Pump
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal/Installation > Page 5609
Fig. 7 Rotor And/Or Pump Ring Installation. CB Series Power Steering Pump
DISASSEMBLE
1. Disconnect battery ground cable, then remove power steering pump from vehicle. Refer to
individual car chapters for procedures. 2. Remove union fitting with O-ring and the O-ring seal, Fig.
5. 3. Remove control valve assembly and flow control spring. 4. Protect driveshaft with shim stock
and remove driveshaft seal by cutting with small chisel. Discard seal. 5. Remove return tube using
tap, nut and washers, Fig. 6, as follows. Plug return tube to prevent chips from entering pump.
a. Stack five 5/8 inch washers onto return tube. b. Run one 9/16 inch-12 nut midway up a 9/1 inch
12 tap. c. Install threaded end of tap into return tube until nut is positioned against washers. d.
Using wrench, hold top stationary while turning nut clockwise.
6. Remove end cover retaining ring by inserting punch in access hole. 7. Gently push on driveshaft
to assist in removing end cover, O-ring, pressure plate spring, pump ring, pump vanes and the
driveshaft subassembly,
consisting of pump rotor, thrust plate, driveshaft and shaft retaining ring.
8. Remove O-ring from housing. 9. Remove dowel pins, then the driveshaft seal if not previously
removed.
10. Remove pressure plate, pressure plate spring and O-ring from end cover. 11. Remove shaft
retaining ring from driveshaft, then the pump rotor and thrust plate.
INSPECTION
1. Clean all parts in power steering fluid, then dry thoroughly. 2. Inspect pump ring, vanes, thrust
plate, pressure plate and driveshaft for scoring, pitting or chatter marks, replacing parts as
necessary.
ASSEMBLE
1. Lubricate new driveshaft seal with power steering fluid and, using seal installer tool No. J 7728,
or equivalent, press driveshaft seal into pump
housing.
2. Install pump ring dowel pins into housing. 3. Install thrust plate and pump rotor onto driveshaft,
Fig. 7. 4. Install new shaft retaining ring onto driveshaft. 5. Install driveshaft subassembly into
housing. 6. Install pump ring with holes positioned correctly onto dowel pins, Fig. 7, in housing. 7.
Install vanes into pump rotor. 8. Lubricate new O-ring (large) with power steering fluid and install
O-ring into end cover. 9. Install pressure plate and pressure plate spring.
10. Lubricate new O-ring (small) and install O-ring into end cover.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal/Installation > Page 5610
11. Lubricate outer edge of end cover with power steering fluid and press end cover into housing.
12. Insert retaining ring into groove in housing, with ring opening near access hole opening. 13.
Remove plug and any chips, then coat end of new return tube with Loctite solvent part No. 75559
and Loctite adhesive part No. 290, or
equivalents and press return tube into housing until bottomed.
P Series L/Reservoir Pump
Fig. 9 Power Steering Pump Assembly Overhaul (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal/Installation > Page 5611
Fig. 9 Power Steering Pump Assembly Overhaul (Part 2 Of 2)
Reverse Rotation Pump
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal/Installation > Page 5612
Fig. 8 Power Steering Pump Assembly Overhaul. Reverse Rotation
DISASSEMBLE
1. Disconnect battery ground cable, then remove power steering pump from vehicle. Refer to
individual chassis chapter for procedure. 2. Remove retaining ring using punch in access hole, Fig.
8. 3. Remove internal components from pump assembly by gently pushing on driveshaft.
Components should include pressure plate and subassembly,
consisting of end cover, O-ring seal, pressure plate spring and pressure plate. Driveshaft
subassembly, consisting of pump rotor, thrust plate, driveshaft and shaft retaining ring.
4. Remove O-ring from pump housing. 5. Remove dowel pins and driveshaft seal. 6. Remove end
cover, pressure plate spring and O-ring from pressure plate. 7. Remove pump ring and vanes from
driveshaft subassembly, then shaft retaining rings from driveshaft.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal/Installation > Page 5613
8. Remove thrust plate and pump rotor from driveshaft.
INSPECTION
1. Clean all parts in power steering fluid, then dry thoroughly. 2. Inspect pump ring, vanes, thrust
plate, pressure plate, rotor and driveshaft for scoring, pitting or chatter marks, replacing parts as
necessary.
ASSEMBLE
1. Lubricate new driveshaft seal with power steering fluid and, using seal installer tool No. J 7728,
or equivalent, press driveshaft seal into pump
housing.
2. Install pump ring dowel pins into housing. 3. Install thrust plate and pump rotor onto driveshaft. 4.
Install new shaft retaining ring onto driveshaft. 5. Install driveshaft subassembly into housing. 6.
Install vanes into pump rotor. 7. Install pump ring, with holes positioned correctly onto dowel pins in
housing. 8. Lubricate new O-ring with power steering fluid and install O-ring into groove in pump
housing. 9. Install pressure plate and pressure plate spring.
10. Lubricate new O-ring and install O-ring into end cover. 11. Lubricate outer edge of end cover
with power steering fluid and press end cover into housing. 12. Insert retaining ring into groove in
housing, with ring opening near access hole opening. 13. Remove plug and any chips, then coat
end of new return tube with Loctite solvent 75559 and Loctite 290 adhesive, or equivalents, and
press return
tube into housing until bottomed.
TC Series Pump
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal/Installation > Page 5614
Fig. 11 Power Steering Pump Assembly Overhaul (Part 1 Of 4).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal/Installation > Page 5615
Fig. 11 Power Steering Pump Assembly Overhaul (Part 2 Of 4).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal/Installation > Page 5616
Fig. 11 Power Steering Pump Assembly Overhaul (Part 3 Of 4).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Power Steering > Power Steering Pump >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Removal/Installation > Page 5617
Fig. 11 Power Steering Pump Assembly Overhaul (Part 4 Of 4).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Center Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 5623
Center Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 5624
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Description and Operation
Power Steering Pressure Switch
PURPOSE
To sense high pressure in the steering box and signal the ECM to adjust the idle speed
accordingly.
OPERATION
The Power Steering Pressure Switch (PSPS) opens during high pressure power steering
situations. When the power steering switch is open, power to the A/C relay is shut "OFF," resulting
in A/C compressor clutch disengagement. Also, a signal is sent to the ECM. The ECM uses this
signal to compensate for the additional engine load by moving the IAC valve.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 5625
Power Steering Pressure Switch: Testing and Inspection
Chart C-1E
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Sensors and Switches - Steering > Power Steering
Pressure Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 5626
Power Steering Pressure Switch Circuit
Circuit Description:
The Power Steering Pressure (PSP) switch is normally open to ground and CKT 495 will be near
the battery voltage.
Turning the steering wheel increases power steering oil pressure and its load on an idling engine.
The pressure switch will close before the load can cause an idle problem.
Closing the switch causes CKT 495 to read less than 1 volt. The PCM will increase the idle air rate
and disengage the A/C relay.
^ A pressure switch that will not close or an open CKT 495 or 450, may cause the engine to stop
when power steering loads are high.
^ A switch that will not open, or a CKT 495 shorted to ground, may affect idle quality and will cause
the A/C relay to be de-energized.
Test Description: Number(s) below refer to circled number(s) on the diagnostic chart.
1. Different makes of scan tools may display the state of this switch in different ways. Refer to scan
tool operator's manual to determine how this
input is displayed.
2. Checks to determine if CKT 495 is shorted to ground.
3. This should simulate a closed switch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Column > Key Reminder Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 433211 > Nov > 94 > Steering Wheel - Noise at Right Dash Area When Turning
Steering Gear: Customer Interest Steering Wheel - Noise at Right Dash Area When Turning
File In Section: 3 - Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 43-32-11
Date: November, 1994
Subject: Crunch Noise from Right Side Dash Area when Turning Steering Wheel (Replace Steering
Grommet)
Models: 1991-94
Buick Skylark
1991-94 Chevrolet Beretta, Corsica, Cavalier
1991 Oldsmobile Cutlass Calais
1992-94 Oldsmobile Achieva
1991-94 Pontiac Grand Am, Sun bird
VIN Breakpoints: 1994 vehicles built prior to the following VIN numbers:
J Car: R7574194 (Pontiac Lordstown)
R7293501 (Chevrolet Lordstown) All "J" cars assembled in Ramos
L Car: RY250151
N Car: RM573861
RM037851 RC777220 RC285393
Condition
Some owners may comment on a brief crunch noise originating from the right side dash area as
the steering wheel is being turned. This noise would be more noticeable when the wheel has been
turned full right, then turned back to the left. This noise may be more noticeable when the vehicle is
stopped or moving slowly during parking maneuvers. Also, this noise would only occur during cold
temperatures below 4O°F (4°C).
Cause
The rubber grommets retaining the steering gear may flex and exhibit a crunch noise.
Correction
Install a new steering grommet, P/N 26047683, on the right side. The new grommet has a softer
compound to allow more compliance without crunching.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Labor Time
E9745 0.5 hr.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 333213 > Nov > 93 > Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull
Steering Gear: Customer Interest Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull
Group Ref.: Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 333213
Date: November, 1993
SUBJECT: VEHICLE MAY LEAD OR PULL (DIAGNOSE/SERVICE PROCEDURE)
MODELS: 1992-94 BUICK SKYLARK 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND
BERETTA 1992-94 OLDSMOBILE ACHIEVA 1992-94 PONTIAC SUNBIRD AND GRAND AM
CONDITION: Some owners may experience that the vehicle may lead or pull.
CORRECTION: DO NOT replace the steering gear to fix a lead or pull on 1993-94 vehicles as this
will not solve the problem. It may temporarily mask the problem due to the higher internal friction in
the new gear. However, the condition will resurface when the gear is worn in with mileage.
On 1992-94 vehicles, the following procedure should be followed for lead and pull conditions:
- Consult J/L/N lead/pull Corporate Bulletin # 073002. Previous divisional publication numbers
were:
Chevrolet 92-5O-3B
Pontiac 92-3-3
Oldsmobile 92-T-20
GM of Canada 92-3-110
- Consult J/L/N memory steer Corporate Bulletin # 233303R. Previous divisional publication
numbers were:
Chevrolet 93-171-3B
Buick 93-3-8
Pontiac 93-3-10
Oldsmobile 93-T-60
GM of Canada 93-3C-102
If the problem still exists, check system flows and pressures using gauge J 5176-D or J 25323-B.
System flow should be 1.9 gpm - 2.3 gpm, back pressure at or less than 100 psi with wheels
straight ahead and the engine at idle. If flows or pressures are out of specification, look for pinched
or crimped steering hoses and check for blockages by blowing air through the steering lines.
If problem still exists for 1992 V-6 vehicles only, evaluate vehicle for steering system induced
lead/pull by coasting with vehicle in neutral and engine off. Restart the vehicle. A steering induced
lead/pull will result in a significant, abrupt pull to the right. If this occurs, remove power steering
cooler lines from the steering system, (refer to Section 3B in the Service Manual). Use the following
hoses to connect directly from the steering gear to the pump reservoir inlet tube.
1. LHO engine (VIN T): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26038210
2. LG7 engine (VIN N): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26031205
If problem still persists on 1992 vehicles only, steering gear replacement can be attempted.
1993-94 vehicles have updated steering racks and should not require replacement for lead/pull
conditions. Also on 1993-94 vehicles, there are no cooler lines; therefore, the above by-pass hoses
do not apply. This is the latest information which should resolve any lead/pull conditions.
Parts are expected to be available on November 8, 1993.
WARRANTY INFORMATION: For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Number: T3385
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 333213 > Nov > 93 > Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull > Page 5643
Labor Time: 0.6 hr.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 83-32-10 > Nov > 98 > Tools - Adjuster Locknut Wrench
Steering Gear: All Technical Service Bulletins Tools - Adjuster Locknut Wrench
File In Section: 3 - Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 83-32-10
Date: November, 1998
INFORMATION
Subject: Essential Tool J 43435 Adjuster Locknut Wrench
Models: 1990-99 Passenger Cars and Trucks with Integral Power Steering
A new essential tool, J 43435 Adjuster Locknut Wrench, has been sent to all GM Dealers. This tool
should be used on all Integral power steering gears, both past and current models.
The following procedure should be used In place of existing Service Manual procedures for
Coupling Shield and Locknut Removal and Replacement. The correct adjustment procedure and
use of the essential tools are critical to restore the vehicle "On Center" feel (See Figure 1).
Important:
Coupling shield retainer and locknut assembly replacement procedures require the following
special tools:
J 42882 Adjuster Nut Wrench J 43435 Adjuster Locknut Wrench
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 83-32-10 > Nov > 98 > Tools - Adjuster Locknut Wrench > Page 5649
(See Figure 2)
Procedure
1. Place J 42882 over the end of the stub shaft. Place J 43435 over the end. J 43435 is reversible
and can be used with both old and new style coupling shield retainers and locknuts.
2. Tighten the coupling shield retainer and locknut assembly after an adjustment or repair has been
made to the power steering gear to the specified torque (See Figure 3).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 433211 > Nov > 94 > Steering Wheel - Noise at Right Dash Area When
Turning
Steering Gear: All Technical Service Bulletins Steering Wheel - Noise at Right Dash Area When
Turning
File In Section: 3 - Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 43-32-11
Date: November, 1994
Subject: Crunch Noise from Right Side Dash Area when Turning Steering Wheel (Replace Steering
Grommet)
Models: 1991-94
Buick Skylark
1991-94 Chevrolet Beretta, Corsica, Cavalier
1991 Oldsmobile Cutlass Calais
1992-94 Oldsmobile Achieva
1991-94 Pontiac Grand Am, Sun bird
VIN Breakpoints: 1994 vehicles built prior to the following VIN numbers:
J Car: R7574194 (Pontiac Lordstown)
R7293501 (Chevrolet Lordstown) All "J" cars assembled in Ramos
L Car: RY250151
N Car: RM573861
RM037851 RC777220 RC285393
Condition
Some owners may comment on a brief crunch noise originating from the right side dash area as
the steering wheel is being turned. This noise would be more noticeable when the wheel has been
turned full right, then turned back to the left. This noise may be more noticeable when the vehicle is
stopped or moving slowly during parking maneuvers. Also, this noise would only occur during cold
temperatures below 4O°F (4°C).
Cause
The rubber grommets retaining the steering gear may flex and exhibit a crunch noise.
Correction
Install a new steering grommet, P/N 26047683, on the right side. The new grommet has a softer
compound to allow more compliance without crunching.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Labor Time
E9745 0.5 hr.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 333213 > Nov > 93 > Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull
Steering Gear: All Technical Service Bulletins Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull
Group Ref.: Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 333213
Date: November, 1993
SUBJECT: VEHICLE MAY LEAD OR PULL (DIAGNOSE/SERVICE PROCEDURE)
MODELS: 1992-94 BUICK SKYLARK 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND
BERETTA 1992-94 OLDSMOBILE ACHIEVA 1992-94 PONTIAC SUNBIRD AND GRAND AM
CONDITION: Some owners may experience that the vehicle may lead or pull.
CORRECTION: DO NOT replace the steering gear to fix a lead or pull on 1993-94 vehicles as this
will not solve the problem. It may temporarily mask the problem due to the higher internal friction in
the new gear. However, the condition will resurface when the gear is worn in with mileage.
On 1992-94 vehicles, the following procedure should be followed for lead and pull conditions:
- Consult J/L/N lead/pull Corporate Bulletin # 073002. Previous divisional publication numbers
were:
Chevrolet 92-5O-3B
Pontiac 92-3-3
Oldsmobile 92-T-20
GM of Canada 92-3-110
- Consult J/L/N memory steer Corporate Bulletin # 233303R. Previous divisional publication
numbers were:
Chevrolet 93-171-3B
Buick 93-3-8
Pontiac 93-3-10
Oldsmobile 93-T-60
GM of Canada 93-3C-102
If the problem still exists, check system flows and pressures using gauge J 5176-D or J 25323-B.
System flow should be 1.9 gpm - 2.3 gpm, back pressure at or less than 100 psi with wheels
straight ahead and the engine at idle. If flows or pressures are out of specification, look for pinched
or crimped steering hoses and check for blockages by blowing air through the steering lines.
If problem still exists for 1992 V-6 vehicles only, evaluate vehicle for steering system induced
lead/pull by coasting with vehicle in neutral and engine off. Restart the vehicle. A steering induced
lead/pull will result in a significant, abrupt pull to the right. If this occurs, remove power steering
cooler lines from the steering system, (refer to Section 3B in the Service Manual). Use the following
hoses to connect directly from the steering gear to the pump reservoir inlet tube.
1. LHO engine (VIN T): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26038210
2. LG7 engine (VIN N): Power steering cooler by-pass hose # 26031205
If problem still persists on 1992 vehicles only, steering gear replacement can be attempted.
1993-94 vehicles have updated steering racks and should not require replacement for lead/pull
conditions. Also on 1993-94 vehicles, there are no cooler lines; therefore, the above by-pass hoses
do not apply. This is the latest information which should resolve any lead/pull conditions.
Parts are expected to be available on November 8, 1993.
WARRANTY INFORMATION: For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Number: T3385
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 333213 > Nov > 93 > Alignment - Vehicle May Lead or Pull > Page
5658
Labor Time: 0.6 hr.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Steering Gear: > 331106 > Dec > 93 > A/C - Water Leaking Into
Passenger Footwell Area
Air Duct: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Water Leaking Into Passenger Footwell Area
Group Ref.: HVAC Bulletin No.: 331106 Date: December, 1993
SUBJECT: WATER LEAKING INTO THE FOOTWELL OF THE RIGHT FRONT PASSENGER
AREA (REPOSITION AIR INLET TO FRONT OF DASH GASKET)
MODELS: 1994 CHEVROLET CAVALIER 1994 PONTIAC SUNBIRD
Vehicles affected were produced at Lordstown:
Chevrolet: S.O.P. to R7118284
Pontiac: S.O.P. to R7506224
CONDITION: Some owners may comment on water leaking into the footwell of the right front
passenger area.
CAUSE: This condition could be caused by a twisted gasket between the blower air inlet and the
front of dash.
CORRECTION: Remove the blower air inlet and reposition the gasket to seal completely around air
inlet and reinstall.
Follow service procedure outlined in Section 1A or 1B of the appropriate service manual.
WARRANTY INFORMATION: For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Number: D1870
Labor Time: Use published labor operation time.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 5669
Steering Gear: Specifications
Component ..........................................................................................................................................
....................................................... Torque/Ft. Lbs.
Adjuster Plug Locknut ..........................................................................................................................
............................................................................. 50 Coupling To Steering Shaft ..............................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.... 37 Coupling To Stub Shaft .............................................................................................................
......................................................................................... 34 Inner Tie Rod Bolts ...............................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............... 65 Pinion Locknut ................................................................................................................
................................................................................................... 26 Pinion Preload [01] .....................
..............................................................................................................................................................
........................ 16 Power Steering Line Fittings ..................................................................................
......................................................................................................... [02]
Rack & Pinion Mounting Clamp Nuts ..................................................................................................
............................................................................. 22 Rod & Piston Assembly To Rack ......................
..............................................................................................................................................................
... 65 Tie Rod End To Steering Knuckle ..............................................................................................
....................................................................................... 35 Tie Rod Pinch Bolts ................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
............. 41
[01] Inch lbs. [02] Valve end, 14 ft. lbs. cylinder end, 20 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Power Steering Gear
Steering Gear: Service and Repair Power Steering Gear
Fig. 9 Power Rack & Pinion Steering Gear Removal
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Remove left hand sound insulator. 3. From under instrument
panel, pull downward on steering column seal, then remove upper pinch bolt from flexible coupling
4. Raise and support front of vehicle, then remove both front wheel and tire assemblies. 5.
Disconnect tie rods from struts using tool No. J24319-01, then lower vehicle. 6. Remove steering
gear mounting clamps, Fig. 9. 7. Move steering gear assembly slightly forward, then remove lower
pinch bolt from flexible coupling and detach coupling from steering gear stub
shaft.
8. Remove dash panel seal from steering gear. 9. Raise and support front of vehicle, then remove
splash shield from left inner fender.
10. Place left hand knuckle and hub assembly in the full left turn position, then remove steering
gear through access hole in left hand inner fender. 11. Reverse procedure to install. Torque
attaching nuts, bolts and screws to specifications.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Power Steering Gear > Page 5672
Steering Gear: Service and Repair Saginaw Rack & Pinion Power Steering Gear
Outer Tie Rod
Fig. 24 Exploded View Of Power Rack & Pinion Assembly
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Power Steering Gear > Page 5673
Fig. 25 Outer Tie Rod Assembly
1. Remove cotter pin, then hex slotted nut from outer tie rod ball stud, Figs. 24 and 25. 2. Loosen
outer tie rod pinch bolts, then separate outer tie rod from steering knuckle using steering linkage
puller, tool No. J 24319-01, or equivalent. 3. Remove outer tie rod from tie rod adjuster. 4. Reverse
procedure to install, noting the following:
a. Torque hex slotted nut to 35 ft. lbs., with a maximum of 50 ft. lbs. to install cotter pin. b. Adjust
toe by turning tie rod adjuster. c. Torque pinch bolts to 41 ft. lbs.
Inner Tie Rod
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Power Steering Gear > Page 5674
Fig. 26 Inner Tie Rod Assembly
1. Remove and dispose of lock plate from inner tie rod bolts, Fig. 26. 2. Remove inner tie rod bolt.
3. Slide out and remove inner tie rod between bolt support plate and rack and pinion boot. If both
inner tie rods are to be removed, after
removing the first tie rod, reinstall bolt to keep rack and pinion and other parts aligned.
4. Reverse procedure to install. Ensure center housing cover washers are fitted into rack and
pinion boot. Torque inner tie rod bolts to 65 ft. lbs. and
install new lock plate with notches in proper position over flats of inner tie rod bolts.
Upper Pinion Bushing and Pinion Shaft Seal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Power Steering Gear > Page 5675
Fig. 36 Pinion Shaft Seal & Bushing Removal
1. Remove upper pinion bushing and seal with a forceful punch, then install new bushing, Fig. 36.
2. Using pinion seal installer, tool No. J 29822, or equivalent, seat new seal in housing with seal tip
facing up.
Boot or Rack Guide
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Power Steering Gear > Page 5676
Fig. 24 Exploded View Of Power Rack & Pinion Assembly
1. Cut off righthand mounting grommet and boot clamps, Fig. 24. 2. Slide boot retaining bushing
from rack and pinion boot. 3. Slide boot assembly from rack and pinion housing. 4. Remove insert
and rack guide assembly as necessary. 5. Slide boot retaining bushing from rack and pinion boot.
6. Slide new boot clamp onto rack and pinion boot. 7. Insert boot retaining bushing into rack and
pinion boot. 8. Coat inner lip of boot retaining bushing lightly with suitable grease to facilitate
assembly, then slide assembly onto housing assembly.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Power Steering Gear > Page 5677
9. Ensure center housing cover washers are in place on rack and pinion boot.
10. For ease of assembly, insert inner tie rod bolt through center housing cover washers, insert and
rack guide and lightly thread bolt into rod and rack
assembly to keep components in proper alignment.
11. Place boot retaining bushing onto cylinder tube of rack and pinion assembly, then slide into end
of rack and pinion boot. 12. Slide boot clamp over cylinder end of housing and position on rack and
pinion boot. 13. Slide rack and pinion boot and boot retaining bushing until seated in bushing
groove in housing. 14. Position boot clamp on rack and pinion boot and crimp clamp. 15. Position
bridge of boot clamp over split in boot retaining bushing and crimp clamp. Bridge of boot clamp
must be crimped over split in boot
retaining bushing to ensure proper sealing.
Rod/Rack and Cylinder Tube Assembly
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Power Steering Gear > Page 5678
Fig. 24 Exploded View Of Power Rack & Pinion Assembly
1. Remove dust cover from housing, Fig. 24. 2. While holding stub shaft, remove locknut from
pinion. 3. With gear centered, mark location of stub shaft notch on housing to aid in proper
installation of the pinion and valve assembly. 4. Using a suitable press, press on threaded end of
pinion until it is possible to remove the pinion and valve assembly from the housing. 5. Remove
stub shaft dust seal, stub shaft seal, stub shaft bearing annulus assembly, then the pinion and
valve assembly with spool shaft retaining
ring and valve body rings attached.
6. Using wrench, tool No. J 36343, or equivalent, remove cylinder tube assembly from housing.
Mark location of fittings on housing before
removal.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Power Steering Gear > Page 5679
7. Remove piston rod guide rack from housing and disassemble as follows:
a. Remove hex nut from rod and rack assembly. b. Remove rack piston with O-ring seal, piston ring
and piston rod guide assembly. c. Remove O-ring seal and piston rod seal from piston rod guide.
8. Remove retaining ring from housing. 9. Remove pinion bearing assembly from housing.
10. Remove pinion shaft seal and upper pinion bushing from housing. 11. Coat all seals with power
steering fluid. 12. Install upper pinion bushing into valve bore in housing. 13. Using seal installer
tool No. J 29822, or equivalent, seat pinion shaft seal into housing. 14. Using suitable press, install
pinion bearing assembly into housing. 15. Install retaining ring in groove in housing, positioning
properly. 16. Assemble piston rod seal and O-ring seal to piston rod guide. 17. Assemble O-ring
seal and piston ring to rack piston. 18. Slide seal back-up washer, piston rod guide assembly and
rack piston onto rod and rack assembly. 19. Install hex nut on rod and rack assembly. Torque to 30
ft. lbs. 20. Slide piston rod guide assembly into housing. 21. Apply one small drop of Loctite 242, or
equivalent, in three equally spaced locations around threaded portion of housing. Be sure to use
sealant
sparingly to ensure ease of removal of cylinder tube assembly if future repairs are necessary.
22. Slide cylinder tube assembly over rack piston ring to housing, then, using torque wrench, or
equivalent, torque to 82 ft. lbs. Be sure to align
fittings on cylinder tube with mark on housing before tightening to ensure cylinder line installation.
23. Assemble insert and rack guide assembly to rod and rack assembly in housing. 24. Center rack
guide assembly in housing window opening. 25. Using protector tool No. J 33057, or equivalent,
install pinion and valve assembly, together with new valve body rings, and spool shaft retaining
ring into housing. When pinion and valve assembly is fully seated in housing, notch in stub shaft
and mark on housing line up and insert and rack guide assembly is centered in window housing.
26. While holding stub shaft, torque locknut to 26 ft. lbs. 27. Install dust cover on housing. 28.
Install stub shaft bearing annulus assembly onto stub shaft and slide into housing. 29. Place seal
protector tool No. J 29810, or equivalent, onto stub shaft, then slide stub shaft seal and stub shaft
dust seal over protector and into
housing.
30. Install retaining ring into groove in housing. 31. Coat rack bearing, with O-ring seal attached,
adjuster spring and the adjuster plug with lithium base grease and install in housing. 32. With rack
centered in window in housing, turn adjuster plug clockwise until it bottoms in housing, then back
off 50-70 °. Check pinion preload
torque, which should not exceed 16 inch lbs.
32. Install locknut on adjuster plug and torque to 50 ft. lbs. while holding adjuster plug stationary.
Rack, Pinion Boot & Breather Tube
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Power Steering Gear > Page 5680
Fig. 15 Boot Replacement
Fig. 16 Boot Seal Application
REMOVAL
1. Remove outer tie rod. 2. Remove hex jam nut from inner tie rod assembly. 3. Remove tie rod
end clamp, Fig. 15, then remove and discard boot clamp with side cutters. 4. Mark location of
breather tube on housing before removing tube, then remove boot and breather tube.
INSTALLATION
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Power Steering Gear > Page 5681
1. Install new boot clamp onto boot. 2. Apply grease to inner tie rod or housing as shown in Fig. 16.
3. Align and install breather tube. 4. Install boot onto housing until seated in housing groove tang.
5. Position boot clamp on boot and crimp. 6. Position tie rod end clamp on boot and secure with
pliers.
Pinion and Valve Assembly
Fig. 34 Pinion & Valve Assembly
REMOVAL
1. Turn stub shaft until rack guide is equal distance from both sides of housing opening, then mark
location of stub shaft notch on housing, Fig. 34. 2. Using a suitable press, press on threaded end of
pinion until it is possible to remove valve and pinion assembly from housing. 3. Replace valve body
rings if necessary.
Rack Bearing Preload
ON VEHICLE ADJUSTMENT
Make adjustment with front wheels raised and steering wheel centered. Ensure the steering wheel
returns to the center position after adjustment. 1. Loosen locknut, then turn adjuster plug clockwise
until it bottoms in housing, then back off 35 ° to 45 °. 2. Torque locknut to adjuster plug to 50 ft. lbs.
while holding adjuster plug.
Pinion Bearing Assembly
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Power Steering Gear > Page 5682
Fig. 36 Pinion Shaft Seal & Bushing Removal
1. Remove bearing retainer ring, Fig. 35. 2. Using a drift or punch, gently tap on bearing until
removed. 3. To install, use a suitable socket and press on outer race of bearing until firmly seated.
4. Install retaining ring.
Inner Pivot Bushing
Fig. 27 Inner Pivot Bushing Replacement
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Power Steering Gear > Page 5683
Refer to Fig. 27 for replacement procedure.
Flange and Steering Coupling Assembly
Fig. 28 Flange & Steering Coupling Assembly
1. Remove rack and pinion assembly from vehicle. 2. Remove pinch bolt from flange and steering
coupling assembly, then the coupling, Fig. 28 3. Reverse procedure to install. Torque pinch bolt to
29 ft. lbs.
Hydraulic Cylinder Lines
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Power Steering Gear > Page 5684
Fig. 24 Exploded View Of Power Rack & Pinion Assembly
Refer to Fig. 24 for replacement procedure. Ensure new O-rings are installed. Torque line fittings at
valve end to 14 ft. lbs. and at cylinder end to 20 ft. lbs.
Rack Guide
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Power Steering Gear > Page 5685
Fig. 24 Exploded View Of Power Rack & Pinion Assembly
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Power Steering Gear > Page 5686
Fig. 25 Outer Tie Rod Assembly
Fig. 26 Inner Tie Rod Assembly
REMOVAL
1. Remove rack and pinion steering assembly from vehicle. 2. Remove lock plate from inner tie rod
bolts and discard, Figs. 24 and 29. 3. Remove inner tie rod bolts, bolt support plate, cylinder lines
and inner tie rod assemblies. 4. Cut and remove mounting grommet and boot clamp.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Power Steering Gear > Page 5687
5. Slide boot retaining bushing from rack and pinion boot, then boot assembly from rack and pinion
housing. 6. Insert rack guide assembly from rod and rack assembly if necessary.
Fig. 27 Inner Pivot Bushing Replacement
Fig. 28 Flange & Steering Coupling Assembly
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Power Steering Gear > Page 5688
Fig. 29 Boot & Rack Guide Assembly
INSTALLATION
1. Slide boot retaining bushing from rack and pinion housing. 2. Slide new boot clamp on rack and
pinion boot and install boot retaining bushing into rack and pinion boot. 3. Install rack guide on
rack. 4. Coat inner lip of boot retaining bushing lightly with grease, then install boot on housing.
Ensure center housing cover washers are in place on boot. 5. Install inner tie rod bolts through
cover washers and rack and pinion boot. Screw into rack lightly. 6. Slide boot and boot retaining
bushing until seated in bushing groove in housing. Crimp new boot clamp. 7. Slide other end of
boot into boot groove on cylinder end of housing. 8. Slide other end of boot into boot groove on
cylinder end of housing and crimp new boot clamp. Bridge of boot clamp must be crimped over
split in boot retaining bushing to ensure proper sealing, Fig. 30.
9. Install new lock plate with notches in proper position over flats of inner tie rod bolts.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Power Steering Gear > Page 5689
Fig. 30 Boot Clamp Position
Rack Bearings
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Power Steering Gear > Page 5690
Fig. 31 Rack Bearing Assembly
REMOVAL
1. Remove rack and pinion assembly from vehicle. 2. Remove adjuster plug nut from adjuster plug,
then adjuster plug from housing, Fig. 31. 3. Remove adjuster spring and rack bearing with O-ring
seal attached.
Stub Shaft Seals and Upper Bearing
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Power Steering Gear > Page 5691
Fig. 33 Stub Shaft Seals & Upper Bearing Assembly
REMOVAL
1. Remove rack and pinion assembly from vehicle. 2. Remove retaining ring and dust cover, Fig.
33. 3. While holding stub shaft, remove locknut from pinion. If stub shaft is not held, damage to
pinion teeth will occur. 4. Using a suitable press, press on threaded end of pinion until flush with
ball bearing assembly. Complete removal of valve and pinion assembly is
not required.
5. Remove stub shaft dust seal, stub shaft seal and stub shaft bearing annulus assembly from
valve end of housing.
Removal/Installation
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Gear > Component Information > Service
and Repair > Power Steering Gear > Page 5692
Fig. 9 Power Rack & Pinion Steering Gear Removal
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove left hand sound insulator.
3. From under instrument panel, pull downward on steering column seal, then remove upper pinch
bolt from flexible coupling.
4. Disconnect pressure line from steering gear and remove screw attaching line bracket to cowl.
5. Raise and support front of vehicle, then remove both front wheel and tire assemblies.
6. Disconnect tie rods from struts using tool No. J24319-01, then lower vehicle.
7. Remove steering gear mounting clamps, Fig. 9.
8. Move steering gear slightly forward, then disconnect return line from gear and drain power
steering fluid.
9. Remove lower pinch bolt from flexible coupling, then detach coupling from steering gear stub
shaft and remove dash seal.
10. Raise and support front of vehicle, then remove splash shield from left inner fender.
11. Place steering knuckle and hub assembly into the full left turn position, then remove steering
gear through access hole in left hand inner fender.
12. Reverse procedure to install, noting the following: a. If steering gear mounting clamps have
backed out during removal, install double nuts on stud and Torque to 22 ft. lbs. b. Torque coupling
to stub shaft pinch bolt to 30 ft. lbs. c. Torque pressure and return line fittings to specifications.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Steering Wheel > Component Information > Service
and Repair
Steering Wheel: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove steering wheel center pad attaching screws.
3. Disconnect horn electrical connector, then remove steering wheel center pad.
4. Remove steering wheel retaining nut and retainer.
5. Remove steering dampener, if equipped.
6. Scribe alignment marks on steering wheel and shaft to aid installation.
7. Using tool J-1859-03 or BT-61-9 or equivalent, remove steering wheel from shaft.
8. Reverse procedure to install. Torque steering wheel attaching nut to 30 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Tie Rod Boot > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Rack, Pinion Boot & Breather Tube
Tie Rod Boot: Service and Repair Rack, Pinion Boot & Breather Tube
Fig. 15 Boot Replacement
Fig. 16 Boot Seal Application
REMOVAL
1. Remove outer tie rod. 2. Remove hex jam nut from inner tie rod assembly. 3. Remove tie rod
end clamp, Fig. 15, then remove and discard boot clamp with side cutters.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Tie Rod Boot > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Rack, Pinion Boot & Breather Tube > Page 5701
4. Mark location of breather tube on housing before removing tube, then remove boot and breather
tube.
INSTALLATION
1. Install new boot clamp onto boot. 2. Apply grease to inner tie rod or housing as shown in Fig. 16.
3. Align and install breather tube. 4. Install boot onto housing until seated in housing groove tang.
5. Position boot clamp on boot and crimp. 6. Position tie rod end clamp on boot and secure with
pliers.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Tie Rod Boot > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Rack, Pinion Boot & Breather Tube > Page 5702
Tie Rod Boot: Service and Repair Boot or Rack Guide
Fig. 24 Exploded View Of Power Rack & Pinion Assembly
1. Cut off righthand mounting grommet and boot clamps, Fig. 24. 2. Slide boot retaining bushing
from rack and pinion boot. 3. Slide boot assembly from rack and pinion housing. 4. Remove insert
and rack guide assembly as necessary.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Tie Rod Boot > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Rack, Pinion Boot & Breather Tube > Page 5703
5. Slide boot retaining bushing from rack and pinion boot. 6. Slide new boot clamp onto rack and
pinion boot. 7. Insert boot retaining bushing into rack and pinion boot. 8. Coat inner lip of boot
retaining bushing lightly with suitable grease to facilitate assembly, then slide assembly onto
housing assembly. 9. Ensure center housing cover washers are in place on rack and pinion boot.
10. For ease of assembly, insert inner tie rod bolt through center housing cover washers, insert and
rack guide and lightly thread bolt into rod and rack
assembly to keep components in proper alignment.
11. Place boot retaining bushing onto cylinder tube of rack and pinion assembly, then slide into end
of rack and pinion boot. 12. Slide boot clamp over cylinder end of housing and position on rack and
pinion boot. 13. Slide rack and pinion boot and boot retaining bushing until seated in bushing
groove in housing. 14. Position boot clamp on rack and pinion boot and crimp clamp. 15. Position
bridge of boot clamp over split in boot retaining bushing and crimp clamp. Bridge of boot clamp
must be crimped over split in boot
retaining bushing to ensure proper sealing.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Tie Rod End > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Outer Tie Rod
Tie Rod End: Service and Repair Outer Tie Rod
Fig. 24 Exploded View Of Power Rack & Pinion Assembly
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Tie Rod End > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Outer Tie Rod > Page 5708
Fig. 25 Outer Tie Rod Assembly
1. Remove cotter pin, then hex slotted nut from outer tie rod ball stud, Figs. 24 and 25. 2. Loosen
outer tie rod pinch bolts, then separate outer tie rod from steering knuckle using steering linkage
puller, tool No. J 24319-01, or equivalent. 3. Remove outer tie rod from tie rod adjuster. 4. Reverse
procedure to install, noting the following:
a. Torque hex slotted nut to 35 ft. lbs., with a maximum of 50 ft. lbs. to install cotter pin. b. Adjust
toe by turning tie rod adjuster. c. Torque pinch bolts to 41 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Tie Rod End > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Outer Tie Rod > Page 5709
Tie Rod End: Service and Repair Inner Tie Rod
Fig. 26 Inner Tie Rod Assembly
1. Remove and dispose of lock plate from inner tie rod bolts, Fig. 26. 2. Remove inner tie rod bolt.
3. Slide out and remove inner tie rod between bolt support plate and rack and pinion boot. If both
inner tie rods are to be removed, after
removing the first tie rod, reinstall bolt to keep rack and pinion and other parts aligned.
4. Reverse procedure to install. Ensure center housing cover washers are fitted into rack and
pinion boot. Torque inner tie rod bolts to 65 ft. lbs. and
install new lock plate with notches in proper position over flats of inner tie rod bolts.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Steering > Tie Rod > Tie Rod End > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Outer Tie Rod > Page 5710
Tie Rod End: Service and Repair Inner Pivot Bushings
Fig. 27 Inner Pivot Bushing Replacement
Refer to Fig. 27 for replacement procedure.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Axle Beam > Component Information >
Specifications
Tightening Specifications
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Axle Beam > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 5715
Axle Beam: Service and Repair
Fig. 2 Rear Suspension Exploded View
1. Raise vehicle and support vehicle. Support rear suspension with suitable jack.
2. Disconnect stabilizer bar at axle assembly, if equipped, Fig. 2.
3. Remove rear wheel assembly and brake drum. Do not hammer on brake drum since damage to
bearings may result.
4. Remove shock absorber to lower mounting bracket attaching bolts, then disconnect shock
absorbers from axle assembly, Fig. 2.
5. Disconnect parking brake cable and brake lines at axle brackets.
6. Carefully lower rear axle assembly and remove coil springs and insulators.
7. Remove control arm to underbody bracket bolts, then lower the axle assembly and remove from
vehicle.
8. Remove hub to rear axle attaching bolts, then the hubs, bearings and backing plates from rear
axle assembly.
9. Reverse procedure to install and bleed brake system.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection
Ball Joint: Testing and Inspection
1. Raise and support vehicle so that suspension is allowed to hang free.
2. Grasp wheel and tire assembly at top and bottom, then rock top of wheel and tire assembly
inward and outward.
3. While rocking wheel and tire assembly, observe movement between steering knuckle and
control arm. If any horizontal movement is present, replace ball joint.
4. If ball joint is disconnected from steering knuckle, use finger to try to twist ball joint in its socket.
If ball joint can be twisted in its socket, replace ball joint.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Ball Joint > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 5719
Ball Joint: Service and Repair
Fig. 7 Assembling Lower Ball Joint To Lower Control Arm
1. Raise and support vehicle, then remove wheel and tire. 2. Install modified tool No. J 34754, or
equivalent, then remove ball joint attaching cotter pin. 3. Remove ball joint stud retaining nut, then
using tool No. J-38892, or equivalent, separate ball joint from steering knuckle. 4. Using a 1/8 inch
drill, drill pilot holes completely through the rivets. Using a 1/2 inch drill, drill final holes through
rivets to ensure fitting of new
ball joint.
5. Loosen stabilizer shaft assembly bushing attaching nut. 6. Remove ball joint from steering
knuckle and control arm. 7. Assemble new ball joint to lower control arm with bolts provided in
service package, Fig. 7. Tighten bolts to specification. 8. Insert ball joint stud into steering knuckle
and tighten nut to specifications. 9. Install wheel and tire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Control Arm > Control Arm Bushing >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Control Arm Bushing: Service and Repair
Fig. 4. Control Arm Bushing Removal And Installation
1. Raise rear of vehicle and support rear axle under front side of spring seat using a suitable jack.
2. Remove wheel and tire assembly.
3. If right hand side bushing is to be replaced, disconnect brake line bracket from body. If left hand
side bushing is to be replaced, disconnect brake line bracket from frame and parking brake cable at
hook guide.
4. Remove control arm to mounting bracket attaching nut, bolt and washer, then allow control arm
to rotate downward.
5. The bushing can now be replaced using tools shown in Fig. 4. When installing bushing, the
arrow on the installer must align with arrow on the receiver, Fig. 4.
6. Reverse procedure to complete installation. The control arm attaching bolt must be torqued after
vehicle is lowered to floor and is in its standing height position. Torque attaching bolt to
specifications.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Front Steering Knuckle > Component Information
> Service and Repair
Front Steering Knuckle: Service and Repair
1. Raise and support vehicle, then remove wheel and tire.
2. Remove front hub and bearing. Refer to Transmission and Drivetrain / Drive Axles, Bearings and
Joints / Wheel Bearing. See: Wheel Bearing/Service and Repair
3. Using tool J-29330, on 1989-90 models or J-38892, on 1991-92 models, separate ball joint from
steering knuckle.
4. Remove strut to steering knuckle attaching bolts, then disconnect strut from steering knuckle.
5. Assemble strut to new steering knuckle and install attaching bolts finger tight.
6. Insert ball joint stud into steering knuckle and torque stud nut to specification.
7. Torque strut to steering knuckle bolts to specification.
8. Reverse removal procedure to complete installation.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Spindle > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Recalls: > NHTSA94V115000 > Jun > 94 > Recall 94V115000: Drive Axle Spindle Nuts Defect
Spindle: Recalls Recall 94V115000: Drive Axle Spindle Nuts Defect
THESE VEHICLES WERE BUILT WITH OVERTORQUED DRIVE AXLE SPINDLE NUTS. THIS
CONDITION CAN CAUSE EXCESSIVE LOADS ON THE SPINDLE NUT AND DRIVE AXLE
RESULTING IN FAILURE OF THE DRIVE AXLE OR THE SPINDLE NUT. FAILURE OF EITHER
OF THESE COMPONENTS CAN RESULT IN SEPARATION OF THE STEERING KNUCKLE
TIRE-WHEEL ASSEMBLY FROM THE DRIVE AXLE. THIS CAN RESULT IN LOSS OF VEHICLE
CONTROL AND A VEHICLE ACCIDENT. DEALERS WILL REPLACE THE LEFT-HAND AND
RIGHT-HAND DRIVE AXLES, BEARING-HUB ASSEMBLIES, SPINDLE NUTS, AND WASHERS
ON ALL INVOLVED VEHICLES.
CORRECTIVE ACTION: DEALERS WILL REPLACE LEFT-HAND AND RIGHT-HAND DRIVE
AXLES, BEARING-HUB ASSEMBLIES, SPINDLE NUTS, AND WASHERS ON ALL INVOLVED
VEHICLES.
SYSTEM: SUSPENSION; INDEPENDENT FRONT SPINDLE; KNUCKLE; STEERING.
VEHICLE DESCRIPTION: PASSENGER CARS.
NOTE: IF YOUR VEHICLE IS PRESENTED TO AN AUTHORIZED DEALER ON AN AGREED
UPON SERVICE DATE AND THE REMEDY IS NOT PROVIDED WITHIN A REASONABLE TIME
AND FREE OF CHARGE OR THE REMEDY DOES NOT CORRECT THE DEFECT OR
NONCOMPLIANCE, PLEASE CONTACT CHEVROLET SERVICE CENTER AT 1-800-222-1020
OR PONTIAC SERVICE CENTER AT1-800-762-2737. ALSO, CONTACT THE NATIONAL
HIGHWAY TRAFFIC SAFETY ADMINISTRATION'S AUTO SAFETY HOTLINE AT
1-800-424-9393.
1994 CHEVROLET CAVALIER 1994 PONTIAC SUNBIRD
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Spindle > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > NHTSA94V115000 > Jun > 94 > Recall 94V115000: Drive Axle Spindle
Nuts Defect
Spindle: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 94V115000: Drive Axle Spindle Nuts Defect
THESE VEHICLES WERE BUILT WITH OVERTORQUED DRIVE AXLE SPINDLE NUTS. THIS
CONDITION CAN CAUSE EXCESSIVE LOADS ON THE SPINDLE NUT AND DRIVE AXLE
RESULTING IN FAILURE OF THE DRIVE AXLE OR THE SPINDLE NUT. FAILURE OF EITHER
OF THESE COMPONENTS CAN RESULT IN SEPARATION OF THE STEERING KNUCKLE
TIRE-WHEEL ASSEMBLY FROM THE DRIVE AXLE. THIS CAN RESULT IN LOSS OF VEHICLE
CONTROL AND A VEHICLE ACCIDENT. DEALERS WILL REPLACE THE LEFT-HAND AND
RIGHT-HAND DRIVE AXLES, BEARING-HUB ASSEMBLIES, SPINDLE NUTS, AND WASHERS
ON ALL INVOLVED VEHICLES.
CORRECTIVE ACTION: DEALERS WILL REPLACE LEFT-HAND AND RIGHT-HAND DRIVE
AXLES, BEARING-HUB ASSEMBLIES, SPINDLE NUTS, AND WASHERS ON ALL INVOLVED
VEHICLES.
SYSTEM: SUSPENSION; INDEPENDENT FRONT SPINDLE; KNUCKLE; STEERING.
VEHICLE DESCRIPTION: PASSENGER CARS.
NOTE: IF YOUR VEHICLE IS PRESENTED TO AN AUTHORIZED DEALER ON AN AGREED
UPON SERVICE DATE AND THE REMEDY IS NOT PROVIDED WITHIN A REASONABLE TIME
AND FREE OF CHARGE OR THE REMEDY DOES NOT CORRECT THE DEFECT OR
NONCOMPLIANCE, PLEASE CONTACT CHEVROLET SERVICE CENTER AT 1-800-222-1020
OR PONTIAC SERVICE CENTER AT1-800-762-2737. ALSO, CONTACT THE NATIONAL
HIGHWAY TRAFFIC SAFETY ADMINISTRATION'S AUTO SAFETY HOTLINE AT
1-800-424-9393.
1994 CHEVROLET CAVALIER 1994 PONTIAC SUNBIRD
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Spindle > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Spindle: > 331106 > Dec > 93 > A/C - Water Leaking Into Passenger
Footwell Area
Air Duct: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Water Leaking Into Passenger Footwell Area
Group Ref.: HVAC Bulletin No.: 331106 Date: December, 1993
SUBJECT: WATER LEAKING INTO THE FOOTWELL OF THE RIGHT FRONT PASSENGER
AREA (REPOSITION AIR INLET TO FRONT OF DASH GASKET)
MODELS: 1994 CHEVROLET CAVALIER 1994 PONTIAC SUNBIRD
Vehicles affected were produced at Lordstown:
Chevrolet: S.O.P. to R7118284
Pontiac: S.O.P. to R7506224
CONDITION: Some owners may comment on water leaking into the footwell of the right front
passenger area.
CAUSE: This condition could be caused by a twisted gasket between the blower air inlet and the
front of dash.
CORRECTION: Remove the blower air inlet and reposition the gasket to seal completely around air
inlet and reinstall.
Follow service procedure outlined in Section 1A or 1B of the appropriate service manual.
WARRANTY INFORMATION: For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Number: D1870
Labor Time: Use published labor operation time.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Shaft <--> [Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control]
> Stabilizer Bushing > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Stabilizer Bushing: >
73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > Interior - Squawk From Front Suspension Or Engine Area
Stabilizer Bushing: Customer Interest Interior - Squawk From Front Suspension Or Engine Area
File In Section: 3 - Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 73-33-01A
Date: December, 1997
Subject: Squawk Noise Coming from Front Suspension or Engine Compartment Area (Install Ultra
High Molecular Tape)
Models: 1993-98 Buick Skylark 1993-94 Chevrolet Cavalier 1993-96 Chevrolet Beretta, Corsica
1993-98 Oldsmobile Achieva 1993-94 Pontiac Sunbird 1993-98 Pontiac Grand Am
This bulletin is being revised to add the 1998 model for the N-Car and eliminate VIN Breakpoints.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 73-33-01 (Section 3 - Steering/Suspension).
Condition
Some owners may comment on a "squawk" noise coming from the front suspension or engine
compartment area. This noise may be more noticeable over small bumps, entering parking lots,
and including any irregular road surfaces. This condition may also be more noticeable in cold
weather conditions.
Cause
The squawk noise may be caused by the rubber stabilizer bushing material bleeding through the
Teflon/Polyester sock (on later models) and coming into contact with the stabilizer shaft. On earlier
models, the squawk may be caused from friction when the stabilizer bushing is grabbing and
releasing the stabilizer shaft.
Correction
If the above conditions exist, perform the following repair:
1. Remove front stabilizer bushing clamps and bushings. Refer to Section 3C of the Service
Manual.
2. Inspect stabilizer bushings for visible wear, replace if necessary.
3. Use crocus cloth (or equivalent) to sand the stabilizer shaft where the stabilizer bushings contact
the stabilizer shaft. Sand all rough corrosion thoroughly. Do not remove paint if it is intact.
4. Install UHM (Ultra High Molecular) tape (provided in kit, P/N 22602686) into stabilizer bushing;
adhesive side of tape should be installed onto the bushing. Install UHM tape to the opening of the
bushing (the slit) as well as the circumference (this will secure the tape in place). Kit provides
enough tape for two bushings (one vehicle).
5. Reassemble.
Parts Information
P/N Description
22602686 Service Kit (Consists of Tape and Instruction Sheet)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Shaft <--> [Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control]
> Stabilizer Bushing > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Stabilizer Bushing: >
73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > Interior - Squawk From Front Suspension Or Engine Area > Page 5759
Stabilizer Bushings Only
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Labor Time
E2180 Use published labor operation time
Add 0.9 hr
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Shaft <--> [Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control]
> Stabilizer Bushing > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Stabilizer
Bushing: > 73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > Interior - Squawk From Front Suspension Or Engine Area
Stabilizer Bushing: All Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Squawk From Front Suspension Or
Engine Area
File In Section: 3 - Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 73-33-01A
Date: December, 1997
Subject: Squawk Noise Coming from Front Suspension or Engine Compartment Area (Install Ultra
High Molecular Tape)
Models: 1993-98 Buick Skylark 1993-94 Chevrolet Cavalier 1993-96 Chevrolet Beretta, Corsica
1993-98 Oldsmobile Achieva 1993-94 Pontiac Sunbird 1993-98 Pontiac Grand Am
This bulletin is being revised to add the 1998 model for the N-Car and eliminate VIN Breakpoints.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 73-33-01 (Section 3 - Steering/Suspension).
Condition
Some owners may comment on a "squawk" noise coming from the front suspension or engine
compartment area. This noise may be more noticeable over small bumps, entering parking lots,
and including any irregular road surfaces. This condition may also be more noticeable in cold
weather conditions.
Cause
The squawk noise may be caused by the rubber stabilizer bushing material bleeding through the
Teflon/Polyester sock (on later models) and coming into contact with the stabilizer shaft. On earlier
models, the squawk may be caused from friction when the stabilizer bushing is grabbing and
releasing the stabilizer shaft.
Correction
If the above conditions exist, perform the following repair:
1. Remove front stabilizer bushing clamps and bushings. Refer to Section 3C of the Service
Manual.
2. Inspect stabilizer bushings for visible wear, replace if necessary.
3. Use crocus cloth (or equivalent) to sand the stabilizer shaft where the stabilizer bushings contact
the stabilizer shaft. Sand all rough corrosion thoroughly. Do not remove paint if it is intact.
4. Install UHM (Ultra High Molecular) tape (provided in kit, P/N 22602686) into stabilizer bushing;
adhesive side of tape should be installed onto the bushing. Install UHM tape to the opening of the
bushing (the slit) as well as the circumference (this will secure the tape in place). Kit provides
enough tape for two bushings (one vehicle).
5. Reassemble.
Parts Information
P/N Description
22602686 Service Kit (Consists of Tape and Instruction Sheet)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Stabilizer Shaft <--> [Stabilizer Bar, Sway Control]
> Stabilizer Bushing > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Stabilizer
Bushing: > 73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > Interior - Squawk From Front Suspension Or Engine Area > Page 5765
Stabilizer Bushings Only
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Labor Time
E2180 Use published labor operation time
Add 0.9 hr
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ): Service and Repair
Fig. 2 Rear Suspension Exploded View
Fig. 3 Coil Spring Installation
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Spring ( Coil / Leaf ) > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 5769
1. Raise and support rear of vehicle. Support rear axle using a suitable jack.
2. Remove wheel and tire assemblies.
3. Remove brake line bracket attaching bolts from frame, Fig. 2, and allow brake lines to hang
freely.
4. Remove shock absorber to lower mounting bracket bolts, then disconnect shock absorbers from
axle assembly. Do not suspend rear axle by brake hoses since damage to hoses may result.
5. Carefully lower rear axle assembly and remove springs and insulators.
6. Reverse procedure to install. Position ends of upper coil in seat of body and within limits shown
in Fig. 3.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Suspension - Shock Absorber/Strut Leakage Information
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Technical Service Bulletins Suspension - Shock
Absorber/Strut Leakage Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-03-08-002C
Date: October 16, 2009
Subject: Information on Replacement of Shock Absorbers and Struts Due to Fluid Leaks
Models:
2010 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2010 model year and Inspection Procedures.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-08-002B (Section 03 - Suspension).
This bulletin is intended to help identify the severity of shock absorber and strut fluid seepage.
Improper diagnosis may lead to components being replaced that are within the manufacturer's
specification. Shock absorbers and strut assemblies are fluid-filled components and will normally
exhibit some seepage. Seepage is defined as oil film or dust accumulation on the exterior of the
shock housing. Shock absorbers and struts are not to be replaced under warranty for seepage.
Use the following information to determine if the condition is normal acceptable seepage or a
defective component.
Important Electronically controlled shock absorbers (MR) may have a tendency to attract dust to
this oil film. Often this film and dust can be wiped off and will not return until similar mileage is
accumulated again.
Inspection Procedure
Note
The shock absorber or strut assembly DOES NOT have to be removed from the vehicle to perform
the following inspection procedure.
Use the following descriptions and graphics to determine the serviceability of the component.
Shock Absorbers
Do Not Replace shock absorbers displaying condition 1 or 2 levels of seepage.
1. Oil or fluid residue only on the bottom or top of the shock absorber and not originating from the
shaft seal (the upper part of the lower shock tube). 2. Light film/residue on approximately 1/3 (a) or
less of the lower shock tube (A) and originating from the shaft seal.
Replace shock absorbers displaying conditions 3 and 4 levels of leaks.
3. Oil drip or trail down the lower shock tube and originating from the shaft seal. 4. An extreme wet
film of oil covering more than 1/3 (b) of the lower shock tube and originating from the shaft seal.
Coil-over Shock Absorber
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Suspension - Shock Absorber/Strut Leakage Information > Page 5774
Do Not Replace coil-over shock absorbers displaying condition 1 or 2 levels of seepage.
1. Oil or fluid residue only on the bottom of the lower shock absorber tube or the coil-over shock
absorber components and not originating from the
shaft seal (located at the top of the coil-over shock tube).
2. Light film/residue on the shock absorber tube, but not on the spring seat and originating from the
shaft seal.
Replace coil-over shock absorbers displaying conditions 3 and 4 levels of leaks.
3. Oil drip or trail down the lower shock tube and originating from the shaft seal. 4. An extreme, wet
film of oil covering the shock absorber tube and pooling in the spring seat and originating from the
shaft seal.
Struts
Do Not Replace Struts displaying condition 1 or 2 levels of seepage.
1. Oil or fluid residue only on the bottom of the strut tube or on other strut components and not
originating from the shaft seal. 2. Light film/residue on the strut tube, but not on the spring seat and
originating from the shaft seal.
Replace Struts displaying conditions 3 and 4 levels of leaks.
3. Oil drip or trail down the strut tube and originating from the shaft seal (located at the top of the
strut tube). 4. Extreme wet film of oil covering the strut tube and pooling in the spring seat and
originating from the shaft seal.
Correction
Use the information published in SI for diagnosis and repair.
Use the applicable published labor operation.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Suspension - Shock Absorber/Strut Leakage Information > Page 5775
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Technical Service Bulletins Suspension - Shock
Absorber/Strut Replacement Guidlines
File In Section: Warranty Administration
Bulletin No.: 72-05-12
Date: January, 1998
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
Subject: Replacement of Shock Absorbers and Struts Labor Operations E3800, E3801, E3807,
E5800, E5801, E5807, E3850, E3851, E3857, E5750, E5751, and E5757
Models: All Past, Present, and Future Passenger Cars & Trucks
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide retail and wholesale service personnel with enhanced
service policies for the above listed subject labor operations.
Service Management should make certain that all dealership personnel responsible for
replacement of suspension components are familiar with GM Service Manual procedures.
Effective with repair orders dated on or after January 15, 1998 the following must also be followed:
- Shock absorber/strut assemblies are fluid filled components and will normally exhibit seepage.
Seepage is defined as oil film or dust accumulation on the exterior of the shock housing. Shock
absorber/strut assemblies are not to be replaced under warranty or seepage.
- Defective shock absorber/strut assemblies will have a visible oil path or drip coming from the
component. A visible oil path or drip coming from the shock absorber/strut assembly should be
replaced as a defective component.
- Only defective shock absorber/strut assemblies should be replaced. DO NOT replace pairs unless
both are defective, unless otherwise instructed in the Service Manual and/or Service Bulletin.
- Service Management approval is required on the repair order for replacement of struts or shocks
in pairs. This approval includes noting the reason for replacement.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Shock Absorber Replace
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Service and Repair Shock Absorber Replace
Fig. 2 Rear Suspension Exploded View
1. Open deck lid, then remove trim cover and shock absorber upper retaining nut.
2. Raise rear of vehicle and support rear axle using a suitable jack.
3. Remove shock absorber lower attaching bolt, then disconnect shock absorber from mounting
bracket, Fig. 2. Remove shock absorber from vehicle.
4. Reverse procedure to install. Torque attaching bolt to specification.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Shock Absorber Replace > Page 5778
Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber: Service and Repair Front Suspension
Removal/Installation
Fig. 7 Installing Strut Assembly
1. Raise hood and remove strut protective cap and three strut to body attaching nuts. 2. Raise and
support vehicle, support suspension using suitable jack stands. 3. Remove wheel and tire
assembly, then install modified inner drive joint boot protector tool No. J-34754, or equivalent. 4.
Using tool J-24319, or equivalent, disconnect tie rod from strut assembly. 5. Remove strut to
steering knuckle attaching bolts, Fig. 7, then remove strut from vehicle. 6. Reverse procedure to
install.
Disassembly/Assembly
Disassembly
1. Position strut compressor J-34013 in holding fixture J-3289-20.
2. Position strut in strut compressor, then compress strut approximately 1/2 of its height. Use care
not to bottom spring or damper rod.
3. Remove nut from strut dampener shaft, then position guide rod J-34013-27 on dampener shaft.
Use guide rod J-34013-27 to position dampener shaft down through bearing cap while
compressing coil spring.
4. Remove components from coil strut unit.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Suspension Strut / Shock Absorber > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Shock Absorber Replace > Page 5779
Fig. 8 Assembling Strut Unit
Assembly
1. Position bearing cap on strut compressor.
2. Position strut to strut compressor and install compressor bottom locking pin.
3. Extend dampener shaft and install clamp J-34013-20 to hold shaft in position, Fig. 8.
4. Position spring over dampener, then position strut to strut compressor upper locking pin hole and
install pin.
5. Install upper insulator, shield, bumper and upper spring seat. The flat on the upper spring seat
should face in the same direction as the centerline of the strut assembly spindle, Fig. 8.
6. Install guide rod J-34013-27 onto dampener shaft, the compress strut unit until dampener shaft
threads are visible. Remove guide rod and install retaining nut.
7. While holding dampener shaft in position with a suitable wrench, torque retaining nut to
specification. After tightening nut, remove clamp from dampener shaft clamp J-34013-20.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Specifications
Front Suspension
Hub and Bearing Assembly to Steering Knuckle Bolts
........................................................................................................................ 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Wheel Bearing Removal and Installation
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front Wheel Bearing Removal and Installation
FRONT WHEEL BEARINGS AND/OR HUB
Fig. 2 Modified Outer Seal Protector
Fig. 3 Removing And Installing Shaft Nut
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Remove tire and wheel assembly, then install modified outer seal
protector No. J 34754 or equivalent, Fig. 2. 3. Insert a drift punch through the rotor, Fig. 3 , then
remove axle shaft nut and washer. 4. Remove ball joint, then using tool No. J-28733-A, or
equivalent, disengage axle from hub and bearing assembly. 5. On all models, move axle shaft
inward, then remove caliper attaching bolts and support caliper. 6. Remove brake rotor, then hub
and bearing assembly attaching bolts. 7. Remove hub and bearing assembly.
INSTALLATION
1. Install hub and bearing assembly, tighten attaching bolts to specification. 2. Install hub and
bearing seal, then the brake rotor. 3. Install caliper, tighten attaching bolts to specification. 4. Move
axle shaft outward, then insert drift punch through rotor, Fig. 3. 5. Install washer and new shaft nut,
tighten shaft nut to specification. 6. Install ball joint, then remove drift punch and seal protector. 7.
Install tire and wheel assembly, then lower vehicle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Wheel Bearing Removal and Installation > Page 5785
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear
REAR HUB AND/OR BEARINGS
1. Raise and support vehicle, then remove wheel and tire assembly and brake drum.
CAUTION: Do not hammer brake drum since damage to bearing may result.
2. Remove four hub/bearing assembly to rear axle attaching bolts, then the hub/bearing assembly
from axle.
NOTE: The upper rear hub attaching bolt may not clear brake shoe when removing hub and
bearing assembly. Partially remove hub and bearing assembly prior to removing this bolt.
3. Reverse procedure to install. Torque hub attaching bolts to specification.
CAUTION: Use care not to drop hub/bearing assembly since damage to bearing may result.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Suspension > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component Information
> Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
Component ..........................................................................................................................................
....................................................... Torque/Ft. Lbs.
Axle Nut ...............................................................................................................................................
............................................................................ 184
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires
Tires: Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-03-10-020C
Date: April 27, 2010
Subject: Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 05-03-10-020B (Section 03 - Suspension).
GM's Position on the Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires
General Motors does not oppose the use of purified nitrogen as an inflation gas for tires. We expect
the theoretical benefits to be reduced in practical use due to the lack of an existing infrastructure to
continuously facilitate inflating tires with nearly pure nitrogen. Even occasional inflation with
compressed atmospheric air will negate many of the theoretical benefits. Given those theoretical
benefits, practical limitations, and the robust design of GM original equipment TPC tires, the
realized benefits to our customer of inflating their tires with purified nitrogen are expected to be
minimal.
The Promise of Nitrogen: Under Controlled Conditions
Recently, nitrogen gas (for use in inflating tires) has become available to the general consumer
through some retailers. The use of nitrogen gas to inflate tires is a technology used in automobile
racing. The following benefits under controlled conditions are attributed to nitrogen gas and its
unique properties:
- A reduction in the expected loss of Tire Pressure over time.
- A reduction in the variance of Tire Pressures with temperature changes due to reduction of water
vapor concentration.
- A reduction of long term rubber degradation due to a decrease in oxygen concentrations.
Important These are obtainable performance improvements when relatively pure nitrogen gas is
used to inflate tires under controlled conditions.
The Promise of Nitrogen: Real World Use
Nitrogen inflation can provide some benefit by reducing gas migration (pressure loss) at the
molecular level through the tire structure. NHTSA (National Highway Traffic Safety Administration)
has stated that the inflation pressure loss of tires can be up to 5% a month. Nitrogen molecules are
larger than oxygen molecules and, therefore, are less prone to "seeping" through the tire casing.
The actual obtainable benefits of nitrogen vary, based on the physical construction and the
materials used in the manufacturing of the tire being inflated.
Another potential benefit of nitrogen is the reduced oxidation of tire components. Research has
demonstrated that oxygen consumed in the oxidation process of the tire primarily comes from the
inflation media. Therefore, it is reasonable to assume that oxidation of tire components can be
reduced if the tire is inflated with pure nitrogen. However, only very small amounts of oxygen are
required to begin the normal oxidation process. Even slight contamination of the tire inflation gas
with compressed atmospheric air during normal inflation pressure maintenance, may negate the
benefits of using nitrogen.
GM Tire Quality, Technology and Focus of Importance
Since 1972, General Motors has designed tires under the TPC (Tire Performance Criteria)
specification system, which includes specific requirements that ensure robust tire performance
under normal usage. General Motors works with tire suppliers to design and manufacture original
equipment tires for GM vehicles. The GM TPC addresses required performance with respect to
both inflation pressure retention, and endurance properties for original equipment tires. The
inflation pressure retention requirements address availability of oxygen and oxidation concerns,
while endurance requirements ensure the mechanical structure of the tire has sufficient strength.
This combination has provided our customers with tires that maintain their structural integrity
throughout their useful treadlife under normal operating conditions.
Regardless of the inflation media for tires (atmospheric air or nitrogen), inflation pressure
maintenance of tires is critical for overall tire, and ultimately, vehicle performance. Maintaining the
correct inflation pressure allows the tire to perform as intended by the vehicle manufacturer in
many areas, including comfort, fuel economy, stopping distance, cornering, traction, treadwear,
and noise. Since the load carrying capability of a tire is related to inflation pressure, proper inflation
pressure maintenance is necessary for the tire to support the load imposed by the vehicle without
excessive structural
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires > Page 5795
degradation.
Important Regardless of the inflation media for tires (atmospheric air or nitrogen), inflation pressure
maintenance of tires is critical for overall tire, and ultimately, vehicle performance.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires > Page 5796
Tires: Technical Service Bulletins Tires/Wheels - Tire Puncture Repair Procedures
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-03-10-001F
Date: April 27, 2010
Subject: Tire Puncture Repair Procedures For All Cars and Light Duty Trucks
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-03-10-001E (Section 03 - Suspension).
This bulletin covers puncture repair procedures for passenger car and light duty truck radial tires in
the tread area only. The tire manufacturer must be contacted for its individual repair policy and
whether or not the speed rating is retained after repair.
Caution
- Tire changing can be dangerous and should be done by trained professionals using proper tools
and procedures. Always read and understand any manufacturer's warnings contained in their
customers literature or molded into the tire sidewall.
- Serious eye and ear injury may result from not wearing adequate eye and ear protection while
repairing tires.
- NEVER inflate beyond 275 kPa (40 pounds) pressure to seat beads.
Some run flat tires, such as the Goodyear Extended Mobility Tire (EMT) used on the Corvette, may
require more than 275 kPa (40 psi) to seat the bead. In such a case, a tire safety cage must be
used. Consult the tire manufacturer for its individual repair policy.
- NEVER stand, lean or reach over the assembly during inflation.
Repairable area on a radial tire.
Important
- NEVER repair tires worn to the tread indicators 1.59 mm (2/32") remaining depth).
- NEVER repair tires with a tread puncture larger than 6.35 mm (1/4").
- NEVER substitute an inner tube for a permissible or non-permissible repair.
- NEVER perform an outside-in tire repair (plug only, on the wheel).
- Every tire must be removed from the wheel for proper inspection and repair.
- Regardless of the type of repair used, the repair must seal the inner liner and fill the injury.
- Consult with repair material supplier/manufacturer for repair unit application procedures and
repair tools/repair material recommendations.
Three basic steps for tire puncture repair:
1. Remove the tire from the wheel for inspection and repair.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires > Page 5797
2. Fill the injury (puncture) to keep moisture out. 3. Seal the inner liner with a repair unit to prevent
air loss.
External Inspection
1. Prior to demounting, inspect the tire surface, the valve and the wheel for the source of the leak
by using a water and soap solution. Mark the
injured area and totally deflate the tire by removing the valve core.
2. Demount the tire from the wheel and place the tire on a well-lighted spreader.
Internal Inspection
1. Spread the beads and mark the puncture with a tire crayon. 2. Inspect the inner tire for any signs
of internal damage. 3. Remove the puncturing object, noting the direction of the penetration. 4.
Probe the injury with a blunt awl in order to determine the extent and direction of the injury. 5.
Remove any loose foreign material from the injury. 6. Punctures exceeding 6.35 mm (1/4") should
not be repaired.
Cleaning
1. Clean the area around the puncture thoroughly with a proper liner cleaner, clean cloth and a
scraper. This step serves to remove dirt and mold
lubricants to insure proper adhesion and non-contamination of the buffing tool.
2. Refer to information on the product or manufacturer's Material Safety Data Sheet and follow
guidelines for handling and disposal.
Clean the Injury Channel
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires > Page 5798
1. Use a proper hand reamer, carbide cutter or drill bit to ream the puncture channel from the inside
of the tire in order to clean the injury. 2. Remove steel wires protruding above the liner surface to
prevent damage to the repair unit. 3. Consult your repair material supplier for recommended
reaming tool(s).
Fill the Injury
1. It is necessary to fill the injury channel to provide back up for the repair unit and to prevent
moisture from entering the tire fabric and steel wires. 2. (For combination repair/plug units skip this
step.) Cement the injured channel and fill the injury from the inside of the tire with the repair plug
per
repair material manufacturer's recommendations. Without stretching the plug, cut the plug off just
above the inside tire surface.
3. Consult your repair material supplier for proper repair material selection.
Repair Unit Selection
Important Do not install the repair unit in this step.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires > Page 5799
1. Center the repair unit over the injury as a reference and outline an area larger than the unit so
that buffing will not remove the crayon marks. 2. Remove the repair unit. 3. DO NOT overlap
previous or multiple repair units. 4. Consult your repair material supplier for proper repair unit
selection.
Buffing
1. To prevent contamination and preserve the outline, buff within the marked area thoroughly and
evenly with a low speed buffing tool using a fine
wire brush or gritted rasp.
2. Buff to a smooth velvet surface (RMA #1 or #2 buffed texture). 3. Use caution not to gouge the
inner liner or expose casing fabric. 4. Remove any buffing dust with a vacuum cleaner. 5. Consult
your repair material supplier for a proper buffing tool.
Cementing
Apply chemical cement according to the repair material manufacturer's procedures.
Repair Unit Application
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires > Page 5800
1. The tire must be in the relaxed position when the repair unit is installed (Do not spread the beads
excessively).
Two-Piece Plug and Repair Units
1. If applicable, install the repair unit so that the alignment is correct. 2. Center the repair unit over
the injury and stitch down thoroughly with the stitching tool, working from the center out.
3. Being careful not to stretch the plug material, cut the plug flush with the outer tread.
Combination Repair/Plug Units
1. Pull the plug through the injury until the repair just reaches the liner. Stitch down thoroughly. 2.
Follow the repair material manufacturer's recommendations for further installation instructions.
2. Consult your repair material supplier for the proper stitching tool.
Safety Cage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires > Page 5801
Some run flat tires, such as the Goodyear Extended Mobility Tire (EMT) used on the Corvette, may
require more than 275 kPa (40 psi) to seat the bead. In such a case, a tire safety cage must be
used. Consult the tire manufacturer for its individual repair policy.
Final Inspection
1. After remounting and inflating the tire, check both beads, the repair and the valve with a water
and soap solution in order to detect leaks. 2. If the tire continues to lose air, the tire must be
demounted and reinspected. 3. Balance the tire and wheel assembly. Refer to Tire and Wheel
Assembly Balancing - OFF Vehicle.
For additional tire puncture repair information, contact:
Rubber Manufacturers Association (RMA)
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires > Page 5802
Tires: Technical Service Bulletins Tires - Correct Inflation Pressure Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-00-90-002J
Date: January 28, 2009
Subject: Information on Proper Tire Pressure
Models: 2010 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2009 and
Prior HUMMER H2, H3, H3T 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years and clarify additional information. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 00-00-90-002I (Section 00 - General Information).
Important:
^ Adjustment of tire pressure for a customer with a Low Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) light on and
no codes in the TPM system is NOT a warrantable repair. Claims to simply adjust the tire pressure
will be rejected.
^ ALL tires (including the spare tire) MUST be set to the recommended inflation pressure stated on
the vehicle's tire placard (on driver's door) during the PRE-DELIVERY INSPECTION (PDI).
Recommended inflation pressure is not the pressure printed on tire sidewall.
^ Tires may be over-inflated from the assembly plant due to the mounting process.
^ Generally a 5.6°C (10°F) temperature change will result in (is equivalent to) a 6.9 kPa (1 psi) tire
pressure change.
^ 2008-2009 HUMMER H2 Only - The H2 comes standard with Light Truck "D" Load Range tires
with a recommended cold inflation pressure of 289 kPa (42 psi). These tires will alert the driver to a
low pressure situation at roughly 262 kPa (38 psi) due to a requirement in FMVSS 138 which
specifies a Minimum Activation Pressure for each tire type. This creates a relatively narrow window
of "usable" pressure values and the warning will be more sensitive to outside temperature changes
during the colder months. As with other cold temperature/tire pressure issues, there is nothing
wrong with the system itself. If a vehicle is brought in with this concern, check for tire damage and
set all tires to the Recommended Cold Inflation Pressure shown on the vehicle placard.
Accurate tire pressures ensure the safe handling and appropriate ride characteristics of GM cars
and trucks. It is critical that the tire pressure be adjusted to the specifications on the vehicle¡C■s
tire placard during PDI.
Ride, handling and road noise concerns may be caused by improperly adjusted tire pressure.
The first step in the diagnosis of these concerns is to verify that the tires are inflated to the correct
pressures. The recommended tire inflation pressure is listed on the vehicle¡C■s tire placard. The
tire placard is located on the driver¡C■s side front or rear door edge, center pillar, or the rear
compartment lid.
Tip
^ Generally a 5.6°C (10°F) temperature increase will result in (is equivalent to) a 6.9 kPa (1 psi) tire
pressure increase.
^ The definition of a "cold" tire is one that has been sitting for at least 3 hours, or driven no more
than 1.6 km (1 mi).
^ On extremely cold days, if the vehicle has been indoors, it may be necessary to compensate for
the low external temperature by adding additional air to the tire during PDI.
^ During cold weather, the Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) indicator light (a yellow horseshoe with an
exclamation point) may illuminate. If this indicator turns off after the tires warm up (reach operating
temperature), the tire pressure should be reset to placard pressure at the cold temperature.
^ The TPM system will work correctly with nitrogen in tires.
^ The TPM system is compatible with the GM Vehicle Care Tire Sealant but may not be with other
commercially available sealants.
Important:
^ Do not use the tire pressure indicated on the tire itself as a guide.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires > Page 5803
^ Always inspect and adjust the pressure when the tires are cold.
^ Vehicles that have different pressures for the front and the rear need to be adjusted after tire
rotation.
Improper tire inflation may result in any or all of the following conditions:
^ Premature tire wear
^ Harsh ride
^ Excessive road noise
^ Poor handling
^ Reduced fuel economy
^ Low Tire Pressure Monitor (TPM) Light ON
^ Low Tire Pressure Message on the Drivers Information Center (DIC)
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires > Page 5804
Tires: Technical Service Bulletins Tires - Speed Rated Information
Group Ref.: 3 - Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 433502
Date: July, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: SPEED RATED TIRES
MODELS: 1995 AND PRIOR YEAR PASSENGER CARS AND LIGHT DUTY TRUCKS
All original equipment passenger car and light duty truck tires used by General Motors have a
speed rating symbol molded on their sidewall. This speed symbol, along with the tire's load index,
make up the service description that follows the tire's size. The original equipment tire size, speed
rating, and recommended inflation pressure are listed on the tire placard usually located on the
driver's door edge. WHEN REPLACING TIRES, NEVER INSTALL A TIRE THAT IS A SMALLER
SIZE OR LESSER SPEED RATING THAN THAT USED AS ORIGINAL EQUIPMENT. As in the
past, it is recommended that replacement tires have a TPC (Tire Performance Criteria) number on
the sidewall that is identical to that on the original tires.
Common speed rating on tires used by General Motors are as follows: (see illustration)
IMPORTANT:
Most base all season tires and touring tires used by GM are S rated. Performance tires will usually
have a higher speed rating. High performance tires are usually Z rated. Z rated tires carry the Z
symbol within the tire size, rather than after the size in the service description. These speeds apply
only at the tire's full pressure. An underinflated tire will not meet its speed rating capability.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Tires > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Wheels/Tires - Use of Nitrogen Gas in Tires > Page 5805
Tires: Technical Service Bulletins Tires - Manufacturers' Assistance
Group Ref.: Steering/ Suspension Bulletin No.: 323501 Date: December, 1993
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: TIRE MANUFACTURERS' CONTACTS FOR ASSISTANCE
MODELS: 1991-94 PASSENGER CARS AND TRUCKS
General Tire has established a "Tire Fix" Department to assist you with anything from a tire
adjustment to the location of the nearest General Tire dealer. "Tire Fix" representatives are
available Monday through Friday from 8:00 A.M. to 6:00 P.M. Eastern Time at 1-800-847-3349.
A General Tire Brochure is provided for review with all appropriate dealer personnel. A single
contact point at General Tire can assist you with most aspects of their product to satisfy your
customers' needs.
Other tire manufacturers can be contacted for assistance at the Toll Free Numbers listed in
illustration:
Please retain this information for future reference.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation
(RFV)
Wheels: Customer Interest Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV)
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-03-10-006F
Date: May 04, 2010
Subject: Information on Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009
and Prior Saab 9-7X 2000-2005 Saturn L Series 2003-2007 Saturn ION
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to considerably expand the available information on
Radial Force Variation (RFV) and should be reviewed in whole. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-03-10-006E (Section 03 - Suspension).
Important
- Before measuring tires on equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700, the vehicle MUST be driven
a minimum of 16 km (10 mi) to ensure removal of any flat-spotting. Refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 03-03-10-007E - Tire/Wheel Characteristics of GM Original Equipment Tires.
- Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 MUST be calibrated prior to measuring tire/wheel
assemblies for each vehicle.
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide guidance to GM dealers when using tire force variation
measurement equipment, such as the Hunter GSP9700. This type of equipment can be a valuable
tool in diagnosing vehicle ride concerns. The most common ride concern involving tire radial force
variation is highway speed shake on smooth roads.
Tire related smooth road highway speed shake can be caused by three conditions: imbalance, out
of round and tire force variation. These three conditions are not necessarily related. All three
conditions must be addressed.
Imbalance is normally addressed first, because it is the simpler of the three to correct. Off-vehicle,
two plane dynamic wheel balancers are readily available and can accurately correct any
imbalance. Balancer calibration and maintenance, proper attachment of the wheel to the balancer,
and proper balance weights, are all factors required for a quality balance. However, a perfectly
balanced tire/wheel assembly can still be "oval shaped" and cause a vibration.
Before balancing, perform the following procedures.
Tire and Wheel Diagnosis
1. Set the tire pressure to the placard values. 2. With the vehicle raised, ensure the wheels are
centered on the hub by loosening all wheel nuts and hand-tightening all nuts first by hand while
shaking the wheel, then torque to specifications using a torque wrench, NOT a torque stick.
3. Visually inspect the tires and the wheels. Inspect for evidence of the following conditions and
correct as necessary:
- Missing balance weights
- Bent rim flange
- Irregular tire wear
- Incomplete bead seating
- Tire irregularities (including pressure settings)
- Mud/ice build-up in wheel
- Stones in the tire tread
- Remove any aftermarket wheels and/or tires and restore vehicle to original condition prior to
diagnosing a smooth road shake condition.
4. Road test the vehicle using the Electronic Vibration Analyzer (EVA) essential tool. Drive for a
sufficient distance on a known, smooth road
surface to duplicate the condition. Determine if the vehicle is sensitive to brake apply. If the brakes
are applied lightly and the pulsation felt in the steering wheel increases, refer to the Brakes section
of the service manual that deals with brake-induced pulsation. If you can start to hear the vibration
as a low boom noise (in addition to feeling it), but cannot see it, the vehicle likely has a first order
(one pulse per propshaft revolution) driveline vibration. Driveline first order vibrations are high
enough in frequency that most humans can start to hear them at highway speeds, but are too high
to be able to be easily seen. These issues can be caused by driveline imbalance or misalignment.
If the vehicle exhibits this low boom and the booming pulses in-and-out on a regular basis (like a
throbbing), chances are good that the vehicle could have driveline vibration. This type
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation
(RFV) > Page 5814
of vibration is normally felt more in the "seat of the pants" than the steering wheel.
5. Next, record the Hertz (Hz) reading as displayed by the EVA onto the tire data worksheet found
at the end of this bulletin. This should be done
after a tire break-in period of at least 16 km (10 mi) at 72 km/h (45 mph) or greater, in order to
eliminate any possible tire flat-spotting. This reading confirms what the vehicle vibration frequency
is prior to vehicle service and documents the amount of improvement occurring as the result of the
various steps taken to repair. Completing the Steering Wheel Shake Worksheet below is required.
A copy of the completed worksheet must be saved with the R.O. and a copy included with any
parts returned to the Warranty Parts Center for analysis. A reading of 35 to 50 Hz typically
indicates a first order propshaft vibration. If this is the situation, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
08-07-30-044D. Generally, a reading between 10 and 20 Hz indicates a tire/wheel vibration and if
this is the reading obtained, continue using this bulletin. If the tire 1st order vibration goes away
and stays away during this evaluation, the cause is likely tire flat-spotting. Tire flat-spotting vibration
may come and go at any speed over 72 km/h (45 mph) during the first 10 minutes of operation, if
vibration continues after 10 minutes of driving at speeds greater than 72 km/h (45 mph), tire
flat-spotting can be ruled out as the cause for vibration.
6. If flat-spotting is the cause, provide the explanation that this has occurred due to the vehicle
being parked for long periods of time and that the
nature of the tire is to take a set. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 03-03-10-007E: Information
on Tire/Wheel Characteristics (Vibration, Balance, Shake, Flat Spotting) of GM Original Equipment
Tires.
7. If the road test indicates a shake/vibration exists, check the imbalance of each tire/wheel
assembly on a known, calibrated, off-car dynamic
balancer.Make sure the mounting surface of the wheel and the surface of the balancer are
absolutely clean and free of debris. Be sure to chose the proper cone/collet for the wheel, and
always use the pilot bore for centering. Never center the wheel using the hub-cap bore since it is
not a precision machined surface. If any assembly calls for more than 1/4 ounce on either rim
flange, remove all balance weights and rebalance to as close to zero as possible. If you can see
the vibration (along with feeling it) in the steering wheel (driving straight without your hands on the
wheel), it is very likely to be a tire/wheel first order (one pulse per revolution) disturbance. First
order disturbances can be caused by imbalance as well as non-uniformities in tires, wheels or
hubs. This first order frequency is too low for a human to hear, but if the amplitude is high enough,
it can be seen.
If a vibration or shake still exists after balancing, any out of round conditions, of the wheel, and
force variation conditions of the tire, must be addressed. Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700
can address both (it is also a wheel balancer).
Tire radial force vibration (RFV) can be defined as the amount of stiffness variation the tire will
produce in one revolution under a constant load. Radial force variation is what the vehicle feels
because the load (weight) of the vehicle is always on the tires. Although free runout of tires (not
under load) is not always a good indicator of a smooth ride, it is critical that total tire/wheel
assembly runout be within specification.
Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 loads the tire, similar to on the vehicle, and measures
radial force variation of the tire/wheel assembly. Note that the wheel is affecting the tire's RFV
measurement at this point. To isolate the wheel, its runout must be measured. This can be easily
done on the Hunter, without the need to set up dial indicators. If the wheel meets the runout
specification, the tire's RFV can then be addressed.
After measuring the tire/wheel assembly under load, and the wheel alone, the machine then
calculates (predicts) the radial force variation of the tire. However, because this is a prediction that
can include mounting inaccuracies, and the load wheel is much smaller in diameter than used in
tire production, this type of service equipment should NOT be used to audit new tires. Rather, it
should be used as a service diagnostic tool to minimize radial force variation of the tire/wheel
assembly.
Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 does an excellent job of measuring wheel runout, and of
finding the low point of the wheel (for runout) and the high point of the tire (for radial force
variation). This allows the tire to be matched mounted to the wheel for lowest tire/wheel assembly
force variation.
The machine will simplify this process into easy steps. The following assembly radial force variation
numbers should be used as a guide:
When measuring RFV and match mounting tires perform the following steps.
Measuring Wheel Runout and Assembly Radial Force Variation
Important The completed worksheet at the end of this bulletin must be attached to the hard copy of
the repair order.
- Measure radial force variation and radial runout.
- If a road force/balancing machine is used, record the radial force variation (RFV) on the
worksheet at the end of this bulletin. It may be of benefit to have the lowest RFV assembly to the
front left corner. If the machine is not available and the EVA data suggests there is an issue, swap
the tire and wheel assemblies from the front to the back. Re-check on the EVA and if the problem
still exists, test another vehicle to find tires that do not exhibit the same frequency and swap those
tires onto the subject vehicle.
- If a runout/balancing machine is used, record the radial runout of the tire/wheel assemblies on the
worksheet at the end of this bulletin. If one or more of the tire/wheel assemblies are more than.040
in (1.02 mm), match mount the tire to the wheel to get below.040 in (1.02 mm). For sensitive
customers, readings of 0.030 inch (0.76 mm) or less are preferable, it may also be of benefit to
have the lowest runout assembly to the front left corner. If the machine is not available and the
EVA data suggests there is an issue, swap the tire and wheel assemblies from the front to the
back. Re-check on the EVA and if the problem still exists, test another vehicle to find tires that do
not exhibit the same frequency and swap those tires
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation
(RFV) > Page 5815
onto the subject vehicle.
- After match mounting, the tire/wheel assembly must be rebalanced.
If match mounting tires to in-spec wheels produces assembly values higher than these, tire
replacement may be necessary. Replacing tires at lower values will probably mean good tires are
being condemned. Because tires can sometimes become temporarily flat-spotted, which will affect
force variation, it is important that the vehicle be driven at least 16 km (10 mi) prior to measuring.
Tire pressure must also be adjusted to the usage pressure on the vehicle's tire placard prior to
measuring.
Most GM vehicles will tolerate radial force variation up to these levels. However, some vehicles are
more sensitive, and may require lower levels. Also, there are other tire parameters that equipment
such as the Hunter GSP9700 cannot measure that may be a factor. In such cases, TAC should be
contacted for further instructions.
Important
- When mounting a GM wheel to a wheel balancer/force variation machine, always use the wheel's
center pilot hole. This is the primary centering mechanism on all GM wheels; the bolt holes are
secondary. Usually a back cone method to the machine should be used. For added accuracy and
repeatability, a flange plate should be used to clamp the wheel onto the cone and machine. This
system is offered by all balancer manufacturers in GM's dealer program.
- Any type of service equipment that removes tread rubber by grinding, buffing or truing is NOT
recommended, and may void the tire warranty. However, tires may have been ground by the tire
company as part of their tire manufacturing process. This is a legitimate procedure.
Steering Wheel Shake Worksheet
When diagnosing vibration concerns, use the following worksheet in conjunction with the
appropriate Vibration Analysis-Road testing procedure in the Vibration Correction sub-section in SI.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation
(RFV) > Page 5816
Refer to the appropriate section of SI for specifications and repair procedures that are related to the
vibration concern.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-03-10-003F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast
Aluminum Wheels
Wheels: Customer Interest Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 05-03-10-003F
Date: April 27, 2010
Subject: Low Tire Pressure, Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels (Repair with Adhesive Sealant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X with Cast Aluminum Wheels
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years and the bulletin reference
information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-10-003E (Section 03 - Suspension).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a low tire pressure condition.
Diagnosis of the low tire pressure condition indicates an air leak through the cast aluminum wheel.
Cause
Porosity in the cast aluminum wheel may be the cause.
Notice
This bulletin specifically addresses issues related to the wheel casting that may result in an air
leak. For issues related to corrosion of the wheel in service, please refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-03-10-006C - Tire Slowly Goes Flat, Tire Air Loss, Low Tire Pressure Warning Light
Illuminated, Aluminum Wheel Bead Seat Corrosion (Clean and Resurface Wheel Bead Seat).
Correction
1. Remove the tire and wheel assembly from the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate service
procedure in SI. 2. Locate the leaking area by inflating the tire to 276 kPa (40 psi) and dipping the
tire/wheel assembly in a water bath, or use a spray bottle with soap
and water to locate the specific leak location.
Important
- If the porosity leak is located in the bead area of the aluminum rim (where the tire meets the rim),
the wheel should be replaced.
- If two or more leaks are located on one wheel, the wheel should be replaced.
3. If air bubbles are observed, mark the location.
- If the leak location is on the tire/rubber area, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 04-03-10-001F Tire Puncture Repair Procedures for All Cars and Light Duty Trucks.
- If the leak is located on the aluminum wheel area, continue with the next step.
4. Inscribe a mark on the tire at the valve stem in order to indicate the orientation of the tire to the
wheel. 5. Dismount the tire from the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 6. Remove
the tire pressure sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor removal procedure in SI. 7. Scuff the
INSIDE rim surface at the leak area with #80 grit paper and clean the area with general purpose
cleaner, such as 3M(R) General Purpose
Adhesive Cleaner, P/N 08984, or equivalent.
8. Apply a 3 mm (0.12 in) thick layer of Silicone - Adhesive/Sealant, P/N 12378478 (in Canada, use
88900041), or equivalent, to the leak area. 9. Allow for the adhesive/sealant to dry.
Notice Caution must be used when mounting the tire so as not to damage the sealer. Damaging
the repair area may result in an air leak.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-03-10-003F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast
Aluminum Wheels > Page 5821
10. Align the inscribed mark on the tire with the valve stem on the wheel. 11. Reinstall the Tire
Pressure Sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor installation procedure in SI. 12. Mount the tire on
the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 13. Pressurize the tire to 276 kPa (40 psi) and
inspect for leaks. 14. Adjust tire pressure to meet the placard specification. 15. Balance the
tire/wheel assembly. Refer to Tire and Wheel Assembly Balancing - Off-Vehicle. 16. Install the tire
and wheel assembly onto the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate service procedure in SI.
Parts Information
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
Important The Silicone - Adhesive/Sealant comes in a case quantity of six. ONLY charge warranty
one tube of adhesive/sealant per wheel repair.
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
One leak repair per wheel.
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Staining/Pitting/Corrosion
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-03-10-002F
Date: April 21, 2011
Subject: Chemical Staining, Pitting, Corrosion and/or Spotted Appearance of Chromed Aluminum
Wheels
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years, suggest additional restorative
products and add additional corrosion information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
00-03-10-002E (Section 03 - Suspension). Important You may give a copy of this bulletin to the
customer.
What is Chemical Staining of Chrome Wheels? Figure 1
Chemical staining in most cases results from acid based cleaners (refer to Figure 1 for an
example). These stains are frequently milky, black, or greenish in appearance. They result from
using cleaning solutions that contain acids on chrome wheels. Soap and water is usually sufficient
to clean wheels.
If the customer insists on using a wheel cleaner they should only use one that specifically states
that it is safe for chromed wheels and does not contain anything in the following list. (Dealers
should also survey any products they use during prep or normal cleaning of stock units for these
chemicals.)
- Ammonium Bifluoride (fluoride source for dissolution of chrome)
- Hydrofluoric Acid (directly dissolves chrome)
- Hydrochloric Acid (directly dissolves chrome)
- Sodium Dodecylbenzenesulfonic Acid
- Sulfamic Acid
- Phosphoric Acid
- Hydroxyacetic Acid
Notice
Many wheel cleaner instructions advise to take care to avoid contact with painted surfaces. Most
customers think of painted surfaces as the fenders, quarter panels and other exterior sheet metal.
Many vehicles have painted brake calipers. Acidic wheel cleaners may craze, crack, or discolor the
paint on the brake calipers. Damage from wheel cleaners is not covered under the vehicle new car
warranty. Soap and water applied with a soft brush is usually all that is required to clean the
calipers.
Whenever any wheel cleaner is used, it must be THOROUGHLY rinsed off of the wheel with clean,
clear water. Special care must be taken to rinse under the hub cap, balance weights, wheel nuts,
lug nut caps, between the wheel cladding and off the back side of the wheel. Wheels returned to
the Warranty Parts Center (WPC) that exhibit damage from wheel cleaners most often have the
damage around and under the wheel weight where the cleaner was incompletely flushed away.
Notice
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 5827
Do not use cleaning solutions that contain hydrofluoric, oxalic and most other acids on chrome
wheels (or any wheels).
If the customer is unsure of the chemical make-up of a particular wheel cleaner, it should be
avoided.
For wheels showing signs of milky staining from acidic cleaners, refer to Customer Assistance and
Instructions below.
Warranty of Stained Chrome Wheels
Stained wheels are not warrantable. Most acid based cleaners will permanently stain chrome
wheels. Follow-up with dealers has confirmed that such cleaners were used on wheels that were
returned to the Warranty Parts Center (WPC). Any stained wheels received by the WPC will be
charged back to the dealership. To assist the customer, refer to Customer Assistance and
Instructions below.
Pitting or Spotted Appearance of Chrome Wheels Figure 2
A second type or staining or finish disturbance may result from road chemicals, such as calcium
chloride used for dust control of unpaved roads. The staining will look like small pitting (refer to
Figure 2). This staining will usually be on the leading edges of each wheel spoke, but may be
uniformly distributed. If a vehicle must be operated under such conditions, the chrome wheels
should be washed with mild soap and water and thoroughly rinsed as soon as conveniently
possible.
Important Road chemicals, such as calcium chloride used for dust control of unpaved roads, can
also stain chrome wheels. The staining will look like small pitting. This staining will usually be on
the leading edges of each wheel spoke. This is explained by the vehicle traveling in the forward
direction while being splashed by the road chemical. If a vehicle must be operated under such
conditions, the chrome wheels should be washed with mild soap and water and thoroughly rinsed
as soon as conveniently possible.
Warranty of Pitted or Spotted Chrome Wheels
Wheels returned with pitting or spotting as a result of road chemicals may be replaced one time.
Damage resulting from contact with these applied road chemicals is corrosive to the wheels finish
and may cause damage if the wheels are not kept clean.
Important Notify the customer that this is a one time replacement. Please stress to the customer
the vital importance of keeping the wheels clean if they are operating the vehicle in an area that
applies calcium chloride or other dust controlling chemicals! "GM of Canada" dealers require prior
approval by the District Manager - Customer Care and Service Process (DM-CCSP).
"Stardust" Corrosion of Chrome Wheels Figure 3
A third type of finish disturbance results from prolonged exposure to brake dust and resultant
penetration of brake dust through the chrome. As brakes are applied hot particles of brake material
are thrown off and tend to be forced through the leading edge of the wheel spoke windows by
airflow. These
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 5828
hot particles embed themselves in the chrome layer and create a small pit. If the material is allowed
to sit on the wheel while it is exposed to moisture or salt, it will corrode the wheel beneath the
chrome leaving a pit or small blister in the chrome.
Heavy brake dust build-up should be removed from wheels by using GM Chrome Cleaner and
Polish, P/N 1050173 (in Canada use 10953013). For moderate cleaning, light brake dust build-up
or water spots use GM Swirl Remover Polish, P/N 12377965 (in Canada, use Meguiars
Plast-X(TM) Clear Plastic Cleaner and Polish #G12310C**). After cleaning, the wheel should be
waxed using GM Cleaner Wax, P/N 12377966 (in Canada, use Meguiars Cleaner Wax
#M0616C**), which will help protect the wheel from brake dust and reduce adhesion of any brake
dust that gets on the wheel surface. For general maintenance cleaning, PEEK Metal Polish† may
be used. It will clean and shine the chrome and leave behind a wax coating that may help protect
the finish.
Warranty of Stardust Corroded Chrome Wheels
Wheels returned with pitting or spotting as a result of neglect and brake dust build-up may be
replaced one time.
Important Notify the customer that this is a one time replacement. Please stress to the customer
the vital importance of keeping the wheels clean and free of prolonged exposure to brake dust
build-up. "GM of Canada" dealers require prior approval by the District Manager - Customer Care
and Service Process (DM-CCSP).
Customer Assistance and Instructions
GM has looked for ways customers may improve the appearance of wheels damaged by acidic
cleaners. The following product and procedure has been found to dramatically improve the
appearance of stained wheels. For wheels that have milky stains caused by acidic cleaners try the
following:
Notice
THE 3M CHROME AND METAL POLISH REQUIRED FOR THIS PROCEDURE IS AN
EXTREMELY AGGRESSIVE POLISH/CLEANER. THE WHEELS MUST BE CLEANED BEFORE
APPLICATION TO AVOID SCRATCHING THE WHEEL SURFACE. THIS PRODUCT WILL
REDUCE THE THICKNESS OF THE CHROME PLATING ON THE WHEEL AND IF USED
INCORRECTLY OR EXCESSIVELY MAY REMOVE THE CHROME PLATING ALL TOGETHER,
EXPOSING A LESS BRIGHT AND BRASSY COLORED SUB-LAYER. FOLLOW INSTRUCTIONS
EXACTLY.
1. Wash the wheels with vigorously with soap and water. This step will clean and may reduce
wheel staining. Flood all areas of the wheel with water
to rinse.
2. Dry the wheels completely.
Notice Begin with a small section of the wheel and with light pressure buff off polish and examine
results. ONLY apply and rub with sufficient force and time to remove enough staining that you are
satisfied with the results. Some wheels may be stained to the extent that you may only achieve a
50% improvement while others may be able to be restored to the original lustre. IN ALL CASES,
only apply until the results are satisfactory.
3. Apply 3M Chrome and Metal Polish #39527* with a clean terry cloth towel. As you apply the
polish, the staining will be diminished. 4. When dry, buff off the polish with a clean portion of the
towel. 5. Repeat application of the 3M Chrome and Metal Polish until satisfied with the results. If
continued applications fail to improve the appearance
further discontinue use.
This procedure will improve the appearance of the wheels and may, with repeated applications,
restore the finish dramatically. For wheels that exhibit spotting from road chemicals the above
procedure may marginally improve the condition but will not restore the finish or remove the pitting.
In this type of staining the wheel finish has actually been removed in spots and no manner of
cleaning will restore the finish.
†*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or
assume any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may
be available from other sources.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel
Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 5829
*This product is currently available from 3M. To obtain information for your local retail location
please call 3M at 1-888-364-3577.
**This product is currently available from Meguiars (Canada). To obtain information for your local
retail location please call Meguiars at 1-800-347-5700 or at www.meguiarscanada.com.
^ This product is currently available from Tri-Peek International. To obtain information for your local
retail location please call Tri-Peek at
1-877-615-4272 or at www.tripeek.com.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 99-08-51-007E > Mar > 11 > Wheels/Tires - Refinishing
Aluminum Wheels
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum Wheels
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 99-08-51-007E
Date: March 17, 2011
Subject: Refinishing Aluminum Wheels
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add additional model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 99-08-51-007D (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
This bulletin updates General Motor's position on refinishing aluminum wheels. GM does not
endorse any repairs that involve welding, bending, straightening or re-machining. Only cosmetic
refinishing of the wheel's coatings, using recommended procedures, is allowed.
Evaluating Damage
In evaluating damage, it is the GM Dealer's responsibility to inspect the wheel for corrosion,
scrapes, gouges, etc. The Dealer must insure that such damage is not deeper than what can be
sanded or polished off. The wheel must be inspected for cracks. If cracks are found, discard the
wheel. Any wheels with bent rim flanges must not be repaired or refinished. Wheels that have been
refinished by an outside company must be returned to the same vehicle. The Dealer must record
the wheel ID stamp or the cast date on the wheel in order to assure this requirement. Refer to
Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company later in this bulletin.
Aluminum Wheel Refinishing Recommendations
- Chrome-plated aluminum wheels Re-plating these wheels is not recommended.
- Polished aluminum wheels These wheels have a polyester or acrylic clearcoat on them. If the
clearcoat is damaged, refinishing is possible. However, the required refinishing process cannot be
performed in the dealer environment. Refer to Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company later
in this bulletin.
- Painted aluminum wheels These wheels are painted using a primer, color coat, and clearcoat
procedure. If the paint is damaged, refinishing is possible. As with polished wheels, all original
coatings must be removed first. Media blasting is recommended. Refer to GM Aluminum
Refinishing Bulletin #53-17-03A for the re-painting of this type of wheel.
- Bright, machined aluminum wheels These wheels have a polyester or acrylic clearcoat on them.
In some cases, the recessed "pocket" areas of the wheel may be painted. Surface refinishing is
possible. The wheel must be totally stripped by media blasting or other suitable means. The wheel
should be resurfaced by using a sanding process rather than a machining process. This allows the
least amount of material to be removed.
Important Do not use any re-machining process that removes aluminum. This could affect the
dimensions and function of the wheel.
Painting is an option to re-clearcoating polished and bright machined aluminum wheels. Paint will
better mask any surface imperfections and is somewhat more durable than clearcoat alone. GM
recommends using Corsican SILVER WAEQ9283 for a fine "aluminum-like" look or Sparkle
SILVER WA9967 for a very bright look. As an option, the body color may also be used. When using
any of the painting options, it is recommended that all four wheels be refinished in order to maintain
color uniformity. Refer to GM Aluminum Refinishing Bulletin #53-17-03A for specific procedures
and product recommendations.
Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company
Important Some outside companies are offering wheel refinishing services. Such refinished wheels
will be permanently marked by the refinisher and are warranted by the refinisher. Any process that
re-machines or otherwise re-manufactures the wheel should not be used.
A refinisher's responsibility includes inspecting for cracks using the Zyglo system or the equivalent.
Any cracked wheels must not be refinished. No welding, hammering or reforming of any kind is
allowed. The wheel ID must be recorded and follow the wheel throughout the process in order to
assure that the same wheel is returned. A plastic media blast may be used for clean up of the
wheel. Hand and/or lathe sanding of the machined surface and the wheel window is allowed.
Material removal, though, must be kept to a minimum. Re-machining of the wheel is not allowed.
Paint and/or clear coat must not be present on the following surfaces: the nut chamfers, the wheel
mounting surfaces and the wheel pilot hole. The refinisher must permanently ID stamp the wheel
and warrant the painted/clearcoated surfaces for a minimum of one year or the remainder of the
new vehicle warranty, whichever is
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 99-08-51-007E > Mar > 11 > Wheels/Tires - Refinishing
Aluminum Wheels > Page 5834
longer.
Important Whenever a wheel is refinished, the mounting surface and the wheel nut contact
surfaces must not be painted or clearcoated. Coating these surfaces could affect the wheel nut
torque.
When re-mounting a tire on an aluminum wheel, coated balance weights must be used in order to
reduce the chance of future cosmetic damage.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing
Procedures/Precautions
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Changing Procedures/Precautions
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-03-10-010A
Date: June 09, 2010
Subject: Information on Proper Wheel Changing Procedures and Cautions
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER Models 2005-2009 Saab
9-7X 2005-2009 Saturn Vehicles
Attention:
Complete wheel changing instructions for each vehicle line can be found under Tire and Wheel
Removal and Installation in Service Information (SI). This bulletin is intended to quickly review and
reinforce simple but vital procedures to reduce the possibility of achieving low torque during wheel
installation. Always refer to SI for wheel lug nut torque specifications and complete jacking
instructions for safe wheel changing.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include the 2011 model year and update the available
special tool list. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-03-10-010 (Section 03 Suspension).
Frequency of Wheel Changes - Marketplace Driven
Just a few years ago, the increasing longevity of tires along with greater resistance to punctures
had greatly reduced the number of times wheels were removed to basically required tire rotation
intervals. Today with the booming business in accessory wheels/special application tires (such as
winter tires), consumers are having tire/wheel assemblies removed - replaced - or installed more
than ever. With this increased activity, it opens up more of a chance for error on the part of the
technician. This bulletin will review a few of the common concerns and mistakes to make yourself
aware of.
Proper Servicing Starts With the Right Tools
The following tools have been made available to assist in proper wheel and tire removal and
installation.
- J 41013 Rotor Resurfacing Kit (or equivalent)
- J 42450-A Wheel Hub Resurfacing Kit (or equivalent)
Corroded Surfaces
One area of concern is corrosion on the mating surfaces of the wheel to the hub on the vehicle.
Excessive corrosion, dirt, rust or debris built up on these surfaces can mimic a properly tightened
wheel in the service stall. Once the vehicle is driven, the debris may loosen, grind up or be washed
away from water splash. This action may result in clearance at the mating surface of the wheel and
an under-torqued condition.
Caution
Before installing a wheel, remove any buildup on the wheel mounting surface and brake drum or
brake disc mounting surface. Installing wheels with poor metal-to-metal contact at the mounting
surfaces can cause wheel nuts to loosen. This may cause a wheel to come off when the vehicle is
moving, possibly resulting in a loss of control or personal injury.
Whenever you remove the tire/wheel assemblies, you must inspect the mating surfaces. If
corrosion is found, you should remove the debris with a die grinder equipped with a fine sanding
pad, wire brush or cleaning disc. Just remove enough material to assure a clean, smooth mating
surface.
The J 41013 (or equivalent) can be used to clean the following surfaces:
- The hub mounting surface
- The brake rotor mounting surface
- The wheel mounting surface
Use the J 42450-A (or equivalent) to clean around the base of the studs and the hub.
Lubricants, Grease and Fluids
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing
Procedures/Precautions > Page 5839
Some customers may use penetrating oils, grease or other lubricants on wheel studs to aid in
removal or installation. Always use a suitable cleaner/solvent to remove these lubricants prior to
installing the wheel and tire assemblies. Lubricants left on the wheel studs may cause improper
readings of wheel nut torque. Always install wheels to clean, dry wheel studs ONLY.
Notice
Lubricants left on the wheel studs or vertical mounting surfaces between the wheel and the rotor or
drum may cause the wheel to work itself loose after the vehicle is driven. Always install wheels to
clean, dry wheel studs and surfaces ONLY. Beginning with 2011 model year vehicles, put a light
coating of grease, GM P/N 1051344 (in Canada, P/N 9930370), on the inner surface of the wheel
pilot hole to prevent wheel seizure to the axle or bearing hub.
Wheel Stud and Lug Nut Damage
Always inspect the wheel studs and lug nuts for signs of damage from crossthreading or abuse.
You should never have to force wheel nuts down the stud. Lug nuts that are damaged may not
retain properly, yet give the impression of fully tightening. Always inspect and replace any
component suspected of damage.
Tip
Always start wheel nuts by hand! Be certain that all wheel nut threads have been engaged
BEFORE tightening the nut.
Important If the vehicle has directional tread tires, verify the directional arrow on the outboard side
of the tire is pointing in the direction of forward rotation.
Wheel Nut Tightening and Torque
Improper wheel nut tightening can lead to brake pulsation and rotor damage. In order to avoid
additional brake repairs, evenly tighten the wheel nuts to the proper torque specification as shown
for each vehicle in SI. Always observe the proper wheel nut tightening sequence as shown below in
order to avoid trapping the wheel on the wheel stud threads or clamping the wheel slightly off
center resulting in vibration.
The Most Important Service You Provide
While the above information is well known, and wheel removal so common, technicians run the risk
of becoming complacent on this very important
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing
Procedures/Precautions > Page 5840
service operation. A simple distraction or time constraint that rushes the job may result in personal
injury if the greatest of care is not exercised. Make it a habit to double check your work and to
always side with caution when installing wheels.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial
Force Variation (RFV)
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV)
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-03-10-006F
Date: May 04, 2010
Subject: Information on Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009
and Prior Saab 9-7X 2000-2005 Saturn L Series 2003-2007 Saturn ION
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to considerably expand the available information on
Radial Force Variation (RFV) and should be reviewed in whole. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-03-10-006E (Section 03 - Suspension).
Important
- Before measuring tires on equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700, the vehicle MUST be driven
a minimum of 16 km (10 mi) to ensure removal of any flat-spotting. Refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 03-03-10-007E - Tire/Wheel Characteristics of GM Original Equipment Tires.
- Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 MUST be calibrated prior to measuring tire/wheel
assemblies for each vehicle.
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide guidance to GM dealers when using tire force variation
measurement equipment, such as the Hunter GSP9700. This type of equipment can be a valuable
tool in diagnosing vehicle ride concerns. The most common ride concern involving tire radial force
variation is highway speed shake on smooth roads.
Tire related smooth road highway speed shake can be caused by three conditions: imbalance, out
of round and tire force variation. These three conditions are not necessarily related. All three
conditions must be addressed.
Imbalance is normally addressed first, because it is the simpler of the three to correct. Off-vehicle,
two plane dynamic wheel balancers are readily available and can accurately correct any
imbalance. Balancer calibration and maintenance, proper attachment of the wheel to the balancer,
and proper balance weights, are all factors required for a quality balance. However, a perfectly
balanced tire/wheel assembly can still be "oval shaped" and cause a vibration.
Before balancing, perform the following procedures.
Tire and Wheel Diagnosis
1. Set the tire pressure to the placard values. 2. With the vehicle raised, ensure the wheels are
centered on the hub by loosening all wheel nuts and hand-tightening all nuts first by hand while
shaking the wheel, then torque to specifications using a torque wrench, NOT a torque stick.
3. Visually inspect the tires and the wheels. Inspect for evidence of the following conditions and
correct as necessary:
- Missing balance weights
- Bent rim flange
- Irregular tire wear
- Incomplete bead seating
- Tire irregularities (including pressure settings)
- Mud/ice build-up in wheel
- Stones in the tire tread
- Remove any aftermarket wheels and/or tires and restore vehicle to original condition prior to
diagnosing a smooth road shake condition.
4. Road test the vehicle using the Electronic Vibration Analyzer (EVA) essential tool. Drive for a
sufficient distance on a known, smooth road
surface to duplicate the condition. Determine if the vehicle is sensitive to brake apply. If the brakes
are applied lightly and the pulsation felt in the steering wheel increases, refer to the Brakes section
of the service manual that deals with brake-induced pulsation. If you can start to hear the vibration
as a low boom noise (in addition to feeling it), but cannot see it, the vehicle likely has a first order
(one pulse per propshaft revolution) driveline vibration. Driveline first order vibrations are high
enough in frequency that most humans can start to hear them at highway speeds, but are too high
to be able to be easily seen. These issues can be caused by driveline imbalance or misalignment.
If the vehicle exhibits this low boom and the booming pulses in-and-out on a regular basis (like a
throbbing), chances are good that the vehicle could have driveline vibration. This type
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial
Force Variation (RFV) > Page 5845
of vibration is normally felt more in the "seat of the pants" than the steering wheel.
5. Next, record the Hertz (Hz) reading as displayed by the EVA onto the tire data worksheet found
at the end of this bulletin. This should be done
after a tire break-in period of at least 16 km (10 mi) at 72 km/h (45 mph) or greater, in order to
eliminate any possible tire flat-spotting. This reading confirms what the vehicle vibration frequency
is prior to vehicle service and documents the amount of improvement occurring as the result of the
various steps taken to repair. Completing the Steering Wheel Shake Worksheet below is required.
A copy of the completed worksheet must be saved with the R.O. and a copy included with any
parts returned to the Warranty Parts Center for analysis. A reading of 35 to 50 Hz typically
indicates a first order propshaft vibration. If this is the situation, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
08-07-30-044D. Generally, a reading between 10 and 20 Hz indicates a tire/wheel vibration and if
this is the reading obtained, continue using this bulletin. If the tire 1st order vibration goes away
and stays away during this evaluation, the cause is likely tire flat-spotting. Tire flat-spotting vibration
may come and go at any speed over 72 km/h (45 mph) during the first 10 minutes of operation, if
vibration continues after 10 minutes of driving at speeds greater than 72 km/h (45 mph), tire
flat-spotting can be ruled out as the cause for vibration.
6. If flat-spotting is the cause, provide the explanation that this has occurred due to the vehicle
being parked for long periods of time and that the
nature of the tire is to take a set. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 03-03-10-007E: Information
on Tire/Wheel Characteristics (Vibration, Balance, Shake, Flat Spotting) of GM Original Equipment
Tires.
7. If the road test indicates a shake/vibration exists, check the imbalance of each tire/wheel
assembly on a known, calibrated, off-car dynamic
balancer.Make sure the mounting surface of the wheel and the surface of the balancer are
absolutely clean and free of debris. Be sure to chose the proper cone/collet for the wheel, and
always use the pilot bore for centering. Never center the wheel using the hub-cap bore since it is
not a precision machined surface. If any assembly calls for more than 1/4 ounce on either rim
flange, remove all balance weights and rebalance to as close to zero as possible. If you can see
the vibration (along with feeling it) in the steering wheel (driving straight without your hands on the
wheel), it is very likely to be a tire/wheel first order (one pulse per revolution) disturbance. First
order disturbances can be caused by imbalance as well as non-uniformities in tires, wheels or
hubs. This first order frequency is too low for a human to hear, but if the amplitude is high enough,
it can be seen.
If a vibration or shake still exists after balancing, any out of round conditions, of the wheel, and
force variation conditions of the tire, must be addressed. Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700
can address both (it is also a wheel balancer).
Tire radial force vibration (RFV) can be defined as the amount of stiffness variation the tire will
produce in one revolution under a constant load. Radial force variation is what the vehicle feels
because the load (weight) of the vehicle is always on the tires. Although free runout of tires (not
under load) is not always a good indicator of a smooth ride, it is critical that total tire/wheel
assembly runout be within specification.
Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 loads the tire, similar to on the vehicle, and measures
radial force variation of the tire/wheel assembly. Note that the wheel is affecting the tire's RFV
measurement at this point. To isolate the wheel, its runout must be measured. This can be easily
done on the Hunter, without the need to set up dial indicators. If the wheel meets the runout
specification, the tire's RFV can then be addressed.
After measuring the tire/wheel assembly under load, and the wheel alone, the machine then
calculates (predicts) the radial force variation of the tire. However, because this is a prediction that
can include mounting inaccuracies, and the load wheel is much smaller in diameter than used in
tire production, this type of service equipment should NOT be used to audit new tires. Rather, it
should be used as a service diagnostic tool to minimize radial force variation of the tire/wheel
assembly.
Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 does an excellent job of measuring wheel runout, and of
finding the low point of the wheel (for runout) and the high point of the tire (for radial force
variation). This allows the tire to be matched mounted to the wheel for lowest tire/wheel assembly
force variation.
The machine will simplify this process into easy steps. The following assembly radial force variation
numbers should be used as a guide:
When measuring RFV and match mounting tires perform the following steps.
Measuring Wheel Runout and Assembly Radial Force Variation
Important The completed worksheet at the end of this bulletin must be attached to the hard copy of
the repair order.
- Measure radial force variation and radial runout.
- If a road force/balancing machine is used, record the radial force variation (RFV) on the
worksheet at the end of this bulletin. It may be of benefit to have the lowest RFV assembly to the
front left corner. If the machine is not available and the EVA data suggests there is an issue, swap
the tire and wheel assemblies from the front to the back. Re-check on the EVA and if the problem
still exists, test another vehicle to find tires that do not exhibit the same frequency and swap those
tires onto the subject vehicle.
- If a runout/balancing machine is used, record the radial runout of the tire/wheel assemblies on the
worksheet at the end of this bulletin. If one or more of the tire/wheel assemblies are more than.040
in (1.02 mm), match mount the tire to the wheel to get below.040 in (1.02 mm). For sensitive
customers, readings of 0.030 inch (0.76 mm) or less are preferable, it may also be of benefit to
have the lowest runout assembly to the front left corner. If the machine is not available and the
EVA data suggests there is an issue, swap the tire and wheel assemblies from the front to the
back. Re-check on the EVA and if the problem still exists, test another vehicle to find tires that do
not exhibit the same frequency and swap those tires
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial
Force Variation (RFV) > Page 5846
onto the subject vehicle.
- After match mounting, the tire/wheel assembly must be rebalanced.
If match mounting tires to in-spec wheels produces assembly values higher than these, tire
replacement may be necessary. Replacing tires at lower values will probably mean good tires are
being condemned. Because tires can sometimes become temporarily flat-spotted, which will affect
force variation, it is important that the vehicle be driven at least 16 km (10 mi) prior to measuring.
Tire pressure must also be adjusted to the usage pressure on the vehicle's tire placard prior to
measuring.
Most GM vehicles will tolerate radial force variation up to these levels. However, some vehicles are
more sensitive, and may require lower levels. Also, there are other tire parameters that equipment
such as the Hunter GSP9700 cannot measure that may be a factor. In such cases, TAC should be
contacted for further instructions.
Important
- When mounting a GM wheel to a wheel balancer/force variation machine, always use the wheel's
center pilot hole. This is the primary centering mechanism on all GM wheels; the bolt holes are
secondary. Usually a back cone method to the machine should be used. For added accuracy and
repeatability, a flange plate should be used to clamp the wheel onto the cone and machine. This
system is offered by all balancer manufacturers in GM's dealer program.
- Any type of service equipment that removes tread rubber by grinding, buffing or truing is NOT
recommended, and may void the tire warranty. However, tires may have been ground by the tire
company as part of their tire manufacturing process. This is a legitimate procedure.
Steering Wheel Shake Worksheet
When diagnosing vibration concerns, use the following worksheet in conjunction with the
appropriate Vibration Analysis-Road testing procedure in the Vibration Correction sub-section in SI.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial
Force Variation (RFV) > Page 5847
Refer to the appropriate section of SI for specifications and repair procedures that are related to the
vibration concern.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 05-03-10-003F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking
Cast Aluminum Wheels
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 05-03-10-003F
Date: April 27, 2010
Subject: Low Tire Pressure, Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels (Repair with Adhesive Sealant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X with Cast Aluminum Wheels
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years and the bulletin reference
information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-10-003E (Section 03 - Suspension).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a low tire pressure condition.
Diagnosis of the low tire pressure condition indicates an air leak through the cast aluminum wheel.
Cause
Porosity in the cast aluminum wheel may be the cause.
Notice
This bulletin specifically addresses issues related to the wheel casting that may result in an air
leak. For issues related to corrosion of the wheel in service, please refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-03-10-006C - Tire Slowly Goes Flat, Tire Air Loss, Low Tire Pressure Warning Light
Illuminated, Aluminum Wheel Bead Seat Corrosion (Clean and Resurface Wheel Bead Seat).
Correction
1. Remove the tire and wheel assembly from the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate service
procedure in SI. 2. Locate the leaking area by inflating the tire to 276 kPa (40 psi) and dipping the
tire/wheel assembly in a water bath, or use a spray bottle with soap
and water to locate the specific leak location.
Important
- If the porosity leak is located in the bead area of the aluminum rim (where the tire meets the rim),
the wheel should be replaced.
- If two or more leaks are located on one wheel, the wheel should be replaced.
3. If air bubbles are observed, mark the location.
- If the leak location is on the tire/rubber area, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 04-03-10-001F Tire Puncture Repair Procedures for All Cars and Light Duty Trucks.
- If the leak is located on the aluminum wheel area, continue with the next step.
4. Inscribe a mark on the tire at the valve stem in order to indicate the orientation of the tire to the
wheel. 5. Dismount the tire from the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 6. Remove
the tire pressure sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor removal procedure in SI. 7. Scuff the
INSIDE rim surface at the leak area with #80 grit paper and clean the area with general purpose
cleaner, such as 3M(R) General Purpose
Adhesive Cleaner, P/N 08984, or equivalent.
8. Apply a 3 mm (0.12 in) thick layer of Silicone - Adhesive/Sealant, P/N 12378478 (in Canada, use
88900041), or equivalent, to the leak area. 9. Allow for the adhesive/sealant to dry.
Notice Caution must be used when mounting the tire so as not to damage the sealer. Damaging
the repair area may result in an air leak.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 05-03-10-003F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking
Cast Aluminum Wheels > Page 5852
10. Align the inscribed mark on the tire with the valve stem on the wheel. 11. Reinstall the Tire
Pressure Sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor installation procedure in SI. 12. Mount the tire on
the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 13. Pressurize the tire to 276 kPa (40 psi) and
inspect for leaks. 14. Adjust tire pressure to meet the placard specification. 15. Balance the
tire/wheel assembly. Refer to Tire and Wheel Assembly Balancing - Off-Vehicle. 16. Install the tire
and wheel assembly onto the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate service procedure in SI.
Parts Information
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
Important The Silicone - Adhesive/Sealant comes in a case quantity of six. ONLY charge warranty
one tube of adhesive/sealant per wheel repair.
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
One leak repair per wheel.
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 04-03-10-012B > Feb > 08 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel Brake
Dust Accumulation/Pitting
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Brake Dust Accumulation/Pitting
Bulletin No.: 04-03-10-012B
Date: February 01, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Pitting and Brake Dust on Chrome wheels
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2008 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
04-03-10-012A (Section 03 - Suspension).
Analysis of Returned Wheels
Chrome wheels returned under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty for pitting concerns have
recently been evaluated. This condition is usually most severe in the vent (or window) area of the
front wheels. This "pitting" may actually be brake dust that has been allowed to accumulate on the
wheel. The longer this accumulation builds up, the more difficult it is to remove.
Cleaning the Wheels
In all cases, the returned wheels could be cleaned to their original condition using GM Vehicle Care
Cleaner Wax, P/N 12377966 (in Canada, P/N 10952905). When using this product, you should
confine your treatment to the areas of the wheel that show evidence of the brake dust build-up.
This product is only for use on chromed steel or chromed aluminum wheels.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Wheel replacement for this condition is NOT applicable under the terms of the New Vehicle Limited
Warranty.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 99-03-10-102 > Jun > 99 > Warranty - OE Chrome Plated
Aluminum Wheel ID
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Warranty - OE Chrome Plated Aluminum Wheel ID
File In Section: 03 - Suspension
Bulletin No.: 99-03-10-102
Date: June, 1999
INFORMATION
Subject: Original Equipment Chrome Plated Aluminum Wheel Identification
Models: 1999 and Prior Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
Chrome plated aluminum wheels have been returned to the Warranty Parts Center that are not the
original equipment (OE) components.
Original equipment chrome plated aluminum wheels can be identified by either a balance weight
clip retention groove (1) or a step (2) that is machined around both of the wheel's rim flanges. The
rim flanges (3) of painted original equipment aluminum wheels do not have a groove or a step.
Chrome plated aluminum wheels that do not have the wheel rim flange groove or step are
aftermarket chrome plated components and are NOT warrantable. Any aftermarket chrome wheels
received by the Warranty Parts Center will be charged back to the dealership.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 72-05-05 > Aug > 97 > Warranty - Guidelines for Using
E0420 Wheel Replace
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Warranty - Guidelines for Using E0420 Wheel Replace
File In Section: Warranty Administration
Bulletin No.: 72-05-05
Date: August, 1997
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
Subject: Guidelines for Using EO42O Wheel Replace
Models: 1989-98 Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide service personnel with guidelines for using the above
subject labor operation.
Effective with repair orders dated on or after September 1, 1997, dealers are to be guided by the
following:
^ Aluminum Wheels (including chrome plated) with Porosity - Wheels that exhibit porosity should
be repaired as described in the vehicle service manual. Wheels should not be replaced without
wholesale approval.
^ Aluminum Wheels (except chrome plated) with a "Finish Defect" - Wheels that exhibit a defect in
the finish, (i.e., discoloration or surface degradation) should be refinished as described in the
Corporate Service Bulletin Number 53-17-03A released in May, 1996.
^ Chrome Wheels - Wheels that are chromed and found to have a finish defect can only be
replaced.
^ Aluminum and chrome wheels replaced under warranty will be subject to random part review and
inspection. Those wheels inspected and found not to be defective and/or should have been
repaired, will be subject to charge back.
Wheels damaged by normal wear, road hazards, car wash brushes, or other physical or chemical
damage are not eligible for warranty coverage.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 531703A > May > 96 > Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing
Technical Service Bulletin # 531703A Date: 960501
Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing
File In Section: 10 - Body
Bulletin No.: 53-17-03A
Date: May, 1996
INFORMATION
Subject: Aluminum Wheel Refinishing
Models: 1991-96 Passenger Cars and Trucks
This bulletin is being revised to delete the 1990 model year and add the 1996 model year. Please
discard Corporate Bulletin Number 53-17-03 (Section 10 - Body).
This bulletin supersedes and cancels all previous service bulletins concerning the refinishing of
aluminum wheels. The purpose of this service bulletin is to assist dealerships in repairing the
discoloration or surface degradation that has occurred on styled aluminum wheels.
This bulletin provides NEW PROCEDURES AND SPECIFIC MATERIALS for the refinishing of
painted aluminum wheels or aluminum wheels with discoloration or surface degradation.
Important:
THE RE-MACHINING OF ALUMINUM WHEELS IS NOT RECOMMENDED. THE RE-CLEAR
COATING OF ALUMINUM WHEELS IS NO LONGER RECOMMENDED DUE TO CONCERNS OF
REPAIR DURABILITY
The new procedure requires the wheel surface be plastic media blasted to remove old paint or
clear coat. CHEMICAL STRIPPERS ARE NOT RECOMMENDED.
Material Required
System 1: DuPont Products
3939-S Cleaning Solvent 615/616 Etching Primer URO 5000 Primer Surfacer IMRON 6000
Basecoat 3440-S IMRON Clear
System 2: PPG Products
DX533 Aluminum Cleaner DX503 Aluminum Conditioner DP Epoxy Primer Deltron Basecoat
(DBC) Concept 2001 Clear Acrylic Urethane
System 3: Spies Hecker
Permahyd Silicone Remover 7090 Permahyd 1:1 Primer 4070 Permahyd 2:1 Surfacer 5080
Permahyd Base Coat Series 280/285 Permahyd H.S. Clearcoat 8060
Color Selection
If the wheels being painted were previously clearcoated aluminum, we would recommend using
Corsican SILVER WAEQ9283 for a fine "aluminum-like" look or Sparkle SILVER WA9967 for a
very bright look. As an option to the customer, you may also use body color. For color
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 531703A > May > 96 > Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing >
Page 5869
selection and verification, refer to your paint manufacturer's color book. On wheels that were
previous clearcoated aluminum it is recommended that all four wheels and their center caps be
refinished to maintain color uniformity.
Important:
THE PRODUCTS LISTED MUST BE USED AS A SYSTEM. DO NOT MIX OTHER
MANUFACTURERS' PRODUCT LINES WITH THE REQUIRED MATERIALS. PRODUCTS
LISTED IN THIS BULLETIN HAVE SHOWN THE REQUIRED REPAIR DURABILITY, AND
CURRENTLY ARE THE ONLY PAINT SYSTEMS THAT MEET GM SPECIFICATION
4350M-A336.
Procedures
1. Remove wheels from vehicle. Tires may remain mounted on wheels.
2. Remove balance weights and mark their location on tire.
3. Wipe excess grease, etc. from wheels with wax and grease remover.
4. Have wheels plastic media blasted to remove clearcoat. FOR FURTHER INFORMATION ON
MEDIA BLASTING IN YOUR AREA, CALL US TECHNOLOGIES INC., CONTACT DAVE
ROSENBURG AT 1-800-634-9185.
Caution:
IT IS MANDATORY THAT ADEQUATE RESPIRATORY PROTECTION BE WORN. EXAMPLES
OF SUCH PROTECTION ARE: AIR LINE RESPIRATORS WITH FULL HOOD OR HALF MASK. IF
NOT AVAILABLE, USE A VAPOR/PARTICULATE RESPIRATOR THAT RESPIRATOR
MANUFACTURER RECOMMENDS AS EFFECTIVE FOR ISOCYANATE VAPOR AND MISTS
(UNLESS LOCAL REGULATIONS PREVAIL).
5. Painting Process
a. Refer to Attachments 1-3 for each System's individual formula and process.
b. After following the specific System's individual formula and process, follow these steps:
6. Unmask wheels.
7. Clean all wheel mounting surface of any corrosion, overspray, or dirt.
8. Install new coated balance weights, at marked locations.
9. Replace wheels on vehicle.
10. USE A TORQUE STICK ON AN IMPACT WRENCH, OR A TORQUE WRENCH TO
CONSISTENTLY AND UNIFORMLY FASTEN THE WHEEL TO THE SPECIFIED TORQUE FOR
THE VEHICLE. THE STAR PATTERN MUST BE FOLLOWED.
Important:
TORQUE STICKS MUST BE USED ANY TIME AN IMPACT WRENCH IS USED TO TIGHTEN
WHEEL NUTS.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use as shown.
Attachment 1 - DuPont Products
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 531703A > May > 96 > Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing >
Page 5870
Painting Process
System: Dupont Products
Paint Color Information: Corsican Silver WA EQ9283 Dupont # C9143, Sparkle Silver WA9967
Dupont # C9339
1. Wipe wheel with cleaning solvent: 3939-S, 3949-S or 3900-S.
2. Mask off tires.
Important:
3. Mask off all wheel mounting surfaces and wheel mount surfaces.
4. Apply two coats of 615/616-S etching primer to wheel allowing 10 minutes flash between coats.
Allow to dry for 30 minutes before applying primer coat.
5. Apply URO 5000 primer 1220/193-S + accelerator 389-S using two coats at 65-70 PSI at the
gun. Allow 12-15 minutes between coats. Force bake 30 minutes at 140°F (60°C).
6. Scuff sand using green Scotch-Brite pad.
7. Solvent wipe before top coating.
8. Apply IMRON 6000 base coat to wheel. 2-3 coats to hiding at 60-70 PSI allowing to flash
between coats. Base coat needs to dry 20-30 minutes before clearcoat is applied.
9. Apply 3440-S clearcoat to wheel using two coats at 60-70 PSI. Flash 10-15 minutes between
coats. 389-S can be used in basecoat and clearcoat to give faster set up times.
10. Allow overnight dry before reassemble. Can be baked for 30 minutes at 140°F (60°C).
Attachment 2 - PPG Products
Painting Process: PPG System
Paint Color Information: Corsican Silver WAEQ9283; PPG # DBC-3531, Sparkle Silver WA9967;
PPG # 35367
1. Wash entire wheel with aluminum cleaner DX533, mix 1:3 with water. Allow to react 2-3 minutes
and rinse thoroughly.
2. Wash entire wheel with aluminum conditioner DX5O3 straight from the container. Allow to react
2-3 minutes until pale gold or tan color develops. Rinse thoroughly and dry.
3. Mask off tires.
Important:
4. Mask off all wheel nut mounting surfaces and wheel mounting surfaces.
5. Apply 1-2 coats of DP Primer and allow to flash for 15-20 minutes.
6. Apply 2-3 coats of Deltron Basecoat (DBC) and allow to flash 20 minutes after the final coat.
7. Apply two (2) wet coats of Concept 2001 Acrylic urethane.
8. Flash 20 minutes and bake 140°F (60°C) for 30 minutes.
For more information contact your PPG Jobber.
Attachment 3 - Spies Hecker
Painting Process: Spies Hecker System
Paint Color Information: Corsican Silver AWEQ9283; SH-72913, Sparkle Silver WA9967;
SH-71912
1. Clean with Permahyd Silicone Remover 7090.
2. Mask off tires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 531703A > May > 96 > Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing >
Page 5871
Important:
3. Mask off all wheel nut mounting surfaces and wheel mounting surfaces.
4. Apply 1-1/2 coats of Permahyd 1:1 Primer 4070. Mix 1:1 with Permahyd Hardener 3070 as per
TDS.
5. Allow to flash for 30 minutes.
6. Apply two (2) coats of Permahyd 2:1 Surfacer 5080. Mix 2:1 with Permahyd Hardener 3071 as
per TDS.
7. Bake for 60 minutes at 140°F (60°C) or allow to flash for 3 hours at 68°F (20°C).
8. Apply Permahyd Base Coat Series 280/285 as per TDS.
9. Allow to flash 10 to 15 minutes.
10. Apply 1 to 2 coats of Permacron High Solid Clear Coat 8060 as per TDS.
11. Allow to flash 10 minutes. Then bake at 140°F (60°C) for 40 minutes.
For more information, contact your SPIES HECKER Jobber.
We believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such products. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products or equipment from these firms or for any such items which may be
available from other sources.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > Interior - Squawk From Front
Suspension Or Engine Area
Stabilizer Bushing: All Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Squawk From Front Suspension Or
Engine Area
File In Section: 3 - Steering/Suspension
Bulletin No.: 73-33-01A
Date: December, 1997
Subject: Squawk Noise Coming from Front Suspension or Engine Compartment Area (Install Ultra
High Molecular Tape)
Models: 1993-98 Buick Skylark 1993-94 Chevrolet Cavalier 1993-96 Chevrolet Beretta, Corsica
1993-98 Oldsmobile Achieva 1993-94 Pontiac Sunbird 1993-98 Pontiac Grand Am
This bulletin is being revised to add the 1998 model for the N-Car and eliminate VIN Breakpoints.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 73-33-01 (Section 3 - Steering/Suspension).
Condition
Some owners may comment on a "squawk" noise coming from the front suspension or engine
compartment area. This noise may be more noticeable over small bumps, entering parking lots,
and including any irregular road surfaces. This condition may also be more noticeable in cold
weather conditions.
Cause
The squawk noise may be caused by the rubber stabilizer bushing material bleeding through the
Teflon/Polyester sock (on later models) and coming into contact with the stabilizer shaft. On earlier
models, the squawk may be caused from friction when the stabilizer bushing is grabbing and
releasing the stabilizer shaft.
Correction
If the above conditions exist, perform the following repair:
1. Remove front stabilizer bushing clamps and bushings. Refer to Section 3C of the Service
Manual.
2. Inspect stabilizer bushings for visible wear, replace if necessary.
3. Use crocus cloth (or equivalent) to sand the stabilizer shaft where the stabilizer bushings contact
the stabilizer shaft. Sand all rough corrosion thoroughly. Do not remove paint if it is intact.
4. Install UHM (Ultra High Molecular) tape (provided in kit, P/N 22602686) into stabilizer bushing;
adhesive side of tape should be installed onto the bushing. Install UHM tape to the opening of the
bushing (the slit) as well as the circumference (this will secure the tape in place). Kit provides
enough tape for two bushings (one vehicle).
5. Reassemble.
Parts Information
P/N Description
22602686 Service Kit (Consists of Tape and Instruction Sheet)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > Interior - Squawk From Front
Suspension Or Engine Area > Page 5877
Stabilizer Bushings Only
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Labor Time
E2180 Use published labor operation time
Add 0.9 hr
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel Staining/Pitting/Corrosion
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Staining/Pitting/Corrosion
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-03-10-002F
Date: April 21, 2011
Subject: Chemical Staining, Pitting, Corrosion and/or Spotted Appearance of Chromed Aluminum
Wheels
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update model years, suggest additional restorative
products and add additional corrosion information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
00-03-10-002E (Section 03 - Suspension). Important You may give a copy of this bulletin to the
customer.
What is Chemical Staining of Chrome Wheels? Figure 1
Chemical staining in most cases results from acid based cleaners (refer to Figure 1 for an
example). These stains are frequently milky, black, or greenish in appearance. They result from
using cleaning solutions that contain acids on chrome wheels. Soap and water is usually sufficient
to clean wheels.
If the customer insists on using a wheel cleaner they should only use one that specifically states
that it is safe for chromed wheels and does not contain anything in the following list. (Dealers
should also survey any products they use during prep or normal cleaning of stock units for these
chemicals.)
- Ammonium Bifluoride (fluoride source for dissolution of chrome)
- Hydrofluoric Acid (directly dissolves chrome)
- Hydrochloric Acid (directly dissolves chrome)
- Sodium Dodecylbenzenesulfonic Acid
- Sulfamic Acid
- Phosphoric Acid
- Hydroxyacetic Acid
Notice
Many wheel cleaner instructions advise to take care to avoid contact with painted surfaces. Most
customers think of painted surfaces as the fenders, quarter panels and other exterior sheet metal.
Many vehicles have painted brake calipers. Acidic wheel cleaners may craze, crack, or discolor the
paint on the brake calipers. Damage from wheel cleaners is not covered under the vehicle new car
warranty. Soap and water applied with a soft brush is usually all that is required to clean the
calipers.
Whenever any wheel cleaner is used, it must be THOROUGHLY rinsed off of the wheel with clean,
clear water. Special care must be taken to rinse under the hub cap, balance weights, wheel nuts,
lug nut caps, between the wheel cladding and off the back side of the wheel. Wheels returned to
the Warranty Parts Center (WPC) that exhibit damage from wheel cleaners most often have the
damage around and under the wheel weight where the cleaner was incompletely flushed away.
Notice
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 5887
Do not use cleaning solutions that contain hydrofluoric, oxalic and most other acids on chrome
wheels (or any wheels).
If the customer is unsure of the chemical make-up of a particular wheel cleaner, it should be
avoided.
For wheels showing signs of milky staining from acidic cleaners, refer to Customer Assistance and
Instructions below.
Warranty of Stained Chrome Wheels
Stained wheels are not warrantable. Most acid based cleaners will permanently stain chrome
wheels. Follow-up with dealers has confirmed that such cleaners were used on wheels that were
returned to the Warranty Parts Center (WPC). Any stained wheels received by the WPC will be
charged back to the dealership. To assist the customer, refer to Customer Assistance and
Instructions below.
Pitting or Spotted Appearance of Chrome Wheels Figure 2
A second type or staining or finish disturbance may result from road chemicals, such as calcium
chloride used for dust control of unpaved roads. The staining will look like small pitting (refer to
Figure 2). This staining will usually be on the leading edges of each wheel spoke, but may be
uniformly distributed. If a vehicle must be operated under such conditions, the chrome wheels
should be washed with mild soap and water and thoroughly rinsed as soon as conveniently
possible.
Important Road chemicals, such as calcium chloride used for dust control of unpaved roads, can
also stain chrome wheels. The staining will look like small pitting. This staining will usually be on
the leading edges of each wheel spoke. This is explained by the vehicle traveling in the forward
direction while being splashed by the road chemical. If a vehicle must be operated under such
conditions, the chrome wheels should be washed with mild soap and water and thoroughly rinsed
as soon as conveniently possible.
Warranty of Pitted or Spotted Chrome Wheels
Wheels returned with pitting or spotting as a result of road chemicals may be replaced one time.
Damage resulting from contact with these applied road chemicals is corrosive to the wheels finish
and may cause damage if the wheels are not kept clean.
Important Notify the customer that this is a one time replacement. Please stress to the customer
the vital importance of keeping the wheels clean if they are operating the vehicle in an area that
applies calcium chloride or other dust controlling chemicals! "GM of Canada" dealers require prior
approval by the District Manager - Customer Care and Service Process (DM-CCSP).
"Stardust" Corrosion of Chrome Wheels Figure 3
A third type of finish disturbance results from prolonged exposure to brake dust and resultant
penetration of brake dust through the chrome. As brakes are applied hot particles of brake material
are thrown off and tend to be forced through the leading edge of the wheel spoke windows by
airflow. These
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 5888
hot particles embed themselves in the chrome layer and create a small pit. If the material is allowed
to sit on the wheel while it is exposed to moisture or salt, it will corrode the wheel beneath the
chrome leaving a pit or small blister in the chrome.
Heavy brake dust build-up should be removed from wheels by using GM Chrome Cleaner and
Polish, P/N 1050173 (in Canada use 10953013). For moderate cleaning, light brake dust build-up
or water spots use GM Swirl Remover Polish, P/N 12377965 (in Canada, use Meguiars
Plast-X(TM) Clear Plastic Cleaner and Polish #G12310C**). After cleaning, the wheel should be
waxed using GM Cleaner Wax, P/N 12377966 (in Canada, use Meguiars Cleaner Wax
#M0616C**), which will help protect the wheel from brake dust and reduce adhesion of any brake
dust that gets on the wheel surface. For general maintenance cleaning, PEEK Metal Polish† may
be used. It will clean and shine the chrome and leave behind a wax coating that may help protect
the finish.
Warranty of Stardust Corroded Chrome Wheels
Wheels returned with pitting or spotting as a result of neglect and brake dust build-up may be
replaced one time.
Important Notify the customer that this is a one time replacement. Please stress to the customer
the vital importance of keeping the wheels clean and free of prolonged exposure to brake dust
build-up. "GM of Canada" dealers require prior approval by the District Manager - Customer Care
and Service Process (DM-CCSP).
Customer Assistance and Instructions
GM has looked for ways customers may improve the appearance of wheels damaged by acidic
cleaners. The following product and procedure has been found to dramatically improve the
appearance of stained wheels. For wheels that have milky stains caused by acidic cleaners try the
following:
Notice
THE 3M CHROME AND METAL POLISH REQUIRED FOR THIS PROCEDURE IS AN
EXTREMELY AGGRESSIVE POLISH/CLEANER. THE WHEELS MUST BE CLEANED BEFORE
APPLICATION TO AVOID SCRATCHING THE WHEEL SURFACE. THIS PRODUCT WILL
REDUCE THE THICKNESS OF THE CHROME PLATING ON THE WHEEL AND IF USED
INCORRECTLY OR EXCESSIVELY MAY REMOVE THE CHROME PLATING ALL TOGETHER,
EXPOSING A LESS BRIGHT AND BRASSY COLORED SUB-LAYER. FOLLOW INSTRUCTIONS
EXACTLY.
1. Wash the wheels with vigorously with soap and water. This step will clean and may reduce
wheel staining. Flood all areas of the wheel with water
to rinse.
2. Dry the wheels completely.
Notice Begin with a small section of the wheel and with light pressure buff off polish and examine
results. ONLY apply and rub with sufficient force and time to remove enough staining that you are
satisfied with the results. Some wheels may be stained to the extent that you may only achieve a
50% improvement while others may be able to be restored to the original lustre. IN ALL CASES,
only apply until the results are satisfactory.
3. Apply 3M Chrome and Metal Polish #39527* with a clean terry cloth towel. As you apply the
polish, the staining will be diminished. 4. When dry, buff off the polish with a clean portion of the
towel. 5. Repeat application of the 3M Chrome and Metal Polish until satisfied with the results. If
continued applications fail to improve the appearance
further discontinue use.
This procedure will improve the appearance of the wheels and may, with repeated applications,
restore the finish dramatically. For wheels that exhibit spotting from road chemicals the above
procedure may marginally improve the condition but will not restore the finish or remove the pitting.
In this type of staining the wheel finish has actually been removed in spots and no manner of
cleaning will restore the finish.
†*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or
assume any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may
be available from other sources.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-002F > Apr > 11 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel Staining/Pitting/Corrosion > Page 5889
*This product is currently available from 3M. To obtain information for your local retail location
please call 3M at 1-888-364-3577.
**This product is currently available from Meguiars (Canada). To obtain information for your local
retail location please call Meguiars at 1-800-347-5700 or at www.meguiarscanada.com.
^ This product is currently available from Tri-Peek International. To obtain information for your local
retail location please call Tri-Peek at
1-877-615-4272 or at www.tripeek.com.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Wheels: > 99-08-51-007E > Mar > 11 > Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum Wheels
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum Wheels
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 99-08-51-007E
Date: March 17, 2011
Subject: Refinishing Aluminum Wheels
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add additional model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 99-08-51-007D (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
This bulletin updates General Motor's position on refinishing aluminum wheels. GM does not
endorse any repairs that involve welding, bending, straightening or re-machining. Only cosmetic
refinishing of the wheel's coatings, using recommended procedures, is allowed.
Evaluating Damage
In evaluating damage, it is the GM Dealer's responsibility to inspect the wheel for corrosion,
scrapes, gouges, etc. The Dealer must insure that such damage is not deeper than what can be
sanded or polished off. The wheel must be inspected for cracks. If cracks are found, discard the
wheel. Any wheels with bent rim flanges must not be repaired or refinished. Wheels that have been
refinished by an outside company must be returned to the same vehicle. The Dealer must record
the wheel ID stamp or the cast date on the wheel in order to assure this requirement. Refer to
Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company later in this bulletin.
Aluminum Wheel Refinishing Recommendations
- Chrome-plated aluminum wheels Re-plating these wheels is not recommended.
- Polished aluminum wheels These wheels have a polyester or acrylic clearcoat on them. If the
clearcoat is damaged, refinishing is possible. However, the required refinishing process cannot be
performed in the dealer environment. Refer to Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company later
in this bulletin.
- Painted aluminum wheels These wheels are painted using a primer, color coat, and clearcoat
procedure. If the paint is damaged, refinishing is possible. As with polished wheels, all original
coatings must be removed first. Media blasting is recommended. Refer to GM Aluminum
Refinishing Bulletin #53-17-03A for the re-painting of this type of wheel.
- Bright, machined aluminum wheels These wheels have a polyester or acrylic clearcoat on them.
In some cases, the recessed "pocket" areas of the wheel may be painted. Surface refinishing is
possible. The wheel must be totally stripped by media blasting or other suitable means. The wheel
should be resurfaced by using a sanding process rather than a machining process. This allows the
least amount of material to be removed.
Important Do not use any re-machining process that removes aluminum. This could affect the
dimensions and function of the wheel.
Painting is an option to re-clearcoating polished and bright machined aluminum wheels. Paint will
better mask any surface imperfections and is somewhat more durable than clearcoat alone. GM
recommends using Corsican SILVER WAEQ9283 for a fine "aluminum-like" look or Sparkle
SILVER WA9967 for a very bright look. As an option, the body color may also be used. When using
any of the painting options, it is recommended that all four wheels be refinished in order to maintain
color uniformity. Refer to GM Aluminum Refinishing Bulletin #53-17-03A for specific procedures
and product recommendations.
Refinisher's Responsibility - Outside Company
Important Some outside companies are offering wheel refinishing services. Such refinished wheels
will be permanently marked by the refinisher and are warranted by the refinisher. Any process that
re-machines or otherwise re-manufactures the wheel should not be used.
A refinisher's responsibility includes inspecting for cracks using the Zyglo system or the equivalent.
Any cracked wheels must not be refinished. No welding, hammering or reforming of any kind is
allowed. The wheel ID must be recorded and follow the wheel throughout the process in order to
assure that the same wheel is returned. A plastic media blast may be used for clean up of the
wheel. Hand and/or lathe sanding of the machined surface and the wheel window is allowed.
Material removal, though, must be kept to a minimum. Re-machining of the wheel is not allowed.
Paint and/or clear coat must not be present on the following surfaces: the nut chamfers, the wheel
mounting surfaces and the wheel pilot hole. The refinisher must permanently ID stamp the wheel
and warrant the painted/clearcoated surfaces for a minimum of one year or the remainder of the
new vehicle warranty, whichever is
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Wheels: > 99-08-51-007E > Mar > 11 > Wheels/Tires - Refinishing Aluminum Wheels > Page 5894
longer.
Important Whenever a wheel is refinished, the mounting surface and the wheel nut contact
surfaces must not be painted or clearcoated. Coating these surfaces could affect the wheel nut
torque.
When re-mounting a tire on an aluminum wheel, coated balance weights must be used in order to
reduce the chance of future cosmetic damage.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Wheels: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing Procedures/Precautions
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Changing Procedures/Precautions
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-03-10-010A
Date: June 09, 2010
Subject: Information on Proper Wheel Changing Procedures and Cautions
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER Models 2005-2009 Saab
9-7X 2005-2009 Saturn Vehicles
Attention:
Complete wheel changing instructions for each vehicle line can be found under Tire and Wheel
Removal and Installation in Service Information (SI). This bulletin is intended to quickly review and
reinforce simple but vital procedures to reduce the possibility of achieving low torque during wheel
installation. Always refer to SI for wheel lug nut torque specifications and complete jacking
instructions for safe wheel changing.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to include the 2011 model year and update the available
special tool list. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-03-10-010 (Section 03 Suspension).
Frequency of Wheel Changes - Marketplace Driven
Just a few years ago, the increasing longevity of tires along with greater resistance to punctures
had greatly reduced the number of times wheels were removed to basically required tire rotation
intervals. Today with the booming business in accessory wheels/special application tires (such as
winter tires), consumers are having tire/wheel assemblies removed - replaced - or installed more
than ever. With this increased activity, it opens up more of a chance for error on the part of the
technician. This bulletin will review a few of the common concerns and mistakes to make yourself
aware of.
Proper Servicing Starts With the Right Tools
The following tools have been made available to assist in proper wheel and tire removal and
installation.
- J 41013 Rotor Resurfacing Kit (or equivalent)
- J 42450-A Wheel Hub Resurfacing Kit (or equivalent)
Corroded Surfaces
One area of concern is corrosion on the mating surfaces of the wheel to the hub on the vehicle.
Excessive corrosion, dirt, rust or debris built up on these surfaces can mimic a properly tightened
wheel in the service stall. Once the vehicle is driven, the debris may loosen, grind up or be washed
away from water splash. This action may result in clearance at the mating surface of the wheel and
an under-torqued condition.
Caution
Before installing a wheel, remove any buildup on the wheel mounting surface and brake drum or
brake disc mounting surface. Installing wheels with poor metal-to-metal contact at the mounting
surfaces can cause wheel nuts to loosen. This may cause a wheel to come off when the vehicle is
moving, possibly resulting in a loss of control or personal injury.
Whenever you remove the tire/wheel assemblies, you must inspect the mating surfaces. If
corrosion is found, you should remove the debris with a die grinder equipped with a fine sanding
pad, wire brush or cleaning disc. Just remove enough material to assure a clean, smooth mating
surface.
The J 41013 (or equivalent) can be used to clean the following surfaces:
- The hub mounting surface
- The brake rotor mounting surface
- The wheel mounting surface
Use the J 42450-A (or equivalent) to clean around the base of the studs and the hub.
Lubricants, Grease and Fluids
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Wheels: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing Procedures/Precautions > Page 5899
Some customers may use penetrating oils, grease or other lubricants on wheel studs to aid in
removal or installation. Always use a suitable cleaner/solvent to remove these lubricants prior to
installing the wheel and tire assemblies. Lubricants left on the wheel studs may cause improper
readings of wheel nut torque. Always install wheels to clean, dry wheel studs ONLY.
Notice
Lubricants left on the wheel studs or vertical mounting surfaces between the wheel and the rotor or
drum may cause the wheel to work itself loose after the vehicle is driven. Always install wheels to
clean, dry wheel studs and surfaces ONLY. Beginning with 2011 model year vehicles, put a light
coating of grease, GM P/N 1051344 (in Canada, P/N 9930370), on the inner surface of the wheel
pilot hole to prevent wheel seizure to the axle or bearing hub.
Wheel Stud and Lug Nut Damage
Always inspect the wheel studs and lug nuts for signs of damage from crossthreading or abuse.
You should never have to force wheel nuts down the stud. Lug nuts that are damaged may not
retain properly, yet give the impression of fully tightening. Always inspect and replace any
component suspected of damage.
Tip
Always start wheel nuts by hand! Be certain that all wheel nut threads have been engaged
BEFORE tightening the nut.
Important If the vehicle has directional tread tires, verify the directional arrow on the outboard side
of the tire is pointing in the direction of forward rotation.
Wheel Nut Tightening and Torque
Improper wheel nut tightening can lead to brake pulsation and rotor damage. In order to avoid
additional brake repairs, evenly tighten the wheel nuts to the proper torque specification as shown
for each vehicle in SI. Always observe the proper wheel nut tightening sequence as shown below in
order to avoid trapping the wheel on the wheel stud threads or clamping the wheel slightly off
center resulting in vibration.
The Most Important Service You Provide
While the above information is well known, and wheel removal so common, technicians run the risk
of becoming complacent on this very important
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Wheels: > 06-03-10-010A > Jun > 10 > Wheels - Changing Procedures/Precautions > Page 5900
service operation. A simple distraction or time constraint that rushes the job may result in personal
injury if the greatest of care is not exercised. Make it a habit to double check your work and to
always side with caution when installing wheels.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV)
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV)
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-03-10-006F
Date: May 04, 2010
Subject: Information on Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009
and Prior Saab 9-7X 2000-2005 Saturn L Series 2003-2007 Saturn ION
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to considerably expand the available information on
Radial Force Variation (RFV) and should be reviewed in whole. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-03-10-006E (Section 03 - Suspension).
Important
- Before measuring tires on equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700, the vehicle MUST be driven
a minimum of 16 km (10 mi) to ensure removal of any flat-spotting. Refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 03-03-10-007E - Tire/Wheel Characteristics of GM Original Equipment Tires.
- Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 MUST be calibrated prior to measuring tire/wheel
assemblies for each vehicle.
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide guidance to GM dealers when using tire force variation
measurement equipment, such as the Hunter GSP9700. This type of equipment can be a valuable
tool in diagnosing vehicle ride concerns. The most common ride concern involving tire radial force
variation is highway speed shake on smooth roads.
Tire related smooth road highway speed shake can be caused by three conditions: imbalance, out
of round and tire force variation. These three conditions are not necessarily related. All three
conditions must be addressed.
Imbalance is normally addressed first, because it is the simpler of the three to correct. Off-vehicle,
two plane dynamic wheel balancers are readily available and can accurately correct any
imbalance. Balancer calibration and maintenance, proper attachment of the wheel to the balancer,
and proper balance weights, are all factors required for a quality balance. However, a perfectly
balanced tire/wheel assembly can still be "oval shaped" and cause a vibration.
Before balancing, perform the following procedures.
Tire and Wheel Diagnosis
1. Set the tire pressure to the placard values. 2. With the vehicle raised, ensure the wheels are
centered on the hub by loosening all wheel nuts and hand-tightening all nuts first by hand while
shaking the wheel, then torque to specifications using a torque wrench, NOT a torque stick.
3. Visually inspect the tires and the wheels. Inspect for evidence of the following conditions and
correct as necessary:
- Missing balance weights
- Bent rim flange
- Irregular tire wear
- Incomplete bead seating
- Tire irregularities (including pressure settings)
- Mud/ice build-up in wheel
- Stones in the tire tread
- Remove any aftermarket wheels and/or tires and restore vehicle to original condition prior to
diagnosing a smooth road shake condition.
4. Road test the vehicle using the Electronic Vibration Analyzer (EVA) essential tool. Drive for a
sufficient distance on a known, smooth road
surface to duplicate the condition. Determine if the vehicle is sensitive to brake apply. If the brakes
are applied lightly and the pulsation felt in the steering wheel increases, refer to the Brakes section
of the service manual that deals with brake-induced pulsation. If you can start to hear the vibration
as a low boom noise (in addition to feeling it), but cannot see it, the vehicle likely has a first order
(one pulse per propshaft revolution) driveline vibration. Driveline first order vibrations are high
enough in frequency that most humans can start to hear them at highway speeds, but are too high
to be able to be easily seen. These issues can be caused by driveline imbalance or misalignment.
If the vehicle exhibits this low boom and the booming pulses in-and-out on a regular basis (like a
throbbing), chances are good that the vehicle could have driveline vibration. This type
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV) > Page 5905
of vibration is normally felt more in the "seat of the pants" than the steering wheel.
5. Next, record the Hertz (Hz) reading as displayed by the EVA onto the tire data worksheet found
at the end of this bulletin. This should be done
after a tire break-in period of at least 16 km (10 mi) at 72 km/h (45 mph) or greater, in order to
eliminate any possible tire flat-spotting. This reading confirms what the vehicle vibration frequency
is prior to vehicle service and documents the amount of improvement occurring as the result of the
various steps taken to repair. Completing the Steering Wheel Shake Worksheet below is required.
A copy of the completed worksheet must be saved with the R.O. and a copy included with any
parts returned to the Warranty Parts Center for analysis. A reading of 35 to 50 Hz typically
indicates a first order propshaft vibration. If this is the situation, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number
08-07-30-044D. Generally, a reading between 10 and 20 Hz indicates a tire/wheel vibration and if
this is the reading obtained, continue using this bulletin. If the tire 1st order vibration goes away
and stays away during this evaluation, the cause is likely tire flat-spotting. Tire flat-spotting vibration
may come and go at any speed over 72 km/h (45 mph) during the first 10 minutes of operation, if
vibration continues after 10 minutes of driving at speeds greater than 72 km/h (45 mph), tire
flat-spotting can be ruled out as the cause for vibration.
6. If flat-spotting is the cause, provide the explanation that this has occurred due to the vehicle
being parked for long periods of time and that the
nature of the tire is to take a set. Refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 03-03-10-007E: Information
on Tire/Wheel Characteristics (Vibration, Balance, Shake, Flat Spotting) of GM Original Equipment
Tires.
7. If the road test indicates a shake/vibration exists, check the imbalance of each tire/wheel
assembly on a known, calibrated, off-car dynamic
balancer.Make sure the mounting surface of the wheel and the surface of the balancer are
absolutely clean and free of debris. Be sure to chose the proper cone/collet for the wheel, and
always use the pilot bore for centering. Never center the wheel using the hub-cap bore since it is
not a precision machined surface. If any assembly calls for more than 1/4 ounce on either rim
flange, remove all balance weights and rebalance to as close to zero as possible. If you can see
the vibration (along with feeling it) in the steering wheel (driving straight without your hands on the
wheel), it is very likely to be a tire/wheel first order (one pulse per revolution) disturbance. First
order disturbances can be caused by imbalance as well as non-uniformities in tires, wheels or
hubs. This first order frequency is too low for a human to hear, but if the amplitude is high enough,
it can be seen.
If a vibration or shake still exists after balancing, any out of round conditions, of the wheel, and
force variation conditions of the tire, must be addressed. Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700
can address both (it is also a wheel balancer).
Tire radial force vibration (RFV) can be defined as the amount of stiffness variation the tire will
produce in one revolution under a constant load. Radial force variation is what the vehicle feels
because the load (weight) of the vehicle is always on the tires. Although free runout of tires (not
under load) is not always a good indicator of a smooth ride, it is critical that total tire/wheel
assembly runout be within specification.
Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 loads the tire, similar to on the vehicle, and measures
radial force variation of the tire/wheel assembly. Note that the wheel is affecting the tire's RFV
measurement at this point. To isolate the wheel, its runout must be measured. This can be easily
done on the Hunter, without the need to set up dial indicators. If the wheel meets the runout
specification, the tire's RFV can then be addressed.
After measuring the tire/wheel assembly under load, and the wheel alone, the machine then
calculates (predicts) the radial force variation of the tire. However, because this is a prediction that
can include mounting inaccuracies, and the load wheel is much smaller in diameter than used in
tire production, this type of service equipment should NOT be used to audit new tires. Rather, it
should be used as a service diagnostic tool to minimize radial force variation of the tire/wheel
assembly.
Equipment such as the Hunter GSP9700 does an excellent job of measuring wheel runout, and of
finding the low point of the wheel (for runout) and the high point of the tire (for radial force
variation). This allows the tire to be matched mounted to the wheel for lowest tire/wheel assembly
force variation.
The machine will simplify this process into easy steps. The following assembly radial force variation
numbers should be used as a guide:
When measuring RFV and match mounting tires perform the following steps.
Measuring Wheel Runout and Assembly Radial Force Variation
Important The completed worksheet at the end of this bulletin must be attached to the hard copy of
the repair order.
- Measure radial force variation and radial runout.
- If a road force/balancing machine is used, record the radial force variation (RFV) on the
worksheet at the end of this bulletin. It may be of benefit to have the lowest RFV assembly to the
front left corner. If the machine is not available and the EVA data suggests there is an issue, swap
the tire and wheel assemblies from the front to the back. Re-check on the EVA and if the problem
still exists, test another vehicle to find tires that do not exhibit the same frequency and swap those
tires onto the subject vehicle.
- If a runout/balancing machine is used, record the radial runout of the tire/wheel assemblies on the
worksheet at the end of this bulletin. If one or more of the tire/wheel assemblies are more than.040
in (1.02 mm), match mount the tire to the wheel to get below.040 in (1.02 mm). For sensitive
customers, readings of 0.030 inch (0.76 mm) or less are preferable, it may also be of benefit to
have the lowest runout assembly to the front left corner. If the machine is not available and the
EVA data suggests there is an issue, swap the tire and wheel assemblies from the front to the
back. Re-check on the EVA and if the problem still exists, test another vehicle to find tires that do
not exhibit the same frequency and swap those tires
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV) > Page 5906
onto the subject vehicle.
- After match mounting, the tire/wheel assembly must be rebalanced.
If match mounting tires to in-spec wheels produces assembly values higher than these, tire
replacement may be necessary. Replacing tires at lower values will probably mean good tires are
being condemned. Because tires can sometimes become temporarily flat-spotted, which will affect
force variation, it is important that the vehicle be driven at least 16 km (10 mi) prior to measuring.
Tire pressure must also be adjusted to the usage pressure on the vehicle's tire placard prior to
measuring.
Most GM vehicles will tolerate radial force variation up to these levels. However, some vehicles are
more sensitive, and may require lower levels. Also, there are other tire parameters that equipment
such as the Hunter GSP9700 cannot measure that may be a factor. In such cases, TAC should be
contacted for further instructions.
Important
- When mounting a GM wheel to a wheel balancer/force variation machine, always use the wheel's
center pilot hole. This is the primary centering mechanism on all GM wheels; the bolt holes are
secondary. Usually a back cone method to the machine should be used. For added accuracy and
repeatability, a flange plate should be used to clamp the wheel onto the cone and machine. This
system is offered by all balancer manufacturers in GM's dealer program.
- Any type of service equipment that removes tread rubber by grinding, buffing or truing is NOT
recommended, and may void the tire warranty. However, tires may have been ground by the tire
company as part of their tire manufacturing process. This is a legitimate procedure.
Steering Wheel Shake Worksheet
When diagnosing vibration concerns, use the following worksheet in conjunction with the
appropriate Vibration Analysis-Road testing procedure in the Vibration Correction sub-section in SI.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Wheels: > 00-03-10-006F > May > 10 > Wheels/Tires - Tire Radial Force Variation (RFV) > Page 5907
Refer to the appropriate section of SI for specifications and repair procedures that are related to the
vibration concern.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Wheels: > 05-03-10-003F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 05-03-10-003F
Date: April 27, 2010
Subject: Low Tire Pressure, Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels (Repair with Adhesive Sealant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X with Cast Aluminum Wheels
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years and the bulletin reference
information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 05-03-10-003E (Section 03 - Suspension).
Condition
Some customers may comment on a low tire pressure condition.
Diagnosis of the low tire pressure condition indicates an air leak through the cast aluminum wheel.
Cause
Porosity in the cast aluminum wheel may be the cause.
Notice
This bulletin specifically addresses issues related to the wheel casting that may result in an air
leak. For issues related to corrosion of the wheel in service, please refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 08-03-10-006C - Tire Slowly Goes Flat, Tire Air Loss, Low Tire Pressure Warning Light
Illuminated, Aluminum Wheel Bead Seat Corrosion (Clean and Resurface Wheel Bead Seat).
Correction
1. Remove the tire and wheel assembly from the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate service
procedure in SI. 2. Locate the leaking area by inflating the tire to 276 kPa (40 psi) and dipping the
tire/wheel assembly in a water bath, or use a spray bottle with soap
and water to locate the specific leak location.
Important
- If the porosity leak is located in the bead area of the aluminum rim (where the tire meets the rim),
the wheel should be replaced.
- If two or more leaks are located on one wheel, the wheel should be replaced.
3. If air bubbles are observed, mark the location.
- If the leak location is on the tire/rubber area, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 04-03-10-001F Tire Puncture Repair Procedures for All Cars and Light Duty Trucks.
- If the leak is located on the aluminum wheel area, continue with the next step.
4. Inscribe a mark on the tire at the valve stem in order to indicate the orientation of the tire to the
wheel. 5. Dismount the tire from the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 6. Remove
the tire pressure sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor removal procedure in SI. 7. Scuff the
INSIDE rim surface at the leak area with #80 grit paper and clean the area with general purpose
cleaner, such as 3M(R) General Purpose
Adhesive Cleaner, P/N 08984, or equivalent.
8. Apply a 3 mm (0.12 in) thick layer of Silicone - Adhesive/Sealant, P/N 12378478 (in Canada, use
88900041), or equivalent, to the leak area. 9. Allow for the adhesive/sealant to dry.
Notice Caution must be used when mounting the tire so as not to damage the sealer. Damaging
the repair area may result in an air leak.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Wheels: > 05-03-10-003F > Apr > 10 > Tires/Wheels - Low Tire/Leaking Cast Aluminum Wheels > Page 5912
10. Align the inscribed mark on the tire with the valve stem on the wheel. 11. Reinstall the Tire
Pressure Sensor. Refer to Tire Pressure Sensor installation procedure in SI. 12. Mount the tire on
the wheel. Refer to Tire Mounting and Dismounting. 13. Pressurize the tire to 276 kPa (40 psi) and
inspect for leaks. 14. Adjust tire pressure to meet the placard specification. 15. Balance the
tire/wheel assembly. Refer to Tire and Wheel Assembly Balancing - Off-Vehicle. 16. Install the tire
and wheel assembly onto the vehicle. Refer to the appropriate service procedure in SI.
Parts Information
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
Important The Silicone - Adhesive/Sealant comes in a case quantity of six. ONLY charge warranty
one tube of adhesive/sealant per wheel repair.
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
One leak repair per wheel.
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Wheels: > 04-03-10-012B > Feb > 08 > Wheels - Chrome Wheel Brake Dust Accumulation/Pitting
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Chrome Wheel Brake Dust Accumulation/Pitting
Bulletin No.: 04-03-10-012B
Date: February 01, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Pitting and Brake Dust on Chrome wheels
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2008 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
04-03-10-012A (Section 03 - Suspension).
Analysis of Returned Wheels
Chrome wheels returned under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty for pitting concerns have
recently been evaluated. This condition is usually most severe in the vent (or window) area of the
front wheels. This "pitting" may actually be brake dust that has been allowed to accumulate on the
wheel. The longer this accumulation builds up, the more difficult it is to remove.
Cleaning the Wheels
In all cases, the returned wheels could be cleaned to their original condition using GM Vehicle Care
Cleaner Wax, P/N 12377966 (in Canada, P/N 10952905). When using this product, you should
confine your treatment to the areas of the wheel that show evidence of the brake dust build-up.
This product is only for use on chromed steel or chromed aluminum wheels.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Wheel replacement for this condition is NOT applicable under the terms of the New Vehicle Limited
Warranty.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Wheels: > 99-03-10-102 > Jun > 99 > Warranty - OE Chrome Plated Aluminum Wheel ID
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Warranty - OE Chrome Plated Aluminum Wheel ID
File In Section: 03 - Suspension
Bulletin No.: 99-03-10-102
Date: June, 1999
INFORMATION
Subject: Original Equipment Chrome Plated Aluminum Wheel Identification
Models: 1999 and Prior Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
Chrome plated aluminum wheels have been returned to the Warranty Parts Center that are not the
original equipment (OE) components.
Original equipment chrome plated aluminum wheels can be identified by either a balance weight
clip retention groove (1) or a step (2) that is machined around both of the wheel's rim flanges. The
rim flanges (3) of painted original equipment aluminum wheels do not have a groove or a step.
Chrome plated aluminum wheels that do not have the wheel rim flange groove or step are
aftermarket chrome plated components and are NOT warrantable. Any aftermarket chrome wheels
received by the Warranty Parts Center will be charged back to the dealership.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Wheels: > 72-05-05 > Aug > 97 > Warranty - Guidelines for Using E0420 Wheel Replace
Wheels: All Technical Service Bulletins Warranty - Guidelines for Using E0420 Wheel Replace
File In Section: Warranty Administration
Bulletin No.: 72-05-05
Date: August, 1997
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
Subject: Guidelines for Using EO42O Wheel Replace
Models: 1989-98 Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide service personnel with guidelines for using the above
subject labor operation.
Effective with repair orders dated on or after September 1, 1997, dealers are to be guided by the
following:
^ Aluminum Wheels (including chrome plated) with Porosity - Wheels that exhibit porosity should
be repaired as described in the vehicle service manual. Wheels should not be replaced without
wholesale approval.
^ Aluminum Wheels (except chrome plated) with a "Finish Defect" - Wheels that exhibit a defect in
the finish, (i.e., discoloration or surface degradation) should be refinished as described in the
Corporate Service Bulletin Number 53-17-03A released in May, 1996.
^ Chrome Wheels - Wheels that are chromed and found to have a finish defect can only be
replaced.
^ Aluminum and chrome wheels replaced under warranty will be subject to random part review and
inspection. Those wheels inspected and found not to be defective and/or should have been
repaired, will be subject to charge back.
Wheels damaged by normal wear, road hazards, car wash brushes, or other physical or chemical
damage are not eligible for warranty coverage.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Wheels: > 531703A > May > 96 > Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing
Technical Service Bulletin # 531703A Date: 960501
Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing
File In Section: 10 - Body
Bulletin No.: 53-17-03A
Date: May, 1996
INFORMATION
Subject: Aluminum Wheel Refinishing
Models: 1991-96 Passenger Cars and Trucks
This bulletin is being revised to delete the 1990 model year and add the 1996 model year. Please
discard Corporate Bulletin Number 53-17-03 (Section 10 - Body).
This bulletin supersedes and cancels all previous service bulletins concerning the refinishing of
aluminum wheels. The purpose of this service bulletin is to assist dealerships in repairing the
discoloration or surface degradation that has occurred on styled aluminum wheels.
This bulletin provides NEW PROCEDURES AND SPECIFIC MATERIALS for the refinishing of
painted aluminum wheels or aluminum wheels with discoloration or surface degradation.
Important:
THE RE-MACHINING OF ALUMINUM WHEELS IS NOT RECOMMENDED. THE RE-CLEAR
COATING OF ALUMINUM WHEELS IS NO LONGER RECOMMENDED DUE TO CONCERNS OF
REPAIR DURABILITY
The new procedure requires the wheel surface be plastic media blasted to remove old paint or
clear coat. CHEMICAL STRIPPERS ARE NOT RECOMMENDED.
Material Required
System 1: DuPont Products
3939-S Cleaning Solvent 615/616 Etching Primer URO 5000 Primer Surfacer IMRON 6000
Basecoat 3440-S IMRON Clear
System 2: PPG Products
DX533 Aluminum Cleaner DX503 Aluminum Conditioner DP Epoxy Primer Deltron Basecoat
(DBC) Concept 2001 Clear Acrylic Urethane
System 3: Spies Hecker
Permahyd Silicone Remover 7090 Permahyd 1:1 Primer 4070 Permahyd 2:1 Surfacer 5080
Permahyd Base Coat Series 280/285 Permahyd H.S. Clearcoat 8060
Color Selection
If the wheels being painted were previously clearcoated aluminum, we would recommend using
Corsican SILVER WAEQ9283 for a fine "aluminum-like" look or Sparkle SILVER WA9967 for a
very bright look. As an option to the customer, you may also use body color. For color
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Wheels: > 531703A > May > 96 > Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing > Page 5929
selection and verification, refer to your paint manufacturer's color book. On wheels that were
previous clearcoated aluminum it is recommended that all four wheels and their center caps be
refinished to maintain color uniformity.
Important:
THE PRODUCTS LISTED MUST BE USED AS A SYSTEM. DO NOT MIX OTHER
MANUFACTURERS' PRODUCT LINES WITH THE REQUIRED MATERIALS. PRODUCTS
LISTED IN THIS BULLETIN HAVE SHOWN THE REQUIRED REPAIR DURABILITY, AND
CURRENTLY ARE THE ONLY PAINT SYSTEMS THAT MEET GM SPECIFICATION
4350M-A336.
Procedures
1. Remove wheels from vehicle. Tires may remain mounted on wheels.
2. Remove balance weights and mark their location on tire.
3. Wipe excess grease, etc. from wheels with wax and grease remover.
4. Have wheels plastic media blasted to remove clearcoat. FOR FURTHER INFORMATION ON
MEDIA BLASTING IN YOUR AREA, CALL US TECHNOLOGIES INC., CONTACT DAVE
ROSENBURG AT 1-800-634-9185.
Caution:
IT IS MANDATORY THAT ADEQUATE RESPIRATORY PROTECTION BE WORN. EXAMPLES
OF SUCH PROTECTION ARE: AIR LINE RESPIRATORS WITH FULL HOOD OR HALF MASK. IF
NOT AVAILABLE, USE A VAPOR/PARTICULATE RESPIRATOR THAT RESPIRATOR
MANUFACTURER RECOMMENDS AS EFFECTIVE FOR ISOCYANATE VAPOR AND MISTS
(UNLESS LOCAL REGULATIONS PREVAIL).
5. Painting Process
a. Refer to Attachments 1-3 for each System's individual formula and process.
b. After following the specific System's individual formula and process, follow these steps:
6. Unmask wheels.
7. Clean all wheel mounting surface of any corrosion, overspray, or dirt.
8. Install new coated balance weights, at marked locations.
9. Replace wheels on vehicle.
10. USE A TORQUE STICK ON AN IMPACT WRENCH, OR A TORQUE WRENCH TO
CONSISTENTLY AND UNIFORMLY FASTEN THE WHEEL TO THE SPECIFIED TORQUE FOR
THE VEHICLE. THE STAR PATTERN MUST BE FOLLOWED.
Important:
TORQUE STICKS MUST BE USED ANY TIME AN IMPACT WRENCH IS USED TO TIGHTEN
WHEEL NUTS.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use as shown.
Attachment 1 - DuPont Products
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Wheels: > 531703A > May > 96 > Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing > Page 5930
Painting Process
System: Dupont Products
Paint Color Information: Corsican Silver WA EQ9283 Dupont # C9143, Sparkle Silver WA9967
Dupont # C9339
1. Wipe wheel with cleaning solvent: 3939-S, 3949-S or 3900-S.
2. Mask off tires.
Important:
3. Mask off all wheel mounting surfaces and wheel mount surfaces.
4. Apply two coats of 615/616-S etching primer to wheel allowing 10 minutes flash between coats.
Allow to dry for 30 minutes before applying primer coat.
5. Apply URO 5000 primer 1220/193-S + accelerator 389-S using two coats at 65-70 PSI at the
gun. Allow 12-15 minutes between coats. Force bake 30 minutes at 140°F (60°C).
6. Scuff sand using green Scotch-Brite pad.
7. Solvent wipe before top coating.
8. Apply IMRON 6000 base coat to wheel. 2-3 coats to hiding at 60-70 PSI allowing to flash
between coats. Base coat needs to dry 20-30 minutes before clearcoat is applied.
9. Apply 3440-S clearcoat to wheel using two coats at 60-70 PSI. Flash 10-15 minutes between
coats. 389-S can be used in basecoat and clearcoat to give faster set up times.
10. Allow overnight dry before reassemble. Can be baked for 30 minutes at 140°F (60°C).
Attachment 2 - PPG Products
Painting Process: PPG System
Paint Color Information: Corsican Silver WAEQ9283; PPG # DBC-3531, Sparkle Silver WA9967;
PPG # 35367
1. Wash entire wheel with aluminum cleaner DX533, mix 1:3 with water. Allow to react 2-3 minutes
and rinse thoroughly.
2. Wash entire wheel with aluminum conditioner DX5O3 straight from the container. Allow to react
2-3 minutes until pale gold or tan color develops. Rinse thoroughly and dry.
3. Mask off tires.
Important:
4. Mask off all wheel nut mounting surfaces and wheel mounting surfaces.
5. Apply 1-2 coats of DP Primer and allow to flash for 15-20 minutes.
6. Apply 2-3 coats of Deltron Basecoat (DBC) and allow to flash 20 minutes after the final coat.
7. Apply two (2) wet coats of Concept 2001 Acrylic urethane.
8. Flash 20 minutes and bake 140°F (60°C) for 30 minutes.
For more information contact your PPG Jobber.
Attachment 3 - Spies Hecker
Painting Process: Spies Hecker System
Paint Color Information: Corsican Silver AWEQ9283; SH-72913, Sparkle Silver WA9967;
SH-71912
1. Clean with Permahyd Silicone Remover 7090.
2. Mask off tires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheels > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheels: > 73-33-01A > Dec > 97 > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Wheels: > 531703A > May > 96 > Aluminum Wheels - Refinishing > Page 5931
Important:
3. Mask off all wheel nut mounting surfaces and wheel mounting surfaces.
4. Apply 1-1/2 coats of Permahyd 1:1 Primer 4070. Mix 1:1 with Permahyd Hardener 3070 as per
TDS.
5. Allow to flash for 30 minutes.
6. Apply two (2) coats of Permahyd 2:1 Surfacer 5080. Mix 2:1 with Permahyd Hardener 3071 as
per TDS.
7. Bake for 60 minutes at 140°F (60°C) or allow to flash for 3 hours at 68°F (20°C).
8. Apply Permahyd Base Coat Series 280/285 as per TDS.
9. Allow to flash 10 to 15 minutes.
10. Apply 1 to 2 coats of Permacron High Solid Clear Coat 8060 as per TDS.
11. Allow to flash 10 minutes. Then bake at 140°F (60°C) for 40 minutes.
For more information, contact your SPIES HECKER Jobber.
We believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such products. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products or equipment from these firms or for any such items which may be
available from other sources.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Specifications
Wheel Bearing: Specifications
Front Suspension
Hub and Bearing Assembly to Steering Knuckle Bolts
........................................................................................................................ 95 Nm (70 ft. lbs.)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Wheel Bearing Removal and Installation
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Front Wheel Bearing Removal and Installation
FRONT WHEEL BEARINGS AND/OR HUB
Fig. 2 Modified Outer Seal Protector
Fig. 3 Removing And Installing Shaft Nut
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Remove tire and wheel assembly, then install modified outer seal
protector No. J 34754 or equivalent, Fig. 2. 3. Insert a drift punch through the rotor, Fig. 3 , then
remove axle shaft nut and washer. 4. Remove ball joint, then using tool No. J-28733-A, or
equivalent, disengage axle from hub and bearing assembly. 5. On all models, move axle shaft
inward, then remove caliper attaching bolts and support caliper. 6. Remove brake rotor, then hub
and bearing assembly attaching bolts. 7. Remove hub and bearing assembly.
INSTALLATION
1. Install hub and bearing assembly, tighten attaching bolts to specification. 2. Install hub and
bearing seal, then the brake rotor. 3. Install caliper, tighten attaching bolts to specification. 4. Move
axle shaft outward, then insert drift punch through rotor, Fig. 3. 5. Install washer and new shaft nut,
tighten shaft nut to specification. 6. Install ball joint, then remove drift punch and seal protector. 7.
Install tire and wheel assembly, then lower vehicle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Bearing > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Front Wheel Bearing Removal and Installation > Page 5937
Wheel Bearing: Service and Repair Rear
REAR HUB AND/OR BEARINGS
1. Raise and support vehicle, then remove wheel and tire assembly and brake drum.
CAUTION: Do not hammer brake drum since damage to bearing may result.
2. Remove four hub/bearing assembly to rear axle attaching bolts, then the hub/bearing assembly
from axle.
NOTE: The upper rear hub attaching bolt may not clear brake shoe when removing hub and
bearing assembly. Partially remove hub and bearing assembly prior to removing this bolt.
3. Reverse procedure to install. Torque hub attaching bolts to specification.
CAUTION: Use care not to drop hub/bearing assembly since damage to bearing may result.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Hub > Axle Nut > Component
Information > Specifications
Axle Nut: Specifications
Component ..........................................................................................................................................
....................................................... Torque/Ft. Lbs.
Axle Nut ...............................................................................................................................................
............................................................................ 184
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 01-03-10-009A > Jul > 04 > Wheels - Plastic Wheel Nut Covers
Loose/Missing
Wheel Fastener: Customer Interest Wheels - Plastic Wheel Nut Covers Loose/Missing
Bulletin No.: 01-03-10-009A
Date: July 27, 2004
TECHNICAL
Subject: Plastic Wheel Nut Covers Missing and/or Loose (Replace Missing Covers and Add
Sealant to All Covers)
Models: 2005 and All Prior Passenger Cars (Except All Cadillac Models and Pontiac GTO)
with Plastic Wheel Nut Covers
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add additional models years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 01-03-10-009.
Condition
Some customers may comment that the plastic wheel nut covers are missing and/or loose.
Correction
Important:
^ DO NOT USE a silicone-based adhesive.
^ Do not apply the *permatex(R) around the threads in a circular pattern.
^ Apply a single bead across the threads approximately 10 mm (0.4 in) in length, 5 mm (0.2 in) in
height and 5 mm (0.2 in) in width.
Replace any missing plastic wheel nut covers with the appropriate covers and apply Permatex(R) #
2 Form A Gasket Sealant(R) to the threads of all the plastic wheel nut covers. Tighten finger tight
plus a 1/4 turn with a hand wrench.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such material.
General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any responsibility for the
products from this firm or for any other such items which may be available from other sources.
Permatex(R) # 2 Form A Gasket Sealant(R) part numbers (available at your local parts supplier)
^ P/N 80009 (2A/2AR) - 44 ml (1.5 oz) tube boxed
^ P/N 80015 (2AR) - 44 ml (1.5 oz) tube carded
^ P/N 80010 (2B/2BR) - 89 ml (3 oz) tube boxed
^ P/N 80016 (2BR) - 89 ml (3 oz) tube carded
^ P/N 80011 (2C) - 325 ml (11 oz) tube boxed
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 01-03-10-009A > Jul > 04 > Wheels - Plastic Wheel Nut Covers
Loose/Missing > Page 5950
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 01-03-10-009A > Jul > 04 > Wheels - Plastic Wheel Nut
Covers Loose/Missing
Wheel Fastener: All Technical Service Bulletins Wheels - Plastic Wheel Nut Covers Loose/Missing
Bulletin No.: 01-03-10-009A
Date: July 27, 2004
TECHNICAL
Subject: Plastic Wheel Nut Covers Missing and/or Loose (Replace Missing Covers and Add
Sealant to All Covers)
Models: 2005 and All Prior Passenger Cars (Except All Cadillac Models and Pontiac GTO)
with Plastic Wheel Nut Covers
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add additional models years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 01-03-10-009.
Condition
Some customers may comment that the plastic wheel nut covers are missing and/or loose.
Correction
Important:
^ DO NOT USE a silicone-based adhesive.
^ Do not apply the *permatex(R) around the threads in a circular pattern.
^ Apply a single bead across the threads approximately 10 mm (0.4 in) in length, 5 mm (0.2 in) in
height and 5 mm (0.2 in) in width.
Replace any missing plastic wheel nut covers with the appropriate covers and apply Permatex(R) #
2 Form A Gasket Sealant(R) to the threads of all the plastic wheel nut covers. Tighten finger tight
plus a 1/4 turn with a hand wrench.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such material.
General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any responsibility for the
products from this firm or for any other such items which may be available from other sources.
Permatex(R) # 2 Form A Gasket Sealant(R) part numbers (available at your local parts supplier)
^ P/N 80009 (2A/2AR) - 44 ml (1.5 oz) tube boxed
^ P/N 80015 (2AR) - 44 ml (1.5 oz) tube carded
^ P/N 80010 (2B/2BR) - 89 ml (3 oz) tube boxed
^ P/N 80016 (2BR) - 89 ml (3 oz) tube carded
^ P/N 80011 (2C) - 325 ml (11 oz) tube boxed
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 01-03-10-009A > Jul > 04 > Wheels - Plastic Wheel Nut
Covers Loose/Missing > Page 5956
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Wheel Fastener: > 331106 > Dec > 93 > A/C - Water Leaking
Into Passenger Footwell Area
Air Duct: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Water Leaking Into Passenger Footwell Area
Group Ref.: HVAC Bulletin No.: 331106 Date: December, 1993
SUBJECT: WATER LEAKING INTO THE FOOTWELL OF THE RIGHT FRONT PASSENGER
AREA (REPOSITION AIR INLET TO FRONT OF DASH GASKET)
MODELS: 1994 CHEVROLET CAVALIER 1994 PONTIAC SUNBIRD
Vehicles affected were produced at Lordstown:
Chevrolet: S.O.P. to R7118284
Pontiac: S.O.P. to R7506224
CONDITION: Some owners may comment on water leaking into the footwell of the right front
passenger area.
CAUSE: This condition could be caused by a twisted gasket between the blower air inlet and the
front of dash.
CORRECTION: Remove the blower air inlet and reposition the gasket to seal completely around air
inlet and reinstall.
Follow service procedure outlined in Section 1A or 1B of the appropriate service manual.
WARRANTY INFORMATION: For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Number: D1870
Labor Time: Use published labor operation time.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information
> Specifications > Front Suspension
Wheel Fastener: Specifications Front Suspension
FRONT SUSPENSION
Component ..........................................................................................................................................
....................................................... Torque/Ft. Lbs.
Ball Joint To Knuckle ...........................................................................................................................
........................................................................ 41-50 Caliper Bolts .....................................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
... 38 Control Arm Pivot Bolt ................................................................................................................
...................................................................................... 61 Hub & Bearing Assembly .........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
........... 70 Hub Nut ..............................................................................................................................
.............................................................................................. 185 Inner Tie Rod End Bolts ................
..............................................................................................................................................................
...................... 65 Power Coupling To Steering Column ......................................................................
.......................................................................................................... 30 Power Coupling To Stub
Shaft ....................................................................................................................................................
....................................... 30 Power Rack & Pinion Mounts .................................................................
........................................................................................................................... 22 Power Steering
Return Lines ........................................................................................................................................
...................................................... 19 Stabilizer Shaft To Control Arm ...............................................
......................................................................................................................................... 13 Stabilizer
To Support Assembly ..........................................................................................................................
............................................................... 16 Steering Knuckle To Strut Assembly ..............................
................................................................................................................................................. 133
Strut Assembly To Body ......................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 18 Strut Cartridge Retaining Nut ..........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
..... 65 Suspension Support Assembly .................................................................................................
........................................................................................ [01]
Tie Rod Pinch Bolts .............................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 41 Tie Rod To Steering Knuckle ...........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
... 37 Tie Rod To Strut .........................................................................................................................
....................................................................................... 37 Wheel Lug Nuts ......................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
........... 100
[01] -- Torque suspension support assembly center bolts to 66 ft. lbs.; then front bolts to 65 ft. lbs.;
then rear bolts to 65 ft. lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Steering and Suspension > Wheels and Tires > Wheel Fastener > Component Information
> Specifications > Front Suspension > Page 5969
Wheel Fastener: Specifications Rear Suspension
REAR SUSPENSION
Component ..........................................................................................................................................
....................................................... Torque/Ft. Lbs.
Axle To Body Bracket ..........................................................................................................................
............................................................................. 68 Brake Line Bracket To Axle ..............................
..............................................................................................................................................................
.. 11 Brake Line Bracket To Frame ......................................................................................................
........................................................................................ 8 Hub & Bearing Assembly .........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
........... 37 Shock Absorber Bolt At Axle ..............................................................................................
.............................................................................................. 35 Shock Absorber Mount To Body ......
..............................................................................................................................................................
................... 13 Shock Absorber To Mount ..........................................................................................
....................................................................................................... 21 Stabilizer Shaft Clamp Bolts At
Axle ......................................................................................................................................................
........................... 13 Stabilizer Shaft Clamp Nuts ................................................................................
............................................................................................................... 16 Wheel Lug Nuts ..............
..............................................................................................................................................................
................................... 100
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Air Door Actuator / Motor: Component Locations
Center Of I/P
Center Of I/P
Center Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Actuator / Motor, HVAC >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 5976
Behind RH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Cable, HVAC > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/C - Inability to Adjust the Temperature Control
Air Door Cable: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Inability to Adjust the Temperature Control
Group Ref.: 1 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 331105A
Date: June, 1994
SUBJECT: DIFFICULTY OR INABILITY TO ADJUST THE TEMPERATURE CONTROL (REPAIR
OR REPLACE TEMPERATURE CABLE)
MODELS: 1994 CHEVROLET CAVALIER 1994 PONTIAC SUNBIRD AFFECTED VEHICLE VINs:
DIVISION LORDSTOWN RAMOS
CHEVROLET R7108384 - R7144698 RS801617 - RS803057
PONTIAC R7502924 - R7517151 RS801618 - RS803056
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING REVISED TO UPDATE WARRANTY INFORMATION - LABOR TIME
WAS NOT PREVIOUSLY SPECIFIED FOR NEW LABOR OPERATION NUMBER D0460.
PLEASE DISCARD BULLETIN 331105 (GROUP REFERENCE 1 - HVAC).
CONDITION:
Some owners may comment on the difficulty or inability to adjust the temperature control on their
vehicle.
CAUSE:
The above condition could be caused by one of the following conditions:
1. Temperature control cable bent at the eyelet.
2. Adjustment clip inadvertently sliding along cable and losing adjustment.
3. Temperature control cable too long and contacting case of the module.
4. Temperature control cable retainer missing from the control head or the module.
CORRECTION:
Determine cause of the inoperation/binding and perform the following:
1. If the temperature control cable is determined to be too long or the temperature control cable
eyelet is bent, replace the temperature control
cable.
2. If the temperature control cable is out of adjustment, readjust cable.
3. If the temperature control cable retainer is missing from either the control head or the module,
reinstall cable and install new retainer.
PARTS INFORMATION:
Description P/N
Cable assembly, temperature control 22596967
Retainer, temperature control cable 11501937
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
WARRANTY INFORMATION: For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Door, HVAC > Air Door Cable, HVAC > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/C - Inability to Adjust the Temperature Control > Page 5981
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Air Duct: > 331106 > Dec > 93 > A/C - Water Leaking Into Passenger Footwell Area
Air Duct: Customer Interest A/C - Water Leaking Into Passenger Footwell Area
Group Ref.: HVAC Bulletin No.: 331106 Date: December, 1993
SUBJECT: WATER LEAKING INTO THE FOOTWELL OF THE RIGHT FRONT PASSENGER
AREA (REPOSITION AIR INLET TO FRONT OF DASH GASKET)
MODELS: 1994 CHEVROLET CAVALIER 1994 PONTIAC SUNBIRD
Vehicles affected were produced at Lordstown:
Chevrolet: S.O.P. to R7118284
Pontiac: S.O.P. to R7506224
CONDITION: Some owners may comment on water leaking into the footwell of the right front
passenger area.
CAUSE: This condition could be caused by a twisted gasket between the blower air inlet and the
front of dash.
CORRECTION: Remove the blower air inlet and reposition the gasket to seal completely around air
inlet and reinstall.
Follow service procedure outlined in Section 1A or 1B of the appropriate service manual.
WARRANTY INFORMATION: For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Number: D1870
Labor Time: Use published labor operation time.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Air Duct > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Air Duct: > 331106 > Dec > 93 > A/C - Water Leaking Into Passenger Footwell
Area
Air Duct: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Water Leaking Into Passenger Footwell Area
Group Ref.: HVAC Bulletin No.: 331106 Date: December, 1993
SUBJECT: WATER LEAKING INTO THE FOOTWELL OF THE RIGHT FRONT PASSENGER
AREA (REPOSITION AIR INLET TO FRONT OF DASH GASKET)
MODELS: 1994 CHEVROLET CAVALIER 1994 PONTIAC SUNBIRD
Vehicles affected were produced at Lordstown:
Chevrolet: S.O.P. to R7118284
Pontiac: S.O.P. to R7506224
CONDITION: Some owners may comment on water leaking into the footwell of the right front
passenger area.
CAUSE: This condition could be caused by a twisted gasket between the blower air inlet and the
front of dash.
CORRECTION: Remove the blower air inlet and reposition the gasket to seal completely around air
inlet and reinstall.
Follow service procedure outlined in Section 1A or 1B of the appropriate service manual.
WARRANTY INFORMATION: For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Number: D1870
Labor Time: Use published labor operation time.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates
Blower Motor: Customer Interest A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates
File In Section: 1 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 53-12-12A
Date: December, 1996
Subject: Air Conditioning Odor at Start Up in Humid Climates (Disinfect Evaporator Core, Install
Delayed Blower Control Package)
Models: 1993-96 Passenger Cars (Except GEO) 1993-96 Light Duty Models (Except Tracker)
This bulletin is being revised to update the wiring diagrams, add the Corvette (with RPO C60) and
delete medium/heavy duty trucks. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 53-12-12 (Section 1 HVAC).
Condition
Some owners may comment on odors emitted from the air conditioning system, primarily at start up
in hot, humid climates.
Cause
This odor may be the result of microbial growth on the evaporator core. When the blower motor fan
is turned on, the microbial growth may release an unpleasant musty odor into the passenger
compartment.
Correction
To remove odors of this type, it is necessary to eliminate the microbial growth and prevent its
recurrence. To accomplish this, these two procedures must be completed.
^ Deodorize the evaporator core using Deodorizing Aerosol Kit, P/N 12377951 (AC Delco 15-102).
^ Install the new A/C Delayed Blower Control Package, P/N 12370470, (AC Delco 15-8632).
The blower control package will enable the blower to run at high speed for five (5) minutes. It will
do so approximately fifty (50) minutes after the ignition has been turned off if the compressor had
been engaged for four (4) or more minutes prior to shutting off engine. By doing so, the evaporator
case and core are dried out, reducing the chances of a recurring A/C odor.
Procedure
1. Visually inspect the air conditioning evaporator drain hose for obstructions or working condition.
2. Apply deodorizing aerosol as described in the instructions supplied with the kit. Once the
deodorizer has been applied, some of the mixture may overflow from the drain hose.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page
6003
3. The chart identifies specific instructions for each vehicle. This chart will identify the proper
deodorizing procedure, template and wiring diagram. Deodorizing the evaporator case can easily
be done by removing the blower motor resistor and tape off opening. The nozzle can now be
inserted through a pierced hole in the tape to deodorize the evaporator case. For some of the
vehicles specified below, a drilling procedure is identified in the deodorizing instructions. This type
of alternative procedure and others can be done by using the referenced templates in the chart.
4. Complete detailed installation instructions are supplied with the blower control package.
Important:
A. 1996 ONLY (Use blower resistor location for drilling procedure)
B. 1994-1996 ONLY
Refer to appropriate Service Manual for enabling afterblow feature through on-board diagnostics.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page
6004
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use as shown.
Figure 1
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page
6005
Figure 2
Figure 3
Figure 4
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page
6006
Figure 5
Figure 6
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page
6007
Figure 7
Figure 8
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page
6008
Figure 9
Figure 10
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page
6009
Figure 11
Figure 12
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page
6010
Figure 13
Figure 14
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page
6011
Figure 15
Figure 16
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page
6012
Figure 17
Figure 18
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page
6013
Figure 19
Figure 20
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page
6014
Figure 21
Figure 22
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page
6015
Figure 23
Figure 24
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page
6016
Figure 25
Figure 26
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates > Page
6017
Figure 27
Figure 28
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates
Blower Motor: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates
File In Section: 1 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 53-12-12A
Date: December, 1996
Subject: Air Conditioning Odor at Start Up in Humid Climates (Disinfect Evaporator Core, Install
Delayed Blower Control Package)
Models: 1993-96 Passenger Cars (Except GEO) 1993-96 Light Duty Models (Except Tracker)
This bulletin is being revised to update the wiring diagrams, add the Corvette (with RPO C60) and
delete medium/heavy duty trucks. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 53-12-12 (Section 1 HVAC).
Condition
Some owners may comment on odors emitted from the air conditioning system, primarily at start up
in hot, humid climates.
Cause
This odor may be the result of microbial growth on the evaporator core. When the blower motor fan
is turned on, the microbial growth may release an unpleasant musty odor into the passenger
compartment.
Correction
To remove odors of this type, it is necessary to eliminate the microbial growth and prevent its
recurrence. To accomplish this, these two procedures must be completed.
^ Deodorize the evaporator core using Deodorizing Aerosol Kit, P/N 12377951 (AC Delco 15-102).
^ Install the new A/C Delayed Blower Control Package, P/N 12370470, (AC Delco 15-8632).
The blower control package will enable the blower to run at high speed for five (5) minutes. It will
do so approximately fifty (50) minutes after the ignition has been turned off if the compressor had
been engaged for four (4) or more minutes prior to shutting off engine. By doing so, the evaporator
case and core are dried out, reducing the chances of a recurring A/C odor.
Procedure
1. Visually inspect the air conditioning evaporator drain hose for obstructions or working condition.
2. Apply deodorizing aerosol as described in the instructions supplied with the kit. Once the
deodorizer has been applied, some of the mixture may overflow from the drain hose.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6023
3. The chart identifies specific instructions for each vehicle. This chart will identify the proper
deodorizing procedure, template and wiring diagram. Deodorizing the evaporator case can easily
be done by removing the blower motor resistor and tape off opening. The nozzle can now be
inserted through a pierced hole in the tape to deodorize the evaporator case. For some of the
vehicles specified below, a drilling procedure is identified in the deodorizing instructions. This type
of alternative procedure and others can be done by using the referenced templates in the chart.
4. Complete detailed installation instructions are supplied with the blower control package.
Important:
A. 1996 ONLY (Use blower resistor location for drilling procedure)
B. 1994-1996 ONLY
Refer to appropriate Service Manual for enabling afterblow feature through on-board diagnostics.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6024
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use as shown.
Figure 1
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6025
Figure 2
Figure 3
Figure 4
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6026
Figure 5
Figure 6
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6027
Figure 7
Figure 8
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6028
Figure 9
Figure 10
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6029
Figure 11
Figure 12
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6030
Figure 13
Figure 14
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6031
Figure 15
Figure 16
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6032
Figure 17
Figure 18
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6033
Figure 19
Figure 20
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6034
Figure 21
Figure 22
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6035
Figure 23
Figure 24
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6036
Figure 25
Figure 26
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Blower Motor: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6037
Figure 27
Figure 28
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 6038
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions
Blower Motor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6041
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6042
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6043
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6044
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6045
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6046
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6047
Blower Motor: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6048
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6049
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6050
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6051
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6052
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6053
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6054
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6055
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6056
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6057
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6058
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6059
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6060
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6061
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6062
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6063
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6064
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6065
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6066
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6067
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6068
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6069
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6070
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6071
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6072
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6073
Blower Motor: Electrical Diagrams
Heater
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Diagrams >
Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6074
HVAC: Blower Controls (C60, Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Heater
Blower Motor: Description and Operation Heater
The Blower Motor delivers air to the interior of the vehicle. Its speed is controlled by the Blower
Switch and the Blower Resistor Assembly. When the Ignition Switch is in RUN, battery voltage is
applied to the Mode Selector. With the Mode Selector in any position except OFF, voltage is then
supplied to the Blower Switch. With the Blower Switch in LO, voltage is applied across all the
Blower Resistors and the Blower Motor; the Blower Motor runs at its slowest speed. With the
Blower Switch in M1, one of the Blower Resistors is bypassed; the Blower Motor runs faster. When
Blower Switch is in M2, two of the Blower Resistors are bypassed; the Blower Motor runs faster.
When the Blower Switch is set to HI, the Blower Resistors are totally bypassed and battery voltage
is applied directly to the Blower Motor; the Blower Motor runs at its fastest speed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Heater > Page 6077
Blower Motor: Description and Operation Air Conditioning
The Blower Motor's speed is controlled by the Blower Switch in the Heater-A/C and Rear Defogger
Control Assembly. With the switch in the LO position, all of the Blower Resistors are in the circuit
with the motor so that it runs slowly. In the M1 and M2 positions, the Blower Switch bypasses some
of the resistors, increasing the motors speed.
The Blower Motor is fed through the contacts of the Blower Motor Relay. When the Blower Switch
is in the HI position, battery voltage is supplied through the ORN wire to the coil of the Blower
Motor Relay. The relay is energized and its contact supplies battery voltage directly to the Blower
Motor from Fusible Link B.
When the Mode Selector is in the OFF position, no voltage is applied to the Blower Switch and
Motor, so the blower does not run. In all other positions, the blower should operate as described.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Blower Motor: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Troubleshooting Hints
TRY THE FOLLOWING CHECKS BEFORE DOING THE SYSTEM CHECK
1. Check HTR-A/C Fuse by visual inspection. 2. Check Fusible Link B by visual inspection. 3.
Check that ground G100 is clean and tight. 4. Check that the Blower Motor connectors and Blower
Motor Relay are mated correctly and firmly seated. 5. If blower runs all of the time with Ignition
Switch OFF, replace the Blower Motor Relay. 6. If blower runs all of the time with the Ignition
Switch in RUN and the Mode Selector OFF replace the Mode Selector. 7. Replace the Mode
Selector if the Blower Motor runs with the Ignition Switch in RUN and the Mode Selector in one but
not all of the following
modes: MAX, VENT, BI-LEV, HTR, BLEND and DEF.
^ Go to HVAC System Check on for a guide to normal operation. See: Testing and Inspection
^ Go to System Diagnosis for diagnostic tests. See: Air Conditioning/System Diagnosis
^ Refer to Heater-A/C and Windows and Glass for Rear Defogger Control Assembly access
information. See: Windows and Glass/Heated Glass Element
System Diagnosis
^ Refer to Symptom Table for listed symptoms and refer Diagnostic Tests for Diagnostic
procedures. See: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/Air Conditioning See: Component
Tests and General Diagnostics/Air Conditioning
^ If your symptom does not appear in the Symptom Table, perform all of the tests.
Circuit Operation
The Blower Motor's speed is controlled by the Blower Switch in the Heater-A/C and Rear Defogger
Control Assembly. With the switch in the LO position, all of the Blower Resistors are in the circuit
with the motor so that it runs slowly. In the M1 and M2 positions, the Blower Switch bypasses some
of the resistors, increasing the motors speed.
The Blower Motor is fed through the contacts of the Blower Motor Relay. When the Blower Switch
is in the HI position, battery voltage is supplied through the ORN wire to the coil of the Blower
Motor Relay. The relay is energized and its contact supplies battery voltage directly to the Blower
Motor from Fusible Link B.
When the Mode Selector is in the OFF position, no voltage is applied to the Blower Switch and
Motor, so the blower does not run. In all other positions, the blower should operate as described.
Circuit Operation
The Blower Motor delivers air to the interior of the vehicle. Its speed is controlled by the Blower
Switch and the Blower Resistor Assembly. When the Ignition Switch is in RUN, battery voltage is
applied to the Mode Selector. With the Mode Selector in any position except OFF, voltage is then
supplied to the Blower Switch. With the Blower Switch in LO, voltage is applied across all the
Blower Resistors and the Blower Motor; the Blower Motor runs at its slowest speed. With the
Blower Switch in M1, one of the Blower Resistors is bypassed; the Blower Motor runs faster. When
Blower Switch is in M2, two of the Blower Resistors are bypassed; the Blower Motor runs faster.
When the Blower Switch is set to HI, the Blower Resistors are totally bypassed and battery voltage
is applied directly to the Blower Motor; the Blower Motor runs at its fastest speed.
System Check
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 6080
System Check Table
^ Use the System Check Table as a guide to normal operation.
^ Refer to System Diagnosis for a list of symptoms and diagnostic steps. See: Heater/System
Diagnosis
^ Refer to System Diagnosis when a result is not normal. See: Heater/System Diagnosis
System Diagnosis
Refer to Symptom Table for listed symptoms and refer Diagnostic Tests for Diagnostic procedures.
See: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/Heater See: Component Tests and General
Diagnostics/Heater
Troubleshooting Hints
TRY THE FOLLOWING CHECKS BEFORE DOING THE SYSTEM CHECK
1. If the Blower Motor does not operate, check HTR-A/C Fuse by visual inspection. 2. If the Blower
Motor does not operate, check that ground G100 is clean and tight. 3. If the Blower Motor operates
with the Mode Selector in OFF, replace the Mode Selector.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 6081
Blower Motor: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Symptom Table
Heater
Symptom Table
If your symptom does not appear in the Symptom Table, perform all of the tests.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 6082
Blower Motor: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Test A: Blower Motor Test
Test B: Blower Motor Relay Test (Table 1)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 6083
Test B: Blower Motor Relay Test (Table 2)
Test C: Blower Resistor Assembly Test
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 6084
Test D: Blower Switch Test (Table 1)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 6085
Test D: Blower Switch Test (Table 2)
Test E: Mode Selector Test
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 6086
Test A: Blower Switch Test
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 6087
Test B: Blower Resistor Test
Test C: Blower Motor Test
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 6088
Blower Motor: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Disconnect blower motor electrical connections. 3. Remove
tower to tower brace assembly. 4. Remove blower motor retaining screws and blower motor. 5.
Reverse procedure to install.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 6093
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Relay > Component Information > Locations >
Page 6094
Harness Connector Faces: High Blower Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Center Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 6099
Center Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Resistor > Component Information >
Locations > Page 6100
Harness Connector Faces: Blower Resistor Assembly
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Blower Motor Switch > Component Information > Locations
A-Center Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
Front Of Engine
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6109
RH Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Bearing >
Component Information > Locations
Compressor Components - Disassembled View
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted
Compressor Clutch Bearing: Service and Repair Conventional Mounted
Remove
Removing Pulley Rotor & Bearing Assembly Retaining Ring
Installing Pulley Rotor/Bearing Puller Guide
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted > Page 6115
Removing Pulley Rotor And Bearing Assembly
Pulley Rotor And Bearing Removal
Remove or Disconnect
1. Remove the clutch plate and hub assembly as described previously. 2. Remove rotor and
bearing assembly retaining ring, using snap ring pliers J 6083. 3. Install pulley rotor and bearing
puller guide J 33023-A to the front head and install J 33020 pulley rotor and bearing puller down
into the inner
circle of slots in the rotor. Turn the J 33020 puller clockwise in the slots to engage the puller tangs
with the segments between the slots in the rotor.
4. Hold the J 33020 puller in place and tighten the puller screw against the puller guide to remove
the pulley rotor and bearing assembly. 5. To prevent damage to the pulley rotor during bearing
removal the rotor hub must be properly supported.
Remove the forcing screw from J 33020 puller and, with the puller tangs still engaged in the rotor
slots, invert the assembly onto a solid flat surface or blocks as shown in the illustration.
6. Drive the bearing out of the rotor hub with rotor bearing remover J 9398-A and J 29886 universal
handle.
NOTICE: It is not necessary to remove the staking in front of the bearing to remove the bearing,
however, it will be necessary to file away the old stake metal for proper clearance for the new
bearing to be installed into the rotor bore or the bearing may be damaged
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted > Page 6116
Replace
Installing Pulley Rotor Bearing
Staking Bearing In Rotor Hub Bore
Bearing Staked In Place
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted > Page 6117
Installing Pulley Rotor And Bearing Assembly
Removing Pulley Rotor & Bearing Assembly Retaining Ring
Install or Connect
1. Place the pulley rotor on the J 21352-A support block to fully support the rotor hub during
bearing installation.
NOTICE: Do Not support the rotor by resting the pulley rim on a flat surface during the bearing
installation or the rotor face will be bent.
2. Align the new bearing squarely with the hub bore and using puller and bearing installer J 9481-A
with universal handle J 29886, drive the bearing
fully into the hub. The installer will apply force to the outer race of the bearing if used as shown.
3. Place bearing staking guide J 33019-1 and bearing staking pin J 33019 in the hub bore as
shown in the illustration. Shift the rotor and bearing
assembly on the J 21352-A support block to give full support of the hub under the staking pin
location. A heavy-duty rubber band may be used to hold the stake pin in the guide, and the stake
pin should be properly positioned in the guide after each impact on the pin.
4. Using care to prevent personal injury, strike the staking pin with a hammer until a metal stake,
similar to the original, is formed down to but not
touching the bearing.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted > Page 6118
The stake metal should not contact the outer face of the bearing to prevent the possibility of
distorting the outer race. Stake three (3) places 120° apart as shown in the illustration.
5. With the compressor mounted to the J 34992 holding fixture, position the rotor and bearing
assembly on the front head. 6. Position the J 33017 pulley rotor and bearing installer and J
33023-A puller pilot directly over the inner race of the bearing. 7. Position puller crossbar J 8433-1
on the puller pilot J 33023-A and assemble the two J 34992-2 through bolts and washers through
the puller bar
slots and thread them into the J 34992 holding fixture. The thread of the through bolts should
engage the full thickness of the holding fixture.
8. Tighten the center screw in the J 8433-1 puller crossbar to force the pulley rotor and bearing
assembly onto the compressor front head. Should the
J 33017 pulley rotor and bearing installer slip off direct in-line contact with the inner face of the
bearing, loosen the J 8433-3 center forcing screw and realign the installer and pilot so that the J
33017 installer will properly clear the front head.
9. Install rotor and bearing assembly retainer ring, using snap ring pliers J 6083.
10. Reinstall clutch plate and hub assembly as described previously.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted > Page 6119
Compressor Clutch Bearing: Service and Repair Direct Mounted
Remove
Removing Pulley Rotor & Bearing Assembly Retaining Ring
Installing Pulley Rotor/Bearing Puller Guide
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted > Page 6120
Removing Pulley Rotor And Bearing Assembly
Pulley Rotor And Bearing Removal
Remove or Disconnect
1. Remove the clutch plate and hub assembly as described previously. 2. Remove rotor and
bearing assembly retaining ring, using snap ring pliers J 6083. 3. Install pulley rotor and bearing
puller guide J 33023-A to the front head and install J 33020 pulley rotor and bearing puller down
into the inner
circle of slots in the rotor. Turn the J 33020 puller clockwise in the slots to engage the puller tangs
with the segments between the slots in the rotor.
4. Hold the J 33020 puller in place and tighten the puller screw against the puller guide to remove
the pulley rotor and bearing assembly. 5. To prevent damage to the pulley rotor during bearing
removal the rotor hub must be properly supported.
Remove the forcing screw from J 33020 puller and, with the puller tangs still engaged in the rotor
slots, invert the assembly onto a solid flat surface or blocks as shown in the illustration.
6. Drive the bearing out of the rotor hub with rotor bearing remover J 9398-A and J 29886 universal
handle.
NOTICE: It is not necessary to remove the staking in front of the bearing to remove the bearing.
however, it will be necessary to file away the old
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted > Page 6121
stake metal for proper clearance for the new bearing to be installed into the rotor bore or the
bearing may be damaged.
Replace
Installing Pulley Rotor Bearing
Staking Bearing In Rotor Hub Bore
Bearing Staked In Place
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted > Page 6122
Installing Pulley Rotor And Bearing Assembly
Removing Pulley Rotor & Bearing Assembly Retaining Ring
Install or Connect
1. Place the pulley rotor on the J 21352-A support block to fully support the rotor hub during
bearing installation.
NOTICE: Do Not support the rotor by resting the pulley rim on a flat surface during the bearing
installation or the rotor face will be bent.
2. Align the new bearing squarely with the hub bore and using puller and bearing installer J 9481-A
with universal handle J 29886, drive the bearing
fully into the hub. The installer will apply force to the outer race of the bearing if used as shown.
3. Place bearing staking guide J 33019-1 and bearing staking pin J 33019 in the hub bore as
shown in the illustration. Shift the rotor and bearing
assembly on the J 21352-A support block to give full support of the hub under the staking pin
location. A heavy-duty rubber band may be used to hold the stake pin in the guide, and the stake
pin should be properly positioned in the guide after each impact on the pin.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Bearing >
Component Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted > Page 6123
4. Using care to prevent personal injury. strike the staking pin with a hammer until a metal stake,
similar to the original, is formed down to but not
touching the bearing. The stake metal should not contact the outer face of the bearing to prevent
the possibility of distorting the outer race. Stake three (3) places 120° apart as shown in the
illustration.
5. With the compressor mounted to the J 34992 holding fixture, position the rotor and bearing
assembly on the front head. 6. Position the J 33017 pulley rotor and bearing installer and J
33023-A puller pilot directly over the inner race of the bearing. 7. Position puller crossbar J 8433-1
on the puller pilot J 33023-A and assemble the two through bolts and washers through the puller
bar slots and
thread them into the J 33025 puller leg. The thread of the through bolts should engage the full
thickness of the puller legs. The two puller legs require two different bolt lengths.
8. Tighten the center screw in the J 8433-1 puller crossbar to force the pulley rotor and bearing
assembly onto the compressor front head. Should the
J 33017 pulley rotor and bearing installer slip off direct in-line contact with the inner face of the
bearing, loosen the J 8433-3 center forcing screw and realign the installer and pilot so that the J
33017 installer will properly clear the front head.
9. Install rotor and bearing assembly retainer ring, using snap ring pliers J 6083.
10. Reinstall clutch plate and hub assembly as described previously.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Locations
Front Of VIN M Engine (Others Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted
Compressor Clutch Coil: Service and Repair Conventional Mounted
Clutch Coil Assembly Removal
Installing Clutch Coil Assembly
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted > Page 6129
Staking Clutch Coil To Front Head
Details Of Stakes In Front Head For Clutch Coil
Remove or Disconnect
1. Perform Steps 1 through 4 of "Clutch Rotor and/or Bearings" removal procedure. Mark clutch coil
terminal location on compressor front head. 2. Install J 33023-A puller pilot on front head of
compressor. Also install J 8433-1 puller crossbar with J 33025 puller legs as shown in the
illustration.
3. Tighten J 8433-3 forcing screw against the puller pilot to remove the clutch coil.
Install or Connect
1. Place the clutch coil assembly on the front head with the terminals positioned at the "marked"
location. 2. Place the J 33024 clutch coil installer over the internal opening of the clutch coil
housing and align installer with the compressor front head. 3. Center the J 8433-1 puller crossbar
in the countersunk center hole of the J 33024 clutch coil installer. Install the J34992-2 through bolts
and
washers through the crossbar slots and thread them, into the holding fixture J 34992 to full fixture
thickness.
4. Turn the center forcing screw of the J 8433-1 puller crossbar to force the clutch coil onto the
front head. Be sure clutch coil and J 33024 installer
stay "in-line" during installation.
5. When coil is fully seated on the front head, use a 1/8" diameter drift punch and stake the front
head at three (3) places 120° apart, to ensure clutch
coil remaining in position. ^
Stake size should be only one half the area of the punch tip and only approximately 0.28-035mm
(0.010-0.015") deep.
6. Install rotor and bearing assembly and the clutch plate and hub assembly according as
described previously. 7. Install shaft nut.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted > Page 6130
Compressor Clutch Coil: Service and Repair Direct Mounted
Clutch Coil Assembly Removal
Remove or Disconnect
1. Perform Steps 1 through 4 of Clutch Rotor and/or Bearings" removal procedure. Mark clutch coil
terminal location on compressor front head. 2. Install J 33023-A puller pilot on front head of
compressor. Also install J 8433-1 puller crossbar with J 33025 puller legs as shown in the
illustration.
3. Tighten J 8433-3 forcing screw against the puller pilot to remove the clutch coil.
Installing Clutch Coil Assembly
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Coil > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted > Page 6131
Staking Clutch Coil To Front Head
Details Of Stakes In Front Head For Clutch Coil
Install or Connect
1. Place the clutch coil assembly on the front head with the terminals positioned at the "marked"
location. 2. Place the J 33024 clutch coil installer over the internal opening of the clutch coil
housing and align installer with the compressor front head. 3. Center the J 8433-1 puller crossbar
in the countersunk center hole of the J 33024 clutch coil installer. Install the J 34992-2 through
bolts and
washers through the crossbar slots and thread them, into the holding fixture J 34992 to full fixture
thickness.
4. Turn the center forcing screw of the J 8433-1 puller crossbar to force the clutch coil onto the
front head. Be sure clutch coil and J 33024 installer
stay "in-line" during installation.
5. When coil is fully seated on the front head, use a 1/8" diameter drift punch and stake the front
head at three (3) places 120° apart, to ensure clutch
coil remaining in position. ^
Stake size should be only one half the area of the punch tip and only approximately 0.280-0.35mm
(0.010-0.015") deep.
6. Install rotor and bearing assembly and the clutch plate and hub assembly according as
described previously. 7. Install shaft nut.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Hub > Component
Information > Specifications > Clutch Plate Air Gap
Compressor Clutch Hub: Specifications Clutch Plate Air Gap
Between clutch plate and rotor
................................................................................................................................................
0.40-0.50mm (0.015-0.020")
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Hub > Component
Information > Specifications > Clutch Plate Air Gap > Page 6136
Compressor Clutch Hub: Specifications Shaft Nut
Shaft nut ..............................................................................................................................................
.................................................. 16.5 N.m (12 lbs.ft.)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Hub > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6137
Compressor Components - Disassembled View
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Hub > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted
Compressor Clutch Hub: Service and Repair Conventional Mounted
Removing Shaft Nut
Clutch Plate And Hub Assembly Removal
Remove or Disconnect
1. Clamp the holding fixture J 34992 in a vise and attach compressor to holding fixture with thumb
screws J 34992-1. 2. Keep the clutch hub and drive plate assembly from turning by using the clutch
hub holding tool J 33027-A. Remove the shaft nut using shaft nut
socket J 33022.
3. Thread the Clutch Plate and Hub Assembly Remover J 33013-B into the hub. Hold the body of
the remover with a wrench and turn the center
screw into the remover body to remove the clutch plate and hub assembly.
4. Remove the shaft key and retain for reassembly.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Hub > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted > Page 6140
Shaft Key, Clutch Plate/Hub Installation
Installing Clutch Plate & Hub Assembly
Install or Connect
1. Install the shaft key into the hub key groove. Allow the key to project approximately 3.2 mm
(1/8") out of the keyway. The shaft key is curved
slightly to provide an interference fit in the hub key groove.
2. Be sure the frictional surface of the clutch plate and the clutch rotor are clean before installing
the clutch plate and hub assembly. 3. Align the shaft key with the shaft keyway and place the clutch
plate and the hub assembly onto the compressor shaft.
NOTICE: Do not drive or pound on the clutch hub or shaft. Internal damage to compressor may
result.
4. Remove the J 33013-B remover-installer center screw and reverse the body direction on the
center screw as shown in the illustration. 5. Install the clutch plate and hub installer J 33013-B with
bearing as shown in the illustration.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Hub > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted > Page 6141
The body of the J 33013-B installer should be backed off sufficiently to allow the center screw to be
threaded onto the end of the compressor shaft.
6. Hold the center screw with a wrench. Tighten the hex portion of the installer J 33013-B body to
press the hub onto the shaft. Tighten the body
several turns, remove the installer and check to see that the shaft key is still in place in the keyway
before installing the clutch plate and hub assembly to its final position. The air gap between
frictional surfaces of the clutch plate and clutch rotor should be 0.40-0.50mm (0.015-0.020"). ^
If the center screw is threaded fully onto the end of the compressor shaft, or if the body of the
installer is held and the center screw is rotated, the key will assume the position as shown in the
illustration and will break the clutch hub.
7. Remove installer J 33013-B, check for proper positioning of the shaft key (even or slightly above
the clutch hub). Install the shaft nut. Hold the
clutch plate and hub assembly with clutch hub holding tool J 33027-A and using shaft nut socket J
33022, tighten the nut against the crankshaft shoulder to 16.5 N.m (12 lbs.ft.) torque, using a
torque wrench.
8. Spin the pulley rotor by hand to see that the rotor is not rubbing the clutch drive plate.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Hub > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted > Page 6142
Compressor Clutch Hub: Service and Repair Direct Mounted
Removing Shaft Nut
Clutch Plate And Hub Assembly Removal
Remove or Disconnect
1. Clamp the holding fixture J 41790 in a vise and attach compressor to holding fixture with nuts
and bolts (2). 2. Keep the clutch hub and drive plate assembly from turning by using the clutch hub
holding tool J 33027-A. Remove the shaft nut using shaft nut
socket J 33022.
3. Thread the Clutch Plate and Hub Assembly Remover J 33013-B into the hub. Hold the body of
the remover with a wrench and turn the center
screw into the remover body to remove the clutch plate and hub assembly.
4. Remove the shaft key and retain for reassembly.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Hub > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted > Page 6143
Shaft Key, Clutch Plate/Hub Installation
Installing Clutch Plate & Hub Assembly
Install or Connect
1. Install the shaft key into the hub key groove. Allow the key to project approximately 3.2 mm
(1/8") out of the keyway. The shaft key is curved
slightly to provide an interference fit in the hub key groove.
2. Be sure the frictional surface of the clutch plate and the clutch rotor are clean before installing
the clutch plate and hub assembly. 3. Align the shaft key with the shaft keyway and place the clutch
plate and the hub assembly onto the compressor shaft.
NOTICE: Do not drive or pound on the clutch hub or shaft. Internal damage to compressor may
result.
4. Remove the J 33013-B remover-installer center screw and reverse the body direction on the
center screw as shown in the illustration. 5. Install the clutch plate and hub installer J 33013-B with
bearing as shown in the illustration.
The body of the J 33013-B installer should be backed off sufficiently to allow the center screw to be
threaded onto the end of the compressor shaft.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Clutch Hub > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted > Page 6144
6. Hold the center screw with a wrench. Tighten the hex portion of the installer J 33013-B body to
press the hub onto the shaft. Tighten the body
several turns, remove the installer and check to see that the shaft key is still in place in the keyway
before installing the clutch plate and hub assembly to its final position. The air gap between
frictional surfaces of the clutch plate and clutch rotor should be 0.40-0.50mm (0.015-0.020"). ^
If the center screw is threaded fully onto the end of the compressor shaft, or if the body of the
installer is held and the center screw is rotated, the key will assume the position as shown in the
illustration and will break the clutch hub.
7. Remove installer J 33013-B, check for proper positioning of the shaft key (even or slightly above
the clutch hub). Install the shaft nut. Hold the
clutch plate and hub assembly with clutch hub holding tool J 33027-A and using shaft nut socket J
33022, tighten the nut against the crankshaft shoulder to 16.5 N.m (12 lbs.ft.) torque, using a
torque wrench.
8. Spin the pulley rotor by hand to see that the rotor Is not rubbing the clutch drive plate.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Control Valve Assembly
> Component Information > Locations
V-5 Compressor
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Control Valve Assembly
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted
Compressor Control Valve Assembly: Service and Repair Conventional Mounted
Remove or Disconnect
1. Recover refrigerant using J 39500-GM. 2. Remove control valve retaining ring using J 5403
internal snap ring pliers. 3. Remove control valve assembly.
Install or Connect
1. When reassembling control valve, coat O-rings with 525 viscosity refrigeration oil and push in
place with thumb pressure. 2. Using J 5403 snap ring pliers, install valve retaining ring with high
point of curved sides against valve housing. Be sure retaining ring is properly
seated in ring groove.
3. Evacuate and recharge the system. 4. Leak test referring to "Compressor Leak Testing".
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Control Valve Assembly
> Component Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted > Page 6150
Compressor Control Valve Assembly: Service and Repair Direct Mounted
Remove or Disconnect
1. Recover refrigerant using J 39500-GM. 2. Remove control valve retaining ring using J 5403
internal snap ring pliers. 3. Remove control valve assembly.
Install or Connect
1. When reassembling control valve, coat O-rings with 525 viscosity refrigeration oil and push in
place with thumb pressure. 2. Using J 5403 snap ring pliers install valve retaining ring with high
point of curved sides against valve housing. Be sure retaining ring is properly
seated in ring groove.
3. Evacuate and recharge the system. 4. Leak test referring to "Compressor Leak Testing".
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Shaft Seal > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/C Compressor Seal Washer - Reference Chart
Compressor Shaft Seal: Technical Service Bulletins A/C Compressor Seal Washer - Reference
Chart
File In Section: 1 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 63-12-15
Date: November, 1996
INFORMATION
Subject: Reference Chart for A/C Compressor Seal Washers
Models: 1997 and Prior Passenger Cars (Except Corvette and GEO) 1997 and Prior Light Duty
Trucks (Except Tracker)
GMSPO A/C compressors include a seal washer kit. These kits contain various color edge painted
washer seals and inserts in which only two (2) washers and possibly one (1) insert are used. It has
come to our attention that some packaging discrepancies were found and some of the seals cannot
be properly identified for installation.
These seals are very close in size and some of the seals were inadvertently edge painted the
wrong color or not painted.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Shaft Seal > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/C Compressor Seal Washer - Reference Chart > Page 6155
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Shaft Seal > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > A/C Compressor Seal Washer - Reference Chart > Page 6156
The chart shown will help to properly identify the seals. Use the chart by placing the seal over the
pictured seal to identity inside and outside diameters and thickness. Because these seals are very
similar in size, specifications are also listed in the chart.
Important:
If seals are damaged upon installation, obtain new seal kit. Seals will be available separately at a
later date.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Shaft Seal > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6157
Compressor Components - Disassembled View
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Shaft Seal > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted
Compressor Shaft Seal: Service and Repair Conventional Mounted
Seal Leak Detection
A shaft seal should not be changed because of small amounts of oil found on an adjacent surface.
The seal is designed to leak some oil for lubrication purposes. A shaft seal should be changed only
when a large amount of sprayed oil is found, and only after actual refrigerant leakage is found by
using an approved leak detector, J 39400 or equivalent.
Installing Shaft Seal O-Ring
Removing Shaft Seal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Shaft Seal > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted > Page 6160
Removing Shaft Seal O-Ring
Remove or Disconnect
1. Recover refrigerant using J 39500-GM. 2. Loosen and reposition compressor in mounting
brackets. 3. Remove clutch plate and hub assembly from compressor as described in minor
repairs. 4. Remove the shaft seal retainer ring, using snap ring pliers J 5403. 5. Thoroughly clean
inside of compressor neck area surrounding the shaft. tile exposed portion of the seal. the shaft
itself and O-ring groove. Any
dirt or foreign material getting into compressor may cause damage.
6. Fully engage the knurled tangs of seal remover-installer J2312-A into the recessed portion of the
seal by turning the handle clockwise. Remove the
seal from the compressor with a rotary-pulling motion. Discard the seal. The handle should be
hand-tightened securely. Do not use a wrench or pliers.
7. Remove and discard the seal O-ring from the compressor neck using O-ring remover J 9553-01.
8. Recheck the shaft and inside of the compressor neck for dirt or foreign material and be sure
these areas are perfectly clean before installing new
parts.
Compressor Shaft Seal
Clean
1. Thoroughly clean seal O-ring groove in front head.
NOTICE: Seals should not be re-used. Always use a new specification service seal kit. Be sure that
the seal to be installed is not scratched or damaged in any way. Make sure that the seal is free of
lint and dirt that could damage the seal surface or prevent sealing.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Shaft Seal > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted > Page 6161
Installing Shaft Seal O-Ring
Lip Seal Installed On Seal Protector
Installing Shaft Seal O-Ring
Install or Connect
1. Dip the new seal O-ring in clean 525 viscosity refrigerant oil and assemble onto O-ring installer J
33011. "New."
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Shaft Seal > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted > Page 6162
2. Insert the O-ring installer J 33011 into the compressor neck until the installer "bottoms." Lower
the moveable slide of the O-ring installer to
release the O-ring into the seal O-ring lower groove. (The compressor neck top groove is for the
shaft seal retainer ring.) Rotate the installer to seat the O-ring and remove the installer.
3. Dip the new seal in clean 525 viscosity refrigerant oil and assemble seal to Seal Installer J
23128-A, by turning handle clockwise. The stamped
steel case side of the lip seal must be engaged with knurled tangs of installer so that flared-out side
of lip seal is facing and installed towards the compressor. Install shaft seal protector J 34614 on the
lip seal. Place the seal protector J 34614 over end of compressor shaft, and slide the new seal onto
the shaft with a rotary motion until it stops. Take care not to dislodge the O-ring. Be sure the seal
makes good contact with the O-ring. Disengage the installer from the seal and remove the installer
J 23128-A and the shaft seal protector J 34614.
NOTICE: Handling and care of seal protector is important. If seal protector is nicked or the bottom
flared. the new seal may be damaged during installation.
4. Install the new seal retainer ring with its flat side against the seal, using snap-ring pliers J 5403.
Use the sleeve from O-ring installer J 33011 to
press in on the seal retainer ring so that it snaps into its groove.
5. To leak test. install compressor leak test fixture J 39893 on rear head of compressor and
connect gage charging lines using J 39500-GM
Refrigerant Recovery System or equivalent. Pressurize suction and high-side of compressor with
R134a Refrigerant. Temporarily install the shaft nut and, with the compressor in horizontal position.
rotate the compressor shaft in normal direction of rotation several turns by hand. Leak test the seal
area and correct any leak found. Recover refrigerant. Remove shaft nut.
6. Remove any excess oil resulting from installing the new seal parts from the shaft and inside the
compressor neck. 7. Install the clutch plate and hub assembly as described in minor repair
procedures. 8. Reinstall the compressor, belt and tighten bracket. 9. Evacuate and charge the
refrigerant system using J 39500-GM.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Shaft Seal > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted > Page 6163
Compressor Shaft Seal: Service and Repair Direct Mounted
Seal Leak Detection
A shaft seal should not be changed because of small amounts of oil found on an adjacent surface.
The seal is designed to leak some oil for lubrication purposes. A shaft seal should be changed only
when a large amount of sprayed oil is found, and only after actual refrigerant leakage is found by
using an approved leak detector. J 39400 or equivalent.
Removing Or Installing Shaft Seal Retaining Ring
Removing Shaft Seal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Shaft Seal > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted > Page 6164
Removing Shaft Seal O-Ring
Remove or Disconnect
1. Recover refrigerant using J 39500-GM. 2. Loosen and reposition compressor in mounting
brackets. 3. Remove clutch plate and hub assembly from compressor as described in minor
repairs. 4. Remove the shaft seal retainer ring, using snap ring pliers J 5403. 5. Thoroughly clean
inside of compressor neck area surrounding the shaft. the exposed portion of the seal, the shaft
itself and O-ring groove. Any dirt
or foreign material getting into compressor may cause damage.
6. Fully engage the knurled tangs of seal remover-installer J 23128-A into the recessed portion of
the seal by turning the handle clockwise. Remove
the seal from the compressor with a rotary-pulling motion. Discard the seal. The handle should be
hand-tightened securely. Do not use a wrench or pliers.
7. Remove and discard the seal O-ring from the compressor neck using O-ring remover J 9553-01.
8. Recheck the shaft and inside of the compressor neck for dirt or foreign material and be sure
these areas are perfectly clean before installing new
parts.
Compressor Shaft Seal
Clean
1. Thoroughly clean seal O-ring groove in front head.
NOTICE: Seals should not be re-used. Always use a new specification service seal kit. Be sure that
the seal to be installed is not scratched or damaged in any way. Make sure that the seal is free of
lint and dirt that could damage the seal surface or prevent sealing.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Shaft Seal > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted > Page 6165
Installing Shaft Seal
Lip Seal Installed On Seal Protector
Removing Or Installing Shaft Seal Retaining Ring
Install or Connect
1. Dip the new seal O-ring in clean 525 viscosity refrigerant oil and assemble onto O-ring installer
33011. "New." 2. Insert the O-ring installer J 33011 into the compressor neck until the installer
"bottoms." Lower the moveable slide of the O-ring installer to
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor HVAC > Compressor Shaft Seal > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Conventional Mounted > Page 6166
release the O-ring into the seal O-ring lower groove. (The compressor neck top groove is for the
shaft seal retainer ring.) Rotate the installer to seat the O-ring and remove the installer.
3. Dip the new seal in clean 525 viscosity refrigerant oil and assemble seal to Seal Installer J
23128-A, by turning handle clockwise. The stamped
steel case side of the lip seal must be engaged with knurled tangs of installer so that flared-out side
of lip seal is facing and installed towards the compressor. In stall shaft seal protector J 34614 on
the lip seal. Place the seal protector J 34614 over end of compressor shaft, and slide the new seal
onto the shaft with a rotary motion until it stops. Take care not to dislodge the O-ring. Be sure the
seal makes good contact with the O-ring. Disengage the installer from the seal and remove the
installer J 23128-A and the shaft seal protector J 34614.
NOTICE: Handling and care of seal protector is important. If seal protector is nicked or the bottom
flared, the new seal may be damaged during installation.
4. Install the new seal retainer ring with its flat side against the seal, using snap-ring pliers J 5403.
Use the sleeve from O-ring installer J 33011 to
press In on the seal retainer ring so that it snaps into its groove.
5. To leak test, install compressor leak test fixture J 39893 on rear head of compressor and
connect gage charging lines using J 39500-GM
Refrigerant Recovery System or equivalent. Pressurize suction and high-side of compressor with
R-134a Refrigerant. Temporarily install the shaft nut and, with the compressor in horizontal
position. rotate the compressor shaft in normal direction of rotation several turns by hand. Leak test
the seal area and correct any leak found. Recover refrigerant. Remove shaft nut.
6. Remove any excess oil resulting from installing the new seal parts from the shaft and inside the
compressor neck. 7. Install the clutch plate and hub assembly as described in minor repair
procedures. 8. Reinstall the compressor, belt and tighten bracket. 9. Evacuate and charge the
refrigerant system using J 39500-GM.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 6171
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component Information >
Locations > Page 6172
Harness Connector Faces: A/C Compressor Control Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Control Assembly: Component Locations
Center Of I/P
Console
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 6177
Control Assembly: Connector Locations
A-Center Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Control Assembly, HVAC > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 6178
A-Center Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Core: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > A/C - Musty Odors Emitted From
(HVAC) System
Evaporator Core: Customer Interest A/C - Musty Odors Emitted From (HVAC) System
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 99-01-39-004C
Date: June 12, 2009
Subject: Air Conditioning Odor (Install Evaporator Core Dryer Kit and Apply Cooling Coil Coating)
Models:
1993-2010 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 All
Equipped with Air Conditioning
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2009 and 2010 model years. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 99-01-39-004B (Section 01 - HVAC).
Condition
Some customers may comment about musty odors emitted from the Heating, Ventilation and Air
Conditioning (HVAC) system at vehicle start-up in hot, humid conditions.
Cause
This condition may be caused by condensate build-up on the evaporator core, which does not
evaporate by itself in high humidity conditions. The odor may be the result of microbial growth on
the evaporator core. When the blower motor fan is turned on, the microbial growth may release an
unpleasant musty odor into the passenger compartment.
There are several other possible sources of a musty odor in a vehicle. A common source is a water
leak into the interior of the vehicle or foreign material in the HVAC air distribution system. Follow
the procedures in SI for identifying and correcting water leaks and air inlet inspection.
The procedure contained in this bulletin is only applicable if the odor source has been determined
to be microbial growth on the evaporator core inside the HVAC module.
Correction
Many vehicles currently incorporate an afterblow function within the HVAC control module
software. The afterblow feature, when enabled, employs the HVAC blower fan to dry the
evaporator after vehicle shut down and this function will inhibit microbial growth. Technicians are to
confirm that the customer concern is evaporator core odor and that the vehicle has the imbedded
afterblow feature, as defined in the SI document for that specific vehicle model, model year and
specific HVAC option. Refer to SI for enabling the afterblow function. Vehicles being delivered in
areas prone to high humidity conditions may benefit from having the afterblow enabled calibration
installed prior to any customer comment.
Important If the vehicle is not factory equipped with the imbedded afterblow enable feature, it may
be added with the Electronic Evaporator Dryer Module Kit (P/N 12497910 or AC Delco 15-5876).
Important When installing the Electronic Evaporator Dryer Module, you MUST use the included
electrical splice connectors to ensure a proper splice. Complete detailed installation instructions
and self testing procedures are supplied with the kit. If necessary, the Electronic Evaporator Dryer
Module may be installed underhood if it is protected from extreme heat and water splash areas.
To immediately remove the evaporator core odor on all suspect vehicles, it is necessary to
eliminate the microbial growth and prevent its re-occurrence. To accomplish this, perform the
following procedure:
Vehicle and Applicator Tool Preparation
1. The evaporator core must be dry. This may be accomplished by disabling the compressor and
running the blower fan on the recirc heat setting for
an extended period of time.
Note Compressor engagement will cause the evaporator core to remain wet and will prevent full
adherence of the Coiling Coil Coating to the evaporator core surfaces.
2. Verify that the air conditioning drain hose is not clogged and place a drain pan beneath the
vehicle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Core: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > A/C - Musty Odors Emitted From
(HVAC) System > Page 6187
3. Place a protective cover over the carpet below the evaporator core. 4. Remove the cabin air
filter, if equipped, and cover the opening prior to applying the Cooling Coil Coating, as the product
may clog the filter. If the
cabin air filter appears to have little or no remaining life, suggest a replacement to your customer.
5. If the HVAC module has a blower motor cooling tube, be careful NOT TO SPRAY THE
COOLING COIL COATING INTO THE
BLOWER MOTOR COOLING TUBE.
6. Attach the Flexible Applicator Pressure Spray Tool (J-43810-20A) to a compressed air line
operating at 586 kPa (85 psi) to 793 kPa (115 psi). 7. Shake the bottle of Cooling Coil Coating well.
Screw the bottle onto the cap on the applicator tool's pick-up tube.
Note The pick-up tube is designed for 120 ml (4 oz) and 240 ml (8 oz) bottles and should coil
slightly in the bottom of a 120 ml (4 oz) bottle.
8. Use one of the following three methods to apply the Cooling Coil Coating.
Important If the Pressure Applicator Spray Tool (J-43810-20A) is not available, the Cooling Coil
Coating is also available in an aerosol can (P/N 12377951 (in Canada, 10953503)).
Application Through Blower Motor Control Module Opening
- Remove the blower motor control module (blower motor resistor). Refer to the applicable
procedure in SI.
- Clean any debris or foreign material from inside the HVAC module and on the evaporator core
surface.
- Apply the Cooling Coil Coating directly to the evaporator core through the blower motor blower
motor control module (blower motor resistor) opening.
- Use the flexible wand to direct the Cooling Coil Coating over the entire evaporator core and
surrounding gasket surfaces.
- When the application is complete, install the blower motor blower motor control module (blower
motor control module).
Application Through Blower Motor Opening
- Remove the blower motor. Refer to the applicable blower motor removal procedure in SI.
- Clean any debris or foreign material from inside the HVAC module and on the evaporator core
surface.
- Apply the Cooling Coil Coating directly to the evaporator core through the blower motor opening.
- Use the flexible wand to direct the Cooling Coil Coating over the entire evaporator core and
surrounding gasket surfaces.
- When the application is complete, install the blower motor.
Application Through a Hole in the HVAC Module
- If neither of the two previous application methods are available, it may be necessary to drill a hole
in the HVAC module.
- Locate an area of the HVAC module between the blower motor and the evaporator core. Drill a 10
mm (3/8 in) hole in the HVAC module. Use caution to keep the drill clear of the evaporator core and
the blower motor fan.
- With the air distribution vents closed and the blower motor fan speed on HIGH, insert the
applicator tool into the hole and spray the Cooling Coil Coating into the airstream toward the
evaporator core.
- Use a GM approved RTV sealant to plug the hole in the HVAC module.
9. After the Cooling Coil Coating application is complete, start and run the vehicle for approximately
10 minutes, with the compressor disabled,
HVAC mode set to Recirculate/Max, heat set to full warm, blower motor fan speed on high, and
one window open approximately 12 mm (1/2 in). This cures the Cooling Coil Coating onto the
evaporator core surface.
10. While the engine is running, rinse the applicator tool with warm water to prolong the life of the
tool. Be sure to spray warm water through the
nozzle to rinse out any residual Cooling Coil Coating still in the capillary pick up tube, otherwise it
will dry and clog the applicator tool. Also remove the small green valve from the bottle cap and
rinse it thoroughly while rolling it between two fingers and then reinstall it. If this valve is clogged ,
the Cooling Coil Coating will not flow through the applicator tool.
11. Shut off the engine and enable the compressor again. 12. Verify proper HVAC system
operation. 13. Remove the protective cover from inside the vehicle. 14. Remove the drain pan from
underneath the vehicle. 15. Reinstall the cabin air filter if necessary.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Core: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > A/C - Musty Odors Emitted From
(HVAC) System > Page 6188
Parts Information
Important The Cooling Coil Coating listed below is the only GM approved product for use under
warranty as an evaporator core disinfectant and for the long term control of evaporator core
microbial growth.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates
Evaporator Core: Customer Interest A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates
File In Section: 1 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 53-12-12A
Date: December, 1996
Subject: Air Conditioning Odor at Start Up in Humid Climates (Disinfect Evaporator Core, Install
Delayed Blower Control Package)
Models: 1993-96 Passenger Cars (Except GEO) 1993-96 Light Duty Models (Except Tracker)
This bulletin is being revised to update the wiring diagrams, add the Corvette (with RPO C60) and
delete medium/heavy duty trucks. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 53-12-12 (Section 1 HVAC).
Condition
Some owners may comment on odors emitted from the air conditioning system, primarily at start up
in hot, humid climates.
Cause
This odor may be the result of microbial growth on the evaporator core. When the blower motor fan
is turned on, the microbial growth may release an unpleasant musty odor into the passenger
compartment.
Correction
To remove odors of this type, it is necessary to eliminate the microbial growth and prevent its
recurrence. To accomplish this, these two procedures must be completed.
^ Deodorize the evaporator core using Deodorizing Aerosol Kit, P/N 12377951 (AC Delco 15-102).
^ Install the new A/C Delayed Blower Control Package, P/N 12370470, (AC Delco 15-8632).
The blower control package will enable the blower to run at high speed for five (5) minutes. It will
do so approximately fifty (50) minutes after the ignition has been turned off if the compressor had
been engaged for four (4) or more minutes prior to shutting off engine. By doing so, the evaporator
case and core are dried out, reducing the chances of a recurring A/C odor.
Procedure
1. Visually inspect the air conditioning evaporator drain hose for obstructions or working condition.
2. Apply deodorizing aerosol as described in the instructions supplied with the kit. Once the
deodorizer has been applied, some of the mixture may overflow from the drain hose.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6193
3. The chart identifies specific instructions for each vehicle. This chart will identify the proper
deodorizing procedure, template and wiring diagram. Deodorizing the evaporator case can easily
be done by removing the blower motor resistor and tape off opening. The nozzle can now be
inserted through a pierced hole in the tape to deodorize the evaporator case. For some of the
vehicles specified below, a drilling procedure is identified in the deodorizing instructions. This type
of alternative procedure and others can be done by using the referenced templates in the chart.
4. Complete detailed installation instructions are supplied with the blower control package.
Important:
A. 1996 ONLY (Use blower resistor location for drilling procedure)
B. 1994-1996 ONLY
Refer to appropriate Service Manual for enabling afterblow feature through on-board diagnostics.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6194
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use as shown.
Figure 1
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6195
Figure 2
Figure 3
Figure 4
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6196
Figure 5
Figure 6
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6197
Figure 7
Figure 8
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6198
Figure 9
Figure 10
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6199
Figure 11
Figure 12
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6200
Figure 13
Figure 14
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6201
Figure 15
Figure 16
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6202
Figure 17
Figure 18
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6203
Figure 19
Figure 20
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6204
Figure 21
Figure 22
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6205
Figure 23
Figure 24
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6206
Figure 25
Figure 26
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid
Climates > Page 6207
Figure 27
Figure 28
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > A/C - Musty Odors
Emitted From (HVAC) System
Evaporator Core: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Musty Odors Emitted From (HVAC) System
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 99-01-39-004C
Date: June 12, 2009
Subject: Air Conditioning Odor (Install Evaporator Core Dryer Kit and Apply Cooling Coil Coating)
Models:
1993-2010 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 All
Equipped with Air Conditioning
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2009 and 2010 model years. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 99-01-39-004B (Section 01 - HVAC).
Condition
Some customers may comment about musty odors emitted from the Heating, Ventilation and Air
Conditioning (HVAC) system at vehicle start-up in hot, humid conditions.
Cause
This condition may be caused by condensate build-up on the evaporator core, which does not
evaporate by itself in high humidity conditions. The odor may be the result of microbial growth on
the evaporator core. When the blower motor fan is turned on, the microbial growth may release an
unpleasant musty odor into the passenger compartment.
There are several other possible sources of a musty odor in a vehicle. A common source is a water
leak into the interior of the vehicle or foreign material in the HVAC air distribution system. Follow
the procedures in SI for identifying and correcting water leaks and air inlet inspection.
The procedure contained in this bulletin is only applicable if the odor source has been determined
to be microbial growth on the evaporator core inside the HVAC module.
Correction
Many vehicles currently incorporate an afterblow function within the HVAC control module
software. The afterblow feature, when enabled, employs the HVAC blower fan to dry the
evaporator after vehicle shut down and this function will inhibit microbial growth. Technicians are to
confirm that the customer concern is evaporator core odor and that the vehicle has the imbedded
afterblow feature, as defined in the SI document for that specific vehicle model, model year and
specific HVAC option. Refer to SI for enabling the afterblow function. Vehicles being delivered in
areas prone to high humidity conditions may benefit from having the afterblow enabled calibration
installed prior to any customer comment.
Important If the vehicle is not factory equipped with the imbedded afterblow enable feature, it may
be added with the Electronic Evaporator Dryer Module Kit (P/N 12497910 or AC Delco 15-5876).
Important When installing the Electronic Evaporator Dryer Module, you MUST use the included
electrical splice connectors to ensure a proper splice. Complete detailed installation instructions
and self testing procedures are supplied with the kit. If necessary, the Electronic Evaporator Dryer
Module may be installed underhood if it is protected from extreme heat and water splash areas.
To immediately remove the evaporator core odor on all suspect vehicles, it is necessary to
eliminate the microbial growth and prevent its re-occurrence. To accomplish this, perform the
following procedure:
Vehicle and Applicator Tool Preparation
1. The evaporator core must be dry. This may be accomplished by disabling the compressor and
running the blower fan on the recirc heat setting for
an extended period of time.
Note Compressor engagement will cause the evaporator core to remain wet and will prevent full
adherence of the Coiling Coil Coating to the evaporator core surfaces.
2. Verify that the air conditioning drain hose is not clogged and place a drain pan beneath the
vehicle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > A/C - Musty Odors
Emitted From (HVAC) System > Page 6213
3. Place a protective cover over the carpet below the evaporator core. 4. Remove the cabin air
filter, if equipped, and cover the opening prior to applying the Cooling Coil Coating, as the product
may clog the filter. If the
cabin air filter appears to have little or no remaining life, suggest a replacement to your customer.
5. If the HVAC module has a blower motor cooling tube, be careful NOT TO SPRAY THE
COOLING COIL COATING INTO THE
BLOWER MOTOR COOLING TUBE.
6. Attach the Flexible Applicator Pressure Spray Tool (J-43810-20A) to a compressed air line
operating at 586 kPa (85 psi) to 793 kPa (115 psi). 7. Shake the bottle of Cooling Coil Coating well.
Screw the bottle onto the cap on the applicator tool's pick-up tube.
Note The pick-up tube is designed for 120 ml (4 oz) and 240 ml (8 oz) bottles and should coil
slightly in the bottom of a 120 ml (4 oz) bottle.
8. Use one of the following three methods to apply the Cooling Coil Coating.
Important If the Pressure Applicator Spray Tool (J-43810-20A) is not available, the Cooling Coil
Coating is also available in an aerosol can (P/N 12377951 (in Canada, 10953503)).
Application Through Blower Motor Control Module Opening
- Remove the blower motor control module (blower motor resistor). Refer to the applicable
procedure in SI.
- Clean any debris or foreign material from inside the HVAC module and on the evaporator core
surface.
- Apply the Cooling Coil Coating directly to the evaporator core through the blower motor blower
motor control module (blower motor resistor) opening.
- Use the flexible wand to direct the Cooling Coil Coating over the entire evaporator core and
surrounding gasket surfaces.
- When the application is complete, install the blower motor blower motor control module (blower
motor control module).
Application Through Blower Motor Opening
- Remove the blower motor. Refer to the applicable blower motor removal procedure in SI.
- Clean any debris or foreign material from inside the HVAC module and on the evaporator core
surface.
- Apply the Cooling Coil Coating directly to the evaporator core through the blower motor opening.
- Use the flexible wand to direct the Cooling Coil Coating over the entire evaporator core and
surrounding gasket surfaces.
- When the application is complete, install the blower motor.
Application Through a Hole in the HVAC Module
- If neither of the two previous application methods are available, it may be necessary to drill a hole
in the HVAC module.
- Locate an area of the HVAC module between the blower motor and the evaporator core. Drill a 10
mm (3/8 in) hole in the HVAC module. Use caution to keep the drill clear of the evaporator core and
the blower motor fan.
- With the air distribution vents closed and the blower motor fan speed on HIGH, insert the
applicator tool into the hole and spray the Cooling Coil Coating into the airstream toward the
evaporator core.
- Use a GM approved RTV sealant to plug the hole in the HVAC module.
9. After the Cooling Coil Coating application is complete, start and run the vehicle for approximately
10 minutes, with the compressor disabled,
HVAC mode set to Recirculate/Max, heat set to full warm, blower motor fan speed on high, and
one window open approximately 12 mm (1/2 in). This cures the Cooling Coil Coating onto the
evaporator core surface.
10. While the engine is running, rinse the applicator tool with warm water to prolong the life of the
tool. Be sure to spray warm water through the
nozzle to rinse out any residual Cooling Coil Coating still in the capillary pick up tube, otherwise it
will dry and clog the applicator tool. Also remove the small green valve from the bottle cap and
rinse it thoroughly while rolling it between two fingers and then reinstall it. If this valve is clogged ,
the Cooling Coil Coating will not flow through the applicator tool.
11. Shut off the engine and enable the compressor again. 12. Verify proper HVAC system
operation. 13. Remove the protective cover from inside the vehicle. 14. Remove the drain pan from
underneath the vehicle. 15. Reinstall the cabin air filter if necessary.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > A/C - Musty Odors
Emitted From (HVAC) System > Page 6214
Parts Information
Important The Cooling Coil Coating listed below is the only GM approved product for use under
warranty as an evaporator core disinfectant and for the long term control of evaporator core
microbial growth.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in
Humid Climates
Evaporator Core: All Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Odor at Start up in Humid Climates
File In Section: 1 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 53-12-12A
Date: December, 1996
Subject: Air Conditioning Odor at Start Up in Humid Climates (Disinfect Evaporator Core, Install
Delayed Blower Control Package)
Models: 1993-96 Passenger Cars (Except GEO) 1993-96 Light Duty Models (Except Tracker)
This bulletin is being revised to update the wiring diagrams, add the Corvette (with RPO C60) and
delete medium/heavy duty trucks. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 53-12-12 (Section 1 HVAC).
Condition
Some owners may comment on odors emitted from the air conditioning system, primarily at start up
in hot, humid climates.
Cause
This odor may be the result of microbial growth on the evaporator core. When the blower motor fan
is turned on, the microbial growth may release an unpleasant musty odor into the passenger
compartment.
Correction
To remove odors of this type, it is necessary to eliminate the microbial growth and prevent its
recurrence. To accomplish this, these two procedures must be completed.
^ Deodorize the evaporator core using Deodorizing Aerosol Kit, P/N 12377951 (AC Delco 15-102).
^ Install the new A/C Delayed Blower Control Package, P/N 12370470, (AC Delco 15-8632).
The blower control package will enable the blower to run at high speed for five (5) minutes. It will
do so approximately fifty (50) minutes after the ignition has been turned off if the compressor had
been engaged for four (4) or more minutes prior to shutting off engine. By doing so, the evaporator
case and core are dried out, reducing the chances of a recurring A/C odor.
Procedure
1. Visually inspect the air conditioning evaporator drain hose for obstructions or working condition.
2. Apply deodorizing aerosol as described in the instructions supplied with the kit. Once the
deodorizer has been applied, some of the mixture may overflow from the drain hose.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in
Humid Climates > Page 6219
3. The chart identifies specific instructions for each vehicle. This chart will identify the proper
deodorizing procedure, template and wiring diagram. Deodorizing the evaporator case can easily
be done by removing the blower motor resistor and tape off opening. The nozzle can now be
inserted through a pierced hole in the tape to deodorize the evaporator case. For some of the
vehicles specified below, a drilling procedure is identified in the deodorizing instructions. This type
of alternative procedure and others can be done by using the referenced templates in the chart.
4. Complete detailed installation instructions are supplied with the blower control package.
Important:
A. 1996 ONLY (Use blower resistor location for drilling procedure)
B. 1994-1996 ONLY
Refer to appropriate Service Manual for enabling afterblow feature through on-board diagnostics.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in
Humid Climates > Page 6220
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use as shown.
Figure 1
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in
Humid Climates > Page 6221
Figure 2
Figure 3
Figure 4
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in
Humid Climates > Page 6222
Figure 5
Figure 6
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in
Humid Climates > Page 6223
Figure 7
Figure 8
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in
Humid Climates > Page 6224
Figure 9
Figure 10
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in
Humid Climates > Page 6225
Figure 11
Figure 12
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in
Humid Climates > Page 6226
Figure 13
Figure 14
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in
Humid Climates > Page 6227
Figure 15
Figure 16
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in
Humid Climates > Page 6228
Figure 17
Figure 18
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in
Humid Climates > Page 6229
Figure 19
Figure 20
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in
Humid Climates > Page 6230
Figure 21
Figure 22
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in
Humid Climates > Page 6231
Figure 23
Figure 24
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in
Humid Climates > Page 6232
Figure 25
Figure 26
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Evaporator Core: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > A/C - Odor at Start up in
Humid Climates > Page 6233
Figure 27
Figure 28
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 6234
Evaporator Core: Service and Repair
Heater/Evaporator Module
SPECIAL TOOL REQUIRED (or equivalent)
^ J-38100-D, A/C refrigerant recovery and recycling station.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Negative battery cable. 2. Recover refrigerant and drain cooling system. 3. Raise and support
vehicle. 4. Heater hoses from heater core. 5. Evaporator block fitting from the evaporator and
discard "O" ring seals. 6. Moisture drain tube from heater-A/C module and lower vehicle. 7. Right
and left sound insulators and steering column opening filler. 8. Floor air outlet duct and heater core
cover.
CAUTION: To avoid breaking the drain tube, carefully pull the heater core cover straight rearward
when removing.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Evaporator Core > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 6235
9. Heater core mounting clamps and remove heater core.
10. Screws holding the defroster vacuum actuator to the module case. 11. Evaporator cover and
evaporator core.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Evaporator and evaporator cover. Add 90 ml (3 oz.) of 525 viscosity refrigerant oil to the system
if installing a new evaporator. 2. Defroster vacuum actuator to the module case with attaching
screws. 3. Heater core and heater core mounting clamps. 4. Heater core cover and floor air outlet
duct. 5. Steering column opening filler, right and left sound insulators. 6. Raise and support vehicle.
Connect moisture drain tube to heater-A/C module. 7. Heater hoses to heater core. 8. Evaporator
block fitting to evaporator using new "O" ring seals lubricated in clean 525 viscosity refrigerant oil.
9. Lower vehicle, evacuate and recharge A/C system.
10. Negative battery cable. 11. Fill cooling system and check for leaks. 12. Leak test evaporator
block fitting and performance test A/C system.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Expansion Block/Orifice Tube > Component Information >
Locations
Expansion Block/Orifice Tube: Locations
Evaporator Tube & Accumulator Tube
Expansion (Orifice) Tube
The Expansion (Orifice) Tube is located at the condenser to evaporator tube connection in the
evaporator tube.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators
Heater Core: Technical Service Bulletins Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 05-06-02-001A
Date: July 16, 2008
Subject: Information On Aluminum Heater Core and/or Radiator Replacement
Models: 2005 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2005
HUMMER H2
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to update the Warranty Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 05-06-02-001 (Section 06 - Engine/Propulsion System).
Important:
2004-05 Chevrolet Aveo (Pontiac Wave, Canada Only) does not use DEX-COOL(R). Refer to the
flushing procedure explained later in this bulletin.
The following information should be utilized when servicing aluminum heater core and/or radiators
on repeat visits. A replacement may be necessary because erosion, corrosion, or insufficient
inhibitor levels may cause damage to the heater core, radiator or water pump. A coolant check
should be performed whenever a heater core, radiator, or water pump is replaced. The following
procedures/ inspections should be done to verify proper coolant effectiveness.
Caution:
To avoid being burned, do not remove the radiator cap or surge tank cap while the engine is hot.
The cooling system will release scalding fluid and steam under pressure if the radiator cap or surge
tank cap is removed while the engine and radiator are still hot.
Important:
If the vehicle's coolant is low, drained out, or the customer has repeatedly added coolant or water
to the system, then the system should be completely flushed using the procedure explained later in
this bulletin.
Technician Diagnosis
^ Verify coolant concentration. A 50% coolant/water solution ensures proper freeze and corrosion
protection. Inhibitor levels cannot be easily measured in the field, but can be indirectly done by the
measurement of coolant concentration. This must be done by using a Refractometer J 23688
(Fahrenheit scale) or J 26568 (centigrade scale), or equivalent, coolant tester. The Refractometer
uses a minimal amount of coolant that can be taken from the coolant recovery reservoir, radiator or
the engine block. Inexpensive gravity float testers (floating balls) will not completely analyze the
coolant concentration fully and should not be used. The concentration levels should be between
50% and 65% coolant concentrate. This mixture will have a freeze point protection of -34 degrees
Fahrenheit (-37 degrees Celsius). If the concentration is below 50%, the cooling system must be
flushed.
^ Inspect the coolant flow restrictor if the vehicle is equipped with one. Refer to Service Information
(SI) and/or the appropriate Service Manual for component location and condition for operation.
^ Verify that no electrolysis is present in the cooling system. This electrolysis test can be performed
before or after the system has been repaired. Use a digital voltmeter set to 12 volts. Attach one test
lead to the negative battery post and insert the other test lead into the radiator coolant, making sure
the lead does not touch the filler neck or core. Any voltage reading over 0.3 volts indicates that
stray current is finding its way into the coolant. Electrolysis is often an intermittent condition that
occurs when a device or accessory that is mounted to the radiator is energized. This type of current
could be caused from a poorly grounded cooling fan or some other accessory and can be verified
by watching the volt meter and turning on and off various accessories or engage the starter motor.
Before using one of the following flush procedures, the coolant recovery reservoir must be
removed, drained, cleaned and reinstalled before refilling the system.
Notice:
^ Using coolant other than DEX‐COOL(R) may cause premature engine, heater core or
radiator corrosion. In addition, the engine coolant may require changing sooner, at 30,000 miles
(50,000 km) or 24 months, whichever occurs first. Any repairs would not be covered by your
warranty. Always use DEX‐COOL(R) (silicate free) coolant in your vehicle.
^ If you use an improper coolant mixture, your engine could overheat and be badly damaged. The
repair cost would not be covered by your warranty. Too much water in the mixture can freeze and
crack the engine, radiator, heater core and other parts.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators > Page 6243
Flushing Procedures using DEX-COOL(R)
Important:
The following procedure recommends refilling the system with DEX-COOL(R), P/N 12346290 (in
Canada, use P/N 10953464), GM specification 6277M. This coolant is orange in color and has a
service interval of 5 years or 240,000 km (150,000 mi). However, when used on vehicles built prior
to the introduction of DEX-COOL(R), maintenance intervals will remain the same as specified in the
Owner's Manual.
^ If available, use the approved cooling system flush and fill machine (available through the GM
Dealer Equipment Program) following the manufacturer's operating instructions.
^ If approved cooling system flush and fill machine is not available, drain the coolant and dispose of
properly following the draining procedures in the appropriate Service Manual. Refill the system
using clear, drinkable water and run the vehicle until the thermostat opens. Repeat and run the
vehicle three (3) times to totally remove the old coolant or until the drained coolant is almost clear.
Once the system is completely flushed, refill the cooling system to a 50%-60% concentration with
DEX‐COOL(R), P/N 12346290 (in Canada, use P/N 10953464), GM specification 6277M,
following the refill procedures in the appropriate Service Manual.
If a Service Manual is not available, fill half the capacity of the system with 100% DEX-COOL(R),
P/N 12346290 (in Canada, use P/N 10953464), GM specification 6277M. Then slowly add clear,
drinkable water (preferably distilled) to the system until the level of the coolant mixture has reached
the base of the radiator neck. Wait two (2) minutes and reverify the coolant level. If necessary, add
clean water to restore the coolant to the appropriate level.
Once the system is refilled, reverify the coolant concentration using a Refractometer J 23688
(Fahrenheit scale) or J 26568 (centigrade scale) coolant tester, or equivalent. The concentration
levels should be between 50% and 65%.
Flushing Procedures using Conventional Silicated (Green Colored) Coolant
Important:
2004-2005 Chevrolet Aveo (Pontiac Wave, Canada Only) does not use DEX‐COOL(R).
The Aveo and Wave are filled with conventional, silicated engine coolant that is blue in color.
Silicated coolants are typically green in color and are required to be drained, flushed and refilled
every 30,000 miles (48,000 km). The Aveo and Wave are to be serviced with conventional, silicated
coolant. Use P/N 12378560 (1 gal) (in Canada, use P/N 88862159 (1 L). Refer to the Owner's
Manual or Service Information (SI) for further information on OEM coolant.
Important:
Do not mix the OEM orange colored DEX-COOL(R) coolant with green colored coolant when
adding coolant to the system or when servicing the vehicle's cooling system. Mixing the orange and
green colored coolants will produce a brown coolant which may be a customer dissatisfier and will
not extend the service interval to that of DEX-COOL(R). Conventional silicated coolants offered by
GM Service and Parts Operations are green in color.
^ If available, use the approved cooling system flush and fill machine (available through the GM
Dealer Equipment Program) following the manufacturer's operating instructions.
^ If approved cooling systems flush and fill machine is not available, drain coolant and dispose of
properly following the draining procedures in appropriate Service Manual. Refill the system using
clear, drinkable water and run vehicle until thermostat opens. Repeat and run vehicle three (3)
times to totally remove old coolant or until drained coolant is almost clear. Once the system is
completely flushed, refill the cooling system to a 50%-60% concentration with a good quality
ethylene glycol base engine coolant, P/N 12378560, 1 gal (in Canada, use P/N 88862159 1 L),
conforming to GM specification 1825M, or recycled coolant conforming to GM specification 1825M,
following the refill procedures in the appropriate Service Manual.
If a Service Manual is not available, fill half the capacity of the system with 100% good quality
ethylene glycol base (green colored) engine coolant, P/N 12378560 1 gal., (in Canada, use P/N
88862159 1 L) conforming to GM specification 1825M. Then slowly add clear, drinkable water
(preferably distilled) to system until the level of the coolant mixture has reached the base of the
radiator neck. Wait two (2) minutes and recheck coolant level. If necessary, add clean water to
restore coolant to the appropriate level.
Once the system is refilled, recheck the coolant concentration using a Refractometer J 23688
(Fahrenheit scale) or J 26568 (centigrade scale) coolant tester, or equivalent. Concentration levels
should be between 50% and 65%.
Parts Information
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Cooling System, A/C - Aluminum Heater Cores/Radiators > Page 6244
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair
> With Air Conditioning
Heater Core: Service and Repair With Air Conditioning
Heater/Evaporator Module
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Negative battery cable and drain cooling system. 2. Raise vehicle and remove drain tube from
heater-A/C module. 3. Heater hoses from heater core and lower vehicle. 4. Right and left sound
insulators and steering column opening filler. 5. Floor air outlet duct and heater core cover.
CAUTION: To avoid breaking the drain tube, carefully pull the heater core cover straight rearward
when removing.
6. Heater core mounting clamps and remove heater core.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Heater core and heater core mounting clamps. 2. Heater core cover and floor air outlet duct.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair
> With Air Conditioning > Page 6247
3. Right and left sound insulators and steering column opening filler. 4. Raise vehicle and connect
heater hoses to heater core. 5. Drain tube to heater case and lower vehicle. 6. Negative battery
cable and fill cooling system. 7. Check for leaks.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair
> With Air Conditioning > Page 6248
Heater Core: Service and Repair Without Air Conditioning
Heater Module
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT
1. Negative battery cable and drain cooling system. 2. Raise vehicle and remove drain tube from
heater case. 3. Heater hoses from heater core and lower vehicle. 4. Right and left sound insulators
and steering column opening filler. 5. Floor air outlet duct and heater core cover. 6. Heater core
mounting clamps and remove heater core.
INSTALL OR CONNECT
1. Heater core and heater core mounting clamps.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Heater Core > Component Information > Service and Repair
> With Air Conditioning > Page 6249
2. Heater core cover and floor air outlet duct. 3. Right and left sound insulators and steering column
opening filler. 4. Raise vehicle and connect heater hoses to heater core. 5. Drain tube to heater
case and lower vehicle. 6. Negative battery cable and fill cooling system. 7. Check for leaks.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC > Component
Information > Specifications
High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC: Specifications
Pressure Relief Valve ..........................................................................................................................
.................................................... 9.0 N.m (6.1 lb. ft.)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6253
Compressor Components - Disassembled View
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 6254
High Pressure Safety Valve HVAC: Service and Repair
V5 Compressor Rear Head Details
Remove or Disconnect
1. Recover refrigerant using J 39500-GM. 2. Remove old pressure relief valve.
Install or Connect
1. Clean valve seat area on rear head. 2. Lubricate O-ring of new pressure relief valve and O-ring
assembly with new 525 viscosity refrigerant oil. Install new valve and torque in place, 9.0
N.m (6.1 lbs. ft.).
3. Evaluate and recharge the system. 4. Leak test system.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling/Equipment
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling/Equipment
Bulletin No.: 08-01-38-001
Date: January 25, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Information On New GE-48800 CoolTech Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2008 and
Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
Attention:
This bulletin is being issued to announce the release of GM approved Air Conditioning (A/C)
Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging Equipment that meets the new Society of Automotive
Engineers (SAE) J2788 Refrigerant Recovery Standards. The ACR2000 (J-43600) cannot be
manufactured in its current state after December 2007 and will be superseded by GE-48800.
The new J2788 standard does not require that GM Dealers replace their ACR2000 units.
ACR2000's currently in use are very capable of servicing today's refrigerant systems when used
correctly and can continue to be used. Details regarding the new SAE J2788 standard are outlined
in GM Bulletin 07-01-38-004.
Effective February 1 2008, new A/C Refrigerant Recovery/Recharging equipment (P/N GE-48800)
will be released as a required replacement for the previously essential ACR2000 (J-43600). This
equipment is SAE J2788 compliant and meets GM requirements for A/C Refrigerant System
Repairs on all General Motors vehicles, including Hybrid systems with Polyolester (POE)
refrigerant oil. This equipment will not be shipped as an essential tool to GM Dealerships.
In addition, this equipment is Hybrid compliant and designed to prevent oil cross contamination
when servicing Hybrid vehicles with Electric A/C Compressors that use POE refrigerant oil.
The ACR2000 (J-43600) will need to be retrofitted with a J-43600-50 (Hose - ACR2000 Oil Flush
Loop) to be able to perform Hybrid A/C service work. All Hybrid dealers will receive the J-43600-50,
with installation instructions, as a component of the Hybrid essential tool package. Dealerships that
do not sell Hybrids, but may need to service Hybrids, can obtain J-43600-50 from SPX Kent Moore.
Refer to GM Bulletin 08-01-39-001 for the ACR2000 Hose Flush procedure.
The High Voltage (HV) electric A/C compressor used on Two Mode Hybrid vehicles uses a
Polyolester (POE) refrigerant oil instead of a Polyalkylene Glycol (PAG) synthetic refrigerant oil.
This is due to the better electrical resistance of the POE oil and its ability to provide HV isolation.
Failure to flush the hoses before adding refrigerant to a Hybrid vehicle with an electric A/C
compressor may result in an unacceptable amount of PAG oil entering the refrigerant system. It
may cause a Battery Energy Control Module Hybrid Battery Voltage System Isolation Lost
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC P1AE7) to be set. Additionally, the A/C system warranty will be
voided.
Warranty Submission Requirements
The Electronically Generated Repair Data (snapshot summary) and printer functions have been
eliminated from the GE-48800. The VGA display and temperature probes were eliminated to
reduce equipment costs. As a result, effective immediately the 18 digit "Snapshot/Charge
Summary" code is no longer required for Air Conditioning (A/C) refrigerant system repairs that are
submitted for warranty reimbursement. The charge summary data from before and after system
repairs will continue to required, but documented on the repair order only. Both high and low
pressures and the recovery and charge amounts should be noted during the repair and entered on
the repair order. If using ACR2000 (J-43600), the "Snapshot/Charge Summary" printouts should
continue to be attached to the shops copy of the repair order.
The labor codes that are affected by this requirement are D3000 through D4500.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 08-01-38-001 > Jan > 08 > A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling/Equipment
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling/Equipment
Bulletin No.: 08-01-38-001
Date: January 25, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Information On New GE-48800 CoolTech Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2008 and
Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
Attention:
This bulletin is being issued to announce the release of GM approved Air Conditioning (A/C)
Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging Equipment that meets the new Society of Automotive
Engineers (SAE) J2788 Refrigerant Recovery Standards. The ACR2000 (J-43600) cannot be
manufactured in its current state after December 2007 and will be superseded by GE-48800.
The new J2788 standard does not require that GM Dealers replace their ACR2000 units.
ACR2000's currently in use are very capable of servicing today's refrigerant systems when used
correctly and can continue to be used. Details regarding the new SAE J2788 standard are outlined
in GM Bulletin 07-01-38-004.
Effective February 1 2008, new A/C Refrigerant Recovery/Recharging equipment (P/N GE-48800)
will be released as a required replacement for the previously essential ACR2000 (J-43600). This
equipment is SAE J2788 compliant and meets GM requirements for A/C Refrigerant System
Repairs on all General Motors vehicles, including Hybrid systems with Polyolester (POE)
refrigerant oil. This equipment will not be shipped as an essential tool to GM Dealerships.
In addition, this equipment is Hybrid compliant and designed to prevent oil cross contamination
when servicing Hybrid vehicles with Electric A/C Compressors that use POE refrigerant oil.
The ACR2000 (J-43600) will need to be retrofitted with a J-43600-50 (Hose - ACR2000 Oil Flush
Loop) to be able to perform Hybrid A/C service work. All Hybrid dealers will receive the J-43600-50,
with installation instructions, as a component of the Hybrid essential tool package. Dealerships that
do not sell Hybrids, but may need to service Hybrids, can obtain J-43600-50 from SPX Kent Moore.
Refer to GM Bulletin 08-01-39-001 for the ACR2000 Hose Flush procedure.
The High Voltage (HV) electric A/C compressor used on Two Mode Hybrid vehicles uses a
Polyolester (POE) refrigerant oil instead of a Polyalkylene Glycol (PAG) synthetic refrigerant oil.
This is due to the better electrical resistance of the POE oil and its ability to provide HV isolation.
Failure to flush the hoses before adding refrigerant to a Hybrid vehicle with an electric A/C
compressor may result in an unacceptable amount of PAG oil entering the refrigerant system. It
may cause a Battery Energy Control Module Hybrid Battery Voltage System Isolation Lost
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC P1AE7) to be set. Additionally, the A/C system warranty will be
voided.
Warranty Submission Requirements
The Electronically Generated Repair Data (snapshot summary) and printer functions have been
eliminated from the GE-48800. The VGA display and temperature probes were eliminated to
reduce equipment costs. As a result, effective immediately the 18 digit "Snapshot/Charge
Summary" code is no longer required for Air Conditioning (A/C) refrigerant system repairs that are
submitted for warranty reimbursement. The charge summary data from before and after system
repairs will continue to required, but documented on the repair order only. Both high and low
pressures and the recovery and charge amounts should be noted during the repair and entered on
the repair order. If using ACR2000 (J-43600), the "Snapshot/Charge Summary" printouts should
continue to be attached to the shops copy of the repair order.
The labor codes that are affected by this requirement are D3000 through D4500.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 06-01-39-007 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Contaminated R134A Refrigerant
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Contaminated R134A Refrigerant
Bulletin No.: 06-01-39-007
Date: July 25, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Contaminated R134a Refrigerant Found on Market for Automotive Air-Conditioning
Systems
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2007 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2007 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Attention:
This bulletin should be directed to the Service Manager as well as the Parts Manager.
Commercially Available Contaminated R134a Refrigerant
Impurities have been found in new commercially available containers of R134a. High levels of
contaminates may cause decreased performance, and be detrimental to some air-conditioning
components. Accompanying these contaminates has been high levels of moisture.
Tip:
Excessive moisture may cause system concerns such as orifice tube freeze-up and reduced
performance.
Industry Reaction: New Industry Purity Standards
Due to the potential availability of these lower quality refrigerants, the Society of Automotive
Engineers (SAE), and the Air Conditioning and Refrigeration Industry (ARI) are in the process of
instituting reliable standards that will be carried on the labels of future R134a refrigerant containers.
This identifying symbol will be your assurance of a product that conforms to the minimum standard
for OEM Automotive Air-Conditioning use.
How Can You Protect Yourself Today?
It is recommended to use GM or ACDelco(R) sourced refrigerants for all A/C repair work. These
refrigerants meet General Motors own internal standards for quality and purity, insuring that your
completed repairs are as good as the way it left the factory.
Parts Information
The part numbers shown are available through GMSPO or ACDelco(R). The nearest ACDelco(R)
distributor in your area can be found by calling 1-800-223-3526 (U.S. Only).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 06-01-39-007 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Contaminated R134A Refrigerant > Page 6268
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 99-01-38-006A > May > 00 > A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
File In Section: 01 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 99-01-38-006A
Date: May, 2000
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
Subject: J-43600 ACR 2000 Essential Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
Models: 1993-2000 Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks with R-134a Refrigerant
This bulletin is being revised to change the effective date and to update the text. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 99-01-38-006 (Section 01 - HVAC).
Effective June 1, 2000, the use of J-43600 ACR 2000 will be required on all repairs that require A/C
system recovery and are reimbursable by GM. Additionally, GM highly recommends that J-43600
ACR 2000 be used on all GM cars and trucks for customer paid A/C repairs.
Important:
Also effective June 1, 2000, the "Add" time for all air conditioning recovery is revised to 0.5 hours
for front systems and 0.7 hours for front/rear dual systems (RPO C69 or C34). After June 1, 2000,
all air conditioning claims submitted with the 0.9 hours "Add" time will be rejected for "labor hours
excessive".
After the completion of repairs (charging), the ACR 2000 will prompt the user to perform a snapshot
of the air conditioning system operating data. The snapshot includes:
^ Maximum high side pressure.
^ Minimum low side pressure.
^ Duct outlet temperatures (2).
^ Refrigerant purity information.
This information is captured on a paper printout and in a warranty code.
For all GM paid repairs, the paper printout should be attached to the shop copy of the repair order.
The warranty code must be submitted in the warranty claim information in the comments field. The
code enables the reporting of valuable information about the repair to GM for product quality
improvement. Claims submitted without this information may be subject to review and subsequent
debit.
The required use of J-43600 ACR 2000 raises the question of the acceptable uses for any existing
recovery/recycle equipment that GM dealers are currently using. GM recognizes that many of the
previously essential ACR4's are reaching the end of their useful life. There are several alternatives
for existing equipment that may be considered:
^ Use the existing equipment as customer paid recovery only equipment. Example: Collision repair
area.
^ Use the existing equipment as a scavenger unit for contaminated A/C systems.
^ Sell the existing units to repair facilities outside the GM dealer network.
^ Discontinue the use of the existing units if the repair/maintenance costs exceed the value of the
equipment.
^ Donate the existing equipment to local technical schools.
^ Dedicate the ACR4 to A/C system flushing, using the J-42939 Flush Adapter.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 99-01-38-006A > May > 00 > A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment >
Page 6273
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a
Technical Service Bulletin # 431207E Date: 970101
A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a
File In Section: 1 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 43-12-07E
Date: January, 1997
INFORMATION
Subject: Guidelines for Retrofitting R-12 Vehicles to R-134a
Models: 1984-94 Passenger Cars and Trucks (See List Below)
This bulletin is being revised with the following changes:
1. Addition of all remaining GM vehicles, as listed.
2. Format rearranged for easier use.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 43-12-07D (Section 1 - HVAC).
Car/Truck Platform Coverage Starts:
1984 - A, B, D, E, F, J, K, P, Y Carlines
1985 - C, M, N, R, S Carlines
1986 - H Carline
1987 - L, V (Allante) Car lines; M/L, G, R/V, S/T, P Truck lines
1988 - T (LeMans), E (Reatta), W Car lines; C/k, MED. Duty Truck lines
1989 - Tracker
1990 - U Van
Vehicles Not Covered: T (Chevette and T1000), G RWD, C RWD, and X Car
If a vehicle is not covered in the list above, GM's recommendation is that the vehicle continue to be
serviced with R-12.
This bulletin outlines the detailed retrofit procedures, as well as providing background information
on many components and procedures. It is important to follow the bulletin, since each car and truck
line has unique parts and procedures. However, the basic procedure is simple, and will become
easier as you complete more retrofits.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6278
Retrofit Requirements
The customer should be reminded that there is NO requirement in the U.S. to retrofit any vehicle
produced with R-12. Vehicles built with R-12 can be serviced with R-12 as long as it is available
(except in certain Canadian Provinces). GM has taken steps to extend the supply of R-12 and
recommends that all R-12 vehicles continue to be serviced with R-12 as long as it is available.
Training Video
Before doing a retrofit the first time, it is recommended that you view the Certified Plus Training
Video, Program number 51010.15, "R-134a Retrofit for GM Cars and Trucks".
Table of Contents
A. Retrofit Procedure
1. Inspect Condition of Vehicle
2. Recover the R-12 (new method)
3. Install the service port conversion fittings
4. Install any additional parts needed
5. Evacuate and recharge with new PAG or V5 retrofit oil and R-134a
6. Install the retrofit label
Platform Details
Compressor Replacement Chart
B. General Information
1. Performance
2. Leakage
3. Desiccant
4. Improved Cooling Performance
5. PAG or V5 Oil Compatibility
6. Refrigerant Oil Level
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6279
C. Parts Information
D. Warranty Information
1. Vehicle Still in Warranty
2. Customer Paid' Retrofitting Costs
3. Labor Time Information
Notes on Retrofit
Important:
Before proceeding with any retrofit, make sure you have all component Parts required on hand to
perform a proper and complete repair with Minimal downtime.
R-12 Removal Prior to Retrofit
To prepare a system for retrofitting, the R-12 must be recovered and the system must be
completely evacuated. Evacuation is necessary to insure that small amounts of R-12 and air
remaining in the system are removed. This will prevent cross contamination of the two refrigerants,
which could lead to reduced A/C system reliability and performance.
It is very important that the specified times for waiting after recovery and evacuation not be
reduced. This time is required to sufficiently remove residual R-12 from the oil in the system.
A considerable amount of testing has determined that the following procedure is required to
achieve satisfactory results and conform to SAE J 1661:
1. Inspect Condition of Vehicle
Install the gauge set on the high and low side ports.
Use normal diagnostic procedures to find the cause of the vehicle's reported condition. One of
three conditions will exist with the refrigerant system:
a. System pressure correct, no leaks - proceed to Step 2 (Recovery). This would normally apply
when:
1. The system must be recovered/recharged for a repair to a system other than the A/C system, or
2. Where the A/C system condition did not involve leaks, but requires recovery/recharge to replace
a component.
b. Compressor not operating, but some charge. Leak test to find the leak, complete Step 2
(Recovery), then correct the leak before proceeding with Step 3 (Conversion port installation).
c. No charge in system - proceed with the Conversion port installation in Step 3. Use the ACR4 to
evacuate for 5 minutes. If the leak can be heard, repair the leak. If the leak cannot be heard,
charge with 1/2 pound of R-134a. Leak test with the J 39400 Leak Detector, recover the R-134a,
repair any additional leaks found, and proceed with the evacuation in Step 5.
2. Recover the R-12 from the System
Notice:
THIS PROCEDURE IS DIFFERENT THAN THE NORMAL (NON-RETROFIT) RECOVERY
PROCEDURE. R-12 will be recovered through the HIGH SIDE SERVICE PORT ONLY, WITH THE
ENGINE RUNNING. Recovery through the low side will not effectively remove the R-12 from the
accumulator, resulting in possible damage to the retrofitted system.
Important:
Vehicle must be above 50° F (10° C) to allow for complete recovery of the R-12. If it is not, either
allow it to warm up in the shop overnight, or increase the evacuation time in Step 5.a to 30 minutes.
a. Connect the recovery hose from the R-12 recovery cart (ACR3) to the middle port of the A/C
gauge set. Open the oil drain valve on the ACR3 cart long enough to drain the oil. Failure to do so
could cause excessive amounts of oil to build up in the separator, resulting in damage to the
recovery cart compressor.
b. Start the engine. Leave the hood up, and the windows open. On vehicles with manual A/C
controls, set the A/C controls to normal A/C mode, high blower, and temperature control to full cold.
On cars with automatic A/C controls, set the temperature to 75° F, "AUTO" mode, and manually
select high blower.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6280
Make sure the vehicle compressor is engaged. Turn the cart on and start the recovery cycle. OPEN
ONLY THE HIGH SIDE VALVE ON THE GAUGE SET. The vehicle system should eventually shut
the compressor off. If the low side pressure drops below 15 psi, and the compressor does not turn
off, turn it off now (go to "VENT" or "ECON" mode), but leave the engine running and the blower on
"high".
c. After the recovery cart shuts off the first time, wait 5 minutes. If the pressure on either the high or
the low side rises above 0 psi, restart the recovery process. After the second shutoff, wait 2
minutes. If the pressure again rises above 0 psi, restart, and after shutoff, again wait 2 minutes.
The process can be stopped when the pressure does not rise above 0 psi after 2 minutes. The
engine can be shut off at this time.
d. Remove the R-12 reclaim hose and the gauge set from the vehicle.
Any repairs needed should be done at this time. If any components other than the compressor are
replaced, they should be installed dry, and no extra oil should be added.
3. Install the Service Port Conversion Fittings
Important:
For GEO vehicles, skip to Step 4. Fitting installation is covered in that step. For vehicles that
require a HPCOS, see Step 4. Some of these vehicles use a specific combination fitting to mount
the HPCOS, which includes the high side service port fitting and the HPCOS port. The low side
fitting is installed as detailed below. See "Platform Details" for further information.
Important:
A new tool kit, P/N J 39500-250, has been released. This kit contains the following items:
^ J 39500-71 Oil Injection Bottle Conversion Kit (includes 3 12 oz bottles, an extender tube, caps,
and fittings)
^ J 39500-275 Tool kit, including the following: (See Figure 2)
- J 34611-A Double ended valve core remover
- J 25498-A High side adapter fitting
- J 38702 Deep valve core adapter fitting
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6281
- J 41265 Thread cleaning wire brush
- J 41266 Low side port thread restorer
- J 41267 High side port thread restorer
- J 39037 High side octagon socket
- J 41256 Low side octagon socket
New low profile, quick connect couplers, J 39500-20A (High side), and J 39500-24A (Low side),
have been released as essential tools, to attach to the ACR4 (see Figure 3). These are much
smaller couplers than the existing ones, and will allow attachment to the port fittings in much tighter
quarters.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6282
Select and install the proper R-134a fittings (shown in Figure 4) from the chart below, based on
how the ACR4 couplers will attach. Also, remember to check for proper hood clearance with the
conversion fittings. Try the straight fittings first. The two-piece high side fitting is used when the
existing fitting is screwed into the pipe fitting (some 1992, and nearly all 1993 models, use these
fittings). Use the 90° elbow if the straight fitting does not allow the ACR4 couplers to connect.
Fitting Type High Side Low Side
Straight 52467941 52467943
Straight Two-piece 52467324 N/A
90° Elbow 52469054 52469055
The fittings should be installed as follows:
a. Remove the caps from the R-12 fittings. Remove any dirt or grease from the port threads using
the thread cleaning wire brush, J 41265. Inspect the fittings for thread damage. If any damage is
found, use the port thread restorer (J 41266 low side, J 41267 high side) to repair the thread.
For the two-piece fitting, remove the existing R-12 fitting and discard it. Use tool J 38704A
(previously released, not part of the above kit) to remove the fitting. Make sure to hold the line
securely to prevent damage when removing the existing fitting. If the fitting cannot be removed
easily, use the saddle clamp valve listed below and seal the R-12 port and cap permanently.
b. Install the selected fitting onto the existing R-12 fitting. Leave the valve core in the straight
fittings, and remove the valve core when using the 90° fittings.
If the valve cores need to be removed at a later time, they can be removed with the straight
conversion fittings in place. On the low side straight fitting, use the J 34611-A tool to remove the
core pin in the conversion fitting, then remove the core valve from the original R-12 fitting. Always
recover the charge before valve core removal.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6283
Use the octagon sockets on the straight fittings (J 39037 high side, and J 41256 low side). Torque
the new fitting until it seats. The fitting should seat fully BEFORE reaching 11 N.m (8 lb ft). If 11
N.m (8 lb ft) of torque is reached and the fitting has not seated, it is probable that the threads have
been damaged. In this case, remove the fitting and use the thread restorer listed above. Reinstall
the fitting, adding one drop of a thread locking compound such as Loctite(R) 242.
The fittings (except the two-piece) have a thread locking compound applied to the threads. This
compound will set up enough to restrict removal of the fitting in about 15 minutes. The fittings can
now be used to evacuate the system (see Step 5).
An additional type of conversion port fitting has been developed. This fitting is called a saddle
clamp valve (see Figure 5). It can be clamped directly on a metal refrigerant line, and will be used if
the existing fitting is damaged or is inaccessible. A drop of a thread locking compound, such as
Loctite(R) 242, should be used on each bolt to prevent the threads from loosening.
The R134a saddle clamp valve part numbers are:
If an existing R-12 service port is not used, it must be rendered inoperative. Place several drops of
a thread locking compound, such as Loctite(R) 243, in the valve core, and onto the cap threads.
Secure the cap and let it set for 15 minutes.
4. Install Any Additional Parts Needed
See "Platform Details" after Step 6. If a vehicle is listed as a "Basic Retrofit", no additional parts are
required (except for compressors, see the Compressor Replacement Chart at the beginning of
Platform Details). If no parts are required, PROCEED TO STEP 5.
Compressors
Compressors do not need to be replaced as part of a normal retrofit, unless indicated in the
Compressor Replacement Chart. An R-12 compressor that is operating properly can, in most
cases, be left in the vehicle when it is retrofitted to R134a. However, if a compressor failure is the
reason the vehicle is in for service, and the vehicle will be retrofitted, OR if a vehicle has already
been retrofitted with R-134a and the compressor fails at some time in the future, new compressors
for use with R-134a are available. See the GMSPO Parts Catalog for specific part numbers. DO
NOT use a replacement R-12 compressor for any vehicle retrofitted to R-134a (unless it is the new
"oil-less" design). See "Compressor Availability" at the end of the Compressor Replacement Chart.
Accumulator /Dryer
If the vehicle is more than 5 years old, the Accumulator/Dryer (A/D) should be replaced to ensure
that moisture is removed from the system. See the instructions for proper A/D identification in
General Information.
High Pressure Cut-Off Switch (HPCOS)
Most trucks, and some 1984-93 B and D cars, require that a HPCOS be added to protect the
refrigerant system during long idles at high temperature. The HPCOS kit (P/N 15981985) contains
the switch, wire harness, heat sealing splice connectors, switch "0" ring, and installation
instructions. A saddle clamp adapter (P/N 15985307), or a special dual fitting, is mounted to the
high pressure line, and provides the port to mount the switch. A drop of a
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6284
thread locking compound, such as Loctite(R) 242, should be used on each bolt of the saddle clamp
to prevent the threads from loosening.
Some vehicles produced during the second half of the 1993 model year will already have a factory
installed HPCOS. Check the back of the compressor for this switch. If present, the above switch
will not have to be added.
5. Evacuate the System, and Recharge with PAG or V5 Retrofit Oil and R-134a
Newly designed low profile quick connect couplers for the ACR4, J 39500-20A and J 39500-24A,
have been released. These should be installed before proceeding with the evacuation. See Step 3,
and Figure 3.
a. Connect the R-134a cart (ACR4) to the system. Open the coupler valves on the hoses so that
the pressures can be read on the gauges. On the cart, open the HIGH SIDE VALVE ONLY. DO
NOT OPEN THE LOW SIDE VALVE! Program the cart for a 15 minute evacuation.
Important:
If the vehicle has been at outside temperatures of less than 50° F (10° C), or at high altitudes
(above 3000 ft), use a 30 minute evacuation to insure complete removal of the R-12.
If the vacuum pump will not start and a "H-P" reading is indicated on the ACR4 display, loosen the
fitting at the high side line connection to the ACR4 to relieve pressure in the line. Tighten the fitting
after pressure has been relieved. DO NOT USE THE RECOVERY MODE TO RELIEVE LINE
PRESSURE.
b. Start the evacuation. For a proper evacuation, the cart must pull down to 28-29 in. Hg. at sea
level (reduce by 1 in. for each 1000 ft above sea level). Check the low side gauge for proper
vacuum level, to make sure the new fittings are operating properly.
While the evacuation is being done, the Retrofit label can be filled out and installed (see Step 6).
Important:
If the compressor was replaced at the same time as this retrofit, and the new compressor was
shipped with the correct amount of PAG oil already in it, DO NOT add any additional oil to the
system! Go to Step D. If an "oil-less" compressor was installed, add oil in Step C.
A new retrofit oil for use with V5 compressor vehicles has been released. This oil will be used
ONLY for retrofitted vehicles in which the original V5 compressor is retained. IT WILL NOT BE
USED IF A COMPRESSOR IS REPLACED AT THE TIME OF THE RETROFIT. Failure to use this
oil may significantly shorten the useful life of the compressor.
Important:
If the V5 Retrofit oil is not available from GMSPO, the compressor MUST BE REPLACED!
To summarize the correct retrofit oil usage:
^ Compressor replaced during retrofit
- NO OIL ADDED if new compressor shipped with oil
- 8 oz. of PAG oil (9 oz of PAG oil with V5 compressor) added if compressor shipped without oil
("oil-less" design)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6285
^ PAG oil used for future service if needed (mark PAG on box on label, Figure 6).
^ HR6 or R4 original compressor RETAINED - add 8 oz FAG oil to system
^ V5 original compressor RETAINED - add 9 oz V5 Retrofit oil to system. If V5 Retrofit oil is not
available from GMSPO, REPLACE THE COMPRESSOR.
c. Based on the above chart, add oil if needed. Use the new oil bottle and the extended tube kit, J
39500-71. Fill the bottle with at least 10 oz of oil. Attach the new bottle to the back of the ACR4,
and open the oil fill valve. Allow the correct amount of oil to be drawn into the system. DO NOT
allow the oil level to drop below the end of the pickup tube. This will prevent any air from being
drawn into the system. If any oil was removed during the R-12 recovery evacuation steps, DO NOT
add additional oil to replace it.
d. Determine the correct amount of R-134a to use. Check the existing label of the vehicle for the
R-12 charge amount.
Use the formula {(R12 x .9) - .25 lb = R-134a} to determine the correct charge. This can also be
stated as: Take 90% of the R12 charge, and subtract 1/4 lb.
Follow the directions for the ACR4 cart to recharge the system. At the end of the process, "CPL"
will be displayed. Close the high side valve.
e. Start the vehicle, turn on the A/C system, and confirm that pressures are within normal operating
ranges, as shown in the 1994 Service Manual. The 1994 Service Manuals can be used as a
reference for diagnosis and specification of retrofitted systems.
On some vehicles with automatic A/C controls or low charge diagnostics, the A/C compressor may
not engage if any diagnostic codes were set during the retrofit. Check to see if any codes were set
in either the HVAC or Engine Control systems. If they were, clear the codes following the directions
in the Service Manual.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6286
f. TO INSURE AN ACCURATE CHARGE AMOUNT, IT IS IMPORTANT TO CLEAR THE ACR4 OF
ANY REMAINING REFRIGERANT. Close the high side coupler valve and remove the high side
hose from the vehicle. Then, open both the high and low side valves on the ACR4. After the
pressures on both gages are at low side pressure, close the low side coupler valve. See Step G
below, then remove the low side hose from the vehicle. Shut off the engine. Install the service port
caps on the new fittings. These serve as a seal and can prevent system leaks.
g. In the unlikely event that the low side fitting leaks when the coupler is removed, use the following
procedure:
1. Immediately reinstall the coupler on the fitting.
2. Find the valve core remover J 34611-A.
3. Remove the coupler.
4. Use the double-ended valve core remover to turn the valve core pin counter-clockwise until the
leak stops.
5. Install the cap.
If the leak was substantial or continued for an extended period of time, it is highly recommended to
evacuate and recharge the system to insure proper performance. If there is any question, the
system can be rechecked by repeating Step F.
h. Leak test any new port fittings, adapters, or valves that were installed, and any joints that were
opened or repaired during the retrofit process, using tool J 39400.
6. Install the Retrofit Label
The retrofit label (P/N 21030857, roll of 250) has been developed following SAF specifications to
insure a smooth transition from R-12 to R-134a, and to insure a professional approach to the
retrofit and a quality repair. Following the instructions in this bulletin will insure that the retrofit
meets the SAE standards.
Fill in the new label using a typewriter or a ball-point pen (see Figure 6). Select a location for the
label that will be easily visible. Some suggested areas are the radiator support panel, an area near
the existing R-12 charge label, or a flat surface near the high or low side service ports. The area
selected should be a clean, underhood, painted sheet metal surface, and should be degreased and
wiped down with a non-petroleum based cleaner. Do not install the label on a rubber surface. Apply
the label, then apply the clear overlay to the label.
Do not remove, cover, or render unreadable the existing R-12 charge label. DO cover the R-12
refrigerant charge amount on the existing label with an indelible, preferably black, marker.
Platform Details
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6287
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6288
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6289
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6290
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6291
FOR ALL VEHICLES EXCEPT GEO, see the "Compressor Replacement Chart" at the end of this
section. Compressor replacement requirements ARE NOT LISTED in the platform details (except
for application details), except as noted below for Y car and P and Medium Duty truck.
Compressor Replacement Chart
Important:
It is important to check the date code on the compressor. Any vehicle may have had a compressor
replaced either during or after the warranty period. The date code will determine whether or not the
compressor must be replaced.
Compressor Availability
A new compressor for use with R-134a systems will be shipped with the correct amount of PAG oil
installed (see "IMPORTANT" below). Do not add any additional oil in Step 5 of the retrofit
procedure if a compressor is to be replaced with a new R-134a compressor at the same time the
initial retrofit is
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6292
being done.
Important:
During 1996, "oil-less" compressors began to be serviced with NO added oil. New part numbers
will be issued, and both the box and the compressor will be clearly marked to indicate that no oil is
present. If you receive one of these newer compressors, simply add the normal amount of oil to the
system in Step 5 of the retrofit procedure (8 oz of PAG oil, or 9 oz of PAG oil with V5 compressor).
These "oil-less" compressors are compatible with EITHER R12 or R-134a.
Geo Models
Compressors DO NOT HAVE TO BE REPLACED as part of the retrofit. New compressors are
shipped with enough oil to accommodate the entire A/C system. Do not add additional PAG oil to
the system it the compressor is being replaced.
1985-88 Nova, 1989-93 Prizm (S)
1. Using the Service Manual, remove the following components in the order given:
a. Receiver/dryer.
b. Loosen evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe (to be reinstalled)
c. 1985-92 only: Loosen compressor to condenser (compressor discharge) pipe (to be reinstalled).
d. 1985-88 only: Service Valve & Extension Housing on compressor (to be installed).
e. Compressor (only if being replaced).
2. Using the Service Manual, install the following components in the order given. Be sure to use
new 0-rings whenever a refrigerant connection has been disconnected.
a. Compressor (if being replaced).
b. High and low side adapter fittings (see Step 3 of the retrofit procedure for detailed installation
instructions).
c. 1985-88 only: Service Valve & Extension Housing on compressor using new 0-rings. Six small
0-rings and one large 0-ring are required.
d. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe 0-ring.
e. 1985-92 Compressor to condenser (discharge) hose 0-ring.
f. Receiver/dryer and 0-rings.
R-134a amount: 85-92 - 650 grams (1.43 lb)
93 - 700 grams (1.54 lb) PAG oil amount: 100 cc (3.0 oz) Parts Required:
Receiver/dryer:
85-88 - 94855761
89-93 - 94855762
Adapter Fittings:
Low Side - 94855760
High Side - 94855759
0-Rings:
85-88 Compressor - Small 0-rings (6 required) - 94857336 - Large 0-ring - 94857337
85-93 Receiver/Dryer (2) - 94845949
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6293
85-93 Suction hose - 94855765
85-92 Discharge hose - 94845943
1985-88 Sprint, 1989-93 Metro (M)
1. Using the Service Manual, remove the following components in the order given:
a. Receiver/dryer.
b. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe.
c. Compressor to condenser (compressor discharge) pipe.
d. Joint service connector on compressor (to be reinstalled).
e. Compressor (only if being replaced).
2. Using the Service Manual, install the following components in the the order given. Be sure to use
new 0-rings whenever a refrigerant connection has been disconnected.
a. Compressor (if being replaced).
b. High and low side adapter fittings (see Step 3 of the retrofit procedure for detailed installation
instructions).
c. Joint service connector to compressor. Use new 0-rings. Six small 0-rings and one large 0-ring
are required.
d. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe, and new 0-ring.
e. Compressor to condenser (discharge) hose and new 0-ring.
f. Receiver/dryer and 0-ring.
R-134a amount: 500 grams (1.10 lb)
PAG oil amount: 100 cc (3.0 oz)
Parts Required:
Receiver/dryer:
85-86 - 91172081
87-88 - 91172079
89-93 - 96068480
Adapter Fittings:
Low Side - 91172092
85-88 - High Side - 91172094
89-93 - High Side - 52467941
0-Rings:
Compressor - Small 0-rings (6 required)
- 91172095
- Large 0-ring - 96068915
Receiver/Dryer (2) - 96068488
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6294
89-93 - Suction hose - 96068490
89-93 - Discharge hose - 96068489
Suction hose:
85-86 - 91172086
85-86 Dealer installed: 91172087
87-88 - 91172088
89-93 - w/turbo - 96069121 - w/o turbo
- 91172089
Discharge hose:
85-86 - 91172082
85-86 Dealer installed: 91172083
87-88 - 91172084
89-93 - 96069024
1989-93 Tracker
1. Using the Service Manual, remove the following components in the order given:
a. Receiver/dryer.
b. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe.
c. Compressor to condenser (compressor discharge) pipe.
d. Joint service connector on compressor (to be reinstalled).
e. Compressor (only if being replaced).
2. Using the Service Manual, install the following components in the order given. Be sure to use
new 0-rings whenever a refrigerant connection has been disconnected.
a. Compressor (if being replaced).
b. High and low side adapter fittings (see Step 3 of the Retrofit procedure for detailed installation
instructions).
c. Joint service connector to compressor. Use new 0-rings. Six small 0-rings and one large 0-ring
are required.
d. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe, and new 0-ring.
e. Compressor to condenser (discharge) hose and new 0-ring.
f. Receiver/dryer and 0-ring.
R-134a amount: 550 grams (1.21 lb)
PAG oil amount: 100 cc (3.0 oz)
Parts Required:
Receiver/dryer - 91172080
Adapter, Low Side - 91172092
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6295
Adapter, High Side - 91172093
0-Rings:
Compressor - Small (6) - 91172095 Large - 96068915
Receiver/dryer (2) - 96068488
Suction hose - 96068490
Discharge hose - 96068489
Suction hose - 91172091
Discharge hose - 91172085
1985-89 Spectrum and 1990-93 Storm (R)
1. Using the Service Manual, remove the following components in the order given:
a. Condenser (Storm) or radiator grille (Spectrum) (to be reinstalled).
b. Triple switch (Storm) or dual pressure switch (Spectrum) (to be reinstalled).
c. Receiver/dryer.
d. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe.
e. Check valve from high side service valve (discard).
f. Compressor (only if being replaced).
2. Using the Service Manual, install the following components in the order given. Be sure to use
new 0-rings whenever a refrigerant connection has been disconnected.
a. Compressor (if being replaced).
b. High side adapter fitting (see Step 3 of the retrofit procedure for detailed installation instructions).
Low Side - Part of suction hose
c. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe, and new 0-rings.
d. Receiver/dryer and 0-rings.
e. Triple switch or dual switch, and new 0-ring.
f. Condenser or radiator grille.
R-134a amount: 91 - 500 grams (1.10 lb)
92-93 - 600 grams (1.32 lb)
PAG oil amount: 150 cc (4.50 oz)
Parts Required:
Receiver/dryer:
85-89 - 97104795
90-91 - 97104797
92-93 - 97104798
Adapter, High Side:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6296
85-89 - 97104794
90-93 - 97104793
Adapter, Low Side: Part of Hose Asm.
0-rings:
Receiver/dryer 85-91 - 94154048
92-93 - 94461700
Switch/pipe - 94461902
Suction hose:
85-86: 1.5L - 97104799; 1.6L - 97104800
90-93: 1.6L - 97104801; 1.8L - 97104803
B. General Information
Several items affecting the performance and durability of the system should be considered:
1. Performance
When performed properly, the retrofit from R-12 to R-134a will have minimal effect on the system's
performance in most climatic conditions found in the United States and Canada.
2. Leakage
Experience has shown that most leakage in an A/C system is due to leaks at the joints, or through
a small leak in a hose, usually at the coupling. The R-134a molecules are smaller than R-12, and a
small leak may result in a faster loss of refrigerant with R-134a. Because of this, it is very important
to leak check all vehicles using the J 39400 leak detector, BEFORE the retrofit is performed, and
repair any leaks found.
"0" rings and hoses used in most GM vehicles are compatible with R-134a and do not need
replacement during a retrofit. "0" rings or hoses installed in previous repairs may have been of
non-compatible materials if GM parts were not used and will be more likely to deteriorate and leak
than the original equipment materials. All "0" rings and hoses available through GMSP0 are
compatible with R-134a. Remember that the normal policy is to replace the "0" rings whenever a
joint is opened for any reason.
3. Desiccant
You may have heard that the currently used desiccant in the accumulator is not compatible with
R-134a. Extensive testing has shown that it is, in fact, suitable for use with R-134a, once it has
been in service in an R-12 system. The accumulator in these models will not have to be changed
during the retrofit procedure, unless the vehicle is more than 5 years old. Vehicles more than 5
years old should have the A/D replaced to add new desiccant for proper system drying.
In the event that an accumulator/dryer (A/D) needs to be replaced on a retrofitted system in the
future, only A/D's with XH-7 desiccant should be used. The service parts for the 1993 vehicles
contain only XH-7 desiccant. The parts for the 1992 and older vehicles may contain either XH-5 or
XH-7. Parts containing XH-7 can be identified (see Figure 1) by 1) an "A" printed on the top of the
A/D; or 2) if there is a label on top of the A/D, there will be a square with an "A" inside; or 3) if there
is a time code and date printed on top of the A/D just under the "Harrison" logo, the A/D contains
XH-7. A/D's containing XH-5 can still be used on R-12 vehicles.
4. Improved Cooling Performance
There have been service bulletins issued in the past with information improving the cooling
performance of existing R-12 systems. These bulletins can also be used to improve the
performance of retrofitted vehicles in high ambient temperature climates.
5. PAG or V5 Oil Compatibility
Contrary to information published to date outside of General Motors, mineral oil and PAG or V5 oil
ARE chemically compatible. The mineral oil left in the system after reclaiming the R-12 can remain
in the system with no harmful effects. However, the mineral oil will not mix with the R-134a, and so
will not circulate and perform its lubricating function. Testing has shown that most of the mineral oil
will eventually collect in the
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6297
accumulator. The system will operate properly as long as refrigerant charge amounts are strictly
adhered to.
6. Refrigerant Charge Level
The retrofit R-134a charge level is more critical than with R-12 systems. Overcharging may push
the mineral oil out of the AID, and cause it to circulate as a liquid. This is more likely to result in
compressor damage. Undercharging may lead to loss of performance. It is very important to clear
the hoses during the charging operation, to insure that all the refrigerant is delivered to the vehicle
A/C system. This is covered in Step 6D of the Retrofit Procedure.
C. Parts Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6298
Important:
All of the following parts are NOT NEEDED for a normal retrofit. Follow the bulletin procedures to
determine which parts you need! Individual vehicle kits are not necessary, since most of the parts
are generic and only a few parts are needed for most vehicles.
GEO Parts are listed in "Platform Details."
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
D. Warranty Information
1. Vehicle Still Within the Original New Vehicle Limited Warranty Period
When GM models for the years listed in the bulletin require repairs to the refrigerant system and
the vehicles are still covered under the New
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6299
Vehicle Limited Warranty, dealers are instructed to proceed as follows:
Important:
On vehicles equipped with A/C systems NOT produced by GM (i.e., rear A/C systems in van
conversions), consult the manufacturer of that A/C system for retrofit guidelines.
^ Offer the customer the option of repairing and recharging the system with R12, or retrofitting after
repair and recharging with R-134a at no additional charge.
^ Provide the owner with, and review the information contained in, the "Converting Your Auto Air
Conditioning System to Use the New Refrigerant" brochure. (Brochure, Form GM-0011, can be
ordered free of charge from GM Fulfillment HQ, Phone 1-800-269-5100).
^ Record the customer's choice on the repair order and, as with all properly completed repair
orders, ask the customer to sign on the appropriate line acknowledging the repairs requested.
^ Under no circumstances should the retrofit to R-134a be performed unless the customer has had
the option explained prior to repair. Once the vehicle has been retrofitted to R-134a, a significant
expenditure would be incurred to go back to R-12, in the event the customer has changed his/her
mind.
THIS OFFER APPLIES ONLY TO VEHICLES REQUIRING A/C REFRIGERANT SYSTEM
REPAIRS UNDER THE TERMS OF THE NEW VEHICLE LIMITED WARRANTY. It is not a special
policy, and any existing deductibles still apply. This is simply an option being offered to the
customer during the warranty period at this time. GM reserves the right to terminate this offer at
any time.
If the R-12 refrigerant system does not require discharging for a warranty repair, but the customer
requests a retrofit to R-134a, the retrofit WOULD BE PERFORMED AT THE CUSTOMER'S
EXPENSE, EVEN DURING THE WARRANTY PERIOD.
2. Customer Paid Retrofitting Costs
If the customer requests a retrofit to R-134a, for a specific vehicle whose retrofit parts and
procedures have been released in this bulletin, the customer would be expected to pay the costs to
retrofit under the following conditions:
^ The vehicle is no longer covered by the terms of the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
^ The vehicle is covered by warranty, but the repair covered under the warranty does not require
evacuating and recharging the refrigerant system.
3. Labor Time Information
For Vehicles Repaired Under Warranty: Use existing labor operations for correcting the original
condition. The quantity of R-134a used should be charged to the normal labor operation (not
D4500), just as if it were R-12.
Use D4500, 0.3 HR., to charge for parts and labor, for all of the following items:
^ Additional time for recovery of R-12 to meet SAE standards;
^ Install high and low side service port converter fittings;
^ Add PAG or V5 retrofit oil;
^ Complete label information and install.
Add 0.2 hours to D4500 for installation of the HPCOS.
Use T5321, 0.3 HR., for the Pontiac Bonneville hood seal installation.
ANY PARTS OR LABOR TIME OTHER THAN THOSE LISTED ABOVE SHOULD BE CHARGED
TO THE REGULAR LABOR OPERATION CORRESPONDING TO THE ORIGINAL CONDITION
THAT 1S BEING REPAIRED.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 631209 > May > 96 > A/C - R12 or R134a Service Recommendations
Technical Service Bulletin # 631209 Date: 960501
A/C - R12 or R134a Service Recommendations
File In Section: 1 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 63-12-09
Date: May, 1996
INFORMATION
Subject: Service Issues for Vehicles with R12 or R134a Air Conditioning Systems
Models: 1988-96 Passenger Cars and Trucks
R12 Service Recommendations
As you know, production of R12 refrigerant ceased on December 31, 1995. Although R12 will no
longer be manufactured, there is a reserve supply of R12 available. This reserve, along with strict
A/C repair service adherence to proper refrigerant recycling procedures, should assure continued
availability to meet consumers' needs.
R12 can and should continue to be used to service vehicles built with R12 A/C systems as long as
it is available. If R12 is no longer available or affordable, a system retrofit utilizing R134a is
recommended. R134a IS THE ONLY SUBSTITUTE REFRIGERANT RECOMMENDED BY GM
FOR USE IN GM VEHICLE A/C SYSTEMS, AND THEN ONLY AFTER FOLLOWING THE
PROPER RETROFIT PROCEDURES FOR THE SPECIFIC MODEL. All new vehicle
manufacturers have chosen R134a for retrofit. One of the key reasons is to protect both the service
industry and consumers from the high costs that would result from purchasing equipment
necessary to service multiple refrigerants. This position also reduces the threat of recycled
refrigerant contamination.
GM currently offers a simple, low cost R12 to R134a retrofit on many of its late model, front wheel
drive passenger cars. Dealers should discuss this capability with owners of these specific models,
listed in Retrofit Corporate Bulletin # 43-12-07D, whenever a repair to the A/C refrigerant system is
required. Early retrofit of these specific models will aid in prolonging availability of the R12 supply
and provide dealer service technicians the opportunity to become more familiar with the proper
procedures for performing a retrofit.
Remember - R12 and R134a refrigerant are not interchangeable! They cannot be mixed together.
In fact, despite the claims of some refrigerant manufacturers, no proposed R12 refrigerant
substitute can be added to, mixed with or used to "top off" an R12 system. Under provisions of law
covering the service of refrigerants, mixing dissimilar refrigerant products during service is
prohibited.
To Summarize GM R12 Service Policy
1. Service R12 vehicles with good quality new or recycled R12 as long as it is available.
2. Purchase R12 from a reliable supplier. GMSPO has a supply of high quality R12 available.
Dealers are requested to use only R12 supplied by GMSPO for warranty repairs. This high quality
refrigerant will insure system performance and avoid the possibility of introducing contaminated
material into the customer's A/C system.
3. Carefully test recovered R12 using the PureGuard monitor. On recovery equipment not
protected by the PureGuard, always test the recovery cylinder prior to recharging a vehicle A/C
system.
4. Discuss the R12 to R134a retrofit option with owners of GM vehicles listed in Retrofit Corporate
Bulletin # 43-12-07D. Provide owner with a copy of the pamphlet "Converting Your Auto Air
Conditioning System to Use the New Refrigerant".
5. Become familiar with retrofit procedures and exercise care in the handling of dissimilar
refrigerants to prevent contamination.
R134A Service Recommendations
When servicing a previously retrofitted vehicle, there is concern that if all of the R12 is not
completely removed prior to the retrofit procedure, it could contaminate your R134a equipment and
recovery tank when a subsequent A/C repair is performed. Although the number of retrofits being
performed today is minimal, the volume will increase as R12 prices rise.
GM Service Technology Group is in the process of field testing a new R134a refrigerant purity
tester similar to the PureGuard R12 refrigerant tester you now use. This new tool will mount to your
ACR4 R134a Recovery Recycle and Recharge cart and sample all R134a refrigerant prior to
recovery. It is expected that testing of this tool will be completed this year.
This new tool, the Pureguard 2, will also test vehicles and your recycle tank for air contamination,
which is threatening A/C system performance. High levels of air have been found in the recovery
tanks on a number of R12 and R134a recovery carts. Air contamination is caused by improper
recovery
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 631209 > May > 96 > A/C - R12 or R134a Service Recommendations > Page
6304
procedures and short-cutting refrigerant recycling times. Use the following procedure for testing
and correcting air contamination in your A/C service equipment.
1. Make certain that the ACR4 equipment has not been used for at least 12 hours. It is
recommended that the equipment be left in an area where the temperature will remain constant
overnight to allow the temperature of the refrigerant in the tank to stabilize.
2. Record the surrounding air temperature next to the ACR4 refrigerant tank.
Important:
A major assumption is that the ambient air temperature next to the tank represents the refrigerant
temperature in the tank. Failure to take care in measuring the temperature could result in
unnecessary work.
3. Close both liquid (blue) and vapor (red) valves on the ACR4 tank.
4. Disconnect low side (blue) service hose from the back of the ACR4.
5. Slowly disconnect the tank vapor hose (red) from the back of the ACR4 and connect it to the low
side service port.
6. Open the vapor (red) valve on the tank and record the tank pressure on the low side gage.
7. Restore hoses to the original position.
8. Referring to the Table, find the ambient temperature measured in Step 2. Compare the pressure
reading from Step 6 to the "maximum allowable pressure". If the pressure reading from Step 6 is
less than the "maximum allowable pressure", no further action is necessary.
Important:
The closer the tank pressure is to the desired tank pressure, the better the A/C system will perform.
9. If the pressure reading from Step 6 exceeds the maximum allowable pressure from the Table,
open both tank valves and operate the ACR4 through 4 or 5 evacuation cycles. This will activate
the automatic air purge to lower the tank pressure.
Important:
Station should not be connected to vehicle.
10. Repeat the tank pressure checking procedure the next day to determine if the pressure has
been reduced to acceptable levels. If the tank pressure has been reduced but is not acceptable,
cycle with ACR4 through more evacuation cycles and recheck the next day. Continue process until
acceptable pressure is obtained. If the tank pressure is not reduced through the evacuation cycling,
then Kent-Moore should be contacted at 1-800-345-2233.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 531205 > May > 95 > Contaminated R12 Refrigerant - Testing & Handling
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins Contaminated R12 Refrigerant - Testing & Handling
FILE IN SECTION: 1 - HVAC
BULLETIN NO.: 53-12-05
DATE: May, 1995
SUBJECT: Contaminated R12 Refrigerant Testing and Handling
MODELS: 1994 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks with R12 A/C Systems
The J 39851 "PureGuard" R12 refrigerant monitor was recently shipped to all GM dealers as an
essential tool to test R12 refrigerant. Dealers are strongly urged to install this protective device on
their ACR3 or other R12 recovery equipment immediately. The PureGuard is easily installed on any
recovery cart (20 minutes), requires no recovery cart modifications, is fully automatic (no training
required) and does not increase the time required to perform normal A/C service procedures.
Proper use of this tool can:
^ Prevent damage to your R12 recovery/recycling equipment.
^ Prevent contamination of previously recovered R12 in the recovery tank.
^ Prevent loss of your recovered R12 as contaminated refrigerant will activate automatic air purge
system.
^ Prevent the spread of contaminated R12 to other vehicles you service.
If your dealership has multiple R12 recovery stations which are not protected, use the PureGuard
to check the refrigerant in these recovery tanks for contamination at least once each week. Simply
connect the PureGuard blue service hose (that would normally be connected to the vehicle low
side service port) to the red or vapor side of any recovery cart tank and run the test. It is also
important to check a tank containing recovered/recycled material for purity before installation on
your charging equipment. Even new R12 refrigerant purchased from sources other than GM should
be tested for contamination prior to use.
Sources of Contaminated R12 Refrigerant
Since refrigerant testing has not been a standard practice in the mobile A/C repair industry, the
amount of R12 refrigerant contamination is unknown. As R12 prices rise and supplies are depleted,
it is anticipated that contaminated R12 refrigerant may become more prevalent from the following
as well as other sources:
^ The use of R12 refrigerant substitutes without installation of unique service fittings and proper
identification labeling.
^ Improper use of R12 substitutes, such as topping off R12 systems with R134a or other
refrigerants available to "do-it-yourselfers".
^ Poor quality or contaminated new or reprocessed R12 refrigerant.
R12 can and should continue to be used to service vehicles built with R12 as long as it is available.
Combining any refrigerant with R12 results in a refrigerant mixture which cannot be used in an A/C
system.
R134a is the only substitute refrigerant approved by GM and should only be used when the
appropriate retrofit service bulletin procedures are explicitly followed. Use of any other substitute
refrigerant requires the purchase of additional dedicated recovery, recycling (if applicable) and
charging equipment to service each substitute refrigerant used.
However, you should know that the Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) has listed several
products as acceptable replacements for R12 mobile A/C systems under the Significant New
Alternatives Policy (SNAP). Some of these products are: R134a, R401c (a DuPont refrigerant
blend) and FRIGC (another refrigerant blend). It is important to understand that the SNAP program
only considers the health, safety and environmental characteristics of a chemical. It does not test
for A/C system cooling performance or durability. That judgment is deferred to the vehicle
manufacturer. Use of any R12 refrigerant substitute without dedicated service equipment, unique
fittings, labels and refrigerant testing prior to recovery, could result in contamination of the R12
supply and the loss of the R12 recycling program.
What To Do When Contamination is Detected
Repeat the test to verify contaminated refrigerant is present. Clear the PureGuard following the
instructions listed on the face panel, then perform a second test to verify that the vehicle A/C
system contains contaminated or mixed refrigerant.
Contact the vehicle owner to advise that previous A/C system repairs were apparently performed
with an R12 refrigerant substitute. Suggest the owner
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 531205 > May > 95 > Contaminated R12 Refrigerant - Testing & Handling > Page
6309
contact or return to the previous repair facility. Explain that environmental regulations prohibit repair
facilities from discharging ozone depleting A/C refrigerants into the atmosphere. Explain that
recovery of this unknown refrigerant could damage your service equipment.
If the customer wishes to pursue repairs through your facility, it is recommended that the proper
A/C service equipment be purchased. General Motors recommends the Kent-Moore J 41428
"Scavenger", an air operated refrigerant recovery station, be used to remove unknown refrigerants.
The air operated feature reduces the hazard of recovering potentially flammable refrigerants.
Dealers should evaluate the need to purchase the equipment based on the number of
contaminated vehicles they encounter.
As an alternative to the initial purchase of a recovery only station, dealers should check locally for
A/C specialty shops which may have the equipment to service substitute or contaminated
refrigerants. They may be able to provide contaminated refrigerant recovery service to the dealer.
The GM Service Technology Group has tested a recovery procedure where a 15 or 30 pound DOT
approved refillable tank is fully evacuated then connected to a vehicle A/C system to recover the
charge. Testing has shown that even when the recovery tank is cooled down in dry ice, the
procedure does not guarantee the entire charge will be recovered. Since EPA regulations require
full recovery of ozone depleting substances, GM does not recommend this procedure.
Contaminated Refrigerant Disposal
Although A/C refrigerant testing and disposal have not been a service practice in the mobile A/C
industry, It has been common in the stationary A/C service industry for many years. Listed at the
end of this bulletin are companies that provide refrigerant disposal service for the stationary A/C
industry. Please be advised that GM has not independently evaluated these companies and is not
in any way endorsing or promoting the use of these companies. Each of these companies has
expressed an interest in providing refrigerant disposal service to GM dealers.
In working with the stationary A/C industry, these companies typically receive large volumes of
different refrigerants that have been mixed together. Unfortunately, because the volume of material
returned by the mobile A/C industry will be in much smaller quantities, the cost of handling will be
greater.
To arrange for return of the refrigerant, simply call the company nearest you using the phone
number listed below. The company will advise you on billing and shipping procedures. Disposal
cost will vary between $3.00 and $5.00 per pound plus freight and handling. Shipping charges will
vary by distance and location. In general, a 7 to 10 day turn-around time on the tank can be
expected. The tank can be shipped via common carrier. Documents that your refrigerant has been
properly disposed of will be sent to you with the return of your tank.
As an alternative, many dealerships already have contracts in place with a disposal company who
manages their hazardous wastes. In these cases, the disposal service may agree to handle
containers of mixed refrigerants. Initially, the local disposal companies may be surprised by this
inquiry. They may want to evaluate how much material will be collected before deciding whether to
provide this service.
As we move forward with the practice of testing R12 refrigerant, it will take time for all the questions
to be answered. STG will provide additional information as soon as it is available.
Understanding The PureGuard
The PureGuard is a highly sensitive instrument capable of detecting R12 with 3% or less
cross-contamination with other refrigerants. Any refrigerant mixture in excess of this amount poses
a threat to both your refrigerant supply and recovery equipment. The PureGuard uses a pass/fail
approach when monitoring the refrigerant and is precisely calibrated to cut power to the recovery
machine if it encounters R12 mixed with any substitute refrigerants. The PureGuard ignores the
presence of the air, dyes or oils in the refrigerant sampled.
At least 20 psi must be present in the vehicle's A/C system for the PureGuard to function.
Otherwise, refrigerant cannot be introduced to the PureGuard's test chamber. If a vehicle's A/C
system contains less than 20 psi, it is an indication that the vehicle's system is nearly depleted of
refrigerant.
Occasionally, erratic PureGuard operation or service code 002 display will be encountered when
A/C system pressure is exactly 20 psi. If this occurs, simply cycle the on/off switch to reset the
PureGuard. After the 30 second PureGuard warm-up cycle, proceed immediately with vehicle
recovery operation.
Feedback from the field has indicated PureGuard service code 002 will also be displayed if the oil
drain port is not sealed. Make sure the "0" ring seal in the cap is in place and that the cap is tight.
If the PureGuard fails to clear or if you experience any other problems operating the PureGuard,
contact Kent-Moore Technical Service at 1-800-345-2233. The unit should not be returned without
first contacting Kent-Moore to obtain return authorization.
Refrigerant Disposal Locations:
United States Refrigerant Reclamation Inc. 12420 North Green River Rd. Evansville, IN 47711
800-207-5931, FAX - 812-867-1463
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 531205 > May > 95 > Contaminated R12 Refrigerant - Testing & Handling > Page
6310
Omega Refrigerant Reclamation 5263 North Fourth St. Irwindale, CA 91706 310-698-0991, FAX 310-696-1908
Refrigerant Management Svcs of Georgia 216 F. Atlanta Hwy. Cumming, GA 30130 Ph/FAX 800-347-5872
Refrigerant Reclaim Inc. 122 Old Stage Coach Rd. Dumfries, VA 22026 800-238-5902, FAX 703-441-0393
Gartech Refrigerant Reclamation Ctr. 2002 Platinum Garland, TX 75042 214-272-4070, FAX 214-272-8548
National Refrigerants, Inc. 11401 Roosevelt Blvd. Philadelphia, PA 19154 215-698-6620, FAX 215-602-8205
CFC Reclamation 1321 Swift North Kansas City, MO 64116 816-471-2511
Full Cycle-Global 550 James Street Lakewood, NJ 08701 908-370-3400, FAX - 908-370-3088
Refrigerant Reclaim Svcs, Inc. dba Full Cycle-Global 121 S. Norwood Drive Ft. Worth, TX
76053-7807 817-282-0022, FAX - 800-831-6182
Full Cycle-Global 2055 Silber, Ste. 109 Houston, TX 77055 713-681-7370, FAX - 713-681-9947
Full Cycle-Global 343 South Airline Hwy. Gonzales, LA 70737 504-644-5303, FAX - 504-644-1809
Full Cycle-Global 2966 Wireton Blue Island, IL 60406 708-388-8551, FAX - 708-388-8550
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 431215 > Nov > 94 > A/C - R134a Leak Detection With Tracer Dye
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - R134a Leak Detection With Tracer Dye
File In Section: 1 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 43-12-15
Date: November, 1994
Subject: R134a Leak Detection with Tracer Dye
Models: All 1993-95 Vehicles with OEM R134a Systems All R12 Vehicles Retrofitted to R134a
Systems
R134a refrigerant is uniquely different from R12 refrigerant and requires some changes in the
repair methods, tools and materials used in A/C service. Two important differences between R134a
and R12 which affect the technicians ability to locate refrigerant leaks are:
1. The R134a molecule is smaller than the R12 molecule and therefore will leak through smaller
openings. For the same size opening the smaller R134a molecule will leak out faster than the R12.
2. R134a refrigerant does not contain chlorine which the older R12 electronic leak detectors found
very easy to identify. Many of today's electronic leak detectors have difficulty locating small R134a
refrigerant leaks.
In order to insure the highest quality in A/C system service, the J 39400 electronic leak detector
was released as an essential tool for all GM dealers. This is the only refrigerant leak detector
approved by GM for service on R134a vehicles. If maintained properly (Reference Bulletin No.
431218) and used in accordance with Service Manual procedures, the J 39400 will provide the
most accurate and efficient method of locating R134a refrigerant leaks under most conditions.
If the technician cannot find the leak with the J 39400 and the system is known to have lost charge,
a new fluorescent leak tracer dye Kent-Moore* P/N J 41447, has been released that mixes with the
R134a PAG oil. This dye is detectable through the use of an ultraviolet (black) light and glows
yellow/green at the leak location (similar to using dye in engine leak detection). J 41447 IS THE
ONLY APPROVED DYE BY GENERAL MOTORS. Not all R134a dyes are compatible with GM's
PAG oil. Some dyes decrease the oil viscosity or chemically react with the oil. Use of alternate
products may affect system reliability and cause premature compressor failure.
Note:
THIS DYE IS NOT TO BE USED IN R-12 SYSTEMS.
Unlike mineral oil, the R134a PAG oil has special properties the technician should keep in mind.
1. PAG oil is water soluble and traces of PAG oil found at leaking joints are subject to "washing
out". Condensation on refrigerant lines or the evaporator core may wash the PAG oil and leak dye
off the line or off the core and out the condensate drain. This can make some leaks harder to find
using the dye detector. Fluorescence at the drain opening would indicate a core leak.
2. Use of the R134a tracer dye requires time. Depending upon the leak rate, it may take between
15 minutes and 7 days for the leak to become visible.
3. The dye, mixed with the PAG oil, is retained in the system and is detectable for 2+ years. Do not
double or triple charge the system with dye as this may cause reliability concerns. Use only the 1/4
oz. charge.
The dye has a refrigerant leak detection notice sticker included with the package. Complete the
sticker information and place near the charge label.
Dye Injection R-134a dye can be injected two ways:
1. With the A/C system charged, use the instructions provided with the new R134a leak dye
injection tool, J 41436.
2. With A/C system discharged, add dye into the newly replaced component assembly.
It is important to note that it is normal to find oil traces at the compressor shaft seal during
compressor operation, some oil will hydraulically seep past the shaft seal. This does not mean that
the shaft seal is defective or that the refrigerant has leaked. Refrigerant leaks at the shaft seal
should be verified with the electronic leak detector (J 39400) following the procedure detailed in the
Service Manual. If, however, the amount of oil is excessive, the shaft seal is suspect and should be
replaced. (For example, refrigerant oil has coated the clutch plate edge at gap between clutch and
pulley, or oil slinging has occurred-oil line shows on underside of hood, etc.).
Also, after working on A/C components with dye, it is important to wipe the joint and/or access
ports clean of any residual dye with GM solvent (GM
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 431215 > Nov > 94 > A/C - R134a Leak Detection With Tracer Dye > Page 6315
P/N 1050436) to prevent false diagnosis at a later point.
* We believe this source and their equipment to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such equipment. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products or equipment from these firms or for any such items which may be
available from other sources.
Parts Information GM solvent, P/N 1050436, is currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 431223 > Sep > 94 > A/C Refrigerant - Contamination
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C Refrigerant - Contamination
File In Section: 1 - HVAC Bulletin No.: 43-12-23 Date: September, 1994
Subject: Contaminated A/C Refrigerant
Models: 1994 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks with R12 Air Conditioning Systems
Government regulations limit the production of R12 refrigerant, commonly referred to as Freon,
during 1994/1995 and restrict manufacture of new R12 material effective January 1, 1996. As R12
prices rise and supplies are depleted, it is anticipated non-approved substitute refrigerants and/or
poor quality R12 material sold as new or reprocessed may become more prevalent.
The Mobile Air Conditioning Society (MACS) recently expressed concern over reports of the sale of
R12 refrigerant containing as high as 15% contamination by R22, a refrigerant commonly used in
stationary home systems but unsuitable for use in mobile units. GM dealers should be careful to
protect against contaminating their existing supplies of R12 or the A/C systems in customers'
vehicles they service by dealing with reputable suppliers. All R12 refrigerant purchased for
warranty repairs should be purchased through GM SPO to ensure GM quality standards are met.
The use of non-approved R12 refrigerant substitutes, some of which contain flammable materials,
has also been reported by MACS. These products are available to "do-it-yourselfers" who, in many
cases, believe they are harmless replacements for the small cans of R12 used so commonly in the
past. Once added to the A/C system, the vehicle can no longer be serviced using R12
recovery/recycling equipment without:
- Risking permanent damage to recovery/recycling equipment
- Contaminating the previously recovered R12 material in the recovery tank
- Spreading the contamination when the recovered material is used to charge other vehicles
or
- Possible loss of the recovered material if the contaminated level is high enough to activate the air
purge system
Contaminated refrigerant also impacts customer satisfaction through poor vehicle A/C performance
and loss of A/C system compressor/component durability. System or component failure resulting
from the use of refrigerant which does not meet GM specification is not covered by the "New
Vehicle Warranty".
Unfortunately, there is no simple method to identify if a "do-it-yourselfer" or repair shop has added
to or recharged a system with a non-approved refrigerant. The inability to protect against the
spread of contaminated refrigerant threatens the recycling program and the industry's desire to
maximize use of the remaining R12 supply.
Beginning in 1993, General Motors STG, Harrison Division, Research Labs and Kent-Moore
worked in conjunction with suppliers of various technologies to develop a tester to identify
contaminated refrigerant in vehicle A/C systems before recovery. During development of the
technology, several dealer service manager focus group studies were conducted to identify design
features to best suit dealership needs.
The discussions and surveys clearly indicated the desire for a dedicated instrument, permanently
mounted to the refrigerant recovery cart to ensure ALL vehicles are automatically tested prior to
recovering refrigerant. Testing ALL refrigerant for contamination prior to recovery is the ONLY
means to ensure customer satisfaction, protect recovery equipment and avoid unintentional venting
of refrigerant by your dealership.
General Motors has evaluated all available technology for this project and only the J 39851 R12
"Pureguard" meets General Motors' specifications. The J 39851 R12 Pureguard Refrigerant
Monitor has been classified as an essential tool and will be shipped by Kent-Moore to your
dealership beginning in September of 1994. The essential price of the R12 "Pureguard" is $561 (for
Canadian dealers the price is $800 Canadian). If your dealership has multiple R12 recovery
equipment, additional units may be ordered from Kent-Moore for $561 at 1-800-345-2233. Features
of the R12 "Pureguard" include:
- Universally mounts to R12 Recovery Equipment
- Automatically interrupts power to the Recovery Equipment when contaminated refrigerant is
identified
- Fully automatic design does not require technician action, training or interpretation
- LCD displays Pureguard functions
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 431223 > Sep > 94 > A/C Refrigerant - Contamination > Page 6320
- Meets GM contamination sensitivity requirements
- Self calibrating
- Micro-processor controlled
- Audio alarm alerts technician
Other Refrigerant Identifiers are being advertised which may be available this A/C season.
However, ONLY the Kent-Moore J 39851 R12 "Pureguard" meets General Motors' current
specifications which ensure recovered refrigerant is compatible with General Motors vehicles and
General Motors approved recovery systems.
An R134a Pureguard Refrigerant Identifier is currently under development and is anticipated to be
available in early 1995. The contamination of R134a refrigerant is not expected to be a concern
until the program to retrofit R12 vehicles to R134a becomes more widely used.
Future bulletins will be issued to address the recovery and disposal of contaminated refrigerant.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 331226 > Jan > 94 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 Vehicles to R-134A
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Retrofitting R-12 Vehicles to R-134A
Group Ref.: HVAC
Bulletin No.: 331226
Date: January, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: RETROFITTING R-12 VEHICLES TO R-134a
MODELS: 1994 AND PRIOR YEARS, PASSENGER CARS AND TRUCKS WITH R-12 A/C
SYSTEMS
There has been a great deal of information presented by the media regarding the need to retrofit
vehicles produced with R-12, to a substitute refrigerant. This bulletin will outline GM's position and
future plans on this subject.
Most important, there is currently NO requirement to retrofit any R-12 vehicle. Vehicles built with
R-12 can be serviced with R-12, as long as the refrigerant is available. At some point in time, R-12
may become either too scarce or too expensive to economically justify service on some vehicles
with R-12. By that time, GM will provide you with instructions on retrofitting those vehicles from
R-12 to R-134a.
GM vehicle divisions, platforms, and component suppliers have been actively working on the
details of retrofitting R-12 vehicles. An enormous amount of work is required to determine how
hundreds of vehicle models can be satisfactorily retrofitted. Additional information will be provided
as it becomes available.
The following items contain important technical information that should answer many of the
questions, and correct some misconceptions reported in the media.
SUBSTITUTE REFRIGERANTS
R-134a is the only approved substitute refrigerant that GM recommends and it should only be used
if a complete retrofit procedure has been performed. None of the other refrigerants currently being
marketed as replacement or drop-in substitutes for R-12 are approved for use in GM vehicles.
R-12 and R-134a are not interchangeable. R-134a cannot be added to fill a low R-12 system. The
combination of the two materials can cause high system pressures, which could cause damage to
the system.
Retrofitting an R-12 vehicle to R-134a requires careful preparation to insure that neither the vehicle
nor the A/C service equipment has become contaminated.
RESIDUAL MINERAL OIL
The concern that mineral oil is chemically incompatible with R-134a and/or PAG lubricant has been
proven to be untrue. A normal charge of mineral oil left in the A/C system after a retrofit to R-134a
will not damage the system. Mineral oil, however, does not mix well with R-134a, and will not
provide adequate lubrication. Tests on both the orifice tube and TXV systems show that the mineral
oil parks in places such as the accumulator, and does not appreciably affect performance or
damage the system. The retrofit service bulletin will specify the correct oil to be used. It is important
that this oil recommendation be followed carefully.
RESIDUAL R-12
Residual R-12 left in a system, due to improper retrofit service procedures, may result in system
damage unless the residual R-12 is kept below the 2 percent limit specified by the Society of
Automotive Engineers' Specification J-1661. New service methods are being developed to
minimize the level of R-12 remaining in the A/C system after the retrofit procedure is completed.
Following these new procedures will be critical to insure that the above limits are met.
SYSTEM FLUSHING
R-11, a material commonly used as an A/C system flushing solvent, has been found to be
chemically incompatible with PAG lubricant. Technicians should be aware that residual R-11
remaining in an R-12 system will be very damaging if the vehicle is retrofitted to R-134a later in its
life. For many years GM has recommended the use of in-line filters as an alternative to system
flushing.
SYSTEM FLUSHING, USING EITHER R-11 OR ANY OTHER FLUSHING MATERIAL, IS NOT
APPROVED BY GM FOR ANY A/C SYSTEM.
DESICCANT PROTECTION
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 331226 > Jan > 94 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 Vehicles to R-134A > Page 6325
It has been reported that the desiccant (moisture absorption material) used in 1992 and older R-12
A/C systems is incompatible with R-134a and PAG oil. The older desiccant was designed
specifically for R-12 systems, but testing has shown that it is NOT necessary to replace the older
desiccant just because the vehicle is being retrofitted to R-134a. 1993 and newer GM vehicles use
desiccant designed to be compatible with both R-12 and R-134a systems.
The amount of desiccant used in most GM vehicles is designed to last for at least seven years. To
help maintain adequate protection for vehicles that must be retrofitted, it is recommended that the
accumulator/dryer, which contains the desiccant, be replaced if the vehicle is more than five years
old.
"O" RINGS
While continuing to service with R-12, be sure to use "O" rings and seal materials which are
compatible with R-134a and PAG oil. This practice will eliminate concern in case the vehicle
requires retrofitting later in its life. All "O" rings and seal materials available from GMSPO are
compatible with R-134a systems.
RETROFITTED SYSTEM PERFORMANCE
Currently, it appears that for most GM vehicles, the retrofit procedure will require minimal changes
to the existing system. Some vehicles may need additional parts and/or procedures to provide
acceptable performance and/or durability. Our testing has shown that vehicles that have undergone
recommended retrofit procedures will, in most climatic conditions, be minimally affected in terms of
A/C performance.
SERVICE POLICY
Basic service policy is as follows:
During Warranty - If an R-12 produced vehicle A/C system must be repaired or recharged under
warranty, repairs will be completed using R-12. If R-12 is unavailable or unaffordable, GM will notify
the dealer body and will pay for the warranty repair and the retrofit to R-134a.
NOTE:
It a customer requests that an in-warranty vehicle be converted to R-134a, and the R-12 system is
functioning properly, the customer will be expected to pay for the retrofit.
Out of Warranty - The cost of the conversion will be the responsibility of the customer.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 331228 > Dec > 93 > A/C - Refrigerant Production Change R12 to R134a
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Production Change R12 to R134a
Group Ref.: HVAC Bulletin No.: 331228 Date: December, 1993
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: REFRIGERANT CHANGE IN PRODUCTION VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIR
CONDITIONING (RPO C60)
MODELS: 1994 CHEVROLET CAVALIER 1994 PONTIAC SUNBIRD
Vehicles produced on and after January 3, 1994 equipped with air conditioning (RPO C60) will be
charged with R134a. This includes vehicles produced at both the Lordstown and Ramos assembly
plants. To identify this change, the vehicles charged with R134a will have the RPO code KR1 in
addition to RPO code C60. Also, an underhood sticker will indicate the use of R134a and proper
charge amount.
With the exception of the special tools needed to service R134a, service diagnostics and
procedures are generally the same as vehicles previously produced with R12. This information can
be located in Section 1B of the appropriate service manual.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > 922501A > Aug > 92 > A/C - Use of Alternate Refrigerants In CFC 12
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Use of Alternate Refrigerants In CFC 12
Number: 92-250-1A
Section: 0A
Date: AUGUST 1992
Corporate Bulletin No.: 231205
ASE No.: A7
Subject: USE OF ALTERNATE REFRIGERANTS IN CFC 12 REFRIGERANT MOBILE AIR
CONDITIONERS
Model and Year: GALL MODEL YEARS - ALL PASSENGER CARS AND TRUCKS INCLUDING
GEO
A number of inquiries have been received concerning the use of "alternate refrigerants" as a
replacement for R-12 refrigerant in General Motors air conditioning systems.
Regardless of any advertised claims, there are currently no substitutes for refrigerant R-12
approved by General Motors. At the present time, only new or recycled R-12 is approved for use in
General Motors R-12 air conditioning systems.
Based on studies performed to date, the use of "alternate refrigerants" in General Motors R-12 air
conditioning systems may result in higher system pressures, higher leak rates or incompatibility
with drying and sealing materials. System performance and reliability may also be affected.
Service equipment manufacturers have indicated that cross-contaminating R-12 recovery/recycling
equipment with "alternate refrigerants" may damage the equipment. General Motors supports the
Society of Automotive Engineers recommended service procedures for recovery and recycling of
R-12. The use of known "alternate refrigerants" without proper service practices for identifying
vehicle systems containing these "alternate refrigerants" and dedicated recovery equipment to
service those vehicles will contaminate the recycled supply of R-12 refrigerant. Contamination of
the recycled R-12 refrigerant makes the refrigerant unusable for recharging air conditioning
systems and could jeopardize the recycling program.
At the present time, General Motors has not approved any "alternate refrigerant" for R-12 in R-12
air conditioning systems. Therefore, R-12 systems should continue to be serviced with new or
recycled R-12 only.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > Page 6334
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Contaminated R134A Refrigerant
Bulletin No.: 06-01-39-007
Date: July 25, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Contaminated R134a Refrigerant Found on Market for Automotive Air-Conditioning
Systems
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2007 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2007 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Attention:
This bulletin should be directed to the Service Manager as well as the Parts Manager.
Commercially Available Contaminated R134a Refrigerant
Impurities have been found in new commercially available containers of R134a. High levels of
contaminates may cause decreased performance, and be detrimental to some air-conditioning
components. Accompanying these contaminates has been high levels of moisture.
Tip:
Excessive moisture may cause system concerns such as orifice tube freeze-up and reduced
performance.
Industry Reaction: New Industry Purity Standards
Due to the potential availability of these lower quality refrigerants, the Society of Automotive
Engineers (SAE), and the Air Conditioning and Refrigeration Industry (ARI) are in the process of
instituting reliable standards that will be carried on the labels of future R134a refrigerant containers.
This identifying symbol will be your assurance of a product that conforms to the minimum standard
for OEM Automotive Air-Conditioning use.
How Can You Protect Yourself Today?
It is recommended to use GM or ACDelco(R) sourced refrigerants for all A/C repair work. These
refrigerants meet General Motors own internal standards for quality and purity, insuring that your
completed repairs are as good as the way it left the factory.
Parts Information
The part numbers shown are available through GMSPO or ACDelco(R). The nearest ACDelco(R)
distributor in your area can be found by calling 1-800-223-3526 (U.S. Only).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins: > Page 6335
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 08-01-38-001 > Jan > 08 > A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling/Equipment
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling/Equipment
Bulletin No.: 08-01-38-001
Date: January 25, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Information On New GE-48800 CoolTech Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2008 and
Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
Attention:
This bulletin is being issued to announce the release of GM approved Air Conditioning (A/C)
Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging Equipment that meets the new Society of Automotive
Engineers (SAE) J2788 Refrigerant Recovery Standards. The ACR2000 (J-43600) cannot be
manufactured in its current state after December 2007 and will be superseded by GE-48800.
The new J2788 standard does not require that GM Dealers replace their ACR2000 units.
ACR2000's currently in use are very capable of servicing today's refrigerant systems when used
correctly and can continue to be used. Details regarding the new SAE J2788 standard are outlined
in GM Bulletin 07-01-38-004.
Effective February 1 2008, new A/C Refrigerant Recovery/Recharging equipment (P/N GE-48800)
will be released as a required replacement for the previously essential ACR2000 (J-43600). This
equipment is SAE J2788 compliant and meets GM requirements for A/C Refrigerant System
Repairs on all General Motors vehicles, including Hybrid systems with Polyolester (POE)
refrigerant oil. This equipment will not be shipped as an essential tool to GM Dealerships.
In addition, this equipment is Hybrid compliant and designed to prevent oil cross contamination
when servicing Hybrid vehicles with Electric A/C Compressors that use POE refrigerant oil.
The ACR2000 (J-43600) will need to be retrofitted with a J-43600-50 (Hose - ACR2000 Oil Flush
Loop) to be able to perform Hybrid A/C service work. All Hybrid dealers will receive the J-43600-50,
with installation instructions, as a component of the Hybrid essential tool package. Dealerships that
do not sell Hybrids, but may need to service Hybrids, can obtain J-43600-50 from SPX Kent Moore.
Refer to GM Bulletin 08-01-39-001 for the ACR2000 Hose Flush procedure.
The High Voltage (HV) electric A/C compressor used on Two Mode Hybrid vehicles uses a
Polyolester (POE) refrigerant oil instead of a Polyalkylene Glycol (PAG) synthetic refrigerant oil.
This is due to the better electrical resistance of the POE oil and its ability to provide HV isolation.
Failure to flush the hoses before adding refrigerant to a Hybrid vehicle with an electric A/C
compressor may result in an unacceptable amount of PAG oil entering the refrigerant system. It
may cause a Battery Energy Control Module Hybrid Battery Voltage System Isolation Lost
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC P1AE7) to be set. Additionally, the A/C system warranty will be
voided.
Warranty Submission Requirements
The Electronically Generated Repair Data (snapshot summary) and printer functions have been
eliminated from the GE-48800. The VGA display and temperature probes were eliminated to
reduce equipment costs. As a result, effective immediately the 18 digit "Snapshot/Charge
Summary" code is no longer required for Air Conditioning (A/C) refrigerant system repairs that are
submitted for warranty reimbursement. The charge summary data from before and after system
repairs will continue to required, but documented on the repair order only. Both high and low
pressures and the recovery and charge amounts should be noted during the repair and entered on
the repair order. If using ACR2000 (J-43600), the "Snapshot/Charge Summary" printouts should
continue to be attached to the shops copy of the repair order.
The labor codes that are affected by this requirement are D3000 through D4500.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 06-01-39-007 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Contaminated R134A Refrigerant
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Contaminated R134A Refrigerant
Bulletin No.: 06-01-39-007
Date: July 25, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Contaminated R134a Refrigerant Found on Market for Automotive Air-Conditioning
Systems
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2007 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2007 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Attention:
This bulletin should be directed to the Service Manager as well as the Parts Manager.
Commercially Available Contaminated R134a Refrigerant
Impurities have been found in new commercially available containers of R134a. High levels of
contaminates may cause decreased performance, and be detrimental to some air-conditioning
components. Accompanying these contaminates has been high levels of moisture.
Tip:
Excessive moisture may cause system concerns such as orifice tube freeze-up and reduced
performance.
Industry Reaction: New Industry Purity Standards
Due to the potential availability of these lower quality refrigerants, the Society of Automotive
Engineers (SAE), and the Air Conditioning and Refrigeration Industry (ARI) are in the process of
instituting reliable standards that will be carried on the labels of future R134a refrigerant containers.
This identifying symbol will be your assurance of a product that conforms to the minimum standard
for OEM Automotive Air-Conditioning use.
How Can You Protect Yourself Today?
It is recommended to use GM or ACDelco(R) sourced refrigerants for all A/C repair work. These
refrigerants meet General Motors own internal standards for quality and purity, insuring that your
completed repairs are as good as the way it left the factory.
Parts Information
The part numbers shown are available through GMSPO or ACDelco(R). The nearest ACDelco(R)
distributor in your area can be found by calling 1-800-223-3526 (U.S. Only).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 06-01-39-007 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Contaminated R134A Refrigerant > Page 6349
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 99-01-38-006A > May > 00 > A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
File In Section: 01 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 99-01-38-006A
Date: May, 2000
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
Subject: J-43600 ACR 2000 Essential Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
Models: 1993-2000 Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks with R-134a Refrigerant
This bulletin is being revised to change the effective date and to update the text. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 99-01-38-006 (Section 01 - HVAC).
Effective June 1, 2000, the use of J-43600 ACR 2000 will be required on all repairs that require A/C
system recovery and are reimbursable by GM. Additionally, GM highly recommends that J-43600
ACR 2000 be used on all GM cars and trucks for customer paid A/C repairs.
Important:
Also effective June 1, 2000, the "Add" time for all air conditioning recovery is revised to 0.5 hours
for front systems and 0.7 hours for front/rear dual systems (RPO C69 or C34). After June 1, 2000,
all air conditioning claims submitted with the 0.9 hours "Add" time will be rejected for "labor hours
excessive".
After the completion of repairs (charging), the ACR 2000 will prompt the user to perform a snapshot
of the air conditioning system operating data. The snapshot includes:
^ Maximum high side pressure.
^ Minimum low side pressure.
^ Duct outlet temperatures (2).
^ Refrigerant purity information.
This information is captured on a paper printout and in a warranty code.
For all GM paid repairs, the paper printout should be attached to the shop copy of the repair order.
The warranty code must be submitted in the warranty claim information in the comments field. The
code enables the reporting of valuable information about the repair to GM for product quality
improvement. Claims submitted without this information may be subject to review and subsequent
debit.
The required use of J-43600 ACR 2000 raises the question of the acceptable uses for any existing
recovery/recycle equipment that GM dealers are currently using. GM recognizes that many of the
previously essential ACR4's are reaching the end of their useful life. There are several alternatives
for existing equipment that may be considered:
^ Use the existing equipment as customer paid recovery only equipment. Example: Collision repair
area.
^ Use the existing equipment as a scavenger unit for contaminated A/C systems.
^ Sell the existing units to repair facilities outside the GM dealer network.
^ Discontinue the use of the existing units if the repair/maintenance costs exceed the value of the
equipment.
^ Donate the existing equipment to local technical schools.
^ Dedicate the ACR4 to A/C system flushing, using the J-42939 Flush Adapter.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 99-01-38-006A > May > 00 > A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment > Page 6354
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a
Technical Service Bulletin # 431207E Date: 970101
A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a
File In Section: 1 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 43-12-07E
Date: January, 1997
INFORMATION
Subject: Guidelines for Retrofitting R-12 Vehicles to R-134a
Models: 1984-94 Passenger Cars and Trucks (See List Below)
This bulletin is being revised with the following changes:
1. Addition of all remaining GM vehicles, as listed.
2. Format rearranged for easier use.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 43-12-07D (Section 1 - HVAC).
Car/Truck Platform Coverage Starts:
1984 - A, B, D, E, F, J, K, P, Y Carlines
1985 - C, M, N, R, S Carlines
1986 - H Carline
1987 - L, V (Allante) Car lines; M/L, G, R/V, S/T, P Truck lines
1988 - T (LeMans), E (Reatta), W Car lines; C/k, MED. Duty Truck lines
1989 - Tracker
1990 - U Van
Vehicles Not Covered: T (Chevette and T1000), G RWD, C RWD, and X Car
If a vehicle is not covered in the list above, GM's recommendation is that the vehicle continue to be
serviced with R-12.
This bulletin outlines the detailed retrofit procedures, as well as providing background information
on many components and procedures. It is important to follow the bulletin, since each car and truck
line has unique parts and procedures. However, the basic procedure is simple, and will become
easier as you complete more retrofits.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6359
Retrofit Requirements
The customer should be reminded that there is NO requirement in the U.S. to retrofit any vehicle
produced with R-12. Vehicles built with R-12 can be serviced with R-12 as long as it is available
(except in certain Canadian Provinces). GM has taken steps to extend the supply of R-12 and
recommends that all R-12 vehicles continue to be serviced with R-12 as long as it is available.
Training Video
Before doing a retrofit the first time, it is recommended that you view the Certified Plus Training
Video, Program number 51010.15, "R-134a Retrofit for GM Cars and Trucks".
Table of Contents
A. Retrofit Procedure
1. Inspect Condition of Vehicle
2. Recover the R-12 (new method)
3. Install the service port conversion fittings
4. Install any additional parts needed
5. Evacuate and recharge with new PAG or V5 retrofit oil and R-134a
6. Install the retrofit label
Platform Details
Compressor Replacement Chart
B. General Information
1. Performance
2. Leakage
3. Desiccant
4. Improved Cooling Performance
5. PAG or V5 Oil Compatibility
6. Refrigerant Oil Level
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6360
C. Parts Information
D. Warranty Information
1. Vehicle Still in Warranty
2. Customer Paid' Retrofitting Costs
3. Labor Time Information
Notes on Retrofit
Important:
Before proceeding with any retrofit, make sure you have all component Parts required on hand to
perform a proper and complete repair with Minimal downtime.
R-12 Removal Prior to Retrofit
To prepare a system for retrofitting, the R-12 must be recovered and the system must be
completely evacuated. Evacuation is necessary to insure that small amounts of R-12 and air
remaining in the system are removed. This will prevent cross contamination of the two refrigerants,
which could lead to reduced A/C system reliability and performance.
It is very important that the specified times for waiting after recovery and evacuation not be
reduced. This time is required to sufficiently remove residual R-12 from the oil in the system.
A considerable amount of testing has determined that the following procedure is required to
achieve satisfactory results and conform to SAE J 1661:
1. Inspect Condition of Vehicle
Install the gauge set on the high and low side ports.
Use normal diagnostic procedures to find the cause of the vehicle's reported condition. One of
three conditions will exist with the refrigerant system:
a. System pressure correct, no leaks - proceed to Step 2 (Recovery). This would normally apply
when:
1. The system must be recovered/recharged for a repair to a system other than the A/C system, or
2. Where the A/C system condition did not involve leaks, but requires recovery/recharge to replace
a component.
b. Compressor not operating, but some charge. Leak test to find the leak, complete Step 2
(Recovery), then correct the leak before proceeding with Step 3 (Conversion port installation).
c. No charge in system - proceed with the Conversion port installation in Step 3. Use the ACR4 to
evacuate for 5 minutes. If the leak can be heard, repair the leak. If the leak cannot be heard,
charge with 1/2 pound of R-134a. Leak test with the J 39400 Leak Detector, recover the R-134a,
repair any additional leaks found, and proceed with the evacuation in Step 5.
2. Recover the R-12 from the System
Notice:
THIS PROCEDURE IS DIFFERENT THAN THE NORMAL (NON-RETROFIT) RECOVERY
PROCEDURE. R-12 will be recovered through the HIGH SIDE SERVICE PORT ONLY, WITH THE
ENGINE RUNNING. Recovery through the low side will not effectively remove the R-12 from the
accumulator, resulting in possible damage to the retrofitted system.
Important:
Vehicle must be above 50° F (10° C) to allow for complete recovery of the R-12. If it is not, either
allow it to warm up in the shop overnight, or increase the evacuation time in Step 5.a to 30 minutes.
a. Connect the recovery hose from the R-12 recovery cart (ACR3) to the middle port of the A/C
gauge set. Open the oil drain valve on the ACR3 cart long enough to drain the oil. Failure to do so
could cause excessive amounts of oil to build up in the separator, resulting in damage to the
recovery cart compressor.
b. Start the engine. Leave the hood up, and the windows open. On vehicles with manual A/C
controls, set the A/C controls to normal A/C mode, high blower, and temperature control to full cold.
On cars with automatic A/C controls, set the temperature to 75° F, "AUTO" mode, and manually
select high blower.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6361
Make sure the vehicle compressor is engaged. Turn the cart on and start the recovery cycle. OPEN
ONLY THE HIGH SIDE VALVE ON THE GAUGE SET. The vehicle system should eventually shut
the compressor off. If the low side pressure drops below 15 psi, and the compressor does not turn
off, turn it off now (go to "VENT" or "ECON" mode), but leave the engine running and the blower on
"high".
c. After the recovery cart shuts off the first time, wait 5 minutes. If the pressure on either the high or
the low side rises above 0 psi, restart the recovery process. After the second shutoff, wait 2
minutes. If the pressure again rises above 0 psi, restart, and after shutoff, again wait 2 minutes.
The process can be stopped when the pressure does not rise above 0 psi after 2 minutes. The
engine can be shut off at this time.
d. Remove the R-12 reclaim hose and the gauge set from the vehicle.
Any repairs needed should be done at this time. If any components other than the compressor are
replaced, they should be installed dry, and no extra oil should be added.
3. Install the Service Port Conversion Fittings
Important:
For GEO vehicles, skip to Step 4. Fitting installation is covered in that step. For vehicles that
require a HPCOS, see Step 4. Some of these vehicles use a specific combination fitting to mount
the HPCOS, which includes the high side service port fitting and the HPCOS port. The low side
fitting is installed as detailed below. See "Platform Details" for further information.
Important:
A new tool kit, P/N J 39500-250, has been released. This kit contains the following items:
^ J 39500-71 Oil Injection Bottle Conversion Kit (includes 3 12 oz bottles, an extender tube, caps,
and fittings)
^ J 39500-275 Tool kit, including the following: (See Figure 2)
- J 34611-A Double ended valve core remover
- J 25498-A High side adapter fitting
- J 38702 Deep valve core adapter fitting
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6362
- J 41265 Thread cleaning wire brush
- J 41266 Low side port thread restorer
- J 41267 High side port thread restorer
- J 39037 High side octagon socket
- J 41256 Low side octagon socket
New low profile, quick connect couplers, J 39500-20A (High side), and J 39500-24A (Low side),
have been released as essential tools, to attach to the ACR4 (see Figure 3). These are much
smaller couplers than the existing ones, and will allow attachment to the port fittings in much tighter
quarters.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6363
Select and install the proper R-134a fittings (shown in Figure 4) from the chart below, based on
how the ACR4 couplers will attach. Also, remember to check for proper hood clearance with the
conversion fittings. Try the straight fittings first. The two-piece high side fitting is used when the
existing fitting is screwed into the pipe fitting (some 1992, and nearly all 1993 models, use these
fittings). Use the 90° elbow if the straight fitting does not allow the ACR4 couplers to connect.
Fitting Type High Side Low Side
Straight 52467941 52467943
Straight Two-piece 52467324 N/A
90° Elbow 52469054 52469055
The fittings should be installed as follows:
a. Remove the caps from the R-12 fittings. Remove any dirt or grease from the port threads using
the thread cleaning wire brush, J 41265. Inspect the fittings for thread damage. If any damage is
found, use the port thread restorer (J 41266 low side, J 41267 high side) to repair the thread.
For the two-piece fitting, remove the existing R-12 fitting and discard it. Use tool J 38704A
(previously released, not part of the above kit) to remove the fitting. Make sure to hold the line
securely to prevent damage when removing the existing fitting. If the fitting cannot be removed
easily, use the saddle clamp valve listed below and seal the R-12 port and cap permanently.
b. Install the selected fitting onto the existing R-12 fitting. Leave the valve core in the straight
fittings, and remove the valve core when using the 90° fittings.
If the valve cores need to be removed at a later time, they can be removed with the straight
conversion fittings in place. On the low side straight fitting, use the J 34611-A tool to remove the
core pin in the conversion fitting, then remove the core valve from the original R-12 fitting. Always
recover the charge before valve core removal.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6364
Use the octagon sockets on the straight fittings (J 39037 high side, and J 41256 low side). Torque
the new fitting until it seats. The fitting should seat fully BEFORE reaching 11 N.m (8 lb ft). If 11
N.m (8 lb ft) of torque is reached and the fitting has not seated, it is probable that the threads have
been damaged. In this case, remove the fitting and use the thread restorer listed above. Reinstall
the fitting, adding one drop of a thread locking compound such as Loctite(R) 242.
The fittings (except the two-piece) have a thread locking compound applied to the threads. This
compound will set up enough to restrict removal of the fitting in about 15 minutes. The fittings can
now be used to evacuate the system (see Step 5).
An additional type of conversion port fitting has been developed. This fitting is called a saddle
clamp valve (see Figure 5). It can be clamped directly on a metal refrigerant line, and will be used if
the existing fitting is damaged or is inaccessible. A drop of a thread locking compound, such as
Loctite(R) 242, should be used on each bolt to prevent the threads from loosening.
The R134a saddle clamp valve part numbers are:
If an existing R-12 service port is not used, it must be rendered inoperative. Place several drops of
a thread locking compound, such as Loctite(R) 243, in the valve core, and onto the cap threads.
Secure the cap and let it set for 15 minutes.
4. Install Any Additional Parts Needed
See "Platform Details" after Step 6. If a vehicle is listed as a "Basic Retrofit", no additional parts are
required (except for compressors, see the Compressor Replacement Chart at the beginning of
Platform Details). If no parts are required, PROCEED TO STEP 5.
Compressors
Compressors do not need to be replaced as part of a normal retrofit, unless indicated in the
Compressor Replacement Chart. An R-12 compressor that is operating properly can, in most
cases, be left in the vehicle when it is retrofitted to R134a. However, if a compressor failure is the
reason the vehicle is in for service, and the vehicle will be retrofitted, OR if a vehicle has already
been retrofitted with R-134a and the compressor fails at some time in the future, new compressors
for use with R-134a are available. See the GMSPO Parts Catalog for specific part numbers. DO
NOT use a replacement R-12 compressor for any vehicle retrofitted to R-134a (unless it is the new
"oil-less" design). See "Compressor Availability" at the end of the Compressor Replacement Chart.
Accumulator /Dryer
If the vehicle is more than 5 years old, the Accumulator/Dryer (A/D) should be replaced to ensure
that moisture is removed from the system. See the instructions for proper A/D identification in
General Information.
High Pressure Cut-Off Switch (HPCOS)
Most trucks, and some 1984-93 B and D cars, require that a HPCOS be added to protect the
refrigerant system during long idles at high temperature. The HPCOS kit (P/N 15981985) contains
the switch, wire harness, heat sealing splice connectors, switch "0" ring, and installation
instructions. A saddle clamp adapter (P/N 15985307), or a special dual fitting, is mounted to the
high pressure line, and provides the port to mount the switch. A drop of a
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6365
thread locking compound, such as Loctite(R) 242, should be used on each bolt of the saddle clamp
to prevent the threads from loosening.
Some vehicles produced during the second half of the 1993 model year will already have a factory
installed HPCOS. Check the back of the compressor for this switch. If present, the above switch
will not have to be added.
5. Evacuate the System, and Recharge with PAG or V5 Retrofit Oil and R-134a
Newly designed low profile quick connect couplers for the ACR4, J 39500-20A and J 39500-24A,
have been released. These should be installed before proceeding with the evacuation. See Step 3,
and Figure 3.
a. Connect the R-134a cart (ACR4) to the system. Open the coupler valves on the hoses so that
the pressures can be read on the gauges. On the cart, open the HIGH SIDE VALVE ONLY. DO
NOT OPEN THE LOW SIDE VALVE! Program the cart for a 15 minute evacuation.
Important:
If the vehicle has been at outside temperatures of less than 50° F (10° C), or at high altitudes
(above 3000 ft), use a 30 minute evacuation to insure complete removal of the R-12.
If the vacuum pump will not start and a "H-P" reading is indicated on the ACR4 display, loosen the
fitting at the high side line connection to the ACR4 to relieve pressure in the line. Tighten the fitting
after pressure has been relieved. DO NOT USE THE RECOVERY MODE TO RELIEVE LINE
PRESSURE.
b. Start the evacuation. For a proper evacuation, the cart must pull down to 28-29 in. Hg. at sea
level (reduce by 1 in. for each 1000 ft above sea level). Check the low side gauge for proper
vacuum level, to make sure the new fittings are operating properly.
While the evacuation is being done, the Retrofit label can be filled out and installed (see Step 6).
Important:
If the compressor was replaced at the same time as this retrofit, and the new compressor was
shipped with the correct amount of PAG oil already in it, DO NOT add any additional oil to the
system! Go to Step D. If an "oil-less" compressor was installed, add oil in Step C.
A new retrofit oil for use with V5 compressor vehicles has been released. This oil will be used
ONLY for retrofitted vehicles in which the original V5 compressor is retained. IT WILL NOT BE
USED IF A COMPRESSOR IS REPLACED AT THE TIME OF THE RETROFIT. Failure to use this
oil may significantly shorten the useful life of the compressor.
Important:
If the V5 Retrofit oil is not available from GMSPO, the compressor MUST BE REPLACED!
To summarize the correct retrofit oil usage:
^ Compressor replaced during retrofit
- NO OIL ADDED if new compressor shipped with oil
- 8 oz. of PAG oil (9 oz of PAG oil with V5 compressor) added if compressor shipped without oil
("oil-less" design)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6366
^ PAG oil used for future service if needed (mark PAG on box on label, Figure 6).
^ HR6 or R4 original compressor RETAINED - add 8 oz FAG oil to system
^ V5 original compressor RETAINED - add 9 oz V5 Retrofit oil to system. If V5 Retrofit oil is not
available from GMSPO, REPLACE THE COMPRESSOR.
c. Based on the above chart, add oil if needed. Use the new oil bottle and the extended tube kit, J
39500-71. Fill the bottle with at least 10 oz of oil. Attach the new bottle to the back of the ACR4,
and open the oil fill valve. Allow the correct amount of oil to be drawn into the system. DO NOT
allow the oil level to drop below the end of the pickup tube. This will prevent any air from being
drawn into the system. If any oil was removed during the R-12 recovery evacuation steps, DO NOT
add additional oil to replace it.
d. Determine the correct amount of R-134a to use. Check the existing label of the vehicle for the
R-12 charge amount.
Use the formula {(R12 x .9) - .25 lb = R-134a} to determine the correct charge. This can also be
stated as: Take 90% of the R12 charge, and subtract 1/4 lb.
Follow the directions for the ACR4 cart to recharge the system. At the end of the process, "CPL"
will be displayed. Close the high side valve.
e. Start the vehicle, turn on the A/C system, and confirm that pressures are within normal operating
ranges, as shown in the 1994 Service Manual. The 1994 Service Manuals can be used as a
reference for diagnosis and specification of retrofitted systems.
On some vehicles with automatic A/C controls or low charge diagnostics, the A/C compressor may
not engage if any diagnostic codes were set during the retrofit. Check to see if any codes were set
in either the HVAC or Engine Control systems. If they were, clear the codes following the directions
in the Service Manual.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6367
f. TO INSURE AN ACCURATE CHARGE AMOUNT, IT IS IMPORTANT TO CLEAR THE ACR4 OF
ANY REMAINING REFRIGERANT. Close the high side coupler valve and remove the high side
hose from the vehicle. Then, open both the high and low side valves on the ACR4. After the
pressures on both gages are at low side pressure, close the low side coupler valve. See Step G
below, then remove the low side hose from the vehicle. Shut off the engine. Install the service port
caps on the new fittings. These serve as a seal and can prevent system leaks.
g. In the unlikely event that the low side fitting leaks when the coupler is removed, use the following
procedure:
1. Immediately reinstall the coupler on the fitting.
2. Find the valve core remover J 34611-A.
3. Remove the coupler.
4. Use the double-ended valve core remover to turn the valve core pin counter-clockwise until the
leak stops.
5. Install the cap.
If the leak was substantial or continued for an extended period of time, it is highly recommended to
evacuate and recharge the system to insure proper performance. If there is any question, the
system can be rechecked by repeating Step F.
h. Leak test any new port fittings, adapters, or valves that were installed, and any joints that were
opened or repaired during the retrofit process, using tool J 39400.
6. Install the Retrofit Label
The retrofit label (P/N 21030857, roll of 250) has been developed following SAF specifications to
insure a smooth transition from R-12 to R-134a, and to insure a professional approach to the
retrofit and a quality repair. Following the instructions in this bulletin will insure that the retrofit
meets the SAE standards.
Fill in the new label using a typewriter or a ball-point pen (see Figure 6). Select a location for the
label that will be easily visible. Some suggested areas are the radiator support panel, an area near
the existing R-12 charge label, or a flat surface near the high or low side service ports. The area
selected should be a clean, underhood, painted sheet metal surface, and should be degreased and
wiped down with a non-petroleum based cleaner. Do not install the label on a rubber surface. Apply
the label, then apply the clear overlay to the label.
Do not remove, cover, or render unreadable the existing R-12 charge label. DO cover the R-12
refrigerant charge amount on the existing label with an indelible, preferably black, marker.
Platform Details
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6368
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6369
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6370
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6371
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6372
FOR ALL VEHICLES EXCEPT GEO, see the "Compressor Replacement Chart" at the end of this
section. Compressor replacement requirements ARE NOT LISTED in the platform details (except
for application details), except as noted below for Y car and P and Medium Duty truck.
Compressor Replacement Chart
Important:
It is important to check the date code on the compressor. Any vehicle may have had a compressor
replaced either during or after the warranty period. The date code will determine whether or not the
compressor must be replaced.
Compressor Availability
A new compressor for use with R-134a systems will be shipped with the correct amount of PAG oil
installed (see "IMPORTANT" below). Do not add any additional oil in Step 5 of the retrofit
procedure if a compressor is to be replaced with a new R-134a compressor at the same time the
initial retrofit is
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6373
being done.
Important:
During 1996, "oil-less" compressors began to be serviced with NO added oil. New part numbers
will be issued, and both the box and the compressor will be clearly marked to indicate that no oil is
present. If you receive one of these newer compressors, simply add the normal amount of oil to the
system in Step 5 of the retrofit procedure (8 oz of PAG oil, or 9 oz of PAG oil with V5 compressor).
These "oil-less" compressors are compatible with EITHER R12 or R-134a.
Geo Models
Compressors DO NOT HAVE TO BE REPLACED as part of the retrofit. New compressors are
shipped with enough oil to accommodate the entire A/C system. Do not add additional PAG oil to
the system it the compressor is being replaced.
1985-88 Nova, 1989-93 Prizm (S)
1. Using the Service Manual, remove the following components in the order given:
a. Receiver/dryer.
b. Loosen evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe (to be reinstalled)
c. 1985-92 only: Loosen compressor to condenser (compressor discharge) pipe (to be reinstalled).
d. 1985-88 only: Service Valve & Extension Housing on compressor (to be installed).
e. Compressor (only if being replaced).
2. Using the Service Manual, install the following components in the order given. Be sure to use
new 0-rings whenever a refrigerant connection has been disconnected.
a. Compressor (if being replaced).
b. High and low side adapter fittings (see Step 3 of the retrofit procedure for detailed installation
instructions).
c. 1985-88 only: Service Valve & Extension Housing on compressor using new 0-rings. Six small
0-rings and one large 0-ring are required.
d. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe 0-ring.
e. 1985-92 Compressor to condenser (discharge) hose 0-ring.
f. Receiver/dryer and 0-rings.
R-134a amount: 85-92 - 650 grams (1.43 lb)
93 - 700 grams (1.54 lb) PAG oil amount: 100 cc (3.0 oz) Parts Required:
Receiver/dryer:
85-88 - 94855761
89-93 - 94855762
Adapter Fittings:
Low Side - 94855760
High Side - 94855759
0-Rings:
85-88 Compressor - Small 0-rings (6 required) - 94857336 - Large 0-ring - 94857337
85-93 Receiver/Dryer (2) - 94845949
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6374
85-93 Suction hose - 94855765
85-92 Discharge hose - 94845943
1985-88 Sprint, 1989-93 Metro (M)
1. Using the Service Manual, remove the following components in the order given:
a. Receiver/dryer.
b. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe.
c. Compressor to condenser (compressor discharge) pipe.
d. Joint service connector on compressor (to be reinstalled).
e. Compressor (only if being replaced).
2. Using the Service Manual, install the following components in the the order given. Be sure to use
new 0-rings whenever a refrigerant connection has been disconnected.
a. Compressor (if being replaced).
b. High and low side adapter fittings (see Step 3 of the retrofit procedure for detailed installation
instructions).
c. Joint service connector to compressor. Use new 0-rings. Six small 0-rings and one large 0-ring
are required.
d. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe, and new 0-ring.
e. Compressor to condenser (discharge) hose and new 0-ring.
f. Receiver/dryer and 0-ring.
R-134a amount: 500 grams (1.10 lb)
PAG oil amount: 100 cc (3.0 oz)
Parts Required:
Receiver/dryer:
85-86 - 91172081
87-88 - 91172079
89-93 - 96068480
Adapter Fittings:
Low Side - 91172092
85-88 - High Side - 91172094
89-93 - High Side - 52467941
0-Rings:
Compressor - Small 0-rings (6 required)
- 91172095
- Large 0-ring - 96068915
Receiver/Dryer (2) - 96068488
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6375
89-93 - Suction hose - 96068490
89-93 - Discharge hose - 96068489
Suction hose:
85-86 - 91172086
85-86 Dealer installed: 91172087
87-88 - 91172088
89-93 - w/turbo - 96069121 - w/o turbo
- 91172089
Discharge hose:
85-86 - 91172082
85-86 Dealer installed: 91172083
87-88 - 91172084
89-93 - 96069024
1989-93 Tracker
1. Using the Service Manual, remove the following components in the order given:
a. Receiver/dryer.
b. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe.
c. Compressor to condenser (compressor discharge) pipe.
d. Joint service connector on compressor (to be reinstalled).
e. Compressor (only if being replaced).
2. Using the Service Manual, install the following components in the order given. Be sure to use
new 0-rings whenever a refrigerant connection has been disconnected.
a. Compressor (if being replaced).
b. High and low side adapter fittings (see Step 3 of the Retrofit procedure for detailed installation
instructions).
c. Joint service connector to compressor. Use new 0-rings. Six small 0-rings and one large 0-ring
are required.
d. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe, and new 0-ring.
e. Compressor to condenser (discharge) hose and new 0-ring.
f. Receiver/dryer and 0-ring.
R-134a amount: 550 grams (1.21 lb)
PAG oil amount: 100 cc (3.0 oz)
Parts Required:
Receiver/dryer - 91172080
Adapter, Low Side - 91172092
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6376
Adapter, High Side - 91172093
0-Rings:
Compressor - Small (6) - 91172095 Large - 96068915
Receiver/dryer (2) - 96068488
Suction hose - 96068490
Discharge hose - 96068489
Suction hose - 91172091
Discharge hose - 91172085
1985-89 Spectrum and 1990-93 Storm (R)
1. Using the Service Manual, remove the following components in the order given:
a. Condenser (Storm) or radiator grille (Spectrum) (to be reinstalled).
b. Triple switch (Storm) or dual pressure switch (Spectrum) (to be reinstalled).
c. Receiver/dryer.
d. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe.
e. Check valve from high side service valve (discard).
f. Compressor (only if being replaced).
2. Using the Service Manual, install the following components in the order given. Be sure to use
new 0-rings whenever a refrigerant connection has been disconnected.
a. Compressor (if being replaced).
b. High side adapter fitting (see Step 3 of the retrofit procedure for detailed installation instructions).
Low Side - Part of suction hose
c. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe, and new 0-rings.
d. Receiver/dryer and 0-rings.
e. Triple switch or dual switch, and new 0-ring.
f. Condenser or radiator grille.
R-134a amount: 91 - 500 grams (1.10 lb)
92-93 - 600 grams (1.32 lb)
PAG oil amount: 150 cc (4.50 oz)
Parts Required:
Receiver/dryer:
85-89 - 97104795
90-91 - 97104797
92-93 - 97104798
Adapter, High Side:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6377
85-89 - 97104794
90-93 - 97104793
Adapter, Low Side: Part of Hose Asm.
0-rings:
Receiver/dryer 85-91 - 94154048
92-93 - 94461700
Switch/pipe - 94461902
Suction hose:
85-86: 1.5L - 97104799; 1.6L - 97104800
90-93: 1.6L - 97104801; 1.8L - 97104803
B. General Information
Several items affecting the performance and durability of the system should be considered:
1. Performance
When performed properly, the retrofit from R-12 to R-134a will have minimal effect on the system's
performance in most climatic conditions found in the United States and Canada.
2. Leakage
Experience has shown that most leakage in an A/C system is due to leaks at the joints, or through
a small leak in a hose, usually at the coupling. The R-134a molecules are smaller than R-12, and a
small leak may result in a faster loss of refrigerant with R-134a. Because of this, it is very important
to leak check all vehicles using the J 39400 leak detector, BEFORE the retrofit is performed, and
repair any leaks found.
"0" rings and hoses used in most GM vehicles are compatible with R-134a and do not need
replacement during a retrofit. "0" rings or hoses installed in previous repairs may have been of
non-compatible materials if GM parts were not used and will be more likely to deteriorate and leak
than the original equipment materials. All "0" rings and hoses available through GMSP0 are
compatible with R-134a. Remember that the normal policy is to replace the "0" rings whenever a
joint is opened for any reason.
3. Desiccant
You may have heard that the currently used desiccant in the accumulator is not compatible with
R-134a. Extensive testing has shown that it is, in fact, suitable for use with R-134a, once it has
been in service in an R-12 system. The accumulator in these models will not have to be changed
during the retrofit procedure, unless the vehicle is more than 5 years old. Vehicles more than 5
years old should have the A/D replaced to add new desiccant for proper system drying.
In the event that an accumulator/dryer (A/D) needs to be replaced on a retrofitted system in the
future, only A/D's with XH-7 desiccant should be used. The service parts for the 1993 vehicles
contain only XH-7 desiccant. The parts for the 1992 and older vehicles may contain either XH-5 or
XH-7. Parts containing XH-7 can be identified (see Figure 1) by 1) an "A" printed on the top of the
A/D; or 2) if there is a label on top of the A/D, there will be a square with an "A" inside; or 3) if there
is a time code and date printed on top of the A/D just under the "Harrison" logo, the A/D contains
XH-7. A/D's containing XH-5 can still be used on R-12 vehicles.
4. Improved Cooling Performance
There have been service bulletins issued in the past with information improving the cooling
performance of existing R-12 systems. These bulletins can also be used to improve the
performance of retrofitted vehicles in high ambient temperature climates.
5. PAG or V5 Oil Compatibility
Contrary to information published to date outside of General Motors, mineral oil and PAG or V5 oil
ARE chemically compatible. The mineral oil left in the system after reclaiming the R-12 can remain
in the system with no harmful effects. However, the mineral oil will not mix with the R-134a, and so
will not circulate and perform its lubricating function. Testing has shown that most of the mineral oil
will eventually collect in the
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6378
accumulator. The system will operate properly as long as refrigerant charge amounts are strictly
adhered to.
6. Refrigerant Charge Level
The retrofit R-134a charge level is more critical than with R-12 systems. Overcharging may push
the mineral oil out of the AID, and cause it to circulate as a liquid. This is more likely to result in
compressor damage. Undercharging may lead to loss of performance. It is very important to clear
the hoses during the charging operation, to insure that all the refrigerant is delivered to the vehicle
A/C system. This is covered in Step 6D of the Retrofit Procedure.
C. Parts Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6379
Important:
All of the following parts are NOT NEEDED for a normal retrofit. Follow the bulletin procedures to
determine which parts you need! Individual vehicle kits are not necessary, since most of the parts
are generic and only a few parts are needed for most vehicles.
GEO Parts are listed in "Platform Details."
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
D. Warranty Information
1. Vehicle Still Within the Original New Vehicle Limited Warranty Period
When GM models for the years listed in the bulletin require repairs to the refrigerant system and
the vehicles are still covered under the New
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page 6380
Vehicle Limited Warranty, dealers are instructed to proceed as follows:
Important:
On vehicles equipped with A/C systems NOT produced by GM (i.e., rear A/C systems in van
conversions), consult the manufacturer of that A/C system for retrofit guidelines.
^ Offer the customer the option of repairing and recharging the system with R12, or retrofitting after
repair and recharging with R-134a at no additional charge.
^ Provide the owner with, and review the information contained in, the "Converting Your Auto Air
Conditioning System to Use the New Refrigerant" brochure. (Brochure, Form GM-0011, can be
ordered free of charge from GM Fulfillment HQ, Phone 1-800-269-5100).
^ Record the customer's choice on the repair order and, as with all properly completed repair
orders, ask the customer to sign on the appropriate line acknowledging the repairs requested.
^ Under no circumstances should the retrofit to R-134a be performed unless the customer has had
the option explained prior to repair. Once the vehicle has been retrofitted to R-134a, a significant
expenditure would be incurred to go back to R-12, in the event the customer has changed his/her
mind.
THIS OFFER APPLIES ONLY TO VEHICLES REQUIRING A/C REFRIGERANT SYSTEM
REPAIRS UNDER THE TERMS OF THE NEW VEHICLE LIMITED WARRANTY. It is not a special
policy, and any existing deductibles still apply. This is simply an option being offered to the
customer during the warranty period at this time. GM reserves the right to terminate this offer at
any time.
If the R-12 refrigerant system does not require discharging for a warranty repair, but the customer
requests a retrofit to R-134a, the retrofit WOULD BE PERFORMED AT THE CUSTOMER'S
EXPENSE, EVEN DURING THE WARRANTY PERIOD.
2. Customer Paid Retrofitting Costs
If the customer requests a retrofit to R-134a, for a specific vehicle whose retrofit parts and
procedures have been released in this bulletin, the customer would be expected to pay the costs to
retrofit under the following conditions:
^ The vehicle is no longer covered by the terms of the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
^ The vehicle is covered by warranty, but the repair covered under the warranty does not require
evacuating and recharging the refrigerant system.
3. Labor Time Information
For Vehicles Repaired Under Warranty: Use existing labor operations for correcting the original
condition. The quantity of R-134a used should be charged to the normal labor operation (not
D4500), just as if it were R-12.
Use D4500, 0.3 HR., to charge for parts and labor, for all of the following items:
^ Additional time for recovery of R-12 to meet SAE standards;
^ Install high and low side service port converter fittings;
^ Add PAG or V5 retrofit oil;
^ Complete label information and install.
Add 0.2 hours to D4500 for installation of the HPCOS.
Use T5321, 0.3 HR., for the Pontiac Bonneville hood seal installation.
ANY PARTS OR LABOR TIME OTHER THAN THOSE LISTED ABOVE SHOULD BE CHARGED
TO THE REGULAR LABOR OPERATION CORRESPONDING TO THE ORIGINAL CONDITION
THAT 1S BEING REPAIRED.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 631209 > May > 96 > A/C - R12 or R134a Service Recommendations
Technical Service Bulletin # 631209 Date: 960501
A/C - R12 or R134a Service Recommendations
File In Section: 1 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 63-12-09
Date: May, 1996
INFORMATION
Subject: Service Issues for Vehicles with R12 or R134a Air Conditioning Systems
Models: 1988-96 Passenger Cars and Trucks
R12 Service Recommendations
As you know, production of R12 refrigerant ceased on December 31, 1995. Although R12 will no
longer be manufactured, there is a reserve supply of R12 available. This reserve, along with strict
A/C repair service adherence to proper refrigerant recycling procedures, should assure continued
availability to meet consumers' needs.
R12 can and should continue to be used to service vehicles built with R12 A/C systems as long as
it is available. If R12 is no longer available or affordable, a system retrofit utilizing R134a is
recommended. R134a IS THE ONLY SUBSTITUTE REFRIGERANT RECOMMENDED BY GM
FOR USE IN GM VEHICLE A/C SYSTEMS, AND THEN ONLY AFTER FOLLOWING THE
PROPER RETROFIT PROCEDURES FOR THE SPECIFIC MODEL. All new vehicle
manufacturers have chosen R134a for retrofit. One of the key reasons is to protect both the service
industry and consumers from the high costs that would result from purchasing equipment
necessary to service multiple refrigerants. This position also reduces the threat of recycled
refrigerant contamination.
GM currently offers a simple, low cost R12 to R134a retrofit on many of its late model, front wheel
drive passenger cars. Dealers should discuss this capability with owners of these specific models,
listed in Retrofit Corporate Bulletin # 43-12-07D, whenever a repair to the A/C refrigerant system is
required. Early retrofit of these specific models will aid in prolonging availability of the R12 supply
and provide dealer service technicians the opportunity to become more familiar with the proper
procedures for performing a retrofit.
Remember - R12 and R134a refrigerant are not interchangeable! They cannot be mixed together.
In fact, despite the claims of some refrigerant manufacturers, no proposed R12 refrigerant
substitute can be added to, mixed with or used to "top off" an R12 system. Under provisions of law
covering the service of refrigerants, mixing dissimilar refrigerant products during service is
prohibited.
To Summarize GM R12 Service Policy
1. Service R12 vehicles with good quality new or recycled R12 as long as it is available.
2. Purchase R12 from a reliable supplier. GMSPO has a supply of high quality R12 available.
Dealers are requested to use only R12 supplied by GMSPO for warranty repairs. This high quality
refrigerant will insure system performance and avoid the possibility of introducing contaminated
material into the customer's A/C system.
3. Carefully test recovered R12 using the PureGuard monitor. On recovery equipment not
protected by the PureGuard, always test the recovery cylinder prior to recharging a vehicle A/C
system.
4. Discuss the R12 to R134a retrofit option with owners of GM vehicles listed in Retrofit Corporate
Bulletin # 43-12-07D. Provide owner with a copy of the pamphlet "Converting Your Auto Air
Conditioning System to Use the New Refrigerant".
5. Become familiar with retrofit procedures and exercise care in the handling of dissimilar
refrigerants to prevent contamination.
R134A Service Recommendations
When servicing a previously retrofitted vehicle, there is concern that if all of the R12 is not
completely removed prior to the retrofit procedure, it could contaminate your R134a equipment and
recovery tank when a subsequent A/C repair is performed. Although the number of retrofits being
performed today is minimal, the volume will increase as R12 prices rise.
GM Service Technology Group is in the process of field testing a new R134a refrigerant purity
tester similar to the PureGuard R12 refrigerant tester you now use. This new tool will mount to your
ACR4 R134a Recovery Recycle and Recharge cart and sample all R134a refrigerant prior to
recovery. It is expected that testing of this tool will be completed this year.
This new tool, the Pureguard 2, will also test vehicles and your recycle tank for air contamination,
which is threatening A/C system performance. High levels of air have been found in the recovery
tanks on a number of R12 and R134a recovery carts. Air contamination is caused by improper
recovery
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 631209 > May > 96 > A/C - R12 or R134a Service Recommendations > Page 6385
procedures and short-cutting refrigerant recycling times. Use the following procedure for testing
and correcting air contamination in your A/C service equipment.
1. Make certain that the ACR4 equipment has not been used for at least 12 hours. It is
recommended that the equipment be left in an area where the temperature will remain constant
overnight to allow the temperature of the refrigerant in the tank to stabilize.
2. Record the surrounding air temperature next to the ACR4 refrigerant tank.
Important:
A major assumption is that the ambient air temperature next to the tank represents the refrigerant
temperature in the tank. Failure to take care in measuring the temperature could result in
unnecessary work.
3. Close both liquid (blue) and vapor (red) valves on the ACR4 tank.
4. Disconnect low side (blue) service hose from the back of the ACR4.
5. Slowly disconnect the tank vapor hose (red) from the back of the ACR4 and connect it to the low
side service port.
6. Open the vapor (red) valve on the tank and record the tank pressure on the low side gage.
7. Restore hoses to the original position.
8. Referring to the Table, find the ambient temperature measured in Step 2. Compare the pressure
reading from Step 6 to the "maximum allowable pressure". If the pressure reading from Step 6 is
less than the "maximum allowable pressure", no further action is necessary.
Important:
The closer the tank pressure is to the desired tank pressure, the better the A/C system will perform.
9. If the pressure reading from Step 6 exceeds the maximum allowable pressure from the Table,
open both tank valves and operate the ACR4 through 4 or 5 evacuation cycles. This will activate
the automatic air purge to lower the tank pressure.
Important:
Station should not be connected to vehicle.
10. Repeat the tank pressure checking procedure the next day to determine if the pressure has
been reduced to acceptable levels. If the tank pressure has been reduced but is not acceptable,
cycle with ACR4 through more evacuation cycles and recheck the next day. Continue process until
acceptable pressure is obtained. If the tank pressure is not reduced through the evacuation cycling,
then Kent-Moore should be contacted at 1-800-345-2233.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 531205 > May > 95 > Contaminated R12 Refrigerant - Testing & Handling
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins Contaminated R12 Refrigerant - Testing & Handling
FILE IN SECTION: 1 - HVAC
BULLETIN NO.: 53-12-05
DATE: May, 1995
SUBJECT: Contaminated R12 Refrigerant Testing and Handling
MODELS: 1994 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks with R12 A/C Systems
The J 39851 "PureGuard" R12 refrigerant monitor was recently shipped to all GM dealers as an
essential tool to test R12 refrigerant. Dealers are strongly urged to install this protective device on
their ACR3 or other R12 recovery equipment immediately. The PureGuard is easily installed on any
recovery cart (20 minutes), requires no recovery cart modifications, is fully automatic (no training
required) and does not increase the time required to perform normal A/C service procedures.
Proper use of this tool can:
^ Prevent damage to your R12 recovery/recycling equipment.
^ Prevent contamination of previously recovered R12 in the recovery tank.
^ Prevent loss of your recovered R12 as contaminated refrigerant will activate automatic air purge
system.
^ Prevent the spread of contaminated R12 to other vehicles you service.
If your dealership has multiple R12 recovery stations which are not protected, use the PureGuard
to check the refrigerant in these recovery tanks for contamination at least once each week. Simply
connect the PureGuard blue service hose (that would normally be connected to the vehicle low
side service port) to the red or vapor side of any recovery cart tank and run the test. It is also
important to check a tank containing recovered/recycled material for purity before installation on
your charging equipment. Even new R12 refrigerant purchased from sources other than GM should
be tested for contamination prior to use.
Sources of Contaminated R12 Refrigerant
Since refrigerant testing has not been a standard practice in the mobile A/C repair industry, the
amount of R12 refrigerant contamination is unknown. As R12 prices rise and supplies are depleted,
it is anticipated that contaminated R12 refrigerant may become more prevalent from the following
as well as other sources:
^ The use of R12 refrigerant substitutes without installation of unique service fittings and proper
identification labeling.
^ Improper use of R12 substitutes, such as topping off R12 systems with R134a or other
refrigerants available to "do-it-yourselfers".
^ Poor quality or contaminated new or reprocessed R12 refrigerant.
R12 can and should continue to be used to service vehicles built with R12 as long as it is available.
Combining any refrigerant with R12 results in a refrigerant mixture which cannot be used in an A/C
system.
R134a is the only substitute refrigerant approved by GM and should only be used when the
appropriate retrofit service bulletin procedures are explicitly followed. Use of any other substitute
refrigerant requires the purchase of additional dedicated recovery, recycling (if applicable) and
charging equipment to service each substitute refrigerant used.
However, you should know that the Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) has listed several
products as acceptable replacements for R12 mobile A/C systems under the Significant New
Alternatives Policy (SNAP). Some of these products are: R134a, R401c (a DuPont refrigerant
blend) and FRIGC (another refrigerant blend). It is important to understand that the SNAP program
only considers the health, safety and environmental characteristics of a chemical. It does not test
for A/C system cooling performance or durability. That judgment is deferred to the vehicle
manufacturer. Use of any R12 refrigerant substitute without dedicated service equipment, unique
fittings, labels and refrigerant testing prior to recovery, could result in contamination of the R12
supply and the loss of the R12 recycling program.
What To Do When Contamination is Detected
Repeat the test to verify contaminated refrigerant is present. Clear the PureGuard following the
instructions listed on the face panel, then perform a second test to verify that the vehicle A/C
system contains contaminated or mixed refrigerant.
Contact the vehicle owner to advise that previous A/C system repairs were apparently performed
with an R12 refrigerant substitute. Suggest the owner
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 531205 > May > 95 > Contaminated R12 Refrigerant - Testing & Handling > Page 6390
contact or return to the previous repair facility. Explain that environmental regulations prohibit repair
facilities from discharging ozone depleting A/C refrigerants into the atmosphere. Explain that
recovery of this unknown refrigerant could damage your service equipment.
If the customer wishes to pursue repairs through your facility, it is recommended that the proper
A/C service equipment be purchased. General Motors recommends the Kent-Moore J 41428
"Scavenger", an air operated refrigerant recovery station, be used to remove unknown refrigerants.
The air operated feature reduces the hazard of recovering potentially flammable refrigerants.
Dealers should evaluate the need to purchase the equipment based on the number of
contaminated vehicles they encounter.
As an alternative to the initial purchase of a recovery only station, dealers should check locally for
A/C specialty shops which may have the equipment to service substitute or contaminated
refrigerants. They may be able to provide contaminated refrigerant recovery service to the dealer.
The GM Service Technology Group has tested a recovery procedure where a 15 or 30 pound DOT
approved refillable tank is fully evacuated then connected to a vehicle A/C system to recover the
charge. Testing has shown that even when the recovery tank is cooled down in dry ice, the
procedure does not guarantee the entire charge will be recovered. Since EPA regulations require
full recovery of ozone depleting substances, GM does not recommend this procedure.
Contaminated Refrigerant Disposal
Although A/C refrigerant testing and disposal have not been a service practice in the mobile A/C
industry, It has been common in the stationary A/C service industry for many years. Listed at the
end of this bulletin are companies that provide refrigerant disposal service for the stationary A/C
industry. Please be advised that GM has not independently evaluated these companies and is not
in any way endorsing or promoting the use of these companies. Each of these companies has
expressed an interest in providing refrigerant disposal service to GM dealers.
In working with the stationary A/C industry, these companies typically receive large volumes of
different refrigerants that have been mixed together. Unfortunately, because the volume of material
returned by the mobile A/C industry will be in much smaller quantities, the cost of handling will be
greater.
To arrange for return of the refrigerant, simply call the company nearest you using the phone
number listed below. The company will advise you on billing and shipping procedures. Disposal
cost will vary between $3.00 and $5.00 per pound plus freight and handling. Shipping charges will
vary by distance and location. In general, a 7 to 10 day turn-around time on the tank can be
expected. The tank can be shipped via common carrier. Documents that your refrigerant has been
properly disposed of will be sent to you with the return of your tank.
As an alternative, many dealerships already have contracts in place with a disposal company who
manages their hazardous wastes. In these cases, the disposal service may agree to handle
containers of mixed refrigerants. Initially, the local disposal companies may be surprised by this
inquiry. They may want to evaluate how much material will be collected before deciding whether to
provide this service.
As we move forward with the practice of testing R12 refrigerant, it will take time for all the questions
to be answered. STG will provide additional information as soon as it is available.
Understanding The PureGuard
The PureGuard is a highly sensitive instrument capable of detecting R12 with 3% or less
cross-contamination with other refrigerants. Any refrigerant mixture in excess of this amount poses
a threat to both your refrigerant supply and recovery equipment. The PureGuard uses a pass/fail
approach when monitoring the refrigerant and is precisely calibrated to cut power to the recovery
machine if it encounters R12 mixed with any substitute refrigerants. The PureGuard ignores the
presence of the air, dyes or oils in the refrigerant sampled.
At least 20 psi must be present in the vehicle's A/C system for the PureGuard to function.
Otherwise, refrigerant cannot be introduced to the PureGuard's test chamber. If a vehicle's A/C
system contains less than 20 psi, it is an indication that the vehicle's system is nearly depleted of
refrigerant.
Occasionally, erratic PureGuard operation or service code 002 display will be encountered when
A/C system pressure is exactly 20 psi. If this occurs, simply cycle the on/off switch to reset the
PureGuard. After the 30 second PureGuard warm-up cycle, proceed immediately with vehicle
recovery operation.
Feedback from the field has indicated PureGuard service code 002 will also be displayed if the oil
drain port is not sealed. Make sure the "0" ring seal in the cap is in place and that the cap is tight.
If the PureGuard fails to clear or if you experience any other problems operating the PureGuard,
contact Kent-Moore Technical Service at 1-800-345-2233. The unit should not be returned without
first contacting Kent-Moore to obtain return authorization.
Refrigerant Disposal Locations:
United States Refrigerant Reclamation Inc. 12420 North Green River Rd. Evansville, IN 47711
800-207-5931, FAX - 812-867-1463
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 531205 > May > 95 > Contaminated R12 Refrigerant - Testing & Handling > Page 6391
Omega Refrigerant Reclamation 5263 North Fourth St. Irwindale, CA 91706 310-698-0991, FAX 310-696-1908
Refrigerant Management Svcs of Georgia 216 F. Atlanta Hwy. Cumming, GA 30130 Ph/FAX 800-347-5872
Refrigerant Reclaim Inc. 122 Old Stage Coach Rd. Dumfries, VA 22026 800-238-5902, FAX 703-441-0393
Gartech Refrigerant Reclamation Ctr. 2002 Platinum Garland, TX 75042 214-272-4070, FAX 214-272-8548
National Refrigerants, Inc. 11401 Roosevelt Blvd. Philadelphia, PA 19154 215-698-6620, FAX 215-602-8205
CFC Reclamation 1321 Swift North Kansas City, MO 64116 816-471-2511
Full Cycle-Global 550 James Street Lakewood, NJ 08701 908-370-3400, FAX - 908-370-3088
Refrigerant Reclaim Svcs, Inc. dba Full Cycle-Global 121 S. Norwood Drive Ft. Worth, TX
76053-7807 817-282-0022, FAX - 800-831-6182
Full Cycle-Global 2055 Silber, Ste. 109 Houston, TX 77055 713-681-7370, FAX - 713-681-9947
Full Cycle-Global 343 South Airline Hwy. Gonzales, LA 70737 504-644-5303, FAX - 504-644-1809
Full Cycle-Global 2966 Wireton Blue Island, IL 60406 708-388-8551, FAX - 708-388-8550
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 431215 > Nov > 94 > A/C - R134a Leak Detection With Tracer Dye
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - R134a Leak Detection With Tracer Dye
File In Section: 1 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 43-12-15
Date: November, 1994
Subject: R134a Leak Detection with Tracer Dye
Models: All 1993-95 Vehicles with OEM R134a Systems All R12 Vehicles Retrofitted to R134a
Systems
R134a refrigerant is uniquely different from R12 refrigerant and requires some changes in the
repair methods, tools and materials used in A/C service. Two important differences between R134a
and R12 which affect the technicians ability to locate refrigerant leaks are:
1. The R134a molecule is smaller than the R12 molecule and therefore will leak through smaller
openings. For the same size opening the smaller R134a molecule will leak out faster than the R12.
2. R134a refrigerant does not contain chlorine which the older R12 electronic leak detectors found
very easy to identify. Many of today's electronic leak detectors have difficulty locating small R134a
refrigerant leaks.
In order to insure the highest quality in A/C system service, the J 39400 electronic leak detector
was released as an essential tool for all GM dealers. This is the only refrigerant leak detector
approved by GM for service on R134a vehicles. If maintained properly (Reference Bulletin No.
431218) and used in accordance with Service Manual procedures, the J 39400 will provide the
most accurate and efficient method of locating R134a refrigerant leaks under most conditions.
If the technician cannot find the leak with the J 39400 and the system is known to have lost charge,
a new fluorescent leak tracer dye Kent-Moore* P/N J 41447, has been released that mixes with the
R134a PAG oil. This dye is detectable through the use of an ultraviolet (black) light and glows
yellow/green at the leak location (similar to using dye in engine leak detection). J 41447 IS THE
ONLY APPROVED DYE BY GENERAL MOTORS. Not all R134a dyes are compatible with GM's
PAG oil. Some dyes decrease the oil viscosity or chemically react with the oil. Use of alternate
products may affect system reliability and cause premature compressor failure.
Note:
THIS DYE IS NOT TO BE USED IN R-12 SYSTEMS.
Unlike mineral oil, the R134a PAG oil has special properties the technician should keep in mind.
1. PAG oil is water soluble and traces of PAG oil found at leaking joints are subject to "washing
out". Condensation on refrigerant lines or the evaporator core may wash the PAG oil and leak dye
off the line or off the core and out the condensate drain. This can make some leaks harder to find
using the dye detector. Fluorescence at the drain opening would indicate a core leak.
2. Use of the R134a tracer dye requires time. Depending upon the leak rate, it may take between
15 minutes and 7 days for the leak to become visible.
3. The dye, mixed with the PAG oil, is retained in the system and is detectable for 2+ years. Do not
double or triple charge the system with dye as this may cause reliability concerns. Use only the 1/4
oz. charge.
The dye has a refrigerant leak detection notice sticker included with the package. Complete the
sticker information and place near the charge label.
Dye Injection R-134a dye can be injected two ways:
1. With the A/C system charged, use the instructions provided with the new R134a leak dye
injection tool, J 41436.
2. With A/C system discharged, add dye into the newly replaced component assembly.
It is important to note that it is normal to find oil traces at the compressor shaft seal during
compressor operation, some oil will hydraulically seep past the shaft seal. This does not mean that
the shaft seal is defective or that the refrigerant has leaked. Refrigerant leaks at the shaft seal
should be verified with the electronic leak detector (J 39400) following the procedure detailed in the
Service Manual. If, however, the amount of oil is excessive, the shaft seal is suspect and should be
replaced. (For example, refrigerant oil has coated the clutch plate edge at gap between clutch and
pulley, or oil slinging has occurred-oil line shows on underside of hood, etc.).
Also, after working on A/C components with dye, it is important to wipe the joint and/or access
ports clean of any residual dye with GM solvent (GM
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 431215 > Nov > 94 > A/C - R134a Leak Detection With Tracer Dye > Page 6396
P/N 1050436) to prevent false diagnosis at a later point.
* We believe this source and their equipment to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such equipment. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products or equipment from these firms or for any such items which may be
available from other sources.
Parts Information GM solvent, P/N 1050436, is currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 431223 > Sep > 94 > A/C Refrigerant - Contamination
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C Refrigerant - Contamination
File In Section: 1 - HVAC Bulletin No.: 43-12-23 Date: September, 1994
Subject: Contaminated A/C Refrigerant
Models: 1994 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks with R12 Air Conditioning Systems
Government regulations limit the production of R12 refrigerant, commonly referred to as Freon,
during 1994/1995 and restrict manufacture of new R12 material effective January 1, 1996. As R12
prices rise and supplies are depleted, it is anticipated non-approved substitute refrigerants and/or
poor quality R12 material sold as new or reprocessed may become more prevalent.
The Mobile Air Conditioning Society (MACS) recently expressed concern over reports of the sale of
R12 refrigerant containing as high as 15% contamination by R22, a refrigerant commonly used in
stationary home systems but unsuitable for use in mobile units. GM dealers should be careful to
protect against contaminating their existing supplies of R12 or the A/C systems in customers'
vehicles they service by dealing with reputable suppliers. All R12 refrigerant purchased for
warranty repairs should be purchased through GM SPO to ensure GM quality standards are met.
The use of non-approved R12 refrigerant substitutes, some of which contain flammable materials,
has also been reported by MACS. These products are available to "do-it-yourselfers" who, in many
cases, believe they are harmless replacements for the small cans of R12 used so commonly in the
past. Once added to the A/C system, the vehicle can no longer be serviced using R12
recovery/recycling equipment without:
- Risking permanent damage to recovery/recycling equipment
- Contaminating the previously recovered R12 material in the recovery tank
- Spreading the contamination when the recovered material is used to charge other vehicles
or
- Possible loss of the recovered material if the contaminated level is high enough to activate the air
purge system
Contaminated refrigerant also impacts customer satisfaction through poor vehicle A/C performance
and loss of A/C system compressor/component durability. System or component failure resulting
from the use of refrigerant which does not meet GM specification is not covered by the "New
Vehicle Warranty".
Unfortunately, there is no simple method to identify if a "do-it-yourselfer" or repair shop has added
to or recharged a system with a non-approved refrigerant. The inability to protect against the
spread of contaminated refrigerant threatens the recycling program and the industry's desire to
maximize use of the remaining R12 supply.
Beginning in 1993, General Motors STG, Harrison Division, Research Labs and Kent-Moore
worked in conjunction with suppliers of various technologies to develop a tester to identify
contaminated refrigerant in vehicle A/C systems before recovery. During development of the
technology, several dealer service manager focus group studies were conducted to identify design
features to best suit dealership needs.
The discussions and surveys clearly indicated the desire for a dedicated instrument, permanently
mounted to the refrigerant recovery cart to ensure ALL vehicles are automatically tested prior to
recovering refrigerant. Testing ALL refrigerant for contamination prior to recovery is the ONLY
means to ensure customer satisfaction, protect recovery equipment and avoid unintentional venting
of refrigerant by your dealership.
General Motors has evaluated all available technology for this project and only the J 39851 R12
"Pureguard" meets General Motors' specifications. The J 39851 R12 Pureguard Refrigerant
Monitor has been classified as an essential tool and will be shipped by Kent-Moore to your
dealership beginning in September of 1994. The essential price of the R12 "Pureguard" is $561 (for
Canadian dealers the price is $800 Canadian). If your dealership has multiple R12 recovery
equipment, additional units may be ordered from Kent-Moore for $561 at 1-800-345-2233. Features
of the R12 "Pureguard" include:
- Universally mounts to R12 Recovery Equipment
- Automatically interrupts power to the Recovery Equipment when contaminated refrigerant is
identified
- Fully automatic design does not require technician action, training or interpretation
- LCD displays Pureguard functions
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 431223 > Sep > 94 > A/C Refrigerant - Contamination > Page 6401
- Meets GM contamination sensitivity requirements
- Self calibrating
- Micro-processor controlled
- Audio alarm alerts technician
Other Refrigerant Identifiers are being advertised which may be available this A/C season.
However, ONLY the Kent-Moore J 39851 R12 "Pureguard" meets General Motors' current
specifications which ensure recovered refrigerant is compatible with General Motors vehicles and
General Motors approved recovery systems.
An R134a Pureguard Refrigerant Identifier is currently under development and is anticipated to be
available in early 1995. The contamination of R134a refrigerant is not expected to be a concern
until the program to retrofit R12 vehicles to R134a becomes more widely used.
Future bulletins will be issued to address the recovery and disposal of contaminated refrigerant.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 331226 > Jan > 94 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 Vehicles to R-134A
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Retrofitting R-12 Vehicles to R-134A
Group Ref.: HVAC
Bulletin No.: 331226
Date: January, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: RETROFITTING R-12 VEHICLES TO R-134a
MODELS: 1994 AND PRIOR YEARS, PASSENGER CARS AND TRUCKS WITH R-12 A/C
SYSTEMS
There has been a great deal of information presented by the media regarding the need to retrofit
vehicles produced with R-12, to a substitute refrigerant. This bulletin will outline GM's position and
future plans on this subject.
Most important, there is currently NO requirement to retrofit any R-12 vehicle. Vehicles built with
R-12 can be serviced with R-12, as long as the refrigerant is available. At some point in time, R-12
may become either too scarce or too expensive to economically justify service on some vehicles
with R-12. By that time, GM will provide you with instructions on retrofitting those vehicles from
R-12 to R-134a.
GM vehicle divisions, platforms, and component suppliers have been actively working on the
details of retrofitting R-12 vehicles. An enormous amount of work is required to determine how
hundreds of vehicle models can be satisfactorily retrofitted. Additional information will be provided
as it becomes available.
The following items contain important technical information that should answer many of the
questions, and correct some misconceptions reported in the media.
SUBSTITUTE REFRIGERANTS
R-134a is the only approved substitute refrigerant that GM recommends and it should only be used
if a complete retrofit procedure has been performed. None of the other refrigerants currently being
marketed as replacement or drop-in substitutes for R-12 are approved for use in GM vehicles.
R-12 and R-134a are not interchangeable. R-134a cannot be added to fill a low R-12 system. The
combination of the two materials can cause high system pressures, which could cause damage to
the system.
Retrofitting an R-12 vehicle to R-134a requires careful preparation to insure that neither the vehicle
nor the A/C service equipment has become contaminated.
RESIDUAL MINERAL OIL
The concern that mineral oil is chemically incompatible with R-134a and/or PAG lubricant has been
proven to be untrue. A normal charge of mineral oil left in the A/C system after a retrofit to R-134a
will not damage the system. Mineral oil, however, does not mix well with R-134a, and will not
provide adequate lubrication. Tests on both the orifice tube and TXV systems show that the mineral
oil parks in places such as the accumulator, and does not appreciably affect performance or
damage the system. The retrofit service bulletin will specify the correct oil to be used. It is important
that this oil recommendation be followed carefully.
RESIDUAL R-12
Residual R-12 left in a system, due to improper retrofit service procedures, may result in system
damage unless the residual R-12 is kept below the 2 percent limit specified by the Society of
Automotive Engineers' Specification J-1661. New service methods are being developed to
minimize the level of R-12 remaining in the A/C system after the retrofit procedure is completed.
Following these new procedures will be critical to insure that the above limits are met.
SYSTEM FLUSHING
R-11, a material commonly used as an A/C system flushing solvent, has been found to be
chemically incompatible with PAG lubricant. Technicians should be aware that residual R-11
remaining in an R-12 system will be very damaging if the vehicle is retrofitted to R-134a later in its
life. For many years GM has recommended the use of in-line filters as an alternative to system
flushing.
SYSTEM FLUSHING, USING EITHER R-11 OR ANY OTHER FLUSHING MATERIAL, IS NOT
APPROVED BY GM FOR ANY A/C SYSTEM.
DESICCANT PROTECTION
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 331226 > Jan > 94 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 Vehicles to R-134A > Page 6406
It has been reported that the desiccant (moisture absorption material) used in 1992 and older R-12
A/C systems is incompatible with R-134a and PAG oil. The older desiccant was designed
specifically for R-12 systems, but testing has shown that it is NOT necessary to replace the older
desiccant just because the vehicle is being retrofitted to R-134a. 1993 and newer GM vehicles use
desiccant designed to be compatible with both R-12 and R-134a systems.
The amount of desiccant used in most GM vehicles is designed to last for at least seven years. To
help maintain adequate protection for vehicles that must be retrofitted, it is recommended that the
accumulator/dryer, which contains the desiccant, be replaced if the vehicle is more than five years
old.
"O" RINGS
While continuing to service with R-12, be sure to use "O" rings and seal materials which are
compatible with R-134a and PAG oil. This practice will eliminate concern in case the vehicle
requires retrofitting later in its life. All "O" rings and seal materials available from GMSPO are
compatible with R-134a systems.
RETROFITTED SYSTEM PERFORMANCE
Currently, it appears that for most GM vehicles, the retrofit procedure will require minimal changes
to the existing system. Some vehicles may need additional parts and/or procedures to provide
acceptable performance and/or durability. Our testing has shown that vehicles that have undergone
recommended retrofit procedures will, in most climatic conditions, be minimally affected in terms of
A/C performance.
SERVICE POLICY
Basic service policy is as follows:
During Warranty - If an R-12 produced vehicle A/C system must be repaired or recharged under
warranty, repairs will be completed using R-12. If R-12 is unavailable or unaffordable, GM will notify
the dealer body and will pay for the warranty repair and the retrofit to R-134a.
NOTE:
It a customer requests that an in-warranty vehicle be converted to R-134a, and the R-12 system is
functioning properly, the customer will be expected to pay for the retrofit.
Out of Warranty - The cost of the conversion will be the responsibility of the customer.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 331228 > Dec > 93 > A/C - Refrigerant Production Change R12 to R134a
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Production Change R12 to R134a
Group Ref.: HVAC Bulletin No.: 331228 Date: December, 1993
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: REFRIGERANT CHANGE IN PRODUCTION VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIR
CONDITIONING (RPO C60)
MODELS: 1994 CHEVROLET CAVALIER 1994 PONTIAC SUNBIRD
Vehicles produced on and after January 3, 1994 equipped with air conditioning (RPO C60) will be
charged with R134a. This includes vehicles produced at both the Lordstown and Ramos assembly
plants. To identify this change, the vehicles charged with R134a will have the RPO code KR1 in
addition to RPO code C60. Also, an underhood sticker will indicate the use of R134a and proper
charge amount.
With the exception of the special tools needed to service R134a, service diagnostics and
procedures are generally the same as vehicles previously produced with R12. This information can
be located in Section 1B of the appropriate service manual.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-39-004C > Jun > 09 > Technical Service Bulletins for
Refrigerant: > 922501A > Aug > 92 > A/C - Use of Alternate Refrigerants In CFC 12
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Use of Alternate Refrigerants In CFC 12
Number: 92-250-1A
Section: 0A
Date: AUGUST 1992
Corporate Bulletin No.: 231205
ASE No.: A7
Subject: USE OF ALTERNATE REFRIGERANTS IN CFC 12 REFRIGERANT MOBILE AIR
CONDITIONERS
Model and Year: GALL MODEL YEARS - ALL PASSENGER CARS AND TRUCKS INCLUDING
GEO
A number of inquiries have been received concerning the use of "alternate refrigerants" as a
replacement for R-12 refrigerant in General Motors air conditioning systems.
Regardless of any advertised claims, there are currently no substitutes for refrigerant R-12
approved by General Motors. At the present time, only new or recycled R-12 is approved for use in
General Motors R-12 air conditioning systems.
Based on studies performed to date, the use of "alternate refrigerants" in General Motors R-12 air
conditioning systems may result in higher system pressures, higher leak rates or incompatibility
with drying and sealing materials. System performance and reliability may also be affected.
Service equipment manufacturers have indicated that cross-contaminating R-12 recovery/recycling
equipment with "alternate refrigerants" may damage the equipment. General Motors supports the
Society of Automotive Engineers recommended service procedures for recovery and recycling of
R-12. The use of known "alternate refrigerants" without proper service practices for identifying
vehicle systems containing these "alternate refrigerants" and dedicated recovery equipment to
service those vehicles will contaminate the recycled supply of R-12 refrigerant. Contamination of
the recycled R-12 refrigerant makes the refrigerant unusable for recharging air conditioning
systems and could jeopardize the recycling program.
At the present time, General Motors has not approved any "alternate refrigerant" for R-12 in R-12
air conditioning systems. Therefore, R-12 systems should continue to be serviced with new or
recycled R-12 only.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling/Equipment
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling/Equipment
Bulletin No.: 08-01-38-001
Date: January 25, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Information On New GE-48800 CoolTech Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2008 and
Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
Attention:
This bulletin is being issued to announce the release of GM approved Air Conditioning (A/C)
Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging Equipment that meets the new Society of Automotive
Engineers (SAE) J2788 Refrigerant Recovery Standards. The ACR2000 (J-43600) cannot be
manufactured in its current state after December 2007 and will be superseded by GE-48800.
The new J2788 standard does not require that GM Dealers replace their ACR2000 units.
ACR2000's currently in use are very capable of servicing today's refrigerant systems when used
correctly and can continue to be used. Details regarding the new SAE J2788 standard are outlined
in GM Bulletin 07-01-38-004.
Effective February 1 2008, new A/C Refrigerant Recovery/Recharging equipment (P/N GE-48800)
will be released as a required replacement for the previously essential ACR2000 (J-43600). This
equipment is SAE J2788 compliant and meets GM requirements for A/C Refrigerant System
Repairs on all General Motors vehicles, including Hybrid systems with Polyolester (POE)
refrigerant oil. This equipment will not be shipped as an essential tool to GM Dealerships.
In addition, this equipment is Hybrid compliant and designed to prevent oil cross contamination
when servicing Hybrid vehicles with Electric A/C Compressors that use POE refrigerant oil.
The ACR2000 (J-43600) will need to be retrofitted with a J-43600-50 (Hose - ACR2000 Oil Flush
Loop) to be able to perform Hybrid A/C service work. All Hybrid dealers will receive the J-43600-50,
with installation instructions, as a component of the Hybrid essential tool package. Dealerships that
do not sell Hybrids, but may need to service Hybrids, can obtain J-43600-50 from SPX Kent Moore.
Refer to GM Bulletin 08-01-39-001 for the ACR2000 Hose Flush procedure.
The High Voltage (HV) electric A/C compressor used on Two Mode Hybrid vehicles uses a
Polyolester (POE) refrigerant oil instead of a Polyalkylene Glycol (PAG) synthetic refrigerant oil.
This is due to the better electrical resistance of the POE oil and its ability to provide HV isolation.
Failure to flush the hoses before adding refrigerant to a Hybrid vehicle with an electric A/C
compressor may result in an unacceptable amount of PAG oil entering the refrigerant system. It
may cause a Battery Energy Control Module Hybrid Battery Voltage System Isolation Lost
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC P1AE7) to be set. Additionally, the A/C system warranty will be
voided.
Warranty Submission Requirements
The Electronically Generated Repair Data (snapshot summary) and printer functions have been
eliminated from the GE-48800. The VGA display and temperature probes were eliminated to
reduce equipment costs. As a result, effective immediately the 18 digit "Snapshot/Charge
Summary" code is no longer required for Air Conditioning (A/C) refrigerant system repairs that are
submitted for warranty reimbursement. The charge summary data from before and after system
repairs will continue to required, but documented on the repair order only. Both high and low
pressures and the recovery and charge amounts should be noted during the repair and entered on
the repair order. If using ACR2000 (J-43600), the "Snapshot/Charge Summary" printouts should
continue to be attached to the shops copy of the repair order.
The labor codes that are affected by this requirement are D3000 through D4500.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 08-01-38-001 > Jan > 08 > A/C - Refrigerant
Recovery/Recycling/Equipment
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recycling/Equipment
Bulletin No.: 08-01-38-001
Date: January 25, 2008
INFORMATION
Subject: Information On New GE-48800 CoolTech Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
Models: 2008 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (Including Saturn) 2008 and
Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2008 Saab 9-7X
Attention:
This bulletin is being issued to announce the release of GM approved Air Conditioning (A/C)
Refrigerant Recovery and Recharging Equipment that meets the new Society of Automotive
Engineers (SAE) J2788 Refrigerant Recovery Standards. The ACR2000 (J-43600) cannot be
manufactured in its current state after December 2007 and will be superseded by GE-48800.
The new J2788 standard does not require that GM Dealers replace their ACR2000 units.
ACR2000's currently in use are very capable of servicing today's refrigerant systems when used
correctly and can continue to be used. Details regarding the new SAE J2788 standard are outlined
in GM Bulletin 07-01-38-004.
Effective February 1 2008, new A/C Refrigerant Recovery/Recharging equipment (P/N GE-48800)
will be released as a required replacement for the previously essential ACR2000 (J-43600). This
equipment is SAE J2788 compliant and meets GM requirements for A/C Refrigerant System
Repairs on all General Motors vehicles, including Hybrid systems with Polyolester (POE)
refrigerant oil. This equipment will not be shipped as an essential tool to GM Dealerships.
In addition, this equipment is Hybrid compliant and designed to prevent oil cross contamination
when servicing Hybrid vehicles with Electric A/C Compressors that use POE refrigerant oil.
The ACR2000 (J-43600) will need to be retrofitted with a J-43600-50 (Hose - ACR2000 Oil Flush
Loop) to be able to perform Hybrid A/C service work. All Hybrid dealers will receive the J-43600-50,
with installation instructions, as a component of the Hybrid essential tool package. Dealerships that
do not sell Hybrids, but may need to service Hybrids, can obtain J-43600-50 from SPX Kent Moore.
Refer to GM Bulletin 08-01-39-001 for the ACR2000 Hose Flush procedure.
The High Voltage (HV) electric A/C compressor used on Two Mode Hybrid vehicles uses a
Polyolester (POE) refrigerant oil instead of a Polyalkylene Glycol (PAG) synthetic refrigerant oil.
This is due to the better electrical resistance of the POE oil and its ability to provide HV isolation.
Failure to flush the hoses before adding refrigerant to a Hybrid vehicle with an electric A/C
compressor may result in an unacceptable amount of PAG oil entering the refrigerant system. It
may cause a Battery Energy Control Module Hybrid Battery Voltage System Isolation Lost
Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC P1AE7) to be set. Additionally, the A/C system warranty will be
voided.
Warranty Submission Requirements
The Electronically Generated Repair Data (snapshot summary) and printer functions have been
eliminated from the GE-48800. The VGA display and temperature probes were eliminated to
reduce equipment costs. As a result, effective immediately the 18 digit "Snapshot/Charge
Summary" code is no longer required for Air Conditioning (A/C) refrigerant system repairs that are
submitted for warranty reimbursement. The charge summary data from before and after system
repairs will continue to required, but documented on the repair order only. Both high and low
pressures and the recovery and charge amounts should be noted during the repair and entered on
the repair order. If using ACR2000 (J-43600), the "Snapshot/Charge Summary" printouts should
continue to be attached to the shops copy of the repair order.
The labor codes that are affected by this requirement are D3000 through D4500.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 06-01-39-007 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Contaminated R134A Refrigerant
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Contaminated R134A Refrigerant
Bulletin No.: 06-01-39-007
Date: July 25, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Contaminated R134a Refrigerant Found on Market for Automotive Air-Conditioning
Systems
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2007 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2007 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Attention:
This bulletin should be directed to the Service Manager as well as the Parts Manager.
Commercially Available Contaminated R134a Refrigerant
Impurities have been found in new commercially available containers of R134a. High levels of
contaminates may cause decreased performance, and be detrimental to some air-conditioning
components. Accompanying these contaminates has been high levels of moisture.
Tip:
Excessive moisture may cause system concerns such as orifice tube freeze-up and reduced
performance.
Industry Reaction: New Industry Purity Standards
Due to the potential availability of these lower quality refrigerants, the Society of Automotive
Engineers (SAE), and the Air Conditioning and Refrigeration Industry (ARI) are in the process of
instituting reliable standards that will be carried on the labels of future R134a refrigerant containers.
This identifying symbol will be your assurance of a product that conforms to the minimum standard
for OEM Automotive Air-Conditioning use.
How Can You Protect Yourself Today?
It is recommended to use GM or ACDelco(R) sourced refrigerants for all A/C repair work. These
refrigerants meet General Motors own internal standards for quality and purity, insuring that your
completed repairs are as good as the way it left the factory.
Parts Information
The part numbers shown are available through GMSPO or ACDelco(R). The nearest ACDelco(R)
distributor in your area can be found by calling 1-800-223-3526 (U.S. Only).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 06-01-39-007 > Jul > 06 > A/C - Contaminated R134A Refrigerant
> Page 6430
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-38-006A > May > 00 > A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge
Equipment
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
File In Section: 01 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 99-01-38-006A
Date: May, 2000
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
Subject: J-43600 ACR 2000 Essential Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
Models: 1993-2000 Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks with R-134a Refrigerant
This bulletin is being revised to change the effective date and to update the text. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 99-01-38-006 (Section 01 - HVAC).
Effective June 1, 2000, the use of J-43600 ACR 2000 will be required on all repairs that require A/C
system recovery and are reimbursable by GM. Additionally, GM highly recommends that J-43600
ACR 2000 be used on all GM cars and trucks for customer paid A/C repairs.
Important:
Also effective June 1, 2000, the "Add" time for all air conditioning recovery is revised to 0.5 hours
for front systems and 0.7 hours for front/rear dual systems (RPO C69 or C34). After June 1, 2000,
all air conditioning claims submitted with the 0.9 hours "Add" time will be rejected for "labor hours
excessive".
After the completion of repairs (charging), the ACR 2000 will prompt the user to perform a snapshot
of the air conditioning system operating data. The snapshot includes:
^ Maximum high side pressure.
^ Minimum low side pressure.
^ Duct outlet temperatures (2).
^ Refrigerant purity information.
This information is captured on a paper printout and in a warranty code.
For all GM paid repairs, the paper printout should be attached to the shop copy of the repair order.
The warranty code must be submitted in the warranty claim information in the comments field. The
code enables the reporting of valuable information about the repair to GM for product quality
improvement. Claims submitted without this information may be subject to review and subsequent
debit.
The required use of J-43600 ACR 2000 raises the question of the acceptable uses for any existing
recovery/recycle equipment that GM dealers are currently using. GM recognizes that many of the
previously essential ACR4's are reaching the end of their useful life. There are several alternatives
for existing equipment that may be considered:
^ Use the existing equipment as customer paid recovery only equipment. Example: Collision repair
area.
^ Use the existing equipment as a scavenger unit for contaminated A/C systems.
^ Sell the existing units to repair facilities outside the GM dealer network.
^ Discontinue the use of the existing units if the repair/maintenance costs exceed the value of the
equipment.
^ Donate the existing equipment to local technical schools.
^ Dedicate the ACR4 to A/C system flushing, using the J-42939 Flush Adapter.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 99-01-38-006A > May > 00 > A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge
Equipment > Page 6435
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a
Technical Service Bulletin # 431207E Date: 970101
A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a
File In Section: 1 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 43-12-07E
Date: January, 1997
INFORMATION
Subject: Guidelines for Retrofitting R-12 Vehicles to R-134a
Models: 1984-94 Passenger Cars and Trucks (See List Below)
This bulletin is being revised with the following changes:
1. Addition of all remaining GM vehicles, as listed.
2. Format rearranged for easier use.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 43-12-07D (Section 1 - HVAC).
Car/Truck Platform Coverage Starts:
1984 - A, B, D, E, F, J, K, P, Y Carlines
1985 - C, M, N, R, S Carlines
1986 - H Carline
1987 - L, V (Allante) Car lines; M/L, G, R/V, S/T, P Truck lines
1988 - T (LeMans), E (Reatta), W Car lines; C/k, MED. Duty Truck lines
1989 - Tracker
1990 - U Van
Vehicles Not Covered: T (Chevette and T1000), G RWD, C RWD, and X Car
If a vehicle is not covered in the list above, GM's recommendation is that the vehicle continue to be
serviced with R-12.
This bulletin outlines the detailed retrofit procedures, as well as providing background information
on many components and procedures. It is important to follow the bulletin, since each car and truck
line has unique parts and procedures. However, the basic procedure is simple, and will become
easier as you complete more retrofits.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page
6440
Retrofit Requirements
The customer should be reminded that there is NO requirement in the U.S. to retrofit any vehicle
produced with R-12. Vehicles built with R-12 can be serviced with R-12 as long as it is available
(except in certain Canadian Provinces). GM has taken steps to extend the supply of R-12 and
recommends that all R-12 vehicles continue to be serviced with R-12 as long as it is available.
Training Video
Before doing a retrofit the first time, it is recommended that you view the Certified Plus Training
Video, Program number 51010.15, "R-134a Retrofit for GM Cars and Trucks".
Table of Contents
A. Retrofit Procedure
1. Inspect Condition of Vehicle
2. Recover the R-12 (new method)
3. Install the service port conversion fittings
4. Install any additional parts needed
5. Evacuate and recharge with new PAG or V5 retrofit oil and R-134a
6. Install the retrofit label
Platform Details
Compressor Replacement Chart
B. General Information
1. Performance
2. Leakage
3. Desiccant
4. Improved Cooling Performance
5. PAG or V5 Oil Compatibility
6. Refrigerant Oil Level
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page
6441
C. Parts Information
D. Warranty Information
1. Vehicle Still in Warranty
2. Customer Paid' Retrofitting Costs
3. Labor Time Information
Notes on Retrofit
Important:
Before proceeding with any retrofit, make sure you have all component Parts required on hand to
perform a proper and complete repair with Minimal downtime.
R-12 Removal Prior to Retrofit
To prepare a system for retrofitting, the R-12 must be recovered and the system must be
completely evacuated. Evacuation is necessary to insure that small amounts of R-12 and air
remaining in the system are removed. This will prevent cross contamination of the two refrigerants,
which could lead to reduced A/C system reliability and performance.
It is very important that the specified times for waiting after recovery and evacuation not be
reduced. This time is required to sufficiently remove residual R-12 from the oil in the system.
A considerable amount of testing has determined that the following procedure is required to
achieve satisfactory results and conform to SAE J 1661:
1. Inspect Condition of Vehicle
Install the gauge set on the high and low side ports.
Use normal diagnostic procedures to find the cause of the vehicle's reported condition. One of
three conditions will exist with the refrigerant system:
a. System pressure correct, no leaks - proceed to Step 2 (Recovery). This would normally apply
when:
1. The system must be recovered/recharged for a repair to a system other than the A/C system, or
2. Where the A/C system condition did not involve leaks, but requires recovery/recharge to replace
a component.
b. Compressor not operating, but some charge. Leak test to find the leak, complete Step 2
(Recovery), then correct the leak before proceeding with Step 3 (Conversion port installation).
c. No charge in system - proceed with the Conversion port installation in Step 3. Use the ACR4 to
evacuate for 5 minutes. If the leak can be heard, repair the leak. If the leak cannot be heard,
charge with 1/2 pound of R-134a. Leak test with the J 39400 Leak Detector, recover the R-134a,
repair any additional leaks found, and proceed with the evacuation in Step 5.
2. Recover the R-12 from the System
Notice:
THIS PROCEDURE IS DIFFERENT THAN THE NORMAL (NON-RETROFIT) RECOVERY
PROCEDURE. R-12 will be recovered through the HIGH SIDE SERVICE PORT ONLY, WITH THE
ENGINE RUNNING. Recovery through the low side will not effectively remove the R-12 from the
accumulator, resulting in possible damage to the retrofitted system.
Important:
Vehicle must be above 50° F (10° C) to allow for complete recovery of the R-12. If it is not, either
allow it to warm up in the shop overnight, or increase the evacuation time in Step 5.a to 30 minutes.
a. Connect the recovery hose from the R-12 recovery cart (ACR3) to the middle port of the A/C
gauge set. Open the oil drain valve on the ACR3 cart long enough to drain the oil. Failure to do so
could cause excessive amounts of oil to build up in the separator, resulting in damage to the
recovery cart compressor.
b. Start the engine. Leave the hood up, and the windows open. On vehicles with manual A/C
controls, set the A/C controls to normal A/C mode, high blower, and temperature control to full cold.
On cars with automatic A/C controls, set the temperature to 75° F, "AUTO" mode, and manually
select high blower.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page
6442
Make sure the vehicle compressor is engaged. Turn the cart on and start the recovery cycle. OPEN
ONLY THE HIGH SIDE VALVE ON THE GAUGE SET. The vehicle system should eventually shut
the compressor off. If the low side pressure drops below 15 psi, and the compressor does not turn
off, turn it off now (go to "VENT" or "ECON" mode), but leave the engine running and the blower on
"high".
c. After the recovery cart shuts off the first time, wait 5 minutes. If the pressure on either the high or
the low side rises above 0 psi, restart the recovery process. After the second shutoff, wait 2
minutes. If the pressure again rises above 0 psi, restart, and after shutoff, again wait 2 minutes.
The process can be stopped when the pressure does not rise above 0 psi after 2 minutes. The
engine can be shut off at this time.
d. Remove the R-12 reclaim hose and the gauge set from the vehicle.
Any repairs needed should be done at this time. If any components other than the compressor are
replaced, they should be installed dry, and no extra oil should be added.
3. Install the Service Port Conversion Fittings
Important:
For GEO vehicles, skip to Step 4. Fitting installation is covered in that step. For vehicles that
require a HPCOS, see Step 4. Some of these vehicles use a specific combination fitting to mount
the HPCOS, which includes the high side service port fitting and the HPCOS port. The low side
fitting is installed as detailed below. See "Platform Details" for further information.
Important:
A new tool kit, P/N J 39500-250, has been released. This kit contains the following items:
^ J 39500-71 Oil Injection Bottle Conversion Kit (includes 3 12 oz bottles, an extender tube, caps,
and fittings)
^ J 39500-275 Tool kit, including the following: (See Figure 2)
- J 34611-A Double ended valve core remover
- J 25498-A High side adapter fitting
- J 38702 Deep valve core adapter fitting
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page
6443
- J 41265 Thread cleaning wire brush
- J 41266 Low side port thread restorer
- J 41267 High side port thread restorer
- J 39037 High side octagon socket
- J 41256 Low side octagon socket
New low profile, quick connect couplers, J 39500-20A (High side), and J 39500-24A (Low side),
have been released as essential tools, to attach to the ACR4 (see Figure 3). These are much
smaller couplers than the existing ones, and will allow attachment to the port fittings in much tighter
quarters.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page
6444
Select and install the proper R-134a fittings (shown in Figure 4) from the chart below, based on
how the ACR4 couplers will attach. Also, remember to check for proper hood clearance with the
conversion fittings. Try the straight fittings first. The two-piece high side fitting is used when the
existing fitting is screwed into the pipe fitting (some 1992, and nearly all 1993 models, use these
fittings). Use the 90° elbow if the straight fitting does not allow the ACR4 couplers to connect.
Fitting Type High Side Low Side
Straight 52467941 52467943
Straight Two-piece 52467324 N/A
90° Elbow 52469054 52469055
The fittings should be installed as follows:
a. Remove the caps from the R-12 fittings. Remove any dirt or grease from the port threads using
the thread cleaning wire brush, J 41265. Inspect the fittings for thread damage. If any damage is
found, use the port thread restorer (J 41266 low side, J 41267 high side) to repair the thread.
For the two-piece fitting, remove the existing R-12 fitting and discard it. Use tool J 38704A
(previously released, not part of the above kit) to remove the fitting. Make sure to hold the line
securely to prevent damage when removing the existing fitting. If the fitting cannot be removed
easily, use the saddle clamp valve listed below and seal the R-12 port and cap permanently.
b. Install the selected fitting onto the existing R-12 fitting. Leave the valve core in the straight
fittings, and remove the valve core when using the 90° fittings.
If the valve cores need to be removed at a later time, they can be removed with the straight
conversion fittings in place. On the low side straight fitting, use the J 34611-A tool to remove the
core pin in the conversion fitting, then remove the core valve from the original R-12 fitting. Always
recover the charge before valve core removal.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page
6445
Use the octagon sockets on the straight fittings (J 39037 high side, and J 41256 low side). Torque
the new fitting until it seats. The fitting should seat fully BEFORE reaching 11 N.m (8 lb ft). If 11
N.m (8 lb ft) of torque is reached and the fitting has not seated, it is probable that the threads have
been damaged. In this case, remove the fitting and use the thread restorer listed above. Reinstall
the fitting, adding one drop of a thread locking compound such as Loctite(R) 242.
The fittings (except the two-piece) have a thread locking compound applied to the threads. This
compound will set up enough to restrict removal of the fitting in about 15 minutes. The fittings can
now be used to evacuate the system (see Step 5).
An additional type of conversion port fitting has been developed. This fitting is called a saddle
clamp valve (see Figure 5). It can be clamped directly on a metal refrigerant line, and will be used if
the existing fitting is damaged or is inaccessible. A drop of a thread locking compound, such as
Loctite(R) 242, should be used on each bolt to prevent the threads from loosening.
The R134a saddle clamp valve part numbers are:
If an existing R-12 service port is not used, it must be rendered inoperative. Place several drops of
a thread locking compound, such as Loctite(R) 243, in the valve core, and onto the cap threads.
Secure the cap and let it set for 15 minutes.
4. Install Any Additional Parts Needed
See "Platform Details" after Step 6. If a vehicle is listed as a "Basic Retrofit", no additional parts are
required (except for compressors, see the Compressor Replacement Chart at the beginning of
Platform Details). If no parts are required, PROCEED TO STEP 5.
Compressors
Compressors do not need to be replaced as part of a normal retrofit, unless indicated in the
Compressor Replacement Chart. An R-12 compressor that is operating properly can, in most
cases, be left in the vehicle when it is retrofitted to R134a. However, if a compressor failure is the
reason the vehicle is in for service, and the vehicle will be retrofitted, OR if a vehicle has already
been retrofitted with R-134a and the compressor fails at some time in the future, new compressors
for use with R-134a are available. See the GMSPO Parts Catalog for specific part numbers. DO
NOT use a replacement R-12 compressor for any vehicle retrofitted to R-134a (unless it is the new
"oil-less" design). See "Compressor Availability" at the end of the Compressor Replacement Chart.
Accumulator /Dryer
If the vehicle is more than 5 years old, the Accumulator/Dryer (A/D) should be replaced to ensure
that moisture is removed from the system. See the instructions for proper A/D identification in
General Information.
High Pressure Cut-Off Switch (HPCOS)
Most trucks, and some 1984-93 B and D cars, require that a HPCOS be added to protect the
refrigerant system during long idles at high temperature. The HPCOS kit (P/N 15981985) contains
the switch, wire harness, heat sealing splice connectors, switch "0" ring, and installation
instructions. A saddle clamp adapter (P/N 15985307), or a special dual fitting, is mounted to the
high pressure line, and provides the port to mount the switch. A drop of a
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page
6446
thread locking compound, such as Loctite(R) 242, should be used on each bolt of the saddle clamp
to prevent the threads from loosening.
Some vehicles produced during the second half of the 1993 model year will already have a factory
installed HPCOS. Check the back of the compressor for this switch. If present, the above switch
will not have to be added.
5. Evacuate the System, and Recharge with PAG or V5 Retrofit Oil and R-134a
Newly designed low profile quick connect couplers for the ACR4, J 39500-20A and J 39500-24A,
have been released. These should be installed before proceeding with the evacuation. See Step 3,
and Figure 3.
a. Connect the R-134a cart (ACR4) to the system. Open the coupler valves on the hoses so that
the pressures can be read on the gauges. On the cart, open the HIGH SIDE VALVE ONLY. DO
NOT OPEN THE LOW SIDE VALVE! Program the cart for a 15 minute evacuation.
Important:
If the vehicle has been at outside temperatures of less than 50° F (10° C), or at high altitudes
(above 3000 ft), use a 30 minute evacuation to insure complete removal of the R-12.
If the vacuum pump will not start and a "H-P" reading is indicated on the ACR4 display, loosen the
fitting at the high side line connection to the ACR4 to relieve pressure in the line. Tighten the fitting
after pressure has been relieved. DO NOT USE THE RECOVERY MODE TO RELIEVE LINE
PRESSURE.
b. Start the evacuation. For a proper evacuation, the cart must pull down to 28-29 in. Hg. at sea
level (reduce by 1 in. for each 1000 ft above sea level). Check the low side gauge for proper
vacuum level, to make sure the new fittings are operating properly.
While the evacuation is being done, the Retrofit label can be filled out and installed (see Step 6).
Important:
If the compressor was replaced at the same time as this retrofit, and the new compressor was
shipped with the correct amount of PAG oil already in it, DO NOT add any additional oil to the
system! Go to Step D. If an "oil-less" compressor was installed, add oil in Step C.
A new retrofit oil for use with V5 compressor vehicles has been released. This oil will be used
ONLY for retrofitted vehicles in which the original V5 compressor is retained. IT WILL NOT BE
USED IF A COMPRESSOR IS REPLACED AT THE TIME OF THE RETROFIT. Failure to use this
oil may significantly shorten the useful life of the compressor.
Important:
If the V5 Retrofit oil is not available from GMSPO, the compressor MUST BE REPLACED!
To summarize the correct retrofit oil usage:
^ Compressor replaced during retrofit
- NO OIL ADDED if new compressor shipped with oil
- 8 oz. of PAG oil (9 oz of PAG oil with V5 compressor) added if compressor shipped without oil
("oil-less" design)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page
6447
^ PAG oil used for future service if needed (mark PAG on box on label, Figure 6).
^ HR6 or R4 original compressor RETAINED - add 8 oz FAG oil to system
^ V5 original compressor RETAINED - add 9 oz V5 Retrofit oil to system. If V5 Retrofit oil is not
available from GMSPO, REPLACE THE COMPRESSOR.
c. Based on the above chart, add oil if needed. Use the new oil bottle and the extended tube kit, J
39500-71. Fill the bottle with at least 10 oz of oil. Attach the new bottle to the back of the ACR4,
and open the oil fill valve. Allow the correct amount of oil to be drawn into the system. DO NOT
allow the oil level to drop below the end of the pickup tube. This will prevent any air from being
drawn into the system. If any oil was removed during the R-12 recovery evacuation steps, DO NOT
add additional oil to replace it.
d. Determine the correct amount of R-134a to use. Check the existing label of the vehicle for the
R-12 charge amount.
Use the formula {(R12 x .9) - .25 lb = R-134a} to determine the correct charge. This can also be
stated as: Take 90% of the R12 charge, and subtract 1/4 lb.
Follow the directions for the ACR4 cart to recharge the system. At the end of the process, "CPL"
will be displayed. Close the high side valve.
e. Start the vehicle, turn on the A/C system, and confirm that pressures are within normal operating
ranges, as shown in the 1994 Service Manual. The 1994 Service Manuals can be used as a
reference for diagnosis and specification of retrofitted systems.
On some vehicles with automatic A/C controls or low charge diagnostics, the A/C compressor may
not engage if any diagnostic codes were set during the retrofit. Check to see if any codes were set
in either the HVAC or Engine Control systems. If they were, clear the codes following the directions
in the Service Manual.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page
6448
f. TO INSURE AN ACCURATE CHARGE AMOUNT, IT IS IMPORTANT TO CLEAR THE ACR4 OF
ANY REMAINING REFRIGERANT. Close the high side coupler valve and remove the high side
hose from the vehicle. Then, open both the high and low side valves on the ACR4. After the
pressures on both gages are at low side pressure, close the low side coupler valve. See Step G
below, then remove the low side hose from the vehicle. Shut off the engine. Install the service port
caps on the new fittings. These serve as a seal and can prevent system leaks.
g. In the unlikely event that the low side fitting leaks when the coupler is removed, use the following
procedure:
1. Immediately reinstall the coupler on the fitting.
2. Find the valve core remover J 34611-A.
3. Remove the coupler.
4. Use the double-ended valve core remover to turn the valve core pin counter-clockwise until the
leak stops.
5. Install the cap.
If the leak was substantial or continued for an extended period of time, it is highly recommended to
evacuate and recharge the system to insure proper performance. If there is any question, the
system can be rechecked by repeating Step F.
h. Leak test any new port fittings, adapters, or valves that were installed, and any joints that were
opened or repaired during the retrofit process, using tool J 39400.
6. Install the Retrofit Label
The retrofit label (P/N 21030857, roll of 250) has been developed following SAF specifications to
insure a smooth transition from R-12 to R-134a, and to insure a professional approach to the
retrofit and a quality repair. Following the instructions in this bulletin will insure that the retrofit
meets the SAE standards.
Fill in the new label using a typewriter or a ball-point pen (see Figure 6). Select a location for the
label that will be easily visible. Some suggested areas are the radiator support panel, an area near
the existing R-12 charge label, or a flat surface near the high or low side service ports. The area
selected should be a clean, underhood, painted sheet metal surface, and should be degreased and
wiped down with a non-petroleum based cleaner. Do not install the label on a rubber surface. Apply
the label, then apply the clear overlay to the label.
Do not remove, cover, or render unreadable the existing R-12 charge label. DO cover the R-12
refrigerant charge amount on the existing label with an indelible, preferably black, marker.
Platform Details
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page
6449
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page
6450
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page
6451
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page
6452
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page
6453
FOR ALL VEHICLES EXCEPT GEO, see the "Compressor Replacement Chart" at the end of this
section. Compressor replacement requirements ARE NOT LISTED in the platform details (except
for application details), except as noted below for Y car and P and Medium Duty truck.
Compressor Replacement Chart
Important:
It is important to check the date code on the compressor. Any vehicle may have had a compressor
replaced either during or after the warranty period. The date code will determine whether or not the
compressor must be replaced.
Compressor Availability
A new compressor for use with R-134a systems will be shipped with the correct amount of PAG oil
installed (see "IMPORTANT" below). Do not add any additional oil in Step 5 of the retrofit
procedure if a compressor is to be replaced with a new R-134a compressor at the same time the
initial retrofit is
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page
6454
being done.
Important:
During 1996, "oil-less" compressors began to be serviced with NO added oil. New part numbers
will be issued, and both the box and the compressor will be clearly marked to indicate that no oil is
present. If you receive one of these newer compressors, simply add the normal amount of oil to the
system in Step 5 of the retrofit procedure (8 oz of PAG oil, or 9 oz of PAG oil with V5 compressor).
These "oil-less" compressors are compatible with EITHER R12 or R-134a.
Geo Models
Compressors DO NOT HAVE TO BE REPLACED as part of the retrofit. New compressors are
shipped with enough oil to accommodate the entire A/C system. Do not add additional PAG oil to
the system it the compressor is being replaced.
1985-88 Nova, 1989-93 Prizm (S)
1. Using the Service Manual, remove the following components in the order given:
a. Receiver/dryer.
b. Loosen evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe (to be reinstalled)
c. 1985-92 only: Loosen compressor to condenser (compressor discharge) pipe (to be reinstalled).
d. 1985-88 only: Service Valve & Extension Housing on compressor (to be installed).
e. Compressor (only if being replaced).
2. Using the Service Manual, install the following components in the order given. Be sure to use
new 0-rings whenever a refrigerant connection has been disconnected.
a. Compressor (if being replaced).
b. High and low side adapter fittings (see Step 3 of the retrofit procedure for detailed installation
instructions).
c. 1985-88 only: Service Valve & Extension Housing on compressor using new 0-rings. Six small
0-rings and one large 0-ring are required.
d. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe 0-ring.
e. 1985-92 Compressor to condenser (discharge) hose 0-ring.
f. Receiver/dryer and 0-rings.
R-134a amount: 85-92 - 650 grams (1.43 lb)
93 - 700 grams (1.54 lb) PAG oil amount: 100 cc (3.0 oz) Parts Required:
Receiver/dryer:
85-88 - 94855761
89-93 - 94855762
Adapter Fittings:
Low Side - 94855760
High Side - 94855759
0-Rings:
85-88 Compressor - Small 0-rings (6 required) - 94857336 - Large 0-ring - 94857337
85-93 Receiver/Dryer (2) - 94845949
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page
6455
85-93 Suction hose - 94855765
85-92 Discharge hose - 94845943
1985-88 Sprint, 1989-93 Metro (M)
1. Using the Service Manual, remove the following components in the order given:
a. Receiver/dryer.
b. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe.
c. Compressor to condenser (compressor discharge) pipe.
d. Joint service connector on compressor (to be reinstalled).
e. Compressor (only if being replaced).
2. Using the Service Manual, install the following components in the the order given. Be sure to use
new 0-rings whenever a refrigerant connection has been disconnected.
a. Compressor (if being replaced).
b. High and low side adapter fittings (see Step 3 of the retrofit procedure for detailed installation
instructions).
c. Joint service connector to compressor. Use new 0-rings. Six small 0-rings and one large 0-ring
are required.
d. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe, and new 0-ring.
e. Compressor to condenser (discharge) hose and new 0-ring.
f. Receiver/dryer and 0-ring.
R-134a amount: 500 grams (1.10 lb)
PAG oil amount: 100 cc (3.0 oz)
Parts Required:
Receiver/dryer:
85-86 - 91172081
87-88 - 91172079
89-93 - 96068480
Adapter Fittings:
Low Side - 91172092
85-88 - High Side - 91172094
89-93 - High Side - 52467941
0-Rings:
Compressor - Small 0-rings (6 required)
- 91172095
- Large 0-ring - 96068915
Receiver/Dryer (2) - 96068488
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page
6456
89-93 - Suction hose - 96068490
89-93 - Discharge hose - 96068489
Suction hose:
85-86 - 91172086
85-86 Dealer installed: 91172087
87-88 - 91172088
89-93 - w/turbo - 96069121 - w/o turbo
- 91172089
Discharge hose:
85-86 - 91172082
85-86 Dealer installed: 91172083
87-88 - 91172084
89-93 - 96069024
1989-93 Tracker
1. Using the Service Manual, remove the following components in the order given:
a. Receiver/dryer.
b. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe.
c. Compressor to condenser (compressor discharge) pipe.
d. Joint service connector on compressor (to be reinstalled).
e. Compressor (only if being replaced).
2. Using the Service Manual, install the following components in the order given. Be sure to use
new 0-rings whenever a refrigerant connection has been disconnected.
a. Compressor (if being replaced).
b. High and low side adapter fittings (see Step 3 of the Retrofit procedure for detailed installation
instructions).
c. Joint service connector to compressor. Use new 0-rings. Six small 0-rings and one large 0-ring
are required.
d. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe, and new 0-ring.
e. Compressor to condenser (discharge) hose and new 0-ring.
f. Receiver/dryer and 0-ring.
R-134a amount: 550 grams (1.21 lb)
PAG oil amount: 100 cc (3.0 oz)
Parts Required:
Receiver/dryer - 91172080
Adapter, Low Side - 91172092
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page
6457
Adapter, High Side - 91172093
0-Rings:
Compressor - Small (6) - 91172095 Large - 96068915
Receiver/dryer (2) - 96068488
Suction hose - 96068490
Discharge hose - 96068489
Suction hose - 91172091
Discharge hose - 91172085
1985-89 Spectrum and 1990-93 Storm (R)
1. Using the Service Manual, remove the following components in the order given:
a. Condenser (Storm) or radiator grille (Spectrum) (to be reinstalled).
b. Triple switch (Storm) or dual pressure switch (Spectrum) (to be reinstalled).
c. Receiver/dryer.
d. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe.
e. Check valve from high side service valve (discard).
f. Compressor (only if being replaced).
2. Using the Service Manual, install the following components in the order given. Be sure to use
new 0-rings whenever a refrigerant connection has been disconnected.
a. Compressor (if being replaced).
b. High side adapter fitting (see Step 3 of the retrofit procedure for detailed installation instructions).
Low Side - Part of suction hose
c. Evaporator to compressor (suction) pipe, and new 0-rings.
d. Receiver/dryer and 0-rings.
e. Triple switch or dual switch, and new 0-ring.
f. Condenser or radiator grille.
R-134a amount: 91 - 500 grams (1.10 lb)
92-93 - 600 grams (1.32 lb)
PAG oil amount: 150 cc (4.50 oz)
Parts Required:
Receiver/dryer:
85-89 - 97104795
90-91 - 97104797
92-93 - 97104798
Adapter, High Side:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page
6458
85-89 - 97104794
90-93 - 97104793
Adapter, Low Side: Part of Hose Asm.
0-rings:
Receiver/dryer 85-91 - 94154048
92-93 - 94461700
Switch/pipe - 94461902
Suction hose:
85-86: 1.5L - 97104799; 1.6L - 97104800
90-93: 1.6L - 97104801; 1.8L - 97104803
B. General Information
Several items affecting the performance and durability of the system should be considered:
1. Performance
When performed properly, the retrofit from R-12 to R-134a will have minimal effect on the system's
performance in most climatic conditions found in the United States and Canada.
2. Leakage
Experience has shown that most leakage in an A/C system is due to leaks at the joints, or through
a small leak in a hose, usually at the coupling. The R-134a molecules are smaller than R-12, and a
small leak may result in a faster loss of refrigerant with R-134a. Because of this, it is very important
to leak check all vehicles using the J 39400 leak detector, BEFORE the retrofit is performed, and
repair any leaks found.
"0" rings and hoses used in most GM vehicles are compatible with R-134a and do not need
replacement during a retrofit. "0" rings or hoses installed in previous repairs may have been of
non-compatible materials if GM parts were not used and will be more likely to deteriorate and leak
than the original equipment materials. All "0" rings and hoses available through GMSP0 are
compatible with R-134a. Remember that the normal policy is to replace the "0" rings whenever a
joint is opened for any reason.
3. Desiccant
You may have heard that the currently used desiccant in the accumulator is not compatible with
R-134a. Extensive testing has shown that it is, in fact, suitable for use with R-134a, once it has
been in service in an R-12 system. The accumulator in these models will not have to be changed
during the retrofit procedure, unless the vehicle is more than 5 years old. Vehicles more than 5
years old should have the A/D replaced to add new desiccant for proper system drying.
In the event that an accumulator/dryer (A/D) needs to be replaced on a retrofitted system in the
future, only A/D's with XH-7 desiccant should be used. The service parts for the 1993 vehicles
contain only XH-7 desiccant. The parts for the 1992 and older vehicles may contain either XH-5 or
XH-7. Parts containing XH-7 can be identified (see Figure 1) by 1) an "A" printed on the top of the
A/D; or 2) if there is a label on top of the A/D, there will be a square with an "A" inside; or 3) if there
is a time code and date printed on top of the A/D just under the "Harrison" logo, the A/D contains
XH-7. A/D's containing XH-5 can still be used on R-12 vehicles.
4. Improved Cooling Performance
There have been service bulletins issued in the past with information improving the cooling
performance of existing R-12 systems. These bulletins can also be used to improve the
performance of retrofitted vehicles in high ambient temperature climates.
5. PAG or V5 Oil Compatibility
Contrary to information published to date outside of General Motors, mineral oil and PAG or V5 oil
ARE chemically compatible. The mineral oil left in the system after reclaiming the R-12 can remain
in the system with no harmful effects. However, the mineral oil will not mix with the R-134a, and so
will not circulate and perform its lubricating function. Testing has shown that most of the mineral oil
will eventually collect in the
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page
6459
accumulator. The system will operate properly as long as refrigerant charge amounts are strictly
adhered to.
6. Refrigerant Charge Level
The retrofit R-134a charge level is more critical than with R-12 systems. Overcharging may push
the mineral oil out of the AID, and cause it to circulate as a liquid. This is more likely to result in
compressor damage. Undercharging may lead to loss of performance. It is very important to clear
the hoses during the charging operation, to insure that all the refrigerant is delivered to the vehicle
A/C system. This is covered in Step 6D of the Retrofit Procedure.
C. Parts Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page
6460
Important:
All of the following parts are NOT NEEDED for a normal retrofit. Follow the bulletin procedures to
determine which parts you need! Individual vehicle kits are not necessary, since most of the parts
are generic and only a few parts are needed for most vehicles.
GEO Parts are listed in "Platform Details."
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
D. Warranty Information
1. Vehicle Still Within the Original New Vehicle Limited Warranty Period
When GM models for the years listed in the bulletin require repairs to the refrigerant system and
the vehicles are still covered under the New
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431207E > Jan > 97 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 to R-134a > Page
6461
Vehicle Limited Warranty, dealers are instructed to proceed as follows:
Important:
On vehicles equipped with A/C systems NOT produced by GM (i.e., rear A/C systems in van
conversions), consult the manufacturer of that A/C system for retrofit guidelines.
^ Offer the customer the option of repairing and recharging the system with R12, or retrofitting after
repair and recharging with R-134a at no additional charge.
^ Provide the owner with, and review the information contained in, the "Converting Your Auto Air
Conditioning System to Use the New Refrigerant" brochure. (Brochure, Form GM-0011, can be
ordered free of charge from GM Fulfillment HQ, Phone 1-800-269-5100).
^ Record the customer's choice on the repair order and, as with all properly completed repair
orders, ask the customer to sign on the appropriate line acknowledging the repairs requested.
^ Under no circumstances should the retrofit to R-134a be performed unless the customer has had
the option explained prior to repair. Once the vehicle has been retrofitted to R-134a, a significant
expenditure would be incurred to go back to R-12, in the event the customer has changed his/her
mind.
THIS OFFER APPLIES ONLY TO VEHICLES REQUIRING A/C REFRIGERANT SYSTEM
REPAIRS UNDER THE TERMS OF THE NEW VEHICLE LIMITED WARRANTY. It is not a special
policy, and any existing deductibles still apply. This is simply an option being offered to the
customer during the warranty period at this time. GM reserves the right to terminate this offer at
any time.
If the R-12 refrigerant system does not require discharging for a warranty repair, but the customer
requests a retrofit to R-134a, the retrofit WOULD BE PERFORMED AT THE CUSTOMER'S
EXPENSE, EVEN DURING THE WARRANTY PERIOD.
2. Customer Paid Retrofitting Costs
If the customer requests a retrofit to R-134a, for a specific vehicle whose retrofit parts and
procedures have been released in this bulletin, the customer would be expected to pay the costs to
retrofit under the following conditions:
^ The vehicle is no longer covered by the terms of the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
^ The vehicle is covered by warranty, but the repair covered under the warranty does not require
evacuating and recharging the refrigerant system.
3. Labor Time Information
For Vehicles Repaired Under Warranty: Use existing labor operations for correcting the original
condition. The quantity of R-134a used should be charged to the normal labor operation (not
D4500), just as if it were R-12.
Use D4500, 0.3 HR., to charge for parts and labor, for all of the following items:
^ Additional time for recovery of R-12 to meet SAE standards;
^ Install high and low side service port converter fittings;
^ Add PAG or V5 retrofit oil;
^ Complete label information and install.
Add 0.2 hours to D4500 for installation of the HPCOS.
Use T5321, 0.3 HR., for the Pontiac Bonneville hood seal installation.
ANY PARTS OR LABOR TIME OTHER THAN THOSE LISTED ABOVE SHOULD BE CHARGED
TO THE REGULAR LABOR OPERATION CORRESPONDING TO THE ORIGINAL CONDITION
THAT 1S BEING REPAIRED.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 631209 > May > 96 > A/C - R12 or R134a Service
Recommendations
Technical Service Bulletin # 631209 Date: 960501
A/C - R12 or R134a Service Recommendations
File In Section: 1 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 63-12-09
Date: May, 1996
INFORMATION
Subject: Service Issues for Vehicles with R12 or R134a Air Conditioning Systems
Models: 1988-96 Passenger Cars and Trucks
R12 Service Recommendations
As you know, production of R12 refrigerant ceased on December 31, 1995. Although R12 will no
longer be manufactured, there is a reserve supply of R12 available. This reserve, along with strict
A/C repair service adherence to proper refrigerant recycling procedures, should assure continued
availability to meet consumers' needs.
R12 can and should continue to be used to service vehicles built with R12 A/C systems as long as
it is available. If R12 is no longer available or affordable, a system retrofit utilizing R134a is
recommended. R134a IS THE ONLY SUBSTITUTE REFRIGERANT RECOMMENDED BY GM
FOR USE IN GM VEHICLE A/C SYSTEMS, AND THEN ONLY AFTER FOLLOWING THE
PROPER RETROFIT PROCEDURES FOR THE SPECIFIC MODEL. All new vehicle
manufacturers have chosen R134a for retrofit. One of the key reasons is to protect both the service
industry and consumers from the high costs that would result from purchasing equipment
necessary to service multiple refrigerants. This position also reduces the threat of recycled
refrigerant contamination.
GM currently offers a simple, low cost R12 to R134a retrofit on many of its late model, front wheel
drive passenger cars. Dealers should discuss this capability with owners of these specific models,
listed in Retrofit Corporate Bulletin # 43-12-07D, whenever a repair to the A/C refrigerant system is
required. Early retrofit of these specific models will aid in prolonging availability of the R12 supply
and provide dealer service technicians the opportunity to become more familiar with the proper
procedures for performing a retrofit.
Remember - R12 and R134a refrigerant are not interchangeable! They cannot be mixed together.
In fact, despite the claims of some refrigerant manufacturers, no proposed R12 refrigerant
substitute can be added to, mixed with or used to "top off" an R12 system. Under provisions of law
covering the service of refrigerants, mixing dissimilar refrigerant products during service is
prohibited.
To Summarize GM R12 Service Policy
1. Service R12 vehicles with good quality new or recycled R12 as long as it is available.
2. Purchase R12 from a reliable supplier. GMSPO has a supply of high quality R12 available.
Dealers are requested to use only R12 supplied by GMSPO for warranty repairs. This high quality
refrigerant will insure system performance and avoid the possibility of introducing contaminated
material into the customer's A/C system.
3. Carefully test recovered R12 using the PureGuard monitor. On recovery equipment not
protected by the PureGuard, always test the recovery cylinder prior to recharging a vehicle A/C
system.
4. Discuss the R12 to R134a retrofit option with owners of GM vehicles listed in Retrofit Corporate
Bulletin # 43-12-07D. Provide owner with a copy of the pamphlet "Converting Your Auto Air
Conditioning System to Use the New Refrigerant".
5. Become familiar with retrofit procedures and exercise care in the handling of dissimilar
refrigerants to prevent contamination.
R134A Service Recommendations
When servicing a previously retrofitted vehicle, there is concern that if all of the R12 is not
completely removed prior to the retrofit procedure, it could contaminate your R134a equipment and
recovery tank when a subsequent A/C repair is performed. Although the number of retrofits being
performed today is minimal, the volume will increase as R12 prices rise.
GM Service Technology Group is in the process of field testing a new R134a refrigerant purity
tester similar to the PureGuard R12 refrigerant tester you now use. This new tool will mount to your
ACR4 R134a Recovery Recycle and Recharge cart and sample all R134a refrigerant prior to
recovery. It is expected that testing of this tool will be completed this year.
This new tool, the Pureguard 2, will also test vehicles and your recycle tank for air contamination,
which is threatening A/C system performance. High levels of air have been found in the recovery
tanks on a number of R12 and R134a recovery carts. Air contamination is caused by improper
recovery
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 631209 > May > 96 > A/C - R12 or R134a Service
Recommendations > Page 6466
procedures and short-cutting refrigerant recycling times. Use the following procedure for testing
and correcting air contamination in your A/C service equipment.
1. Make certain that the ACR4 equipment has not been used for at least 12 hours. It is
recommended that the equipment be left in an area where the temperature will remain constant
overnight to allow the temperature of the refrigerant in the tank to stabilize.
2. Record the surrounding air temperature next to the ACR4 refrigerant tank.
Important:
A major assumption is that the ambient air temperature next to the tank represents the refrigerant
temperature in the tank. Failure to take care in measuring the temperature could result in
unnecessary work.
3. Close both liquid (blue) and vapor (red) valves on the ACR4 tank.
4. Disconnect low side (blue) service hose from the back of the ACR4.
5. Slowly disconnect the tank vapor hose (red) from the back of the ACR4 and connect it to the low
side service port.
6. Open the vapor (red) valve on the tank and record the tank pressure on the low side gage.
7. Restore hoses to the original position.
8. Referring to the Table, find the ambient temperature measured in Step 2. Compare the pressure
reading from Step 6 to the "maximum allowable pressure". If the pressure reading from Step 6 is
less than the "maximum allowable pressure", no further action is necessary.
Important:
The closer the tank pressure is to the desired tank pressure, the better the A/C system will perform.
9. If the pressure reading from Step 6 exceeds the maximum allowable pressure from the Table,
open both tank valves and operate the ACR4 through 4 or 5 evacuation cycles. This will activate
the automatic air purge to lower the tank pressure.
Important:
Station should not be connected to vehicle.
10. Repeat the tank pressure checking procedure the next day to determine if the pressure has
been reduced to acceptable levels. If the tank pressure has been reduced but is not acceptable,
cycle with ACR4 through more evacuation cycles and recheck the next day. Continue process until
acceptable pressure is obtained. If the tank pressure is not reduced through the evacuation cycling,
then Kent-Moore should be contacted at 1-800-345-2233.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531205 > May > 95 > Contaminated R12 Refrigerant - Testing &
Handling
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins Contaminated R12 Refrigerant - Testing & Handling
FILE IN SECTION: 1 - HVAC
BULLETIN NO.: 53-12-05
DATE: May, 1995
SUBJECT: Contaminated R12 Refrigerant Testing and Handling
MODELS: 1994 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks with R12 A/C Systems
The J 39851 "PureGuard" R12 refrigerant monitor was recently shipped to all GM dealers as an
essential tool to test R12 refrigerant. Dealers are strongly urged to install this protective device on
their ACR3 or other R12 recovery equipment immediately. The PureGuard is easily installed on any
recovery cart (20 minutes), requires no recovery cart modifications, is fully automatic (no training
required) and does not increase the time required to perform normal A/C service procedures.
Proper use of this tool can:
^ Prevent damage to your R12 recovery/recycling equipment.
^ Prevent contamination of previously recovered R12 in the recovery tank.
^ Prevent loss of your recovered R12 as contaminated refrigerant will activate automatic air purge
system.
^ Prevent the spread of contaminated R12 to other vehicles you service.
If your dealership has multiple R12 recovery stations which are not protected, use the PureGuard
to check the refrigerant in these recovery tanks for contamination at least once each week. Simply
connect the PureGuard blue service hose (that would normally be connected to the vehicle low
side service port) to the red or vapor side of any recovery cart tank and run the test. It is also
important to check a tank containing recovered/recycled material for purity before installation on
your charging equipment. Even new R12 refrigerant purchased from sources other than GM should
be tested for contamination prior to use.
Sources of Contaminated R12 Refrigerant
Since refrigerant testing has not been a standard practice in the mobile A/C repair industry, the
amount of R12 refrigerant contamination is unknown. As R12 prices rise and supplies are depleted,
it is anticipated that contaminated R12 refrigerant may become more prevalent from the following
as well as other sources:
^ The use of R12 refrigerant substitutes without installation of unique service fittings and proper
identification labeling.
^ Improper use of R12 substitutes, such as topping off R12 systems with R134a or other
refrigerants available to "do-it-yourselfers".
^ Poor quality or contaminated new or reprocessed R12 refrigerant.
R12 can and should continue to be used to service vehicles built with R12 as long as it is available.
Combining any refrigerant with R12 results in a refrigerant mixture which cannot be used in an A/C
system.
R134a is the only substitute refrigerant approved by GM and should only be used when the
appropriate retrofit service bulletin procedures are explicitly followed. Use of any other substitute
refrigerant requires the purchase of additional dedicated recovery, recycling (if applicable) and
charging equipment to service each substitute refrigerant used.
However, you should know that the Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) has listed several
products as acceptable replacements for R12 mobile A/C systems under the Significant New
Alternatives Policy (SNAP). Some of these products are: R134a, R401c (a DuPont refrigerant
blend) and FRIGC (another refrigerant blend). It is important to understand that the SNAP program
only considers the health, safety and environmental characteristics of a chemical. It does not test
for A/C system cooling performance or durability. That judgment is deferred to the vehicle
manufacturer. Use of any R12 refrigerant substitute without dedicated service equipment, unique
fittings, labels and refrigerant testing prior to recovery, could result in contamination of the R12
supply and the loss of the R12 recycling program.
What To Do When Contamination is Detected
Repeat the test to verify contaminated refrigerant is present. Clear the PureGuard following the
instructions listed on the face panel, then perform a second test to verify that the vehicle A/C
system contains contaminated or mixed refrigerant.
Contact the vehicle owner to advise that previous A/C system repairs were apparently performed
with an R12 refrigerant substitute. Suggest the owner
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531205 > May > 95 > Contaminated R12 Refrigerant - Testing &
Handling > Page 6471
contact or return to the previous repair facility. Explain that environmental regulations prohibit repair
facilities from discharging ozone depleting A/C refrigerants into the atmosphere. Explain that
recovery of this unknown refrigerant could damage your service equipment.
If the customer wishes to pursue repairs through your facility, it is recommended that the proper
A/C service equipment be purchased. General Motors recommends the Kent-Moore J 41428
"Scavenger", an air operated refrigerant recovery station, be used to remove unknown refrigerants.
The air operated feature reduces the hazard of recovering potentially flammable refrigerants.
Dealers should evaluate the need to purchase the equipment based on the number of
contaminated vehicles they encounter.
As an alternative to the initial purchase of a recovery only station, dealers should check locally for
A/C specialty shops which may have the equipment to service substitute or contaminated
refrigerants. They may be able to provide contaminated refrigerant recovery service to the dealer.
The GM Service Technology Group has tested a recovery procedure where a 15 or 30 pound DOT
approved refillable tank is fully evacuated then connected to a vehicle A/C system to recover the
charge. Testing has shown that even when the recovery tank is cooled down in dry ice, the
procedure does not guarantee the entire charge will be recovered. Since EPA regulations require
full recovery of ozone depleting substances, GM does not recommend this procedure.
Contaminated Refrigerant Disposal
Although A/C refrigerant testing and disposal have not been a service practice in the mobile A/C
industry, It has been common in the stationary A/C service industry for many years. Listed at the
end of this bulletin are companies that provide refrigerant disposal service for the stationary A/C
industry. Please be advised that GM has not independently evaluated these companies and is not
in any way endorsing or promoting the use of these companies. Each of these companies has
expressed an interest in providing refrigerant disposal service to GM dealers.
In working with the stationary A/C industry, these companies typically receive large volumes of
different refrigerants that have been mixed together. Unfortunately, because the volume of material
returned by the mobile A/C industry will be in much smaller quantities, the cost of handling will be
greater.
To arrange for return of the refrigerant, simply call the company nearest you using the phone
number listed below. The company will advise you on billing and shipping procedures. Disposal
cost will vary between $3.00 and $5.00 per pound plus freight and handling. Shipping charges will
vary by distance and location. In general, a 7 to 10 day turn-around time on the tank can be
expected. The tank can be shipped via common carrier. Documents that your refrigerant has been
properly disposed of will be sent to you with the return of your tank.
As an alternative, many dealerships already have contracts in place with a disposal company who
manages their hazardous wastes. In these cases, the disposal service may agree to handle
containers of mixed refrigerants. Initially, the local disposal companies may be surprised by this
inquiry. They may want to evaluate how much material will be collected before deciding whether to
provide this service.
As we move forward with the practice of testing R12 refrigerant, it will take time for all the questions
to be answered. STG will provide additional information as soon as it is available.
Understanding The PureGuard
The PureGuard is a highly sensitive instrument capable of detecting R12 with 3% or less
cross-contamination with other refrigerants. Any refrigerant mixture in excess of this amount poses
a threat to both your refrigerant supply and recovery equipment. The PureGuard uses a pass/fail
approach when monitoring the refrigerant and is precisely calibrated to cut power to the recovery
machine if it encounters R12 mixed with any substitute refrigerants. The PureGuard ignores the
presence of the air, dyes or oils in the refrigerant sampled.
At least 20 psi must be present in the vehicle's A/C system for the PureGuard to function.
Otherwise, refrigerant cannot be introduced to the PureGuard's test chamber. If a vehicle's A/C
system contains less than 20 psi, it is an indication that the vehicle's system is nearly depleted of
refrigerant.
Occasionally, erratic PureGuard operation or service code 002 display will be encountered when
A/C system pressure is exactly 20 psi. If this occurs, simply cycle the on/off switch to reset the
PureGuard. After the 30 second PureGuard warm-up cycle, proceed immediately with vehicle
recovery operation.
Feedback from the field has indicated PureGuard service code 002 will also be displayed if the oil
drain port is not sealed. Make sure the "0" ring seal in the cap is in place and that the cap is tight.
If the PureGuard fails to clear or if you experience any other problems operating the PureGuard,
contact Kent-Moore Technical Service at 1-800-345-2233. The unit should not be returned without
first contacting Kent-Moore to obtain return authorization.
Refrigerant Disposal Locations:
United States Refrigerant Reclamation Inc. 12420 North Green River Rd. Evansville, IN 47711
800-207-5931, FAX - 812-867-1463
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531205 > May > 95 > Contaminated R12 Refrigerant - Testing &
Handling > Page 6472
Omega Refrigerant Reclamation 5263 North Fourth St. Irwindale, CA 91706 310-698-0991, FAX 310-696-1908
Refrigerant Management Svcs of Georgia 216 F. Atlanta Hwy. Cumming, GA 30130 Ph/FAX 800-347-5872
Refrigerant Reclaim Inc. 122 Old Stage Coach Rd. Dumfries, VA 22026 800-238-5902, FAX 703-441-0393
Gartech Refrigerant Reclamation Ctr. 2002 Platinum Garland, TX 75042 214-272-4070, FAX 214-272-8548
National Refrigerants, Inc. 11401 Roosevelt Blvd. Philadelphia, PA 19154 215-698-6620, FAX 215-602-8205
CFC Reclamation 1321 Swift North Kansas City, MO 64116 816-471-2511
Full Cycle-Global 550 James Street Lakewood, NJ 08701 908-370-3400, FAX - 908-370-3088
Refrigerant Reclaim Svcs, Inc. dba Full Cycle-Global 121 S. Norwood Drive Ft. Worth, TX
76053-7807 817-282-0022, FAX - 800-831-6182
Full Cycle-Global 2055 Silber, Ste. 109 Houston, TX 77055 713-681-7370, FAX - 713-681-9947
Full Cycle-Global 343 South Airline Hwy. Gonzales, LA 70737 504-644-5303, FAX - 504-644-1809
Full Cycle-Global 2966 Wireton Blue Island, IL 60406 708-388-8551, FAX - 708-388-8550
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431215 > Nov > 94 > A/C - R134a Leak Detection With Tracer Dye
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - R134a Leak Detection With Tracer Dye
File In Section: 1 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 43-12-15
Date: November, 1994
Subject: R134a Leak Detection with Tracer Dye
Models: All 1993-95 Vehicles with OEM R134a Systems All R12 Vehicles Retrofitted to R134a
Systems
R134a refrigerant is uniquely different from R12 refrigerant and requires some changes in the
repair methods, tools and materials used in A/C service. Two important differences between R134a
and R12 which affect the technicians ability to locate refrigerant leaks are:
1. The R134a molecule is smaller than the R12 molecule and therefore will leak through smaller
openings. For the same size opening the smaller R134a molecule will leak out faster than the R12.
2. R134a refrigerant does not contain chlorine which the older R12 electronic leak detectors found
very easy to identify. Many of today's electronic leak detectors have difficulty locating small R134a
refrigerant leaks.
In order to insure the highest quality in A/C system service, the J 39400 electronic leak detector
was released as an essential tool for all GM dealers. This is the only refrigerant leak detector
approved by GM for service on R134a vehicles. If maintained properly (Reference Bulletin No.
431218) and used in accordance with Service Manual procedures, the J 39400 will provide the
most accurate and efficient method of locating R134a refrigerant leaks under most conditions.
If the technician cannot find the leak with the J 39400 and the system is known to have lost charge,
a new fluorescent leak tracer dye Kent-Moore* P/N J 41447, has been released that mixes with the
R134a PAG oil. This dye is detectable through the use of an ultraviolet (black) light and glows
yellow/green at the leak location (similar to using dye in engine leak detection). J 41447 IS THE
ONLY APPROVED DYE BY GENERAL MOTORS. Not all R134a dyes are compatible with GM's
PAG oil. Some dyes decrease the oil viscosity or chemically react with the oil. Use of alternate
products may affect system reliability and cause premature compressor failure.
Note:
THIS DYE IS NOT TO BE USED IN R-12 SYSTEMS.
Unlike mineral oil, the R134a PAG oil has special properties the technician should keep in mind.
1. PAG oil is water soluble and traces of PAG oil found at leaking joints are subject to "washing
out". Condensation on refrigerant lines or the evaporator core may wash the PAG oil and leak dye
off the line or off the core and out the condensate drain. This can make some leaks harder to find
using the dye detector. Fluorescence at the drain opening would indicate a core leak.
2. Use of the R134a tracer dye requires time. Depending upon the leak rate, it may take between
15 minutes and 7 days for the leak to become visible.
3. The dye, mixed with the PAG oil, is retained in the system and is detectable for 2+ years. Do not
double or triple charge the system with dye as this may cause reliability concerns. Use only the 1/4
oz. charge.
The dye has a refrigerant leak detection notice sticker included with the package. Complete the
sticker information and place near the charge label.
Dye Injection R-134a dye can be injected two ways:
1. With the A/C system charged, use the instructions provided with the new R134a leak dye
injection tool, J 41436.
2. With A/C system discharged, add dye into the newly replaced component assembly.
It is important to note that it is normal to find oil traces at the compressor shaft seal during
compressor operation, some oil will hydraulically seep past the shaft seal. This does not mean that
the shaft seal is defective or that the refrigerant has leaked. Refrigerant leaks at the shaft seal
should be verified with the electronic leak detector (J 39400) following the procedure detailed in the
Service Manual. If, however, the amount of oil is excessive, the shaft seal is suspect and should be
replaced. (For example, refrigerant oil has coated the clutch plate edge at gap between clutch and
pulley, or oil slinging has occurred-oil line shows on underside of hood, etc.).
Also, after working on A/C components with dye, it is important to wipe the joint and/or access
ports clean of any residual dye with GM solvent (GM
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431215 > Nov > 94 > A/C - R134a Leak Detection With Tracer Dye
> Page 6477
P/N 1050436) to prevent false diagnosis at a later point.
* We believe this source and their equipment to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such equipment. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products or equipment from these firms or for any such items which may be
available from other sources.
Parts Information GM solvent, P/N 1050436, is currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431223 > Sep > 94 > A/C Refrigerant - Contamination
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C Refrigerant - Contamination
File In Section: 1 - HVAC Bulletin No.: 43-12-23 Date: September, 1994
Subject: Contaminated A/C Refrigerant
Models: 1994 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks with R12 Air Conditioning Systems
Government regulations limit the production of R12 refrigerant, commonly referred to as Freon,
during 1994/1995 and restrict manufacture of new R12 material effective January 1, 1996. As R12
prices rise and supplies are depleted, it is anticipated non-approved substitute refrigerants and/or
poor quality R12 material sold as new or reprocessed may become more prevalent.
The Mobile Air Conditioning Society (MACS) recently expressed concern over reports of the sale of
R12 refrigerant containing as high as 15% contamination by R22, a refrigerant commonly used in
stationary home systems but unsuitable for use in mobile units. GM dealers should be careful to
protect against contaminating their existing supplies of R12 or the A/C systems in customers'
vehicles they service by dealing with reputable suppliers. All R12 refrigerant purchased for
warranty repairs should be purchased through GM SPO to ensure GM quality standards are met.
The use of non-approved R12 refrigerant substitutes, some of which contain flammable materials,
has also been reported by MACS. These products are available to "do-it-yourselfers" who, in many
cases, believe they are harmless replacements for the small cans of R12 used so commonly in the
past. Once added to the A/C system, the vehicle can no longer be serviced using R12
recovery/recycling equipment without:
- Risking permanent damage to recovery/recycling equipment
- Contaminating the previously recovered R12 material in the recovery tank
- Spreading the contamination when the recovered material is used to charge other vehicles
or
- Possible loss of the recovered material if the contaminated level is high enough to activate the air
purge system
Contaminated refrigerant also impacts customer satisfaction through poor vehicle A/C performance
and loss of A/C system compressor/component durability. System or component failure resulting
from the use of refrigerant which does not meet GM specification is not covered by the "New
Vehicle Warranty".
Unfortunately, there is no simple method to identify if a "do-it-yourselfer" or repair shop has added
to or recharged a system with a non-approved refrigerant. The inability to protect against the
spread of contaminated refrigerant threatens the recycling program and the industry's desire to
maximize use of the remaining R12 supply.
Beginning in 1993, General Motors STG, Harrison Division, Research Labs and Kent-Moore
worked in conjunction with suppliers of various technologies to develop a tester to identify
contaminated refrigerant in vehicle A/C systems before recovery. During development of the
technology, several dealer service manager focus group studies were conducted to identify design
features to best suit dealership needs.
The discussions and surveys clearly indicated the desire for a dedicated instrument, permanently
mounted to the refrigerant recovery cart to ensure ALL vehicles are automatically tested prior to
recovering refrigerant. Testing ALL refrigerant for contamination prior to recovery is the ONLY
means to ensure customer satisfaction, protect recovery equipment and avoid unintentional venting
of refrigerant by your dealership.
General Motors has evaluated all available technology for this project and only the J 39851 R12
"Pureguard" meets General Motors' specifications. The J 39851 R12 Pureguard Refrigerant
Monitor has been classified as an essential tool and will be shipped by Kent-Moore to your
dealership beginning in September of 1994. The essential price of the R12 "Pureguard" is $561 (for
Canadian dealers the price is $800 Canadian). If your dealership has multiple R12 recovery
equipment, additional units may be ordered from Kent-Moore for $561 at 1-800-345-2233. Features
of the R12 "Pureguard" include:
- Universally mounts to R12 Recovery Equipment
- Automatically interrupts power to the Recovery Equipment when contaminated refrigerant is
identified
- Fully automatic design does not require technician action, training or interpretation
- LCD displays Pureguard functions
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 431223 > Sep > 94 > A/C Refrigerant - Contamination > Page 6482
- Meets GM contamination sensitivity requirements
- Self calibrating
- Micro-processor controlled
- Audio alarm alerts technician
Other Refrigerant Identifiers are being advertised which may be available this A/C season.
However, ONLY the Kent-Moore J 39851 R12 "Pureguard" meets General Motors' current
specifications which ensure recovered refrigerant is compatible with General Motors vehicles and
General Motors approved recovery systems.
An R134a Pureguard Refrigerant Identifier is currently under development and is anticipated to be
available in early 1995. The contamination of R134a refrigerant is not expected to be a concern
until the program to retrofit R12 vehicles to R134a becomes more widely used.
Future bulletins will be issued to address the recovery and disposal of contaminated refrigerant.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 331226 > Jan > 94 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 Vehicles to R-134A
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Retrofitting R-12 Vehicles to R-134A
Group Ref.: HVAC
Bulletin No.: 331226
Date: January, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: RETROFITTING R-12 VEHICLES TO R-134a
MODELS: 1994 AND PRIOR YEARS, PASSENGER CARS AND TRUCKS WITH R-12 A/C
SYSTEMS
There has been a great deal of information presented by the media regarding the need to retrofit
vehicles produced with R-12, to a substitute refrigerant. This bulletin will outline GM's position and
future plans on this subject.
Most important, there is currently NO requirement to retrofit any R-12 vehicle. Vehicles built with
R-12 can be serviced with R-12, as long as the refrigerant is available. At some point in time, R-12
may become either too scarce or too expensive to economically justify service on some vehicles
with R-12. By that time, GM will provide you with instructions on retrofitting those vehicles from
R-12 to R-134a.
GM vehicle divisions, platforms, and component suppliers have been actively working on the
details of retrofitting R-12 vehicles. An enormous amount of work is required to determine how
hundreds of vehicle models can be satisfactorily retrofitted. Additional information will be provided
as it becomes available.
The following items contain important technical information that should answer many of the
questions, and correct some misconceptions reported in the media.
SUBSTITUTE REFRIGERANTS
R-134a is the only approved substitute refrigerant that GM recommends and it should only be used
if a complete retrofit procedure has been performed. None of the other refrigerants currently being
marketed as replacement or drop-in substitutes for R-12 are approved for use in GM vehicles.
R-12 and R-134a are not interchangeable. R-134a cannot be added to fill a low R-12 system. The
combination of the two materials can cause high system pressures, which could cause damage to
the system.
Retrofitting an R-12 vehicle to R-134a requires careful preparation to insure that neither the vehicle
nor the A/C service equipment has become contaminated.
RESIDUAL MINERAL OIL
The concern that mineral oil is chemically incompatible with R-134a and/or PAG lubricant has been
proven to be untrue. A normal charge of mineral oil left in the A/C system after a retrofit to R-134a
will not damage the system. Mineral oil, however, does not mix well with R-134a, and will not
provide adequate lubrication. Tests on both the orifice tube and TXV systems show that the mineral
oil parks in places such as the accumulator, and does not appreciably affect performance or
damage the system. The retrofit service bulletin will specify the correct oil to be used. It is important
that this oil recommendation be followed carefully.
RESIDUAL R-12
Residual R-12 left in a system, due to improper retrofit service procedures, may result in system
damage unless the residual R-12 is kept below the 2 percent limit specified by the Society of
Automotive Engineers' Specification J-1661. New service methods are being developed to
minimize the level of R-12 remaining in the A/C system after the retrofit procedure is completed.
Following these new procedures will be critical to insure that the above limits are met.
SYSTEM FLUSHING
R-11, a material commonly used as an A/C system flushing solvent, has been found to be
chemically incompatible with PAG lubricant. Technicians should be aware that residual R-11
remaining in an R-12 system will be very damaging if the vehicle is retrofitted to R-134a later in its
life. For many years GM has recommended the use of in-line filters as an alternative to system
flushing.
SYSTEM FLUSHING, USING EITHER R-11 OR ANY OTHER FLUSHING MATERIAL, IS NOT
APPROVED BY GM FOR ANY A/C SYSTEM.
DESICCANT PROTECTION
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 331226 > Jan > 94 > A/C - Retrofitting R-12 Vehicles to R-134A >
Page 6487
It has been reported that the desiccant (moisture absorption material) used in 1992 and older R-12
A/C systems is incompatible with R-134a and PAG oil. The older desiccant was designed
specifically for R-12 systems, but testing has shown that it is NOT necessary to replace the older
desiccant just because the vehicle is being retrofitted to R-134a. 1993 and newer GM vehicles use
desiccant designed to be compatible with both R-12 and R-134a systems.
The amount of desiccant used in most GM vehicles is designed to last for at least seven years. To
help maintain adequate protection for vehicles that must be retrofitted, it is recommended that the
accumulator/dryer, which contains the desiccant, be replaced if the vehicle is more than five years
old.
"O" RINGS
While continuing to service with R-12, be sure to use "O" rings and seal materials which are
compatible with R-134a and PAG oil. This practice will eliminate concern in case the vehicle
requires retrofitting later in its life. All "O" rings and seal materials available from GMSPO are
compatible with R-134a systems.
RETROFITTED SYSTEM PERFORMANCE
Currently, it appears that for most GM vehicles, the retrofit procedure will require minimal changes
to the existing system. Some vehicles may need additional parts and/or procedures to provide
acceptable performance and/or durability. Our testing has shown that vehicles that have undergone
recommended retrofit procedures will, in most climatic conditions, be minimally affected in terms of
A/C performance.
SERVICE POLICY
Basic service policy is as follows:
During Warranty - If an R-12 produced vehicle A/C system must be repaired or recharged under
warranty, repairs will be completed using R-12. If R-12 is unavailable or unaffordable, GM will notify
the dealer body and will pay for the warranty repair and the retrofit to R-134a.
NOTE:
It a customer requests that an in-warranty vehicle be converted to R-134a, and the R-12 system is
functioning properly, the customer will be expected to pay for the retrofit.
Out of Warranty - The cost of the conversion will be the responsibility of the customer.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 331228 > Dec > 93 > A/C - Refrigerant Production Change R12 to
R134a
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Production Change R12 to R134a
Group Ref.: HVAC Bulletin No.: 331228 Date: December, 1993
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: REFRIGERANT CHANGE IN PRODUCTION VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIR
CONDITIONING (RPO C60)
MODELS: 1994 CHEVROLET CAVALIER 1994 PONTIAC SUNBIRD
Vehicles produced on and after January 3, 1994 equipped with air conditioning (RPO C60) will be
charged with R134a. This includes vehicles produced at both the Lordstown and Ramos assembly
plants. To identify this change, the vehicles charged with R134a will have the RPO code KR1 in
addition to RPO code C60. Also, an underhood sticker will indicate the use of R134a and proper
charge amount.
With the exception of the special tools needed to service R134a, service diagnostics and
procedures are generally the same as vehicles previously produced with R12. This information can
be located in Section 1B of the appropriate service manual.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 922501A > Aug > 92 > A/C - Use of Alternate Refrigerants In CFC
12
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Use of Alternate Refrigerants In CFC 12
Number: 92-250-1A
Section: 0A
Date: AUGUST 1992
Corporate Bulletin No.: 231205
ASE No.: A7
Subject: USE OF ALTERNATE REFRIGERANTS IN CFC 12 REFRIGERANT MOBILE AIR
CONDITIONERS
Model and Year: GALL MODEL YEARS - ALL PASSENGER CARS AND TRUCKS INCLUDING
GEO
A number of inquiries have been received concerning the use of "alternate refrigerants" as a
replacement for R-12 refrigerant in General Motors air conditioning systems.
Regardless of any advertised claims, there are currently no substitutes for refrigerant R-12
approved by General Motors. At the present time, only new or recycled R-12 is approved for use in
General Motors R-12 air conditioning systems.
Based on studies performed to date, the use of "alternate refrigerants" in General Motors R-12 air
conditioning systems may result in higher system pressures, higher leak rates or incompatibility
with drying and sealing materials. System performance and reliability may also be affected.
Service equipment manufacturers have indicated that cross-contaminating R-12 recovery/recycling
equipment with "alternate refrigerants" may damage the equipment. General Motors supports the
Society of Automotive Engineers recommended service procedures for recovery and recycling of
R-12. The use of known "alternate refrigerants" without proper service practices for identifying
vehicle systems containing these "alternate refrigerants" and dedicated recovery equipment to
service those vehicles will contaminate the recycled supply of R-12 refrigerant. Contamination of
the recycled R-12 refrigerant makes the refrigerant unusable for recharging air conditioning
systems and could jeopardize the recycling program.
At the present time, General Motors has not approved any "alternate refrigerant" for R-12 in R-12
air conditioning systems. Therefore, R-12 systems should continue to be serviced with new or
recycled R-12 only.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > Page 6496
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Contaminated R134A Refrigerant
Bulletin No.: 06-01-39-007
Date: July 25, 2006
INFORMATION
Subject: Contaminated R134a Refrigerant Found on Market for Automotive Air-Conditioning
Systems
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2007 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2007 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Attention:
This bulletin should be directed to the Service Manager as well as the Parts Manager.
Commercially Available Contaminated R134a Refrigerant
Impurities have been found in new commercially available containers of R134a. High levels of
contaminates may cause decreased performance, and be detrimental to some air-conditioning
components. Accompanying these contaminates has been high levels of moisture.
Tip:
Excessive moisture may cause system concerns such as orifice tube freeze-up and reduced
performance.
Industry Reaction: New Industry Purity Standards
Due to the potential availability of these lower quality refrigerants, the Society of Automotive
Engineers (SAE), and the Air Conditioning and Refrigeration Industry (ARI) are in the process of
instituting reliable standards that will be carried on the labels of future R134a refrigerant containers.
This identifying symbol will be your assurance of a product that conforms to the minimum standard
for OEM Automotive Air-Conditioning use.
How Can You Protect Yourself Today?
It is recommended to use GM or ACDelco(R) sourced refrigerants for all A/C repair work. These
refrigerants meet General Motors own internal standards for quality and purity, insuring that your
completed repairs are as good as the way it left the factory.
Parts Information
The part numbers shown are available through GMSPO or ACDelco(R). The nearest ACDelco(R)
distributor in your area can be found by calling 1-800-223-3526 (U.S. Only).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > Page 6497
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > Page 6498
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
File In Section: 01 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 99-01-38-006A
Date: May, 2000
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
Subject: J-43600 ACR 2000 Essential Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
Models: 1993-2000 Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks with R-134a Refrigerant
This bulletin is being revised to change the effective date and to update the text. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 99-01-38-006 (Section 01 - HVAC).
Effective June 1, 2000, the use of J-43600 ACR 2000 will be required on all repairs that require A/C
system recovery and are reimbursable by GM. Additionally, GM highly recommends that J-43600
ACR 2000 be used on all GM cars and trucks for customer paid A/C repairs.
Important:
Also effective June 1, 2000, the "Add" time for all air conditioning recovery is revised to 0.5 hours
for front systems and 0.7 hours for front/rear dual systems (RPO C69 or C34). After June 1, 2000,
all air conditioning claims submitted with the 0.9 hours "Add" time will be rejected for "labor hours
excessive".
After the completion of repairs (charging), the ACR 2000 will prompt the user to perform a snapshot
of the air conditioning system operating data. The snapshot includes:
^ Maximum high side pressure.
^ Minimum low side pressure.
^ Duct outlet temperatures (2).
^ Refrigerant purity information.
This information is captured on a paper printout and in a warranty code.
For all GM paid repairs, the paper printout should be attached to the shop copy of the repair order.
The warranty code must be submitted in the warranty claim information in the comments field. The
code enables the reporting of valuable information about the repair to GM for product quality
improvement. Claims submitted without this information may be subject to review and subsequent
debit.
The required use of J-43600 ACR 2000 raises the question of the acceptable uses for any existing
recovery/recycle equipment that GM dealers are currently using. GM recognizes that many of the
previously essential ACR4's are reaching the end of their useful life. There are several alternatives
for existing equipment that may be considered:
^ Use the existing equipment as customer paid recovery only equipment. Example: Collision repair
area.
^ Use the existing equipment as a scavenger unit for contaminated A/C systems.
^ Sell the existing units to repair facilities outside the GM dealer network.
^ Discontinue the use of the existing units if the repair/maintenance costs exceed the value of the
equipment.
^ Donate the existing equipment to local technical schools.
^ Dedicate the ACR4 to A/C system flushing, using the J-42939 Flush Adapter.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > Page 6499
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Technical Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > Page 6500
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Production Change R12 to R134a
Group Ref.: HVAC Bulletin No.: 331228 Date: December, 1993
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: REFRIGERANT CHANGE IN PRODUCTION VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIR
CONDITIONING (RPO C60)
MODELS: 1994 CHEVROLET CAVALIER 1994 PONTIAC SUNBIRD
Vehicles produced on and after January 3, 1994 equipped with air conditioning (RPO C60) will be
charged with R134a. This includes vehicles produced at both the Lordstown and Ramos assembly
plants. To identify this change, the vehicles charged with R134a will have the RPO code KR1 in
addition to RPO code C60. Also, an underhood sticker will indicate the use of R134a and proper
charge amount.
With the exception of the special tools needed to service R134a, service diagnostics and
procedures are generally the same as vehicles previously produced with R12. This information can
be located in Section 1B of the appropriate service manual.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > 531212A > Dec > 96 > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 6501
Refrigerant: Specifications
Refrigerant Capacity, Lbs. ...................................................................................................................
.............................................................................. 1.5 Refrigerant Type .............................................
............................................................................................................................................................
R-134a Refrigeration Oil
Viscosity ..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................ [02] Total System Capacity, Ounces ..........................
..............................................................................................................................................................
9 Compressor Oil Level .......................................................................................................................
........................................................................... [01]
Compressor Clutch Air Gap, Inch ........................................................................................................
................................................................... .015-.020
[01] Note that "Oil Level" cannot be checked. Refer to total capacity in ounces. [02] PAG
(Polyalkylene Glycol) synthetic refrigerant oil, GM part No. 12345923 or equivalent.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > Page 6502
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
File In Section: 01 - HVAC
Bulletin No.: 99-01-38-006A
Date: May, 2000
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
Subject: J-43600 ACR 2000 Essential Refrigerant Recovery/Recharge Equipment
Models: 1993-2000 Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks with R-134a Refrigerant
This bulletin is being revised to change the effective date and to update the text. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 99-01-38-006 (Section 01 - HVAC).
Effective June 1, 2000, the use of J-43600 ACR 2000 will be required on all repairs that require A/C
system recovery and are reimbursable by GM. Additionally, GM highly recommends that J-43600
ACR 2000 be used on all GM cars and trucks for customer paid A/C repairs.
Important:
Also effective June 1, 2000, the "Add" time for all air conditioning recovery is revised to 0.5 hours
for front systems and 0.7 hours for front/rear dual systems (RPO C69 or C34). After June 1, 2000,
all air conditioning claims submitted with the 0.9 hours "Add" time will be rejected for "labor hours
excessive".
After the completion of repairs (charging), the ACR 2000 will prompt the user to perform a snapshot
of the air conditioning system operating data. The snapshot includes:
^ Maximum high side pressure.
^ Minimum low side pressure.
^ Duct outlet temperatures (2).
^ Refrigerant purity information.
This information is captured on a paper printout and in a warranty code.
For all GM paid repairs, the paper printout should be attached to the shop copy of the repair order.
The warranty code must be submitted in the warranty claim information in the comments field. The
code enables the reporting of valuable information about the repair to GM for product quality
improvement. Claims submitted without this information may be subject to review and subsequent
debit.
The required use of J-43600 ACR 2000 raises the question of the acceptable uses for any existing
recovery/recycle equipment that GM dealers are currently using. GM recognizes that many of the
previously essential ACR4's are reaching the end of their useful life. There are several alternatives
for existing equipment that may be considered:
^ Use the existing equipment as customer paid recovery only equipment. Example: Collision repair
area.
^ Use the existing equipment as a scavenger unit for contaminated A/C systems.
^ Sell the existing units to repair facilities outside the GM dealer network.
^ Discontinue the use of the existing units if the repair/maintenance costs exceed the value of the
equipment.
^ Donate the existing equipment to local technical schools.
^ Dedicate the ACR4 to A/C system flushing, using the J-42939 Flush Adapter.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > Page 6503
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Refrigerant: > Page 6504
Refrigerant: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - Refrigerant Production Change R12 to R134a
Group Ref.: HVAC Bulletin No.: 331228 Date: December, 1993
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: REFRIGERANT CHANGE IN PRODUCTION VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIR
CONDITIONING (RPO C60)
MODELS: 1994 CHEVROLET CAVALIER 1994 PONTIAC SUNBIRD
Vehicles produced on and after January 3, 1994 equipped with air conditioning (RPO C60) will be
charged with R134a. This includes vehicles produced at both the Lordstown and Ramos assembly
plants. To identify this change, the vehicles charged with R134a will have the RPO code KR1 in
addition to RPO code C60. Also, an underhood sticker will indicate the use of R134a and proper
charge amount.
With the exception of the special tools needed to service R134a, service diagnostics and
procedures are generally the same as vehicles previously produced with R12. This information can
be located in Section 1B of the appropriate service manual.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Component
Information > Locations > C2
A-Center Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Component
Information > Locations > C2 > Page 6508
A-Center Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6509
Heated Glass Control Module: Diagrams
Harness Connector Faces: Heater-A/C And Rear Defogger Control Assembly- C1
Harness Connector Faces: Heater-A/C And Rear Defogger Control Assembly- C2
Harness Connector Faces: Heater-A/C And Rear Defogger Control Assembly- C3
Harness Connector Faces: Heater-A/C And Rear Defogger Control Assembly- C1 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant > Component Information > Component
Information > Locations > Page 6510
Harness Connector Faces: Heater-A/C And Rear Defogger Control Assembly- C2 (Description)
Harness Connector Faces: Heater-A/C And Rear Defogger Control Assembly- C3 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > A/C - New PAG Oil
Refrigerant Oil: Technical Service Bulletins A/C - New PAG Oil
Bulletin No.: 02-01-39-004B
Date: November 16, 2005
INFORMATION
Subject: New PAG Oil Released
Models: 2006 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2006 HUMMER
H2 2006 HUMMER H3 2005-2006 Saab 9-7X
Built With R-134a Refrigeration System
All Air Conditioning Compressor Types (Excluding R4 and A6 Type Compressors)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to change the PAG oil part number used for R4 and A6 compressors
with R-134a refrigerant systems. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-01-39-004A
(Section 01 - HVAC).
All General Motors vehicles built with R-134a refrigerant systems shall now be serviced with GM
Universal PAG Oil (excluding vehicles equipped with an R4 or A6 compressor).
R4 and A6 compressors with R-134a refrigerant systems shall use PAG OIL, GM P/N 12356151
(A/C Delco part number 15-118) (in Canada, use P/N 10953486).
Important:
The PAG oil referenced in this bulletin is formulated with specific additive packages that meet
General Motors specifications and use of another oil may void the A/C systems warranty.
Use this new PAG oil when servicing the A/C system on the vehicles listed above. Oil packaged in
an 8 oz tube should be installed using A/C Oil Injector, J 45037. Refer to the HVAC Section of
Service Information for detailed information on Oil Balancing and Capacities.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications
Refrigerant Oil: Capacity Specifications
Compressor Model [01] .......................................................................................................................
............................................................................ V-5 Oil Charge (FL. Oz.) When Replacing
Component
Compressor .........................................................................................................................................
............................................................................. [03]
Evaporator ...........................................................................................................................................
................................................................................. 3 Condenser ......................................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
........ 1 Accumulator .............................................................................................................................
......................................................................................... 3.5
[01] Variable displacement compressor. [03] Drain oil from old compressor and measure, then
drain new compressor. If more than one ounce is drained from old compressor, add same amount
to new compressor. If less than one ounce is drained from compressor, add two ounces.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Oil > Component Information > Specifications >
Capacity Specifications > Page 6517
Refrigerant Oil: Fluid Type Specifications
REFRIGERANT OIL TYPE
^ R-134a PAG (Polyalkaline Glycol) synthetic refrigerant oil (GM Part No. 12345923) or equivalent.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component
Information > Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6526
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6527
Harness Connector Faces: High Blower Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6532
RH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 6533
Harness Connector Faces: A/C Compressor Control Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch >
Component Information > Locations
A-Center Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Heating and Air Conditioning > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure
Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Air Bag - Module Shipping/Return Procedure
Air Bag: Technical Service Bulletins Air Bag - Module Shipping/Return Procedure
File In Section: 9 - Accessories
Bulletin No.: 31-90-04A
Date: September, 1996
Subject: Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) Module Shipping/Return Procedure
Models: 1993-97 Passenger Cars and Trucks - Equipped with Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
(SIR) Modules
EXCEPT THE MODELS AND YEARS AS LISTED
This bulletin is being revised to update the: models and years affected, the contact telephone
numbers and the hazardous classification rating. Various areas of the text and the attachments
have also been revised. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 319004 (Group Reference Accessories).
This bulletin outlines the return procedure for undeployed Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR)
modules. Undeployed SIR modules in all vehicles (except models indicated), removed for warranty
purposes, are to be returned to Delphi Interior and Lighting Systems, General Motors Corporation.
This bulletin outlines procedures that all dealers must follow for shipping undeployed airbag
modules. This bulletin is in effect and should be retained at all times at the dealership until
superseded by a subsequent bulletin.
This return program does NOT apply to dealers in Alaska, Hawaii, US Territories, and foreign
countries. SIR modules replaced outside the continental United States should be deployed and
disposed of following the procedure outlined in Corporate Bulletin Number 319003R. All other
modules (i.e., out of warranty or car scrapped) should be disposed of per Corporate Bulletin
Number 319003R.
Important:
If a vehicle is the subject of a Preliminary Investigation (GM-1241), DO NOT ALTER the SIR
system until cleared by the Zone Service Representative. An SIR module returned following a 1241
investigation must be clearly designated by:
1. Indicating on the REPAIR ORDER copy inside the box "SUBJECT TO 1241".
2. Indicating the VIN and vehicle owner on the REPAIR ORDER.
3. Sending photocopies of the REPAIR ORDER to:
a. The appropriate Zone service Representative
b. Cigna Company GM Central Claims Unit 485 W. Milwaukee Suite 690 Detroit, MI 48202
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Air Bag - Module Shipping/Return Procedure > Page 6547
Mailing Address: P.O. Box 02489, Detroit, MI 48202
Questions related to handling of 1241 associated SIR modules may be answered by calling: Cigna
Company - GM Central Claims Unit, 1-800-888-1491.
The U.S. Department of Transportation (DOT) Hazardous Materials Regulations classify SIR
modules as the following:
^ Proper Shipping Name: Air Bag Modules
^ Hazardous Class: Class 9 - Air Bag
Failure to comply with DOT regulations will result in civil penalties of up to $10,000 per violation or
criminal penalties of up to $25,000 per violation and imprisonment.
Return Procedure for Supplemental Inflatable Restraint Modules
(Undeployed Modules Only)
All undeployed SIR modules in all vehicles (except as indicated in the models section of this
bulletin), removed for warranty purposes, are to be returned to Delphi Interior and Lighting
Systems, General Motors. The following procedure should be followed when returning SIR
modules from any location within the continental United States.
1. Packaging Requirements
Return undeployed SIR modules in the same carton that was received with the new replacement
module. Do not use any carton that has been damaged to the extent that the product will not be
protected during the shipment. If you need a replacement carton, contact Delphi Interior and
Lighting Systems at (513) 356-2426. ENCLOSE A COPY OF THE REPAIR ORDER, detailing the
reason(s) for the SIR module replacement.
Close and secure the carton with packaging tape (transparent tape is recommended). All existing
labels and markings on the carton must be visible.
Important:
DO NOT staple container. DO NOT cover any portion of the black and white "Class 9" label or any
markings on the carton.
2. Package Labels and Markings
Add the names and addresses for the consignee and the consignor. The method of closure cannot
interfere with the labels or the markings on the package (see Attachments "A" - Driver Side, and
"D" - Passenger Side).
3. Shipping Paper (UPS Hazardous Material Label and Shipper's Certification)
The following items on the shipping papers must be completed with the same information as
enclosed with the replacement SIR module when received: proper shipping name, hazard class,
identification number, packaging group number, "EX" number, and emergency response telephone
number. The remaining information should be completed in accordance with Attachments "B" and
"E" (Driver Side) and "C" and "F" (Passenger Side).
A copy of the emergency response guidelines (see Attachment "G") is enclosed with the
replacement SIR module and must be attached to the shipping papers you complete for the SIR
module being shipped.
4. Transportation
All SIR modules are to be returned using United Parcel Service (UPS) which will require the sender
to pre-pay the freight charges. If difficulties arise, contact Delphi Interior and Lighting Systems,
General Motors at (513) 356-2426.
5. RETURN ALL SUPPLEMENTAL INFLATABLE RESTRAINT MODULES (EXCEPT FOR THOSE
MODELS LISTED IN THIS BULLETIN) TO THE FOLLOWING ADDRESS:
Delphi Interior and Light Systems 3249 McCall Avenue Dayton, OH 45417
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Air Bag - Module Shipping/Return Procedure > Page 6548
ATTACHMENT A DRIVER AIRBAG
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Air Bag - Module Shipping/Return Procedure > Page 6549
ATTACHMENT B DRIVER SIDE
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Air Bag - Module Shipping/Return Procedure > Page 6550
ATTACHMENT C DRIVER SIDE
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Air Bag - Module Shipping/Return Procedure > Page 6551
ATTACHMENT D PASSENGER AIRBAG
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Air Bag - Module Shipping/Return Procedure > Page 6552
ATTACHMENT E PASSENGER SIDE
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Air Bag - Module Shipping/Return Procedure > Page 6553
ATTACHMENT F PASSENGER SIDE
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Air Bag - Module Shipping/Return Procedure > Page 6554
ATTACHMENT G
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Air Bag - Module Shipping/Return Procedure > Page 6555
Technical Service Bulletin # 319003 Date: 931201
Air Bag - Module Scrapping Procedure
Group Ref.: Accessories
Bulletin No.: 319003
Date: December, 1993
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: SUPPLEMENTAL INFLATOR RESTRAINT (SIR) PASSENGER-SIDE INFLATOR
MODULE SCRAPPING PROCEDURE
MODELS: 1992-94 MODELS WITH PASSENGER SIDE SUPPLEMENTAL INFLATABLE
RESTRAINT (SIR)
This bulletin outlines THE SCRAPPING OF UNDEPLOYED PASSENGER-SIDE INFLATOR
MODULES. This procedure should be used ONLY for dealers in Alaska, Hawaii, US Territories and
Foreign Countries. Passenger-side inflator modules replaced in the continental United States
should be returned for analysis following the procedures outlined in Bulletin Number 319004R.
This Bulletin, in conjunction with Bulletin Number 319004, cancels and replaces Bulletin Number
209006 (Chevrolet 93-72-9J, Pontiac 93-9-5 and Cadillac 93-I-13).
PASSENGER INFLATOR MODULE SCRAPPING PROCEDURE
Alaska, Hawaii, US Territories, and Foreign Countries Only
Tools Required:
J38826-SIR Deployment Harness
J39401-Passenger Side SIR Module Deployment Fixture
During the course of a vehicle's useful life, certain situations may arise which will necessitate the
disposal of a live (undeployed) inflator module. This information covers proper procedures for
disposing of a live passenger inflator module. Information for disposing of a live driver inflator
module can be found in the applicable service manual or in a service bulletin.
Before a live inflator module can be disposed of, it must be deployed. Live inflator modules must
not be disposed of through normal refuse channels.
CAUTION:
Failure to follow proper Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) inflator module disposal procedures
can result in air bag deployment which may cause personal injury. Undeployed inflator modules
must not be disposed of through normal refuse channels. The undeployed inflator module contains
substances that can cause severe illness or personal injury if the sealed container is damaged
during disposal. Disposal in any manner inconsistent with proper procedures may be a violation of
federal, state, and/or local laws.
If a vehicle is the subject of a Product Liability Report related to the SIR system and is subject to a
Preliminary Investigation (GM-1241), DO NOT DEPLOY the inflator module and DO NOT ALTER
the SIR system in any manner. Refer to the applicable service bulletin on SIR shipping procedures
(bulletin applies to U.S only, except Alaska and Hawaii and all foreign countries) for details on
handling SIR systems involved with GM-1241. If a vehicle is the subject of a campaign affecting
inflator modules, DO NOT DEPLOY the inflator module. Follow instructions in the Campaign
Service Bulletin for proper disposition of the inflator module.
In situations which require deployment of a live inflator module, deployment may be accomplished
in or out of the vehicle. The method employed depends upon final disposition of the particular
vehicle, as noted in "Deployment Out Of Vehicle" and "Deployment In Vehicle" shown below.
Deployment Out of Vehicle
Deployment out of the vehicle is proper when the vehicle is to be returned to service. This includes,
for example, situations in which a functionally or cosmetically deficient inflator module is replaced.
Deployment and disposal of an inflator module is, of course, subject to any required retention
period.
For deployment of a live inflator module out of the vehicle, the deployment procedure must be
followed exactly. ALWAYS wear safety glasses during this deployment procedure until the
deployed inflator module is scrapped. Before performing the procedures you should be familiar with
servicing the SIR system and with proper handling of the inflator module. Procedures should be
read fully before they are performed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Air Bag - Module Shipping/Return Procedure > Page 6556
The following procedure requires use of J 38826 SIR Deployment Harness with the appropriate
pigtail adapter. The procedure also requires the use of J 39401 Passenger Side SIR Module
Deployment Fixture. Do not attempt this procedure without J 38826 and adapter, and J 39401.
CAUTION:
Failure to follow procedures in the order listed may result in personal injury. Never connect
deployment harness to any power source before connecting deployment harness to the inflator
module. Deployment harness shall remain shorted and not be connected to a power source until
the airbag is to be deployed. The inflator module will immediately deploy the airbag when a power
source is connected to it. Wear safety glasses throughout this entire deployment and disposal
procedure.
Important:
This information applies only to passenger inflator modules. Information for disposing of a live
driver inflator module can be found in the applicable service manual or in a service bulletin.
1. Turn ignition switch to "LOCK", remove key, and put on safety glasses.
2. Inspect J 38826 SIR Deployment Harness and appropriate pigtail adapter for damage. If harness
or pigtail is damaged, discard and obtain a replacement.
3. Short the two SIR Deployment Harness leads together by fully seating one banana plug into the
other. The SIR Deployment Harness shall remain shorted and not be connected to a power source
until the air bag is to be deployed. Refer to Figure 1.
4. Connect the appropriate pigtail adapter to the SIR Deployment Harness. Refer to Figure 1.
5. Remove inflator module from vehicle. Refer to "On-Vehicle Service" in Section 9J.
CAUTION:
When storing a live inflator module or when leaving a live inflator module unattended on a bench or
other surface, always face the bag up and away from the surface. This is necessary so that a free
space is provided to allow the air bag to expand in the unlikely event of accidental deployment.
Failure to follow procedures may result in personal injury.
6. Clear a space on the ground approximately 185 cm (six feet) in diameter where the fixture with
attached inflator module is to be placed for deployment. A paved outdoor location where there is no
activity is preferred. If an outdoor location is not available, a space on the shop floor where there is
no activity and sufficient ventilation is recommended. Ensure that no loose or flammable objects
are within the deployment area.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Air Bag - Module Shipping/Return Procedure > Page 6557
7. Place the J 39401 on the ground in the space cleared in step 6, if it has not already been placed
there. Refer to Figure 2.
8. Fill plastic reservoir in fixture with water or sand. This is necessary to provide sufficient
stabilization of the fixture during deployment.
9. Attach the passenger inflator module in the J 39401 Passenger Side SIR Module Deployment
Fixture using the Flange/Arm Mounting Method or Stud Mounting Method as appropriate (most
applications will work best with the Flange/Arm Mounting Method). Refer to Figure 3. Inflator
module must be mounted such that the bag will deploy upward. SECURELY HAND-TIGHTEN ALL
FASTENERS PRIOR TO DEPLOYMENT
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Air Bag - Module Shipping/Return Procedure > Page 6558
Important:
When using the Stud Mounting Method, the mounting nuts for attaching the inflator module to the
vehicle must be removed from the module. J 39401-1 Mounting Nuts (4 required) MUST be used to
attach the module to the fixture to ensure sufficient thread engagement. When using the
Flange/Arm Mounting Method, use the J 39401-13 Hold-Down Nuts (4 required) whenever
possible. However, if clearance re-strictions do not allow the use of the J 39401-13 nuts, (4) M6 x
1.0 nuts with washers may be used.
10. Stretch the SIR Deployment Harness and pigtail adapter from the inflator module to its full
length. Refer to Figure 4.
11. Place a power source near the shorted end of the SIR Deployment Harness. (Recommended
application: 12 volts minimum, 2 amps mini-mum. A vehicle battery is suggested.)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Air Bag - Module Shipping/Return Procedure > Page 6559
12. Connect the inflator module to the pigtail adapter on the SIR Deployment Harness. The SIR
Deployment Harness shall remain shorted and not be connected to a power source until the air bag
is to be deployed. The inflator module will immediately deploy the air bag when a power source is
connected to it. Refer to Figure 5.
Important:
Ensure that the pigtail adapter is firmly seated into the inflator module connector. Failure to fully
seat the connectors may leave the shorting bar located in the inflator module connector functioning
(shorting the deployment circuit) and may result in nondeployment of the inflator module.
13. Verify that the area around the inflator module is clear of all people and loose or flammable
objects.
14. Verify that the inflator module is firmly and properly secured in J 39401.
15. Notify all people in the immediate area of your intention to deploy the inflator module. The
deployment will be accompanied by a substantial noise which may startle the uninformed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Air Bag - Module Shipping/Return Procedure > Page 6560
16. Separate the two banana plugs on the SIR Deployment Harness that were shorted together in
Step 3. Refer to Figure 6.
NOTICE:
When air bag deploys, the rapid gas expansion will create a substantial noise. Notify all people in
the immediate area that you intend to deploy the inflator module.
CAUTION:
Deployment harness shall remain shorted and not be connected to a power source until the air bag
is to be deployed. The inflator module will immediately deploy the air bag when a power source is
connected to it. Connecting the deployment harness to the power source should always be the last
step in the inflator module deployment procedure. Failure to follow procedures in the order listed
may result in personal injury.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Air Bag - Module Shipping/Return Procedure > Page 6561
17. Connect the SIR Deployment Harness wires to the power source to immediately deploy the
inflator module. Refer to Figure 7.
18. Disconnect the SIR Deployment Harness from the power source.
19. Short the two SIR Deployment Harness leads together by fully seating one banana plug into the
other. Refer to Figure 1.
20. In the unlikely event that the inflator module did not deploy after following these procedures,
proceed immediately with Steps 25 through 28. If the inflator module deployed as intended,
proceed with Steps 21 through 24.
21. Put on a pair of shop gloves to protect your hands from possible irritation and heat when
handling the deployed inflator module.
After the inflator module has been deployed, the surface of the air bag may contain a powdery
residue. This powder consists primarily of cornstarch (used to lubricate the bag as it inflates) and
by-products of the chemical reaction. Sodium hydroxide dust (similar to lye soap) is produced as a
by-product of the deployment reaction. The sodium hydroxide quickly reacts with the atmospheric
moisture and is converted to sodium carbonate and sodium bicarbonate (baking soda). Therefore,
it is unlikely that sodium hydroxide will be present for very long after deployment. As a precaution,
however, gloves and safety glasses are recommended to prevent any possible irritation of the skin
or eyes.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Air Bag - Module Shipping/Return Procedure > Page 6562
CAUTION:
Safety precautions must be observed when handling a deployed inflator module. After deployment,
the metal surfaces of the inflator module will be hot. Allow the inflator module to cool before
handling any metal portion of it. Do not place the deployed inflator module near any flammable
objects. Failure to follow procedures may result in fire or personal injury. After an inflator module
has been deployed, the metal canister and surrounding areas of the inflator module will be hot. Do
not touch the metal areas of the inflator module for about ten minutes after deployment. If the
deployed inflator module must be moved before it is cool, wear gloves and handle by the air bag
itself. Refer to Figure 8.
22. Disconnect the pigtail adapter from the inflator module as soon after deployment as possible to
avoid damage to the pigtail adapter or SIR Deployment Harness from contacting the hot inflator
module canister. The pigtail adapter and SIR Deployment Harness are designed to be reused.
They should, however, be inspected for damage after each deployment and replaced if necessary.
23. Dispose of the deployed inflator module through normal refuse channels after it has cooled for
at least 10 minutes.
24. Wash your hands with mild soap and water afterward.
NOTICE:
The remaining steps are to be followed in the unlikely event that the inflator module did not deploy
after following the above procedures.
25. Ensure that the SIR Deployment Harness has been disconnected from the power source and
that its two banana plugs have been shorted together by fully seating one banana plug into the
other. Refer to Figure 1.
26. Disconnect the pigtail adapter from the inflator module.
CAUTION:
When storing a live inflator module or when leaving a live inflator module unattended on a bench or
other surface, always face the bag up and away from the surface. This is necessary so that a free
space is provided to allow the air bag to expand in the unlikely event of accidental deployment.
Failure to follow procedures may result in personal injury.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Air Bag - Module Shipping/Return Procedure > Page 6563
27. Temporarily store the inflator module with the bag facing up, away from the surface upon which
it rests. Refer to Figure 9.
28. Call the Technical Assistance group for further assistance.
Deployment In Vehicle
Deployment in the vehicle is proper when the vehicle is to be destroyed or salvaged for component
parts. This includes, but is not limited to, the following situations:
1. The vehicle has completed its useful life.
2. The vehicle has been damaged beyond repair in a non-deployment type of accident.
3. The vehicle has been stripped or damaged beyond repair in a theft.
4. The vehicle will be salvaged for component parts to be used on a vehicle with a different Vehicle
Identification Number (VIN) as opposed to being rebuilt as the same VIN. This is done to ensure
SIR system integrity since only new SIR system components, with the exception of remanufactured
parts as noted below, may be used in servicing an SIR equipped vehicle. Remanufactured parts
purchased from an authorized General Motors dealer may be used for SIR repairs. Refer to
applicable model and year service manual for the in-vehicle passenger inflator module deployment
procedure.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 6564
Air Bag: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The inflator modules consist of an inflatable bag and an inflator (a canister of gas-generating
material and an initiating device).
OPERATION
When the vehicle is in a frontal crash of sufficient force, the SDM or arming sensor causes current
to flow through the deployment loops. Current passing through the initiator ignites the material in
the inflator module. The gas produced from this reaction rapidly inflates the air bag.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 6565
Air Bag: Service and Repair
WARNING: The diagnostic energy reserve module or sensing and diagnostic module
(DERM/SDM) can maintain enough voltage to cause air bag deployment for up to two minutes after
the ignition switch is turned off and the battery is disconnected. Servicing the SIR system during
this period may result in accidental deployment and personal injury.
1. Disarm system as described in Air Bag System Disarming & Arming. 2. Remove module
attaching bolts from rear of steering wheel. 3. Rotate horn lead 1/4 turn and disconnect. 4.
Disconnect inflator module electrical connector, then remove module from steering wheel. 5.
Reverse procedure to install, noting the following:
a. After completing installation, rearm system as described in Air Bag System Disarming & Arming.
b. Turn ignition switch to On position and verify that the Air Bag or SIR warning lamp flashes seven
to nine times and then turns off. If lamp
does not respond as specified, refer to System Diagnosis
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Air Bag Control Module > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM) performs several system functions. These functions
include energy reserve, air bag deployment, malfunction detection, malfunction diagnosis, driver
notification, frontal crash detection and frontal crash recording.
OPERATION
The SDM contains a sensing device which converts vehicle velocity changes to an electrical signal.
The electrical signal generated is processed by the SDM and then compared to a value stored in
memory. When the generated signal exceeds the stored value, additional signals are compared to
signals stored in memory. When two of the generated signals exceed the stored values or when
one of the generated signals exceeds the stored value and the forward discriminating sensor
closes, the SDM will cause current to flow through the inflator modules deploying the air bags.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The SIR coil assembly consists of two current carrying coils. They are attached to the steering
column and allow rotation of the steering wheel while maintaining continuous contact of the driver
deployment loop to the driver's inflator module.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable, Air Bag >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 6572
Clockspring Assembly / Spiral Cable: Service and Repair
WARNING: The diagnostic energy reserve module or sensing and diagnostic module
(DERM/SDM) can maintain enough voltage to cause air bag deployment for up to two minutes after
the ignition switch is turned off and the battery is disconnected. Servicing the SIR system during
this period may result in accidental deployment and personal injury.
1. Disarm system as described in Air Bag System Disarming & Arming. 2. Position front wheels in
the straight ahead position. 3. Remove driver's air bag as described in Air Bag Module. 4.
Disconnect electrical connectors. 5. Place alignment marks on steering wheel hub and steering
column shaft for installation reference. 6. Remove steering wheel retaining nut. 7. Using suitable
steering wheel puller, remove steering wheel. 8. Place ignition switch in the Lock position, to retain
coil assembly in the centered position. 9. Remove coil assembly retaining ring.
10. Remove lock plate, turn signal canceling cam and upper bearing spring, inner race seat and
inner race. 11. Place turn signal lever in righthand turn position, then remove multi-function lever
and hazard flasher warning knob. 12. Remove turn signal switch lever attaching screw, then the
lever. 13. Remove turn signal switch attaching screws and allow switch to hang from wire. 14.
Disconnect SIR coil connector from turn signal switch electrical connector. 15. Using mechanics
wire, gently pull SIR coil wire through steering column. 16. Remove SIR coil assembly from
steering column. 17. Reverse procedure to install, noting the following:
a. Ensure wheels are in the straight ahead position. b. Ensure coil assembly is in the centered
position. c. After completing installation, rearm system as described in Air Bag System Disarming &
Arming. d. Turn ignition switch to On position and verify that the AIR BAG or SIR warning lamp
flashes seven to nine times and then turns off. If lamp
does not respond as specified, refer to System Diagnosis.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Discriminating Sensors and Arming Sensors <-->
[Impact Sensor] > Component Information > Description and Operation
Discriminating Sensors and Arming Sensors: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The discriminating and arming sensors are used by the SIR system to determine whether or not
certain frontal crashes require deployment of the air bags.
OPERATION
The sensor consists of a sensing element, normally open switch contacts and a diagnostic resistor.
The sensing element closes the switch contacts when the vehicle velocity changes are severe
enough to warrant air bag deployment.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Discriminating Sensors and Arming Sensors <-->
[Impact Sensor] > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 6576
Discriminating Sensors and Arming Sensors: Service and Repair
WARNING: The diagnostic energy reserve module or sensing and diagnostic module
(DERM/SDM) can maintain enough voltage to cause air bag deployment for up to two minutes after
the ignition switch is turned off and the battery is disconnected. Servicing the SIR system during
this period may result in accidental deployment and personal injury.
1. Disarm system as described in Air Bag System Disarming & Arming. 2. Remove Connector
Position Assurance (CPA), then disconnect sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove sensor
attaching bolts, then the sensor from vehicle. 4. Reverse procedure to install, noting the following:
a. Install sensor with arrow pointed toward front of vehicle. b. After completing installation, rearm
system as described in Air Bag System Disarming & Arming. c. Turn ignition switch on and verify
that the AIR BAG or SIR warning lamp flashes seven to nine times and then turns off. If lamp does
not
respond as specified, refer to System Diagnosis.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Passenger Presence System Information
Seat Occupant Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Passenger Presence System
Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-08-50-009F
Date: December 23, 2010
Subject: Information on Passenger Presence Sensing System (PPS or PSS) Concerns With
Custom Upholstery, Accessory Seat Heaters or Other Comfort Enhancing Devices
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Equipped with Passenger Presence Sensing
System
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 06-08-50-009E (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Concerns About Safety and Alterations to the Front Passenger Seat
Important ON A GM VEHICLE EQUIPPED WITH A PASSENGER SENSING SYSTEM, USE THE
SEAT COVERS AND OTHER SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT AS RELEASED BY GM FOR THAT
VEHICLE. DO NOT ALTER THE SEAT COVERS OR SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT. ANY
ALTERATIONS TO SEAT COVERS OR GM ACCESSORIES DEFEATS THE INTENDED DESIGN
OF THE SYSTEM. GM WILL NOT BE LIABLE FOR ANY PROBLEMS CAUSED BY USE OF
SUCH IMPROPER SEAT ALTERATIONS, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTY REPAIRS INCURRED.
The front passenger seat in many GM vehicles is equipped with a passenger sensing system that
will turn off the right front passenger's frontal airbag under certain conditions, such as when an
infant or child seat is present. In some vehicles, the passenger sensing system will also turn off the
right front passenger's seat mounted side impact airbag. For the system to function properly,
sensors are used in the seat to detect the presence of a properly-seated occupant. The passenger
sensing system may not operate properly if the original seat trim is replaced (1) by non-GM covers,
upholstery or trim, or (2) by GM covers, upholstery or trim designed for a different vehicle or (3) by
GM covers, upholstery or trim that has been altered by a trim shop, or (4) if any object, such as an
aftermarket seat heater or a comfort enhancing pad or device is installed under the seat fabric or
between the occupant and the seat fabric.
Aftermarket Seat Heaters, Custom Upholstery, and Comfort Enhancing Pads or Devices
Important ON A GM VEHICLE EQUIPPED WITH A PASSENGER SENSING SYSTEM, USE ONLY
SEAT COVERS AND OTHER SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT RELEASED AS GM
ACCESSORIES FOR THAT VEHICLE. DO NOT USE ANY OTHER TYPE OF SEAT COVERS OR
SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT, OR GM ACCESSORIES RELEASED FOR OTHER VEHICLE
APPLICATIONS. GM WILL NOT BE LIABLE FOR ANY PROBLEMS CAUSED BY USE OF SUCH
IMPROPER SEAT ACCESSORIES, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTY REPAIRS MADE
NECESSARY BY SUCH USE.
Many types of aftermarket accessories are available to customers, upfitting shops, and dealers.
Some of these devices sit on top of, or are Velcro(R) strapped to the seat while others such as seat
heaters are installed under the seat fabric. Additionally, seat covers made of leather or other
materials may have different padding thickness installed that could prevent the Passenger Sensing
System from functioning properly. Never alter the vehicle seats. Never add pads or other devices to
the seat cushion, as this may interfere with the operation of the Passenger Sensing System and
either prevent proper deployment of the passenger airbag or prevent proper suppression of the
passenger air bag.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Diagnostic Energy Reserve Module (DERM) <-->
[Standby Power Supply, Air Bag] > Component Information > Description and Operation
Standby Power Supply: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The Diagnostic Energy Reserve Module (DERM) performs several system functions. These
functions include energy reserve, malfunction detection, malfunction recording, driver notification
and frontal crash recording.
OPERATION
The DERM is connected to the SIR wiring harness by a 24-way connector. This harness connector
uses a shorting bar across certain terminals in the contact area. This shorting bar connects the AIR
BAG warning lamp to ground when the DERM harness connector is disconnected. This will cause
the AIR BAG warning lamp to come on steady whenever the ignition switch is at the Run, Bulb Test
or Start positions with the DERM disconnected.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Malfunction Lamp / Indicator: > 83-81-34 > Mar > 99 > SIR
- Operating Vehicle with Warning Light On
Malfunction Lamp / Indicator: Customer Interest SIR - Operating Vehicle with Warning Light On
File In Section: 8 - Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 83-81-34
Date: March, 1999
INFORMATION
Subject: Operating Vehicle with Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) Warning Light Illuminated
Models: 1999 and Prior Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks with SDM Controlled Air Bag
System
The AIR BAG warning light is the key to driver notification of Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
(SIR) system malfunctions. When the warning light remains illuminated or continues to flash, one or
more of the following conditions may occur if vehicle operation is continued.
^ Non-deployment of the air bags in the event of a crash.
^ Deployment of the air bags without a crash.
^ Deployment of the air bags in crashes less severe than intended.
If an AIR BAG warning light is illuminated or flashing, you should advise the customer of these
possibilities and that the vehicle should be serviced right away.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Malfunction Lamp / Indicator: > 83-81-34 >
Mar > 99 > SIR - Operating Vehicle with Warning Light On
Malfunction Lamp / Indicator: All Technical Service Bulletins SIR - Operating Vehicle with Warning
Light On
File In Section: 8 - Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 83-81-34
Date: March, 1999
INFORMATION
Subject: Operating Vehicle with Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) Warning Light Illuminated
Models: 1999 and Prior Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks with SDM Controlled Air Bag
System
The AIR BAG warning light is the key to driver notification of Supplemental Inflatable Restraint
(SIR) system malfunctions. When the warning light remains illuminated or continues to flash, one or
more of the following conditions may occur if vehicle operation is continued.
^ Non-deployment of the air bags in the event of a crash.
^ Deployment of the air bags without a crash.
^ Deployment of the air bags in crashes less severe than intended.
If an AIR BAG warning light is illuminated or flashing, you should advise the customer of these
possibilities and that the vehicle should be serviced right away.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Air Bag Systems > Malfunction Lamp / Indicator, Air Bag > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 6597
Malfunction Lamp / Indicator: Description and Operation
On models equipped with an air bag system, if the air bag warning lamp illuminates and stays on,
diagnosis and repair of the air bag system will be necessary to reset the lamp.
DESCRIPTION
Voltage is supplied to the AIR BAG/SIR warning lamp when the ignition switch is at the Run, Bulb
Test or Start position. The DERM/SDM controls the lamp by providing ground with a lamp driver.
OPERATION
The AIR BAG warning lamp is used in the SIR system to verify lamp and DERM/SDM operation by
flashing seven times whenever the ignition is turned on and to warn the driver of any SIR system
malfunctions.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Head Restraint System > System Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Restraints - Driver/Passenger Seat Head Rest Information
Head Restraint System: Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Driver/Passenger Seat Head Rest
Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 10-08-50-003A
Date: March 24, 2011
Subject: Information on Driver or Passenger Seat Head Restraint Concerns with Comfort, Custom
Upholstery or Other Comfort Enhancing Devices
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Equipped with Adjustable Head Restraints
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 10-08-50-003 (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Important ON A GM VEHICLE EQUIPPED WITH ADJUSTABLE HEAD RESTRAINTS, USE THE
HEAD RESTRAINT COVERS, FOAM AND OTHER SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT AS
RELEASED BY GM FOR THAT VEHICLE. DO NOT ALTER OR REPOSITION THE HEAD
RESTRAINT SYSTEM. ANY ALTERATIONS TO HEAD RESTRAINTS DEFEATS THE INTENDED
DESIGN OF THE SYSTEM. GM WILL NOT BE LIABLE FOR ANY PROBLEMS CAUSED BY USE
OF SUCH IMPROPER DESIGN ALTERATIONS, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTY REPAIRS
INCURRED.
You may have a customer with a concern that the head restraint is uncomfortable or sits too far
forward. The front driver and passenger seats are equipped with head restraints that have been
designed to help minimize injuries while still providing comfort to the occupants. Each GM vehicle
has its own specifically designed head restraint.
The head restraints should only be used in the vehicle for which they were designed. The head
restraint will not operate to its design intent if the original foam is replaced (1) by non-GM foam or
head restraint, (2) by GM foam or head restraint designed for a different vehicle, (3) by GM foam or
head restraint that has been altered by a trim shop or (4) if any object, such as an aftermarket
comfort enhancing pad or device, is installed.
Never modify the design of the head restraint or remove the head restraint from the vehicle as this
may interfere with the operation of the seating and restraint systems and may prevent proper
positioning of the passenger within the vehicle.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM) performs several system functions. These functions
include energy reserve, air bag deployment, malfunction detection, malfunction diagnosis, driver
notification, frontal crash detection and frontal crash recording.
OPERATION
The SDM contains a sensing device which converts vehicle velocity changes to an electrical signal.
The electrical signal generated is processed by the SDM and then compared to a value stored in
memory. When the generated signal exceeds the stored value, additional signals are compared to
signals stored in memory. When two of the generated signals exceed the stored values or when
one of the generated signals exceeds the stored value and the forward discriminating sensor
closes, the SDM will cause current to flow through the inflator modules deploying the air bags.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Child Seat Top Teather Attachment Kits
Child Seat Tether Attachment: Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Child Seat Top Teather
Attachment Kits
Bulletin No.: 99-09-40-004a
Date: April 12, 2005
INFORMATION
Subject: Top Tether Hardware Package for Child Restraint Seats
Models: 1989-2002 Passenger Cars, Light Duty Trucks and Multi-Purpose Passenger Vehicles
(Except EV1 and Prizm)
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2000-2002 model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 99-09-40-009 (Section 09 - Restraints).
Important:
GM of Canada and IPC Dealers are not authorized to utilize this service bulletin.
Beginning in August, 1997 General Motors began providing Child Restraint Seat Top Tether
Hardware Packages to customers in the United States who requested them. The Top Tether
Hardware Package contains the necessary hardware for anchoring a forward facing child restraint
seat top tether.
One Child Restraint Seat Top Tether Hardware Package will be provided per vehicle to the retail
customer at no charge for installation. Charges for installation of additional Top Tether Hardware
Packages per vehicle are the responsibility of the customer.
Most forward facing child restraint seats (CRS) sold in the United States prior to calendar year
1999 were not sold with top tether straps, but have provisions for them. Top tethers, which are
required in Canada, can help to better secure the seat in the vehicle. When a forward facing CRS
including a top tether is used, specially designed components must be used to secure the child
seat top tether. These components are included in the Hardware Package from GMSPO.
Top tethers are not normally required or used with rearward facing infant restraint seats. Rearward
facing infant restraint seats should never be secured in the front seat of an air bag equipped
vehicle unless the vehicle is equipped with an air bag de-activation (shut-off) switch and the switch
has been used to turn the air bag off.
Should a retail customer request installation of a Tether Hardware Package at the time of sale or
delivery, it is to be installed at no charge to the owner. The labor to install a Tether Hardware
Package prior to delivery of a new vehicle to the customer is considered to be part of the delivery
"get ready process", and as such, is not claimable. Claiming for the cost and applicable handling
allowance of the proper Tether Hardware Package used in the installation is allowed.
If the customer requests installation of a Tether Hardware Package some time after delivery, the
package is to be provided free of charge. Hardware Packages include installation instructions
which are easily followed and can be installed by most customers. However, should the customer
request the dealership's assistance to install the Tether Hardware Package, it is to be installed at
no charge to the customer and the labor may be claimed. All claims submitted for installation labor
of an approved Tether Hardware Package must be supported by a signed customer work order.
Additional Hardware Packages and installation charges are the responsibility of the customer.
In addition, passenger vehicle deliveries, including vans and sport utilities for daily rental usage,
may have one tether hardware package supplied. Additional packages are the owner's
responsibility. Dealers may claim appropriate parts under these circumstances. Sufficient quantities
of parts should be ordered in advance of the arrival of vehicles to avoid delays.
Important:
When installing a Child Restraint Seat Top Tether Hardware Package, follow the installation
instructions included in the package. Additional information about specific mounting locations and
installations may be available in the Seat Belt Section (Sections 9, 10-10, 10-11 or 10A) I of the
appropriate Service Manual, or the Restraints section of SI.
Any questions regarding this policy should be directed to your Area Manager, Parts or Service.
Parts Information
For Top Tether Hardware Package part numbers and usage, see Group 14.870 (passenger cars &
U-van), or Group 16.710 (Light Duty Truck) of the appropriate GMSPO Parts Catalog. In addition,
they can also be found in Accessories Group 21.042.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Child Restraint > Child Seat Tether Attachment >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Child Seat Top Teather Attachment Kits > Page 6612
Warranty Information
The dealership will be reimbursed for the parts and labor, if applicable, through the submission of a
regular warranty claim.
All claims submitted must be supported by a signed customer work order. Purchase and installation
of additional Hardware Packages is the responsibility of the customer.
For Top Tether Hardware Packages installed in the United States, submit as a normal warranty
claim using the labor operations and time allowances shown.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Belt Buckle: > 09-09-40-001A > Feb > 11 > Restraints - Seat Belt
Warning Lamp On/Buckling Issues
Seat Belt Buckle: Customer Interest Restraints - Seat Belt Warning Lamp On/Buckling Issues
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 09-09-40-001A
Date: February 02, 2011
Subject: Seat Belt Buckle Latching Issues and/or Seat Belt Warning Lights Illuminated
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7 X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 09-09-40-001 (Section 09 - Restraints).
This bulletin is being published to advise dealers about seat belt buckles not operating and/or seat
belt warning light illumination, as well as difficulty latching and unlatching the buckle or the buckle
release button sticking.
Analysis of warranty data has determined that this condition may be caused by sticky beverages
being spilled onto or into the seat belt buckle assembly. Foreign debris from food, candy wrappers,
paper and coins can also contribute to this condition.
Important If foreign material (debris) or sticky liquids are the cause of the concern, show the
customer the condition of the component (buckle assembly) and explain how it is affecting the
function of the restraint system. Strongly recommend that the component be replaced. Point out the
fact that this is not a manufacturing defect and is not covered by the new vehicle warranty. If the
customer declines to have parts replaced, the service department management must make a
notation on the service record that the lack of functionality of seating position with an inoperative
buckle was fully explained to the customer. The service department management must advise the
customer that having a non-functioning buckle in a seating position voids ability to use that seating
position (no one should ride in the seat). Also make the customer aware that it may be against the
law to ride in a vehicle without wearing a restraint system.
Important Never insert anything other than the seat belt latch plate into the buckle assembly. Do
not attempt to dig anything out of a buckle with a tool. Never try to wash out a buckle to remove a
spilled liquid as this may damage the buckle.
Use the following steps to determine the cause of the concern.
1. Inspect the buckle assembly with a light shining on the latch plate insertion area. Look for any
debris or foreign objects in the buckle. 2. If any debris or foreign objects are observed, try to
vacuum out the item. After the foreign material is removed, latch and unlatch the seat belt. If
the system functions properly, do not replace the seat belt buckle assembly.
3. If the condition has not been corrected, inspect the buckle assembly for any sticky residue. If
sticky residue is found, inform the customer that a
substance was spilled on the seat belt buckle assembly causing the malfunction. The buckle
assembly will need to be replaced at the customer's expense.
4. Refer to SI for seat belt component replacement.
Important If foreign material (debris) or sticky liquids are the cause of the concern, show the
customer the condition of the component (buckle assembly) and explain how it is affecting the
function of the restraint system. Strongly recommend that the component be replaced at the
customer's expense. Point out the fact that this is not a manufacturing defect and is not covered by
the new vehicle warranty. If the customer declines to have parts replaced, the service department
management must make a notation on the service record that the lack of functionality of seating
position with an inoperative buckle was fully explained to the customer. The service department
management must advise customer that having a non-functioning buckle in a seating position voids
ability to use that seating position (no one should ride in the seat). Also make the customer aware
that it may be against the law to ride in a vehicle without wearing a restraint system.
5. If further restraint diagnosis is required, refer to Seat Belt System Operational and Functional
Checks in SI.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Seat Belt Buckle: > 09-09-40-001A > Feb > 11 > Restraints - Seat Belt
Warning Lamp On/Buckling Issues > Page 6621
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Belt Buckle: > 09-09-40-001A > Feb > 11 > Restraints
- Seat Belt Warning Lamp On/Buckling Issues
Seat Belt Buckle: All Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Seat Belt Warning Lamp On/Buckling
Issues
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 09-09-40-001A
Date: February 02, 2011
Subject: Seat Belt Buckle Latching Issues and/or Seat Belt Warning Lights Illuminated
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7 X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 09-09-40-001 (Section 09 - Restraints).
This bulletin is being published to advise dealers about seat belt buckles not operating and/or seat
belt warning light illumination, as well as difficulty latching and unlatching the buckle or the buckle
release button sticking.
Analysis of warranty data has determined that this condition may be caused by sticky beverages
being spilled onto or into the seat belt buckle assembly. Foreign debris from food, candy wrappers,
paper and coins can also contribute to this condition.
Important If foreign material (debris) or sticky liquids are the cause of the concern, show the
customer the condition of the component (buckle assembly) and explain how it is affecting the
function of the restraint system. Strongly recommend that the component be replaced. Point out the
fact that this is not a manufacturing defect and is not covered by the new vehicle warranty. If the
customer declines to have parts replaced, the service department management must make a
notation on the service record that the lack of functionality of seating position with an inoperative
buckle was fully explained to the customer. The service department management must advise the
customer that having a non-functioning buckle in a seating position voids ability to use that seating
position (no one should ride in the seat). Also make the customer aware that it may be against the
law to ride in a vehicle without wearing a restraint system.
Important Never insert anything other than the seat belt latch plate into the buckle assembly. Do
not attempt to dig anything out of a buckle with a tool. Never try to wash out a buckle to remove a
spilled liquid as this may damage the buckle.
Use the following steps to determine the cause of the concern.
1. Inspect the buckle assembly with a light shining on the latch plate insertion area. Look for any
debris or foreign objects in the buckle. 2. If any debris or foreign objects are observed, try to
vacuum out the item. After the foreign material is removed, latch and unlatch the seat belt. If
the system functions properly, do not replace the seat belt buckle assembly.
3. If the condition has not been corrected, inspect the buckle assembly for any sticky residue. If
sticky residue is found, inform the customer that a
substance was spilled on the seat belt buckle assembly causing the malfunction. The buckle
assembly will need to be replaced at the customer's expense.
4. Refer to SI for seat belt component replacement.
Important If foreign material (debris) or sticky liquids are the cause of the concern, show the
customer the condition of the component (buckle assembly) and explain how it is affecting the
function of the restraint system. Strongly recommend that the component be replaced at the
customer's expense. Point out the fact that this is not a manufacturing defect and is not covered by
the new vehicle warranty. If the customer declines to have parts replaced, the service department
management must make a notation on the service record that the lack of functionality of seating
position with an inoperative buckle was fully explained to the customer. The service department
management must advise customer that having a non-functioning buckle in a seating position voids
ability to use that seating position (no one should ride in the seat). Also make the customer aware
that it may be against the law to ride in a vehicle without wearing a restraint system.
5. If further restraint diagnosis is required, refer to Seat Belt System Operational and Functional
Checks in SI.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Seat Belt Buckle: > 09-09-40-001A > Feb > 11 > Restraints
- Seat Belt Warning Lamp On/Buckling Issues > Page 6627
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Locations
Seat Belt Switch is located at the Part of LH front Seat Belt Buckle
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Extension > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Extender Availability For Seat Belt
Seat Belt Extension: Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Extender Availability For Seat Belt
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 99-09-40-005F
Date: June 23, 2010
Subject: Seat Belt Extender Availability
Models: 2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2009 and Prior
HUMMER H2 2010 and Prior HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add the 2009‐2011 model years and update the Warranty
Information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 99-09-40-005E (Section 09 Restraints).
Important:
DO NOT use belt extenders when securing a child restraint.
The seat and shoulder belt restraint systems used in all General Motors vehicles have sufficient
belt length to accommodate most drivers and passengers. Consequently, requests for belt
extensions (extenders) should be minimal.
Seat belt extenders are available ONLY IN BLACK for most GM passenger cars and trucks
produced in recent years. They are available in two different lengths, 23 cm (9 in) and 38 cm (15
in). They are designed to be coupled with the existing belts in each vehicle. When in use, the
extender makes the belt arrangement a "custom fit" and use by anyone else or in another vehicle
will lessen or nullify the protection offered by the vehicle's restraint system. For this reason, it is
extremely important that the correct length extender be used for the vehicle and occupant intended.
Important:
Do not use an extender just to make it easier to buckle the safety belt. Use an extender only when
you cannot buckle the safety belt without using an extender.
Parts Information
For part numbers, usage and availability of extenders, see Extension Kit in Group 14.875 (cars) or
Group 16.714 (trucks) of the appropriate parts catalog. Saturn retailers should refer to the
appropriate model year Parts & Illustration catalog for the vehicle. U.S. Saab dealers should contact
the Parts Help line. Canadian Saab dealers should fax requests to Partech Canada.
Warranty Information
^ Seat belt extenders are a NO CHARGE item to all GM customers who request them for their
specific vehicles.
^ Dealers should not be charging part costs since these extenders are supplied by GM to the
dealers.
^ Dealers should not be charging labor costs since the extender can be customer installed.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Locations > Convertible
Seat Belt Retractor: Locations Convertible
LH Front Of Door (Convertible)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Locations > Convertible > Page 6639
LH Front Of Door (Convertible)
RH Front Door (Convertible)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Locations > Convertible > Page 6640
RH Front Door (Convertible)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Locations > Convertible > Page 6641
Seat Belt Retractor: Locations Coupe
LH Front Of Door (Coupe)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Locations > Convertible > Page 6642
LH Front Of Door (Coupe)
RH Front Of Door (Coupe)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Locations > Convertible > Page 6643
RH Front Of Door (Coupe)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Locations > Convertible > Page 6644
Seat Belt Retractor: Locations Station Wagon and Sedan
LH Front Door (Station Wagon Shown, Sedan Similar)
LH Front Door (Station Wagon Shown, Sedan Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Systems > Seat Belt Retractor > Component Information >
Locations > Convertible > Page 6645
RH Front Door (Station Wagon Shown, Sedan Similar)
RH Front Door (Station Wagon Shown, Sedan Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Discriminating Sensors
and Arming Sensors <--> [Impact Sensor] > Component Information > Description and Operation
Discriminating Sensors and Arming Sensors: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The discriminating and arming sensors are used by the SIR system to determine whether or not
certain frontal crashes require deployment of the air bags.
OPERATION
The sensor consists of a sensing element, normally open switch contacts and a diagnostic resistor.
The sensing element closes the switch contacts when the vehicle velocity changes are severe
enough to warrant air bag deployment.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Discriminating Sensors
and Arming Sensors <--> [Impact Sensor] > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 6650
Discriminating Sensors and Arming Sensors: Service and Repair
WARNING: The diagnostic energy reserve module or sensing and diagnostic module
(DERM/SDM) can maintain enough voltage to cause air bag deployment for up to two minutes after
the ignition switch is turned off and the battery is disconnected. Servicing the SIR system during
this period may result in accidental deployment and personal injury.
1. Disarm system as described in Air Bag System Disarming & Arming. 2. Remove Connector
Position Assurance (CPA), then disconnect sensor electrical connector. 3. Remove sensor
attaching bolts, then the sensor from vehicle. 4. Reverse procedure to install, noting the following:
a. Install sensor with arrow pointed toward front of vehicle. b. After completing installation, rearm
system as described in Air Bag System Disarming & Arming. c. Turn ignition switch on and verify
that the AIR BAG or SIR warning lamp flashes seven to nine times and then turns off. If lamp does
not
respond as specified, refer to System Diagnosis.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch
> Component Information > Locations
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Locations
Seat Belt Switch is located at the Part of LH front Seat Belt Buckle
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Restraint Systems > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Occupant Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Restraints - Passenger Presence System Information
Seat Occupant Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Passenger Presence System
Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-08-50-009F
Date: December 23, 2010
Subject: Information on Passenger Presence Sensing System (PPS or PSS) Concerns With
Custom Upholstery, Accessory Seat Heaters or Other Comfort Enhancing Devices
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Equipped with Passenger Presence Sensing
System
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 06-08-50-009E (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Concerns About Safety and Alterations to the Front Passenger Seat
Important ON A GM VEHICLE EQUIPPED WITH A PASSENGER SENSING SYSTEM, USE THE
SEAT COVERS AND OTHER SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT AS RELEASED BY GM FOR THAT
VEHICLE. DO NOT ALTER THE SEAT COVERS OR SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT. ANY
ALTERATIONS TO SEAT COVERS OR GM ACCESSORIES DEFEATS THE INTENDED DESIGN
OF THE SYSTEM. GM WILL NOT BE LIABLE FOR ANY PROBLEMS CAUSED BY USE OF
SUCH IMPROPER SEAT ALTERATIONS, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTY REPAIRS INCURRED.
The front passenger seat in many GM vehicles is equipped with a passenger sensing system that
will turn off the right front passenger's frontal airbag under certain conditions, such as when an
infant or child seat is present. In some vehicles, the passenger sensing system will also turn off the
right front passenger's seat mounted side impact airbag. For the system to function properly,
sensors are used in the seat to detect the presence of a properly-seated occupant. The passenger
sensing system may not operate properly if the original seat trim is replaced (1) by non-GM covers,
upholstery or trim, or (2) by GM covers, upholstery or trim designed for a different vehicle or (3) by
GM covers, upholstery or trim that has been altered by a trim shop, or (4) if any object, such as an
aftermarket seat heater or a comfort enhancing pad or device is installed under the seat fabric or
between the occupant and the seat fabric.
Aftermarket Seat Heaters, Custom Upholstery, and Comfort Enhancing Pads or Devices
Important ON A GM VEHICLE EQUIPPED WITH A PASSENGER SENSING SYSTEM, USE ONLY
SEAT COVERS AND OTHER SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT RELEASED AS GM
ACCESSORIES FOR THAT VEHICLE. DO NOT USE ANY OTHER TYPE OF SEAT COVERS OR
SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT, OR GM ACCESSORIES RELEASED FOR OTHER VEHICLE
APPLICATIONS. GM WILL NOT BE LIABLE FOR ANY PROBLEMS CAUSED BY USE OF SUCH
IMPROPER SEAT ACCESSORIES, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTY REPAIRS MADE
NECESSARY BY SUCH USE.
Many types of aftermarket accessories are available to customers, upfitting shops, and dealers.
Some of these devices sit on top of, or are Velcro(R) strapped to the seat while others such as seat
heaters are installed under the seat fabric. Additionally, seat covers made of leather or other
materials may have different padding thickness installed that could prevent the Passenger Sensing
System from functioning properly. Never alter the vehicle seats. Never add pads or other devices to
the seat cushion, as this may interfere with the operation of the Passenger Sensing System and
either prevent proper deployment of the passenger airbag or prevent proper suppression of the
passenger air bag.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antenna > Antenna Mast > Component Information
> Technical Service Bulletins > Power Antenna Mast - Replacement
Antenna Mast: Technical Service Bulletins Power Antenna Mast - Replacement
Group Ref.: Accessories
Bulletin No.: 439604
Date: April, 1994
SUBJECT: POWER ANTENNA MAST REPLACEMENT
MODELS: 1991-94 PASSENGER CARS (EXCEPT GEO)
On most GM vehicles with a power antenna option, it is not necessary to replace the entire power
antenna assembly if the mast becomes damaged. The mast can be ordered separately (see the
GMSPO Parts Catalog for specific applications).
Mast installation instructions are included with the service package.
WARRANTY INFORMATION: For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation: R0420
Use published labor operation time.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Remote Keyless
Entry <--> [Keyless Entry] > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tools Keyless Entry Transmitter Tester
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Technical Service Bulletins Tools - Keyless Entry Transmitter Tester
File In Section: 9 - Accessories
Bulletin No.: 83-90-12
Date: August, 1998
INFORMATION
Subject: Essential Tool J 43241 Remote Keyless Entry and Passive Keyless Entry Transmitter
Tester
Models:
1990-99 Passenger Cars and Trucks with Remote Keyless Entry or Passive Keyless Entry
Systems
A new essential tool, J 43241 Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter Tester, has been sent to all GM
Dealers. This tester can be used on all RKE and PKE systems, on past as well as current models.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Remote Keyless
Entry <--> [Keyless Entry] > Keyless Entry Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tools Keyless Entry Transmitter Tester > Page 6670
Important:
Before using the tester and the diagnostic chart, the following two steps must be performed.
1. Verify that the keyless entry transmitter is the correct model for the vehicle remote system. An
incorrect model transmitter may pass this test, but may not activate the vehicle remote system. The
correct transmitter can usually be identified by part number.
2. Ensure that the transmitter is synchronized with the vehicle (if applicable). Refer to Transmitter
Synchronization in the appropriate Service Manual.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft and Alarm Systems > Security
Lamp/Indicator > Component Information > Description and Operation
Security Lamp/Indicator: Description and Operation
The security indicator is controlled by the theft deterrent module. The module will turn the
SECURITY lamp on for about five seconds during engine start-up for a bulb check. A solid (not
flashing) SECURITY indicator is illuminated if the theft deterrent module enters shut down mode
thus preventing the vehicle from starting.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Radio Telephone/Mobile Radio - Install/Troubleshooting
Technical Service Bulletin # 83-96-05 Date: 980701
Radio Telephone/Mobile Radio - Install/Troubleshooting
File In Section: 9 - Accessories
Bulletin No.: 83-96-05
Date: July, 1998
Subject: Radio Telephone/Mobile Radio (Transceiver) Installation and Troubleshooting Guidelines
Models: 1990-99 Passenger Cars and Trucks
This bulletin cancels and supercedes bulletin 34-92-12. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
34-92-12 (Section 9 - Accessories).
The following information is being provided to assist in the installation and troubleshooting of Radio
Telephone/Mobile Radios.
Certain radio telephones or land mobile radios (also known as Radio Transceivers), or the way in
which they are installed, may adversely affect various vehicle operations such as engine
performance, driver information, entertainment and electrical systems.
Expenses incurred to protect the vehicle systems from any adverse effect of any such installation
are NOT the responsibility of General Motors Corporation.
The following are general guidelines for installing a radio transceiver in General Motors vehicles.
These guidelines are intended to supplement, but not to be used in place of, detailed instructions
which are the sole responsibility of the manufacturer of the involved radio transceiver. Although this
document refers to passenger vehicles, the same general guidelines apply to trucks.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Radio Telephone/Mobile Radio - Install/Troubleshooting > Page 6678
EMC TROUBLESHOOTING CHART
1. Transceiver Location
Refer to the attached figures during installation.
1. Transceiver Location
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Radio Telephone/Mobile Radio - Install/Troubleshooting > Page 6679
a. One piece transceivers should be mounted under the dash, or on the transmission hump where
they will not interfere with vehicle controls or passenger movement (See Figure 1 - One Piece
Transceiver Installation).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Radio Telephone/Mobile Radio - Install/Troubleshooting > Page 6680
b. Locate the transceiver for remote radios on the driver's side of trunk as near to the vehicle body
side as possible (See Figure 2 - Trunk Mount Transceiver Installation).
Caution:
To avoid possible serious injury, do not mount any transceivers, microphones, speakers, or any
other item In the deployment path of a Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) or "Air Bag".
2. Antenna Installation
a. Each vehicle model reacts to radio frequency energy differently.
It is suggested that a magnetic-mount antenna be used to check the proposed antenna location for
unwanted effects on the vehicle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Radio Telephone/Mobile Radio - Install/Troubleshooting > Page 6681
Antenna location is a major factor in these effects.
b. The antenna should be a permanent-mount type, located in the center of the roof or center of the
rear deck lid.
If a magnet-mount antenna is used, care should be taken to mount the antenna in the same
location as a permanent-mount type.
If a disguise-mount antenna is used, great care should be taken to shield (using copper tape, etc.)
any tuning network from vehicle electronics and wiring, or mount the tuning network in an area
completely clear (6 inches or 15 cm away) of vehicle electronics and wiring.
c. Standard metal mount antennas may be mounted on a vehicle with non-metallic body panels by
two methods:
1. Mount the antenna near a metal frame section and bond the antenna mount to the frame with a
short metal strap, which will provide the ground plane connection.
2. Some antenna manufacturers may offer "Ground Plane Kits" that consist of self adhesive metal
foil that may be attached to the body panel to provide a ground plane connection.
d. Glass Mount Antennas
Glass mounted antennas should be kept as high as possible in the center of the rear window or
windshield, between rear window defrost "grid lines", if present.
Some vehicles use glass that contains a thin metallic layer for defrosting, or to control solar gain.
GLASS MOUNT ANTENNAS WILL NOT FUNCTION WHEN MOUNTED ON THIS TYPE OF
GLASS.
3. Antenna Cable Routing
a. Always use high quality coax cable (95% shield coverage minimum), located away (at least 6
inches or 15 cm) from ECM's, PCM's and other electronic modules.
b. Care should be taken to maintain as great a distance as possible between any vehicle wiring
and coax cable.
4. Antenna Tuning
It is important that the antenna be tuned properly and that reflected power be kept to less than 10%
(VSWR less than 2:1) at all operating frequencies.
Important:
High VSWR has been shown to contribute/cause interference problems with vehicle systems.
5. Radio Wiring and Power Lead Connection Locations
a. Methods to connect radio power on General Motors vehicles is dependent on the vehicle model
(See Figure 1 - One Piece Transceiver Installation or Figure 2 - Trunk Mount Transceiver
Installation as needed).
Do not connect the negative power lead to any under-dash termination point.
One of the following four methods is suggested:
1. Connect the positive and negative power leads directly to the battery terminals.
GM approved methods of connecting auxiliary wiring include the adapter package illustrated in
Figure 4 - Power Cable Battery Connections.
Important:
It is recommended that a fuse be placed in the transceiver negative power lead.
This is to prevent possible transceiver damage in the event the battery to engine block ground lead
is inadvertently disconnected.
2. Connect the positive lead to the auxiliary power terminal (usually identified by a red plastic cover
in the underhood area).
Connect the negative lead directly to the negative battery terminal.
Important:
See above important statement regarding fusing the negative power lead.
3. Connect the positive lead to the auxiliary power terminal (usually identified by a red plastic cover
in the underhood area).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Radio Telephone/Mobile Radio - Install/Troubleshooting > Page 6682
Connect the negative lead to the battery body connection point (usually identified by a short # 10
AWG or larger wire running from the negative battery terminal to the body of the vehicle).
Important:
See above important statement regarding fusing the negative power lead.
4. Connect the positive and negative leads to the Special Equipment Option (SEO) wiring provided
for this purpose (if vehicle has this option).
b. For One Piece Transceivers (See Figure 1 - One Piece Transceiver Installation)
When ignition switch control is desired, and no SEO wiring exists, a 12 volt power contactor must
be installed in the transceiver positive power lead (See Figure 3 - Power Contactor Wiring).
The contactor (supplied by the installer) should be located near a proper 12 volt feed source.
One lead of the contactor coil should be connected through an appropriate in-line fuse to an
available accessory circuit or ignition circuit not
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Cellular Phone > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Radio Telephone/Mobile Radio - Install/Troubleshooting > Page 6683
powered during engine cranking.
The return lead of the contactor coil must return to a proper fused negative point.
c. Handset or Control Units
1. Any negative power lead from a handset or control unit must return to a properly fused negative
connection point.
2. It is preferable that the positive power lead for a handset, or control unit, be connected directly to
a properly fused positive power feed point.
If ignition switch control is desired, the handset or control unit positive power lead may be
connected through an appropriate in-line fuse to an available accessory circuit (or ignition circuit
not powered during engine cranking).
3. It is recommended that the handset or control unit positive and negative power leads be
appropriately fused separately from the transceiver positive and negative power leads.
d. Multiple Transceivers or Receivers
If multiple transceivers or receivers are to be installed in the vehicle, power leads to the trunk or
under the dash should be connected to covered, insulated terminal strips.
All transceivers or receivers may then have their power leads connected to the insulated terminal
strips. This makes a neater installation and reduces the number of wires running to the vehicle
underhood area.
Both positive and negative power leads should be fused.
6. Radio Wire Routing
(See Figure 1 - One Piece Transceiver Installation, or Figure 2 - Trunk Mount Transceiver
Installation as needed).
a. The power leads (fused) should be brought through a grommeted hole (provided by the installer)
in the front cowl.
For trunk mounted transceivers, the cables should continue on along the driver's side door sills,
under the rear seat and into the trunk through a rear bulkhead.
Maintain as great a distance as possible between radio power leads and vehicle electronic
modules and wiring.
b. If the radio power leads need to cross the engine compartment, they should cross between the
engine and the front of the vehicle.
Troubleshooting
Refer to the Troubleshooting Chart as needed.
1. Most vehicle-radio interaction is avoided by following the Installation Guidelines outlined above.
2. If vehicle-radio interaction is evident following radio installation, the source of the problem should
be determined prior to further vehicle/radio operation.
The EMC Troubleshooting Chart should help in determining the source of the vehicle-radio
interaction.
Parts Information
P/N Description
1846855 Adapter Kit, Side Terminal Battery (consisting of Adapter Terminal,
Terminal Cover, Wire Connector, Insulation Boot)
12004188 Bolt, Battery Cable Terminal
12354951 Spacer, Battery Cable Terminal
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Compact Disc Player (CD): >
649601 > Jan > 97 > Compact Disc Players - CD Changer Loading Procedures
Compact Disc Player (CD): Customer Interest Compact Disc Players - CD Changer Loading
Procedures
File In Section: 9 - Accessories
Bulletin No.: 64-96-01
Date: January, 1997
INFORMATION
Subject: Compact Disc Players - Procedures for Correct Use and Maintenance
Models: 1997 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
CD Changer Loading Procedures
Because of differences in CD changer loading procedures, some confusion exists regarding this
issue. Although correct loading procedures are included with each changer's Owner's Manual,
often this information is not available to the dealer service personnel.
Verify proper loading when evaluating customer concerns of "CD inoperative".
Delco Electronics Product Type Loading Procedure
Radio w/intergral CD label side up
6 disc changer (LLAI) label side up
10 disc changer (FMI) label side up
12 disc changer (LLAI) label side down
Important:
Failure to load magazine/player correctly will disable the operation.
Important:
Only the 12 disc changer is to be loaded with the label side down.
CD Cleaners
Avoid use of commercially available CD cleaners.
The use of CD cleaners is not recommended and can damage the player's CD mechanism.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Compact Disc
Player (CD): > 649601 > Jan > 97 > Compact Disc Players - CD Changer Loading Procedures
Compact Disc Player (CD): All Technical Service Bulletins Compact Disc Players - CD Changer
Loading Procedures
File In Section: 9 - Accessories
Bulletin No.: 64-96-01
Date: January, 1997
INFORMATION
Subject: Compact Disc Players - Procedures for Correct Use and Maintenance
Models: 1997 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
CD Changer Loading Procedures
Because of differences in CD changer loading procedures, some confusion exists regarding this
issue. Although correct loading procedures are included with each changer's Owner's Manual,
often this information is not available to the dealer service personnel.
Verify proper loading when evaluating customer concerns of "CD inoperative".
Delco Electronics Product Type Loading Procedure
Radio w/intergral CD label side up
6 disc changer (LLAI) label side up
10 disc changer (FMI) label side up
12 disc changer (LLAI) label side down
Important:
Failure to load magazine/player correctly will disable the operation.
Important:
Only the 12 disc changer is to be loaded with the label side down.
CD Cleaners
Avoid use of commercially available CD cleaners.
The use of CD cleaners is not recommended and can damage the player's CD mechanism.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Compact Disc Player (CD): Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6700
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6701
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6702
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6703
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6704
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6705
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6706
Compact Disc Player (CD): Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6707
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6708
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6709
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6710
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6711
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6712
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6713
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6714
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6715
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6716
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6717
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6718
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6719
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6720
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6721
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6722
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6723
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6724
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6725
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6726
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6727
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6728
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6729
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6730
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Compact Disc
Player (CD) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6731
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Audio - Procedure To Handle Customer Radio Concerns
Radio/Stereo: Technical Service Bulletins Audio - Procedure To Handle Customer Radio Concerns
File In Section: 9 - Accessories
Bulletin No.: 68-96-O1A
Date: October, 1996
INFORMATION
Subject: Procedure to Handle Customer Radio Concerns
Models: 1997 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks
This bulletin is being revised to change the Sales Center Information to Service Center Information.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 68-96-01 (Section 9 - Accessories).
Many of the radios being returned to the Delco Electronics remanufacturing centers have been
misdiagnosed. This misdiagnosis results in unnecessary customer comebacks, decreased
customer satisfaction and reduces the availability of exchange radios.
To resolve these issues, the following information was developed to give General Motors' dealers a
common service process to handle customer audio system concerns.
When a customer either calls or comes in with a concern about the radio system in their vehicle, it
is important that as much information as possible is gathered. This process begins with the Service
Consultant asking the customer specific questions related to their vehicle as outlined on the
Service Writer/Customer Check list.
Once the Service Consultant has completed the diagnostic worksheet, it should be attached to the
customer repair order for the technician. This worksheet should help the technician determine if the
concern is vehicle related or radio related. Two excellent service manuals are also available for this
purpose and are available from General Motors at the address shown below. A service bulletin,
34-92-12, Radio Frequency Interference Diagnosis, is also available as is assistance from the
Divisional Technical Assistance Centers.
Mascotech Mktg. Service 1972 Brown Road Auburn Hills, ML 48326 1-800-393-4831
Delco Electronics Sound Service Audio Systems Diagnostic Guide
P/N 19007.03-1A @ $10.00 per manual STG Audio Systems Training manual P/N 19007.03-2 @
$15.00 per manual
Repairs to the vehicle or the audio system can usually be done very quickly and the vehicle
returned to the customer that day. If the diagnosis indicates that the radio needs to be replaced,
remove the radio from the vehicle and order an exchange radio from your local AC Delco radio
exchange center. There are 28 approved AC Delco exchange centers nationally (listing attached).
If your local exchange center does not have the required exchange radio, it is important that you
contact the AC Delco locator service. This service can be found on the Service Parts TRACS
system 1-800-433-6961, prompt 4. It will be necessary to request overnight shipping so that the
owner's vehicle is retained at your dealership for only one night.
If the vehicle is kept overnight and it is a warranty repair, the customer should be offered courtesy
transportation or alternate transportation. Please do not return the vehicle with the suspect radio
installed or without a radio. Many of our vehicles today use a multiplex wiring system and the
vehicle will not run correctly without a radio.
When you receive the exchange radio, please return the removed radio to the AC Delco Exchange
Center within 24 hours (please enclose the diagnostic worksheet that the Service Consultant and
the Technician used with the removed radio along with the 1078 form). This will help the AC Delco
Exchange Center.
In the event you know the vehicle will need a radio before the customer brings the vehicle in, every
effort should be made to have a pre-exchanged radio available. A radio identification list is attached
to help you select the correct radio.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Audio - Procedure To Handle Customer Radio Concerns > Page
6736
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Audio - Procedure To Handle Customer Radio Concerns > Page
6737
AC Delco AUTHORIZED ELECTRONIC SERVICE CENTERS
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Audio - Procedure To Handle Customer Radio Concerns > Page
6738
Duplicate form for your convenience SERVICE WRITER/CUSTOMER CHECK LIST
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Audio - Procedure To Handle Customer Radio Concerns > Page
6739
RECEPTION/NOISE CONCERN:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Audio - Procedure To Handle Customer Radio Concerns > Page
6740
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Audio - Procedure To Handle Customer Radio Concerns > Page
6741
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Audio - Procedure To Handle Customer Radio Concerns > Page
6742
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Audio - Procedure To Handle Customer Radio Concerns > Page
6743
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Audio - Procedure To Handle Customer Radio Concerns > Page
6744
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Audio - Procedure To Handle Customer Radio Concerns > Page
6745
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Audio - Procedure To Handle Customer Radio Concerns > Page
6746
1997 APPLICATIONS
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Locations > Connector Locations
A-Center Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Locations > Connector Locations > Page 6749
Radio/Stereo: Ground Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Radio/Stereo: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6752
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6753
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6754
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6755
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6756
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6757
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6758
Radio/Stereo: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6759
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6760
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6761
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6762
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6763
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6764
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6765
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6766
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6767
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6768
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6769
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6770
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6771
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6772
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6773
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6774
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6775
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6776
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6777
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6778
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6779
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6780
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6781
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6782
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6783
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Radio/Stereo >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6784
Radio/Stereo: Connector Views
Harness Connector Faces: Radio
Harness Connector Faces: Radio (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Locations > LF
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Locations > LF > Page 6789
Tailgate (Station Wagon)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Locations > LF > Page 6790
Tailgate (Station Wagon)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Speaker: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6793
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6794
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6795
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6796
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6797
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6798
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6799
Speaker: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6800
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6801
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6802
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6803
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6804
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6805
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6806
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6807
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6808
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6809
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6810
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6811
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6812
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6813
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6814
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6815
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6816
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6817
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6818
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6819
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6820
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6821
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6822
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6823
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Speaker >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6824
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Tape Player: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6829
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6830
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6831
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6832
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6833
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6834
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6835
Tape Player: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6836
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6837
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6838
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6839
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6840
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6841
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6842
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6843
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6844
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6845
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6846
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6847
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6848
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6849
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6850
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6851
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6852
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6853
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6854
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6855
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6856
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6857
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6858
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6859
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc > Tape Player >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 6860
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Relay Module: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
Relay Module: Customer Interest Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D
Date: December 08, 2010
Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle
Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion
(Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Attention:
This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body
electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the
point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal
surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011
model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
- An intermittent no crank/no start
- Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination
- Intermittent service lamp illumination
- Intermittent service message(s) being displayed
The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as
fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector.
This may be caused by any of the following conditions:
- Vibration
- Thermal cycling
- Poor connection/terminal retention
- Micro motion
- A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement
On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent
connections.
On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and
may cause a device to become inoperative.
Representative List of Control Modules and Components
The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected
by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or
component for every vehicle.
- Blower Control Module
- Body Control Module (BCM)
- Communication Interface Module (CIM)
- Cooling Fan Control Module
- Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
- Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM)
- Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module
- Engine Control Module (ECM)
- Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Relay Module: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 6870
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Relay Module: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 6871
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Relay Module: >
09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 6872
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
Relay Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control
Modules
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D
Date: December 08, 2010
Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle
Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion
(Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Attention:
This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body
electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the
point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal
surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011
model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
- An intermittent no crank/no start
- Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination
- Intermittent service lamp illumination
- Intermittent service message(s) being displayed
The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as
fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector.
This may be caused by any of the following conditions:
- Vibration
- Thermal cycling
- Poor connection/terminal retention
- Micro motion
- A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement
On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent
connections.
On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and
may cause a device to become inoperative.
Representative List of Control Modules and Components
The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected
by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or
component for every vehicle.
- Blower Control Module
- Body Control Module (BCM)
- Communication Interface Module (CIM)
- Cooling Fan Control Module
- Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
- Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM)
- Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module
- Engine Control Module (ECM)
- Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 6878
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 6879
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional
Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 6880
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's
Set By Various Control Modules
Relay Module: Customer Interest Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D
Date: December 08, 2010
Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle
Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion
(Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Attention:
This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body
electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the
point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal
surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011
model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
- An intermittent no crank/no start
- Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination
- Intermittent service lamp illumination
- Intermittent service message(s) being displayed
The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as
fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector.
This may be caused by any of the following conditions:
- Vibration
- Thermal cycling
- Poor connection/terminal retention
- Micro motion
- A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement
On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent
connections.
On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and
may cause a device to become inoperative.
Representative List of Control Modules and Components
The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected
by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or
component for every vehicle.
- Blower Control Module
- Body Control Module (BCM)
- Communication Interface Module (CIM)
- Cooling Fan Control Module
- Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
- Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM)
- Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module
- Engine Control Module (ECM)
- Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's
Set By Various Control Modules > Page 6889
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's
Set By Various Control Modules > Page 6890
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's
Set By Various Control Modules > Page 6891
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules
Relay Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control
Modules
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D
Date: December 08, 2010
Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle
Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion
(Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Attention:
This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body
electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the
point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal
surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011
model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
- An intermittent no crank/no start
- Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination
- Intermittent service lamp illumination
- Intermittent service message(s) being displayed
The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as
fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector.
This may be caused by any of the following conditions:
- Vibration
- Thermal cycling
- Poor connection/terminal retention
- Micro motion
- A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement
On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent
connections.
On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and
may cause a device to become inoperative.
Representative List of Control Modules and Components
The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected
by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or
component for every vehicle.
- Blower Control Module
- Body Control Module (BCM)
- Communication Interface Module (CIM)
- Cooling Fan Control Module
- Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
- Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM)
- Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module
- Engine Control Module (ECM)
- Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 6897
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 6898
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Accessories and Optional Equipment > Relay Module > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Relay Module: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control Modules > Page 6899
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Body - TPO Fascia Cleaning Prior to Painting
Front Bumper Cover / Fascia: Technical Service Bulletins Body - TPO Fascia Cleaning Prior to
Painting
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-08-51-002
Date: March 12, 2008
Subject: New Primer For TPO Fascias and Affected Cleaning Process of Painting Operation
Models: 2009 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3
The purpose of this bulletin is to inform the technician that General Motors has made a change in
the primer it uses for TPO plastic for service parts. This new primer comes in several different
colors from five different suppliers. This change affects the cleaning process of the painting
operation. The new process is as follows.
1. Wash with soap and water.
2. Clean with a 50% mix of isopropyl alcohol and water (or a waterborne cleaner). Check with your
paint supplier for product recommendations.
3. Scuff sand per your paint suppliers recommendations.
Note:
The use of a solvent-type cleaner will soften, or begin to dissolve the primer. Base coats do not
have any affect on this primer.
4. Reclean with a 50% mix of isopropyl alcohol and water (or a waterborne cleaner).
All fascias, with the exception of the Corvette, Camaro, and Cadillac XLR, are made of TPO. You
may find other TPO parts with this primer. If the technician has a question as to the type of plastic
they are painting, inspect the back of the part for the plastic symbol (TPO).
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Reinforcement > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Body - Polypropylene Energy Absorber Replacement
Front Bumper Reinforcement: Technical Service Bulletins Body - Polypropylene Energy Absorber
Replacement
Bulletin No.: 07-08-63-001
Date: April 17, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Information on Repair of Polypropylene Energy Absorbers
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2007 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to change the repair information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 63-20-02 (Section 8 - Body and Accessories).
Because the energy absorbers are relatively low in cost to replace, it is now more cost efficient to
replace the energy absorbers whenever they are damaged.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Front Bumper > Front Bumper Shock Absorber > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Polypropylene Foam Energy Absorbers - Repair
Front Bumper Shock Absorber: Technical Service Bulletins Polypropylene Foam Energy Absorbers
- Repair
File In Section: 10 - Body
Bulletin No.: 63-20-02
Date: September, 1996
INFORMATION
Subject: Repair of Polypropylene Foam Energy Absorbers
Models: 1997 and Prior Passenger Cars Using Polypropylene Foam Energy Absorbers
Some General Motors vehicles use a formed piece of Polypropylene foam as energy absorbers
behind fascias. These energy absorbers (EA) are designed to offer a measure of safety in the
event of a collision and have been engineered to withstand slight impacts (5 mph or less) with little
or no damage. However, in some instances, the EA may crack or even break.
The following information has been developed to offer an alternative to low impact EA
replacements. The foam EA can be identified in most cases by the symbol "PP" molded into the
surface. Following the procedure will allow the technician to repair an EA and return the vehicle to
the original crashworthiness state.
Polypropylene Foam EA Repair Procedure
1. If cracked or broken, make sure all the pieces of the EA are available for the repair.
Important:
If pieces of the EA are missing, the EA must be replaced.
2. Clean the areas to be bonded by brushing off any loose dirt or using soap and water, if
necessary.
Notice:
DO NOT USE SOLVENTS TO CLEAN POLYPROPYLENE EA. The use of solvents may result in
damage to the EA.
3. Using a 3M POLYGUN TC HOT MELT APPLICATOR GUN* and 3M JETMELT ADHESIVE #
3764*, apply adhesive to the parts by following the instructions for the applicator gun. Ensure
complete wet out of the adhesive on the repair surfaces during reassembly of the EA.
Important:
The adhesive has a 40 second "work time" and requires a 2 minute "clamp time". Allow 20 minutes
for the adhesive to fully cure.
The "3M Polygun TC Hotmelt Applicator Gun" and "3M Jetmelt Adhesive # 3764" can be obtained
by calling DIRECTECH at 1-800-877-9344 or 612-941-2616.
* We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such products. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products from this firm or for any such items which may be available from
other sources.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Body - TPO Fascia Cleaning Prior to Painting
Rear Bumper Cover / Fascia: Technical Service Bulletins Body - TPO Fascia Cleaning Prior to
Painting
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-08-51-002
Date: March 12, 2008
Subject: New Primer For TPO Fascias and Affected Cleaning Process of Painting Operation
Models: 2009 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3
The purpose of this bulletin is to inform the technician that General Motors has made a change in
the primer it uses for TPO plastic for service parts. This new primer comes in several different
colors from five different suppliers. This change affects the cleaning process of the painting
operation. The new process is as follows.
1. Wash with soap and water.
2. Clean with a 50% mix of isopropyl alcohol and water (or a waterborne cleaner). Check with your
paint supplier for product recommendations.
3. Scuff sand per your paint suppliers recommendations.
Note:
The use of a solvent-type cleaner will soften, or begin to dissolve the primer. Base coats do not
have any affect on this primer.
4. Reclean with a 50% mix of isopropyl alcohol and water (or a waterborne cleaner).
All fascias, with the exception of the Corvette, Camaro, and Cadillac XLR, are made of TPO. You
may find other TPO parts with this primer. If the technician has a question as to the type of plastic
they are painting, inspect the back of the part for the plastic symbol (TPO).
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Reinforcement > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Body - Polypropylene Energy Absorber Replacement
Rear Bumper Reinforcement: Technical Service Bulletins Body - Polypropylene Energy Absorber
Replacement
Bulletin No.: 07-08-63-001
Date: April 17, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: Information on Repair of Polypropylene Energy Absorbers
Models: 2007 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2007 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to change the repair information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 63-20-02 (Section 8 - Body and Accessories).
Because the energy absorbers are relatively low in cost to replace, it is now more cost efficient to
replace the energy absorbers whenever they are damaged.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Bumper > Rear Bumper > Rear Bumper Shock Absorber > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Polypropylene Foam Energy Absorbers - Repair
Rear Bumper Shock Absorber: Technical Service Bulletins Polypropylene Foam Energy Absorbers
- Repair
File In Section: 10 - Body
Bulletin No.: 63-20-02
Date: September, 1996
INFORMATION
Subject: Repair of Polypropylene Foam Energy Absorbers
Models: 1997 and Prior Passenger Cars Using Polypropylene Foam Energy Absorbers
Some General Motors vehicles use a formed piece of Polypropylene foam as energy absorbers
behind fascias. These energy absorbers (EA) are designed to offer a measure of safety in the
event of a collision and have been engineered to withstand slight impacts (5 mph or less) with little
or no damage. However, in some instances, the EA may crack or even break.
The following information has been developed to offer an alternative to low impact EA
replacements. The foam EA can be identified in most cases by the symbol "PP" molded into the
surface. Following the procedure will allow the technician to repair an EA and return the vehicle to
the original crashworthiness state.
Polypropylene Foam EA Repair Procedure
1. If cracked or broken, make sure all the pieces of the EA are available for the repair.
Important:
If pieces of the EA are missing, the EA must be replaced.
2. Clean the areas to be bonded by brushing off any loose dirt or using soap and water, if
necessary.
Notice:
DO NOT USE SOLVENTS TO CLEAN POLYPROPYLENE EA. The use of solvents may result in
damage to the EA.
3. Using a 3M POLYGUN TC HOT MELT APPLICATOR GUN* and 3M JETMELT ADHESIVE #
3764*, apply adhesive to the parts by following the instructions for the applicator gun. Ensure
complete wet out of the adhesive on the repair surfaces during reassembly of the EA.
Important:
The adhesive has a 40 second "work time" and requires a 2 minute "clamp time". Allow 20 minutes
for the adhesive to fully cure.
The "3M Polygun TC Hotmelt Applicator Gun" and "3M Jetmelt Adhesive # 3764" can be obtained
by calling DIRECTECH at 1-800-877-9344 or 612-941-2616.
* We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such products. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products from this firm or for any such items which may be available from
other sources.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle >
Front Door Handle Switch > System Information > Locations > LH Front
Front Door Handle Switch: Locations LH Front
LH Front Door Handle Switch is located In LH Front Door Latch Assembly
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Handle >
Front Door Handle Switch > System Information > Locations > LH Front > Page 6936
Front Door Handle Switch: Locations RH Front
RH Front Door Handle Switch is located In RH Front Door Latch Assembly
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Glass > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion Information
Front Door Window Glass: Technical Service Bulletins Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-08-48-005D
Date: September 10, 2010
Subject: Distortion in Outer Surface of Vehicle Glass
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X 2010 and Prior Saturn
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-08-48-005C (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Distortion in the outer surface of the windshield glass, door glass or backlite glass may appear after
the vehicle has:
- Accumulated some mileage.
- Been frequently washed in automatic car washes, particularly "touchless" car washes.
This distortion may look like a subtle orange peel pattern, or may look like a drip or sag etched into
the surface of the glass.
Some car wash solutions contain a buffered solution of hydrofluoric acid which is used to clean the
glass. This should not cause a problem if used in the correct concentration. However, if not used
correctly, hydrofluoric acid will attack the glass, and over time, will cause visual distortion in the
outer surface of the glass which cannot be removed by scraping or polishing.
If this condition is suspected, look at the area of the windshield under the wipers or below the belt
seal on the side glass. The area of the glass below the wipers or belt seal will not be affected and
what looks like a drip or sag may be apparent at the edge of the wiper or belt seal. You may also
see a line on the glass where the wiper blade or the belt seal contacts the glass.
Important The repair will require replacing the affected glass and is not a result of a defect in
material or workmanship. Therefore, is not covered by New Vehicle Warranty.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Glass > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion Information > Page 6941
Front Door Window Glass: Technical Service Bulletins Body - Side Window Chipping Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-08-64-001B
Date: October 20, 2009
Subject: Information on Side Door Window Glass Chipping Caused by Hanging Vehicle Key Lock
Box
Models:
2010 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3
2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add vehicles and model years and to include all types of
door window glass. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-08-64-001A (Section 08 - Body &
Accessories).
- In several warranty parts review cases, side door window glass was observed with a chip or chips
on the top side of the window glass. Dealer contacts confirmed that they use a vehicle key lock box
on the front side door window glass.
- A random selection of side door glass returns will be conducted to confirm adherence. If a side
door glass is discovered with a chip or chips in the location previously described, the side door
glass will be returned to the dealership for debit.
Example of Side Door Glass
- DO NOT place a vehicle key lock box on a side door window glass.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Doors > Front Door > Front Door Window
Glass > System Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion Information > Page 6942
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Hood > Component Information > Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Trap Resistant Trunk Kit - Function/Installation
Trunk / Liftgate Latch: Technical Service Bulletins Trap Resistant Trunk Kit - Function/Installation
File In Section: 08 - Body and Accessories
Bulletin No.: 99-08-66-002A
Date: January, 2000
Subject: Trap Resistant Rear Compartment (Trunk) Kit
Models: 1990-2000 Passenger Cars with Rear Compartments Except: 1990-1991 Buick Reatta
2000
Buick LeSabre
1990-1993 Cadillac Allante, Fleetwood Brougham 1997-2000 Cadillac Seville 2000
Cadillac Deville
1990 Chevrolet Caprice
1990-1991 Chevrolet Cavalier 1990-1996 Chevrolet Beretta 1990-2000 Chevrolet Metro, Prizm
1998-2000 Chevrolet Corvette 2000
Chevrolet Impala
1990-1992 Oldsmobile Toronado/Trofeo 1990-1991 Pontiac Sunbird 1990-1993 Pontiac LeMans
2000
Pontiac Bonneville
This bulletin is being revised to add additional models and new part numbers. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 99-O8-66-002 (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
The purpose of this bulletin is to inform dealership personnel about the Trap Resistant Rear
Compartment (Trunk) Kit, including the system function, necessary vehicle modifications and part
numbers required to install the kit.
The Trap Resistant Rear Compartment kit is composed of three main system components; one of
which (the Rear Seat Tether), may or may not be needed, depending on the vehicle being retrofit.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Trap Resistant Trunk Kit - Function/Installation > Page 6951
The first component of the kit is the illuminated Interior Release Handle (1). The Release Handle is
mounted inside the rear compartment to the deck lid. This handle was designed so that a small
child trapped in the rear compartment could use it to open the deck lid. The handle operates the
deck lid latch mechanically, but is illuminated with two LED's when the deck lid is closed. The
handle remains illuminated for a period of about one hour after the deck lid is closed. The LED's
create a small parasitic load that will not drain the vehicle battery with normal usage.
The second component of the kit is the Trap Resistant Latch (2). the Trap Resistant Latch is a
modified deck lid latch designed to help prevent a child from unintentionally closing and latching the
deck lid. The Trap Resistant Latch opens the rear compartment normally through all current means
(key, RKE or passenger compartment release) but cannot be re-latched without the user
performing a reset function. This reset function consists of pushing up on a small knob (3), while
simultaneously pushing a slide mechanism to the right (4). Once the slide mechanism is fully
pushed over, the small knob can be released. This function is a simple on-hand operation for an
adult, but is difficult for a young child to perform. If the latch is not enabled, the deck lid will not
latch and the rear compartment will not close.
The third component is the Rear Seat Tether Kit. If the vehicle is equipped with a pass-through to
the rear compartment and the folding rear seat can be unlatched from within the passenger
compartment without the use of a key or other unlocking feature, then a Rear Seat Tether must be
installed. This tether helps prevent a child from gaining access to the rear compartment of a vehicle
from the passenger compartment by allowing a secondary lock of the seatback. The Rear Seat
Tether employs one or two tethers (one per folding seatback), each permanently connected to a
T-handle anchor mounted in the rear compartment. To lock the folding seatback, the user can
partially fold the seatback and attach the tether to another T-handle anchor mounted to the
seatback. When the tether is affixed to both T-handle anchors, the seat cannot be folded down. To
fold down the seatback, the tether must be removed from the anchor attached to the seatback.
Important:
Installation of the Trap Resistant Latch on some vehicles may require sheet metal and/or trim
modifications to the rear compartment striker area. These modifications should be communicated
with the customer prior to installations. Also, installation of the Trap Resistant Latch requires a rear
compartment lid "ajar" switch. Prior to ordering the Trap Resistant Rear Compartment Kit, inspect
the old deck lid latch to see if it is equipped with an "ajar" switch. If the vehicle is not equipped with
this switch, P/N 12506174 must be ordered.
After completing the Trap Resistant Rear Compartment Kit installation, provide the customer with
the supplemental Owner's Manual insert included in the kit and demonstrate the system function.
This program is specially structured for a single purchase price to the owner. The owner is
responsible to pay a maximum of $50.00 U.S.; $80.00 Canadian for parts and labor to install the
complete Trap Resistant Rear Compartment Kit and Rear Seat Tether(s), if required.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Latch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Trap Resistant Trunk Kit - Function/Installation > Page 6952
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Labor Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Behind RH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6957
Behind RH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Solenoid >
Component Information > Locations
Tailgate (Station Wagon)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Component Locations
Tailgate (Station Wagon)
Behind RH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Doors, Hood and Trunk > Trunk / Liftgate > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 6965
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Connector Locations
Behind RH Side Of I/P
Behind RH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Exterior Moulding / Trim > Body Emblem > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > 06-08-111-004B - BULLETIN CANCELLATION NOTIFICATION
Body Emblem: Technical Service Bulletins 06-08-111-004B - BULLETIN CANCELLATION
NOTIFICATION
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 06-08-111-004B
Date: September 25, 2009
Subject: Information on Discoloration, Blistering, Peeling or Erosion of Various Exterior Emblems
Including Chevy Bowtie (Bulletin Cancelled)
Models:
2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2
2006-2009 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being cancelled. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number
06-08-111-004A (Section 08 - Body & Accessories).
This bulletin is being cancelled. The information is no longer applicable.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Body Squeeze Type Resistance Spot Welding/Equipment
Frame: Technical Service Bulletins Body - Squeeze Type Resistance Spot Welding/Equipment
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 03-08-98-002B
Date: June 30, 2010
Subject: Squeeze Type Resistance Spot Welding/Equipment
Models:
2011 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2010 HUMMER H2, H3
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 03-08-98-002A (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
This bulletin provides guidelines for repair shops that wish to use squeeze type resistance spot
welding (or simply, spot welding) as an alternative to MIG plug welding when performing collision
repair procedures. The process of spot welding for attaching body panels and components has
been around for many years and is similar to the production welding process used in assembly
plants. Spot welding may be applicable in similar situations that are currently MIG plug welded.
The following are some of the benefits of spot welding:
- Less heat or burn damage
- Less damage to corrosion protection
- Drilling of holes not required
- Replication of the production weld appearance
Applicable components for this technology may be panels or components with flanges that are
accessible with arms and tips supplied by the equipment manufacturer. Welds from this equipment
should be applied on a one-for-one basis, next to the production welds.
Here are some of the important factors in proper welding with this equipment.
Important Proper use and safety training for each user of the equipment is a must.
- Use equipment from companies that are able to produce welds that meet industry standards for
size and strength. Equipment most likely to meet those standards at this time would be "inverter"
technology and include the following suppliers (other suppliers may have comparable equipment):
- Pro Spot (PR2000)
- Elektron (M100)
- Blackhawk (WEL700)
- Car-O-Liner (CR500) For specific information about this and other equipment, call GM Dealer
Equipment.
- Ensure that the building power source is capable of meeting the equipment manufacturer's power
requirement specifications. For example, fuse 60 amp, 208-230 V single or 3-phase, using supply
wire of sufficient gauge to carry the current load. Consult with a qualified electrician for wiring
assistance.
- Prepare and perform sample welds for destructive testing made from similar materials. Perform
this operation for each vehicle repaired and prior to actual repair.
- Proper equipment maintenance
- Proper weld tip alignment and maintenance
- Ensure that metal flanges are clean and conform to each other
A more complete description of these practices and standards can be found in the following
publications:
- SAE J-2667, Surface Vehicles Recommended Practice, http://www.sae.org
- AWS D8.7-88, Recommended Practices Automotive Weld Quality - Resistance Spot Welding,
http://www.aws.org/w/a/
- AWS D8.9-97, Recommended Practices for Test Methods for Evaluating the Resistance Spot
Welding Behavior of Automotive Sheet Steels, http://www.aws.com
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Frame > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Body Squeeze Type Resistance Spot Welding/Equipment > Page 6975
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Interior - Proper Use of Floor Mats
Carpet: Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Proper Use of Floor Mats
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 10-08-110-001
Date: March 30, 2010
Subject: Information on Proper Use of Floor Mats
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2009 HUMMER H2
2006-2010 HUMMER H3, H3T 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
GM's carpeted and all-weather (rubber) floor mats are especially designed for use in specific GM
vehicles. Using floor mats that were not designed for the specific vehicle or using them incorrectly
may cause interference with the accelerator or brake pedal. Please review the following safety
guidelines regarding proper driver's side floor mat usage with the customer.
Warning
If a floor mat is the wrong size or is not properly installed, it can interfere with the accelerator pedal
and/or brake pedal. Interference with the pedals can cause unintended acceleration and/or
increased stopping distance which can cause a crash and injury. Make sure the floor mat does not
interfere with the accelerator or brake pedal.
- Do not flip the driver's floor mat over (in an effort to keep the floor mat clean)
- Do not place anything on top of the driver's floor mat (e.g. carpet remnant, towel)
- Do not place another mat on top of the driver's floor mat (e.g. do not place all-weather rubber
mats over carpeted floor mats)
- Only use floor mats that are designed specifically for your vehicle
- When using replacement mats, make certain the mats do not interfere with the accelerator or
brake pedal before driving the vehicle
If your vehicle is equipped with a floor mat retaining pin(s) or clip(s), make certain the mat is
installed correctly and according to the instructions.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Interior - Proper Use of Floor Mats > Page 6981
After installing floor mats, make certain they cannot move and do not interfere with the accelerator
or brake pedals.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Interior - Proper Use of Floor Mats > Page 6982
Carpet: Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Elimination Of Unwanted Odors
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-00-89-027E
Date: September 29, 2008
Subject: Eliminating Unwanted Odors in Vehicles
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2009 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 Vehicles 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years and refine the instructions. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 00-00-89-027D (Section 00 - General Information).
Vehicle Odor Elimination
General Motors offers a product that may control or eliminate odors in the interior and luggage
compartment areas of GM vehicles. GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator is a non-toxic,
biodegradable odor remover. This odorless product has been shown to greatly reduce or remove
objectionable smells of mold and mildew resulting from vehicle water leaks (as well as customer
created odors, i.e. smoke). You may use GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator on fabrics, vinyl,
leather, carpet and sound deadening materials. It may also be induced into HVAC modules and
instrument panel ducts (for the control of non-bacterial related odors).
Important:
This product leaves no residual scent and should not be sold as or considered an air freshener.
Product action may result in the permanent elimination of an odor and may be preferable to
customers with allergies who are sensitive to perfumes.
How to Use This Product
GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator may be sprayed on in a ready-to-use formula or used in steam
cleaners as an additive with carpet shampoo. This water-based, odorless product is safe for all
vehicle interiors. Do not wet or soak any interior surface that plain water would cause to
deteriorate, as this product will have the same effect. Also avoid letting this product come into
contact with vinegar or any acidic substance. Acid-based products will hamper the effectiveness of,
or render GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator inert.
Note:
Complete eight page treatment sheets are enclosed within each case of GM Vehicle Care Odor
Eliminator. These treatment instructions range from simple vehicle odor elimination to full step by
step procedures for odor removal from water leaks. If lost, contact 800-977-4145 to get a
replacement set faxed or e-mailed to your dealership.
Instructions and cautions are printed on the bottle, but additional help is available. If you encounter
a difficult to eliminate or reoccurring odor, you may call 1-800-955-8591 (in Canada,
1-800-977-4145) to obtain additional information and usage suggestions.
Important:
This product may effectively remove odors when directly contacting the odor source. It should be
used in conjunction with diagnostic procedures (in cases such as a water leak) to first eliminate the
root cause of the odor, and then the residual odor to permanently correct the vehicle condition.
Vehicle Waterleak Odor Elimination
STEP ONE:
Confirm that all water leaks have been repaired. Determine what areas of the vehicle were water
soaked or wet. Components with visible mold/mildew staining should be replaced. Isolate the odor
source inside the vehicle. Often an odor can be isolated to an area or component of the vehicle
interior by careful evaluation. Odor evaluation may need to be performed by multiple persons.
Another method of isolating an odor source is to remove and segregate interior trim and
components. Plastic sheeting or drop cloths can be used to confine seats, headliners, etc. to assist
in evaluation and diagnoses. If appropriate the vehicle and interior trim should be evaluated
separately to determine if the odor stays with the vehicle or the interior components. Odors that
stay with the vehicle may be isolated to insulating and sound deadening materials (i.e. water leak
at the windshield or standing water in the front foot well area caused mold/mildew to form on the
bulkhead or kick panel sound deadening pads. If the interior is removed the floor pan and
primed/painted surfaces should be treated with bleach/soap solution, rinsed with clean water and
dried. Interior surfaces should then be treated with GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator product
before reinstalling carpet or reassembling.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Interior - Proper Use of Floor Mats > Page 6983
The GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator product is an effective odor elimination product when used
properly. It must come into direct contact with the odor source. It should be used in conjunction with
diagnostic procedures to first eliminate the root cause of the odor. Some procedures for use after
odor root cause correction are:
STEP TWO:
^ Use the trigger spray head.
^ Put a drop of dish soap the size of a quarter in the bottom of a bottle.
^ Add 8 oz. of GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator (1 cup) to the dish soap and top off the bottle with
tap water.
^ This formula should be used on hard surfaces (dash, interior plastic molding, and floor pan)
STEP THREE:
The third step to neutralizing the vehicle is a light to medium treatment of all carpeting and
upholstered seats with the GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator formula and a wide fan spray setting
(at full strength) (i.e.: carpeting on the driver's side requires 4-5 triggers pulls for coverage). The
headliner and trunk should be sprayed next. Lightly brushing the formula into the carpeting and
upholstery is a recommended step for deep odor problems. The dash and all hard surfaces should
be sprayed with dish soap/water mixture. Let stand for 1-2 minutes then wipe off the surface.
STEP FOUR: (vehicle ventilation system treatment)
The ventilation system is generally the last step in the treatment of the vehicle.
a. Spray the GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator formula into all dash vents. (1-2 trigger pulls per
vent).
b. Start the vehicle and turn the vehicle fan on high cool (not A/C setting).
c. Spray the formula (10 trigger pulls) into the outside fresh air intake vent (cowl at base of
windshield)
d. Enter the vehicle after 1 minute and wipe off the excess formula spurting out of the dash vents.
e. Smell the air coming from the dash vents. If odors are still present, spray another 5 triggers into
the cowl, wait another minute and smell the results. Once you have obtained a fresh, clean smell
coming from the vents, turn the system to the A/C re-circulation setting. Roll up the windows, spray
3-5 pumps into the right lower IP area and let the vehicle run with the fan set on high for 5-7
minutes.
Please follow this diagnosis process thoroughly and complete each step. If the condition exhibited
is resolved without completing every step, the remaining steps do not need to be performed. If
these steps do not resolve the condition, please contact GM TAC for further diagnostic assistance.
Additional Suggestions to Increase Customer Satisfaction
Here are some additional ideas to benefit your dealership and to generate greater customer
enthusiasm for this product.
^ Keep this product on-hand for both the Service Department and the Used Car lot. Add value to
your used car trades; treat loaner and demo cars during service and at final sale to eliminate
smoke, pet, and other common odors offensive to customers. Make deodorizing a vehicle part of
your normal vehicle detailing service.
^ Consider including GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator as a give-away item with new vehicle
purchases. Many dealers give away as "gifts" various cleaning supplies at time of delivery. GM
Odor Eliminator is one of a few products GM offers that has as many uses in the home as in the
vehicle. Customers may find this product can be used for a host of recreational activities
associated with their new vehicle, such as deodorizing a boat they tow, or a camper.
^ GM Odor Eliminator and many of the GM Vehicle Care products offer you the chance to increase
dealership traffic as these superior quality products cannot be purchased in stores. Many
Dealerships have product displays at the parts counter. Consider additional displays in the
Customer Service Lounge, the Showroom and at the Service Desk or Cashier Window. Many
customers who purchase vehicles and receive regular maintenance at your dealership may never
visit the parts counter, and subsequently are not exposed to the variety and value that these
products offer.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Carpet > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Interior - Proper Use of Floor Mats > Page 6984
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Console > Component Information > Locations
Console
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dash Board / Instrument Panel <-->
[Dashboard / Instrument Panel] > Component Information > Service and Repair
Dash Board / Instrument Panel: Service and Repair
Fig. 87 Steering Column Opening Filler Removal
Fig. 88 I/P Compartment Housing Removal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dash Board / Instrument Panel <-->
[Dashboard / Instrument Panel] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 6991
Fig. 89 Convenience Center Removal
Fig. 90 I/P Removal
1. Disconnect battery ground cable, then remove three screws from steering column opening filler,
Fig. 87, and pull downward to disengage clips and remove.
2. Remove left and right sound insulators.
3. Remove instrument panel compartment housing as follows: a. Open instrument panel
compartment door, Fig. 88, then remove screws attaching instrument panel housing to instrument
panel. b. Pull out housing enough to disconnect rear compartment lid release switch and remove
instrument panel compartment light and right courtesy
lamp.
c. Remove instrument panel compartment housing.
4. Remove console assembly, then the convenience center, Fig. 89.
5. Disconnect forward lamp and engine electrical harnesses from bulkhead connector.
6. Remove two corner instrument panel retaining screws, and one screw to instrument panel brace
at left side of instrument panel opening, Fig. 90.
7. Remove defroster grilles, then the upper retaining screws located in defroster duct openings.
8. Remove steering column as described in ``Steering Columns'' section.
9. Pull instrument panel assembly out enough to disconnect all electrical connectors and vacuum
lines.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Interior Moulding / Trim > Dash Board / Instrument Panel <-->
[Dashboard / Instrument Panel] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 6992
10. Remove instrument panel assembly with electrical harness attached.
11. If necessary, remove electrical harness assembly.
12. Reverse procedure to install.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Door Locks > Door Module > Component Information >
Locations
Convenience Center
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Key > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Locks - Key Code Security Rules and Information
Key: Technical Service Bulletins Locks - Key Code Security Rules and Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 10-00-89-010
Date: May 27, 2010
Subject: Key Code Security Rules and Information on GM KeyCode Look-Up Application (Canada
Only)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior
Saturn and Saab 2002 and Prior Isuzu
Attention:
This bulletin has been created to address potential issues and questions regarding KeyCode
security. This bulletin should be read by all parties involved in KeyCode activity, including dealer
operator, partner security coordinator, sales, service and parts departments. A copy of this bulletin
should be printed and maintained in the parts department for use as a reference.
Important U.S. dealers should refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 10-00-89-009.
Where Are Key Codes Located?
General Motors provides access to KeyCodes through three sources when a vehicle is delivered to
a dealer. Vehicle KeyCodes are located on the original vehicle invoice to the dealership. There is a
small white bar coded tag sent with most new vehicles that also has the key code printed on it.
Dealerships should make a practice of comparing the tag's keycode numbers to the keycode listed
on the invoice. Any discrepancy should be reported immediately to the GM of Canada Key Code
Inquiry Desk. Remember to remove the key tag prior to showing vehicles to potential customers.
The third source for Key codes is through the GM KeyCode Look-Up feature within the
OEConnection D2DLink application. KeyCode Look-Up currently goes back 17 previous model
years from the current model year.
When a vehicle is received by the dealership, care should be taken to safeguard the original
vehicle invoice and KeyCode tag provided with the vehicle. Potential customers should not have
access to the invoice or this KeyCode tag prior to the sale being completed. After a sale has been
completed, the KeyCode information belongs to the customer and General Motors.
Tip
Only the original invoice contains key code information, a re-printed invoice does not.
GM KeyCode Look-Up Application for GM of Canada Dealers
All dealers should review the General Motors of Canada KeyCode Look-Up Policies and
Procedures (Service Policy & Procedures Manual Section 3.1.6 "Replacement of VIN plates &
keys").
Please note that the KeyCode Access site is restricted. Only authorized users should be using this
application. Please see your Parts Manager for site authorized users. KeyCode Look-Up currently
goes back 17 years from current model year.
Important notes about security:
- Users may not access the system from multiple computers simultaneously.
- Users may only request one KeyCode at a time.
- KeyCode information will only be available on the screen for 2 minutes.
- Each user is personally responsible for maintaining and protecting their password.
- Never share your password with others.
- User Id's are suspended after 6 consecutive failed attempts.
- User Id's are disabled if not used for 90 days.
- Processes must be in place for regular dealership reviews.
- The Parts Manager (or assigned management) must have processes in place for employee
termination or life change events. Upon termination individuals access must be turned off
immediately and access should be re-evaluated upon any position changes within the dealership.
- If you think your password or ID security has been breached, contact Dealer Systems Support at
1-800-265-0573.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Key > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Locks - Key Code Security Rules and Information > Page 7002
Each user will be required to accept the following agreement each time the KeyCode application is
used.
Key Code User Agreement
- Key codes are proprietary information belonging to General Motors Corporation and to the vehicle
owner.
- Unauthorized access to, or use of, key code information is unlawful and may subject the user to
criminal and civil penalties.
- This information should be treated as strictly confidential and should not be disclosed to anyone
unless authorized.
I will ensure that the following information is obtained prior to releasing any Key Code information:
1. Government issued picture ID (Drivers License) 2. Registration or other proof of ownership.
Registration should have normal markings from the Province that issued the registration and
possibly the
receipt for payment recorded as well.
Important
- GM takes this agreement seriously. Each user must be certain of vehicle ownership before giving
out key codes.
- When the ownership of the vehicle is in doubt, dealership personnel should not provide the
information.
Key code requests should never be received via a fax or the internet and key codes should never
be provided to anyone in this manner. A face to face contact with the owner of the vehicle is the
expected manner that dealers will use to release a key code or as otherwise stipulated in this
bulletin or other materials.
- Key codes should NEVER be sent via a fax or the internet.
- Each Dealership should create a permanent file to document all KeyCode Look Up transactions.
Requests should be filed by VIN and in each folder retain copies of the following:
- Government issued picture ID (Drivers License)
- Registration or other proof of ownership.
- Copy of the paid customer receipt which has the name of the employee who cut and sold the key
to the customer.
- Do not put yourself or your Dealership in the position of needing to "explain" a KeyCode Look Up
to either GM or law enforcement officials.
- Dealership Management has the ability to review all KeyCode Look-Up transactions.
- Dealership KeyCode documentation must be retained for two years.
Frequently Asked Questions (FAQs) for GM of Canada Dealers
How do I request a KeyCode for customer owned vehicle that is not registered?
Scrapped, salvaged or stored vehicles that do not have a current registration should still have the
ownership verified by requesting the vehicle title, current insurance policy and / or current lien
holder information from the customers financing source. If you cannot determine if the customer is
the owner of the vehicle, do not provide the key code information. In these cases, a short
description of the vehicle (scrapped, salvaged, etc.) and the dealership location should be kept on
file. Any clarifying explanation should be entered into the comments field.
How do I document a KeyCode request for a vehicle that is being repossessed?
The repossessor must document ownership of the vehicle by providing a court ordered
repossession order and lien-holder documents prior to providing key code information. Copies of
the repossessors Drivers License and a business card should be retained by the dealership for
documentation.
What do I do if the registration information is locked in the vehicle?
Every effort should be made to obtain complete information for each request. Each Dealership will
have to decide on a case by case basis if enough information is available to verify the customer's
ownership of the vehicle. Other forms of documentation include vehicle title, insurance policy, and
or current lien information from the customers financing source. Dealership Management must be
involved in any request without complete information. If you cannot determine if the customer is the
owner of the vehicle, do not provide the key code information.
Can I get a print out of the information on the screen?
It is important to note that the Key Code Look Up Search Results contain sensitive and/or
proprietary information. For this reason GM recommends against printing it. If the Search Results
must be printed, store and/or dispose of the printed copy properly to minimize the risk of improper
or illegal use.
Who in the dealership has access to the KeyCode application?
Dealership Parts Manager (or assigned management) will determine, and control, who is
authorized to access the KeyCode Look Up application. However, we anticipate that dealership
parts and service management will be the primary users of the application. The KeyCode Look Up
application automatically tracks each user activity session. Information tracked by the system
includes: User name, User ID, all other entered data and the date/time of access.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Key > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Locks - Key Code Security Rules and Information > Page 7003
What if I input the VIN incorrectly?
If an incorrect VIN is entered into the system (meaning that the system does not recognize the VIN
or that the VIN has been entered incorrectly) the system will return an error message.
If I am an authorized user for the KeyCode application, can I access the application from home?
Yes.
What if I suspect key code misuse?
Your dealership should communicate the proper procedures for requesting key codes. Any
suspicious activity either within the dealership or externally should be reported to Dealer Systems
Support at 1-800-265-0573 or GM of Canada Key Code Inquiry Desk at 1-905-644-4892.
Whose key codes can I access through the system?
At this time the following Canadian vehicle codes are available through the system: Chevrolet,
Cadillac, Buick, Pontiac, GMC, HUMMER (H2 and H3 only), Oldsmobile, Saturn, Saab and Isuzu
(up to 2002 model year) for a maximum of 17 model years.
What should I do if I enter a valid VIN and the system does not produce any key code information?
Occasionally, the KeyCode Look Up application may not produce a key code for a valid VIN. This
may be the result of new vehicle information not yet available. In addition, older vehicle information
may have been sent to an archive status. If you do not receive a key code returned for valid VIN,
you should contact GM of Canada Key Code Inquiry Desk at 1-905-644-4892.
How do I access KeyCodes if the KeyCode Look-up system is down?
If the KeyCode Look-up system is temporarily unavailable, you can contact the original selling
dealer who may have it on file or contact GM of Canada Key Code Inquiry Desk at
1-905-644-4892. If the customer is dealing with an emergency lock-out situation, you need to have
the customer contact Roadside assistance, OnStar if subscribed, or 911.
What should I do if the KeyCode from the look-up system does not work on the vehicle?
On occasion a dealer may encounter a KeyCode that will not work on the vehicle in question. In
cases where the KeyCode won't work you will need to verify with the manufacturer of the cutting
equipment that the key has been cut correctly. If the key has been cut correctly you may be able to
verify the proper KeyCode was given through the original selling dealer. When unable to verify the
KeyCode through the original selling dealer contact GM of Canada Key Code Inquiry Desk at
1-905-644-4892. If the key has been cut correctly and the code given does not work, the lock
cylinder may have been changed. In these situations following the proper SI document for recoding
a key or replacing the lock cylinder may be necessary.
How long do I have to keep KeyCode Records?
Dealership KeyCode documentation must be retained for two years.
Can I get a KeyCode changed in the Look-Up system?
Yes, KeyCodes can be changed in the Look-Up system if a lock cylinder has been changed.
Contact GM of Canada Key Code Inquiry Desk at 1-905-644-4892.
What information do I need before I can provide a driver of a company fleet vehicle Keys or
KeyCode information?
The dealership should have a copy of the individual's driver's license, proof of employment and
registration. If there is any question as to the customer's employment by the fleet company, the
dealer should attempt to contact the fleet company for verification. If there is not enough
information to determine ownership and employment, this information should not be provided.
How do I document a request from an Independent Repair facility for a KeyCode or Key?
The independent must provide a copy of their driver's license, proof of employment and signed
copy of the repair order for that repair facility. The repair order must include customer's name,
address, VIN, city, province and license plate number. Copies of this information must be included
in your dealer KeyCode file.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Key > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Locks - Key Code Security Rules and Information > Page 7004
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Remote Keyless Entry <--> [Keyless Entry] > Keyless Entry
Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tools - Keyless Entry Transmitter Tester
Keyless Entry Transmitter: Technical Service Bulletins Tools - Keyless Entry Transmitter Tester
File In Section: 9 - Accessories
Bulletin No.: 83-90-12
Date: August, 1998
INFORMATION
Subject: Essential Tool J 43241 Remote Keyless Entry and Passive Keyless Entry Transmitter
Tester
Models:
1990-99 Passenger Cars and Trucks with Remote Keyless Entry or Passive Keyless Entry
Systems
A new essential tool, J 43241 Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter Tester, has been sent to all GM
Dealers. This tester can be used on all RKE and PKE systems, on past as well as current models.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Remote Keyless Entry <--> [Keyless Entry] > Keyless Entry
Transmitter > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Tools - Keyless Entry Transmitter Tester > Page 7010
Important:
Before using the tester and the diagnostic chart, the following two steps must be performed.
1. Verify that the keyless entry transmitter is the correct model for the vehicle remote system. An
incorrect model transmitter may pass this test, but may not activate the vehicle remote system. The
correct transmitter can usually be identified by part number.
2. Ensure that the transmitter is synchronized with the vehicle (if applicable). Refer to Transmitter
Synchronization in the appropriate Service Manual.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Locations > Left Front
Power Door Lock Actuator: Locations Left Front
LH Front Of Door (Coupe)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Locations > Left Front > Page 7016
LH Front Of Door (Convertible)
LH Front Door (Station Wagon Shown, Sedan Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Locations > Left Front > Page 7017
Power Door Lock Actuator: Locations Right Front
RH Front Of Door (Coupe)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Locations > Left Front > Page 7018
RH Front Door (Convertible)
RH Front Door (Station Wagon Shown, Sedan Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Actuator > Component
Information > Locations > Left Front > Page 7019
LH Rear Door (Sedan And Station Wagon) (RH Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > Auto Door Lock Module/Enable Relay
Power Door Lock Control Module: Locations Auto Door Lock Module/Enable Relay
The Automatic Door Unlock Module is located at the left hand side of the Dash, near C100.
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
C100 (42 cavities) is located at the upper left hand side of Engine Compartment.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > Auto Door Lock Module/Enable Relay > Page 7024
Convenience Center
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7025
Harness Connector Faces: Door Unlock Module
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Relay > Component
Information > Locations
RH Front Door (Convertible)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7029
Harness Connector Faces: Automatic Door Lock Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Door Lock Switch: > 438101B > Sep > 95 > Interior
- Lights Remain On/Battery Becomes Rundown
Power Door Lock Switch: Customer Interest Interior - Lights Remain On/Battery Becomes
Rundown
File In Section: 8 - Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 43-81-01B
Date: September, 1995
Subject: Battery Rundown/Interior Lights Remain On (Diagnostic Check/Replace Door Handle
Switch)
Models: 1992-94 Chevrolet Cavalier 1994
Chevrolet Corsica, Beretta
1992-94 Pontiac Sunbird
This bulletin is being revised to update the correction procedure and parts and warranty
information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 43-81-01A (Section 8 - Chassis/Body
Electrical).
Condition
Some owners may experience interior lights staying "ON" after all doors are closed and after the
Multi-Function Alarm Module's inadvertent lighting function has timed out, causing battery rundown.
In the Corsica/Beretta, the Multi-Function Alarm Module will automatically turn off the interior lights
after 20 minutes. The Cavalier and Sunbird's interior lights will continue to light indefinitely.
Cause
The LH and/or RH front door handle switch(es) may be providing a resistive path to ground which
may cause the Multi-Function Alarm Module to sense that the door(s) are falsely open.
Correction
Follow the diagnostic procedure as listed below. If a resistance other than the specified value
registers during testing, replace the malfunctioning door handle switch, (see P/N chart). Continue
through the entire test to check that both the RH and LH door handle switches are functioning
properly.
1. Disconnect the Multi-Function Alarm Module.
2. With the LH front door open, measure the resistance from:
Term "J" to Term "P" (J Car)
CONN C1, Term "H" to CONN C2, Term "E" (L Car)
Resistance should be between 0 - 0.5 Ohms.
3. With the LH front door closed, measure the resistance from:
Term "J" to Term "P" (J Car)
CONN C1, Term "H" to CONN C2, Term "E" (L Car)
Resistance should be > 30 Mega Ohms.
4. With the RH front door open, measure the resistance from:
Term "K" to Term "P" (J Car)
CONN C1, Term "G" to CONN C2, Term "E" (L Car)
Resistance should be between 0 - 0.5 Ohms.
5. With the RH front door closed, measure the resistance from:
Term "K" to Term "P" (J Car)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Door Lock Switch: > 438101B > Sep > 95 > Interior
- Lights Remain On/Battery Becomes Rundown > Page 7038
CONN C1, Term "G" to CONN 02, Term "E" (L Car)
Resistance should be > 30 Mega Ohms.
Parts Information
All parts are found in Group 10.470 - LOCK ASM F/RH or LH
Important:
The door handle switches are part of the front side door lock assembly.
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Door Lock Switch: > 438101B > Sep >
95 > Interior - Lights Remain On/Battery Becomes Rundown
Power Door Lock Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Lights Remain On/Battery
Becomes Rundown
File In Section: 8 - Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 43-81-01B
Date: September, 1995
Subject: Battery Rundown/Interior Lights Remain On (Diagnostic Check/Replace Door Handle
Switch)
Models: 1992-94 Chevrolet Cavalier 1994
Chevrolet Corsica, Beretta
1992-94 Pontiac Sunbird
This bulletin is being revised to update the correction procedure and parts and warranty
information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 43-81-01A (Section 8 - Chassis/Body
Electrical).
Condition
Some owners may experience interior lights staying "ON" after all doors are closed and after the
Multi-Function Alarm Module's inadvertent lighting function has timed out, causing battery rundown.
In the Corsica/Beretta, the Multi-Function Alarm Module will automatically turn off the interior lights
after 20 minutes. The Cavalier and Sunbird's interior lights will continue to light indefinitely.
Cause
The LH and/or RH front door handle switch(es) may be providing a resistive path to ground which
may cause the Multi-Function Alarm Module to sense that the door(s) are falsely open.
Correction
Follow the diagnostic procedure as listed below. If a resistance other than the specified value
registers during testing, replace the malfunctioning door handle switch, (see P/N chart). Continue
through the entire test to check that both the RH and LH door handle switches are functioning
properly.
1. Disconnect the Multi-Function Alarm Module.
2. With the LH front door open, measure the resistance from:
Term "J" to Term "P" (J Car)
CONN C1, Term "H" to CONN C2, Term "E" (L Car)
Resistance should be between 0 - 0.5 Ohms.
3. With the LH front door closed, measure the resistance from:
Term "J" to Term "P" (J Car)
CONN C1, Term "H" to CONN C2, Term "E" (L Car)
Resistance should be > 30 Mega Ohms.
4. With the RH front door open, measure the resistance from:
Term "K" to Term "P" (J Car)
CONN C1, Term "G" to CONN C2, Term "E" (L Car)
Resistance should be between 0 - 0.5 Ohms.
5. With the RH front door closed, measure the resistance from:
Term "K" to Term "P" (J Car)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Door Lock Switch: > 438101B > Sep >
95 > Interior - Lights Remain On/Battery Becomes Rundown > Page 7044
CONN C1, Term "G" to CONN 02, Term "E" (L Car)
Resistance should be > 30 Mega Ohms.
Parts Information
All parts are found in Group 10.470 - LOCK ASM F/RH or LH
Important:
The door handle switches are part of the front side door lock assembly.
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Left Front Door Lock Switch
Power Door Lock Switch: Locations Left Front Door Lock Switch
LH Front Of Door (Coupe)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Left Front Door Lock Switch > Page 7047
LH Front Of Door (Convertible)
LH Front Door (Station Wagon Shown, Sedan Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Left Front Door Lock Switch > Page 7048
Power Door Lock Switch: Locations Right Front Door Lock Switch
RH Front Of Door (Coupe)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Left Front Door Lock Switch > Page 7049
RH Front Door (Convertible)
RH Front Door (Station Wagon Shown, Sedan Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Left Front Door Lock Switch > Page 7050
LH Rear Door (Sedan And Station Wagon) (RH Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Left Front Door Lock Switch
Harness Connector Faces: LH Front Door Lock Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Locks > Power Locks > Power Door Lock Switch > Component
Information > Diagrams > Left Front Door Lock Switch > Page 7053
Harness Connector Faces: RH Front Door Lock Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Mirrors > Heated Element, Mirror > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Mirrors - Heated Mirrors, Defrosting Time
Heated Element: Technical Service Bulletins Mirrors - Heated Mirrors, Defrosting Time
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-08-64-011A
Date: February 25, 2010
Subject: Information on Heated Electrochromatic Outside Rearview Mirror Performance
Models:
2010 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks (including Saturn) 2009 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the model years. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 08-08-64-011 (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Defrosting Time/Performance Concern
The electrochromatic (auto-dimming) outside rearview mirror used on the driver's side of many GM
vehicles is slower to defrost than the passenger side outside rearview mirror.
This is a normal condition. The glass on the driver's side electrochromatic mirror is twice as thick as
the traditional glass on the passenger side mirror. The heating elements for the mirrors on both
sides draw the same wattage, therefore the driver's side mirror will take approximately twice as
long to defrost as the passenger mirror (approximately four minutes versus two minutes). Should a
customer indicate that the driver's side heated mirror is not functioning correctly, verify it's function
based upon this information prior to replacing the mirror.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-08-51-008C > Jun > 09 > Body - Bumps or Rust Colored Spots in Paint
Paint: Customer Interest Body - Bumps or Rust Colored Spots in Paint
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 05-08-51-008C
Date: June 22, 2009
Subject: Bumps or Rust Colored Spots in Paint Due to Rail or Iron Dust (Remove Rail Dust)
Models:
1994-2010 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2010 HUMMER H2
2006-2010 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 05-08-51-008B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Condition
Visible rust colored spots or bumps on a vehicle's paint surface from rail or iron dust.
Cause
Rail dust comes from tiny iron particles produced from the friction between train wheels and the
tracks and gets deposited on the vehicle surfaces. Iron dust can get deposited on the surface if the
vehicle is stored near any operation producing iron dust such as an iron ore yard. Either material
can lay on top of, or become embedded in, the paint surface.
Correction
Because the severity of the condition varies, proper diagnosis of the damage is critical to the
success of repairs. Diagnosis should be performed on horizontal surfaces (hood, roof, deck lid, pick
up box, etc.) after the vehicle has been properly cleaned. There are two types of repair materials
recommended to repair rail dust or iron dust:
1. GEL TYPE OXALIC ACID:
- Has the characteristics of the liquid type oxalic acid but stays where you put it because of its gel
consistency.
2. CLAY TYPE NON-ACID BASED:
- Requires surface lubricant during use. - Has different grades available.
Caution
Rail dust remover (Oxalic Acid) is an acidic substance containing chemicals that will break down
the iron particles embedded in the finish. When working with rail dust remover, use the necessary
safety equipment, including gloves and goggles. Follow the chemical manufacturer's directions
closely because it may require special handling and disposal.
If, upon inspection, some particles are still present, the various chemical manufacturer's processes
can be repeated.
After the removal process, small pits may remain in the clearcoat and can be corrected, in most
cases, with a finesse/polish operation.
Procedure
1. Move the vehicle to a cool shaded area and make sure that the vehicle surfaces are cool during
the removal process. DO NOT PERFORM THE
REMOVAL PROCESS IN DIRECT SUNLIGHT OR ON A VEHICLE WITH HOT OR WARM BODY
PANELS.
2. Wash the vehicle with soap and water. Dry it immediately and clean the affected areas with a
wax and grease remover. 3. Perform the removal process according to the chemical
manufacturer's directions.
Once the damage has been repaired, the final step involves a polishing process.
Rail Dust Remover Manufacturers
Use the chemical manufacturers listed below, or equivalent:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 05-08-51-008C > Jun > 09 > Body - Bumps or Rust Colored Spots in Paint > Page
7068
Auto Magic(R) or Clay Magic(R) products available from:
Auto Wax Company, Inc. 1275 Round Table Dr. Dallas, TX 75247 (800) 826-0828 (Toll-Free) or
(214) 631-4000 (Local) Fax (214) 634-1342 www.automagic.com
[email protected]
E038 Fallout Gel or E038E Liquid Fallout Remover II available from:
Valvoline Car Brite Company 1910 South State Avenue Indianapolis, In 46203 (800) 347-2439 (Toll
Free) or (317) 788-9925 (Local) Fax (317) 788-9930 www.carbrite.com
[email protected] *We
believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products from these firms or for any such items which may be available from
other sources.
If rail dust remover is not available in your area, call one of the numbers listed above for a
distributor near your location.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
Important Refer to the Policy & Procedures Manual, section 1.2.1.7 for detailed information
regarding warranty coverage for this condition.
Important In certain cases where the vehicle finish is severely damaged and the actual repair time
exceeds the published time, the additional time should be submitted in the "Other Labor Hours"
field.
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 33-17-01A > Dec > 97 > Exhaust System - Paint Peeling from Painted Muffler
Paint: Customer Interest Exhaust System - Paint Peeling from Painted Muffler
File In Section: 10 - Body
Bulletin No.: 33-17-01A
Date: December, 1997
Subject: Paint Peeling from Muffler (New Repair Paint Available)
Models: 1993-98 Passenger Cars with Painted Mufflers
This bulletin is being revised to add additional model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 33-17-01 (Section 10 - Body).
Condition
Some owners may experience paint peeling from the muffler.
Correction
Clean and repaint the affected area using the following procedure and product.
Important:
DO NOT REPLACE COMPONENTS TO REPAIR THIS CONDITION.
The exhaust system must be cold to begin this procedure.
Material Required: * Wabash Products # KB-318-HHHS, available in pints or quarts as ready to
spray material (no mixing required). Call Wabash Products, 1-800-326-7269 or 812-232-6097 for
pricing and shipping information.
Procedure
On a cold exhaust system:
1. Raise vehicle on hoist.
2. While supporting exhaust with a transmission jack, remove the rear exhaust system hangers and
lower the exhaust.
3. Clean the affected area with a wax and grease remover, lacquer thinner or other suitable
solvent.
4. Wire brush the affected area to remove flaking paint and blow off with air.
5. Sand the affected area with # 80 to 150 grit sandpaper to remove rust, dirt or other
contaminants.
6. Clean the affected area with a wax and grease remover, lacquer thinner or other suitable
solvent.
7. Tape off the rear lower body panels and exhaust pipes forward of mufflers to protect from
overspray.
8. Apply paint to affected area in several (6 to 8) thin coats (to prevent sags and runs) obtaining
approximately 1 mil paint coverage.
9. Raise exhaust system with jack, reinstall exhaust hangers, lower vehicle and remove from hoist.
^ Allow 30 minutes drying time.
10. In a well ventilated area, start engine and allow to idle for up to 30 minutes until paint is cured
and dry.
Important:
Some "smoking" will occur while curing the paint with the engine running.
The paint can be heated and cured while driving, but be careful not to get the exhaust system wet
during the first 30 minutes.
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 33-17-01A > Dec > 97 > Exhaust System - Paint Peeling from Painted Muffler >
Page 7073
Labor Material
Operation Labor Time Allowance
A6150 0.6 hr - Single Exhaust GC
Add 0.2 hr - Dual Exhaust GC
Important:
While the above procedure and materials are correct for vehicles from 1993 to 1998, the Labor
Operation and Time Allowance only pertains to vehicles in the Warranty period.
* We believe this source and their equipment to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such equipment. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products or equipment from these firms or for any such items which may be
available from other sources.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 331708 > Nov > 93 > Paint - Clearcoat Degradation, Chalking and Whitening
Paint: Customer Interest Paint - Clearcoat Degradation, Chalking and Whitening
Group Ref.: Body
Bulletin No.: 331708
Date: November, 1993
SUBJECT: CLEARCOAT DEGRADATION - CHALKING AND WHITENING
MODELS: PASSENGER CARS WITH BASECOAT/CLEARCOAT
CONDITION: The vehicle exterior surface may show large chalky or white patches in the clearcoat,
usually but not limited to the horizontal surfaces.
Blacks, Dark Blues, Reds, may have potential for this condition. On rare occasions, other colors
may be involved.
CAUSE: The clearcoat (with sunlight and heat) may degrade and turn white or chalky.
IDENTIFICATION: On a clean surface, at or above room temperature, firmly apply a 2" wide piece
of masking tape to the chalky or white area of the clearcoat and pull upward quickly. The adhesive
side of the tape WILL NOT HAVE THE PAINT COLOR ON IT. A light shine or reduced tackiness
may be noticed on the tape adhesive surface, indicating clearcoat transfer to the tape.
CORRECTION: Refinish all horizontal surfaces using the following procedure.
- Remove the clearcoat layer from all horizontal surfaces and the top surfaces of fenders and
quarter panels.
NOTE:
In some cases, it will be necessary to remove the clearcoat from the upper vertical surfaces of
fenders, doors and quarters (approximately 3"), and the top areas directly above the front and rear
wheelhouse openings.
- Lightly sand any previously exposed base color to remove any chalky residue from the surface.
- The vertical surfaces should be sanded and colorcoated to the next lower breakline (typically the
body side moldings) for color uniformity of the repair.
IMPORTANT:
The following procedure covers clearcoat degradation only. It does not address any other paint
condition.
PROCEDURE:
1. Some vehicle components will be removed, while others will require masking. The list located at
the end of this bulletin will establish the removal items. Items not found on the list and non repair
areas are to be masked.
2. Prior to removing the paint finish, clean the area to be refinished with soap and water, followed
by an appropriate wax and grease remover.
3. Mask the remaining moldings and hardware for protection during sanding.
4. Remove the clearcoat material from all horizontal surfaces (and tops of fenders and quarters)
using a DA (dual action orbital sander) and # 120 grit sanding discs. Lightly sand any previously
exposed base color to remove any chalky residue from the surface.
NOTE:
Chemical stripping is not recommended because of negative Impact to moldings, non-metal
components, ELPO and environmental concerns.
5. Lightly sand the unaffected vertical panels to the next lower breakline, smooth and "featheredge"
the surface to be refinished with # 240 or # 320 grit sandpaper for maximum adhesion.
6. Blow off the sanding dust and residue.
7. Remove masking tape and remask all necessary areas for priming.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 331708 > Nov > 93 > Paint - Clearcoat Degradation, Chalking and Whitening >
Page 7078
8. Wipe and clean repair area with an appropriate wax and grease remover.
9. Wipe repair area with a tack rag.
10. Apply a coat of self etching or epoxy primer to the bare metal areas exposed during the
sanding process. Follow manufacturer's instructions and recommended dry times.
Typical materials would be: DuPont 615S/616S, BASF DE17/PR80/DA18, PPG DP40/DP401 or
equivalent.
V.O.C. materials would be: DuPont 615S/616S, BASF DE17/PR80/DA18, PPG DCP21/DCP212 or
equivalent.
11. Apply two to three medium wet coats of primer surfacer to the entire repair area (including
vertical surfaces) of the vehicle, following manufacturer's instructions for application and film build
requirements.
NOTE:
A guide coat Is recommended to highlight high and low spots during the wet or dry sanding
process.
Typical materials would be: DuPont 1120S/1130S/1125S, BASF DP20/PR80/PH36, PPG
K36/DT870/K201 or equivalent.
V.O.C. materials would be: DuPont 275S, BASF HP400, PPG DCP21/DCP212 or equivalent.
12. After adequate drying time, wet sand with # 400 grit (or finer) or dry sand with # 320 grit (or
finer) sand paper.
13. Repeat steps 6 through 9 and remask the vehicle.
14. Apply a medium coat of primer sealer to the entire repair area.
Typical materials would be: DuPont 2610S/2605S, BASF DP21/DH60/PR80, PPG DP40/DP401 or
equivalent.
V.O.C. materials would be: DuPont 210S, PPG DPW1834 or equivalent.
15. Apply 2 to 3 medium wet coats of basecoat (or until primer is hidden). Follow manufacturer's
instructions and recommended dry times.
16. Apply clearcoat. Follow manufacturer's instructions and recommended dry times.
17. After sufficient force dry or air dry time, remove masking.
18. Spot finesse/polish as required.
19. Reinstall previously removed hardware and moldings.
HARDWARE ITEM REMOVAL Vehicles have many different hardware options and treatments, but
the following list of items can be used as guidelines for item removal.
^ Windshield moldings (non-modular type windows)
^ Back window moldings (non-modular type windows)
^ Side view mirrors (outer panel mounted)
^ Ft. door belt seal strips (doors without window frames)
^ Name plates on fenders, doors, quarters, fascias and deck lids
^ Antenna base (power or fixed mast types)
^ Wiper arms (on vehicles with cowl grilles)
^ Cowl vent grille
^ Fender marker lamps
^ Tail lamps
^ Rocker aero molding emblems
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 331708 > Nov > 93 > Paint - Clearcoat Degradation, Chalking and Whitening >
Page 7079
^ Roof weld seam moldings
^ Auxiliary weatherstrips
^ Deck lid lock cyl. cover
^ Wheel opening moldings
^ Roof drip scalp moldings
^ Door edge guards*
^ Spoilers*
^ Luggage racks*
^ Hood grills/ornaments*
^ Decals*
^ Stripes*
^ Body side moldings if mechanically retained. If adhesive retained, mask molding.
NOTE:
Only items marked with an asterisk are "add" conditions to the Major Operation being performed.
Removal time for the other Items listed is included in the allowance.
LABOR OPERATION: A6110
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 331708 > Nov > 93 > Paint - Clearcoat Degradation, Chalking and Whitening >
Page 7080
TIME ALLOWANCE: See Chart That Follows (**)
NOTE:
The time allowances provided on the chart includes the hardware removal and installation (as
indicated by the list guidelines), the masking and unmasking of the vehicle, clearcoat removal (as
indicated by the guidelines), the refinish (and colorcoat when required), mix time for primer/paint
and clearcoat, finesse/polish where required, washing and preparing the vehicle for delivery.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > 05-08-51-008C > Jun > 09 > Body - Bumps or Rust Colored
Spots in Paint
Paint: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Bumps or Rust Colored Spots in Paint
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 05-08-51-008C
Date: June 22, 2009
Subject: Bumps or Rust Colored Spots in Paint Due to Rail or Iron Dust (Remove Rail Dust)
Models:
1994-2010 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2010 HUMMER H2
2006-2010 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 05-08-51-008B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Condition
Visible rust colored spots or bumps on a vehicle's paint surface from rail or iron dust.
Cause
Rail dust comes from tiny iron particles produced from the friction between train wheels and the
tracks and gets deposited on the vehicle surfaces. Iron dust can get deposited on the surface if the
vehicle is stored near any operation producing iron dust such as an iron ore yard. Either material
can lay on top of, or become embedded in, the paint surface.
Correction
Because the severity of the condition varies, proper diagnosis of the damage is critical to the
success of repairs. Diagnosis should be performed on horizontal surfaces (hood, roof, deck lid, pick
up box, etc.) after the vehicle has been properly cleaned. There are two types of repair materials
recommended to repair rail dust or iron dust:
1. GEL TYPE OXALIC ACID:
- Has the characteristics of the liquid type oxalic acid but stays where you put it because of its gel
consistency.
2. CLAY TYPE NON-ACID BASED:
- Requires surface lubricant during use. - Has different grades available.
Caution
Rail dust remover (Oxalic Acid) is an acidic substance containing chemicals that will break down
the iron particles embedded in the finish. When working with rail dust remover, use the necessary
safety equipment, including gloves and goggles. Follow the chemical manufacturer's directions
closely because it may require special handling and disposal.
If, upon inspection, some particles are still present, the various chemical manufacturer's processes
can be repeated.
After the removal process, small pits may remain in the clearcoat and can be corrected, in most
cases, with a finesse/polish operation.
Procedure
1. Move the vehicle to a cool shaded area and make sure that the vehicle surfaces are cool during
the removal process. DO NOT PERFORM THE
REMOVAL PROCESS IN DIRECT SUNLIGHT OR ON A VEHICLE WITH HOT OR WARM BODY
PANELS.
2. Wash the vehicle with soap and water. Dry it immediately and clean the affected areas with a
wax and grease remover. 3. Perform the removal process according to the chemical
manufacturer's directions.
Once the damage has been repaired, the final step involves a polishing process.
Rail Dust Remover Manufacturers
Use the chemical manufacturers listed below, or equivalent:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > 05-08-51-008C > Jun > 09 > Body - Bumps or Rust Colored
Spots in Paint > Page 7086
Auto Magic(R) or Clay Magic(R) products available from:
Auto Wax Company, Inc. 1275 Round Table Dr. Dallas, TX 75247 (800) 826-0828 (Toll-Free) or
(214) 631-4000 (Local) Fax (214) 634-1342 www.automagic.com
[email protected]
E038 Fallout Gel or E038E Liquid Fallout Remover II available from:
Valvoline Car Brite Company 1910 South State Avenue Indianapolis, In 46203 (800) 347-2439 (Toll
Free) or (317) 788-9925 (Local) Fax (317) 788-9930 www.carbrite.com
[email protected] *We
believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products from these firms or for any such items which may be available from
other sources.
If rail dust remover is not available in your area, call one of the numbers listed above for a
distributor near your location.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
Important Refer to the Policy & Procedures Manual, section 1.2.1.7 for detailed information
regarding warranty coverage for this condition.
Important In certain cases where the vehicle finish is severely damaged and the actual repair time
exceeds the published time, the additional time should be submitted in the "Other Labor Hours"
field.
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > 08-08-51-002 > Mar > 08 > Body - TPO Fascia Cleaning Prior
to Painting
Paint: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - TPO Fascia Cleaning Prior to Painting
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-08-51-002
Date: March 12, 2008
Subject: New Primer For TPO Fascias and Affected Cleaning Process of Painting Operation
Models: 2009 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3
The purpose of this bulletin is to inform the technician that General Motors has made a change in
the primer it uses for TPO plastic for service parts. This new primer comes in several different
colors from five different suppliers. This change affects the cleaning process of the painting
operation. The new process is as follows.
1. Wash with soap and water.
2. Clean with a 50% mix of isopropyl alcohol and water (or a waterborne cleaner). Check with your
paint supplier for product recommendations.
3. Scuff sand per your paint suppliers recommendations.
Note:
The use of a solvent-type cleaner will soften, or begin to dissolve the primer. Base coats do not
have any affect on this primer.
4. Reclean with a 50% mix of isopropyl alcohol and water (or a waterborne cleaner).
All fascias, with the exception of the Corvette, Camaro, and Cadillac XLR, are made of TPO. You
may find other TPO parts with this primer. If the technician has a question as to the type of plastic
they are painting, inspect the back of the part for the plastic symbol (TPO).
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > 33-17-01A > Dec > 97 > Exhaust System - Paint Peeling from
Painted Muffler
Paint: All Technical Service Bulletins Exhaust System - Paint Peeling from Painted Muffler
File In Section: 10 - Body
Bulletin No.: 33-17-01A
Date: December, 1997
Subject: Paint Peeling from Muffler (New Repair Paint Available)
Models: 1993-98 Passenger Cars with Painted Mufflers
This bulletin is being revised to add additional model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 33-17-01 (Section 10 - Body).
Condition
Some owners may experience paint peeling from the muffler.
Correction
Clean and repaint the affected area using the following procedure and product.
Important:
DO NOT REPLACE COMPONENTS TO REPAIR THIS CONDITION.
The exhaust system must be cold to begin this procedure.
Material Required: * Wabash Products # KB-318-HHHS, available in pints or quarts as ready to
spray material (no mixing required). Call Wabash Products, 1-800-326-7269 or 812-232-6097 for
pricing and shipping information.
Procedure
On a cold exhaust system:
1. Raise vehicle on hoist.
2. While supporting exhaust with a transmission jack, remove the rear exhaust system hangers and
lower the exhaust.
3. Clean the affected area with a wax and grease remover, lacquer thinner or other suitable
solvent.
4. Wire brush the affected area to remove flaking paint and blow off with air.
5. Sand the affected area with # 80 to 150 grit sandpaper to remove rust, dirt or other
contaminants.
6. Clean the affected area with a wax and grease remover, lacquer thinner or other suitable
solvent.
7. Tape off the rear lower body panels and exhaust pipes forward of mufflers to protect from
overspray.
8. Apply paint to affected area in several (6 to 8) thin coats (to prevent sags and runs) obtaining
approximately 1 mil paint coverage.
9. Raise exhaust system with jack, reinstall exhaust hangers, lower vehicle and remove from hoist.
^ Allow 30 minutes drying time.
10. In a well ventilated area, start engine and allow to idle for up to 30 minutes until paint is cured
and dry.
Important:
Some "smoking" will occur while curing the paint with the engine running.
The paint can be heated and cured while driving, but be careful not to get the exhaust system wet
during the first 30 minutes.
Warranty Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > 33-17-01A > Dec > 97 > Exhaust System - Paint Peeling from
Painted Muffler > Page 7095
Labor Material
Operation Labor Time Allowance
A6150 0.6 hr - Single Exhaust GC
Add 0.2 hr - Dual Exhaust GC
Important:
While the above procedure and materials are correct for vehicles from 1993 to 1998, the Labor
Operation and Time Allowance only pertains to vehicles in the Warranty period.
* We believe this source and their equipment to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such equipment. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products or equipment from these firms or for any such items which may be
available from other sources.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > 72-05-11 > Dec > 97 > Warranty - Rail Dust Removal &
Chemical Spotting Labor
Paint: All Technical Service Bulletins Warranty - Rail Dust Removal & Chemical Spotting Labor
File In Section: Warranty Administration
Bulletin No.: 72-05-11
Date: December, 1997
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
Subject: Clarification of Rail Dust Removal (A5575-A5580) and Chemical Spotting (A5541-A5544)
Labor Operations
Models: All Past and Future Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
The purpose of this Warranty Administration Bulletin is to clarify the usage, limits and guidelines for
the proper use of the above subject labor operations.
The above subject labor operations were introduced to correct paint imperfections caused by fallout
that occurred either during shipment to the dealer or within the first 12 months or 12,000 miles
(20,000 kms) of vehicle ownership. GM vehicle owners are informed that although no defect in the
factory applied paint causes this, GM will repair, at no charge to the owner, the surfaces of new
vehicles damaged by fallout condition within 12 months or 12,000 miles (20,000 kms) whichever
occurs first. Effective with repair orders dated on or after December 1, 1997, labor operations
A5575-A5580 Rail Dust Removal and A5541 through A5544 Chemical Spotting will be limited to
within the first 12 months or 12,000 miles of the Base Vehicle Warranty (20,000 kms) whichever
occurs first.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > 63-17-07B > Jun > 97 > Paint - Basecoat/Clearcoat Paint
Systems Specifications
Paint: All Technical Service Bulletins Paint - Basecoat/Clearcoat Paint Systems Specifications
File In Section: 10 - Body
Bulletin No.: 63-17-07B
Date: June, 1997
INFORMATION
Subject: New Aftermarket Paint Specification (GM4901M) for Basecoat/Clearcoat Paint Systems
(Rigid Exterior Surfaces)
Models: 1993-97 Passenger Cars and Trucks
This bulletin is being revised to provide additional information on approved paint systems
(Attachment 1 added). Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 63-17-07A (Section 10 - Body).
A vehicle's appearance is important to any customer's perception of that vehicle's quality and
value. Furthermore, when an exterior finish repair is made, the customer expects that repair to
match the showroom finish.
Based upon rigorous and exhaustive testing, General Motors has established an aftermarket
refinish paint specification, known as GM4901M, which is listed in the GM Engineering
Specifications Manual. Use this specification when selecting a paint system for General Motors
vehicle warranty paint repairs. All major paint suppliers are involved and support this program.
The booklet enclosed with Corporate Bulletin # 63-17-07, "GM Approved Refinish Materials", P/N
GM4901 M-D, identifies the paint systems you may use. All approved products (including
VOC-compliant) are listed in the "system" approach recommended by the individual manufacturer.
This booklet will be updated periodically to ensure you are provided with the latest information on
paint systems. GM and Paint Supplier training services encompass this new specification and can
address any questions.
All materials listed in the booklet fall under the current materials allowance. However, this may
change as costs increase.
With this program, it is our goal to ensure quality repairs. After all, skilled technicians using the right
materials offer the only path to true customer enthusiasm. By adhering to the GM4901M
Specification for Aftermarket Paint Repair Materials, you will ensure our customers only receive the
best while maximizing your quality throughout on exterior finish repairs.
When a meeting or training session is held in your area, be sure your team is represented. We look
forward to your support for this program.
Additional Information
In the development of this paint specification, major paint suppliers were invited to submit materials
for approval. The requirements of the program are included in the approved materials booklet
referenced above, dated December, 1996.
Important:
As of 7-1-97, the BASF products listed on Attachment 1 are now approved for use.
The approved suppliers are:
^ Akzo Nobel (Sikkens)
^ American Standox
^ BASF
^ DuPont
^ ICI Autocolor
^ Martin Senour
^ PPG
^ Sherwin Williams
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > 63-17-07B > Jun > 97 > Paint - Basecoat/Clearcoat Paint
Systems Specifications > Page 7104
^ Spies Hecker
Your Zone wholesale personnel, Training Centers, STG Field Service Engineers, and the approved
suppliers have additional training materials that may answer your further questions.
Use of these GM approved materials ensures the highest quality for maintaining customer
satisfaction. The dealer or retailer must ensure that all refinish materials, including sublets, meet
GM Specification GM4901-M. Use of materials (and associated application methods) that do not
meet this GM standard may result in a review of claim(s) leading to chargeback(s), as specified in
the Policies and Procedures manual, Article 1.4.17.
The standards will be updated periodically and other suppliers may be added when new standards
are released by the fall of 1997.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > 63-17-07B > Jun > 97 > Paint - Basecoat/Clearcoat Paint
Systems Specifications > Page 7105
ATTACHMENT 1
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > 531704 > Sep > 95 > Paint - Polishing And Swirl Mark
Removal
Paint: All Technical Service Bulletins Paint - Polishing And Swirl Mark Removal
File in Section: 10 - Body
Bulletin No. 53-17-04
Date: September, 1995
INFORMATION
Subject: Polishing and Swirl Mark Removal Techniques for Basecoat/Clearcoat Paint
Models: 1993-96 Passenger Cars and Trucks with Basecoat/Clearcoat
This bulletin supersedes and cancels Corporate Bulletin Number 111702. Previous divisional
publication numbers were:
Buick 93-10-22
Cadillac T-93-104
Chevrolet 93-188-OB
GM Canada 93-10-158
Oldsmobile 07-93-106 (Service Guild)
Pontiac 93-10-28
Today's basecoat/clearcoat paint finishes are very different from materials used on vehicles in the
1980's.
Materials, procedures and equipment which once worked well for polishing traditional finishes may
not be acceptable for use on basecoat/clearcoat paint surfaces. The use of outdated materials,
procedures and equipment may produce what appears to be acceptable results under shop
lighting, but will be unacceptable to the owner when the finish is exposed to sunlight (typically, swirl
marks).
While the following information can be most helpful in the new car "prep" area, it should also be
made available to the "used car" area and the collision/ paint repair area.
KEEP THE VEHICLE CLEAN AND DRY;
^ Avoid washing vehicles in direct sunlight.
^ Avoid using strong soaps or chemical detergents.
^ Use "brush less" type automatic car wash equipment.
^ Avoid using products containing acids (unless specified to correct a condition such as "rail dust").
^ Don't use brushes or brooms to remove snow or ice from vehicles in storage or on lots.
^ Cleaning agents and water should be dried promptly and not allowed to dry on the surface.
^ Standing rinse water should be dried promptly and not allowed to dry on the surface.
^ Drying with a soft chamois is recommended.
DON'T CREATE A PROBLEM:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > 531704 > Sep > 95 > Paint - Polishing And Swirl Mark
Removal > Page 7110
^ DO NOT polish vehicles unless a surface condition exists that can only be corrected by polishing
(see chart).
^ If a surface condition does exist, the repair approach should be one of "less is best" (the very
least it takes to correct the condition).
^ Avoid removing too much clearcoat (whenever possible, use paint gauges before, during, and
after polishing).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > 531704 > Sep > 95 > Paint - Polishing And Swirl Mark
Removal > Page 7111
^ Use ONLY the products recommended in this bulletin (or their equivalent).
^ Make sure that any power polishing equipment does not exceed the requirements in the polish
manufacturer's recommendation or in the chart.
FINAL STEP:
The final step of the finesse/polish procedure is the removal of SWIRL MARKS. Swirl marks are
defined as very fine scratches in a uniform circular direction that cause an optical distortion on the
paint surface. Swirl marks may not be visible with shop lighting. They should be viewed in direct
sunlight or under specific lights, i.e. Sodium Vapor (parking lot type lights).
SWIRL MARK REMOVAL - To remove swirl marks, use an orbital polisher (DA) with speeds in the
1,500 to 2,000 RPM range. Apply a small amount of the appropriate material (see chart) to the swirl
mark area. Use the pad on the random orbital buffer to spread the material evenly over polished
area before buffing. When buffing, keep pad flat and constantly moving over the repair area. Polish
with heavier pressure applied for 4-6 seconds, then polish with lighter pressure for 6-8 more
seconds. Always blend or feather outer edges of repair spot. After buffing, the buffed areas should
be inspected by the buffing person to ensure that the swirls are completely removed. If swirls are
still present, rebuff as needed. Hand wipe the surface with a clean soft, non-scratching cloth and a
50/50 mixture of Isopropyl Alcohol and water.
^ DON'T USE WAX OR SILICONE-TYPE PRODUCTS TO HIDE SWIRL MARKS (this condition
will reappear later and cause owner dissatisfaction).
^ Specific conditions on paint (environmental damage, rail dust, etc.) can be corrected by referring
to previously published Service bulletins on those specific topics.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > 331708 > Nov > 93 > Paint - Clearcoat Degradation, Chalking
and Whitening
Paint: All Technical Service Bulletins Paint - Clearcoat Degradation, Chalking and Whitening
Group Ref.: Body
Bulletin No.: 331708
Date: November, 1993
SUBJECT: CLEARCOAT DEGRADATION - CHALKING AND WHITENING
MODELS: PASSENGER CARS WITH BASECOAT/CLEARCOAT
CONDITION: The vehicle exterior surface may show large chalky or white patches in the clearcoat,
usually but not limited to the horizontal surfaces.
Blacks, Dark Blues, Reds, may have potential for this condition. On rare occasions, other colors
may be involved.
CAUSE: The clearcoat (with sunlight and heat) may degrade and turn white or chalky.
IDENTIFICATION: On a clean surface, at or above room temperature, firmly apply a 2" wide piece
of masking tape to the chalky or white area of the clearcoat and pull upward quickly. The adhesive
side of the tape WILL NOT HAVE THE PAINT COLOR ON IT. A light shine or reduced tackiness
may be noticed on the tape adhesive surface, indicating clearcoat transfer to the tape.
CORRECTION: Refinish all horizontal surfaces using the following procedure.
- Remove the clearcoat layer from all horizontal surfaces and the top surfaces of fenders and
quarter panels.
NOTE:
In some cases, it will be necessary to remove the clearcoat from the upper vertical surfaces of
fenders, doors and quarters (approximately 3"), and the top areas directly above the front and rear
wheelhouse openings.
- Lightly sand any previously exposed base color to remove any chalky residue from the surface.
- The vertical surfaces should be sanded and colorcoated to the next lower breakline (typically the
body side moldings) for color uniformity of the repair.
IMPORTANT:
The following procedure covers clearcoat degradation only. It does not address any other paint
condition.
PROCEDURE:
1. Some vehicle components will be removed, while others will require masking. The list located at
the end of this bulletin will establish the removal items. Items not found on the list and non repair
areas are to be masked.
2. Prior to removing the paint finish, clean the area to be refinished with soap and water, followed
by an appropriate wax and grease remover.
3. Mask the remaining moldings and hardware for protection during sanding.
4. Remove the clearcoat material from all horizontal surfaces (and tops of fenders and quarters)
using a DA (dual action orbital sander) and # 120 grit sanding discs. Lightly sand any previously
exposed base color to remove any chalky residue from the surface.
NOTE:
Chemical stripping is not recommended because of negative Impact to moldings, non-metal
components, ELPO and environmental concerns.
5. Lightly sand the unaffected vertical panels to the next lower breakline, smooth and "featheredge"
the surface to be refinished with # 240 or # 320 grit sandpaper for maximum adhesion.
6. Blow off the sanding dust and residue.
7. Remove masking tape and remask all necessary areas for priming.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > 331708 > Nov > 93 > Paint - Clearcoat Degradation, Chalking
and Whitening > Page 7116
8. Wipe and clean repair area with an appropriate wax and grease remover.
9. Wipe repair area with a tack rag.
10. Apply a coat of self etching or epoxy primer to the bare metal areas exposed during the
sanding process. Follow manufacturer's instructions and recommended dry times.
Typical materials would be: DuPont 615S/616S, BASF DE17/PR80/DA18, PPG DP40/DP401 or
equivalent.
V.O.C. materials would be: DuPont 615S/616S, BASF DE17/PR80/DA18, PPG DCP21/DCP212 or
equivalent.
11. Apply two to three medium wet coats of primer surfacer to the entire repair area (including
vertical surfaces) of the vehicle, following manufacturer's instructions for application and film build
requirements.
NOTE:
A guide coat Is recommended to highlight high and low spots during the wet or dry sanding
process.
Typical materials would be: DuPont 1120S/1130S/1125S, BASF DP20/PR80/PH36, PPG
K36/DT870/K201 or equivalent.
V.O.C. materials would be: DuPont 275S, BASF HP400, PPG DCP21/DCP212 or equivalent.
12. After adequate drying time, wet sand with # 400 grit (or finer) or dry sand with # 320 grit (or
finer) sand paper.
13. Repeat steps 6 through 9 and remask the vehicle.
14. Apply a medium coat of primer sealer to the entire repair area.
Typical materials would be: DuPont 2610S/2605S, BASF DP21/DH60/PR80, PPG DP40/DP401 or
equivalent.
V.O.C. materials would be: DuPont 210S, PPG DPW1834 or equivalent.
15. Apply 2 to 3 medium wet coats of basecoat (or until primer is hidden). Follow manufacturer's
instructions and recommended dry times.
16. Apply clearcoat. Follow manufacturer's instructions and recommended dry times.
17. After sufficient force dry or air dry time, remove masking.
18. Spot finesse/polish as required.
19. Reinstall previously removed hardware and moldings.
HARDWARE ITEM REMOVAL Vehicles have many different hardware options and treatments, but
the following list of items can be used as guidelines for item removal.
^ Windshield moldings (non-modular type windows)
^ Back window moldings (non-modular type windows)
^ Side view mirrors (outer panel mounted)
^ Ft. door belt seal strips (doors without window frames)
^ Name plates on fenders, doors, quarters, fascias and deck lids
^ Antenna base (power or fixed mast types)
^ Wiper arms (on vehicles with cowl grilles)
^ Cowl vent grille
^ Fender marker lamps
^ Tail lamps
^ Rocker aero molding emblems
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > 331708 > Nov > 93 > Paint - Clearcoat Degradation, Chalking
and Whitening > Page 7117
^ Roof weld seam moldings
^ Auxiliary weatherstrips
^ Deck lid lock cyl. cover
^ Wheel opening moldings
^ Roof drip scalp moldings
^ Door edge guards*
^ Spoilers*
^ Luggage racks*
^ Hood grills/ornaments*
^ Decals*
^ Stripes*
^ Body side moldings if mechanically retained. If adhesive retained, mask molding.
NOTE:
Only items marked with an asterisk are "add" conditions to the Major Operation being performed.
Removal time for the other Items listed is included in the allowance.
LABOR OPERATION: A6110
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > 331708 > Nov > 93 > Paint - Clearcoat Degradation, Chalking
and Whitening > Page 7118
TIME ALLOWANCE: See Chart That Follows (**)
NOTE:
The time allowances provided on the chart includes the hardware removal and installation (as
indicated by the list guidelines), the masking and unmasking of the vehicle, clearcoat removal (as
indicated by the guidelines), the refinish (and colorcoat when required), mix time for primer/paint
and clearcoat, finesse/polish where required, washing and preparing the vehicle for delivery.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > 331704 > Sep > 93 > Paint - Exterior Color Code & Cross
Reference
Paint: All Technical Service Bulletins Paint - Exterior Color Code & Cross Reference
Group Ref.: Body
Bulletin No.: 331704
Date: September, 1993
SUBJECT: PAINT INFORMATION
MODELS: 1994 CHEVROLET PRODUCTS (Except GEO)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Paint: > 331704 > Sep > 93 > Paint - Exterior Color Code & Cross
Reference > Page 7123
The chart provides paint information on 1994 Chevrolet products, The paint types listed the models
indicate the material the vehicle was manufactured with. See illustrations.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > 08-08-51-002 > Mar > 08 > Body - TPO Fascia Cleaning Prior to
Painting
Paint: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - TPO Fascia Cleaning Prior to Painting
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 08-08-51-002
Date: March 12, 2008
Subject: New Primer For TPO Fascias and Affected Cleaning Process of Painting Operation
Models: 2009 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3
The purpose of this bulletin is to inform the technician that General Motors has made a change in
the primer it uses for TPO plastic for service parts. This new primer comes in several different
colors from five different suppliers. This change affects the cleaning process of the painting
operation. The new process is as follows.
1. Wash with soap and water.
2. Clean with a 50% mix of isopropyl alcohol and water (or a waterborne cleaner). Check with your
paint supplier for product recommendations.
3. Scuff sand per your paint suppliers recommendations.
Note:
The use of a solvent-type cleaner will soften, or begin to dissolve the primer. Base coats do not
have any affect on this primer.
4. Reclean with a 50% mix of isopropyl alcohol and water (or a waterborne cleaner).
All fascias, with the exception of the Corvette, Camaro, and Cadillac XLR, are made of TPO. You
may find other TPO parts with this primer. If the technician has a question as to the type of plastic
they are painting, inspect the back of the part for the plastic symbol (TPO).
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > 72-05-11 > Dec > 97 > Warranty - Rail Dust Removal & Chemical
Spotting Labor
Paint: All Technical Service Bulletins Warranty - Rail Dust Removal & Chemical Spotting Labor
File In Section: Warranty Administration
Bulletin No.: 72-05-11
Date: December, 1997
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
Subject: Clarification of Rail Dust Removal (A5575-A5580) and Chemical Spotting (A5541-A5544)
Labor Operations
Models: All Past and Future Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
The purpose of this Warranty Administration Bulletin is to clarify the usage, limits and guidelines for
the proper use of the above subject labor operations.
The above subject labor operations were introduced to correct paint imperfections caused by fallout
that occurred either during shipment to the dealer or within the first 12 months or 12,000 miles
(20,000 kms) of vehicle ownership. GM vehicle owners are informed that although no defect in the
factory applied paint causes this, GM will repair, at no charge to the owner, the surfaces of new
vehicles damaged by fallout condition within 12 months or 12,000 miles (20,000 kms) whichever
occurs first. Effective with repair orders dated on or after December 1, 1997, labor operations
A5575-A5580 Rail Dust Removal and A5541 through A5544 Chemical Spotting will be limited to
within the first 12 months or 12,000 miles of the Base Vehicle Warranty (20,000 kms) whichever
occurs first.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > 63-17-07B > Jun > 97 > Paint - Basecoat/Clearcoat Paint Systems
Specifications
Paint: All Technical Service Bulletins Paint - Basecoat/Clearcoat Paint Systems Specifications
File In Section: 10 - Body
Bulletin No.: 63-17-07B
Date: June, 1997
INFORMATION
Subject: New Aftermarket Paint Specification (GM4901M) for Basecoat/Clearcoat Paint Systems
(Rigid Exterior Surfaces)
Models: 1993-97 Passenger Cars and Trucks
This bulletin is being revised to provide additional information on approved paint systems
(Attachment 1 added). Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 63-17-07A (Section 10 - Body).
A vehicle's appearance is important to any customer's perception of that vehicle's quality and
value. Furthermore, when an exterior finish repair is made, the customer expects that repair to
match the showroom finish.
Based upon rigorous and exhaustive testing, General Motors has established an aftermarket
refinish paint specification, known as GM4901M, which is listed in the GM Engineering
Specifications Manual. Use this specification when selecting a paint system for General Motors
vehicle warranty paint repairs. All major paint suppliers are involved and support this program.
The booklet enclosed with Corporate Bulletin # 63-17-07, "GM Approved Refinish Materials", P/N
GM4901 M-D, identifies the paint systems you may use. All approved products (including
VOC-compliant) are listed in the "system" approach recommended by the individual manufacturer.
This booklet will be updated periodically to ensure you are provided with the latest information on
paint systems. GM and Paint Supplier training services encompass this new specification and can
address any questions.
All materials listed in the booklet fall under the current materials allowance. However, this may
change as costs increase.
With this program, it is our goal to ensure quality repairs. After all, skilled technicians using the right
materials offer the only path to true customer enthusiasm. By adhering to the GM4901M
Specification for Aftermarket Paint Repair Materials, you will ensure our customers only receive the
best while maximizing your quality throughout on exterior finish repairs.
When a meeting or training session is held in your area, be sure your team is represented. We look
forward to your support for this program.
Additional Information
In the development of this paint specification, major paint suppliers were invited to submit materials
for approval. The requirements of the program are included in the approved materials booklet
referenced above, dated December, 1996.
Important:
As of 7-1-97, the BASF products listed on Attachment 1 are now approved for use.
The approved suppliers are:
^ Akzo Nobel (Sikkens)
^ American Standox
^ BASF
^ DuPont
^ ICI Autocolor
^ Martin Senour
^ PPG
^ Sherwin Williams
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > 63-17-07B > Jun > 97 > Paint - Basecoat/Clearcoat Paint Systems
Specifications > Page 7137
^ Spies Hecker
Your Zone wholesale personnel, Training Centers, STG Field Service Engineers, and the approved
suppliers have additional training materials that may answer your further questions.
Use of these GM approved materials ensures the highest quality for maintaining customer
satisfaction. The dealer or retailer must ensure that all refinish materials, including sublets, meet
GM Specification GM4901-M. Use of materials (and associated application methods) that do not
meet this GM standard may result in a review of claim(s) leading to chargeback(s), as specified in
the Policies and Procedures manual, Article 1.4.17.
The standards will be updated periodically and other suppliers may be added when new standards
are released by the fall of 1997.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > 63-17-07B > Jun > 97 > Paint - Basecoat/Clearcoat Paint Systems
Specifications > Page 7138
ATTACHMENT 1
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > 531704 > Sep > 95 > Paint - Polishing And Swirl Mark Removal
Paint: All Technical Service Bulletins Paint - Polishing And Swirl Mark Removal
File in Section: 10 - Body
Bulletin No. 53-17-04
Date: September, 1995
INFORMATION
Subject: Polishing and Swirl Mark Removal Techniques for Basecoat/Clearcoat Paint
Models: 1993-96 Passenger Cars and Trucks with Basecoat/Clearcoat
This bulletin supersedes and cancels Corporate Bulletin Number 111702. Previous divisional
publication numbers were:
Buick 93-10-22
Cadillac T-93-104
Chevrolet 93-188-OB
GM Canada 93-10-158
Oldsmobile 07-93-106 (Service Guild)
Pontiac 93-10-28
Today's basecoat/clearcoat paint finishes are very different from materials used on vehicles in the
1980's.
Materials, procedures and equipment which once worked well for polishing traditional finishes may
not be acceptable for use on basecoat/clearcoat paint surfaces. The use of outdated materials,
procedures and equipment may produce what appears to be acceptable results under shop
lighting, but will be unacceptable to the owner when the finish is exposed to sunlight (typically, swirl
marks).
While the following information can be most helpful in the new car "prep" area, it should also be
made available to the "used car" area and the collision/ paint repair area.
KEEP THE VEHICLE CLEAN AND DRY;
^ Avoid washing vehicles in direct sunlight.
^ Avoid using strong soaps or chemical detergents.
^ Use "brush less" type automatic car wash equipment.
^ Avoid using products containing acids (unless specified to correct a condition such as "rail dust").
^ Don't use brushes or brooms to remove snow or ice from vehicles in storage or on lots.
^ Cleaning agents and water should be dried promptly and not allowed to dry on the surface.
^ Standing rinse water should be dried promptly and not allowed to dry on the surface.
^ Drying with a soft chamois is recommended.
DON'T CREATE A PROBLEM:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > 531704 > Sep > 95 > Paint - Polishing And Swirl Mark Removal >
Page 7143
^ DO NOT polish vehicles unless a surface condition exists that can only be corrected by polishing
(see chart).
^ If a surface condition does exist, the repair approach should be one of "less is best" (the very
least it takes to correct the condition).
^ Avoid removing too much clearcoat (whenever possible, use paint gauges before, during, and
after polishing).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > 531704 > Sep > 95 > Paint - Polishing And Swirl Mark Removal >
Page 7144
^ Use ONLY the products recommended in this bulletin (or their equivalent).
^ Make sure that any power polishing equipment does not exceed the requirements in the polish
manufacturer's recommendation or in the chart.
FINAL STEP:
The final step of the finesse/polish procedure is the removal of SWIRL MARKS. Swirl marks are
defined as very fine scratches in a uniform circular direction that cause an optical distortion on the
paint surface. Swirl marks may not be visible with shop lighting. They should be viewed in direct
sunlight or under specific lights, i.e. Sodium Vapor (parking lot type lights).
SWIRL MARK REMOVAL - To remove swirl marks, use an orbital polisher (DA) with speeds in the
1,500 to 2,000 RPM range. Apply a small amount of the appropriate material (see chart) to the swirl
mark area. Use the pad on the random orbital buffer to spread the material evenly over polished
area before buffing. When buffing, keep pad flat and constantly moving over the repair area. Polish
with heavier pressure applied for 4-6 seconds, then polish with lighter pressure for 6-8 more
seconds. Always blend or feather outer edges of repair spot. After buffing, the buffed areas should
be inspected by the buffing person to ensure that the swirls are completely removed. If swirls are
still present, rebuff as needed. Hand wipe the surface with a clean soft, non-scratching cloth and a
50/50 mixture of Isopropyl Alcohol and water.
^ DON'T USE WAX OR SILICONE-TYPE PRODUCTS TO HIDE SWIRL MARKS (this condition
will reappear later and cause owner dissatisfaction).
^ Specific conditions on paint (environmental damage, rail dust, etc.) can be corrected by referring
to previously published Service bulletins on those specific topics.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > 331704 > Sep > 93 > Paint - Exterior Color Code & Cross
Reference
Paint: All Technical Service Bulletins Paint - Exterior Color Code & Cross Reference
Group Ref.: Body
Bulletin No.: 331704
Date: September, 1993
SUBJECT: PAINT INFORMATION
MODELS: 1994 CHEVROLET PRODUCTS (Except GEO)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > 331704 > Sep > 93 > Paint - Exterior Color Code & Cross
Reference > Page 7149
The chart provides paint information on 1994 Chevrolet products, The paint types listed the models
indicate the material the vehicle was manufactured with. See illustrations.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > Page 7150
Paint: By Symptom
Technical Service Bulletin # 05-08-51-008C Date: 090622
Body - Bumps or Rust Colored Spots in Paint
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 05-08-51-008C
Date: June 22, 2009
Subject: Bumps or Rust Colored Spots in Paint Due to Rail or Iron Dust (Remove Rail Dust)
Models:
1994-2010 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2010 HUMMER H2
2006-2010 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 05-08-51-008B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Condition
Visible rust colored spots or bumps on a vehicle's paint surface from rail or iron dust.
Cause
Rail dust comes from tiny iron particles produced from the friction between train wheels and the
tracks and gets deposited on the vehicle surfaces. Iron dust can get deposited on the surface if the
vehicle is stored near any operation producing iron dust such as an iron ore yard. Either material
can lay on top of, or become embedded in, the paint surface.
Correction
Because the severity of the condition varies, proper diagnosis of the damage is critical to the
success of repairs. Diagnosis should be performed on horizontal surfaces (hood, roof, deck lid, pick
up box, etc.) after the vehicle has been properly cleaned. There are two types of repair materials
recommended to repair rail dust or iron dust:
1. GEL TYPE OXALIC ACID:
- Has the characteristics of the liquid type oxalic acid but stays where you put it because of its gel
consistency.
2. CLAY TYPE NON-ACID BASED:
- Requires surface lubricant during use. - Has different grades available.
Caution
Rail dust remover (Oxalic Acid) is an acidic substance containing chemicals that will break down
the iron particles embedded in the finish. When working with rail dust remover, use the necessary
safety equipment, including gloves and goggles. Follow the chemical manufacturer's directions
closely because it may require special handling and disposal.
If, upon inspection, some particles are still present, the various chemical manufacturer's processes
can be repeated.
After the removal process, small pits may remain in the clearcoat and can be corrected, in most
cases, with a finesse/polish operation.
Procedure
1. Move the vehicle to a cool shaded area and make sure that the vehicle surfaces are cool during
the removal process. DO NOT PERFORM THE
REMOVAL PROCESS IN DIRECT SUNLIGHT OR ON A VEHICLE WITH HOT OR WARM BODY
PANELS.
2. Wash the vehicle with soap and water. Dry it immediately and clean the affected areas with a
wax and grease remover. 3. Perform the removal process according to the chemical
manufacturer's directions.
Once the damage has been repaired, the final step involves a polishing process.
Rail Dust Remover Manufacturers
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > Page 7151
Use the chemical manufacturers listed below, or equivalent:
Auto Magic(R) or Clay Magic(R) products available from:
Auto Wax Company, Inc. 1275 Round Table Dr. Dallas, TX 75247 (800) 826-0828 (Toll-Free) or
(214) 631-4000 (Local) Fax (214) 634-1342 www.automagic.com
[email protected]
E038 Fallout Gel or E038E Liquid Fallout Remover II available from:
Valvoline Car Brite Company 1910 South State Avenue Indianapolis, In 46203 (800) 347-2439 (Toll
Free) or (317) 788-9925 (Local) Fax (317) 788-9930 www.carbrite.com
[email protected] *We
believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products from these firms or for any such items which may be available from
other sources.
If rail dust remover is not available in your area, call one of the numbers listed above for a
distributor near your location.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
Important Refer to the Policy & Procedures Manual, section 1.2.1.7 for detailed information
regarding warranty coverage for this condition.
Important In certain cases where the vehicle finish is severely damaged and the actual repair time
exceeds the published time, the additional time should be submitted in the "Other Labor Hours"
field.
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
Disclaimer
Technical Service Bulletin # 33-17-01A Date: 971201
Exhaust System - Paint Peeling from Painted Muffler
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > Page 7152
File In Section: 10 - Body
Bulletin No.: 33-17-01A
Date: December, 1997
Subject: Paint Peeling from Muffler (New Repair Paint Available)
Models: 1993-98 Passenger Cars with Painted Mufflers
This bulletin is being revised to add additional model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 33-17-01 (Section 10 - Body).
Condition
Some owners may experience paint peeling from the muffler.
Correction
Clean and repaint the affected area using the following procedure and product.
Important:
DO NOT REPLACE COMPONENTS TO REPAIR THIS CONDITION.
The exhaust system must be cold to begin this procedure.
Material Required: * Wabash Products # KB-318-HHHS, available in pints or quarts as ready to
spray material (no mixing required). Call Wabash Products, 1-800-326-7269 or 812-232-6097 for
pricing and shipping information.
Procedure
On a cold exhaust system:
1. Raise vehicle on hoist.
2. While supporting exhaust with a transmission jack, remove the rear exhaust system hangers and
lower the exhaust.
3. Clean the affected area with a wax and grease remover, lacquer thinner or other suitable
solvent.
4. Wire brush the affected area to remove flaking paint and blow off with air.
5. Sand the affected area with # 80 to 150 grit sandpaper to remove rust, dirt or other
contaminants.
6. Clean the affected area with a wax and grease remover, lacquer thinner or other suitable
solvent.
7. Tape off the rear lower body panels and exhaust pipes forward of mufflers to protect from
overspray.
8. Apply paint to affected area in several (6 to 8) thin coats (to prevent sags and runs) obtaining
approximately 1 mil paint coverage.
9. Raise exhaust system with jack, reinstall exhaust hangers, lower vehicle and remove from hoist.
^ Allow 30 minutes drying time.
10. In a well ventilated area, start engine and allow to idle for up to 30 minutes until paint is cured
and dry.
Important:
Some "smoking" will occur while curing the paint with the engine running.
The paint can be heated and cured while driving, but be careful not to get the exhaust system wet
during the first 30 minutes.
Warranty Information
Labor Material
Operation Labor Time Allowance
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > Page 7153
A6150 0.6 hr - Single Exhaust GC
Add 0.2 hr - Dual Exhaust GC
Important:
While the above procedure and materials are correct for vehicles from 1993 to 1998, the Labor
Operation and Time Allowance only pertains to vehicles in the Warranty period.
* We believe this source and their equipment to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such equipment. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products or equipment from these firms or for any such items which may be
available from other sources.
Technical Service Bulletin # 331708 Date: 931101
Paint - Clearcoat Degradation, Chalking and Whitening
Group Ref.: Body
Bulletin No.: 331708
Date: November, 1993
SUBJECT: CLEARCOAT DEGRADATION - CHALKING AND WHITENING
MODELS: PASSENGER CARS WITH BASECOAT/CLEARCOAT
CONDITION: The vehicle exterior surface may show large chalky or white patches in the clearcoat,
usually but not limited to the horizontal surfaces.
Blacks, Dark Blues, Reds, may have potential for this condition. On rare occasions, other colors
may be involved.
CAUSE: The clearcoat (with sunlight and heat) may degrade and turn white or chalky.
IDENTIFICATION: On a clean surface, at or above room temperature, firmly apply a 2" wide piece
of masking tape to the chalky or white area of the clearcoat and pull upward quickly. The adhesive
side of the tape WILL NOT HAVE THE PAINT COLOR ON IT. A light shine or reduced tackiness
may be noticed on the tape adhesive surface, indicating clearcoat transfer to the tape.
CORRECTION: Refinish all horizontal surfaces using the following procedure.
- Remove the clearcoat layer from all horizontal surfaces and the top surfaces of fenders and
quarter panels.
NOTE:
In some cases, it will be necessary to remove the clearcoat from the upper vertical surfaces of
fenders, doors and quarters (approximately 3"), and the top areas directly above the front and rear
wheelhouse openings.
- Lightly sand any previously exposed base color to remove any chalky residue from the surface.
- The vertical surfaces should be sanded and colorcoated to the next lower breakline (typically the
body side moldings) for color uniformity of the repair.
IMPORTANT:
The following procedure covers clearcoat degradation only. It does not address any other paint
condition.
PROCEDURE:
1. Some vehicle components will be removed, while others will require masking. The list located at
the end of this bulletin will establish the removal items. Items not found on the list and non repair
areas are to be masked.
2. Prior to removing the paint finish, clean the area to be refinished with soap and water, followed
by an appropriate wax and grease remover.
3. Mask the remaining moldings and hardware for protection during sanding.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > Page 7154
4. Remove the clearcoat material from all horizontal surfaces (and tops of fenders and quarters)
using a DA (dual action orbital sander) and # 120 grit sanding discs. Lightly sand any previously
exposed base color to remove any chalky residue from the surface.
NOTE:
Chemical stripping is not recommended because of negative Impact to moldings, non-metal
components, ELPO and environmental concerns.
5. Lightly sand the unaffected vertical panels to the next lower breakline, smooth and "featheredge"
the surface to be refinished with # 240 or # 320 grit sandpaper for maximum adhesion.
6. Blow off the sanding dust and residue.
7. Remove masking tape and remask all necessary areas for priming.
8. Wipe and clean repair area with an appropriate wax and grease remover.
9. Wipe repair area with a tack rag.
10. Apply a coat of self etching or epoxy primer to the bare metal areas exposed during the
sanding process. Follow manufacturer's instructions and recommended dry times.
Typical materials would be: DuPont 615S/616S, BASF DE17/PR80/DA18, PPG DP40/DP401 or
equivalent.
V.O.C. materials would be: DuPont 615S/616S, BASF DE17/PR80/DA18, PPG DCP21/DCP212 or
equivalent.
11. Apply two to three medium wet coats of primer surfacer to the entire repair area (including
vertical surfaces) of the vehicle, following manufacturer's instructions for application and film build
requirements.
NOTE:
A guide coat Is recommended to highlight high and low spots during the wet or dry sanding
process.
Typical materials would be: DuPont 1120S/1130S/1125S, BASF DP20/PR80/PH36, PPG
K36/DT870/K201 or equivalent.
V.O.C. materials would be: DuPont 275S, BASF HP400, PPG DCP21/DCP212 or equivalent.
12. After adequate drying time, wet sand with # 400 grit (or finer) or dry sand with # 320 grit (or
finer) sand paper.
13. Repeat steps 6 through 9 and remask the vehicle.
14. Apply a medium coat of primer sealer to the entire repair area.
Typical materials would be: DuPont 2610S/2605S, BASF DP21/DH60/PR80, PPG DP40/DP401 or
equivalent.
V.O.C. materials would be: DuPont 210S, PPG DPW1834 or equivalent.
15. Apply 2 to 3 medium wet coats of basecoat (or until primer is hidden). Follow manufacturer's
instructions and recommended dry times.
16. Apply clearcoat. Follow manufacturer's instructions and recommended dry times.
17. After sufficient force dry or air dry time, remove masking.
18. Spot finesse/polish as required.
19. Reinstall previously removed hardware and moldings.
HARDWARE ITEM REMOVAL Vehicles have many different hardware options and treatments, but
the following list of items can be used as guidelines for item removal.
^ Windshield moldings (non-modular type windows)
^ Back window moldings (non-modular type windows)
^ Side view mirrors (outer panel mounted)
^ Ft. door belt seal strips (doors without window frames)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > Page 7155
^ Name plates on fenders, doors, quarters, fascias and deck lids
^ Antenna base (power or fixed mast types)
^ Wiper arms (on vehicles with cowl grilles)
^ Cowl vent grille
^ Fender marker lamps
^ Tail lamps
^ Rocker aero molding emblems
^ Roof weld seam moldings
^ Auxiliary weatherstrips
^ Deck lid lock cyl. cover
^ Wheel opening moldings
^ Roof drip scalp moldings
^ Door edge guards*
^ Spoilers*
^ Luggage racks*
^ Hood grills/ornaments*
^ Decals*
^ Stripes*
^ Body side moldings if mechanically retained. If adhesive retained, mask molding.
NOTE:
Only items marked with an asterisk are "add" conditions to the Major Operation being performed.
Removal time for the other Items listed is included in the allowance.
LABOR OPERATION: A6110
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > Page 7156
TIME ALLOWANCE: See Chart That Follows (**)
NOTE:
The time allowances provided on the chart includes the hardware removal and installation (as
indicated by the list guidelines), the masking and unmasking of the vehicle, clearcoat removal (as
indicated by the guidelines), the refinish (and colorcoat when required), mix time for primer/paint
and clearcoat, finesse/polish where required, washing and preparing the vehicle for delivery.
Technical Service Bulletin # 05-08-51-008C Date: 090622
Body - Bumps or Rust Colored Spots in Paint
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 05-08-51-008C
Date: June 22, 2009
Subject: Bumps or Rust Colored Spots in Paint Due to Rail or Iron Dust (Remove Rail Dust)
Models:
1994-2010 GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2003-2010 HUMMER H2
2006-2010 HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 05-08-51-008B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > Page 7157
Condition
Visible rust colored spots or bumps on a vehicle's paint surface from rail or iron dust.
Cause
Rail dust comes from tiny iron particles produced from the friction between train wheels and the
tracks and gets deposited on the vehicle surfaces. Iron dust can get deposited on the surface if the
vehicle is stored near any operation producing iron dust such as an iron ore yard. Either material
can lay on top of, or become embedded in, the paint surface.
Correction
Because the severity of the condition varies, proper diagnosis of the damage is critical to the
success of repairs. Diagnosis should be performed on horizontal surfaces (hood, roof, deck lid, pick
up box, etc.) after the vehicle has been properly cleaned. There are two types of repair materials
recommended to repair rail dust or iron dust:
1. GEL TYPE OXALIC ACID:
- Has the characteristics of the liquid type oxalic acid but stays where you put it because of its gel
consistency.
2. CLAY TYPE NON-ACID BASED:
- Requires surface lubricant during use. - Has different grades available.
Caution
Rail dust remover (Oxalic Acid) is an acidic substance containing chemicals that will break down
the iron particles embedded in the finish. When working with rail dust remover, use the necessary
safety equipment, including gloves and goggles. Follow the chemical manufacturer's directions
closely because it may require special handling and disposal.
If, upon inspection, some particles are still present, the various chemical manufacturer's processes
can be repeated.
After the removal process, small pits may remain in the clearcoat and can be corrected, in most
cases, with a finesse/polish operation.
Procedure
1. Move the vehicle to a cool shaded area and make sure that the vehicle surfaces are cool during
the removal process. DO NOT PERFORM THE
REMOVAL PROCESS IN DIRECT SUNLIGHT OR ON A VEHICLE WITH HOT OR WARM BODY
PANELS.
2. Wash the vehicle with soap and water. Dry it immediately and clean the affected areas with a
wax and grease remover. 3. Perform the removal process according to the chemical
manufacturer's directions.
Once the damage has been repaired, the final step involves a polishing process.
Rail Dust Remover Manufacturers
Use the chemical manufacturers listed below, or equivalent:
Auto Magic(R) or Clay Magic(R) products available from:
Auto Wax Company, Inc. 1275 Round Table Dr. Dallas, TX 75247 (800) 826-0828 (Toll-Free) or
(214) 631-4000 (Local) Fax (214) 634-1342 www.automagic.com
[email protected]
E038 Fallout Gel or E038E Liquid Fallout Remover II available from:
Valvoline Car Brite Company 1910 South State Avenue Indianapolis, In 46203 (800) 347-2439 (Toll
Free) or (317) 788-9925 (Local) Fax (317) 788-9930 www.carbrite.com
[email protected] *We
believe these sources and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products from these firms or for any such items which may be available from
other
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > Page 7158
sources.
If rail dust remover is not available in your area, call one of the numbers listed above for a
distributor near your location.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
Important Refer to the Policy & Procedures Manual, section 1.2.1.7 for detailed information
regarding warranty coverage for this condition.
Important In certain cases where the vehicle finish is severely damaged and the actual repair time
exceeds the published time, the additional time should be submitted in the "Other Labor Hours"
field.
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
Disclaimer
Technical Service Bulletin # 33-17-01A Date: 971201
Exhaust System - Paint Peeling from Painted Muffler
File In Section: 10 - Body
Bulletin No.: 33-17-01A
Date: December, 1997
Subject: Paint Peeling from Muffler (New Repair Paint Available)
Models: 1993-98 Passenger Cars with Painted Mufflers
This bulletin is being revised to add additional model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 33-17-01 (Section 10 - Body).
Condition
Some owners may experience paint peeling from the muffler.
Correction
Clean and repaint the affected area using the following procedure and product.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > Page 7159
Important:
DO NOT REPLACE COMPONENTS TO REPAIR THIS CONDITION.
The exhaust system must be cold to begin this procedure.
Material Required: * Wabash Products # KB-318-HHHS, available in pints or quarts as ready to
spray material (no mixing required). Call Wabash Products, 1-800-326-7269 or 812-232-6097 for
pricing and shipping information.
Procedure
On a cold exhaust system:
1. Raise vehicle on hoist.
2. While supporting exhaust with a transmission jack, remove the rear exhaust system hangers and
lower the exhaust.
3. Clean the affected area with a wax and grease remover, lacquer thinner or other suitable
solvent.
4. Wire brush the affected area to remove flaking paint and blow off with air.
5. Sand the affected area with # 80 to 150 grit sandpaper to remove rust, dirt or other
contaminants.
6. Clean the affected area with a wax and grease remover, lacquer thinner or other suitable
solvent.
7. Tape off the rear lower body panels and exhaust pipes forward of mufflers to protect from
overspray.
8. Apply paint to affected area in several (6 to 8) thin coats (to prevent sags and runs) obtaining
approximately 1 mil paint coverage.
9. Raise exhaust system with jack, reinstall exhaust hangers, lower vehicle and remove from hoist.
^ Allow 30 minutes drying time.
10. In a well ventilated area, start engine and allow to idle for up to 30 minutes until paint is cured
and dry.
Important:
Some "smoking" will occur while curing the paint with the engine running.
The paint can be heated and cured while driving, but be careful not to get the exhaust system wet
during the first 30 minutes.
Warranty Information
Labor Material
Operation Labor Time Allowance
A6150 0.6 hr - Single Exhaust GC
Add 0.2 hr - Dual Exhaust GC
Important:
While the above procedure and materials are correct for vehicles from 1993 to 1998, the Labor
Operation and Time Allowance only pertains to vehicles in the Warranty period.
* We believe this source and their equipment to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such equipment. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products or equipment from these firms or for any such items which may be
available from other sources.
Technical Service Bulletin # 331708 Date: 931101
Paint - Clearcoat Degradation, Chalking and Whitening
Group Ref.: Body
Bulletin No.: 331708
Date: November, 1993
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > Page 7160
SUBJECT: CLEARCOAT DEGRADATION - CHALKING AND WHITENING
MODELS: PASSENGER CARS WITH BASECOAT/CLEARCOAT
CONDITION: The vehicle exterior surface may show large chalky or white patches in the clearcoat,
usually but not limited to the horizontal surfaces.
Blacks, Dark Blues, Reds, may have potential for this condition. On rare occasions, other colors
may be involved.
CAUSE: The clearcoat (with sunlight and heat) may degrade and turn white or chalky.
IDENTIFICATION: On a clean surface, at or above room temperature, firmly apply a 2" wide piece
of masking tape to the chalky or white area of the clearcoat and pull upward quickly. The adhesive
side of the tape WILL NOT HAVE THE PAINT COLOR ON IT. A light shine or reduced tackiness
may be noticed on the tape adhesive surface, indicating clearcoat transfer to the tape.
CORRECTION: Refinish all horizontal surfaces using the following procedure.
- Remove the clearcoat layer from all horizontal surfaces and the top surfaces of fenders and
quarter panels.
NOTE:
In some cases, it will be necessary to remove the clearcoat from the upper vertical surfaces of
fenders, doors and quarters (approximately 3"), and the top areas directly above the front and rear
wheelhouse openings.
- Lightly sand any previously exposed base color to remove any chalky residue from the surface.
- The vertical surfaces should be sanded and colorcoated to the next lower breakline (typically the
body side moldings) for color uniformity of the repair.
IMPORTANT:
The following procedure covers clearcoat degradation only. It does not address any other paint
condition.
PROCEDURE:
1. Some vehicle components will be removed, while others will require masking. The list located at
the end of this bulletin will establish the removal items. Items not found on the list and non repair
areas are to be masked.
2. Prior to removing the paint finish, clean the area to be refinished with soap and water, followed
by an appropriate wax and grease remover.
3. Mask the remaining moldings and hardware for protection during sanding.
4. Remove the clearcoat material from all horizontal surfaces (and tops of fenders and quarters)
using a DA (dual action orbital sander) and # 120 grit sanding discs. Lightly sand any previously
exposed base color to remove any chalky residue from the surface.
NOTE:
Chemical stripping is not recommended because of negative Impact to moldings, non-metal
components, ELPO and environmental concerns.
5. Lightly sand the unaffected vertical panels to the next lower breakline, smooth and "featheredge"
the surface to be refinished with # 240 or # 320 grit sandpaper for maximum adhesion.
6. Blow off the sanding dust and residue.
7. Remove masking tape and remask all necessary areas for priming.
8. Wipe and clean repair area with an appropriate wax and grease remover.
9. Wipe repair area with a tack rag.
10. Apply a coat of self etching or epoxy primer to the bare metal areas exposed during the
sanding process. Follow manufacturer's instructions and recommended dry times.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > Page 7161
Typical materials would be: DuPont 615S/616S, BASF DE17/PR80/DA18, PPG DP40/DP401 or
equivalent.
V.O.C. materials would be: DuPont 615S/616S, BASF DE17/PR80/DA18, PPG DCP21/DCP212 or
equivalent.
11. Apply two to three medium wet coats of primer surfacer to the entire repair area (including
vertical surfaces) of the vehicle, following manufacturer's instructions for application and film build
requirements.
NOTE:
A guide coat Is recommended to highlight high and low spots during the wet or dry sanding
process.
Typical materials would be: DuPont 1120S/1130S/1125S, BASF DP20/PR80/PH36, PPG
K36/DT870/K201 or equivalent.
V.O.C. materials would be: DuPont 275S, BASF HP400, PPG DCP21/DCP212 or equivalent.
12. After adequate drying time, wet sand with # 400 grit (or finer) or dry sand with # 320 grit (or
finer) sand paper.
13. Repeat steps 6 through 9 and remask the vehicle.
14. Apply a medium coat of primer sealer to the entire repair area.
Typical materials would be: DuPont 2610S/2605S, BASF DP21/DH60/PR80, PPG DP40/DP401 or
equivalent.
V.O.C. materials would be: DuPont 210S, PPG DPW1834 or equivalent.
15. Apply 2 to 3 medium wet coats of basecoat (or until primer is hidden). Follow manufacturer's
instructions and recommended dry times.
16. Apply clearcoat. Follow manufacturer's instructions and recommended dry times.
17. After sufficient force dry or air dry time, remove masking.
18. Spot finesse/polish as required.
19. Reinstall previously removed hardware and moldings.
HARDWARE ITEM REMOVAL Vehicles have many different hardware options and treatments, but
the following list of items can be used as guidelines for item removal.
^ Windshield moldings (non-modular type windows)
^ Back window moldings (non-modular type windows)
^ Side view mirrors (outer panel mounted)
^ Ft. door belt seal strips (doors without window frames)
^ Name plates on fenders, doors, quarters, fascias and deck lids
^ Antenna base (power or fixed mast types)
^ Wiper arms (on vehicles with cowl grilles)
^ Cowl vent grille
^ Fender marker lamps
^ Tail lamps
^ Rocker aero molding emblems
^ Roof weld seam moldings
^ Auxiliary weatherstrips
^ Deck lid lock cyl. cover
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > Page 7162
^ Wheel opening moldings
^ Roof drip scalp moldings
^ Door edge guards*
^ Spoilers*
^ Luggage racks*
^ Hood grills/ornaments*
^ Decals*
^ Stripes*
^ Body side moldings if mechanically retained. If adhesive retained, mask molding.
NOTE:
Only items marked with an asterisk are "add" conditions to the Major Operation being performed.
Removal time for the other Items listed is included in the allowance.
LABOR OPERATION: A6110
TIME ALLOWANCE: See Chart That Follows (**)
NOTE:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Paint, Striping and Decals > Paint > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Paint: > Page 7163
The time allowances provided on the chart includes the hardware removal and installation (as
indicated by the list guidelines), the masking and unmasking of the vehicle, clearcoat removal (as
indicated by the guidelines), the refinish (and colorcoat when required), mix time for primer/paint
and clearcoat, finesse/polish where required, washing and preparing the vehicle for delivery.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Convertible Top Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Rear Of Passenger Compartment (Convertible)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Convertible Top Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7168
Harness Connector Faces: Convertable Top Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Door Module > Component
Information > Locations
Convenience Center
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Auto Door Lock Module/Enable Relay
Power Door Lock Control Module: Locations Auto Door Lock Module/Enable Relay
The Automatic Door Unlock Module is located at the left hand side of the Dash, near C100.
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
C100 (42 cavities) is located at the upper left hand side of Engine Compartment.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Auto Door Lock Module/Enable Relay > Page 7176
Convenience Center
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7177
Harness Connector Faces: Door Unlock Module
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Relay >
Component Information > Locations
RH Front Door (Convertible)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7181
Harness Connector Faces: Automatic Door Lock Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Behind RH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Relays and Modules - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7186
Behind RH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Convertible Top > Convertible Top
Frame > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Folding Top Rear Side Rail - Removal and Installation
Convertible Top Frame: Technical Service Bulletins Folding Top Rear Side Rail - Removal and
Installation
Group Ref.: 10 - Body
Bulletin No.: 431029
Date: June, 1994
SERVICE MANUAL UPDATE
SUBJECT: SECTION 10 - TO ADD FOLDING TOP REAR SIDE RAIL REMOVAL AND
INSTALLATION PROCEDURE
MODELS: 1986-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER 1986-94 PONTIAC SUNBIRD
This bulletin is being issued to add the folding top rear side rail removal and installation procedure
not previously provided in Section 10 of the appropriate Service Manual.
REMOVE OR DISCONNECT: (Refer to illustration)
1. Clevis pin attaching cylinder to rear side rail.
2. Quarter window weatherstrip retainer (do not remove 3 lower nuts attaching weatherstrip to rear
side rail).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Convertible Top > Convertible Top
Frame > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Folding Top Rear Side Rail - Removal and Installation >
Page 7193
3. Bottom and top tension cables.
4. Bow # 3 from rear side rail.
5. Front side rail from rear side rail.
6. Bow # 4 link from rear side rail.
7. Rear side rail lower pivot bolt.
8. Inner arm upper pivot bolt.
9. Rear side rail.
10. Quarter window weatherstrip from rear side rail.
INSTALL OR CONNECT: (Refer to illustration)
Note:
Tighten all bolts and nuts to 20.3 N-m (15 lbs.ft.). Tighten all screws until fully seated, fastened, not
stripped.
1. Lower 3 nuts attaching quarter window weatherstrip to rear side rail.
2. Rear side rail.
3. Rear side rail lower pivot bolt.
4. Clevis pin attaching cylinder to rear side rail. Use a cotter pin to secure the clevis pin. DO NOT
reuse the hairpin clip if used.
5. Front side rail to rear side rail.
6. Position folding top halfway up.
7. Bow # 4 link to rear side rail.
8. Inner arm upper pivot bolt.
9. Bow # 3 to rear side rail.
10. Bottom and top tension cables.
11. Quarter window weatherstrip retainer.
12. Quarter window weatherstrip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Convertible Top > Convertible Top
Pump > Component Information > Locations
Convertible Top Pump: Locations
Hydraulic Power Assembly is located In Luggage Compartment, behind center of Rear Seat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Convertible Top > Convertible Top
Relay > Component Information > Locations
Rear Of Passenger Compartment (Convertible)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Convertible Top > Convertible Top
Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 7200
Harness Connector Faces: Convertable Top Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Convertible Top > Convertible Top
Switch > Component Information > Locations
LH Front Of Door (Convertible)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Convertible Top > Convertible Top
Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 7204
Harness Connector Faces: Convertable Top Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Roof and Associated Components > Sunroof / Moonroof > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Webasto Sunroof System - Information Hotline
Sunroof / Moonroof: Technical Service Bulletins Webasto Sunroof System - Information Hotline
Group Ref.: Body
Bulletin No.: 431018A
Date: May, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A WEBASTO SUNROOF SYSTEM
MODELS: 1987-94 BUICK MODELS 1987-94 CADILLAC MODELS 1988-94 CHEVROLET
MODELS 1987-94 OLDSMOBILE MODELS 1986-94 PONTIAC MODELS
THIS BULLETIN IS BEING REVISED TO INCLUDE CHEVROLET AND PONTIAC VEHICLES.
PLEASE DISCARD BULLETIN 431018.
Webasto Sunroof Corporation has established a hotline for information pertaining to parts or
serviceability of Webasto sunroofs. Call 1-800-995-5911 with any questions concerning these
issues.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Head Restraint System > System Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Restraints - Driver/Passenger Seat Head Rest Information
Head Restraint System: Technical Service Bulletins Restraints - Driver/Passenger Seat Head Rest
Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 10-08-50-003A
Date: March 24, 2011
Subject: Information on Driver or Passenger Seat Head Restraint Concerns with Comfort, Custom
Upholstery or Other Comfort Enhancing Devices
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks Equipped with Adjustable Head Restraints
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 10-08-50-003 (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Important ON A GM VEHICLE EQUIPPED WITH ADJUSTABLE HEAD RESTRAINTS, USE THE
HEAD RESTRAINT COVERS, FOAM AND OTHER SEAT-RELATED EQUIPMENT AS
RELEASED BY GM FOR THAT VEHICLE. DO NOT ALTER OR REPOSITION THE HEAD
RESTRAINT SYSTEM. ANY ALTERATIONS TO HEAD RESTRAINTS DEFEATS THE INTENDED
DESIGN OF THE SYSTEM. GM WILL NOT BE LIABLE FOR ANY PROBLEMS CAUSED BY USE
OF SUCH IMPROPER DESIGN ALTERATIONS, INCLUDING ANY WARRANTY REPAIRS
INCURRED.
You may have a customer with a concern that the head restraint is uncomfortable or sits too far
forward. The front driver and passenger seats are equipped with head restraints that have been
designed to help minimize injuries while still providing comfort to the occupants. Each GM vehicle
has its own specifically designed head restraint.
The head restraints should only be used in the vehicle for which they were designed. The head
restraint will not operate to its design intent if the original foam is replaced (1) by non-GM foam or
head restraint, (2) by GM foam or head restraint designed for a different vehicle, (3) by GM foam or
head restraint that has been altered by a trim shop or (4) if any object, such as an aftermarket
comfort enhancing pad or device, is installed.
Never modify the design of the head restraint or remove the head restraint from the vehicle as this
may interfere with the operation of the seating and restraint systems and may prevent proper
positioning of the passenger within the vehicle.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Interior - Seat Cover Wrinkle/Crease/Burn Info
Seat Cover: Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Seat Cover Wrinkle/Crease/Burn Info
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 04-08-50-006D
Date: September 09, 2010
Subject: Minor Wrinkles/Creases, Discoloration, Cigarette Burns and Customer Induced Cuts and
Stains on Front and Rear Driver and Passenger Seats with Leather, Vinyl or Cloth Seat Covers
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2 2010 and
Prior HUMMER H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X 2010 and Prior Saturn
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add a model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 04-08-50-006C (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
If a customer comes in to your dealership due to certain conditions of the seat covers (splits,
wrinkles, loose stitching, etc.), you must examine the seat cover in order to determine the validity of
the customer claim. Some components from the above listed vehicles have been returned to the
Warranty Parts Center (WPC) and analysis of these parts showed "customer induced damage" or
No Trouble Found (NTF).
The dealer should pay particular attention to the following conditions:
- Cigarette burns
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Interior - Seat Cover Wrinkle/Crease/Burn Info > Page 7218
- Customer induced cuts (knife cuts, cut by customer tools, etc.)
- Paint stains (customer should have cleaned paint stains while paint was still wet)
- Coffee stains and other removable dirt These should be cleaned as described in the Owner's
Manual under Appearance Care. Also, refer to Corporate Bulletin Number 06-00-89-029A or later.
- Evidence of chemicals used for cleaning, other than those specified in the Owner's Manual
- Other chemical spills
- Minor and normal leather wrinkles as a result of use
- Other defects to the seat cover not detected during the pre-delivery inspection (PDI).
Inform the customer that the above issues were not present when the vehicle was purchased and
cannot be replaced under warranty. The covers, however, may be repaired or replaced at the
customer's expense.
The following conditions are not caused by the customer and should be covered by warranty:
- Split seams
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Interior - Seat Cover Wrinkle/Crease/Burn Info > Page 7219
- Wear/cracking/peeling
- Discoloration/dye transfer from customer clothing (if discoloration/dye transfer is not removed
after using GM Leather and Vinyl Plastic Cleaner, P/N 88861401 (in Canada, P/N 88861409),
replace the covers.)
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Interior - Seat Cover Wrinkle/Crease/Burn Info > Page 7220
Seat Cover: Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Elimination Of Unwanted Odors
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-00-89-027E
Date: September 29, 2008
Subject: Eliminating Unwanted Odors in Vehicles
Models: 2009 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2009 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3 Vehicles 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to add model years and refine the instructions. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 00-00-89-027D (Section 00 - General Information).
Vehicle Odor Elimination
General Motors offers a product that may control or eliminate odors in the interior and luggage
compartment areas of GM vehicles. GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator is a non-toxic,
biodegradable odor remover. This odorless product has been shown to greatly reduce or remove
objectionable smells of mold and mildew resulting from vehicle water leaks (as well as customer
created odors, i.e. smoke). You may use GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator on fabrics, vinyl,
leather, carpet and sound deadening materials. It may also be induced into HVAC modules and
instrument panel ducts (for the control of non-bacterial related odors).
Important:
This product leaves no residual scent and should not be sold as or considered an air freshener.
Product action may result in the permanent elimination of an odor and may be preferable to
customers with allergies who are sensitive to perfumes.
How to Use This Product
GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator may be sprayed on in a ready-to-use formula or used in steam
cleaners as an additive with carpet shampoo. This water-based, odorless product is safe for all
vehicle interiors. Do not wet or soak any interior surface that plain water would cause to
deteriorate, as this product will have the same effect. Also avoid letting this product come into
contact with vinegar or any acidic substance. Acid-based products will hamper the effectiveness of,
or render GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator inert.
Note:
Complete eight page treatment sheets are enclosed within each case of GM Vehicle Care Odor
Eliminator. These treatment instructions range from simple vehicle odor elimination to full step by
step procedures for odor removal from water leaks. If lost, contact 800-977-4145 to get a
replacement set faxed or e-mailed to your dealership.
Instructions and cautions are printed on the bottle, but additional help is available. If you encounter
a difficult to eliminate or reoccurring odor, you may call 1-800-955-8591 (in Canada,
1-800-977-4145) to obtain additional information and usage suggestions.
Important:
This product may effectively remove odors when directly contacting the odor source. It should be
used in conjunction with diagnostic procedures (in cases such as a water leak) to first eliminate the
root cause of the odor, and then the residual odor to permanently correct the vehicle condition.
Vehicle Waterleak Odor Elimination
STEP ONE:
Confirm that all water leaks have been repaired. Determine what areas of the vehicle were water
soaked or wet. Components with visible mold/mildew staining should be replaced. Isolate the odor
source inside the vehicle. Often an odor can be isolated to an area or component of the vehicle
interior by careful evaluation. Odor evaluation may need to be performed by multiple persons.
Another method of isolating an odor source is to remove and segregate interior trim and
components. Plastic sheeting or drop cloths can be used to confine seats, headliners, etc. to assist
in evaluation and diagnoses. If appropriate the vehicle and interior trim should be evaluated
separately to determine if the odor stays with the vehicle or the interior components. Odors that
stay with the vehicle may be isolated to insulating and sound deadening materials (i.e. water leak
at the windshield or standing water in the front foot well area caused mold/mildew to form on the
bulkhead or kick panel sound deadening pads. If the interior is removed the floor pan and
primed/painted surfaces should be treated with bleach/soap solution, rinsed with clean water and
dried. Interior surfaces should then be treated with GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator product
before reinstalling carpet or reassembling.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Interior - Seat Cover Wrinkle/Crease/Burn Info > Page 7221
The GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator product is an effective odor elimination product when used
properly. It must come into direct contact with the odor source. It should be used in conjunction with
diagnostic procedures to first eliminate the root cause of the odor. Some procedures for use after
odor root cause correction are:
STEP TWO:
^ Use the trigger spray head.
^ Put a drop of dish soap the size of a quarter in the bottom of a bottle.
^ Add 8 oz. of GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator (1 cup) to the dish soap and top off the bottle with
tap water.
^ This formula should be used on hard surfaces (dash, interior plastic molding, and floor pan)
STEP THREE:
The third step to neutralizing the vehicle is a light to medium treatment of all carpeting and
upholstered seats with the GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator formula and a wide fan spray setting
(at full strength) (i.e.: carpeting on the driver's side requires 4-5 triggers pulls for coverage). The
headliner and trunk should be sprayed next. Lightly brushing the formula into the carpeting and
upholstery is a recommended step for deep odor problems. The dash and all hard surfaces should
be sprayed with dish soap/water mixture. Let stand for 1-2 minutes then wipe off the surface.
STEP FOUR: (vehicle ventilation system treatment)
The ventilation system is generally the last step in the treatment of the vehicle.
a. Spray the GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator formula into all dash vents. (1-2 trigger pulls per
vent).
b. Start the vehicle and turn the vehicle fan on high cool (not A/C setting).
c. Spray the formula (10 trigger pulls) into the outside fresh air intake vent (cowl at base of
windshield)
d. Enter the vehicle after 1 minute and wipe off the excess formula spurting out of the dash vents.
e. Smell the air coming from the dash vents. If odors are still present, spray another 5 triggers into
the cowl, wait another minute and smell the results. Once you have obtained a fresh, clean smell
coming from the vents, turn the system to the A/C re-circulation setting. Roll up the windows, spray
3-5 pumps into the right lower IP area and let the vehicle run with the fan set on high for 5-7
minutes.
Please follow this diagnosis process thoroughly and complete each step. If the condition exhibited
is resolved without completing every step, the remaining steps do not need to be performed. If
these steps do not resolve the condition, please contact GM TAC for further diagnostic assistance.
Additional Suggestions to Increase Customer Satisfaction
Here are some additional ideas to benefit your dealership and to generate greater customer
enthusiasm for this product.
^ Keep this product on-hand for both the Service Department and the Used Car lot. Add value to
your used car trades; treat loaner and demo cars during service and at final sale to eliminate
smoke, pet, and other common odors offensive to customers. Make deodorizing a vehicle part of
your normal vehicle detailing service.
^ Consider including GM Vehicle Care Odor Eliminator as a give-away item with new vehicle
purchases. Many dealers give away as "gifts" various cleaning supplies at time of delivery. GM
Odor Eliminator is one of a few products GM offers that has as many uses in the home as in the
vehicle. Customers may find this product can be used for a host of recreational activities
associated with their new vehicle, such as deodorizing a boat they tow, or a camper.
^ GM Odor Eliminator and many of the GM Vehicle Care products offer you the chance to increase
dealership traffic as these superior quality products cannot be purchased in stores. Many
Dealerships have product displays at the parts counter. Consider additional displays in the
Customer Service Lounge, the Showroom and at the Service Desk or Cashier Window. Many
customers who purchase vehicles and receive regular maintenance at your dealership may never
visit the parts counter, and subsequently are not exposed to the variety and value that these
products offer.
Parts Information
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Interior - Seat Cover Wrinkle/Crease/Burn Info > Page 7222
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Seats > Seat Cover > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Interior - Seat Cover Wrinkle/Crease/Burn Info > Page 7223
Seat Cover: Technical Service Bulletins Leather Seat Covers - Cleaning Procedure
File In Section: 10 - Body Bulletin No.: 43-16-06 Date: October, 1994
Subject: Cleaning Procedure for Leather Seat Covers
Models: 1995 and Prior Passenger Cars and "C/K" and "S/T" Trucks
If leather seat covers are being returned only because they are dirty, a more aggressive cleaning
procedure is recommended by General Motors prior to replacing covers.
Procedure
Dirty or soiled leather seat covers should be cleaned with a mild soap and water solution, using
clean soft cloths. When this procedure proves inadequate, a commercially available leather
cleaner, "Tanner's Preserve Leather Cleaner"* should be used with a 3M "Type T"* scrubbing pad.
Important:
The type of scrubbing pad is very critical because the common 3M Scotch-Brite green pad is too
aggressive and will damage the leather finish.
The cleaner is available from "First Brands" by calling 1-800-726-1001, identifying yourself as a GM
dealership, requesting "Tanner's Preserve Leather Cleaner" product, number AS-330, quantity and
shipping address. This product is also available at stores.
The 3M "Type T" scrubbing pad is available from a 3M distributor. Call 1-800-742-9546 for the
nearest distributor and then request the Scotch-Brite Clean and Finish Sheet, "Type T", in 6 x 9
inch sheets, UPC code number 048011-01276.
* We believe these sources and their equipment to be reliable. There may be additional
manufacturers of such equipment. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or
assume any responsibility for the products or equipment from these firms or for any such items
which may be available from other sources.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Convertible Top Switch >
Component Information > Locations
LH Front Of Door (Convertible)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Convertible Top Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7228
Harness Connector Faces: Convertable Top Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Door Lock Switch: > 438101B > Sep >
95 > Interior - Lights Remain On/Battery Becomes Rundown
Power Door Lock Switch: Customer Interest Interior - Lights Remain On/Battery Becomes
Rundown
File In Section: 8 - Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 43-81-01B
Date: September, 1995
Subject: Battery Rundown/Interior Lights Remain On (Diagnostic Check/Replace Door Handle
Switch)
Models: 1992-94 Chevrolet Cavalier 1994
Chevrolet Corsica, Beretta
1992-94 Pontiac Sunbird
This bulletin is being revised to update the correction procedure and parts and warranty
information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 43-81-01A (Section 8 - Chassis/Body
Electrical).
Condition
Some owners may experience interior lights staying "ON" after all doors are closed and after the
Multi-Function Alarm Module's inadvertent lighting function has timed out, causing battery rundown.
In the Corsica/Beretta, the Multi-Function Alarm Module will automatically turn off the interior lights
after 20 minutes. The Cavalier and Sunbird's interior lights will continue to light indefinitely.
Cause
The LH and/or RH front door handle switch(es) may be providing a resistive path to ground which
may cause the Multi-Function Alarm Module to sense that the door(s) are falsely open.
Correction
Follow the diagnostic procedure as listed below. If a resistance other than the specified value
registers during testing, replace the malfunctioning door handle switch, (see P/N chart). Continue
through the entire test to check that both the RH and LH door handle switches are functioning
properly.
1. Disconnect the Multi-Function Alarm Module.
2. With the LH front door open, measure the resistance from:
Term "J" to Term "P" (J Car)
CONN C1, Term "H" to CONN C2, Term "E" (L Car)
Resistance should be between 0 - 0.5 Ohms.
3. With the LH front door closed, measure the resistance from:
Term "J" to Term "P" (J Car)
CONN C1, Term "H" to CONN C2, Term "E" (L Car)
Resistance should be > 30 Mega Ohms.
4. With the RH front door open, measure the resistance from:
Term "K" to Term "P" (J Car)
CONN C1, Term "G" to CONN C2, Term "E" (L Car)
Resistance should be between 0 - 0.5 Ohms.
5. With the RH front door closed, measure the resistance from:
Term "K" to Term "P" (J Car)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Door Lock Switch: > 438101B > Sep >
95 > Interior - Lights Remain On/Battery Becomes Rundown > Page 7237
CONN C1, Term "G" to CONN 02, Term "E" (L Car)
Resistance should be > 30 Mega Ohms.
Parts Information
All parts are found in Group 10.470 - LOCK ASM F/RH or LH
Important:
The door handle switches are part of the front side door lock assembly.
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Door Lock Switch: >
438101B > Sep > 95 > Interior - Lights Remain On/Battery Becomes Rundown
Power Door Lock Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Interior - Lights Remain On/Battery
Becomes Rundown
File In Section: 8 - Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 43-81-01B
Date: September, 1995
Subject: Battery Rundown/Interior Lights Remain On (Diagnostic Check/Replace Door Handle
Switch)
Models: 1992-94 Chevrolet Cavalier 1994
Chevrolet Corsica, Beretta
1992-94 Pontiac Sunbird
This bulletin is being revised to update the correction procedure and parts and warranty
information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 43-81-01A (Section 8 - Chassis/Body
Electrical).
Condition
Some owners may experience interior lights staying "ON" after all doors are closed and after the
Multi-Function Alarm Module's inadvertent lighting function has timed out, causing battery rundown.
In the Corsica/Beretta, the Multi-Function Alarm Module will automatically turn off the interior lights
after 20 minutes. The Cavalier and Sunbird's interior lights will continue to light indefinitely.
Cause
The LH and/or RH front door handle switch(es) may be providing a resistive path to ground which
may cause the Multi-Function Alarm Module to sense that the door(s) are falsely open.
Correction
Follow the diagnostic procedure as listed below. If a resistance other than the specified value
registers during testing, replace the malfunctioning door handle switch, (see P/N chart). Continue
through the entire test to check that both the RH and LH door handle switches are functioning
properly.
1. Disconnect the Multi-Function Alarm Module.
2. With the LH front door open, measure the resistance from:
Term "J" to Term "P" (J Car)
CONN C1, Term "H" to CONN C2, Term "E" (L Car)
Resistance should be between 0 - 0.5 Ohms.
3. With the LH front door closed, measure the resistance from:
Term "J" to Term "P" (J Car)
CONN C1, Term "H" to CONN C2, Term "E" (L Car)
Resistance should be > 30 Mega Ohms.
4. With the RH front door open, measure the resistance from:
Term "K" to Term "P" (J Car)
CONN C1, Term "G" to CONN C2, Term "E" (L Car)
Resistance should be between 0 - 0.5 Ohms.
5. With the RH front door closed, measure the resistance from:
Term "K" to Term "P" (J Car)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Door Lock Switch: >
438101B > Sep > 95 > Interior - Lights Remain On/Battery Becomes Rundown > Page 7243
CONN C1, Term "G" to CONN 02, Term "E" (L Car)
Resistance should be > 30 Mega Ohms.
Parts Information
All parts are found in Group 10.470 - LOCK ASM F/RH or LH
Important:
The door handle switches are part of the front side door lock assembly.
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Door Lock Switch
Power Door Lock Switch: Locations Left Front Door Lock Switch
LH Front Of Door (Coupe)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Door Lock Switch > Page 7246
LH Front Of Door (Convertible)
LH Front Door (Station Wagon Shown, Sedan Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Door Lock Switch > Page 7247
Power Door Lock Switch: Locations Right Front Door Lock Switch
RH Front Of Door (Coupe)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Door Lock Switch > Page 7248
RH Front Door (Convertible)
RH Front Door (Station Wagon Shown, Sedan Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Left Front Door Lock Switch > Page 7249
LH Rear Door (Sedan And Station Wagon) (RH Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Door Lock Switch
Harness Connector Faces: LH Front Door Lock Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Front Door Lock Switch > Page 7252
Harness Connector Faces: RH Front Door Lock Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Component Locations
Tailgate (Station Wagon)
Behind RH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Trunk / Liftgate Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7257
Trunk / Liftgate Switch: Connector Locations
Behind RH Side Of I/P
Behind RH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 431511 > Oct > 94 > Door Glass/Quarter Window Area - Waterleak
Weatherstrip: Customer Interest Door Glass/Quarter Window Area - Waterleak
File In Section: 10 - Body
Bulletin No.: 43-15-11
Date: October, 1994
Subject: Waterleak at Door Glass and Quarter Window Area (Diagnostic Service Procedure)
Models: 1988-94 Chevrolet Cavalier
1988-94 Pontiac Sunbird (Convertible models only)
Caution:
To help avoid injury to you or others when raising or lowering the convertible top, keep your hands
away from any hinges and linkage and close all latching handles.
This bulletin is being issued to help identify potential areas of waterleaks at: A-pillar weatherstrip to
front rail weatherstrip, front rail weatherstrip to center rail weatherstrip and center rail weatherstrip
to rear rail weatherstrip.
Before performing any repair procedures, verify with owner that proper convertible top operating
procedures and conditions have been observed as follows:
^ Never raise or lower the top while the car is moving. The wind could get under it and cause
damage.
^ If automatic car washes are used, it is recommended that a soft cloth car wash be used and the
vehicle climate control system should be set to "vent" and the fan be set at its highest speed. This
will prevent the high pressure water from entering around the convertible top.
^ Do not try to lower or raise the convertible top if your vehicle is out in cold weather, 41°F (5°C) or
below. The cold can cause cracks and other damage to the convertible top as it is being lowered or
raised.
^ Do not lower the convertible top if it is damp or wet. After the convertible top is down, the trapped
water can cause stains, mildew and damage to the inside of the vehicle. Be sure to dry off the
convertible top before you lower it.
^ Make sure there is nothing in the convertible top storage well (the area behind the rear seat
where the convertible top will go) or under the well in the trunk. Even a small item could damage
the rear window or convertible top when it is lowered.
^ The convertible top is not designed to carry weight. Never let anyone sit on the convertible top,
and do not put anything on top of it when it is up or down, or it could be damaged.
^ All side windows must be partially lowered before lowering or raising convertible top to prevent
weatherstrip and seal damage or displacement which could result in water and/or wind leaks.
Gathering detailed information from the vehicle owner is a valuable tool in locating and repairing
water leaks. It may be necessary to ask leading questions to the location and conditions when
water leaks occur. Some helpful questions may be asked as follows:
1. What area of the vehicle does water appear?
2. Does water leak occur when it rains?
3. Does water leak occur when vehicle is washed?
4. Is vehicle washed in an automatic car wash or is it washed by hand?
5. Have seals or weatherstrips been serviced previously?
6. Have door or quarter windows been serviced previously?
7. Has vehicle been in a collision at any time?
As an aid in diagnosIng waterleaks, the following video should be reviewed: "Pontiac Tech Track
Sunbird Convertible Wlndnoise and Water Leak Diagnosis and AlIgnment".
The vehicle should be visually inspected and watertested wIth water test stands as described in
Section 10-1 of the appropriate Service Manual.
Check and adjust quarter glass alignment if necessary. Refer to Section 10-7 of the appropriate
Service Manual.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 431511 > Oct > 94 > Door Glass/Quarter Window Area - Waterleak > Page 7266
Check and adjust door glass to quarter glass alignment if necessary. Refer to Sections 10-6 and
10-7 of the appropriate Service Manual.
Check and adjust convertible top alignment if necessary. Refer to Section 10-9 of the appropriate
Service Manual.
Condition
1. Permanent damage to weatherstrips at A-pillar, front rail, center rail and/or rear rail such as:
^ Hole in weatherstrip (refer to Figure 1).
^ Extensively deformed (refer to Figure 1).
^ Torn or badly distorted (refer to Figure 1).
2. Waterleak found between weatherstrip retainer and A-pillar, front rail, center rail or rear rail.
3. Waterleak found between A-pillar weatherstrip to folding top front seal assembly has two
potential conditions identified:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 431511 > Oct > 94 > Door Glass/Quarter Window Area - Waterleak > Page 7267
^ Gaping (refer to Figure 2).
^ Puckering (refer to Figure 2).
4. Waterleak found between front rail weatherstrip to center rail weatherstrip has two potential
conditions identified:
^ Gaping (Refer to Figure 3).
^ Puckering (Refer to Figure 3).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 431511 > Oct > 94 > Door Glass/Quarter Window Area - Waterleak > Page 7268
5. Waterleak found between center rail weatherstrip to rear rail weatherstrip has three potential
conditions identified:
^ Gaping (Refer to Figure 4).
^ Puckering (Refer to Figure 4).
^ Rolling (Refer to Figure 4).
Correction
Note:
When correction procedures are complete, apply a thin coat of petroleum jelly or silicone to sides of
center rail weatherstrip and rear rail weatherstrip
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 431511 > Oct > 94 > Door Glass/Quarter Window Area - Waterleak > Page 7269
to reduce weatherstrip rolling. Refer to Figure 5.
1. Damaged weatherstrips to be replaced. Refer to procedures in Section 10-9 of the appropriate
Service Manual.
2. Repair weatherstrip retainer. Refer to procedures in Section 10-9 of the appropriate Service
Manual.
3. To correct A-pillar weatherstrip to front rail weatherstrip gaping, use the following procedure:
1. Remove approximately 100 mm (4.0 inch) of weatherstrip from top of A-pillar retainer.
2. Using black weatherstrip adhesive, P/N 12345097, or equivalent, install weatherstrip into A-pillar
retainer while pulling weatherstrip upward until contacting front rail weatherstrip end. Refer to
Figure 6.
3A. To correct A-pillar weatherstrip to folding top front seal assembly puckering, use the following
procedure:
1. Lower convertible top about halfway.
2. Remove approximately 100 mm (4.0 inch) of weatherstrip from top of A-pillar retainer.
3. Remove approximately 100 mm (4.0 inch) of folding top front seal assembly from across No. 1
bow and down front side rail retainer.
4. Install stuffers (two each end) into the cut-away in back of weatherstrips. Refer to Figure 7. This
will push the weatherstrip surface back to its original shape.
5. Using black weatherstrip adhesive, P/N 12345097, or equivalent, install weatherstrip into A-pillar
retainer.
6. Using black weatherstrip adhesive, P/N 12345097, or equivalent, install folding top front seal
assembly.
7. Raise convertible top and lock.
4. To correct front rail weatherstrip to center rail weatherstrip gaping, use the following procedure:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 431511 > Oct > 94 > Door Glass/Quarter Window Area - Waterleak > Page 7270
1. Remove center rail weatherstrip retaining screw. Refer to Figure 8.
2. Remove front rail weatherstrip retaining screw. Refer to Figure 8.
3. Remove approximately 100 mm (4.0 inch) of weatherstrip from rear to center of front retainer.
4. Remove approximately 100 mm (4.0 inch) of weatherstrip from front to center of center retainer.
5. Using black weatherstrip adhesive, P/N 12345097, or equivalent, install front and center rail
weatherstrips into retainer, pulling ends together until contacting. Refer to Figure 8.
6. Install front and center rail weatherstrip retaining screws. Refer to Figure 8.
4A. To correct front rail weatherstrip to center rail weatherstrip puckering, use the following
procedure.
1. Lower convertible top about halfway.
2. Remove center rail weatherstrip retaining screw. Refer to Figure 8.
3. Remove front rail weatherstrip retaining screw. Refer to Figure 8.
4. Remove approximately 100 mm (4.0 inch) of weatherstrip from rear to center of front retainer.
5. Remove approximately 100 mm (4.0 inch) of weatherstrip from front to center of center retainer.
6. Install stuffers (two each end) into the cut-away in back of weatherstrips. Refer to Figure 7. This
will push the weatherstrip surface back to its original shape.
7. Raise convertible top and lock.
8. Using black weatherstrip adhesive, PIN 12345097, or equivalent, install front and center rail
weatherstrips into retainer, pulling ends together until contacting. Refer to Figure 8.
9. Install front and center rail weatherstrip retaining screws. Refer to Figure 8.
5. To correct center rail weatherstrip to rear rail weatherstrip gaping, use the following procedure:
1. Lower convertible top about halfway.
2. Lower quarter window.
3. Remove center rail weatherstrip retaining screw.
4. Remove approximately 1OO mm (4.0 inch) of weatherstrip from front to center of retainer.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 431511 > Oct > 94 > Door Glass/Quarter Window Area - Waterleak > Page 7271
5. Relocate center rail weatherstrip retaining screw hole forward 4 - 5 mm (0.156 - 0.203 inch).
Refer to Figure 9.
6. Using black weatherstrip adhesive, P/N 12345097, or equivalent, install center rail weatherstrip
forward in retainer.
7. Install center rail weatherstrip retaining screw into new hole. Refer to Figure 9.
8. Perform watertest. If waterleak is still existing, proceed to step 9.
9. Remove center portion of center rail weatherstrip, approximately 25 mm (1.0 inch) from retainer
ends. Refer to Figure 10.
10. Apply black weatherstrip adhesive, P/N 12345097, or equivalent, in retainer.
11. Install center rail weatherstrip into retainer while pushing weatherstrip rearward. Refer to Figure
10.
5A. To correct center rail weatherstrip to rear rail weatherstrip puckering, use the following
procedure:
1. Lower convertible top about halfway.
2. Lower quarter window.
3. Remove center rail weatherstrip approximately 100 mm (4.0 inch) from the rear joint end by
disconnecting clip.
4. Install stuffers (two) into the cut-away in back of center rail weatherstrip. Refer to Figure 7. This
will push the weatherstrip surface back to its original shape.
5. Apply black weatherstrip adhesive, P/N 12345097, or equivalent, in retainer.
6. Install center rail weatherstrip into retainer.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 431511 > Oct > 94 > Door Glass/Quarter Window Area - Waterleak > Page 7272
5B. To correct center rail weatherstrip to rear rail weatherstrip rolling, use the following procedure:
1. Lower convertible top about halfway.
2. Lower quarter window.
3. Remove center rail weatherstrip retaining screw. Refer to Figure 11.
4. Remove approximately 100 mm (4.0 inch) of weatherstrip from front to center of retainer.
5. Apply black weatherstrip adhesive, P/N 12345097, or equivalent, in retainer.
6. Install center rail weatherstrip into retainer while pushing weatherstrip rearward 3 - 4 mm (0.118 0.157 inch). Refer to Figure 11.
7. Install center rail weatherstrip retaining screw.
8. Perform watertest. If waterleak is still existing, proceed to step 9.
9. Remove center portion of center rail weatherstrip approximately 25 mm (1.0 inch) from retainer
ends. Refer to Figure 10.
10. Apply black weatherstrip adhesive, P/N 12345097, or equivalent, in retainer.
11. Install center rail weatherstrip into retainer while pushing weatherstrip rearward. Refer to Figure
10.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: Seal, center to rear rail Labor Operation Labor Time
B3110 (Right) 0.3 hr.
B3111 (Left) 0.3 hr.
Seal, side rail weatherstrip
Labor Operation Labor Time
B3140 (Right) 0.3 hr.
B3141 (Left) 0.3 hr.
Seal, rear rail (rear roof rail weatherstrip) Labor Operation Labor Time
B3150 (Right) 0.3 hr.
B3151 (Left) 0.3 hr.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Weatherstrip: > 99-08-64-016C > Jul > 09 > Body - Maintaining Exterior Weatherstrip
Appearance
Weatherstrip: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Maintaining Exterior Weatherstrip Appearance
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 99-08-64-016C
Date: July 29, 2009
Subject: Information on Maintaining Exterior Weatherstrip Appearance
Models:
2010 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3
2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and update the parts and procedure
information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 99-08-64-016B (Section 08 - Body and
Accessories).
Exterior weatherstrips are exposed to a variety of environmental elements, including UV rays, acid
rain, insect and bird residue and atmospheric fallout. All of these may effect the appearance of the
weatherstrips; however, they do not effect the functionality of the weatherstrip.
Weatherstrips that are discolored should not be replaced under the normal GM New Vehicle
Warranty.
Weatherstrip Maintenance Instructions
Silicone grease on weatherstrips will make them last longer, seal better, and not stick or squeak.
Clean the weatherstrips with a mild soap and water solution. Apply silicone grease with a clean
cloth. During very cold, damp weather, frequent application may be required. Refer to the
information below for the recommended maintenance products. Weatherstrips that are not
maintained may crack and weather due to environmental elements.
Parts Information
Weatherstrip Conditioning Weatherstrip Lubricant (GM P/N 3634770 [in Canada, P/N 10953518])
or Dielectric Silicone Grease (GM P/N 12345579 [in Canada, P/N 992887]).
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Weatherstrip: > 431511 > Oct > 94 > Door Glass/Quarter Window Area - Waterleak
Weatherstrip: All Technical Service Bulletins Door Glass/Quarter Window Area - Waterleak
File In Section: 10 - Body
Bulletin No.: 43-15-11
Date: October, 1994
Subject: Waterleak at Door Glass and Quarter Window Area (Diagnostic Service Procedure)
Models: 1988-94 Chevrolet Cavalier
1988-94 Pontiac Sunbird (Convertible models only)
Caution:
To help avoid injury to you or others when raising or lowering the convertible top, keep your hands
away from any hinges and linkage and close all latching handles.
This bulletin is being issued to help identify potential areas of waterleaks at: A-pillar weatherstrip to
front rail weatherstrip, front rail weatherstrip to center rail weatherstrip and center rail weatherstrip
to rear rail weatherstrip.
Before performing any repair procedures, verify with owner that proper convertible top operating
procedures and conditions have been observed as follows:
^ Never raise or lower the top while the car is moving. The wind could get under it and cause
damage.
^ If automatic car washes are used, it is recommended that a soft cloth car wash be used and the
vehicle climate control system should be set to "vent" and the fan be set at its highest speed. This
will prevent the high pressure water from entering around the convertible top.
^ Do not try to lower or raise the convertible top if your vehicle is out in cold weather, 41°F (5°C) or
below. The cold can cause cracks and other damage to the convertible top as it is being lowered or
raised.
^ Do not lower the convertible top if it is damp or wet. After the convertible top is down, the trapped
water can cause stains, mildew and damage to the inside of the vehicle. Be sure to dry off the
convertible top before you lower it.
^ Make sure there is nothing in the convertible top storage well (the area behind the rear seat
where the convertible top will go) or under the well in the trunk. Even a small item could damage
the rear window or convertible top when it is lowered.
^ The convertible top is not designed to carry weight. Never let anyone sit on the convertible top,
and do not put anything on top of it when it is up or down, or it could be damaged.
^ All side windows must be partially lowered before lowering or raising convertible top to prevent
weatherstrip and seal damage or displacement which could result in water and/or wind leaks.
Gathering detailed information from the vehicle owner is a valuable tool in locating and repairing
water leaks. It may be necessary to ask leading questions to the location and conditions when
water leaks occur. Some helpful questions may be asked as follows:
1. What area of the vehicle does water appear?
2. Does water leak occur when it rains?
3. Does water leak occur when vehicle is washed?
4. Is vehicle washed in an automatic car wash or is it washed by hand?
5. Have seals or weatherstrips been serviced previously?
6. Have door or quarter windows been serviced previously?
7. Has vehicle been in a collision at any time?
As an aid in diagnosIng waterleaks, the following video should be reviewed: "Pontiac Tech Track
Sunbird Convertible Wlndnoise and Water Leak Diagnosis and AlIgnment".
The vehicle should be visually inspected and watertested wIth water test stands as described in
Section 10-1 of the appropriate Service Manual.
Check and adjust quarter glass alignment if necessary. Refer to Section 10-7 of the appropriate
Service Manual.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Weatherstrip: > 431511 > Oct > 94 > Door Glass/Quarter Window Area - Waterleak >
Page 7282
Check and adjust door glass to quarter glass alignment if necessary. Refer to Sections 10-6 and
10-7 of the appropriate Service Manual.
Check and adjust convertible top alignment if necessary. Refer to Section 10-9 of the appropriate
Service Manual.
Condition
1. Permanent damage to weatherstrips at A-pillar, front rail, center rail and/or rear rail such as:
^ Hole in weatherstrip (refer to Figure 1).
^ Extensively deformed (refer to Figure 1).
^ Torn or badly distorted (refer to Figure 1).
2. Waterleak found between weatherstrip retainer and A-pillar, front rail, center rail or rear rail.
3. Waterleak found between A-pillar weatherstrip to folding top front seal assembly has two
potential conditions identified:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Weatherstrip: > 431511 > Oct > 94 > Door Glass/Quarter Window Area - Waterleak >
Page 7283
^ Gaping (refer to Figure 2).
^ Puckering (refer to Figure 2).
4. Waterleak found between front rail weatherstrip to center rail weatherstrip has two potential
conditions identified:
^ Gaping (Refer to Figure 3).
^ Puckering (Refer to Figure 3).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Weatherstrip: > 431511 > Oct > 94 > Door Glass/Quarter Window Area - Waterleak >
Page 7284
5. Waterleak found between center rail weatherstrip to rear rail weatherstrip has three potential
conditions identified:
^ Gaping (Refer to Figure 4).
^ Puckering (Refer to Figure 4).
^ Rolling (Refer to Figure 4).
Correction
Note:
When correction procedures are complete, apply a thin coat of petroleum jelly or silicone to sides of
center rail weatherstrip and rear rail weatherstrip
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Weatherstrip: > 431511 > Oct > 94 > Door Glass/Quarter Window Area - Waterleak >
Page 7285
to reduce weatherstrip rolling. Refer to Figure 5.
1. Damaged weatherstrips to be replaced. Refer to procedures in Section 10-9 of the appropriate
Service Manual.
2. Repair weatherstrip retainer. Refer to procedures in Section 10-9 of the appropriate Service
Manual.
3. To correct A-pillar weatherstrip to front rail weatherstrip gaping, use the following procedure:
1. Remove approximately 100 mm (4.0 inch) of weatherstrip from top of A-pillar retainer.
2. Using black weatherstrip adhesive, P/N 12345097, or equivalent, install weatherstrip into A-pillar
retainer while pulling weatherstrip upward until contacting front rail weatherstrip end. Refer to
Figure 6.
3A. To correct A-pillar weatherstrip to folding top front seal assembly puckering, use the following
procedure:
1. Lower convertible top about halfway.
2. Remove approximately 100 mm (4.0 inch) of weatherstrip from top of A-pillar retainer.
3. Remove approximately 100 mm (4.0 inch) of folding top front seal assembly from across No. 1
bow and down front side rail retainer.
4. Install stuffers (two each end) into the cut-away in back of weatherstrips. Refer to Figure 7. This
will push the weatherstrip surface back to its original shape.
5. Using black weatherstrip adhesive, P/N 12345097, or equivalent, install weatherstrip into A-pillar
retainer.
6. Using black weatherstrip adhesive, P/N 12345097, or equivalent, install folding top front seal
assembly.
7. Raise convertible top and lock.
4. To correct front rail weatherstrip to center rail weatherstrip gaping, use the following procedure:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Weatherstrip: > 431511 > Oct > 94 > Door Glass/Quarter Window Area - Waterleak >
Page 7286
1. Remove center rail weatherstrip retaining screw. Refer to Figure 8.
2. Remove front rail weatherstrip retaining screw. Refer to Figure 8.
3. Remove approximately 100 mm (4.0 inch) of weatherstrip from rear to center of front retainer.
4. Remove approximately 100 mm (4.0 inch) of weatherstrip from front to center of center retainer.
5. Using black weatherstrip adhesive, P/N 12345097, or equivalent, install front and center rail
weatherstrips into retainer, pulling ends together until contacting. Refer to Figure 8.
6. Install front and center rail weatherstrip retaining screws. Refer to Figure 8.
4A. To correct front rail weatherstrip to center rail weatherstrip puckering, use the following
procedure.
1. Lower convertible top about halfway.
2. Remove center rail weatherstrip retaining screw. Refer to Figure 8.
3. Remove front rail weatherstrip retaining screw. Refer to Figure 8.
4. Remove approximately 100 mm (4.0 inch) of weatherstrip from rear to center of front retainer.
5. Remove approximately 100 mm (4.0 inch) of weatherstrip from front to center of center retainer.
6. Install stuffers (two each end) into the cut-away in back of weatherstrips. Refer to Figure 7. This
will push the weatherstrip surface back to its original shape.
7. Raise convertible top and lock.
8. Using black weatherstrip adhesive, PIN 12345097, or equivalent, install front and center rail
weatherstrips into retainer, pulling ends together until contacting. Refer to Figure 8.
9. Install front and center rail weatherstrip retaining screws. Refer to Figure 8.
5. To correct center rail weatherstrip to rear rail weatherstrip gaping, use the following procedure:
1. Lower convertible top about halfway.
2. Lower quarter window.
3. Remove center rail weatherstrip retaining screw.
4. Remove approximately 1OO mm (4.0 inch) of weatherstrip from front to center of retainer.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Weatherstrip: > 431511 > Oct > 94 > Door Glass/Quarter Window Area - Waterleak >
Page 7287
5. Relocate center rail weatherstrip retaining screw hole forward 4 - 5 mm (0.156 - 0.203 inch).
Refer to Figure 9.
6. Using black weatherstrip adhesive, P/N 12345097, or equivalent, install center rail weatherstrip
forward in retainer.
7. Install center rail weatherstrip retaining screw into new hole. Refer to Figure 9.
8. Perform watertest. If waterleak is still existing, proceed to step 9.
9. Remove center portion of center rail weatherstrip, approximately 25 mm (1.0 inch) from retainer
ends. Refer to Figure 10.
10. Apply black weatherstrip adhesive, P/N 12345097, or equivalent, in retainer.
11. Install center rail weatherstrip into retainer while pushing weatherstrip rearward. Refer to Figure
10.
5A. To correct center rail weatherstrip to rear rail weatherstrip puckering, use the following
procedure:
1. Lower convertible top about halfway.
2. Lower quarter window.
3. Remove center rail weatherstrip approximately 100 mm (4.0 inch) from the rear joint end by
disconnecting clip.
4. Install stuffers (two) into the cut-away in back of center rail weatherstrip. Refer to Figure 7. This
will push the weatherstrip surface back to its original shape.
5. Apply black weatherstrip adhesive, P/N 12345097, or equivalent, in retainer.
6. Install center rail weatherstrip into retainer.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Weatherstrip: > 431511 > Oct > 94 > Door Glass/Quarter Window Area - Waterleak >
Page 7288
5B. To correct center rail weatherstrip to rear rail weatherstrip rolling, use the following procedure:
1. Lower convertible top about halfway.
2. Lower quarter window.
3. Remove center rail weatherstrip retaining screw. Refer to Figure 11.
4. Remove approximately 100 mm (4.0 inch) of weatherstrip from front to center of retainer.
5. Apply black weatherstrip adhesive, P/N 12345097, or equivalent, in retainer.
6. Install center rail weatherstrip into retainer while pushing weatherstrip rearward 3 - 4 mm (0.118 0.157 inch). Refer to Figure 11.
7. Install center rail weatherstrip retaining screw.
8. Perform watertest. If waterleak is still existing, proceed to step 9.
9. Remove center portion of center rail weatherstrip approximately 25 mm (1.0 inch) from retainer
ends. Refer to Figure 10.
10. Apply black weatherstrip adhesive, P/N 12345097, or equivalent, in retainer.
11. Install center rail weatherstrip into retainer while pushing weatherstrip rearward. Refer to Figure
10.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use: Seal, center to rear rail Labor Operation Labor Time
B3110 (Right) 0.3 hr.
B3111 (Left) 0.3 hr.
Seal, side rail weatherstrip
Labor Operation Labor Time
B3140 (Right) 0.3 hr.
B3141 (Left) 0.3 hr.
Seal, rear rail (rear roof rail weatherstrip) Labor Operation Labor Time
B3150 (Right) 0.3 hr.
B3151 (Left) 0.3 hr.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Weatherstrip: > 431020 > Apr > 94 > Squeak Between Door Header and Auxiliary
Weatherstrip
Weatherstrip: All Technical Service Bulletins Squeak Between Door Header and Auxiliary
Weatherstrip
Group Ref.: Body
Bulletin No.: 431020
Date: April, 1994
SUBJECT: SQUEAK BETWEEN DOOR HEADER AND AUXILIARY WEATHERSTRIP (APPLY
SQUEAK REDUCTION TAPE)
MODELS: 1993-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER 1993-94 PONTIAC SUNBIRD
Condition:
Some owners may comment on a squeak between the door header and auxiliary weatherstrip.
Cause:
Squeak is caused by contact between the door header and auxiliary weatherstrip.
Correction:
1. Clean door header at auxiliary weatherstrip location.
2. Inspect door header for rub marks or indication of contact with auxiliary weatherstrip.
3. Apply 3M 5430 Squeak Reduction Tape or equivalent to auxiliary weatherstrip at point of
contact.
Warranty Information:
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation: T3463
Labor Time: 0.3 hrs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Weatherstrip: > 99-08-64-016C > Jul > 09 > Body - Maintaining Exterior Weatherstrip
Appearance
Weatherstrip: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Maintaining Exterior Weatherstrip Appearance
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 99-08-64-016C
Date: July 29, 2009
Subject: Information on Maintaining Exterior Weatherstrip Appearance
Models:
2010 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3
2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and update the parts and procedure
information. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 99-08-64-016B (Section 08 - Body and
Accessories).
Exterior weatherstrips are exposed to a variety of environmental elements, including UV rays, acid
rain, insect and bird residue and atmospheric fallout. All of these may effect the appearance of the
weatherstrips; however, they do not effect the functionality of the weatherstrip.
Weatherstrips that are discolored should not be replaced under the normal GM New Vehicle
Warranty.
Weatherstrip Maintenance Instructions
Silicone grease on weatherstrips will make them last longer, seal better, and not stick or squeak.
Clean the weatherstrips with a mild soap and water solution. Apply silicone grease with a clean
cloth. During very cold, damp weather, frequent application may be required. Refer to the
information below for the recommended maintenance products. Weatherstrips that are not
maintained may crack and weather due to environmental elements.
Parts Information
Weatherstrip Conditioning Weatherstrip Lubricant (GM P/N 3634770 [in Canada, P/N 10953518])
or Dielectric Silicone Grease (GM P/N 12345579 [in Canada, P/N 992887]).
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Body and Frame > Weatherstrip > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Weatherstrip: > 431020 > Apr > 94 > Squeak Between Door Header and Auxiliary
Weatherstrip
Weatherstrip: All Technical Service Bulletins Squeak Between Door Header and Auxiliary
Weatherstrip
Group Ref.: Body
Bulletin No.: 431020
Date: April, 1994
SUBJECT: SQUEAK BETWEEN DOOR HEADER AND AUXILIARY WEATHERSTRIP (APPLY
SQUEAK REDUCTION TAPE)
MODELS: 1993-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER 1993-94 PONTIAC SUNBIRD
Condition:
Some owners may comment on a squeak between the door header and auxiliary weatherstrip.
Cause:
Squeak is caused by contact between the door header and auxiliary weatherstrip.
Correction:
1. Clean door header at auxiliary weatherstrip location.
2. Inspect door header for rub marks or indication of contact with auxiliary weatherstrip.
3. Apply 3M 5430 Squeak Reduction Tape or equivalent to auxiliary weatherstrip at point of
contact.
Warranty Information:
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation: T3463
Labor Time: 0.3 hrs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Component Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 7307
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Connector Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Locations >
Page 7308
Harness Connector Faces: Brake Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Combination Cruise/Stop Light Switch
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Combination Cruise/Stop Light Switch
A separately mounted vacuum release valve is used with this combination switch. When the brake
pedal is depressed, the switch resets the cruise function to a non-cruise condition and illuminates
the brake lights. Two sets of electrical contacts are used in the switch: one to operate the stop
lights, and the other to operate the cruise release function.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Combination Cruise/Stop Light Switch > Page 7311
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Combination Vacuum Release
Valve/Converter Clutch Switch
The vacuum release valve provides an additional vent to atmosphere for the servo unit when the
brake pedal is held in the depressed position. The venting is spring actuated and occurs within the
free travel of the brake pedal arm.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 7312
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Testing and Inspection
1. Turn ignition switch to On position. 2. Connect test light to ground. 3. Probe brown wire at brake
switch connector. Lamp should illuminate. 4. Check switch adjustment, with probe still at brown
wire, depressing brake pedal 1/8-1/2 inch. Light should go out. 5. If lamp did not illuminate in step
3, probe wire in adjacent connector cavity. If lamp illuminates, adjust or replace switch as
necessary. If light does
not illuminate, check wiring to switch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) > Component Information > Description and
Operation > Page 7313
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Adjustments
The switch assembly and valve assembly cannot be adjusted until brake booster pushrod is
assembled to brake pedal assembly. Adjustment is as follows: 1. Depress brake pedal and switch
assembly and valve assembly into their proper retaining clips until fully seated. 2. On vehicles
equipped with ABS, release brake pedal and allow to come to rest. 3. On models less ABS, slowly
pull pedal back to its fully retracted position. The switch assembly and valve assembly will move
within their
retainers to their adjusted position.
4. The following brake pedal travel distances may be used to check for a properly adjusted cruise
control and stop lamp switch assembly and vacuum
release valve assembly. a. Cruise control switch contacts must open at 1/8- 1/2 inch pedal travel,
measured at centerline of brake pedal pad. Nominal actuation of stop
lamp contacts is 3/16 inch after cruise control contacts open.
b. Vacuum release valve assembly must open at 11/16-1 5/16 inches pedal travel, measured at
centerline of brake pedal pad.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise Control > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise Control > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 7318
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise Control > Component Information > Locations >
Page 7319
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
The clutch switch is used on vehicles equipped with manual transmission. When the clutch pedal is
depressed, the cruise function is disconnected and will remain so after the pedal is released.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise Control > Component Information > Locations >
Page 7320
Clutch Switch: Adjustments
1. Ensure clutch release switch is fully seated in retainer. 2. Pull clutch pedal pad upward.
CAUTION: Do not exert an upward force on the clutch pedal of more than 20 lbs., or damage to
clutch master cylinder retaining ring may result.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 7325
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7326
Cruise Control Module: Diagrams
Harness Connector Faces: Cruise Control Module (Description)
Harness Connector Faces: Cruise Control Module
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 7327
Cruise Control Module: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The module will interpret the position of the servo, the position of the control switches and the
output of the speed sensor. In response to these inputs, the module electrically signals the opening
or closing of the vent and vacuum solenoid valves in the servo.
The module is mounted on the dash support bracket at the right side of the steering column, but is
integral with the ECM on some models with certain engines.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo > Component Information > Locations > Component
Locations > Page 7332
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo > Component Information > Locations > Page 7333
Harness Connector Faces: Cruise Control Servo
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo > Component Information > Locations > Page 7334
Cruise Control Servo: Description and Operation
Fig. 1 Servo Unit.
DESCRIPTION
The servo unit, Fig. 1, operates the throttle in response to signals from the electronic controller.
OPERATION
During a steady speed cruise condition, both vacuum and vent valves are closed or sealed. The
servo holds a constant vacuum on the diaphragm and places no flow requirements on the vacuum
source.
During vehicle deceleration, the vacuum solenoid is energized by the controller to open vacuum
valve to vacuum source. Throttle angle is increased by increased vacuum level in the servo, and
the vent remains closed.
During vehicle acceleration, the vent solenoid is de-energized by the controller to open the vent
valve to atmosphere. This reduces vacuum in the servo and allows throttle return spring to
decrease throttle angle while the vacuum valve remains closed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo > Component Information > Locations > Page 7335
Cruise Control Servo: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect servo assembly electrical connector. 2. Disconnect vacuum hoses. 3. Disconnect
actuating chain, cable or rod from servo assembly. 4. Remove servo assembly and servo unit
solenoid valve assembly to mounting bracket attaching screws, then remove servo assembly. 5.
Reverse procedure to install. Torque servo assembly to bracket attaching screws to 14-18 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo Cable > Component Information > Adjustments >
Control Cable
Cruise Control Servo Cable: Adjustments Control Cable
1. Ensure cable assembly in cable and servo bracket. 2. Pull servo assembly cable and toward
servo without moving throttle body lever. 3. If one of the holes in the servo tab aligns with cable pin,
connect pin to tab with retainer. 4. If tab hole does not align with pin, move cable from servo
assembly until next closest tab hole lines up, then connect pin to tab with retainer. Do
not stretch cable to make adjustment, as the engine will not be able to return to idle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Servo Cable > Component Information > Adjustments >
Control Cable > Page 7340
Cruise Control Servo Cable: Adjustments Servo Rod
1. Ensure engine high idle speed is properly adjusted, turn off engine, the set carburetor choke to
hot idle position. 2. Remove servo rod retainer, then adjust rod and install retainer in hole which
provides some clearance between retainer and servo bushing.
Clearance must not exceed width of one hole.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair
Refer to multi-function switch replacement procedures.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7349
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7350
Cruise Control Module: Diagrams
Harness Connector Faces: Cruise Control Module (Description)
Harness Connector Faces: Cruise Control Module
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Relays and Modules - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Module >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7351
Cruise Control Module: Description and Operation
OPERATION
The module will interpret the position of the servo, the position of the control switches and the
output of the speed sensor. In response to these inputs, the module electrically signals the opening
or closing of the vent and vacuum solenoid valves in the servo.
The module is mounted on the dash support bracket at the right side of the steering column, but is
integral with the ECM on some models with certain engines.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Component Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7357
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Connector Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7358
Harness Connector Faces: Brake Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Combination Cruise/Stop Light Switch
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Combination Cruise/Stop Light Switch
A separately mounted vacuum release valve is used with this combination switch. When the brake
pedal is depressed, the switch resets the cruise function to a non-cruise condition and illuminates
the brake lights. Two sets of electrical contacts are used in the switch: one to operate the stop
lights, and the other to operate the cruise release function.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Combination Cruise/Stop Light Switch > Page 7361
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Description and Operation Combination Vacuum Release
Valve/Converter Clutch Switch
The vacuum release valve provides an additional vent to atmosphere for the servo unit when the
brake pedal is held in the depressed position. The venting is spring actuated and occurs within the
free travel of the brake pedal arm.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 7362
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Testing and Inspection
1. Turn ignition switch to On position. 2. Connect test light to ground. 3. Probe brown wire at brake
switch connector. Lamp should illuminate. 4. Check switch adjustment, with probe still at brown
wire, depressing brake pedal 1/8-1/2 inch. Light should go out. 5. If lamp did not illuminate in step
3, probe wire in adjacent connector cavity. If lamp illuminates, adjust or replace switch as
necessary. If light does
not illuminate, check wiring to switch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Brake Switch (Cruise Control) >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 7363
Brake Switch (Cruise Control): Adjustments
The switch assembly and valve assembly cannot be adjusted until brake booster pushrod is
assembled to brake pedal assembly. Adjustment is as follows: 1. Depress brake pedal and switch
assembly and valve assembly into their proper retaining clips until fully seated. 2. On vehicles
equipped with ABS, release brake pedal and allow to come to rest. 3. On models less ABS, slowly
pull pedal back to its fully retracted position. The switch assembly and valve assembly will move
within their
retainers to their adjusted position.
4. The following brake pedal travel distances may be used to check for a properly adjusted cruise
control and stop lamp switch assembly and vacuum
release valve assembly. a. Cruise control switch contacts must open at 1/8- 1/2 inch pedal travel,
measured at centerline of brake pedal pad. Nominal actuation of stop
lamp contacts is 3/16 inch after cruise control contacts open.
b. Vacuum release valve assembly must open at 11/16-1 5/16 inches pedal travel, measured at
centerline of brake pedal pad.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise Control >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise Control >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7368
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise Control >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7369
Clutch Switch: Description and Operation
The clutch switch is used on vehicles equipped with manual transmission. When the clutch pedal is
depressed, the cruise function is disconnected and will remain so after the pedal is released.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Clutch Switch, Cruise Control >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7370
Clutch Switch: Adjustments
1. Ensure clutch release switch is fully seated in retainer. 2. Pull clutch pedal pad upward.
CAUTION: Do not exert an upward force on the clutch pedal of more than 20 lbs., or damage to
clutch master cylinder retaining ring may result.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair
Refer to multi-function switch replacement procedures.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Description and Operation
Vehicle Speed Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
On models with conventional instrument panels, a speedometer frame mounted optic head is used
to pick up light reflected by a speedometer cable mounted blade. The reflected light is produced by
a light emitting diode (LED). As the speedometer cable mounted blade enters the LED light beam,
the light is reflected into the optic head. From there, the light enters a photocell in the optic head
and produces a low power speed signal. This signal is sent to a buffer for amplification and
conditioning, then to the controller.
On models with electronic speedometers or electronic instrumentation, a transmission mounted
speed sensor is used. This sensor utilizes a permanent magnet (PM) to generate vehicle speed
information to the controller. Some models use a buffer amplifier to modify the sensor output.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Vacuum Vent Valve, Cruise Control > Component Information > Locations
> Brake Cruise Vacuum Release Valve
Vacuum Vent Valve: Locations Brake Cruise Vacuum Release Valve
Brake Cruise Release Valve is located Behind I/P, on Brake Pedal Support
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Vacuum Vent Valve, Cruise Control > Component Information > Locations
> Brake Cruise Vacuum Release Valve > Page 7381
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Vacuum Vent Valve, Cruise Control > Component Information > Locations
> Brake Cruise Vacuum Release Valve > Page 7382
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Vacuum Vent Valve, Cruise Control > Component Information > Locations
> Page 7383
Vacuum Vent Valve: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The vacuum release valve provides an additional vent to atmosphere for the servo unit when the
brake pedal is held in the depressed position. The venting is spring actuated and occurs within the
free travel of the brake pedal arm.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Vacuum Vent Valve, Cruise Control > Component Information > Locations
> Page 7384
Vacuum Vent Valve: Adjustments
The switch assembly and valve assembly cannot be adjusted until brake booster pushrod is
assembled to brake pedal assembly. Adjustment is as follows: 1. Depress brake pedal and switch
assembly and valve assembly into their proper retaining clips until fully seated. 2. On vehicles
equipped with ABS, release brake pedal and allow to come to rest. 3. On models less ABS, slowly
pull pedal back to its fully retracted position. The switch assembly and valve assembly will move
within their
retainers to their adjusted position.
4. The following brake pedal travel distances may be used to check for a properly adjusted cruise
control and stop lamp switch assembly and vacuum
release valve assembly. a. Cruise control switch contacts must open at 1/8- 1/2 inch pedal travel,
measured at centerline of brake pedal pad. Nominal actuation of stop
lamp contacts is 3/16 inch after cruise control contacts open.
b. Vacuum release valve assembly must open at 11/16-1 5/16 inches pedal travel, measured at
centerline of brake pedal pad.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Vehicle Speed Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
On models with conventional instrument panels, a speedometer frame mounted optic head is used
to pick up light reflected by a speedometer cable mounted blade. The reflected light is produced by
a light emitting diode (LED). As the speedometer cable mounted blade enters the LED light beam,
the light is reflected into the optic head. From there, the light enters a photocell in the optic head
and produces a low power speed signal. This signal is sent to a buffer for amplification and
conditioning, then to the controller.
On models with electronic speedometers or electronic instrumentation, a transmission mounted
speed sensor is used. This sensor utilizes a permanent magnet (PM) to generate vehicle speed
information to the controller. Some models use a buffer amplifier to modify the sensor output.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > ABS Light > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for ABS Light: > 415012 > Oct > 94 > ABS Warning Lamp ON, DTC's 46
and 86 Set
ABS Light: Customer Interest ABS Warning Lamp ON, DTC's 46 and 86 Set
File In Section: 5 - Brakes Bulletin No.: 41-50-12 Date: October, 1994
Subject: Antilock Brake System (ABS)/Brake Warning Indicator Lamp On (Reprogram EBCM)
Models: 1993
Buick Skylark
1993 Chevrolet Beretta, Corsica
1993-1994 Chevrolet Cavalier
1993 Oldsmobile Achieva
1993 Pontiac Grand Am
1993-1994 Pontiac Sunbird
Condition
Some owners may experience an Antilock Brake System (ABS) indicator lamp or brake warning
lamp coming on prematurely. This may result in the combination of ABS diagnostic trouble codes
46 and 86 being set.
Correction
Reprogram EBCM using TECH 1 and cartridge.
The Service Technology Group has released a reprogramming procedure for servicing the
above-mentioned vehicles with the combination of ABS brake diagnostic trouble codes 46 and 86.
This procedure is available in the mass storage cartridge through a CD ROM software release. The
following criteria must be met before reprogramming the EBCM:
The combination of DTC 46 and 86 must be present in EBCM memory.
Only vehicles with verified DTC 46 and 86 can be reprogrammed.
Prior to reprogramming, if any diagnostic trouble codes other than 46 and 86 are present, proceed
to the vehicle's service manual, SECTION 5E1, for diagnosis of these codes first.
The information required to reprogram the EBCM properly will first be available in the September
1994 CD ROM release. After updating the TECH 1 cartridge and connecting the TECH 1 to the
vehicle, select "ABS VI REPRGM" from the Applications menu. The TECH 1 should display the
following...
The reprogramming process is started by pressing the "ENTER" key. The ignition key must be in
the "run" position (engine off) and the vehicle stopped for the reprogramming to take place. The
user is informed by the following screen that the test is in progress.
If the vehicle has previously been reprogrammed, it cannot be reprogrammed again, and the
following screens will be displayed on the TECH 1.
Press the "EXIT" key to continue if the above screen is displayed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > ABS Light > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for ABS Light: > 415012 > Oct > 94 > ABS Warning Lamp ON, DTC's 46
and 86 Set > Page 7397
If the reprogramming is successful, the operator may hear the motors rehome and will see the
following screens displayed on the TECH 1:
Press the "EXIT" key to complete the reprogramming process. If any other problems are
encountered during reprogramming, the TECH 1 cartridge will notify the user appropriately.
After reprogramming, clear codes using the 1988-1995 Chassis selection of the Tech 1 Mass
Storage Cartridge.
WITH FOOT OFF BRAKE PEDAL, start the engine twice and allow it to run for at least 10 seconds
each time. If any codes return (including 46 and 86), proceed to the vehicle's service manual,
SECTION 5E1, for further diagnosis.
If there are any questions regarding the usage of this reprogramming procedure or diagnosis of the
ABS Vi brake system, please contact Delco Chassis Technical Assistance at 1-800-523-0203.
Warranty Information For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Labor Time
H 2504 0.2 Hours
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > ABS Light > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for ABS Light: > 415012 > Oct > 94 > ABS Warning Lamp ON,
DTC's 46 and 86 Set
ABS Light: All Technical Service Bulletins ABS Warning Lamp ON, DTC's 46 and 86 Set
File In Section: 5 - Brakes Bulletin No.: 41-50-12 Date: October, 1994
Subject: Antilock Brake System (ABS)/Brake Warning Indicator Lamp On (Reprogram EBCM)
Models: 1993
Buick Skylark
1993 Chevrolet Beretta, Corsica
1993-1994 Chevrolet Cavalier
1993 Oldsmobile Achieva
1993 Pontiac Grand Am
1993-1994 Pontiac Sunbird
Condition
Some owners may experience an Antilock Brake System (ABS) indicator lamp or brake warning
lamp coming on prematurely. This may result in the combination of ABS diagnostic trouble codes
46 and 86 being set.
Correction
Reprogram EBCM using TECH 1 and cartridge.
The Service Technology Group has released a reprogramming procedure for servicing the
above-mentioned vehicles with the combination of ABS brake diagnostic trouble codes 46 and 86.
This procedure is available in the mass storage cartridge through a CD ROM software release. The
following criteria must be met before reprogramming the EBCM:
The combination of DTC 46 and 86 must be present in EBCM memory.
Only vehicles with verified DTC 46 and 86 can be reprogrammed.
Prior to reprogramming, if any diagnostic trouble codes other than 46 and 86 are present, proceed
to the vehicle's service manual, SECTION 5E1, for diagnosis of these codes first.
The information required to reprogram the EBCM properly will first be available in the September
1994 CD ROM release. After updating the TECH 1 cartridge and connecting the TECH 1 to the
vehicle, select "ABS VI REPRGM" from the Applications menu. The TECH 1 should display the
following...
The reprogramming process is started by pressing the "ENTER" key. The ignition key must be in
the "run" position (engine off) and the vehicle stopped for the reprogramming to take place. The
user is informed by the following screen that the test is in progress.
If the vehicle has previously been reprogrammed, it cannot be reprogrammed again, and the
following screens will be displayed on the TECH 1.
Press the "EXIT" key to continue if the above screen is displayed.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > ABS Light > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for ABS Light: > 415012 > Oct > 94 > ABS Warning Lamp ON,
DTC's 46 and 86 Set > Page 7403
If the reprogramming is successful, the operator may hear the motors rehome and will see the
following screens displayed on the TECH 1:
Press the "EXIT" key to complete the reprogramming process. If any other problems are
encountered during reprogramming, the TECH 1 cartridge will notify the user appropriately.
After reprogramming, clear codes using the 1988-1995 Chassis selection of the Tech 1 Mass
Storage Cartridge.
WITH FOOT OFF BRAKE PEDAL, start the engine twice and allow it to run for at least 10 seconds
each time. If any codes return (including 46 and 86), proceed to the vehicle's service manual,
SECTION 5E1, for further diagnosis.
If there are any questions regarding the usage of this reprogramming procedure or diagnosis of the
ABS Vi brake system, please contact Delco Chassis Technical Assistance at 1-800-523-0203.
Warranty Information For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Labor Operation Labor Time
H 2504 0.2 Hours
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > ABS Light > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Anti-Lock Warning Lamp
ABS Light: Description and Operation Anti-Lock Warning Lamp
DESCRIPTION
This lamp will be illuminated when the ignition switch is placed in the ON position. The lamp may
be illuminated for as long as 30 seconds as a bulb and system check. If lamp remains illuminated
or comes on while operating the vehicle, a problem in the anti-lock brake system is indicated.
OPERATION
When lamp is illuminated, place ignition switch in OFF position, then restart engine. If lamp still
remains illuminated, the antilock brake system should be serviced. The brake system will remain
functional, but without the anti-lock function. After servicing the anti-lock brake system the lamp will
automatically reset.
NOTE: On some models it may be necessary to operate vehicle at a speed over 18 mph to reset
lamp.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > ABS Light > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Anti-Lock Warning Lamp > Page 7406
ABS Light: Description and Operation Anti-Lock Warning Lamp (Amber)
DESCRIPTION
The ABS warning light operates on a signal it receives from the EBCM/EBTCM. If the
EBCM/EBTCM detects a fault that does not interfere immediately with ABS operation, the ABS
warning lamp will flash. However, ABS operation will continue. If the EBCM/EBTCM detects a fault
that does interfere with ABS operation, the ABS warning lamp will stay lit and ABS operation will be
suspended until the fault is repaired. In any case, the warning lamp is indicating that the system be
serviced as soon as possible.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > ABS Light > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Anti-Lock Warning Lamp > Page 7407
ABS Light: Description and Operation Anti-Lock Warning Lamp (Red)
DESCRIPTION
This warning lamp can be activated by a low brake fluid condition, a closed parking brake switch, a
bulb test switch section of the ignition switch is closed or under the control of the EBCM/EBTCM
when certain ABS diagnostic trouble codes are set.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Ammeter Gauge > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Ammeter Gauge: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The CS generator uses a new type of regulator which has a built in fault detection. The CS
generator does not have a diode trio or test hole. This generator uses only two connections, battery
positive and an "L" terminal to the charge indicator bulb. Use of " P", "F" and "S" terminals is
optional. The "P" terminal is connected to the stator and may be connected to a tachometer or
other device. The "F" terminal is connected internally to field positive and is used in service
diagnostics. The "S" terminal may be connected externally to a voltage source, such as battery
voltage.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Ammeter Gauge > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 7411
Ammeter Gauge: Testing and Inspection
If charge indicator light works abnormally, perform the following test procedure:
1. Visually check belt and wiring. 2. With engine control switch ON and engine stopped, charge
indicator lamp should be on. If lamp is not on, detach wiring harness at generator and
ground "L" terminal. If lamp lights, generator is faulty. If lamp does not light, locate open circuit
between grounding lead and ignition switch and check for a faulty bulb.
3. With engine control switch ON and engine running at a moderate speed, charge indicator lamp
should be off. If lamp is not off, detach wiring
harness at generator. If lamp goes off, generator is faulty. If lamp stays on, check for grounded "L"
terminal in wire harness.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Audible Warning Device: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7416
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7417
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7418
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7419
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7420
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7421
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7422
Audible Warning Device: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7423
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7424
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7425
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7426
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7427
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7428
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7429
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7430
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7431
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7432
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7433
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7434
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7435
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7436
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7437
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7438
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7439
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7440
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7441
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7442
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7443
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7444
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7445
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7446
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7447
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7448
Audible Warning Device: Electrical Diagrams
Audible Warning: Chime (Lights-On/Ignition/Fasten Belts) (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7449
Audible Warning: Chime (Lights-On/Ignition/Fasten Belts) (Part 2 Of 2)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 7450
Audible Warning Device: Description and Operation
The Audible Warnings System sounds a chime to bring attention to one or more of several
conditions. These conditions are: 1) the Headlight Switch is in "HEAD" or "PARK" and the Ignition
Switch is not in "RUN," "BULB TEST" or "START"; 2) the key is in the Ignition Switch and the LH
front door is open; 3) the driver's seat belt is unbuckled when the Ignition Switch is turned to
"RUN," "BULB TEST" or "START."
Key-In-Ignition Chime Voltage is applied at all times to term "A" of the Multi-function Alarm Module
through the CTSY Fuse. When the key is in the ignition and LH front door is open, term "J" of the
Multi-function Alarm Module is grounded. This sounds the chime.
Fasten Belts Chime With the Ignition Switch in "RUN," "BULB TEST" or "START" voltage is applied
through the GAGES Fuse to term "G" of the Multi-function Alarm Module. With the LH front seat
belt unbuckled, term "D" of the Multi-function Alarm Module is grounded through the Seat Belt
Switch. The fasten belts chime sounds for 4 to 8 seconds. The Fasten Belts Indicator operates for
60 to 90 seconds.
Lights-On Chime When the Headlight Switch is in "HEAD" or "PARK," voltage is applied through
the Lamp Dimmer Module to term "E" of the Multi-function Alarm Module. When the Ignition Switch
is in "RUN," "BULB TEST" or "START" voltage is applied through the GAGES Fuse to term "G" of
the Multi-function Alarm Module. If these two voltages are sensed, the chime will not be sounded.
When the Ignition Switch is turned to "LOCK," "OFF" or "ACCY," the GAGES Fuse loses voltage.
The Multi-function Alarm Module senses the change. If voltage is available from the Headlight
Switch, voltage from the CTSY Fuse is applied to sound the chime.
Fasten Belts Indicator The Fasten Belts Indicator is also controlled by the Multi-function Alarm
Module. The indicator will light: ^
For 60 to 90 seconds after the ignition is turned on if the doors are closed.
^ Any time the doors are open and the Ignition Switch is in "RUN," "BULB TEST" or "START"
^ If there is a fault in the Seat Belt Retractor Solenoid's circuit.
Additional Features The Multi-function Alarm Module also controls the Seat Belt Retractor
Solenoids, Illuminated Entry and Automatic Door Locks features. Refer to Lighting and Horns, See:
Lighting and Horns Body and Frame See: Body and Frame & Air Bags and Seat Belts for further
information. See: Restraint Systems
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures
Audible Warning Device: Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures
System Check
System Diagnosis - Chime
Perform the System Check and refer to the Symptom Table for the appropriate diagnostic
procedures. See: System Check - Chime See: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/Symptom
Table - Chime
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures > Page 7453
Audible Warning Device: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Chart #1 All Warning Chimes Inoperative
Chart #2 Key-In-Ignition Warning Does Not Operate Properly (Part 1 Of 2)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures > Page 7454
Chart #2 Key-In-Ignition Warning Does Not Operate Properly (Part 2 Of 2)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures > Page 7455
Chart #3 Fasten Belt Indicator Is ON Continuously
Chart #4 Fasten Belt Indicator Is ON Continuously
Chart #5 Fasten Belt Indicator Does Not Light
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures > Page 7456
Chart #6 Fasten Belt Indicator Does Not Light And Fasten Belt Chime Does Not Sound (Part 1 Of
2)
Chart #6 Fasten Belt Indicator Does Not Light And Fasten Belt Chime Does Not Sound (Part 2 Of
2)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures > Page 7457
Symptom Table
Troubleshooting Hints - Chime
PERFORM BEFORE BEGINNING SYSTEM DIAGNOSIS
1. If Speedometer does not operate properly, refer to Powertrain Management for Vehicle Speed
Sensor diagnosis. See: Powertrain Management 2. Check CTSY Fuse by operating Courtesy
Lights. 3. Check GAGES Fuse by observing the Instrument Cluster. 4. Check Headlight Switch by
operating Park Lights. 5. Check that ground G200 is clean and tight. 6. Check that Multi-function
Alarm Module is seated properly.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures > Page 7458
Audible Warning Device: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
The Audible Warnings System sounds a chime to bring attention to one or more of several
conditions. These conditions are: 1) the Headlight Switch is in "HEAD" or "PARK" and the Ignition
Switch is not in "RUN," "BULB TEST" or "START"; 2) the key is in the Ignition Switch and the LH
front door is open; 3) the driver's seat belt is unbuckled when the Ignition Switch is turned to
"RUN," "BULB TEST" or "START."
Key-In-Ignition Chime Voltage is applied at all times to term "A" of the Multi-function Alarm Module
through the CTSY Fuse. When the key is in the ignition and LH front door is open, term "J" of the
Multi-function Alarm Module is grounded. This sounds the chime.
Fasten Belts Chime With the Ignition Switch in "RUN," "BULB TEST" or "START" voltage is applied
through the GAGES Fuse to term "G" of the Multi-function Alarm Module. With the LH front seat
belt unbuckled, term "D" of the Multi-function Alarm Module is grounded through the Seat Belt
Switch. The fasten belts chime sounds for 4 to 8 seconds. The Fasten Belts Indicator operates for
60 to 90 seconds.
Lights-On Chime When the Headlight Switch is in "HEAD" or "PARK," voltage is applied through
the Lamp Dimmer Module to term "E" of the Multi-function Alarm Module. When the Ignition Switch
is in "RUN," "BULB TEST" or "START" voltage is applied through the GAGES Fuse to term "G" of
the Multi-function Alarm Module. If these two voltages are sensed, the chime will not be sounded.
When the Ignition Switch is turned to "LOCK," "OFF" or "ACCY," the GAGES Fuse loses voltage.
The Multi-function Alarm Module senses the change. If voltage is available from the Headlight
Switch, voltage from the CTSY Fuse is applied to sound the chime.
Fasten Belts Indicator The Fasten Belts Indicator is also controlled by the Multi-function Alarm
Module. The indicator will light: ^
For 60 to 90 seconds after the ignition is turned on if the doors are closed.
^ Any time the doors are open and the Ignition Switch is in "RUN," "BULB TEST" or "START"
^ If there is a fault in the Seat Belt Retractor Solenoid's circuit.
Additional Features The Multi-function Alarm Module also controls the Seat Belt Retractor
Solenoids, Illuminated Entry and Automatic Door Locks features. Refer to Lighting and Horns, See:
Lighting and Horns Body and Frame See: Body and Frame & Air Bags and Seat Belts for further
information. See: Restraint Systems
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Multi-Function Chime (MFC) Module
Audible Warning Device Control Module: Locations Multi-Function Chime (MFC) Module
Convenience Center
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Multi-Function Chime (MFC) Module > Page 7463
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Audible Warning Device Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Multi-Function Chime (MFC) Module > Page 7464
Convenience Center
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Brake Warning Indicator: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7469
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7470
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7471
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7472
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7473
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7474
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7475
Brake Warning Indicator: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7476
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7477
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7478
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7479
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7480
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7481
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7482
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7483
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7484
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7485
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7486
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7487
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7488
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7489
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7490
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7491
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7492
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7493
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7494
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7495
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7496
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7497
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7498
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7499
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7500
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7501
Brake Warning
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Brake Warning System
Brake Warning Indicator: Description and Operation Brake Warning System
DESCRIPTION
The "Brake" warning indicator will be illuminated when a low brake fluid level in the master cylinder
is sensed or when the Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM) lights it in response to certain
diagnostic trouble codes.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Brake Warning System > Page 7504
Brake Warning Indicator: Description and Operation Circuit Operation
Battery voltage is applied to the BRAKE Indicator when the Ignition Switch is in RUN, BULB TEST
or START. Three switches are connected in parallel to the BRAKE Indicator. When any one of
these switches closes, ground is provided and the indicator lights.
The Ignition Switch provides a ground when it is in the BULB TEST and START positions.
The Park Brake Switch provides a ground when the Park Brake is applied.
The Brake Fluid Level Switch closes to light the BRAKE Indicator when there is low brake fluid in
one of the two hydraulic brake systems. This could be caused by a leak in one of the brake lines.
The switch can be reset to an open position by refilling the reservoir, however this can only be
accomplished after the faulty system has been repaired.
The Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM) will cause the BRAKE Indicator to light only when the
Antilock Brake System degrades the base brake system.
In cars with Daytime Running Lights, the Daytime Running Lights remain off if the BRAKE Indicator
is lit.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Brake Warning System > Page 7505
Brake Warning Indicator: Description and Operation Brake Pressure Warning Lamp
DESCRIPTION
The warning lamp should illuminate when the ignition switch is in the start position, and turn off
when the switch returns to run. If the brake lamp remains on after the ignition returns to run, check
fluid level in master cylinder reservoir and inspect parking brake. If the warning lamp does not turn
on during cranking, check for defective bulb or blown fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Brake Warning Indicator: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Circuit Operation
Battery voltage is applied to the BRAKE Indicator when the Ignition Switch is in RUN, BULB TEST
or START. Three switches are connected in parallel to the BRAKE Indicator. When any one of
these switches closes, ground is provided and the indicator lights.
The Ignition Switch provides a ground when it is in the BULB TEST and START positions.
The Park Brake Switch provides a ground when the Park Brake is applied.
The Brake Fluid Level Switch closes to light the BRAKE Indicator when there is low brake fluid in
one of the two hydraulic brake systems. This could be caused by a leak in one of the brake lines.
The switch can be reset to an open position by refilling the reservoir, however this can only be
accomplished after the faulty system has been repaired.
The Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM) will cause the BRAKE Indicator to light only when the
Antilock Brake System degrades the base brake system.
In cars with Daytime Running Lights, the Daytime Running Lights remain off if the BRAKE Indicator
is lit.
System Diagnosis
Refer to Symptom Table for listed symptoms and refer Diagnostic Tests for Diagnostic procedures.
See: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures/Symptom Table See: Symptom Related Diagnostic
Procedures/Diagnostic Tests
System Check
System Check Table
Refer to the System Diagnosis given if other results occur. See: System Diagnosis
Troubleshooting Hints
TRY THE FOLLOWING CHECKS BEFORE DOING THE SYSTEM CHECK
1. Check GAGES Fuse by operating the Rear Defogger and observing the Indicator with the
Ignition Switch in RUN and engine off. 2. Check ground G100 by operating the Blower Motor. 3. If
the BRAKE Indicator does not light for a particular condition, check the suspect switch for battery
voltage at the TAN/WHT (33) terminal and a
good ground circuit. If the TAN/WHT (33) wires are good to suspect switch, check 150 (BLK) wire
for an open (see schematic). If OK, replace suspect switch.
^ Go to System Check for a guide to normal operation. See: System Check
^ Go to System Diagnosis for diagnostic tests. See: System Diagnosis
^ Refer to Starting and Charging for Ignition Switch access information. See: Starting and Charging
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Brake Warning Indicator > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7508
Brake Warning Indicator: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Symptom Table
Symptom Table:
Chart A: BRAKE Indicator remains on with ignition switch in RUN and park brake off. See:
Diagnostic Tests
Diagnostic Tests
1. Put Ignition Switch in RUN. Disconnect the Park Brake Switch and Brake Fluid Level Switch and
observe BRAKE Indicator.
^ If BRAKE Indicator goes out when a switch is disconnected, replace suspect switch.
^ If BRAKE Indicator stays on and vehicle is equipped with Daytime Running Lights, go to step 2. If
vehicle is not equipped with Daytime Running Lights, go to step 3.
2. Disconnect Daytime Running Lights (DRL) Module and observe BRAKE Indicator with the
Ignition Switch in RUN.
^ If BRAKE Indicator goes out when module is disconnected, replace the module.
^ If BRAKE Indicator stays on, go to step 3.
3. Disconnect the Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM) connector C2.
^ If BRAKE Indicator goes out, refer to Brakes and Traction Control. See: Brakes and Traction
Control
^ If BRAKE Indicator stays on, go to step 4.
4. With the Ignition Switch in RUN and connector disconnected, check for continuity between the
Ignition Switch half of terminal D/C1 and F/C2.
^ If there is continuity, replace the Ignition Switch.
^ If there is no continuity, check for a short to ground in the 33 (TAN/WHT) wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Check Gauges Lamp > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Check Gauges Lamp: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The "Check Gage" warning lamp will illuminate to warn the driver to check the oil pressure gauge,
engine coolant temperature gauge and the voltmeter. When lit, the "Check Gage" lamp indicates
that one of these gauges is operating in an abnormal range.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Locations
Console
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Cigarette Lighter: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7517
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7518
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7519
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7520
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7521
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7522
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7523
Cigarette Lighter: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7524
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7525
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7526
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7527
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7528
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7529
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7530
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7531
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7532
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7533
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7534
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7535
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7536
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7537
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7538
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7539
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7540
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7541
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7542
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7543
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7544
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7545
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7546
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7547
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7548
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7549
Cigarette Lighter: Electrical Diagrams
Interior Lights: Cigar Lighter/I/P Compartment/Luggage Compartment/Cargo (All Except
Convertible)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7550
Interior Lights: Cigar Lighter/I/P Compartment/Luggage Compartment/Header/Quarter Courtesy
(Convertible)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7551
Interior Lights: Dome/Map (All Except Convertible)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7552
Interior Lights: Illuminated Entry
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Cigarette Lighter: Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview
Circuit Operation
Voltage is applied at all times through the CTSY Fuse to the Multi-function Alarm Module, and the
Interior Lights. Voltage is also applied in RUN, BULB TEST or START through the GAGES Fuse to
the Multi-function Alarm Module.
The Front Door Handle Switches turn on the Interior Lights through the Multi-function Alarm
Module. When either front door handle is raised or door is opened, its Front Door Handle Switch
closes to ground an input to the module. The module then grounds the Interior Lights to turn them
on.
The Dome Light Switch also turns on the Interior Lights, independent of the door switches or the
Multi- function Alarm Module.
An Interior Lights-on delay is provided by the Multi-function Alarm Module after a front door has
been opened. The lights remain on for about 40 seconds, or until the Ignition Switch is turned to
RUN. This 40 second delay is reduced to 4 seconds if a front door is opened within 2 minutes after
the Ignition Switch is moved from the RUN, START or BULB TEST position.
System Check
Troubleshooting Hints
PERFORM BEFORE BEGINNING SYSTEM DIAGNOSIS
1. The Multi-function Alarm Module controls Interior Lights and generates chime alarms (Refer to
Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning
Indicators). See: It also controls Automatic Door Locks (Refer to Body and Frame) See: Body and
Frameand Seat Belt Release Solenoids (Refer to Air Bags and Seat Belts). See: Restraint Systems
2. Verify that all chime alarms operate before proceeding with following diagnostic text. If any
chime alarms do not operate, Refer to Instrument
Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators. See:
3. If only one light does not operate, check bulb and related wiring. 4. Check that Multi-function
Alarm Module is properly seated. 5. If none of the Courtesy Lights opeate, check CTSY Fuse. 6. If
Interior Lights are intermittently inoperative, check that there are no Interior Lights left on,
especially the Luggage Compartment and I/P
Compartment Lights.
7. If Cigar Lighter is inoperative, check GIG LTR Fuse, CKT 840 and CKT 150 for an open. If OK,
replace Cigar Lighter. 8. Refer to Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators for
Multi-function Alarm Module access. See:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7555
Cigarette Lighter: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Chart #1 Interior Lights Do Not Operate When Front Door Opened
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Cigarette Lighter > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection > Initial Inspection and Diagnostic Overview > Page 7556
Chart #2 Interior Lights Do Not Turn OFF
Symptom Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Coolant Level Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Coolant Level Indicator Lamp: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
This lamp will be illuminated when engine coolant level in the radiator drops below a predetermined
level. To turn lamp off, check cooling system, then add coolant to bring system to proper level.
OPERATION
Some vehicles use a buzzer or indicator lamp to convey a low coolant level condition. The buzzer
or lamp is activated by a sensor, located in the radiator, when the coolant level becomes one quart
low, or more.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dash Board / Instrument Panel <-->
[Dashboard / Instrument Panel] > Component Information > Service and Repair
Dash Board / Instrument Panel: Service and Repair
Fig. 87 Steering Column Opening Filler Removal
Fig. 88 I/P Compartment Housing Removal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dash Board / Instrument Panel <-->
[Dashboard / Instrument Panel] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 7563
Fig. 89 Convenience Center Removal
Fig. 90 I/P Removal
1. Disconnect battery ground cable, then remove three screws from steering column opening filler,
Fig. 87, and pull downward to disengage clips and remove.
2. Remove left and right sound insulators.
3. Remove instrument panel compartment housing as follows: a. Open instrument panel
compartment door, Fig. 88, then remove screws attaching instrument panel housing to instrument
panel. b. Pull out housing enough to disconnect rear compartment lid release switch and remove
instrument panel compartment light and right courtesy
lamp.
c. Remove instrument panel compartment housing.
4. Remove console assembly, then the convenience center, Fig. 89.
5. Disconnect forward lamp and engine electrical harnesses from bulkhead connector.
6. Remove two corner instrument panel retaining screws, and one screw to instrument panel brace
at left side of instrument panel opening, Fig. 90.
7. Remove defroster grilles, then the upper retaining screws located in defroster duct openings.
8. Remove steering column as described in ``Steering Columns'' section.
9. Pull instrument panel assembly out enough to disconnect all electrical connectors and vacuum
lines.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dash Board / Instrument Panel <-->
[Dashboard / Instrument Panel] > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 7564
10. Remove instrument panel assembly with electrical harness attached.
11. If necessary, remove electrical harness assembly.
12. Reverse procedure to install.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dimmer Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > IP Dimmer Control - Proper Setting
Dimmer Switch: Technical Service Bulletins IP Dimmer Control - Proper Setting
File In Section: 08 - Body and Accessories
Bulletin No.: 99-08-42-009
Date: November, 1999
INFORMATION
Subject: Proper Setting of I/P Dimmer Control to View PRNDL Display with Automatic Headlamp
Control
Models: 2000 and Prior All Passenger Cars and Trucks With Automatic Headlamp Control and
Electronic PRNDL Display
Under certain conditions, if the instrument panel dimmer control is turned relatively low, the PRNDL
will not be visible until the automatic headlamp control turns the headlamps off and the daytime
running lamps (DRL) are turned back on. Such a condition may be if the vehicle is first started in an
environment where the headlamp control turns on the headlamps and then the vehicle is driven out
into a brighter environment (for example, when a vehicle is backed out of a dark garage into the
bright sunlight).
This condition is normal and any repair attempt will not be successful. Demonstrate this condition
to the customer using the service lane and then turn the instrument panel dimmer control to a
higher setting. This will enable the driver to see the PRNDL display
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dimmer Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7569
Dimmer Switch: Locations
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Panel Dimmer Switch is located at LH side of I/P near LH front Speaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dimmer Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7570
Harness Connector Faces: Panel Dimmer Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Dimmer Switch > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7571
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair
1. Remove steering wheel as outlined under Steering Wheel. Refer to Steering and
Suspension/Steering.
2. Remove turn signal switch as outlined under Turn Signal Switch. Refer to Turn Signals.
3. Remove windshield wiper switch as outlined under Windshield Wiper Switch. Refer to Wiper and
Washer System.
4. Remove ignition switch to ignition switch housing attaching screws.
5. Depress ignition switch locking tab, then disconnect switch electrical connectors.
6. Reverse procedure to install, noting the following: a. Ensure lock cylinder shaft aligns with slotted
opening on ignition switch. b. Torque ignition switch attaching screws to 21 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Door Switch > Component Information
> Locations
Center Of Console (Sedan Shown, Station Wagon Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Fuel Gauge System
Fuel Gauge: Description and Operation Fuel Gauge System
DESCRIPTION
The fuel gauge system consists of a sending unit, instrument voltage regulator and an electric fuel
gauge. The sending unit is a variable resistor that is controlled by a float. Corresponding to actual
fuel level, the float will rise or fall. When the ignition is turned to the On position, voltage is applied
to the gauge through the voltage regulator, completing the gauge ground circuit through the
sending unit.
OPERATION
When the tank is full and the float is raised, maximum resistance (approximately 90 ohms) is
produced by the sending unit, current flow through the gauge is decreased, and the gauge pointer
moves slightly. As the tank empties and the float drops resistance in the sending unit decreases,
current flow through the gauge increases and the gauge pointer moves toward empty.
Most analog fuel gauges are of the free floating type, which means that the gauge pointer does not
remain against the full stop when the ignition is off. Rather, the pointer floats to a mid-position when
no voltage is applied to the gauge.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Description and Operation > Fuel Gauge System > Page 7579
Fuel Gauge: Description and Operation Fuel Usage
DESCRIPTION
This system consists of green and amber indicator lights located on the fuel gauge or telltale lamp
cluster, a switch mounted on the instrument panel behind the gauges and an interconnecting
vacuum hose and tee.
OPERATION
The system operates on engine vacuum through a dual contact vacuum sensing switch. When the
accelerator is operated slowly and smoothly, engine vacuum remains high and the switch passes
current to the green indicator light which indicates economical fuel consumption. When the
accelerator pedal is depressed rapidly, vacuum decreases and the switch passes current to the
amber indicator light, which indicates high fuel consumption. The amber indicator light will glow
when the ignition switch is in the On position with the engine stopped.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Fuel Gauge: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
Fuel Gauge Inaccurate
Tester BT-6508 or equivalent must be used to diagnose dash gauge malfunction.
1. Ensure battery is fully charged, disconnect electrical connector to tank unit and connect tester to
between harness connector and suitable ground
following manufacturer's instructions.
2. Set tester on empty then turn on ignition. Gauge should read empty or below. 3. Set tester on
full. Gauge should read full or above. 4. If gauge does not respond to tester input, replace dash
gauge. If gauge responds correctly, check for poor connections at tank unit, poor tank unit
ground or defective tank unit.
Gauge Reads Empty When Tank Is Full
This condition is generally caused by a short in the fuel tank unit circuit.
1. Disconnect electrical connector to sending unit, then turn ignition switch to ON position. 2. If
gauge reads past full, test gauge with tester tool No. BT-6508, or equivalent. If gauge reads empty,
disconnect main body harness connector,
near the fuse block.
3. If gauge still shows empty, check for short in printed circuit or defective gauge. If gauge reads
beyond full, reconnect front body harness connector
and disconnect rear body harness connector (in left wheel house).
4. If gauge shows empty, locate and repair grounded wire in harness between front and rear body
harness connectors. If gauge reads beyond full,
check for short between rear body harness connector, damaged float or defective sending unit.
Gauge Reads Full or Beyond at All Times
This condition is generally caused by an open in the tank unit circuit.
1. Check tank unit ground for proper contact with body or chassis and repair as needed. 2. If tank
unit ground is satisfactory, disconnect electrical connector to tank unit and connect harness side of
connector to suitable ground with
jumper wire, then turn on ignition.
3. If gauge reads empty, remove fuel tank and inspect wiring to sending unit. If wiring and
connections are satisfactory, replace tank unit. 4. If gauge still shows full, disconnect front body
harness connector and ground fuel gauge wire terminal in instrument panel side of connector. 5. If
gauge still reads full, check for loose connection in cluster, open (crack) in printed circuit or
defective gauge. If gauge reads empty, locate and
repair open or poor connection between front body connector and tank unit connector.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge > Component Information
> Testing and Inspection > Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures > Page 7582
Fuel Gauge: Component Tests and General Diagnostics
1. With ignition switch in the on position, ground each terminal at the economy switch. Both green
and amber indicator lights should glow. If not
check for burned out bulbs.
2. With ignition switch in On position, amber indicator light should glow. If not, check for loose or
disconnected wires at fuel economy switch or for
poor ground. If amber indicator light still does not glow replace switch.
3. Start engine and allow to idle, the green indicator light should glow. If not, check for leaking,
plugged or kinked vacuum hose between vacuum
source and fuel economy switch. Check for loose or disconnected wires at economy switch or poor
ground. If green indicator lamp still does not glow, replace switch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair
Modular Fuel Sender To Tank
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 7586
Modular Fuel Sender Assembly
NOTE: Always replace fuel sender assembly O-ring when reinstalling fuel sender assembly.
Remove or Disconnect:
1. Negative battery cable.
2. Relieve system fuel pressure.
3. Drain fuel tank. Refer to "DRAINING FUEL TANK."
4. Fuel tank, Refer to "FUEL TANK REPLACEMENT."
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Page 7587
5. While holding, the modular fuel sender assembly down, remove the snap ring from designated
slots located on the retainer.
IMPORTANT:
^ The modular fuel sender assembly may spring up from its position.
^ When removing the modular fuel sender assembly from the fuel tank, be aware that that the
reservoir bucket is full of fuel. It must be tipped slightly during removal to avoid damage to the float.
Discard fuel sender O-ring and replace with a new one.
^ Carefully discard the reservoir fuel into an approved container.
INSTALL OR CONNECT:
1. New O-ring on modular fuel sender to tank.
2. Align tab on front of sender with slot on front of retainer snap ring.
3. Slowly apply pressure to top of spring loaded sender until sender aligns flush with retainer on
tank.
4. Insert snap ring into designated slots.
IMPORTANT:
^ Be sure that the snap ring is fully seated within the tab slots.
5. Fuel tank. Refer to "FUEL TANK REPLACEMENT"
6. Lower vehicle.
7. Refill tank.
INSPECT:
^ Turn ignition to "ON" position for two seconds, then to "OFF" for ten seconds. Again turn to "ON"
position, and check for fuel leak's.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier <-->
[Instrument Cluster / Carrier] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 99-08-49-006 >
Apr > 99 > Instrument Panel - Upper Surface Reflection
Instrument Cluster / Carrier: Customer Interest Instrument Panel - Upper Surface Reflection
File In Section: 08 - Body and Accessories
Bulletin No.: 99-08-49-006
Date: April, 1999
INFORMATION
Subject: Cleaning of Upper Instrument Panel Surfaces
Models: 1999 and Prior Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
Comments on a reflection of the upper instrument panel pad into the windshield, when driving in
direct sunlight, may be received. This condition, sometimes referred to as a "veiling reflection", may
be aggravated by the use of wax or silicone based products when cleaning the surface.
Advise customers, technicians and new car prep or make ready personnel, that products
containing wax or silicone should not be used to clean the top instrument panel pad. A warm water
and mild soap solution such as saddle soap, oil soap or an equivalent, should be used whenever
the top instrument panel pad needs cleaning.
If a customer requests that a protectant type product be applied, ONLY USE THOSE THAT LEAVE
A FLAT OR SATIN FINISH. Do NOT apply products that leave a glossy finish or those that
Increase the shine level above the original production level.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier <-->
[Instrument Cluster / Carrier] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Instrument Cluster / Carrier: > 99-08-42-009 > Nov > 99 > IP Dimmer Control - Proper Setting
Instrument Cluster / Carrier: All Technical Service Bulletins IP Dimmer Control - Proper Setting
File In Section: 08 - Body and Accessories
Bulletin No.: 99-08-42-009
Date: November, 1999
INFORMATION
Subject: Proper Setting of I/P Dimmer Control to View PRNDL Display with Automatic Headlamp
Control
Models: 2000 and Prior All Passenger Cars and Trucks With Automatic Headlamp Control and
Electronic PRNDL Display
Under certain conditions, if the instrument panel dimmer control is turned relatively low, the PRNDL
will not be visible until the automatic headlamp control turns the headlamps off and the daytime
running lamps (DRL) are turned back on. Such a condition may be if the vehicle is first started in an
environment where the headlamp control turns on the headlamps and then the vehicle is driven out
into a brighter environment (for example, when a vehicle is backed out of a dark garage into the
bright sunlight).
This condition is normal and any repair attempt will not be successful. Demonstrate this condition
to the customer using the service lane and then turn the instrument panel dimmer control to a
higher setting. This will enable the driver to see the PRNDL display
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier <-->
[Instrument Cluster / Carrier] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for
Instrument Cluster / Carrier: > 99-08-49-006 > Apr > 99 > Instrument Panel - Upper Surface Reflection
Instrument Cluster / Carrier: All Technical Service Bulletins Instrument Panel - Upper Surface
Reflection
File In Section: 08 - Body and Accessories
Bulletin No.: 99-08-49-006
Date: April, 1999
INFORMATION
Subject: Cleaning of Upper Instrument Panel Surfaces
Models: 1999 and Prior Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
Comments on a reflection of the upper instrument panel pad into the windshield, when driving in
direct sunlight, may be received. This condition, sometimes referred to as a "veiling reflection", may
be aggravated by the use of wax or silicone based products when cleaning the surface.
Advise customers, technicians and new car prep or make ready personnel, that products
containing wax or silicone should not be used to clean the top instrument panel pad. A warm water
and mild soap solution such as saddle soap, oil soap or an equivalent, should be used whenever
the top instrument panel pad needs cleaning.
If a customer requests that a protectant type product be applied, ONLY USE THOSE THAT LEAVE
A FLAT OR SATIN FINISH. Do NOT apply products that leave a glossy finish or those that
Increase the shine level above the original production level.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier <-->
[Instrument Cluster / Carrier] > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for
Instrument Cluster / Carrier: > 99-08-42-009 > Nov > 99 > IP Dimmer Control - Proper Setting
Instrument Cluster / Carrier: All Technical Service Bulletins IP Dimmer Control - Proper Setting
File In Section: 08 - Body and Accessories
Bulletin No.: 99-08-42-009
Date: November, 1999
INFORMATION
Subject: Proper Setting of I/P Dimmer Control to View PRNDL Display with Automatic Headlamp
Control
Models: 2000 and Prior All Passenger Cars and Trucks With Automatic Headlamp Control and
Electronic PRNDL Display
Under certain conditions, if the instrument panel dimmer control is turned relatively low, the PRNDL
will not be visible until the automatic headlamp control turns the headlamps off and the daytime
running lamps (DRL) are turned back on. Such a condition may be if the vehicle is first started in an
environment where the headlamp control turns on the headlamps and then the vehicle is driven out
into a brighter environment (for example, when a vehicle is backed out of a dark garage into the
bright sunlight).
This condition is normal and any repair attempt will not be successful. Demonstrate this condition
to the customer using the service lane and then turn the instrument panel dimmer control to a
higher setting. This will enable the driver to see the PRNDL display
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier <-->
[Instrument Cluster / Carrier] > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier <-->
[Instrument Cluster / Carrier] > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7612
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Instrument Cluster / Carrier <-->
[Instrument Cluster / Carrier] > Component Information > Locations > Page 7613
Instrument Cluster / Carrier: Service and Repair
Fig. 9 Instrument Cluster.
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove steering column opening filler attaching screws, then remove steering opening filler.
3. Pull down slightly on steering column cover to remove bottom cluster extension attaching
screws, then remove cluster extension.
4. Disconnect instrument panel dimmer and interior lamp control switches electrical connectors.
5. Remove instrument cluster top attaching screws, Fig. 9.
6. Pull instrument cluster rearward to remove.
7. Reverse procedure to install. Torque instrument cluster attaching bolts to 19 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Key Reminder Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Low Fuel Lamp/Indicator: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The switch type consists of an indicator light and a low fuel warning switch located on the
instrument panel.
OPERATION
The warning switch contacts are closed by the difference in voltage potential between the fuel
gauge terminals. This voltage differential will activate the warning switch when the fuel tank is less
than 1/4 full and, in turn, cause the indicator to light.
This system incorporates an indicator light. With ignition switch turned to On, the indicator should
light. If not, check bulb and all electrical connections. Replace warning switch if bulb and
connections prove satisfactory.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Malfunction Indicator Lamp >
Component Information > Service and Repair
Malfunction Indicator Lamp: Service and Repair
The check "engine lamp", "service engine soon" or "malfunction indiactor" lamp will be illuminated
when the ignition switch is placed in the "ON" position. When the engine is started, the lamp should
go "OFF." If the lamp remains "ON" for 10 seconds or constantly after the engine is started, the self
diagnosis system has detected a problem and has stored a code in the system Electronic Control
Module (ECM/PCM). After diagnosis and repair, the ECM/PCM memory can be cleared of codes
as follows:
Remove the ECM/PCM fuse or disconnect the battery ground cable for approximately 30 seconds,
with ignition switch in the "OFF" position. It should be noted, if battery ground cable is disconnected
to clear codes, components such as clocks, electronically tuned radios etc., will have to be reset.
On vehicles that are equipped as such, the ECM/PCM power feed is connected by a pigtail, in-line
fuse holder, at the positive battery terminal. To clear codes within the ECM/PCM system and
protect the components that need resetting, disconnect the in-line fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Odometer > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Odometer/Speedometer - ACDelco Service Center Locations
Odometer: Technical Service Bulletins Odometer/Speedometer - ACDelco Service Center
Locations
File In Section: 8 - Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 66-83-04A
Date: September, 1996
INFORMATION
Subject: AC Delco Service Center Locations for Odometer/Speedometer Service
Models: 1997 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (excluding Cadillac)
This bulletin is being revised to provide the necessary contact information only. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 66-83-04 (Section 8 - Chassis/Body Electrical)
General Motors provides service for sophisticated electronic products through the authorized AC
Delco Service Center Program. This program is designed to provide GM vehicle owners with the
highest quality and most technically up-to-date product available. Repair products from
unauthorized service outlets are not acceptable as warranty replacements.
Currently, there are 25 authorized AC Delco Service Centers who exchange and remanufacture
odometer/speedometers (list included). Only these Centers should be contacted for service.
Important:
W series and 1997 T series Medium Duty truck odometer/speedometers must be ordered directly
from GMSPO.
The following steps should be taken when utilizing the AC Delco Service Centers: Dealers should
contact their local AC Delco Service Center (list included). Any listed facility may be used.
The following information must be provided:
Part number VIN, Mileage, Vehicle Year, Make and Model Dealer Name and Address Delivery
Date of Vehicle Name of the person requesting exchange or service Phone number Repair Order
Number P.O. number (if non - warranty)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Odometer > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Odometer/Speedometer - ACDelco Service Center Locations > Page 7627
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Odometer > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Odometer/Speedometer - ACDelco Service Center Locations > Page 7628
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Odometer > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Odometer/Speedometer - ACDelco Service Center Locations > Page 7629
AC Delco Service Centers
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Level Warning Indicator >
Component Information > Description and Operation
Oil Level Warning Indicator: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
This lamp illuminates to warn the driver that the engine oil level is low. When the ignition switch is
first moved to Run, the oil level indicator lights for about 1 1/2 seconds as a bulb check. The oil
level detection circuit has two internal timers. The first timer records the amount of time the ignition
has been Off. The second timer records the amount of time the ignition has been On before the
ignition was shut Off. The instrument cluster uses this information to determine if the engine has
been sitting long enough for the oil to have returned to the oil pan.
OPERATION
The oil level monitoring circuits will check the oil level switch under the following conditions:
1. Ignition has been turned Off for more than 30 minutes. 2. Ignition has been Off for at least three
minutes after ignition has been On for at least 12 minutes.
If the oil level is low (oil level switch open), the "Check Oil" indicator will be turned On for the
remainder of the ignition cycle.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Gauge > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Oil Pressure Gauge: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
This oil pressure indicating system incorporates an instrument voltage regulator, electrical oil
pressure gauge and a sending unit which are connected in series. The sending unit consists of a
diaphragm, contact and a variable resistor.
OPERATION
As oil pressure increases or decreases, the diaphragm actuated the contact on the variable
resistor, in turn controlling current flow through the gauge. When oil pressure is low, the resistance
of the variable resistor is high, restricting current flow to the gauge, in turn indicating low oil
pressure. As oil pressure increases, the resistance of the variable resistor is lowered, permitting an
increased current flow to the gauge, resulting in an increased gauge reading.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Pressure Gauge > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 7636
Oil Pressure Gauge: Service and Repair
Disconnect the oil pressure gauge lead from the sending unit, connect a 12 volt test lamp between
the gauge lead and the ground and turn ignition on. If test lamp flashes, the instrument voltage
regulator is functioning properly and the gauge circuit is not broken. If the test lamp remains lit, the
instrument voltage regulator is defective and must be replaced. If the test lamp does not light,
check the instrument voltage regulator for proper ground or an open circuit. Also, check for an open
in the instrument voltage regulator to oil pressure gauge wire or in the gauge itself. If test lamp
flashes and gauge is not accurate, the gauge may be out of calibration, requiring replacement.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Oil Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Testing and Inspection
Oil Temperature Gauge: Testing and Inspection
Check for a defective wire inside the insulation which could cause system malfunction but prove
"GOOD" in a continuity/voltage check with the system disconnected. These circuits may be
intermittent or resistive when loaded, and if possible, should be checked by monitoring for a voltage
drop with the system operational.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Console
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Parking Brake Warning Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7644
Console
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Relays and Modules - Instrument
Panel > Audible Warning Device Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Multi-Function Chime (MFC)
Module
Audible Warning Device Control Module: Locations Multi-Function Chime (MFC) Module
Convenience Center
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Relays and Modules - Instrument
Panel > Audible Warning Device Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Multi-Function Chime (MFC)
Module > Page 7650
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Relays and Modules - Instrument
Panel > Audible Warning Device Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Multi-Function Chime (MFC)
Module > Page 7651
Convenience Center
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument
Panel > Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > IP Dimmer Control - Proper Setting
Dimmer Switch: Technical Service Bulletins IP Dimmer Control - Proper Setting
File In Section: 08 - Body and Accessories
Bulletin No.: 99-08-42-009
Date: November, 1999
INFORMATION
Subject: Proper Setting of I/P Dimmer Control to View PRNDL Display with Automatic Headlamp
Control
Models: 2000 and Prior All Passenger Cars and Trucks With Automatic Headlamp Control and
Electronic PRNDL Display
Under certain conditions, if the instrument panel dimmer control is turned relatively low, the PRNDL
will not be visible until the automatic headlamp control turns the headlamps off and the daytime
running lamps (DRL) are turned back on. Such a condition may be if the vehicle is first started in an
environment where the headlamp control turns on the headlamps and then the vehicle is driven out
into a brighter environment (for example, when a vehicle is backed out of a dark garage into the
bright sunlight).
This condition is normal and any repair attempt will not be successful. Demonstrate this condition
to the customer using the service lane and then turn the instrument panel dimmer control to a
higher setting. This will enable the driver to see the PRNDL display
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument
Panel > Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7657
Dimmer Switch: Locations
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Panel Dimmer Switch is located at LH side of I/P near LH front Speaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument
Panel > Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7658
Harness Connector Faces: Panel Dimmer Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument
Panel > Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7659
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair
1. Remove steering wheel as outlined under Steering Wheel. Refer to Steering and
Suspension/Steering.
2. Remove turn signal switch as outlined under Turn Signal Switch. Refer to Turn Signals.
3. Remove windshield wiper switch as outlined under Windshield Wiper Switch. Refer to Wiper and
Washer System.
4. Remove ignition switch to ignition switch housing attaching screws.
5. Depress ignition switch locking tab, then disconnect switch electrical connectors.
6. Reverse procedure to install, noting the following: a. Ensure lock cylinder shaft aligns with slotted
opening on ignition switch. b. Torque ignition switch attaching screws to 21 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument
Panel > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations
Center Of Console (Sedan Shown, Station Wagon Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument
Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair
Modular Fuel Sender To Tank
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument
Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 7666
Modular Fuel Sender Assembly
NOTE: Always replace fuel sender assembly O-ring when reinstalling fuel sender assembly.
Remove or Disconnect:
1. Negative battery cable.
2. Relieve system fuel pressure.
3. Drain fuel tank. Refer to "DRAINING FUEL TANK."
4. Fuel tank, Refer to "FUEL TANK REPLACEMENT."
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument
Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 7667
5. While holding, the modular fuel sender assembly down, remove the snap ring from designated
slots located on the retainer.
IMPORTANT:
^ The modular fuel sender assembly may spring up from its position.
^ When removing the modular fuel sender assembly from the fuel tank, be aware that that the
reservoir bucket is full of fuel. It must be tipped slightly during removal to avoid damage to the float.
Discard fuel sender O-ring and replace with a new one.
^ Carefully discard the reservoir fuel into an approved container.
INSTALL OR CONNECT:
1. New O-ring on modular fuel sender to tank.
2. Align tab on front of sender with slot on front of retainer snap ring.
3. Slowly apply pressure to top of spring loaded sender until sender aligns flush with retainer on
tank.
4. Insert snap ring into designated slots.
IMPORTANT:
^ Be sure that the snap ring is fully seated within the tab slots.
5. Fuel tank. Refer to "FUEL TANK REPLACEMENT"
6. Lower vehicle.
7. Refill tank.
INSPECT:
^ Turn ignition to "ON" position for two seconds, then to "OFF" for ten seconds. Again turn to "ON"
position, and check for fuel leak's.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument
Panel > Key Reminder Switch > Component Information > Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument
Panel > Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Console
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument
Panel > Parking Brake Warning Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7675
Console
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Sensors and Switches - Instrument
Panel > Temperature Switch (Warning Indicator) > Component Information > Description and Operation
Temperature Switch (Warning Indicator): Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
If the red light is not lit when the engine is being cranked, check for a burned out bulb, an open in
the light circuit, or a defective ignition switch.
If the red light is lit when the engine is running, check the wiring between light and switch for a
ground, temperature switch defective, or overheated cooling system. As a test circuit to check
whether the red bulb is functioning properly, a wire which is connected to the ground terminal of the
ignition switch is tapped into its circuit. When the ignition is in the start engine cranking position, the
ground terminal is grounded inside the switch and the red bulb will be lit. When the engine is
started and the ignition switch is in the on position, the test circuit is opened and the bulb is then
controlled by the temperature switch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Shift Indicator: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
This lamp is used on most models equipped with manual transmission.
OPERATION
The Upshift lamp is illuminated to inform the driver of ideal shift points, with improved fuel economy
as the specific objective. When the light is illuminated, the transmission should be shifted to the
next highest gear, if driving conditions permit such an action.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Shift Indicator > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 7682
Shift Indicator: Service and Repair
If upshift indicator is not working properly, perform the following test. 1. Disconnect ECM connector
C1. 2. Place ignition switch in run. 3. Measure voltage at terminal A2 of ECM connector. 4. If
battery voltage is present, further ECM diagnosis is necessary. 5. If battery voltage is not present,
repair open circuit in brown/black wire, circuit 456.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Speedometer Head > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Odometer/Speedometer - ACDelco Service Center Locations
Speedometer Head: Technical Service Bulletins Odometer/Speedometer - ACDelco Service Center
Locations
File In Section: 8 - Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 66-83-04A
Date: September, 1996
INFORMATION
Subject: AC Delco Service Center Locations for Odometer/Speedometer Service
Models: 1997 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (excluding Cadillac)
This bulletin is being revised to provide the necessary contact information only. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 66-83-04 (Section 8 - Chassis/Body Electrical)
General Motors provides service for sophisticated electronic products through the authorized AC
Delco Service Center Program. This program is designed to provide GM vehicle owners with the
highest quality and most technically up-to-date product available. Repair products from
unauthorized service outlets are not acceptable as warranty replacements.
Currently, there are 25 authorized AC Delco Service Centers who exchange and remanufacture
odometer/speedometers (list included). Only these Centers should be contacted for service.
Important:
W series and 1997 T series Medium Duty truck odometer/speedometers must be ordered directly
from GMSPO.
The following steps should be taken when utilizing the AC Delco Service Centers: Dealers should
contact their local AC Delco Service Center (list included). Any listed facility may be used.
The following information must be provided:
Part number VIN, Mileage, Vehicle Year, Make and Model Dealer Name and Address Delivery
Date of Vehicle Name of the person requesting exchange or service Phone number Repair Order
Number P.O. number (if non - warranty)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Speedometer Head > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Odometer/Speedometer - ACDelco Service Center Locations > Page 7687
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Speedometer Head > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Odometer/Speedometer - ACDelco Service Center Locations > Page 7688
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Speedometer Head > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Odometer/Speedometer - ACDelco Service Center Locations > Page 7689
AC Delco Service Centers
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Speedometer Head > Component
Information > Description and Operation > With Manual Cluster
Speedometer Head: Description and Operation With Manual Cluster
DESCRIPTION
NOTE: The following information covers only that service on speedometers which can be
performed by the average service man. Repairs on the units themselves are not included as they
require special equipment and extreme care when making repairs and adjustments and only an
experienced speedometer mechanic should attempt such servicing.
The speedometer has two main parts: the indicator head and the speedometer drive cable. When
the speedometer fails to indicate speed or mileage, the cable or housing is probably broken.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Speedometer Head > Component
Information > Description and Operation > With Manual Cluster > Page 7692
Speedometer Head: Description and Operation With Electronic Cluster
DESCRIPTION
The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) generates a signal that indicates the vehicle speed. The signal is
processed by the powertrain control module (PCM) to supply inputs to the speedometer and
odometer.
OPERATION
The VSS is mounted in the transaxle and generates an AC voltage signal with a frequency
proportional to vehicle speed. The PCM takes the voltage pulses from the sensor and uses them to
close a solid state output switch. The output terminal is switched to ground at a rate proportional to
vehicle speed. The speedometer and odometer are switched at the same frequency that the sensor
generates at. The speedometer and odometer are operated by a circuit board in the instrument
cluster that converts pulses received from the PCM into a control signal for the vacuum fluorescent
display.
Check for a broken, or partially broken, wire inside the insulation which could cause system
malfunction but prove "GOOD" in a continuity/voltage check with a system disconnected. These
circuits may be intermittent or resistive when loaded, and if possible, should be checked by
monitoring for a voltage drop with the system operational.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Speedometer Head > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 7693
Speedometer Head: Testing and Inspection
Most cables are broken due to lack of lubrication or a sharp bend or kink in the housing.
Cable can break because the speedometer head mechanism binds. If such is the case, the
speedometer head should be repaired or replaced before a new cable or housing is installed.
A jumpy pointer condition, together with a sort of scraping noise, is due, in most instances, to a dry
or kinked speedometer cable. The kinked cable rubs on the housing and winds up, slowing down
the pointer. The cable then unwinds and the pointer jumps.
To check for kinks, remove the cable, lay it on a flat surface and twist one end with the fingers. If it
turns over smoothly the cable is not kinked. But if part of the cable flops over as it is twisted, the
cable is kinked and should be replaced.
LUBRICATION
The speedometer cable should be lubricated with special cable lubricant every 10,000 miles.
Fill the ferrule on the upper end of the housing with the cable lubricant. Insert the cable in the
housing, starting at the upper end. Turn the cable around carefully while feeding it into the housing.
Repeat filling the ferrule except for the last six inches of cable. Too much lubricant at this point may
cause the lubricant to work into the indicating hand.
INSTALLATION
During installation, if the cable sticks when inserted in the housing and will not go through, the
housing is damaged inside or kinked. Be sure to check the housing from one end to the other.
Straighten any sharp bends by relocating clamps or elbows. Replace housing if it is badly kinked or
broken. Position the cable and housing so that they lead into the head as straight as possible.
Check the new cable for kinks before installing it. Use wide, sweeping, gradual curves when the
cable comes out of the transmission and connects to the head so the cable will not be damaged
during its installation.
If inspection indicates that the cable and housing are in good condition, yet pointer action is erratic,
check the speedometer head for possible binding.
The speedometer drive pinion should also be checked. If the pinion is dry or its teeth are stripped,
the speedometer may not register properly.
The transmission mainshaft nut must be tight or the speedometer drive gear may slip on the
mainshaft and cause slow speed readings.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Temperature Gauge: > 478101 > Apr > 94 > Temperature
Gauge - Fluctuation
Temperature Gauge: Customer Interest Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Group Ref.: Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 478101
Date: April, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: TEMPERATURE GAUGE FLUCTUATION
MODELS: 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND BERETTA 1993-94 BUICK
CENTURY 1993-94 OLDSMOBILE CUTLASS CIERA WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK S TRUCKS
WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
Some vehicles described above may exhibit a condition where temperature gauge readings
fluctuate in the normal range. These gauge fluctuations may be as much as 1/4 of the scale,
however, the indicator should never enter the red high temperature warning area of the gauge
under normal operating conditions.
Coolant temperature sensor location combined with the thermostat cycling characteristics
contribute to this sensitivity. The condition is considered a normal characteristic of this engine and
should not be cause for instrument panel cluster, gauge, indicator sender, or engine coolant
thermostat replacement or alteration.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Temperature Gauge: > 478101 > Apr > 94 >
Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Temperature Gauge: All Technical Service Bulletins Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Group Ref.: Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 478101
Date: April, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: TEMPERATURE GAUGE FLUCTUATION
MODELS: 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND BERETTA 1993-94 BUICK
CENTURY 1993-94 OLDSMOBILE CUTLASS CIERA WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK S TRUCKS
WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
Some vehicles described above may exhibit a condition where temperature gauge readings
fluctuate in the normal range. These gauge fluctuations may be as much as 1/4 of the scale,
however, the indicator should never enter the red high temperature warning area of the gauge
under normal operating conditions.
Coolant temperature sensor location combined with the thermostat cycling characteristics
contribute to this sensitivity. The condition is considered a normal characteristic of this engine and
should not be cause for instrument panel cluster, gauge, indicator sender, or engine coolant
thermostat replacement or alteration.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Gauge > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7707
Temperature Gauge: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
This temperature indicating system consists of a sending unit, located on the cylinder head,
electrical temperature gauge and an instrument voltage regulator.
OPERATION
As engine temperature increases or decreases, the resistance of the sending unit changes, in turn
controlling current flow through the gauge. When engine temperature is low sending unit resistance
is high, current flow through the gauge is restricted, and the gauge pointer remains against the stop
or moves very little. As engine temperature increases sending unit resistance decreases and
current flow through the gauge increases, resulting in increased pointer movement.
Troubleshooting for the electrical temperature indicating system is the same as for the electrical oil
pressure indicating system.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Temperature Sensor (Gauge): > 478101 >
Apr > 94 > Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Temperature Sensor (Gauge): Customer Interest Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Group Ref.: Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 478101
Date: April, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: TEMPERATURE GAUGE FLUCTUATION
MODELS: 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND BERETTA 1993-94 BUICK
CENTURY 1993-94 OLDSMOBILE CUTLASS CIERA WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK S TRUCKS
WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
Some vehicles described above may exhibit a condition where temperature gauge readings
fluctuate in the normal range. These gauge fluctuations may be as much as 1/4 of the scale,
however, the indicator should never enter the red high temperature warning area of the gauge
under normal operating conditions.
Coolant temperature sensor location combined with the thermostat cycling characteristics
contribute to this sensitivity. The condition is considered a normal characteristic of this engine and
should not be cause for instrument panel cluster, gauge, indicator sender, or engine coolant
thermostat replacement or alteration.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Temperature Sensor (Gauge): >
478101 > Apr > 94 > Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Temperature Sensor (Gauge): All Technical Service Bulletins Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Group Ref.: Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 478101
Date: April, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: TEMPERATURE GAUGE FLUCTUATION
MODELS: 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND BERETTA 1993-94 BUICK
CENTURY 1993-94 OLDSMOBILE CUTLASS CIERA WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK S TRUCKS
WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
Some vehicles described above may exhibit a condition where temperature gauge readings
fluctuate in the normal range. These gauge fluctuations may be as much as 1/4 of the scale,
however, the indicator should never enter the red high temperature warning area of the gauge
under normal operating conditions.
Coolant temperature sensor location combined with the thermostat cycling characteristics
contribute to this sensitivity. The condition is considered a normal characteristic of this engine and
should not be cause for instrument panel cluster, gauge, indicator sender, or engine coolant
thermostat replacement or alteration.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Sensor (Gauge) >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7721
Temperature Sensor (Gauge): Locations
Rear Of Engine Compartment
LH rear of engine, on Coolant Outlet
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Switch (Warning
Indicator) > Component Information > Description and Operation
Temperature Switch (Warning Indicator): Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
If the red light is not lit when the engine is being cranked, check for a burned out bulb, an open in
the light circuit, or a defective ignition switch.
If the red light is lit when the engine is running, check the wiring between light and switch for a
ground, temperature switch defective, or overheated cooling system. As a test circuit to check
whether the red bulb is functioning properly, a wire which is connected to the ground terminal of the
ignition switch is tapped into its circuit. When the ignition is in the start engine cranking position, the
ground terminal is grounded inside the switch and the red bulb will be lit. When the engine is
started and the ignition switch is in the on position, the test circuit is opened and the bulb is then
controlled by the temperature switch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator,
Engine Cooling > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Temperature Warning
Lamp/Indicator: > 478101 > Apr > 94 > Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator: Customer Interest Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Group Ref.: Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 478101
Date: April, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: TEMPERATURE GAUGE FLUCTUATION
MODELS: 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND BERETTA 1993-94 BUICK
CENTURY 1993-94 OLDSMOBILE CUTLASS CIERA WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK S TRUCKS
WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
Some vehicles described above may exhibit a condition where temperature gauge readings
fluctuate in the normal range. These gauge fluctuations may be as much as 1/4 of the scale,
however, the indicator should never enter the red high temperature warning area of the gauge
under normal operating conditions.
Coolant temperature sensor location combined with the thermostat cycling characteristics
contribute to this sensitivity. The condition is considered a normal characteristic of this engine and
should not be cause for instrument panel cluster, gauge, indicator sender, or engine coolant
thermostat replacement or alteration.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator,
Engine Cooling > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Temperature
Warning Lamp/Indicator: > 478101 > Apr > 94 > Temperature Gauge - Fluctuation
Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator: All Technical Service Bulletins Temperature Gauge Fluctuation
Group Ref.: Chassis/Body Electrical
Bulletin No.: 478101
Date: April, 1994
INFORMATION
SUBJECT: TEMPERATURE GAUGE FLUCTUATION
MODELS: 1992-94 CHEVROLET CAVALIER, CORSICA AND BERETTA 1993-94 BUICK
CENTURY 1993-94 OLDSMOBILE CUTLASS CIERA WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
1994 CHEVROLET AND GMC TRUCK S TRUCKS
WITH 2.2L ENGINE (RPO LN2 - VIN 4)
Some vehicles described above may exhibit a condition where temperature gauge readings
fluctuate in the normal range. These gauge fluctuations may be as much as 1/4 of the scale,
however, the indicator should never enter the red high temperature warning area of the gauge
under normal operating conditions.
Coolant temperature sensor location combined with the thermostat cycling characteristics
contribute to this sensitivity. The condition is considered a normal characteristic of this engine and
should not be cause for instrument panel cluster, gauge, indicator sender, or engine coolant
thermostat replacement or alteration.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator,
Engine Cooling > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7738
Temperature Warning Lamp/Indicator: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
If the red light is not lit when the engine is being cranked, check for a burned out bulb, an open in
the light circuit, or a defective ignition switch.
If the red light is lit when the engine is running, check the wiring between light and switch for a
ground, temperature switch defective, or overheated cooling system. As a test circuit to check
whether the red bulb is functioning properly, a wire which is connected to the ground terminal of the
ignition switch is tapped into its circuit. When the ignition is in the start engine cranking position, the
ground terminal is grounded inside the switch and the red bulb will be lit. When the engine is
started and the ignition switch is in the on position, the test circuit is opened and the bulb is then
controlled by the temperature switch.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Instruments - Reduced PRNDL Display Visibility
Transmission Shift Position Indicator Lamp: Technical Service Bulletins Instruments - Reduced
PRNDL Display Visibility
Bulletin No.: 02-08-42-004A
Date: March 30, 2007
INFORMATION
Subject: PRNDL Display Reduced Visibility For Approximately One Minute
Models: 2007 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2007 and Prior HUMMER
H2, H3 2005-2007 Saab 9-7X
with Automatic Headlamp Control and Vacuum Fluorescent PRNDL Indicator Instrument Panel
Cluster
Supercede:
This bulletin is being revised to include additional models and model years. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-42-0004 (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
After backing the vehicle out of a garage or dark environment into a daylight environment, the
PRNDL display has reduced visibility for approximately one minute.
While the vehicle is parked in a dark environment, the sensor for the automatic headlamp/driving
lamps senses that it is dark. When the key is turned to the run/start position, the automatic
headlamp module will turn all driving lamps, the instrument panel cluster and PRNDL display ON in
the night-time mode. The night-time mode intensity of the instrument panel lamps and PRNDL
display is controlled by the automatic headlamp module and can be dimmed further by the
customer using the dimming control of the headlamp switch.
When the customer then moves the vehicle from the dark environment into the bright sunlight, it will
take approximately one minute before the headlamp control module recognizes this as true daylight
and not just a bright overhead street lamp shining on the sensor. The headlamp control module will
then turn the headlamps off and restore the instrument panel and PRNDL display to full brilliance.
Without the time delay, the automatic headlamp control module would switch to the night mode
(turn on all driving lamps, instrument panel lamps and PRNDL display would dim) each time the
vehicle was driven under an overpass or other darkened environment.
This is a normal condition and no repair should be attempted.
Ensure the instrument panel backlighting control is in the full bright position. This will help alleviate
the condition. You may demonstrate to the customer what happens by placing a repair order over
the automatic headlamp control light sensor, which will cause the automatic headlamp control
module to switch to the night mode in approximately one minute. All driving lamps will come ON,
the instrument panel backlight will be dim, and the PRNDL display will also dim to the night setting
in conjunction with the position of the headlamp switch dimming control. Demonstrate to the
customer the variance in the instrument panel backlighting and PRNDL display while adjusting the
headlamp switch dimming control to both ends of its allowable range. Advise the customer to keep
the headlight switch dimming control in the highest position to allow viewing of the PRNDL display
in a bright environment.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Transmission Shift Position Indicator
Lamp > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 7743
Console
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Description and Operation
Volt Meter Gauge: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The voltmeter is a gauge which measures the electrical flow from the battery to indicate whether
the battery output is within tolerances. The voltmeter reading can range from 13.5-14.0 volts under
normal operating conditions. If an undercharge or overcharge condition is indicated for an extended
period, the battery and charging system should be checked.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Instrument Panel, Gauges and Warning Indicators > Volt Meter Gauge > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 7747
Volt Meter Gauge: Testing and Inspection
To test meter, turn key and headlights On with engine Off. Pointer should move to 12.5 volts. If no
needle movement is observed, check connections from battery to circuit breaker. If connections are
tight and meter shows no movement, check wire continuity. If wire continuity is satisfactory, the
meter is inoperative and must be replaced.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Backup Lamp Switch: Component Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 7754
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp > Backup Lamp Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 7755
Backup Lamp Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Disconnect back-up lamp switch electrical connector.
3. Remove back-up lamp switch from top of transaxle case.
4. Reverse procedure to install. Prior to installation, apply sealant 1052080 or equivalent to switch
threads.
5. Torque back up lamp switch to 24 ft-lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Lighting - Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement
Brake Lamp: Technical Service Bulletins Lighting - Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 01-08-42-001H
Date: January 05, 2011
Subject: Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement Guidelines
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 01-08-42-001G (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
The following information is being provided to better define the causes of condensation in exterior
lamps and includes guidelines for determining the difference between a lamp with a normal
atmospheric condition (condensation) and a lamp with a water leak.
Some exterior lamps, such as cornering, turn signal, backup, headlamps or tail lamps may exhibit
very small droplets of water, a fine mist or white fog (condensation) on the inside of the lamp lens.
This may be more noticeable on lamps with "multi-lens" designs and may be normal during certain
weather conditions.
Condensation occurs when the air inside the lamp assembly, through atmospheric changes,
reaches the "dew point". When this takes place, the moisture in the air within the lamp assembly
condenses, creating a fine mist or white fog on the inside surface of the lamp lens.
Most exterior lamps on General Motors vehicles use a vented design and feature a replaceable
bulb assembly. They are designed to remove any accumulated moisture vapor by expelling it
through a vent system. The vent system operates at all times, however, it is most effective when
the lamps are ON or when the vehicle is in motion. Depending on the size, shape and location of
the lamp on the vehicle, and the atmospheric conditions occurring, the amount of time required to
clear the lamp may vary from 2 to 6 hours.
Completely sealed headlamp assemblies (sealed beams) are still used on a limited number of
models being manufactured today. These lamps require the replacement of the complete lamp
assembly if a bulb filament burns out.
Condensation 2006 TrailBlazer Shown
A Fine Mist or White Fog on the Inside Surface of the Lamp Lens Occurring After a Period of High
Humidity
- May be located primarily in the lens corners (near the vents) and SHOULD NOT cover more than
half the lens surface.
- The condition should clear of moisture when the vehicle is parked in a dry environment, or when
the vehicle is driven with the lights ON.
- A comparison of the equivalent lamp on the opposing side of the vehicle indicates a SIMILAR
performance.
If the above conditions are noted, the customer should be advised that replacement of a lamp
assembly may not correct this condition.
Water Leak New Style Pickup Shown
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Lamp > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Lighting - Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement > Page 7760
Numerous & Various Size Drops of Water Collecting on the Inside Surface of the Lamp Lens After
the Vehicle Has Been Exposed to Rain or a Car Washing Environment
- A condition that covers more than half the surface of the lamp lens.
- An accumulation of water in the bottom of the lamp assembly.
- A condition that WON'T clear when the vehicle is parked in a dry environment, or when the
vehicle is driven with the lights ON.
- A comparison of the equivalent lamp on the opposing side of the vehicle indicates a different
performance.
Any of the above conditions would indicate the need to service the lens or lamp assembly.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Brake Light Switch: Component Locations
Insert stop lamp switch in retainer until switch body seats on retainer.
Pull brake pedal upward against internal pedal stop.
Switch will be moved in retainer providing proper adjustment.
Proper switch adjustment is achieved when no audible clicks are heard when the pedal is pulled
upward and the brake lights do not remin on without brake application.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 7765
Brake Light Switch: Connector Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
7766
Harness Connector Faces: Brake Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page
7767
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove drivers' side hash panel.
3. Disconnect switch electrical connector.
4. Remove switch from brake pedal support bracket.
5. Reverse procedure to install.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Locations >
Convertible and Sedan
Center Mounted Brake Lamp: Locations Convertible and Sedan
Underside Of Luggage Compartment Lid
Underside Of Luggage Compartment Lid (Convertible And Sedan Without Luggage Carrier)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Center Mounted Brake Lamp > Component Information > Locations >
Convertible and Sedan > Page 7772
Center Mounted Brake Lamp: Locations Station Wagon
Underside Of Luggage Compartment Lid
Tailgate (Station Wagon)
Tailgate (Station Wagon)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Courtesy Lamp > Glove Box Lamp Switch > Component Information >
Locations
RH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit >
Component Information > Locations
Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit: Locations
Daytime Running Lights (DRL) Module is located Behind LH side of I/P near C200
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7781
Harness Connector Faces: Daytime Running Lights (DRL) Module
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Daytime Running Lights (DRL) Ignition Relay
Harness Connector Faces: Daytime Running Lights (DRL) Ignition Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp > Daytime Running Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Daytime Running Lights (DRL) Ignition Relay > Page 7787
Harness Connector Faces: Daytime Running Light (DRL) Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > IP Dimmer Control - Proper Setting
Dimmer Switch: Technical Service Bulletins IP Dimmer Control - Proper Setting
File In Section: 08 - Body and Accessories
Bulletin No.: 99-08-42-009
Date: November, 1999
INFORMATION
Subject: Proper Setting of I/P Dimmer Control to View PRNDL Display with Automatic Headlamp
Control
Models: 2000 and Prior All Passenger Cars and Trucks With Automatic Headlamp Control and
Electronic PRNDL Display
Under certain conditions, if the instrument panel dimmer control is turned relatively low, the PRNDL
will not be visible until the automatic headlamp control turns the headlamps off and the daytime
running lamps (DRL) are turned back on. Such a condition may be if the vehicle is first started in an
environment where the headlamp control turns on the headlamps and then the vehicle is driven out
into a brighter environment (for example, when a vehicle is backed out of a dark garage into the
bright sunlight).
This condition is normal and any repair attempt will not be successful. Demonstrate this condition
to the customer using the service lane and then turn the instrument panel dimmer control to a
higher setting. This will enable the driver to see the PRNDL display
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 7792
Dimmer Switch: Locations
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Panel Dimmer Switch is located at LH side of I/P near LH front Speaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 7793
Harness Connector Faces: Panel Dimmer Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dimmer Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 7794
Dimmer Switch: Service and Repair
1. Remove steering wheel as outlined under Steering Wheel. Refer to Steering and
Suspension/Steering.
2. Remove turn signal switch as outlined under Turn Signal Switch. Refer to Turn Signals.
3. Remove windshield wiper switch as outlined under Windshield Wiper Switch. Refer to Wiper and
Washer System.
4. Remove ignition switch to ignition switch housing attaching screws.
5. Depress ignition switch locking tab, then disconnect switch electrical connectors.
6. Reverse procedure to install, noting the following: a. Ensure lock cylinder shaft aligns with slotted
opening on ignition switch. b. Torque ignition switch attaching screws to 21 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Dome Lamp > Dome Light Switch <--> [Dome Lamp Relay] >
Component Information > Diagrams
Harness Connector Faces: Dome Light Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Door Switch > Component Information > Locations
Center Of Console (Sedan Shown, Station Wagon Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Locations > Flasher
Hazard Warning Flasher: Locations Flasher
The hazard flasher is located under dash panel, left side of steering column.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Locations > Flasher > Page 7807
Hazard Warning Flasher: Locations Fuse Panel & Flasher Locations
The fuse panel is located on the left side of the instrument panel. To gain access to the panel, pivot
access door downward. The hazard flasher is located under dash panel, left side of steering
column. The turn signal flasher is located under dash panel, right side of steering column.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Flasher > Component
Information > Locations > Flasher > Page 7808
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
Hazard Warning Switch: Component Locations
LH Side Of I/P
Turn/Hazard Headlight Switch Assembly is located Top of Steering Column, below Steering Wheel
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7813
LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7814
Hazard Warning Switch: Diagrams
Harness Connector Faces: Turn/Hazard-Headlight Switch Assembly- C1
Harness Connector Faces: Turn/Hazard-Headlight Switch Assembly- C2
Harness Connector Faces: Turn/Hazard-Headlight Switch Assembly- C1 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Lamps > Hazard Warning Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7815
Harness Connector Faces: Turn/Hazard-Headlight Switch Assembly- C2 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Lens > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Lighting - Headlamp Polycarbonate Lens Damage Prevention
Headlamp Lens: Technical Service Bulletins Lighting - Headlamp Polycarbonate Lens Damage
Prevention
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 02-08-42-001D
Date: June 21, 2010
Subject: Headlamp Lens Overheating When Covered and Chemical Damage to Exterior
Polycarbonate Headlamp Lenses
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years and to revise the warning statements.
Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 02-08-42-001C (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
The bulletin is being issued to make dealers and customers aware of chemical damage that may
be caused to exterior polycarbonate headlamp lenses. Most late model vehicles have these types
of headlamp lenses. This material is used because of its temperature and high impact resistance.
A variety of chemicals can cause crazing or cracking of the headlamp lens. Headlamp lenses are
very sensitive. Care should be exercised to avoid contact with all exterior headlamp lenses when
treating a vehicle with any type of chemical, such as those recommended for rail dust removal.
Rubbing compound, grease tar and oil removers, tire cleaners, cleaner waxes and even car wash
soaps in too high a concentration may also attribute to this condition. This could result in the need
to replace the entire headlamp housing.
Warning
Use only lukewarm or cold water, a soft cloth and a car washing soap to clean exterior lamps and
lenses.
Also, crazing or deformations of the lens may occur if a shop mat or fender cover is draped over
the fender and covers a portion or all of the headlamp assembly while the DRL or headlamps are
on. This action restricts the amount of heat dissipated by the headlamps.
Warning
Care should be taken to not cover headlamps with shop mats or fender covers if the vehicle is
being serviced with the headlamps or DRL illuminated. Covering an illuminated lamp can cause
excessive heat build up and crazing/deformation of the lens may occur. The degradation of the lens
can be unnoticeable at first and eventually become hairline cracks in the lens. In extreme cases, it
could cause the lens to deform. This damage can also be caused by aftermarket shields that are
often tinted in color.
Once a heat buildup is generated by the headlamp, a degradation of the headlamp lens begins.
This degradation of the lens can be unnoticeable at first and eventually manifest as spider cracks.
In more extreme cases, it will begin to melt the lens of the headlamp.
Notice
Headlamps damaged by chemicals, improper cleaning, or overheating due to being covered are
not covered under the new vehicle warranty.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Component Locations
Headlamp Switch: Component Locations
LH Side Of I/P
Turn/Hazard Headlight Switch Assembly is located Top of Steering Column, below Steering Wheel
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Locations
> Component Locations > Page 7825
LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions
Headlamp Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7828
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7829
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7830
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7831
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7832
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7833
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7834
Headlamp Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7835
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7836
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7837
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7838
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7839
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7840
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7841
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7842
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7843
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7844
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7845
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7846
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7847
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7848
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7849
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7850
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7851
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7852
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7853
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7854
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7855
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7856
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7857
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7858
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7859
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7860
Headlamp Switch: Electrical Diagrams
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 1 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7861
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 2 Of 4)
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Wagon) (Part 4 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7862
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 1 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7863
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 2 Of 4)
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Sedan) (Part 4 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7864
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 1 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7865
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 2 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7866
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Coupe And Convertable) (Part 4 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7867
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 3 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7868
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 3 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7869
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Wagon) (Part 4 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7870
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 3 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7871
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 3 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7872
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Sedan) (Part 4 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7873
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 3 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7874
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 3 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7875
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Coupe And Convertable) (Part 4 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Headlamp > Headlamp Switch > Component Information > Diagrams
> Page 7876
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
The headlamp switch is part of the turn signal lever assembly and is not serviceable. The
headlamp switch, turn signal lever and cruise control switch must be replaced as an assembly.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Relay > Component Information > Locations
Convenience Center
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Recalls: > NHTSA96I001000 > Jan > 96 > Recall 96I001000: Horn Assembly Defect
Horn Switch: Recalls Recall 96I001000: Horn Assembly Defect
This is not a safety recall in accordance with Federal Regulation 573. However, it is deemed a
safety improvement campaign by the agency. These vehicles were built with insufficient retention
of the horn pad. The horn pad can separate from the steering wheel falling between the steering
wheel spokes. The horn pad could become jammed between the steering wheel spokes and the
turn signal lever, resulting in damage to the turn signal lever, horn pad, and horn wiring. Dealers
will modify the horn pad retention clips, install horn pad retention brackets to the steering wheel,
reinstall the horn pad and assure that the hornpad is properly retained.
NOTE: General Motors has decided to conduct a safety improvement campaign to modify the horn
pad on these vehicles. Owners can contact Chevrolet at1-800-222-1020.
1993 CHEVROLET CAVALIER 1994 CHEVROLET CAVALIER
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > NHTSA96I001000 > Jan > 96 > Recall 96I001000: Horn Assembly Defect
Horn Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 96I001000: Horn Assembly Defect
This is not a safety recall in accordance with Federal Regulation 573. However, it is deemed a
safety improvement campaign by the agency. These vehicles were built with insufficient retention
of the horn pad. The horn pad can separate from the steering wheel falling between the steering
wheel spokes. The horn pad could become jammed between the steering wheel spokes and the
turn signal lever, resulting in damage to the turn signal lever, horn pad, and horn wiring. Dealers
will modify the horn pad retention clips, install horn pad retention brackets to the steering wheel,
reinstall the horn pad and assure that the hornpad is properly retained.
NOTE: General Motors has decided to conduct a safety improvement campaign to modify the horn
pad on these vehicles. Owners can contact Chevrolet at1-800-222-1020.
1993 CHEVROLET CAVALIER 1994 CHEVROLET CAVALIER
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Horn Switch: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By
Various Control Modules
Relay Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By Various Control
Modules
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-06-03-004D
Date: December 08, 2010
Subject: Intermittent No Crank/No Start, No Module Communication, MIL, Warning Lights, Vehicle
Messages or DTCs Set by Various Control Modules - Diagnosing and Repairing Fretting Corrosion
(Disconnect Affected Connector and Apply Dielectric Lubricant)
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks
Attention:
This repair can be applied to ANY electrical connection including, but not limited to: lighting, body
electrical, in-line connections, powertrain control sensors, etc. DO NOT over apply lubricant to the
point where it prevents the full engagement of sealed connectors. A light coating on the terminal
surfaces is sufficient to correct the condition.
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the Attention statement and add the 2011
model year. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 09-06-03-004C (Section 06 Engine/Propulsion System).
Condition
Some customers may comment on any of the following conditions:
- An intermittent no crank/no start
- Intermittent malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) illumination
- Intermittent service lamp illumination
- Intermittent service message(s) being displayed
The technician may determine that he is unable to duplicate the intermittent condition.
Cause
This condition may be caused by a buildup of nonconductive insulating oxidized debris known as
fretting corrosion, occurring between two electrical contact surfaces of the connection or connector.
This may be caused by any of the following conditions:
- Vibration
- Thermal cycling
- Poor connection/terminal retention
- Micro motion
- A connector, component or wiring harness not properly secured resulting in movement
On low current signal circuits this condition may cause high resistance, resulting in intermittent
connections.
On high current power circuits this condition may cause permanent increases in the resistance and
may cause a device to become inoperative.
Representative List of Control Modules and Components
The following is only a representative list of control modules and components that may be affected
by this connection or connector condition and DOES NOT include every possible module or
component for every vehicle.
- Blower Control Module
- Body Control Module (BCM)
- Communication Interface Module (CIM)
- Cooling Fan Control Module
- Electronic Brake Control Module (EBCM)
- Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module (EBTCM)
- Electronic Suspension Control (ESC) Module
- Engine Control Module (ECM)
- Heating, Ventilation and Air Conditioning (HVAC) Control Module
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Horn Switch: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By
Various Control Modules > Page 7899
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Horn Switch: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By
Various Control Modules > Page 7900
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Horn Switch: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By
Various Control Modules > Page 7901
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Horn Switch: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By
Various Control Modules > Page 7907
- HVAC Actuator
- Inflatable Restraint Sensing and Diagnostic Module (SDM)
- Any AIR BAG module
- Seatbelt Lap Anchor Pretensioner
- Seatbelt Retractor Pretensioner
- An SIR system connection or connector condition resulting in the following DTCs being set:
B0015, B0016, B0019, B0020, B0022, or B0023
- Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
- Remote Control Door Lock Receiver (RCDLR)
- Transmission Control Module (TCM)
Correction
Important DO NOT replace the control module, wiring or component for the following conditions:
- The condition is intermittent and cannot be duplicated.
- The condition is present and by disconnecting and reconnecting the connector the condition can
no longer be duplicated.
Use the following procedure to correct the conditions listed above.
1. Install a scan tool and perform the Diagnostic System Check - Vehicle. Retrieve and record any
existing history or current DTCs from all of the
control modules (refer to SI).
‹› If any DTC(s) are set, refer to Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) List - Vehicle to identify the
connector(s) of the control module/component
which may be causing the condition (refer to SI).
‹› If DTCs are not set, refer to Symptoms - Vehicle to identify the connector(s) of the control
module/component which may be causing the
condition (refer to SI).
2. When identified, use the appropriate DTC Diagnostics, Symptoms, Schematics, Component
Connector End Views and Component Locator
documents to locate and disconnect the affected harness connector(s) which are causing the
condition.
Note Fretting corrosion looks like little dark smudges on electrical terminals and appear where the
actual electrical contact is being made. In less severe cases it may be unable to be seen or
identified without the use of a magnifying glass.
Important DO NOT apply an excessive amount of dielectric lubricant to the connectors as shown,
as hydrolock may result when attempting to mate the connectors. Use ONLY a clean nylon brush
that is dedicated to the repair of the conditions in this bulletin.
3. With a one-inch nylon bristle brush, apply dielectric lubricant to both the module/component side
and the harness side of the affected connector(s).
4. Reconnect the affected connector(s) and wipe away any excess lubricant that may be present.
5. Attempt to duplicate the condition by using the following information:
- DTC Diagnostic Procedure
- Circuit/System Description
- Conditions for Running the DTC
- Conditions for Setting the DTC
- Diagnostic Aids
- Circuit/System Verification
‹› If the condition cannot be duplicated, the repair is complete. ‹› If the condition can be duplicated,
then follow the appropriate DTC, Symptom or Circuit/System Testing procedure (refer to SI).
Repair Order Documentation
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Horn Switch: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By
Various Control Modules > Page 7908
Important The following information MUST be documented on the repair order. Failure to do so
may result in a chargeback.
- Customer vehicle condition.
- Was a Service Lamp or Service Message illuminated? If yes, specify which Service Lamp or
Service Message.
- Was a DTC(s) set? If yes, specify which DTC(s) were set.
- After following the procedure contained within this bulletin, could the condition be duplicated?
‹› If the condition was not duplicated, then document the affected module/component connector
name and number on the repair order.
- If the condition was duplicated after the procedure contained within this bulletin was followed, and
additional diagnosis led to the replacement of a module or component, the SI Document ID
Number MUST be written on the repair order.
Parts Information
Alternate Distributor For All of North America
Note
NyoGel(R) 760G Lubricant* is equivalent to GMSPO P/N 12377900, and P/N 10953529 (Canada),
specified for use to correct the condition in this bulletin.
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products/materials. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for, or assume
any responsibility for the products or material from this firm or for any such items that may be
available from other sources.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to:
Warranty Information (Saab Models)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Horn > Horn Switch > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Horn Switch: > 09-06-03-004D > Dec > 10 > Electrical - MIL ON/DTC's Set By
Various Control Modules > Page 7909
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the appropriate/closest labor operation depending upon
the module/component connection that the dielectric lubricant was applied to refer to the table
above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Lamp Dimmer Module <--> [Lamp Control Module] > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Lamp Dimmer Module <--> [Lamp Control Module] > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7914
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Lamp Dimmer Module <--> [Lamp Control Module] > Component
Information > Locations > Page 7915
Harness Connector Faces: Lamp Dimmer Module
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Lighting - Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement
Parking Lamp: Technical Service Bulletins Lighting - Exterior Lamp Condensation and
Replacement
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 01-08-42-001H
Date: January 05, 2011
Subject: Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement Guidelines
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 01-08-42-001G (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
The following information is being provided to better define the causes of condensation in exterior
lamps and includes guidelines for determining the difference between a lamp with a normal
atmospheric condition (condensation) and a lamp with a water leak.
Some exterior lamps, such as cornering, turn signal, backup, headlamps or tail lamps may exhibit
very small droplets of water, a fine mist or white fog (condensation) on the inside of the lamp lens.
This may be more noticeable on lamps with "multi-lens" designs and may be normal during certain
weather conditions.
Condensation occurs when the air inside the lamp assembly, through atmospheric changes,
reaches the "dew point". When this takes place, the moisture in the air within the lamp assembly
condenses, creating a fine mist or white fog on the inside surface of the lamp lens.
Most exterior lamps on General Motors vehicles use a vented design and feature a replaceable
bulb assembly. They are designed to remove any accumulated moisture vapor by expelling it
through a vent system. The vent system operates at all times, however, it is most effective when
the lamps are ON or when the vehicle is in motion. Depending on the size, shape and location of
the lamp on the vehicle, and the atmospheric conditions occurring, the amount of time required to
clear the lamp may vary from 2 to 6 hours.
Completely sealed headlamp assemblies (sealed beams) are still used on a limited number of
models being manufactured today. These lamps require the replacement of the complete lamp
assembly if a bulb filament burns out.
Condensation 2006 TrailBlazer Shown
A Fine Mist or White Fog on the Inside Surface of the Lamp Lens Occurring After a Period of High
Humidity
- May be located primarily in the lens corners (near the vents) and SHOULD NOT cover more than
half the lens surface.
- The condition should clear of moisture when the vehicle is parked in a dry environment, or when
the vehicle is driven with the lights ON.
- A comparison of the equivalent lamp on the opposing side of the vehicle indicates a SIMILAR
performance.
If the above conditions are noted, the customer should be advised that replacement of a lamp
assembly may not correct this condition.
Water Leak New Style Pickup Shown
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Parking Lamp > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins
> Lighting - Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement > Page 7920
Numerous & Various Size Drops of Water Collecting on the Inside Surface of the Lamp Lens After
the Vehicle Has Been Exposed to Rain or a Car Washing Environment
- A condition that covers more than half the surface of the lamp lens.
- An accumulation of water in the bottom of the lamp assembly.
- A condition that WON'T clear when the vehicle is parked in a dry environment, or when the
vehicle is driven with the lights ON.
- A comparison of the equivalent lamp on the opposing side of the vehicle indicates a different
performance.
Any of the above conditions would indicate the need to service the lens or lamp assembly.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Control Unit > Component Information > Locations
Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit: Locations
Daytime Running Lights (DRL) Module is located Behind LH side of I/P near C200
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Control Unit > Component Information > Locations > Page 7925
Harness Connector Faces: Daytime Running Lights (DRL) Module
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Relay > Component Information > Locations
LH Side Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Daytime Running Lights (DRL) Ignition Relay
Harness Connector Faces: Daytime Running Lights (DRL) Ignition Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Daytime Running Lights (DRL) Ignition Relay > Page 7931
Harness Connector Faces: Daytime Running Light (DRL) Relay
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Dome Light Switch <-->
[Dome Lamp Relay] > Component Information > Diagrams
Harness Connector Faces: Dome Light Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Convenience Center
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Lamp Dimmer Module
<--> [Lamp Control Module] > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Lamp Dimmer Module
<--> [Lamp Control Module] > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7942
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Lamp Dimmer Module
<--> [Lamp Control Module] > Component Information > Locations > Page 7943
Harness Connector Faces: Lamp Dimmer Module
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Backup Lamp Switch: Component Locations
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7949
LH Rear Of Engine Compartment (Manual)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7950
Backup Lamp Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Disconnect back-up lamp switch electrical connector.
3. Remove back-up lamp switch from top of transaxle case.
4. Reverse procedure to install. Prior to installation, apply sealant 1052080 or equivalent to switch
threads.
5. Torque back up lamp switch to 24 ft-lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Brake Light Switch: Component Locations
Insert stop lamp switch in retainer until switch body seats on retainer.
Pull brake pedal upward against internal pedal stop.
Switch will be moved in retainer providing proper adjustment.
Proper switch adjustment is achieved when no audible clicks are heard when the pedal is pulled
upward and the brake lights do not remin on without brake application.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7955
Brake Light Switch: Connector Locations
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Below LH Side Of I/P (Automatic)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7956
Harness Connector Faces: Brake Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 7957
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove drivers' side hash panel.
3. Disconnect switch electrical connector.
4. Remove switch from brake pedal support bracket.
5. Reverse procedure to install.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Center Of Console (Sedan Shown, Station Wagon Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Glove Box Lamp Switch
> Component Information > Locations
RH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Hazard Warning Switch: Component Locations
LH Side Of I/P
Turn/Hazard Headlight Switch Assembly is located Top of Steering Column, below Steering Wheel
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7968
LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 7969
Hazard Warning Switch: Diagrams
Harness Connector Faces: Turn/Hazard-Headlight Switch Assembly- C1
Harness Connector Faces: Turn/Hazard-Headlight Switch Assembly- C2
Harness Connector Faces: Turn/Hazard-Headlight Switch Assembly- C1 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 7970
Harness Connector Faces: Turn/Hazard-Headlight Switch Assembly- C2 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Headlamp Switch: Component Locations
LH Side Of I/P
Turn/Hazard Headlight Switch Assembly is located Top of Steering Column, below Steering Wheel
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 7975
LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Headlamp Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Abbreviation
A/C Air Conditioning
CCM Central Control Module
CKT Circuit
CONN
Connector
EBCM Electronic Brake Control Module
EBTCM Electronic Brake and Traction Control Module
ECM Engine Control Module
HARN Harness
I/P Instrument Panel
LH Left Hand
PCM Powertrain Control Module
RH Right Hand
TERM Terminal
Body Part Names
Cell References
CELL REFERENCES
General Motors vehicles often use "CELL" references in their electrical wiring diagrams. These
references are used in the Original Equipment Manual to refer to a section in the manual and not a
specific diagram(s).
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7978
GM Sample Diagram W/ Cell Reference
For instance, in the diagram illustrated "Cell 20" is not a reference to another diagram but a
reference to "Section 20" in the OE manual. In the example, "Section 20" is the engine control
section of the manual.
To navigate through these "Cell" references start at the vehicle level and go to: Diagrams /
Electrical Diagrams - for a complete list of the diagrams available for the vehicle. Choose the
system you are working on and view those diagrams.
Note: If unsure of the system - try utilizing the search feature. Type a component in the search
feature that belongs to the system and when the results are displayed note the path displayed. This
will show the system the component belongs in.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD Sensitive Devices)
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are Solid State and the following
information applies to them.
ESD Symbol
Typical Schematic
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7979
The ESD symbol is used on schematics to indicate which components are ESD sensitive. When
handling any electronic part, the service technician should follow the guidelines below to reduce
any possible electrostatic charge build-up on the service technician's body and inadvertent
discharge to the electronic part. If it is not known whether or not a component is ESD sensitive,
assume it is susceptible.
Handling Procedures 1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should
be repeated while handling the pan and more frequently after sliding
across a seat, sitting down from a standing position or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless so instructed by a written diagnostic
procedure. 3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove a
part from its protective package until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its
package, ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Measuring Procedures The circuits shown within the boxes are greatly simplified. Do not
troubleshoot by measuring resistance at any terminal of these devices unless so instructed by a
written diagnostic procedure. Due to the simplification of the schematics, resistance measurements
could be misleading, or could lead to electrostatic discharge.
Schematic Symbols
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7980
Fig.1-Symbols (Part 1 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7981
Fig.2-Symbols (Part 2 Of 3)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7982
Fig.3-Symbols (Part 3 Of 3)
Vacuum Motors operate like electrical solenoids, mechanically pushing or pulling a shaft between
two fixed positions. When vacuum is applied, the shaft is pulled in. When no vacuum is applied, the
shaft is pushed all the way out by a spring.
Double Diaphragm Motors can be operated by vacuum in two directions. When there is no vacuum,
the motor is in the center "at rest" position.
Some Vacuum Motors such as the Servo Motor in the Cruise Control can position the actuating
arm at any position between fully extended and fully retracted. The servo is operated by a control
valve that applies varying amounts of vacuum to the motor. The higher the vacuum level, the
greater the retraction of the motor arm. Servo Motors work like the two position motors; the only
difference is in the way the vacuum is applied. Servo Motors are generally larger and provide a
calibrated control.
Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) System
SIR Symbol
The Supplemental Inflatable Restraint (SIR) symbol is used on schematics to alert the technician to
the following important caution.
CAUTION: This vehicle is equipped with SIR. Refer to CAUTIONS in SIR under Air Bags and Seat
Belts before performing service on or around SIR components or wiring. Failure to follow
CAUTIONS could result in possible air bag deployment, personal injury, or otherwise unneeded
SIR system repairs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7983
Wire Color Code Identification
Black: BLK
Blue: BLU
Brown: BRN
Grey: GR Or GRY
Green: GRN
Natural: NAT
Orange: ORN
Pink: PNK
Purple: PPL
Red: RED
Tan: TAN
White: WHT
Yellow: YEL
Dark: DK (example: DK GRN same as Dark Green)
Light: LT (example: LT BLU same as Light Blue)
Wire Size Conversion Table
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7984
Headlamp Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Additional Information
NOTE: Turn OFF power to the test circuit before attempting in-circuit resistance measurements to
prevent false readings or damage to the meter. Do not use the meter to measure resistance
through a solid state module.
Continuity tests that work well for detecting intermittent shorts to ground can be performed by
setting the meter to "ohms" then pressing the "PEAK MIN MAX" button. An audible tone will be
heard whenever the meter detects continuity for at least 1 millisecond.
The J 39200 Instruction Manual is a good source of information and should be read thoroughly
upon receipt of the meter as well as kept on hand for reference during new procedures.
Basic Knowledge Required
Without a basic knowledge of electricity, it will be difficult to use the diagnostic procedures
contained in this section. You should understand the basic theory of electricity and know the
meaning of voltage, current (amps) and resistance (ohms). You should understand what happens
in a circuit with an open or a shorted wire. You should be able to read and understand a wiring
diagram. The following four-step troubleshooting procedure is recommended:
Step 1: Check the Problem Perform a System Check to determine a symptom. Don't waste time
fixing part of the problem! Do not begin disassembly or testing until you have narrowed down the
possible causes.
Step 2: Read the Electrical Schematic Study the schematic. Read the Circuit Operation text if you
do not understand how the circuit should work. Check circuits that share wiring with the problem
circuit. (Shared circuits are shown on Power Distribution, Ground Distribution, Fuse Block Details
and Light Switch Details.) Try to operate the shared circuits. If the shared circuits work, then the
shared wiring is OK. The cause must be within the wiring used only by the problem circuit. If
several circuits fail at the same time, chances are the power (fuse) or ground circuit is faulty.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair ^
Narrow down the possible causes.
^ Use the Troubleshooting Hints.
^ Make the necessary measurements or checks as given in the System Diagnosis.
^ Before replacing a component, check power, signal and ground wires at the component harness
connector. If the checks and connections are OK, the most probable cause is component failure.
Step 4: Test the Repair Repeat the System Check to verify that the fault has been corrected and
that no other faults were induced during the repair.
EXAMPLE: A customer brings in a vehicle and says that the HI beams do not work.
Step 1: Perform a System Check on the Headlight Circuit You may discover that both LO beams
operate. In HI, you may notice that the HI Beam Indicator comes ON, but neither HI beam
operates.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7985
Typical Headlights Schematic
Step 2: Read the Headlights Electrical Schematic This is the step that will save time and labor.
Remember, it is essential to understand how a circuit should work, before trying to figure out why it
doesn't.
After you understand how the circuit should operate, read the schematic again, this time keeping in
mind what you have learned by operating the circuit.
Since both LO beams work, you know that the Headlight Switch, the YEL wire, the LO contacts of
the Headlight Dimmer Switch, terminal "1E" of C100, the TAN wires and grounds G1O5 and G109
are all good.
Furthermore, since you saw that the HI Beam Indicator came ON when the Headlight Dimmer
Switch was moved to HI you know that the HI contacts of the Headlight Dimmer Switch and the LT
GRN wire between the Headlight Dimmer Switch and C100 are good.
At this point, you could test for voltage at the RH Headlamp with the Headlight Dimmer Switch in
HI. However, it is extremely unlikely that the HI beam filaments have burned out in both
headlamps, or that both headlamps connections are bad. The cause must be a bad connection at
C100, or a break in the LT GRN wire between C100 and the RH Headlamp.
You have quickly narrowed the possible causes down to one specific area, and have done
absolutely no work on the vehicle itself.
Step 3: Find the fault and repair it Using the Component Location List and the corresponding figure,
you can quickly find C100 and the LT GRN wire, locate the exact trouble point and make the repair.
Step 4: Check the repair by performing a System Check on the Headlights Circuit This, of course,
means making sure that both HI beams, both LO beams and the HI Beam Indicator are all working.
Now suppose that the symptoms were different. You may have operated the Headlamps and found
that the LO beams were working, but neither the HI beams nor the HI Beam Indicator were
working. Looking at the schematic, you might conclude that it is unlikely that both HI beam
filaments and the HI Beam Indicator have all burned out at once. The cause is probably the
Headlight Dimmer Switch or its connector.
Checking Terminal Contacts
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7986
DESCRIPTION
When diagnosing an electrical system that utilizes Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 series terminals
(refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4 for terminal identification), it is important to
check terminal contact between a connector and component, or between in-line connectors, before
replacing a suspect component.
Frequently, a diagnostic chart leads to a step that reads: Check for poor connection. Mating
terminals must be inspected to assure good terminal contact. A poor connection between the male
and female terminal at a connector may be the result of contamination or deformation.
Contamination is caused by the connector halves being improperly connected, a missing or
damaged connector seal, or damage to the connector itself, exposing the terminals to moisture and
dirt. Contamination, usually in underhood or underbody connectors, leads to terminal corrosion,
causing an open circuit or intermittently open circuit.
Deformation Of A Typical Metri-Pack 150/280/480/630 Series Female Terminal
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7987
Deformation is caused by probing the mating side of a connector terminal without the proper
adapter, improperly joining the connector halves or repeatedly separating and joining the connector
halves. Deformation, usually to the female terminal contact tang, can result in poor terminal
contact, causing an open or intermittently open circuit.
PROCEDURE
Follow the procedure below to check terminal contact. 1. Separate the connector halves. Refer to
Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, J 38125-4. 2. Inspect the connector halves for contamination.
Contamination will result in a white or green build-up within the connector body or between
terminals, causing HI terminal resistance, intermittent contact or an open circuit. An underhood or
underbody connector that shows signs of contamination should be replaced in its entirety:
terminals, seals and connector body.
3. Using an equivalent male terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, check the retention
force of the female terminal in question by
inserting and removing the male terminal to the female terminal in the connector body. Good
terminal contact will require a certain amount of force to separate the terminals.
4. Using an equivalent female terminal from the Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A, compare the
retention force of this terminal to the female
terminal in question by joining and separating the male terminal to the good female terminal, and
then joining and separating the male terminal to the female terminal in question. If the retention
force is significantly different between the two female terminals, replace the female terminal in
question (refer to Terminal Repair Kit, J 38125-A).
If a visual (physical) check does not reveal the cause of the problem, the vehicle may be able to be
driven with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) connected to the suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage
reading when the problem occurs indicates the problem may be in that circuit.
Detecting Electrical Intermittents
PROCEDURE
Use the following procedure to detect intermittent terminal contact or a broken wire with an
intermittent connection inside the insulation.
The J 39200 Digital Multimeter has the ability to monitor current, resistance, or voltage while
recording the minimum (MIN) and maximum (MAX) values measured. The meter can also be set to
display the average (AVG) value measured.
When diagnosing circuits that have voltage applied, use the voltage setting to monitor a connector
(or length of a circuit) which is suspected of having an intermittent connection but is currently
operating normally. 1. Connect the J 39200 Digital Multimeter to both sides of a suspect connector
(still connected) or from one end of a suspect circuit to the other.
This will continuously monitor the terminal contacts or length of wire being checked. Refer to Meter
Connections for examples of the various methods for connecting the meter to the circuit. See:
General Troubleshooting Procedures/Meter Connections
2. Set the meter for voltage. Since the "MIN MAX" mode does not use auto ranging, manually
select the voltage range necessary before
proceeding.
3. Press the "MIN MAX" button. The meter should read "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond
record) and emit a 1/4 second beep. The meter is
now ready to record and will generate an audible tone for any change in voltage. At this point, you
may wish to press the "PEAK MIN MAX" button, which will record any voltage variations that occur
for at least 1 millisecond.
4. Try to simulate the condition that is potentially causing an intermittent connection, either by
wiggling connections or wiring, test driving or
performing other operations. If an open or resistance is created, a voltage will be present and the
meter will emit a tone for as long as the open or resistance exists. Any change in voltage will cause
the meter to emit a tone for no less than 1/4 second. (Listening for a tone while manipulating wiring
is very helpful for narrowing down an intermittent connection.)
Use the MIN and MAX values when the meter is out of sight or sound range, in noisy areas or for
test driving when it may not be possible to monitor the meter.
To check the MIN and MAX recorded voltages press "MIN MAX" once for MAX and twice for MIN.
A variation between MIN and MAX recorded voltages (unless nearly 0 volts) suggests an
intermittent open or that resistance exists and should be repaired as necessary.
IMPORTANT: The "100 ms RECORD" (100 millisecond record) mode is NOT the amount of time
allowed to perform a specific procedure. It is the amount of time used to record each snapshot of
information used for calculating "AVG" when in the "MIN MAX" mode.
Intermittents and Poor Connections
Most intermittents are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring, although occasionally a
sticking relay or solenoid can be a problem. Some items to check are:
^ Poor mating of connector halves, or terminals not fully seated in the connector body (backed out).
^ Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. The terminals must be clean and free of any foreign material
which could impede proper terminal contact.
^ Damaged connector body, exposing the terminals to moisture and dirt, as well as not maintaining
proper terminal orientation with the component or mating connector.
^ Improperly formed or damaged terminals. All connector terminals in problem circuits should be
checked carefully to ensure good contact tension. Use a corresponding mating terminal to check
for proper tension. Refer to Checking Terminal Contact for the specific procedure.
^ The J 35616-A Connector Test Adapter Kit must be used whenever a diagnostic procedure
requests checking or probing a terminal. Using the adapter will ensure that no damage to the
terminal will occur, as well as giving an idea of whether contact tension is sufficient. If contact
tension seems incorrect, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General Troubleshooting
Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
^ Poor terminal-to-wire connection. Some conditions which fall under this description are poor
crimps, poor solder joints, crimping over wire insulation rather than the wire itself, corrosion in the
wire-to-terminal contact area, etc.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7988
^ Wire insulation which is rubbed through, causing an intermittent short as the bare area touches
other wiring or parts of the vehicle.
^ Wiring broken inside the insulation. This condition could cause a continuity check to show a good
circuit, but if only 1 or 2 strands of a multi-strand type wire are intact, resistance could be far too HI.
To avoid any of the above problems when making wiring or terminal repairs, always follow the
instructions for wiring and terminal repair outlined under the Repair Procedures. See: Wire Repair
Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures
Meter Connections
The previous diagnostic procedure was written to detect intermittents using the meter set to
voltage. Whether using the current, voltage or resistance setting to detect intermittents, it is
necessary to connect the meter to the circuit.
Following are examples of the various methods of connecting the meter to the circuit to be
checked:
^ Backprobe both ends of the connector and either hold the leads in place while manipulating the
connector or tape the leads to the harness for continuous monitoring while performing other
operations or test driving. (Do not backprobe "Weather Pack(R)" type connectors.)
^ Disconnect the harness at both ends of the suspect circuit where it connects either to a
component or to other harnesses.
^ Use Connector Test Adapter Kit J 35616-A to connect the meter to the circuit.
^ If the system being diagnosed has a specified Pinout or breakout box, it may be used to simplify
connecting the meter to the circuit or for checking multiple circuits quickly.
Aftermarket Accessories
Always check for aftermarket accessories as the first step in diagnosing electrical problems. If the
vehicle is so equipped, disconnect the system to verify that these add-on accessories are not the
cause of the problems.
Some possible causes of vehicle problems related to aftermarket accessories include:
1. Power feeds connected to points other than the Battery. 2. Antenna location. 3. Transceiver
wiring located too close to vehicle electronic modules or wiring. 4. Poor shielding or poor
connectors on antenna feed line.
Probing (Frontprobe & Backprobe)
After probing, when reconnecting connectors or replacing terminals, always be sure to reinstall
Connector Position Assurance (CPA) and Terminal Position Assurance (TPA).
Frontprobe When frontprobing of connectors is required, always use a mating terminal adapter
from Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A). The use of proper adapters will ensure that proper
terminal contact integrity is maintained. (refer to Procedures in Checking Terminal Contact).
Backprobe Only backprobe connector terminals when specifically called for in diagnostic
procedures. Since backprobing can be a source of damage to connector terminals, extra care must
be taken to avoid deforming the terminal, either by forcing the test probe too far into the cavity or by
using too large a test probe.
After backprobing any connector, always check for terminal damage. If terminal damage is
suspected, check for proper terminal contact, refer to Checking Terminal Contact. See: General
Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Testing For Voltage
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7989
Voltage Check
1. Connect one lead of a test light to a known good ground. When using a Digital Voltmeter (DVM),
be sure the voltmeter's negative lead is
connected to ground.
2. Connect the other lead of the test light or voltmeter to a selected test point (connector or
terminal). 3. If the test light illuminates, there is voltage present. When using a DVM, note the
voltage reading.
Testing For Continuity
Continuity Check Through A Switch
1. Remove the fuse to the circuit involved. 2. Connect one lead of a self-powered test light or
ohmmeter to one end of the part of the circuit you wish to test. 3. Connect the other lead to the
other end of the circuit. 4. If the self-powered test light glows, there is continuity. When using an
ohmmeter, LO or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7990
Voltage Drop Test
This test checks for voltage being lost along a wire, or through a connection or switch.
1. Connect the positive lead of a Digital Voltmeter (DVM) to the end of the wire (or to one side of
the connection or switch) which is closer to the
Battery.
2. Connect the negative lead to the other end of the wire (or the other side of the connection or
switch). 3. Operate the circuit. 4. The DVM will show the difference in voltage between the two
points.
Testing For Short to Ground
Testing For Short With Self Powered Test Light Or Ohmmeter
WITH A TEST LIGHT OR DIGITAL VOLTMETER (DVM)
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the load. 2. Connect a test light or voltmeter across the
fuse terminals (be sure that the fuse is powered). 3. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the
harness from side to side. Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching
the
test light or DVM.
4. When the test light glows, or the DVM registers, there is a short to ground in the wiring near that
point.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7991
Testing For Short With Test Light Or DVM
WITH A SELF-POWERED TEST LIGHT OR OHMMETER.
1. Remove the blown fuse and disconnect the Battery and load. 2. Connect one lead of a
self-powered test light or ohmmeter to the fuse terminal on the load side. 3. Connect the other lead
to a known good ground. 4. Beginning near the Fuse Block, wiggle the harness from side to side.
Continue this at convenient points (about 6 inches apart) while watching the
self-powered test light or ohmmeter.
5. When the self-powered test light glows, or the ohmmeter registers, there is a short to ground in
the wiring near that point.
FUSES POWERING SEVERAL LOADS
1. Find the schematic under "Fuse Block Details," for the fuse that has blown. 2. Open the first
connector or switch leading from the fuse to each load. 3. Replace the fuse.
^ If the fuse blows, the short is in the wiring leading to the first connector or switch. Use a test light
or meter as described.
^ If fuse does not blow, refer to next step.
4. Close each connector or switch until the fuse blows in order to find which circuit has the short.
Connect test lamp or meter at the connector to the
suspect circuit (disconnected) rather than at the fuse terminals.
Test Light/Digital Voltmeter
Use a test light to check for voltage. A Test Light (J 34l42-B) is made up of a 12 volt light bulb with
a pair of leads attached. After grounding one lead, touch the other lead to various points along the
circuit where voltage should be present. When the bulb goes ON, there is voltage at the point being
tested.
A Digital Voltmeter (DVM) can be used instead of a test light. While a test light shows whether or
not voltage is present, a DVM indicates how much voltage is present.
An increasing number of circuits include solid state control modules. One example is the Engine
Control Module (ECM). Voltages in these circuits should be tested only with a 10-megohm or
higher impedance DVM or multimeter (J 39200). Unless directed to within the diagnostics, NEVER
use a test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage to these components
may result.
When testing for voltage or continuity at the connection, it is not necessary to separate the two
halves of the connector. Unless testing a Weather Pack(R) connector, always probe the connector
from the back. Always check both sides of the connector. An accumulation of dirt and corrosion
between contact surfaces is sometimes a cause of electrical problems. Refer to Procedures in
checking terminal contact. See: General Troubleshooting Procedures/Checking Terminal Contacts
Connector Test Adapters
Connector Test Adapter Kit (J 35616-A) is available for making tests and measurements at
separated connectors. This kit contains an assortment of probes which mate with many of the
types of terminals you will see. Avoid using paper clips and other substitutes since they can
damage terminals and cause incorrect measurements.
Self-Powered Test Light
A self-powered test light (J 21008-A) can be used to check for continuity. This tool is made up of a
light bulb, Battery and two leads. If the leads are
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7992
touched together, the bulb will go ON.
A self-powered test light is used only on an unpowered circuit. First remove the fuse which feeds
the circuit you're working on. Select two specific points along the circuit through which there should
be continuity. Connect one lead of the self-powered test light to each point. If there is continuity, the
test light circuit will be completed and the bulb will go ON.
NEVER use a self-powered test light on circuits that contain solid state components, since damage
to these components may result.
Ohmmeter
An ohmmeter can be used instead of a self-powered test light. The ohmmeter shows how much
resistance there is between two points along a circuit. LO resistance means good continuity.
Circuits which include any solid state control modules, such as the Engine Control Module (ECM),
should be tested only with a 10-megohm or higher impedance digital multimeter (J 39200).
When measuring resistance with a Digital Voltmeter (DVM), the vehicle Battery should be
disconnected. This will prevent incorrect readings. DVMs apply such a small voltage to measure
resistance that the presence of voltages can upset a resistance reading.
Diodes and solid state components in a circuit can cause an ohmmeter to give a false reading. To
find out if a component is affecting a measurement, take a reading once, reverse the leads and
take a second reading. If the readings differ, the solid state component is affecting the
measurement.
Fused Jumper Wire
A fused jumper (J 36169) is available with small clamp connectors providing adaptation to most
connectors without damage. This fused jumper wire is supplied with a 20 amp fuse which may not
be suitable for some circuits. Do not use a fuse with a higher rating than the fuse that protects the
circuit being tested.
NOTE: A fused jumper may not protect solid state components from being damaged.
Short Finder
Short Finders (J 8681-A) are available to locate hidden shorts to ground. The short finder creates a
pulsing magnetic field in the shorted circuit and shows you the location of the short through body
trim or sheet metal.
Fuse Tester
A simple tester (J 34764) can detect a blown fuse. To check a fuse, the tester is applied directly to
the fuse in the Fuse Block. Two probes contact the fuse, either into the slots of a flat fuse or to the
metal ends of a glass fuse. With power ON, a red Light Emitting Diode (LED) in the tester lights if
the fuse is open. The handle of the tester is a tool for removing either type of fuse.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7993
Special Tools
Circuit Breakers
A circuit breaker is a protective device designed to open the circuit when a current load is in excess
of rated breaker capacity. If there is a short or other type of overload condition in the circuit, the
excessive current will open the circuit between the circuit breaker terminals. There are two basic
types of circuit breakers used in GM vehicles: cycling and non-cycling.
Cycling Circuit Breaker The cycling breaker will open due to heat generated when excessive
current passes through it for a period of time. Once the circuit breaker cools, it will close again after
a few seconds. If the cause of the HI current is still present it will open again. It will continue to
cycle open and closed until the condition causing the HI current is removed.
Non-Cycling Circuit Breaker
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7994
There are two types of non-cycling circuit breakers. One type is mechanical and is nearly the same
as a cycling breaker. The difference is a small heater wire within the non-cycling circuit breaker.
This wire provides enough heat to keep the bimetallic element open until the current source is
removed.
The other type is solid state, called out in this section as Electronic Circuit Breaker (ECB). This
device has a Positive Temperature Coefficient. It increases its resistance greatly when excessive
current passes through it. The excessive current heats the ECB. As it heats, its resistance
increases, therefore having a Positive Temperature Coefficient. Eventually the resistance gets so
HI that the circuit is effectively open. The ECB will not reset until the circuit is opened, removing
voltage from its terminals. Once voltage is removed, the circuit breaker will re-close within a second
or two.
Fuses
Fuse Devices
The most common method of automotive wiring circuit protection is the fuse. A fuse is a device
that, by the melting of its element, opens an electrical circuit when the current exceeds a given
level for a sufficient time. The action is non-reversible and the fuse must be replaced each time a
circuit is overloaded or after a malfunction is repaired.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7995
Fuse Rating And Color
Fuses are color coded. The standardized color identification and ratings are shown. For service
replacement, non-color coded fuses of the same respective current rating can be used.
Examine a suspect fuse for a break in the element. If the element is broken or melted, replace the
fuse with one of equal current rating.
There are additional specific circuits with in-line fuses. These fuses are located within the individual
wiring harness and will appear to be an open circuit if blown.
Autofuse The Autofuse, normally referred to simply as "Fuse," is the most common circuit
protection device in today's vehicle. The Autofuse is most often used to protect the wiring assembly
between the Fuse Block and the system components.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7996
Maxifuse The Maxifuse was designed to replace the fusible link and Pacific Fuse elements. The
Maxifuse is designed to protect cables, normally between the battery and fuse block, from both
direct short circuits and resistive short circuits.
Compared to a fusible link or a Pacific Fuse element, the Maxifuse performs much more like an
Autofuse, although the average opening time is slightly longer. This is because the Maxifuse was
designed to be a slower blowing fuse, with less chance of nuisance blows.
Minifuse The Minifuse is a smaller version of the Autofuse and has a similar performance. As with
the Autofuse, the Minifuse is usually used to protect the wiring assembly between a fuse block and
system components. Since the Minifuse is a smaller device, it allows for more system specific
fusing to be accomplished within the same amount of space as Autofuses.
Pacific Fuse Element/Maxifuse The Pacific Fuse Element and Maxifuse were developed to be a
replacement for the fusible link. Like a fusible link, the fuses are designed to protect wiring from a
direct short to ground. These elements are easier to service and inspect than a fusible link and will
eventually replace fusible links in all future vehicle applications.
Fusible Links
Good And Damaged Fusible Links
In addition to circuit breakers and fuses, some circuits use fusible links to protect the wiring. Like
fuses, fusible links are "one-time" protection devices that will melt and create an open circuit.
Not all fusible link open Circuits can be detected by observation. Always inspect that there is
battery voltage past the fusible link to verify continuity.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7997
Wire Size Conversion Table
Fusible links are used instead of a fuse in wiring circuits that are not normally fused, such as the
ignition circuit. For AWG sizes, each fusible link is four wire gage sizes smaller than the wire it is
designed to protect. For example: to protect a 10 gage wire use a 14 gage link or for metric, to
protect a 5 mm Sq. wire use a 2 mm Sq. link, refer to Wire Size Conversion Table. Links are
marked on the insulation with wire-gage size because the heavy insulation makes the link appear
to be a heavier gage than it actually is. The same wire size fusible link must be used when
replacing a blown fusible link.
Fusible links are available with three types of insulation: Hypalon(R), Silicone/GXL (SIL/GXL) and
Expanded Duty. All future vehicles that use fusible links will utilize the Expanded Duty type of
fusible link. When servicing fusible links, all fusible links can be replaced with the Expanded Duty
type. SIL/GXI fusible links can be used to replace either SIL/GXI or Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Hypalon(R) fusible links can only be used to replace Hypalon(R) fusible links.
Determining characteristics of the types of fusible links are:
- Hypalon(R) (limited use): only available in 0.35 mm Sq. or smaller and its insulation is one color
all the way through.
- SIL/GXL (widely used): available in all sizes and has a white inner core under the outer color of
insulation.
- Expanded Duty: available in all sizes, has an insulation that is one color all the way through and
has three dots following the writing on the insulation. Service fusible links are available in many
lengths.
Service fusible links are available in many lengths. Choose the shortest length that is suitable. If
the fusible link is to be cut from a spool, it should be cut 150-225 mm (approx. 6-9 in.) long. NEVER
make a fusible link longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.).
CAUTION: Fusible links cut longer than 225 mm (approx. 9 in.) will not provide sufficient overload
protection.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7998
Single Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link, cut it off beyond the splice. Replace with a repair link. When
connecting the repair link, strip wire and use staking-type pliers to crimp the splice securely in two
places. For more details on splicing procedures, refer to "Typical Electrical Repair Procedures."
Use crimp and seal splices whenever possible. See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical
Repair Procedures
Double Wire Feed Fusible Link
To replace a damaged fusible link which feeds two harness wires, cut them both off beyond the
splice. Use two repair links, one spliced to each harness wire.
General Information
The purpose of circuit protection is to protect the wiring assembly during normal and overload
conditions. An overload is defined as a current requirement that is higher than normal. This
overload could be caused by a short circuit or system malfunction. The short circuit could be the
result of a pinched or cut wire or an internal device short circuit, such as an electronic module
failure.
The circuit protection device is only applied to protect the wiring assembly, and not the electrical
load at the end of the assembly. For example, if an electronic component short circuits, the circuit
protection device will assure a minimal amount of damage to the wiring assembly. However, it will
not necessarily prevent damage to the component.
There are three basic types of circuit protection devices: Circuit Breaker, Fuse and Fusible Link.
Diode Replacement
Many vehicle electrical systems use a diode to isolate circuits and protect the components from
voltage spikes. When installing a new diode, use the following procedure:
Step 1: Open the Harness If the diode is taped to the harness, remove all of the tape.
Step 2: Remove inoperative Diode Paying attention to current flow direction, remove inoperative
diode from the harness with a suitable soldering tool. If the diode is located next to a connector
terminal, remove the terminal(s) from the connector to prevent damage from the soldering tool.
Step 3: Strip the Insulation Carefully strip away a section of insulation next to the old soldered
portion of the wire(s). Do not remove any more than is needed to attach the new diode.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 7999
Diode Identification
Step 4: Install New Diode Check current flow direction of the new diode, being sure to install the
diode with correct bias. Refer the image for replacement diode symbols and current flow
explanations. Attach the new diode to the wire(s) using 60/40 rosin core solder. Use a beat sink
(aluminum alligator clip) attached across the diode wire ends to protect the diode from excess heat.
Follow the manufacturer's instructions for the soldering equipment you are using.
Step 5: Install Terminal(s) Install terminal(s) into the connector body if previously removed in Step
2.
Step 6: Tape Diode to Harness Tape the diode to the harness or connector using electrical tape.
To prevent shorts to ground and water intrusion, completely cover all exposed wire and diode
attachment points.
Acceptable Diode Replacements
In the event 1 amp, 50 PIV (Peak Inverse Rating) diodes are unavailable, a universal diode with a 1
amp, 400 PIV rating can be used for the following applications: ^
A/C Compressor Clutch
^ ABS/4WAL (the ABS Diode on the Delco Moraine is hidden inside of an electrical connector
under the carpet at the RH panel)
^ Wiper
^ Charging System (hidden in wire harness)
^ Parking Brake (vehicle with ABS)
^ Relays
^ Solenoids
^ Diesel Glow Plug Circuit
General Information
OPEN CIRCUIT
An open circuit is an incomplete circuit. Power cannot reach the load or reach ground. If a circuit is
open, active components do not energize.
SHORT CIRCUIT
A short circuit is an unwanted connection between one part of the circuit and either ground or
another part of the circuit. A short circuit causes a fuse to blow or a circuit breaker to open.
Heated Oxygen Sensor (O2S) Repair
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8000
If the Heated Oxygen Sensor pigtail wiring, connector or terminal is damaged, the entire Oxygen
Sensor Assembly must be replaced. Do not attempt to repair the wiring, connector or terminals. In
order for the sensor to function properly, it must have provided to it a clean air reference. This
clean air reference is obtained by way of the Oxygen Sensor signal and heater wires. Any attempt
to repair the wires, connectors or terminals could result in the obstruction of the air reference and
degraded Oxygen Sensor performance.
The following guidelines should be used when servicing the Heated Oxygen Sensor:
^ Do not apply contact cleaner or other materials to the sensor or vehicle harness connectors.
These materials may get into the sensor causing poor performance. Also the sensor pigtail and
harness wires must not be damaged in such a way that the wires inside are exposed. This could
provide a path for foreign materials to enter the sensor and cause performance problems.
^ Neither the sensor or vehicle lead wires should be bent sharply or kinked. Sharp bends, kinks,
etc., could block the reference air path through the lead wire.
^ Do not remove or defeat the Oxygen Sensor ground wire (where applicable). Vehicles that utilize
the ground wired sensor may rely on this ground as the only ground contact to the sensor.
Removal of the ground wire will also cause poor engine performance.
^ To prevent damage due to water intrusion, be sure that the peripheral seal remains intact on the
vehicle harness connector.
The Engine Harness may be repaired using Packard's Crimp and Splice Seals Terminal Repair Kit
J 38125-A. Under no circumstances should repairs be soldered since this could result in the air
reference being obstructed.
General Information
^ The following general repair procedures can be used to repair most types of connectors. The
repair procedures are divided into three general groups: Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat and Weather
Pack(R).
^ Use the proper Pick(s) or Tool(s) that apply to the terminal.
^ The Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Push-to-Seat and Pull-to-Seat Connectors
Typical Push-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Typical Pull-to-seat Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Push-to-Seat or Pull-to-Seat connectors. The steps are illustrated
with typical connectors. Your connector may differ, but the repair steps are similar. Some
connectors do not require all the steps shown. Skip those that don't apply.
Step 1: Remove any Connector Position Assurance (CPA) Locks . CPAs are designed to retain
connectors when mated.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8001
Step 2: Remove any Terminal Position Assurance (TPA) Locks. TPAs are designed to keep the
terminal from backing out of the connector.
NOTE: The TPA must be removed prior to terminal removal and must be replaced when the
terminal is repaired and reseated.
Step 3: Open any secondary locks. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually
molded to the connector.
Step 4: Separate the connector halves and back out seals.
Step 5: Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this
position.
Step 6: Locate the terminal lock tang in the connector canal.
Step 7: Insert the proper size pick (refer to Terminal Repair kit J 38125-A) straight into the
connector canal at the mating end of the connector.
Step 8: Depress the locking tang to unseat the terminal. ^
Push-to-Seat - Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
^ Pull-to-Seat - Gently push on the lead to remove the terminal through the front of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 9: Inspect terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repairs). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 10: Reform lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body. Apply grease if connector was
originally equipped with grease.
Step 11: Install any CPAs or TPAs, close any secondary locks and join connector halves.
Weather Pack(R) Connectors
Typical Weather Pack(R) Connector And Terminal
Follow the steps below to repair Weather Pack(R) connectors.
Step 1: Separate the connector halves.
Step 2: Open secondary lock. A secondary lock aids in terminal retention and is usually molded to
the connector.
Step 3:
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8002
Grasp the lead and push the terminal to the forward most position. Hold the lead at this position.
Step 4: Insert the Weather Pack(R) terminal removal tool into the front (mating end) of the
connector cavity until it rests on the cavity shoulder.
Step 5: Gently pull on the lead to remove the terminal through the back of the connector.
NOTE: NEVER use force to remove a terminal from a connector.
Step 6: Inspect the terminal and connector for damage. Repair as necessary (refer to Terminal
Repair). See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Terminal Repairs
Step 7: Re-form the lock tang and reseat terminal in connector body.
Step 8: Close secondary locks and join connector halves.
Repairing Short Circuits Caused By Damaged Wire
^ Locate the damaged wire.
^ Find and correct the cause of the wire insulation damage.
^ For minor damage, tape over the wire. If damage is more extensive, replace the faulty segment of
the wire (refer to the Splicing Instructions for copper or shielded cable for the correct splicing
procedure).
See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper Wire Using
Splice Clips See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair Procedures/Splicing Copper
Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves See: Wire Repair Procedures/Typical Electrical Repair
Procedures/Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Splicing Copper Wire Using Crimp and Seal Splice Sleeves
Crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and coaxial to
form a one-to-one splice. They are to be used where there are special requirements such as
moisture sealing. Crimp and seal splice sleeves are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). The crimp and seal splice sleeves may be used on all types of insulation except Tefzel and
coaxial and may only be used to form a one-to-one splice.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of wire later if you decide to cut more wire to change the location of a splice. You may
have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.) away
from other splices, harness branches or connectors. This will help prevent moisture from bridging
adjacent splices and causing damage.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation If it is necessary to add a length of wire to the existing harness, be
certain to use the same size as the original wire.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8003
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic and convert the metric size to the
equivalent AWG size or use an AWG wire gage. If unsure about the wire size, begin with the
largest opening in the wire stripper and work down until a clean strip of the insulation is removed.
Strip approximately 7.5 mm (5/16 in.) of insulation from each wire to be spliced. Be careful to avoid
nicking or cutting any of the wires. Check the stripped wire for nicks or cut strands. If the wire is
damaged, repeat this procedure after removing the damaged section.
Crimp And Seal Splice Sleeve Chart
Step 4: Select and Position the Splice Sleeve Select the proper splice sleeve according to wire
size. The splice sleeves and tool tests are color coded (refer to Chart).
Hand Crimp Tool
Using the J 38125-8 splice crimp tool, position the splice sleeve in the proper color nest of the hand
crimp tool. Place the splice sleeve in the nest so that the crimp falls midway between the end of the
barrel and the stop.
Seal Splice Sequence
The sleeve has a stop in the middle of the barrel to prevent the wire from going further. Close the
hand crimper handles slightly to hold the splice sleeve firmly in the proper nest.
Step 5: Insert Wires into Splice Sleeve and Crimp Insert the wire into the splice sleeve until it hits
the barrel stop and close the handles of the J 38125-8 crimper tightly until the crimper handles
open when released. The crimper handles will not open until the proper amount of pressure is
applied to the splice sleeve. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for opposite end of the splice.
Step 6: Shrink the Insulation Around the Splice Using the Ultratorch J 38125-5 (follow instructions
that accompany Ultratorch), apply heat where the barrel is crimped. Gradually move the heat
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8004
barrel to the open end of the tubing, shrinking the tubing completely as the heat is moved along the
insulation. A small amount of sealant will come out of the end of the tubing when sufficient
shrinking is achieved.
Splicing Copper Wire Using Splice Clips
Splice clips are included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit. The splice clip is a general purpose
wire repair device. It may not be acceptable for applications having special requirements such as
moisture sealing.
Step 1: Open the Harness If the harness is taped, remove the tape. To avoid wire insulation
damage, use a sewing "seam ripper" to cut open the harness (available from sewing supply
stores). If the harness has a black plastic conduit, simply pull out the desired wire.
Step 2: Cut the Wire Begin by cutting as little wire off the harness as possible. You may need the
extra length of the wire later if you decide to cut more wire off to change the location of a splice.
You may have to adjust splice locations to make certain that each splice is at least 40 mm (1.5 in.)
away from other splices, harness branches or connectors.
Wire Size Conversion Table
Step 3: Strip the Insulation When replacing a wire, use a wire of the same size as the original wire
or larger. The schematics list wire size in metric units. The table shows the commercial AWG wire
sizes that can be used to replace each metric wire size. Each AWG size is either equal to or larger
than the equivalent metric size.
To find the correct wire size either find the wire on the schematic page and convert the metric size
to the AWG size, or use an AWG wire gage.
If you aren't sure of the wire size, start with the largest opening in the wire stripper and work down
until a clean strip of the insulation is removed. Be careful to avoid nicking or cutting any of the
wires.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8005
Entering The Splice Clip
Step 4: Crimp the Wires Select the proper clip to secure the splice. To determine the proper clip
size for the wire being spliced, follow the directions included in the J 38125-A Terminal Repair Kit.
Select the correct anvil on the crimper. (On most crimpers your choice is limited to either a small or
large anvil.) Overlap the stripped wire ends and hold them between your thumb and forefinger as
shown. Then, center the splice clip under the stripped wires and hold it in place. ^
Open the crimping tool to its full width and rest one handle on a firm flat surface.
^ Center the back of the splice clip on the proper anvil and close the crimping tool to the point
where the former touches the wings of the clip.
Crimping The Splice Clip
^ Make sure that the clip and wires are still in the correct position. Then, apply steady pressure until
the crimping tool closes.
^ Before crimping the ends of the clip, be sure that: The wires extend beyond the clip in each direction.
- No strands of wire are cut loose.
- No insulation is caught under the clip.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8006
Completing The Crimp
Crimp the splice again, once on each end. Do not let the crimping tool extend beyond the edge of
the clip or you may damage or nick the wires.
Applying The Solder
Step 5: Solder Apply 60/40 rosin core solder to the opening in the back of the clip. Follow the
manufacturer's instruction for the solder equipment you are using.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8007
Proper First Taping
Step 6: Tape the Splice Center and roll the splicing tape. The tape should cover the entire splice.
Roll on enough tape to duplicate the thickness of the insulation on the existing wires. Do not flag
the tape. Flagged tape may not provide enough insulation, and the flagged ends will tangle with the
other wires in the harness.
Proper Second Taping
If the wire does not belong in a conduit or other harness covering, tape the wire again. Use a
winding motion to cover the first piece of tape.
Splicing Twisted/Shielded Cable
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8008
Twisted/shielded Cable
Twisted/shielded cable is sometimes used to protect wiring from electrical noise (stray signals). For
example, two-conductor cable of this construction is used between the Engine Control Module
(ECM) and the distributor.
Step 1: Remove Outer Jacket Remove the outer jacket and discard it. Be careful to avoid cutting
into the drain wire or the mylar tape.
Step 2: Unwrap the Tape Unwrap the aluminium/mylar tape, but do not remove it. The tape will be
used to rewrap the twisted conductors after the splices have been made.
The Untwisted Conductors
Step 3: Prepare the Splice Untwist the conductors. Then, prepare the splice by following the
splicing instructions for copper wire presented earlier. Remember to stagger splices to avoid
shorts.
Step 4: Re-assemble the Cable After you have spliced and taped each wire, rewrap the conductors
with the mylar tape. Be careful to avoid wrapping the drain wire in the tape.
The Re-assembled Cable
Next, splice the drain wire following the splicing instructions for copper wire. Then, wrap the drain
wire around the conductors and mylar tape.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8009
Proper Taping
Step 5: Tape the Cable Tape over the entire cable using a winding motion. This tape will replace
the section of the jacket you removed to make the repair.
Terminal Repairs
Terminal Repair
The following repair procedures can be used to repair Push-to-Seat, Pull-to-Seat or Weather
Pack(R) terminals. Some terminals do not require all steps shown. Skip those that don't apply. The
Terminal Repair Kit (J 38125-A) contains further information.
Step 1: Cut off terminal between core and insulation crimp (minimize wire loss) and remove seal for
Weather Pack(R) terminals.
Step 2: Apply correct seal per gauge size of wire and slide back along wire to enable insulation
removal (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 3: Remove insulation.
Step 4: Align seal with end of cable insulation (Weather Pack(R) terminals only).
Step 5: Position strip (and seal for Weather Pack(R)) in terminal.
Step 6: Hand crimp core wings.
Step 7: Hand crimp insulation wings (non-Weather Pack(R)). Hand crimp insulation wings around
seal and cable (Weather Pack(R)).
Step 8: Solder all hand crimped terminals.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8010
Headlamp Switch: Electrical Diagrams
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 1 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8011
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 2 Of 4)
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Wagon) (Part 4 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8012
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 1 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8013
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 2 Of 4)
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Sedan) (Part 4 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8014
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 1 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8015
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 2 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8016
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Coupe And Convertable) (Part 4 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8017
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 3 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8018
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 3 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8019
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Wagon) (Part 4 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8020
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 3 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8021
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 3 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8022
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Sedan) (Part 4 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8023
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 3 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8024
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Part 3 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 8025
Light Switch Details: With Daytime Running Lights (T61) (Coupe And Convertable) (Part 4 Of 4)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 8026
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
The headlamp switch is part of the turn signal lever assembly and is not serviceable. The
headlamp switch, turn signal lever and cruise control switch must be replaced as an assembly.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Recalls for Horn Switch: > NHTSA96I001000 > Jan > 96 > Recall
96I001000: Horn Assembly Defect
Horn Switch: Recalls Recall 96I001000: Horn Assembly Defect
This is not a safety recall in accordance with Federal Regulation 573. However, it is deemed a
safety improvement campaign by the agency. These vehicles were built with insufficient retention
of the horn pad. The horn pad can separate from the steering wheel falling between the steering
wheel spokes. The horn pad could become jammed between the steering wheel spokes and the
turn signal lever, resulting in damage to the turn signal lever, horn pad, and horn wiring. Dealers
will modify the horn pad retention clips, install horn pad retention brackets to the steering wheel,
reinstall the horn pad and assure that the hornpad is properly retained.
NOTE: General Motors has decided to conduct a safety improvement campaign to modify the horn
pad on these vehicles. Owners can contact Chevrolet at1-800-222-1020.
1993 CHEVROLET CAVALIER 1994 CHEVROLET CAVALIER
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Horn Switch: > NHTSA96I001000
> Jan > 96 > Recall 96I001000: Horn Assembly Defect
Horn Switch: All Technical Service Bulletins Recall 96I001000: Horn Assembly Defect
This is not a safety recall in accordance with Federal Regulation 573. However, it is deemed a
safety improvement campaign by the agency. These vehicles were built with insufficient retention
of the horn pad. The horn pad can separate from the steering wheel falling between the steering
wheel spokes. The horn pad could become jammed between the steering wheel spokes and the
turn signal lever, resulting in damage to the turn signal lever, horn pad, and horn wiring. Dealers
will modify the horn pad retention clips, install horn pad retention brackets to the steering wheel,
reinstall the horn pad and assure that the hornpad is properly retained.
NOTE: General Motors has decided to conduct a safety improvement campaign to modify the horn
pad on these vehicles. Owners can contact Chevrolet at1-800-222-1020.
1993 CHEVROLET CAVALIER 1994 CHEVROLET CAVALIER
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Turn Signal Switch: Component Locations
LH Side Of I/P
Turn/Hazard Headlight Switch Assembly is located Top of Steering Column, below Steering Wheel
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 8044
LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 8045
Turn Signal Switch: Service and Repair
WARNING:
On models equipped with Airbags, Refer to Air Bags (Supplemental Restraint Systems) Service
and Repair Disarming procedures before performing any repair. See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag
Systems/Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Remove steering wheel. Refer to Steering and Suspension /
Steering / Steering Wheel. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering
Wheel/Service and Repair
3. Remove lower steering column cover upper and lower attaching bolts, then remove lower
steering column cover. 4. Separate rose bud fastener, integral to wiring harness, from jacket
assembly. 5. Remove turn signal switch attaching screws, the depress locking tab and remove turn
signal switch electrical connectors. 6. Reverse procedure to install. Torque turn signal switch
attaching screws to 48 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Lighting - Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement
Tail Lamp: Technical Service Bulletins Lighting - Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 01-08-42-001H
Date: January 05, 2011
Subject: Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement Guidelines
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 01-08-42-001G (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
The following information is being provided to better define the causes of condensation in exterior
lamps and includes guidelines for determining the difference between a lamp with a normal
atmospheric condition (condensation) and a lamp with a water leak.
Some exterior lamps, such as cornering, turn signal, backup, headlamps or tail lamps may exhibit
very small droplets of water, a fine mist or white fog (condensation) on the inside of the lamp lens.
This may be more noticeable on lamps with "multi-lens" designs and may be normal during certain
weather conditions.
Condensation occurs when the air inside the lamp assembly, through atmospheric changes,
reaches the "dew point". When this takes place, the moisture in the air within the lamp assembly
condenses, creating a fine mist or white fog on the inside surface of the lamp lens.
Most exterior lamps on General Motors vehicles use a vented design and feature a replaceable
bulb assembly. They are designed to remove any accumulated moisture vapor by expelling it
through a vent system. The vent system operates at all times, however, it is most effective when
the lamps are ON or when the vehicle is in motion. Depending on the size, shape and location of
the lamp on the vehicle, and the atmospheric conditions occurring, the amount of time required to
clear the lamp may vary from 2 to 6 hours.
Completely sealed headlamp assemblies (sealed beams) are still used on a limited number of
models being manufactured today. These lamps require the replacement of the complete lamp
assembly if a bulb filament burns out.
Condensation 2006 TrailBlazer Shown
A Fine Mist or White Fog on the Inside Surface of the Lamp Lens Occurring After a Period of High
Humidity
- May be located primarily in the lens corners (near the vents) and SHOULD NOT cover more than
half the lens surface.
- The condition should clear of moisture when the vehicle is parked in a dry environment, or when
the vehicle is driven with the lights ON.
- A comparison of the equivalent lamp on the opposing side of the vehicle indicates a SIMILAR
performance.
If the above conditions are noted, the customer should be advised that replacement of a lamp
assembly may not correct this condition.
Water Leak New Style Pickup Shown
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Tail Lamp > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Lighting - Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement > Page 8050
Numerous & Various Size Drops of Water Collecting on the Inside Surface of the Lamp Lens After
the Vehicle Has Been Exposed to Rain or a Car Washing Environment
- A condition that covers more than half the surface of the lamp lens.
- An accumulation of water in the bottom of the lamp assembly.
- A condition that WON'T clear when the vehicle is parked in a dry environment, or when the
vehicle is driven with the lights ON.
- A comparison of the equivalent lamp on the opposing side of the vehicle indicates a different
performance.
Any of the above conditions would indicate the need to service the lens or lamp assembly.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Flasher > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Flasher > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 8056
Behind LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Lighting - Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement
Turn Signal Lamp: Technical Service Bulletins Lighting - Exterior Lamp Condensation and
Replacement
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 01-08-42-001H
Date: January 05, 2011
Subject: Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement Guidelines
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn)
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 model year. Please discard Corporate
Bulletin Number 01-08-42-001G (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
The following information is being provided to better define the causes of condensation in exterior
lamps and includes guidelines for determining the difference between a lamp with a normal
atmospheric condition (condensation) and a lamp with a water leak.
Some exterior lamps, such as cornering, turn signal, backup, headlamps or tail lamps may exhibit
very small droplets of water, a fine mist or white fog (condensation) on the inside of the lamp lens.
This may be more noticeable on lamps with "multi-lens" designs and may be normal during certain
weather conditions.
Condensation occurs when the air inside the lamp assembly, through atmospheric changes,
reaches the "dew point". When this takes place, the moisture in the air within the lamp assembly
condenses, creating a fine mist or white fog on the inside surface of the lamp lens.
Most exterior lamps on General Motors vehicles use a vented design and feature a replaceable
bulb assembly. They are designed to remove any accumulated moisture vapor by expelling it
through a vent system. The vent system operates at all times, however, it is most effective when
the lamps are ON or when the vehicle is in motion. Depending on the size, shape and location of
the lamp on the vehicle, and the atmospheric conditions occurring, the amount of time required to
clear the lamp may vary from 2 to 6 hours.
Completely sealed headlamp assemblies (sealed beams) are still used on a limited number of
models being manufactured today. These lamps require the replacement of the complete lamp
assembly if a bulb filament burns out.
Condensation 2006 TrailBlazer Shown
A Fine Mist or White Fog on the Inside Surface of the Lamp Lens Occurring After a Period of High
Humidity
- May be located primarily in the lens corners (near the vents) and SHOULD NOT cover more than
half the lens surface.
- The condition should clear of moisture when the vehicle is parked in a dry environment, or when
the vehicle is driven with the lights ON.
- A comparison of the equivalent lamp on the opposing side of the vehicle indicates a SIMILAR
performance.
If the above conditions are noted, the customer should be advised that replacement of a lamp
assembly may not correct this condition.
Water Leak New Style Pickup Shown
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Lamp > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Lighting - Exterior Lamp Condensation and Replacement > Page 8061
Numerous & Various Size Drops of Water Collecting on the Inside Surface of the Lamp Lens After
the Vehicle Has Been Exposed to Rain or a Car Washing Environment
- A condition that covers more than half the surface of the lamp lens.
- An accumulation of water in the bottom of the lamp assembly.
- A condition that WON'T clear when the vehicle is parked in a dry environment, or when the
vehicle is driven with the lights ON.
- A comparison of the equivalent lamp on the opposing side of the vehicle indicates a different
performance.
Any of the above conditions would indicate the need to service the lens or lamp assembly.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Turn Signal Switch: Component Locations
LH Side Of I/P
Turn/Hazard Headlight Switch Assembly is located Top of Steering Column, below Steering Wheel
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 8066
LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Lighting and Horns > Turn Signals > Turn Signal Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 8067
Turn Signal Switch: Service and Repair
WARNING:
On models equipped with Airbags, Refer to Air Bags (Supplemental Restraint Systems) Service
and Repair Disarming procedures before performing any repair. See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag
Systems/Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Remove steering wheel. Refer to Steering and Suspension /
Steering / Steering Wheel. See: Steering and Suspension/Steering/Steering
Wheel/Service and Repair
3. Remove lower steering column cover upper and lower attaching bolts, then remove lower
steering column cover. 4. Separate rose bud fastener, integral to wiring harness, from jacket
assembly. 5. Remove turn signal switch attaching screws, the depress locking tab and remove turn
signal switch electrical connectors. 6. Reverse procedure to install. Torque turn signal switch
attaching screws to 48 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > C2
A-Center Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > C2 > Page 8074
A-Center Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8075
Heated Glass Control Module: Diagrams
Harness Connector Faces: Heater-A/C And Rear Defogger Control Assembly- C1
Harness Connector Faces: Heater-A/C And Rear Defogger Control Assembly- C2
Harness Connector Faces: Heater-A/C And Rear Defogger Control Assembly- C3
Harness Connector Faces: Heater-A/C And Rear Defogger Control Assembly- C1 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Element > Heated Glass Control Module > Component
Information > Locations > Page 8076
Harness Connector Faces: Heater-A/C And Rear Defogger Control Assembly- C2 (Description)
Harness Connector Faces: Heater-A/C And Rear Defogger Control Assembly- C3 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > C2
A-Center Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > C2 > Page 8082
A-Center Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8083
Heated Glass Control Module: Diagrams
Harness Connector Faces: Heater-A/C And Rear Defogger Control Assembly- C1
Harness Connector Faces: Heater-A/C And Rear Defogger Control Assembly- C2
Harness Connector Faces: Heater-A/C And Rear Defogger Control Assembly- C3
Harness Connector Faces: Heater-A/C And Rear Defogger Control Assembly- C1 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Relays and Modules - Windows and Glass > Heated Glass Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Page 8084
Harness Connector Faces: Heater-A/C And Rear Defogger Control Assembly- C2 (Description)
Harness Connector Faces: Heater-A/C And Rear Defogger Control Assembly- C3 (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Coupe
Center Of Console (Coupe)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Coupe > Page 8090
Power Window Switch: Locations Station Wagon and Sedan
Center Of Console (Sedan Shown, Station Wagon Similar)
Center Of Console (Sedan Shown, Station Wagon Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 8091
Power Window Switch: Diagrams
Harness Connector Faces: Console Window Switch- C1 (All Except Coupe)
Harness Connector Faces: Console Window Switch- C2 (All Except Coupe)
Harness Connector Faces: Console Window Switch- C1 (All Except Coupe) (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 8092
Harness Connector Faces: Console Window Switch- C2 (All Except Coupe) (Description)
Harness Connector Faces: Console Window Switch (Coupe)
Harness Connector Faces: LH Rear Window Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 8093
Harness Connector Faces: RH Rear Window Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Component Information >
Locations > LH Front Power Window Motor Connector
Power Window Motor: Locations LH Front Power Window Motor Connector
LH Front Of Door (Coupe)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Component Information >
Locations > LH Front Power Window Motor Connector > Page 8099
LH Front Of Door (Convertible)
LH Front Door (Station Wagon Shown, Sedan Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Component Information >
Locations > LH Front Power Window Motor Connector > Page 8100
Power Window Motor: Locations LH Rear Power Window Motor Connector
Rear Of Passenger Compartment (Convertible)
LH Rear Door (Sedan And Station Wagon) (RH Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Component Information >
Locations > LH Front Power Window Motor Connector > Page 8101
Power Window Motor: Locations RH Front Power Window Motor Connector
RH Front Of Door (Coupe)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Component Information >
Locations > LH Front Power Window Motor Connector > Page 8102
RH Front Door (Convertible)
RH Front Door (Station Wagon Shown, Sedan Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Motor > Component Information >
Locations > LH Front Power Window Motor Connector > Page 8103
RH Rear Of Passenger Compartment (Convertible)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Coupe
Center Of Console (Coupe)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Coupe > Page 8108
Power Window Switch: Locations Station Wagon and Sedan
Center Of Console (Sedan Shown, Station Wagon Similar)
Center Of Console (Sedan Shown, Station Wagon Similar)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 8109
Power Window Switch: Diagrams
Harness Connector Faces: Console Window Switch- C1 (All Except Coupe)
Harness Connector Faces: Console Window Switch- C2 (All Except Coupe)
Harness Connector Faces: Console Window Switch- C1 (All Except Coupe) (Description)
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 8110
Harness Connector Faces: Console Window Switch- C2 (All Except Coupe) (Description)
Harness Connector Faces: Console Window Switch (Coupe)
Harness Connector Faces: LH Rear Window Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Power Window Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Page 8111
Harness Connector Faces: RH Rear Window Switch
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Back Window Glass > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion Information
Back Window Glass: Technical Service Bulletins Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-08-48-005D
Date: September 10, 2010
Subject: Distortion in Outer Surface of Vehicle Glass
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X 2010 and Prior Saturn
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-08-48-005C (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Distortion in the outer surface of the windshield glass, door glass or backlite glass may appear after
the vehicle has:
- Accumulated some mileage.
- Been frequently washed in automatic car washes, particularly "touchless" car washes.
This distortion may look like a subtle orange peel pattern, or may look like a drip or sag etched into
the surface of the glass.
Some car wash solutions contain a buffered solution of hydrofluoric acid which is used to clean the
glass. This should not cause a problem if used in the correct concentration. However, if not used
correctly, hydrofluoric acid will attack the glass, and over time, will cause visual distortion in the
outer surface of the glass which cannot be removed by scraping or polishing.
If this condition is suspected, look at the area of the windshield under the wipers or below the belt
seal on the side glass. The area of the glass below the wipers or belt seal will not be affected and
what looks like a drip or sag may be apparent at the edge of the wiper or belt seal. You may also
see a line on the glass where the wiper blade or the belt seal contacts the glass.
Important The repair will require replacing the affected glass and is not a result of a defect in
material or workmanship. Therefore, is not covered by New Vehicle Warranty.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Corner Window Glass >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion Information
Front Corner Window Glass: Technical Service Bulletins Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion
Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-08-48-005D
Date: September 10, 2010
Subject: Distortion in Outer Surface of Vehicle Glass
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X 2010 and Prior Saturn
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-08-48-005C (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Distortion in the outer surface of the windshield glass, door glass or backlite glass may appear after
the vehicle has:
- Accumulated some mileage.
- Been frequently washed in automatic car washes, particularly "touchless" car washes.
This distortion may look like a subtle orange peel pattern, or may look like a drip or sag etched into
the surface of the glass.
Some car wash solutions contain a buffered solution of hydrofluoric acid which is used to clean the
glass. This should not cause a problem if used in the correct concentration. However, if not used
correctly, hydrofluoric acid will attack the glass, and over time, will cause visual distortion in the
outer surface of the glass which cannot be removed by scraping or polishing.
If this condition is suspected, look at the area of the windshield under the wipers or below the belt
seal on the side glass. The area of the glass below the wipers or belt seal will not be affected and
what looks like a drip or sag may be apparent at the edge of the wiper or belt seal. You may also
see a line on the glass where the wiper blade or the belt seal contacts the glass.
Important The repair will require replacing the affected glass and is not a result of a defect in
material or workmanship. Therefore, is not covered by New Vehicle Warranty.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion Information
Front Door Window Glass: Technical Service Bulletins Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-08-48-005D
Date: September 10, 2010
Subject: Distortion in Outer Surface of Vehicle Glass
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X 2010 and Prior Saturn
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-08-48-005C (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Distortion in the outer surface of the windshield glass, door glass or backlite glass may appear after
the vehicle has:
- Accumulated some mileage.
- Been frequently washed in automatic car washes, particularly "touchless" car washes.
This distortion may look like a subtle orange peel pattern, or may look like a drip or sag etched into
the surface of the glass.
Some car wash solutions contain a buffered solution of hydrofluoric acid which is used to clean the
glass. This should not cause a problem if used in the correct concentration. However, if not used
correctly, hydrofluoric acid will attack the glass, and over time, will cause visual distortion in the
outer surface of the glass which cannot be removed by scraping or polishing.
If this condition is suspected, look at the area of the windshield under the wipers or below the belt
seal on the side glass. The area of the glass below the wipers or belt seal will not be affected and
what looks like a drip or sag may be apparent at the edge of the wiper or belt seal. You may also
see a line on the glass where the wiper blade or the belt seal contacts the glass.
Important The repair will require replacing the affected glass and is not a result of a defect in
material or workmanship. Therefore, is not covered by New Vehicle Warranty.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion Information > Page 8125
Front Door Window Glass: Technical Service Bulletins Body - Side Window Chipping Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-08-64-001B
Date: October 20, 2009
Subject: Information on Side Door Window Glass Chipping Caused by Hanging Vehicle Key Lock
Box
Models:
2010 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2, H3
2009 and Prior Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add vehicles and model years and to include all types of
door window glass. Please discard Corporate Bulletin Number 06-08-64-001A (Section 08 - Body &
Accessories).
- In several warranty parts review cases, side door window glass was observed with a chip or chips
on the top side of the window glass. Dealer contacts confirmed that they use a vehicle key lock box
on the front side door window glass.
- A random selection of side door glass returns will be conducted to confirm adherence. If a side
door glass is discovered with a chip or chips in the location previously described, the side door
glass will be returned to the dealership for debit.
Example of Side Door Glass
- DO NOT place a vehicle key lock box on a side door window glass.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Front Door Window Glass > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion Information > Page 8126
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windows > Window Glass > Quarter Window Glass > Component
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion Information
Quarter Window Glass: Technical Service Bulletins Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-08-48-005D
Date: September 10, 2010
Subject: Distortion in Outer Surface of Vehicle Glass
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X 2010 and Prior Saturn
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-08-48-005C (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Distortion in the outer surface of the windshield glass, door glass or backlite glass may appear after
the vehicle has:
- Accumulated some mileage.
- Been frequently washed in automatic car washes, particularly "touchless" car washes.
This distortion may look like a subtle orange peel pattern, or may look like a drip or sag etched into
the surface of the glass.
Some car wash solutions contain a buffered solution of hydrofluoric acid which is used to clean the
glass. This should not cause a problem if used in the correct concentration. However, if not used
correctly, hydrofluoric acid will attack the glass, and over time, will cause visual distortion in the
outer surface of the glass which cannot be removed by scraping or polishing.
If this condition is suspected, look at the area of the windshield under the wipers or below the belt
seal on the side glass. The area of the glass below the wipers or belt seal will not be affected and
what looks like a drip or sag may be apparent at the edge of the wiper or belt seal. You may also
see a line on the glass where the wiper blade or the belt seal contacts the glass.
Important The repair will require replacing the affected glass and is not a result of a defect in
material or workmanship. Therefore, is not covered by New Vehicle Warranty.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 09-08-48-006 > Sep > 09 > Body - Stain/Film On Windshield Glass Perimeter
Windshield: Customer Interest Body - Stain/Film On Windshield Glass Perimeter
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-08-48-006
Date: September 18, 2009
Subject: Clear Stain or Film on Inside Perimeter of Windshield Glass (Clean/Polish Glass)
Models:
2010 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn and Saab) 2010 and Prior HUMMER
H2, H3
Condition
Some customers may comment on a clear stain or film on the inside of the windshield glass. This
condition appears along the outer edges of the glass along the top, bottom or A-pillar areas.
Normal glass cleaning procedures will not remove the stain.
Cause
The assembly plant uses a clear sealer/primer on the outer edge of the windshield glass to improve
adhesion to the urethane adhesive that bonds the windshield glass to the vehicle body. Excess
sealer/primer may drip or flow onto the windshield and cause a stain. Once the sealer/primer dries,
it may appear to have etched the glass.
Correction
Note
A "white" type of toothpaste is recommended for this repair. Gel-type toothpaste may provide less
satisfactory results.
Use a small amount of toothpaste on a soft, cotton cloth to polish the stained area. It may be
necessary to wrap the cloth around a paint stir stick or a similar tool to reach the lower corners of
the windshield glass.
After polishing the glass, clean the inside of the windshield glass with a clean, damp, cotton cloth
and verify all of the stain is removed. Do not use any cleaners or solvents - use only clean warm
water.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 09-08-48-006 > Sep > 09 > Body - Stain/Film On Windshield Glass Perimeter > Page 8139
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
Customer Interest: > 09-08-48-002A > Mar > 09 > Body - Marks/Stains on Windshield When Wet
Windshield: Customer Interest Body - Marks/Stains on Windshield When Wet
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-08-48-002A
Date: March 19, 2009
Subject: Marks/Stains on Windshield When Wet (Clean Windshield)
Models: 2010 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn and Saab) 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the models and model years. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 09-08-48-002 (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Condition
Some owners may comment that marks/stains appear on the windshield when the windshield is
wet.
Cause
This condition may be caused by contact between the windshield and the vacuum hoses or other
tools used in the assembly process. This contact may leave a residue that creates a water repellent
surface on the glass which, in wet conditions, appear as marks/stains on the surface.
Correction
Important
DO NOT REPLACE THE WINDSHIELD FOR THIS CONDITION.
To clean the windshield, use Eastwood Glass Polishing Compound*. Follow the manufacturer's
directions for product use. Use only hand tools. DO NOT USE POWER TOOLS.
Parts Information
Eastwood Glass Polishing Compound
1-800-343-9353 (for overseas inquiries: +1-610-705-2200)
http://www.eastwoodco.com/
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products from this firm or for any such items which may be available from
other sources.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 06-08-43-003C > Feb > 11 > Glass/Body - Windshield Wiper Performance
Windshield: All Technical Service Bulletins Glass/Body - Windshield Wiper Performance
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-08-43-003C
Date: February 21, 2011
Subject: Windshield Wiper Performance, Cleaning Instructions and Maintenance
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2010 and Prior Isuzu Medium Duty Trucks 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 and 2012 model year. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 06-08-43-003B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Wiper Concerns
Most concerns about windshield wiper performance are the result of dirty wiper blades, damaged
wiper blades, or worn out blades that are continuing to be used beyond their useful life. Depending
on environmental conditions, wiper blades can have dramatic differences in lifespan. Here are
some tips and guidelines to maximize wiper performance to avoid damage to the blades, and to
avoid unnecessary replacements.
Many wiper blades are being replaced under warranty with reviews showing there is nothing wrong
with the returned blades other than a build-up of dirt. Additionally, advise the customer to review
the information in their Owner Manual.
Inspection and Cleaning
Scheduled Maintenance
- Inspect your wipers rubber blades every 4-6 months or 12,000 km (7,500 mi) for wear, cracking or
contamination.
- Clean the windshield and the rubber wiper blades (using the procedure below) if the blades are
not clearing the glass satisfactorily. If this does not correct the problem, then replace the rubber
elements.
Cleaning Procedure
Important Avoid getting windshield washer fluid on your hands. Wear rubber gloves or avoid direct
contact with washer fluid.
Important Do not use gasoline, kerosene, or petroleum based products to clean wiper blades.
- Clean the rubber blades using a lint free cloth or paper towel soaked with windshield washer fluid
or a mild detergent. You should see significant amounts of dirt being removed on the cloth.
- Be sure to wash the windshield thoroughly when you clean the blades. Bugs, road grime, sap and
a buildup of car wash/wax treatments may additionally cause wiper streaking.
Tip For a larger scale buildup on the windshield, use a non-abrasive cleaner such as Bon-Ami*
(www.faultless.com) cleanser with a wet sponge, being sure to use plenty of water to avoid
scratching the glass. Flush the surface and body panels completely.
Tip For day-to-day exterior glass cleaning and to maintain a streak free appearance, suggest
Vehicle Care Glass Cleaner, P/N 88862560 (in Canada, 992727). This product is an easy to use
foaming cleaner that quickly removes dirt and grime from glass surfaces.
Tip Interior glass should be cleaned with plain, clean water to eliminate any film or haze on the
window and help prevent fogging, a major customer dissatisfier. Refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 03-00-89-006D for more information. The New Vehicle Pre-Delivery Inspection form also
recommends using plain water to clean interior glass.
*"We believe this material to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such material.
General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any responsibility for the
products or equipment from these firms or any such items which may be available from other
sources.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 06-08-43-003C > Feb > 11 > Glass/Body - Windshield Wiper Performance
> Page 8149
Avoiding Wiper Damage
The following are major contributors to wiper damage. Some of these you can control and others
are environmental concerns.
- Extremely dusty areas (such as driving on dirt roads) may cause the wipers rubber edge to wear
quickly and unevenly.
- Sand and salt used on roads for increasing winter traction and ice control will cause the wiper
blades to wear quicker. Areas with significant snowfall require more frequent blade replacements.
- Heat and time may cause the rubber blades to take a "permanent set" resulting in the rubber not
flexing and turning over uniformly. This condition may result in streaking and/or unwiped areas.
- Rubber blades are easily cut or torn when using ice scrapers. Likewise pulling blades up off a
frozen windshield can tear the rubber. Exercise caution when clearing ice and snow.
- Using your wipers to "wear through" frost and ice, instead of allowing the defrosters to melt the
ice, can dull, nick or tear the rubber blades.
- Banging wipers on the glass to remove ice and snow may cause the blade to bend, dislodging the
rubber and causing potential scratching of the windshield.
- Ice can form in the pin joints of the wipers, which can cause streaking and unwiped areas. To
remove ice from pin joints, compress the blade and rubber edge with your hand to loosen the
frozen joints. Consider using Winter Blades that have a rubber cover to avoid this condition.
Note
GM does not recommend the use of any spray on/wipe on windshield treatments or washer fluid
additives. The variation in friction that results on the glass from the use of these products causes
wipers to chatter and have premature wear.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 00-08-48-005D > Sep > 10 > Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion Information
Windshield: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-08-48-005D
Date: September 10, 2010
Subject: Distortion in Outer Surface of Vehicle Glass
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X 2010 and Prior Saturn
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-08-48-005C (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Distortion in the outer surface of the windshield glass, door glass or backlite glass may appear after
the vehicle has:
- Accumulated some mileage.
- Been frequently washed in automatic car washes, particularly "touchless" car washes.
This distortion may look like a subtle orange peel pattern, or may look like a drip or sag etched into
the surface of the glass.
Some car wash solutions contain a buffered solution of hydrofluoric acid which is used to clean the
glass. This should not cause a problem if used in the correct concentration. However, if not used
correctly, hydrofluoric acid will attack the glass, and over time, will cause visual distortion in the
outer surface of the glass which cannot be removed by scraping or polishing.
If this condition is suspected, look at the area of the windshield under the wipers or below the belt
seal on the side glass. The area of the glass below the wipers or belt seal will not be affected and
what looks like a drip or sag may be apparent at the edge of the wiper or belt seal. You may also
see a line on the glass where the wiper blade or the belt seal contacts the glass.
Important The repair will require replacing the affected glass and is not a result of a defect in
material or workmanship. Therefore, is not covered by New Vehicle Warranty.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 09-08-48-006 > Sep > 09 > Body - Stain/Film On Windshield Glass
Perimeter
Windshield: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Stain/Film On Windshield Glass Perimeter
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-08-48-006
Date: September 18, 2009
Subject: Clear Stain or Film on Inside Perimeter of Windshield Glass (Clean/Polish Glass)
Models:
2010 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn and Saab) 2010 and Prior HUMMER
H2, H3
Condition
Some customers may comment on a clear stain or film on the inside of the windshield glass. This
condition appears along the outer edges of the glass along the top, bottom or A-pillar areas.
Normal glass cleaning procedures will not remove the stain.
Cause
The assembly plant uses a clear sealer/primer on the outer edge of the windshield glass to improve
adhesion to the urethane adhesive that bonds the windshield glass to the vehicle body. Excess
sealer/primer may drip or flow onto the windshield and cause a stain. Once the sealer/primer dries,
it may appear to have etched the glass.
Correction
Note
A "white" type of toothpaste is recommended for this repair. Gel-type toothpaste may provide less
satisfactory results.
Use a small amount of toothpaste on a soft, cotton cloth to polish the stained area. It may be
necessary to wrap the cloth around a paint stir stick or a similar tool to reach the lower corners of
the windshield glass.
After polishing the glass, clean the inside of the windshield glass with a clean, damp, cotton cloth
and verify all of the stain is removed. Do not use any cleaners or solvents - use only clean warm
water.
Warranty Information (excluding Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use:
Warranty Information (Saab U.S. Models)
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 09-08-48-006 > Sep > 09 > Body - Stain/Film On Windshield Glass
Perimeter > Page 8158
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 09-08-48-002A > Mar > 09 > Body - Marks/Stains on Windshield When Wet
Windshield: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Marks/Stains on Windshield When Wet
TECHNICAL
Bulletin No.: 09-08-48-002A
Date: March 19, 2009
Subject: Marks/Stains on Windshield When Wet (Clean Windshield)
Models: 2010 and Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Including Saturn and Saab) 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H2, H3
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to update the models and model years. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 09-08-48-002 (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Condition
Some owners may comment that marks/stains appear on the windshield when the windshield is
wet.
Cause
This condition may be caused by contact between the windshield and the vacuum hoses or other
tools used in the assembly process. This contact may leave a residue that creates a water repellent
surface on the glass which, in wet conditions, appear as marks/stains on the surface.
Correction
Important
DO NOT REPLACE THE WINDSHIELD FOR THIS CONDITION.
To clean the windshield, use Eastwood Glass Polishing Compound*. Follow the manufacturer's
directions for product use. Use only hand tools. DO NOT USE POWER TOOLS.
Parts Information
Eastwood Glass Polishing Compound
1-800-343-9353 (for overseas inquiries: +1-610-705-2200)
http://www.eastwoodco.com/
*We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products from this firm or for any such items which may be available from
other sources.
Warranty Information
For vehicles repaired under warranty, use the table above.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 83-15-16 > Oct > 98 > New Windshield/Glass Urethane Adhesive Caulking
Kit
Windshield: All Technical Service Bulletins New Windshield/Glass Urethane Adhesive Caulking Kit
File In Section: 10 - Body
Bulletin No.: 83-15-16
Date: October, 1998
INFORMATION
Subject: New Windshield and Stationary Glass Urethane Adhesive Caulking Kit
Models: 1990-99 All Passenger Cars and Trucks
As a result of a change from standard viscosity urethane to high-viscosity urethane, a new
Urethane Adhesive Caulking Kit, P/N 12346392, is now available from GMSPO. This kit contains
the "High Viscosity" Urethane Adhesive for thicker and more consistent bead size applications.
When applied properly, this new high viscosity urethane in many instances will eliminate the need
for depth setting blocks or the damming material to control squeeze out. The following is the
contents of the new kit:
Like the standard viscosity urethane contained in kit (P/N 12346284) that it replaces, it is a
one-part, moisture cure product with curing times that vary as a result of changes in either
temperature or humidity.
THE REQUIRED TIME FOR THIS NEW ONE-PART MATERIAL to ensure a safe installation of
stationary glass before returning the vehicle to the customer, IS A MINIMUM OF SIX (6) HOURS
AT 70°F (21°C) AND 30% RELATIVE HUMIDITY.
Alternate equivalent materials for this kit may be available from a local glass repair shop under the
following product numbers:
Other manufacturers of Urethane Adhesive that have documented their ability to meet or exceed
General Motors specification # 3651M (Performance Requirements for Stationary Glass Bonding
Adhesive System Service) are also considered to be equivalent to GM Kit (P/N 12346392).
In previously published Corporate Bulletin Number 73-10-54, increasing customer demands for
faster service have resulted in quicker two-part urethane adhesives to be made available. Essex
Beta Seal U216* (two-part urethane adhesive) also meets the General Motors 3651M Specification
and can be
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 83-15-16 > Oct > 98 > New Windshield/Glass Urethane Adhesive Caulking
Kit > Page 8167
used when the customer demands quicker repair of the vehicle than the above described one-part
product can provide.
This two-part, chemical cure product requires ONE (1) TO ONE-AND-ONE-HALF (1-1/2) HOURS
FOR CURING BEFORE RETURNING THE VEHICLE TO THE CUSTOMER. This two-part product
also requires primers on the glass and pinchweld surfaces. The primers and applicator daubers are
not included with this two-part product and therefore, must be purchased separately. In addition,
this two-part product requires a special applicator (gun) for proper mixing and dispensing of the
adhesive.
Important:
The U216 product is NOT available from GMSPO and must be obtained locally.
* We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such products. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products from this firm or for any such products which may be available from
other sources.
When using either of the above described products, make sure to follow the manufacturer's
directions for application and drying times. For information regarding the removal and installation of
stationary glass, consult the appropriate Service Manual.
Parts information
P/N Description
12346392 Urethane Adhesive Caulking Kit
Parts are expected to be available from GMSPO, 10/12/98.
Important:
The previously recommended adhesive kit (P/N 12346284) will no longer be available from
GMSPO once inventory is exhausted.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 72-05-04 > Aug > 97 > Warranty - Guidelines for Claiming Windshield
Replace
Windshield: All Technical Service Bulletins Warranty - Guidelines for Claiming Windshield Replace
File In Section: Warranty Administration
Bulletin No.: 72-05-04
Date: August, 1997
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
Subject: Guidelines for Claiming C0034 - Windshield Replacement
Models: 1989-98 Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide retail and wholesale service personnel with guidelines for
using the above subject labor operations.
In an effort to understand the windshield replacements, the following two phase approval process is
being implemented. We feel this approach will allow GM to be responsive to repair decisions on
vehicles over 10,000 miles (16,000KMS), while providing you, our dealers, the empowerment to
address customer needs on those cases requiring repairs early in the vehicle's life, under 10,000
miles (16,000KMS).
Effective with repair orders dated on or after September 1, 1997, dealers are to be guided by the
following:
^ Windshield replacement on vehicles under 10,000 miles (16,0OOKMS) can only be made after
Service Management inspection, review and approval. This approval must be noted on the repair
order clearly identifying the defect and reason for replacement. This comment must be submitted in
the comment field of the claim for engineering review.
^ Windshield replacement on vehicles over 10,000 miles (16,000KMS) can only be made after
Service Management inspection, review and approval from the divisional service representative.
Vehicles may be required to be held for wholesale inspection. This approval must be noted on the
repair order clearly identifying the defect and reason for replacement. This comment must be
submitted in the comment field of the claim for engineering review. The claim will require wholesale
authorization for payment.
Additional Requirements
^ Windshields replaced must be held for the normal parts retention period and the defect should be
clearly identified on the glass by means of tape and/or a grease pencil.
^ Sublet windshield replacements, like other sublet repairs are to be claimed for actual dealership
cost less any discounts and or allowances offered. Sublet repairs cannot exceed the normal
allowance provided to the dealership had the repair been completed in-house. See your GM Policy
and Procedure Manual for the complete guidelines.
Windshields damaged by normal wear, road hazards, vandalism, or other physical damage are not
eligible for warranty coverage.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Technical Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 73-10-54 > May > 97 > Windshield - Two-Part Urethane Adhesive For
Installation
Windshield: All Technical Service Bulletins Windshield - Two-Part Urethane Adhesive For
Installation
File In Section: 10 - Body
Bulletin No.: 73-10-54
Date: May, 1997
INFORMATION
Subject: Two-Part Urethane Adhesive For Windshield Installations
Models: 1997 And Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Using Urethane Adhesive To Retain
Windshields)
General Motors passenger cars and trucks use urethane adhesive as a means to retain the
windshield in the body opening. The urethane adhesive is used to bond the windshield in the
opening, increasing vehicle structure.
The current recommended urethane adhesive, GM P/N 12346284, is a one-part moisture cure
product that requires a minimum curing period of 6 hours at room temperature before returning the
vehicle to the customer.
Increasing customer demands for faster service in recent years have resulted in quicker cure
two-part urethane adhesives.
Essex Beta Seal U216* (two-part urethane adhesive) meets the General Motors 3651M
Specification (Performance Requirements for Stationary Glass Bonding Adhesive System Service)
and can be used when the customer demands quicker repair of the vehicle than the current
one-part materials can provide.
Either of these products can be used when glass replacement is performed. The differences
between these products are as follows:
The CURRENT URETHANE ADHESIVE KIT, GM P/N 12346284, IS A ONE-PART ADHESIVE. It
includes the necessary glass and pinchweld primers and is specified in Service Manuals for
General Motors' vehicles. Since this is a "moisture cure" product, the curing time for this one-part
material will vary with changes to either temperature or humidity. The REQUIRED TIME FOR THIS
ONE-PART
MATERIAL to ensure a safe installation of stationary glass before returning the vehicle to the
customer IS A MINIMUM OF SIX (6) HOURS AT 70°F (21°C) AND 30% RELATIVE HUMIDITY.
ESSEX BETA SEAL U216 IS A TWO-PART ADHESIVE MATERIAL THAT PROVIDES FOR A
ONE (1) TO ONE AND ONE HALF (11/2) HOUR CURE BEFORE RETURNING THE VEHICLE TO
THE CUSTOMER. This product also requires primers on the glass and pinchweld surfaces. This
product requires a special applicator for the mixing and dispensing of the adhesive.
When using this (or any) product, make sure to follow the manufacturer's directions for application
and drying times.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
* We believe this source and their product to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products from this firm or for any such products which may be available from
other sources.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 06-08-43-003C > Feb > 11 > Glass/Body - Windshield Wiper Performance
Windshield: All Technical Service Bulletins Glass/Body - Windshield Wiper Performance
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-08-43-003C
Date: February 21, 2011
Subject: Windshield Wiper Performance, Cleaning Instructions and Maintenance
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2010 and Prior Isuzu Medium Duty Trucks 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 and 2012 model year. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 06-08-43-003B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Wiper Concerns
Most concerns about windshield wiper performance are the result of dirty wiper blades, damaged
wiper blades, or worn out blades that are continuing to be used beyond their useful life. Depending
on environmental conditions, wiper blades can have dramatic differences in lifespan. Here are
some tips and guidelines to maximize wiper performance to avoid damage to the blades, and to
avoid unnecessary replacements.
Many wiper blades are being replaced under warranty with reviews showing there is nothing wrong
with the returned blades other than a build-up of dirt. Additionally, advise the customer to review
the information in their Owner Manual.
Inspection and Cleaning
Scheduled Maintenance
- Inspect your wipers rubber blades every 4-6 months or 12,000 km (7,500 mi) for wear, cracking or
contamination.
- Clean the windshield and the rubber wiper blades (using the procedure below) if the blades are
not clearing the glass satisfactorily. If this does not correct the problem, then replace the rubber
elements.
Cleaning Procedure
Important Avoid getting windshield washer fluid on your hands. Wear rubber gloves or avoid direct
contact with washer fluid.
Important Do not use gasoline, kerosene, or petroleum based products to clean wiper blades.
- Clean the rubber blades using a lint free cloth or paper towel soaked with windshield washer fluid
or a mild detergent. You should see significant amounts of dirt being removed on the cloth.
- Be sure to wash the windshield thoroughly when you clean the blades. Bugs, road grime, sap and
a buildup of car wash/wax treatments may additionally cause wiper streaking.
Tip For a larger scale buildup on the windshield, use a non-abrasive cleaner such as Bon-Ami*
(www.faultless.com) cleanser with a wet sponge, being sure to use plenty of water to avoid
scratching the glass. Flush the surface and body panels completely.
Tip For day-to-day exterior glass cleaning and to maintain a streak free appearance, suggest
Vehicle Care Glass Cleaner, P/N 88862560 (in Canada, 992727). This product is an easy to use
foaming cleaner that quickly removes dirt and grime from glass surfaces.
Tip Interior glass should be cleaned with plain, clean water to eliminate any film or haze on the
window and help prevent fogging, a major customer dissatisfier. Refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 03-00-89-006D for more information. The New Vehicle Pre-Delivery Inspection form also
recommends using plain water to clean interior glass.
*"We believe this material to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such material.
General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any responsibility for the
products or equipment from these firms or any such items which may be available from other
sources.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 06-08-43-003C > Feb > 11 > Glass/Body - Windshield Wiper Performance >
Page 8181
Avoiding Wiper Damage
The following are major contributors to wiper damage. Some of these you can control and others
are environmental concerns.
- Extremely dusty areas (such as driving on dirt roads) may cause the wipers rubber edge to wear
quickly and unevenly.
- Sand and salt used on roads for increasing winter traction and ice control will cause the wiper
blades to wear quicker. Areas with significant snowfall require more frequent blade replacements.
- Heat and time may cause the rubber blades to take a "permanent set" resulting in the rubber not
flexing and turning over uniformly. This condition may result in streaking and/or unwiped areas.
- Rubber blades are easily cut or torn when using ice scrapers. Likewise pulling blades up off a
frozen windshield can tear the rubber. Exercise caution when clearing ice and snow.
- Using your wipers to "wear through" frost and ice, instead of allowing the defrosters to melt the
ice, can dull, nick or tear the rubber blades.
- Banging wipers on the glass to remove ice and snow may cause the blade to bend, dislodging the
rubber and causing potential scratching of the windshield.
- Ice can form in the pin joints of the wipers, which can cause streaking and unwiped areas. To
remove ice from pin joints, compress the blade and rubber edge with your hand to loosen the
frozen joints. Consider using Winter Blades that have a rubber cover to avoid this condition.
Note
GM does not recommend the use of any spray on/wipe on windshield treatments or washer fluid
additives. The variation in friction that results on the glass from the use of these products causes
wipers to chatter and have premature wear.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 00-08-48-005D > Sep > 10 > Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion Information
Windshield: All Technical Service Bulletins Body - Vehicle Glass Distortion Information
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 00-08-48-005D
Date: September 10, 2010
Subject: Distortion in Outer Surface of Vehicle Glass
Models:
2011 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks 2009 and Prior HUMMER H2 2010 and Prior
HUMMER H3 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X 2010 and Prior Saturn
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add model years. Please discard Corporate Bulletin
Number 00-08-48-005C (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Distortion in the outer surface of the windshield glass, door glass or backlite glass may appear after
the vehicle has:
- Accumulated some mileage.
- Been frequently washed in automatic car washes, particularly "touchless" car washes.
This distortion may look like a subtle orange peel pattern, or may look like a drip or sag etched into
the surface of the glass.
Some car wash solutions contain a buffered solution of hydrofluoric acid which is used to clean the
glass. This should not cause a problem if used in the correct concentration. However, if not used
correctly, hydrofluoric acid will attack the glass, and over time, will cause visual distortion in the
outer surface of the glass which cannot be removed by scraping or polishing.
If this condition is suspected, look at the area of the windshield under the wipers or below the belt
seal on the side glass. The area of the glass below the wipers or belt seal will not be affected and
what looks like a drip or sag may be apparent at the edge of the wiper or belt seal. You may also
see a line on the glass where the wiper blade or the belt seal contacts the glass.
Important The repair will require replacing the affected glass and is not a result of a defect in
material or workmanship. Therefore, is not covered by New Vehicle Warranty.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 83-15-16 > Oct > 98 > New Windshield/Glass Urethane Adhesive Caulking Kit
Windshield: All Technical Service Bulletins New Windshield/Glass Urethane Adhesive Caulking Kit
File In Section: 10 - Body
Bulletin No.: 83-15-16
Date: October, 1998
INFORMATION
Subject: New Windshield and Stationary Glass Urethane Adhesive Caulking Kit
Models: 1990-99 All Passenger Cars and Trucks
As a result of a change from standard viscosity urethane to high-viscosity urethane, a new
Urethane Adhesive Caulking Kit, P/N 12346392, is now available from GMSPO. This kit contains
the "High Viscosity" Urethane Adhesive for thicker and more consistent bead size applications.
When applied properly, this new high viscosity urethane in many instances will eliminate the need
for depth setting blocks or the damming material to control squeeze out. The following is the
contents of the new kit:
Like the standard viscosity urethane contained in kit (P/N 12346284) that it replaces, it is a
one-part, moisture cure product with curing times that vary as a result of changes in either
temperature or humidity.
THE REQUIRED TIME FOR THIS NEW ONE-PART MATERIAL to ensure a safe installation of
stationary glass before returning the vehicle to the customer, IS A MINIMUM OF SIX (6) HOURS
AT 70°F (21°C) AND 30% RELATIVE HUMIDITY.
Alternate equivalent materials for this kit may be available from a local glass repair shop under the
following product numbers:
Other manufacturers of Urethane Adhesive that have documented their ability to meet or exceed
General Motors specification # 3651M (Performance Requirements for Stationary Glass Bonding
Adhesive System Service) are also considered to be equivalent to GM Kit (P/N 12346392).
In previously published Corporate Bulletin Number 73-10-54, increasing customer demands for
faster service have resulted in quicker two-part urethane adhesives to be made available. Essex
Beta Seal U216* (two-part urethane adhesive) also meets the General Motors 3651M Specification
and can be
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 83-15-16 > Oct > 98 > New Windshield/Glass Urethane Adhesive Caulking Kit
> Page 8190
used when the customer demands quicker repair of the vehicle than the above described one-part
product can provide.
This two-part, chemical cure product requires ONE (1) TO ONE-AND-ONE-HALF (1-1/2) HOURS
FOR CURING BEFORE RETURNING THE VEHICLE TO THE CUSTOMER. This two-part product
also requires primers on the glass and pinchweld surfaces. The primers and applicator daubers are
not included with this two-part product and therefore, must be purchased separately. In addition,
this two-part product requires a special applicator (gun) for proper mixing and dispensing of the
adhesive.
Important:
The U216 product is NOT available from GMSPO and must be obtained locally.
* We believe this source and their products to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers
of such products. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products from this firm or for any such products which may be available from
other sources.
When using either of the above described products, make sure to follow the manufacturer's
directions for application and drying times. For information regarding the removal and installation of
stationary glass, consult the appropriate Service Manual.
Parts information
P/N Description
12346392 Urethane Adhesive Caulking Kit
Parts are expected to be available from GMSPO, 10/12/98.
Important:
The previously recommended adhesive kit (P/N 12346284) will no longer be available from
GMSPO once inventory is exhausted.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 72-05-04 > Aug > 97 > Warranty - Guidelines for Claiming Windshield Replace
Windshield: All Technical Service Bulletins Warranty - Guidelines for Claiming Windshield Replace
File In Section: Warranty Administration
Bulletin No.: 72-05-04
Date: August, 1997
WARRANTY ADMINISTRATION
Subject: Guidelines for Claiming C0034 - Windshield Replacement
Models: 1989-98 Passenger Cars and Light Duty Trucks
The purpose of this bulletin is to provide retail and wholesale service personnel with guidelines for
using the above subject labor operations.
In an effort to understand the windshield replacements, the following two phase approval process is
being implemented. We feel this approach will allow GM to be responsive to repair decisions on
vehicles over 10,000 miles (16,000KMS), while providing you, our dealers, the empowerment to
address customer needs on those cases requiring repairs early in the vehicle's life, under 10,000
miles (16,000KMS).
Effective with repair orders dated on or after September 1, 1997, dealers are to be guided by the
following:
^ Windshield replacement on vehicles under 10,000 miles (16,0OOKMS) can only be made after
Service Management inspection, review and approval. This approval must be noted on the repair
order clearly identifying the defect and reason for replacement. This comment must be submitted in
the comment field of the claim for engineering review.
^ Windshield replacement on vehicles over 10,000 miles (16,000KMS) can only be made after
Service Management inspection, review and approval from the divisional service representative.
Vehicles may be required to be held for wholesale inspection. This approval must be noted on the
repair order clearly identifying the defect and reason for replacement. This comment must be
submitted in the comment field of the claim for engineering review. The claim will require wholesale
authorization for payment.
Additional Requirements
^ Windshields replaced must be held for the normal parts retention period and the defect should be
clearly identified on the glass by means of tape and/or a grease pencil.
^ Sublet windshield replacements, like other sublet repairs are to be claimed for actual dealership
cost less any discounts and or allowances offered. Sublet repairs cannot exceed the normal
allowance provided to the dealership had the repair been completed in-house. See your GM Policy
and Procedure Manual for the complete guidelines.
Windshields damaged by normal wear, road hazards, vandalism, or other physical damage are not
eligible for warranty coverage.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Windows and Glass > Windshield > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins >
All Other Service Bulletins for Windshield: > 73-10-54 > May > 97 > Windshield - Two-Part Urethane Adhesive For
Installation
Windshield: All Technical Service Bulletins Windshield - Two-Part Urethane Adhesive For
Installation
File In Section: 10 - Body
Bulletin No.: 73-10-54
Date: May, 1997
INFORMATION
Subject: Two-Part Urethane Adhesive For Windshield Installations
Models: 1997 And Prior Passenger Cars and Trucks (Using Urethane Adhesive To Retain
Windshields)
General Motors passenger cars and trucks use urethane adhesive as a means to retain the
windshield in the body opening. The urethane adhesive is used to bond the windshield in the
opening, increasing vehicle structure.
The current recommended urethane adhesive, GM P/N 12346284, is a one-part moisture cure
product that requires a minimum curing period of 6 hours at room temperature before returning the
vehicle to the customer.
Increasing customer demands for faster service in recent years have resulted in quicker cure
two-part urethane adhesives.
Essex Beta Seal U216* (two-part urethane adhesive) meets the General Motors 3651M
Specification (Performance Requirements for Stationary Glass Bonding Adhesive System Service)
and can be used when the customer demands quicker repair of the vehicle than the current
one-part materials can provide.
Either of these products can be used when glass replacement is performed. The differences
between these products are as follows:
The CURRENT URETHANE ADHESIVE KIT, GM P/N 12346284, IS A ONE-PART ADHESIVE. It
includes the necessary glass and pinchweld primers and is specified in Service Manuals for
General Motors' vehicles. Since this is a "moisture cure" product, the curing time for this one-part
material will vary with changes to either temperature or humidity. The REQUIRED TIME FOR THIS
ONE-PART
MATERIAL to ensure a safe installation of stationary glass before returning the vehicle to the
customer IS A MINIMUM OF SIX (6) HOURS AT 70°F (21°C) AND 30% RELATIVE HUMIDITY.
ESSEX BETA SEAL U216 IS A TWO-PART ADHESIVE MATERIAL THAT PROVIDES FOR A
ONE (1) TO ONE AND ONE HALF (11/2) HOUR CURE BEFORE RETURNING THE VEHICLE TO
THE CUSTOMER. This product also requires primers on the glass and pinchweld surfaces. This
product requires a special applicator for the mixing and dispensing of the adhesive.
When using this (or any) product, make sure to follow the manufacturer's directions for application
and drying times.
Parts Information
Parts are currently available from GMSPO.
* We believe this source and their product to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of
such products. General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any
responsibility for the products from this firm or for any such products which may be available from
other sources.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems >
Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems >
Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 8205
LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper
Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair
Fig. 13 Wiper Switch Removal
WARNING:
On models equipped with Airbags, Refer to Air Bags (Supplemental Restraint Systems) Service
and Repair Disarming procedures before performing any repair. See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag
Systems/Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Remove horn pad and steering wheel. Refer to Steering and
Suspension / Steering / Steering Wheel. See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Wheel/Service and Repair
3. Remove tilt lever from column, if equipped, Fig. 13. 4. Remove upper and lower steering column
covers. 5. Remove dampener assembly, then the headlight switch assembly. 6. Remove
windshield wiper switch assembly. 7. Reverse procedure to install.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid Level Indicator > Component Information >
Description and Operation
Washer Fluid Level Indicator: Description and Operation
There are two types of low washer fluid indicating systems. They are the mechanical type and
electrically controlled type. The mechanical type consists of a float and rod assembly, sending unit
and a fiber optic. The electrically controlled type consists of a float, magnet, contact points and a
resistor.
On the mechanical type, the upper end of the rod extends into the sending unit and has colored red
and green portions. When the windshield wipers are activated, a lamp bulb in the sending unit
lights either the red or green sections of the rod. The colored light is then picked up by the fiber
optic and is transmitted through it to the telltale lens. The lens will show red or green depending
upon washer fluid level.
The electrically controlled type, has an indicator that is activated when the windshield wipers are
engaged. A slight amount of current flows from the wiper motor to the washer bottle float unit. This
current will either pass through the contact points or the resistor which is in parallel with the points.
When the washer fluid level is high, the magnet holds the contact points open. The current will now
flow through the resistor where it is reduced so the indicator will not light. When the washer fluid
level is low, the float drops and the magnet will separate from the cap assembly allowing the
current to pass through the contact points and activate the indicator light.
On the mechanical indicating system, if the telltale lens fails to glow when the windshield wipers
are activated, check lamp bulb in sending unit and see that fiber optic is not broken.
On the electrically controlled system, the first item to check is the indicator bulb. With the
windshield wipers On, connect a jumper wire between the two terminals on the washer bottle cap.
The indicator should then light. If not, replace bulb. If the bulb is found to be satisfactory, remove
cap and float assembly from washer bottle. The float should be able to move to the bottom of the
stem and the magnet should separate from the cap. If not, replace float and cap assembly.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Motor > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Washer Will Not Operate
Windshield Washer Motor: Testing and Inspection Washer Will Not Operate
Permanent Magnet Depressed Park System
Fig. 73 Test 8: Washer Will Not Operate.
Permanent Magnet Positive Park System
Fig. 8 Chart 6: Washer Will Not Operate
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Motor > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Washer Will Not Operate > Page 8216
Windshield Washer Motor: Testing and Inspection Washer Will Not Shut Off
Fig. 74 Test 9: Washer Will Not Shut Off.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Pump > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Lower LH Front Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Pump > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 8221
Lower LH Front Front Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield Washer Switch > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 8226
LH Side Of I/P
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Glass/Body - Windshield Wiper Performance
Wiper Blade: Technical Service Bulletins Glass/Body - Windshield Wiper Performance
INFORMATION
Bulletin No.: 06-08-43-003C
Date: February 21, 2011
Subject: Windshield Wiper Performance, Cleaning Instructions and Maintenance
Models:
2012 and Prior GM Passenger Cars and Trucks (including Saturn) 2010 and Prior HUMMER H2,
H3 2010 and Prior Isuzu Medium Duty Trucks 2005-2009 Saab 9-7X
Supercede: This bulletin is being revised to add the 2011 and 2012 model year. Please discard
Corporate Bulletin Number 06-08-43-003B (Section 08 - Body and Accessories).
Wiper Concerns
Most concerns about windshield wiper performance are the result of dirty wiper blades, damaged
wiper blades, or worn out blades that are continuing to be used beyond their useful life. Depending
on environmental conditions, wiper blades can have dramatic differences in lifespan. Here are
some tips and guidelines to maximize wiper performance to avoid damage to the blades, and to
avoid unnecessary replacements.
Many wiper blades are being replaced under warranty with reviews showing there is nothing wrong
with the returned blades other than a build-up of dirt. Additionally, advise the customer to review
the information in their Owner Manual.
Inspection and Cleaning
Scheduled Maintenance
- Inspect your wipers rubber blades every 4-6 months or 12,000 km (7,500 mi) for wear, cracking or
contamination.
- Clean the windshield and the rubber wiper blades (using the procedure below) if the blades are
not clearing the glass satisfactorily. If this does not correct the problem, then replace the rubber
elements.
Cleaning Procedure
Important Avoid getting windshield washer fluid on your hands. Wear rubber gloves or avoid direct
contact with washer fluid.
Important Do not use gasoline, kerosene, or petroleum based products to clean wiper blades.
- Clean the rubber blades using a lint free cloth or paper towel soaked with windshield washer fluid
or a mild detergent. You should see significant amounts of dirt being removed on the cloth.
- Be sure to wash the windshield thoroughly when you clean the blades. Bugs, road grime, sap and
a buildup of car wash/wax treatments may additionally cause wiper streaking.
Tip For a larger scale buildup on the windshield, use a non-abrasive cleaner such as Bon-Ami*
(www.faultless.com) cleanser with a wet sponge, being sure to use plenty of water to avoid
scratching the glass. Flush the surface and body panels completely.
Tip For day-to-day exterior glass cleaning and to maintain a streak free appearance, suggest
Vehicle Care Glass Cleaner, P/N 88862560 (in Canada, 992727). This product is an easy to use
foaming cleaner that quickly removes dirt and grime from glass surfaces.
Tip Interior glass should be cleaned with plain, clean water to eliminate any film or haze on the
window and help prevent fogging, a major customer dissatisfier. Refer to Corporate Bulletin
Number 03-00-89-006D for more information. The New Vehicle Pre-Delivery Inspection form also
recommends using plain water to clean interior glass.
*"We believe this material to be reliable. There may be additional manufacturers of such material.
General Motors does not endorse, indicate any preference for or assume any responsibility for the
products or equipment from these firms or any such items which may be available from other
sources.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Blade > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Glass/Body - Windshield Wiper Performance > Page 8231
Avoiding Wiper Damage
The following are major contributors to wiper damage. Some of these you can control and others
are environmental concerns.
- Extremely dusty areas (such as driving on dirt roads) may cause the wipers rubber edge to wear
quickly and unevenly.
- Sand and salt used on roads for increasing winter traction and ice control will cause the wiper
blades to wear quicker. Areas with significant snowfall require more frequent blade replacements.
- Heat and time may cause the rubber blades to take a "permanent set" resulting in the rubber not
flexing and turning over uniformly. This condition may result in streaking and/or unwiped areas.
- Rubber blades are easily cut or torn when using ice scrapers. Likewise pulling blades up off a
frozen windshield can tear the rubber. Exercise caution when clearing ice and snow.
- Using your wipers to "wear through" frost and ice, instead of allowing the defrosters to melt the
ice, can dull, nick or tear the rubber blades.
- Banging wipers on the glass to remove ice and snow may cause the blade to bend, dislodging the
rubber and causing potential scratching of the windshield.
- Ice can form in the pin joints of the wipers, which can cause streaking and unwiped areas. To
remove ice from pin joints, compress the blade and rubber edge with your hand to loosen the
frozen joints. Consider using Winter Blades that have a rubber cover to avoid this condition.
Note
GM does not recommend the use of any spray on/wipe on windshield treatments or washer fluid
additives. The variation in friction that results on the glass from the use of these products causes
wipers to chatter and have premature wear.
Disclaimer
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Gear Box > Component Information > Service and
Repair
Wiper Gear Box: Service and Repair
1. Remove wiper arms from transmission spindle shafts.
2. Remove shroud top vent grille panel and screen.
3. Loosen, but do not remove, transmission drive link to motor crank arm attaching nuts then pull
drive link from motor crank arm.
4. Remove transmission to cowl panel attaching screws and the transmission assembly.
5. Reverse procedure to install. Torque wiper transmission attaching screws and nuts to 64 inch
lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations
Center Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Locations >
Component Locations > Page 8239
Center Rear Of Engine Compartment
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Locations > Page
8240
Harness Connector Faces: Wiper Motor Assembly
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Motor > Component Information > Locations > Page
8241
Wiper Motor: Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Remove wiper arms from transmission spindle shafts.
3. Remove shroud top vent grille panel and screen.
4. Loosen, but do not remove, transmission drive link to motor crank arm attaching nuts, then pull
drive link out of motor crank arm.
5. Disconnect wiper motor electrical connections and remove wiper motor attaching bolts.
6. Rotate wiper motor upward and outward, and remove from vehicle.
7. Reverse procedure to install. Torque wiper motor attaching bolts to 48 inch lbs.
Chevrolet Cavalier Workshop Manual (Cavalier-Z24 V6-191 3.1L VIN T MFI (1994))
Chevrolet Workshop Manuals > Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch > Component Information > Service and Repair
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair
Fig. 13 Wiper Switch Removal
WARNING:
On models equipped with Airbags, Refer to Air Bags (Supplemental Restraint Systems) Service
and Repair Disarming procedures before performing any repair. See: Restraint Systems/Air Bag
Systems/Service and Repair
1. Disconnect battery ground cable. 2. Remove horn pad and steering wheel. Refer to Steering and
Suspension / Steering / Steering Wheel. See: Steering and
Suspension/Steering/Steering Wheel/Service and Repair
3. Remove tilt lever from column, if equipped, Fig. 13. 4. Remove upper and lower steering column
covers. 5. Remove dampener assembly, then the headlight switch assembly. 6. Remove
windshield wiper switch assembly. 7. Reverse procedure to install.